--- /dev/null
+Description: Documentation and .ini files from ckermit-211
+ These files are not shipped with betas.
+
+
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckututor.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,1959 @@
++
++C-KERMIT 8.0 UNIX MANUAL PAGE AND TUTORIAL
++
++ Frank da Cruz, Christine M. Gianone
++ [1]The Kermit Project, [2]Columbia University
++
++ [ [3]PDF version ] [ [4]Nroff version ]
++
++ This document is intended to give the beginner sufficient
++ information to make basic (if not advanced) use of C-Kermit 8.0.
++ Although it might be rather long for a Unix manual page (about 1600
++ lines), it's still far shorter than the C-Kermit manual, which
++ should be consulted for advanced topics such as customization,
++ character-sets, scripting, etc. We also attempt to provide a clear
++ structural overview of C-Kermit's many capabilities, functional
++ areas, states, and modes and their interrelation, that should be
++ helpful to beginners and veterans alike, as well as to those
++ upgrading to the new release.
++
++ Most recent update: 24 October 2002
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ CONTENTS
++ * [5]DESCRIPTION
++ * [6]SYNOPSIS
++ * [7]OPTIONS
++ * [8]COMMAND LANGUAGE
++ * [9]INITIALIZATION FILE
++ * [10]MODES OF OPERATION
++ * [11]MAKING CONNECTIONS
++ * [12]TRANSFERRING FILES WITH KERMIT
++ * [13]KERMIT CLIENT/SERVER CONNECTIONS
++ * [14]KERMIT'S BUILT-IN FTP AND HTTP CLIENTS
++ * [15]INTERNET KERMIT SERVICE
++ * [16]SECURITY
++ * [17]ALTERNATIVE COMMAND-LINE PERSONALITIES
++ * [18]LICENSE
++ * [19]OTHER TOPICS
++ * [20]DOCUMENTATION AND UPDATES
++ * [21]FILES
++ * [22]AUTHORS
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ DESCRIPTION [ [23]Top ] [ [24]Contents ] [ [25]Next ]
++
++ [26]C-Kermit is an all-purpose communications software package from
++ the [27]Kermit Project at [28]Columbia University that:
++
++ * Is portable to many platforms, Unix and non-Unix alike.
++ * Can make both serial and network connections.
++ * Can conduct interactive terminal sessions over its connection.
++ * Can transfer text or binary files over the same connection.
++ * Can convert text-file character sets in terminal mode or file
++ transfer.
++ * Is customizable in every aspect of its operation.
++
++ C-Kermit is a modem program, a Telnet client, an Rlogin client, an FTP
++ client, an HTTP client, and on selected platforms, also an X.25
++ client. It can make its own secure Internet connections using
++ IETF-approved security methods including Kerberos IV, Kerberos V,
++ SSL/TLS, and SRP and it can also make SSH (Secure Shell) connections
++ through your external SSH client application. It can be the far-end
++ file-transfer or client/server partner of your desktop Kermit client.
++ It can also accept incoming dialed and network connections. It can
++ even be installed as an Internet service on its own standard TCP
++ socket, 1649 [[29]RFC2839, [30]RFC2840].
++
++ And perhaps most important, everything you can do "by hand"
++ (interactively) with C-Kermit, can be "scripted" (automated) using its
++ built-in cross-platform transport-independent script programming
++ language, which happens to be identical to its interactive command
++ language.
++
++ This manual page offers an overview of C-Kermit 8.0 for Unix ("Unix"
++ is an operating system family that includes AIX, DG/UX, FreeBSD,
++ HP-UX, IRIX, Linux, Mac OS X, NetBSD, OpenBSD, Open Server, Open Unix,
++ QNX, Solaris, SunOS, System V R3, System V R4, Tru64 Unix, Unixware,
++ Xenix, and many others). For thorough coverage, please consult the
++ published C-Kermit manual and supplements (see [31]DOCUMENTATION
++ below). For further information about C-Kermit, Kermit software for
++ other platforms, and Kermit manuals, visit the Kermit Project website:
++
++ [32]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++
++ This is a longer-than-average manual page, and yet it barely scratches
++ the surface. Don't be daunted. C-Kermit is a large and complex
++ package, evolving over decades of practice and experience, but that
++ doesn't mean it's hard to learn or use. Its most commonly used
++ functions are explained here with pointers to additional information
++ elsewhere.
++
++ [ [33]Kermit Home ] [ [34]C-Kermit Home ] [ [35]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ SYNOPSIS [ [36]Top ] [ [37]Contents ] [ [38]Next ] [ [39]Previous ]
++
++ Usage: kermit [filename] [-x arg [-x arg]...[-yyy]..] [ {=,--,+} text
++ ] ]
++ Or: kermit URL
++
++ * -x is an option requiring an argument;
++ * -y is an option with no argument.
++
++ If the first command-line argument is the name of a file,
++ interactive-mode commands are executed from the file. The '=' (or
++ "--") argument tells Kermit not to parse the remainder of the command
++ line, but to make the words following '=' available as \%1, \%2, ...
++ \%9. The "+" argument is like "=" but for use in "kerbang scripts"
++ (explained [40]below). A second command-line format allows the one and
++ only argument to be a [41]Telnet, FTP, HTTP, or IKSD URL.
++
++ Order of execution:
++
++ 1. [42]The command file (if any).
++ 2. [43]The initialization file, if any, unless suppressed with -Y.
++ 3. [44]The customization file (if it is executed by the
++ initialization file).
++ 4. [45]The command-line URL (if any, and if so, execution stops
++ here).
++ 5. [46]Command-line options (if any).
++ 6. [47]Interactive commands.
++
++ Some command-line options can cause actions (such as -s to send a
++ file); others just set parameters. If any action options are included
++ on the command line, Kermit exits when finished unless also given the
++ -S ("stay") option. If no action options are given, no initialization
++ or command files contained an EXIT or QUIT command, and no fatal
++ errors occurred, Kermit issues its prompt and waits for you to type
++ commands.
++
++ Bear in mind that C-Kermit can be built with selected features
++ disabled, and also that certain features are not available on all
++ platforms. For example, C-Kermit can't be built with TCP/IP support
++ on a platform that does not have TCP/IP header files and libraries
++ (and even if Kermit does include TCP/IP support, it can't be used
++ to make TCP/IP connections on a computer that does not have a
++ TCP/IP stack installed). If your version of C-Kermit lacks a
++ feature mentioned here, use its SHOW FEATURES command to see what
++ might have been excluded.
++
++ C-Kermit has three kinds of commands: regular single-letter
++ command-line options, extended-format command-line options, and
++ interactive commands.
++
++ [ [48]Kermit Home ] [ [49]C-Kermit Home ] [ [50]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ OPTIONS [ [51]Top ] [ [52]Contents ] [ [53]Next ] [ [54]Previous ]
++
++ Like most Unix commands, C-Kermit can be be given options on the
++ command line. But C-Kermit also can be used interactively by giving it
++ [55]commands composed of words, which are more intuitive than cryptic
++ command-line options, and more flexible too. In other words, you don't
++ have to use C-Kermit's command-line options, but they are available if
++ you want to. (By the same token, you don't have to use its interactive
++ commands either -- you can use either or both in any combination.)
++
++ C-Kermit is generally installed in the PATH as "kermit", and therefore
++ is invoked by typing the word "kermit" (lowercase) at the shell
++ prompt, and then pressing the Return or Enter key. If you wish to
++ include command-line options, put them after the word "kermit" but
++ before pressing Return or Enter, separated by spaces, for example:
++
++ $ kermit -s ckermit.tar.gz
++
++ ('$' is the shell prompt; "kermit -s ckermit.tar.gz" is what you type,
++ followed by Return or Enter.)
++
++ Here is a list of C-Kermit's single-letter command-line options, which
++ start with a single dash (-), in ASCII ("alphabetical") order.
++ Alphabetic case is significant (-A is not the same as -a). The Action?
++ column contains Y for action options and N for non-action options.
++ Option Action? Description
++ -0 N (digit zero) 100% transparent Connect state for "in-the-middle"
++ operation: 8 bits, no parity, no escape character, everything passes
++ through.
++ -8 N (digit eight) Connection is 8-bit clean (this is the default in
++ C-Kermit 8.0). Equivalent to the EIGHTBIT command, which in turn is a
++ shortcut for SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8, SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8, SET
++ PARITY NONE.
++ -9 arg N (digit nine) Make a connection to an FTP server. Equivalent
++ to the FTP OPEN command.
++ Argument: IP-address-or-hostname[:optional-TCP-port].
++ NOTE: C-Kermit also has a separate FTP command-line personality, with
++ regular FTP-like command-line syntax. [56]More about this below.
++ -A N Kermit is to be started as an Internet service (IKSD) (only from
++ inetd.conf).
++ -B N Kermit is running in Batch or Background (no controlling
++ terminal). To be used in case Kermit doesn't automatically sense its
++ background status. Equivalent to the SET BACKGROUND ON command.
++ -C arg N Interactive-mode Commands to be executed.
++ Argument: Commands separated by commas, list in doublequotes.
++ -D arg N Delay before starting to send in Remote mode. Equivalent to
++ the SET DELAY command.
++ Argument: Number of seconds.
++ -E N Exit automatically when connection closes. Equivalent to SET EXIT
++ ON-DISCONNECT ON.
++ -F arg N Use an open TCP connection.
++ Argument: Numeric file descriptor of open TCP connection.
++ Also see: -j, -J.
++ -G arg Y Get file(s) from server, send contents to standard output,
++ which normally would be piped to another process.
++ Argument: Remote file specification, in quotes if it contains
++ metacharacters.
++ Also see: -g, -k.
++ -H N Suppress program startup Herald and greeting.
++ -I N Tell Kermit it has a reliable connection, to force streaming to
++ be used where it normally would not be. Equivalent to the SET RELIABLE
++ ON command.
++ -J arg N "Be like Telnet." Like -j but implies -E.
++ Argument: IP hostname/address optionally followed by service.
++ NOTE: C-Kermit also has a separate Telnet command-line personality,
++ with regular Telnet-like command-line syntax. [57]More about this
++ below.
++ -L N Recursive directory descent for files in -s option.
++ -M arg N My user name (for use with Telnet, Rlogin, FTP, etc).
++ Equivalent to the SET LOGIN USER command.
++ Argument: Username string.
++ -O Y (Uppercase letter O) Be a server for One command only. Also see:
++ -x.
++ -P N Don't convert file (Path) names of transferred files. Equivalent
++ to SET FILE NAMES LITERAL.
++ -Q N Quick Kermit protocol settings. Equivalent to the FAST command.
++ This is the default in C-Kermit 7.0 and later.
++ -R N Remote-only (this just makes IF REMOTE true).
++ -S N Stay (enter command parser after action options).
++ -T N Force Text mode for file transfer; implies -V. Equivalent to SET
++ TRANSFER MODE MANUAL, SET FILE TYPE TEXT.
++ -V N Disable automatic per-file text/binary switching. Equivalent to
++ SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL.
++ -Y N Skip (don't execute) the initialization file.
++ -a arg N As-name for file(s) in -s, -r, or -g.
++ Argument: As-name string (alternative filename). When receiving files,
++ this can be a directory name.
++ -b arg N Speed for serial device. Equivalent to SET SPEED.
++ Argument: Numeric Bits per second for serial connections.
++ -c Y Enter Connect state before transferring files.
++ -d N Create a debug.log file with detailed debugging information (a
++ second -d adds timestamps). Equivalent to LOG DEBUG but takes effect
++ sooner.
++ -e arg N Maximum length for incoming Kermit file-transfer packets.
++ Equivalent to SET RECEIVE PACKET-LENGTH.
++ Argument: Length in bytes.
++ -f Y Send a FINISH command to a Kermit server.
++ -g arg N Get file(s) from a Kermit server.
++ Argument: File specification on other computer, in quotes if it
++ contains metacharacters. Equivalent to GET.
++ Also see: -a, -G, -r.
++ -h Y Print Help text for single-letter command-line options (pipe thru
++ 'more' to prevent scrolling).
++ -i N Force binary (Image) mode for file transfer; implies -V.
++ Equivalent to SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL, SET FILE TYPE BINARY.
++ -j arg N Make a TCP/IP connection.
++ Argument: IP host name/address and optional service name or number.
++ Equivalent to the TELNET command.
++ Also see: -J, -F.
++ -k Y Receive file(s) to standard output, which normally would be piped
++ to another process.
++ Also see: -r, -G.
++ -l arg N (Lowercase letter L) Make a connection on the given serial
++ communications device. Equivalent to the SET LINE (SET PORT) command.
++ Argument: Serial device name, e.g. /dev/ttyS0.
++ -m arg N Modem type for use with the -l device. Equivalent to the SET
++ MODEM TYPE command.
++ Argument: Modem name as in SET MODEM TYPE command, e.g. "usrobotics".
++ -n Y Enter Connect state after transferring files (historical).
++ -p arg N Parity. Equivalent to the SET PARITY command.
++ Argument: One of the following: e(ven), o(dd), m(ark), n(one),
++ s(pace).
++ -q N Quiet (suppress most messages). Equivalent to SET QUIET ON.
++ -r Y Receive file(s). Equivalent to the RECEIVE command.
++ Argument: (none, but see -a)
++ -s arg N Send file(s).
++ Argument: One or more local file specifications. Equivalent to the
++ SEND command.
++ Also see: -a.
++ -t N (Historical) Xon (Ctrl-Q) Turnaround character for half-duplex
++ connections (used on serial linemode connections to old mainframes).
++ Equivalent to SET DUPLEX HALF, SET HANDSHAKE XON.
++ -v arg N Window size for Kermit protocol (ignored when streaming).
++ Equivalanet to SET WINDOW-SIZE.
++ Argument: Number, 1 to 32.
++ -w N Incoming files Write over existing files. Equivalent to SET FILE
++ COLLISION OVERWRITE.
++ -x Y Enter server mode. Equivalent to the SERVER command. Also see:
++ -O.
++ -y arg N Alternative initialization file.
++ Argument: Filename.
++ -z N Force foreground behavior. To be used in case Kermit doesn't
++ automatically sense its foreground status. Equivalent to the SET
++ BACKGROUND OFF command.
++
++ Extended command-line options (necessary because single-letter ones
++ are about used up) start with two dashes (--), with words rather than
++ single letters as option names. If an extended option takes an
++ argument, it is separated from the option word by a colon (:).
++ Extended options include:
++ Option Description
++ --bannerfile:filename File to display upon startup or IKSD login.
++ --cdfile:filename File to be sent for display to the client when
++ server changes directory (filename is relative to the changed-to
++ directory).
++ --cdmessage:{on,off} Enable/disable the server CD message feature.
++ --help Prints usage message for extended options.
++ --helpfile:filename Designates a file containing custom text to
++ replace the top-level HELP command.
++ --nointerrupts Disables keyboard interrupts.
++ --noperms Disables the Kermit protocol file Permissions attribute, to
++ prevent transmission of file permissions (protection) from sender to
++ receiver.
++
++ Plus several other [58]IKSD-Only options.
++
++ See the [59]file-transfer section for examples of command-line
++ invocation.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ COMMAND LANGUAGE [ [60]Top ] [ [61]Contents ] [ [62]Next ] [ [63]Previous ]
++
++ * [64]Command Files, Macros, and Scripts
++ * [65]Command List
++
++ C-Kermit's interactive command language is the subject of a
++ [66]622-page book and another several hundred pages of updates, far
++ too much for a manual page. But it's not hard to get started. At the
++ shell prompt, just type "kermit" to get C-Kermit's interactive command
++ prompt:
++
++ $ kermit
++ (/current/directory) C-Kermit>
++
++ Begin by typing "help" (and then press the Return or Enter key) for a
++ top-level overview, read it, and go from there. Your second command
++ should probably be "intro" (introduction). Note the prompt shows your
++ current directory (unless you tell Kermit to prompt you with something
++ else).
++
++ Interactive commands are composed mainly of regular English words,
++ usually in the form of imperative sentences, such as:
++
++ send oofa.txt
++
++ which tells Kermit to send (transfer) the file whose name is oofa.txt,
++ or:
++
++ set transfer mode automatic
++
++ which sets Kermit's "transfer mode" to "automatic" (whatever that
++ means).
++
++ While typing commands, you can abbreviate, ask for help (by pressing
++ the "?" key anywhere in a command), complete keywords or filenames
++ (with the Tab or Esc key), and edit your typing with Backspace or
++ Delete, Ctrl-W, Ctrl-U, etc. You can also recall previous commands,
++ save your command history, and who knows what else. Give the INTRO
++ command for details.
++
++ C-Kermit has hundreds of commands, and they can be issued in infinite
++ variety and combinations, including commands for:
++
++ * Making connections (SET LINE, DIAL, TELNET, SSH, FTP, CONNECT,
++ ...)
++ * Breaking connections (HANGUP, CLOSE)
++ * Transferring files (SEND, GET, RECEIVE, MOVE, RESEND, ...)
++ * Establishing preferences (SET)
++ * Displaying preferences (SHOW)
++ * Managing local files (CD, DELETE, MKDIR, DIRECTORY, RENAME, TYPE,
++ ...)
++ * Managing remote files (RCD, RDEL, RMKDIR, RDIR, ...)
++ * Using local files (FOPEN, FCLOSE, FREAD, FWRITE)
++ * Programming (TAKE, DEFINE, IF, FOR, WHILE, SWITCH, DECLARE, ...)
++ * Interacting with the user (ECHO, ASK, ...)
++ * Interacting with a remote computer (INPUT, OUTPUT, ...)
++ * Interacting with local programs (RUN, EXEC, PTY, ...)
++ * Logging things (LOG SESSION, LOG PACKETS, LOG DEBUG, ...)
++
++ And of course QUIT or EXIT to get out and HELP to get help, and for
++ programmers: loops, decision making, variables, arrays, associative
++ arrays, integer and floating point arithmetic, macros, built-in and
++ user-defined functions, string manipulation, pattern matching, block
++ structure, scoping, recursion, and all the rest. To get a list of all
++ C-Kermit's commands, type a question mark (?) at the prompt. To get a
++ description of any command, type HELP followed by the name of the
++ command, for example:
++
++ help send
++
++ The command interruption character is Ctrl-C (hold down the Ctrl key
++ and press the C key).
++
++ The command language "escape character", used to introduce variable
++ names, function invocations, and so on, is backslash (\). If you need
++ to include a literal backslash in a command, type two of them, e.g.:
++
++ get c:\\k95\\k95custom.ini
++
++ Command Files, Macros, and Scripts
++
++ A file containing Kermit commands is called a Kermit command file or
++ Kermit script. It can be executed with Kermit's TAKE command:
++
++ (/current/dir) C-Kermit> take commandfile
++
++ (where "commandfile" is the name of the command file). Please don't
++ pipe a command file into Kermit's standard input (which might or might
++ not work); if you have Kermit commands in a file, tell Kermit to TAKE
++ the file.
++
++ In Unix only, a Kermit command file can also be executed directly by
++ including a "kerbang" line as the first line of the file:
++
++ #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
++
++ That is, a top line that starts with "#!", followed immediately by the
++ full path of the Kermit executable, and then, if the Kermit script is
++ to be given arguments on the command line, a space and a plus sign.
++ The script file must also have execute permission:
++
++ chmod +x commandfile
++
++ Except for the " +" part, this is exactly the same as you would do for
++ a shell script, a Perl script, etc. Here's a simple but useless
++ example script that regurgitates its arguments (up to three of them):
++
++ #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
++ if defined \%1 echo "Argument 1: \%1"
++ if defined \%2 echo "Argument 2: \%2"
++ if defined \%3 echo "Argument 3: \%3"
++ if defined \%4 echo "etc..."
++ exit
++
++ If this file is stored in your current directory as "commandfile",
++ then:
++
++ ./commandfile one two three four five
++
++ prints:
++
++ Argument 1: one
++ Argument 2: two
++ Argument 3: three
++ etc...
++
++ This illustrates the basic structure of a standalone Kermit script:
++ the "kerbang line", then some commands. It should end with "exit"
++ unless you want the Kermit prompt to appear when it is finished. \%1
++ is the first argument, \%2 the second, and so on.
++
++ You can also create your own commands by defining named macros
++ composed of other Kermit commands (or macros). Here's a simple
++ example:
++
++ define mydial {
++ set modem type usrobotics
++ set port /dev/ttyS0
++ if fail end 1
++ set speed 57600
++ dial \%1
++ if success connect
++ }
++
++ This shows how you can combine many commands into one command,
++ "mydial" in this case (you can use any name you like, provided it does
++ not clash with the name of a built-in command). When this macro
++ definition is in effect, you can type commands like:
++
++ mydial 7654321
++
++ and it executes all the commands in macro definition, substituting the
++ first operand ("7654321") for the formal parameter ("\%1") in the
++ definition. This saves you from having to type lots of commands every
++ time you want to make a modem call.
++
++ One way to have the macro definition in effect is to type the
++ definition at the Kermit prompt. Another way is to store the
++ definition in a file and TAKE the file. If you want the the definition
++ to be in effect automatically every time you start Kermit, put the
++ definition in your initialization or customization file (explained
++ [67]below).
++
++ Here's a somewhat more ambitious example:
++
++ define mydelete {
++ local trash
++ assign trash \v(home)trashcan/
++ if not defined \%1 end 1 "Delete what?"
++ if wild \%1 end 1 "Deleting multiple files is too scary"
++ if not exist \%1 end 1 "I can't find \%1"
++ if not directory \m(trash) {
++ mkdir \m(trash)
++ if fail end 1 "No trash can"
++ }
++ rename /list \%1 \m(trash)
++ }
++ define myundelete {
++ local trash
++ assign trash \v(home)trashcan/
++ if not defined \%1 end 1 "Undelete what?"
++ if wild \%1 end 1 "Undeleting multiple files is too hard"
++ if not directory \m(trash) end 1 "No trash can"
++ if not exist \m(trash)\%1 end 1 "I can't find \%1 in trash can"
++ rename /list \m(trash)\%1 .
++ }
++
++ These macros are not exactly production quality (they don't handle
++ filenames that include path segments, they don't handle multiple
++ files, etc), but you get the idea: you can pass arguments to macros,
++ they can check them and make other kinds of decisions, and the
++ commands themselves are relatively intuitive and intelligible.
++
++ If you put the above lines into your initialization or customization
++ file, you'll have MYDELETE and MYUNDELETE commands available every
++ time you start Kermit, at least as long as you don't suppress
++ execution of the initialization file. (Exercise for the reader: Make
++ these macros generally useful: remove limitations, add trashcan
++ display, browsing, emptying, etc.)
++
++ Kerbang scripts execute without the initialization file. This to keep
++ them portable and also to make them start faster. If you want to write
++ Kerbang scripts that depend on the initialization file, include the
++ command
++
++ take \v(home).kermrc
++
++ at the desired spot in the script. By the way, \v(xxx) is a built-in
++ variable (xxx is the variable name, "home" in this case). To see what
++ built-in variables are available, type "show variables" at the
++ C-Kermit prompt. To see what else you can show, type "show ?". \m(xxx)
++ is a user defined variable (strictly speaking, it is a macro used as a
++ variable).
++
++ Command List
++
++ C-Kermit has more than 200 top-level commands, and some of these, such
++ as SET, branch off into hundreds of subcommands of their own, so it's
++ not practical to describe them all here. Instead, here's a concise
++ list of the most commonly used top-level commands, grouped by
++ category. To learn about each command, type "help" followed by the
++ command name, e.g. "help set". Terms such as Command state and Connect
++ state are explained in subsequent sections.
++
++ Optional fields are shown in [ italicized brackets ]. filename means
++ the name of a single file. filespec means a file specification that is
++ allowed to contain wildcard characters like '*' to match groups of
++ files. options are (optional) switches like /PAGE, /NOPAGE, /QUIET,
++ etc, listed in the HELP text for each command. Example:
++
++ send /recursive /larger:10000 /after:-1week /except:*.txt *
++
++ which can be read as "send all the files in this directory and all the
++ ones underneath it that are larger than 10000 bytes, no more than one
++ week old, and whose names don't end with ".txt".
++
++ Basic Commands
++ HELP Requests top-level help.
++ HELP command Requests help about the given command.
++ INTRODUCTION Requests a brief introduction to C-Kermit.
++ LICENSE Displays the C-Kermit software copyright and license.
++ VERSION Displays C-Kermit's version number.
++ EXIT [ number ] Exits from Kermit with the given status code.
++ Synonyms: QUIT, E, Q.
++ TAKE filename [ parameters... ] Executes commands from the
++ given file.
++ LOG item [ filename ] Keeps a log of the given item in the
++ given file.
++ [ DO ] macro [ parameters... ] Executes commands from the
++ given macro.
++ SET parameter value Sets the given parameter to the given
++ value.
++ SHOW category Shows settings in a given category.
++ STATUS Tells whether previous command succeeded or failed.
++ DATE [ date-and/or-time ] Shows current date-time or interprets
++ given date-time.
++ RUN [ extern-command [ parameters... ] Runs the given external
++ command. Synonym: !.
++ EXEC [ extern-command [ params... ] Kermit overlays itself with
++ the given command.
++ SUSPEND Stops Kermit and puts it in the background. Synonym: Z.
++
++ Local File Management
++ TYPE [ options ] filename Displays the contents of the given
++ file.
++ MORE [ options ] filename Equivalent to TYPE /PAGE (pause after
++ each screenful).
++ CAT [ options ] filename Equivalent to TYPE /NOPAGE.
++ HEAD [ options ] filename Displays the first few lines of a
++ given file.
++ TAIL [ options ] filename Displays the last few lines of a
++ given file.
++ GREP [ options ] pattern filespec Displays lines from files
++ that match the pattern. Synonym: FIND.
++ DIRECTORY [ options ] [ filespec ] Lists files (built-in, many
++ options).
++ LS [ options ] [ filespec ] Lists files (runs external "ls"
++ command).
++ DELETE [ options ] [ filespec ] Deletes files. Synonym: RM.
++ PURGE [ options ] [ filespec ] Removes backup (*.~n~) files.
++ COPY [ options ] [ filespecs... ] Copies files. Synonym: CP.
++ RENAME [ options ] [ filespecs... ] Renames files. Synonym: MV.
++ CHMOD [ options ] [ filespecs... ] Changes permissions of
++ files.
++ TRANSLATE filename charsets filename ] Converts file's
++ character set. Synonym: XLATE.
++ CD Changes your working directory to your home directory.
++ CD directory Changes your working directory to the one given.
++ CDUP Changes your working directory one level up.
++ PWD Displays your working directory.
++ BACK Returns to your previous working directory.
++ MKDIR [ directory ] Creates a directory.
++ RMDIR [ directory ] Removes a directory.
++
++ Making Connections
++ SET LINE [ options ] devicename Opens the named serial
++ port. Synonym: SET PORT.
++ OPEN LINE [ options ] devicename Same as SET LINE. Synonym:
++ OPEN PORT.
++ SET MODEM TYPE [ name ] Tells Kermit what kind of modem is on
++ the port.
++ DIAL [ number ] Tells Kermit to dial the given phone number
++ with the modem.
++ REDIAL Redials the most recently dialed phone number.
++ ANSWER Waits for and answers an incoming call on the modem.
++ AUTHENTICATE [ parameters... ] Performs secure authentication
++ on a TCP/IP connection.
++ SET NETWORK TYPE { TCP/IP, X.25, ... } Selects network type for
++ subsequent SET HOST commands.
++ SET HOST [ options ] host [ port ] Opens a network connection
++ to the given host and port.
++ SET HOST [ options ] * port Waits for an incoming TCP/IP
++ connection on the given port.
++ TELNET [ options ] host Opens a Telnet connection to the host
++ and enters Connect state.
++ RLOGIN [ options ] host Opens an Rlogin connection to the host
++ and enters Connect state.
++ IKSD [ options ] host Opens a connection to an Internet Kermit
++ Service.
++ SSH [ options ] host Opens an SSH connection to the host and
++ enters Connect state.
++ FTP OPEN host [ options ] Opens an FTP connection to the host.
++ HTTP [ options ] OPEN host Opens an HTTP connection to the
++ host.
++ PTY external-command Runs the command on a pseudoterminal as if
++ it were a connection.
++ PIPE external-command Runs the command through a pipe as if it
++ were a connection.
++
++ Using Connections
++ CONNECT [ options ] Enters Connect
++ (terminal) state. Synonym: C.
++ REDIRECT command Redirects the given external command over the
++ connection.
++ TELOPT command Sends a Telnet protocol command (Telnet
++ connections only).
++ Ctrl-\C "Escapes back" from Connect state to Command state.
++ Ctrl-\B (In Connect state) Sends a BREAK signal (serial or
++ Telnet).
++ Ctrl-\! (In Connect state) Enters inferior shell; "exit" to
++ return.
++ Ctrl-\? (In Connect state) Shows a menu of other escape-level
++ options.
++ Ctrl-\Ctrl-\ (In Connect state) Type two Ctrl-Backslashes to
++ send one of them.
++ SET ESCAPE [ character ] Changes Kermit's Connect-state escape
++ character.
++
++ Closing Connections
++ HANGUP Hangs up the currently open serial-port or network
++ connection.
++ CLOSE Closes the currently open serial-port or network
++ connection.
++ SET LINE (with no devicename) Closes the currently
++ open serial-port or network connection.
++ SET HOST (with no hostname) Closes the currently open
++ serial-port or network connection.
++ FTP CLOSE Closes the currently open FTP connection.
++ HTTP CLOSE Closes the currently open HTTP connection.
++ EXIT Also closes all connections. Synonym: QUIT.
++ SET EXIT WARNING OFF Suppresses warning about open connections
++ on exit or close.
++
++ File Transfer
++ SEND [ options ] filename [ as-name ] Sends the given file.
++ Synonym: S.
++ SEND [ options ] filespec Sends all files that match.
++ RESEND [ options ] filespec Resumes an interupted SEND from the
++ point of failure.
++ RECEIVE [ options ] [ as-name ] Waits passively for files to
++ arrive. Synonym: R.
++ LOG TRANSACTIONS [ filename ] Keeps a record of file transfers.
++ FAST Use fast file-transfer settings (default).
++ CAUTIOUS Use cautious and less fast file-transfer settings.
++ ROBUST Use ultra-conservative and slow file-transfer settings.
++ STATISTICS [ options ] Gives statistics about the most recent
++ file transfer.
++ WHERE After transfer: "Where did my files go?".
++ TRANSMIT [ options ] [ filename ] Sends file without protocol.
++ Synonym: XMIT.
++ LOG SESSION [ filename ] Captures remote text or files without
++ protocol.
++ SET PROTOCOL [ name... ] Tells Kermit to use an external
++ file-transfer protocol.
++ FTP { PUT, MPUT, GET, MGET, ... } FTP client commands.
++ HTTP { PUT, GET, HEAD, POST, ... } HTTP client commands.
++
++ Kermit Server
++ ENABLE, DISABLE Controls which features
++ can be used by clients.
++ SET SERVER Sets parameters prior to entering Server state.
++ SERVER Enters Server state.
++
++ Client of Kermit or FTP Server
++ [ REMOTE ] LOGIN [ user password ] Logs in to a Kermit server
++ or IKSD that requires it.
++ [ REMOTE ] LOGOUT Logs out from a Kermit server or IKSD.
++ SEND [ options ] filename [ as-name ] Sends the given file to
++ the server. Synonyms: S, PUT.
++ SEND [ options ] filespec Sends all files that match.
++ RESEND [ options ] filespec Resumes an interupted SEND from the
++ point of failure.
++ GET [ options ] remote-filespec Asks the server to send the
++ given files. Synonym: G.
++ REGET [ options ] remote-filespec Resumes an interrupted GET
++ from the point of failure.
++ REMOTE CD [ directory ] Asks server to change its working
++ directory. Synonym: RCD.
++ REMOTE PWD [ directory ] Asks server to display its working
++ directory. Synonym: RPWD.
++ REMOTE DIRECTORY [ filespec... ] Asks server to send a
++ directory listing. Synonym: RDIR.
++ REMOTE DELETE [ filespec... ] Asks server to delete files.
++ Synonym: RDEL.
++ REMOTE [ command... ] (Many other commands: "remote ?" for a
++ list).
++ MAIL [ options ] filespec Sends file(s) to be delivered as
++ e-mail (Kermit only).
++ FINISH Asks the server to exit server state (Kermit only).
++ BYE Asks the server to log out and close the connection.
++
++ Script Programming
++ DEFINE, DECLARE, UNDEFINE, UNDECLARE, ASSIGN, EVALUATE,
++ SEXPRESSION, ARRAY, SORT, INPUT, OUTPUT, IF, FOR, WHILE,
++ SWITCH, GOTO, ECHO, ASK, GETC, GETOK, ASSERT, WAIT, SLEEP,
++ FOPEN, FREAD, FWRITE, FCLOSE, STOP, END, RETURN, LEARN, SHIFT,
++ TRACE, VOID, INCREMENT, DECREMENT, ... For these and many more
++ you'll need to consult the [68]manual and supplements, and/or
++ visit the [69]Kermit Script Library, which also includes a
++ brief tutorial. Hint: HELP LEARN to find out how to get Kermit
++ to write simple scripts for you.
++
++ Many of Kermit's commands have synonyms, variants, relatives, and so
++ on. For example, MSEND is a version of SEND that accepts a list of
++ file specifications to be sent, rather than just one file
++ specification, and MPUT is a synonym of MSEND. MOVE means to SEND and
++ then DELETE the source file if successful. MMOVE is like MOVE, but
++ accepts a list of filespecs, and so on. These are described in the
++ [70]full documentation.
++
++ Use question mark to feel your way through an unfamiliar command, as
++ in this example (the part you type is underlined):
++
++ C-Kermit> remote ? One of the following:
++ assign delete help login print rename space
++ cd directory host logout pwd rmdir type
++ copy exit kermit mkdir query set who
++ C-Kermit> remote set ? One of the following:
++ attributes file retry transfer
++ block-check receive server window
++ C-Kermit> remote set file ? One of the following:
++ character-set incomplete record-length
++ collision names type
++ C-Kermit> remote set file names ? One of the following:
++ converted literal
++ C-Kermit> remote set file names literal
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ This is called menu on demand: you get a menu when you want one, but
++ menus are not forced on you even when know what you're doing. Note
++ that you can also abbreviate most keywords, and you can complete them
++ with the Tab or Esc key. Also note that ? works for filenames too, and
++ that you can use it in the middle of a keyword or filename, not just
++ at the beginning. For example, "send x?" lists all the files in the
++ current directory whose names start with 'x'.
++
++ [ [71]Kermit Home ] [ [72]C-Kermit Home ] [ [73]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ INITIALIZATION FILE [ [74]Top ] [ [75]Contents ] [ [76]Next ] [ [77]Previous
++ ]
++
++ In its default configuration, C-Kermit executes commands from a file
++ called .kermrc in your home directory when it starts, unless it is
++ given the -Y or -y command-line option. Custom configurations might
++ substitute a shared system-wide initialization file. The SHOW FILE
++ command tells what initialization file, if any, was used. The standard
++ initialization file "chains" to an individual customization file,
++ .mykermc, in the home directory, in which each user can establish
++ her/his own preferences, define macros, and so on.
++
++ Since execution of the initialization file (at least the standard one)
++ makes C-Kermit take longer to start, it might be better not to have an
++ initialization file, especially now that Kermit's default startup
++ configuration is well attuned to modern computing and networking -- in
++ other words, you no longer have do anything special to make Kermit
++ transfers go fast. So instead of having an initialization file that is
++ executed every time Kermit starts, you might consider making one or
++ more kerbang scripts (with names other that .kermrc) that do NOT
++ include an "exit" command, and invoke those when you need the
++ settings, macro definitions, and/or scripted actions they contain, and
++ invoke C-Kermit directly when you don't.
++
++ To put it another way... We still distribute the standard
++ initialization file since it's featured in the manual and backwards
++ compatibility is important to us. But there's no harm in not using it
++ if you don't need the stuff that's in it (services directory, dialing
++ directory, network directory, and associated macro definitions). On
++ the other hand, if there are settings or macros you want in effect
++ EVERY time you use Kermit, the initialization file (or the
++ customization file it chains to) is the place to put them, because
++ that's the only place Kermit looks for them automatically each time
++ you start it.
++
++ [ [78]Kermit Home ] [ [79]C-Kermit Home ] [ [80]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ MODES OF OPERATION [ [81]Top ] [ [82]Contents ] [ [83]Next ] [ [84]Previous ]
++
++ Kermit is said to be in Local mode if it has made a connection to
++ another computer, e.g. by dialing it or establishing a Telnet
++ connection to it. The other computer is remote, so if you start
++ another copy of Kermit on the remote computer, it is said to be in
++ Remote mode (as long as it has not made any connections of its own).
++ The local Kermit communicates over the communications device or
++ network connection, acting as a conduit between the the remote
++ computer and your keyboard and screen. The remote Kermit is the
++ file-transfer partner to the local Kermit and communicates only
++ through its standard input and output.
++
++ At any moment, a Kermit program can be in any of the following states.
++ It's important to know what they are and how to change from one to the
++ other.
++
++ Command state
++
++ In this state, Kermit reads commands from:
++
++ + Your keyboard; or:
++ + A file, or:
++ + A macro definition.
++
++ You can exit from Command state back to Unix with the EXIT or
++ QUIT command (same thing). You can enter Connect state with any
++ of various commands (CONNECT, DIAL, TELNET, etc). You can enter
++ file transfer state with commands like SEND, RECEIVE, and GET.
++ You can enter Server state with the SERVER command. The TAKE
++ command tells Kermit to read and execute commands from a file.
++ The (perhaps implied) DO command tells Kermit to read and
++ execute commands from a macro definition. While in Command
++ state, you can interrupt any command, macro, or command file by
++ typing Ctrl-C (hold down the Ctrl key and press the C key);
++ this normally brings you back to the prompt.
++
++ Shell state
++
++ You can invoke an inferior shell or external command from the
++ Kermit command prompt by using the PUSH, RUN (!), EDIT, or
++ BROWSE command. While the inferior shell or command is active,
++ Kermit is suspended and does nothing. Return to Kermit Command
++ state by exiting from the inferior shell or application.
++
++ Connect state
++
++ In this state, which can be entered only when in Local mode
++ (i.e. when Kermit has made a connection to another computer),
++ Kermit is acting as a terminal to the remote computer. Your
++ keystrokes are sent to the remote computer and characters that
++ arrive over the communication connection are displayed on your
++ screen. This state is entered when you give a CONNECT, DIAL,
++ TELNET, RLOGIN, or IKSD command. You can return to command
++ state by logging out of the remote computer, or by typing:
++
++ Ctrl-\c
++
++ That is: Hold down the Ctrl key and press the backslash key,
++ then let go of the Ctrl key and press the C key. This is called
++ escaping back. Certain other escape-level commands are also
++ provided; type Ctrl-\? for a list. For example, you can enter
++ Shell state with:
++
++ Ctrl-\!
++
++ To send a Ctrl-\ to the host while in Connect state, type two
++ of them in a row. See HELP CONNECT and HELP SET ESCAPE for more
++ info.
++
++ Local file-transfer state
++
++ In this state, Kermit is sending packets back and forth with
++ the other computer in order to transfer a file or accomplish
++ some other file-related task. And at the same time, it is
++ displaying its progress on your screen and watching your
++ keyboard for interruptions. In this state, the following
++ single-keystroke commands are accepted:
++
++ X Interrupt the current file and go on to the next (if any).
++ Z Interrupt the current file and skip all the rest.
++ E Like Z but uses a "stronger" protocol (use if X or Z don't
++ work).
++ Ctrl-C Interrupt file-transfer mode (use if Z or E don't
++ work).
++
++ Kermit returns to its previous state (Command or Connect) when
++ the transfer is complete or when interrupted successfully by X,
++ Z, E, or Ctrl-C (hold down the Ctrl key and press the C key).
++
++ Remote file-transfer state
++
++ In this state, Kermit is exchanging file-transfer packets with
++ its local partner over its standard i/o. It leaves this state
++ automatically when the transfer is complete. In case you find
++ your local Kermit in Connect state and the remote one in
++ File-transfer state (in which it seems to ignore your
++ keystrokes), you can usually return it to command state by
++ typing three Ctrl-C's in a row. If that doesn't work, return
++ your local Kermit to Command state (Ctrl-\ C) and type
++ "e-packet" and then press the Return or Enter key; this forces
++ a fatal Kermit protocol error.
++
++ Remote Server state
++
++ This is like Remote File-transfer state, except it never
++ returns automatically to Command state. Rather, it awaits
++ further instructions from the client program; that is, from
++ your Local Kermit program. You can return the Remote Server to
++ its previous state by issuing a "finish" command to the client,
++ or if you are in Connect state, by typing three Ctrl-C's in a
++ row. You can tell the server job to log out and break the
++ connection by issuing a "bye" command to the client.
++
++ Local Server state
++
++ Like Remote-Server state, but in local mode, and therefore with
++ its file-transfer display showing, and listening for single-key
++ commands, as in Local File-transfer state. Usually this state
++ is entered automatically when a remote Kermit program gives a
++ GET command.
++
++ C-Kermit, Kermit 95, and MS-DOS Kermit all can switch automatically
++ from Connect state to Local File-transfer state when you initiate a
++ file transfer from the remote computer by starting Kermit and telling
++ it to send or get a file, in which case, Connect state is
++ automatically resumed after the file transfer is finished.
++
++ Note that C-Kermit is not a terminal emulator. It is a communications
++ application that you run in a terminal window (e.g. console or Xterm).
++ The specific emulation, such as VT100, VT220, Linux Console, or Xterm,
++ is provided by the terminal window in which you are running C-Kermit.
++ Kermit 95 and MS-DOS Kermit, on the other hand, are true terminal
++ emulators. Why is C-Kermit not a terminal emulator? [85]CLICK HERE to
++ read about it.
++
++ [ [86]Kermit Home ] [ [87]C-Kermit Home ] [ [88]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ MAKING CONNECTIONS [ [89]Top ] [ [90]Contents ] [ [91]Next ] [ [92]Previous ]
++
++ Here is how to make different kinds of connections using interactive
++ Kermit commands (as noted above, you can also make connections with
++ command-line options). Note that you don't have to make connections
++ with Kermit. It can also be used on the far end of a connection as the
++ remote file transfer and management partner of your local
++ communications software.
++
++ Making a Telnet Connection
++
++ At the C-Kermit command prompt, simply type:
++
++ telnet foo.bar.com ; Substitute desired host name or address.
++ telnet xyzcorp.com 3000 ; You can also include a port number.
++
++ If the connection is successful, Kermit automically enters
++ Connect state. When you logout from the remote host, Kermit
++ automatically returns to its prompt. More info: HELP TELNET,
++ HELP SET TELNET, HELP SET TELOPT. Also see the [93]IKSD section
++ below.
++
++ Making an Rlogin connection
++
++ This is just like Telnet, except you have to be root to do it
++ because Rlogin uses a privileged TCP port:
++
++ rlogin foo.bar.com ; Substitute desired host name or address.
++
++ More info: HELP RLOGIN.
++
++ Making an SSH Connection
++
++ Unlike Telnet and Rlogin, SSH connections are not built-in, but
++ handled by running your external SSH client through a
++ pseudoterminal. Using C-Kermit to control the SSH client gives
++ you all of Kermit's features (file transfer, character-set
++ conversion, scripting, etc) over SSH.
++
++ ssh foo.bar.com ; Substitute desired host name or address.
++
++ More info: HELP SSH, HELP SET SSH.
++
++ Dialing with a Modem
++
++ If it's an external modem, make sure it is connected to a
++ usable serial port on your computer with a regular
++ (straight-through) modem cable, and to the telephone jack with
++ a telephone cable, and that it's turned on. Then use these
++ commands:
++
++ set modem type usrobotics ; Or other supported type
++ set line /dev/ttyS0 ; Specify device name
++ set speed 57600 ; Or other desired speed
++ set flow rts/cts ; Most modern modems support this
++ set dial method tone ; (or pulse)
++ dial 7654321 ; Dial the desired number
++
++ Type "set modem type ?" for a list of supported modem types. If
++ you omit the SET MODEM TYPE command, the default type is
++ "generic-high-speed", which should work for most modern
++ AT-command-set modems. If the line is busy, Kermit redials
++ automatically. If the call does not succeed, use "set dial
++ display on" and try it again to watch what happens. If the call
++ succeeds, Kermit enters Connect state automatically and returns
++ to its prompt automatically when you log out from the remote
++ computer or the connection is otherwise lost.
++
++ You can also dial from a modem that is accessible by Telnet,
++ e.g. to a reverse terminal server. In this case the command
++ sequence is:
++
++ set host ts.xxx.com 2000 ; Terminal-server and port
++ set modem type usrobotics ; Or other supported type
++ set dial method tone ; (or pulse)
++ dial 7654321 ; Dial the desired number
++
++ If the terminal server supports the Telnet Com Port Option,
++ [94]RFC 2217, you can also give serial-port related commands
++ such as SET SPEED, SET PARITY, and so on, and Kermit relays
++ them to the terminal server using the protocol specified in the
++ RFC.
++
++ More info: HELP SET MODEM, HELP SET LINE, HELP SET SPEED, HELP
++ SET FLOW, HELP DIAL, HELP SET DIAL, HELP SET MODEM, HELP SET
++ CARRIER-WATCH, SHOW COMMUNICATIONS, SHOW MODEM, SHOW DIAL.
++
++ Direct Serial Port
++
++ Connect the two computers, A and B, with a null modem cable (or
++ two modem cables interconnected with a null-modem adapter or
++ modem eliminator). From Computer A:
++
++ set modem type none ; There is no modem
++ set line /dev/ttyS0 ; Specify device name
++ set carrier-watch off ; If DTR and CD are not cross-connected
++ set speed 57600 ; Or other desired speed
++ set flow rts/cts ; If RTS and CTS are cross-connected
++ set flow xon/xoff ; If you can't use RTS/CTS
++ set parity even ; (or "mark" or "space", if necessary)
++ set stop-bits 2 ; (rarely necessary)
++ connect ; Enter Connect (terminal) state
++
++ This assumes Computer B is set up to let you log in. If it
++ isn't, you can run a copy of Kermit on Computer B and follow
++ approximately the same directions. More info: As above plus
++ HELP CONNECT.
++
++ With modems or direct serial connections, you might also have to "set
++ parity even" (or "mark" or "space") if it's a 7-bit connection.
++
++ Of the connection types listed above, only one can be open at a time.
++ However, any one of these can be open concurrently with an [95]FTP or
++ HTTP session. Each connection type can be customized to any desired
++ degree, scripted, logged, you name it. See the manual.
++
++ NOTE: On selected platforms, C-Kermit also can make X.25 connections.
++ See the manual for details.
++
++ [ [96]Kermit Home ] [ [97]C-Kermit Home ] [ [98]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ TRANSFERRING FILES WITH KERMIT [ [99]Top ] [ [100]Contents ] [ [101]Next ] [
++ [102]Previous ]
++
++ * [103]Downloading Files
++ * [104]Uploading Files
++ * [105]Kermit Transfers the Old-Fashioned Way
++ * [106]If File Transfer Fails
++ * [107]Advanced Kermit File Transfer Features
++ * [108]Non-Kermit File Transfer
++
++ There is a [109]widespread and persistent belief that Kermit is a slow
++ protocol. This is because, until recently, it used conservative tuning
++ by default to make sure file transfers succeeded, rather than failing
++ because they overloaded the connection. Some extra commands (or
++ command-line options, like -Q) were needed to make it go fast, but
++ nobody bothered to find out about them. Also, it takes two to tango:
++ most non-Kermit-Project Kermit protocol implementations really ARE
++ slow. The best file-transfer partners for C-Kermit are: another copy
++ of [110]C-Kermit (7.0 or later) and [111]Kermit 95. These combinations
++ work well and they work fast by default. MS-DOS Kermit is good too,
++ but you have to tell it to go fast (by giving it the FAST command).
++
++ Furthermore, all three of these Kermit programs support "autodownload"
++ and "autoupload", meaning that when they are in Connect state and a
++ Kermit packet comes in from the remote, they automatically switch into
++ file transfer mode.
++
++ And plus, C-Kermit and K95 also switch automatically between text and
++ binary mode for each file, so there is no need to "set file type
++ binary" or "set file type text", or to worry about files being
++ corrupted because they were transferred in the wrong mode.
++
++ What all of these words add up to is that now, when you use up-to-date
++ Kermit software from the Kermit Project, file transfer is not only
++ fast, it's ridiculously easy. You barely have to give any commands at
++ all.
++
++ Downloading Files
++
++ Let's say you have [112]Kermit 95, [113]C-Kermit, or
++ [114]MS-DOS Kermit on your desktop computer, with a connection
++ to a Unix computer that has C-Kermit installed as "kermit". To
++ download a file (send it from Unix to your desktop computer),
++ just type the following command at your Unix shell prompt:
++
++ kermit -s oofa.txt
++
++ (where oofa.txt is the filename). If you want to send more than
++ one file, you can put as many filenames as you want on the
++ command line, and they can be any combination of text and
++ binary:
++
++ kermit -s oofa.txt oofa.zip oofa.html oofa.tar.gz
++
++ and/or you can use wildcards to send groups of files:
++
++ kermit -s oofa.*
++
++ If you want to send a file under an assumed name, use:
++
++ kermit -s friday.txt -a today.txt
++
++ This sends the file friday.txt but tells the receiving Kermit
++ that its name is today.txt. In all cases, as noted, when the
++ file transfer is finished, your desktop Kermit returns
++ automatically to Connect state. No worries about escaping back,
++ re-connecting, text/binary mode switching. Almost too easy,
++ right?
++
++ Uploading Files
++
++ To upload files (send them from your desktop computer to the
++ remote Unix computer) do the same thing, but use the -g (GET)
++ option instead of -s:
++
++ kermit -g oofa.txt
++
++ This causes your local Kermit to enter server mode; then the
++ remote Kermit program requests the named file and the local
++ Kermit sends it and returns automatically to Connect state when
++ done.
++
++ If you want to upload multiple files, you have have use shell
++ quoting rules, since these aren't local files:
++
++ kermit -g "oofa.txt oofa.zip oofa.html oofa.tar.gz"
++ kermit -g "oofa.*"
++
++ If you want to upload a file but store it under a different
++ name, use:
++
++ kermit -g friday.txt -a today.txt
++
++ Kermit Transfers the Old-Fashioned Way
++
++ If your desktop communications software does not support
++ autoupload or autodownload, or it does not include Kermit
++ server mode, the procedure requires more steps.
++
++ To download a file, type:
++
++ kermit -s filename
++
++ on the host as before, but if nothing happens automatically in
++ response to this command, you have to switch your desktop
++ communications software into Kermit Receive state. This might
++ be done by escaping back using keyboard characters or hot keys
++ (Alt-x is typical) and/or with a command (like RECEIVE) or a
++ menu. When the file transfer is complete, you have to go back
++ to Connect state, Terminal emulation, or whatever terminology
++ applies to your desktop communications software.
++
++ To upload a file, type:
++
++ kermit -r
++
++ on the host (rather than "kermit -g"). This tells C-Kermit to
++ wait passively for a file to start arriving. Then regain the
++ attention of your desktop software (Alt-x or whatever) and
++ instruct it to send the desired file(s) with Kermit protocol.
++ When the transfer is finished, return to the Connect or
++ Terminal screen.
++
++ If File Transfer Fails
++
++ Although every aspect of Kermit's operation can be finely
++ tuned, there are also three short and simple "omnibus tuning"
++ commands you can use for troubleshooting:
++
++ FAST
++ Use fast file-transfer settings. This has been the
++ default since C-Kermit 7.0 now that most modern computers
++ and connections support it. If transfers fail with fast
++ settings, try . . .
++
++ CAUTIOUS
++ Use cautious but not paranoid settings. File transfers,
++ if they work, will go at medium speed. If not, try . . .
++
++ ROBUST
++ Use the most robust, resilient, conservative, safe, and
++ reliable settings. File transfers will almost certainly
++ work, but they will be quite slow (of course this is a
++ classic tradeoff; ROBUST was C-Kermit's default tuning in
++ versions 6.0 and earlier, which made everybody think
++ Kermit protocol was slow). If ROBUST doesn't do the
++ trick, try again with SET PARITY SPACE first in case it's
++ not an 8-bit connection.
++
++ Obviously the success and performance of a file transfer also
++ depends on C-Kermit's file transfer partner. Up-to-date, real
++ [115]Kermit Project partners are recommended because they
++ contain the best Kermit protocol implementations and because
++ [116]we can support them in case of trouble.
++
++ If you still have trouble, consult Chapter 10 of [117]Using
++ C-Kermit, or send email to [118]kermit-support@columbia.edu.
++
++ Advanced Kermit File-Transfer Features
++
++ Obviously there is a lot more to Kermit file transfer,
++ including all sorts of interactive commands, preferences,
++ options, logging, debugging, troubleshooting, and anything else
++ you can imagine but that's what the [119]manual and updates are
++ for. Here are a few topics you can explore if you're interested
++ by Typing HELP for the listed commands:
++
++ Logging transfers:
++ LOG TRANSACTIONS (HELP LOG)
++
++ Automatic per-file text/binary mode switching:
++ SET TRANSFER MODE { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL } (HELP SET
++ TRANSFER).
++
++ Cross-platform recursive directory tree transfer:
++ SEND /RECURSIVE, GET /RECURSIVE (HELP SEND, HELP GET).
++
++ File collision options:
++ SET FILE COLLISION { OVERWRITE, BACKUP, DISCARD, ... }
++ (HELP SET FILE).
++
++ Update mode (only transfer files that changed since last time):
++ SET FILE COLLISION UPDATE (HELP SET FILE).
++
++ Filename selection patterns:
++ (HELP WILDCARD).
++
++ Flexible file selection:
++ SEND (or GET) /BEFORE /AFTER /LARGER /SMALLER /TYPE
++ /EXCEPT, ...
++
++ Character-set conversion:
++ SET { FILE, TRANSFER } CHARACTER-SET, ASSOCIATE, ...
++
++ File/Pathname control:
++ SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES, SET FILE NAMES.
++
++ Atomic file movement:
++ SEND (or GET) /DELETE /RENAME /MOVE-TO
++
++ Transferring to/from standard i/o of other commands:
++ SEND (or GET) /COMMAND
++
++ Recovery of interrupted transfer from point of failure:
++ RESEND, REGET (HELP RESEND, HELP REGET).
++
++ Non-Kermit File Transfer
++
++ You can also use C-Kermit to transfer files with FTP or HTTP
++ Internet protocols; [120]see below.
++
++ On a regular serial or Telnet connection where the other
++ computer doesn't support Kermit protocol at all, you have
++ several options. For example, if your desktop communications
++ software supports Zmodem, use "rz" and "sz" on the host rather
++ than Kermit. But if Kermit is your desktop software, and you
++ are using it to make calls or network connections to other
++ computers that don't support Kermit protocol (or that don't
++ have a good implementation of it), then if your computer also
++ has external X, Y, or Zmodem programs that are redirectable,
++ Kermit can use them as external protocols. HELP SET PROTOCOL
++ for details.
++
++ You can also capture "raw" data streams from the other computer
++ with LOG SESSION (HELP LOG and HELP SET SESSION-LOG for
++ details), and you can upload files without any protocol at all
++ with TRANSMIT (HELP TRANSMIT, HELP SET TRANSMIT).
++
++ [ [121]Kermit Home ] [ [122]C-Kermit Home ] [ [123]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ KERMIT CLIENT/SERVER CONNECTIONS [ [124]Top ] [ [125]Contents ] [ [126]Next ]
++ [ [127]Previous ]
++
++ On any kind of connection you can make with Kermit -- serial, TCP/IP,
++ X.25, etc -- you can set up a convenient client/server relationship
++ between your Kermit client (the one that made the connection) and the
++ Kermit program on the far end of the connection (the remote Kermit) by
++ putting the remote Kermit in server mode. This is normally done by
++ giving it a SERVER command, or by starting it with the -x command-line
++ option. In some cases ([128]Internet Kermit Service, SSH connections
++ to a Kermit subsystem, or specially configured hosts), there is
++ already a Kermit server waiting on the far end. Here is a quick
++ synopsis of the commands you can give to the client for interacting
++ with the server:
++
++ SEND [ switches ] filename
++ Sends the named file to the server. The filename can include
++ wildcards. Lots of switches are available for file selection,
++ etc. Type HELP SEND at the client prompt for details.
++
++ GET [ switches ] filename
++ Asks the server to send the named file. The filename can
++ include wildcards. Type HELP GET at the client prompt for
++ details.
++
++ BYE
++ Terminates the server and closes your connection to it.
++
++ FINISH
++ Terminates the server. If you started the server yourself, this
++ leaves the remote host at its shell prompt. If it was a
++ dedicated server (such as IKSD or an SSH subsystem), FINISH is
++ equivalent to BYE.
++
++ SET LOCUS { LOCAL, REMOTE, AUTO }
++ (C-Kermit 8.0.201 and later, K95 1.1.21 and later) This tells
++ the client whether file-management commands like CD, PWD,
++ DIRECTORY, DELETE, MKDIR, etc, should be executed locally or by
++ the server. In this type of connection, the default is LOCAL.
++ Use SET LOCUS REMOTE if you want Kermit to behave like an FTP
++ client, in which case these commands are executed remotely, and
++ their local versions must have an L prefix: LCD, LPWD,
++ LDIRECTORY, etc. When LOCUS is LOCAL, then the remote versions
++ must have an R prefix: RCD, RPWD, RDIRECTORY, etc. HELP SET
++ LOCUS for details. SHOW COMMAND to see current locus.
++
++ The following commands are affected by SET LOCUS:
++
++ CD, LCD, RCD
++ Change (working, current) directory. HELP CD for details.
++
++ CDUP, LCDUP, RCDUP
++ CD one level up.
++
++ DIRECTORY, LDIRECTORY, RDIRECTORY
++ Produce a directory listing. Many options are available for local
++ listings. HELP DIRECTORY for details.
++
++ DELETE, LDELETE, RDELETE
++ Deletes files or directories. Many options available, HELP DELETE.
++
++ RENAME, LRENAME, RRENAME
++ Renames files or directories. Many options available, HELP RENAME.
++
++ MKDIR, LMKDIR, RMKDIR
++ Creates a directory. HELP MKDIR.
++
++ RMDIR, LRMDIR, RRMDIR
++ Removes a directory. HELP RMDIR. There are dozens -- maybe hundreds --
++ of other commands, described in the built-in help, on the website,
++ and/or in the published or online manuals. But even if you don't have
++ access to documentation, you can "set locus remote" and then use
++ pretty much the same commands you would use with any FTP client.
++
++ [ [129]Kermit Home ] [ [130]C-Kermit Home ] [ [131]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ KERMIT'S BUILT-IN FTP AND HTTP CLIENTS [ [132]Top ] [ [133]Contents ] [
++ [134]Next ] [ [135]Previous ]
++
++ Kermit's FTP client is like the regular Unix FTP client that you're
++ used to, but with some differences:
++
++ * It has lots more commands and features.
++ * You can have an FTP session and a regular Kermit serial or Telnet
++ session open at the same time.
++ * FTP sessions can be fully automated.
++
++ By default Kermit's FTP client tries its best to present the same user
++ interface as a regular FTP client: PUT, GET, DIR, CD, BYE, etc, should
++ work the same, even though some of these commands have different
++ meaning in Kermit-to-Kermit connections; for example, CD, DIR, RENAME,
++ etc, in Kermit act locally, whereas in FTP they are commands for the
++ server. This might cause some confusion, but as in all things Kermit,
++ you have total control:
++
++ * The [136]SET LOCUS command lets you specify where file management
++ commands should be executed -- locally or remotely -- for any kind
++ of connection.
++ * Any FTP command can be prefixed with the word "FTP" to remove any
++ ambiguity.
++
++ Pending publication of the next edition of the manual, the Kermit FTP
++ client is thoroughly documented at the Kermit Project website:
++
++ [137]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpclient.html
++
++ You also can use HELP FTP and HELP SET FTP to get descriptions of
++ Kermit's FTP-related commands.
++
++ The HTTP client is similar to the FTP one, except you prefix each
++ command with HTTP instead of FTP: HTTP OPEN, HTTP GET, HTTP PUT, HTTP
++ CLOSE, etc. Type HELP HTTP for details, or visit the to view the
++ [138]manual supplements. HTTP connections can be open at the same time
++ as regular serial or Telnet connections and FTP connections. So Kermit
++ can manage up to three types connections simultaneously.
++
++ [ [139]Kermit Home ] [ [140]C-Kermit Home ] [ [141]C-Kermit FAQ ] [
++ [142]FTP Client ] [ [143]HTTP Client ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ INTERNET KERMIT SERVICE [ [144]Top ] [ [145]Contents ] [ [146]Next ] [
++ [147]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit can be configured and run as an Internet service (called
++ IKSD), similar to an FTP server (FTPD) except you can (but need not)
++ interact with it directly, plus it does a lot more than an FTP server
++ can do. The TCP port for IKSD is 1649. It uses Telnet protocol.
++ C-Kermit can be an Internet Kermit Server, or it can be a client of an
++ IKSD. You can make connections from C-Kermit to an IKSD with any of
++ the following commands:
++
++ telnet foo.bar.edu 1649
++ telnet foo.bar.edu kermit ; if "kermit" is listed in /etc/services
++ iksd foo.bar.edu
++
++ The IKSD command is equivalent to a TELNET command specifying port
++ 1649. For more information about making and using connections to an
++ IKSD, see:
++
++ [148]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/cuiksd.html
++
++ You can run an Internet Kermit Service on your own computer too (if
++ you are the system administrator). For instructions, see:
++
++ [149]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++
++ [ [150]Kermit Home ] [ [151]C-Kermit Home ] [ [152]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ SECURITY [ [153]Top ] [ [154]Contents ] [ [155]Next ] [ [156]Previous ]
++
++ All of C-Kermit's built-in TCP/IP networking methods (Telnet, Rlogin,
++ IKSD, FTP, and HTTP) can be secured by one or more of the following
++ IETF-approved methods:
++
++ * MIT Kerberos IV
++ * MIT Kerberos V
++ * SSL/TLS
++ * Stanford SRP
++
++ For complete instructions see:
++
++ [157]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++
++ And as noted previously, you can also make SSH connections with
++ C-Kermit if you already have an SSH client installed.
++
++ [ [158]Kermit Home ] [ [159]C-Kermit Home ] [ [160]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ ALTERNATIVE COMMAND-LINE PERSONALITIES [ [161]Top ] [ [162]Contents ] [
++ [163]Next ] [ [164]Previous ]
++
++ When invoked as "kermit" or any other name besides any of the special
++ ones, C-Kermit has the command-line options described above in the
++ [165]OPTIONS section. However, if you invoke C-Kermit using any of the
++ following names:
++
++ telnet Telnet client
++ ftp FTP client
++ http HTTP client
++ https Secure HTTP client
++
++ Kermit's command-line personality changes to match. This can be done
++ (among other ways) with symbolic links (symlinks). For example, if you
++ want C-Kermit to be your regular Telnet client, or the Telnet helper
++ of your Web browser, you can create a link like the following in a
++ directory that lies in your PATH ahead of the regular telnet program:
++
++ ln -s /usr/local/bin/kermit telnet
++
++ Now when you give a "telnet" command, you are invoking Kermit instead,
++ but with its Telnet command-line personality so, for example:
++
++ telnet xyzcorp.com
++
++ Makes a Telnet connection to xyzcorp.com, and Kermit exits
++ automatically when the connection is closed (just like the regular
++ Telnet client). Type "telnet -h" to get a list of Kermit's
++ Telnet-personality command-line options, which are intended to be as
++ compatible as possible with the regular Telnet client.
++
++ Similarly for FTP:
++
++ ln -s /usr/local/bin/kermit ftp
++
++ And now type "ftp -h" to see its command-line options, and use command
++ lines just like you would give your regular FTP client:
++
++ ftp -n xyzcorp.com
++
++ but with additional options allowing an entire session to be specified
++ on the command line, as explained in the C-Kermit [166]FTP client
++ documentation.
++
++ And similarly for HTTP:
++
++ ln -s /usr/local/bin/kermit http
++ ./http -h
++ ./http www.columbia.edu -g kermit/index.html
++
++ Finally, if Kermit's first command-line option is a Telnet, FTP, IKSD,
++ or HTTP URL, Kermit automatically makes the appropriate kind of
++ connection and, if indicated by the URL, takes the desired action:
++
++ kermit telnet:xyzcorp.com ; Opens a Telnet session
++ kermit telnet://olga@xyzcorp.com ; Ditto for user olga
++ kermit ftp://olga@xyzcorp.com/public/oofa.zip ; Downloads a file
++ kermit kermit://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/READ.ME ; Ditto for IKSD
++ kermit iksd://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/READ.ME ; (This works too)
++ kermit http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html ; Grabs a web page
++ kermit https://wwws.xyzcorp.com/secret/plan.html ; Grabs a secure web pag
++e
++
++ [ [167]Kermit Home ] [ [168]C-Kermit Home ] [ [169]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ LICENSE [ [170]Top ] [ [171]Contents ] [ [172]Next ] [ [173]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit has an unusual license, but a fair and sensible one given
++ that the Kermit Project must support itself out of revenue: it's not a
++ BSD license, not GPL, not Artistic, not commercial, not shareware, not
++ freeware. It can be summed up like this: if you want C-Kermit for your
++ own use, you can download and use it without cost or license (but we'd
++ appreciate it if you would purchase the manual). But if you want to
++ sell C-Kermit or bundle it with a product or otherwise distribute it
++ in a commercial setting EXCEPT WITH AN OPEN-SOURCE OPERATING SYSTEM
++ DISTRIBUTION such as Linux, FreeBSD, NetBSD, or OpenBSD, you must
++ license it. To see the complete license, give the LICENSE command at
++ the prompt, or see the COPYING.TXT file distributed with C-Kermit 7.0
++ or later, or download it from
++ [174]ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/COPYING.TXT. Send
++ licensing inquiries to [175]kermit@columbia.edu.
++
++ [ [176]Kermit Home ] [ [177]C-Kermit Home ] [ [178]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ OTHER TOPICS [ [179]Top ] [ [180]Contents ] [ [181]Next ] [ [182]Previous ]
++
++ There's way more to C-Kermit than we've touched on here --
++ troubleshooting, customization, character sets, dialing directories,
++ sending pages, script writing, and on and on, all of which are covered
++ in the manual and updates and supplements. For the most up-to-date
++ information on documentation (or updated documentation itself) visit
++ the Kermit Project website:
++
++ [183]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++
++ There you will also find [184]Kermit software packages for other
++ platforms: different Unix varieties, Windows, DOS, VMS, IBM
++ mainframes, and many others: 20+ years' worth.
++
++ [ [185]Kermit Home ] [ [186]C-Kermit Home ] [ [187]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ DOCUMENTATION AND UPDATES [ [188]Top ] [ [189]Contents ] [ [190]Next ] [
++ [191]Previous ]
++
++ The manual for C-Kermit is:
++
++ 1. Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, [192]Using C-Kermit,
++ Second Edition, Digital Press / Butterworth-Heinemann, Woburn, MA,
++ 1997, 622 pages, ISBN 1-55558-164-1. This is a printed book. It
++ covers C-Kermit 6.0.
++ 2. The C-Kermit 7.0 Supplement:
++ [193]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html
++ 3. The C-Kermit 8.0 Supplement:
++ [194]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++
++ The C-Kermit home page is here:
++
++ [195]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++
++ Visit this page to learn about new versions, Beta tests, and other
++ news; to read case studies and tutorials; to download source code,
++ install packages, and [196]prebuilt binaries for many platforms. Also
++ visit:
++
++ [197]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/scriptlib.html
++ The Kermit script library and tutorial
++
++ [198]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/newfaq.html
++ The Kermit FAQ (Frequently Asked Questions about Kermit)
++
++ [199]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ The C-Kermit FAQ (Frequently Asked Questions about C-Kermit)
++
++ [200]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++ The Kermit security reference.
++
++ [201]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/telnet.html
++ C-Kermit Telnet client documentation.
++
++ [202]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/studies.html
++ Case studies.
++
++ [203]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ General C-Kermit Hints and Tips.
++
++ [204]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ Unix C-Kermit Hints and Tips.
++
++ [205]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckvbwr.html
++ VMS C-Kermit Hints and Tips.
++
++ [206]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ Unix C-Kermit Installation Instructions
++
++ [207]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckvins.html
++ VMS C-Kermit Installation Instructions
++
++ [208]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/support.html
++ Technical support.
++
++ [209]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95tutorial.html
++ Kermit 95 tutorial (this document).
++
++ [210]comp.protocols.kermit.misc
++ The Kermit newsgroup (unmoderated).
++
++ [ [211]Kermit Home ] [ [212]C-Kermit Home ] [ [213]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ FILES [ [214]Top ] [ [215]Contents ] [ [216]Next ] [ [217]Previous ]
++
++ [218]COPYING.TXT
++ C-Kermit license.
++
++ [219]~/.kermrc
++ Initialization file.
++
++ [220]~/.mykermrc
++ Customization file.
++
++ ~/.kdd
++ Kermit dialing directory (see manual).
++
++ ~/.knd
++ Kermit network directory (see manual).
++
++ ~/.ksd
++ Kermit services directory (see manual).
++
++ [221]ckuins.html
++ Installation instructions for Unix.
++
++ [222]ckcbwr.html
++ General C-Kermit bugs, hints, tips.
++
++ [223]ckubwr.html
++ Unix-specific C-Kermit bugs, hints, tips.
++
++ [224]ckcplm.html
++ C-Kermit program logic manual.
++
++ [225]ckccfg.html
++ C-Kermit compile-time configuration options.
++
++ ssh
++ (in your PATH) SSH connection helper.
++
++ rz, sz, etc.
++ (in your PATH) external protocols for XYZmodem.
++
++ /var/spool/locks (or whatever)
++ UUCP lockfile for dialing out (see [226]installation
++ instructions).
++
++ [ [227]Kermit Home ] [ [228]C-Kermit Home ] [ [229]C-Kermit FAQ ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ AUTHORS [ [230]Top ] [ [231]Contents ] [ [232]Previous ]
++
++ Frank da Cruz and Jeffrey E Altman
++ The Kermit Project - Columbia Univerity
++ 612 West 115th Street
++ New York NY 10025-7799
++ USA
++
++ 1985-present, with contributions from hundreds of others all over the
++ world.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 Unix Manual Page and Tutorial /
++ [233]kermit@columbia.edu / 24 October 2002
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.pdf
++ 4. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/test/text/ckuker.nr
++ 5. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#description
++ 6. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#synopsis
++ 7. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#options
++ 8. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#commands
++ 9. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#initfile
++ 10. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#modes
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#connections
++ 12. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#transfer
++ 13. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#server
++ 14. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#ftp
++ 15. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#iksd
++ 16. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#security
++ 17. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#personae
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#license
++ 19. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#other
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 21. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#files
++ 22. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#authors
++ 23. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 24. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 25. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#synopsis
++ 26. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 27. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 29. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2839.txt
++ 30. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2840.txt
++ 31. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 33. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 34. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 35. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 36. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 37. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 38. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#options
++ 39. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#synopsis
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#kerbang
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#personae
++ 42. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#kerbang
++ 43. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#initfile
++ 44. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#initfile
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#personae
++ 46. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#options
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#commands
++ 48. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 49. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 50. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 51. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 52. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 53. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#commands
++ 54. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#description
++ 55. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#commands
++ 56. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#personae
++ 57. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#personae
++ 58. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#iksd
++ 59. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#transfer
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#initfile
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#options
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#kerbang
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#cmdlist
++ 66. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 67. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#initfile
++ 68. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 69. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckscripts.html
++ 70. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 71. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 72. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 73. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 74. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 75. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#modes
++ 77. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#commands
++ 78. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 79. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 80. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 81. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 82. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 83. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#connections
++ 84. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#initfile
++ 85. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html#term
++ 86. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 87. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 88. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 89. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 90. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 91. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#transfer
++ 92. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#modes
++ 93. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#iksd
++ 94. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2217.txt
++ 95. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#ftp
++ 96. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 97. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 98. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 99. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 100. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 101. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#server
++ 102. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#connections
++ 103. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#download
++ 104. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#upload
++ 105. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#oldfashioned
++ 106. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#trouble
++ 107. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#advanced
++ 108. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#nonkermit
++ 109. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/kermit.html#notslow
++ 110. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 111. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95.html
++ 112. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95.html
++ 113. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 114. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/mskermit.html
++ 115. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 116. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/support.html
++ 117. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckmanual.html
++ 118. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 119. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 120. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#ftp
++ 121. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 122. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 123. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 124. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 125. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 126. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#ftp
++ 127. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#transfer
++ 128. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#iksd
++ 129. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 130. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 131. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 132. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 133. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 134. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#iksd
++ 135. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#transfer
++ 136. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#server
++ 137. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpclient.html
++ 138. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 139. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 140. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 141. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 142. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit3.html#x3
++ 143. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit3.html#x2.2
++ 144. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 145. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 146. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#security
++ 147. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#ftp
++ 148. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/cuiksd.html
++ 149. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 150. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 151. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 152. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 153. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 154. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 155. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#personae
++ 156. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#iksd
++ 157. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++ 158. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 159. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 160. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 161. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 162. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 163. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#license
++ 164. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#iksd
++ 165. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#options
++ 166. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit3.html#x3.1.2
++ 167. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 168. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 169. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 170. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 171. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 172. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#other
++ 173. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#personae
++ 174. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/COPYING.TXT
++ 175. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
++ 176. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 177. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 178. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 179. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 180. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 181. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 182. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#license
++ 183. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 184. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/howtoget.html
++ 185. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 186. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 187. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 188. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 189. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 190. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#files
++ 191. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#other
++ 192. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckmanual.html
++ 193. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html
++ 194. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++ 195. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 196. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80binaries.html
++ 197. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/scriptlib.html
++ 198. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/newfaq.html
++ 199. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 200. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++ 201. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/telnet.html
++ 202. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/studies.html
++ 203. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ 204. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 205. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckvbwr.html
++ 206. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 207. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckvins.html
++ 208. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/support.html
++ 209. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95tutorial.html
++ 210. news:comp.protocols.kermit.misc
++ 211. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 212. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 213. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 214. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 215. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 216. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#authors
++ 217. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#documentation
++ 218. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/COPYING.TXT
++ 219. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckermit.ini
++ 220. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckermod.ini
++ 221. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 222. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ 223. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 224. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html
++ 225. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 226. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 227. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 228. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 229. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html
++ 230. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#top
++ 231. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#contents
++ 232. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html#files
++ 233. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckuins.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,3519 @@
++
++C-Kermit 8.0 Unix Installation Instructions
++
++ [ [1]Contents ] [ [2]C-Kermit ] [ [3]Kermit Home ]
++
++ Frank da Cruz
++ The Kermit Project
++ Columbia University
++
++ As of C-Kermit version: 8.0.211, 10 April 2004
++ This file last updated: Tue Apr 13 10:14:33 2004 (New York City
++ time)
++
++ IF YOU ARE READING A PLAIN-TEXT version of this document, note that
++ this file is a plain-text dump of a Web page. You can visit the
++ original (and possibly more up-to-date) Web page here:
++
++[4]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++CONTENTS
++
++ [5]OVERVIEW
++
++ 1. [6]INTERNET QUICK START
++ 2. [7]INSTALLING FROM PACKAGES
++ 3. [8]INSTALLING PREBUILT BINARIES
++ 4. [9]BUILDING FROM SOURCE CODE
++ 5. [10]INSTALLING THE KERMIT FILES
++ 6. [11]INSTALLING UNIX C-KERMIT FROM DOS-FORMAT DISKETTES
++ 7. [12]CHECKING THE RESULTS
++ 8. [13]REDUCING THE SIZE OF THE EXECUTABLE PROGRAM IMAGE
++ 9. [14]UNIX VERSIONS
++ 10. [15]DIALING OUT AND COORDINATING WITH UUCP
++ 11. [16]RUNNING UNIX C-KERMIT SETUID OR SETGID
++ 12. [17]CONFIGURING UNIX WORKSTATIONS
++ 13. [18]BIZARRE BEHAVIOR AT RUNTIME
++ 14. [19]CRASHES AND CORE DUMPS
++ 15. [20]SYSLOGGING
++ 16. [21]BUILDING SECURE VERSIONS OF C-KERMIT 8.0
++ 17. [22]INSTALLING C-KERMIT AS AN SSH SERVER SUBSYSTEM
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++OVERVIEW
++
++ [ [23]Top ] [ [24]Contents ] [ [25]Next ]
++
++ WARNING: This document contains notes that have been accumulating
++ since the early 1980s. Many of the products and Unix versions
++ mentioned here have not been heard of in a long while, but that
++ does not necessarily mean they are not still running in some
++ obscure nook.
++
++ This file contains Unix-specific information. A lot of it. Unlike most
++ other packages, C-Kermit tries very hard to be portable to every Unix
++ variety (and every release of each one) known to exist, including many
++ that are quite old, as well as to other platforms like VMS, AOS/VS,
++ VOS, OS-9, the BeBox, the Amiga, etc.
++
++ Since C-Kermit gets so deeply into the file system, i/o system, and
++ other areas that differ radically from one Unix platform to the next,
++ this means that a lot can go wrong when you try to install C-Kermit on
++ (for example) a new release of a particular variety of Unix, in which
++ certain things might have changed that C-Kermit depended upon.
++
++ This file concentrates on installation. For a description of general
++ configuration options for C-Kermit, please read the [26]Configurations
++ Options document. For troubleshooting after installation, see the
++ [27]General Hints and Tips and [28]Unix-Specific Hints and Tips
++ documents. The latter, in particular, contains lots of information on
++ lots of specific Unix platforms. If you want to work on the source
++ code, see the [29]C-Kermit Program Logic Manual
++
++ You may install C-Kermit:
++
++ * From an "[30]install package", if one is available.
++ * As a [31]prebuilt binary, if available, plus accompanying text
++ files.
++ * By building from [32]source code.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++1. INTERNET QUICK START
++
++ [ [33]Top ] [ [34]Contents ] [ [35]Next ] [ [36]Previous ]
++
++ If your Unix computer is on the Internet and it has a C compiler,
++ here's how to download, build, and install C-Kermit directly from the
++ "tarballs" or Zip archives:
++
++ 1. Make a fresh directory and cd to it.
++ 2. Download the C-Kermit source code:
++ [37]ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/archives/cku211.tar.Z
++ (compress format) or
++ [38]ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/archives/cku211.tar.gz
++ (gunzip format).
++ 3. Uncompress the compressed tar file with "uncompress" or "gunzip",
++ according to which type of compressed file you downloaded. (If you
++ don't understand this, you could download a (much larger)
++ uncompressed tar archive directly:
++ [39]ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/archives/cku211.tar
++ 4. Now type "tar xvf cku211.tar" to unpack the individual files from
++ the tar archive.
++ 5. Type "rm cku211.tar" to get rid of the tar archive, which is no
++ longer needed.
++ 6. Read the comments at the top of the makefile to find out which
++ target to use and then type the appropriate "make" command, such
++ as "make linux", "make solaris8", etc.
++ 7. This produces a binary in your current directory called "wermit".
++ Start it by typing "./wermit" and [40]try it out to make sure it
++ works. Then read [41]Section 5 for how to install it, or simply
++ copy the wermit binary to the desired public directory, rename it
++ to kermit, and give it the needed permissions (and, if it is going
++ to be used to dial out, give it the same group and owner and
++ permissions as the cu, tip, or minicom program).
++
++ For secure installations, see [42]Sections 5 and [43]16.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++2. INSTALLING FROM PACKAGES
++
++ [ [44]Top ] [ [45]Contents ] [ [46]Next ] [ [47]Previous ]
++
++ Various Unix varieties -- Linux, Solaris, AIX, etc -- now incorporate
++ the idea of "install packages", and many users expect to find all new
++ applications in this format. A selection of install packages might be
++ available for any given release of C-Kermit, but there is a tradeoff
++ between convenience and safety. Unix presents several notable problems
++ to the builder of install packages:
++
++ a. Since C-Kermit is portable to many non-Unix platforms (VMS, VOS,
++ AOS/VS, etc), some of the files in the C-Kermit distribution do
++ not fit into the Unix application model. In particular, C-Kermit
++ includes some plain text files (described in [48]Section 5) and
++ Unix has no standard place to put such files. Typical Unix package
++ managers do not allow for them. Where should they go, and how will
++ the user know where to find them?
++ b. Installation of any program that will be used to make modem calls
++ requires some important decisions from the installer regarding
++ security and privilege.
++
++ Item (b) is discussed at length in [49]Sections 10 and [50]11 of this
++ document, but the package-related aspects are also given here. The
++ basic problem is that Unix dialout devices and the UUCP "lock files"
++ that regulate contention for them (described in [51]Section 10) are
++ usually protected against "world". Therefore, the install procedure
++ must either run as root in order to give the Kermit binary the
++ required permissions, group, and/or owner, or else the dialout devices
++ and associated directories must be open for group or world reading and
++ writing. Otherwise, the Kermit program just installed WILL NOT WORK
++ for dialing out.
++
++ Thus, a well-crafted installation procedure should present the options
++ and allow the installer to choose the method, if any, for regulating
++ access to the dialout devices:
++
++ a. Check the permissions of the lockfile directory and the dialout
++ devices. If they do not allow group or world R/W access, then:
++ b. "Your UUCP lockfile directory and/or dialout devices require
++ privilege to access. You must either change their permissions or
++ install Kermit with privileges."
++ c. "If you wish to install Kermit with privileges, it will be given
++ the same owner, group, and permissions as the cu program so it can
++ use the dialout devices."
++ d. If they choose (c) but the user is not root, give a message that
++ the install procedure can be run only by root and then quit.
++
++ It should go without saying, of course, that any binaries that are to
++ be included in an install package should be built fresh on the exact
++ platform (e.g. Red Hat 8.0 on Intel) for which the package is
++ targeted; prebuilt binaries ([52]next section) from other sites are
++ likely to have library mismatches. [53]CLICK HERE for more about
++ building C-Kermit install packages.
++
++ The Kermit Project does not have the resources or the expertise to
++ make install packages for every platform. Most install packages,
++ therefore, are contributed by others, and they do not necessarily
++ follow the guidelines given above. Pay attention to what they do.
++
++ If you are an end user who has obtained a C-Kermit install package for
++ a particular platform, you should be aware that some additional steps
++ might needed if you want to use Kermit to dial out. Read [54]Section
++ 10 for details.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++3. INSTALLING PREBUILT BINARIES
++
++ [ [55]Top ] [ [56]Contents ] [ [57]Next ] [ [58]Previous ]
++
++ Hundreds of prebuilt C-Kermit binaries are available on the CDROM in
++ the BINARY tree [NOTE: The C-Kermit CDROM is still for version 7.0],
++ and at our ftp site in the [59]kermit/bin area (with names starting
++ with "ck"), also accessible on the [60]C-Kermit website. To install a
++ prebuilt binary:
++
++ a. Rename the binary to "wermit".
++ b. Make sure it works; some tests are suggested in [61]Section 7.
++ c. Follow steps (b) through (e) in [62]Section 4.
++ d. Install related files as described in [63]Section 5.
++
++ But first... Please heed the following cautions:
++
++ a. If you pick the wrong binary, it won't work (or worse).
++ b. Even when you pick the appropriate binary, it still might not work
++ due to shared-library mismatches, etc. (see [64]Section 4.0).
++ c. Don't expect a binary built on or for version n of your OS to work
++ on version n - x (where x > 0). However, it is usually safe to run
++ a binary built on (or for) an older OS release on a newer one.
++
++ Therefore, it is better to build your own binary from source code
++ ([65]next section) if you can. But since it is increasingly for Unix
++ systems (not to mention VMS and other OS's) to be delivered without C
++ compilers, it is often impractical. In such cases, try the most
++ appropriate prebuilt binary or binaries, and if none of them work,
++ [66]contact us and we'll see what we can do to help.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++4. BUILDING FROM SOURCE CODE
++
++ [ [67]Top ] [ [68]Contents ] [ [69]Next ] [ [70]Previous ]
++
++ Also see: [71]Section 8 and [72]Section 9.
++
++ C-Kermit is designed to be built and used on as many platforms as
++ possible: Unix and non-Unix, old and new (and ancient), ANSI C and
++ K&R. The Unix version does not use or depend on any external tools for
++ building except the "make" utility, the C compiler, and the linker. It
++ does not use any automated configuration tools such as configure,
++ autoconf, automake, libtool, etc. Everything in C-Kermit has been
++ built by hand based on direct experience or reports or contributions
++ from users of each platform.
++
++ The [73]C-Kermit makefile contains the rules for building the program
++ for each of the hundreds of different kinds of Unix systems that
++ C-Kermit attempts to support. It covers all Unix variations since
++ about 1980 -- pretty much everything after Unix V6. Separate makefiles
++ are used for [74]Plan 9 and [75]2.x BSD.
++
++ Prerequisites:
++
++ * The C compiler, linker, and make program must be installed.
++ * The C libraries and header files must be installed (*).
++ * The C-Kermit source code and makefile in your current directory.
++ * The C-Kermit text files ([76]Section 5) in your current directory.
++
++ * This is becoming problematic in this new age of "selective
++ installs" e.g. of Linux packages. C-Kermit builds will often fail
++ because replying "no" to some obscure Linux installation option
++ will result in missing libraries or header files. Ditto on
++ platforms like AIX and Solaris that don't come with C compilers,
++ and then later have gcc installed, but are still missing crucial
++ libraries, like libm (math).
++
++ Plus:
++
++ * For TCP/IP networking support, the sockets library and related
++ header files must be installed.
++ * The math library for floating-point arithmetic support (can be
++ deselected by adding -DNOFLOAT to CFLAGS and removing -lm from
++ LIBS).
++ * Many and varied security libraries for building a secure version
++ (Kerberos, SSL/TLS, SRP, Zlib,...) These are required only if you
++ select a secure target.
++ * For the curses-based fullscreen file-ransfer display, the curses
++ or ncurses header file(s) and library, and probably also the
++ termcap and/or termlib library. Note that the names and locations
++ of these files and libraries are likely to change capriciously
++ with every new release of your Unix product. If you discover that
++ the C-Kermit build procedure fails because your curses and/or
++ termxxx headers or libraries are not named or located as expected,
++ please [77]let us know. In the meantime, work around by installing
++ symlinks.
++ * IMPORTANT: Modern Linux distributions might give you the choice
++ during installation of whether to install the "ncurses development
++ package" (perhaps called "ncurses-devel"). If you did not install
++ it, you won't be able to build C-Kermit with curses support
++ included. In this case, either go back and install ncurses, or
++ else choose (or create) a non-curses makefile target for your
++ platform. To install the ncurses developers tools in Red Hat
++ Linux, do:
++
++mount redhat cdrom
++goto RedHat/RPMS
++rpm -ivh ncurses-devel*.rpm
++or to have the exact name ls ncurse* and load as
++rpm -ivh filename
++then leave the cdrom and unmount it.
++
++ * In AIX you might have to go back and install any or all of:
++
++bos.adt.base
++bos.adt.include
++bos.adt.lib
++bos.adt.libm
++bos.adt.utils
++
++ from the first installation CD.
++
++ The makefile might need to be renamed from ckuker.mak to makefile.
++ Directions:
++
++ a. Type "make xxx" where xxx is the name of the makefile target most
++ appropriate to your platform, e.g. "make linux", "make aix43",
++ etc. Read the [78]comments at the top of the makefile for a
++ complete list of available targets (it's a long list).
++ b. Test the resulting 'wermit' file (see [79]Section 7 for
++ suggestions). If it's OK, proceed; otherwise [80]notify us.
++
++ NOTE: steps (c) through (e) can be accomplished using the
++ [81]makefile 'install' target as described in [82]Section 5.4.
++ c. Rename the 'wermit' file to 'kermit', copy it to the desired
++ binary directory (such as /usr/local/bin or /opt/something), and
++ if it is to be used for dialing out, give it the same owner,
++ group, and permissions as the 'cu' program (IMPORTANT: read
++ [83]Sections 10 and [84]11 for details).
++ d. Install the man page, ckuker.nr, with your other man pages.
++ e. Install the accompanying text files (see [85]Section 5).
++ f. If you want C-Kermit to also offer a Telnet command-line
++ personality, make a symbolic link as follows:
++
++cd directory-where-kermit-binary-is
++ln -s kermit telnet
++
++ If you want C-Kermit to be the default Telnet client, make sure
++ the directory in which you created the symlink is in the PATH
++ ahead of the where the regular Telnet client is.
++ g. If you want C-Kermit to also offer an FTP command-line
++ personality, make a symlink called "ftp" as in (f).
++ h. If you want C-Kermit to also offer an FTTP command-line
++ personality, make a symlink called "http" as in (f).
++ i. If you want to offer an Internet Kermit Service, follow the
++ directions in the [86]IKSD Administrator's Guide.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0. Special Considerations for C-Kermit 8.0
++
++ [ [87]Top ] [ [88]Contents ] [ [89]Next ]
++
++ Also see: [90]C-Kermit Configuration Options
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++4.1. [91]The Unix Makefile
++4.2. [92]The C-Kermit Initialization File
++4.3. [93]The 2.x BSD Makefile
++4.4. [94]The Plan 9 Makefile
++4.5. [95]Makefile Failures
++
++ (Also see the [96]Configurations Options document, [97]Section 8).
++
++ Lots of new features have been added in versions 7.0 and 8.0 that
++ require access to new symbols, APIs, libraries, etc, and this will no
++ doubt cause problems in compiling, linking, or execution on platforms
++ where 6.0 and earlier built without incident. This section contains
++ what we know as of the date of this file.
++
++ The first category concerns the new Kermit Service Daemon (IKSD; see
++ the [98]IKSD Administrator's Guide for details):
++
++ The wtmp File
++ When C-Kermit is started as an IKSD (under inetd), it makes
++ syslog and wtmp entries, and also keeps its own ftpd-like log.
++ The code assumes the wtmp log is /var/log/wtmp on Linux and
++ /usr/adm/wtmp elsewhere. No doubt this assumption will need
++ adjustment. Use -DWTMPFILE=path to override at compile time
++ (there is also a runtime override). See [99]iksd.html for
++ details.
++
++ UTMP, utsname(), etc
++ C-Kermit 7.0 gets as much info as it can about its job --
++ mainly for IKSD logging -- from utmp. But of course utmp
++ formats and fields differ, and for that matter, there can be
++ two different header files, <utmp.h> and <utmpx.h>. Look for
++ HAVEUTMPX and HAVEUTHOST in [100]ckufio.c and let me know of
++ any needed adjustments.
++
++ Password lookup
++ IKSD needs to authenticate incoming users against the password
++ list. In some cases, this requires the addition of -lcrypt
++ (e.g. in Unixware 2.x). In most others, the crypt functions are
++ in the regular C library. If you get "crypt" as an unresolved
++ symbol at link time, add -lcrypt to LIBS. If your site has
++ local replacement libraries for authentication, you might need
++ a special LIBS clause such as "LIBS=-L/usr/local/lib -lpwent".
++
++ These days most Unix systems take advantage of shadow password
++ files or Plugable Authentication Modules (PAM). If your system
++ uses shadow passwords you must add -DCK_SHADOW to the CFLAGS
++ list. If your system requires PAM you must add -DCK_PAM to the
++ CFLAGS and -lpam -ldl to LIBS.
++
++ getusershell()
++ This is called by the IKSD at login time to see if a user has
++ been "turned off". But many Unix platforms lack this function.
++ In that case, you will get unresolved symbol reports at link
++ time for _getusershell, _endusershell; to work around, add
++ -DNOGETUSERSHELL.
++
++ initgroups()
++ This is called by IKSD after successful authentication. But
++ some platforms do not have this function, so obviously it can't
++ be called there, in which case add -DNOINITGROUPS.
++
++ setreuid(), setreuid(), setregid() not found or "deprecated"
++ Find out what your Unix variety wants you to use instead, and
++ make appropriate substitutions in routine zvpass(), module
++ [101]ckufio.c, and [102]let us know.
++
++ printf()
++ IKSD installs a printf() substitute to allow redirection of
++ printf-like output to the connection. However, this can
++ conflict with some curses libraries. In this case, separate
++ binaries must be built for IKSD and non-IKSD use.
++
++ If you encounter difficulties with any of the above, and you are not
++ interested in running C-Kermit as an IKSD, then simply add NOIKSD to
++ CFLAGS and rebuild. Example:
++
++make sco286
++(get lots of errors)
++make clean
++make sco286 "KFLAGS=-DNOIKSD"
++
++ Some non-IKSD things to watch out for:
++
++ Return type of main()
++ The main() routine is in [103]ckcmai.c. If you get complaints
++ about "main: return type is not blah", define MAINTYPE on the
++ CC command line, e.g.:
++
++make xxx "KFLAGS=-DMAINTYPE=blah
++
++ (where blah is int, long, or whatever). If the complaint is
++ "Attempt to return a value from a function of type void" then
++ add -DMAINISVOID:
++
++make xxx "KFLAGS=-DMAINISVOID=blah
++
++ DNS Service Records
++ This feature allows a remote host to redirect C-Kermit to the
++ appropriate socket for the requested service; e.g. if C-Kermit
++ requests service "telnet" and the host offers Telnet service on
++ port 999 rather than the customary port 23. If you get
++ compile-time complaints about not being able to find
++ <resolv.h>, <netdb.h>, or <arpa/nameser.h>, add -DNO_DNS_SRV to
++ CFLAGS. If you get link-time complaints about unresolved
++ symbols res_search or dn_expand, try adding -lresolve to LIBS.
++
++ \v(ipaddress)
++ If "echo \v(ipaddress)" shows an empty string rather than your
++ local IP address, add -DCKGHNLHOST to CFLAGS and rebuild.
++
++ <sys/wait.h>
++ If this file can't be found at compile time, add -DNOREDIRECT
++ to CFLAGS. This disables the REDIRECT and PIPE commands and
++ anything else that needs the wait() system service.
++
++ syslog()
++ C-Kermit can now write syslog records. Some older platforms
++ might not have the syslog facility. In that case, add
++ -DNOSYSLOG. Others might have it, but require addition of
++ -lsocket to LIBS (SCO OSR5 is an example). See [104]Section 15.
++
++ putenv()
++ If "_putenv" comes up as an undefined symbol, add -DNOPUTENV to
++ CFLAGS and rebuild.
++
++ "Passing arg1 of 'time' from incompatible pointer"
++ This is a mess. See the mass of #ifdefs in the appropriate
++ module, [105]ckutio.c or [106]ckufio.c.
++
++ gettimeofday()
++ Wrong number of arguments. On most platforms, gettimeofday()
++ takes two arguments, but on a handful of others (e.g. Motorola
++ System V/88 V4, SNI Reliant UNIX 5.43, etc) it takes one. If
++ your version of gettimeofday() is being called with two args
++ but wants one, add -DGTODONEARG.
++
++ "Assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast"
++ This warning might appear in [107]ckutio.c or [108]ckufio.c.
++ (or elsewhere), and usually can be traced to the use of a
++ system or library function that returns a pointer but that is
++ not declared in the system header files even though it should
++ be. Several functions are commonly associated with this error:
++
++ + getcwd(): Add -DDCLGETCWD to CFLAGS and rebuild.
++ + popen() : Add -DDCLPOPEN to CFLAGS and rebuild.
++ + fdopen(): Add -DDCLFDOPEN to CFLAGS and rebuild.
++
++ "Operands of = have incompatible types"
++ "Incompatible types in assignment"
++ If this comes from [109]ckcnet.c and comes from a statement
++ involving inet_addr(), try adding -DINADDRX to CFLAGS. If that
++ doesn't help, then try adding -DNOMHHOST.
++
++ Complaints about args to get/setsockopt(), getpeername(),
++ getsockname()
++ These are all in [110]ckcnet.c. Different platforms and OS's
++ and versions of the same OS change this all the time: int,
++ size_t, unsigned long, etc. All the affected variables are
++ declared according to #ifdefs within ckcnet.c, so find the
++ declarations and adjust the #ifdefs accordingly.
++
++ size_t
++ In case of complaints about "unknown type size_t", add
++ -DSIZE_T=int (or other appropriate type) to CFLAGS.
++
++ 'tz' undefined
++ Use of undefined enum/struct/union 'timezone'
++ Left of 'tv_sec' specifies undefined struct/union 'timeval' And
++ similar complaints in [111]ckutio.c: Add -DNOGFTIMER and/or
++ -DNOTIMEVAL.
++
++ Symlinks
++ The new built-in DIRECTORY command should show symlinks like
++ "ls -l" does. If it does not, check to see if your platform has
++ the lstat() and readlink() functions. If so, add -DUSE_LSTAT
++ and -DCKSYMLINK to CFLAGS and rebuild. On the other hand, if
++ lstat() is unresolved at link time, add -DNOLSTAT to CFLAGS. If
++ readlink() is also unresolved, add -DNOSYMLINK.
++
++ realpath()
++ Link-time complains about realpath() -- find the library in
++ which it resides and add it to LIBS (example for Unixware 7.1:
++ "-lcudk70") or add -DNOREALPATH to CFLAGS and rebuild. If built
++ with realpath() but debug log file is truncated or mangled,
++ ditto (some realpath() implementations behave differently from
++ others). If built with realpath() and seemingly random core
++ dumps occur during file path resolution, ditto.
++
++ Failure to locate header file <term.h>
++ Usually happens on Linux systems that have the C compiler
++ installed, but not the ncurses package (see comments about
++ selective installs above). Go back and install ncurses, or use
++ "make linuxnc" (Linux No Curses).
++
++ "Can't find shared library libc.so.2.1"
++ "Can't find shared library libncurses.so.3.0", etc...
++ You are trying to run a binary that was built on a computer
++ that has different library versions than your computer, and
++ your computer's loader is picky about library version numbers.
++ Rebuild from source on your computer.
++
++ Time (struct tm) related difficulties:
++ Errors like the following:
++
++"ckutio.c", line 11994: incomplete struct/union/enum tm: _tm
++"ckutio.c", line 11995: error: cannot dereference non-pointer type
++"ckutio.c", line 11995: error: assignment type mismatch
++"ckutio.c", line 11997: warning: using out of scope declaration: localtime
++"ckutio.c", line 11997: error: unknown operand size: op "="
++"ckutio.c", line 11997: error: assignment type mismatch
++"ckutio.c", line 11998: error: undefined struct/union member: tm_year
++"ckutio.c", line 12000: error: undefined struct/union member: tm_mon
++"ckutio.c", line 12001: error: undefined struct/union member: tm_mday
++"ckutio.c", line 12002: error: undefined struct/union member: tm_hour
++"ckutio.c", line 12003: error: undefined struct/union member: tm_min
++"ckutio.c", line 12004: error: undefined struct/union member: tm_sec
++
++ are due to failure to include the appropriate time.h header
++ files. Unix platforms generally have one or more of the
++ following: <time.h>, <sys/time.h>, and <sys/timeb.h>. Any
++ combination of these might be required. Defaults are set up for
++ each makefile target. The defaults can be corrected on the CC
++ command line by adding the appropriate definition from the
++ following list to CFLAGS:
++
++-DTIMEH Include <time.h>
++-DNOTIMEH Don't include <time.h>
++-DSYSTIMEH Include <sys/time.h>
++-DNOSYSTIMEH Don't include <sys/time.h>
++-DSYSTIMEBH Include <sys/timeb.h>
++-DNOSYSTIMEBH Don't include <sys/timeb.h>
++
++ Note that <sys/timeb.h> is relatively scarce in the System V
++ and POSIX environments; the only platform of recent vintage
++ where it was/is used is OSF/1 and its derivatives (Digital Unix
++ and Tru64 Unix).
++
++ Struct timeval and/or timezone not declared:
++ In some cases, merely including the appropriate time.h header
++ files is still not enough. POSIX.1 does not define the timeval
++ struct, and so the items we need from the header are protected
++ against us by #ifndef _POSIX_SOURCE or somesuch. In this case,
++ we have to declare the timeval (and timezone) structs
++ ourselves. To force this, include -DDCLTIMEVAL in CFLAGS.
++
++ Warnings about dn_expand() Argument #4
++ WARNING: argument is incompatible with prototyp. It's the old
++ char versus unsigned char stupidity again. Try to find a
++ compiler switch like GCC's "-funsigned-char". Failing that, add
++ -DCKQUERYTYPE=xxx to CFLAGS, where xxx is whatever 'man
++ dn_expand' tells you the type of the 4th argument should be
++ (presumably either char or unsigned char; in the latter case
++ use CHAR to avoid confusion caused by multiple words.
++
++ Switch Table Overflow (in [112]ckcuni.c)
++ Add -DNOUNICODE to CFLAGS.
++
++ Compile-time warnings about ck_out() or tgetstr() or tputs():
++ Easy solution: Add -DNOTERMCAP to CFLAGS. But then you lose the
++ SCREEN function. Real solution: Try all different combinations
++ of the following CFLAGS:
++
++-DTPUTSARGTYPE=char -DTPUTSFNTYPE=int
++-DTPUTSARGTYPE=int -DTPUTSFNTYPE=void
++
++ Until the warnings go away, except maybe "ck_outc: return with
++ a value in a function returning void", and in that case also
++ add -DTPUTSISVOID.
++
++ "Passing arg 1 of to tputs() makes pointer from integer without a
++ cast":
++ Add -DTPUTSARG1CONST to CFLAGS.
++
++ "Undefined symbol: dup2"
++ Add -DNOZEXEC to CFLAGS.
++
++ "header file 'termcap.h' not found"
++ Add -DNOHTERMCAP to CFLAGS.
++
++ Other difficulties are generally of the "where is curses.h and what is
++ it called this week?" variety (most easily solved by making symlinks
++ in the include and lib directories), or overzealous complaints
++ regarding type mismatches in function calls because of the totally
++ needless and silly signed versus unsigned char conflict (*), etc. In
++ any case, please send any compilation or linking warnings or errors to
++ the author, preferably along with fixes.
++
++ * C-Kermit does not use the signed property of chars at all
++ anywhere, ever. So if all chars and char *'s can be made unsigned
++ at compile time, as they can in gcc with "-funsigned-char", they
++ should be.
++
++ IMPORTANT: If you find any of these hints necessary for a particular
++ make target (or you hit upon others not listed here), PLEASE SEND A
++ REPORT TO:
++
++[113]kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.1. The Unix Makefile
++
++ [ [114]Top ] [ [115]Contents ] [ [116]Section Contents ] [ [117]Next ]
++ [ [118]Previous ]
++
++ If your distribution does not contain a file with the name "makefile"
++ or "Makefile", then rename the file called ckuker.mak to makefile:
++
++mv ckuker.mak makefile
++
++ Then type "make xxx", where xxx is the platform you want to build
++ C-Kermit for. These are listed in the [119]comments at the top of the
++ makefile. For example, to build C-Kermit for Linux, type:
++
++make linux
++
++ Here are some typical examples:
++
++ Target Description
++ linux Linux, any version on any hardware platform
++ openbsd OpenBSD, any version on any hardware platform
++ aix43 AIX 4.3
++ aix43g AIX 4.3, built with gcc
++ solaris9 Solaris 9
++ solaris9g Solaris 9 built with gcc
++ hpux1100 HP-UX 11-point-anything
++
++ The makefile is quite long, and at least two versions of Unix, SCO
++ Xenix/286 and 2.x BSD, cannot cope with its length. An attempt to
++ "make sco286" gives the message "Make: Cannot alloc mem for env..
++ Stop". Solution: edit away some or all of the nonrelevant material
++ from the makefile. (A separate version of the makefile is provided for
++ BSD 2.x: ckubs2.mak but C-Kermit 8.0 can't be built for BSD 2.x -- it
++ has simply grown too large.)
++
++ Some make programs reportedly cannot handle continued lines (lines
++ ending in backslash (\)). If you have a problem with the makefile, try
++ editing the makefile to join the continued lines (remove the
++ backslashes and the following linefeed).
++
++ Other makefile troubles may occur because tabs in the makefile have
++ somehow been converted to spaces. Spaces and tabs are distinct in Unix
++ makefiles.
++
++ Similarly, carriage returns might have been added to the end of each
++ line, which also proves confusing to most Unix versions of make.
++
++ Check to see if there are comments about your particular version in
++ its makefile target itself. In a text editor such as EMACS or VI,
++ search for the make entry name followed by a colon, e.g. "linux:" (if
++ you really are building C-Kermit for Linux, do this now).
++
++ Check to see if there are comments about your particular version in
++ the [120]ckubwr.txt file ([121]CLICK HERE for the Web version).
++
++ If you have trouble with building [122]ckwart.c, or running the
++ resulting wart preprocessor program on [123]ckcpro.w:
++
++ 1. Just "touch" the [124]ckcpro.c file that comes in the distribution
++ and then give the "make" command again, or:
++ 2. Compile ckwart.c "by hand": cc -o wart ckwart.c, or:
++ 3. Try various other tricks. E.g. one Linux user reported that that
++ adding the "static" switch to the rule for building wart fixed
++ everything:
++
++wart: ckwart.$(EXT)
++ $(CC) -static -o wart ckwart.$(EXT) $(LIBS)
++
++ If your compiler supports a compile-time option to treat ALL chars
++ (and char *'s, etc) as unsigned, by all means use it -- and send me
++ email to let me know what it is (I already know about gcc
++ -funsigned-char).
++
++ To add compilation options (which are explained later in this
++ document) to your makefile target without editing the makefile,
++ include "KFLAGS=..." on the make command line, for example:
++
++make linux KFLAGS=-DNODEBUG
++make bsd "KFLAGS=-DKANJI -DNODEBUG -DNOTLOG -DDYNAMIC -UTCPSOCKET"
++
++ Multiple options must be separated by spaces. Quotes are necessary if
++ the KFLAGS= clause includes spaces. The KFLAGS are added to the end of
++ the CFLAGS that are defined in the selected makefile target. For
++ example, the "bsd" entry includes -DBSD4 -DTCPSOCKET, so the second
++ example above compiles Kermit with the following options:
++
++-DBSD4 -DTCPSOCKET -DKANJI -DNODEBUG -DNOTLOG -DDYNAMIC -UTCPSOCKET
++
++ (Notice how "-UTCPSOCKET" is used to negate the effect of the
++ "-DTCPSOCKET" option that is included in the makefile target.)
++
++ WARNING: Be careful with KFLAGS. If you build C-Kermit, change some
++ files, and then run make again using the same make entry but
++ specifying different KFLAGS than last time, make won't detect it and
++ you could easily wind up with inconsistent object modules, e.g. some
++ of them built with a certain option, others not. When in doubt, "make
++ clean" first to make sure all your object files are consistent.
++ Similarly, if you change CFLAGS, LIBS, or any other items in the
++ makefile, or you rebuild using a different makefile target, "make
++ clean" first.
++
++ If you create a new makefile target, use static linking if possible.
++ Even though this makes your C-Kermit binary bigger, the resulting
++ binary will be more portable. Dynamically linked binaries tend to run
++ only on the exact configuration and version where they were built; on
++ others, invocation tends to fail with a message like:
++
++Can't find shared library "libc.so.2.1"
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2. The C-Kermit Initialization File
++
++ [ [125]Top ] [ [126]Contents ] [ [127]Section Contents ] [ [128]Next ]
++ [ [129]Previous ]
++
++ (This section is obsolete.) Read [130]Section 5 about the
++ initialization file.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.3. The 2.x BSD Makefile
++
++ [ [131]Top ] [ [132]Contents ] [ [133]Section Contents ] [ [134]Next ]
++ [ [135]Previous ]
++
++ This section is obsolete. C-Kermit 6.0 was the last release that
++ could be built on PDP-11 based BSD versions.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.4. The Plan 9 Makefile
++
++ [ [136]Top ] [ [137]Contents ] [ [138]Section Contents ] [ [139]Next ]
++ [ [140]Previous ]
++
++ Use the separate makefile [141]ckpker.mk. NOTE: The Plan 9 version of
++ C-Kermit 8.0 has not yet been built. There should be no impediment to
++ building it. However, even when built successfully, certain key
++ features are missing, notably TCP/IP networking.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.5. Makefile Failures
++
++ [ [142]Top ] [ [143]Contents ] [ [144]Section Contents ] [
++ [145]Previous ]
++
++ First, be sure the source files are stored on your current disk and
++ directory with the right names (in lowercase). Second, make sure that
++ the makefile itself does not contain any lines with leading spaces:
++ indented lines must all start with horizontal TAB, and no spaces.
++
++ Then make sure that your Unix PATH is defined to find the appropriate
++ compiler for your makefile target. For example, on SunOS systems,
++ "make sunos41" builds C-Kermit for the BSD environment, and assumes
++ that /usr/ucb/cc will be used for compilation and linking. If your
++ PATH has /usr/5bin ahead of /usr/ucb, you can have problems at compile
++ or link time (a commonly reported symptom is the inability to find
++ "ftime" during linking). Fix such problems by redefining your Unix
++ PATH, or by specifying the appropriate "cc" in CC= and CC2= statements
++ in your makefile target.
++
++ During edits 166-167, considerable effort went into making C-Kermit
++ compilable by ANSI C compilers. This includes prototyping all of
++ C-Kermit's functions, and including the ANSI-defined system header
++ files for system and library functions, as defined in K&R, second
++ edition: <string.h>, <stdlib.h>, <unistd.h> (except in NeXTSTEP this
++ is <libc.h>), and <sys/stdtypes.h>. If you get warnings about any of
++ these header files not being found, or about argument mismatches
++ involving pid_t, uid_t, or gid_t, look in ckcdeb.h and make
++ amendments. C-Kermit assumes it is being compiled by an ANSI-compliant
++ C compiler if __STDC__ is defined, normally defined by the compiler
++ itself. You can force ANSI compilation without defining __STDC__
++ (which some compilers won't let you define) by including -DCK_ANSIC on
++ the cc command line.
++
++ On the other hand, if your compiler defines __STDC__ but still
++ complains about the syntax of Kermit's function prototypes, you can
++ disable the ANSI-style function prototyping by including -DNOANSI on
++ the command line.
++
++ For SCO OpenServer, UNIX, ODT, and XENIX compilations, be sure to pick
++ the most appropriate [146]makefile target, and be sure you have
++ installed an SCO development system that is keyed to your exact SCO
++ operating system release, down to the minor version (like 2.3.1).
++
++ Also note that SCO distributes some of its libraries in encrypted
++ form, and they must be decrypted before C-Kermit can be linked with
++ them. If not, you might see a message like:
++
++ld: file /usr/lib/libsocket.a is of unknown type: magic number = 6365
++
++ To decrypt, you must supply a key (password) that came with your
++ license. Call SCO for further info.
++
++ If your compiler uses something other than int for the pid (process
++ id) data type, put -DPID_T=pid_t or whatever in your CFLAGS.
++
++ If you get complaints about unknown data types uid_t and gid_t, put
++ -DUID_T=xxx -DGID_T=yyy in your CFLAGS, where xxx and yyy are the
++ appropriate types.
++
++ If your compilation fails because of conflicting or duplicate
++ declarations for sys_errlist, add -DUSE_STRERROR or -DNDSYSERRLIST to
++ CFLAGS.
++
++ If your compilation dies because getpwnam() is being redeclared (or
++ because of "conflicting types for getwpnam"), add -DNDGPWNAM to your
++ CFLAGS. If that doesn't work, then add -DDCGPWNAM to your CFLAGS (see
++ ckufio.c around line 440).
++
++ If the compiler complains about the declaration of getpwnam() during
++ an ANSI C compilation, remove the declaration from ckufio.c or change
++ the argument in the prototype from (char *) to (const char *).
++
++ If you get complaints that getpwuid() is being called with an improper
++ type, put -DPWID_T=xx in your CFLAGS.
++
++ If you get compile-time warnings that t_brkc or t_eofc (tchars
++ structure members, used in BSD-based versions) are undefined, or
++ structure-member- related warnings that might be traced to this fact,
++ add -DNOBRKC to CFLAGS.
++
++ If you get a linker message to the effect that _setreuid or _setregid
++ is not defined, add -DNOSETREU to CFLAGS, or add -DCKTYP_H=blah to
++ CFLAGS to make C-Kermit read the right <types.h>-kind-of-file to pick
++ up these definitions.
++
++ If you get a message that _popen is undefined, add -DNOPOPEN to
++ CFLAGS.
++
++ If you get a complaint at compile time about an illegal
++ pointer-integer combination in ckufio.c involving popen(), or at link
++ time that _popen is an undefined symbol, add the declaration "FILE
++ *popen();" to the function zxcmd() in ckufio.c (this declaration is
++ supposed to be in <stdio.h>). If making this change does not help,
++ then apparently your Unix does not have the popen() function, so you
++ should add -DNOPOPEN to your make entry, in which case certain
++ functions involving "file" i/o to the standard input and output of
++ subprocesses will not be available.
++
++ If your linker complains that _getcwd is undefined, you can add a
++ getcwd() function to ckufio.c, or add it to your libc.a library using
++ ar:
++
++#include <stdio.h>
++
++char *
++getcwd(buf,size) char *buf; int size; {
++#ifndef NOPOPEN
++#ifdef DCLPOPEN
++ FILE *popen();
++#endif
++ FILE *pfp;
++
++ if (!buf) return(NULL);
++ if (!(pfp = popen("pwd","r"))) return(NULL);
++ fgets(buf,size-2,pfp);
++ pclose(pfp);
++ buf[strlen(buf)-1] = '\0';
++ return((char *)buf);
++#else
++ buf[0] = '\0';
++ return(NULL);
++#endif /* NOPOPEN */
++}
++
++#ifdef NOPOPEN
++FILE *popen(s,t) char *s,*t; {
++ return(NULL);
++}
++#endif /* NOPOPEN */
++
++ If you get complaints about NPROC having an invalid value, add a valid
++ definition for it (depends on your system), as in the cray entry.
++
++ If you get some symbol that's multiply defined, it probably means that
++ a variable name used by Kermit is also used in one of your system
++ libraries that Kermit is linked with. For example, under PC/IX some
++ library has a variable or function called "data", and the variable
++ "data" is also used extensively by Kermit. Rather than edit the Kermit
++ source files, just put a -D in the make entry CFLAGS to change the
++ Kermit symbol at compile time. In this example, it might be
++ -Ddata=xdata.
++
++ Some symbol is defined in your system's header files, but it produces
++ conflicts with, or undesired results from, Kermit. Try undefining the
++ symbol in the makefile target's CFLAGS, for example -UFIONREAD.
++
++ Some well-known symbol is missing from your system header files. Try
++ defining in the makefile target's CFLAGS, for example -DFREAD=1.
++
++ You get many warnings about pointer mismatches. This probably means
++ that Kermit is assuming an int type for signal() when it should be
++ void, or vice-versa. Try adding -DSIG_I (for integer signal()) or
++ -DSIG_V (for void) to CFLAGS. Or just include KFLAGS=-DSIG_V (or
++ whatever) in your "make" command, for example:
++
++make bsd KFLAGS=-DSIG_V
++
++ You get many messages about variables that are declared and/or set but
++ never used. It is difficult to avoid these because of all the
++ conditional compilation in the program. Ignore these messages.
++
++ Some of C-Kermit's modules are so large, or contain so many character
++ string constants, or are so offensive in some other way, that some C
++ compilers give up and refuse to compile them. This is usually because
++ the -O (optimize) option is included in the make entry. If this
++ happens to you, you can (a) remove the -O option from the make entry,
++ which will turn off the optimizer for ALL modules; or (b) compile the
++ offending module(s) by hand, including all the switches from make
++ entry except for -O, and then give the appropriate "make" command
++ again; or (c) increase the value of the -Olimit option, if your
++ compiler supports this option; or (d) change the [147]makefile target
++ to first compile each offending module explicitly without
++ optimization, then compile the others normally (with optimization),
++ for example:
++
++#Fortune 32:16, For:Pro 2.1 (mostly like 4.1bsd)
++ft21:
++ @echo 'Making C-Kermit $(CKVER) for Fortune 32:16 For:Pro 2.1...'
++ $(MAKE) ckuusx.$(EXT) "CFLAGS= -DNODEBUG -DBSD4 -DFT21 -DNOFILEH \
++ -SYM 800 \ -DDYNAMIC -DNOSETBUF -DCK_CURSES $(KFLAGS) -DPID_T=short"
++ $(MAKE) ckuxla.$(EXT) "CFLAGS= -DNODEBUG -DBSD4 -DFT21 -DNOFILEH \
++ -SYM 800 \ -DDYNAMIC -DNOSETBUF -DCK_CURSES $(KFLAGS) -DPID_T=short"
++ $(MAKE) ckudia.$(EXT) "CFLAGS= -DNODEBUG -DBSD4 -DFT21 -DNOFILEH \
++ -SYM 800 \ -DDYNAMIC -DNOSETBUF -DCK_CURSES $(KFLAGS) -DPID_T=short"
++ $(MAKE) wermit "CFLAGS= -O -DNODEBUG -DBSD4 -DFT21 -DNOFILEH -SYM 800 \
++ -DDYNAMIC -DNOSETBUF -DCK_CURSES $(KFLAGS) -DPID_T=short" \
++ "LNKFLAGS= -n -s" "LIBS= -lcurses -ltermcap -lv -lnet"
++
++ As an extreme example, some compilers (e.g. gcc on the DG AViiON) have
++ been known to dump core when trying to compile ckwart.c with
++ optimization. So just do this one "by hand":
++
++cc -o wart ckwart.c
++
++ or:
++
++touch ckcpro.c
++
++ and then give the "make" command again.
++
++ Speaking of wart, it is unavoidable that some picky compilers might
++ generate "statement unreachable" messages when compiling ckcpro.c.
++ Unreachable statements can be generated by the wart program, which
++ generates ckcpro.c automatically from [148]ckcpro.w, which translates
++ lex-like state/input constructions into a big switch/case
++ construction.
++
++ Some function in Kermit wreaks havoc when it is called. Change all
++ invocations of the function into a macro that evaluates to the
++ appropriate return code that would have been returned by the function
++ had it been called and failed, for example: -Dzkself()=0. Obviously
++ not a good idea if the function is really needed.
++
++ If you have just installed SunOS 4.1.2 or 4.1.3, you might find that
++ C-Kermit (and any other C program) fails to link because of unresolved
++ references from within libc. This is because of a mistake in Sun's
++ /usr/lib/shlib.etc files for building the new libc. Change the libc
++ Makefile so that the "ld" lines have "-ldl" at the end. Change the
++ README file to say "mv xccs.multibyte. xccs.multibyte.o" and follow
++ that instruction.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++5. INSTALLING THE KERMIT FILES
++
++ [ [149]Top ] [ [150]Contents ] [ [151]Next ] [ [152]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++5.1. [153]The C-Kermit Initialization File
++5.2. [154]Text Files
++5.3. [155]Installing the Kermit Files
++5.4. [156]The Makefile Install Target
++
++ The C-Kermit executable does not need any external files to run.
++ Unlike, say, the cu program, which on most platforms is useless unless
++ you (as root) edit the /usr/spool/uucp/Systems and
++ /usr/spool/uucp/Devices files to supply whatever obscure and
++ undocumented syntax is required to match some supposedly user-friendly
++ mnemonic to the real pathname of whatever device you want to use,
++ Kermit runs on its own without needing any external configuration
++ files, and lets you refer to device (and network hosts and services)
++ by their own natural undisguised names.
++
++ Nevertheless, a number of external files can be installed along with
++ the C-Kermit executable if you wish. These include configuration and
++ customization files that are read by Kermit as well as documentation
++ files to be read by people. All of this material is (a) optional, and
++ (b) available on the Kermit website:
++
++[157]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++
++ and usually in a more pleasant form, perhaps also with updated
++ content. So if your computer is on the Internet, there is no need to
++ install anything but the Kermit executable if users know how to find
++ the Kermit website (and if they don't, Kermit's "help" command tells
++ them).
++
++ 5.1. The C-Kermit Initialization File
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0 and earlier, the standard initialization file was a
++ key C-Kermit component because:
++
++ a. It "loaded" the dialing and network directories.
++ b. It defined all the macros and variables for the services
++ directory.
++ c. It defined macros for quickly changing Kermit's file-transfer
++ performance tuning.
++
++ The standard initialization file is quite long (more than 600 lines)
++ and requires noticeable processing time (the slower the computer, the
++ more noticeable), yet few people actually use the services directory,
++ whose definition takes up most of its bulk. Meanwhile, in C-Kermit
++ 8.0, many of the remaining functions of the standard initialization
++ file are now built in; for example, the FAST, CAUTIOUS, and ROBUST
++ commands.
++
++ More to the point, many of the settings that could be made only in the
++ initialization and customization files can now be picked up from
++ environment variables. The first group identifies initialization and
++ directory files:
++
++ CKERMIT_INI
++ The path of your Kermit initialization file, if any. This
++ overrides the built-in search for $HOME/.kermrc.
++
++ K_CHARSET
++ The character set used for encoding local text files.
++ Equivalent to SET FILE CHARACTER-SET.
++
++ K_DIAL_DIRECTORY
++ The full pathname of one or more Kermit dialing directory
++ files. Equivalent to SET DIAL DIRECTORY.
++
++ K_NET_DIRECTORY
++ The full pathname of one or more Kermit network directory
++ files. Equivalent to SET NETWORK DIRECTORY.
++
++ K_INFO_DIRECTORY
++ K_INFO_DIR
++ The full pathname of a directory containing Kermit (if any)
++ containing ckubwr.txt and other Kermit text files. Overrides
++ Kermit's built-in search for this directory.
++
++ The next group is related to dialing modems:
++
++ K_COUNTRYCODE
++ The telephonic numeric country code for this location, e.g. 1
++ for North America or 39 for Italy. It is recommended that this
++ one be set for all users, system-wide. Not only is it used to
++ process portable-format dialing directory entries, but it is
++ also compared against Kermit's built-in list of "tone
++ countries" to see if tone dialing can be used. Equivalent to
++ Kermit's SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE command.
++
++ K_AREACODE
++ The telephonic numeric area code for this location, e.g. 212
++ for Manhattan, New York, USA. Recommend this one also be set
++ system-wide, so shared portable-format dialing directories will
++ work automatically for everybody. Equivalent to Kermit's SET
++ DIAL AREA-CODE command.
++
++ K_DIAL_METHOD
++ TONE or PULSE. Equivalent to Kermit's SET DIAL METHOD command.
++ If a dial method is not set explicitly (or implicitly from the
++ country code), Kermit does not specify a dialing method, and
++ uses the modem's default method, which tends to be pulse.
++
++ K_INTL_PREFIX
++ The telephonic numeric international dialing prefix for this
++ location. Equivalent to Kermit's SET DIAL INTL-PREFIX command.
++
++ K_LD_PREFIX
++ The telephonic numeric long-distance dialing prefix for this
++ location. Equivalent to Kermit's SET DIAL LD-PREFIX command.
++
++ K_PBX_ICP
++ The telephonic numeric PBX internal call prefix for this
++ location. Equivalent to Kermit's SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX
++ command.
++
++ K_PBX_OCP
++ The telephonic numeric PBX external call prefix for this
++ location. Equivalent to Kermit's SET DIAL PBX-OUTSIDE-PREFIX
++ command.
++
++ K_PBX_XCH
++ The telephonic numeric PBX exchange (first part of the
++ subscriber number). Equivalent to Kermit's SET DIAL
++ PBX-EXCHANGE command.
++
++ K_TF_AREACODE
++ A list of one or more telephonic numeric toll-free area codes.
++
++ K_TF_PREFIX
++ The telephonic numeric toll-free dialing prefix, in case it is
++ different from the long-distance prefix. Equivalent to Kermit's
++ SET DIAL TF-PREFIX command.
++
++ The final group includes well-known environment variables that are
++ also used by Kermit:
++
++ CDPATH
++ Where the CD command should look for relative directory names.
++
++ SHELL
++ The path of your Unix shell. Used by the RUN (!) command to
++ choose the shell to execute its arguments.
++
++ USER
++ Your Unix username.
++
++ EDITOR
++ The name or path of your preferred editor (used by the EDIT
++ command). Equivalent to SET EDITOR.
++
++ BROWSER
++ The name or path of your preferred web browser (used by the
++ BROWSE command). Equivalent to Kermit's SET BROWSER command.
++
++ Does this mean the initialization file can be abolished? I think so.
++ Here's why:
++
++ * Kermit already does everything most people want it to do without
++ one.
++ * Important site-specific customizations can be done with global
++ environment variables.
++ * There is no longer any need for everybody to have to use the
++ standard initialization file.
++ * This means that your initialization file, if you want one, can
++ contain your own personal settings, definitions, and preferences,
++ rather than 600 lines of "standard" setups.
++ * If you still want the services directory, you can either TAKE the
++ standard initialization file (which must be named anything other
++ than $HOME/.kermrc to avoid being executed automatically every
++ time you start Kermit), or you can make it a kerbang script and
++ execute it "directly" (the [158]makefile install target does this
++ for you by putting ckermit.ini in the same directory as the Kermit
++ binary, adding the appropriate Kerbang line to the top, and giving
++ it execute permission).
++
++ In fact, you can put any number of kerbang scripts in your PATH to
++ start up C-Kermit in different ways, to have it adopt certain
++ settings, make particular connections, execute complicated scripts,
++ whatever you want.
++
++ 5.2. Text Files
++
++ These are entirely optional. Many of them are to be found at the
++ Kermit website in HTML form (i.e. as Web pages with clickable links,
++ etc), and very likely also more up to date. Plain-text files that
++ correspond to Web pages were simply "dumped" by Lynx from the website
++ to plain ASCII text. The format is whatever Lynx uses for this
++ purpose. If you wish, you can install them on your computer as
++ described in the [159]next section.
++
++ [160]COPYING.TXT
++ Copyright notice, permissions, and disclaimer.
++
++ [161]ckermit.ini
++ The standard initialization file, intended more for reference
++ (in most cases) than actual use; see [162]Section 5.1.
++
++ [163]ckermod.ini
++ A sample customization file.
++
++ [164]ckermit70.txt
++ Supplement to [165]Using C-Kermit for version 7.0. Available on
++ the Kermit website as:
++ [166]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html
++
++ [167]ckermit80.txt
++ Supplement to [168]Using C-Kermit for version 8.0. Available on
++ the Kermit website as:
++ [169]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++
++ [170]ckcbwr.txt
++ The general C-Kermit hints and tips ("beware") file. Available
++ on the Kermit website as:
++ [171]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++
++ [172]ckubwr.txt
++ The Unix-specific C-Kermit hints and tips file. Available on
++ the Kermit website as:
++ [173]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++
++ [174]ckuins.txt
++ Unix C-Kermit Installation Instructions (this file). Available
++ on the Kermit website as:
++ [175]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++
++ [176]ckccfg.txt
++ C-Kermit compile-time configuration options. Available on the
++ Kermit website as:
++ [177]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++
++ [178]ckcplm.txt
++ The C-Kermit program logic manual. Available on the Kermit
++ website as:
++ [179]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html
++
++ [180]ca_certs.pem
++ Certificate Authority certificates for secure connections (see
++ [181]Section 16).
++
++ 5.3. Installing the Kermit Files
++
++ There is an "install" target in the [182]makefile that you can use if
++ you wish. However, since every site has its own layout and
++ requirements, it is often better to install the Kermit files by hand.
++ You don't have to use the makefile install target to install C-Kermit.
++ This is especially true since not all sites build C-Kermit from
++ source, and therefore might not even have the makefile. But you should
++ read this section in any case.
++
++ If your computer already has an older version of C-Kermit
++ installed, you should rename it (e.g. to "kermit6" or "kermit7") so
++ in case you have any trouble with the new version, the old one is
++ still available.
++
++ In most cases, you need to be root to install C-Kermit, if only to
++ gain write access to directories in which the binary and manual page
++ are to be copied. The C-Kermit binary should be installed in a
++ directory that is in the users' PATH, but that is not likely to be
++ overwritten when you install a new version of the operating system. A
++ good candidate would be the /usr/local/bin/ directory, but the
++ specific choice is site dependent. Example (assuming the appropriate
++ Kermit binary is stored in your current directory as "wermit", e.g.
++ because you just built it from source and that's the name the makefile
++ gave it):
++
++mv wermit /usr/local/bin/kermit
++chmod 755 /usr/local/bin/kermit
++
++ or (only after you finish reading this section!) simply:
++
++make install
++
++ IMPORTANT: IF C-KERMIT IS TO BE USED FOR DIALING OUT, you must also do
++ something to give it access to the dialout devices and lockfile
++ directories. The 'install' target does not attempt to set Kermit's
++ owner, group, and permissions to allow dialing out. This requires
++ privileges, open eyes, and human decision-making. Please read
++ [183]Sections 10 and [184]11 below, make the necessary decisions, and
++ then implement them by hand as described in those sections.
++
++ You should also install the man page, which is called ckuker.nr, in
++ the man page directory for local commands, such as /usr/man/man1/,
++ renamed appropriately, e.g. to kermit.1. This is also taken care of by
++ "make install".
++
++ Optionally, the text files listed in the [185]previous section can be
++ placed in a publicly readable directory. Suggested directory names
++ are:
++
++/usr/local/doc/kermit/
++/usr/local/lib/kermit/
++/usr/share/lib/kermit/
++/opt/kermit/doc/
++
++ (or any of these without the "/kermit"). Upon startup, C-Kermit checks
++ the following environment variables whose purpose is to specify the
++ directory where the C-Kermit text files are, in the following order:
++
++K_INFO_DIRECTORY
++K_INFO_DIR
++
++ If either of these is defined, C-Kermit checks for the existence of
++ the ckubwr.txt file (Unix C-Kermit Hints and Tips). If not found, it
++ checks the directories listed above (both with and without the
++ "/kermit") plus several others to see if they contain the ckubwr.txt
++ file. If found, various C-Kermit messages can refer the user to this
++ directory.
++
++ Finally, if you want to put the source code files somewhere for people
++ to look at, you can do that too.
++
++ 5.4. The Makefile Install Target
++
++ The makefile "install" target does almost everything for you if you
++ give it the information it needs by setting the variables described
++ below. You can use this target if:
++
++ * You downloaded the [186]complete C-Kermit archive and built
++ C-Kermit from source; or:
++ * You downloaded an [187]individual C-Kermit binary and the
++ [188]C-Kermit text-file archive, and your computer has a "make"
++ command.
++
++ Here are the parameters you need to know:
++
++ BINARY
++ Name of the binary you want to install as "kermit". Default:
++ "wermit".
++
++ prefix
++ (lower case) If you define this variable, its value is
++ prepended to all the following xxxDIR variables (8.0.211 and
++ later).
++
++ DESTDIR
++ If you want to install the Kermit files in a directory
++ structure like /opt/kermit/bin/, /opt/kermit/doc/,
++ /opt/kermit/src/, then define DESTIR as the root of this
++ structure; for example, /opt/kermit. The DESTDIR string should
++ not end with a slash. By default, DESTDIR is not defined. If it
++ is defined, but the directory does not exist, the makefile
++ attempts to create it, which might require you to be root. Even
++ so, this can fail if any segments in the path except the last
++ one do not already exist. WARNING: If the makefile creates any
++ directories, it gives them a mode of 755, and the default owner
++ and group. Modify these by hand if necessary.
++
++ BINDIR
++ Directory in which to install the Kermit binary (and the
++ standard C-Kermit initialization file, if it is found, as a
++ Kerbang script). If DESTDIR is defined, BINDIR must start with
++ a slash. BINDIR must not end with a slash. If DESTDIR is
++ defined, BINDIR is a subdirectory of DESTDIR. If BINDIR does
++ not exist, the makefile attempts to create it as with DESTDIR.
++ Default: /usr/local/bin.
++
++ MANDIR
++ Directory in which to install the C-Kermit manual page as
++ "kermit" followed by the manual-chapter extension (next item).
++ Default: /usr/man/man1. If MANDIR is defined, the directory
++ must already exist.
++
++ MANEXT
++ Extension for the manual page. Default: 1 (digit one).
++
++ SRCDIR
++ Directory in which to install the C-Kermit source code. If
++ DESTDIR is defined, this is a subdirectory of DESTDIR. Default:
++ None.
++
++ CERTDIR
++ For secure builds only: Directory in which to install the
++ ca_certs.pem file. This must be the verification directory used
++ by programs that use the SSL libraries at your site. Default:
++ none. Possibilities include: /usr/local/ssl, /opt/ssl,
++ /usr/lib/ssl, . . . If CERTDIR is defined, the directory
++ must already exist.
++
++ INFODIR
++ Directory in which to install the C-Kermit text files. If
++ DESTDIR is defined, this is a subdirectory of DESTDIR. Default:
++ None. If INFODIR is defined but does not exist, the makefile
++ attempts to create it, as with DESTDIR.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ make install
++ Installs "wermit" as /usr/local/bin/kermit with permissions
++ 755, the default owner and group, and no special privileges.
++ The manual page is installed as /usr/man/man1/kermit.1. Text
++ files are not copied anywhere, nor are the sources.
++
++ make MANDIR= install
++ Just like "make install" but does not attempt to install the
++ manual page.
++
++ make DESTDIR=/opt/kermit BINDIR=/bin SRCDIR=/src INFODIR=/doc install
++ Installs the Kermit binary "wermit" as /opt/kermit/bin/kermit,
++ puts the source code in /opt/kermit/src, and puts the text
++ files in /opt/kermit/doc, creating the directories if they
++ don't already exist, and puts the man page in the default
++ location.
++
++ make BINDIR=/usr/local/bin CERTDIR=/usr/local/ssl install
++ Installs the Kerberized Kermit binary "wermit" as
++ /usr/local/bin/kermit, puts the CA Certificates file in
++ /usr/local/ssl/, and the man page in the normal place.
++
++ For definitive information, see the makefile. The following is
++ excerpted from the 8.0.211 makefile:
++
++# The following symbols are used to specify library and header file locations
++# Redefine them to the values used on your system by:
++# . editing this file
++# . defining the values on the command line
++# . defining the values in the environment and use the -e option
++#
++prefix = /usr/local
++srproot = $(prefix)
++sslroot = $(prefix)
++manroot = $(prefix)
++
++K4LIB=-L/usr/kerberos/lib
++K4INC=-I/usr/kerberos/include
++K5LIB=-L/usr/kerberos/lib
++K5INC=-I/usr/kerberos/include
++SRPLIB=-L$(srproot)/lib
++SRPINC=-I$(srproot)/include
++SSLLIB=-L$(sslroot)/ssl/lib
++SSLINC=-I$(sslroot)/ssl/include
++...
++WERMIT = makewhat
++BINARY = wermit
++DESTDIR =
++BINDIR = $(prefix)/bin
++MANDIR = $(manroot)/man/man1
++MANEXT = 1
++SRCDIR =
++INFODIR =
++CERTDIR =
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++6. INSTALLING UNIX C-KERMIT FROM DOS-FORMAT DISKETTES
++
++ [ [189]Top ] [ [190]Contents ] [ [191]Next ] [ [192]Previous ]
++
++ This section is obsolete. We don't distribute C-Kermit on diskettes
++ any more because (a)there is no demand, and (b) it no longer fits.
++
++ If you received a DOS-format diskette containing a binary executable
++ C-Kermit program plus supporting text files, be sure to chmod +x the
++ executable before attempting to run it.
++
++ In version 5A(190) and later, all the text files on the C-Kermit
++ DOS-format diskettes are in Unix format: LF at the end of each line
++ rather than CRLF. This means that no conversions are necessary when
++ copying to your Unix file system, and that all the files on the
++ diskette, text and binary, can be copied together. The following
++ comments apply to the DOS-format diskettes furnished with version
++ 5A(189) and earlier or to other DOS-format diskettes you might have
++ obtained from other sources.
++
++ If you have received C-Kermit on MS-DOS format diskettes (such as
++ those distributed by Columbia University), you should make sure that
++ your DOS-to-Unix conversion utility (such as "dosread") both: (1)
++ changes line terminators in all files from carriage-return linefeed
++ (CRLF) to just linefeed (LF) (such as "dosread -a") and remove any
++ Ctrl-Z's, and (2) that all filenames are converted from uppercase to
++ lowercase. If these conversions were not done, you can use the
++ following shell script on your Unix system to do them:
++
++---(cut here)---
++#!/bin/sh
++#
++# Shell script to convert C-Kermit DOS-format files into Unix format.
++# Lowercases the filenames, strips out carriage returns and Ctrl-Z's.
++#
++x=$1 # the name of the source directory
++y=$2 # the name of the target directory if [ $# -lt 2 ]; then
++ echo "usage: $0 source-directory target-directory"
++ exit 1
++fi
++if cd $1 ; then
++ echo "Converting files from $1 to $2"
++else
++ echo "$0: cannot cd to $1"
++ exit 1
++fi
++for i in *; do
++ j=`echo $i | tr 'A-Z' 'a-z'`
++ echo $x/$i =\> $y/$j
++ tr -d '\015\032' < $i > $y/$j
++done
++---(cut here)---
++
++ Cut out this shell script, save it as "convert.sh" (or any other name
++ you prefer), then "chmod +x convert.sh". Then, create a new, empty
++ directory to put the converted files in, and then "convert.sh /xxx
++ /yyy" where /xxx is the name of the directory where the PC-format
++ files are, and /yyy is the name of the new, empty directory. The
++ converted files will appear in the new directory.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++7. CHECKING THE RESULTS
++
++ [ [193]Top ] [ [194]Contents ] [ [195]Next ] [ [196]Previous ]
++
++ First some quick checks for problems that can be easily corrected by
++ recompiling with different options:
++
++ DIRECTORY listing is garbage
++ Permissions, size, and date are random garbage (but the
++ filenames are correct) in a C-Kermit DIRECTORY listing. On some
++ platforms, the lstat() function is present but simply doesn't
++ work; try adding -DNOLSTAT to CFLAGS and rebuild. If that
++ doesn't fix it, also add -DNOLINKBITS. If it's still not fixed,
++ remove -DNOLSTAT and -DNOLINKBITS and add -DNOSYMLINK.
++
++ curses
++ When you make a connection with C-Kermit and transfer files
++ using the fullscreen (curses) file-transfer display, and then
++ get the C-Kermit> prompt back afterwards, do characters echo
++ when you type them? If not, the curses library has altered the
++ buffering of /dev/tty. Try rebuilding with KFLAGS=-DCK_NEWTERM.
++ If it already has -DCK_NEWTERM in CFLAGS, try removing it. If
++ that doesn't help, then rebuild with -DNONOSETBUF (yes, two
++ NO's). If none of this works (and you can't fix the code), then
++ either don't use the fullscreen display, or rebuild with
++ -DNOCURSES.
++
++ Ctrl-L or any SCREEN command crashes C-Kermit:
++ Rebuild with -DNOTERMCAP.
++
++ No prompt after CONNECT:
++ After escaping back from CONNECT mode, does your C-Kermit>
++ prompt disappear? (Yet, typing "?" still produces a command
++ list, etc) In that case, add -DCKCONINTB4CB to CFLAGS and
++ rebuild.
++
++ Here is a more thorough checklist can use to tell whether your version
++ of C-Kermit was built correctly for your Unix system, with hints on
++ how to fix or work around problems:
++
++ a. Start C-Kermit (usually by typing "./wermit" in the directory
++ where you ran the makefile). Do you see the C-Kermit> prompt? If
++ not, C-Kermit incorrectly deduced that it was running in the
++ background. The test is in conbgt() in [197]ckutio.c. If you can
++ fix it for your system, please send in the fix (Hint: read about
++ "PID_T" below). Otherwise, you can force C-Kermit to foreground
++ mode by starting it with the -z command line option, as in "kermit
++ -z", or giving the interactive command SET BACKGROUND OFF.
++ b. When you type characters at the C-Kermit prompt, do they echo
++ immediately? If not, something is wrong with concb() and probably
++ the other terminal mode settings routines in [198]ckutio.c. Be
++ sure you have used the most appropriate make entry.
++ c. At the C-Kermit> prompt, type "send ./?". C-Kermit should list all
++ the files in the current directory. If not, it was built for the
++ wrong type of Unix file system. Details below. In the meantime,
++ try SET WILDCARD-EXPANSION SHELL as a workaround.
++ d. CD to a directory that contains a variety of files, symlinks, and
++ subdirectories and give a DIRECTORY command at the C-Kermit>
++ prompt. Do the permissions, size, and date appear correct? If not
++ see [199]Section 4.0.
++ e. Assuming your platform supports long file names, create a file
++ with a long name in your current directory, e.g.:
++
++$ touch thisisafilewithaveryveryveryveryveryveryveryverylooooooooongname
++
++ (you might need to make it longer than this, perhaps as long as
++ 257 or even 1025 characters).
++ Check with ls to see if your version of Unix truncated the name.
++ Now start C-Kermit and type "send thisis<ESC>". Does Kermit
++ complete the name, showing the same name as ls did? If not, wrong
++ filesystem. Read on.
++ f. Make sure that Kermit has the maximum path length right. Just type
++ SHOW FILE and see what it says about this. If it is too short,
++ there could be some problems at runtime. To correct, look in
++ [200]ckcdeb.h to see how the symbol CKMAXPATH is set and make any
++ needed adjustments.
++ g. Send a file to your new Kermit program from a different Kermit
++ program that is known to work. Is the date/timestamp of the new
++ file identical to the original? If not, adjustments are needed in
++ zstrdt() in [201]ckufio.c.
++ h. Go to another computer (Computer B) from which you can send files
++ to C-Kermit. Connect Computer B to the computer (A) where you are
++ testing C-Kermit. Then:
++ i. Send a file from B to A. Make sure it transferred OK and was
++ created with the the right name.
++ j. Send a file from B to A, specifying an "as-name" that is very,
++ very long (longer than the maximum name length on computer A).
++ Check to make sure that the file was received OK and that its name
++ was truncated to Computer A's maximum length. If not, check the
++ MAXNAMLEN definition in [202]ckufio.c.
++ k. Tell C-Kermit on Computer A to "set receive pathnames relative"
++ and then send it a file from Computer B specifying an as-name that
++ contains several directory segments:
++
++send foo dir1/dir2/dir3/foo
++
++ Check to make sure that dir1/dir2/dir3/foo was created in Computer
++ A's current directory (i.e. that three levels of directories were
++ created).
++ l. Repeat step k, but make each path segment in the pathname longer
++ than Computer A's maximum name length. Make sure each directory
++ name, and the final filename, were truncated properly.
++ m. Type Ctrl-C (or whatever your Unix interrupt character is) at the
++ prompt. Do you get "^C..." and a new prompt? If instead, you get a
++ core dump (this shouldn't happen any more) "rm core" and then
++ rebuild with -DNOCCTRAP added to your CFLAGS. If it did work, then
++ type another Ctrl-C. If this does the same thing as the first one,
++ then Ctrl-C handling is OK. Otherwise, the SIGINT signal is either
++ not getting re-armed (shouldn't happen) or is being masked off
++ after the first time it is caught, in which case, if your Unix is
++ POSIX-based, try rebuilding C-Kermit with -DCK_POSIX_SIG.
++ n. Type Ctrl-Z (or whatever your Unix suspend character is) to put
++ C-Kermit in the background. Did it work? If nothing happened, then
++ (a)your version of Unix does not support job control, or (b) your
++ version of C-Kermit was probably built with -DNOJC. If your
++ session became totally frozen, then you are probably running
++ C-Kermit on a Unix version that supports job control, but under a
++ shell that doesn't. If that's not the case, look in the congm()
++ and psuspend() routines in [203]ckutio.c and see if you can figure
++ out what's wrong. If you can't, rebuild with -DNOJC.
++ o. Give a SET LINE command for a dialout device, e.g. "set line
++ /dev/tty00". If you got some kind of permission or access denied
++ message, go read [204]Section 10 and then come back here.
++ p. After giving a successful SET LINE command, type "show comm" to
++ see the communication parameters. Do they make sense?
++ q. Type "set speed ?" and observe the list of available speeds. Is it
++ what you expected? If not, see [205]Section 2) of the
++ [206]Configurations Options document.
++ r. Give a SET SPEED command to change the device's speed. Did it
++ work? (Type "show comm" again to check.)
++ s. Try dialing out: SET MODEM TYPE , SET LINE , SET SPEED , DIAL . If
++ it doesn't work, keep reading. After dialing, can you REDIAL?
++ t. If your version was built with TCP/IP network support, try the
++ TELNET command.
++ u. Transfer some files in remote mode on incoming asynchronous serial
++ (direct or modem) connections, and on incoming network (telnet,
++ rlogin, terminal server) connections. If you get lots of errors,
++ try different SET FLOW settings on the remote Kermit program.
++ v. Establish a serial connection from C-Kermit to another computer
++ (direct or dialed) and transfer some files. If you have network
++ support, do the same with a network connection.
++ w. If your version was built with fullscreen file transfer display
++ support, check that it works during local-mode file transfer.
++ Also, check C-Kermit's operation afterwards: is the echoing funny?
++ etc etc. If there are problems, see [207]Section 4.
++ x. If your version was built with script programming language
++ support, TAKE the ckedemo.ksc file to give it a workout.
++ y. Does C-Kermit interlock correctly with UUCP-family programs (cu,
++ tip, uucp, etc)? If not, read the section [208]DIALING OUT AND
++ COORDINATING WITH UUCP below.
++ z. Modem signals... Give a SET LINE command to a serial device and
++ then type the SHOW MODEM command. If it says "Modem signals
++ unavailable in this version of Kermit", then you might want to
++ look at the ttgmdm() routine in [209]ckutio.c and add the needed
++ code -- if indeed your version of Unix provides a way to get modem
++ signals (some don't; e.g. modem signals are a foreign concept to
++ POSIX, requiring politically incorrect workarounds).
++ aa. If it says "Modem signals unavailable", then it is likely that the
++ API for getting modem signals is provided, but it doesn't actually
++ do anything (e.g. ioctl(ttyfd,TIOCMGET,&x) returns EINVAL).
++ ab. In any case, it still should be able to manipulate the DTR signal.
++ To test, SET LINE , SET MODEM NONE, and HANGUP. The DTR light
++ should go out momentarily. If it doesn't, see if you can add the
++ needed code for your system to the tthang() routine in
++ [210]ckutio.c.
++ ac. If your version of Kermit has the SET FLOW RTS/CTS command, check
++ to see if it works: give Kermit this command, set your modem for
++ RTS/CTS, transfer some files (using big packet and window sizes)
++ and watch the RTS and CTS lights on the modem. If they go on and
++ off (and Kermit does not get packet errors), then it works. If
++ your version of Kermit does not have this command, but your
++ version of Unix does support hardware flow control, take a look at
++ the tthflow() command in [211]ckutio.c and see if you can add the
++ needed code (see the section on [212]HARDWARE FLOW CONTROL below).
++ (And please [213]send back any added code, so that others can
++ benefit from it and it can be carried forward into future
++ releases.)
++ ad. If C-Kermit starts normally and issues its prompt, echoing is
++ normal, etc, but then after returning from a CONNECT session, the
++ prompt no longer appears, try rebuilding with -DCKCONINTB4CB.
++ ae. (8.0.206 or later) Type some commands at the C-Kermit prompt. Can
++ you use the Up-arrow and Down-arrow keys on your keyboard to
++ access Kermit's command history? If not, and you're a programmer,
++ take a look at the USE_ARROWKEYS sections of ckucmd.c.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++8. REDUCING THE SIZE OF THE EXECUTABLE PROGRAM IMAGE
++
++ [ [214]Top ] [ [215]Contents ] [ [216]Next ] [ [217]Previous ]
++
++ Also see: [218]C-Kermit Configuration Options
++
++ a. Many of C-Kermit's options and features can be deselected at
++ compile time. The greatest savings at the least sacrifice in
++ functionality is to disable the logging of debug information by
++ defining NODEBUG during compilation. See the [219]Configurations
++ Options document for further information.
++ b. Use shared libraries rather than static linking. This is the
++ default on many Unix systems anyway. However, executables built
++ for dynamic linking with shared libraries are generally not
++ portable away from the machine they were built on, so this is
++ recommended if the binary is for your use only.
++ c. Most Unix systems have a "strip" command to remove symbol table
++ information from an executable program image. "man strip" for
++ further information. The same effect can be achieved by including
++ "-s" among the link flags when building C-Kermit.
++ d. SCO, Interactive, and some other Unix versions have an "mcs"
++ command. "mcs -d wermit" can be used to delete the contents of the
++ ".comment" section from the executable program image.
++ e. Many modern optimizers can be instructed to optimize for space
++ rather than execution efficiency. Check the CFLAGS in the makefile
++ target, adjust as desired.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++9. UNIX VERSIONS
++
++ [ [220]Top ] [ [221]Contents ] [ [222]Next ] [ [223]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++9.1 [224]Standards
++ 9.1.1. [225]POSIX
++ 9.1.2. [226]ANSI C
++ 9.1.3. [227]Other Standards
++9.2. [228]Library Issues
++9.3. [229]Unix File System Peculiarities
++9.4. [230]Hardware Flow Control
++9.5. [231]Terminal Speeds
++9.6. [232]Millisecond Sleeps
++9.7. [233]Nondestructive Input Buffer Peeking
++9.8. [234]Other System-Dependent Features
++9.9. [235]Terminal Interruption
++
++ There are several major varieties of Unix: Bell Laboratories Seventh
++ Edition, AT&T System V, Berkeley Standard Distribution (BSD), and
++ POSIX. Each has many, many subvarieties and descendents, and there are
++ also hybrids that exhibit symptoms of two or more varieties, plus
++ special quirks of their own.
++
++ Seventh edition versions of C-Kermit include the compile-time option
++ -DV7 in the CFLAGS string in the makefile target. Various V7-based
++ implementations are also supported: -DCOHERENT, -DMINIX, etc.
++
++ AT&T-based versions of Unix Kermit include the compile-time option
++ -DATTSV (standing for AT∓T Unix System V). This applies to System
++ III and to System V up to and including Release 2. For System V
++ Release 3, the flag -DSVR3 should be used instead (which also implies
++ -DATTSV). This is because the data type of signal() and several other
++ functions was changed between SVR2 and SVR3. For System V Release 4,
++ include -DSVR4 because of changes in UUCP lockfile conventions; this
++ also implies -DSVR3 and -DATTSV.
++
++ For BSD, the flag -BSDxx must be included, where xx is the BSD version
++ number, for example BSD4 (for version 4.2 or later, using only 4.2
++ features), -DBSD41 (for BSD 4.1 only), -DBSD43 (for 4.3), -DBSD29 (BSD
++ 2.9 for DEC PDP-11s). -DBSD44 is for 4.4BSD, which is the basis of
++ FreeBSD, NetBSD, OpenBSD, BSDI, and Mac OS X, and which contains many
++ POSIX features, and has little relation to 4.3BSD and earlier.
++
++ For POSIX, include the flag -DPOSIX. POSIX defines a whole new set of
++ terminal i/o functions that are not found in traditional AT&T or
++ Berkeley implementations, and also defines the symbol _POSIX_SOURCE,
++ which is used in many system and library header files, mainly to
++ disable non-POSIX (i.e. useful) features.
++
++ Note (circa 1997): In order to enable serial speeds higher than 38400
++ bps, it is generally necessary to add -DPOSIX (among other things),
++ since the older terminal APIs can not accommodate the new speeds --
++ out o' bits. But this often also means wholesale conversion to POSIX
++ APIs. In general, just try adding -DPOSIX and then see what goes
++ wrong. Be wary of features disappearing: when _POSIX_SOURCE is
++ defined, all sorts of things that were perfectly OK before suddenly
++ become politically incorrect -- like reading modem signals, doing
++ hardware flow control, etc. POSIX was evidently not designed with
++ serial communication in mind!
++
++ Case in point: In UnixWare 7.0, #define'ing POSIX causes strictness
++ clauses in the header files to take effect. These prevent <sys/time.h>
++ from defining the timeval and timezone structs, which are needed for
++ all sorts of things (like select()). Thus, if we want the high serial
++ speeds, we have to circumvent the POSIX clauses.
++
++ Similarly in SCO OpenServer R5.0.4 where, again, we must use the POSIX
++ APIs to get at serial speeds higher than 38400, but then doing so
++ removes hardware flow control -- just when we need it most! In cases
++ like this, dirty tricks are the only recourse (search for SCO_OSR504
++ in [236]ckutio.c for examples).
++
++ For reasons like this, Unix implementations tend to be neither pure
++ AT&T nor pure BSD nor pure POSIX, but a mixture of two or more of
++ these, with "compatibility features" allowing different varieties of
++ programs to be built on the same computer. In general, Kermit tries
++ not to mix and match but to keep a consistent repertoire throughout.
++ However, there are certain Unix implementations that only work when
++ you mix and match. For example, the Silicon Graphics IRIX operating
++ system (prior to version 3.3) is an AT&T Unix but with a BSD file
++ system. The only way you can build Kermit successfully for this
++ configuration is to include -DSVR3 plus the special option -DLONGFN,
++ meaning "pretend I was built with -DBSDxx when it's time to compile
++ file-related code". See the "iris" makefile target.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.1. Standards
++
++ [ [237]Top ] [ [238]Section Contents ] [ [239]Contents ] [ [240]Next ]
++
++ SUBSECTION CONTENTS
++
++9.1.1. [241]POSIX
++9.1.2. [242]ANSI C
++9.1.3. [243]Other Standards
++
++ In edits 166-167 (1988-89), C-Kermit was heavily modified to try to
++ keep abreast of new standards while still remaining compatible with
++ old versions of C and Unix. There are two new standards of interest:
++ ANSI C (as described in Kernighan and Ritchie, "The C Programming
++ Language", Second Edition, Prentice Hall, 1988) and POSIX.1 (IEEE
++ Standard 1003.1 and ISO/IEC 9945-1, 1990, "Portable Operating System
++ Interface"). These two standards have nothing to do with each other:
++ you can build C-Kermit with a non-ANSI compiler for a POSIX system, or
++ for a non-POSIX system with with an ANSI compiler.
++
++ 9.1.1. POSIX
++
++ POSIX.1 defines a repertoire of system functions and header files for
++ use by C language programs. Most notably, the ioctl() function is not
++ allowed in POSIX; all ioctl() functions have been replaced by
++ device-specific functions like tcsetattr(), tcsendbreak(), etc.
++
++ Computer systems that claim some degree of POSIX compliance have made
++ some attempt to put their header files in the right places and give
++ them the right names, and to provide system library functions with the
++ right names and calling conventions. Within the header files,
++ POSIX-compliant functions are supposed to be within #ifdef
++ _POSIX_SOURCE..#endif conditionals, and non-POSIX items are not within
++ these conditionals.
++
++ If Kermit is built with neither -D_POSIX_SOURCE nor -DPOSIX, the
++ functions and header files of the selected version of Unix (or VMS,
++ etc) are used according to the CFLAGS Kermit was built with.
++
++ If Kermit is built with -D_POSIX_SOURCE but not -DPOSIX, then one of
++ the -DBSD or -DATTSV flags (or one that implies them) must also be
++ defined, but it still uses only the POSIX features in the system
++ header files. This allows C-Kermit to be built on BSD or AT&T systems
++ that have some degree of POSIX compliance, but still use BSD or AT&T
++ specific features.
++
++ The dilimma is this: it is often necessary to define _POSIX_SOURCE to
++ get at new or modern features, such as high serial speeds and the APIs
++ to deal with them. But defining _POSIX_SOURCE also hides other APIs
++ that Kermit needs, for example the ones dealing with modem signals
++ (others are listed just below). Thus all sorts of hideous contortions
++ are often required to get a full set of features.
++
++ The POSIX standard does not define anything about uucp lockfiles.
++ "make posix" uses NO (repeat, NO) lockfile conventions. If your
++ POSIX-compliant Unix version uses a lockfile convention such as
++ HDBUUCP (see below), use the "posix" entry, but include the
++ appropriate lockfile option in your KFLAGS on the "make" command line,
++ for example:
++
++make posix "KFLAGS=-DHDBUUCP"
++
++ POSIX.1 also lacks certain other features that Kermit needs. For
++ example:
++
++ * There is no defined way for an application to do wildcard matching
++ of filenames. Kermit uses the inode in the directory structure,
++ but POSIX.1 does not include this concept. (Later POSIX revisions
++ include functions named (I think) glob() and fnmatch(), but these
++ functions are not yet in Kermit, and might not be appropriate in
++ any case.)
++ * There is no POSIX mechanism for sensing or controlling modem
++ signals, nor to enable RTS/CTS or other hardware flow control.
++ * There is no select() for multiplexing i/o, and therefore no
++ TCP/IP.
++ * There is no way to check if characters are waiting in a
++ communications device (or console) input buffer, short of trying
++ to read them -- no select(), ioctl(fd,FIONREAD,blah), rdchk(),
++ etc. This is bad for CONNECT mode and bad for sliding windows.
++ * No way to do a millisecond sleep (no nap(), usleep(), select(),
++ etc).
++ * There is no popen().
++
++ So at this point, there cannot be one single fully functional POSIX
++ form of C-Kermit unless it also has "extensions", as do Linux, QNX,
++ etc.
++
++ More on POSIX (quoting from a newsgroup posting by Dave Butenhof):
++
++ Standards tend to look at themselves as "enabling". So POSIX
++ standards say that, in order to use POSIX functions, a program must
++ define some macro that will put the development environment in
++ "POSIX mode". For the ancient POSIX 1003.1-1990, the symbol is
++ _POSIX_SOURCE. For recent revisions, it's _POSIX_C_SOURCE with an
++ appropriate value. POSIX 1003.1-1996 says that, to use its features
++ in a portable manner, you must define _POSIX_C_SOURCE=199506L
++ before including any header files.
++
++ But for Solaris, or Digital Unix, the picture is different. POSIX
++ is one important but small part of the universe. Yet POSIX
++ unconditionally and unambiguously REQUIRES that, when
++ _POSIX_C_SOURCE=199506L, ALL of the functions and definitions
++ required by the standard, and NO others (except in specific
++ restricted namespaces, specifically "_" followed by an uppercase
++ letter or "__" followed by a lowercase letter) shall be visible.
++ That kinda puts a cramp on BSD and SVID support, because those
++ require names that are not in the "protected" POSIX namespaces.
++ It's ILLEGAL to make those symbols visible, unless you've done
++ something else that's beyond the scope of POSIX to allow the system
++ to infer that you didn't really mean it.
++
++ In most cases, you should just compile, with no standards-related
++ macros defined. The system will make available every interface and
++ definition that isn't incompatible with the "main stream". There
++ may indeed be cases where two standards cross, and you really can't
++ use both together. But, in general, they play nicely together as
++ long as you don't do anything rash -- like telling the system that
++ it's not allowed to let them.
++
++ In the area of threads, both Solaris and Digital Unix support
++ incompatible thread APIs. We have POSIX and DCE, they have POSIX
++ and UI. The nasty areas are in the _r routines and in some aspects
++ of signal behavior. You cannot compile a single source file that
++ uses both semantics. That's life. It sounds as if Solaris defaults
++ to the UI variants, but allows you to define this
++ _POSIX_THREAD_SEMANTICS to get around it. We default to POSIX, and
++ allow you to define _PTHREAD_USE_D4 (automatically defined by the
++ cc "-threads" switch) to select the DCE thread variants. That
++ default, because you're operating outside of any individual
++ standard, is really just a marketing decision.
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.1.2. ANSI C
++
++ [ [244]Top ] [ [245]Contents ] [ [246]Section Contents ] [
++ [247]Subsection Contents ] [ [248]Next ] [ [249]Previous ]
++
++ The major difference between ANSI C and earlier C compilers is
++ function prototyping. ANSI C allows function arguments to be checked
++ for type agreement, and (when possible) type coercion in the event of
++ a mismatch. For this to work, functions and their arguments must be
++ declared before they are called. The form for function declarations is
++ different in ANSI C and non-ANSI C (ANSI C also accepts the earlier
++ form, but then does not do type checking).
++
++ As of edit 167, C-Kermit tries to take full advantage of ANSI C
++ features, especially function prototyping. This removes many bugs
++ introduced by differing data types used or returned by the same
++ functions on different computers. ANSI C features are automatically
++ enabled when the symbol __STDC__ is defined. Most ANSI C compilers,
++ such as GNU CC and the new DEC C compiler define this symbol
++ internally.
++
++ On the downside, ANSI C compilation increases the
++ administrative/bureacratic burden, spewing out countless unneeded
++ warnings about mismatched types, especially when we are dealing with
++ signed and unsigned characters, requiring casts everywhere to shut up
++ the mindless complaints -- there is no use for signed chars in Kermit
++ (or probably anywhere else). Some compilers, mercifully, include a
++ "treat all chars as unsigned" option, and when available it should be
++ used -- not only to stop the warnings, but also to avoid unhelpful
++ sign extension on high-bit characters.
++
++ To force use of ANSI C prototypes, include -DCK_ANSIC on the cc
++ command line. To disable the use of ANSI prototypes, include -DNOANSI.
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.1.3. Other Standards
++
++ [ [250]Top ] [ [251]Contents ] [ [252]Section Contents ] [
++ [253]Subsection Contents ] [ [254]Next ] [ [255]Previous ]
++
++ As the years go by, standards with-which-all-must-comply continue to
++ pile up: AES, XPG2, XPG3, XPG4, FIPS 151-2, successive generations of
++ POSIX, OSF/1, X/Open, Spec 1170, UNIX95, Open Group UNIX98, ISO/IEC
++ 9945 parts 1-4, ISO 9899, 88Open, OS 99, Single Unix Specification
++ (SUS, [256]IEEE 1003.1-2001, not to mention "mature standards" like
++ V7, 4.2/4.3BSD, System V R3 and R4 (SVID2 and SVID3), 4.4BSD (the
++ basis for BSDI, OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD, Mac OS X etc), /usr/group,
++ plus assorted seismic pronouncements of the neverending series of
++ ephemeral corporate consortia, not to mention the libc-vs-glibc
++ turmoil in the Linux arena and who knows what else.
++
++ None of these standards simplifies life for portable applications like
++ C-Kermit -- each one is simply one more environment to support (or
++ circumvent, as in many cases these standards do more harm than good by
++ denying access to facilities we need, e.g. as noted in above in
++ [257]9.1.1).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.2. Library Issues
++
++ [ [258]Top ] [ [259]Contents ] [ [260]Section Contents ] [
++ [261]Subsection Contents ] [ [262]Next ] [ [263]Previous ]
++
++ On most modern platforms, applications are -- and often must be --
++ dynamically linked. This has numerous advantages (smaller executables,
++ ability to patch a library and thereby patch all applications that use
++ it, etc), but also causes some headaches: most commonly, the library
++ ID built into the executable at link time does not match the ID of the
++ corresponding library on the target system, and so the loader refuses
++ to let the application run.
++
++ This problem only gets worse over time. In the Linux and *BSD world,
++ we also have totally different libraries (each with their own names
++ and numbering systems) that cover the same territory; for example,
++ curses vs ncurses, libc versus glibc. Combinations proliferate and any
++ given Unix computer might have any combination. For this reason it is
++ becoming increasingly difficult to produce a "Linux binary" for a
++ given architecture (e.g. PC or Alpha). There has to be a separate
++ binary for (at least) every combination of curses vs ncurses and libc
++ vs glibc.
++
++ In such cases, the best advice is for every user to build C-Kermit
++ from source code on the system where it will run. Too bad most
++ commercial Unix vendors have stopped including C compilers with the
++ operating system!
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.3. Unix File System Peculiarities
++
++ [ [264]Top ] [ [265]Contents ] [ [266]Section Contents ] [ [267]Next ]
++ [ [268]Previous ]
++
++ Normally, including a BSD, System-V, POSIX, or DIRENT flag in the make
++ entry selects the right file system code. But some versions of Unix
++ are inconsistent in this regard, and building in the normal way either
++ gives compiler or linker errors, or results in problems at runtime,
++ typically failure to properly expand wildcard file specifications when
++ you do something like "send *.*", or failure to recognize long
++ filenames, as in "send filewithaveryveryveryveryverylongname".
++
++ C-Kermit is supposed to know about all the various styles of Unix file
++ systems, but it has to be told which one to use when you build it,
++ usually in the makefile target CFLAGS as shown below, but you might
++ also have to add something like -I/usr/include/bsd to CFLAGS, or
++ something like -lbsd to LIBS.
++
++ C-Kermit gives you the following CFLAGS switches to adapt to your file
++ system's peculiarities:
++
++-DDIRENT - #include <dirent.h>
++-DSDIRENT - #include <sys/dirent.h>
++-DNDIR - #include <ndir.h>
++-DXNDIR - #include <sys/ndir.h>
++-DRTU - #include "/usr/lib/ndir.h", only if NDIR and XNDIR not defined.
++-DSYSUTIMH - #include <sys/utime.h> for setting file creation dates.
++-DUTIMEH - #include <utime.h> for setting file creation dates.
++
++ (Note, RTU should only be used for Masscomp RTU systems, because it
++ also selects certain other RTU-specific features.)
++
++ If none of these is defined, then <sys/dir.h> is used. IMPORTANT: If
++ your system has the file /usr/include/dirent.h then be sure to add
++ -DDIRENT to your makefile target's CFLAGS. "dirent" should be used in
++ preference to any of the others, because it supports all the features
++ of your file system, and the others probably don't.
++
++ Having selected the appropriate directory header file, you might also
++ need to tell Kermit how to declare the routines and variables it needs
++ to read the directory. This happens most commonly on AT&T System-V
++ based UNIXes, particularly System V R3 and earlier, that provide long
++ file and directory names (longer than 14 characters). Examples include
++ certain releases of HP-UX, DIAB DNIX, older versions of Silicon
++ Graphics IRIX, and perhaps also MIPS. In this case, try adding
++ -DLONGFN to your makefile target.
++
++ Another problem child is <sys/file.h>. Most Unix C-Kermit versions
++ need to #include this file from within [269]ckufio.c and
++ [270]ckutio.c, but some not only do not need to include it, but MUST
++ not include it because (a) it doesn't exist, or (b) it has already
++ been included by some other header file and it doesn't protect itself
++ against multiple inclusion, or (c) some other reason that prevents
++ successful compilation. If you have compilation problems that seem to
++ stem from including this file, then add the following switch to CFLAGS
++ in your makefile target:
++
++-DNOFILEH
++
++ There are a few odd cases where <sys/file.h> must be included in one
++ of the cku[ft]io.c files, but not the other. In that case, add the
++ aforementioned switch, but go into the file that needs <sys/file.h>
++ and add something like this:
++
++#ifdef XXX /* (where XXX is a symbol unique to your system) */
++#undef NOFILEH
++#endif /* XXX */
++
++ before the section that includes <sys/file.h>.
++
++ Kermit's SEND command expands wildcard characters "?" and "*" itself.
++ Before version 5A, commands like "send *" would send all regular
++ (non-directory) files, including "hidden files" (whose names start
++ with "."). In version 5A, the default behavior is to match like the
++ Bourne shell or the ls command, and not include files whose names
++ start with dot. Such files can still be sent if the dot is included
++ explicitly in the SEND command: "send .oofa, send .*". To change back
++ to the old way and let leading wildcard characters match dot files,
++ include the following in your CFLAGS:
++
++-DMATCHDOT
++
++ (In C-Kermit 6.0, there is also a command to control this at runtime.)
++
++ Complaints about data-type mismatches:
++
++ * If you get compile-time complaints about data type mismatches for
++ process-ID related functions like getpid(), add -DPID_T=pid_t.
++ * If you get compile-time complaints about data type mismatches for
++ user ID related functions like getuid(), add -DUID_T=uid_t.
++ * If you get compile-time complaints about data type mismatches for
++ user-ID related functions like getgid(), add -DGID_T=gid_t.
++ * If you get compile-time complaints about data type mismatches for
++ getpwuid(), add -DPWID_T=uid_t (or whatever it should be).
++
++ File creation dates: C-Kermit attempts to set the creation date/time
++ of an incoming file according to the date/time given in the file's
++ attribute packet, if any. If you find that the dates are set
++ incorrectly, you might need to build Kermit with the -DSYSUTIMEH flag,
++ to tell it to include <sys/utime.h>. If that doesn't help, look at the
++ code in zstrdt() in [271]ckufio.c.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.4. Hardware Flow Control
++
++ [ [272]Top ] [ [273]Contents ] [ [274]Section Contents ] [ [275]Next ]
++ [ [276]Previous ]
++
++ Hardware flow control is a problematic concept in many popular Unix
++ implementations. Often it is lacking altogether, and when available,
++ the application program interface (API) to it is inconsistent from
++ system to system. Here are some examples:
++
++ a. POSIX does not support hardware flow control.
++ b. RTS/CTS flow control support MIGHT be available for System V R3
++ and later if /usr/include/termiox.h exists (its successful
++ operation also depends on the device driver, and the device
++ itself, not to mention the cable, etc, actually supporting it). If
++ your SVR3-or-later Unix system does have this file, add:
++
++-DTERMIOX
++
++ to your CFLAGS. If the file is in /usr/include/sys instead, add:
++
++-DSTERMIOX
++
++ Note that the presence of this file does not guarantee that
++ RTS/CTS will actually work -- that depends on the device-driver
++ implementation (reportedly, many Unix versions treat
++ hardware-flow-control related ioctl's as no-ops).
++ c. Search ("grep -i") through /usr/include/*.h and
++ /usr/include/sys/*.h for RTS or CTS and see what turns up. For
++ example, in SunOS 4.x we find "CRTSCTS". Figuring out how to use
++ it is another question entirely! In IBM AIX RS/6000 3.x, we have
++ to "add" a new "line discipline" (and you won't find uppercase RTS
++ or CTS symbols in the header files).
++ d. NeXTSTEP and IRIX, and possibly others, support hardware flow
++ control, but do not furnish an API to control it, and thus on
++ these systems Kermit has no command to select it -- instead, a
++ special device name must be used. (NeXTSTEP: /dev/cufa instead of
++ /dev/cua; IRIX: /dev/ttyf00)
++
++ See the routine tthflow() in [277]ckutio.c for details. If you find
++ that your system offers hardware flow control selection under program
++ control, you can add this capability to C-Kermit as follows:
++
++ a. See if it agrees with one of the methods already used in
++ tthflow(). if not, add new code, appropriately #ifdef'd.
++ b. Add -DCK_RTSCTS to the compiler CFLAGS in your makefile target or
++ define this symbol within the appropriate #ifdefs in
++ [278]ckcdeb.h.
++
++ To illustrate the difficulties with RTS/CTS, here is a tale from Jamie
++ Watson <jw@adasoft.ch>, who added the RTS/CTS code for the RS/6000,
++ about his attempts to do the same for DEC ULTRIX:
++
++ "The number and type of hardware signals available to/from a serial
++ port vary between different machines and different types of serial
++ interfaces on each machine. This means that, for example, there are
++ virtually no hardware signals in or out available on the DECsystem
++ 3000/3100 series; on the DECsystem 5000/2xx series all modem
++ signals in/out are present on both built-in serial ports; on the
++ DECsystem 5100 some ports have all signals and some only have some;
++ and so on... It looks to me as if this pretty well rules out any
++ attempt to use hardware flow control on these platforms, even if we
++ could figure out how to do it. The confusion on the user level
++ about whether or not it should work for any given platform or port
++ would be tremendous. And then it isn't clear how to use the
++ hardware signals even in the cases where the device supports them."
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.5. Terminal Speeds
++
++ [ [279]Top ] [ [280]Contents ] [ [281]Section Contents ] [ [282]Next ]
++ [ [283]Previous ]
++
++ The allowable speeds for the SET SPEED command are defined in
++ [284]ckcdeb.h. If your system supports speeds that are not listed in
++ "set speed ?", you can add definitions for them to ckcdeb.h.
++
++ Then if the speed you are adding is one that was never used before in
++ Kermit, such as 921600, you'll also need to add the appropriate
++ keywords to spdtab[] in [285]ckuus3.c, and the corresponding case to
++ ttsspd() in [286]ckutio.c.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.6. Millisecond Sleeps
++
++ [ [287]Top ] [ [288]Contents ] [ [289]Section Contents ] [ [290]Next ]
++ [ [291]Previous ]
++
++ There is no standard for millisecond sleeps, but at least five
++ different functions have appeared in various Unix versions that can be
++ used for this purpose: nap() (mostly in System V), usleep() (found at
++ least in SunOS and NeXT OS), select() (found in 4.2BSD and later, and
++ part of any TCP/IP sockets library), nanosleep(), and sginap(). If you
++ have any of these available, pick one (in this order of preference, if
++ you have more than one):
++
++-DSELECT: Include this in CFLAGS if your system has the select() function.
++-DNAP: Include this in CFLAGS if your system has the nap() function.
++-USLEEP: Include this in CFLAGS if your system has the usleep() function.
++
++ NOTE: The nap() function is assumed to be a function that puts the
++ process to sleep for the given number of milliseconds. If your
++ system's nap() function does something else or uses some other units
++ of time (like the NCR Tower 32, which uses clock-ticks), do not
++ include -DNAP.
++
++ Reportedly, all versions of System V R4 for Intel-based computers, and
++ possibly also SVR3.2, include nap() as a kernel call, but it's not in
++ the library. To include code to use it via syscall(3112,x), without
++ having to include Xenix compatibility features, include the following
++ compile-time option:
++
++-DNAPHACK
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.7. Nondestructive Input Buffer Peeking
++
++ [ [292]Top ] [ [293]Contents ] [ [294]Section Contents ] [ [295]Next ]
++ [ [296]Previous ]
++
++ Some AT&T Unix versions have no way to check if input is waiting on a
++ tty device, but this is a very important feature for Kermit. Without
++ it, sliding windows might not work very well (or at all), and you also
++ have to type your escape character to get Kermit's attention in order
++ to interrupt a local-mode file transfer. If your system offers an
++ FIONREAD ioctl, the build procedure should pick that up automatically
++ and use it, which is ideal.
++
++ If your system lacks FIONREAD but has a select() function, this can be
++ used instead. If the build procedure fails to include it (SHOW
++ FEATURES will list SELECT), then you can add it to your CFLAGS:
++
++-DSELECT
++
++ Conversely, if the build procedure tries to use select() when it
++ really is not there, add:
++
++-DNOSELECT
++
++ Note: select() is not part of System V nor of POSIX, but it has been
++ added to various System-V- and POSIX-based systems as an extension.
++
++ Some System-V variations (SCO Xenix/UNIX/ODT and DIAB DNIX) include a
++ rdchk() function that can be used for buffer peeking. It returns 0 if
++ no characters are waiting and 1 if characters are waiting (but unlike
++ FIONREAD, it does not tell the actual number). If your system has
++ rdchk(), add:
++
++-DRDCHK: Include this in CFLAGS if your system has the rdchk() function.
++
++ Otherwise, if your version of Unix has the poll() function (and the
++ /usr/include/poll.h file) -- which appears to be a standard part of
++ System V going back to at least SVR3, include:
++
++-DCK_POLL
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.8. Other System-Dependent Features
++
++ [ [297]Top ] [ [298]Contents ] [ [299]Section Contents ] [ [300]Next ]
++ [ [301]Previous ]
++
++ Systems with <termios.h> might have the symbol IEXTEN defined. This is
++ used to turn "extended features" in the tty device driver on and off,
++ such as Ctrl-O to toggle output flushing, Ctrl-V to quote input
++ characters, etc.
++
++ In most Unix implementations, it should be turned off during Kermit
++ operation, so if [302]ckutio.c finds this symbol, it uses it. This is
++ necessary, at least, on BSDI. On some systems, however, IEXTEN is
++ either misdefined or misimplemented. The symptom is that CR, when
++ typed to the command processor, is echoed as LF, rather than CRLF.
++ This happens (at least) on Convex/OS 9.1. The solution is to add the
++ following symbol to the makefile target's CFLACS:
++
++-DNOIEXTEN
++
++ However, in at least one Unix implementation, QNX 4.21, IEXTEN must be
++ set before hardware flow control can be used.
++
++ In edits 177 and earlier, workstation users noticed a "slow screen
++ writing" phenomenon during interactive command parsing. This was
++ traced to a setbuf() call in [303]ckutio.c that made console (stdout)
++ writes unbuffered. This setbuf() call has been there forever, and
++ could not be removed without some risk. Kermit's operation was tested
++ on the NeXT in edit 178 with the setbuf() call removed, and the
++ slow-writing symptom was cured, and everything else (command parsing,
++ proper wakeup on ?, ESC, Ctrl-U, and other editing characters,
++ terminal emulation, remote-mode and local-mode file transfer, etc)
++ seemed to work as well as or better than before. In subsequent edits,
++ this change was made to many other versions too, with no apparent ill
++ effects. To remove the setbuf() call for your version of Kermit, add:
++
++-DNOSETBUF
++
++ Later reports indicate that adding -DNOSETBUF has other beneficial
++ effects, like cutting down on swapping when Kermit is run on
++ workstations with small memories. But BEWARE: on certain small Unix
++ systems, notably the AT&T 6300 and 3B1 (the very same ones that
++ benefit from NOSETBUF), NOSETBUF seems to conflict with CK_CURSES. The
++ program builds and runs OK, but after once using the curses display,
++ echoing is messed up. In this case, we use a System-V specific
++ variation in the curses code, using newterm() to prevent System V from
++ altering the buffering. See makefile entries for AT&T 6300 and 3B1.
++
++ The Unix version of C-Kermit includes code to switch to file
++ descriptor zero (stdin) for remote-mode file transfer. This code is
++ necessary to prevent Kermit from giving the impression that it is
++ "idle" during file transfers, which, at some sites, can result in the
++ job being logged out in the middle of an active file transfer by
++ idle-job monitors.
++
++ However, this feature can interfere with certain setups; for example,
++ there is a package which substitutes a pty/tty pair for /dev/tty and
++ sets file descriptor 0 to be read-only, preventing Kermit from sending
++ packets. Or... When a Unix shell is invoked under the PICK
++ environment, file descriptor 0 is inoperative.
++
++ To remove this feature and allow Kermit to work in such environments,
++ add the compile-time option:
++
++-DNOFDZERO
++
++ On some versions of Unix, earlier releases of C-Kermit were reported
++ to render a tty device unusable after a hangup operation. Examples
++ include IBM AIX on the RT PC and RS/6000. A typical symptom of this
++ phenomenon is that the DIAL command doesn't work, but CONNECTing to
++ the device and dialing manually do work. A further test is to SET DIAL
++ HANGUP OFF, which should make dialing work once by skipping the
++ pre-dial hangup. However, after the connection is broken, it can't be
++ used any more: subsequent attempts to DIAL the same device don't work.
++ The cure is usually to close and reopen the device as part of the
++ hangup operation. To do this, include the following compile-time
++ option:
++
++-DCLSOPN
++
++ Similarly, there is a section of code in ttopen(), which does another
++ close(open()) to force the O_NDELAY mode change. On some systems, the
++ close(open()) is required to make the mode change take effect, and
++ apparently on most others it does no harm. But reportedly on at least
++ one System V R4 implementation, and on SCO Xenix 3.2, the
++ close(open()) operation hangs if the device lacks carrier, EVEN THOUGH
++ the CLOCAL characteristic has just been set to avoid this very
++ problem. If this happens to you, add this to your CFLAGS:
++
++-DNOCOTFMC
++
++ or, equivalently, in your KFLAGS on the make command line. It stands
++ for NO Close(Open()) To Force Mode Change.
++
++ C-Kermit renames files when you give a RENAME command and also
++ according to the current SET FILE COLLISION option when receiving
++ files. The normal Unix way to rename a file is via two system calls:
++ link() and unlink(). But this leaves open a window of vulnerability.
++ Some Unix systems also offer an atomic rename(oldname,newname)
++ function. If your version of Unix has this function, add the following
++ to your CFLAGS:
++
++-DRENAME
++
++ C-Kermit predefines the RENAME for several Unix versions in
++ [304]ckcdeb.h (SVR4, SUNOS41, BSD44, AIXRS, etc). You can tell if
++ rename() is being used if the SHOW FEATURES command includes RENAME in
++ the compiler options list. If the predefined RENAME symbol causes
++ trouble, then add NORENAME to your CFLAGS. Trouble includes:
++
++ a. Linker complains that _rename is an unresolved symbol.
++ b. Linking works, but Kermit's RENAME command doesn't work (which
++ happens because older versions of rename() might have their
++ arguments reversed).
++
++ If rename() is not used, then Kermit uses link()/unlink(), which is
++ equivalent except it is not atomic: there is a tiny interval in which
++ some other process might "do something" to one of the files or links.
++
++ Some Unix systems (Olivetti X/OS, Amdahl UTS/V, ICL SVR3, etc) define
++ the S_ISREG and S_ISDIR macros incorrectly. This is compensated for
++ automatically in [305]ckufio.c. Other systems might have this same
++ problem. If you get a compile-time error message regarding S_ISREG
++ and/or S_ISDIR, add the following to your CFLAGS:
++
++-DISDIRBUG
++
++ Finally, here's a symbol you should NEVER define:
++
++-DCOMMENT
++
++ It's used for commenting out blocks of code. If for some reason you
++ find that your compiler has COMMENT defined, then add -UCOMMENT to
++ CFLAGS or KFLAGS! Similarly, some header files have been known to
++ define COMMENT, in which case you must add "#undef COMMENT" to each
++ C-Kermit source module, after all the #includes.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.9. Terminal Interruption
++
++ [ [306]Top ] [ [307]Contents ] [ [308]Section Contents ] [ [309]Next ]
++ [ [310]Previous ]
++
++ When C-Kermit enters interactive command mode, it sets a Control-C
++ (terminal keyboard interrupt = SIGINT) trap to allow it to return to
++ the command prompt whenever the user types Control-C (or whatever is
++ assigned to be the interrupt character). This is implemented using
++ setjmp() and longjmp(). On some systems, depending on the machine
++ architecture and C compiler and who knows what else, you might get
++ "Memory fault (coredump)" or "longjmp botch" instead of the desired
++ effect (this should not happen in 5A(190) and later). In that case,
++ add -DNOCCTRAP to your CFLAGS and rebuild the program.
++
++ Job control -- the ability to "suspend" C-Kermit on a Unix system by
++ typing the "susp" character (normally Ctrl-Z) and then resume
++ execution later (with the "fg" command) -- is a tricky business.
++ C-Kermit must trap suspend signals so it can put the terminal back
++ into normal mode when you suspend it (Kermit puts the terminal into
++ various strange modes during interactive command parsing, CONNECT, and
++ file transfer). Supporting code is compiled into C-Kermit
++ automatically if <signal.h> includes a definition for the SIGTSTP
++ signal. HOWEVER... some systems define this signal without supporting
++ job control correctly. You can build Kermit to ignore SIGTSTP signals
++ by including the -DNOJC option in CFLAGS. (You can also do this at
++ runtime by giving the command SET SUSPEND OFF.)
++
++ NOTE: As of version 5A(190), C-Kermit makes another safety check.
++ Even if job control is available in the operating system (according
++ to the numerous checks made in congm()), it will still disable the
++ catching of SIGTSTP signals if SIGTSTP was set to SIG_IGN at the
++ time C-Kermit was started.
++
++ System V R3 and earlier systems normally do not support job control.
++ If you have an SVR3 system that does, include the following option in
++ your CFLAGS:
++
++-DSVR3JC
++
++ On systems that correctly implement POSIX signal handling, signals can
++ be handled more reliably than in Bell, Berkeley, or AT&T Unixes. On
++ systems (such as QNX) that are "strictly POSIX", POSIX signal handling
++ *must* be used, otherwise no signal will work more than once. If you
++ have POSIX-based system and you find that your version of Kermit
++ responds to Ctrl-C (SIGINT) or Ctrl-Z (SIGTSTP) only once, then you
++ should add the following option to your CFLAGS:
++
++-DCK_POSIX_SIG
++
++ But be careful; some POSIX implementations, notably 4.4BSD, include
++ POSIX signal handling symbols and functions as "stubs" only, which do
++ nothing. Look in <signal.h> for sigsetjmp and siglongjmp and read the
++ comments.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++10. DIALING OUT AND COORDINATING WITH UUCP
++
++ [ [311]Top ] [ [312]Contents ] [ [313]Next ] [ [314]Previous ]
++
++ NOTE: Red Hat Linux 7.2 and later include a new API that allows
++ serial-port arbitration by non-setuid/gid programs. This API has
++ not yet been added to C-Kermit. If C-Kermit is to be used for
++ dialing out on Red Hat 7.2 or later, it must still be installed as
++ described in this section and the next.
++
++ The short version:
++
++ In order for C-Kermit to be able to dial out from your Unix
++ computer, you need to give it the same owner, group, and
++ permissions as your other dialout programs, such as cu, tip,
++ minicom, uucp, seyon, etc.
++
++ The long version:
++
++ Make sure your dialout line is correctly configured for dialing out
++ (as opposed to login). The method for doing this is different for each
++ kind of Unix. Consult your system documentation for configuring lines
++ for dialing out (for example, Sun SPARCstation IPC users should read
++ the section "Setting up Modem Software" in the Desktop SPARC Sun
++ System and Network Manager's Guide, or the Terminals and Modems
++ section of the HP manual, "Configuring HP-UX for Peripherals" (e.g.
++ /usr/sbin/sam => Peripheral Devices => Terminals and Modems => Add
++ Modem).
++
++ Unlike most other multiuser, multitasking operating systems, Unix
++ allows multiple users to access the same serial device at the same
++ time, even though there is no earthly reason why two users should do
++ this. When they do, user A will read some of the incoming characters,
++ and user B will read the others. In all likelihood, neither user will
++ see them all. Furthermore, User B can hang up User A's call, etc.
++
++ Rather than change Unix to enforce exclusive access to serial devices
++ such as ttys, Unix developers chose instead to use a "lock file". Any
++ process that wants to open a tty device should first check to see if a
++ file of a certain name exists, and if so, not to open the device. If
++ the file does not exist, the process creates the file and then opens
++ the device. When the process closes the device, it destroys the
++ lockfile. This procedure was originated for use with Unix's UUCP, CU,
++ and TIP programs, and so these lockfiles are commonly called "UUCP
++ lockfiles" (UUCP = Unix-to-Unix Copy Program).
++
++ As you can imagine, this method is riddled with pitfalls:
++
++ * If a process does not observe the prevailing lockfile convention,
++ then it can interfere with other "polite" processes. And in fact,
++ very few Unix applications or commands handle lockfiles at all; an
++ original design goal of Unix was that "everything is a file", and
++ countless utilities operate on files directly (by opening them) or
++ indirectly through redirection of standard i/o, without creating
++ or looking for lockfiles.
++ * If a process crashes while it has the device open, the lockfile is
++ left behind, preventing further processes from using the device.
++ * Various versions of Unix use different names for the lockfiles,
++ put them in different directories, with different owners and
++ groups and permissions, and specify their contents differently.
++ * On a given platform, the lockfile conventions may change from one
++ Unix release to the next (for example, SunOS 4.0 to 4.1) or, in
++ the case of Linux, across different distributions.
++ * The same tty device might have more than one name, and most
++ lockfile conventions don't allow for this. Similarly for symbolic
++ links.
++
++ In an attempt to address the problem of "stale" lockfiles, most UUCP
++ implementations put the PID (Process ID) of the creating process in
++ the lockfile. Thus, another process that wants to open the
++ corresponding device can check not only for the lockfile itself, but
++ also can check the PID for validity. But this doesn't work well
++ either:
++
++ * PIDs are stored in diverse formats that change with every new
++ release (short, integer, long, or string in any of various
++ formats). If the reading program does not follow the same
++ convention as the writing program, it can diagnose a valid PID to
++ be invalid, and therefore not honor the lock.
++ * PIDs recycle. If the lockfile was created by PID 1234, which later
++ crashed without removing the lockfile, and then a new process 1234
++ exists a the time the lockfile is checked, the lockfile will be
++ improperly taken as valid, and access to the device denied
++ unnecessarily.
++
++ Several techniques address the problem of multiple names for the same
++ device:
++
++ * Multiple lockfiles. For example, if the user opens a device
++ through a symlink, a lockfile is created for both the symlink name
++ and the true name (obtained from readlink()). However, when
++ multiple drivers are installed for the same device (e.g. /dev/cua,
++ /dev/cufa, etc), this approach won't work unless all applications
++ *know* all the different names for the same device and make
++ lockfiles for all of them, which is obviously not practical.
++ * Lockfiles whose names are not based on the device name. These
++ lockfiles generally have names like LK.inode/major/minor, where
++ inode, major, and minor are numbers, which will always be the same
++ for any physical device, no matter what its name. This form of
++ lockfile is used in System V R4 and its derivatives, such as
++ Solaris, UnixWare, etc. If lockfiles must be used (as opposed to,
++ say, kernel-based locks), this would seem to be the most effective
++ form.
++
++ Most versions of Unix were not designed to accommodate third-party
++ communications software; thus vendors of these Unix products feel no
++ compunction about changing lockfile conventions from release to
++ release, since they also change their versions of the cu, uucp, tip,
++ etc, programs at the same time to match. And since the source code to
++ these programs might not be published, it is difficult for makers of
++ third-party products like C-Kermit to find out what the new
++ conventions are. It also forces release of new versions of C-Kermit
++ whenever the OS vendor makes a change like this.
++
++ Some Unix vendors have taken a small step to simplify communications
++ application development for their products: the inclusion of lockfile
++ routines in the standard system C runtime libraries to shield the
++ application from the details of lockfile management (IBM AIX is an
++ example). When such routines are used, communications applications do
++ not need modification when lockfile conventions change (although they
++ will need recompiling if the routines are statically linked into the
++ application). In the AIX example, the simple function calls ttylock(),
++ ttyunlock(), and ttylocked() replace hundreds of lines of ugly code in
++ C-Kermit that attempts to keep pace with every release of every Unix
++ product over the last 20 years. Inclusion of ttylock() code occurs
++ when:
++
++-DUSETTYLOCK
++
++ is included in the CFLAGS.
++
++ If such routines are available, they should be used. The rest of this
++ section applies when they are not.
++
++ To fit in with UUCP and other Unix-based communication software,
++ C-Kermit must have the same idea as your system's uucp, cu, and tip
++ programs about what the UUCP lock directory is called, what the
++ lockfile itself is called, and what its contents should be. In most
++ cases, C-Kermit preprocessor flags create the appropriate
++ configuration at compile time if the appropriate makefile target was
++ used (see [315]ckutio.c). The following CFLAGS options can be used to
++ override the built-in configuration:
++
++ -DLCKDIR
++ Tells Kermit that the UUCP lock directory is
++ /usr/spool/uucp/LCK.
++
++ -DACUCNTRL
++ Tells Kermit to use the BSD 4.3 acucntrl() program to turn off
++ getty (login) on the line before using it, and restore getty
++ when done.
++
++ -DHDBUUCP
++ Include this if your system uses Honey DanBer UUCP, in which
++ the lockfile directory and format are relatively standardized.
++
++ -DLOCK_DIR=\\\"/xxx/yyy\\\"
++ Gives the lock directory name explicitly. The triple quoting is
++ necessary. For example:
++
++CFLAGS= -DBSD4 -DLOCK_DIR=\\\"/usr/local/locks\\\" -DNODEBUG
++
++ (NOTE: The triple quoting assumes this is a "top-level" make
++ entry, and not a make entry that calls another one.)
++
++ -DLFDEVNO The lockfile name uses the tty device inode and major and
++ minor
++ numbers: LK.dev.maj.min, as in Sys V R4, e.g. LK.035.044.008.
++
++ When the LK.inode.major.minor form is used, a single lockfile is
++ enough. Otherwise, a single lockfile rarely suffices. For example, in
++ Linux, it is common to have a /dev/modem symbolic link to an actual
++ dialout device, like /dev/cua0 or /dev/ttyS0, whose purpose is to hide
++ the details of the actual driver from the user. So if one user opens
++ /dev/modem, a lockfile called LCK..modem is created, which does not
++ prevent another user from simulataneously opening the same device by
++ its real name.
++
++ On SCO Unix platforms, we have a slightly different problem: the same
++ device is, by convention, known by "lowercase" and "uppercase" names,
++ depending on whether it has modem control. So by convention,
++ communications programs are supposed to create the lockfiles based on
++ the lowercase name. But some programs don't follow this convention. In
++ HP-UX, we have several different names for each serial device. And so
++ on.
++
++ For this reason, on platforms where the LK.inode.major.minor form is
++ not used, C-Kermit also creates a secondary lockfile (which is simply
++ a link to the first) if:
++
++ a. The given device name is a symbolic link. The secondary link is
++ based on the device's real name.
++ b. On SCO: The device name is not a symbolic link, but it contains
++ uppercase letters. The primary link is based on the lowercase
++ name; the secondary link is based on the name that was given.
++ c. On HP-UX: The device name starts with "cu". The primary link is
++ based on the name that was given; the secondary link is based on
++ the corresponding "ttyd" device, e.g. "LCK..cua0p0" and
++ "LCK..ttyd0p0".
++
++ NOTE: symlinks are not handled in HP-UX.
++
++ Honey DanBer (HDB) UUCP, which is becoming increasingly popular, has
++ two characteristics:
++
++ a. Lockfiles are kept in /usr/spool/locks/ (usually).
++ b. A lockfile contains the process id (pid) in ASCII, rather than as
++ an int.
++
++ Non-HDB selections assume the lockfile contains the pid in int form
++ (or, more precisely, in PID_T form, where PID_T is either int or
++ pid_t, depending on your system's C library and header files). (b), by
++ the way, is subject to interpretation: the numeric ASCII string may or
++ may not be terminated by a newline, it may or may not have leading
++ spaces (or zeros), and the number of leading spaces or zeros can
++ differ, and the differences can be significant.
++
++ Even if you build the program with the right lockfile option, you can
++ still have problems when you try to open the device. Here are the
++ error messages you can get from SET LINE, and what they mean:
++
++ a. "Timed out, no carrier." This one is not related to lockfiles. It
++ means that you have SET CARRIER ON xx, where xx is the number of
++ seconds to wait for carrier, and carrier did not appear within xx
++ seconds. Solution: SET CARRIER AUTO or OFF.
++ b. "Sorry, access to lock denied." Kermit has been configured to use
++ lockfiles, but (a)the lockfile directory is write-protected
++ against you, or (b) it does not exist. The "access to lock denied"
++ message will tell you the reason. If the directory does not exist,
++ check to make sure Kermit is using the right name. Just because
++ version n of your Unix used a certain lockfile directory is no
++ gurantee that version n.1 does not use a different one.
++ Workaround: ask the system administrator to install a symbolic
++ link from the old name to the new name. Other solutions: (see
++ below)
++ c. "Sorry, access to tty device denied." The tty device that you
++ specified in your SET LINE command is read/write protected against
++ you. Solution: (see below)
++ d. "Sorry, device is in use." The tty device you have specified is
++ currently being used by another user. A prefatory message gives
++ you an "ls -l" listing of the lockfile, which should show the
++ username of the person who created it, plus a message "pid = nnn"
++ to show you the process id of the user's program. Solutions: try
++ another device, wait until the other user is finished, ask the
++ other user to hurry up, or ask the system manager for help.
++ e. "Sorry, can't open connection: reason". The device cannot be
++ opened for some other reason, which is listed.
++ f. "sh: /usr/lib/uucp/acucntrl: not found". This means your Kermit
++ program was built with the -DACUCNTRL switch, but your computer
++ system does not have the BSD 4.3 acucntrl program. Solution:
++ install the acucntrl program if you have it, or rebuild Kermit
++ without the -DACUCNTRL switch.
++
++ There are two solutions for problems (b) and (c), both of which
++ involve intervention by your Unix system administrator (superuser):
++
++ a. Have the superuser change the permission of the lockfile directory
++ and to the tty devices so that everyone on the system has
++ read/write permission.
++
++su% chmod 777 /usr/spool/locks (or whatever the path is)
++su% chmod 666 /dev/ttyXX
++
++ One risk here is that people can write lots of junk into the
++ lockfile directory, delete other people's files in the lockfile
++ directory, and intercept other people's data as it goes in and out
++ of the tty device. The major danger here would be intercepting a
++ privileged password. Of course, any user could write a short,
++ ordinary, unprivileged program to do exactly the same thing if the
++ tty device was world read/writeable. The other risk as that
++ telephone calls are not controlled -- anybody on your system can
++ make them, without having to belong to any particular group, and
++ this could run up your phone bill.
++ b. Use groups to regulate access. Normally the lockfile directory and
++ and the dialout devices will have the same group (such as uucp).
++ If so, then put everybody who's allowed to dial out into that
++ group, and make sure that the lockfile directory and the tty
++ devices have group read AND write permission. Example:
++
++su% chmod 770 /usr/spool/locks (or whatever the path is)
++su% chmod 660 /dev/ttyXX
++
++ User whatever tool is available on your platform to add users to
++ the appropropriate group (e.g. edit the /etc/group file).
++ c. Have the superuser change Kermit to run setuid and/or setgid to
++ the owner and/or group of the lockfile directory and the tty
++ devices if necessary), typically uucp (see [316]next section), but
++ NOT root. Example:
++
++su% chown uucp kermit - or - chgrp uucp kermit
++su% chmod u+s kermit (setuid) - or - chmod g+s kermit (setgid)
++
++ and then make sure the lockfile directory, and the tty devices,
++ have owner (setuid) and/or group (setgid) write permission. For
++ example:
++
++su% chmod o+rwx /usr/spool/uucp
++su% chown uucp /dev/ttyXX ; chmod 600 /dev/ttyXX
++
++ In some cases, the owner and group must be distinct; the key point
++ is that read/write access is required to both the UUCP lockfile
++ directory and the tty itself.
++
++ If you make C-Kermit setuid or setgid to root, it refuses to run:
++
++Fatal: C-Kermit setuid to root!
++
++ Example:
++
++crw-r----- 1 uucp uucp 5, 67 Feb 11 06:23 /dev/cua3
++drwxrwxr-x 3 root uucp 1024 Feb 11 06:22 /var/lock
++
++ requires suid uucp to get read/write access on /dev/cua3 and sgid to
++ get read/write access on /var/lock (since you can't set Kermit's uid
++ or gid to root).
++
++ The reason Kermit can't be setuid or setgid to root has to do with
++ the fact that some Unix OS's can't switch user or group IDs in that
++ case. Unfortunately, the prohibition against making Kermit setuid
++ or setgid to root means that Unix C-Kermit can't be used to make
++ rlogin connections by non-root users. (The rlogin port is
++ privileged, which is why the regular rlogin command is setuid root
++ -- which is safe because the rlogin program never has to create or
++ access files like Kermit does.)
++
++ For the lockfile mechanism to achieve its desired purpose --
++ prevention of access to the same tty device by more than one process
++ at a time -- ALL programs on a given computer that open, read or
++ write, and close tty devices must use the SAME lockfile conventions.
++ Unfortunately, this is often not the case. Here is a typical example
++ of how this can go wrong: In SunOS 4.0 and earler, the lockfile
++ directory was /usr/spool/uucp; in 4.1 it was changed to
++ /var/spool/locks in the quest for political correctness. Consequently,
++ any third-party programs (such as C-Kermit) that were not modified to
++ account for this change, recompiled, and reinstalled, did not use the
++ same lockfiles as uucp, tip, etc, and so the entire purpose of the
++ lockfile is defeated.
++
++ What if your Unix system does not have UUCP installed? For example,
++ you have a Unix workstation, and you do not use uucp, cu, or tip, or
++ UUCP was not even supplied with your version of Unix (QNX is an
++ example). In this case, you have two choices:
++
++ a. If there may be more than one person running Kermit at the same
++ time, competing for the same tty device, then create a special
++ lockfile directory just for Kermit, for example,
++ /usr/spool/kermit, and make sure you have read/write access to it.
++ Then add the following to your makefile target CFLAGS, as shown
++ earlier:
++
++-DLOCK_DIR=\\\"/usr/spool/kermit\\\"
++
++ b. If you are the only user on your workstation, and no other
++ processes will ever be competing with Kermit for the dialout tty
++ device, then add -DNOUUCP to your makefile target's CFLAGS and
++ rebuild Kermit.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++11. RUNNING UNIX C-KERMIT SETUID OR SETGID
++
++ [ [317]Top ] [ [318]Contents ] [ [319]Next ] [ [320]Previous ]
++
++ Even if you don't intend to run C-Kermit setuid, somebody else might
++ come along and chown and chmod it after it has been built. You should
++ be sure that it is built correctly to run setuid on your system. For
++ POSIX and AT&T Unix based versions, you don't have to do anything
++ special.
++
++ For 4.2 and 4.3 BSD-based Unix versions, you normally need not add
++ anything special to the makefile. The program assumes that the
++ setreuid() and setregid() functions are available, without which we
++ cannot switch back and forth between real and effective uids. If
++ "make" complains that _setreuid or _setregid is/are not defined, add
++ -DNOSETREU to CFLAGS. In this case it is very likely (but not certain)
++ that you cannot protect ttys and lockfiles against people and have
++ them run Kermit setuid.
++
++ If make does not complain about this, you should find out whether your
++ BSD version (4.3 or other systems like SunOS 4.x that claim to include
++ BSD 4.3 compatibility) includes the saved-setuid feature (see long
++ notes under edit 146 in ckc178.upd). If it does, then add -DSAVEDUID
++ to CFLAGS.
++
++ IMPORTANT NOTE: Most Unix system documentation will not give you
++ the required information. To determine whether your Unix system
++ supplies the the saved-original-effective-user/group-id feature,
++ use the ckuuid.c program. Read and follow the instructions in the
++ comments at the beginning.
++
++ C-Kermit for 4.4BSD-based systems automatically use sete[ug]id(). See
++ [321]ckutio.c.
++
++ If you have a version of Unix that is not BSD-based, but which
++ supplies the setreuid() and setregid() functions, and these are the
++ only way to switch between real and effective uid, add -DSETREUID to
++ your makefile target.
++
++ WARNING: There are two calls to access() in [322]ckufio.c, by which
++ Kermit checks to see if it can create an output file. These calls
++ will not work correctly when (a)you have installed C-Kermit setuid
++ or setgid on a BSD-based Unix system, and (b) the
++ saved-original-effective-uid/gid feature is not present, and (c)
++ the access() function always checks what it believes to be the real
++ ID rather than the effective ID. This is the case, for example, in
++ Olivetti X/OS and in NeXTSTEP. In such cases, you can force correct
++ operation of access() calls by defining the symbol SW_ACC_ID at
++ compile time in CFLAGS.
++
++ If you have a version of Unix that does not allow a process to switch
++ back and forth between its effective and real user and group ids
++ multiple times, you probably should not attempt to run Kermit setuid,
++ because once having given up its effective uid or gid (which it must
++ do in order to transfer files, fork a shell, etc) it can never get it
++ back, and so it can not use the original effective uid or gid to
++ create or delete uucp lockfiles. In this case, you'll either have to
++ set the permissions on your lockfile directory to make them publicly
++ read/writable, or dispense with locking altogether.
++
++ MORAL: Are you thoroughly sickened and/or frightened by all that you
++ have just read? You should be. What is the real answer? Simple. Serial
++ devices -- such as ttys and magnetic tapes -- in Unix should be opened
++ with exclusive access only, enforced by the Unix kernel. Shared access
++ has no conceivable purpose, legitimate or otherwise, except by
++ privileged system programs such as getty. The original design dates
++ from the late 1960s, when Unix was developed for laboratory use under
++ a philosophy of trust by people within shouting distance of each other
++ -- but even then, no useful purpose was served by this particular form
++ of openness; it was probably more of a political statement. Since the
++ emergence of Unix from the laboratory into the commercial market, we
++ have seen every vestige of openness -- but this one -- stripped away.
++ I'd like to see some influential Unix maker take the bold step of
++ making the simple kernel change required to enforce exclusive access
++ to serial devices. (Well, perhaps not so simple when bidirectionality
++ must also be a goal -- but then other OS's like VMS solved this
++ problem decades ago.)
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++12. CONFIGURING UNIX WORKSTATIONS
++
++ [ [323]Top ] [ [324]Contents ] [ [325]Next ] [ [326]Previous ]
++
++ On desktop workstations that are used by only the user at the console
++ keyboard, C-Kermit is always used in local mode. But as delivered,
++ C-Kermit runs in remote mode by default. To put it in local mode at
++ startup, you can put a SET LINE command in your .mykermrc.
++
++ You can also build C-Kermit to start up in local mode by default. To
++ do this, include the following in the CFLAGS in your makefile target:
++
++-DDFTTY=\\\"/dev/ttyxx\\\"
++
++ where ttyxx is the name of the device you will be using for
++ communications. Presently there is no way of setting the default modem
++ type at compile time, so use this option only for direct lines.
++
++ C-Kermit does not work well on certain workstations if it is not run
++ from within a terminal window. For example, you cannot start C-Kermit
++ on a NeXT by launching it directly from NeXTstep. Similarly for Sun
++ workstations in the Open Windows environment. Run Kermit in a terminal
++ window.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++13. BIZARRE BEHAVIOR AT RUNTIME
++
++ [ [327]Top ] [ [328]Contents ] [ [329]Next ] [ [330]Previous ]
++
++ See the "beware file",
++
++ [331]ckubwr.txt, for hints about runtime misbehavior. This section
++ lists some runtime problems that can be cured by rebuilding C-Kermit.
++
++ The program starts, but there is no prompt, and certain operations
++ don't work (you see error messages like "Kermit command error in
++ background execution"). This is because Kermit thinks it is running in
++ the background. See conbgt() in [332]ckutio.c. Try rebuilding Kermit
++ with:
++
++ -DPID_T=pid_t
++
++ added to your CFLAGS. If that doesn't help, find out the actual data
++ type for pids (look in types.h or similar file) and use it in place of
++ "pid_t", for example:
++
++ -DPID_T=short
++
++ Unexplainable and inappropriate error messages ("Sockets not supported
++ on this device", etc) have been traced in at least one case to a lack
++ of agreement between the system header files and the actual kernel.
++ This happened because the GNU C compiler (gcc) was being used. gcc
++ wants to have ANSI-C-compliant header files, and so part of the
++ installation procedure for gcc is (or was) to run a shell script
++ called "fixincludes", which translates the system's header files into
++ a separate set of headers that gcc likes. So far so good. Later, a new
++ version of the operating system is installed and nobody remembers to
++ run fixincludes again. From that point, any program compiled with gcc
++ that makes use of header files (particularly ioctl.h) is very likely
++ to misbehave. Solution: run fixincludes again, or use your system's
++ regular C compiler, libraries, and header files instead of gcc.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++14. CRASHES AND CORE DUMPS
++
++ [ [333]Top ] [ [334]Contents ] [ [335]Next ] [ [336]Previous ]
++
++ If C-Kermit constitently dumps core at the beginning of a file
++ transfer, look in SHOW FEATURES for CKREALPATH. If found, rebuild with
++ -DNOREALPATH and see if that fixes the problem (some UNIXes have
++ realpath() but it doesn't work).
++
++ Total failure of the Kermit program can occur because of bad memory
++ references, bad system calls, or problems with dynamic memory
++ allocation. First, try to reproduce the problem with debugging turned
++ on: run Kermit with the -d command-line option (for example, "wermit
++ -d") and then examine the resulting debug.log file. The last entry
++ should be in the vicinity of the crash. In VMS, a crash automatically
++ produces a "stack dump" which shows the routine where the crash
++ occurs. In some versions of Unix, you can get a stack dump with "adb"
++ -- just type "adb wermit core" and then give the command "$c", then
++ Ctrl-D to quit (note: replace "wermit" by "kermit" or by the full
++ pathname of the executable that crashed if it is not in the current
++ directory). Or use gdb to get a backtrace, etc.
++
++ In edit 186, one implementation, UNISYS 5000/95 built with "make
++ sys5r3", has been reported to run out of memory very quickly (e.g.
++ while executing a short initialization file that contains a SET DIAL
++ DIRECTORY command). Debug logs show that malloc calls are failing,
++ reason unknown. For this and any other implementation that gives error
++ messages about "malloc failure" or "memory allocation failure",
++ rebuild the program *without* the -DDYNAMIC CFLAGS definition, for
++ example:
++
++make sys5r3 KFLAGS=-UDYNAMIC
++
++ As of edit 169, C-Kermit includes a malloc() debugging package which
++ you may link with the Kermit program to catch runtime malloc errors.
++ See the makefile entries for sunos41md and nextmd for examples of how
++ to select malloc debugging. Once you have linked Kermit with the
++ malloc debugger, it will halt with an informative message if a
++ malloc-related error occurs and, if possible, dump core. For this
++ reason, malloc-debugging versions of Kermit should be built without
++ the "-s" link option (which removes symbols, preventing analysis of
++ the core dump). You have several ways to track down the malloc error:
++ Analyze the core dump with adb. Or reproduce the problem with "log
++ debug" and then look at the code around the last debug.log entry. If
++ you have gcc, build the program with "-g" added to CFLAGS and then
++ debug it with gdb, e.g.
++
++gdb wermit
++break main
++run
++.. set other breakpoints or watchpoints
++continue
++
++ Watchpoints are especially useful for finding memory leaks, but they
++ make the program run about a thousand times slower than usual, so
++ don't set them until the last possible moment. When a watchpoint is
++ hit, you can use the "where" command to find out which C-Kermit source
++ statement triggered it.
++
++ If you have the Pure Software Inc "Purify" product, see the sunos41cp
++ makefile entry for an example of how to use it to debug C-Kermit.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++15. SYSLOGGING
++
++ [ [337]Top ] [ [338]Contents ] [ [339]Next ] [ [340]Previous ]
++
++ "Syslogging" means recording selected in the system log via the Unix
++ syslog() facility, which is available in most Unix versions.
++ Syslogging is not done unless C-Kermit is started with:
++
++--syslog:n
++
++ on the command-line, where n is a number greater than 0 to indicate
++ the level of syslogging. See [341]Section 4.2 of the [342]IKSD
++ Administrator's Guide for details.
++
++ Obviously you can't depend on users to include --syslog:3 (or
++ whatever) on the command line every time they start C-Kermit, so if
++ you want certain kinds of records to be recorded in the system log,
++ you can build C-Kermit with forced syslogging at the desired level,
++ e.g.:
++
++make linux KFLAGS=-DSYSLOGLEVEL=2
++
++ Levels 2 and 3 are the most likely candidates for this treatment.
++ Level 2 forces logging of all successful dialout calls (e.g. for
++ checking against or phone bills), and level 3 records all connections
++ (SET LINE or SET HOST / TELNET / RLOGIN, etc) so you can see who is
++ connecting out from your system, and to where.
++
++ Level 2 and 3 records are equivalent to those in the connection log;
++ see the [343]C-Kermit 7.0 Supplement) for a detailed description of
++ the connection log.
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++16. BUILDING SECURE VERSIONS OF C-KERMIT 8.0
++
++ [ [344]Top ] [ [345]Contents ] [ [346]Next ] [ [347]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 and later may be built with Kerberos(TM) and/or SRP(TM)
++ (Secure Remote Password) and/or SSL/TLS security for strong
++ authentication and encryption of Internet connections. These security
++ methods require external libraries that, in their binary forms, are
++ restricted from export by USA law. See the [348]Kermit Security
++ Reference) for details. C-Kermit binaries themselves are likewise
++ restricted; the C-Kermit binaries that are available for public
++ download on the Internet are not allowed to contain the security
++ options.
++
++ Sample makefile entries are provided for Linux and many other
++ operating systems. A list of secure makefile entries is included in
++ the Makefile. Complete instructions on building C-Kermit 8.0 with MIT
++ Kerberos; Secure Remote Password; and/or OpenSSL can be found in the
++ [349]Kermit Security Reference.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 comes with a current list of Certificate Authority
++ certificates, including one for the Kermit Project that can be used
++ for authentication to Columbia's [350]Internet Kermit Service (IKSD).
++ You can use C-Kermit 7.0 or later to access Columbia's IKSD securely
++ by installing the Kermit Project certificate in
++ /usr/local/ssl/cert.pem (or the appropriate location based upon the
++ installation of OpenSSL on your system). You can find a copy of the
++ certificates file at:
++
++[351]ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ca_certs.pem
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++17. INSTALLING C-KERMIT AS AN SSH SERVER SUBSYSTEM
++
++ [ [352]Top ] [ [353]Contents ] [ [354]Previous ]
++
++ This requires C-Kermit 8.0.206 or later and an SSH v2 server. If you
++ list C-Kermit as a Subsystem in the SSH v2 server configuration file
++ (as, for example, SFTP is listed), users can make SSH connections
++ direct to a Kermit server as explained here:
++
++[355]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/skermit.html
++
++ The name and location of the SSH server configuration file depends on
++ your platform, which SSH product(s) you have, etc. C-Kermit itself
++ must be referred to in this file as "kermit-sshsub". On the host,
++ install the C-Kermit 8.0.211 binary in the normal way. Then, in the
++ same directory as the C-Kermit binary, make a symbolic link:
++
++ln -s kermit kermit-sshsub
++
++ (Note: the "make install" makefile target does this for you.) Then in
++ the sshd configuration file, add a line:
++
++Subsystem kermit /some/path/kermit-sshsub
++
++ (where /some/path is the fully specified directory where the symlink
++ is.) This is similar to the line that sets up the SFTP susbsystem.
++ Example:
++
++Subsystem sftp /usr/local/libexec/sftp-server
++Subsystem kermit /usr/local/bin/kermit-sshsub
++
++ The mechanics might vary for other SSH servers; "man sshd" for
++ details. The method shown here is used because the OpenSSH server does
++ not permit the subsystem invocation to include command-line options.
++ C-Kermit would have no way of knowing that it should enter Server mode
++ if it were not called by a special name.
++
++ [ [356]Top ] [ [357]Contents ] [ [358]C-Kermit Home ] [ [359]C-Kermit
++ 8.0 Overview ] [ [360]Kermit Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 Unix Installation Instructions / The Kermit Project /
++ Columbia University / 10 April 2004
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 4. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 5. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x0
++ 6. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x1
++ 7. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x2
++ 8. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x3
++ 9. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 10. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x6
++ 12. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x7
++ 13. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x8
++ 14. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 15. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 16. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 17. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x12
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x13
++ 19. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x14
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x15
++ 21. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x16
++ 22. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x16
++ 23. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 24. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 25. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x1
++ 26. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 27. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 29. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html
++ 30. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x2
++ 31. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/x3
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 33. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 34. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 35. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x2
++ 36. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x0
++ 37. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/archives/cku211.tar.Z
++ 38. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/archives/cku211.tar.gz
++ 39. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/archives/cku211.tar
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x7
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 42. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 43. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x16
++ 44. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 46. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x3
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x1
++ 48. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 49. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#X10
++ 50. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 51. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 52. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x3
++ 53. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80packages.html
++ 54. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 55. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 56. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 57. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 58. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x2
++ 59. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/bin/
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80binaries.html
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x7
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#build
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 66. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
++ 67. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 68. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 69. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 70. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x3
++ 71. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x8
++ 72. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 73. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 74. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckpker.mk
++ 75. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckubsd.mak
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 77. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 78. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 79. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x7
++ 80. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 81. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 82. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.4
++ 83. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 84. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 85. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 86. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 87. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 88. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 89. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.1
++ 90. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 91. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.1
++ 92. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.2
++ 93. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.3
++ 94. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.4
++ 95. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.5
++ 96. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 97. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8
++ 98. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 99. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 100. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 101. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 102. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 103. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcmai.c
++ 104. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x15
++ 105. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 106. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 107. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 108. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 109. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.c
++ 110. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.c
++ 111. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 112. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcuni.c
++ 113. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 114. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 115. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 116. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 117. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.2
++ 118. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.0
++ 119. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 120. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckubwr.txt
++ 121. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 122. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckwart.c
++ 123. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcpro.w
++ 124. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcpro.c
++ 125. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 126. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 127. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 128. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.3
++ 129. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.1
++ 130. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 131. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 132. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 133. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 134. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.4
++ 135. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.2
++ 136. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 137. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 138. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 139. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.5
++ 140. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.3
++ 141. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckpker.mk
++ 142. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 143. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 144. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 145. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.4
++ 146. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 147. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 148. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcpro.w
++ 149. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 150. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 151. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x6
++ 152. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 153. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.1
++ 154. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.2
++ 155. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.3
++ 156. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.4
++ 157. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 158. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.4
++ 159. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.3
++ 160. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/COPYING.TXT
++ 161. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckermit.ini
++ 162. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.1
++ 163. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckermod.ini
++ 164. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckermit70.txt
++ 165. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual
++ 166. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html
++ 167. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckermit80.txt
++ 168. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual
++ 169. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++ 170. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcbwr.txt
++ 171. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ 172. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckubwr.txt
++ 173. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 174. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuins.txt
++ 175. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 176. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckccfg.txt
++ 177. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 178. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcplm.txt
++ 179. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html
++ 180. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ca_certs.pem
++ 181. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x16"
++ 182. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 183. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x?
++ 184. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 185. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5.2
++ 186. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html#download
++ 187. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80binaries.html
++ 188. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html#download
++ 189. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 190. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 191. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x7
++ 192. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 193. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 194. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 195. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x8
++ 196. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x6
++ 197. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 198. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 199. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4.0
++ 200. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 201. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 202. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 203. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 204. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 205. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x2
++ 206. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 207. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 208. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 209. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 210. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 211. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 212. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.4
++ 213. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 214. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 215. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 216. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 217. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x7
++ 218. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 219. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 220. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 221. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 222. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 223. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x8
++ 224. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1
++ 225. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.1
++ 226. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.2
++ 227. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.3
++ 228. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.2
++ 229. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.3
++ 230. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.4
++ 231. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.5
++ 232. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.6
++ 233. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.7
++ 234. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.8
++ 235. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.9
++ 236. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 237. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 238. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 239. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 240. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.2
++ 241. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.1
++ 242. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.2
++ 243. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.3
++ 244. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 245. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 246. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 247. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1
++ 248. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.3
++ 249. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.1
++ 250. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 251. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 252. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 253. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1
++ 254. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.2
++ 255. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.2
++ 256. http://www.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/007904975/
++ 257. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1.1
++ 258. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 259. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 260. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 261. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1
++ 262. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.3
++ 263. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.1
++ 264. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 265. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 266. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 267. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.4
++ 268. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.2
++ 269. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 270. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 271. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 272. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 273. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 274. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 275. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.5
++ 276. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.3
++ 277. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 278. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 279. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 280. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 281. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 282. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.6
++ 283. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.4
++ 284. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 285. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuus3.c
++ 286. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 287. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 288. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 289. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 290. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.7
++ 291. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.5
++ 292. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 293. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 294. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 295. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.8
++ 296. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.6
++ 297. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 298. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 299. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 300. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.9
++ 301. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.7
++ 302. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 303. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 304. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 305. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 306. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 307. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 308. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 309. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 310. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.8
++ 311. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 312. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 313. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 314. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9
++ 315. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 316. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 317. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 318. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 319. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x12
++ 320. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 321. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 322. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 323. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 324. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 325. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x13
++ 326. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 327. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 328. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 329. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x14
++ 330. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x12
++ 331. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckubwr.txt
++ 332. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 333. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 334. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 335. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x15
++ 336. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x13
++ 337. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 338. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 339. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x16
++ 340. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x14
++ 341. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html#x4.2
++ 342. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 343. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit2.html
++ 344. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 345. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 346. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x17
++ 347. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x15
++ 348. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++ 349. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security80.html
++ 350. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/cuiksd.html
++ 351. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ca_certs.pem
++ 352. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 353. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 354. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x16
++ 355. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/skermit.html
++ 356. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#top
++ 357. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#contents
++ 358. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 359. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80.html
++ 360. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckubwr.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,5330 @@
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 Unix Hints and Tips
++
++ Frank da Cruz
++ [1]The Kermit Project, [2]Columbia University
++
++ As of: C-Kermit 8.0.211 10 April 2004
++ This page last updated: Fri Apr 16 16:13:14 2004 (New York USA Time)
++
++ IF YOU ARE READING A PLAIN-TEXT version of this document, note it
++ is a plain-text dump of a Web page. You can visit the original (and
++ possibly more up-to-date) Web page here:
++
++ [3]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++
++ Since the material in this file has been accumulating since 1985,
++ some (much) of it might be dated. [4]Feedback from experts on
++ particular OS's and platforms is always welcome.
++
++ [ [5]C-Kermit ] [ [6]Installation Instructions ] [ [7]TUTORIAL ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ CONTENTS
++
++ 1. [8]INTRODUCTION
++ 2. [9]PREBUILT C-KERMIT BINARIES
++ 3. [10]PLATFORM-SPECIFIC NOTES
++ 4. [11]GENERAL UNIX-SPECIFIC LIMITATIONS AND BUGS
++ 5. [12]INITIALIZATION AND COMMAND FILES
++ 6. [13]COMMUNICATION SPEED SELECTION
++ 7. [14]COMMUNICATIONS AND DIALING
++ 8. [15]HARDWARE FLOW CONTROL
++ 9. [16]TERMINAL CONNECTION AND KEY MAPPING
++ 10. [17]FILE TRANSFER
++ 11. [18]EXTERNAL FILE TRANSFER PROTOCOLS
++ 12. [19]SECURITY
++ 13. [20]MISCELLANEOUS USER REPORTS
++ 14. [21]THIRD-PARTY DRIVERS
++
++ Quick Links: [ [22]Linux ] [ [23]*BSD ] [[24]Mac OS X] [ [25]AIX ] [
++ [26]HP-UX ] [ [27]Solaris ] [ [28]SCO ] [ [29]DEC/Compaq ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1. INTRODUCTION
++
++ [ [30]Top ] [ [31]Contents ] [ [32]Next ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 1.1. [33]Documentation
++ 1.2. [34]Technical Support
++ 1.3. [35]The Year 2000
++ 1.4. [36]The Euro
++
++ THIS IS WHAT USED TO BE CALLED the "beware file" for the Unix version
++ of C-Kermit, previously distributed as ckubwr.txt and, before that, as
++ ckuker.bwr, after the fashion of old Digital Equipment Corporation
++ (DEC) software releases that came with release notes (describing what
++ had changed) and a "beware file" listing known bugs, limitations,
++ "non-goals", and things to watch out for. The C-Kermit beware file has
++ been accumulating since 1985, and it applies to many different
++ hardware platforms and operating systems, and many versions of them,
++ so it is quite large. Prior to C-Kermit 8.0, it was distributed only
++ in plain-text format. Now it is available as a Web document with
++ links, internal cross references, and so on, to make it easier to use.
++
++ This document applies to Unix C-Kermit in general, as well as to
++ specific Unix variations like [37]Linux, [38]AIX, [39]HP-UX,
++ [40]Solaris, and so on, and should be read in conjunction with the
++ [41]platform-independent C-Kermit beware file, which contains similar
++ information, but applying to all versions of C-Kermit (VMS, Windows,
++ OS/2, AOS/VS, VOS, etc, as well as to Unix).
++
++ There is much in this document that is (only) of historical interest.
++ The navigation links should help you skip directly to the sections
++ that are relevant to you. Numerous offsite Web links are supposed to
++ lead to further information but, as you know, Web links go stale
++ frequently and without warning. If you can supply additional,
++ corrected, updated, or better Web links, please feel free to [42]let
++ us know.
++
++ 1.1. Documentation
++
++ [ [43]Top ] [ [44]Contents ] [ [45]Next ]
++
++ C-Kermit 6.0 is documented in the book [46]Using C-Kermit, Second
++ Edition, by Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, Digital Press,
++ Burlington, MA, USA, ISBN 1-55558-164-1 (1997), 622 pages. This
++ remains the definitive C-Kermit documentation. Until the third edition
++ is published (sorry, there is no firm timeframe for this), please also
++ refer to:
++
++ [47]Supplement to Using C-Kermit, Second Edition, For C-Kermit 7.0
++ Thorough documentation of features new to version 7.0.
++
++ [48]Supplement to Using C-Kermit, Second Edition, For C-Kermit 8.0
++ Thorough documentation of features new to version 8.0.
++
++ 1.2. Technical Support
++
++ [ [49]Top ] [ [50]Contents ] [ [51]Section Contents ] [ [52]Next ] [
++ [53]Previous ]
++
++ For information on how to get technical support, please visit:
++
++ [54]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/support.html
++
++ 1.3. The Year 2000
++
++ [ [55]Top ] [ [56]Contents ] [ [57]Section Contents ] [ [58]Next ] [
++ [59]Previous ]
++
++ The Unix version of C-Kermit, release 6.0 and later, is "Year 2000
++ compliant", but only if the underlying operating system is too.
++ Contact your Unix operating system vendor to find out which operating
++ system versions, patches, hardware, and/or updates are required.
++ (Quite a few old Unixes are still in operation in the new millenium,
++ but with their date set 28 years in the past so at least the non-year
++ parts of the calendar are correct.)
++
++ As of C-Kermit 6.0 (6 September 1996), post-millenium file dates are
++ recognized, transmitted, received, and reproduced correctly during the
++ file transfer process in C-Kermit's File Attribute packets. If
++ post-millenium dates are not processed correctly on the other end,
++ file transfer still takes place, but the modification or creation date
++ of the received file might be incorrect. The only exception would be
++ if the "file collision update" feature is being used to prevent
++ unnecessary transfer of files that have not changed since the last
++ time a transfer took place; in this case, a file might be transferred
++ unnecessarily, or it might not be transferred when it should have
++ been. Correct operation of the update feature depends on both Kermit
++ programs having the correct date and time.
++
++ Of secondary importance are the time stamps in the transaction and/or
++ debug logs, and the date-related script programming constructs, such
++ as \v(date), \v(ndate), \v(day), \v(nday), and perhaps also the
++ time-related ones, \v(time) and \v(ntime), insofar as they might be
++ affected by the date. The \v(ndate) is a numeric-format date of the
++ form yyyymmdd, suitable for both lexical and numeric comparison and
++ sorting: e.g. 19970208 or 20011231. If the underlying operating system
++ returns the correct date information, these variables will have the
++ proper values. If not, then scripts that make decisions based on these
++ variables might not operate correctly.
++
++ Most date-related code is based upon the C Library asctime() string,
++ which always has a four-digit year. In Unix, the one bit of code in
++ C-Kermit that is an exception to this rule is several calls to
++ localtime(), which returns a pointer to a tm struct, in which the year
++ is presumed to be expressed as "years since 1900". The code depends on
++ this assumption. Any platforms that violate it will need special
++ coding. As of this writing, no such platforms are known.
++
++ Command and script programming functions that deal with dates use
++ C-Kermit specific code that always uses full years.
++
++ 1.4. The Euro
++
++ [ [60]Top ] [ [61]Contents ] [ [62]Section Contents ] [ [63]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 and later support Unicode (ISO 10646), ISO 8859-15 Latin
++ Alphabet 9, PC Code Page 858, Windows Code Pages 1250 and 1251, and
++ perhaps other character sets, that encode the Euro symbol, and can
++ translate among them as long as no intermediate character-set is
++ involved that does not include the Euro.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2. PREBUILT C-KERMIT BINARIES
++
++ [ [64]Top ] [ [65]Contents ] [ [66]Next ] [ [67]Previous ]
++
++ It is often dangerous to run a binary C-Kermit (or any other) program
++ built on a different computer. Particularly if that computer had a
++ different C compiler, libraries, operating system version, processor
++ features, etc, and especially if the program was built with shared
++ libraries, because as soon as you update the libraries on your system,
++ they no longer match the ones referenced in the binary, and the binary
++ might refuse to load when you run it, in which case you'll see error
++ messages similar to:
++
++ Could not load program kermit
++ Member shr4.o not found or file not an archive
++ Could not load library libcurses.a[shr4.o]
++ Error was: No such file or directory
++
++ (These samples are from AIX.) To avoid this problem, we try to build
++ C-Kermit with statically linked libraries whenever we can, but this is
++ increasingly impossible as shared libraries become the norm.
++
++ It is often OK to run a binary built on an earlier OS version, but it
++ is rarely possible (or safe) to run a binary built on a later one, for
++ example to run a binary built under Solaris 8 on Solaris 2.6.
++ Sometimes even the OS-or-library patch/ECO level makes a difference.
++
++ A particularly insidious problem occurs when a binary was built on a
++ version of the OS that has patches from the vendor (e.g. to
++ libraries); in many cases you won't be able to run such a binary on an
++ unpatched version of the same platform.
++
++ When in doubt, build C-Kermit from the source code on the computer
++ where it is to be run (if possible!). If not, ask us for a binary
++ specific to your configuration. We might have one, and if we don't, we
++ might be able to find somebody who will build one for you.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3. NOTES ON SPECIFIC UNIX VERSIONS
++
++ [ [68]Top ] [ [69]Contents ] [ [70]Next ] [ [71]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 3.0. [72]C-KERMIT ON PC-BASED UNIXES
++ 3.1. [73]C-KERMIT AND AIX
++ 3.2. [74]C-KERMIT AND HP-UX
++ 3.3. [75]C-KERMIT AND LINUX
++ 3.4. [76]C-KERMIT AND NEXTSTEP
++ 3.5. [77]C-KERMIT AND QNX
++ 3.6. [78]C-KERMIT AND SCO
++ 3.7. [79]C-KERMIT AND SOLARIS
++ 3.8. [80]C-KERMIT AND SUNOS
++ 3.9. [81]C-KERMIT AND ULTRIX
++ 3.10. [82]C-KERMIT AND UNIXWARE
++ 3.11. [83]C-KERMIT AND APOLLO SR10
++ 3.12. [84]C-KERMIT AND TANDY XENIX 3.0
++ 3.13. [85]C-KERMIT AND OSF/1 (DIGITAL UNIX) (TRU64 UNIX)
++ 3.14. [86]C-KERMIT AND SGI IRIX
++ 3.15. [87]C-KERMIT AND THE BEBOX
++ 3.16. [88]C-KERMIT AND DG/UX
++ 3.17. [89]C-KERMIT AND SEQUENT DYNIX
++ 3.18. [90]C-KERMIT AND {FREE,OPEN,NET}BSD
++ 3.19. [91]C-KERMIT AND MAC OS X
++ 3.20. [92]C-KERMIT AND COHERENT
++
++ The following sections apply to specific Unix versions. Most of them
++ contain references to FAQs (Frequently Asked Questions), but these
++ tend to be ephemeral. For possibly more current information see:
++
++ [93]http://www.faqs.org
++ [94]http://aplawrence.com/Unixart/newtounix.html
++
++ One thread that runs through many of them, and implicitly perhaps
++ through all, concerns the problems that occur when trying to dial out
++ on a serial device that is (also) enabled for dialing in. The
++ "solutions" to this problem are many, varied, diverse, and usually
++ gross, involving configuring the device for bidirectional use. This is
++ done in a highly OS-dependent and often obscure manner, and the
++ effects (good or evil) are also highly dependent on the particular OS
++ (and getty variety, etc). Many examples are given in the
++ [95]OS-specific sections below.
++
++ An important point to keep in mind is that C-Kermit is a
++ cross-platform, portable software program. It was not designed
++ specifically and only for your particular Unix version, or for that
++ matter, for Unix in particular at all. It also runs on VMS, AOS/VS,
++ VOS, and other non-Unix platforms. All the Unix versions of C-Kermit
++ share common i/o modules, with compile-time #ifdef constructions used
++ to account for the differences among the many Unix products and
++ releases. If you think that C-Kermit is behaving badly or missing
++ something on your particular Unix version, you might be right -- we
++ can't claim to be expert in hundreds of different OS / version /
++ hardware / library combinations. If you're a programmer, take a look
++ at the source code and [96]send us your suggested fixes or changes. Or
++ else just [97]send us a report about what seems to be wrong and we'll
++ see what we can do.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.0. C-KERMIT ON PC-BASED UNIXES
++
++ [ [98]Top ] [ [99]Contents ] [ [100]Section Contents ] [ [101]Next ]
++
++ Also see: [102]http://www.pcunix.com/.
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 3.0.1. [103]Interrupt Conflicts
++ 3.0.2. [104]Windows-Specific Hardware
++ 3.0.3. [105]Modems
++ 3.0.4. [106]Character Sets
++ 3.0.5. [107]Keyboard, Screen, and Mouse Access
++ 3.0.6. [108]Laptops
++
++ 3.0.1. Interrupt Conflicts
++
++ [ [109]Top ] [ [110]Contents ] [ [111]Section Contents ] [ [112]Next ]
++
++ PCs are not the best platform for real operating systems like Unix.
++ The architecture suffers from numerous deficiencies, not the least of
++ which is the stiflingly small number of hardware interrupts (either 7
++ or 15, many of which are preallocated). Thus adding devices, using
++ multiple serial ports, etc, is always a challenge and often a
++ nightmare. The free-for-all nature of the PC market and the lack of
++ standards combined with the diversity of Unix OS versions make it
++ difficult to find drivers for any particular device on any particular
++ version of Unix.
++
++ Of special interest to Kermit users is the fact that there is no
++ standard provision in the PC architecture for more than 2
++ communication (serial) ports. COM3 and COM4 (or higher) will not work
++ unless you (a) find out the hardware address and interrupt for each,
++ (b) find out how to provide your Unix version with this information,
++ and (c) actually set up the configuration in the Unix startup files
++ (or whatever other method is used). Watch out for interrupt conflicts,
++ especially when using a serial mouse, and don't expect to be able to
++ use more than two serial ports.
++
++ The techniques for resolving interrupt conflicts are different for
++ each operating system (Linux, NetBSD, etc). In general, there is a
++ configuration file somewhere that lists COM ports, something like
++ this:
++
++ com0 at isa? port 0x3f8 irq 4 # DOS COM1
++ com1 at isa? port 0x2f8 irq 3 # DOS COM2
++
++ The address and IRQ values in this file must agree with the values in
++ the PC BIOS and with the ports themselves, and there must not be more
++ than one device with the same interrupt. Unfortunately, due to the
++ small number of available interrupts, installing new devices on a PC
++ almost always creates a conflict. Here is a typical tale from a Linux
++ user (Fred Smith) about installing a third serial port:
++
++ ...problems can come from a number of causes. The one I fought with
++ for some time, and finally conquered, was that my modem is on an
++ add-in serial port, cua3/IRQ5. By default IRQ5 has a very low
++ priority, and does not get enough service in times when the system
++ is busy to prevent losing data. This in turn causes many resends.
++ There are two 'fixes' that I know of, one is to relax hard disk
++ interrupt hogging by using the correct parameter to hdparm, but I
++ don't like that one because the hdparm man page indicates it is
++ risky to use. The other one, the one I used, was to get 'irqtune'
++ and use it to give IRQ5 the highest priority instead of nearly the
++ lowest. Completely cured the problem.
++
++ Here's another one from a newsgroup posting:
++
++ After much hair pulling, I've discovered why my serial port won't
++ work. Apparently my [PC] has three serial devices (two comm ports
++ and an IR port), of which only two at a time can be active. I
++ looked in the BIOS setup and noticed that the IR port was
++ activated, but didn't realize at the time that this meant that COM2
++ was thereby de-activated. I turned off the IR port and now the
++ serial port works as advertised.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.0.2. Windows-Specific Hardware
++
++ [ [113]Top ] [ [114]Contents ] [ [115]Section Contents ] [ [116]Next ]
++ [ [117]Previous ]
++
++ To complicate matters, the PC platform is becoming increasingly and
++ inexorably Windows-oriented. More and more add-on devices are "Windows
++ only" -- meaning they are incomplete and rely on proprietary
++ Windows-based software drivers to do the jobs that you would expect
++ the device itself to do. PCMCIA, PCI, or "Plug-n-Play" devices are
++ rarely supported on PC-based Unix versions such as SCO; Winmodems,
++ Winprinters, and the like are not supported on any Unix variety (with
++ [118]a few exceptions). The self-proclaimed Microsoft PC 97 (or later)
++ standard only makes matters worse since its only purpose to ensure
++ that PCs are "optimized to run Windows 95 and Windows NT 4.0 and
++ future versions of these operating systems".
++
++ With the exception noted (the Lucent modem, perhaps a handful of
++ others by the time you read this), drivers for "Win" devices are
++ available only for Windows, since the Windows market dwarfs that of
++ any particular Unix brand, and for that matter all Unixes (or for that
++ matter, all non-Windows operating systems) combined. If your version
++ of Unix (SCO, Linux, BSDI, FreeBSD, etc) does not support a particular
++ device, then C-Kermit can't use it either. C-Kermit, like any Unix
++ application, must access all devices through drivers and not directly
++ because Unix is a real operating system.
++
++ Don't waste time thinking that you, or anybody else, could write a
++ Linux (or other Unix) driver for a Winmodem or other "Win" device.
++ First of all, these devices generally require realtime control, but
++ since Unix is a true multitasking operating system, realtime device
++ control is not possible outside the kernel. Second, the specifications
++ for these devices are secret and proprietary, and each one (and each
++ version of each one) is potentially different. Third, a Winmodem
++ driver would be enormously complex; it would take years to write and
++ debug, by which time it would be obsolete.
++
++ A more recent generation of PCs (circa 1999-2000) is marketed as
++ "Legacy Free". One can only speculate what that could mean. Most
++ likely it means it will ONLY run the very latest versions of Windows,
++ and is made exclusively of Winmodems, Winprinters, Winmemory, and
++ Win-CPU-fans (Legacy Free is a concept [119]pioneered by Microsoft).
++
++ Before you buy a new PC or add-on equipment, especially serial ports,
++ internal modems, or printers, make sure they are compatible with your
++ version of Unix. This is becoming an ever-greater challenge; only a
++ huge company like Microsoft can afford to be constantly cranking out
++ and/or verifying drivers for the thousands of video boards, sound
++ cards, network adapters, SCSI adapters, buses, etc, that spew forth in
++ an uncontrolled manner from all corners of the world on a daily basis.
++ With very few exceptions, makers of PCs assemble the various
++ components and then verify them only with Windows, which they must do
++ since they are, no doubt, preloading the PC with Windows. To find a
++ modern PC that is capable of running a variety of non-Windows
++ operating systems (e.g. Linux, SCO OpenServer, Unixware, and Solaris)
++ is a formidable challenge requiring careful study of each vendor's
++ "compatibility lists" and precise attention to exact component model
++ numbers and revision levels.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.0.3. Modems
++
++ [ [120]Top ] [ [121]Contents ] [ [122]Section Contents ] [ [123]Next ]
++ [ [124]Previous ]
++
++ External modems are recommended:
++
++ * They don't need any special drivers.
++ * You can use the lights and speaker to troubleshoot dialing.
++ * You can share them among all types of computers.
++ * You can easily turn them off and on when power-cycling seems
++ warranted.
++ * They are more likely to have manuals.
++
++ Internal PC modems (even when they are not Winmodems, which is
++ increasingly unlikely in new PCs) are always trouble, especially in
++ Unix. Even when they work for dialing out, they might not work for
++ dialing in, etc. Problems that occur when using an internal modem can
++ almost always be eliminated by switching to an external one. Even when
++ an internal modem is not a Winmodem or Plug-n-Play, it is often a
++ no-name model of unknown quality -- not the sort of thing you want
++ sitting directly on your computer's bus. (Even if it does not cause
++ hardware problems, it probably came without a command list, so no Unix
++ software will know how to control it.) For more about Unix compatible
++ modems, see:
++
++ [125]http://www.idir.net/~gromitkc/winmodem.html
++
++ Remember that PCs, even now -- more than two decades after they were
++ first introduced -- are not (in general) capable of supporting more
++ than 2 serial devices. Here's a short success story from a recent
++ newsgroup posting: "I have a Diamond SupraSonic II dual modem in my
++ machine. What I had to end up doing is buying a PS/2 mouse and port
++ and install it. Had to get rid of my serial mouse. I also had to
++ disable PnP in my computer bios. I was having IRQ conflicts between my
++ serial mouse and 'com 3'. Both modems work fine for me. My first modem
++ is ttyS0 and my second is ttyS1." Special third-party multiport boards
++ such as [126]DigiBoard are available for certain Unix platforms
++ (typically SCO, maybe Linux) that come with special platform-specific
++ drivers.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.0.4. Character Sets
++
++ [ [127]Top ] [ [128]Contents ] [ [129]Section Contents ] [ [130]Next ]
++ [ [131]Previous ]
++
++ PCs generally have PC code pages such as CP437 or CP850, and these are
++ often used by PC-based Unix operating systems, particularly on the
++ console. These are supported directly by C-Kermit's SET FILE
++ CHARACTER-SET and SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET commands. Some PC-based
++ Unix versions, such as recent Red Hat Linux releases, might also
++ support Microsoft Windows code pages such as CP1252, or even Latin
++ Alphabet 1 itself (perhaps displayed with CP437 glyphs). (And work is
++ in progress to support Unicode UTF8 in Linux.)
++
++ Certain Windows code pages are not supported directly by C-Kermit, but
++ since they are ISO Latin Alphabets with nonstandard "extensions" in
++ the C1 control range, you can substitute the corresponding Latin
++ alphabet (or other character set) in any C-Kermit character-set
++ related commands:
++
++ Windows Code Page Substitution
++ CP 1004 Latin-1
++ CP 1051 HP Roman-8
++
++ Other Windows code pages are mostly (or totally) incompatible with
++ their Latin Alphabet counterparts (e.g. CP1250 and Latin-2), and
++ several of these are already supported by C-Kermit 7.0 and later
++ (1250, 1251, and 1252).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.0.5. Keyboard, Screen, and Mouse Access
++
++ [ [132]Top ] [ [133]Contents ] [ [134]Section Contents ] [ [135]Next ]
++ [ [136]Previous ]
++
++ Finally, note that as a real operating system, Unix (unlike Windows)
++ does not provide the intimate connection to the PC keyboard, screen,
++ and mouse that you might expect. Unix applications can not "see" the
++ keyboard, and therefore can not be programmed to understand F-keys,
++ Editing keys, Arrow keys, Alt-key combinations, and the like. This is
++ because:
++
++ a. Unix is a portable operating system, not only for PCs;
++ b. Unix sessions can come from anywhere, not just the PC's own
++ keyboard and screen; and:
++ c. even though it might be possible for an application that actually
++ is running on the PC's keyboard and screen to access these devices
++ directly, there are no APIs (outside of X) for this.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.0.6. Laptops
++
++ [ [137]Top ] [ [138]Contents ] [ [139]Section Contents ] [
++ [140]Previous ]
++
++ (To be filled in . . .)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1. C-KERMIT AND AIX
++
++ [ [141]Top ] [ [142]Contents ] [ [143]Section Contents ] [ [144]Next ]
++ [ [145]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 3.1.1. [146]AIX: General
++ 3.1.2. [147]AIX: Network Connections
++ 3.1.3. [148]AIX: Serial Connections
++ 3.1.4. [149]AIX: File Transfer
++ 3.1.5. [150]AIX: Xterm Key Map
++
++ For additional information see:
++ * [151]http://www.emerson.emory.edu/services/aix-faq/
++ * [152]http://www.faqs.org/faqs/by-newsgroup/comp/comp.unix.aix.html
++ * [153]http://www.cis.ohio-state.edu/hypertext/faq/usenet/aix-faq/to
++ p.html
++ * [154]http://aixpdslib.seas.ucla.edu/
++ * [155]http://www.rootvg.net (AIX history)
++ * [156]ftp://rtfm.mit.edu/pub/usenet/news.answers/aix-faq/part1
++ * [157]ftp://mirrors.aol.com/pub/rtfm/usenet-by-hierarchy/comp/unix/
++ aix
++
++ and/or read the [158]comp.unix.aix newsgroup.
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.1. AIX: General
++
++ [ [159]Top ] [ [160]Contents ] [ [161]Section Contents ] [ [162]Next ]
++
++ About AIX version numbers: "uname -a" tells the two-digit version
++ number, such as 3.2 or 4.1. The three-digit form can be seen with the
++ "oslevel" command (this information is unavailable at the API level
++ and is reportedly obtained by scanning the installed patch list).
++ Supposedly all three-digit versions within the same two-digit version
++ (e.g. 4.3.1, 4.3.2) are binary compatible; i.e. a binary built on any
++ one of them should run on all others, but who knows. Most AIX
++ advocates tell you that any AIX binary will run on any AIX version
++ greater than or equal to the one under which it was built, but
++ experience with C-Kermit suggests otherwise. It is always best to run
++ a binary built under your exact same AIX version, down to the third
++ decimal place, if possible. Ideally, build it from source code
++ yourself. Yes, this advice would be easier to follow if AIX came with
++ a C compiler.
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.2. AIX: Network Connections
++
++ [ [163]Top ] [ [164]Contents ] [ [165]Section Contents ] [ [166]Next ]
++ [ [167]Previous ]
++
++ File transfers into AIX 4.2 or 4.3 through the AIX Telnet or Rlogin
++ server have been observed to fail (or accumulate huge numbers of
++ correctable errors, or even disconnect the session), when exactly the
++ same kind of transfers into AIX 4.1 work without incident, as do such
++ transfers into all non-AIX platforms on the same kind of connections
++ (with a few exceptions noted elsewhere in this document). AIX 4.3.3
++ seems to be particularly fragile in this regard; the weakness seems to
++ be in its pseudoterminal (pty) driver. High-speed streaming transfers
++ work perfectly, however, if the AIX Telnet server and pty driver are
++ removed from the picture; e.g, by using "set host * 3000" on AIX.
++
++ The problem can be completely cured by replacing the IBM Telnet server
++ with [168]MIT's Kerberos Telnet server -- even if you don't actually
++ use the Kerberos part. Diagnosis: AIX pseudoterminals (which are
++ controlled by the Telnet server to give you a login terminal for your
++ session) have quirks that not even IBM knows about. The situation with
++ AIX 5.x is not known, but if it has the same problem, the same cure is
++ available.
++
++ Meanwhile, the only remedy when going through the IBM Telnet server is
++ to cut back on Kermit's performance settings until you find a
++ combination that works:
++
++ * SET STREAMING OFF
++ * SET WINDOW-SIZE small-number
++ * SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PACKET-LENGTH small-number
++ * SET PREFIXING { CAUTIOUS, ALL }
++
++ In some cases, severe cutbacks are required, e.g. those implied by the
++ ROBUST command. Also be sure that the AIX C-Kermit on the remote end
++ has "set flow none" (which is the default). NOTE: Maybe this one can
++ also be addressed by starting AIX telnetd with the "-a" option. The
++ situation with SSH connections is not known, but almost certainly the
++ same.
++
++ When these problems occur, the system error log contains:
++
++ LABEL: TTY_TTYHOG
++ IDENTIFIER: 0873CF9F
++ Type: TEMP
++ Resource Name: pts/1
++
++ Description
++ TTYHOG OVER-RUN
++
++ Failure Causes
++ EXCESSIVE LOAD ON PROCESSOR
++
++ Recommended Actions
++ REDUCE SYSTEM LOAD.
++ REDUCE SERIAL PORT BAUD RATE
++
++ Before leaving the topic of AIX pseudoterminals, it is very likely
++ that Kermit's PTY and SSH commands do not work well either, for the
++ same reason that Telnet connections into AIX don't work well. A brief
++ test with "pty rlogin somehost" got a perfectly usable terminal
++ (CONNECT) session, but file-transfer problems like those just
++ described.
++
++ Reportedly, telnet from AIX 4.1-point-something to non-Telnet ports
++ does not work unless the port number is in the /etc/services file;
++ it's not clear from the report whether this is a problem with AIX
++ Telnet (in which case it would not affect Kermit), or with the sockets
++ library (in which case it would). The purported fix is IBM APAR
++ IX61523.
++
++ C-Kermit SET HOST or TELNET from one AIX 3.1 (or earlier) system to
++ another won't work right unless you set your local terminal type to
++ something other than AIXTERM. When your terminal type is AIXTERM, AIX
++ TELNET sends two escapes whenever you type one, and the AIX telnet
++ server swallows one of them. This has something to do with the "hft"
++ device. This behavior seems to be removed in AIX 3.2 and later.
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.3. AIX: Serial Connections
++
++ [ [169]Top ] [ [170]Contents ] [ [171]Section Contents ] [ [172]Next ]
++ [ [173]Previous ]
++
++ In AIX 3, 4, or 5, C-Kermit won't be able to "set line /dev/tty0" (or
++ any other dialout device) if you haven't installed "cu" or "uucp" on
++ your system, because installing these is what creates the UUCP
++ lockfile directory. If SET LINE commands always result in "Sorry,
++ access to lock denied", even when C-Kermit has been given the same
++ owner, group, and permissions as cu:
++
++ -r-sr-xr-x 1 uucp uucp 67216 Jul 27 1999 cu
++
++ and even when you run it as root, then you must go back and install
++ "cu" from your AIX installation media.
++
++ According to IBM's "From Strength to Strength" document (21 April
++ 1998), in AIX 4.2 and later "Async supports speeds on native serial
++ ports up to 115.2kbps". However, no API is documented to achieve
++ serial speeds higher than 38400 bps. Apparently the way to do this --
++ which might or might not work only on the IBM 128-port multiplexer --
++ is:
++
++ cxma-stty fastbaud /dev/tty0
++
++ which, according to "man cxma-stty":
++
++ fastbaud Alters the baud rate table, so 50 baud becomes 57600 baud.
++ -fastbaud Restores the baud rate table, so 57600 baud becomes 50
++ baud.
++
++ Presumably (but not certainly) this extrapolates to 110 "baud" becomes
++ 76800 bps, and 150 becomes 115200 bps. So to use high serial speeds in
++ AIX 4.2 or 4.3, the trick would be to give the "cxma-stty fastbaud"
++ command for the desired tty device before starting Kermit, and then
++ use "set speed 50", "set speed 110", or "set speed 150" to select
++ 56700, 76800, or 115200 bps. It is not known whether cxma-stty
++ requires privilege.
++
++ According to one report, "Further investigation with IBM seems to
++ indicate that the only hardware capable of doing this is the 128-port
++ multiplexor with one (or more) of the 16 port breakout cables
++ (Enhanced Remote Async Node 16-Port EIA-232). We are looking at about
++ CDN$4,000 in hardware just to hang a 56kb modem on there. Of course,
++ we can then hang 15 more, if we want. This hardware combo is described
++ to be good to 230.4kbps."
++
++ Another report says (quote from AIX newsgroup, March 1999):
++
++ The machine type and the adapter determine the speed that one can
++ actually run at. The older microchannel machines have much slower
++ crystal frequencies and may not go beyond 76,800. A feature put
++ into AIX 421 allows one to key in non-POSIX baud rates and if the
++ uart can support that speed, it will get set. this applies also to
++ 43p's and beyond. 115200 is the max for the 43P's native serial
++ port. As crytal frequencies continue to increase, the built-in
++ serial ports speeds will improve. To use 'uucp' or 'ate' at the
++ higher baud rates, configure the port for the desired speed, but
++ set the speed of uucp or ate to 50. Any non-POSIX speeds set in the
++ ttys configuration will the be used. In the case of the 128-port
++ adapters or the ISA 8-port or PCI 8-port adapter, there are only a
++ few higher baud rates.
++
++ a. Change the port to enable high baud rates:
++ + B50 for 57600
++ + B75 for 76800
++ + B110 for 115200
++ + B200 for 230000
++ b. chdev -l ttyX -a fastbaud=enable
++ + For the 128 ports original style rans, only 57600 bps is
++ supported.
++ + For the new enhanced RANs, up to 230Kbps is supported.
++
++ In AIX 2.2.1 on the RT PC with the 8-port multiplexer, SET SPEED 38400
++ gives 9600 bps, but SET SPEED 19200 gives 19200 (on the built-in S1
++ port).
++
++ Note that some RS/6000s (e.g. the IBM PowerServer 320) have
++ nonstandard rectangular 10-pin serial ports; the DB-25 connector is
++ NOT a serial port; it is a parallel printer port. IBM cables are
++ required for the serial ports, (The IBM RT PC also had rectangular
++ serial ports -- perhaps the same as these, perhaps different.)
++
++ If you dial in to AIX through a modem that is connected directly to an
++ AIX port (e.g. on the 128-port multiplexer) and find that data is
++ lost, especially when uploading files to the AIX system (and system
++ error logs report buffer overruns on the port):
++
++ 1. Make sure the port and modem are BOTH configured for hardware
++ (RTS/CTS) flow control. The port is configured somewhere in the
++ system configuration, outside of Kermit.
++ 2. Tell C-Kermit to "set flow keep"; experimentation shows that SET
++ FLOW RTS/CTS has no effect when used in remote mode (i.e. on
++ /dev/tty, as opposed to a specify port device).
++ 3. Fixes for bugs in the original AIX 4.2 tty (serial i/o) support
++ and other AIX bugs are available from IBM at:
++ [174]http://service.software.ibm.com/rs6000/
++ Downloads -> Software Fixes -> Download FixDist gets an
++ application for looking up known problems.
++
++ Many problems reported with bidirectional terminal lines on AIX 3.2.x
++ on the RS/6000. Workaround: don't use bidirectional terminal lines, or
++ write a shell-script wrapper for Kermit that turns getty off on the
++ line before starting Kermit, or before Kermit attempts to do the SET
++ LINE. (But note: These problems MIGHT be fixed in C-Kermit 6.0 and
++ later.) The commands for turning getty off and on (respectively) are
++ /usr/sbin/pdisable and /usr/sbin/penable.
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.4. AIX: File Transfer
++
++ [ [175]Top ] [ [176]Contents ] [ [177]Section Contents ] [ [178]Next ]
++ [ [179]Previous ]
++
++ Evidently AIX 4.3 (I don't know about earlier versions) does not allow
++ open files to be overwritten. This can cause Kermit transfers to fail
++ when FILE COLLISION is OVERWRITE, where they might work on other Unix
++ varieties or earlier AIX versions.
++
++ Transfer of binary -- and maybe even text -- files can fail in AIX if
++ the AIX terminal has particular port can have character-set
++ translation done for it by the tty driver. The following advice from a
++ knowledgeable AIX user:
++
++ [This feature] has to be checked (and set/cleared) with a separate
++ command, unfortunately stty doesn't handle this. To check:
++
++ $ setmaps
++ input map: none installed
++ output map: none installed
++
++ If it says anything other than "none installed" for either one, it
++ is likely to cause a problem with kermit. To get rid of installed
++ maps:
++
++ $ setmaps -t NOMAP
++
++ However, I seem to recall that with some versions of AIX before
++ 3.2.5, only root could change the setting. I'm not sure what
++ versions - it might have only been under AIX 3.1 that this was
++ true. At least with AIX 3.2.5 an ordinary user can set or clear the
++ maps.
++
++ On the same problem, another knowledgeable AIX user says:
++
++ The way to get information on the NLS mapping under AIX (3.2.5
++ anyway) is as follows. From the command line type:
++
++ lsattr -l tty# -a imap -a omap -E -H
++
++ Replace the tty number for the number sign above. This will give a
++ human readable output of the settings that looks like this;
++
++ # lsattr -l tty2 -a imap -a omap -E -H
++ attribute value description user_settable
++
++ imap none INPUT map file True
++ omap none OUTPUT map file True
++
++ If you change the -H to a -O, you get output that can easily be
++ processed by another program or a shell script, for example:
++
++ # lsattr -l tty2 -a imap -a omap -E -O
++ #imap:omap
++ none:none
++
++ To change the settings from the command line, the chdev command is
++ used with the following syntax.
++
++ chdev -l tty# -a imap='none' -a omap='none'
++
++ Again substituting the appropriate tty port number for the number
++ sign, "none" being the value we want for C-Kermit. Of course, the
++ above can also be changed by using the SMIT utility and selecting
++ devices - tty. (...end quote)
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.5. AIX: Xterm Key Map
++
++ [ [180]Top ] [ [181]Contents ] [ [182]Section Contents ] [
++ [183]Previous ]
++
++ Here is a sample configuration for setting up an xterm keyboard for
++ VT220 or higher terminal emulation on AIX, courtesy of Bruce Momjian,
++ Drexel Hill, PA. Xterm can be started like this:
++
++ xterm $XTERMFLAGS +rw +sb +ls $@ -tm 'erase ^? intr ^c' -name vt220 \
++ -title vt220 -tn xterm-220 "$@" &
++
++---------------------------------------------------------------------------
++ XTerm*VT100.Translations: #override \n\
++ <Key>Home: string(0x1b) string("[3~") \n \
++ <Key>End: string(0x1b) string("[4~") \n
++ vt220*VT100.Translations: #override \n\
++ Shift <Key>F1: string("[23~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F2: string("[24~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F3: string("[25~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F4: string("[26~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F5: string("[K~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F6: string("[31~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F7: string("[31~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F8: string("[32~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F9: string("[33~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F10: string("[34~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F11: string("[28~") \n \
++ Shift <Key>F12: string("[29~") \n \
++ <Key>Print: string(0x1b) string("[32~") \n\
++ <Key>Cancel: string(0x1b) string("[33~") \n\
++ <Key>Pause: string(0x1b) string("[34~") \n\
++ <Key>Insert: string(0x1b) string("[2~") \n\
++ <Key>Delete: string(0x1b) string("[3~") \n\
++ <Key>Home: string(0x1b) string("[1~") \n\
++ <Key>End: string(0x1b) string("[4~") \n\
++ <Key>Prior: string(0x1b) string("[5~") \n\
++ <Key>Next: string(0x1b) string("[6~") \n\
++ <Key>BackSpace: string(0x7f) \n\
++ <Key>Num_Lock: string(0x1b) string("OP") \n\
++ <Key>KP_Divide: string(0x1b) string("Ol") \n\
++ <Key>KP_Multiply: string(0x1b) string("Om") \n\
++ <Key>KP_Subtract: string(0x1b) string("OS") \n\
++ <Key>KP_Add: string(0x1b) string("OM") \n\
++ <Key>KP_Enter: string(0x1b) string("OM") \n\
++ <Key>KP_Decimal: string(0x1b) string("On") \n\
++ <Key>KP_0: string(0x1b) string("Op") \n\
++ <Key>KP_1: string(0x1b) string("Oq") \n\
++ <Key>KP_2: string(0x1b) string("Or") \n\
++ <Key>KP_3: string(0x1b) string("Os") \n\
++ <Key>KP_4: string(0x1b) string("Ot") \n\
++ <Key>KP_5: string(0x1b) string("Ou") \n\
++ <Key>KP_6: string(0x1b) string("Ov") \n\
++ <Key>KP_7: string(0x1b) string("Ow") \n\
++ <Key>KP_8: string(0x1b) string("Ox") \n\
++ <Key>KP_9: string(0x1b) string("Oy") \n
++
++ ! <Key>Up: string(0x1b) string("[A") \n\
++ ! <Key>Down: string(0x1b) string("[B") \n\
++ ! <Key>Right: string(0x1b) string("[C") \n\
++ ! <Key>Left: string(0x1b) string("[D") \n\
++
++ *visualBell: true
++ *saveLines: 1000
++ *cursesemul: true
++ *scrollKey: true
++ *scrollBar: true
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2. C-KERMIT AND HP-UX
++
++ [ [184]Top ] [ [185]Contents ] [ [186]Section Contents ] [ [187]Next ]
++ [ [188]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 3.2.0. [189]Common Problems
++ 3.2.1. [190]Building C-Kermit on HP-UX
++ 3.2.2. [191]File Transfer
++ 3.2.3. [192]Dialing Out and UUCP Lockfiles in HP-UX
++ 3.2.4. [193]Notes on Specific HP-UX Releases
++ 3.2.5. [194]HP-UX and X.25
++
++ REFERENCES
++
++ For further information, read the [195]comp.sys.hp.hpux newsgroup.
++
++ C-Kermit is included as part of the HP-UX operating system by contract
++ between Hewlett Packard and Columbia University for HP-UX 10.00 and
++ later. Each level of HP-UX includes a freshly built C-Kermit binary in
++ /bin/kermit, which should work correctly. Binaries built for regular
++ HP-UX may be used on Trusted HP-UX and vice-versa, except for use as
++ IKSD because of the different authentication methods.
++
++ Note that HP does not update C-Kermit versions for any but its most
++ current HP-UX release. So, for example, HP-UX 10.20 has C-Kermit 6.0;
++ 11.00 has C-Kermit 7.0, and 11.22 has 8.0. Of course, as with all
++ software, older Kermit versions have bugs (such as buffer overflow
++ vulnerabilities) that are fixed in later versions. From time to time,
++ HP discovers one of these (long-ago fixed) bugs and issues a security
++ alert for the older OS's, recommending some draconian measure to avoid
++ the problem. The true fix in each situation is to install the current
++ release of C-Kermit.
++
++ 3.2.0. Common Problems
++
++ [ [196]Top ] [ [197]Contents ] [ [198]Section Contents ] [ [199]Next ]
++
++ Some HP workstations have a BREAK/RESET key. If you hit this key while
++ C-Kermit is running, it might kill or suspend the C-Kermit process.
++ C-Kermit arms itself against these signals, but evidently the
++ BREAK/RESET key is -- at least in some circumstances, on certain HP-UX
++ versions -- too powerful to be caught. (Some report that the first
++ BREAK/RESET shows up as SIGINT and is caught by C-Kermit's former
++ SIGINT handler even when SIGINT is currently set to SIG_IGN; the
++ second kills Kermit; other reports suggest the first BREAK/RESET sends
++ a SIGTSTP (suspend signal) to Kermit, which it catches and suspends
++ itself. You can tell C-Kermit to ignore suspend signals with SET
++ SUSPEND OFF. You can tell C-Kermit to ignore SIGINT with SET COMMAND
++ INTERRUPTION OFF. It is not known whether these commands also grant
++ immunity to the BREAK/RESET key (one report states that with SET
++ SUSPEND OFF, the BREAK/RESET key is ignored the first four times, but
++ kills Kermit the 5th time). In any case:
++
++ 1. If this key is mapped to SIGINT or SIGTSTP, C-Kermit catches or
++ ignores it, depending on which mode (CONNECT, command, etc) Kermit
++ is in.
++ 2. If it causes HP-UX to kill C-Kermit, there is nothing C-Kermit can
++ do to prevent it.
++
++ When HP-UX is on the remote end of the connection, it is essential
++ that HP-UX C-Kermit be configured for Xon/Xoff flow control (this is
++ the default, but in case you change it and then experience
++ file-transfer failures, this is a likely reason).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.1. Building C-Kermit on HP-UX
++
++ [ [200]Top ] [ [201]Contents ] [ [202]Section Contents ] [ [203]Next ]
++ [ [204]Previous ]
++
++ This section applies mainly to old (pre-10.20) HP-UX version on
++ old, slow, and/or memory-constrained hardware.
++
++ During the C-Kermit 6.0 Beta cycle, something happened to ckcpro.w
++ (or, more precisely, the ckcpro.c file that is generated from it)
++ which causes HP optimizing compilers under HP-UX versions 7.0 and 8.0
++ (apparently on all platforms) as well as under HP-UX 9.0 on Motorola
++ platforms only, to blow up. In versions 7.0 and 8.0 the problem has
++ spread to other modules.
++
++ The symptoms vary from the system grinding to a halt, to the compiler
++ crashing, to the compilation of the ckcpro.c module taking very long
++ periods of time, like 9 hours. This problem is handled by compiling
++ the modules that tickle it without optimization; the new C-Kermit
++ makefile takes care of this, and shows how to do it in case the same
++ thing begins happening with other modules.
++
++ On HP-UX 9.0, a kernel parameter, maxdsiz (maximum process data
++ segment size), seems to be important. On Motorola systems, it is 16MB
++ by default, whereas on RISC systems the default is much bigger.
++ Increasing maxdsiz to about 80MB seems to make the problem go away,
++ but only if the system also has a lot of physical memory -- otherwise
++ it swaps itself to death.
++
++ The optimizing compiler might complain about "some optimizations
++ skipped" on certain modules, due to lack of space available to the
++ optimizer. You can increase the space (the incantation depends on the
++ particular compiler version -- see the [205]makefile), but doing so
++ tends to make the compilations take a much longer time. For example,
++ the "hpux0100o+" makefile target adds the "+Onolimit" compiler flag,
++ and about an hour to the compile time on an HP-9000/730. But it *does*
++ produce an executable that is about 10K smaller :-)
++
++ In the makefile, all HP-UX entries automatically skip optimization of
++ problematic modules.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.2. File Transfer
++
++ [ [206]Top ] [ [207]Contents ] [ [208]Section Contents ] [ [209]Next ]
++ [ [210]Previous ]
++
++ Telnet connections into HP-UX versions up to and including 11.11 (and
++ possibly 11.20) tend not to lend themselves to file transfer due to
++ limitations, restrictions, and/or bugs in the HP-UX Telnet server
++ and/or pseudoterminal (pty) driver.
++
++ In C-Kermit 6.0 (1996) an unexpected slowness was noted when
++ transferring files over local Ethernet connections when an HP-UX
++ system (9.05 or 10.00) was on the remote end. The following experiment
++ was conducted to determine the cause. C-Kermit 6.0 was used; the
++ situation is slightly better using C-Kermit 7.0's streaming feature
++ and HP-UX 10.20 on the far end.
++
++ The systems were HP-UX 10.00 (on 715/33) and SunOS 4.1.3 (on
++ Sparc-20), both on the same local 10Mbps Ethernet, packet length 4096,
++ parity none, control prefixing "cautious", using only local disks on
++ each machine -- no NFS. In the C-Kermit 6.0 (ACK/NAK) case, the window
++ size was 20; in the streaming case there is no window size (i.e. it is
++ infinite). The test file was C-Kermit executable, transferred in
++ binary mode. Conditions were relatively poor: the Sun and the local
++ net heavily loaded; the HP system is old, slow, and
++ memory-constrained.
++
++ C-Kermit 6.0... C-Kermit 7.0...
++ Local Remote ACK/NAK........ Streaming......
++ Client Server Send Receive Send Receive
++ Sun HP 36 18 64 18
++ HP HP 25 15 37 16
++ HP Sun 77 83 118 92
++ Sun Sun 60 60 153 158
++
++ So whenever HP is the remote we have poor performance. Why?
++
++ * Changing file display to CRT has no effect (so it's not the curses
++ library on the client side).
++ * Changing TCP RECV-BUFFER or SEND-BUFFER has little effect.
++ * Telling the client to make a binary-mode connection (SET TELNET
++ BINARY REQUESTED, which successfully negotiates a binary
++ connection) has no effect on throughput.
++
++ BUT... If I start HP-UX C-Kermit as a TCP service:
++
++ set host * 3000
++ server
++
++ and then from the client "set host xxx 3000", I get:
++
++ C-Kermit 6.0... C-Kermit 7.0...
++ Local Remote ACK/NAK........ Streaming......
++ Client Server Send Receive Send Receive
++ Sun HP 77 67 106 139
++ HP HP 50 50 64 62
++ HP Sun 57 85 155 105
++ Sun Sun 57 50 321 314
++
++ Therefore the HP-UX telnet server or pty driver seems to be adding
++ more overhead than the SunOS one, and most others. When going through
++ this type of connection (a remote telnet server) there is little
++ Kermit can do improve matters, since the telnet server and pty driver
++ are between the two Kermits, and neither Kermit program can have any
++ influence over them (except putting the Telnet connection in binary
++ mode, but that doesn't help).
++
++ (The numbers for the HP-HP transfers are lower than the others since
++ both Kermit processes are running on the same slow 33MHz CPU.)
++
++ Matters seem to have deteriorated in HP-UX 11. Now file transfers over
++ Telnet connections fail completely, rather than just being slow. In
++ the following trial, a Telnet connection was made from Kermit 95 to
++ HP-UX 11.11 on an HP-9000/785/B2000 over local 10Mbps Ethernet running
++ C-Kermit 8.00 in server mode (under the HP-UX Telnet server):
++
++ Text........ Binary......
++ Stream Pktlen GET SEND GET SEND
++ On 4000 Fail Fail Fail Fail
++ Off 4000 Fail Fail Fail Fail
++ Off 2000 OK Fail OK Fail
++ On 2000 OK Fail OK Fail
++ On 3000 Fail Fail Fail Fail
++ On 2500 Fail Fail Fail Fail
++ On 2047 OK Fail OK Fail
++ On 2045 OK Fail OK Fail
++ Off 500 OK OK OK OK
++ On 500 OK Fail OK Fail
++ On 240 OK Fail OK Fail
++
++ As you can see, downloads are problematic unless the receiver's Kermit
++ packet length is 2045 or less, but uploads work only with streaming
++ disabled and the packet length restricted to 500. To force file
++ transfers to work on this connection, the desktop Kermit must be told
++ to:
++
++ set streaming off
++ set receive packet-length 2000
++ set send packet-length 500
++
++ However, if a connection is made between the same two programs on the
++ same two computers over the same network, but this time a direct
++ socket-to-socket connection bypassing the HP-UX Telnet server and pty
++ driver (tell HP-UX C-Kermit to "set host /server * 3000 /raw"; tell
++ desktop client program to "set host blah 3000 /raw"), everything works
++ perfectly with the default Kermit settings (streaming, 4K packets,
++ liberal control-character unprefixing, 8-bit transparency, etc):
++
++ Text........ Binary......
++ Stream Pktlen GET SEND GET SEND
++ On 4000 OK OK OK OK
++
++ And in this case, transfer rates were approximately 900,000 cps. To
++ verify that the behavior reported here is not caused by the new Kermit
++ release, the same experiment was performed on a Telnet connection from
++ the same PC over the same network to the old 715/33 running HP-UX
++ 10.20 and C-Kermit 8.00. Text and binary uploads and downloads worked
++ perfectly (albeit slowly) with all the default settings -- streaming,
++ 4K packets, etc.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.3. Dialing Out and UUCP Lockfiles in HP-UX
++
++ [ [211]Top ] [ [212]Contents ] [ [213]Section Contents ] [ [214]Next ]
++ [ [215]Previous ]
++
++ HP workstations do not come with dialout devices configured; you have
++ to do it yourself (as root). First look in /dev to see what's there;
++ for example in HP-UX 10.00 or later:
++
++ ls -l /dev/cua*
++ ls -l /dev/tty*
++
++ If you find a tty0p0 device but no cua0p0, you'll need to creat one if
++ you want to dial out; the tty0p0 does not work for dialing out. It's
++ easy: start SAM; in the main Sam window, double-click on Peripheral
++ Device, then in the Peripheral Devices window, double-click on
++ Terminals and Modems. In the Terminals and Modems dialog, click on
++ Actions, then choose "Add modem" and fill in the blanks. For example:
++ Port number 0, speed 57600 (higher speeds tend not to work reliably),
++ "Use device for calling out", do NOT "Receive incoming calls" (unless
++ you know what you are doing), leave "CCITT modem" unchecked unless you
++ really have one, and do select "Use hardware flow control (RTS/CTS)".
++ Then click OK. This creates cua0p0 as well as cul0p0 and ttyd0p0
++
++ If the following sequence:
++
++ set line /dev/cua0p0 ; or other device
++ set speed 115200 ; or other normal speed
++
++ produces the message "?Unsupported line speed". This means either that
++ the port is not configured for dialout (go into SAM as described above
++ and make sure "Use device for calling out" is selected), or else that
++ speed you have given (such as 460800) is supported by the operating
++ system but not by the physical device (in which case, use a lower
++ speed like 57600).
++
++ In HP-UX 9.0, serial device names began to change. The older names
++ looked like "/dev/cua00", "/dev/tty01", etc (sometimes with only one
++ digit). The newer names have two digits with the letter "p" in
++ between. HP-UX 8.xx and earlier have the older form, HP-UX 10.00 and
++ later have the newer form. HP-UX 9.xx has the newer form on Series 800
++ machines, and the older form on other hardware models. The situation
++ is summarized in the following table (the Convio 10.0 column applies
++ to HP-UX 10 and 11).
++
++ Converged HP-UX Serial I/O Filenames : TTY Mux Naming
++ ---------------------------------------------------------------------
++ General meaning Old Form S800 9.0 Convio 10.0
++ ---------------------------------------------------------------------
++ tty* hardwired ports tty<YY> tty<X>p<Y> tty<D>p<p>
++ diag:mux<X> diag:mux<D>
++ ---------------------------------------------------------------------
++ ttyd* dial-in modems ttyd<YY> ttyd<X>p<Y> ttyd<D>p<p>
++ diag:ttyd<X>p<Y> diag:ttyd<D>p<p>
++ ---------------------------------------------------------------------
++ cua* auto-dial out cua<YY> cua<X>p<Y> cua<D>p<p>
++ diag:cua<X>p<Y>
++ ---------------------------------------------------------------------
++ cul* dial-out cul<YY> cul<X>p<Y> cul<D>p<p>
++ diag:cul<X>p<Y>
++ ---------------------------------------------------------------------
++ <X>= LU (Logical Unit) <D>= Devspec (decimal card instance)
++ <Y> or <YY> = Port <p>= Port
++
++ For dialing out, you should use the cua or cul devices. When
++ C-Kermit's CARRIER setting is AUTO or ON, C-Kermit should pop back to
++ its prompt automatically if the carrier signal drops, e.g. when you
++ log out from the remote computer or service. If you use the tty<D>p<d>
++ (e.g. tty0p0) device, the carrier signal should be ignored. The
++ tty<D>p<d> device should be used for direct connections where the
++ carrier signal does not follow RS-232 conventions (use the cul device
++ for hardwired connections through a true null modem). Do not use the
++ ttyd<D>p<d> device for dialing out.
++
++ Kermit's access to serial devices is controlled by "UUCP lockfiles",
++ which are intended to prevent different users using different software
++ programs (Kermit, cu, etc, and UUCP itself) from accessing the same
++ serial device at the same time. When a device is in use by a
++ particular user, a file with a special name is created in:
++
++ /var/spool/locks (HP-UX 10.00 and later)
++ /usr/spool/uucp (HP-UX 9.xx and earlier)
++
++ The file's name indicates the device that is in use, and its contents
++ indicates the process ID (pid) of the process that is using the
++ device. Since serial devices and the locks directory are not both
++ publicly readable and writable, Kermit and other communication
++ software must be installed setuid to the owner (bin) of the serial
++ device and setgid to the group (daemon) of the /var/spool/locks
++ directory. Kermit's setuid and setgid privileges are enabled only when
++ opening the device and accessing the lockfiles.
++
++ Let's say "unit" means a string of decimal digits (the interface
++ instance number) followed (in HP-UX 10.00 and later) by the letter "p"
++ (lowercase), followed by another string of decimal digits (the port
++ number on the interface), e.g.:
++
++ "0p0", "0p1", "1p0", etc (HP-UX 10.00 and later)
++ "0p0", "0p1", "1p0", etc (HP-UX 9.xx on Series 800)
++ "00", "01", "10", "0", etc (HP-UX 9.xx not on Series 800)
++ "00", "01", "10", "0", etc (HP-UX 8.xx and earlier)
++
++ Then a normal serial device (driver) name consists of a prefix ("tty",
++ "ttyd", "cua", "cul", or possibly "cuad" or "culd") followed by a
++ unit, e.g. "cua0p0". Kermit's treatment of UUCP lockfiles is as close
++ as possible to that of the HP-UX "cu" program. Here is a table of the
++ lockfiles that Kermit creates for unit 0p0:
++
++ Selection Lockfile 1 Lockfile 2
++ /dev/tty0p0 LCK..tty0p0 (none)
++* /dev/ttyd0p0 LCK..ttyd0p0 (none)
++ /dev/cua0p0 LCK..cua0p0 LCK..ttyd0p0
++ /dev/cul0p0 LCK..cul0p0 LCK..ttyd0p0
++ /dev/cuad0p0 LCK..cuad0p0 LCK..ttyd0p0
++ /dev/culd0p0 LCK..culd0p0 LCK..ttyd0p0
++ <other> LCK..<other> (none)
++
++ (* = Dialin device, should not be used.)
++
++ In other words, if the device name begins with "cu", a second lockfile
++ for the "ttyd" device, same unit, is created, which should prevent
++ dialin access on that device.
++
++ The <other> case allows for symbolic links, etc, but of course it is
++ not foolproof since we have no way of telling which device is really
++ being used.
++
++ When C-Kermit tries to open a dialout device whose name ends with a
++ "unit", it searches the lockfile directory for all possible names for
++ the same unit. For example, if user selects /dev/cul2p3, Kermit looks
++ for lockfiles named:
++
++ LCK..tty2p3
++ LCK..ttyd2p3
++ LCK..cua2p3
++ LCK..cul2p3
++ LCK..cuad2p3
++ LCK..culd2p3
++
++ If any of these files are found, Kermit opens them to find out the ID
++ (pid) of the process that created them; if the pid is still valid, the
++ process is still active, and so the SET LINE command fails and the
++ user is informed of the pid so s/he can use "ps" to find out who is
++ using the device.
++
++ If the pid is not valid, the file is deleted. If all such files (i.e.
++ with same "unit" designation) are successfully removed, then the SET
++ LINE command succeeds; up to six messages are printed telling the user
++ which "stale lockfiles" are being removed.
++
++ When the "set line" command succeeds in HP-UX 10.00 and later,
++ C-Kermit also creates a Unix System V R4 "advisory lock" as a further
++ precaution (but not guarantee) against any other process obtaining
++ access to the device while you are using it.
++
++ If the selected device was in use by "cu", Kermit can't open it,
++ because "cu" has changed its ownership, so we never get as far as
++ looking at the lockfiles. In the normal case, we can't even look at
++ the device to see who the owner is because it is visible only to its
++ (present) owner. In this case, Kermit says (for example):
++
++ /dev/cua0p0: Permission denied
++
++ When Kermit releases a device it has successfully opened, it removes
++ all the lockfiles that it created. This also happens whenever Kermit
++ exits "under its own power".
++
++ If Kermit is killed with a device open, the lockfile(s) are left
++ behind. The next Kermit program that tries to assign the device, under
++ any of its various names, will automatically clean up the stale
++ lockfiles because the pids they contain are invalid. The behavior of
++ cu and other communication programs under these conditions should be
++ the same.
++
++ Here, by the way, is a summary of the differences between the HP-UX
++ port driver types from John Pezzano of HP:
++
++ There are three types of device files for each port.
++
++ The ttydXXX device file is designed to work as follows:
++
++ 1. The process that opens it does NOT get control of the port until
++ CD is asserted. This was intentional (over 15 years ago) to allow
++ getty to open the port but not control it until someone called in.
++ If a process wants to use the direct or callout device files
++ (ttyXXX and culXXX respectively), they will then get control and
++ getty would be blocked. This eliminated the need to use uugetty
++ (and its inherent problems with lock files) for modems. You can
++ see this demonstrated by the fact that "ps -ef" shows a ? in the
++ tty column for the getty process as getty does not have the port
++ yet.
++ 2. Once CD is asserted, the port is controlled by getty (or the
++ process handling an incoming call) if there was no process using
++ the port. The ? in the "ps" command now shows the port. At this
++ point, the port accepts data.
++
++ Therefore you should use either the callout culXXX device file
++ (immediate control but no data until CD is asserted) or the direct
++ device file ttyXXX which gives immediate control and immediate data
++ and which ignores by default modem control signals.
++
++ The ttydXXX device should be used only for callin and my
++ recommendation is to use it only for getty and uugetty.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.4 Notes on Specific HP-UX Releases
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 3.2.4.1. [216]HP-UX 11
++ 3.2.4.2. [217]HP-UX 10
++ 3.2.4.3. [218]HP-UX 9
++ 3.2.4.4. [219]HP-UX 8
++ 3.2.4.5. [220]HP-UX 7 and Earlier
++
++ 3.2.4.1. HP-UX 11
++
++ [ [221]Top ] [ [222]Contents ] [ [223]Section Contents ] [ [224]Next ]
++
++ As noted in [225]Section 3.2.2, the HP-UX 11 Telnet server and/or
++ pseudoterminal driver are a serious impediment to file transfer over
++ Telnet connections into HP-UX. If you have a Telnet connection into
++ HP-UX 11, tell your desktop Kermit program to:
++
++ set streaming off
++ set receive packet-length 2000
++ set send packet-length 500
++
++ File transfer speeds over connections from HP-UX 11 (dialed or Telnet)
++ are not impeded whatsoever, and can go at whatever speed is allowed by
++ the connection and the Kermit partner on the far end.
++
++ PA-RISC binaries for HP-UX 10.20 or later should run on any PA-RISC
++ system, S700 or S800, as long as the binary was not built under a
++ later HP-UX version than the host operating system. HP-UX 11.00 and
++ 11.11 are only for PA-RISC systems. HP-UX 11.20 is only for IA64
++ (subsequent HP-UX releases will be for both PA-RISC and IA64). To
++ check binary compatibility, the following C-Kermit 8.0 binaries were
++ run successfully on an HP-9000/785 with HP-UX 11.11:
++
++ * Model 7xx HP-UX 10.20
++ * Model 8xx HP-UX 10.20
++ * Model 7xx HP-UX 11.00
++ * Model 8xx HP-UX 11.00
++ * Model 7xx HP-UX 11.11
++ * Model 8xx HP-UX 11.11
++
++ Binaries built under some of the earlier HP-UX releases, such as 9.05,
++ might also work, but only if built for the same hardware family (e.g.
++ s700).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.4.2. HP-UX 10
++
++ [ [226]Top ] [ [227]Contents ] [ [228]Section Contents ] [ [229]Next ]
++ [ [230]Previous ]
++
++ Beginning in HP-UX 10.10, libcurses is linked to libxcurses, the new
++ UNIX95 (X/Open) version of curses, which has some serious bugs; some
++ routines, when called, would hang and never return, some would dump
++ core. Evidently libxcurses contains a select() routine, and whenever
++ C-Kermit calls what it thinks is the regular (sockets) select(), it
++ gets the curses one, causing a segmentation fault. There is a patch
++ for this from HP, PHCO_8086, "s700_800 10.10 libcurses patch", "shared
++ lib curses program hangs on 10.10", "10.10 enhanced X/Open curses core
++ dumps due to using wrong select call", 96/08/02 (you can tell if the
++ patch is installed with "what /usr/lib/libxcurses.1"; the unpatched
++ version is 76.20, the patched one is 76.20.1.2). It has been verified
++ that C-Kermit works OK with the patched library, but results are not
++ definite for HP-UX 10.20 or higher.
++
++ To ensure that C-Kermit works even on non-patched HP-UX 10.10 systems,
++ separate makefile entries are provided for HP-UX 10.00/10.01, 10.10,
++ 10.20, etc, in which the entries for 10.10 and above link with
++ libHcurses, which is "HP curses", the one that was used in
++ 10.00/10.01. HP-UX 11.20 and later, however, link with libcurses, as
++ libHcurses disappeared in 11.20.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.4.3. HP-UX 9
++
++ [ [231]Top ] [ [232]Contents ] [ [233]Section Contents ] [ [234]Next ]
++ [ [235]Previous ]
++
++ HP-UX 9.00 and 9.01 need patch PHNE_10572 (note: this replaces
++ PHNE_3641) for hptt0.o, asio0.o, and ttycomn.o in libhp-ux.a. Contact
++ Hewlett Packard if you need this patch. Without it, the dialout device
++ (tty) will be hung after first use; subsequent attempts to use will
++ return an error like "device busy". (There are also equivalent patches
++ for s700 9.03 9.05 9.07 (PHNE_10573) and s800 9.00 9.04 (PHNE_10416).
++
++ When C-Kermit is in server mode, it might have trouble executing
++ REMOTE HOST commands. This problem happens under HP-UX 9.00 (Motorola)
++ and HP-UX 9.01 (RISC) IF the C-Shell is the login shell AND with the
++ C-Shell Revision 70.15. Best thing is to install HP's Patch PHCO_4919
++ for Series 300/400 and PHCO_5015 for the Series 700/800. PHCO_5015 is
++ called "s700_800 9.X cumulative csh(1) patch with memory leak fix"
++ which works for HP-UX 9.00, 9.01, 9.03, 9.04, 9.05 and 9.07. At least
++ you need C-Shell Revision 72.12!
++
++ C-Kermit works fine -- including its curses-based file-transfer
++ display -- on the console terminal, in a remote session (e.g. when
++ logged in to the HP 9000 on a terminal port or when telnetted or
++ rlogin'd), and in an HP-VUE hpterm window or an xterm window.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.4.4. HP-UX 8
++
++ [ [236]Top ] [ [237]Contents ] [ [238]Section Contents ] [ [239]Next ]
++ [ [240]Previous ]
++
++ To make C-Kermit work on HP-UX 8.05 on a model 720, obtain and install
++ HP-UX patch PHNE_0899. This patch deals with a lot of driver issues,
++ particularly related to communication at higher speeds.
++
++ One user reports:
++
++ On HP-UX 8 DON'T install 'tty patch' PHKL_4656, install PHKL_3047
++ instead! Yesterday I tried this latest tty patch PHKL_4656 and had
++ terrible problems. This patch should fix RTS/CTS problems. With
++ text transver all looks nice. But when I switched over to binary
++ files the serial interface returned only rubish to C-Kermit. All
++ sorts of protocol, CRC and packed errors I had. After several tests
++ and after uninstalling that patch, all transvers worked fine. MB's
++ of data without any errors. So keep your fingers away from that
++ patch. If anybody needs the PHKL_3047 patch I have it here. It is
++ no longer availabel from HP's patch base.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.4.5. HP-UX 7 and Earlier
++
++ [ [241]Top ] [ [242]Contents ] [ [243]Section Contents ] [
++ [244]Previous ]
++
++ When transferring files into HP-UX 5 or 6 over a Telnet connection,
++ you must not use streaming, and you must not use a packet length
++ greater than 512. However, you can use streaming and longer packets
++ when sending files from HP-UX on a Telnet connection. In C-Kermit 8.0,
++ the default receive packet length for HP-UX 5 and 6 was changed to 500
++ (but you can still increase it with SET RECEIVE PACKET-LENGTH if you
++ wish, e.g. for non-Telnet connections). Disable streaming with SET
++ STREAMING OFF.
++
++ The HP-UX 5.00 version of C-Kermit does not include the fullscreen
++ file-transfer because of problems with the curses library.
++
++ If HP-UX 5.21 with Wollongong TCP/IP is on the remote end of a Telnet
++ connection, streaming transfers to HP-UX invariably fail. Workaround:
++ SET STREAMING OFF. Packets longer than about 1000 should not be used.
++ Transfers from these systems, however, can use streaming and/or longer
++ packets.
++
++ Reportedly, "[there is] a bug in C-Kermit using HP-UX version 5.21 on
++ the HP-9000 series 500 computers. It only occurs when the controlling
++ terminal is using an HP-27140 six-port modem mux. The problem is not
++ present if the controlling terminal is logged into an HP-27130
++ eight-port mux. The symptom is that just after dialing successfully
++ and connecting Kermit locks up and the port is unusable until both
++ forks of Kermit and the login shell are killed." (This report predates
++ C-Kermit 6.0 and might no longer apply.)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2.5. HP-UX and X.25
++
++ [ [245]Top ] [ [246]Contents ] [ [247]Section Contents ] [
++ [248]Previous ]
++
++ Although C-Kermit presently does not include built-in support for
++ HP-UX X.25 (as it does for the Sun and IBM X.25 products), it can
++ still be used to make X.25 connections as follows: start Kermit and
++ then telnet to localhost. After logging back in, start padem as you
++ would normally do to connect over X.25. Padem acts as a pipe between
++ Kermit and X.25. In C-Kermit 7.0, you might also be able to avoid the
++ "telnet localhost" step by using:
++
++ C-Kermit> pty padem address
++
++ This works if padem uses standard i/o (who knows?).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3. C-KERMIT AND LINUX
++
++ [ [249]Top ] [ [250]Contents ] [ [251]Section Contents ] [ [252]Next ]
++ [ [253]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 3.3.1. [254]Problems Building C-Kermit for Linux
++ 3.3.2. [255]Problems with Serial Devices in Linux
++ 3.3.3. [256]Terminal Emulation in Linux
++ 3.3.4. [257]Dates and Times
++ 3.3.5. [258]Startup Errors
++ 3.3.6. [259]The Fullscreen File Transfer Display
++
++ REFERENCES
++
++ For further information, read the [260]comp.os.linux.misc,
++ [261]comp.os.linux.answers, and other Linux-oriented newsgroups, and
++ see:
++
++ The Linux Document Project (LDP)
++ [262]http://www.tldp.org/
++
++ The Linux FAQ
++ [263]http://www.tldp.org/FAQ/Linux-FAQ.html
++
++ The Linux HOWTOs (especially the Serial HOWTO)
++
++ [264]http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/Serial-HOWTO.html
++
++ [265]http://tldp.org/HOWTO/Modem-HOWTO.html
++
++ [266]ftp://sunsite.unc.edu/pub/Linux/docs/HOWTO
++
++ [267]ftp://tsx-11.mit.edu/pub/linux/docs/HOWTO
++
++ [268]http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/
++
++ [269]http://www.tldp.org/hmirrors.html
++
++ Linux Vendor Tech Support Pages:
++
++ [270]http://www.redhat.com/apps/support/
++
++ [271]http://www.debian.org/support
++
++ [272]http://www.slackware.com/support/
++
++ [273]http://www.caldera.com/support/
++
++ [274]http://www.suse.com/support/
++
++ [275]http://www.mandrake.com/support/
++
++ [276]http://www.turbolinux.com/support/
++
++ Linux Winmodem Support
++ [277]http://www.linmodems.org/
++
++ Also see general comments on PC-based Unixes in [278]Section 3.0.
++
++ What Linux version is it? -- "uname -a" supplies only kernel
++ information, but these days it's the distribution that matters: Red
++ Hat 7.3, Debian 2.2, Slackware 8.0, etc. Unfortunately there's no
++ consistent way to get the distribution version. Usually it's in a
++ distribution-specific file:
++
++ Red Hat: /etc/issue or /etc/redhat-release
++ Debian: /etc/debian_version
++ Slackware: /etc/slackware-version (at least in later versions)
++
++ Did you know: DECnet is available for Linux? See:
++
++ [279]http://linux.dreamtime.org/decnet/
++
++ (But there is no support for it in C-Kermit -- anybody interested in
++ adding it, please [280]let us know).
++
++ Before proceeding, let's handle the some of the most frequently asked
++ question in the Linux newsgroups:
++
++ 1. Neither C-Kermit nor any other Linux application can use
++ Winmodems, except in the [281]rare cases where Linux drivers have
++ been written for them. See [282]Section 3.0.2 for details.
++ 2. "Why does it take such a long time to make a telnet connection to
++ (or from) my Linux PC?" (this applies to C-Kermit and to regular
++ Telnet). Most telnet servers these days perform reverse DNS
++ lookups on the client (for security and/or logging reasons). If
++ the Telnet client's address cannot be found by the server's local
++ DNS server, the DNS request goes out to the Internet at large, and
++ this can take quite some time. The solution to this problem is to
++ make sure that both client and host are registered in DNS, and
++ that the registrations are exported. C-Kermit itself performs
++ reverse DNS lookups unless you tell it not to; this is to allow
++ C-Kermit to let you know which host it is actually connected to in
++ case you have made a connection to a host pool (multihomed host).
++ You can disable C-Kermit's reverse DNS lookup with SET TCP
++ REVERSE-DNS-LOOKUP OFF.
++ 3. (Any question that has the word "Telnet" in it...) The knee-jerk
++ reaction is "don't use Telnet, use SSH!" There's nothing wrong
++ with Telnet. In fact it's far superior to SSH as a protocol in
++ terms of features and extensibility, not to mention platform
++ neutrality. The issue lurking behind the knee-jerk reaction is
++ security. SSH is thought to be secure, whereas Telnet is thought
++ to be insecure. This is true for clear-text Telnet (because
++ passwords travel in the clear across the network), but apparently
++ few people realize that [283]secure Telnet clients and servers
++ have been available for years, and these are more secure than SSH
++ (for reasons explained [284]HERE.
++ 4. (Any question that has the word "FTP" in it...) The knee-jerk
++ reaction being "Don't use FTP, use SCP!" (or SFTP). Same answer as
++ above, but moreso. SCP and SFTP are not only not platform neutral,
++ they're diversity-hostile. They transfer files only in binary
++ mode, which mangles text files across different platforms, to the
++ same degree the platform's text-file record format and character
++ set differ. An extreme example would be an Variable-Block format
++ EBCDIC text file on an IBM mainframe, binary transfer of which to
++ Unix would do you little good indeed. FTP was designed with
++ diversity in mind and secure versions are available.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3.1. Problems Building C-Kermit for Linux
++
++ [ [285]Top ] [ [286]Contents ] [ [287]Section Contents ] [ [288]Next ]
++
++ Modern Linux distributions like Red Hat give you a choice at
++ installation whether to include "developer tools". Obviously, you
++ can't build C-Kermit or any other C program from source code if you
++ have not installed the developer tools. But to confuse matters, you
++ might also have to choose (separately) to install the "curses" or
++ "ncurses" terminal control library; thus it is possible to install the
++ C compiler and linker, but omit the (n)curses library and headers. If
++ curses is not installed, you will not be able to build a version of
++ C-Kermit that supports the fullscreen file-transfer display, in which
++ case you'll need to use the "linuxnc" makefile target (nc = No Curses)
++ or else install ncurses before building.
++
++ There are all sorts of confusing issues caused by the many and varied
++ Linux distributions. Some of the worst involve the curses library and
++ header files: where are they, what are they called, which ones are
++ they really? Other vexing questions involve libc5 vs libc6 vs glibc vs
++ glibc2 (C libraries), gcc vs egcs vs lcc (compilers), plus using or
++ avoiding features that were added in a certain version of Linux or a
++ library or a distribution, and are not available in others. As of
++ C-Kermit 8.0, these questions should be resolved by the "linux"
++ makefile target itself, which does a bit of looking around to see
++ what's what, and then sets the appropriate CFLAGS.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3.2. Problems with Serial Devices in Linux
++
++ [ [289]Top ] [ [290]Contents ] [ [291]Section Contents ] [ [292]Next ]
++ [ [293]Previous ]
++
++ Also see: "man setserial", "man irqtune".
++ And: [294]Sections 3.0, [295]6, [296]7, and [297]8 of this
++ document.
++
++ NOTE: Red Hat Linux 7.2 and later include a new API that allows
++ serial-port arbitration by non-setuid/gid programs. This API has
++ not yet been added to C-Kermit. If C-Kermit is to be used for
++ dialing out on Red Hat 7.2 or later, it must still be installed as
++ described in in Sections [298]10 and [299]11 of the
++ [300]Installation Instructions.
++
++ Don't expect it to be easy. Queries like the following are posted to
++ the Linux newsgroups almost daily:
++
++ Problem of a major kind with my Compaq Presario 1805 in the sense
++ that the pnpdump doesn't find the modem and the configuration tells
++ me that the modem is busy when I set everything by hand!
++
++ I have <some recent SuSE distribution>, kernel 2.0.35. Using the
++ Compaq tells me that the modem (which is internal) is on COM2, with
++ the usual IRQ and port numbers. Running various Windows diagnostics
++ show me AT-style commands exchanged so I have no reason to beleive
++ that it is a Winmodem. Also, the diagnostics under Win98 tell me
++ that I am talking to an NS 16550AN.
++
++ [Editor's note: This does not necessarily mean it isn't a Winmodem.]
++
++ Under Linux, no joy trying to talk to the modem on /dev/cua1
++ whether via minicom, kppp, or chat; kppp at least tells me that
++ tcgetattr() failed.
++
++ Usage of setserial:
++
++ setserial /dev/cua1 port 0x2F8 irq 3 autoconfig
++ setserial -g /dev/cua1
++
++ tells me that the uart is 'unknown'. I have tried setting the UART
++ manullay via. setserial to 16550A, 16550, and the other one (8550?)
++ (I didn't try 16540). None of these manual settings resulted in any
++ success.
++
++ A look at past articles leads me to investigate PNP issues by
++ calling pnpdump but pnpdump returns "no boards found". I have
++ looked around on my BIOS (Phoenix) and there is not much evidence
++ of it being PNP aware. However for what it calls "Serial port A",
++ it offers a choice of Auto, Disabled or Manual settings (currently
++ set to Auto), but using the BIOS interface I tried to change to
++ 'manual' and saw the default settings offered to be were 0x3F8 and
++ IRQ 4 (COM1). The BIOS menus did not give me any chance to
++ configure COM2 or any "modem". I ended up not saving any BIOS
++ changes in the course of my investigations.
++
++ You can also find out a fair amount about your PC's hardware
++ configuration in the text files in /proc, e.g.:
++
++ -r--r--r-- 1 root 0 Sep 4 14:00 /proc/devices
++ -r--r--r-- 1 root 0 Sep 4 14:00 /proc/interrupts
++ -r--r--r-- 1 root 0 Sep 4 14:00 /proc/ioports
++ -r--r--r-- 1 root 0 Sep 4 14:00 /proc/pci
++
++ From the directory listing they look like empty files, but in fact
++ they are text files that you "cat":
++
++$ cat /proc/pci
++ Bus 0, device 14, function 0:
++ Serial controller: US Robotics/3Com 56K FaxModem Model 5610 (rev 1).
++ IRQ 10.
++ I/O at 0x1050 [0x1057].
++
++$ setserial -g /dev/ttyS4
++/dev/ttyS4, UART: 16550A, Port: 0x1050, IRQ: 10
++
++$ cat /proc/ioports
++1050-1057 : US Robotics/3Com 56K FaxModem Model 5610
++ 1050-1057 : serial(auto)
++
++$ cat /proc/interrupts
++ CPU0
++ 0: 7037515 XT-PIC timer
++ 1: 2 XT-PIC keyboard
++ 2: 0 XT-PIC cascade
++ 4: 0 XT-PIC serial
++ 8: 1 XT-PIC rtc
++ 9: 209811 XT-PIC usb-uhci, eth0
++ 14: 282015 XT-PIC ide0
++ 15: 6 XT-PIC ide1
++
++ Watch out for PCI, PCMCIA and Plug-n-Play devices, Winmodems, and the
++ like (see cautions in [301]Section 3.0 Linux supports Plug-n-Play
++ devices to some degree via the isapnp and pnpdump programs; read the
++ man pages for them. (If you don't have them, look on your installation
++ CD for isapnptool or download it from sunsite or a sunsite mirror or
++ other politically correct location du jour).
++
++ PCI modems do not use standard COM port addresses. The I/O address and
++ IRQ are assigned by the BIOS. All you need to do to get one working,
++ find out the I/O address and interrupt number with (as root) "lspci -v
++ | more" and then give the resulting address and interrupt number to
++ setserial.
++
++ Even when you have a real serial port, always be wary of interrupt
++ conflicts and similar PC hardware configuration issues: a PC is not a
++ real computer like other Unix workstations -- it is generally pieced
++ together from whatever random components were the best bargain on the
++ commodity market the week it was built. Once it's assembled and boxed,
++ not even the manufacturer will remember what it's made of or how it
++ was put together because they've moved on to a new model. Their job is
++ to get it (barely) working with Windows; for Linux and other OS's you
++ are on your own.
++
++ "set line /dev/modem" or "set line /dev/ttyS2", etc, results in an
++ error, "/dev/modem is not a tty". Cause unknown, but obviously a
++ driver issue, not a Kermit one (Kermit uses "isatty()" to check that
++ the device is a tty, so it knows it will be able to issue all the
++ tty-related ioctl's on it, like setting the speed & flow control). Try
++ a different name (i.e. driver) for the same port, e.g. "set line
++ /dev/cua2" or whatever.
++
++ To find what serial ports were registered at the most recent system
++ boot, type (as root): "grep tty /var/log/dmesg".
++
++ "set modem type xxx" (where xxx is the name of a modem) followed by
++ "set line /dev/modem" or "set
++ line /dev/ttyS2", etc, hangs (but can be interrupted with Ctrl-C).
++ Experimentation shows that if the modem is configured to always assert
++ carrier (&C0) the same command does not hang. Again, a driver issue.
++ Use /dev/cua2 (or whatever) instead. (Or not -- hopefully none of
++ these symptoms occurs in C-Kermit 7.0 or later.)
++
++ "set line /dev/cua0" reports "Device is busy", but "set line
++ /dev/ttyS0" works OK.
++
++ In short: If the cua device doesn't work, try the corresponding ttyS
++ device. If the ttyS device doesn't work, try the corresponding cua
++ device -- but note that Linux developers do not recommend this, and
++ are phasing out the cua devices. From /usr/doc/faq/howto/Serial-HOWTO:
++
++ 12.4. What's The Real Difference Between the /dev/cuaN And /dev/ttySN
++ Devices?
++ The only difference is the way that the devices are opened. The
++ dialin devices /dev/ttySN are opened in blocking mode, until CD
++ is asserted (ie someone connects). So, when someone wants to
++ use the /dev/cuaN device, there is no conflict with a program
++ watching the /dev/ttySN device (unless someone is connected of
++ course). The multiple /dev entries, allow operation of the same
++ physical device with different operating characteristics. It
++ also allows standard getty programs to coexist with any other
++ serial program, without the getty being retrofitted with
++ locking of some sort. It's especially useful since standard
++ Unix kernel file locking, and UUCP locking are both advisory
++ and not mandatory.
++
++ It was discovered during development of C-Kermit 7.0 that rebuilding
++ C-Kermit with -DNOCOTFMC (No Close/Open To Force Mode Change) made the
++ aforementioned problem with /dev/ttyS0 go away. It is not yet clear,
++ however, what its affect might be on the /dev/cua* devices. As of 19
++ March 1998, this option has been added to the CFLAGS in the makefile
++ entries for Linux ("make linux").
++
++ Note that the cua device is now "deprecated", and new editions of
++ Linux will phase (have phased) it out in favor of the ttyS device. See
++ (if it's still there):
++
++ [302]http://linuxwww.db.erau.edu/mail_archives/linux-kernel/Mar_98/1441.html
++
++ (no, of course it isn't; you'll have to use your imagination). One
++ user reported that C-Kermit 7.0, when built with egcs 1.1.2 and run on
++ Linux 2.2.6 with glibc 2.1 (hardware unknown but probably a PC) dumps
++ core when given a "set line /dev/ttyS1" command. When rebuilt with
++ gcc, it works fine.
++
++ All versions of Linux seem to have the following deficiency: When a
++ modem call is hung up and CD drops, Kermit can no longer read the
++ modem signals; SHOW COMMUNICATIONS says "Modem signals not available".
++ The TIOCMGET ioctl() returns -1 with errno 5 ("I/O Error").
++
++ The Linux version of POSIX tcsendbreak(), which is used by C-Kermit to
++ send regular (275msec) and long (1.5sec) BREAK signals, appears to
++ ignore its argument (despite its description in the man page and info
++ topic), and always sends a regular 275msec BREAK. This has been
++ observed in Linux versions ranging from Debian 2.1 to Red Hat 7.1.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3.3. Terminal Emulation in Linux
++
++ [ [303]Top ] [ [304]Contents ] [ [305]Section Contents ] [ [306]Next ]
++ [ [307]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit is not a terminal emulator. For a brief explanation of why
++ not, see [308]Section 3.0.5. For a fuller explanation, [309]ClICK
++ HERE.
++
++ In Unix, terminal emulation is supplied by the Window in which you run
++ Kermit: the regular console screen, which provides Linux Console
++ "emulation" via the "console" termcap entry, or under X-Windows in an
++ xterm window, which gives VTxxx emulation. An xterm that includes
++ color ANSI and VT220 emulation is available with Xfree86:
++
++ [310]http://dickey.his.com/xterm/xterm.html
++
++ Before starting C-Kermit in an xterm window, you might need to tell
++ the xterm window's shell to "stty sane".
++
++ To set up your PC console keyboard to send VT220 key sequences when
++ using C-Kermit as your communications program in an X terminal window
++ (if it doesn't already), create a file somewhere (e.g. in /root/)
++ called .xmodmaprc, containing something like the following:
++
++ keycode 77 = KP_F1 ! Num Lock => DEC Gold (PF1)
++ keycode 112 = KP_F2 ! Keypad / => DEC PF1
++ keycode 63 = KP_F3 ! Keypad * => DEC PF3
++ keycode 82 = KP_F4 ! Keypad - => DEC PF4
++ keycode 111 = Help ! Print Screen => DEC Help
++ keycode 78 = F16 ! Scroll Lock => DEC Do
++ keycode 110 = F16 ! Pause => DEC Do
++ keycode 106 = Find ! Insert => DEC Find
++ keycode 97 = Insert ! Home => DEC Insert
++ keycode 99 = 0x1000ff00 ! Page Up => DEC Remove
++ keycode 107 = Select ! Delete => DEC Select
++ keycode 103 = Page_Up ! End => DEC Prev Screen
++ keycode 22 = Delete ! Backspace sends Delete (127)
++
++ Then put "xmodmap filename" in your .xinitrc file (in your login
++ directory), e.g.
++
++ xmodmap /root/.xmodmaprc
++
++ Of course you can move things around. Use the xev program to find out
++ key codes.
++
++ Console-mode keys are mapped separately using loadkeys, and different
++ keycodes are used. Find out what they are with showkey.
++
++ For a much more complete VT220/320 key mapping for [311]Xfree86 xterm,
++ [312]CLICK HERE.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3.4. Dates and Times
++
++ [ [313]Top ] [ [314]Contents ] [ [315]Section Contents ] [ [316]Next ]
++ [ [317]Previous ]
++
++ If C-Kermit's date-time (e.g. as shown by its DATE command) differs
++ from the system's date and time:
++
++ a. Make sure the libc to which Kermit is linked is set to GMT or is
++ not set to any time zone. Watch out for mixed libc5/libc6 systems;
++ each must be set indpendently.
++ b. If you have changed your TZ environment variable, make sure it is
++ exported. This is normally done in /etc/profile or /etc/TZ.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3.5. Startup Errors
++
++ [ [318]Top ] [ [319]Contents ] [ [320]Section Contents ] [ [321]Next ]
++ [ [322]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit should work on all versions of Linux current through March
++ 2003, provided it was built on the same version you have, with the
++ same libraries and header files (just get the source code and "make
++ linux"). Binaries tend not to travel well from one Linux machine to
++ another, due to their many differences. There is no guarantee that a
++ particular C-Kermit binary will not stop working at a later date,
++ since Linux tends to change out from under its applications. If that
++ happens, rebuild C-Kermit from source. If something goes wrong with
++ the build process, look on the [323]C-Kermit website for a newer
++ version. If you have the latest version, then [324]report the problem
++ to us.
++
++ Inability to transfer files in Red Hat 7.2: the typical symptom would
++ be if you start Kermit and tell it to RECEIVE, it fails right away
++ with "?/dev/tty: No such device or address" or "?Bad file descriptor".
++ One report says this is because of csh, and if you change your shell
++ to bash or other shell, it doesn't happen. Another report cite bugs in
++ Red Hat 7.2 Telnetd "very seldom (if ever) providing a controlling
++ tty, and lots of other people piled on saying they have the same
++ problem.") A third theory is that this happens only when Linux has
++ been installed without "virtual terminal support".
++
++ A search of RedHat's errata pages shows a bug advisory (RHBA-2001-153)
++ issued 13 November 2001, but updated 6 December, about this same
++ symptom (but with tcsh and login.) Seems that login was not always
++ assigning a controlling TTY for the session, which would make most use
++ of "/dev/tty" somewhat less than useful.
++
++ [325]http://www.redhat.com/support/errata/RHBA-2001-153.html
++
++ Quoting: "Due to terminal handling problems in /bin/login, tcsh would
++ not find the controlling terminal correctly, and a shell in single
++ user mode would exhibit strange terminal input characteristics. This
++ update fixes both of these problems."
++
++ Since the Red Hat 5.1 release (circa August 1998), there have been
++ numerous reports of prebuilt Linux executables, and particularly the
++ Kermit RPM for Red Hat Linux, not working; either it won't start at
++ all, or it gives error messages about "terminal type unknown" and
++ refuses to initialize its curses support. The following is from the
++ [326]Kermit newsgroup:
++
++ From: rchandra@hal9000.buf.servtech.com
++ Newsgroups: comp.protocols.kermit.misc
++ Subject: Red Hat Linux/Intel 5.1 and ncurses: suggestions
++ Date: 22 Aug 1998 15:54:46 GMT
++ Organization: Verio New York
++ Keywords: RedHat RPM 5.1
++
++ Several factors can influence whether "linux" is recognized as a
++ terminal type on many Linux systems.
++
++ 1. Your program, or the libraries it linked with (if statically
++ linked), or the libraries it dynamically links with at runtime,
++ are looking for an entry in /etc/termcap that isn't there. (not
++ likely, but possible... I believe but am not certain that this is
++ a very old practice in very old [n]curses library implementations
++ to use a single file for all terminal descriptions.)
++ 2. Your program, or the libraries...are looking for a terminfo file
++ that just plain isn't there. (also not so likely, since many
++ people in other recent message threads said that other programs
++ work OK).
++ 3. Your program, or the libraries...are looking for a terminfo file
++ that is stored at a pathname that isn't expected by your program,
++ the libraries--and so on. I forgot if I read this in the errata
++ Web page or where exactly I discovered this (Netscape install?
++ Acrobat install?), but it may just be that one libc (let's say for
++ sake of argument, libc5, but I don't know this to be true) expects
++ your terminfo to be in /usr/share/terminfo, and the other (let's
++ say libc6/glibc) expects /usr/lib/terminfo. I remember that the
++ specific instructions in this bugfix/workaround were to do the
++ following or equivalent:
++ cd /usr/lib
++ ln -s ../share/terminfo ./terminfo
++ or:
++ ln -s /usr/share/terminfo /usr/lib/terminfo
++
++ So what this says is that the terminfo database/directory structure
++ can be accessed by either path. When something goes to reference
++ /usr/lib/terminfo, the symlink redirects it to essentially
++ /usr/share/terminfo, which is where it really resides on your
++ system. I personally prefer wherever possible to use relative
++ symlinks, because they still hold, more often than break, across
++ mount points, particularly NFS mounts, where the directory
++ structure may be different on the different systems.
++
++ Evidently the terminfo file moved between Red Hat 5.0 and 5.1, but Red
++ Hat did not include a link to let applications built prior to 5.1 find
++ it. Users reported that installing the link fixes the problem.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3.6. The Fullscreen File Transfer Display
++
++ [ [327]Top ] [ [328]Contents ] [ [329]Section Contents ] [
++ [330]Previous ]
++
++ Starting with ncurses versions dated 1998-12-12 (about a year before
++ ncurses 5.0), ncurses sets the terminal for buffered i/o, but
++ unfortunately is not able to restore it upon exit from curses (via
++ endwin()). Thus after a file transfer that uses the fullscreen file
++ transfer display, the terminal no longer echos nor responds
++ immediately to Tab, ?, and other special command characters. The same
++ thing happens on other platforms that use ncurses, e.g. FreeBSD.
++ Workarounds:
++
++ * Use SET XFER DISPLAY BRIEF, CRT, SERIAL, or NONE instead of
++ FULLSCREEN; or:
++ * Rebuild with KFLAGS=-DNONOSETBUF (C-Kermit 8.0)
++
++ In Red Hat 7.1, when using C-Kermit in a Gnome terminal window, it was
++ noticed that when the fullscreen file transfer display exits (via
++ endwin()), the previous (pre-file-transfer-display) screen is
++ restored. Thus you can't look at the completed display to see what
++ happened. This is a evidently a new feature of xterm. I can only
++ speculate that initscreen() and endwin() must send some kind of
++ special escape sequences that command xterm to save and restore the
++ screen. To defeat this effect, tell Linux you have a vt100 or other
++ xterm-compatible terminal that is not actually an xterm, or else tell
++ Kermit to SET TRANSFER DISPLAY to something besides FULLSCREEN.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.4. C-KERMIT AND NEXTSTEP
++
++ [ [331]Top ] [ [332]Contents ] [ [333]Section Contents ] [ [334]Next ]
++ [ [335]Previous ]
++
++ Run C-Kermit in a Terminal, Stuart, or xterm window, or when logged in
++ remotely through a serial port or TELNET connection. C-Kermit does not
++ work correctly when invoked directly from the NeXTSTEP File Viewer or
++ Dock. This is because the terminal-oriented gtty, stty, & ioctl calls
++ don't work on the little window that NeXTSTEP pops up for non-NeXTSTEP
++ applications like Kermit. CBREAK and No-ECHO settings do not take
++ effect in the command parser -- commands are parsed strictly line at a
++ time. "set line /dev/cua" works. During CONNECT mode, the console
++ stays in cooked mode, so characters are not transmitted until carriage
++ return or linefeed is typed, and you can't escape back. If you want to
++ run Kermit directly from the File Viewer, then launch it from a shell
++ script that puts it in the desired kind of window, something like this
++ (for "Terminal"):
++
++ Terminal -Lines 24 -Columns 80 -WinLocX 100 -WinLocY 100 $FONT $FONTSIZE \
++ -SourceDotLogin -Shell /usr/local/bin/kermit &
++
++ C-Kermit does not work correctly on a NeXT with NeXTSTEP 3.0 to which
++ you have established an rlogin connection, due to a bug in NeXTSTEP
++ 3.0, which has been reported to NeXT.
++
++ The SET CARRIER command has no effect on the NeXT -- this is a
++ limitation of the NeXTSTEP serial-port device drivers.
++
++ Hardware flow control on the NeXT is selected not by "set flow
++ rts/cts" in Kermit (since NeXTSTEP offers no API for this), but
++ rather, by using a specially-named driver for the serial device:
++ /dev/cufa instead /dev/cua; /dev/cufb instead of /dev/cub. This is
++ available only on 68040-based NeXT models (the situation for Intel
++ NeXTSTEP implementations is unknown).
++
++ NeXT-built 68030 and 68040 models have different kinds of serial
++ interfaces; the 68030 has a Macintosh-like RS-422 interface, which
++ lacks RTS and CTS signals; the 68040 has an RS-423 (RS-232 compatible)
++ interface, which supports the commonly-used modem signals. WARNING:
++ the connectors look exactly the same, but the pins are used in
++ completely DIFFERENT ways -- different cables are required for the two
++ kinds of interfaces.
++
++ IF YOU GET LOTS OF RETRANSMISSIONS during file transfer, even when
++ using a /dev/cuf* device and the modem is correctly configured for
++ RTS/CTS flow control, YOU PROBABLY HAVE THE WRONG KIND OF CABLE.
++
++ On the NeXT, Kermit reportedly (by TimeMon) causes the kernel to use a
++ lot of CPU time when using a "set line" connection. That's because
++ there is no DMA channel for the NeXT serial port, so the port must
++ interrupt the kernel for each character in or out.
++
++ One user reported trouble running C-Kermit on a NeXT from within
++ NeXT's Subprocess class under NeXTstep 3.0, and/or when rlogin'd from
++ one NeXT to another: Error opening /dev/tty:, congm: No such device or
++ address. Diagnosis: Bug in NeXTSTEP 3.0, cure unknown.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.5. C-KERMIT AND QNX
++
++ [ [336]Top ] [ [337]Contents ] [ [338]Section Contents ] [ [339]Next ]
++ [ [340]Previous ]
++
++ See also: The [341]comp.os.qnx newsgroup.
++
++ Support for QNX 4.x was added in C-Kermit 5A(190). This is a
++ full-function implementation, thoroughly tested on QNX 4.21 and later,
++ and verified to work in both 16-bit and 32-bit versions. The 16-bit
++ version was dropped in C-Kermit 7.0 since it can no longer be built
++ successfully (after stripping most most features, I succeeded in
++ getting it to compile and link without complaint, but the executable
++ just beeps when you run it); for 16-bit QNX 4.2x, use C-Kermit 6.0 or
++ earlier, or else [342]G-Kermit.
++
++ The 32-bit version (and the 16-bit version prior to C-Kermit 7.0)
++ supports most of C-Kermit's advanced features including TCP/IP, high
++ serial speeds, hardware flow-control, modem-signal awareness, curses
++ support, etc.
++
++ BUG: In C-Kermit 6.0 on QNX 4.22 and earlier, the fullscreen file
++ transfer display worked fine the first time, but was fractured on
++ subsequent file transfers. Cause and cure unknown. In C-Kermit 7.0 and
++ QNX 4.25, this no longer occurs. It is not known if it would occur in
++ C-Kermit 7.0 or later on earlier QNX versions.
++
++ Dialout devices are normally /dev/ser1, /dev/ser2, ..., and can be
++ opened explicitly with SET LINE. Reportedly, "/dev/ser" (no unit
++ number) opens the first available /dev/sern device.
++
++ Like all other Unix C-Kermit implementations, QNX C-Kermit does not
++ provide any kind of terminal emulation. Terminal specific functions
++ are provided by your terminal, terminal window (e.g. QNX Terminal or
++ xterm), or emulator.
++
++ QNX C-Kermit, as distributed, does not include support for UUCP
++ line-locking; the QNX makefile entries (qnx32 and qnx16) include the
++ -DNOUUCP switch. This is because QNX, as distributed, does not include
++ UUCP, and its own communications software (e.g. qterm) does not use
++ UUCP line locking. If you have a UUCP product installed on your QNX
++ system, remove the -DNOUUCP switch from the makefile entry and
++ rebuild. Then check to see that Kermit's UUCP lockfile conventions are
++ the same as those of your UUCP package; if not, read the [343]UUCP
++ lockfile section of the [344]Installation Instructions and make the
++ necessary changes to the makefile entry (e.g. add -DHDBUUCP).
++
++ QNX does, however, allow a program to get the device open count. This
++ can not be a reliable form of locking unless all applications do it,
++ so by default, Kermit uses this information only for printing a
++ warning message such as:
++
++ C-Kermit>set line /dev/ser1
++ WARNING - "/dev/ser1" looks busy...
++
++ However, if you want to use it as a lock, you can do so with:
++
++ SET QNX-PORT-LOCK { ON, OFF }
++
++ This is OFF by default; if you set in ON, C-Kermit will fail to open
++ any dialout device when its open count indicates that another process
++ has it open. SHOW COMM (in QNX only) displays the setting, and if you
++ have a port open, it also shows the open count.
++
++ As of C-Kermit 8.0, C-Kermit's "open-count" form of line locking works
++ only in QNX4, not in QNX6 (this might change in a future C-Kermit
++ release).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6. C-KERMIT AND SCO
++
++ [ [345]Top ] [ [346]Contents ] [ [347]Section Contents ] [ [348]Next ]
++ [ [349]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++3.6.1. [350]SCO XENIX
++3.6.2. [351]SCO UNIX and OSR5
++3.6.3. [352]Unixware
++3.6.4. [353]Open UNIX 8
++
++ REFERENCES
++
++ * The comp.unix.sco.* newsgroups.
++ * [354]Section 3.10 below for Unixware.
++ * The following FAQs:
++
++ The comp.sco.misc FAQ:
++ [355]http://aplawrence.com/SCOFAQ/
++
++ Caldera (SCO) comp.unix.sco.programmer FAQ:
++ [356]http://www.zenez.com/cgi-bin/scoprogfaq/faq.pl
++
++ The UnixWare 7/OpenUNIX 8 FAQ:
++ [357]http://www.zenez.com/cgi-bin/scouw7faq/faq.pl
++ [358]http://zenez.pcunix.com/cgi-bin/scouw7faq/faq.pl
++
++ High Speed Modems for SCO Unix:
++ [359]http://pcunix.com/Unixart/modems.html
++
++ The UnixWare FAQ
++ [360]http://www.freebird.org/faq/
++
++ The UnixWare 1.x and 2.0 Programmer FAQ
++ [361]http://www.freebird.org/faq/developer.html
++
++ Caldera Support Knowledge Base
++ [362]http://support.caldera.com/caldera
++
++ [363]http://stage.caldera.com/ta/
++ Caldera (SCO) Technical Article Search Center
++
++ [364]http://aplawrence.com/newtosco.html
++ New to SCO (Tony Lawrence)
++
++ The same comments regarding terminal emulation and key mapping apply
++ to SCO operating systems as to all other Unixes. C-Kermit is not a
++ terminal emulator, and you can't use it to map F-keys, Arrow keys,
++ etc. The way to do this is with xmodmap (xterm) or loadkeys (console).
++ For a brief explanation, see [365]Section 3.0.5. For a fuller
++ explanation, [366]ClICK HERE.
++
++ Also see general comments on PC-based Unixes in [367]Section 3.0.
++
++ 3.6.1. SCO XENIX
++
++ [ [368]Top ] [ [369]Contents ] [ [370]Section Contents ] [ [371]Next ]
++
++ Old Xenix versions... Did you know: Xenix 3.0 is *older* than Xenix
++ 2.0?
++
++ In Xenix 2.3.4 and probably other Xenix versions, momentarily dropping
++ DTR to hang up a modem does not work. DTR goes down but does not come
++ up again. Workaround: Use SET MODEM HANGUP-METHOD MODEM-COMMAND.
++ Anybody who would like to fix this is welcome to take a look at
++ tthang() in [372]ckutio.c. Also: modem signals can not be read in
++ Xenix, and the maximum serial speed is 38400.
++
++ There is all sorts of confusion among SCO versions, particularly when
++ third- party communications boards and drivers are installed,
++ regarding lockfile naming conventions, as well as basic functionality.
++ As far as lockfiles go, all bets are off if you are using a
++ third-party multiport board. At least you have the source code.
++ Hopefully you also have a C compiler :-)
++
++ Xenix 2.3.0 and later claim to support RTSFLOW and CTSFLOW, but this
++ is not modern bidirectional hardware flow control; rather it
++ implements the original RS-232 meanings of these signals for
++ unidirectional half-duplex line access: If both RTSFLOW and CTSFLOW
++ bits are set, Xenix asserts RTS when it wants to send data and waits
++ for CTS assertion before it actually starts sending data (also,
++ reportedly, even this is broken in Xenix 2.3.0 and 2.3.1).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6.2. SCO UNIX AND OSR5
++
++ [ [373]Top ] [ [374]Contents ] [ [375]Section Contents ] [ [376]Next ]
++ [ [377]Previous ]
++
++ SCO systems tend to use different names (i.e. drivers) for the same
++ device. Typically /dev/tty1a refers to a terminal device that has no
++ modem control; open, read, write, and close operations do not depend
++ on carrier. On the other hand, /dev/tty1A (same name, but with final
++ letter upper case), is the same device with modem control, in which
++ carrier is required (the SET LINE command does not complete until
++ carrier appears, read/write operations fail if there is no carrier,
++ etc).
++
++ SCO OpenServer 5.0.5 and earlier do not support the reading of modem
++ signals. Thus "show comm" does not list modem signals, and C-Kermit
++ does not automatically pop back to its prompt when the modem hangs up
++ the connection (drops CD). The ioctl() call for this is simply not
++ implmented, at least not in the standard drivers. OSR5.0.6 attempts to
++ deal with modem signals but fails; however OSR5.0.6a appears to
++ function properly.
++
++ Dialing is likely not to work well in SCO OpenServer 5.0.x because
++ many of the serial-port APIs simply do not operate when using the
++ standard drivers. For example, if DTR is dropped by the recommended
++ method (setting speed to 0 for half a seconds, then restoring the
++ speed), DTR and RTS go down but never come back up. When in doubt SET
++ MODEM HANGUP-METHOD MODEM-COMMAND or SET DIAL HANGUP OFF.
++
++ On the other hand, certain functions that might not (do not) work
++ right or at all when using SCO drivers (e.g. high serial speeds,
++ hardware flow control, and/or reading of modem signals) might work
++ right when using third-party drivers. (Example: hardware flow control
++ works, reportedly, only on uppercase device like tty1A -- not tty1a --
++ and only when CLOCAL is clear when using the SCO sio driver, but there
++ are no such restrictions in, e.g., [378]Digiboard drivers).
++
++ One user reports that he can't transfer large files with C-Kermit
++ under SCO OSR5.0.0 and 5.0.4 -- after the first 5K, everything falls
++ apart. Same thing without Kermit -- e.g. with ftp over a PPP
++ connection. Later, he said that replacing SCO's SIO driver with FAS,
++ an alternative communications driver, made the problem go away:
++
++ [379]ftp://ftp.fu-berlin.de/pub/unix/driver/fas
++
++ With regard to bidirectional serial ports on OpenServer 5.0.4, the
++ following advice appeared on an SCO-related newsgroup:
++
++ No amount of configuration information is going to help you on
++ 5.0.4 unless it includes the kludge for the primary problem. With
++ almost every modem, the 5.0.4 getty will barf messages and may or
++ may not connect. There are 2 solutions and only one works on 5.0.4.
++ Get the atdialer binary from a 5.0.0 system and substitute it for
++ the native 5.0.4 atdialer. The other solution is to upgrade to
++ 5.0.5. And, most of all, on any OpenServer products, do NOT run the
++ badly broken Modem Manager. Configure the modems in the time
++ honored way that dates back to Xenix.
++
++ Use SCO-provided utilities for switching the directionality of a modem
++ line, such as "enable" and "disable" commands. For example, to dial
++ out on tty1a, which is normally set up for logins:
++
++ disable tty1a
++ kermit -l /dev/tty1a
++ enable tty1a
++
++ If a tty device is listed as an ACU in /usr/lib/uucp/Devices and is
++ enabled, getty resets the ownership and permissions to uucp.uucp and
++ 640 every time the device is released. If you want to use the device
++ only for dialout, and you want to specify other owners or permissions,
++ you should disable it in /usr/lib/uucp/Devices; this will prevent
++ getty from doing things to it. You should also changes the device's
++ file modes in /etc/conf/node.d/sio by changing fields 5-7 for the
++ desired device(s); this determines how the devices are set if you
++ relink the kernel.
++
++ One SCO user of C-Kermit 5A(190) reported that only one copy of Kermit
++ can run at a time when a Stallion Technologies multiport boards are
++ installed. Cause, cure, and present status unknown (see [380]Section
++ 14 for more info regarding Stallion).
++
++ Prior to SCO OpenServer 5.0.4, the highest serial port speed supported
++ by SCO was 38400. However, in some SCO versions (e.g. OSR5) it is
++ possible to map rarely-used lower speeds (like 600 and 1800) to higher
++ ones like 57600 and 115200. To find out how, go to
++ [381]http://www.sco.com/ and search for "115200". In OSR5.0.4, serial
++ speeds up to 921600 are supported through the POSIX interface;
++ C-Kermit 6.1.193 or later, when built for OSR5.0.4 using /bin/cc (NOT
++ the UDK, which hides the high-speed definitions from CPP), supports
++ these speeds, but you might be able to run this binary on earlier
++ releases to get the high serial speeds, depending on various factors,
++ described by Bela Lubkin of SCO:
++
++ Serial speeds under SCO Unix / Open Desktop / OpenServer
++ ========================================================
++ Third party drivers (intelligent serial boards) may provide any speeds
++ they desire; most support up to 115.2Kbps.
++
++ SCO's "sio" driver, which is used to drive standard serial ports with
++ 8250/16450/16550 and similar UARTs, was limited to 38400bps in older
++ releases. Support for rates through 115.2Kbps was added in the
++ following releases:
++
++ SCO OpenServer Release 5.0.0 (requires supplement "rs40b")
++ SCO OpenServer Release 5.0.2 (requires supplement "rs40a" or "rs40b")
++ SCO OpenServer Release 5.0.4 or later
++ SCO Internet FastStart Release 1.0.0 or later
++
++ SCO supplements are at [382]ftp://ftp.sco.com/; the "rs40" series are
++ under directory /Supplements/internet
++
++ Kermit includes the high serial speeds in all OSR5 builds, but that
++ does not necessarily mean they work. For example, on our in-house
++ 5.0.5 system, SET SPEED 57600 or higher seems to succeed (no error
++ occurs) but when we read the speed back the driver says it is 50.
++ Similarly, 76800 becomes 75, and 115200 becomes 110. Testing shows the
++ resulting speed is indeed the low one we read back, not the high one
++ we asked for. Moral: Use speeds higher than 38400 with caution on SCO
++ OSR5.
++
++ Reportedly, if you have a script that makes a TCP/IP SET HOST (e.g.
++ Telnet) connection to SCO 3.2v4.2 with TCP/IP 1.2.1, and then does the
++ following:
++
++ script $ exit
++ hangup
++
++ this causes a pseudoterminal (pty) to be consumed on the SCO system;
++ if you do it enough times, it will run out of ptys. An "exit" command
++ is being sent to the SCO shell, and a HANGUP command is executed
++ locally, so the chances are good that both sides are trying to close
++ the connection at once, perhaps inducing a race condition in which the
++ remote pty is not released. It was speculated that this would be fixed
++ by applying SLS net382e, but it did not. Meanwhile, the workaround is
++ to insert a "pause" between the SCRIPT and HANGUP commands. (The
++ situation with later SCO releases is not known.)
++
++ SCO UNIX and OpenServer allow their console and/or terminal drivers to
++ be configured to translate character sets for you. DON'T DO THIS WHEN
++ USING KERMIT! First of all, you don't need it -- Kermit itself already
++ does this for you. And second, it will (a) probably ruin the
++ formatting of your screens (depending on which emulation you are
++ using); and (b) interfere with all sorts of other things -- legibility
++ of non-ASCII text on the terminal screen, file transfer, etc. Use:
++
++ mapchan -n
++
++ to turn off this feature.
++
++ Note that there is a multitude of SCO entries in the makefile, many of
++ them exhibiting an unusually large number of compiler options. Some
++ people actually understand all of this. Reportedly, things are
++ settling down with SCO OpenServer 5.x and Unixware 7 (and Open UNIX 8
++ and who knows what the next one will be -- Linux probably) -- the SCO
++ UDK compiler is said to generate binaries that will run on either
++ platform, by default, automatically. When using gcc or egcs, on the
++ other hand, differences persist, plus issues regarding the type of
++ binary that is generated (COFF, ELF, etc), and where and how it can
++ run. All of this could stand further clarification by SCO experts.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6.3. Unixware
++
++ [ [383]Top ] [ [384]Contents ] [ [385]Section Contents ] [ [386]Next ]
++ [ [387]Previous ]
++
++ Unixware changed hands several times before landing at SCO, and so has
++ its [388]own section in this document. (Briefly: AT&T UNIX Systems
++ Laboratories sold the rights to the UNIX name and to System V R4 (or
++ R5?) to Novell; later Novell spun its UNIX division off into a new
++ company called Univel, which eventually was bought by SCO, which later
++ was bought by Caldera, which later sort of semi-spun-off SCO...)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6.4. Open UNIX 8
++
++ [ [389]Top ] [ [390]Contents ] [ [391]Section Contents ] [
++ [392]Previous ]
++
++ SCO was bought by Caldera in 2000 or 2001 and evolved Unixware 7.1
++ into Caldera Open UNIX 8.00. It's just like Unixware 7.1 as far as
++ Kermit is concerned (the Unixware 7.1 makefile target works for Open
++ UNIX 8.00, and in fact a Unixware 7.1 Kermit binary built on Unixware
++ 7.1 runs under OU8; a separate OU8 makefile target exists simply to
++ generate an appropriate program startup herald). Open Unix is now
++ defunct; subsequent releases are called UnixWare again (e.g. UnixWare
++ 7.1.3).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7. C-KERMIT AND SOLARIS
++
++ [ [393]Top ] [ [394]Contents ] [ [395]Section Contents ] [ [396]Next ]
++ [ [397]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++3.7.1. [398]Serial Port Configuration
++3.7.2. [399]Serial Port Problems
++3.7.3. [400]SunLink X.25
++3.7.4. [401]Sun Workstation Keyboard Mapping
++3.7.5. [402]Solaris 2.4 and Earlier
++
++ REFERENCES
++
++ * The [403]comp.unix.solaris newsgroup
++ * [404]http://access1.sun.com/
++ * [405]http://docs.sun.com/
++ * [406]http://www.sunhelp.com/
++ * [407]http://www.wins.uva.nl/pub/solaris/solaris2/
++ * [408]http://www.wins.uva.nl/cgi-bin/sfaq.cgi
++ * [409]ftp://ftp.wins.uva.nl/pub/solaris
++ * [410]http://www.science.uva.nl/pub/solaris/solaris2.html
++
++ And about serial communications in particular, see "Celeste's Tutorial
++ on Solaris 2.x Modems and Terminals":
++
++ [411]http://www.stokely.com/
++
++ In particular:
++
++ [412]http://www.stokely.com/unix.sysadm.resources/faqs.sun.html
++
++ For PC-based Solaris, also see general comments on PC-based Unixes in
++ [413]Section 3.0. Don't expect Solaris or any other kind of Unix to
++ work right on a PC until you resolve all interrupt conflicts. Don't
++ expect to be able to use COM3 or COM4 (or even COM2) until you have
++ configured their addresses and interrupts.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.1. Serial Port Configuration
++
++ [ [414]Top ] [ [415]Contents ] [ [416]Section Contents ] [
++ [417]Section Contents ] [ [418]Next ]
++
++ Your serial port can't be used -- or at least won't work right --
++ until it is enabled in Solaris. For example, you get a message like
++ "SERIAL: Operation would block" when attempting to dial. This probably
++ indicates that the serial port has not been enabled for use with
++ modems. You'll need to follow the instructions in your system setup or
++ management manual, such as (e.g.) the Desktop SPARC Sun System &
++ Network Manager's Guide, which should contain a section "Setting up
++ Modem Software"; read it and follow the instructions. These might (or
++ might not) include running a program called "eeprom", editing some
++ system configuration file (such as, for example:
++
++ /platform/i86pc/kernel/drv/asy.conf
++
++ and then doing a configuration reboot, or running some other programs
++ like drvconfig and devlinks. "man eeprom" for details.
++
++ Also, on certain Sun models like IPC, the serial port hardware might
++ need to have a jumper changed to make it an RS-232 port rather than
++ RS-423.
++
++ eeprom applies only to real serial ports, not to "Spiff" devices
++ (serial port expander), in which case setup with Solaris' admintool is
++ required.
++
++ Another command you might need to use is pmadm, e.g.:
++
++ pmadm -d -p zsmon -s tty3
++ pmadm -e -p zsmon -s tty3
++
++ You can use the following command to check if a process has the device
++ open:
++
++ fuser -f /dev/term/3
++
++ In some cases, however (according to Sun support, May 2001) "It is
++ still possible that a zombie process has hold of the port EVEN IF
++ there is no lock file and the fuser command comes up empty. In that
++ case, the only way to resolve the problem is by rebooting."
++
++ If you can't establish communication through a serial port to a device
++ that is not asserting CD (Carrier Detect), try setting the environment
++ variable "ttya-ignore-cd" to "true" (replace "ttya" with the port
++ name).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.2. Serial Port Problems
++
++ [ [419]Top ] [ [420]Contents ] [ [421]Section Contents ] [ [422]Next ]
++ [ [423]Previous ]
++
++ Current advice from Sun is to always the /dev/cua/x devices for
++ dialing out, rather than the /dev/term/x. Nevertheless, if you have
++ trouble dialing out with one, try the other.
++
++ Reportedly, if you start C-Kermit and "set line" to a port that has a
++ modem connected to it that is not turned on, and then "set flow
++ rts/cts", there might be some (unspecified) difficulties closing the
++ device because the CTS signal is not coming in from the modem.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.3. SunLink X.25
++
++ [ [424]Top ] [ [425]Contents ] [ [426]Section Contents ] [ [427]Next ]
++ [ [428]Previous ]
++
++ The built-in SunLink X.25 support for Solaris 2.3/2.4./25 and SunLink
++ 8.01 or 9.00 works OK provided the X.25 system has been installed and
++ initialized properly. Packet sizes might need to be reduced to 256,
++ maybe even less, depending on the configuration of the X.25
++ installation. On one connection where C-Kermit 6.0 was tested, very
++ large packets and window sizes could be used in one direction, but
++ only very small ones would work in the other.
++
++ In any case, according to Sun, C-Kermit's X.25 support is superfluous
++ with SunLink 8.x / Solaris 2.3. Quoting an anonymous Sun engineer:
++
++ ... there is now no need to include any X.25 code within kermit. As
++ of X.25 8.0.1 we support the use of kermit, uucp and similar
++ protocols over devices of type /dev/xty. This facility was there in
++ 8.0, and should also work on the 8.0 release if patch 101524 is
++ applied, but I'm not 100% sure it will work in all cases, which is
++ why we only claim support from 8.0.1 onwards.
++
++ When configuring X.25, on the "Advanced Configuration->Parameters"
++ screen of the x25tool you can select a number of XTY devices. If
++ you set this to be > 1, press Apply, and reboot, you will get a
++ number of /dev/xty entries created.
++
++ Ignore /dev/xty0, it is a special case. All the others can be used
++ exactly as if they were a serial line (e.g. /dev/tty) connected to
++ a modem, except that instead of using Hayes-style commands, you use
++ PAD commands.
++
++ From kermit you can do a 'set line' command to, say, /dev/xty1,
++ then set your dialing command to be "CALL 12345678", etc. All the
++ usual PAD commands will work (SET, PAR, etc).
++
++ I know of one customer in Australia who is successfully using this,
++ with kermit scripts, to manage some X.25-connected switches. He
++ used standard kermit, compiled for Solaris 2, with X.25 8.0 xty
++ devices.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.4. Sun Workstation Keyboard Mapping
++
++ [ [429]Top ] [ [430]Contents ] [ [431]Section Contents ] [ [432]Next ]
++ [ [433]Previous ]
++
++ Hints for using a Sun workstation keyboard for VT emulation when
++ accessing VMS, from the [434]comp.os.vms newsgroup:
++
++ From: Jerry Leichter <leichter@smarts.com>
++ Newsgroups: comp.os.vms
++ Subject: Re: VT100 keyboard mapping to Sun X server
++ Date: Mon, 19 Aug 1996 12:44:21 -0400
++
++ > I am stuck right now using a Sun keyboard (type 5) on systems
++ running SunOS
++ > and Solaris. I would like to use EVE on an OpenVMS box with
++ display back to
++ > the Sun. Does anyone know of a keyboard mapping (or some other
++ procedure)
++ > which will allow the Sun keyboard to approximate a VT100/VT220?
++
++ You can't get it exactly - because the keypad has one fewer key -
++ but you can come pretty close. Here's a set of keydefs I use:
++
++ keycode 101=KP_0
++ keycode 119=KP_1
++ keycode 120=KP_2
++ keycode 121=KP_3
++ keycode 98=KP_4
++ keycode 99=KP_5
++ keycode 100=KP_6
++ keycode 75=KP_7
++ keycode 76=KP_8
++ keycode 77=KP_9
++ keycode 52=KP_F1
++ keycode 53=KP_F2
++ keycode 54=KP_F3
++ keycode 57=KP_Decimal
++ keycode 28=Left
++ keycode 29=Right
++ keycode 30=KP_Separator
++ keycode 105=KP_F4
++ keycode 78=KP_Subtract
++ keycode 8=Left
++ keycode 10=Right
++ keycode 32=Up
++ keycode 33=Down
++ keycode 97=KP_Enter
++
++ Put this in a file - I use "keydefs" in my home directory and feed
++ it into xmodmap:
++
++ xmodmap - <$HOME/keydefs
++
++ This takes care of the arrow keys and the "calculator" key cluster.
++ The "+" key will play the role of the DEC "," key. The Sun "-" key
++ will be like the DEC "-" key, though it's in a physically different
++ position - where the DEC PF4 key is. The PF4 key is ... damn, I'm
++ not sure where "key 105" is. I *think* it may be on the leftmost
++ key of the group of four just above the "calculator" key cluster.
++
++ I also execute the following (this is all in my xinitrc file):
++
++ xmodmap -e 'keysym KP_Decimal = KP_Decimal'
++ xmodmap -e 'keysym BackSpace = Delete BackSpace' \
++ -e 'keysym Delete = BackSpace Delete'
++ xmodmap -e 'keysym KP_Decimal = Delete Delete KP_Decimal'
++ xmodmap -e 'add mod1 = Meta_R'
++ xmodmap -e 'add mod1 = Meta_L'
++
++ Beware of one thing about xmodmap: Keymap changes are applied to
++ the *whole workstation*, not just to individual windows. There is,
++ in fact, no way I know of to apply them to individual windows.
++ These definitions *may* confuse some Unix programs (and/or some
++ Unix users).
++
++ If you're using Motif, you may also need to apply bindings at the
++ Motif level. If just using xmodmap doesn't work, I can try and dig
++ that stuff up for you.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.5. Solaris PPP Connections
++
++ [ [435]Top ] [ [436]Contents ] [ [437]Section Contents ] [ [438]Next ]
++ [ [439]Previous ]
++
++ The following is a report from a user of C-Kermit 8.0 on Solaris 8 and
++ 9, who had complained that while Kermit file transfers worked
++ perfectly on direct (non-PPP) dialout connections, they failed
++ miserably on PPP connections. We suggested that the PPP dialer
++ probably was not setting the port and/or modem up in the same way that
++ Kermit did:
++
++ I want to get back on this and tell you what the resolution was.
++ You pointed me in the direction of flow control, which turned out
++ to be the key.
++
++ Some discussion on the comp.unix.solaris newsgroup led to some
++ comments from Greg Andrews about the need to use the uucp driver to
++ talk to the modem (/dev/cua/a). I had to remind Greg that no matter
++ what the manpages for the zs and se drivers say, the ppp that Sun
++ released with Solaris 8 7/01, and has in Solaris 9, is a setuid
++ root program, and simply trying to make a pppd call from user space
++ specifying /dev/cua/a would fail because of permissions. Greg
++ finally put the question to the ppp people, who came back with
++ information that is not laid out anywhere in the docs available for
++ Solaris users. Namely, put /dev/cua/a in one of the priviledged
++ options files in the /etc/ppp directory. That, plus resetting the
++ OBP ttya-ignore-cd flag (this is Sun hardware) to false, seems to
++ have solved the problems.
++
++ While I note that I had installed Kermit suid to uucp to use
++ /dev/cua/a on this particular box, it seems to run fine through
++ /dev/term/a. Not so with pppd.
++
++ With this change in place, I seem to be able to upload and download
++ through telnet run on Kermit with the maximum length packets. I
++ note that the window allocation display does show STREAMING, using
++ telnet. Running ssh on Kermit, I see the standard 1 of 30 windows
++ display, and note that there appears to be a buffer length limit
++ between 1000 and 2000 bytes. Run with 1000, and it's tick-tock,
++ solid as a rock. With 2000 I see timeout errors and RTS/CTS action
++ on the modem.
++
++ Kermit's packet-length and other controls let you make adjustments
++ like this to get around whatever obstacles might be thrown up -- in
++ this case (running Kermit over ssh), the underling Solaris PTY driver.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.6. Solaris 2.4 and Earlier
++
++ [ [440]Top ] [ [441]Contents ] [ [442]Section Contents ] [
++ [443]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit can't be compiled successfully under Solaris 2.3 using
++ SUNWspro cc 2.0.1 unless at least some of the following patches are
++ applied to cc (it is not known which one(s), if any, fix the problem):
++
++ * 100935-01 SparcCompiler C 2.0.1: bad code generated when addresses
++ of two double arguments are involved
++ * 100961-05 SPARCcompilers C 2.0.1: conditional expression with
++ function returning structure gives wrong value
++ * 100974-01 SparcWorks 2.0.1: dbx jumbo patch
++ * 101424-01 SPARCworks 2.0.1 maketool SEGV's instantly on Solaris
++ 2.3
++
++ With unpatched cc 2.0.1, the symptom is that certain modules generate
++ truncated object files, resulting in many unresolved references at
++ link time.
++
++ The rest of the problems in this section have to do with
++ bidirectional terminal ports and the Solaris Port Monitor. A bug in
++ C-Kermit 5A ticked a bug in Solaris. The C-Kermit bug was fixed in
++ version 6.0, and the Solaris bug was fixed in 2.4 (I think, or
++ maybe 2.5).
++
++ Reportedly, "C-Kermit ... causes a SPARCstation running Solaris 2.3 to
++ panic after the modem connects. I have tried compiling C-Kermit with
++ Sun's unbundled C compiler, with GCC Versions 2.4.5 and 2.5.3, with
++ make targets 'sunos51', 'sunos51tcp', 'sunos51gcc', and even 'sys5r4',
++ and each time it compiles and starts up cleanly, but without fail, as
++ soon as I dial the number and get a 'CONNECT' message from the modem,
++ I get:
++
++ BAD TRAP
++ kermit: Data fault
++ kernel read fault at addr=0x45c, pme=0x0
++ Sync Error Reg 80 <INVALID>
++ ...
++ panic: Data Fault.
++ ...
++ Rebooting...
++
++ The same modem works fine for UUCP/tip calling." Also (reportedly),
++ this only happens if the dialout port is configured as in/out via
++ admintool. If it is configured as out-only, no problem. This is the
++ same dialing code that works on hundreds of other System-V based Unix
++ OS's. Since it should be impossible for a user program to crash the
++ operating system, this problem must be chalked up to a Solaris bug.
++ Even if you SET CARRIER OFF, CONNECT, and dial manually by typing
++ ATDTnnnnnnn, the system panics as soon as the modem issues its CONNECT
++ message. (Clearly, when you are dialing manually, C-Kermit does not
++ know a thing about the CONNECT message, and so the panic is almost
++ certainly caused by the transition of the Carrier Detect (CD) line
++ from off to on.) This problem was reported by many users, all of whom
++ say that C-Kermit worked fine on Solaris 2.1 and 2.2. If the
++ speculation about CD is true, then a possible workaround might be to
++ configure the modem to leave CD on (or off) all the time. Perhaps by
++ the time you read this, a patch will have been issued for Solaris 2.3.
++
++ The following is from Karl S. Marsh, Systems & Networks Administrator,
++ AMBIX Systems Corp, Rochester, NY:
++
++ Environment: Solaris 2.3 Patch 101318-45 C-Kermit 5A(189) (and
++ presumably this applies to 188 and 190 also). eeprom setting:
++
++ ttya-rts-dtr-off=false
++ ttya-ignore-cd=false
++ ttya-mode=19200,8,n,8,-
++
++ To use C-Kermit on a bidirectional port in this environment, do not
++ use admintool to configure the port. Use admintool to delete any
++ services running on the port and then quit admintool and issue the
++ following command:
++
++ pmadm -a -p zsmon -s ttyb -i root -fu -v 1 -m "`ttyadm -b -d /dev/term/b \
++ -l conttyH -m ldterm,ttcompat -s /usr/bin/login -S n`"
++
++ [NOTE: This was copied from a blurry fax, so please check it
++ carefully] where:
++
++ -a = Add service
++ -p = pmtag (zsmon)
++ -s = service tag (ttyb)
++ -i = id to be associated with service tag (root)
++ -fu = create utmp entry
++ -v = version of ttyadm
++ -m = port monitor-specific portion of the port monitor administrative file
++ entry for the service
++ -b = set up port for bidirectional use
++ -d = full path name of device
++ -l = which ttylabel in the /etc/ttydefs file to use
++ -m = a list of pushable STREAMS modules
++ -s = pathname of service to be invoked when connection request received
++ -S = software carrier detect on or off (n = off)
++
++ "This is exactly how I was able to get Kermit to work on a
++ bi-directional port without crashing the system."
++
++ On the Solaris problem, also see SunSolve Bug ID 1150457 ("Using
++ C-Kermit, get Bad Trap on receiving prompt from remote system").
++ Another user reported "So, I have communicated with the Sun tech
++ support person that submitted this bug report [1150457]. Apparently,
++ this bug was fixed under one of the jumbo kernel patches. It would
++ seem that the fix did not live on into 101318-45, as this is EXACTLY
++ the error that I see when I attempt to use kermit on my system."
++
++ Later (Aug 94)... C-Kermit dialout successfully tested on a Sun4m with
++ a heavily patched Solaris 2.3. The patches most likely to have been
++ relevant:
++
++ * 101318-50: SunOS 5.3: Jumbo patch for kernel (includes libc,
++ lockd)
++ * 101720-01: SunOS 5.3: ttymon - prompt not always visible on a
++ modem connection
++ * 101815-01: SunOS 5.3: Data fault in put() NULL queue passed from
++ ttycommon_qfull()
++ * 101328-01: SunOS 5.3: Automation script to properly setup tty
++ ports prior to PCTS execution
++
++ Still later (Nov 94): another user (Bo Kullmar in Sweden) reports that
++ after using C-Kermit to dial out on a bidirectional port, the port
++ might not answer subsequent incoming calls, and says "the problem is
++ easy enough to fix with the Serial Port Manager; I just delete the
++ service and install it again using the graphical interface, which
++ underneath uses commands like sacadm and pmadm." Later Bo reports, "I
++ have found that if I run Kermit with the following script then it
++ works. This script is for /dev/cua/a, "-s a" is the last a in
++ /dev/cua/a:
++
++ #! /bin/sh
++ kermit
++ sleep 2
++ surun pmadm -e -p zsmon -s a
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.8. C-KERMIT AND SUNOS
++
++ [ [444]Top ] [ [445]Contents ] [ [446]Section Contents ] [ [447]Next ]
++ [ [448]Previous ]
++
++ For additional information, see "Celeste's Tutorial on SunOS 4.1.3+
++ Modems and Terminals":
++
++ [449]http://www.stokely.com/
++
++ For FAQs, etc, from Sun, see:
++ * [450]http://access1.sun.com/
++
++ For history of Sun models and SunOS versions, see (should be all the
++ same):
++ * [451]http://www.ludd.luth.se/~bear/project/sun/sun.hardware.txt
++ * [452]ftp://ftp.netcom.com/pub/ru/rubicon/sun.hdwr.ref
++ * [453]ftp://ftp.intnet.net/pub/SUN/Sun-Hardware-Ref
++
++ Sun SPARCstation users should read the section "Setting up Modem
++ Software" in the Desktop SPARC Sun System & Network Manager's Guide.
++ If you don't set up your serial ports correctly, Kermit (and other
++ communications software) won't work right.
++
++ Also, on certain Sun models like IPC, the serial port hardware might
++ need to have a jumper changed to make it an RS-232 port rather than
++ RS-423.
++
++ Reportedly, C-Kermit does not work correctly on a Sun SPARCstation in
++ an Open Windows window with scrolling enabled. Disable scrolling, or
++ else invoke Kermit in a terminal emulation window (xterm, crttool,
++ vttool) under SunView (this might be fixed in later SunOS releases).
++
++ On the Sun with Open Windows, an additional symptom has been reported:
++ outbound SunLink X.25 connections "magically" translate CR typed at
++ the keyboard into LF before transmission to the remote host. This
++ doesn't happen under SunView.
++
++ SET CARRIER ON, when used on the SunOS 4.1 version of C-Kermit
++ (compiled in the BSD universe), causes the program to hang
++ uninterruptibly when SET LINE is issued for a device that is not
++ asserting carrier. When Kermit is built in the Sys V universe on the
++ same computer, there is no problem (it can be interrupted with
++ Ctrl-C). This is apparently a limitation of the BSD-style tty driver.
++
++ SunOS 4.1 C-Kermit has been observed to dump core when running a
++ complicated script program under cron. The dump invariably occurs in
++ ttoc(), while trying to output a character to a TCP/IP TELNET
++ connection. ttoc() contains a write() call, and when the system or the
++ network is very busy, the write() call can get stuck for long periods
++ of time. To break out of deadlocks caused by stuck write() calls,
++ there is an alarm around the write(). It is possible that the core
++ dump occurs when this alarm signal is caught. (This one has not been
++ observed recently -- possibly fixed in edit 190.)
++
++ On Sun computers with SunOS 4.0 or 4.1, SET FLOW RTS/CTS works only if
++ the carrier signal is present from the communication device at the
++ time when C-Kermit enters packet mode or CONNECT mode. If carrier is
++ not sensed (e.g. when dialing), C-Kermit does not attempt to turn on
++ RTS/CTS flow control. This is because the SunOS serial device driver
++ does not allow characters to be output if RTS/CTS is set (CRTSCTS) but
++ carrier (and DSR) are not present. Workaround (maybe): SET CARRIER OFF
++ before giving the SET LINE command, establish the connection, then SET
++ FLOW RTS/CTS
++
++ It has also been reported that RTS/CTS flow control under SunOS 4.1
++ through 4.1.3 works only on INPUT, not on output, and that there is a
++ patch from Sun to correct this problem: Patch-ID# T100513-04, 20 July
++ 1993 (this patch might apply only to SunOS 4.1.3). It might also be
++ necessary to configure the eeprom parameters of the serial port; e.g.
++ do the following as root at the shell prompt:
++
++ eeprom ttya-ignore-cd=false
++ eeprom ttya-rts-dtr-off=true
++
++ There have been reports of file transfer failures on Sun-3 systems
++ when using long packets and/or large window sizes. One user says that
++ when this happens, the console issues many copies of this message:
++
++ chaos vmunix: zs1: ring buffer overflow
++
++ This means that SunOS is not scheduling Kermit frequently enough to
++ service interrupts from the zs serial device (Zilog 8350 SCC serial
++ communication port) before its input silo overflows. Workaround: use
++ smaller packets and/or a smaller window size, or use "nice" to
++ increase Kermit's priority. Use hardware flow control if available, or
++ remove other active processes before running Kermit.
++
++ SunLink X.25 support in C-Kermit 5A(190) was built and tested
++ successfully under SunOS 4.1.3b and SunLink X.25 7.00.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.9. C-KERMIT AND ULTRIX
++
++ [ [454]Top ] [ [455]Contents ] [ [456]Section Contents ] [ [457]Next ]
++ [ [458]Previous ]
++
++ See also: The [459]comp.unix.ultrix and [460]comp.sys.dec newsgroups.
++
++ There is no hardware flow control in Ultrix. That's not a Kermit
++ deficiency, but an Ultrix one.
++
++ When sending files to C-Kermit on a Telnet connection to a remote
++ Ultrix system, you must SET PREFIXING ALL (or at least prefix more
++ control characters than are selected by SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS).
++
++ Reportedly, DEC ULTRIX 4.3 is immune to C-Kermit's disabling of
++ SIGQUIT, which is the signal that is generated when the user types
++ Ctrl-\, which kills the current process (i.e. C-Kermit) and dumps
++ core. Diagnosis and cure unknown. Workaround: before starting C-Kermit
++ -- or for that matter, when you first log in because this applies to
++ all processes, not just Kermit -- give the following Unix command:
++
++ stty quit undef
++
++ Certain operations driven by RS-232 modem signal do not work on
++ DECstations or other DEC platforms whose serial interfaces use MMP
++ connectors (DEC version of RJ45 telephone jack with offset tab). These
++ connectors convey only the DSR and DTR modem signals, but not carrier
++ (CD), RTS, CTS, or RI. Use SET CARRIER OFF to enable communication, or
++ "hotwire" DSR to CD.
++
++ The maximum serial speed on the DECstation 5000 is normally 19200, but
++ various tricks are available (outside Kermit) to enable higher rates.
++ For example, on the 5000/200, 19200 can be remapped (somehow,
++ something to do with "a bit in the SIR", whatever that is) to 38400,
++ but in software you must still refer to this speed as 19200; you can't
++ have 19200 and 38400 available at the same time.
++
++ 19200, reportedly, is also the highest speed supported by Ultrix, but
++ NetBSD reportedly supports speeds up to 57600 on the DECstation,
++ although whether and how well this works is another question.
++
++ In any case, given the lack of hardware flow control in Ultrix, high
++ serial speeds are problematic at best.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.10. C-KERMIT AND UNIXWARE
++
++ [ [461]Top ] [ [462]Contents ] [ [463]Section Contents ] [ [464]Next ]
++ [ [465]Previous ]
++
++ See also:
++ * The Freebird Project (Unixware software repository)
++ [466]http://www.freebird.org/
++ * The UnixWare FAQ: [467]http://www.freebird.org/faq/
++ * The following newsgroups:
++ + [468]comp.unix.unixware.misc
++ + [469]comp.unix.sco.misc.
++
++ Also see general comments on PC-based Unixes in [470]Section 3.0. By
++ the way, this section is separate from the SCO (Caldera) section
++ because at the time this section was started, Unixware was owned by a
++ company called Univel. Later it was sold to Novell, and then to SCO.
++ Still later, SCO was sold to Caldera.
++
++ In Unixware 2.0 and later, the preferred serial device names (drivers)
++ are /dev/term/00 (etc), rather than /dev/tty00 (etc). Note the
++ following correspondence of device names and driver characteristics:
++
++ New name Old name Description
++ /dev/term/00 /dev/tty00 ???
++ /dev/term/00h /dev/tty00h Modem signals and hardware flow control
++ /dev/term/00m /dev/tty00m Modem signals(?)
++ /dev/term/00s /dev/tty00s Modem signals and software flow control
++ /dev/term/00t /dev/tty00t ???
++
++ Lockfile names use device.major.minor numbers, e.g.:
++
++ /var/spool/locks/LK.7679.003.005
++
++ The minor number varies according to the device name suffix (none, h,
++ m, s, or t). Only the device and major number are compared, and thus
++ all of the different names for the same physical device (e.g. all of
++ those shown in the table above) interlock effectively.
++
++ Prior to UnixWare 7, serial speeds higher than 38400 are not
++ supported. In UnixWare 7, we also support 57600 and 115200, plus some
++ unexpected ones like 14400, 28800, and 76800, by virtue of a strange
++ new interface, evidently peculiar to UnixWare 7, discovered while
++ digging through the header files: tcsetspeed(). Access to this
++ interface is allowed only in POSIX builds, and thus the UnixWare 7
++ version of C-Kermit is POSIX-based, unlike C-Kermit for Unixware 1.x
++ and 2.x (since the earlier UnixWare versions did not support high
++ serial speeds, period).
++
++ HOWEVER, turning on POSIX features engages all of the "#if
++ (!_POSIX_SOURCE)" clauses in the UnixWare header files, which in turn
++ prevent us from having modem signals, access to the hardware flow
++ control APIs, select(), etc -- in short, all the other things we need
++ in communications software, especially when high speeds are used. Oh
++ the irony. And so C-Kermit must be shamelessly butchered -- as it has
++ been so many times before -- to allow us to have the needed features
++ from the POSIX and non-POSIX worlds. See the UNIXWAREPOSIX sections of
++ [471]ckutio.c.
++
++ After the butchery, we wind up with Unixware 2.x having full
++ modem-signal capability, but politically-correct Unixware 7.x lacking
++ the ability to automatically detect a broken connection when carrier
++ drops.
++
++ Meanwhile the Unixware tcsetspeed() function allows any number at all
++ (any long, 0 or positive) as an argument and succeeds if the number is
++ a legal bit rate for the serial device, and fails otherwise. There is
++ no list anywhere of legal speeds. Thus the SET SPEED keyword table
++ ("set speed ?" to see it) is hardwired based on trial and error with
++ all known serial speeds, the maximum being 115200. However, to allow
++ for the possibility that other speeds might be allowed in the future
++ (or with different port drivers), the SET SPEED command for UnixWare 7
++ only allows you to specify any number at all; a warning is printed if
++ the number is not in the list, but the number is accepted anyway; the
++ command succeeds if tcsetspeed() accepts the number, and fails
++ otherwise.
++
++ In C-Kermit 8.0 testing, it was noticed that the POSIX method for
++ hanging up the phone by dropping DTR (set speed 0, pause, restore
++ speed) did not actually drop DTR. The APIs do not return any error
++ indication, but nothing happens. I changed tthang() to skip the
++ special case I had made for Unixware and instead follow the normal
++ path: if TIOCSDTR is defined use that, otherwise blah blah... It turns
++ out TIOCSDTR *is* defined, and it works.
++
++ So in Unixware (at least in 2.1.3) we can read modem signals, hangup
++ by toggling DTR, and so on, BUT... But once the remote hangs up and
++ Carrier drops, the API for reading modem signals ceases to function;
++ although the device is still open, the TIOCMGET ioctl always raises
++ errno 6 = ENXIO, "No such device or address".
++
++ Old business:
++
++ Using C-Kermit 6.0 on the UnixWare 1.1 Application Server, one user
++ reported a system panic when the following script program is executed:
++
++ set line /dev/tty4
++ set speed 9600
++ output \13
++ connect
++
++ The panic does not happen if a PAUSE is inserted:
++
++ set line /dev/tty4
++ set speed 9600
++ pause 1
++ output \13
++ connect
++
++ This is using a Stallion EasyIO card installed as board 0 on IRQ 12 on
++ a Gateway 386 with the Stallion-supplied driver. The problem was
++ reported to Novell and Stallion and (reportedly) is now fixed.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.11. C-KERMIT AND APOLLO SR10
++
++ [ [472]Top ] [ [473]Contents ] [ [474]Section Contents ] [ [475]Next ]
++ [ [476]Previous ]
++
++ Reportedly, version 5A(190), when built under Apollo SR10 using "make
++ sr10-bsd", compiles, links, and executes OK, but leaves the terminal
++ unusable after it exits -- the "cs7" or "cs8" (character size)
++ parameter has become cs5. The terminal must be reset from another
++ terminal. Cause and cure unknown. Suggested workaround: Wrap Kermit in
++ a shell script something like:
++
++ kermit @*
++ stty sane
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.12. C-KERMIT AND TANDY XENIX 3.0
++
++ [ [477]Top ] [ [478]Contents ] [ [479]Section Contents ] [ [480]Next ]
++ [ [481]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 was too big to be built on Tandy Xenix, even in a minimum
++ configuration; version 6.0 is the last one that fits.
++
++ Reportedly, in C-Kermit 6.0, if you type lots of Ctrl-C's during
++ execution of the initialization file, ghost Kermit processes will be
++ created, and will compete for the keyboard. They can only be removed
++ via "kill -9" from another terminal, or by rebooting. Diagnosis --
++ something strange happening with the SIGINT handler while the process
++ is reading the directory (it seems to occur during the SET PROMPT
++ [\v(dir)] ... sequence). Cure: unknown. Workaround: don't interrupt
++ C-Kermit while it is executing its init file on the Tandy 16/6000.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.13. C-KERMIT AND OSF/1 (DIGITAL UNIX) (TRU64 UNIX)
++
++ [ [482]Top ] [ [483]Contents ] [ [484]Section Contents ] [ [485]Next ]
++ [ [486]Previous ]
++
++ While putting together and testing C-Kermit 8.0, it was discovered
++ that binaries built for one version of Tru64 Unix (e.g. 4.0G) might
++ exhibit very strange behavior if run on a different version of Tru64
++ Unix (e.g. 5.1A). The typical symptom was that a section of the
++ initialization file would be skipped, notably locating the dialing
++ and/or network directory as well as finding and executing the
++ customization file, ~/.mykermrc. This problem also is reported to
++ occur on Tru64 Unix 5.0 (Rev 732) even when running a C-Kermit binary
++ that was built there. However, the Tru64 5.1A binary works correctly
++ on 5.0. Go figure.
++
++ When making Telnet connections to a Digital Unix or Tru64 system, and
++ your Telnet client forwards your user name, the Telnet server
++ evidently stuffs the username into login's standard input, and you
++ see:
++
++ login: ivan
++ Password:
++
++ This is clearly going to play havoc with scripts that look for
++ "login:". Workaround (when Kermit is your Telnet client): SET LOGIN
++ USER to nothing, to prevent Kermit from sending your user ID.
++
++ Before you can use a serial port on a new Digital Unix system, you
++ must run uucpsetup to enable or configure the port. Evidently the
++ /dev/tty00 and 01 devices that appear in the configuration are not
++ usable; uucpsetup turns them into /dev/ttyd00 and 01, which are. Note
++ that uucpsetup and other uucp-family programs are quite primitive --
++ they only know about speeds up to 9600 bps and their selection of
++ modems dates from the early 1980s. None of this affects Kermit, though
++ -- with C-Kermit, you can use speeds up to 115200 bps (at least in
++ DU4.0 and later) and modern modems with hardware flow control and all
++ the rest.
++
++ Reportedly, if a modem is set for &S0 (assert DSR at all times), the
++ system resets or drops DTR every 30 seconds; reportedly DEC says to
++ set &S1.
++
++ Digital Unix 3.2 evidently wants to believe your terminal is one line
++ longer than you say it is, e.g. when a "more" or "man" command is
++ given. This is has nothing to do with C-Kermit, but tends to annoy
++ those who use Kermit or other terminal emulators to access Digital
++ Unix systems. Workaround: tell Unix to "stty rows 23" (or whatever).
++
++ Reportedly, there is some bizarre behavior when trying to use a
++ version of C-Kermit built on one Digital Unix 4.0 system on another
++ one, possibly due to differing OS or library revision levels; for
++ example, the inability to connect to certain TCP/IP hosts. Solution:
++ rebuild C-Kermit from source code on the system where you will be
++ using it.
++
++ Digital Unix tgetstr() causes a segmentation fault. C-Kermit 7.0 added
++ #ifdefs to avoid calling this routine in Digital Unix. As a result,
++ the SCREEN commands always send ANSI escape sequences -- even though
++ curses knows your actual terminal type.
++
++ Reportedy the Tru64 Unix 4.0E 1091 Telnet server does not tolerate
++ streaming transfers into itself, at least not when the sending Kermit
++ is on the same local network. Solution: tell one Kermit or the other
++ (or both) to "set streaming off". This might or might be the case with
++ earlier and/or later Tru64, Digital Unix, and OSF/1 releases.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.14. C-KERMIT AND SGI IRIX
++
++ [ [487]Top ] [ [488]Contents ] [ [489]Section Contents ] [ [490]Next ]
++ [ [491]Previous ]
++
++ See also:
++ * The [492]comp.sys.sgi.misc and [493]comp.sys.sgi.admin newsgroups.
++ [494]The SGI website
++ * The SGI FAQ:
++ + [495]http://www-viz.tamu.edu/~sgi-faq/
++ + [496]ftp://viz.tamu.edu/pub/sgi/faq/
++
++ About IRIX version numbers: "uname -a" tells the "two-digit" version
++ number, such as "5.3" or "6.5". The three-digit form can be seen with
++ "uname -R". (this information is unavailable at the simple API level).
++ Supposedly all three-digit versions within the same two-digit version
++ (e.g. 6.5.2, 6.5.3) are binary compatible; i.e. a binary built on any
++ one of them should run on all others. The "m" suffix denotes just
++ patches; the "f" suffix indicates that features were added.
++
++ An IRIX binary built on lower MIPS model (Instruction Set
++ Architecture, ISA) can run on higher models, but not vice versa:
++
++ MIPS1 R3000 and below
++ MIPS2 R4000
++ MIPS3 R4x00
++ MIPS4 R5000 and above
++
++ Furthermore, there are different Application Binary Inferfaces (ABIs):
++
++ COFF 32 bits, IRIX 5.3, 5.2, 5.1, 4.x and below
++ o32 ELF 32 bits, IRIX 5.3, 6.0 - 6.5
++ N32 ELF 32 bits, IRIX 6.2 - 6.5
++ N64 ELF 64 bits, IRIX 6.2 - 6.5
++
++ Thus a prebuilt IRIX binary works on a particular machine only if (a)
++ the machine's IRIX version (to one decimal place) is equal to or
++ greater than the version under which the binary was built; (b) the
++ machine's MIPS level is greater or equal to that of the binary; and
++ (c) the machine supports the ABI of the binary. If all three
++ conditions are not satisfied, of course, you can build a binary
++ yourself from source code since, unlike some other Unix vendors, SGI
++ does supply a C compiler and libraries.
++
++ SGI did not supply an API for hardware flow control prior to IRIX 5.2.
++ C-Kermit 6.1 and higher for IRIX 5.2 and higher supports hardware flow
++ control in the normal way, via "set flow rts/cts".
++
++ For hardware flow control on earlier IRIX and/or C-Kermit versions,
++ use the ttyf* (modem control AND hardware flow control) devices and
++ not the ttyd* (direct) or ttym* (modem control but no hardware flow
++ control) ones, and obtain the proper "hardware handshaking" cable from
++ SGI, which is incompatible with the ones for the Macintosh and NeXT
++ even though they look the same ("man serial" for further info) and
++ tell Kermit to "set flow keep" and "set modem flow rts/cts".
++
++ Serial speeds higher than 38400 are available in IRIX 6.2 and later,
++ on O-class machines (e.g. Origin, Octane) only, and are supported by
++ C-Kermit 7.0 and later. Commands such as "set speed 115200" may be
++ given on other models (e.g. Iris, Indy, Indigo) but will fail because
++ the OS reports an invalid speed for the device.
++
++ Experimentation with both IRIX 5.3 and 6.2 shows that when logged in
++ to IRIX via Telnet, that remote-mode C-Kermit can't send files if the
++ packet length is greater than 4096; the Telnet server evidently has
++ this restriction (or bug), since there is no problem sending long
++ packets on serial or rlogin connections. However, it can receive files
++ with no problem if the packet length is greater than 4096. As a
++ workaround, the FAST macro for IRIX includes "set send packet-length
++ 4000". IRIX 6.5.1 does not have this problem, so evidently it was
++ fixed some time after IRIX 6.2. Tests show file-transfer speeds are
++ better (not worse) with 8K packets than with 4K packets from IRIX
++ 6.5.1.
++
++ Reportedly some Indys have bad serial port hardware. IRIX 5.2, for
++ example, needs patch 151 to work around this; or upgrade to a later
++ release. Similarly, IRIX 5.2 has several problems with serial i/o,
++ flow control, etc. Again, patch or upgrade.
++
++ Reportedly on machines with IRIX 4.0, Kermit cannot be suspended by
++ typing the suspend ("swtch") character if it was started from csh,
++ even though other programs can be suspended this way, and even though
++ the Z and SUSPEND commands still work correctly. This is evidently
++ because IRIX's csh does not deliver the SIGTSTP signal to Kermit. The
++ reason other programs can be suspended in the same environment is
++ probably that they do not trap SIGTSTP themselves, so the shell is
++ doing the suspending rather than the application.
++
++ Also see notes about IRIX 3.x in the [497]C-Kermit for Unix
++ Installation Instructions.
++
++ If you have problems making TCP/IP connections in versions of IRIX
++ built with GCC 2.95.2, see the bugs section of:
++
++ [498]http://freeware.sgi.com/Installable/gcc-2.95.2.html.
++
++ Reportedly, if you allow gcc to compile C-Kermit on Irix you should be
++ aware that there might be problems with some of the network code. The
++ specifics are at
++ [499]http://freeware.sgi.com/Installable/gcc-2.95.2.html; scroll down
++ to the "known bugs" section at the end of the document.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.15. C-KERMIT AND THE BEBOX
++
++ [ [500]Top ] [ [501]Contents ] [ [502]Section Contents ] [ [503]Next ]
++ [ [504]Previous ]
++
++ See also: The [505]comp.sys.be newsgroup.
++
++ The BeBox has been discontinued and BeOS repositioned for PC
++ platforms. The POSIX parts of BeOS are not finished, nor is the
++ sockets library, therefore a fully functional version of C-Kermit is
++ not possible. In version 6.0 of C-Kermit, written for BeOS DR7, it was
++ possible to:
++
++ * set line /dev/serial2 (and probably the other serial ports)
++ * set speed 115200 (and at least some of the lower baud rates)
++ * connect
++ * set modem type hayes (and likely others, too)
++ * dial phone-number
++ * set send packet-length 2048 (other lengths for both send and
++ receive)
++ * set receive packet length 2048
++ * set file type binary (text mode works, too) (with remote kermit
++ session in server mode)
++ * put bedrop.jpg
++ * get bedrop.jpg
++ * get bedrop.jpg bedrop.jpg2
++ * finish, bye
++
++ The following do not work:
++ * kermit does not detect modem hangup
++ * !/RUN/PUSH [commandline command]
++ * Running kermit in remote mode
++ * Using other protocols (x/y/zmodem)
++ * TCP networking interface (Be's TCP/IP API has a ways to go, still)
++
++ C-Kermit does not work on BeOS DR8 because of changes in the
++ underlying APIs. Unfortunately not enough changes were made to allow
++ the regular POSIX-based C-Kermit to work either. Note: the lack of a
++ fork() service requires the select()-based CONNECT module, but there
++ is no select(). There is a select() in DR8, but it doesn't work.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 was built for BeOS 4.5 and works in remote mode. It does
++ not include networking support since the APIs are still not there. It
++ is not known if dialing out works, but probably not. Be experts are
++ welcome to lend a hand.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.16. C-KERMIT AND DG/UX
++
++ [ [506]Top ] [ [507]Contents ] [ [508]Section Contents ] [ [509]Next ]
++ [ [510]Previous ]
++
++ Somebody downloaded the C-Kermit 6.0 binary built under DG/UX 5.40 and
++ ran it under DG/UX 5.4R3.10 -- it worked OK except that file dates for
++ incoming files were all written as 1 Jan 1970. Cause and cure unknown.
++ Workaround: SET ATTRIBUTE DATE OFF. Better: Use a version of C-Kermit
++ built under and for DG/UX 5.4R3.10.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.17. C-KERMIT AND SEQUENT DYNIX
++
++ [ [511]Top ] [ [512]Contents ] [ [513]Section Contents ] [ [514]Next ]
++ [ [515]Previous ]
++
++ Reportedly, when coming into a Sequent Unix (DYNIX) system through an
++ X.25 connection, Kermit doesn't work right because the Sequent's
++ FIONREAD ioctl returns incorrect data. To work around, use the
++ 1-character-at-a-time version of myread() in ckutio.c (i.e. undefine
++ MYREAD in ckutio.c and rebuild the program). This is unsatisfying
++ because two versions of the program would be needed -- one for use
++ over X.25, and the other for serial and TCP/IP connections.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.18. C-KERMIT AND {FREE,OPEN,NET}BSD
++
++ [ [516]Top ] [ [517]Contents ] [ [518]Section Contents ] [ [519]Next ]
++ [ [520]Previous ]
++
++ Some NebBSD users have reported difficulty escaping back from CONNECT
++ mode, usually when running NetBSD on non-PC hardware. Probably a
++ keyboard issue.
++
++ NetBSD users have also reported that C-Kermit doesn't pop back to the
++ prompt if the modem drops carrier. This needs to be checked out &
++ fixed if possible.
++
++ (All the above seems to work properly in C-Kermit 7.0 and later.)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.19. C-KERMIT AND MAC OS X (Rhapsody, Darwin, Jaguar, Panther)
++
++ [ [521]Top ] [ [522]Contents ] [ [523]Section Contents ] [ [524]Next ]
++ [ [525]Previous ]
++
++ Mac OS X is Apple's 4.4BSD Unix variety, closely related to FreeBSD,
++ but different. "uname -a" is singularly uninformative, as in Linux,
++ giving only the Darwin kernel version number. As far as I can tell,
++ there is no way to find out the Mac OS X version number, such as 10.3
++ (in Linux you can find the distribution version in a
++ distribution-dependent file). Here are some points to be aware of:
++
++ * The biggest gotcha for Kermit users is that Mac OS X does not
++ support serial ports and, as far as I can tell, doesn't support
++ its built-in modem either, for anything other than making Internet
++ connections. Macintoshes capable of running Mac OS X, such as the
++ G5, some without serial ports and without any APIs to support
++ them, and also without the UUCP family of programs (including cu),
++ nor any standard for serial-port lockfile directory.
++ * At least early versions of Mac OS X came without Curses, Termlib,
++ or Terminfo libraries. Later versions seem to have ncurses. Kermit
++ uses curses for its file-transfer display. See elsewhere about
++ curses-vs-ncurses confusion.
++ * In the HFS+ file system, filenames are case-folded. Thus
++ "makefile" and "Makefile" are the same file. The UFS file system
++ is, like normal Unix, case-sensitive.
++ * Files that are composed of a resource fork and a data fork... I
++ doubt that C-Kermit does anything useful with them. There is no
++ code in C-Kermit for traditional two-forked Macintosh files, but
++ it could be added if there is any demand.
++ * In case you want to transfer a traditional Macintosh text file (or
++ data fork of a file that is plain text), you can use these
++ C-Kermit commands:
++
++set file eol cr
++set file character-set apple-quickdraw
++send /text filename
++
++ * File or pathnames that include spaces must be enclosed in either
++ doublequotes or curly braces in C-Kermit commands.
++ * Mac OS X has its own package format for applications, called
++ "fink". Various fink packages for C-Kermit are floating around
++ that are not standard releases. For example, there's a C-Kermit
++ 8.0.201 package in which C-Kermit was modifed (at least) to use a
++ UUCP lockfile directory that does not exist on vanilla Mac OS X
++ systems.
++
++ Mac OS X and Serial Ports
++
++ Apple is in the forefront of companies that believe serial ports have
++ no use in the modern world and so has simply eliminated all traces of
++ them from its machines and OS. But of course serial ports are still
++ needed to connect not only to external modems, but also to the control
++ ports of hubs, routers, terminal servers, PBXs, and similar devices,
++ not to mention barcode readers, POS systems and components, automated
++ factory-floor equipment, and scientific, medical, and lab equipment
++ (to name a few). Among workers in these areas, there is a need to add
++ serial ports back onto this platform, which is being filled by
++ third-party products such as the [526]Keyspan USB Serial Adapter. To
++ use the Keyspan device, you must install the accompanying device
++ drivers, which wind up giving you serial ports with names like
++ /dev/cu.USA19H3b1P1.1.
++
++ To configure your Mac OS X system to allow C-Kermit to use these (or
++ any other) serial devices:
++
++ 1. su
++ chgrp xxxx /var/spool/lock
++ chmod g+w /var/spool/lock
++ chgrp xxxx /dev/cu.*
++ (where xxxx is the name of the group for users to whom serial-port
++ access is to be granted). Use "admin" or other existing group, or
++ create a new group if desired. NB:
++
++ In the absence of official guidance from Apple or anyone else, we
++ choose /var/spool/lock as the lockfile directory because this
++ directory (a) already exists on vanilla Mac OS X installations, and
++ (b) it is the directory used for serial-port lockfiles on many
++ other platforms.
++ 2. Put all users who need access to the serial port in the same
++ group.
++ 3. Make sure the serial device files that are to be used by C-Kermit
++ have group read-write permission and (if you care) lack world
++ read-write permission, e.g.:
++ chmod g+rw,o-rw /dev/cu.*
++
++ If you do the above, then there's no need to become root to use
++ Kermit, or to make Kermit suid or sgid. Just do this:
++
++chmod 775 wermit
++mv wermit /usr/local/bin/kermit
++
++ (or whatever spot is more appropriate). For greater detail about
++ installation (man page, etc), [527]CLICK HERE.
++
++ Back when Macs had serial ports, they were not RS-232 (the standard
++ for connecting computers with nearby modems) but rather RS-422 or -423
++ (a standard for connecting serial devices over longer distances).
++ Macintosh serial ports do not support modems well because they do not
++ have enough wires (or more properly in the case RS-422/423, wire
++ pairs) to convey a useful subset of modem signals. The Keyspan USB
++ adapter gives you two Mini-Din8 RS-422 ports, that are no better (or
++ worse) for communicating with modems or serial devices than a real Mac
++ Din-8 port was. In essense, you get Data In, Data Out, and two modem
++ signals. It looks to me as if the signals chosen by Keyspan are RTS
++ and CTS. This gives you hardware flow control, but at the expense of
++ Carrier Detect. Thus to use C-Kermit with a Keyspan USB serial port,
++ you must tell C-Kermit to:
++
++set modem type none ; (don't expect a modem)
++set carrier-watch off ; (ignore carrier signal)
++set port /dev/cu.USA19H3b1P1.1 ; (open the port)
++set flow rts/cts ; (this is the default)
++set speed 57600 ; (or whatever)
++connect ; (or whatever)
++
++ Use Ctrl-\C in the normal manner to escape back to the C-Kermit>
++ prompt. Kermit can't pop back to its prompt automatically when Carrier
++ drops because there is no Carrier signal.
++
++ Instructions for the built-in modem remain to be written.
++
++ Links:
++ * [528]Unix tips for Mac OS X (Jerry Stratton)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.20. C-KERMIT AND COHERENT
++
++ [ [529]Top ] [ [530]Contents ] [ [531]Section Contents ] [
++ [532]Previous ]
++
++ Also see:
++
++ [533]http://www.uni-giessen.de/faq/archiv/coherent-faq.general/msg00
++ 000.html
++
++ Mark Williams COHERENT was perhaps the first commercial Unix-based
++ operating system for PCs, first appearing about 1983 or -84 for the
++ PC/XT (?), and popular until about 1993, when Linux took over.
++ C-Kermit, as of version 8.0, is still current for COHERENT 386 4.2
++ (i.e. only for i386 and above). Curses is included, but lots of other
++ features are omitted due to lack of the appropriate OS features, APIs,
++ libraries, hardware, or just space: e.g. TCP/IP, floating-point
++ arithmetic, learned scripts. Earlier versions of COHERENT ran on 8086
++ and 80286, but these are to small to build or run C-Kermit, but
++ G-Kermit should be OK (as might be ancient versions of C-Kermit).
++
++ You can actually build a version with floating point support -- just
++ take -DNOFLOAT out of CFLAGS and add -lm to LIBS; NOFLOAT is the
++ default because COHERENT tends to run on old PCs that don't have
++ floating-point hardware. You can also add "-f" to CFLAGS to have it
++ link in the floating-point emulation library. Also I'm not sure why
++ -DNOLEARN is included, since it depends on select(), which COHERENT
++ has.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4. GENERAL UNIX-SPECIFIC HINTS, LIMITATIONS, AND BUGS
++
++ [ [534]Top ] [ [535]Contents ] [ [536]Next ] [ [537]Previous ]
++
++ 4.1. Modem Signals
++
++ There seems to be an escalating demand for the ability to control
++ "dumb serial devices" (such as "smartcard readers", barcode readers,
++ etc) by explicitly manipulating modem signals, particularly RTS. This
++ might have been easy to do in DOS, where there is no operating system
++ standing between the application and the serial device, but it is
++ problematic in Unix, where modem signals are controlled by the serial
++ device driver. If the driver does not provide an API for doing this,
++ then the application can't do it. If it does provide an API, expect it
++ to be totally different on each Unix platform, since there is no
++ standard for this.
++
++ 4.2. NFS Troubles
++
++ Beginning with C-Kermit 6.0, the default C-Kermit prompt includes your
++ current (working) directory; for example:
++
++ [/usr/olga] C-Kermit>
++
++ (In C-Kermit 7.0 the square braces were replaced by round parentheses
++ to avoid conflicts with ISO 646 national character sets.)
++
++ If that directory is on an NFS-mounted disk, and NFS stops working or
++ the disk becomes unavailable, C-Kermit will hang waiting for NFS
++ and/or the disk to come back. Whether you can interrupt C-Kermit when
++ it is hung this way depends on the specific OS. Kermit has called the
++ operating systems's getcwd() function, and is waiting for it to
++ return. Some versions of Unix (e.g. HP-UX 9.x) allow this function to
++ be interrupted with SIGINT (Ctrl-C), others (such as HP-UX 8.x) do
++ not. To avoid this effect, you can always use SET PROMPT to change
++ your prompt to something that does not involve calling getcwd(), but
++ if NFS is not responding, C-Kermit will still hang any time you give a
++ command that refers to an NFS-mounted directory. Also note that in
++ some cases, the uninterruptibility of NFS-dependent system or library
++ calls is considered a bug, and sometimes there are patches. For HP-UX,
++ for example:
++
++ replaced by:
++ HP-UX 10.20 libc PHCO_8764 PHCO_14891/PHCO_16723
++ HP-UX 10.10 libc PHCO_8763 PHCO_14254/PHCO_16722
++ HP-UX 9.x libc PHCO_7747 S700 PHCO_13095
++ HP-UX 9.x libc PHCO_6779 S800 PHCO_11162
++
++ 4.3. C-Kermit as Login Shell
++
++ You might have reason to make C-Kermit the login shell for a specific
++ user, by entering the pathname of Kermit (possibly with command-line
++ switches, such as -x to put it in server mode) into the shell field of
++ the /etc/passwd file. This works pretty well. In some cases, for
++ "ultimate security", you might want to use a version built with
++ -DNOPUSH (see the [538]Configurations Options document for this, but
++ even if you don't, then PUSHing or shelling out from C-Kermit just
++ brings up a new copy of C-Kermit (but warning: this does not prevent
++ the user from explicitly running a shell; e.g. "run /bin/sh"; use
++ NOPUSH to prevent this).
++
++ 4.4. C-Kermit versus screen and splitvt
++
++ C-Kermit file transfers will probably not work if attemped through the
++ "splitvt" or GNU "screen" programs because the screen optimization (or
++ at least, line wrapping, control-character absorption) done by this
++ package interferes with Kermit's packets.
++
++ The same can apply to any other environment in which the user's
++ session is captured, monitored, recorded, or manipulated. Examples
++ include the 'script' program (for making a typescript of a session),
++ the Computronics PEEK package and pksh (at least versions of it prior
++ to 1.9K), and so on.
++
++ You might try the following -- what we call "doomsday Kermit" --
++ settings to push packets through even the densest and most obstructive
++ connections, such as "screen" and "splitvt" (and certain kinds of 3270
++ protocol emulators): Give these commands to BOTH Kermit programs:
++
++ SET FLOW NONE
++ SET CONTROL PREFIX ALL
++ SET RECEIVE PACKET-LENGTH 70
++ SET RECEIVE START 62
++ SET SEND START 62
++ SET SEND PAUSE 100
++ SET BLOCK B
++
++ If it works, it will be slow.
++
++ 4.5. C-Kermit versus DOS Emulators
++
++ On Unix workstations equipped with DOS emulators like SoftPC, watch
++ out for what these emulators do to the serial port drivers. After
++ using a DOS emulator, particularly if you use it to run DOS
++ communications software, you might have to reconfigure the serial
++ ports for use by Unix.
++
++ 4.6. C-Kermit versus Job Control
++
++ Interruption by Ctrl-Z makes Unix C-Kermit try to suspend itself with
++ kill(0,SIGTSTP), but only on platforms that support job control, as
++ determined by whether the symbol SIGTSTP is defined (or on POSIX or
++ SVR4 systems, if syconf(_SC_JOB_CONTROL) or _POSIX_JOB_CONTROL in
++ addition to SIGTSTP). However, if Kermit is running under a login
++ shell (such as the original Bourne shell) that does not support job
++ control, the user's session hangs and must be logged out from another
++ terminal, or hung up on. There is no way Kermit can defend itself
++ against this. If you use a non-job control shell on a computer that
++ supports job control, give a command like "stty susp undef" to fix it
++ so the suspend signal is not attached to any particular key, or give
++ the command SET SUSPEND OFF to C-Kermit, or build C-Kermit with
++ -DNOJC.
++
++ 4.7. Dates and Times
++
++ Unix time conversion functions typically apply locale rules to return
++ local time in terms of any seasonal time zone change in effect for the
++ given date. The diffdate function assumes that the same timezone rules
++ are in effect for both dates, but a date with timezone information
++ will be converted to the local time zone in effect at the given time,
++ e.g., a GMT specification will produce either a Standard Time or
++ Daylight Savings Time, depending on which applies at the given time.
++ An example using the 2001 seasonal change from EDT (-0400) to EST
++ (-0500):
++
++ C-Kermit> DATE 20011028 05:01:02 GMT ; EDT
++ 20011028 01:01:02
++ C-Kermit> DATE 20011028 06:01:02 GMT ; EST
++ 20011028 01:01:02
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ but the implicit change in timezone offset is not recognized:
++
++ C-Kermit> echo \fdiffdate(20011028 05:01:02 GMT, 20011028 06:01:02 GMT)
++ +0:00
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ Date/time arithmetic, offsets, delta times, and timezone support are
++ new to C-Kermit 8.0, and might be expected to evolve and improve in
++ subsequent releases.
++
++ On some platforms, files downloaded with HTTP receive the current
++ timestamp, rather than the HTTP "Last Modified" time (this can be
++ fixed by including utime.h, e.g. in SunOS and Tru64...).
++
++ 4.8. Pseudoterminals
++
++ The SSH and PTY commands work by assigning a pseudoterminal and
++ reading and writing from it. Performance varies according to the
++ specific platform ranging from very fast to very flow.
++
++ SSH and PTY commands can fail if (a) all pseudoterminals are in use;
++ or (b) you do not have read/write access to the pseudoterminal that
++ was assigned. An example of (b) was reported with the Zipslack
++ Slackware Linux distribution, in which the pseudoterminals were
++ created with crw-r--r-- permission, instead of crw-rw-rw-.
++
++ 4.9. Miscellaneous
++
++ * Reportedly, the Unix C-Kermit server, under some conditions, on
++ certain particular systems, fails to log out its login session
++ upon receipt of a BYE command. Before relying on the BYE command
++ working, test it a few times to make sure it works on your system:
++ there might be system configuration or security mechanisms to
++ prevent an inferior process (like Kermit) from killing a superior
++ one (like the login shell).
++ * On AT&T 7300 (3B1) machines, you might have to "stty nl1" before
++ starting C-Kermit. Do this if characters are lost during
++ communications operations.
++ * Under the bash shell (versions prior to 1.07 from CWRU), "pushing"
++ to an inferior shell and then exiting back to Kermit leaves Kermit
++ in the background such that it must be explicitly fg'd. This is
++ reportedly fixed in version 1.07 of bash (and definitely in modern
++ bash versions).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5. INITIALIZATION AND COMMAND FILES
++
++ [ [539]Top ] [ [540]Contents ] [ [541]Next ] [ [542]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit's initialization file for Unix is .kermrc (lowercase, starts
++ with period) in your home directory, unless Kermit was built with the
++ system-wide initialization-file option (see the [543]C-Kermit for Unix
++ Installation Instructions).
++
++ C-Kermit identifies your home directory based on the environment
++ variable, HOME. Most Unix systems set this variable automatically when
++ you log in. If C-Kermit can't find your initialization file, check
++ your HOME variable:
++
++ echo $HOME (at the Unix prompt)
++
++ or:
++
++ echo \$(HOME) (at the C-Kermit prompt)
++
++ If HOME is not defined, or is defined incorrectly, add the appropriate
++ definition to your Unix .profile or .login file, depending on your
++ shell:
++
++ setenv HOME full-pathname-of-your-home-directory (C-Shell, .login file)
++
++ or:
++
++ HOME=full-pathname-of-your-home-directory (sh, ksh, .profile file)
++ export HOME
++
++ NOTE: Various other operations depend on the correct definition of
++ HOME. These include the "tilde-expansion" feature, which allows you to
++ refer to your home directory as "~" in filenames used in C-Kermit
++ commands, e.g.:
++
++ send ~/.kermrc
++
++ as well as the \v(home) variable.
++
++ Prior to version 5A(190), C-Kermit would look for its initialization
++ file in the current directory if it was not found in the home
++ directory. This feature was removed from 5A(190) because it was a
++ security risk. Some people, however, liked this behavior and had
++ .kermrc files in all their directories that would set up things
++ appropriately for the files therein. If you want this behavior, you
++ can accomplish it in various ways, for example:
++
++ * Create a shell alias, for example:
++ alias kd="kermit -Y ./.kermrc"
++ * Create a .kermrc file in your home directory, whose contents are:
++ take ./.kermrc
++
++ Suppose you need to pass a password from the Unix command line to a
++ C-Kermit script program, in such a way that it does not show up in
++ "ps" or "w" listings. Here is a method (not guaranteed to be 100%
++ secure, but definitely more secure than the more obvious methods):
++
++ echo mypassword | kermit myscript
++
++ The "myscript" file contains all the commands that need to be executed
++ during the Kermit session, up to and including EXIT, and also includes
++ an ASK or ASKQ command to read the password from standard input, which
++ has been piped in from the Unix 'echo' command, but it must not
++ include a CONNECT command. Only "kermit myscript" shows up in the ps
++ listing.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6. COMMUNICATION SPEED SELECTION
++
++ [ [544]Top ] [ [545]Contents ] [ [546]Next ] [ [547]Previous ]
++
++ Version-7 based Unix implementations, including 4.3 BSD and earlier
++ and Unix systems based upon BSD, use a 4-bit field to record a serial
++ device's terminal speed. This leaves room for 16 speeds, of which the
++ first 14 are normally:
++
++ 0, 50, 75, 110, 134.5, 150, 200, 300, 600, 1200, 1800, 2400, 4800,
++ and 9600
++
++ The remaining two are usually called EXTA and EXTB, and are defined by
++ the particular Unix implementation. C-Kermit determines which speeds
++ are available on your system based on whether symbols for them are
++ defined in your terminal device header files. EXTA is generally
++ assumed to be 19200 and EXTB 38400, but these assumptions might be
++ wrong, or they might not apply to a particular device that does not
++ support these speeds. Presumably, if you try to set a speed that is
++ not legal on a particular device, the driver will return an error, but
++ this can not be guaranteed.
++
++ On these systems, it is usually not possible to select a speed of
++ 14400 bps for use with V.32bis modems. In that case, use 19200 or
++ 38400 bps, configure your modem to lock its interface speed and to use
++ RTS/CTS flow control, and tell C-Kermit to SET FLOW RTS/CTS and SET
++ DIAL SPEED-MATCHING OFF.
++
++ The situation is similar, but different, in System V. SVID Third
++ Edition lists the same speeds, 0 through 38400.
++
++ Some versions of Unix, and/or terminal device drivers that come with
++ certain third-party add-in high-speed serial communication interfaces,
++ use the low "baud rates" to stand for higher ones. For example, SET
++ SPEED 50 gets you 57600 bps; SET SPEED 75 gets you 76800; SET SPEED
++ 110 gets 115200.
++
++ SCO ODT 3.0 is an example where a "baud-rate-table patch" can be
++ applied that can rotate the tty driver baud rate table such that
++ 600=57600 and 1800=115k baud. Similarly for Digiboard
++ multiport/portservers, which have a "fastbaud" setting that does this.
++ Linux has a "setserial" command that can do it, etc.
++
++ More modern Unixes support POSIX-based speed setting, in which the
++ selection of speeds is not limited by a 4-bit field. C-Kermit 6.1
++ incorporates a new mechanism for finding out (at compile time) which
++ serial speeds are supported by the operating system that does not
++ involve editing of source code by hand; on systems like Solaris 5.1,
++ IRIX 6.2, and SCO OSR5.0.4, "set speed ?" will list speeds up to
++ 460800 or 921600. In C-Kermit 7.0 and later:
++
++ 1. If a symbol for a particular speed (say B230400 for 230400 bps)
++ appears in whatever header file defines acceptable serial speeds
++ (e.g. <termbits.h> or <sys/termios.h> or <sys/ttydev.h>, etc), the
++ corresponding speed will appear in C-Kermit's "set speed ?" list.
++ 2. The fact that a given speed is listed in the header files and
++ appears in C-Kermit's list does not mean the driver will accept
++ it. For example, a computer might have some standard serial ports
++ plus some add-on ones with different drivers that accept a
++ different repertoire of speeds.
++ 3. The fact that a given speed is accepted by the driver does not
++ guarantee the underlying hardware can accept it.
++
++ When Kermit is given a "set speed" command for a particular device,
++ the underlying system service is called to set the speed; its return
++ code is checked and the SET SPEED command fails if the return code
++ indicates failure. Regardless of the system service return status, the
++ device's speed is then read back and if it does not match the speed
++ that was requested, an error message is printed and the command fails.
++
++ Even when the command succeeds, this does not guarantee successful
++ operation at a particular speed, especially a high one. That depends
++ on electricity, information theory, etc. How long is the cable, what
++ is its capacitance, how well is it shielded, etc, not to mention that
++ every connection has two ends and its success depends on both of them.
++ (With the obvious caveats about internal modems, is the cable really
++ connected, interrupt conflicts, etc etc etc).
++
++ Note, in particular, that there is a certain threshold above which
++ modems can not "autobaud" -- i.e. detect the serial interface speed
++ when you type AT (or whatever else the modem's recognition sequence
++ might be). Such modems need to be engaged at a lower speed (say 2400
++ or 9600 or even 115200 -- any speed below their autobaud threshold)
++ and then must be given a modem-specific command (which can be found in
++ the modem manual) to change their interface speed to the desired
++ higher speed, and then the software must also be told to change to the
++ new, higher speed.
++
++ For additional information, read [548]Section 9.5 of the Installation
++ Instructions, plus any platform-specific notes in [549]Section 3
++ above.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7. COMMUNICATIONS AND DIALING
++
++ [ [550]Top ] [ [551]Contents ] [ [552]Next ] [ [553]Previous ]
++
++ 7.1. Serial Ports and Modems
++
++ If you SET LINE to a serial port modem-control device that has nothing
++ plugged in to it, or has a modem connected that is powered off, and
++ you have not given a prior SET MODEM TYPE or SET CARRIER-WATCH OFF
++ command, the SET LINE command is likely to hang. In most cases, you
++ can Ctrl-C out. If not, you'll have to kill C-Kermit from another
++ terminal.
++
++ Similarly, if you give a SET MODEM TYPE HAYES (or USR, or any other
++ modem type besides DIRECT, NONE, or UNKNOWN) and then SET LINE to an
++ empty port, the subsequent close (implicit or explicit) is liable to
++ hang or even crash (through no fault of Kermit's -- the hanging or
++ crashing is inside a system call such as cfsetospeed() or close()).
++
++ The SET CARRIER-WATCH command works as advertised only if the
++ underlying operating system and device drivers support this feature;
++ in particular only if a read() operation returns immediately with an
++ error code if the carrier signal goes away or, failing that, if
++ C-Kermit can obtain the modem signals from the device driver (you can
++ tell by giving a "set line" command to a serial device, and then a
++ "show communications" command -- if modem signals are not listed,
++ C-Kermit won't be able to detect carrier loss, the WAIT command will
++ not work, etc). Of course, the device itself (e.g. modem) must be
++ configured appropriately and the cables convey the carrier and other
++ needed signals, etc.
++
++ If you dial out from Unix system, but then notice a lot of weird
++ character strings being stuck into your session at random times
++ (especially if they look like +++ATQ0H0 or login banners or prompts),
++ that means that getty is also trying to control the same device.
++ You'll need to dial out on a device that is not waiting for a login,
++ or else disable getty on the device.
++
++ As of version 7.0, C-Kermit makes explicit checks for the Carrier
++ Detect signal, and so catches hung-up connections much better than 6.0
++ and earlier. However, it still can not be guaranteed to catch every
++ ever CD on-to-off transition. For example, when the HP-UX version of
++ C-Kermit is in CONNECT mode on a dialed connection and CARRIER-WATCH
++ ON or AUTO, and you turn off the modem, HP-UX is stuck in a read()
++ that never returns. (C-Kermit does not pop back to its prompt
++ automatically, but you can still escape back.)
++
++ If, on the other hand, you log out from the remote system, and it
++ hangs up, and CD drops on the local modem, C-Kermit detects this and
++ pops back to the prompt as it should. (Evidently there can be a
++ difference between CD and DSR turning off at the same time, versus CD
++ turning off while DSR stays on; experimentation with &S0/&S1/&S2 on
++ your modem might produce the desired results).
++
++ When Unix C-Kermit exits, it closes (and must close) the
++ communications device. If you were dialed out, this will most likely
++ hang up the connection. If you want to get out of Kermit and still use
++ Kermit's communication device, you have several choices:
++
++ 1. Shell out from Kermit or suspend Kermit, and refer to the device
++ literally (as in "term -blah -blah < /dev/cua > /dev/cua").
++ 2. Shell out from Kermit and use the device's file descriptor which
++ Kermit makes available to you in the \v(ttyfd) variable.
++ 3. Use C-Kermit's REDIRECT command.
++ 4. Use C-Kermit new EXEC /REDIRECT command.
++
++ If you are having trouble dialing:
++
++ 1. Make sure the dialout line is configured correctly. More about
++ this below.
++ 2. Make sure all necessary patches are installed for your operating
++ system.
++ 3. If you can't dial on a "bidirectional" line, then configure it for
++ outbound-only (remove the getty) and try again. (The mechanisms --
++ if any -- for grabbing bidirectional lines for dialout vary wildly
++ among Unix implementations and releases, and C-Kermit -- which
++ runs on well over 300 different Unix variations -- makes no effort
++ to keep up with them; the recommended method for coping with this
++ situation is to wrap C-Kermit in a shell script that takes the
++ appropriate actions.)
++ 4. Make sure C-Kermit's SET DIAL and SET MODEM parameters agree with
++ the modem you are actually using -- pay particular attention to
++ SET DIAL SPEED-MATCHING.
++ 5. If MODEM HANGUP-METHOD is set to RS232-SIGNAL, change it to
++ MODEM-COMMAND. Or vice-versa.
++ 6. Try SET DIAL HANGUP OFF before the DIAL command. Also, SET DIAL
++ DISPLAY ON to watch what's happening. See [554]Section 8 of the
++ [555]Installation Instructions.
++ 7. Read pages 50-67 of [556]Using C-Kermit.
++ 8. As a last resort, don't use the DIAL command at all; SET CARRIER
++ OFF and CONNECT to the modem and dial interactively, or write a
++ script program to dial the modem.
++
++ Make sure your dialout line is correctly configured for dialing out
++ (as opposed to login). The method for doing this is different for each
++ kind of Unix system. Consult your system documentation for configuring
++ lines for dialing out (for example, Sun SparcStation IPC users should
++ read the section "Setting up Modem Software" in the Desktop SPARC Sun
++ System & Network Manager's Guide; HP-9000 workstation users should
++ consult the manual Configuring HP-UX for Peripherals, etc).
++
++ Symptom: DIAL works, but a subsequent CONNECT command does not.
++ Diagnosis: the modem is not asserting Carrier Detect (CD) after the
++ connection is made, or the cable does not convey the CD signal. Cure:
++ Reconfigure the modem, replace the cable. Workaround: SET CARRIER OFF
++ (at least in System-V based Unix versions).
++
++ For Berkeley-Unix-based systems (4.3BSD and earlier), Kermit includes
++ code to use LPASS8 mode when parity is none, which is supposed to
++ allow 8-bit data and Xon/Xoff flow control at the same time. However,
++ as of edit 174, this code is entirely disabled because it is
++ unreliable: even though the host operating system might (or might not)
++ support LPASS8 mode correctly, the host access protocols (terminal
++ servers, telnet, rlogin, etc) generally have no way of finding out
++ about it and therefore render it ineffective, causing file transfer
++ failures. So as of edit 174, Kermit once again uses rawmode for 8-bit
++ data, and so there is no Xon/Xoff flow control during file transfer or
++ terminal emulation in the Berkeley-based versions (4.3 and earlier,
++ not 4.4).
++
++ Also on Berkeley-based systems (4.3 and earlier), there is apparently
++ no way to configure a dialout line for proper carrier handling, i.e.
++ ignore carrier during dialing, require carrier thereafter, get a fatal
++ error on any attempt to read from the device after carrier drops (this
++ is handled nicely in System V by manipulation of the CLOCAL flag). The
++ symptom is that carrier loss does not make C-Kermit pop back to the
++ prompt automatically. This is evident on the NeXT, for example, but
++ not on SunOS, which supports the CLOCAL flag. This is not a Kermit
++ problem, but a limitation of the underlying operating system. For
++ example, the cu program on the NeXT doesn't notice carrier loss
++ either, whereas cu on the Sun does.
++
++ On certain AT&T Unix systems equipped with AT&T modems, DIAL and
++ HANGUP don't work right. Workarounds: (1) SET DIAL HANGUP OFF before
++ attempting to dial; (2) If HANGUP doesn't work, SET LINE, and then SET
++ LINE <device> to totally close and reopen the device. If all else
++ fails, SET CARRIER OFF.
++
++ C-Kermit does not contain any particular support for AT&T DataKit
++ devices. You can use Kermit software to dial in to a DataKit line, but
++ C-Kermit does not contain the specialized code required to dial out
++ from a DataKit line. If the Unix system is connected to DataKit via
++ serial ports, dialout should work normally (e.g. set line /dev/ttym1,
++ set speed 19200, connect, and then see the DESTINATION: prompt, from
++ which you can connect to another computer on the DataKit network or to
++ an outgoing modem pool, etc). But if the Unix system is connected to
++ the DataKit network through the special DataKit interface board, then
++ SET LINE to a DataKit pseudodevice (such as /dev/dk031t) will not work
++ (you must use the DataKit "dk" or "dkcu" program instead). In C-Kermit
++ 7.0 and later, you can make Kermit connections "though" dk or dkcu
++ using "set line /pty".
++
++ In some BSD-based Unix C-Kermit versions, SET LINE to a port that has
++ nothing plugged in to it with SET CARRIER ON will hang the program (as
++ it should), but it can't be interrupted with Ctrl-C. The interrupt
++ trap is correctly armed, but apparently the Unix open() call cannot be
++ interrupted in this case. When SET CARRIER is OFF or AUTO, the SET
++ LINE will eventually return, but then the program hangs
++ (uninterruptibly) when the EXIT or QUIT command (or, presumably,
++ another SET LINE command) is given. The latter is probably because of
++ the attempt to hang up the modem. (In edit 169, a timeout alarm was
++ placed around this operation.)
++
++ With SET DIAL HANGUP OFF in effect, the DIAL command might work only
++ once, but not again on the same device. In that case, give a CLOSE
++ command to close the device, and then another SET LINE command to
++ re-open the same device. Or rebuild your version of Kermit with the
++ -DCLSOPN compile-time switch.
++
++ The DIAL command says "To cancel: Type your interrupt character
++ (normally Ctrl-C)." This is just one example of where program messages
++ and documentation assume your interrupt character is Ctrl-C. But it
++ might be something else. In most (but not necessarily all) cases, the
++ character referred to is the one that generates the SIGINT signal. If
++ Ctrl-C doesn't act as an interrupt character for you, type the Unix
++ command "stty -a" or "stty all" or "stty everything" to see what your
++ interrupt character is. (Kermit could be made to find out what the
++ interrupt character is, but this would require a lot of
++ platform-dependent coding and #ifdefs, and a new routine and interface
++ between the platform-dependent and platform-independent parts of the
++ program.)
++
++ In general, the hangup operation on a serial communication device is
++ prone to failure. C-Kermit tries to support many, many different kinds
++ of computers, and there seems to be no portable method for hanging up
++ a modem connection (i.e. turning off the RS-232 DTR signal and then
++ turning it back on again). If HANGUP, DIAL, and/or Ctrl-\H do not work
++ for you, and you are a programmer, look at the tthang() function in
++ ckutio.c and see if you can add code to make it work correctly for
++ your system, and send the code to the address above. (NOTE: This
++ problem has been largely sidestepped as of edit 188, in which Kermit
++ first attempts to hang up the modem by "escaping back" via +++ and
++ then giving the modem's hangup command, e.g. ATH0, when DIAL
++ MODEM-HANGUP is ON, which is the default setting.)
++
++ Even when Kermit's modem-control software is configured correctly for
++ your computer, it can only work right if your modem is also configured
++ to assert the CD signal when it is connected to the remote modem and
++ to hang up the connection when your computer drops the DTR signal. So
++ before deciding Kermit doesn't work with your modem, check your modem
++ configuration AND the cable (if any) connecting your modem to the
++ computer -- it should be a straight-through modem cable conducting the
++ signals FG, SG, TD, RD, RTS, CTS, DSR, DTR, CD, and RI.
++
++ Many Unix systems keep aliases for dialout devices; for example,
++ /dev/acu might be an alias for /dev/tty00. But most of these Unix
++ systems also use UUCP lockfile conventions that do not take this
++ aliasing into account, so if one user assigns (e.g.) /dev/acu, then
++ another user can still assign the same device by referring to its
++ other name. This is not a Kermit problem -- Kermit must follow the
++ lockfile conventions used by the vendor-supplied software (cu, tip,
++ uucp).
++
++ The SET FLOW-CONTROL KEEP option should be given *before* any
++ communication (dialing, terminal emulation, file transfer,
++ INPUT/OUTPUT/TRANSMIT, etc) is attempted, if you want C-Kermit to use
++ all of the device's preexisting flow-control related settings. The
++ default flow-control setting is XON/XOFF, and it will take effect when
++ the first communication-related command is given, and a subsequent SET
++ FLOW KEEP command will not necessarily know how to restore *all* of
++ the device's original flow-control settings.
++
++ 7.2. Network Connections
++
++ C-Kermit tries to use the 8th bit for data when parity is NONE, and
++ this generally works on real Unix terminal (tty) devices, but it often
++ does not work when the Unix system is accessed over a network via
++ telnet or rlogin protocols, including (in many cases) through terminal
++ servers. For example, an Encore computer with Annex terminal servers
++ only gives a 7-bit path if the rlogin protocol is selected in the
++ terminal server but it gives the full 8 bits if the proprietary RDP
++ protocol is used.
++
++ If file transfer does not work through a host to which you have
++ rlogin'd, use "rlogin -8" rather than "rlogin". If that doesn't work,
++ tell both Kermit programs to "set parity space".
++
++ The Encore TELNET server does not allow long bursts of input. When you
++ have a TELNET connection to an Encore, tell C-Kermit on the Encore to
++ SET RECEIVE PACKET-LENGTH 200 or thereabouts.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8. HARDWARE FLOW CONTROL
++
++ [ [557]Top ] [ [558]Contents ] [ [559]Next ] [ [560]Previous ]
++
++ SET FLOW RTS/CTS is available in Unix C-Kermit only when the
++ underlying operating system provides an Application Program Interface
++ (API) for turning this feature on and off under program control, which
++ turns out to be a rather rare feature among Unix systems. To see if
++ your Unix C-Kermit version supports hardware flow control, type "set
++ flow ?" at the C-Kermit prompt, and look for "rts/cts" among the
++ options. Other common situations include:
++
++ 1. The API is available, so "set flow rts/cts" appears as a valid
++ C-Kermit command, but it doesn't do anything because the device
++ driver (part of the operating system) was never coded to do
++ hardware flow control. This is common among System V R4
++ implementations (details below).
++ 2. The API is not available, so "set flow rts/cts" does NOT appear as
++ a valid C-Kermit command, but you can still get RTS/CTS flow
++ control by selecting a specially named device in your SET LINE
++ command. Examples:
++ + NeXTSTEP: /dev/cufa instead of /dev/cua, /dev/cufb instead of
++ /dev/cub (68040 only; "man zs" for further info).
++ + IRIX: /dev/ttyf2 instead of /dev/ttyd2 or /dev/ttym2 ("man 7
++ serial").
++ 3. The API is available, doesn't work, but a workaround as in (2) can
++ be used.
++ 4. The API is available, but Kermit doesn't know about it. In these
++ cases, you can usually use an stty command to enable RTS/CTS on
++ the device, e.g. "stty crtscts" or "stty ctsflow", "stty rtsflow",
++ before starting Kermit, and then tell Kermit to SET FLOW KEEP.
++ 5. No API and no special device drivers. Hardware flow control is
++ completely unavailable.
++
++ System V R4 based Unixes are supposed to supply a <termiox.h> file,
++ which gives Kermit the necessary interface to command the terminal
++ driver to enable/disable hardware flow control. Unfortunately, but
++ predictably, many implementations of SVR4 whimsically place this file
++ in /usr/include/sys rather than /usr/include (where SVID clearly
++ specifies it should be; see SVID, Third Edition, V1, termiox(BA_DEV).
++ Thus if you build C-Kermit with any of the makefile entries that
++ contain -DTERMIOX or -DSTERMIOX (the latter to select
++ <sys/termiox.h>), C-Kermit will have "set flow rts/cts" and possibly
++ other hardware flow-control related commands. BUT... That does not
++ necessarily mean that they will work. In some cases, the underlying
++ functions are simply not coded into the operating system.
++
++ WARNING: When hardware flow control is available, and you enable in
++ Kermit on a device that is not receiving the CTS signal, Kermit can
++ hang waiting for CTS to come up. This is most easily seen when the
++ local serial port has nothing plugged in to it, or is connected to an
++ external modem that is powered off.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9. TERMINAL CONNECTION AND KEY MAPPING
++
++ [ [561]Top ] [ [562]Contents ] [ [563]Next ] [ [564]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit is not a terminal emulator. Refer to page 147 of [565]Using
++ C-Kermit, 2nd Edition: "Most versions of C-Kermit -- Unix, VMS,
++ AOS/VS, VOS, etc -- provide terminal connection without emulation.
++ These versions act as a 'semitransparent pipe' between the remote
++ computer and your terminal, terminal emulator, console driver, or
++ window, which in turn emulates (or is) a specific kind of terminal."
++ The environment in which you run C-Kermit is up to you.
++
++ If you are an X Windows user, you should be aware of an alternative to
++ xterm that supports VT220 emulation, from Thomas E. Dickey:
++
++ [566]http://dickey.his.com/xterm/xterm.html
++
++ Unix C-Kermit's SET KEY command currently can not be used with keys
++ that generate "wide" scan codes or multibyte sequences, such as
++ workstation function or arrow keys, because Unix C-Kermit does not
++ have direct access to the keyboard.
++
++ However, many Unix workstations and/or console drivers provide their
++ own key mapping feature. With xterm, for example, you can use
++ 'xmodmap' ("man xmodmap" for details); here is an xterm mapping to map
++ the Sun keyboard to DEC VT200 values for use with VT-terminal oriented
++ applications like VMS EVE:
++
++ keycode 101=KP_0
++ keycode 119=KP_1
++ keycode 120=KP_2
++ keycode 121=KP_3
++ keycode 98=KP_4
++ keycode 99=KP_5
++ keycode 100=KP_6
++ keycode 75=KP_7
++ keycode 76=KP_8
++ keycode 77=KP_9
++ keycode 52=KP_F1
++ keycode 53=KP_F2
++ keycode 54=KP_F3
++ keycode 57=KP_Decimal
++ keycode 28=Left
++ keycode 29=Right
++ keycode 30=KP_Separator
++ keycode 105=KP_F4
++ keycode 78=KP_Subtract
++ keycode 8=Left
++ keycode 10=Right
++ keycode 32=Up
++ keycode 33=Down
++ keycode 97=KP_Enter
++
++ Users of Linux consoles can use loadkeys ("man dumpkeys loadkeys
++ keytables" for details. The format used by loadkeys is compatible with
++ that used by Xmodmap, although it is not definitely certain that the
++ keycodes are compatible for different keyboard types (e.g. Sun vs HP
++ vs PC, etc).
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 10. FILE TRANSFER
++
++ [ [567]Top ] [ [568]Contents ] [ [569]Next ] [ [570]Previous ]
++
++ If uploads (or downloads) fail immediately, give the CAUTIOUS command
++ to Kermit and try again. If they still fail, then try SET PREFIXING
++ ALL. If they still fail, try SET PARITY SPACE. If they still fail, try
++ ROBUST.
++
++ If reception (particularly of large files and/or binary files) begins
++ successfully but then fail constently after a certain amount of bytes
++ have been sent, check:
++
++ * Your ulimit ("ulimit -a")
++ * The amount of available space on the target disk ("df ." or "df -k
++ .")
++ * Your personal disk quota (platform- and site-dependent)
++ * The maximum file size on the receiver's file system (e.g. 2GB in
++ old verions the Linux VFS file system, and/or in applications that
++ have not been recoded to use new "large file" APIs).
++ * If it's an NFS-mounted disk (if so, try uploading to a local disk)
++ * Is there an "idle limit" on the receiving end?
++
++ If none of these seem to explain it, then the problem is not size
++ related, but reflects some clash between the file contents and the
++ characteristics of the connection, in which case follow the
++ instructions in the first paragraph of this section.
++
++ Suppose two copies of Kermit are receiving files into the same
++ directory, and the files have the same name, e.g. "foo.bar". Whichever
++ one starts first opens an output file called "foo.bar". The second one
++ sees there is already a foo.bar file, and so renames the existing
++ foo.bar to foo.bar.~1~ (or whatever). When the first file has been
++ received completely, Kermit goes to change its modification time and
++ permissions to those given by the file sender in the Attribute packet.
++ But in Unix, the APIs for doing this take a filename, not a file
++ descriptor. Since the first Kermit's file has been renamed, and the
++ second Kermit is using the original name, the first Kermit changes the
++ modtime and permissions of the second Kermit's file, not its own.
++ Although there might be a way to work around this in the code, e.g.
++ using inode numbers to keep track of which file is which, this would
++ be tricky and most likely not very portable. It's better to set up
++ your application to prevent such things from happening, which is easy
++ enough using the script language, filename templates, etc.
++
++ Suppose you start C-Kermit with a command-line argument to send or
++ receive a file (e.g. "kermit -r") and then type Ctrl-\c immediately
++ afterwards to escape back and initiate the other end of the transfer,
++ BUT your local Kermit's escape character is not Ctrl-\. In this case,
++ the local Kermit passes the Ctrl-\ to the remote system, and if this
++ is Unix, Ctrl-\ is likely to be its SIGQUIT character, which causes
++ the current program to halt and dump core. Well, just about the first
++ thing C-Kermit does when it starts is to disable the SIGQUIT signal.
++ However, it is still possible for SIGQUIT to cause Kermit to quit and
++ dump core if it is delivered while Kermit is being loaded or started,
++ before the signal can be disabled. There's nothing Kermit itself can
++ do about this, but you can prevent it from happening by disabling
++ SIGQUIT in your Unix session. The command is usually something like:
++
++ stty quit undef
++
++ Unix C-Kermit does not reject incoming files on the basis of size.
++ There appears to be no good (reliable, portable) way to determine in
++ advance how much disk space is available, either on the device, or
++ (when quotas or other limits are involved) to the user.
++
++ Unix C-Kermit discards all carriage returns from incoming files when
++ in text mode.
++
++ If C-Kermit has problems creating files in writable directories when
++ it is installed setuid or setgid on BSD-based versions of Unix such as
++ NeXTSTEP 3.0, it probably needs to be rebuilt with the -DSW_ACC_ID
++ compilation switch.
++
++ If you SET FILE DISPLAY FULLSCREEN, and C-Kermit complains "Sorry,
++ terminal type not supported", it means that the terminal library
++ (termcap or termlib) that C-Kermit was built with does not know about
++ a terminal whose name is the current value of your TERM environment
++ variable. If this happens, but you want to have the fullscreen file
++ transfer display, EXIT from C-Kermit and set a Unix terminal type from
++ among the supported values that is also supported by your terminal
++ emulator, or else have an entry for your terminal type added to the
++ system termcap and/or terminfo database.
++
++ If you attempt to suspend C-Kermit during local-mode file transfer and
++ then continue it in the background (via bg), it will block for "tty
++ output" if you are using the FULLSCREEN file transfer display. This is
++ apparently a problem with curses. Moving a local-mode file transfer
++ back and forth between foreground and background works correctly,
++ however, with the SERIAL, CRT, BRIEF, or NONE file transfer displays.
++
++ If C-Kermit's command parser no longer echoes, or otherwise acts
++ strangely, after returning from a file transfer with the fullscreen
++ (curses) display, and the curses library for your version of Unix
++ includes the newterm() function, then try rebuilding your version of
++ C-Kermit with -DCK_NEWTERM. Similarly if it echoes doubly, which might
++ even happen during a subsequent CONNECT session. If rebuilding with
++ -DCK_NEWTERM doesn't fix it, then there is something very strange
++ about your system's curses library, and you should probably not use
++ it. Tell C-Kermit to SET FILE DISPLAY CRT, BRIEF, or anything else
++ other than FULLSCREEN, and/or rebuild without -DCK_CURSES, and without
++ linking with (termlib and) curses. Note: This problem seemed to have
++ escalated in C-Kermit 7.0, and -DCK_NEWTERM had to be added to many
++ builds that previously worked without it: Linux, AIX 4.1, DG/UX, etc.
++ In the Linux case, it is obviously because of changes in the (n)curses
++ library; the cause in the other cases is not known.
++
++ C-Kermit creates backup-file names (such as "oofa.txt.~1~") based on
++ its knowledge of the maximum filename length on the platform where it
++ is running, which is learned at compile time, based on MAXNAMLEN or
++ equivalent symbols from the system header files. But suppose C-Kermit
++ is receiving files on a Unix platform that supports long filenames,
++ but the incoming files are being stored on an NFS-mounted file system
++ that supports only short names. NFS maps the external system to the
++ local APIs, so C-Kermit has no way of knowing that long names will be
++ truncated. Or that C-Kermit is running on a version of Unix that
++ supports both long-name and short-name file systems simultaneously
++ (such as HP-UX 7.00). This can cause unexpected behavior when creating
++ backup files, or worse. For example, you are sending a group of files
++ whose names are differentiated only by characters past the point at
++ which they would be truncated, each file will overwrite the previous
++ one upon arrival.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11. EXTERNAL FILE TRANSFER PROTOCOLS
++
++ [ [571]Top ] [ [572]Contents ] [ [573]Next ] [ [574]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 11.1. [575]C-Kermit as an External Protocol
++ 11.2. [576]Invoking External Protocols from C-Kermit
++
++ Unix C-Kermit can be used in conjunction with other communications
++ software in various ways. C-Kermit can be invoked from another
++ communications program as an "external protocol", and C-Kermit can
++ also invoke other communication software to perform external
++ protocols.
++
++ This sort of operation makes sense only when you are dialing out from
++ your Unix system (or making a network connection from it). If the Unix
++ system is the one you have dialed in to, you don't need any of these
++ tricks. Just run the desired software on your Unix system instead of
++ Kermit. When dialing out from a Unix system, the difficulty is getting
++ two programs to share the same communication device in spite of the
++ Unix UUCP lockfile mechanism, which would normally prevent any
++ sharing, and preventing the external protocol from closing (and
++ therefore hanging up) the device when it exits back to the program
++ that invoked it.
++
++ 11.1. C-KERMIT AS AN EXTERNAL PROTOCOL
++
++ [ [577]Top ] [ [578]Contents ] [ [579]Section Contents ] [ [580]Next ]
++
++ (This section deleted; see [581]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed, Chapter 14.)
++
++ "pcomm" is a general-purpose terminal program that provides file
++ transfer capabilities itself (X- and YMODEM variations) and the
++ ability to call on external programs to do file transfers (ZMODEM and
++ Kermit, for example). You can tell pcomm the command to send or
++ receive a file with an external protocol:
++ Send Receive
++ ZMODEM sz filename rz
++ Kermit kermit -s filename kermit -r
++
++ pcomm runs external programs for file transfer by making stdin and
++ stdout point to the modem port, and then exec-ing "/bin/sh -c xxx"
++ (where xxx is the appropriate command). However, C-Kermit does not
++ treat stdin and stdout as the communication device unless you instruct
++ it:
++
++
++ Send Receive
++ Kermit kermit -l 0 -s filename kermit -l 0 -r
++
++ The "-l 0" option means to use file descriptor 0 for the communication
++ device.
++
++ In general, any program can pass any open file descriptor to C-Kermit
++ for the communication device in the "-l" command-line option. When
++ Kermit is given a number as the argument to the "-l" option, it simply
++ uses it as a file descriptor, and it does not attempt to close it upon
++ exit.
++
++ Here's another example, for Seyon (a Linux communication program).
++ First try the technique above. If that works, fine; otherwise... If
++ Seyon does not give you a way to access and pass along the file
++ descriptor, but it starts up the Kermit program with its standard i/o
++ redirected to its (Seyon's) communications file descriptor, you can
++ also experiment with the following method, which worked here in brief
++ tests on SunOS. Instead of having Seyon use "kermit -r" or "kermit -s
++ filename" as its Kermit protocol commands, use something like this
++ (examples assume C-Kermit 6.0):
++
++ For serial connections:
++
++ kermit -YqQl 0 -r <-- to receive
++ kermit -YqQl 0 -s filename(s) <-- to send one or more files
++
++ For Telnet connections:
++
++ kermit -YqQF 0 -r <-- to receive
++ kermit -YqQF 0 -s filename(s) <-- to send one or more files
++
++ Command line options:
++
++ Y - skip executing the init file
++ Q - use fast file transfer settings (default in 8.0)
++ l 0 - transfer files using file descriptor 0 for a serial connection
++ F 0 - transfer files using file descriptor 0 for a Telnet connection
++ q - quiet - no messages
++ r - receive
++ s - send
++
++ 11.2. INVOKING EXTERNAL PROTOCOLS FROM C-KERMIT
++
++ [ [582]Top ] [ [583]Contents ] [ [584]Section Contents ] [
++ [585]Previous ]
++
++ (This section is obsolete, but not totally useless. See Chapter 14
++ of [586]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition).
++
++ After you have opened a communication link with C-Kermit's SET LINE
++ (SET PORT) or SET HOST (TELNET) command, C-Kermit makes its file
++ descriptor available to you in the \v(ttyfd) variable so you can pass
++ it along to other programs that you RUN from C-Kermit. Here, for
++ example, C-Kermit runs itself as an external protocol:
++
++ C-Kermit>set modem type hayes
++ C-Kermit>set line /dev/acu
++ C-Kermit>set speed 2400
++ C-Kermit>dial 7654321
++ Call complete.
++ C-Kermit>echo \v(ttyfd)
++ 3
++ C-Kermit>run kermit -l \v(ttyfd)
++
++ Other programs that accept open file descriptors on the command line
++ can be started in the same way.
++
++ You can also use your shell's i/o redirection facilities to assign
++ C-Kermit's open file descriptor (ttyfd) to stdin or stdout. For
++ example, old versions of the Unix ZMODEM programs, sz and rz, when
++ invoked as external protocols, expect to find the communication device
++ assigned to stdin and stdout with no option for specifying any other
++ file descriptor on the sz or rz command line. However, you can still
++ invoke sz and rz as exterior protocols from C-Kermit if your current
++ shell ($SHELL variable) is ksh (the Korn shell) or bash (the
++ Bourne-Again shell), which allows assignment of arbitrary file
++ descriptors to stdin and stdout:
++
++ C-Kermit> run rz <&\v(ttyfd) >&\v(ttyfd)
++
++ or:
++
++ C-Kermit> run sz oofa.zip <&\v(ttyfd) >&\v(ttyfd)
++
++ In version 5A(190) and later, you can use C-Kermit's REDIRECT command,
++ if it is available in your version of C-Kermit, to accomplish the same
++ thing without going through the shell:
++
++ C-Kermit> redirect rz
++
++ or:
++
++ C-Kermit> redirect sz oofa.zip
++
++ A complete set of rz,sz,rb,sb,rx,sx macros for Unix C-Kermit is
++ defined in the file ckurzsz.ini. It automatically chooses the best
++ redirection method (but is redundant since C-Kermit 6.0, which now has
++ built-in support for external protocols via its SET PROTOCOL command).
++
++ Note that external protocols can be used on C-Kermit SET LINE or SET
++ HOST connections only if they operate through standard input and
++ standard output. If they open their own connections, Kermit can't
++ redirect them over its own connection.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 12. SECURITY
++
++ [ [587]Top ] [ [588]Contents ] [ [589]Next ] [ [590]Previous ]
++
++ As of version 7.0, C-Kermit supports a wide range of security options
++ for authentication and encryption: Kerberos 4, Kerberos 5 / GSSAPI,
++ SSL/TLS, and SRP. See the separate [591]security document for details.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 13. MISCELLANEOUS USER REPORTS
++
++ [ [592]Top ] [ [593]Contents ] [ [594]Next ] [ [595]Previous ]
++
++Date: Thu, 12 Mar 92 1:59:25 MEZ
++From: Walter Mecky <walter@rent-a-guru.de>
++Subject: Help.Unix.sw
++To: svr4@pcsbst.pcs.com, source@usl.com
++
++PRODUCT: Unix
++RELEASE: Dell SVR4 V2.1 (is USL V3.0)
++MACHINE: AT-386
++PATHNAME: /usr/lib/libc.so.1
++ /usr/ccs/lib/libc.a
++ABSTRACT: Function ttyname() does not close its file descriptor
++DESCRIPTION:
++ ttyname(3C) opens /dev but never closes it. So if it is called
++ often enough the open(2) in ttyname() fails. Because the broken
++ ttyname() is in the shared lib too all programs using it can
++ fail if they call it often enough. One important program is
++ uucico which calls ttyname for every file it transfers.
++
++ Here is a little test program if your system has the bug:
++
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <stdio.h>
++main() {
++ int i = 0;
++ while (ttyname(0) != NULL)
++ i++;
++ perror("ttyname");
++ printf("i=%d\n", i);
++}
++
++ If this program runs longer than some seconds you don't have the bug.
++
++ WORKAROUND: None FIX: Very easy if you have source code.
++
++ Another user reports some more explicit symptoms and recoveries:
++
++> What happens is when invoking ckermit we get one of the following
++> error messages:
++> You must set line
++> Not a tty
++> No more processes.
++> One of the following three actions clears the peoblem:
++> shutdown -y -g0 -i6
++> kill -9 the ttymon with the highest PID
++> Invoke sysadm and disable then enable the line you want to use.
++> Turning off respawn of sac -t 300 and going to getty's and uugetty's
++> does not help.
++>
++> Also C-Kermit reports "?timed out closing /dev/ttyxx".
++> If this happens all is well.
++
++------------------------------
++
++ (Note: the following problem also occurs on SGI and probably many
++ other Unix systems):
++
++ From: James Spath <spath@jhunix.hcf.jhu.edu>
++ To: Info-Kermit-Request@cunixf.cc.columbia.edu
++ Date: Wed, 9 Sep 1992 20:20:28 -0400
++ Subject: C-Kermit vs uugetty (or init) on Sperry 5000
++
++ We have successfully compiled the above release on a Unisys/Sperry
++ 5000/95. We used the sys5r3 option, rather than sys5r2 since we have
++ VR3 running on our system. In order to allow dialout access to
++ non-superusers, we had to do "chmod 666 /dev/tty###, where it had been
++ -rw--w--w- (owned by uucp), and to do "chmod +w /usr/spool/locks". We
++ have done text and binary file transfers through local and remote
++ connections.
++
++ The problem concerning uucp ownership and permissions is worse than I
++ thought at first. Apparently init or uugetty changes the file
++ permissions after each session. So I wrote the following C program to
++ open a set of requested tty lines. I run this for any required
++ outgoing line prior to a Kermit session.
++
++ ------ cut here -------
++/* opentty.c -- force allow read on tty lines for modem i/o */
++/* idea from: restrict.c -- System 5 Admin book Thomas/Farrow p. 605 */
++/* /jes jim spath {spath@jhunix.hcj.jhu.edu } */
++/* 08-Sep-92 NO COPYRIGHT. */
++/* this must be suid to open other tty lines */
++
++/* #define DEBUG */
++#define TTY "/dev/tty"
++#define LOK "/usr/spool/locks/LCK..tty"
++#include <stdio.h>
++
++/* allowable lines: */
++#define TOTAL_LINES 3
++static char allowable[TOTAL_LINES][4] = { "200", "201", "300" };
++static int total=TOTAL_LINES;
++int allow;
++
++/* states: */
++#define TTY_UNDEF 0
++#define TTY_LOCK 1
++#define TTY_OKAY 2
++
++main(argc, argv)
++int argc; char *argv[]; {
++ char device[512];
++ char lockdev[512];
++ int i;
++ if (argc == 1) {
++ fprintf(stderr, "usage: open 200 [...]\n");
++ }
++ while (--argc > 0 && (*++argv) != NULL ) {
++#ifdef DEBUG
++ fprintf(stderr, "TRYING: %s%s\n", TTY, *argv);
++#endif
++ sprintf(device, "%s%s", TTY, *argv);
++ sprintf(lockdev, "%s%s", LOK, *argv);
++ allow = TTY_UNDEF; i = 0;
++ while (i <= total) { /* look at all defined lines */
++#ifdef DEBUG
++ fprintf(stderr, "LOCKFILE? %s?\n", lockdev);
++#endif
++ if (access(lockdev, 00) == 0) {
++ allow=TTY_LOCK;
++ break;
++ }
++#ifdef DEBUG
++ fprintf(stderr, "DOES:%s==%s?\n", allowable[i], *argv);
++#endif
++ if (strcmp(allowable[i], *argv) == 0)
++ allow=TTY_OKAY;
++ i++;
++ }
++#ifdef DEBUG
++ fprintf(stderr, "allow=%d\n", allow);
++#endif
++ switch (allow) {
++ case TTY_UNDEF:
++ fprintf (stderr, "open: not allowed on %s\n", *argv);
++ break;
++ case TTY_LOCK:
++ fprintf (stderr, "open: device locked: %s\n", lockdev);
++ break;
++ case TTY_OKAY:
++ /* attempt to change mode on device */
++ if (chmod (device, 00666) < 0)
++ fprintf (stderr, "open: cannot chmod on %s\n", device);
++ break;
++ default:
++ fprintf (stderr, "open: FAULT\n");
++ }
++ }
++ exit (0);
++}
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 14. THIRD-PARTY DRIVERS
++
++ [ [596]Top ] [ [597]Contents ] [ [598]Next ] [ [599]Previous ]
++
++ Unix versions, especially those for PCs (SCO, Unixware, etc) might be
++ augmented by third-party communication-board drivers from Digiboard,
++ Stallion, etc. These can sometimes complicate matters for Kermit
++ considerably since Kermit has no way of knowing that it is going
++ through a possibly nonstandard driver. Various examples are listed in
++ the earlier sections of this document; search for Stallion, Digiboard,
++ etc. Additionally:
++
++ * The Stallion Technologies EasyConnection serial board driver does
++ not always report the state of DSR as low. From Stallion (October
++ 1997): "Unfortunately, this is a bug in our driver. We have
++ implemented all of the other TIOMC functions, eg DTR, DCD, RTS and
++ CTS, but not DSR. Our driver should report the actual state of DSR
++ on those of our cards that have a DSR signal. That the driver
++ always reports DSR as not asserted (0), is a bug in the driver.
++ The driver should be either reporting the state of DSR correctly
++ on those cards that support DSR or as always asserted (1) on those
++ cards that do not have a DSR signal. This will be fixed in a
++ future version of our drivers; at this time I cannot say when this
++ will be." And later, "As far as I can tell, we don't support the
++ termios/termiox ioctls that relate specifically to DSR and RI; all
++ the rest are supported. This will, as I mentioned earlier, be
++ fixed in the next release of our ATA software."
++ - World Wide Escalation Support, Stallion Technologies, Toowong
++ QLD, [600]support@stallion.oz.au.
++
++ Later (December 1997, from the same source):
++
++ * We have now released a new version of the ATA software, version
++ 5.4.0. This version fixes the problem with the states of the DSR
++ and RI signals and how they were being reported by the driver.
++ This is the problem that you reported in October. The DSR signal
++ is reported correctly on those cards that support the DSR signal,
++ such as the early revision of the EasyIO card and the
++ EasyConnection 8D4 panel, and as always asserted on those cards
++ that do not support the DSR signal in the hardware. The new driver
++ is available from our Web site, [601]www.stallion.com, in the
++ /drivers/ata5/UnixWare directory.
++
++ [ [602]Top ] [ [603]Contents ] [ [604]C-Kermit Home ] [ [605]C-Kermit
++ 8.0 Overview ] [ [606]Kermit Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 Unix Hints and Tips / [607]The Kermit Project /
++ [608]Columbia University / [609]kermit@columbia.edu
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 4. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 5. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 6. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 7. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html
++ 8. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1
++ 9. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x2
++ 10. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x4
++ 12. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x5
++ 13. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x6
++ 14. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x7
++ 15. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x8
++ 16. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x9
++ 17. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x10
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11
++ 19. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x12
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x13
++ 21. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x14
++ 22. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 23. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.18
++ 24. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.19
++ 25. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 26. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 27. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 29. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.13
++ 30. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 31. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x2
++ 33. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.1
++ 34. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.2
++ 35. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.3
++ 36. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.4
++ 37. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 38. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 39. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ 42. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 43. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 44. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.2
++ 46. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html
++ 48. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++ 49. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 50. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 51. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1
++ 52. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.3
++ 53. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.1
++ 54. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/support.html
++ 55. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 56. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 57. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1
++ 58. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.4
++ 59. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.2
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1.3
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 66. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 67. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x1
++ 68. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 69. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 70. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x4
++ 71. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x2
++ 72. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 73. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 74. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 75. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.4
++ 77. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.5
++ 78. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 79. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 80. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.8
++ 81. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.9
++ 82. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.10
++ 83. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.11
++ 84. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.12
++ 85. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.13
++ 86. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.14
++ 87. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.15
++ 88. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.16
++ 89. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.17
++ 90. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.18
++ 91. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.19
++ 92. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.20
++ 93. http://www.faqs.org/
++ 94. http://aplawrence.com/Unixart/newtounix.html
++ 95. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/x3
++ 96. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 97. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/support.html
++ 98. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 99. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 100. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 101. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 102. http://www.pcunix.com/
++ 103. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.1
++ 104. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.2
++ 105. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.3
++ 106. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.4
++ 107. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.5
++ 108. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.6
++ 109. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 110. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 111. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 112. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.2
++ 113. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 114. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 115. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 116. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.3
++ 117. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.1
++ 118. http://www.linmodems.org/
++ 119. http://www.microsoft.com/hwdev/platform/PCdesign/LR/default.asp
++ 120. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 121. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 122. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 123. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.4
++ 124. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.2
++ 125. http://www.idir.net/~gromitkc/winmodem.html
++ 126. http://www.digi.com/
++ 127. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 128. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 129. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 130. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.5
++ 131. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.3
++ 132. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 133. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 134. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 135. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.6
++ 136. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.4
++ 137. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 138. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 139. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 140. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.5
++ 141. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 142. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 143. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 144. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 145. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 146. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.1
++ 147. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.2
++ 148. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.3
++ 149. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.4
++ 150. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.5
++ 151. http://www.emerson.emory.edu/services/aix-faq/
++ 152. http://www.faqs.org/faqs/by-newsgroup/comp/comp.unix.aix.html
++ 153. http://www.cis.ohio-state.edu/hypertext/faq/usenet/aix-faq/top.html
++ 154. http://aixpdslib.seas.ucla.edu/
++ 155. http://www.rootvg.net (AIX history)/
++ 156. ftp://rtfm.mit.edu/pub/usenet/news.answers/aix-faq/part1
++ 157. ftp://mirrors.aol.com/pub/rtfm/usenet-by-hierarchy/comp/unix/aix
++ 158. news:comp.unix.aix
++ 159. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 160. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 161. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 162. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.2
++ 163. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 164. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 165. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 166. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.3
++ 167. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.1
++ 168. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html#servers
++ 169. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 170. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 171. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 172. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.4
++ 173. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.2
++ 174. http://service.software.ibm.com/rs6000/
++ 175. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 176. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 177. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 178. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.5
++ 179. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.3
++ 180. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 181. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 182. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 183. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1.4
++ 184. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 185. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 186. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 187. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 188. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.1
++ 189. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.0
++ 190. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.1
++ 191. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.2
++ 192. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.3
++ 193. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4
++ 194. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.5
++ 195. news:comp.sys.hp.hpux
++ 196. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 197. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 198. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 199. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.1
++ 200. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 201. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 202. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 203. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.2
++ 204. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.0
++ 205. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/makefile
++ 206. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 207. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 208. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 209. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.3
++ 210. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.1
++ 211. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 212. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 213. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 214. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4
++ 215. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.2
++ 216. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.1
++ 217. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.2
++ 218. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.3
++ 219. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.4
++ 220. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.5
++ 221. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 222. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 223. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 224. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.2
++ 225. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.2
++ 226. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 227. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 228. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4
++ 229. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.3
++ 230. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.1
++ 231. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 232. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 233. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4
++ 234. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.4
++ 235. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.2
++ 236. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 237. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 238. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4
++ 239. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.5
++ 240. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.3
++ 241. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 242. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 243. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4
++ 244. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4.4
++ 245. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 246. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 247. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 248. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2.4
++ 249. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 250. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 251. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 252. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.4
++ 253. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.2
++ 254. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.1
++ 255. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.2
++ 256. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.3
++ 257. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.4
++ 258. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.5
++ 259. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.6
++ 260. news:comp.os.linux.misc
++ 261. news:comp.os.linux.answers
++ 262. http://www.tldp.org/
++ 263. http://www.tldp.org/FAQ/Linux-FAQ.html
++ 264. http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/Serial-HOWTO.html
++ 265. http://tldp.org/HOWTO/Modem-HOWTO.html
++ 266. ftp://sunsite.unc.edu/pub/Linux/docs/HOWTO
++ 267. ftp://tsx-11.mit.edu/pub/linux/docs/HOWTO
++ 268. http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/
++ 269. http://www.tldp.org/hmirrors.html
++ 270. http://www.redhat.com/apps/support/
++ 271. http://www.debian.org/support
++ 272. http://www.slackware.com/support/
++ 273. http://www.caldera.com/support/
++ 274. http://www.suse.com/support/
++ 275. http://www.mandrake.com/support/
++ 276. http://www.turbolinux.com/support/
++ 277. http://www.linmodems.org/
++ 278. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 279. http://linux.dreamtime.org/decnet/
++ 280. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 281. http://www.linmodems.org/
++ 282. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.2
++ 283. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html#servers
++ 284. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/sshclient.html
++ 285. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 286. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 287. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 288. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.2
++ 289. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 290. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 291. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 292. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.3
++ 293. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.1
++ 294. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 295. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x6
++ 296. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x7
++ 297. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x8
++ 298. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 299. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 300. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 301. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 302. http://linuxwww.db.erau.edu/mail_archives/linux-kernel/Mar_98/1441.html
++ 303. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 304. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 305. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 306. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.4
++ 307. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.2
++ 308. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.5
++ 309. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html#term
++ 310. http://dickey.his.com/xterm/xterm.html
++ 311. http://dickey.his.com/xterm/xterm.html
++ 312. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/xmodmap.txt
++ 313. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 314. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 315. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 316. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.5
++ 317. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.3
++ 318. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 319. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 320. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 321. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.6
++ 322. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.4
++ 323. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 324. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 325. http://www.redhat.com/support/errata/RHBA-2001-153.html
++ 326. news:comp.protocols.kermit.misc
++ 327. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 328. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 329. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 330. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3.5
++ 331. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 332. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 333. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 334. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.5
++ 335. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.3
++ 336. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 337. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 338. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 339. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 340. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.4
++ 341. news:comp.os.qnx
++ 342. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/gkermit.html
++ 343. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x10
++ 344. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 345. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 346. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 347. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 348. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 349. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.5
++ 350. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.1
++ 351. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.2
++ 352. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.3
++ 353. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.4
++ 354. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.10
++ 355. http://aplawrence.com/SCOFAQ/
++ 356. http://www.zenez.com/cgi-bin/scoprogfaq/faq.pl
++ 357. http://www.zenez.com/cgi-bin/scouw7faq/faq.pl
++ 358. http://zenez.pcunix.com/cgi-bin/scouw7faq/faq.pl
++ 359. http://pcunix.com/Unixart/modems.html
++ 360. http://www.freebird.org/faq/
++ 361. http://www.freebird.org/faq/developer.html
++ 362. http://support.caldera.com/caldera
++ 363. http://stage.caldera.com/ta/
++ 364. http://aplawrence.com/newtosco.html
++ 365. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0.5
++ 366. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckfaq.html#term
++ 367. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 368. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 369. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 370. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 371. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.1
++ 372. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 373. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 374. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 375. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 376. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.3
++ 377. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.1
++ 378. http://www.digi.com/
++ 379. ftp://ftp.fu-berlin.de/pub/unix/driver/fas
++ 380. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x14
++ 381. http://www.sco.com/
++ 382. ftp://ftp.sco.com/
++ 383. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 384. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 385. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 386. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.4
++ 387. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.2
++ 388. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.10
++ 389. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 390. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 391. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 392. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6.3
++ 393. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 394. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 395. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 396. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.8
++ 397. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.6
++ 398. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.1
++ 399. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.2
++ 400. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.3
++ 401. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.4
++ 402. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.5
++ 403. news:comp.unix.solaris
++ 404. http://access1.sun.com/
++ 405. http://docs.sun.com/
++ 406. http://www.sunhelp.com/
++ 407. http://www.wins.uva.nl/pub/solaris/solaris2/
++ 408. http://www.wins.uva.nl/cgi-bin/sfaq.cgi
++ 409. ftp://ftp.wins.uva.nl/pub/solaris
++ 410. http://www.science.uva.nl/pub/solaris/solaris2.html
++ 411. http://www.stokely.com/
++ 412. http://www.stokely.com/unix.sysadm.resources/faqs.sun.html
++ 413. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 414. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 415. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 416. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 417. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 418. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.2
++ 419. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 420. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 421. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 422. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.3
++ 423. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.1
++ 424. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 425. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 426. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 427. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.4
++ 428. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.2
++ 429. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 430. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 431. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 432. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.5
++ 433. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.3
++ 434. news:comp.os.vms
++ 435. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 436. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 437. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 438. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.6
++ 439. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.4
++ 440. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 441. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 442. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 443. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7.5
++ 444. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 445. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 446. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 447. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.9
++ 448. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.7
++ 449. http://www.stokely.com/
++ 450. http://access1.sun.com/
++ 451. http://www.ludd.luth.se/~bear/project/sun/sun.hardware.txt
++ 452. ftp://ftp.netcom.com/pub/ru/rubicon/sun.hdwr.ref
++ 453. ftp://ftp.intnet.net/pub/SUN/Sun-Hardware-Ref
++ 454. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 455. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 456. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 457. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.10
++ 458. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.8
++ 459. news:comp.unix.ultrix
++ 460. news:comp.sys.dec
++ 461. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 462. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 463. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 464. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.11
++ 465. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.9
++ 466. http://www.freebird.org/
++ 467. http://www.freebird.org/faq/
++ 468. news:comp.unix.unixware.misc
++ 469. news:comp.unix.sco.misc
++ 470. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.0
++ 471. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckutio.c
++ 472. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 473. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 474. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 475. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.12
++ 476. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.10
++ 477. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 478. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 479. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 480. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.13
++ 481. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.11
++ 482. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 483. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 484. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 485. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.14
++ 486. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.12
++ 487. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 488. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 489. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 490. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.15
++ 491. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.13
++ 492. news:comp.sys.sgi.misc
++ 493. news:comp.sys.sgi.admin
++ 494. http://www.sgi.com/
++ 495. http://www-viz.tamu.edu/~sgi-faq/
++ 496. ftp://viz.tamu.edu/pub/sgi/faq/
++ 497. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 498. http://freeware.sgi.com/Installable/gcc-2.95.2.html
++ 499. http://freeware.sgi.com/Installable/gcc-2.95.2.html
++ 500. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 501. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 502. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 503. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.16
++ 504. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.14
++ 505. news:comp.sys.be
++ 506. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 507. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 508. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 509. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.17
++ 510. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.15
++ 511. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 512. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 513. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 514. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.18
++ 515. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.16
++ 516. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 517. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 518. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 519. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.19
++ 520. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.17
++ 521. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 522. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 523. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 524. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.20
++ 525. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.18
++ 526. http://www.keyspan.com/products/usb/adapter/
++ 527. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 528. http://cerebus.sandiego.edu/~jerry/UnixTips/
++ 529. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 530. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 531. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 532. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3.19
++ 533. http://www.uni-giessen.de/faq/archiv/coherent-faq.general/msg00000.html
++ 534. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 535. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 536. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x5
++ 537. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 538. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 539. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 540. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 541. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x6
++ 542. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x4
++ 543. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 544. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 545. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 546. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x7
++ 547. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x5
++ 548. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#9.5
++ 549. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x3
++ 550. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 551. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 552. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x8
++ 553. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x6
++ 554. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x8
++ 555. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 556. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 557. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 558. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 559. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x9
++ 560. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x7
++ 561. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 562. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 563. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x10
++ 564. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x8
++ 565. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 566. http://dickey.his.com/xterm/xterm.html
++ 567. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 568. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 569. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11
++ 570. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x9
++ 571. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 572. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 573. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x12
++ 574. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x10
++ 575. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11.1
++ 576. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11.2
++ 577. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 578. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 579. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11
++ 580. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11.2
++ 581. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 582. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 583. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 584. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11
++ 585. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11.1
++ 586. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 587. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 588. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 589. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x13
++ 590. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x11
++ 591. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++ 592. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 593. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 594. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x14
++ 595. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x12
++ 596. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 597. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 598. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x15
++ 599. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#x14
++ 600. mailto:support@stallion.oz.au
++ 601. http://www.stallion.com/
++ 602. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#top
++ 603. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html#contents
++ 604. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 605. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80.html
++ 606. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 607. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 608. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 609. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckermit.ini
+@@ -0,0 +1,618 @@
++COMMENT - Standard C-Kermit initialization file
++;
++; For C-Kermit Version: 8.0
++;
++; Filename:
++; .kermrc (UNIX, OS-9, Aegis)
++; CKERMIT.INI (OS/2, VMS, OpenVMS, AOS/VS, Atari ST, Commodore Amiga)
++; ckermit.ini (Stratus VOS)
++; K95.INI (Kermit 95 -- but this big version is not used there)
++; K2.INI (Kermit/2 -- but ditto)
++;
++; Authors:
++; Frank da Cruz, Christine M. Gianone, Jeffrey Altman
++; Columbia University, New York, NY 10025-7799, USA
++;
++; This is the standard and recommended C-Kermit 8.0 initialization file. To
++; override settings or definitions made in this file, to add new settings or
++; definitions, or to make any other desired customizations, create a separate,
++; personal customization file called:
++;
++; .mykermrc (UNIX, OS-9, Aegis, BeBox, Plan 9)
++; CKERMOD.INI (OS/2, VMS, OpenVMS, AOS/VS, Atari ST, Commodore Amiga)
++; ckermod.ini (VOS)
++;
++; You can also define the customization filename in an environment
++; variable (logical name in VMS), CKERMOD, which takes precedence over
++; the names shown above.
++;
++; WHAT THIS FILE DOES:
++;
++; . Defines your default dialing directory name:
++; .kdd for UNIX, OS-9 and Aegis; CKERMIT.KDD for other operating systems.
++; You can override this with the environment variable K_DIAL_DIRECTORY
++; . Defines your default network directory name:
++; .knd for UNIX, OS-9 and Aegis; CKERMIT.KND for other operating systems.
++; You can override this with the environment variable K_NET_DIRECTORY
++; . Defines your default services directory name:
++; .ksd for UNIX, OS-9 and Aegis; CKERMIT.KSD for other operating systems.
++; You can override this with environment variable K_SERVICE_DIRECTORY.
++; . Defines your customization file name (name given above)
++; . Performs system-dependent setups for UNIX, VMS, OS/2, etc.
++; . Defines VTPRINT macros for use with K95, MS-DOS Kermit, etc.
++; . If you have a services directory, all the macros needed to use it are
++; defined. If you don't have a services directory, the macros are not
++; defined and Kermit starts faster.
++; . Executes your personal customization file, if you have one.
++; NOTE: Your customization file is NOT executed by Kermit itself; it is
++; executed by this file.
++;
++; In UNIX, with C-Kermit 7.0 and later, you can store this file with a name
++; other than .kermrc, and it will not be executed automatically, but, if you
++; give this file execute permission, you can execute directly because of the
++; "kerbang line" at the top, whenever you want all of the above actions to
++; occur. The kerbang line must reflect the actual full path of the Kermit
++; 7.0-or-later executable.
++;
++; C-Kermit 6.0 is documented in the book "Using C-Kermit", 2nd Edition,
++; by Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, 1997, Digital Press /
++; Butterworth-Heinemann, ISBN 1-55558-164-1. New features of subsequent
++; versions are documented at the Kermit website:
++; http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++;
++; Everything after this point depends on the script programming language.
++; The CHECK command terminates this command file immediately if the script
++; programming language (IF command) is not configured.
++;
++set take error on ; This makes CHECK quit if no script language.
++check if ; Do we have an IF command? If not, quit now.
++set take error off ; Back to normal.
++
++local _sd _servicedir _xp ; Declare local variables.
++
++COMMENT - C-Kermit version 6.0 or later required.
++;
++
++asg _xp \v(xprogram)
++if not def _xp asg _xp \v(program)
++if not equal "\m(_xp)" "C-Kermit" -
++ stop 1 \v(cmdfile): This initialization file is only for C-Kermit.
++echo Executing \v(cmdfile) for \v(system)...
++if < \v(version) 60000 -
++ stop 1 \v(cmdfile): C-Kermit 6.0 or later required.
++
++forward \v(system) ; First do system-dependent items...
++
++:unknown ; Should not happen
++Stop 1 Error: System type unknown!
++
++:Aegis ; Apollo Aegis and
++:UNIX ; UNIX, all versions
++asg _myinit -
++ \v(home).mykermrc ; Customization filename
++if remote forward COMMON ; Skip local-mode items if "-R"
++asg _dialdir -
++ \v(home).kdd ; C-Kermit dialing directory
++asg _netdir -
++ \v(home).knd ; C-Kermit network directory
++asg _servicedir -
++ \v(home).ksd ; C-Kermit services directory
++forward COMMON ; End of UNIX section
++
++:OS9/68K ; OS-9
++asg _myinit -
++ \v(home).mykermrc ; Customization filename
++if remote forward COMMON
++asg _dialdir -
++ \v(home).kdd ; C-Kermit dialing directory
++asg _netdir -
++ \v(home).knd ; C-Kermit network directory
++asg _servicedir -
++ \v(home).ksd ; C-Kermit services directory
++else set file display crt
++forward COMMON ; End of OS-9 section
++
++:VMS ; VMS and OpenVMS
++forward COMMON
++
++:OS/2 ; Kermit 95
++:WIN32
++echo This initialization file is not for use with K95.
++forward COMMON ; End of OS/2 section
++
++:AOS/VS ; Data General AOS/VS
++set window 1 ; Sliding windows don't work
++set file char dg-international ; File character-set
++set xfer char latin1 ; Transfer character-set
++set file display crt ; File transfer fisplay
++def cli push ; Escape to CLI
++def reset - ; Macro to reset DG DASHER terminal
++ run write [!ascii 236 306 301]
++forward COMMON ; End of AOS/VS section
++
++:Amiga ; Commodore Amiga
++def cls echo \27[H\27[2J ; CLS command to clear the screen
++set file char latin1 ; Use Latin Alphabet 1 for file transfer
++set xfer char latin1 ; ...
++forward COMMON ; End of Amiga section
++
++:Atari_ST ; Atari ST
++def cls echo \27H\27J ; Clear screen a`la VT52
++set server display on ; Show file xfer display in server mode too
++set server timeout 15 ; Nonzero required for ^C interruption!
++forward COMMON ; End of Atari ST section
++
++:Macintosh ; Apple Macintosh
++set server display on ; Show file xfer display in server mode too.
++forward COMMON
++
++:Stratus_VOS ; Stratus VOS
++asg _myinit \v(home)ckermod.ini
++if remote forward COMMON
++asg _dialdir \v(home)ckermit.kdd
++asg _netdir \v(home)ckermit.knd
++asg _servicedir \v(home)ckermit.ksd
++forward COMMON ; End of Stratus VOS section
++
++:COMMON ; For all systems
++
++; Define macros that are useful when running C-Kermit in remote mode.
++; These macros serve no purpose on local-mode-only versions such as
++; OS/2, Macintosh, Amiga, and Atari ST Kermit, so we skip defining them
++; for those systems.
++;
++if not = 0 \findex(\v(system),WIN32:OS/2:Macintosh:Amiga:Atari_ST) -
++ forward files
++
++; VTPRINT macro. Print a file on your PC's local printer.
++
++def VTPRINT echo \27[5i, type \%1, echo \27[4i
++; or if your printer needs a formfeed to force the page out:
++; def VTPRINT def echo \27[5i, type \%1, echo \12\27[4i
++
++; Macros for host-initiated file transfer using APC:
++; NOT NEEDED ANY MORE because of autodownload/autoupload.
++; Remove the following FORWARD command to reinstate these definitions:
++
++:FILES
++
++; Get customization and directory file names. Environment variables take
++; precedence, so you do not have to edit this file to change these filenames.
++;
++if def \$(CKERMOD) assign _myinit \$(CKERMOD)
++if not def _myinit assign _myinit \v(home)CKERMOD.INI
++
++if remote forward CUSTOM ; Skip all this if -R given on command line
++
++if def \$(K_NET_DIRECTORY) assign _netdir \$(K_NET_DIRECTORY)
++if not def _netdir assign _netdir \v(home)CKERMIT.KND
++
++if def \$(K_DIAL_DIRECTORY) assign _dialdir \$(K_DIAL_DIRECTORY)
++if not def _dialdir assign _dialdir \v(home)CKERMIT.KDD
++
++CHECK DIAL ; Is there a DIAL command?
++xif fail { ; No.
++ echo DIAL disabled
++ forward CUSTOM
++}
++
++CHECK NETWORK
++xif success {
++ xif exist \m(_netdir) {
++ set net directory \m(_netdir)
++ echo { Network directory is \m(_netdir) }
++ }
++}
++
++if eq "\v(name)" "telnet" forward CUSTOM
++
++xif exist \m(_dialdir) {
++ set dial directory \m(_dialdir)
++ echo { Dial directory is \m(_dialdir) }
++}
++
++COMMENT - Services directory
++
++if def \$(K_SERVICE_DIRECTORY) assign _servicedir \$(K_SERVICE_DIRECTORY)
++if not def _servicedir assign _servicedir \v(home)CKERMIT.KSD
++
++; If no services directory is found skip all the big macro definitions and
++; go straight to the bottom, where we execute the customization file.
++
++if not exist \m(_servicedir) forward custom
++
++echo { Services directory is \m(_servicedir)}
++
++def MAX_SVCS 200 ; Adjust this if you have more entries
++define _sd 0 ; Assume no services directory
++open read \m(_servicedir) ; Try to open services directory file
++xif success {
++ declare \&d[\m(MAX_SVCS)] ; It's open, declare directory array
++ for \%i 1 \m(MAX_SVCS) 1 { ; Read the lines into the array
++ read \&d[\%i]
++ if fail break
++ }
++ close read
++ xif > \%i \m(MAX_SVCS) {
++ echo Too many entries in services directory
++ echo { Maximum is \m(MAX_SVCS).}
++ echo { Change definition of MAX_SVCS in \v(cmdfile) to allow more. }
++ echo { Services directory disabled.}
++ } else {
++ asg \&d[0] \feval(\%i - 1)
++ define _sd 1
++ }
++}
++
++xif not \m(_sd) {
++ def access echo { Services directory not available.}
++ asg list \m(access)
++} else {
++ def FIND {
++ set case off
++ for \%i 1 \&d[0] 1 {
++ if eq {\%1} {\fsubstr(\&d[\%i],1,\flen(\%1))} break
++ }
++ if not > \%i \&d[0] return \&d[\%i]
++ }
++ def LIST {
++ xif > \v(argc) 1 {
++ do find \%1
++ if def \v(return) echo \v(return)
++ else echo \%1: Not found
++ } else {
++ echo \&d[0] items in services directory:
++ for \%i 1 \&d[0] 1 { echo \fcont(\&d[\%i]) }
++ }
++ }
++ def SPLIT { asg _word1 \%1, asg _word2 \%2 }
++ def DOACCESS { ; (Used internally by ACCESS macro)
++ do \%5 \%6 \%7 \%8 \%9 ; Do the connection macro
++ if fail end 1
++ split \%3 ; Get words from \%3
++ asg \%3 \m(_word1)
++ asg \%2 \m(_word2)
++ do \%3 \%4 {\%1} \%2 ; Login macro, userid, password, prompt
++ }
++ def ACCESS {
++ if not defined \%1 end 1 access what? ; Check service
++ do find \%1 ; Look it up
++ if success doaccess {\%2} \v(return) ; OK, try it
++ else end 1 "\%1" not in services directory ; Not found
++ if fail end 1 ; DOACCESS failed?
++ xif eq \v(cmdlevel) 1 {
++ echo
++ echo ACCESS: Login succeeded - CONNECTing...
++ show escape
++ output \13
++ connect /quietly
++ }
++ }
++}
++
++:CONNECTION ; Macros for making connections
++
++COMMENT - SERIAL macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = device name
++; \%2 = speed
++;
++def SERIAL {
++ if < \v(argc) 3 ; All arguments given?
++ end 1 Usage: SERIAL device speed ; No.
++ set line \%1 ; OK, try to SET LINE.
++ if failure - ; If this failed,
++ end 1 Can't open device: \%1 ; print message and quit.
++ set speed \%2 ; Try to set the speed.
++ if fail end 1 Unsupported speed: \%2 ; Failed.
++ echo Connection successful. ; Succeeded.
++}
++
++COMMENT - NET macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = network type
++; \%2 = host name or address
++;
++def NET {
++ if < \v(argc) 3 end 1 Usage: NET network host
++ set network type \%1
++ if fail end 1 unsupported network: \%1
++ set login user ; Don't send user ID.
++ set host \%2
++ if fail end 1 Can't reach host: \%2
++ echo Connection successful.
++}
++
++COMMENT - CALL macro. Arguments:
++;
++; \%1 = modem type
++; \%2 = device name
++; \%3 = speed
++; \%4 = phone number
++;
++def CALL {
++ if < \v(argc) 5 - ; All arguments present?
++ end 1 Usage: CALL modem device speed number
++ xif not equal {\v(modem)} {\%1} { ; Set modem type
++ set modem \%1
++ if fail end 1 unknown modem type: \%1
++ }
++ xif not equal {\v(line)} {\%2} { ; Communication device
++ set line \%2
++ if fail end 1 can't open device: \%2
++ }
++ xif not equal {\v(speed)} {\%3} { ; Communication speed
++ set speed \%3
++ if fail end 1 unsupported speed: \%3
++ }
++ dial \%4 ; Dial the number
++ if fail end 1 Can't place call: \%4
++ end 0 Connection successful.
++}
++
++COMMENT - TCPCALL macro. Arguments:
++;
++; \%1 = server name:port
++; \%2 = modem type
++; \%3 = phone number
++;
++def TCPCALL {
++ if < \v(argc) 4 - ; All arguments present?
++ end 1 Usage: TCPCALL server[:port] modem number
++ set net type tcp/ip ; Which network to use
++ if fail end 1 unsupported network: tcp/ip
++ set host \%1 ; Access server and port
++ if fail end 1 can't access server \%1
++ set modem \%2 ; Set modem type
++ if fail end 1 unknown modem type: \%2
++ dial \%3 ; Dial the number
++ if fail end 1 Can't place call: \%3
++ end 0 Connection successful.
++}
++
++COMMENT - SPRINT macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = Service name or address
++;
++def SPRINT {
++ if < \v(argc) 2 end 1 Usage: \%0 service
++ set input timeout proceed
++ output @D\13
++ input 10 TERMINAL=
++ if fail end 1 No terminal prompt
++ out D1\13
++ inp 10 @
++ if fail end 1 No atsign prompt
++ output c \%1\13
++ input 10 CONNECTED
++ if fail end 1 Can't access \%1 from SprintNet
++}
++
++COMMENT - ULOGIN macro. For logging into systems where user ID is required
++; but there is no password. Arguments:
++; \%1 = UNIX user ID
++;
++define ULOGIN {
++ if < \v(argc) 2 end 1 Usage: \%0 userid
++ set input timeout proceed ; Handle timeouts ourselves
++ set case on ; Case is important in UNIX
++ minput 5 login: Username: {User ID:} {User Name:}
++ out \%1\13 ; Send username, carriage return
++ end 0
++}
++
++COMMENT - VMSLOGIN macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = VMS user ID
++; \%2 = Password. If password not supplied, it is prompted for.
++; \%3 = System prompt. If omitted a default is supplied.
++;
++define VMSLOGIN {
++ if < \v(argc) 2 end 1 Usage: \%0 userid [ password [ prompt ] ]
++ while not defined \%2 {
++ askq \%2 { \%1's password: }
++ }
++ set parity none ; Set communication parameters
++ set duplex full
++ set handshake none
++ set input timeout proceed ; Handle timeouts ourselves
++ in 5 Username: ; Is prompt already there?
++ xif fail { ; No.
++ for \%i 1 3 1 { ; Try 3 times to get it.
++ out \13 ; Send carriage return
++ in 5 Username: ; Look for prompt
++ if success break ; Success, go log in
++ }
++ if > \%i 3 end 1 No Username prompt
++ }
++ out \%1\13 ; Send username, carriage return
++ inp 5 Password: ; Wait 5 sec for this prompt
++ if fail end 1 No password prompt
++ pause ; Wait a sec
++ out \%2\13 ; Send password
++ xif not emulation { ; No emulator built in?
++ set input echo off ; Protect terminal from this
++ minput 10 {\27Z} {\27[c} {\27[0c} ; Get terminal ID query
++ xif success { ; Got one
++ output \27[\?1c ; Send VT100 terminal ID
++ in 2 \27[6n ; Screen dimension query?
++ if succ out \27[\v(rows);\v(cols)R ; Send dimensions
++ }
++ set input echo on ; Echo input again
++ }
++ if not def \%3 - ; If we were not given a prompt
++ asg \%3 {\v(prompt)} ; use the SET LOGIN PROMPT value
++ if not def \%3 - ; If we still don't have a prompt
++ asg \%3 {\13$\32} ; use this one as the default
++ reinp 0 \%3 ; Did we INPUT the prompt already?
++ if fail inp 60 \%3 ; No, look now.
++ if fail end 1
++}
++
++COMMENT - UNIXLOGIN macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = UNIX user ID
++; \%2 = Password. If password not supplied, it is prompted for.
++; \%3 = System prompt. If omitted a default is supplied.
++;
++define UNIXLOGIN {
++ local \%m \%i
++ if < \v(argc) 2 -
++ end 1 Usage: \%0 userid [ password [ prompt ] ]
++ while not defined \%2 {
++ askq \%2 { \%1's password: }
++ }
++ set input echo on
++ set parity none ; Set communication parameters.
++ set duplex full
++ set handshake none
++ set input timeout proceed ; Handle timeouts ourselves
++ set case on ; Case is important in UNIX
++ def \%m 10 ; Waiting time for INPUT
++ for \%i 1 5 1 {
++ minput \%m login: {ssword:} {Password for \%1:}
++ if success break
++ output \B\13
++ \%m ::= 6-\%1
++ }
++ if > \%i 5 end 1 {No response from host}
++ xif = \v(minput) 1 { ; Have username prompt
++ output \%1\13 ; Send username
++ minput 5 {ssword:} {ssword for \%1:} ; Wait for password prompt
++ if fail end 1 {No password prompt}
++ }
++ pause ; Wait a sec
++ out \%2\13 ; Send password
++ if not def \%3 - ; If we were not given a prompt
++ asg \%3 {\v(prompt)} ; use the SET LOGIN PROMPT value
++ if not def \%3 - ; If we still don't have a prompt
++ asg \%3 {\10$ } ; use this one as the default
++ reinp 0 \%3 ; Did we INPUT the prompt already?
++ if fail inp 60 \%3 ; No, look now.
++ if fail end 1
++}
++
++COMMENT - VMLINELOGIN macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = User ID
++; \%2 = Password
++;
++define VMLINELOGIN {
++ if < \v(argc) 2 -
++ end 1 Usage: \%0 userid [ password ]
++ while not defined \%2 {
++ askq \%2 { \%1's password: }
++ }
++ set parity mark ; Set communication parameters
++ set flow none
++ set handshake xon
++ set duplex half
++ set input timeout quit ; Don't bother with IF FAILURE
++ input 10 BREAK KEY ; Look for BREAK KEY prompt
++ pause 1 ; Wait a second
++ output \B ; Send BREAK
++ input 10 .\17, output logon \%1\13 ; Now log in
++ input 10 .\17, output \%2\13 ; Send password
++ input 10 .\17, output \13 ; Send carriage return
++ input 10 .\17, output \13 ; Send another one
++ end 0
++}
++
++COMMENT - VMFULLOGIN macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = User ID
++; \%2 = Password
++;
++define VMFULLOGIN {
++ if < \v(argc) 2 -
++ end 1 Usage: \%0 userid [ password ]
++ while not defined \%2 {
++ askq \%2 { \%1's password: }
++ }
++ set input timeout quit ; Quit if INPUT fails
++ set parity even ; Set communication parameters
++ set duplex full
++ set handshake none
++ set flow xon/xoff
++ out \13 ; Send carriage return
++ inp 5 TERMINAL TYPE: ; Get terminal-type prompt
++ out vt-100\13 ; Just send "vt-100"
++ inp 20 RUNNING ; Get RUNNING message
++ pau 1 ; Wait one second
++ out \%1\9\%2\13 ; Send user ID, tab, password
++ out \13\13 ; Two more carriage returns
++ end 0
++}
++
++COMMENT - CISLOGIN macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = CompuServe User ID
++; \%2 = Password
++; \%3 = Prompt
++;
++define CISLOGIN {
++ if < \v(argc) 2 -
++ end 1 Usage: \%0 userid [ password [ prompt ] ]
++ while not defined \%2 {
++ askq \%2 { \%1's password: }
++ }
++ set terminal bytesize 7 ; No 8-bit characters
++ set input timeout quit ; Skip the IF FAILURE's
++ output \13 ; Send initial carriage return
++ input 5 Host Name: ; Look for Host Name prompt
++ output cis\13 ; Send "cis" and carriage return
++ input 5 User ID: ; Look for User ID prompt
++ output \%1\13 ; Send ID and carriage return
++ input Password: ; Look for Password prompt
++ output \%2\13 ; Send password and CR
++ if not def \%3 asg \%3 \v(prompt)
++ if not def \%3 asg \%3 {CompuServe Information Service}
++ input 30 \%3
++ end 0
++}
++
++COMMENT - DOWLOGIN macro. Arguments:
++; \%1 = Dow Jones Password
++;
++define DOWLOGIN {
++ while not defined \%1 { ; Get password
++ askq \%1 { Dow Jones password: }
++ }
++ set input timeout proceed
++ input 20 SERVICE PLEASE\?\?\?\? ; Look for Dow prompt
++ if fail end 1 No service prompt
++ out djnr\13 ; Select DJNR
++ input 10 @@@@@@@@ ; Get password prompt
++ if fail end 1 No password prompt
++ pause 1 ; Wait a second, then...
++ output \%1\13 ; send password and CR
++ input 30 ENTER QUERY ; Get DJNR query prompt
++ if fail end 1 No main query prompt
++ pause 1
++}
++
++COMMENT - DJNRSPRINT macro: Log in to Dow Jones via SprintNet.
++;
++def djnrsprint sprint dow, if success dowlogin
++
++COMMENT - NOLOGIN macro. Does nothing. Use when login not required.
++;
++def nologin comment
++
++:CUSTOM ; Customization file
++
++; In VMS and OpenVMS, allow for system-wide site customizations
++
++xif equal "\v(system)" "VMS" {
++ xif exist CKERMIT_INI:CKERMIT.SYS {
++ echo Executing CKERMIT_INI:CKERMIT.SYS
++ take CKERMIT_INI:CKERMIT.SYS
++ }
++}
++
++; Execute user's personal customization file
++
++xif exist \m(_myinit) { ; If it exists,
++ echo Executing \m(_myinit)... ; print message,
++ take \m(_myinit) ; and TAKE the file.
++}
++
++; Finish up with traditional greeting.
++
++if < \v(ntime) 43200 echo Good Morning!
++ else if < \v(ntime) 61200 echo Good Afternoon!
++ else echo Good Evening.
++
++End ; of C-Kermit 8.0 initialization file.
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckc211.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,3595 @@
++C-KERMIT CHANGE LOG (Changes since 8.0.200 of 12 Dec 2001)
++
++Chronological order: Go to the bottom to find the newest edits.
++
++---8.0.200---
++
++Known bugs (+ = fixed after release):
++
++ + 1. tilde_expand() can call getcwd() with NULL arg.
++ + 2. getexedir() called too early (fatal in combination with (1)).
++ + 3. Kermit "get blah" where blah is a symlink; server refuses to send it.
++ Should not do this if GET not recursive.
++ ? 4. Dave Sneddon's report about VMS fore/background confusion.
++ + 5. FTP GET path/file doesn't work - path not stripped - but MGET works.
++ + 6. IRIX 5.3 compilation problems (have patches from Marcus Herbert)
++ X 7. Filename completion bug (see below) (deferred).
++ + 8. QNX6 herald and other problems.
++
++-------------
++
++Merged Jeff's changes, 20 Dec 2001:
++
++ . Changed all occurrences of "ttnproto == NP_TELNET" to "IS_TELNET()" to
++ account for the difference between SSH and Telnet. ckuscr.c,
++ ckuus[3457].c, ckcnet.h, ckcfns.c, ckudia.c, ckutio.c, ckucon.c, ckucns.c.
++
++ . Moved SSH pty failure warnings. ckuusr.c.
++
++ . Security adjustments to FTP module, plus fix an error message. ckcftp.c.
++
++ . Adjustment of some security-related #ifdefs. ckcdeb.h, ckuus2.c, ckctel.c.
++
++ . Guard against calling getpwnam() with a NULL arg in tilde_expand() ckufio.c.
++
++ . Moved getexedir() call to later, where it's safe. ckcmai.c.
++
++Added SSH ADD and many SSH SET commands from Jeff's spec. Fixed SHOW SSH
++to not dump core if variables weren't set. ckcker.h, ckuus[r3].c, 20 Dec 2001.
++
++C-Kermit in server mode, client says "get foo" where foo is a symlink.
++Server says "no files meet selection criteria" instead of sending the file.
++It should only refuse to follow symlinks if it's a recursive get. Fixed
++in sgetinit(): ckcpro.w, 21 Dec 2001.
++
++More work on SSH and SET/SHOW SSH commands. ckuus[r3].c, 21 Dec 2001.
++
++Undid Jeff's replacement of the SSH pseudoterminal allocation failure
++message, because now it comes out any time an SSH command has to be
++reparsed (in the non-SSHBUILTIN case). ckuusr.c, 21 Dec 2001.
++
++More SSH and SET SSH command work back & forth with Jeff, plus Jeff added
++SET HOST /NET:SSH. ckcmai.c, ckuus[r37].c, ckcdeb.h, ckuusr.h, 22 Dec 2001.
++
++Added SSH OPEN switches. ckuusr.c, 22 Dec 2001.
++
++Added SSH CLEAR, HELP SSH, and HELP SET SSH. ckuus[r2].c, 23 Dec 2001.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . SET TCP commands now apply to SSH
++ . SSH V2 REKEY and FORWRD-{LOCAL,REMOTE}-PORT commands now implemented
++ . Missing DLLs automatically disable appropriate authentication mechanisms.
++ckuusr.c ckcnet.c ckuus3.c ckcmai.c ckcnet.h ckuus4.c, 26 Dec 2001.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . Remove SET SSH KEEPALIVES.
++ . Add help text for SSH AGENT { ADD, DELETE, LIST }.
++ckuus[23].c, 28 Dec 2001.
++
++Added parsing for SSH AGENT { ADD, DELETE, LIST }. ckuusr.c, 28 Dec 2001.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . Fixed a crash that can happen when making an SSH connection.
++ . Filled in SSH AGENT actions.
++ . Changed default for strict host key check (to ASK) and help text.
++ . uploaded new binaries include ~kermit/os2test/beta/ssh-agent.exe
++ . Read man ssh-agent on ftp.kermit.columbia.edu for details on what it does.
++ckuus[r23].c, 28 Dec 2001.
++
++"ftp get path/filename" didn't work; the FTP client did not strip the path
++from the local copy of the filename when doing a GET, even though it did
++for MGET. Diagnosis: in doftpget(), the "if (!getone && !skipthis)" statement
++lacked an "else" part for the getone case. ckcftp.c, 28 Dec 2001.
++
++A while back Jeff reported that in FTP MGET, if you cancel a file with 'x',
++all the rest of the files arrive truncated to 0 bytes. I tried this on both
++Unix and Windows and couldn't reproduce it.
++
++In the last-minute flurry to release C-Kermit 8.0, I thought I noticed the FTP
++client failing to update the fullscreen file-transfer display. But it seems
++to work right, at least in Unix. When downloading a big file with FTP, all
++the display fields are updated as expected. But smaller files might go by too
++fast for the display to do anything. HOWEVER, in K95 the file transfer
++display does not update itself until the end of the file, even if the file
++takes a long time to transfer. This happens in both the Console and GUI
++versions. A thread thing? (Jeff says no.) Yet the same display works fine
++on Telnet connections.
++
++In IRIX 5.3, the select()-based CONNECT module had to include <sys/time.h>
++or else it blew up with "struct timeval" unknown. Since there already was
++a SYSTIMEH CFLAG, I added the #include within #ifdef SYSTIMEH..#endif and
++rebuilt with KFLAGS=-DSYSTIMEH, only to discover that the irix5* targets
++didn't bother to propogate KFLAGS. Fixed in ckucns.c, makefile, 30 Dec 2001.
++
++Increased IRIX5x Olimit from 2400 to 3000 because of ckuus[34].c. Added
++-ansi, since (Marcus Herbert reported) we were not actually getting ANSI-C
++compilation even though CK_ANSIC was defined. But now that we are, we get
++warnings in <netinet/tcp.h>, which is included by ckcnet.h:
++
++ bit-field 'th_off' type required to be int, unsigned int, or signed int.
++ (3.5.2.1(30))
++ u_char th_off:4,
++ ------ ^
++Tough. makefile, 30 Dec 2001.
++
++But adding -ansi to the IRIX 5x targets also make compilation bomb whenever we
++referenced fdopen() or popen(), which evidently don't have prototypes in any
++of the header files. Luckily we already have CFLAGS for this occasion too:
++DCLFDOPEN and DCLPOPEN. Added these to the irix51 target. Also had to copy
++the fdopen()-popen() prototype section to ckuusx.c, which has a new reference
++to fdopen() in a workaround for the curses console buffering bug. makefile,
++ckuusx.c, 30 Dec 2001.
++
++The QNX6 version did not receive a proper herald (it announced itself as
++"unknown version". Reshuffled #ifdefs in ckuver.h, added display of QNX6
++and NEUTRINO symbols to ckuus5.c, 30 Dec 2001.
++
++Lucas Hart sent in a patch for the VMS problem. Apparently it was even worse
++than Dave Sneddon had reported: 8.0 couldn't run at all under Batch. ckvtio.c,
++31 Dec 2001.
++
++A major obstacle to the usability of the FTP client is that certain commands
++don't behave as FTP users expect: CD, DIR, DELETE, MKDIR, etc, which are local
++rather remote, and there are no LCD (etc), USER, or ACCOUNT commands. We
++could fix this by adding an FTP command-language personality, but file
++management commands can also be remote or local on connections to Kermit
++servers too. So:
++
++SET LOCUS { LOCAL, REMOTE, AUTO }
++ Sets the locus for unprefixed file management commands.
++ When LOCAL, a REMOTE (or R) prefix is required for
++ to send file management commands to a remote server (e.g. RCD, RDIR).
++ When REMOTE, an L prefix is required to issue local file management
++ commands (e.g. LCD, LDIR). The word LOCAL can't be used as a prefix
++ since it is used for declaring local variables.
++
++This applies to all types of connections, and thus is orthogonal to SET
++GET-PUT-REMOTE, which selects between Kermit and FTP for remote file-transfer
++and management commands.
++
++The default LOCUS is AUTO, which means we switch to REMOTE whenever an FTP
++connection is made, and to LOCAL whenever a non-FTP connection is made,
++and switch back accordingly whenever a connnection is closed.
++
++Implementation (31 Dec 2001):
++ . None of this is compiled if LOCUS is not defined.
++ . Added XYLOCUS (SET LOCUS) and LOCUS definitions: ckuusr.h.
++ . Override by defining NOLOCUS (which inhibits definition of LOCUS).
++ . Added LOCUS to SET keyword table: ckuusr.c.
++ . Added locus & autolocus variables: ckuusr.c.
++ . Added SET LOCUS parsing and variable setting: ckuus3.c.
++ . Added display of LOCUS setting to SHOW COMMAND: ckuus5.c.
++ . Added automatic locus setting to setlin(): ckuus7.c.
++ . Added automatic locus setting to ftpopen() and ftpclose(): ckcftp.c.
++
++How to catch all the places where a Kermit connection is closed? Turns out
++we've done this before, when we added the connection log. So I made
++dologend() take care of locus switching. But dologend() was not compiled in
++if certain symbols were defined, such as NOLOCAL, or not defined, such as
++CKLOGDIAL. So I (a) rearranged the #ifdefs so that even if these would
++otherwise have obliviated dologend(), now they leave a piece of it for
++locus-setting; (b) moved the prototype out of #ifdefs; and (c) took all calls
++to it out of #ifdefs. ckcker.h, ckcfn2.c, ckcmai.c, ckucns.c, ckucon.c,
++ckuus[r347x].c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++Added locus checking to the following commands: DIRECTORY, CD/CWD, CDUP,
++DELETE, PWD, MKDIR, RMDIR, RENAME. ckuusr.c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++Added LDIRECTORY, LCD/LCWD, LCDUP, LDELETE, LPWD, LMKDIR, LRMDIR,
++LRENAME. ckuusr.[ch], 31 Dec 2001.
++
++Added USER and ACCOUNT commands, which are the same as FTP USER and FTP
++ACCOUNT. ckuusr.[ch], ckcftp.c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++Since automatic locus switching could be a big surprise for most people, I
++printed message any time it changed. ckcftp.c, ckuus[37].c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++Added help text for the new L commands and filled in missing HELP text for
++SET GET-PUT-REMOTE, CDUP, MKDIR, and RMDIR. ckuus2.c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++Changed help text of CD, DIR, etc, for LOCUS. Changed the help text for
++RCD, RPWD, RDEL, RDIR, etc, to mention that they also work with FTP servers.
++Updated HELP REMOTE for this too. ckuus2.c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++Made sure code builds with NOLOCAL, NOLOGDIAL, and NOLOCUS (it does).
++
++The IKSD command, when given with a /USER: switch, sends the user ID to the
++IKSD. But the SET HOST /USER: command does not, when making a connection to a
++Kermit service. This makes it impossible to script IKSD interactions using
++only client commands. Furthermore, even if you include a /PASSWORD switch
++with the IKSD command, it does not send the password. I added code near the
++bottom of setlin() to do this. If we have a connection to a Kermit service
++and a /USER: switch was given, then we attempt a REMOTE LOGIN. If a
++/PASSWORD: switch was not given then if the username is "ftp" or "anonymous",
++we automatically supply a password of user@host; otherwise we prompt for a
++password. If a /USER: switch was not given, it acts like before. It all
++works, but it might not be the best way (or place) to do it. setlin():
++ckuus7.c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++ NOTE: The above change doesn't help with IKSD /USER:anonymous,
++ the server prompts for password anyway, not sure why.
++
++ NOTE 2: What about secure authentication? We have to test to see
++ if user was already authenticated before sending the login packet.
++
++Added /opt/kermit and /opt/kermit/doc to info_dir[] list (for Solaris).
++ckuus5.c, 31 Dec 2001.
++
++From Jeff: new Help text for SET TERM FONT (K95 GUI). ckuus2.c, 1 Jan 2002.
++
++More work on help text for file management commands -- e.g. we can't lump
++the L-commands together with the unprefixed ones; they need separate entries.
++Also: added missing HELP REMOTE PWD, improved the default case (in which
++help text had been omitted for a valid command). ckuus2.c, 1 Jan 2002.
++
++It seems VMS C-Kermit was pretty much ignoring the -B (force background) and
++-z (force foreground) command-line options. Fixed in congm(): ckvtio.c,
++1 Jan 2002.
++
++Tested the SET LOCUS business with VMS C-Kermit, which does not have a
++built-in FTP client. Of course in this case there is no automatic locus
++switching, but SET LOCUS REMOTE works nicely on IKSD connections.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . #ifdef adjustments for LOCUS changes.
++ . SSH KEY CREATE /TYPE:SRP.
++ . Fix \v(serial) to not be 8N2 by default if speed is 0.
++ . Don't let doexit() run if sysinit() hasn't been called first.
++ckuus[r247x].c, 2 Jan 2002.
++
++Made SET BACKGROUND { ON, OFF } do exactly the same as -B and -z options.
++ckuus3.c, 2 Jan 2002.
++
++Updated user-visible copyright dates to 2002 (but still need to do all the
++source-module comments). ckcmai.c, ckuus[25].c, 2 Jan 2002.
++
++Rearranged #include <sys/time.h> in ckucns.c that was done for IRIX 5.3,
++to avoid conflicts in SV/68 R3v6. 3 Jan 2002.
++
++From Dave Sneddon: Code changes in VMS sysinit() and congm() to work around
++problems in batch, SPAWN'd, etc, and change CTTNAM from TT: to SYS$INPUT:.
++ckcdeb.h, ckvtio.c, 3 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . Fixed typo in definition of CTTNAM for VMS. ckcdeb.h
++ . Moved macro definitions for SSHBUILTIN from ckuus3.c to ckuusr.h
++ so they can be referenced in ckuus7.c
++ . Added SSH functionality to SET HOST:
++ SET HOST /NET:SSH /CONNECT hostname [port] /switches
++ . Fixed SET NET TYPE so it won't reject SSH if SSH is installed.
++ . Changes to allow IKSD to continue functioning. Somehow this minor change
++ to ckcmai.c got lost in one of the back and forth exchanges.
++ . HELP TEXT for UCS2 kverb
++ . Fix a problem in K95 where multiple threads could be attempting to
++ send a telnet negotiation simultaneously.
++ckcmai.c ckcdeb.h ckuus2.c ckuus3.c ckuusr.c ckuusr.h ckuus7.c ckctel.c
++ck_crp.c ckuat2.h ckuath.c, 4 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff:
++
++ Peter Runestig complaining that the Telnet Forward X code was corrupting
++ data. This resulted in a very thorough examination of the telnet module
++ code and a discovery of some rather significant problems. The root of the
++ problems is the lack of thread safety. To correct this problem the
++ following was done.
++
++ All code (regardless of module) which outputs telnet commands is placed
++ into a mutex region to ensure that competing output threads do not result
++ in interleaving their output. This could happen for instance when the
++ forward-x thread is forwarding data and the user changes the window size
++ or sends an AYT or BREAK. Next the buffer used for input and output
++ processing were identical. This means that output data could be treated
++ as input or vice versa. Ugh....
++
++ I also spent some more time cleaning up setlin(). Mostly reorganizing the
++ code into single if (...) blocks so that breaking it up will be easier.
++
++ckctel.c ckuus7.c, 4 Jan 2002.
++
++Updated internal copyright notices. All modules, 5 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff:
++ More of same, plus new makefile target and changes from Spike Gronim
++ for freebsd44+srp+openssl.
++ckcdeb.h ckcnet.c ckctel.c ckuus7.c ck_ssl.c makefile, 5 Jan 2002.
++
++Some minor updates and fixes to SSH and SET SSH help text.
++ckuus2.c, 6 Jan 2002.
++
++Added SET RGB-COLORS for GUI. ckuusr.[ch], ckuus3.c, 6 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff: More Telnet changes, Debug semaphores for K95, etc: ckcdeb.h,
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[r35x].c, ckctel.[ch], ckuath.c, 7 Jan 2002.
++
++Added --xpos:n --ypos:n, SET GUI WINDOW POSITION x y, and changed SET
++RGB-COLORS to SET GUI RGBCOLOR. Action needs to be filled in (in setguiwin()
++in ckuus3.c), and gui_xpos and gui_ypos need to be defined in cko???.c.
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[r3y].c, 7 Jan 2002.
++
++Added --fontname:name --fontsize:name (and facename as synonym for fontname).
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[7y].c, 7 Jan 2002.
++
++Moved GUI (not OS/2) SET TERM FONT code in ckuus7.c to its own routine,
++setguifont(), in ckuus3.c, and made GUI SET TERM FONT call this routine,
++and also made SET GUI FONT call the same routine. ckuus[37].c, 7 Jan 2002.
++
++Added --termtype:, --height:, --width:, --user:. Also added symbols for
++--telnet:, --ssh:, --ftp:, --[remote-]charset, and --password:, but didn't
++fill them in. --password: is probably not a good idea (but we allow it for
++FTP); the others involve a lot of code-shuffling and reconciliation, which
++I'll try to do when I get a chance (especially the connection ones, which
++can be done as part of the setlin() restructuring). ckuusr.h, ckuusy.c,
++8 Jan 2002.
++
++Also I tried commenting out the #ifndef KUI..#endif's around SET TERMINAL
++CHARACTER-SET (easier said than done because a crucial #endif was mislabeled).
++Let's see if it compiles & works... ckuus7.c, 8 Jan 2002
++
++Added FTP [ OPEN ] /NOINIT, meaning don't send REST, STRU, and MODE commands
++upon making an FTP connection. This allows connection to servers that close
++the connection (or worse) when given these commands (e.g. Linux 2.4 TUX 2.0
++FTP server). ckcftp.c, 8 Jan 2002.
++
++Looked at adding caller ID support for the ANSWER command:
++
++ . SET ANSWER CALLER-ID { ON, OFF }
++ . SET ANSWER RINGS <number>
++ . \v(callid_xxx) xxx = { date, time, name, nmbr, mesg }
++ . CKD_CID modem capability
++ . Set CKD_CID for modems that have it.
++ . A quick survey shows:
++ - USR V.90: No (but Jeff says some USRs have it).
++ - V.250: No
++ - Lucent Venus: No
++ - USR: #CID=1 (the ones that have it -- X2?)
++ - Diamond Supra: #CID=1
++ - Rockwell 56K: #CID=1
++ - PCTEL: #CID=1
++ - Zoltrix: +VCID=1
++ - Conexant: +VCID=1
++ . Since there are different commands to enable caller ID reporting,
++ we need a new field in struct MDMINF.
++ . SHOW MODEM and SHOW DIAL would need updating.
++ . etc etc...
++
++This is all way too much for now so I just did the setting of the \v(callid_*)
++variables. These are reset at the beginning of an ANSWER command, and then
++set by the ANSWER command if they come in; thus they persist from the time
++they are collected until another ANSWER command is given. To take advantage
++of autoanswer, the user has to enable it in the modem (all the modems I found
++that support it have it disabled by default), and also has to set the number
++of rings to at least 2. This can be done with (depending on the modem):
++
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=2#CID=1\{13}
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=2+VCID=1\{13}
++
++and undone with:
++
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=1#CID=0\{13}
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=1+VCID=0\{13}
++
++The variables can be accessed only after the call is answered. Therefore the
++only way to refuse a call is to answer it, inspect the variables, and then
++hang it up if desired. Future Kermit releases can do this more nicely (as
++sketched out above.) Also while I was in the dialing code, I added result
++code VCON (= VOICE), used by several of the newer modems. These changes are
++untested. The SET ANSWER command is written but commented out. ckuusr.h,
++ckcker.h, ckuus[r3].c, ckudia.c, 8 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff: fixes to --termtype:, --height:, --width:, --user:, and filling in
++of --rcharset:, which required extracting code from settrm() into a separate
++parse-method-independent remote character-set setting routine. ckuus[7y].c,
++8 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff: More work on TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET code reorganization, and
++reinstatement of SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET in K95G. Also, fix char/CHAR
++warnings in Telnet module. ckuus7.c, ckctel.c, 9 Jan 2002.
++
++Made SET TERM CHARACTER-SET visible for all builds, including K95G, and filled
++in HELP text for it. ckuus[27].c, 9 Jan 2002.
++
++Added help text for new extended options. ckuusy.c, 9 Jan 2002.
++
++Commented out the return(-2) statement at the end of xgnbyte() to make the
++"Statement not reached" errors go away, after checking to make sure that there
++was no path that could fall through to the end. I'm 99.99% sure there isn't,
++but that doesn't mean that some compilers might not still complain. ckcfns.c,
++9 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff: fix typo in the K95 extended-option help text; add more
++semaphores to network i/o. ckuusy.c, ckcnet.c, 10 Jan 2002.
++
++Undid ansiisms in set{lcl,rem}charset() declarations. ckuus7.c, 10 Jan 2002.
++
++Removed a duplicated clause from the install target. makefile, 10 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff: more semaphores. ckcnet.c, 11 Jan 2002.
++
++Moved references to tmpusrid and tmpstring out of NOSPL #ifdefs -- they can
++be used with NOSPL. setlin(): ckuus7.c, 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Made a dummy dologend() routine outside of #ifndef NOICP, so we don't have
++to enclose every reference to dologend in #ifdefs. (I had added a bunch of
++calls to dologend() throughout the code to handle automatic LOCUS switching.)
++ckuus3.c, 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Moved "extern int nettype" outside of NOICP #ifdefs in ckuus4.c for NOICP
++builds. 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Moved a misplaced #ifdef in the VERSION command. ckuusr.c, 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Did 81 different feature-selection builds on Linux (RH 7.0), all OK after the
++changes listed above for today. 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Added prototypes for set{rem,lcl}charset(). ckcxla.h, 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Added ckcxla.h to dependencies for ckuusy.c. ckvker.com, 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Made a correction to the HELP SET LOCUS text and supplied a missing comma
++for HELP REMOTE. ckuus2.c, 13 Jan 2002.
++
++Built OK on HP-UX 11.11 (K&R and ANSI), Solaris 8 (cc), Solaris 2.5.1 (gcc),
++SunOS 4.1.3 (cc and gcc), VMS 7.1 (DEC C, net and nonet), Unixware 7.1.1,
++Tru64 4.0G, HP-UX 10.20 (K&R), AIX 4.3.3, FreeBSD 2.2.8, Slackware 8.0, IRIX
++6.5.13f, IRIX 5.3 (??? Can't tell -- the computer ran out of swap space -- but
++it was OK a few days ago), VMS 5.5-2 (VAX C, UCX + nonet)... HP-UX 9.05, ...
++
++Some corrections to comments in HP targets from PeterE. makefile, 14 Jan 2002.
++
++Corrections to prototypes for set{rem,lcl}charset() (VOID, not void) from Jeff.
++ckcxla.h, 14 Jan 2002.
++
++Builds, cont'd... SINIX 5.42, Red Hat Linux 5.2 on i386, SuSE 7.0 on S/390,
++Red Hat 7.1 on IA64, QNX 4.25, HP-UX 5.21/WinTCP, ...,
++
++Dell Coleman <dell@aleph.tum.com> noticed that in AIX, the COPY command always
++says "Source and destination are the same file" when the destination file
++doesn't exist. This is because in AIX, realpath() fails with ENOENT (errno
++2). The zfnqfp() code already accounts for this, but evidently not well
++enough. So I did what I should have done long ago. zfnqfp() was originally
++accomplished with do-it-yourself code. Later I added support for realpath(),
++and partitioned the routine into mutually exclusive compile-time sections:
++#ifdef CKREALPATH realpath()... #else do-it-yourself... #endif. But if
++realpath() failed, there was no recourse to the do-it-yourself code. Today I
++replaced the #else with the #endif, so the do-it-yourself part is always
++included and is executed if the realpath() call fails. Built and tested on
++AIX 4.3.3 and Solaris 2.5.1, as well as on Linux with and without the
++realpath() code included. zfnqfp(): ckufio.c, 16 Jan 2002.
++
++Separated K95 and C-Kermit test version numbers, so C-Kermit can be RC.02
++while K95 is Beta.01. ckcmai.c, 16 Jan 2002.
++
++Inhibited 0-length writes by conol() and conoll(), since they cause big
++trouble with the AIX 4.3.3 pty driver, e.g. when you have an SSH connection
++into AIX and run C-Kermit there. ckutio.c, 16 Jan 2002.
++
++Suppressed "Switching LOCUS..." messages from FTP client when it was invoked
++from the command line. ckcfns.c, 17 Jan 2002.
++
++Dave Sneddon noticed that FOPEN /APPEND gets "?Write access denied" in VMS
++if the file exists. This is apparently because VMS zchko() does the wrong
++thing. Commenting out the call zchko() in the VMS case gets past this but
++then the appended part of the file has different attributes than the orignal
++part, e.g.:
++
++ abc <- original line (horizontal, normal)
++ d <- appended line (vertical)
++ e
++ f
++
++VMS fopen() takes an optional 4th argument: a series of RMS keyword=value
++pairs. Kermit doesn't give any. Experimentation shows that appending to
++a Stream_LF works fine. That'll be a restriction for now, until somebody
++sends in code to get the RMS attributes of the original file and feed them
++to fopen(). Also need code to fix VMS zhcko() to say whether it's OK to
++append to a file. ckuus7.c, 17 Jan 2002.
++
++Somebody suggested I could get a working Kermit for Neutrino 2+ by doing the
++QNX6 build on Neutrino itself. I verified that this can't be done -- at least
++not by me -- since Netutrino 2+ doesn't have a compiler, and we already know
++the version cross-built for it on QNX4 doesn't work. 17 Jan 2002.
++
++From Jeff: SET SSH GSSAPI KEY-EXCHANGE { ON, OFF } parsing, SHOW SSH.
++ckuus3.c, 18 Jan 2002.
++
++PeterE suggested that SET ESCAPE allow 8-bit escape characters because of the
++difficulty in entering Ctrl-\ on European keyboards and the hardship (e.g. to
++EMACS and VI users) of sacrificing another C0 control character. Like
++everything these days, this turns out to be rather a bigger deal than it would
++seem. The SET ESCAPE parser calls setcc(), which accepts control characters
++in various formats (literal, ^X notation, or numbers), and gives an error
++return if the value is not 0-31 or 127. This is changed easily enough to also
++allow numbers between 128 and 255. But who else calls setcc()? The commands
++for setting Kermit packet start and end characters. No big deal, this gives
++people a bit more flexibility in case they need it, but it won't be
++documented. setcc(): ckuus7.c, 18 Jan 2002.
++
++Since code to display the escape character is scattered all over the place,
++and some of it indexes into an array based on the character value (which would
++now dump core if the escape character was > 128), I put the code in one place,
++a new shoesc() routine in ckuusx.c (which needs to be outside #ifndef NOICP,
++since the CONNECT modules use it even in command-line only builds). Also
++discovered that this code was indexing into the nm[] array with tt_escape to
++get "enabled" or "disabled", which is no longer appropriate, so fixed this
++too. ckuusr.h, ckuus[5x].c, 18 Jan 2002.
++
++Made SHOW ESCAPE, SHOW TERM, and the various CONNECT modules call shoesc(),
++and updated HELP SET ESC. ckuus[25].c, ckucns.c, ck[cuvd9]con.c, 18 Jan 2002.
++
++After all that, it occurred to me that this is a really bad idea for K95,
++with all the confusion about Console code pages, OEM code pages, Windows
++code pages, and Unicode. But I tried "echo \161" at the K95 prompt and got
++the expected 8-bit character in both the Console version and the GUI, so
++maybe it's OK after all.
++
++Removed the automatic IKSD login code from setlin() since it complicates
++interactive anonymous login. ckuus7.c, 20 Jan 2002.
++
++An #ifdef clause from Matthew Clarke to avoid "redeclaration of free" error
++when building a curses version of C-Kermit for AIX 2.2.1 on RT PC. ckuusx.c,
++22 Jan 2002.
++
++Took care of one detail I omitted when adding the 8-bit escape character:
++not stripping the 8th bit before comparing the keyboard char with the escape
++char. ck[uv]con.c, ckucns.c, 24 Jan 2002.
++
++Started to go through Jeff's changes of the last week but he had run trim -t
++on them, which untabifies, so the diffs were huge. Retabifying Jeff's files
++only makes matters worse. So instead of comparing each old and new source
++file in EMACS windows with M-X Compare-Windows like I usually do (which can't
++be told to ignore whitespace), I had to work from the diff -c -b listings.
++In ascending order of size of diffs:
++
++ckcker.h: Add I_AM_SSHSUB definition.
++ckuusr.h: XXLINK and VN_PERSONAL, etc, definitions.
++ckuusy.c: Support for "I Am SSHSUB" invocation.
++ckuus5.c: Support for new K95 directory structure.
++ckcmai.c: Init endianness earlier (K95 TYPE was broken), "I Am SSHSUB" support.
++ckuus7.c: Security #ifdefs, SSH OPEN /PASSWORD, SSHSUB support
++ckcftp.c: <-- SAVE TIL LAST
++ckuus6.c: Add LINK command for K95 on NT.
++ckuus4.c: Support for new K95 directory structure; SSHSUB support
++ckuus3.c: Support for new K95 directory structure; some SSH changes
++ckuus2.c: Changes to SSH related help text, add HELP LINK text
++ckuusr.c: LINK command, SSH OPEN /PASSWORD: /SUBSYSTEM: switches,
++ Pattern-management fixes.
++ckctel.c, ck_ssl.c, ckuath.c, ckcnet.c:
++ Took Jeff's without looking.
++ckuusx.c, ckucns.c, ckucon.c, ckwart.c:
++ My changes from weeks ago that were never picked up.
++
++Built OK on Solaris with gcc and on SunOS with (K&R non-ANSI) cc.
++31 Jan 2002.
++
++Meanwhile, Jeff had made various changes in response to Jaya Natarajan at IBM,
++whose basic complaint was that numerous failure conditions were not being
++detected if the fullscreen file-transfer display was active. Jeff found that
++this was because big blocks of code were skipped in that case and changed the
++code not to do that, which fixed the reported problems. But later Jaya said
++that "ftp mget file1 file2" acted like "ftp mget *", so it seemed that Jeff's
++fixes broke file selection. After taking Jeff's fixes for ckcftp.c, however,
++I still could not reproduce the problem. ckcftp.c, 31 Jan 2002. <-- Later,
++it turned out the problem was with IBM's custom FTP server.
++
++Fixed updates that I missed yesterday in ckcftp.c, ckuusr.c. Moved misplaced
++#ifdef in ckuusy.c breaking nonet builds. Added #ifdefs to sysinit() for
++nonet builds in ckutio.c. Ran through build-in-many-configurations script
++in Linux, all builds OK. 1 Feb 2002.
++
++Moved shoesc() definition outside of NOXFER to fix NOXFER builds.
++ckuusx.c, 1 Feb 2002.
++
++Added MYCUSTOM definition alongside KERMRC and changed KERMCL to be the
++same as CKMAXPATH, instead of some random hardwired number. ckuusr.h,
++1 Feb 2002.
++
++Changed ckcdeb.h to define DIRSEP and ISDIRSEP(), and put #ifndef
++[IS]DIRSEP..#endif around all [IS]DIRSEP definitions in ck[udso]fio.c, so we
++can finally put away the many repeated #ifdef chains when we get around to it.
++1 Feb 2002.
++
++Make VMS zkermini() return 1 on success, 0 on failure, rather than 0 always.
++ckvfio.c, 1 Feb 2002.
++
++Added code to doinit(), just before it goes to execute the init file. If the
++init file name we are about to open is empty or fails zchki(), substitute the
++customization filename. For now this code is in #ifdef USE_CUSTOM..#endif,
++which is not defined by default. It does the trick in Unix and VMS. Also
++included code from Jeff for K95, but this needs verification and testing.
++Also used DIRSEP and ISDIRSEP() throughout doinit() instead of the long #ifdef
++chains. ckuus5.c, 1 Feb 2002.
++
++Moved shoesc() prototype from ckuusr.h to ckcker.h so modules that need it
++don't have to include ckuusr.h just for this one thing (example: ckvcon.c).
++1 Feb 2002.
++
++Defined USE_CUSTOM by default, except if NOCUSTOM is defined. ckuusr.h,
++1 Feb 2002.
++
++Fixed kermit-sshsub code to really enter server mode, and to print
++"KERMIT READY TO SERVE..." so scripts can wait for it. Also bumped the
++C-Kermit test ID to RC.03 and the K95 one to Beta.02. ckcpro.w, ckcmai.c,
++2 Feb 2002.
++
++I was thinking about adding SET COMMAND BUFFER-SIZE to let people allocate
++as big a buffer as they wanted at runtime, mainly for defining huge macros.
++Moved the SCMD_blah definitions from ckuusr.h to ckuus3.c, since they aren't
++used anywhere else. But stopped there since the rest turns out to be a rather
++big deal. ckuusr.h, ckuus3.c, 2 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 3 Feb 2002:
++ . Fix an out-of-order modem name in the SET MODEM TYPE table: ckudia.c.
++ . Use SET LOGIN USER and PASSWORD if present. ckcftp.c.
++
++Cody Gould noticed that array declarations had become case sensitive, and
++upper case didn't work. Diagnosis: misplaced case conversion in xarray().
++Fixed in ckuus5.c, 4 Feb 2002.
++
++SHOW VAR dumps core on \v(sexpression) or \v(svalue) -- failure to check for
++NULL pointer. I wonder why this didn't happen before (answer: because I was
++doing it on SunOS; now I'm doing it on Solaris). ckuus4.c, 6 Feb 2002.
++
++I've had several requests for "show var name name name...". I added this to
++doshow(), such that SHOW VAR works exactly as it did before (if you don't give
++it an arg, it lists all variables; if you give it an arg, it appends "*" to it
++and lists all matching variables) but now you can also give more than one arg
++and it works the same way with each one as it did before if you gave it a
++single item (i.e., "*" is appended, so "show var os cmd" shows all variables
++whose names begin with "os" or "cmd". You can also freely use pattern
++notation, including anchors. Hmmm, no, actually it's different in that now
++each includes an implied * before AND after, so "show var version" shows all
++variables whose name contain "version" rather than all variables whose names
++start with it. ckuus5.c, 6 Feb 2002.
++
++Cody Gould reported that WRITE FILE blah blah \fexec(anything) ... got a
++spurious "File or Log not open" error. This turns out to be a rather
++pervasive problem -- whenever you use \fexec() it calls the parser recursively
++and this can run roughshod over global variables, such as our innocent little
++x, y, and s. The fix in this case was to put x and y on the stack. The same
++thing probably needs doing in about 10,000 other places. Too bad C isn't
++Algol. ckuusr.c, 6 Feb 2002.
++
++Minor fix to SHO VAR -- the "^" anchor wasn't working (e.g. "show var ^os").
++ckuus5.c, 6 Feb 2002.
++
++Fixes from Jeff for FTP file-transfer character-set translation in K95 and
++in WIKSD, plus updated K95 SSH help text. ckcftp.c, ckcfns.c, ckuus2.c,
++7 Feb 2002.
++
++Server has its date set in the past. Client says "remote dir". Server sends
++A packet containing old date. If client has FILE COLLISION UPDATE, it
++rejects the directory listing. Changed gattr() to only reject real files
++(introduced by F packet), not X-packet material like directory listings.
++ckcfn3.c, 7 Feb 2002.
++
++Up-down arrow keys for command recall. People have been asking for it for
++years but now it's actually important because of PDAs that don't have Ctrl
++keys. Would have been trivial except that we use getchar() rather than
++coninc() for reading from the keyboard in Unix so conchk() doesn't help. In
++fact there are lots of other places where conchk() is used this way and works
++only by accident. The only reason we never noticed a problem before is that
++characters don't usually arrive from the keyboard that fast. But when an
++arrow key sends "ESC [ A" all once, the stdin buffer gets some extra stuff in
++it, which getchar() will return next time, but which coninc()/conchk() will
++never see. So I added a new cmdconchk() routine which, if the keyboard is
++being read with getchar() rather than coninc(), looks at the stdin buffer.
++Unfortunately, however, there is no API for this, nor is there any standard
++way to access the stdin buffer directly. So first I did it for Solaris. Then
++to make it portable requires a survey of the headers for every platform. I
++found four major variations:
++
++ stdin->_r:
++ {Free,Open,Net}BSD, BSDI
++ stdin->_cnt:
++ SunOS, Solaris, HP-UX 5-6, AIX, VMS, SINIX, IRIX 5.3-6.5, DGUX
++ 4.2BSD, 4.3BSD, OSF/1..Tru64, QNX4, Unixware 1.0-2.1.0
++ stdin->__cnt:
++ HP-UX 7-11, SCO: OSR5.0.6a, Unixware 2.1.3-7.x, OU8, UNIX 3.2v4.x
++ Subtract read from end pointer (_IO_file_flags defined):
++ Linux (tested on RH 5.2 thru 7.1)
++
++The Linux method is new and different to account for multibyte characters.
++All the others assume character == byte.
++
++For docs: ANSI only, 7-bit only; both application and cursor modes are
++accepted. Only up and down arrow are handled; left and right arrows cause
++a beep. ckucmd.c, 8 Feb 2002.
++
++Build-all: Discovered that changing CTTNAM from TT: to SYS$INPUT: in VMS
++(which was done on 3 Jan 2002 to work around problems starting Kermit in
++batch, spawn'd, etc) breaks Kermit on VMS 5.5/VAX (concb() fails with "lacks
++sufficient privilege"; if you enable all privs Kermit starts but then spews
++out a constant stream of BEL characters). If you put dftty back to "TT:",
++everything is fine -- I have no idea why, so I used #ifdef VMSV70 to decide,
++which is totally crude. Next I had to find where the boundary really is: VAX
++vs Alpha? VAX C vs DEC C? Or between VMS releases? Built on:
++ . VMS 6.2 Alpha (DEC C) - OK with TT:
++ . VMS 6.2 Alpha (DEC C) - OK with SYS$INPUT: <-- keep this one
++ . VMS 7.1 VAX (DEC C)
++So the final condition is #ifdef VMSV60. ckvker.com, ckvtio.c, ckuus5.c.
++
++QNX 6 needed some attention too:
++ . Whoever did the makefile target made the default port "/dev/ser1".
++ . Arrow keys...
++But I gave up on getting arrow keys to work -- it should be just like *BSD,
++but for some reason gcc complains that struct FILE has no _r member, even
++though it does (getchar uses it).
++
++Checked stdio.h on Mac OS X and it looks like the *BSDs.
++
++--- C-Kermit 8.0.201 ---
++
++Removed -g from solaris2xg+krb5+krb4+openssl+shadow makefile target -- it
++was producing a 15MB binary! makefile, 14 Feb 2002.
++
++Fixed a couple thinkos in "make install": $(DESTDIR) should not have been
++included in the tests for whether INFODIR or SRCDIR were desired. makefile,
++14 Feb 2002.
++
++(tarball refreshed 16 Feb 2002)
++
++--- C-Kermit 8.0.201 ---
++
++From Jeff: Better seeding of \frandom(): ckcmai.c, ckuus4.c, 18 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff: Make arrow keys work in WIKSD, but now also unconditionally
++compile arrow-key code in all versions. ckucmd.c, 18 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff: ckuath.c, ck_ssl.c, ckcnet.c (didn't look). 18 Feb 2002.
++
++Added ORIENTATION command, that lists the various important directories, and
++\flongpathname() and \fshortpathname(), which do path format conversions in
++Windows, and are just synonynyms for \fpathname() elsewhere. The new functions
++need building and testing in Windows. ckuusr.h, ckuus[r24].c, 18 Feb 2002.
++
++Changed PWD for Windows only to show both short and long paths (but only if
++they are different; otherwise it behaves as before). ckuusr.c, 18 Feb 2002.
++
++Changed default Windows prompt to show long pathname. ckuus5.c, 18 Feb 2002.
++
++Updated INTRO command to mention FTP, HTTP, and SSH. ckuus2.c, 18 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff: fixes for typos in GetLongPathName() code: ckuus[r4].c, 22 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff: net/auth updates: ckcnet.c, ckuath.c, 22 Feb 2002.
++
++Added -DUSE_FILE__CNT to NCR MPRAS targets, George Gilmer: makefile,
++24 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff: Add support for GetLongPathName() in Win95 and NT: ckcdeb.h,
++ckuus[r4].c, 24 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff: More fixes for FTP SIGINT, plus fix [M]PUT /MOVE. ckcftp.c,
++24 Feb 2002.
++
++Fixed an unguarded reference to inserver, gtword(): ckucmd.c, 24 Feb 2002.
++
++Adapted RETRIEVE for use with FTP connections; this one was missed when
++adapting GET, REGET, MOVE, etc. ckuus6.c, ckcftp.c, 24 Feb 2002.
++
++Added special COPYRIGHT command text for the free version of WIKSD.
++ckcmai.c, ckuusr.c, 24 Feb 2002.
++
++C-Kermit, when in CONNECT mode and given the <Esc-Char>U sequence, would
++unconditionally close the connection if it was a network connection. This
++is bad when Telnetting to a modem server. I added to code to prevent this
++in the RFC2117 TELNET COMPORT case but I'm not sure how to exend this to the
++general case (or whether it would be a good idea). ckucns.c, 24 Feb 2002.
++
++During file transfer, chktimo() calls ttgspd() for every packet, which clearly
++doesn't make sense on network connections, especially since on Telnet COMPORT
++connections it results in a network speed query for every packet. Rearranged
++the code so this happens only on true serial-port connections. ckcfn2.c,
++24 Feb 2002.
++
++From Jeff: Fix reversed ANSI/non-ANSI function declarations clauses in
++ckcftp.c, 26 Feb 2002.
++
++Changed Unix CONNECT module to call kstart() only when it has a chance of
++doing anything (i.e. a Kermit packet has been partially detected, or the
++packet start character just came in), rather than unconditionally on every
++incoming character. ckucns.c, 8 Mar 2002.
++
++FTP PUT /SERVER-RENAME:, /RENAME-TO:, /MOVE-TO: were sticky. Patch: In
++ckcftp.c, near the top of doftpput(), add the lines marked with "+":
++
++ makestr(&filefile,NULL); /* No filename list file yet. */
+++ makestr(&srv_renam,NULL); /* Clear /SERVER-RENAME: */
+++ makestr(&snd_rename,NULL); /* PUT /RENAME */
+++ makestr(&snd_move,NULL); /* PUT /MOVE */
++ putpath[0] = NUL; /* Initialize for syncdir(). */
++
++ckcftp.c, 26 Mar 2002.
++
++\fday() and \fnday() were broken for dates prior to 17 Nov 1858. Fixed in
++fneval(): ckuus4.c, 28 Mar 2002.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . New calling convenion for demoscrn(): ckucmd.c, ckuusx.c
++ . Fix for host-initiated 80/132 col screen mode change. ckuus7.c.
++ . New \v(desktop) variable: K95 user desktop directory, ckuusr.h, ckuus4.c
++ . New \v(rfc2717_signature) var: Telnet Com Port, ckuusr.h, ckuus4.c
++ . Uncomment "not-reached" return(-2) in xgnbyte(): ckcfns.c
++ . New dates: ckcmai.c.
++ . Telnet Com Port fixes: ckutio.c
++ . SET PRINTER fixes for K95: ckuus3.c
++ . Session limit adjustments: ckuus3.c
++ . New directory layout for K95 (TAKE, ORIENT): ckuusr.c
++ . Fixes for Telnet Com Port, recycling SSH connections: ckuusr.c
++
++From me, not picked up by Jeff previously:
++ . kstart() speedup: ckucns.c.
++
++1 Apr 2002.
++
++---K95 1.1.21---
++
++From Jeff, 4 Apr 2002:
++ . More fixes for Telnet Com Port: ckuus4.c, ckudia.c, ckutio.c, ckcnet.c:
++ . network connections will check for carrier detect if SET
++ CARRIER-WATCH is ON. This could have a potential conflict if
++ the option is negotiated and the carrier is off, but the site
++ requires login.
++ . modem hangup message generated since the dial module did not
++ believe that network modems could be reset with a DTR drop.
++ . Version number adjustments: 8.0.203, 1.1.99: ckcmai.c.
++ . Security: ck_ssl.[ch], ckuath.c.
++
++---C-Kermit 8.0.203---
++
++From Jeff, 6 Apr 2002:
++ . Fix typo in HELP REMOTE HOST: ckuus2.c.
++ . More Telnet Com Port fixes: ckctel.c, ckcnet.c, ckudia.c, ckutio.c
++
++From Jeff, 9 Apr 2002:
++ . Fix autodownload problem: ckcfn[2s].c.
++
++Chiaki Ishikawa reported that in Linux (two different kinds), if you choose
++hardware parity, CONNECT, then escape back, the speed can change. I tracked
++this down to the following statement in ttvt():
++
++ tttvt.c_cflag &= ~(IGNPAR); /* Don't discard incoming bytes */
++
++Somehow execution of this statement corrupted the speed words of the termios
++struct, which are entirely separate words that are nowhere near the c_cflag
++member. Anyway, the statement is wrong; it should be:
++
++ tttvt.c_cflag |= IGNPAR; /* Don't discard incoming bytes */
++
++Fixing it cured the problem; don't ask me why. ckutio.c, 9 Apr 2002.
++
++From Jeff:
++ fixes the problem reported by robi@hastdeer.com.au. The request to
++ enter server mode was received while we were entering server mode.
++ But the server was waiting for the response to REQ_STOP sent to the
++ client. Therefore, we weren't quite in server mode yet and the
++ request to enter server mode was rejected. A check for the sstate
++ value solves the problem. ckctel.c, 10 Apr 2002.
++
++Chiaki Ishikawa (CI) discovered the real cause for the speed changing problem.
++I was setting the IGNPAR bit in the wrong flag word: it should have been
++c_iflag instead of c_oflag, silly me. Fixed in ttvt() and ttpkt(): ckutio.c.
++I also did a thorough census of all the termio[s] flags to ensure each was
++applied to the right flag word -- they were, IGNPAR in the HWPARITY case was
++the only mistake. CI also discovered that the speed words in the Linux
++termios struct are not used at all -- the speeds are encoded in an
++undocumented field of c_cflag, which explains the problem. 10 Apr 2002.
++
++Any use of \{nnn} character notation in a macro definition, loop, or other
++braced block caused an "unbalanced braces" parse error. The backslash in this
++case is not quoting the open brace; it's introducing a balanced braced
++quantity. Special-cased in getncm(): ckuus5.c, 12 Apr 2002.
++
++The semantics of "if defined \v(xxx)" were changed in 8.0 to avoid obnoxious
++error messages when xxx was not a built-in variable (see notes of 19 Nov
++2000), such that "if defined \v(xxx)" would always succeed if there were such
++a variable, even if it had no value. The behavior that is documented in the
++book (and also in ckermit70.html) and that we had in versions 6 and 7, was
++that IF DEFINED \v(xxx) would fail if \v(xxx) was defined but had an empty
++value OR if it was not defined, and would succeed only if it was defined and
++had a value. Fixed in boolexp(): ckuus6.c, 12 Apr 2002.
++
++What about \function()s? IF DEF \fblah() presently succeeds if the function
++exists; you don't even have to give arguments. I think this behavior is more
++useful than if I required valid arguments and then evaluated the function --
++you can do that anyway with 'if not eq "\fxxx(a,b)" "" ...' Of course this
++argument applies to "if def \v(xxx)" too, except that the current behavior is
++consistent with the 7.0 behavior, so there is no need for a change.
++
++Kent Martin discovered that if a macro contains a LOCAL statement for a
++variable whose name is the same as, or a unique left substring of, the macro's
++name, then undefining the local variable makes the macro disappear:
++
++ define DateDiff {
++ echo {DateDiff(\%1) executing...}
++ }
++ define Kent {
++ do DateDiff {2}
++ local date
++ assign date {}
++ do DateDiff {3} <-- This fails (A)
++ }
++ do DateDiff {1}
++ do Kent
++ do DateDiff {4} <-- So does this (B)
++
++The first part of the problem is that "assign date {}" called delmac with
++exact=0, so delmac evidently deleted first macro whose name started with
++"date" -- and since the only one was DateDiff, that's the one that was
++deleted. Fixing this (change "delmac(vnp,0)" to "delmac(vnp,1)" in dodef())
++got us past A. The second part was making the same fix to the delmac()
++call in popclvl(). ckuus[56].c, 13 Apr 2002.
++
++The INPUT command ignored the parity setting, thus SET PARITY EVEN,
++INPUT 10 "login:" didn't work. Fixed in doinput(): ckuus4.c. Also fixed a
++bogus #ifdef COMMENT section that messed up the block structure of the module
++and therefore EMACS's indenting. 18 Apr 2002.
++
++Added sco32v500net+ssl and Added sco32v505net+ssl targets, from Scott Rochford
++at Dell (not sure yet if they work). Makefile, 19 Apr 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 22 Apr 2002:
++ . Added "darkgray" color and made "dgray" an invisible synonym: ckuus3.c.
++ . Fix carrier sense on Telnet Com Port immediately after dial: ckudia.c.
++ . Change krb5_des_blah() arg list: ckutio.c.
++ . Fix ttgmdm() for Telnet Com Port: ckutio.c.
++ . Fix tthang() return code: ckutio.c.
++ . Add aix43gcc+openssl target: makefile.
++
++From Jeff, 25 Apr 2002:
++ . Fix SET GUI keyword table: ckuus[37].c.
++ . A final fix to Telnet Com Port: ckctel.c, ckcnet.c.
++
++From Jeff, 26 Apr 2002:
++ . Another final fix to Telnet Com Port: ckctel.c, ckudia.c.
++
++From Jeff, 27 Apr 2002:
++ . separate the wait mechanism for TELNET SB COMPORT synchronous messages
++ from the asynchronous TELNET SB COMPORT MODEMSTATUS messages: ckctel.[ch]
++ . fix debug messages in Certificate verify functions: ck_ssl.c, ckcftp.c.a
++
++Frank, 27 Apr 2002:
++ . Fixed VMS zgetfs() to fail when file doesn't exist: ckvfio.c.
++ . Fixed UNIX zgetfs() to check for null or empty arg: ckufio.c.
++ . Added #include <time.h> for time() call: ckcmai.c.
++ . Add casts to args in tn_wait() calls: ckctel.c.
++
++SINIX-P 5.42 (Pyramid architecture) makefile target from Igor Sobrado.
++makefile (no source-code changes), 1 May 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 5 May 2002,
++ . Fix some "unknown host" messages: ckcftp.c.
++ . Add more casts to tnc_wait() calls: ckudia.c.
++ . Improvements to SHOW SSH, SHOW GUI: ckuus3.c.
++ . Fixes to SET COMMAND { WIDTH, HEIGHT }: ckuus3.c.
++ . Updates to ck_ssl.[ch], ckctel.c, ckcnet.c.
++
++Fixed the erroneous setting of ssh_cas during switch parsing rather than
++after cmcfm() in setlin(): ckuus7.c, 5 May 2002.
++
++setlin() decomposition (2300 lines), Part One:
++
++ . Copied a big chunk from the end of setlin(), beginning with net directory
++ lookup, but only the network-specific and common parts, to a new routine,
++ cx_net(), 900 lines.
++
++ . Extracted many repetitious lines of error-message code from cx_net()
++ to a new routine, cx_fail(). Error messages are stored in slmsg, and
++ also printed but only if we were not called from a GUI dialog (and
++ QUIET wasn't set, etc etc). Any adjutments in this policy can now be
++ made in one place.
++
++ . I put a call to cx_net() in setlin() just before all the code it replaced.
++ It works for TELNET and SET HOST /TELNET.
++
++ . Built with mkwatsol-k5k4ssl; after a couple fixes it builds OK and makes
++ Kerberized connections OK.
++
++ . Copied the serial-port and common parts of the setlin() post-cmcfm()
++ code to another new routine, cx_serial(), about 275 lines. Fixed
++ messages not to come out when called from GUI dialog, etc. Inserted
++ a call to cx_serial() at the appropriate spot in setlin(). Tested
++ serial connections on watsun with "set line /dev/ttyh6", works OK.
++
++ . Removed all the code from setlin() that was copied to cx_*(). This slims
++ setlin() down to 1120 lines. Tested regular Telnet, Kerberized Telnet, and
++ serial connections again, all OK. The Unix version of the SSH command is
++ OK too.
++
++setlin() deconstruction, Part Two:
++
++Now that we have the common network and serial connection pieces moved out of
++setlin(), we still need to move out the little code snippets for each network
++type that take place between command confirmation and the common code we just
++replaced. As far as I can tell, this needs doing only for SSH. The code
++labeled "Stash everything" copied to cx_ssh() but I didn't remove the original
++code since I can't test this. I think I'm done -- maybe I'm overlooking
++something but I don't know what... First we need to test the heck out of it
++in all command-line versions (K95 and C-Kermit). Then to use this from
++the GUI, see the calling sequences for cx_serial(), cx_net(), and cx_ssh():
++
++ . For serial or TAPI connections, the GUI should call cx_serial().
++ . For SSH connections, it should call cx_ssh() and then cx_net().
++ . For all other network connections, just calls cx_net().
++
++ckuus7.c, Cinco de Mayo de 2002.
++
++New ckuus7.c from Jeff, 8 May 2002. Merge cx_ssh() into cx_net(). Also: I
++had made line[] an automatic variable, since the global line[] buffer is used
++by almost every parsing routine in C-Kermit to hold string fields between
++parsing and execution but Jeff says he found that some code somewhere depended
++on line[] containing the hostname after setlin() was finished.
++
++From Jeff, 10 May 2002:
++ . Fix SET SSH STRICT-HOST-CHECKING parse: ckuus3.c.
++ . Add prototypes for cx_net() and cx_serial(): ckuusr.h.
++ . Add ANSI versions of cx_net() and cx_serial() declarations and supply a
++ missing parameter in the cx_serial() invocation, change SSHCMD cx_net()
++ invocation to new form.
++
++From Jeff, 16 May 2002:
++ . ANSI strictness changes: ck_ssl.[ch]
++ . New DIALER command: ckuusr.[ch]
++ . Correction to how -0 turns off autodownload: ckuusy.c
++ . Prototypes for GUI menu action functions: ckuusr.h.
++ . Replace setting of GUI-action variables by function calls: ckuus[3457x].c
++ . Fix FTP -z switch parsing: ckcftp.c.
++ . Fix SET HOST testing of setlin() return code: ckuus3.c
++
++From Jeff, 18 May 2002:
++ . Allow half-size GUI fonts: ckuus[35y].c.
++
++Fixed setguifont() to parse fractional font sizes and round to nearest half
++point. ckuus3.c, 18 May 2002.
++
++For GUI, wrote front ends for getyesno(), readtext(), and readpass():
++
++ . uq_ok() prints text and gets Yes/No, OK/Cancel, or just OK response.
++ This replaces getyesno() and can also be used for alert or help boxes.
++
++ . uq_txt() prints text and gets a single text response. Replaces
++ readtext() and readpass().
++
++ . uq_mtxt() is like uq_txt() but allows multiple text fields. Replaces
++ any combination of readtext() and readpass().
++
++Obviously the #ifdef KUI portions of the uq_blah() routines need filling in.
++ckuusr.h, ckuus3.c, 18 May 2002.
++
++Converted selected getyesno() calls to uq_ok(): ckcftp.c, ckuus3.c, ckuus6.c.
++Some were not converted because it was inappropriate, e.g. DELETE /ASK; others
++because they're in Jeff's code. The most interesting conversions are in the
++DIAL command when DIAL CONFIRMATION is ON. Here there is a dialog for each
++phone number asking if it's OK (ug_ok()) and if not, asking for a replacement
++(uq_txt()); seems to work fine in C-Kermit. All the candidates for uq_mtxt()
++are in Jeff's code. 18 May 2002.
++
++From Jeff: Convert remaining getyesno/readtext/readpass calls to uq_blah()
++so they can be GUI dialogs. ckuus[37].c, ckcftp.c, ckuath.c, ck_ssl.c,
++21 May 2002.
++
++Added KCD command = CD to symbolic directory name (EXEDIR, COMMON, APPDATA,
++TMPDIR, etc etc). ckuusr.h, ckuus[r25].c, 21 May 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 28 May 2002:
++ . --title: commandline option: ckuusr.h, ckuusy.c
++ . Fix some #includes, move some declarations: ckcfns.c
++ . Change K95 version from Dev.00 to Beta.01
++ . ASK[Q] /GUI: ckuus6.c.
++ . Various GUI screen updates and #ifdefs: ckuus7.c
++ . Add missing cx_net() calls to new setlin() for file SuperLAT..: ckuus7.c
++ . Updated uq_*() routines for GUI dialogs: ckuus3.c.
++
++Added GETOK switches (/TIMEOUT for all; /POPUP and /GUI for K95G):
++ckuus6.c, 29 May 2002.
++
++Added HELP SET GUI text. ckuus2.c, 29 May 2002.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . Another K95-specific #include for ckcfns.c.
++ . More items for K95G Actions menu.
++ . Change K95G Locus switching to call setlocus() rather than set variable.
++ . Ditto for several other variables now settable from Actions menu.
++ . Fix SET HOST /NET:SSH status code so IF SUCCESS works.
++ . Fix SHOW SSH port-forwarding.
++ckcfns.c, ckuus[r367].c, ckcftp.c, ckcmai.c, 30 May 2002.
++
++Changed SET LOCUS to have a new value, ASK, corresponding to new autolocus
++value of 2, K95G only. Changed setlocus() to not do anything if the new and
++old loci are the same, otherwise to invoke a GUI dialog in K95G if autolocus
++is 2, and also to handle any text messages. Changed SHOW COMMAND to show ASK
++value for SET LOCUS. Rewrote HELP SET LOCUS. ckuusr.[ch], ckuus[23].c,
++ckcftp.c, 30 May 2002.
++
++Add a missing space to Locus popup, and fix Jeff's version of the code to
++compile in C-Kermit. ckuusr.c, 31 May 2002.
++
++From Jeff, for K95 GUI, 6 June 2002:
++ . Force some GUI popups to be in foreground: ckuus3.c.
++ . Fix SHOW TERM font display: ckuus5.c.
++ . Update K95 version numbers and date (4 June 2002): ckcmai.c.
++ . Add note about encrypted private keys vs scripts to HELP SET AUTH: ckuus2.c.
++ . Fix SET HOST for DECnet: ckuus7.c.
++
++--- K95 2.0 ---
++
++From Jeff, 7 June 2002:
++ . Fix some #ifdefs for Unix builds (locus, dial, etc): ckuus7.c
++ . Add gui_resize_scale_font() prototype: ckuus3.c
++ . Add some missing SET GUI commands: ckuus3.c
++ . Update version numbers: ckcmai.c
++
++--- K95 2.0.1 ---
++
++From Jeff, 11 June 2002:
++ . Conditionalize Locus-switching popup text for GUI/Console: ckuusr.c.
++ . Fix the SRP_installed_as_server() function. The new API returns TRUE even
++ if the SRP config and password files cannot be found. Went back to the old
++ API. This bug affects C-Kermit 8 when built with SRP as well as 1.1.21
++ through 2.0.1. Since iksdnt.exe has not been shipped yet I fixed it and
++ uploaded a new non-beta build of it. ckuath.c.
++
++From Jeff, 12 June 2002:
++ . Fix SSH AGENT ADD: ckuusr.c.
++ . Fix --facename: option to not fail if name unknown: ckuusy.c.
++ . Fixes for OpenSSL 0.9.7 and OpenBSD 3.1: ck_ssl.c.
++ . Fix SET AUTH TLS VERIFY NO to prevent a dialog but still a warning if
++ SET AUTH TLS VERBOSE ON is set: ck_ssl.c.
++ . Fix FTP code to verify the hostname as specified by the user and not
++ the hostname discovered by the reverse DNS lookup. For example,
++ FTP OPEN kermit.columbia.edu
++ should produce a dialog because that name is not in the certificate
++ even though ftp.kermit.columbia.edu (the reverse DNS name) is: ckcftp.c.
++
++Add support for Solaris 9 and NetBSD 1.6. makefile, ckuver.h, ckcdeb.h,
++13 Jun 2002.
++
++Discovered that Solaris 9 wants to hide the members of struct FILE, and
++enforces this for 64-bit builds. They offer some functions like __fbufsize()
++to get the info, but not the info we need for reading escape sequences (the
++_cnt member). Let's hear it for political correctness. Created new solaris9g
++(32-bit) and solaris9g64 (64-bit) targets. Sorry, no arrow keys in 64-bit
++mode. Also no more direct access to sys_errlist[]; must use strerror().
++makefile, ckucmd.c, 13 Jun 2002.
++
++Added solaris9g+openssl+zlib+pam+shadow, which in turn required adding
++solaris2xg32+openssl+zlib+pam+shadow, needed for gcc 3.1 in which you have
++to specify 32-bit. Fails for some mysterious reason in link step
++(can't find libssl.so.0.9.6 even though it's there). makefile, 13 Jun 2002.
++
++Solaris 8 empty socket problems again -- tthang() times out, subsequent
++tcsetattr() calls do horrible things. Added a bandaid to ttclos(): don't
++call tcsetattr() any more if hangup timed out. ckutio.c, 14 June 2002.
++
++Gerry B reported the bandaid got us bit farther but Kermit still disappears.
++Added code to reassert the alarm signal handler, since it is likely that
++Solaris has become stricter about this since last time I looked. (Later
++Gerry reported back that this did the trick -- C-Kermit now exits normally
++and releases the lockfile). ttclos(): ckutio.c, 17 Jun 2002.
++
++If you use Kermit to copy a file to a destination file that already exists and
++is longer than the source file, the destination file is not truncated. I had
++mistakenly assumed that setting O_CREAT in the open() call in zcopy() would
++create a new copy of the file. Fixed by also setting O_TRUNC. ckufio.c,
++17 Jun 2002.
++
++Updated HELP INPUT and MINPUT text to explain 0 and -1 timeout values, and
++HELP DIAL to explain about entering CONNECT mode automatically. ckuus2.c,
++17 Jun 2002.
++
++Got rid of client-side "Press the X or E key to cancel" message when giving
++a REMOTE command if QUIET is set or if XFER DISPLAY is NONE. ckuus7.c,
++17 Jun 2002.
++
++From Jeff 25 Jun 2002:
++ . Add SUN terminal type: ckuusr.h, ckuus[57].c.
++ . Add GUI file transfer display: ckcker.h, ckuus[47x].c.
++ . Changes to allow C-Kermit to build with OpenSSL 0.9.7. Current
++ C-Kermit code is designed to compile with 0.9.6 and earlier. To
++ compile with 0.9.7 you must specify -DOPENSSL_097. This avoids
++ missing symbols in the DES library. The functions in OpenSSL were
++ renamed in 0.9.7 to avoid link time conflicts with Kerberos 4.
++ ckufio.c ck_crp.c ckuath.c ck_ssl.h ck_ssl.c, makefile.
++
++From Jeff 26 Jun 2002:
++ . apparently the SSL Passphrase Callback function was not converted
++ from readpass() to uq_txt()
++ . FTP Authentication failure errors were not being reported to the
++ user. So a failure would appear to be a successful completion
++ unless FTP DEBUG was ON. Now the message is reported unless
++ the QUIET flag is set.
++ck_ssl.c, ckcftp.c.
++
++SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL didn't work for FTP; fixed in putfile() and getfile():
++ckcftp.c, 1 Jul 2002.
++
++Changed debug log for FTP to log "FTP SENT" and "FTP RECD" for protocol
++messages, just like we do for Telnet, to make it easy to grep them out of
++the log. ckcftp.c, 1 Jul 2002.
++
++In FTP MGET /UPDATE, equal times spuriously caused download. doftpget() was
++misinterpreting chkmodtime()'s return code. ckcftp.c, 3 Jul 2002.
++
++In FTP MGET /RECOVER, recovery is skipped if the local file is newer than
++the remote. This would seem to make sense, but when a download is
++interrupted, the partial file never gets the date of the remote file, so
++the partial file is always newer, and recovery never works. Fixed in
++recvrequest() by commenting out the date check. ckcftp.c, 3 Jul 2002.
++
++A better way to fix the previous problem is to always set the file date from
++the server and then only allow /RECOVER to work when the dates are equal.
++But that's not possible because MDTM is not implemented universally, and it
++conflicts with how Kermit currently works, namely that FTP DATES are OFF by
++default. Also, checking dates prevents [M]GET /RECOVER from working with
++files that were incompletely downloaded by some other FTP client.
++
++In FTP MGET /RECOVER <wildcard> <wildcard> ..., the first file in each group
++is always downloaded. Diagnosis: Kermit sends "TYPE A" prior to NLST (as it
++must). Then when it sends its first SIZE command, it's still in ASCII mode,
++so the server sends the "ASCII size" rather than the binary size, which does
++not agree with the size of the local file (which was downloaded in binary
++mode), so recovery is always attempted even when the files are identical. The
++TYPE A command is sent by initconn(). After the remote_files() call, we have
++to change the type back to the prevailing type before sending the first SIZE
++command. Fixed in cmdlinget() and doftpget(): ckcftp.c, 3 Jul 2002.
++
++In FTP MGET /EXCEPT:<pattern> used with SET XFER DISPLAY brief, files that
++are skipped just say ERROR instead of saying why they were skipped. Fixed
++in doftpget(): ckcftp.c, 3 Jul 2002.
++
++Added EXIT to top-level HELP text. ckuus2.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Strip braces in REINPUT n {string}. ckuusr.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Added /QUIET switch to ASK-class commands. This means not to print any error
++messages when an ASK-class command times out waiting for a response. Made
++sure that when a timeout occurs, the command fails. Also made sure the
++c-Kermit prompt doesn't write over the ASK prompt if ASK times out. Also
++fixed ASK, when it times out, not to return -9, which it did in one case,
++which causes a command-stack dump. ckuus[267].c, ckucmd.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed SET FILE INCOMPLETE help text, which said that both KEEP and AUTO were
++the default. ckuus2.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++If you SET FTP DEB ON and then turn it OFF, the MGET temp file is still kept.
++Fixed by getting rid of ftp_knf variable and using ftp_deb to control whether
++temp file is deleted (ftp_knf was being set from ftp_deb anyway, but then
++wasn't being reset by SET FTP DEB OFF). ckcftp.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++If an FTP transfer was in progress but the FTP connection drops and automatic
++locus switching is enabled, the locus does not change; thus (for example) a
++subsequent DELETE command makes Kermit send a REMOTE DELETE packet on stdout.
++Fixed in lostpeer(): ckcftp.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++For docs: FTP CD with no arg might not be accepted by the server; e.g. the
++Kermit FTP server says "501 Invalid number of arguments".
++
++The FTP module never handled SET INCOMPLETE. Fixed in doftprecv2(). ckcftp.c,
++13 Jul 2002.
++
++When FTP DATES is ON, we set an incoming file's date only if the file was
++received successfully. Changed the code to set the file's date even if it was
++received only partially (assuming we can get the date from server). ckcftp.c,
++13 Jul 2002.
++
++Suppose we were doing FTP MGET /UPDATE from a server directory of 100,000
++files. Kermit would send a SIZE command for every file unconditionally. On
++some connections, e.g. to the Red Hat Rawhide server, each one could take up
++to 30 seconds. That would be 3 million seconds = 34 days. Don't send a SIZE
++command during the selection phase unless a /SMALLER or /LARGER selector was
++given. Once the file is selected, send a SIZE command only if one hadn't been
++sent for that file already. ckcftp.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Made [M]GET and [M]PUT /UPDATE switch imply FTP DATES ON, since they didn't
++work unless it was. ckcftp.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Added FTP [M]GET /DATES-DIFFER, which is like /UPDATE except it selects files
++that are newer or older, rather than only newer. This allows updates from
++sources where files might be rolled back to earlier versions. It's a bit
++dangerous if you use it without knowing what it's for, since it allows older
++files to overwrite newer ones. (Code is also in place for [M]PUT
++/DATES-DIFFER, and it works, but I commented it out because it's either
++useless or dangerous since when uploading, you can't set the the file dates
++when they are arrive on the server.) ckcftp.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Changed chkmodtime() to remember if MDTM fails on a particular connection
++because it's an unknown command (500, 502, or 202), and if so, not to ask
++again. ckcftp.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++With this last change, I think it's safe to change the default for FTP DATES
++from OFF to ON. ckcftp.c, 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Increased max number of /EXCEPT: patterns from 8 to 64 for file transfer (not
++necessarily for other things). This is now a compile-time symbol NSNDEXCEPT.
++ckcker.h, ckcmai.c, ckclib.c, ckcfns.c, ckcftp.c, ckuus[rx].c. 13 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed FTP MGET to not send SIZE command when there is a name collision and
++FILE COLLISION is DISCARD, even if /SMALLER or /LARGER were also specified.
++ckcftp.c, 15 Jul 2002.
++
++MGET fails if no files were transferred, even if the reason is that no files
++met the selection critieria: /COLLISION:DISCARD, /UPDATE, /SMALLER, etc.
++Changed MGET to succeed in that case. domget(): ckcftp.c, 16 Jul 2002.
++
++Big problems with canceling MGET; Ctrl-C cancels the current file, but we
++don't break out of the file loop, we just go on to the next file. Worse, if
++we're executing a command file that has a series of MGETs, Ctrl-C doesn't
++break us out of the command file. Fixed by making failftprecv() and
++failftprecv2() "chain" to the main SIGINT handler, trap(). This is fine in
++Unix, but I'd be really surprised if it works in K95 so I put it in #ifndef
++OS2. Ditto for MPUT: Added the same treatment to failftpsend() and
++failftpsend2(). Ditto for cmdcancel(). To adapt to K95, search for "TEST ME
++IN K95" (5 places). ckcftp.c, 16 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed previous fix to account for the fact that failftpblah() can be called
++not only upon Ctrl-C, but also if transfer interrupted with X or Z.
++ckcftp.c, 16 Jul 2002.
++
++Yesterday's fixes revealed another problem: Interrupt MGET with Ctrl-C, start
++another MGET, and the file list is total garbage. Diagnosis: secure_getc()
++and secure_getbyte() use internal static buffer pointers. The only way they
++ever get reset is when the data connection is closed by the server, so if you
++interrupt a GET, the pointers are not reset and the next network read (e.g. of
++an NLST response) returns whatever junk was lying around in the old buffer.
++ckcftp.c, 17 Jul 2002.
++
++FTP MGET temp file is kept only if FTP DEBUG is ON. Changed FTP module to
++also keep it if the regular debug log is active. ckcftp.c, 17 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed version test in ckermit.ini: should be 6 digits, not 5. 17 Jul 2002.
++
++Changed C-Kermit version number to 8.0.205 so scripts can test for the
++recent changes. ckcmai.c, 18 Jul 2002.
++
++---8.0.205---
++
++SET FILE COLLISION UPDATE would unset FTP DATES due to a typo in the recent
++changes. ckcftp.c, 21 Jul 2002.
++
++FTP [M]GET /DATES-DIFFER really should have been a collision option. Added
++this option (implemented for FTP only) to both SET FTP COLLISION and the
++FTP [M]GET /COLLISION: table, so this way if you have lots of [M]GETs, you
++don't have to put /DATES-DIFFER on each one. ckcker.h, ckcftp.c, 21 Jul 2002.
++
++"FTP MGET a* b* c*" would fail to get any c*'s if no b*'s existed.
++ckcftp.c, 21 Jul 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 22 Jul 2002:
++ . Beginnings of Ann Arbor Ambassador terminal emulation for K95;
++ ckuus[57].c, ckuusr.h.
++ . Bump K95 version number to 2.0.2: ckcmai.c
++
++Added -DCK_PAM -DCK_SHADOW to all Solaris targets, 2.6 and above. makefile,
++23 Jul 2002.
++
++Discovered that CK_SCRIPTS path search for TAKE files was #ifdef'd out
++except for K95. Fixed in ckuusr.c, 25 Jul 2002.
++
++From Jeff: changes to support K95 italics: ckuus[57].c, 25 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed path search for TAKE to not search the CK_SCRIPTS path if the filespec
++contains any directory or path parts. Added a new function to check for
++this: int hasnopath(filespec) in ckucmd.c: 26 Jul 2002.
++
++Update HP-UX build instructions from PeterE: makefile, 26 Jul 2002.
++
++Commented out "const" from struct pam_message declarations because it
++causes "initialization type mismatch" warnings. ckufio.c, 26 Jul 2002.
++
++Suppose you have a network directory containing a listing for host "foo":
++
++ foo tcp/ip foo.bar.com
++
++Then in K95 you give a command "set host /network-type:ssh foo". This
++results in the directory lookup replacing the "ssh" network type with TCP/IP,
++and making a Telnet connection. Fix attempted at about line 8625 of ckuus7.c
++in cx_net(); needs testing in K95. 26 Jul 2002.
++
++FTP Password: prompt in Unix was not allowing editing. The code looked right;
++I put in some debugging and suddenly it worked. Took out the debugging and
++it still worked. Maybe I dreamed it. Anyway, I fixed the "FTP SENT" debug
++log entry to not record the password, and removed a redundant section above
++to log the same thing, but prior to any charset conversion. ckcftp.c,
++27 Jul 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 28 Jul 2002:
++ . Fix typo in initxlist(): ckcmai.c.
++ . Fix typo in Friday's set-host fix: ckuus7.c.
++ . Move parsing of --height/width command-line args after prescan(): ckuusy.c.
++
++Added invisible top-level SITE and PASSIVE commands for FTP as a convenience
++for habituated FTP client users. ckuusr.[ch], ckcftp.c, 28 Jul 2002.
++
++A while back a user asked if it was possible to MGET a bunch of files from
++an FTP server and have them all appended to each other upon arrival. The
++obvious way to do this would have been:
++
++ mget /collision:append /as-name:bigfile *.*
++
++But to make this work, I had to get rid of the "as-name must contain
++variables" check in the MGET parser. doftpget(): ckcftp.c, 28 Jul 2002.
++
++Verified that it was possible to do the same thing (GET a bunch of files
++and append them all into one result file) with Kermit protocol. It works
++fine but in this case there is no /COLLISION switch; you have to SET FILE
++COLLISION APPEND first. 30 Jul 2002.
++
++Changed COPY /APPEND to allow wild source to single destination file, e.g.
++"copy /append *.* bigfile". ckuus6.c, 30 Jul 2002.
++
++From Mark Berryman: a replacement for zchkpath(), the VMS routine that checks
++whether a file is in the current directory; the old one (that I wrote) was
++a hack that only worked sometimes. Martin Vorlaender verified Mark's code in
++the situation where mine was breaking (server running in captive account).
++ckvfio.c, 30 Jul 2002.
++
++PeterE reported a problem with SWITCH case labels that start with '#':
++The problem is that the SWITCH variable contents in this case happens to be
++a comment, e.g.:
++
++ CMD(M)[_forward # Stand: 24.07.2002<CR>]
++
++so the GOTO target is null. The solution would be for SWITCH to put the GOTO
++(_FORWARD) target in quotes. But GOTO does not strip quotes or braces from
++around its target. Fixed in ckuusr.c, 30 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed the SWITCH macro definition to put the _FORWARD target in quotes.
++ckuus5.c, 30 Jul 2002.
++
++PeterE also reported that an empty SWITCH case label did not work. There's no
++particular reason why it should, but after a brief look, it wasn't that hard
++so I did it. It required commenting out the check for empty labels and fixing
++the comparison in dogoto(). Now it's possible to read lines from a file and
++use each line as a SWITCH variable, with patterns as case labels, including an
++empty label to match empty lines, #* labels to match comment lines, etc.
++ckuus[r6].c, 30 Jul 2002.
++
++PeterE also reported the value of \%* acquiring a trailing blank when
++referenced inside a SWITCH statment. This happens because \%* is formed using
++\fjoin() on the \&_[] array based on its dimension, and at some point the
++dimension is spuriously increased by one. As a workaround, I made \fjoin()
++ignore trailing empty \&_[] array elements and oddly enough this also fixed
++the growing dimensions problem. The many script torture tests reveal no ill
++effects, so it seems like a keeper. ckuus4.c, 30 Jul 2002.
++
++Some of Peter's sample scripts made C-Kermit 8.0.201 dump core, but no more.
++
++Fixed "delete xxx" to print an error message and fail if if xxx does not exist.
++Ditto for when xxx is a directory. ckuus6.c, 30 Jul 2002.
++
++Patches to SSL modules from Jeff based on yesterday's advisory. ck_ssl.[ch],
++31 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed some typos affecting the filename collision action during command-line
++FTP [M]GET. ckcftp.c, 31 Jul 2002.
++
++Fixed SHOW FTP to handle FTP COLLISION DATES-DIFFER. ckcftp.c, 31 Jul 2002.
++
++A while back someone pointed out that SET CONTROL UNPREFIX ALL and SET
++PREFIXING NONE gave different results. Fixed them to use the same code.
++Also made "set prefixing none" visible. ckuus3.c, 4 Aug 2002.
++
++Added SET CD HOME <path>, to let the user specify which directory is intended
++when "CD" or "KCD" is given by itself. This is because in Windows, some
++applications set up their own HOME environment variable that isn't necessarily
++where the user wants "cd" to go, but redefining HOME can interfere with the
++application (example: Windows EMACS). SET CD HOME was done by adding a myhome
++variable, initially a NULL pointer, and then changing homepath() to use it if
++it is set. zhome() is not affected. Also the homepath() prototype had been
++missing from header files. ckcmai.c, ckuusr.h, ckuus[2345].c, 4 Aug 2002.
++
++PeterE got another core dump with his SWITCH statement. Found a place where
++an out-of-bounds array reference could occur if the switch variable was
++empty. ckuus6.c, 5 Aug 2002.
++
++PeterE noticed that if the switch variable contained a comma, spurious matches
++could occur with the label pattern. The real problem turns out to be what
++happens when the SWITCH variable doesn't match any of the case labels and
++there is no DEFAULT label. Fixed by having dogoto() in the SWITCH (_FORWARD)
++case pop the command stack before returning failure, i.e. by moving the
++"if (stopflg) return(0);" statement down a few lines. ckuus6.c, 5 Aug 2002.
++
++PeterE noticed that a SWITCH case label of :* did not match an empty SWITCH
++variable. Fixed in doswitch(): ckuus6.c, 6 Aug 2002.
++
++In testing the previous fix, I found it only worked sometimes. Inspection
++of the debug log showed that a statement like:
++
++ if (y == -3) s = "{}";
++
++was assigning "{" rather than "{}" to s. Replacing the string constant by a
++buffer containing the same string fixed it. The reason (guessed correctly by
++PeterE) was the following sequence:
++
++ y = cmfld("Variable name","",&s,xxstring);
++ if (y == -3) s = "{}";
++ len = ckstrncpy(tmpbuf,brstrip(s),TMPBUFSIZ);
++
++brstrip() (by design and as documented) affects the string in place. But in
++this case the string is a constant, not data in a buffer, so all further uses
++of "{}" get the wrong string (at least in optimized builds). The only real
++cure is to change brstrip() to make a copy of its argument if it has to do
++anything to it. This will slow down some scripts, but it's too risky to
++leave it as it was. ckclib.c, 6 Aug 2002.
++
++The previous change required an audit of the C-Kermit code to make sure that
++no references to brstrip() depended the result buffer being persistent, or the
++result pointer indicating a position in the source buffer. Oops, it turns out
++that thousands of places rely on brstrip() working in place. Therefore the
++change had to be undone. There's no good way to write a dummy-proof brstrip();
++programmers either have be sure they're not calling it with a pointer to a
++string constant, or else they have to copy the result back to the right place
++each time. Better to leave it as it was and audit the code to fix any calls
++that refer to string constants (turns out there were only two). Restored the
++original fix to doswitch() (replacing the string constant by a buffer holding
++the same string), plus minor fixes to ckcftp.c, ckuus[r36].c, 6 Aug 2002.
++
++We need file dialogs in several situations in the K95 GUI. I added a "user
++query" routine for this, uq_file(), in ckuus3.c, filling it in only for Unix.
++Then I added code to call it from rcvfil() when (a) it's an autodownload, and
++(b) SET TERM AUTODOWNLOAD is ASK (I just added this option; it needs to be set
++to see it in action -- maybe it should be the default for KUI, in which case
++initialize "int autodl = ?" to TAD_ASK in ckcmai.c). Works fine, except of
++course it interferes with the file-transfer display, but that won't be a
++problem in K95G. ckuusr.h, ckuus[37].c, ckcfns.c, ckucns.c, 6 Aug 2002.
++
++Another place we need a file dialog is when Kermit is a URL interpreter. The
++problem is: how can we let the user decide whether Kermit should ask? There
++really isn't any way. Either it always asks or it never does. In this case I
++think it makes sense to always ask if it's KUI, otherwise never. I added the
++code for ftp: URLs to to doftprecv2(), which I tested successfully in Unix
++before putting it into #ifdef KUI..#endif. Also added code for http[s] to
++ckuusy.c in #ifdef KUI..#endif, not tested.
++
++Still need this added for K95G Actions->Capture. The clearest example is the
++FTP one. Just search for KUI in the FTP module.
++
++Some minor adjustments to yesterday's work, mainly just comments, plus
++generate the full pathname for the default file. ckuus3.c, ckcftp.c,
++7 Aug 2002.
++
++Note: for some reason cmofi() is not supplying the default value if user
++enters an empty name... (but that won't affect the Windows version).
++
++Added /USER: and /PASSWORD: switches to SET TCP { HTTP-PROXY, SOCKS-SERVER }.
++ckuus3.c, 7 Aug 2002.
++
++New 'uninstall' target from PeterE, works by having the 'install' target
++write an UNINSTALL shell script. makefile, 8 Aug 2002.
++
++Added some debugging statements to the VMS communications i/o module to try
++to track down a problem that occurs when the controlling terminal is a LAT
++device. ckvtio.c, 10 Aug 2002.
++
++Fixed the non-K95 uq_file() to respect the given default name, but still show
++the fully qualified absolute pathname for the default in the dialog. The
++reason to not use the fully qualifed name as the default in the cmxxx() calls
++is that this can easily result in a whole directory tree being created due to
++directory aliases, symlinks, etc. So when you get a file by referring to its
++URL (e.g. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/READ.ME), uq_file() converts the
++READ.ME part to (e.g.) /home/fdc/tmp/READ.ME but gives just "READ.ME" as the
++default when parsing the name. This way the user knows where it will go and
++gets an opportunity to change it, and if the default is accepted, it goes into
++the current directory. uq_file(): ckuus3.c, 10 Aug 2002.
++
++Found the spot for calling uq_file() for kermit:// URL downloads. Added
++prefatory text to filename prompts for Kermit and FTP downloads. ckcfns.c,
++ckcftp.c, 10 Aug 2002.
++
++Now with kermit:// or ftp:// URL downloads there's no way to disable the
++prompting. I could easily make SET TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD ASK cover these
++cases too (even though "terminal" has nothing to do with FTP or URL
++downloads). OK, I did this, but now prompting is disabled by default.
++ckcftp.c, ckcfns.c. 10 Aug 2002.
++
++Enabled file prompting (adl_ask) by default in K95G, disabled it by default
++everywhere else. So now FTP and Kermit URL downloads as well as terminal-mode
++Kermit (but not Zmodem) downloads are prompted for if TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD is
++ASK, which is it by default only in K95G. But this will happen only if
++uq_file() is filled in for K95G; otherwise everything should work as before.
++ckcmai.c, 10 Aug 2002.
++
++Notes:
++ . Need a better command to control this.
++ . FTP URL downloads are almost instantaneous, whereas Kermit URL downloads
++ take a really long time to set up (logging in takes at least 10 seconds).
++
++From Jeff, 13 Aug 2002:
++ . Increase K95 version to 2.1.0: ckcmai.c.
++ . SET TCP { HTTP-PROXY, SOCKS-SERVER } /USER: /PASSWORD: actions: ckuus3.c.
++
++From PeterE: a new install target that's only about half as a big as the
++previous one, yet still generates an UNINSTALL script. makefile, 13 Aug 2002.
++
++Vace wanted to be able to give the FTP client an offset for the server time,
++in case the server's time (or timezone) is set incorrectly. I added this by
++building on all the date/time parsing/arithmetic code -- notably delta times
++-- that was done for C-Kermit 8.0. The new command is SET FTP
++SERVER-TIME-OFFSET delta-time; shows up in SHOW FTP and HELP SET FTP.
++ckcftp.c, 13 Aug 2002.
++
++Fixed HELP ASK and HELP GETOK text. ckuus2.c, 14 Aug 2002.
++
++Fixed GETOK to accept /GUI switch even in K95.EXE and C-Kermit, just like ASK
++does (in which case, it just ignores it). ckuus6.c, 14 Aug 2002.
++
++SET XFER CHAR TRANSPARENT no longer disables character-set translation because
++file-scanning turns it back on. The "new way" to disable character-set
++translation is SET XFER TRANSLATION OFF. This needlessly confuses users who
++expect the old way to still work. So I fixed SET XFER CHAR TRANSPARENT to set
++XFER TRANSLATION OFF, and SET XFER CHAR anything-else to set it back ON.
++ckuus3.c, 15 Aug 2002.
++
++Fixed SET TERM AUTODOWNLOAD { ON, OFF } to turn off the ASK flag (adl_ask).
++ckuus7.c, 16 Aug 2002.
++
++Added FEAT query to FTP client from draft-ietf-ftpext-mlst-13.txt. FEAT is
++sent along with REST 0, MODE S, and STRU F if /NOINIT is not included in the
++FTP OPEN command. Parsing the FEAT result is handled by turning the "auth"
++argument to getreply() into a function code: GRF_AUTH to parse AUTH reply;
++GRF_FEAT to parse FEAT reply. For GRF_FEAT, getreply() fills in a flag array,
++sfttab[] (server feature table); sfttab[0] > 0 means server responded to the
++FEAT query, in which case individual elements are set > 0 for each supported
++feature. ckcftp.c, 18 Aug 2002.
++
++If server sends a feature list, display it if FTP DEBUG is on, then set mdtmok
++and sizeok (the flags that say whether it's OK to send MDTM and SIZE commands)
++accordingly. If user gives an [M]PUT /RECOVER command and server has
++announced it doesn't support REST, print a warning but try anyway (maybe
++change this later). Responses about other features that we use such as AUTH
++and PBSZ are ignored for now -- i.e. we try them anyway. And of course
++responses for features we don't care about (LANG, TVFS, PROT) are ignored.
++ckcftp.c, 18 Aug 2002.
++
++If the server says it supports MLST, use MLSD instead of NLST to get the file
++list. This is done in remote_files() with some simple string-twiddling. Then
++replace the relevant (but not all) SIZE commands with code to first check if
++we already got the size from the MLSD response and use that instead rather
++than asking again. Same deal for MDTM. ckcftp.c, 18 Aug 2002.
++
++Checked that this works when giving pathnames in the MGET filespec. Checked
++to make sure everything works as before with servers that don't support FEAT
++or MLSD. Checked to make sure FTP OPEN blah /NOINIT worked with servers that
++do support FEAT and MLSD. Checked that FTP CHECK works. It's all OK.
++
++Tested only with Ipswitch server; need to find and test with others.
++
++The stack of temp files needed for MGET /RECURSIVE is annoying because what
++if we run out of file descriptors... But the spec doesn't provide a way to
++request a recursive listing.
++
++Supplied a missing comma in HELP SET CD text. ckuus2.c, 19 Aug 2002.
++
++Generalized parsing of MLST/MLSD file facts and values. Got file type from
++server and had MGET skip non-regular files. ckcftp.c, 19 Aug 2002.
++
++Kirk Turner-Rustin <ktrustin@owu.edu> reported that if Unix C-Kermit has a SET
++HOST PTY connection (e.g. SSH) open, local window size changes are not
++propogated through the connection to the host. I imagine that must be because
++the SIGWINCH signal is caught by Kermit and its children don't see it; maybe
++if I pass it along to the child fork, all will be OK. Began by exporting
++"slavepid" from the pty module and changing its name to pty_fork_pid. Moved
++the SIGWINCH handler, winchh(), from ckctel.c to ckutio.c. Armed it from Unix
++sysinit() so it's always armed. This way window changes affect Unix C-Kermit
++no matter what mode it's in: tt_rows, tt_cols, cmd_rows, and cmd_cols are all
++kept in sync. Then if we're not in remote mode (i.e. we have a ttyfd), we
++call tn_snaws() and rlog_snaws() (which should be ok since they return right
++away if the appropriate kind of connection is not open) and then if
++(pty_fork_pid > -1), a SIGWINCH signal is sent to it. ckupty.c, ckctel.c,
++ckutio.c, 20 Aug 2002.
++
++All this works fine except the PTY part; in other words, the original problem
++is not fixed. The "kill(pty_fork_pid,SIGWINCH)" call executes without error
++but has no effect because the size of the PTY never changed. To make this
++work I had to add an ioctl() to change the size of the PTY before sending it
++the SIGWINCH. Compiles and works ok on Linux and Solaris; Kirk also confirmed
++it for AIX 4.3.3. ckutio.c, 20 Aug 2002.
++
++Fixed xlookup() to work for uppercase keywords. ckucmd.c, 20 Aug 2002.
++
++Fixed FTP parsefeat() and parsefacts() to use xlookup() instead of lookup(),
++since abbreviated keywords are not allowed. ckcftp.c, 20 Aug 2002.
++
++Adjusted some lines from yesterday's window-size code for platforms I hadn't
++tried yet. ckutio.c, 21 Aug 2002.
++
++EXIT from K95 when it has an FTP connection open and it pops up the
++Locus dialog. Made it not do this if it knows it's in the act of EXITing.
++ckuus[rx].c, 22 Aug 2002.
++
++In K95, FTP GET in ASCII mode results in a file with Unix line terminators
++even though the protocol is correct:
++
++ RETR smjulie.txt
++ 150 Opening ASCII mode data connection for smjulie.txt (1878 bytes).
++
++The source file is a regular Unix text file with LF at the end of each line.
++It's incredible that nobody noticed this before. It only came to light when
++somebody tried to open a downloaded text file with Notepad, which doesn't
++handle Unix-format files (Wordpad and Emacs have no problems with them). The
++problem was in doftprecv2() in the FTT_ASC section. There was no conditional
++code for Unix vs Windows. In all cases, the code discarded incoming CR's in
++ASCII mode. I put the CR-discarding code in #ifdef UNIX..#endif. ckcftp.c,
++22 Aug 2002.
++
++Removed super-verbose debugging from gtword(): ckucmd.c, 23 Aug 2002.
++
++Gregory Bond reported a problem with "if defined \$(BLAH) ..." inside of a
++SWITCH statement. It wasn't really the SWITCH that was doing it, it was the
++fact that he had enclosed the SWITCH case in braces, which made it an
++"immediate macro" (XXMACRO). The XXMACRO code parsed the macro definition
++(the part inside the braces) with cmtxt(...,xxstring), which should have been
++cmtxt(...,NULL) to defer the evaluation of the interior of the macro until it
++was executed. This is better illustrated with the following example:
++
++ { echo START, for \%i 1 3 1 { echo \%i }, echo STOP }
++
++which totally fell on its face prior to the fix. Also fixed ?-help for
++immediate macros, which was broken too. ckuusr.c, 23 Aug 2002.
++
++RFC959 says STOU does not take an argument. But every FTP server I've
++encountered but one accepts the arg and constructs the unique name from it,
++which is better than making up a totally random name for the file, which is
++what RFC959 calls for. Especially because there is no way for the client to
++find out the name chosen by the server (because RFC 959 and 1123 are
++contradictory, plus no servers follow either one of them for this anyway). So
++we try STOU with the argument first, which works with most servers, and if it
++fails, we retry it without the arg, for the benefit of the one picky server
++that is not "liberal in what it accepts" UNLESS the first STOU got a 502 code
++("not implemented") which means STOU is not accepted, period (which happens
++with ProFTPD). ckcftp.c, 25 Aug 2002.
++
++Added SET FTP ANONYMOUS-PASSWORD (plus help text and show value). ckcftp.c,
++25 Aug 2002.
++
++Made FTP command "not available" if NOFTP is defined. ckuusr.c, 25 Aug 2002.
++
++Forced client to send a TYPE command upon initial connection, since given
++the variable quality of FTP servers, it's not safe to assume the server is
++in ASCII or any other particular mode. ckcftp.c, 25 Aug 2002.
++
++SET FTP CHARACTER-SET-TRANSLATION ON is completely broken in K95, although it
++works fine in C-Kermit. Furthermore it is broken in both the GUI and Console
++versions, so it's not a Unicode vs OEM console-character-set issue.
++
++Added Concurrent PowerMAX OS target from Tom Horsley. makefile, ckuver.h,
++27 Aug 2002.
++
++Minor fixes to FTP module from Jeff. ckcftp.c, 27 Aug 2002.
++
++New Makefile target for Mac OS X 10.2, needs -DNDSYSERRLIST added, from
++William Bader. 2 Sep 2002.
++
++SET OPT DIR /DOTFILES didn't work for server listings. A few years ago when
++I front-ended zxpand() with nzxpand(), I missed a couple places where
++traverse() needed to refer to xmatchdot (nzxpand's argument flag) rather than
++global matchdot. Fixed in traverse(): ckufio.c, 2 Sep 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 4 Sep 2002:
++ . setautodl(x) -> setautodl(x,y): ckuusr.h, ckuus[7y].c
++ . Add another parameter to popup_readblah(): ckuus6.c
++ . Sort out some confusion in scanfile() where a parameter was also used as a
++ local flag. ckuusx.c.
++ . Protect restoring of saved terminal idle parameters with a flag that says
++ they were actually saved. ckuusr.c.
++ . Rework uq_text() and uq_mtxt(). ckuus3.c.
++ . Fix FTP charset translation for little-endian hardware: ckcftp.c.
++
++The latter still doesn't work in Linux:
++
++ (/home/fdc/kermit/) C-Kermit>set ftp server-character-set latin1-iso
++ (/home/fdc/kermit/) C-Kermit>set file character-set utf8
++ (/home/fdc/kermit/) C-Kermit>get latin1.txt
++
++Results in "????????: file not found". But it works fine on the Sun.
++
++Jeff's patch removed a little-endian byte-swap (LEBS) from doftpsend2(). But
++the real problem was that LEBS was not being done consistently throughout the
++module. There were similar xgnbyte()/xpnbyte() loops elsewhere in the code,
++and all of them needed to work the same way. Undoing Jeff's fix and then
++adding the LEBS to the loop in getreply() makes downloads work right, but the
++messages are still messed up (they come out in Chinese :-) Begin by moving all
++byte-swapping operations that occur in ckcftp.c itself into a new function,
++bytswap(). It's either right to do it all the time, or to do it never; this
++way we can turn it on and off in one place.
++
++xp/gnbyte() include behavior that depends on what Kermit is doing: W_SEND,
++etc. xpnbyte() tests W_KERMIT, which is a combination of W_SEND, W_RECV, etc.
++Defined a new symbol W_XFER, which is like W_KERMIT but includes W_FTP. These
++are all the "whats" in which character sets might need to be converted.
++Changed the W_KERMIT reference in xpnbyte() to W_XFER. Fixed the inderminate
++"what" state after an FTP command by moving "what = W_COMMAND;" from before
++the main parse loop to inside it (this didn't matter before the addition of
++FTP but now it does). ckcker.h, ckcftp.c, ckuus5.c, 6 Sep 2002.
++
++Finally I changed xlatec() to be consistent with all the other xgnbyte() /
++xpnbyte() usage throughout the FTP module and, poof, everything worked in
++Linux (and still works on the Sun). We still need some work in Windows (where
++the file character-set is not necessarily the console character set for
++messages) but we can tackle that next. ckcftp.c, 6 Sep 2002.
++
++Checking yesterday's work:
++
++Kermit file transfers with charset translation work fine in both directions.
++
++FTP GET with charset translation works fine on both BE and LE
++
++Fixed a typo in yesterday's changes that made FTP PUT with charset translation
++always upload 0-length files. ckcftp.c, 7 Sep 2002.
++
++FTP PUT (after the typo was fixed) with charset translation works fine on BE,
++but on LE the message comes out in Chinese and the resulting file gets ? or
++nothing for all for the accented letters:
++
++ FTP... Kermit
++ Up Dn Up Dn Term
++ BE OK OK OK OK xx
++ LE no OK OK OK xx
++
++xx = C-Kermit CONNECT mode with translation doesn't seem to do anything, not
++only in today's code, but also in the 8.0 release version: "set term char
++latin1 utf8" -- SHOW CHAR shows the right stuff, but no translation is done.
++Ditto for the 7.0 release. That can't be right...
++
++But one problem at a time -- what's wrong with LE FTP uploads? Note that
++XLATE works on the same machine, so it's obviously confusion in xgnbyte()
++about "what". Suppose we make xgnbyte() ALWAYS return bytes in BE order.
++This makes sense because xgnbyte() is almost always used to feed xpnbyte(),
++and xpnbyte() requires its bytes to come in BE order. This means that all
++code that uses xgnbyte()/xpnbyte() loops can be simplifed, which I did for
++the FTP module. ckcfns.c, ckcftp.c, 7 Sep 2002.
++
++Of course Kermit protocol uses xgnbyte() too, but only for filling
++packets, and packets never contain UCS2 and even if they did, it would have
++to be big-endian, so no changes needed for getpkt(). Now we have:
++
++ FTP... Kermit
++ Up Dn Up Dn
++ BE OK OK OK OK
++ LE OK OK OK OK
++
++Now let's look at the remaining xgnbyte() calls in the rest of the code:
++
++ckuus4.c:
++ xlate() uses it of course. I simplified the general-case loop.
++ Works OK on both Sun and Linux.
++
++ckuus6.c:
++ typegetline() uses it. I commented out the byte swap. Seems OK.
++
++Built and tested on Linux, Solaris, and SunOS. I'm sure I must have broken
++something, but the main things are better than they were. Kermit and FTP
++transfers need testing in K95, as well as the TYPE command (there's a bunch of
++special K95 code in there). C-Kermit charset translation during CONNECT is
++still broken, or else I forgot how to use it, but that's a separate issue
++since xgnbyte()/xpnbyte() are not involved. And we still need to do something
++in FTP getreply() for K95 to convert messages to the console character set for
++display, rather than the file character set (should be trivial). Also there's
++still a lot of extra debugging and commented-out junk in ckcftp.c to be
++cleaned up after more testing.
++
++During yesterday's testing, I noticed that REMOTE SET { FILE, XFER }
++CHARACTER-SET didn't work. The server accepted these commands but they didn't
++seem to do anything. In fact, they did work, but they were undone later by
++code in sfile() that restored the global settings in case they had been
++temporarily overridden by autoswitching or whatever. The solution is to
++"unsave" the saved values whenever a global setting is performed explicitly.
++Tested successfully against Sun and Linux servers. Also the server end of
++REMOTE SET needed updating for Unicode. ckcfn[s3].c, ckuus3.c, 8 Sep 2002.
++
++Cleaned commented-out cruft and extra debugging from ckcftp.c. 8 Sep 2002.
++
++Kermit autodownload with ASK file dialog: if user supplied an absolute
++pathname, it was treated like a relative one. Fixed the invocation of
++uq_file() in rcvfil() to temporarily override the RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting.
++ckcfns.c, 10 Sep 2002.
++
++Added SET TERMINAL ROLL KEYSTROKES { SEND, RESTORE-AND-SEND, IGNORE }, parse
++only. Needs implementation (search for tt_rkeys and rollkeytab in ckuus7.c).
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[27].c, 10 Sep 2002.
++
++If FILE INCOMPLETE is DISCARD and a file is being received by IKSD but IKSD
++gets a Telnet LOGOUT command, the partial file is not deleted. In fact this
++happens any time doexit() is called for any reason during file reception,
++e.g. because of SIGHUP. Added code to doclean() to check if a download
++output file was open, and if so, to delete it after closing it if keep==0.
++ckuusx.c, 10 Sep 2002.
++
++Added a brief one-line message after remote-mode file transfer saying
++what (or how many) file(s) were transferred, where they went, and whether
++the transfer was successful -- kind of an automatic WHERE command, useful
++with autodownloads so you know what happened. ckcpro.w, 11 Sep 2002.
++
++The Unix and VMS C-Kermit CONNECT modules have botched remote-charset to
++local-UTF8 translation ever since the Unicode was first added in v7.0. Fixed
++in ckucns.c, ckucon.c, ckvcon.c, 11 Sep 2002.
++
++On to pattern-matching... The matchdot business should apply only for (Unix)
++filename matching, not for general string matching. Fixed in ckmatch():
++ckclib.c, 11 Sep 2002.
++
++A bigger problem occurs in filename matching. Somehow the dirsep == fence
++business interferes with matching {foo,bar,baz} segments. For example, I have
++a filename "foo" and I want to match it with the pattern "{foo,bar}". Somehow
++the segment pattern becomes "*/foo" and doesn't match the string. Where does
++the '/' get tacked on? I don't even know how to explain this, but the short
++story was that ckmatch(), under certain circumstances, would back up to before
++the beginning of the filename string, which just happened to contain a "/"
++(and before that a ".") because of who was calling it. Obviously this is not
++how to write a pattern matching function... Ensuring that it never backs up
++beyond the beginning of a string fixed the immediate problem and does not seem
++to have broken any other matching scenarios (I have 150 of them in my test
++script). ckclib.c, 11 Sep 2002.
++
++There's still a problem though. Suppose the a client sends "dir {{.*,*}}" to
++a server. This asks for a directory listing of all files that begin with
++dot as well as all files. Still doesn't work because we don't normally show
++dot-files, but in this case it SHOULD work because ".*" was explicitly
++requested. Staring at the ckmatch() code revealed how to fix this, and I did,
++but that was only half the problem. The other half was that the list of
++files being fed to ckmatch() did not include the dotfiles in the first place.
++The cure here is to change nzxpand() to prescan the pattern to see if it
++includes a leading dot, and if so to set the "xmatchdot" flag itself, even
++if it wasn't set by the caller. ckclib.c, ckufio.c, 11 Sep 2002.
++
++Now that {foo,bar,...} patterns work better, I added a quick hack to the
++DIRECTORY command to allow multiple filespecs to be given, in which case we
++combine them into a {file1,file2,...} pattern before calling nzxpand(). Works
++fine but it's a hack because you don't get file lists upon "?" in the second
++and subsequent filespec fields, but I doubt anyone will notice. So now,
++finally, people can do "dir .* *" like they do in Unix (except with ls) to get
++a listing of all files in a directory without having to know about or use the
++/DOTFILES switch. This was NOT done for the server end of RDIR because of
++ambiguity of spaces as separators versus filename characters.) domydir():
++ckuus6.c, ckuus[r2].c, 11 Sep 2002.
++
++Added a CONTINUE command. In a script, this does whatever CONTINUE did before
++(e.g. in a FOR or WHILE loop). At the prompt, it calls popclvl(), which gives
++a more natural way to continue a script that has "shelled out" to the prompt.
++ckuusr.[ch], 11 Sep 2002.
++
++Added help text for CONTINUE. ckuus2.c, 12 Sep 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 16 Sep 2002:
++ . SET TERM ROLL KEYSTROKES for K95: ckuusr.h, ckuus7.c
++ . Remove the doexit() call from the Telnet TELOPT_LOGOUT handler: ckctel.c
++
++Fixed an FTP debug message to be consistent with Kermit ones.
++ckcftp.c, 16 Sep 2002.
++
++Added SET/SHOW TRANSFER REPORT to turn the post-transfer report off and on.
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[234].c, 16 Sep 2002.
++
++Fixed Solaris (and maybe some other SVORPOSIX builds) to find out their full
++hostname rather than just short form (e.g. watsol.cc.columbia.edu rather than
++just watsol). ckhost(): ckuusx.c, 16 Sep 2002.
++
++"cat somefile | kermit -Ts -" is supposed to send stdin in text mode, but
++K95's file transfer display reports BINARY. Looked at C-Kermit code; it seems
++fine. Looked at packet and debug logs; C-Kermit was indeed sending in text
++mode and announcing it correctly. K95 gattr() is doing the right thing:
++
++ gattr file type[AMJ]=3
++ gattr attribute A=text=0
++ gattr sets tcharset TC_TRANSP[A]
++
++Same thing happens when C-Kermit is receiving. Yet when I send an actual
++file, rather than stdin, it's received in text mode. The only difference is
++that stdin does not have a Length attribute in its A-packet, so in this case
++the receiver skips any calls to screen() that show the length or percent done.
++Aha, so maybe it's just a display problem -- scrft() is not being called to
++repaint the file type if the size was not known. Fixed in opena() by
++removing the IF clause from "if (fsize > -1L) xxscreen(SCR_FS,0,fsize,"");".
++ckcfn3.c, 18 Sep 2002.
++
++K95 user has a listfile containing some regular filenames and then some
++filenames that include paths and has all kinds of problems with MGET /LISTFILE
++(pieces of different names concatenated to each other, etc). Setting up the
++same scenario here, I don't see the same problems but I do see "Refused: Name"
++when we go to get a path/name file. This happens because (a) we had already
++got a top-level file with a certain name, (b) a file in a subdirectory has the
++same name, (c) we are stripping the path before calling zchki(), and (d)
++FTP COLLISION is set to DISCARD. How do we make FTP not strip the path?
++
++This is an interesting question... The answer depends on where the user
++wants the file to go. Normally if you tell an FTP client to "get foo/bar",
++you want the file "bar" to be downloaded to the current directory.
++
++Anyway, it turns out the FTP module uses paths locally during MGET only if
++/RECURSIVE was specified. So:
++
++ mget /listfile:blah /recursive
++
++should have made this work, but it didn't because in the /LISTFILE case,
++we have effectively turned an MGET into a series of GETs, where the code to
++check whether to strip the path didn't check the recursive flag because how
++could a GET (as opposed to an MGET) be recursive? Adding this exception to
++the if-condition got us a bit farther but now when we try to open the output
++file in doftprecv2(), zopeno() fails because the name contains a dirsep.
++We have to call zmkdir() first but that wasn't happening because some other
++flag wasn't set right in this case. Finally zmkdir was called, but with
++the wrong string. After fixing that, it works. Now we should be able
++to use /RECURSIVE to force the pathname to be used on the local end.
++ckcftp.c, 19 Sep 2002.
++
++Checked FTP filename conversion issues. FTP FILENAMES AUTO is supposed to
++mean LITERAL if "wearealike" OR server is UNIX or Windows, otherwise
++CONVERTED, but there were places where this rule was not applied consistently,
++fixed now. ckcftp.c, 21 Sep 2002.
++
++Added SET FTP DISPLAY, which is like SET TRANSFER DISPLAY but applies only to
++FTP, mainly because I tended to type it all the time. Now if you have dual
++sessions, each session can have its own transfer display style. ckcftp.c,
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[347].c, 21 Sep 2002.
++
++Back to FTP MLSD. We're supposed to match the pattern locally, not rely on
++the server to filter its list according to the client's pattern. Thus we must
++also allow an empty argument to MGET and must not send a filespec with MLSD.
++Actually this is tricky -- how is the client supposed to know whether to send
++a filespec. For example, if the user's command is "mget foo*bar", and the
++server supports MLSD, then what should the client do? The client does not
++know the wildcard syntax on the server, so for all the client knows, this
++might be a valid directory name, in which case it should be sent. On the
++other hand, the user might intend it as a wildcard, in which case it should
++NOT be sent. But the FTP client can't read the user's mind. This is another
++serious flaw in the Elz/Hethmon draft. Anyway, I got the local matching
++business working for MLSD as long as the user's MGET arg is really a pattern
++and not a directory name. To be continued... ckcftp.c, 21 Sep 2002.
++
++Added FTP { ENABLE, DISABLE } { FEAT, MLST }. If we always send FEAT, we
++usually get a complaint. If we send FEAT and MLST is negotiated, there is a
++good chance it is misimplemented or will have undesirable side effects, such
++as sending huge file lists. NOTE: /NOINIT on the FTP OPEN command also
++disables both of these. ckcftp.c, 22 Sep 2002.
++
++Fixed mkstemp() code in FTP remote_files(). mktemp() does not open the file,
++mkstemp() does open it; previously we had been opening it again and never
++closing the first instance so every MGET would create another open file
++descriptor. ckcftp.c, 22 Sep 2002.
++
++Added debug messages for temp-file creation and lines read from the temp file.
++ckcftp.c, 22 Sep 2002.
++
++Eliminated sending of some extraneous TYPE commands, but there's still room
++for improvement. ckcftp.c, 22 Sep 2002.
++
++Moved definition of build date to top of ckcmai.c. 22 Sep 2002.
++
++Added recursion to MGET with MLSD... It's all done in remote_files().
++Temp-file pointers are on a stack (max size 128). When parsing MLSD lines
++from the temp file and we see "type=dir", we create the local directory by
++calling zmkdir(), change to the remote by sending CWD, increment the depth,
++and call ourselves. When reading from a temp file, upon EOF we close and
++dispose of the temp file, return -3 if currently at top level, otherwise we
++free the tmpfile name, decrement the depth, send CDUP to the server, "cd .."
++locally, and go back and read the next line from the previous but now current
++temp file. Conceptually simple but needed hours of debugging -- what must
++be static, what must be on the stack... Seems OK now but still needs some
++heavy testing. ckcftp.c, 22 Sep 2002.
++
++Added FTP { ENABLE, DISABLE } { SIZE, MDTM } and add help text for FTP
++ENABLE and DISABLE. ckcftp.c, 23 Sep 2002.
++
++Don't allow restart if SIZE disabled. ckcftp.c, 23 Sep 2002.
++
++Make sure all implicit SIZE commands are surpressed if SIZE disabled.
++ckcftp.c, 23 Sep 2002.
++
++If an explicit FTP MODTIME command is sent when MDTM is DISABLED, and it
++succeeds, re-ENABLE MDTM. Ditto for SIZE. ckcftp.c, 23 Sep 2002.
++
++If an explicit FTP FEATURES command is sent during an FTP session, redo the
++features database from it. ckcftp.c, 23 Sep 2002.
++
++After further discussion with Robert Elz, I realized I had to expose the
++underlying MGET mechanisms to the user; the draft isn't going to change, and
++the new spec will result in undesirable effects if the client tries to "do the
++right thing" by magic in all situations; thus the user must have some new
++controls:
++
++ MGET [ /MLST, /NLST, /MATCH:xxx ] [ filespec [ filespec [ ... ] ] ]
++
++These switches let the user force the use of MLSD or NLST when there's a
++choice, and to force local use of a pattern rather than sending it to the
++server, and even to send a directory name to the server at the same time as
++specifying a pattern for local matching, and of course by default we try to do
++the right thing in all scenarios. Symbols only; not coded yet. ckuusr.h,
++23 Sep 2002.
++
++Added the three new switches to MGET, plus /MLST is an invisible synonym for
++/MLSD. If /NLST or /MLSD is given it, it forces the corresponding FTP protocol
++directive. ckcftp.c, 25 Sep 2002.
++
++Now for the tricky part: now we have two separate concepts for what to send to
++the server: a filename or wildcard to be interpreted by the server (NLST only)
++or a directory from which to get a list of all the files (NLST or MLSD),
++possibly together with a pattern to be used by the client to match filenames
++returned by the server. This required giving remote_files() an additional
++argument. Now it uses "pattern" (if any) strictly for local pattern matching
++(because now it is the /MATCH: switch argument, not the MGET filespec), and
++"arg" (the MGET filespec) is what it sends to the server, maybe (see the
++comments in the code for the actual details); either or both these can be
++null. ckcftp.c, 25 Sep 2002.
++
++Discovered that "mget foo", where foo is a directory name, never worked.
++Fixed in remote_files(): ckcftp.c, 25 Sep 2002.
++
++Going through every combination of NLST, MLSD, /MATCH:, and MGET arg and
++debugging each case until OK... Then also with the panix.com NetBSD server
++(lukemftpd 1.0) which also supports MLSD.... 11 test cases all debugged and
++tested OK. ckcftp.c, 26 Sep 2002.
++
++Added /NODOTFILES switch to FTP MGET, to control what happens with dot-files
++if the server includes their names in the list (as lukemftpd does). There's
++no point in adding a /DOTFILES switch because what could it possibly do?
++ckcftp.c, 26 Sep 2002.
++
++Changed a bunch of "skipthis++" to "continue" in doftpget(), to avoid
++error messages when skipping files that user said she wanted to skip.
++ckcftp.c, 26 Sep 2002.
++
++Added help text for the new MGET switches. ckcftp.c, 26 Sep 2002.
++
++Don't switch LOCUS when making an FTP connection until logged in.
++ckcftp.c, 26 Sep 2002.
++
++Fixed LDIR to run Kermit's built-in DIRECTORY code rather than the external
++directory program. ckuusr.c, 26 Sep 2002.
++
++Protect iswild() against NULL args. ckufio.c, 26 Sep 2002.
++
++From Jeff: SET GUI WINDOW RUN-MODE { MAXIMIZE, MINIMIZE, RESTORE },
++plus variables for GUI Window X position, GUI Window Y position, GUI
++Window X resolution, GUI Window Y resolution, GUI Window Run mode.
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[24].c, 27 Sep 2002.
++
++From Ronan Flood: updated FreeBSD 1.0 makefile entry, plus an #ifdef to protect
++sysconf() calls. makefile, ckutio.c, 28 Sep 2002.
++
++Change ftp_auth() to return(0) if an AUTH command gets a 500 response, so it
++doesn't keep sending other kinds of AUTH commands. ckcftp.c, 29 Sep 2002.
++
++Changes from Jeff to yesterday's changes. ckcftp.c, 30 Sep 2002.
++
++From Jeff: SSH command-line personality. Uses same command line as the Telnet
++personality. ckcker.h, ckcmai.c, ckuus[4y].c, 3 Oct 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 7 Oct 2002:
++ . SET PRINTER CHARACTER-SET. ckuxla.c, ckuusr.h, ckuus[25].c
++ . Promotion of K95 to Beta.01. ckcmai.c
++ . Promotion of SET GUI { MENUBAR, TOOLBAR } to visible. ckuus3.c
++
++Changed the URL parser as follows: if the username and/or password fields are
++present but empty, as in:
++
++ ftp://@ftp.xyzcorp.com/somepath
++ or: ftp://:@ftp.xyzcorp.com/somepath
++ but not: ftp://:ftp.xyzcorp.com/somepath
++
++the pointer for these items becomes a pointer to an empty string, rather than
++a NULL pointer. Then when we go to open the connection, if the username
++string pointer points to an empty string, we prompt for the username (and/or
++password). ckuusy.c 9 Oct 2002.
++
++Jason Heskett reported an interesting bug involving a core dump when an
++ON_EXIT macro is defined that executes another macro. Sometimes. He was able
++to send a short command file that always crashed. Diagnosis: ON_EXIT, when it
++is called, pokes itself out of the macro table by setting its own entry in the
++macro name list to an empty string. But this interferes with any macro
++lookups that are done while executing ON_EXIT's body and also evidently some
++code is not happy with empty macro names... To fix: replace "on_exit" with
++"on_exxx", so the replacement keyword is (a) nonempty, and (b) doesn't wreck
++the alphabetical sorting of the table. ckuusx.c, 9 Oct 2002.
++
++Added makefile targets for FreeBSD 4.6 and 5.0. Built and tested on 4.6;
++don't know about 5.0. ckuver.h, makefile, 9 Oct 2002.
++
++Added targets for AIX 5.2 and 5.3; totally untested. ckuver.h, makefile,
++9 Oct 2002.
++
++Built current source on Unixware 7.1.3 (make uw7); it's fine. 9 Oct 2002.
++
++Promoted C-Kermit to 8.0.206 Beta.01 in hopes of a simultaneous release
++with K95 2.1. ckcmai.c, 9 Oct 2002.
++
++From Jeff: Change KERMITFONT definitions to use the new (Unicode 3.1) code
++points for the terminal graphics characters (such as VT100 horizontal scan
++lines), rather than private-use codes. ckcuni.c, 10 Oct 2002.
++
++Jason Heskett also complained that REMOTE CD would print the name of the new
++directory returned by the server even if he SET QUIET ON. This is a tricky
++one. Which server replies should the QUIET settings apply to? If I give a
++REMOTE DIRECTORY command, it means I want to see the directory listing,
++period. But if I give a REMOTE CD command, I get an "unsolicited" response
++message that SET QUIET ON should suppress. Adding message suppression to
++rcv_shortreply() is close, but not totally right; for example, it also
++suppresses the response to REMOTE PWD, which is not helpful. The only right
++way to do this is to suppress for REMOTE CD only, which can be done only by
++setting a (new) global flag, rcdactive. ckuus[r57].c, ckcpro.w, 10 Oct 2002.
++
++Ditto for REMOTE LOGIN response message ("Logged in"). ckuus7.c, 11 Oct 2002.
++
++From Jeff: SET GUI WINDOW FONT { NAME, SIZE }. ckuusr.h, ckuus4.c, 11 Oct 2002.
++
++Quick preliminary 8.0.206 build-all:
++
++ OK SunOS 4.1.3
++ OK Solaris 2.5.1
++ OK Solaris 9
++ OK AIX 4.3.3
++ OK HP-UX 10.20
++ OK VMS 7.1 Alpha + TCP/IP
++ OK VMS 7.1 Alpha nonet
++ OK VMS 5.5 VAX + TCP/IP
++ OK VMS 5.5 VAX nonet
++ OK Unixware 7.1.3
++ OK FreeBSD 3.1
++ OK FreeBSD 4.6
++ OK NetBSD 1.5.2 MVME (Gerry B)
++ OK Sinix 5.42
++
++Sinix build got stuck on ckuusr.c even though we're not optimizing on Sinix
++any more. Rebooting the machine fixed it.
++
++Fixed some #ifdefs for VMS in new incomplete-file deletion code in doclean().
++ckuusx.c, 11 Oct 2002.
++
++Moved uq_blah() prototypes from ckuusr.h to ckcker.h because these routines
++are called in modules that don't (and shouldn't have to) include ckuusr.h.
++11 Oct 2002.
++
++Jeff verified secure builds on Linux and Solaris.
++
++Custom-build workout: 80 different feature-selection combinations:
++ . Fixed yesterday's change for NOSPL: ckcfns.c.
++ . Fixed conflict between NORECALL and USE_ARROWKEYS: ckucmd.c.
++ . Moved setseslog() from ckuus5.c to ckuusx.c to avoid link-time foulups.
++ . Fixed an unguarded reference to zmkdir() in ckcftp.c.
++ . Protected rmsg() by #ifndef NOXFER: ckuus7.c.
++ . Protected initxlist() by #ifndef NOXFER: ckcmai.c.
++ . Fixed unguarded references to g_url struct in xx_ftp(): ckuusy.c.
++ . Fixed unguarded references to tt_snaws() in winchh(): ckutio.c.
++
++--- 8.0.206 Beta.01 11 Oct 2002 ---
++
++From Jeff, 16 Oct 2002:
++ . Fix K95 RMDIR: ckcfn3.c.
++ . Makefile targets for Red Hat 7.2, 7.3, 8.0: ckuver.h, makefile.
++ . Added \v(log_xxx) for each kind of log for PeterE: ckuusr.h, ckuus4.c.
++ . Added SET TERM ATTRIBUTE DIM { ON, OFF }: ckuus[27].c.
++ . Change "const" to "CONST" in some PAM declarations. ckufio.c.
++
++Added SET MATCH { DOTFILE, FIFO } { ON, OFF }. A FIFO special file is a named
++pipe, used for interprocess communication. It must be opened at both ends, so
++it's silly to match them by default; opening a FIFO and attempting to read
++will block forever unless somebody is writing into the other end. Made the
++MATCH FIFO default OFF in all cases. The dotfile default is the same as
++always (OFF for UNIX, ON elsewhere); SET MATCH DOTFILE is simply a more
++untuitive and findable command than SET WILD KERMIT /MATCH-DOT-FILES. Note
++that SET MATCH DOTFILE undoes SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY /[NO]DOTFILES, and vice
++versa. ckcmai.c, ckuusr.h, ckuus[23].c, ckufio.c. 17 Oct 2002.
++
++Added client and server end of REMOTE SET MATCH { DOTFILE, FIFO } { ON, OFF }.
++The new protocol codes are 330 and 331, respectively. ckuus[367].c, ckcfns.c,
++17 Oct 2002.
++
++Adjusted the "match dot if pattern starts with dot" heuristic in nzxpand()
++to not kick in if the filespec is "./foo". This probably needs more work.
++ckufio.c, 17 Oct 2002.
++
++Fixed typo in transcribing Jeff's ckcfn3.c code from yesterday. 18 Oct 2002.
++
++Moved some help text out of #ifdef ANYSSH that had nothing to do with SSH.
++(Idea for a new EMACS feature: M-X list-ifdef-environment.)
++ckuus2.c, 18 Oct 2002.
++
++Removed "set file { permission, protection }" keywords, which led nowhere.
++ckuus7.c, 18 Oct 2002.
++
++Added -DSV68 to all SV/68 targets. Make ckgetfqhostname() just return its
++argument in SV/68; it dumps core otherwise. In case this happens anywhere
++else, add -DNOCKGETFQHOST to CFLAGS. makefile, ckcnet.c, 18 Oct 2002.
++
++For PeterE, added SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PERMISSIONS { ON, OFF } so incoming and
++outbound permission attributes can be set separately. ckuus[27].c, 18 Oct 2002.
++
++Changed SHOW ATTRIBUTES to show In and Out permissions separately.
++ckuus5.c, 18 Oct 2002.
++
++Fixed REDO to display the command it's redoing and to add it to the bottom
++of the recall buffer. ckuusr.c, 18 Oct 2002.
++
++Discovered that DATE SATURDAY dumps core... Apparently it always did; this
++case was not included in the date-time torture test script. The crash happens
++because the DATE parsing code doesn't check for a NULL date-converion
++error-message pointer. Fixed in ckuusr.c, 18 Oct 2002.
++
++The reason DATE SATURDAY got a date-conversion error was that this path thru
++the code left a result pointer unset. Fixed in cmcvtdate(): ckucmd.c,
++19 Oct 2002.
++
++DATE SUNDAY +1DAY returned incorrect results (for any day-of-week name, any
++delta time), even though DATE TODAY +1DAY worked fine. Fixed in cmcvtdate():
++ckucmd.c, 19 Oct 2002.
++
++SET TAKE ECHO ON counted each line twice when GOTO was active. Fixed in
++dogoto(): ckuus6.c, 19 Oct 2002.
++
++Jeff noticed:
++"KERMIT READY TO GET...
++ RCVD: (2 files) Last: [/amd/prost/p/kd/jaltman/.src/ckonet.c] (OK)
++the last file attempted may have been ckonet.c but it certainly was
++not the last file received" (similarly for sending). Fixed by having two
++pointers for each name; a preliminary pointer, which is set for each file at
++the beginning of the transfer (when we have all the needed info), and a final
++one that is set from the preliminary one only after the file was transferred
++successfully. This corrects not only the automatic "wheremessage" at the end
++of a remote-mode transfer, but also the WHERE and SHOW FILE command results.
++ckuusx.c, ckcfn[s3].c, ckcpro.w, 19 Oct 2002.
++
++From Jeff: Improve ORIENTATION message for K95 to say which directories are
++for which INI files. ckuusr.c, 23 Oct 2002.
++
++Removed Beta designation from herald. ckcmai.c, 23 Oct 2002.
++
++Put final dates and ID strings in Unix and VMS build procedures.
++Makefile, ckvker.com, 23 Oct 2002.
++
++Build-all... #ifdef adjustments: ckcfns.c... 83 different feature-set
++combinations build OK on Linux. 23 Oct 2002.
++
++From Jeff: SET WIN95 HORIZONTAL-SCAN-LINE-SUBSTITUTIONS. ckuusr.h, ckuus7.c,
++24 Oct 2002.
++
++Fixed Heath-19 graphic character-set table to use new Unicode 3.1 values
++if WIN95 HORIZ OFF. ckcuni.c, 24 Oct 2002.
++
++Changed tx_usub() to return Unicode 3.1 values if WIN95 HORIZ OFF.
++ckcuni.c, 24 Oct 2002. <-- No backed off on this.
++
++Some problems during build-all:
++
++ . VMS 7.1 TGV 4.2: If I make a Telnet connection with it, then try to send
++ a file (itself. wermit.exe) over the connection, the connection drops
++ after about 20%, the thermometer zooms out to 100% and SUCCESS is reported.
++ This doesn't happen with UCX.
++
++ . VMS 7.3 TGV 4.3: ckcmai.c won't compile because of a complaint about the
++ declaration of select() (which ckcmai.c doesn't use) in
++ SYS$COMMON:[SYSLIB]DECC$RTLDEF.TLB. Ditto in VMS 7.2 TGV 4.3.
++ Adding NOSELECT to CFLAGS doesn't help. I don't think the VMS version
++ even uses select(). But the TGV 4.3 builds were OK in 8.0.201, so what
++ changed? I don't see anything in ckcnet.h that would have done it.
++
++It builds OK with VMS 7.1 / TGV 4.2 but sending files on Telnet connections
++fails in a strange way: the connection drops, but the thermomoter goes to 100%
++and success is reported. I don't know why the connection is dropping (s_errno
++is 32 == "broken pipe"), but the spurious success indication is because of
++a double failure in sdata(): (1) The packet-sending loop index could go
++negative without breaking the loop when streaming; (2) if spack() fails,
++sdata() should return -2, not -1 (which means EOF). Also if any ttchk() in
++sdata() returns < 0, sdata should return -2. I fixed this code (which has
++been this way for YEARS) and now VMS C-Kermit properly fails when it gets
++the spack() error, but ttchk() in this case still doesn't think the connection
++is lost, but that must be our new problem with MultiNet. ckcfns.c,
++27 Oct 2002.
++
++The compilation failure in ckcmai.c is a clue... The problem was that I added
++#ifdef VMS / #include <time.h> / #endif to shut up complaints about the time()
++call. Evidently something in VMS <time.h> gives MultiNet a bad case of
++indigestion; removing it fixes the compilation and the result works fine. The
++transmission failures in the other case seem to be a coincidence -- something
++to do with the U of Arizona (probably some obscure VMS quota on my IDs there,
++or some kind of network connection throttling), since it doesn't happen
++anywhere else. ckcmai.c, 27 Oct 2002.
++
++Changed four occurrences of "void" to "VOID" in ckcftp.c, 27 Oct 2002.
++
++Defined NOCKFQHOSTNAME for HPUXPRE65. Might also need this for HP-UX 7
++and maybe 8. ckcnet.c, 27 Oct 2002.
++
++From Jeff: PAM_CONST definition to clear up warnings caused by different
++vendors' definitions of PAM structs. ckufio.c, 28 Oct 2002.
++
++Unixware 2.1.0 build bombs immediately with "UX:make: ERROR: line too long"
++(which line?) Not worth chopping up the makefile to fix but in a pinch it
++could be done. 2.1.3 builds OK.
++
++Did another 20-some platform builds, bringing the total to 83, plus a final
++runthrough of the build-with-84-different-feature-set-combinations script on
++Linux. Should be good to go!
++
++--- 8.0.206 24 Oct 2002 ---
++
++Finally got access to Linux on IA64 again. Builds OK but dumps core
++immediately on startup. Adding -DNOCKGETFQHOST was necessary but not
++sufficient. In this case, the very call to ckgetfqhostname() from ckhost()
++(which is in ckuusx.c) was dumping core; thus I had to move the definition of
++NOCKGETFQHOST from ckcnet.c to ckcdeb.h, add an #ifdef __ia64__ clause to it,
++and protect the call to ckgetfqhostname() with it. Obviously there has to be
++a better fix but this will have to for now. ckcnet.c, ckuusx.c, ckcdeb.h,
++31 Oct 2002.
++
++Link step fails in Mandrake 9.0 with undefined references to res_search,
++dn_expand, and crypt. Turns out the linux makefile target tests for the
++existence of libcrypt.a and libresolv.a, but in Mandrake 9.0 they exist
++only as *.so. Changed linux target to look for both. makefile, 1 Nov 2002.
++
++Vace reported that "ftp mget a b c" would get ALL files from the server's
++directory if c did not exist. Diagnosis: off-by-one error in counting MGET
++args processed. Naturally fixing this bug revealed another (this time
++cosmetic) one, which resulted in spurious error messages when hitting MGET
++args that have no match on the server. Fixed in ckcftp.c, 1 Nov 2002.
++
++Rebuilt about 60 of the most important Unix binaries to pick up the fixes
++31 Oct - 1 Nov 2002, and refreshed the FTP site with new sources, tarballs,
++ZIP files, etc. Sat Nov 2 19:11:30 2002
++
++From Martin Vorlaender and Jeff, SSL/TLS support for VMS:
++ckuusr.h, ckuath.h, ckcnet.c, ckctel.c, ckuath.c, 10 Nov 2002.
++
++Added PASV as invisible synonym for PASSIVE. ckcftp.c, 10 Nov 2002.
++
++--- 8.0.206 24 Oct 2002 #2 ---
++
++More work on SSL in VMS: Jeff + Martin Vorlaender: ck_ssl.c ckcmai.c ckcnet.c
++ckctel.c ckuath.h ckvcon.c ckvtio.c ckvker.com 10-15 Nov 2002.
++
++Discovered that ckvfio.c would not compile on VMS 6.1 with UCX 4.1 because
++<conv$routines.h> was missing, which is explicitly included. Enclosed the
++#include in #ifdef NOCONVROUTINES..#endif and rebuilt with
++@[users.fdc.src]ckvker.com "" "" "NOCONVROUTINES". 16 Nov 2002.
++
++Fixed the "ftp mget */data/*" problem with two small changes to doftpget():
++ckcftp.c, 16 Nov 2002. Placed a copy of ckcftp.patch in ~kermit/f.
++
++From Lucas Hart: Fixes for VAX C 2.x and CMU TCP/IP. "Can't guarantee that
++the revised CKVOLD will work for all combinations of more recent
++VMS/compiler/TCPIP releases, but I've tested it for compatibility on our AXP
++VMS 6.2, UCX 4.0, DECC 5.6, your AXP VMS 7.1, DEC TCPIP 5.1, DECC 6.0 as well
++as with VAX VMS 5.4, VAX C 3.2, CMU12 and VAX VMS 4.7, VAX C 2.4." ckvfio.c,
++ckvtio.c, ckuus5.c, ckvker.com, ckvold.com, 17 Nov 2002.
++
++From Jeff: More work on VMS SSL. Now it actually works, even in CONNECT mode,
++except it hangs when it gets an error alert or the remote closes the
++connection. ckcnet.c. ckvtio.c, 17 Nov 2002.
++
++NOTE: Lucas's changes should go into the 8.0.206 source code but it's too
++late since ckvtio.c (upon which he based his changes) is already full of
++SSL code.
++
++MGET in K95 in totally broken FOR SOME PEOPLE (mainly me) if the TMP (or TEMP)
++value is too long. It works fine if you set these to C:\TMP. Diagnosis: (1)
++we were malloc'ing only 16 bytes for the temp file name (I think this was my
++fault -- I was only looking at the "ckXXXXXX" part and forgetting that this
++was appended to the TMP path); (2) the Windows version of mktemp() wants you
++to use the value pointed to by the pointer it returns, rather than assuming
++the mktemp() arg will be modified in place. The code was changed to malloc a
++longer string and to use the return value from mktemp() (if any) rather than
++assuming that mktemp() modified its argument string (in K95 only -- not sure
++about Unix platforms; the man pages differ on this, but at least this way if
++some mktemp() version does NOT alter its argument, we still have a usable
++filename (like /tmp/ckXXXXXX)). Of course this won't be good for recursive
++MLSD downloads, but we can always issue patches for the Unix version later if
++needed. The Linux and BSD versions use mkstemp() anyway. There is, however,
++a danger of a memory leak in the Unix version if the user has defined a TMPDIR
++or CK_TMP environment variable whose value is longer than 9 bytes. All this
++is highly unlikely so we should be OK. ckcftp.c, 17 Nov 2002.
++
++--- K95 2.1.1 and updated ck[uv]206.{tar,zip} but not C-Kermit binaries ---
++
++From Jeff: Fixes for Telnet Com Port Control, update to a newer release of
++OpenSSL: ck_ssl.c ck_ssl.h ckcdeb.h ckcftp.c ckcmai.c ckcnet.c ckctel.c
++ckuath.c ckuath.h ckucns.c ckuus4.c ckuus5.c ckuusr.c ckuusr.h ckvcon.c
++ckvfio.c ckvker.com ckvtio.c ckvvms.h, 25 Nov 2002.
++
++--- K95 2.1.2 and C-Kermit 8.0 CDROM ---
++
++From Jeff, 28 Nov 2002:
++ . Updated SSL modules: ck_ssl.[ch].
++ . Fixed cipher-list display in SHOW AUTH & FTP ssl_auth(): ckuus7.c. ckcftp.c
++ . Some minor tn_wait() fixes: ckctel.c.
++ . Preliminary SSL support for VMS CONNECT: ckvcon.c.
++
++Bumped C-Kermit edit number to 207.
++
++From Jeff, 29 Nov 2002: "[C-Kermit was dumping core on SCO OSR5 Telnet Com Port
++connections because] the SCO compiler treats all characters as signed. This
++was causing 'sprintf(buf,"02x ",ch);' to produce strings such as "ffffffc2"
++instead of "c2" for values between 128 and 255. This wrote beyond the end of
++a buffer and blew away the stack. Having fixed this I also noticed that
++conect() did not properly check for carrier when TN CPC was negotiated. This
++has now been fixed as well." ckucns.c, ckucon.c, ckctel.c, 29 Nov 2002.
++
++From Jeff, 30 Nov 2002: Fix SSL for VMS and also carry forward the CPC fixes
++to VMS. ckcnet.c, ckvtio.c, ckvcon.c, 30 Nov 2002.
++
++Changed copyright dates that are displayed (but not yet all the internal
++ones) from 2002 to 2003. ckcmai.c, 3 Jan 2003.
++
++Fixed the FTP module's brief-format transaction log, which had the status
++inverted: OK for FAILED and v.v. ckcftp.c 3 Jan 2003.
++
++From Jeff, 4 Jan 2003:
++ . Make /MOVE-TO:xxx convert xxx to full pathname: ckuus[r67].c,
++ . Make SHOW OPTIONS ALL show both kinds of options: ckuus2.c.
++ . More command-line personalities: ckcmai.c, ckuusy.c.
++ . New NOSCROLL command for K95: ckuusr.[ch], ckuus2.c.
++ . New lockdown and other command-line options: ckuusr.h, ckuusy.c.
++ . SSL interface updated to OpenSSL 0.9.7: ck_ssl.c.
++ . SET TERM LINE-SPACING and CURSOR xxx NOBLINK: ckuus[27]c.
++ . Expanded SHOW GUI command: ckuus3.c
++ . New SHOW TABS code: ckuus5.c.
++
++Updated SUPPORT (BUG), NEWS, and INTRO texts. ckuus[26].c. 5 Jan 2003.
++
++Fixed FTP module to suppress "'FEAT': Command not understood" message
++unless FTP DEBUG is ON. ckcftp.c, 6 Jan 2003.
++
++Got a report that C-Kermit dumps core on Solaris when executing a certain
++script. Seems to be related to changing vnambuf[] in zzstring() from an
++automatic array to a malloc'd buffer (see notes from 29 Jun 2000). Changed
++it to an automatic buffer except for K95. ckuus4.c, 6 Jan 2003.
++
++Nope, that's not it. It evidently happens only after FTP PUT has been used.
++Fixed solaris9g makefile target to include -funsigned-char and built a new
++binary. Determined that building with gcc and -funsigned-char makes no
++difference. makefile, 7 Jan 2003.
++
++I did a preliminary audit, looking at the items in the left column: if used in
++a given routine, are there any obvious mistakes:
++
++ 1 2 3 4 5
++ doftpput->putfile->sendrequest->doftpsend2->secure_write
++malloc OK OK OK OK OK
++makestr OK OK OK OK OK
++automatic arrays OK OK OK OK OK
++[ck]str[n]cpy OK OK OK OK OK
++[ck]str[n]cat OK OK OK OK OK
++sprintf OK OK OK OK OK
++nzltor OK OK OK OK OK
++zfnqfp OK OK OK OK OK
++memcpy OK OK OK OK OK
++bcopy OK OK OK OK OK
++
++secure_write sends the data directly on clear-text connections. On secure
++connections, it calls secure_putbuf(), which calls secure_putbyte(), but we
++aren't using those, so secure_write() is the end of the call chain for FTP
++PUT. doftpsend2 has buf[] as an automatic array, which it reads file data
++into using zxin (binary mode only), but this looks OK. Still, I changed it
++read 1 less than the buffer size (fread) just in case. Also there was one
++debug() statement that referred to an automatic array (fullname[]) before it
++was initialized (but not used in this case), which I fixed. ckcftp.c,
++7 Jan 2003.
++
++FTP GET /RECURSIVE somepath/somefile still didn't work, despite what the
++notes of 19 Sep 2001 say. There are so many paths through the code,
++depending on switch values, GET vs MGET, etc, that a crucial spot was missed.
++Fixed in doftpget(): ckcftp.c, 7 Jan 2003.
++
++Back to the core dump... after two days of full-time debugging, I found the
++culprit: the buffer-full test in the zzout() macro should have been ">="
++rather than just ">", thus Kermit wrote 1 byte past the end of the malloc'd
++FTP PUT output buffer, ucbuf. Why did it never happen in K95? Because, since
++it's a secure build, FUDGE_FACTOR is defined there. But it's not defined in
++Solaris or other clear-text builds. Although the crash wouldn't happen in
++secure builds, the 1-byte leak might have caused errors in the data transfer.
++In non-Solaris clear-text builds, like Linux, I suspect that malloc() tends
++add something for safety (especially given the man page statement that it
++allocates "at least" what you asked for). Another reason the problem escaped
++notice is that zzout() is used only for text-mode PUTs (and then only when
++there is no character-set translation), but most transfers these days are
++binary and/or downloads. Anyway, in the course of debugging, a lot of small
++cleanups were done: sizeof(blah) for all arrays was replaced by the same
++symbolic size that was used to allocate the array, numeric array sizes were
++replaced with symbolic ones, etc. The real fix is one character long.
++ckcftp.c, 9 Jan 2003.
++
++Got a report that "mget /recursive */somedir/*" downloaded the files into
++the current directory, rather than re-creating the remote directory structure.
++Fixed in doftpget(): ckcftp.c, 10 Jan 2003.
++
++Unix C-Kermit did not allow file transfer if started under inetd and accessed
++via Internet raw socket (or whatever). Diagnosis: isatty() and friends would
++fail causing ttopen() to fail. Fixed by adding escape clauses for "-l 0"
++situations (i.e. Kermit invoked with an already-open file descriptor) at the
++appropriate places. ckcmai.c, ckutio.c, 14 Jan 2003.
++
++From Jeff for K95 2.1.3
++ . Add test for startflags & 128 to trap() for ignoring BREAK.
++ . Fix for SHOW TRANSMIT.
++
++--- K95 2.1.3 ---
++
++FTP USER, FTP ACCOUNT, plus the various prompts and switches for FTP username,
++password, and account all neglected to strip quotes, and in most cases quotes
++are necessary to specify a username that contains spaces. ckcftp.c,
++15 Jan 2003.
++
++FTP MPUT f1 f2 f3... gets a parse error if any of the fn's do not match an
++existing file. This is bad for scripts. In doftpput(), cmfdb() looks for
++keywords (switches) or CMIFI. When it hits CMIFI, it exits from the initial
++parse loop and then does additional cmifi()s in a loop until done. The most
++obvious fix is to parse each field with cmfdb(CMIFI,CMFLD), i.e. fall back to
++CMFLD if CMIFI doesn't match anything. Then if CMFLD was used, we don't add
++the filespec to the list. This is a rather big change but it seems to work.
++No error messages or failures happen for non-matching fields, but an error
++message is printed (and the MPUT command fails) if none of the fields match
++any files. This fix got in too late for 2.1.3; workaround: use C-Shell
++like wildcard list (ftp mput "{*.abc,foo.*}"). ckcftp.c, 16 Jan 2003.
++
++GREP did not pass its pattern through the expander, thus variables could
++not be used for patterns. This must have been an oversight -- I can't find
++anything in my notes about it. Fixed in dogrep(): ckuus6.c, 24 Jan 2003.
++
++New makefile target for HP-UX 11.xx with OpenSSL from Tapani Tarvainen.
++makefile, 31 Jan 2003.
++
++From Jeff:
++ . Avoid core dump when dereferencing tnc_get_signature(): ckuus4.c.
++ . Bump version numbers to 8.0.208, 2.1.4: ckcmai.c.
++
++Added /NOLOGIN to FTP [OPEN]. ckcftp.c, 10 Feb 2003.
++
++Don't dump core if FTP DEBUG is ON and FTP OPEN does not include a service.
++openftp(): ckcftp.c, 10 Feb 2003.
++
++HELP PATTERN text incorrectly identified commands and functions with
++floating and anchored patterns. The corrected lists are:
++Floating: GREP, TYPE /MATCH:, /EXCEPT: patterns, \farraylook(),
++Anchored: IF MATCH, file-matching wildcards, \fsearch(), \frsearch()
++ckuus2.c, 10 Feb 2003.
++
++INPUT n \fpattern(xxx) did not work for case-independent comparisons.
++Fixed in doinput(): ckuus4.c, 10 Feb 2003.
++
++It seems \fpattern() didn't work with MINPUT at all. There was no code to
++handle \fpattern() in the MINPUT parse loop, so it never worked. The code
++had to be totally rewritten to use cmfld() in a loop, rather than cmtxt()
++and then cksplit(). Furthermore, whenever any of the fields was an
++\fjoin(), this had to be split. ckuusr.c, 10 Feb 2003.
++
++Macro replacement via \m() and \fdefinition() does not work as advertised
++(i.e. case sensitively) for associative array elements; e.g. \m(xxx<abc>) is
++treated the same as \m(xxx<ABC>), contrary to section 7.10.10 of the C-Kermit
++7.0 update notes, and to the fact that the two really do exist separately.
++Fixed by adding a static function isaarray(s) which succeeds if s is an
++associative array reference and fails otherwise, and then having \m()
++and \fdef() call mxxlook() (case-sensitive lookup) if isaarray(), otherwise
++(as before) mxlook()). ckuus4.c, 11 Feb 2003.
++
++Fixed FTP OPEN to allow the /USER switch to override SET FTP AUTOLOGIN OFF,
++just as /NOLOGIN overrides SET FTP AUTOLOGIN ON. ckcftp.c, 11 Feb 2003.
++
++In K95, "set key \1234 \27H" (any SET KEY command in which the first char of
++the definition was backslash, and the ONLY character after the backslash
++quantity was an uppercase letter, that letter would be lowercased). Diagnosis:
++xlookup() poking its argument (see notes from July 2000). Jeff sent a fix.
++ckucmd.c, 15 Feb 2003.
++
++Ran my S-Expression torture test to make sure Sexps still worked. They do,
++except the bitwise & and | operators were broken, e.g. (& 7 2) and (| 1 2 4)
++get "Invalid operand" errors. Jeff's code had added an early failure return
++from the lookup loop when when a single-byte keyword matched a keyword that
++started with the same byte but was more than one byte long. So "&" would hit
++"&&" and fail instead of continuing its search (xlookup tables aren't sorted
++so there can be no early return). Fixed in xlookup(): ckucmd.c, 16 Feb 2003.
++
++Got rid of "krbmit" target from makefile. It's still there, but we don't
++use it any more. All secure targets now use "xermit", and produce a binary
++called wermit, just like the regular ones do (except the old ckucon.c ones).
++Non-secure targets, since they don't define any of the security symbols,
++wind up compiling and linking to (mostly) empty security modules. makefile,
++15 Feb 2003.
++
++Added \fcvtdate(xxx,3) to format its result in MDTM format (yyyymmddhhmmss,
++all numeric, no spaces or punctuation). Of course these numeric strings
++are too big to be 32-bit numbers and are useless for arithmetic, but they're
++useful for lexical comparison, etc. ckuus[24].c, 16 Feb 2003.
++
++The following FTP commands did not set FAILURE when they failed: RMDIR,
++CD, CDUP, Fixed in the corresponding doftpblah() routines. ckcftp.c,
++16 Feb 2003.
++
++RENAME would sometimes not print an error message when it failed, e.g. in K95
++when the destination file already existed. ckuus6.c, 17 Feb 2003.
++
++Fixed COPY error messages, which did not come out in standard format when
++/LIST was not included. ckuus6.c, 17 Feb 2003.
++
++Fixed #ifdefs in ck_crp.c to allow nonsecure builds on old platforms like
++System V/68 R3. 19 Feb 2003.
++
++Similar treatment for ck_ssl.c. 20 Feb 2003.
++
++From Jeff, 21 Feb 2003:
++ . AIX53 and AIX52 symbols for ckcdeb.h, makefile.
++ . New gcc targets for various AIX 4.x/5.x versions: makefile.
++ . Copyright date updates: ck_crp.c, ck_ssl.c.
++ . ENABLE/DISABLE QUERY broken because keyword table out of order: ckuusr.c.
++ . Fixed the use of HTTP proxies for HTTP [RE]OPEN for Unix: ckcnet.c.
++
++Also for K95 only: Allow file transfer when K95 is invoked on the remote end
++of a connection to a Pragma Systems Terminal Server connection; automatically
++SET EXIT HANGUP OFF when invoked with open port handle ("k95 -l nnnn").
++
++"cd a*" failed even when "a*" matched only one directory. Fixed in cmifi():
++ckucmd.c, 21 Feb 2003.
++
++In the Unix version, replace "extern int errno;" with "#include <errno.h>"
++if __GLIBC__ is defined, since glibc now defines a thread-specific errno.
++ckcdeb.h, 26 Feb 2003.
++
++Added #ifdefs to skip compilation of ckuath.c in nonsecure builds. Tested
++by building both secure and regular versions in Linux. ckuath.c, 26 Feb 2003.
++
++Ran the build-in-84-different-configurations script on Linux to make sure it
++still builds with all different combinations of feature selection options.
++All OK. 26 Feb 2003.
++
++Built on VMS. Needed to add a prototype for mxxlook*() to ckuusr.h; built
++OK otherwise. 26 Feb 2003.
++
++From Jeff: More #ifdef shuffling for nonsecure builds: ckuath.c, ck_ssl.c,
++27 Feb 2003.
++
++Added code to ensure \v(download) ends in a directory separator in Unix,
++Windows, and OS/2. ckuus7.c, 27 Feb 2003.
++
++Added code to K95 zfnqfp() to tack on directory separator when returning
++a directory name. ckofio.c, 27 Feb 2003.
++
++Somehow an old copy of ckuath.c popped to replace the new one. Put the new
++one back. 28 Feb 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Fix typo in my K95 zfnqfp() code from yesterday; fixes for handling
++UNCs uniformly, no matter which way their slashes are leaning. ckofio.c,
++28 Feb 2003.
++
++At Jeff Mezei's suggestion, separate text and binary mode open sequences
++for VMS session log. ckvfio.c, 28 Feb 2003.
++
++Added freebsd48 target for FreeBSD 4.8. makefile, 1 Mar 2003.
++
++Changed Mac OS X entries to include -DUSE_STRERROR. makefile, 2 Mar 2003.
++
++Fixed GETOK /GUI to evaluate its text argument. ckuus6.c, 3 Mar 2003.
++
++Jeff fixed the K95 Dialer QUICK dialog to (a) allow templates, and (b) have
++a Save-As option. 3 Mar 2003.
++
++Jeff fixed a problem with the Xmodem-CRC checksum being crunched whenever
++there was a retransmission. 7 Mar 2003.
++
++Added target/banner for Tru64 5.1B. makefile, ckuver.h, 5 Mar 2003.
++
++In Unix, the zcopy() routine (used by the COPY command) reset the user's umask
++to 0 for the remainder of the Kermit process lifetime. The bug was in
++ckufio.c 8.0.194, 24 Oct 2002, and is fixed in ckufio.c 8.0.195, 6 Mar 2003.
++Of course this happened after building 155 C-Kermit 8.0.208 binaries. (But
++before officially releasing 8.0.208.)
++
++In the VMS version, changed:
++
++ while ((n--) && xx_inc(2) > -1) ;
++to:
++ while ((n--) && xx_inc(2) >= 0) ;
++
++to suppress the "...is being compared with a relational operator to a constant
++whose value is not greater than zero" warning. ckvtio.c, 7 Mar 2002.
++
++Added a debug call to dologend in hopes of catching overzealous Locus
++switching, which seems to happen only in K95. ckuus3.c, 7 Mar 2002.
++
++Rebuilt binaries for some of the more current Unix releases: AIX 4.3.3-5.1,
++Solaris 7-9 , Red Hat 7.0-8.0, Slackware 8.1, Freebsd 4.7-4.8, NetBSD 1.6,
++OpenBSD 3.2, Unixware 7.1.3, Open Unix 8, OSR5.0.6a, etc. A Unix binary with
++COPY umask fix shows a 6 Mar 2003 date for "UNIX File support" in SHOW
++VERSIONS; a binary without the fix shows 24 Oct 2002.
++
++C-Kermit 8.0.208 dated 14 March 2003 released on 10 March 2003.
++
++---8.0.208---
++
++From Jeff 13 Mar 2003:
++ . Updated SSL module allows importation of tickets from host.
++ . freebsd50+openssl target: makefile.
++ . FTP PUT /PERMISSIONS error message for K95: ckcftp.c.
++
++Fixed MINPUT to strip quotes or braces from around targets (this was broken
++on Feb 10th). Thanks to Jason Heskett for discovering and reporting this
++(killer) bug. ckuusr.c, 14 Mar 2003.
++
++Changed version number to 209 Dev.00. ckcmai.c, 14 Mar 2003.
++
++While debugging the alphapage script, I found that the command "minput 8 \6\13
++\21\13 \13\27\4\13 \30\13" gets "?Not confirmed" in 8.0.208 and 8.0.209, but
++not in 206 and earlier. This problem too was introduced on Feb 10th by
++changing MINPUT parsing from cmtxt() followed by cksplit() to cmfld() in a
++loop. cmfld() uses setatm() to return its result and of course setatm()
++breaks on \13. Changing setatm() not to do this would break everything else.
++But cmfld() has no arguments that let us tell it to do anything different in
++this case. Changing the API would be a disaster. The only solution is to add
++an "MINPUT ACTIVE" (minputactive) global variable that tells cmfld() to tell
++setatm() not to break on CR. Now MINPUT with braced targets containing CR
++and/or LF works in 209, 206, and 201 (but not 208). ckucmd.c, ckuusr.c,
++ckuus5.c, 15 Mar 2003.
++
++MINPUT n \fjoin(&a) works OK if all the members of \&a[] are text strings, but
++if they are strings of control chars (as above), they don't get separated by
++the spaces. For example in:
++
++ dcl \&a[] = "\4\5" "\6\7" xxx
++ minput 10 \fjoin(&a)
++
++MINPUT gets two targets: "aaa" and "\4\5 \6\7 xxx". The bug was in the
++cksplit() call in the \fjoin() case of MINPUT: it needed to specify an
++include set consisting of all the control characters except NUL. ckuusr.c,
++16 Mar 2003.
++
++But there's still a problem:
++
++ dcl \&a[] = "\4\5\13\10" "\6\7" "xxx"
++
++creates an array whose first member is "^D^E (one doublequote included). But
++if braces are used instead, there's no problem. Same deal as MINPUT: cmfld()
++breaks on CR or LF, thus the end quote is lost. If I set minputactive for
++DECLARE initializers too, that fixes it. Is there any reason not to do this?
++Can't think of any (famous last words)... ckuusr.c, 16 Mar 2003.
++
++Since it has multiple applications, changed the flag's name from minputactive
++to keepallchars. ckucmd.c, ckuus[r5].c, 16 Mar 2003.
++
++\v(exedir) wasn't being set correctly (it included the program name as well
++as the directory). Fixed in getexedir(): ckuus4.c, 16 Mar 2003.
++
++SET CARRIER-WATCH <Esc> "auto matic" (spurious space in supplied keyword).
++Cosmetic only; it still worked. Fixed in setdcd(): ckuus3.c, 16 Mar 2003.
++
++"directory a b c" listed too many files -- all files whose names END WITH a,
++b, or c, rather than the files whose names WERE a, b, or c. Diagnosis: The
++filespec is changed into a pattern: {a,b,c}, which is the correct form. It is
++passed to nzxpand(), which goes through the directory getting filenames and
++sending each one to ckmatch() with the given pattern. ckmatch() receives the
++correct pattern but then prepends a "*" -- that's not right. It's not just
++in filename matching either. The following succeeds when it shouldn't:
++
++ if match xxxxc {{a,b,c}} <command>
++
++Changing ckmatch() to not prepend the "*" to each segment fixes the command
++above but breaks lots of others. Running through the "match" torture-test
++script shows the problem occurs only when the {a,b,c} list is the entire
++pattern, and not embedded within a larger pattern. Testing for this case
++fixed the problem. ckmatch(): ckclib.c, 16 Mar 2003.
++
++Fixed FTP MODTIME to not print anything if QUIET ON. ckcftp.c, 16 Mar 2003.
++
++Picked up a new ckuath.c from Jeff, not sure what the changes are. 16 Mar 2003.
++
++Did a few regular and secure builds to make sure I didn't wreck anything.
++
++Changed version number to 209 (final). ckcmai.c, 16 Mar 2003.
++
++Jason Heskett found another bug: if you define a macro FOO inside the
++definition of another macro BAR, and FOO's definition includes an odd number
++of doublequotes (such as 1), FOO's definition absorbs the rest of BAR's
++definition. Example:
++
++ def TEST {
++ .foo = {X"}
++ sho mac foo
++ }
++ do test
++ sho mac foo
++
++Results in:
++
++ foo = {X"}, sho mac foo
++
++Diagnosis: the TEST definition becomes:
++
++ def TEST .foo = {X"}, sho mac foo
++
++and the macro reader is erroneously treating the doublequote as an open
++quote, and then automatically closes the quote at the end of the definition.
++The error is that a doublequote should be significant only at the beginning of
++a field. But the macro reader isn't a command parser; it doesn't know what
++a field is -- it's just looking for commas and skipping over quoted ones.
++First we have to fix an oversight: SET COMMAND DOUBLEQUOTING OFF should have
++worked here, but it wasn't tested in this case. Fixed in getncm(): ckuus5.c,
++17 Mar 2003.
++
++There are only certain cases where it makes sense to treat doublequotes as
++signicant:
++
++ . An open quote must be at the beginning or preceded by a space.
++ . A close quote is only at the end or else followed by a space.
++
++This too was fixed in getncm(): ckuus5.c, 17 Mar 2003.
++
++A fix from Jeff SSL/TLS FTP data decoding. ckcftp.c, 18 Mar 2003.
++
++Tried building C-Kermit on a Cray Y-MP with UNICOS 9.0. "int suspend",
++declared in ckcmai.c and used in many modules, conflicts with:
++
++ unistd.h:extern int suspend __((int _Category, int _Id));
++
++The "=Dsuspend=xsuspend" trick doesn't work for this; there is no way around
++the conflict other than to rename the variable: ckcmai.c, ckutio.c,
++ckuus[35xy].c. 26 Mar 2003. VMS and K95 not affected.
++
++OK that gets us past ckcmai.c... Then in ckutio.c I had to add a new #ifdef
++around the LFDEVNO setting, because the Cray didn't have mkdev.h. Could not
++find a Cray-specific manifest symbol, so I made a new makefile target (cray9)
++that sets this symbol. Having done this I have no idea what kind of lockfile
++would be created, but I also doubt if anybody dials out from a Cray. The
++binary should run a C90, J90, or Y-MP. makefile, 26 Mar 2003.
++
++Added a target for SCO OSR5.0.7. makefile, ckuver.h, 30 Mar 2003.
++
++Changed since 208:
++makefile ckuver.h ckcmai.c ckclib.c ckcftp.c ckucmd.c ckuus*.c ckutio.c.
++
++---8.0.209---
++
++From Mark Sapiro, a fix for the March 17th doubleqote fix, getncm(): ckuus5.c,
++4 Apr 2003.
++
++From Jeff, 29 Apr 2003:
++ . Corrected target for HP-UX 11.00 + OpenSSL: makefile,
++ . Do not allow WILL AUTH before WONT START_TLS: ckctel.h ckctel.c
++ . Add hooks for SFTP and SET/SHOW SFTP: ckcdeb.h ckuusr.h ckuusr.c ckuus3.c
++ . Add SKERMIT ckuusr.h ckuusr.c
++ . Add ADM-5 terminal emulation: ckuus7.c, ckuus5.c
++ . Uncomment and update HELP SET SSH V2 AUTO-REKEY: ckuus2.c
++ . Enable IF TERMINAL-MACRO and IF STARTED-FROM-DIALER for C-Kermit: ckuus6.c
++ . Fix conflicting NOSCROLL keyword definition: ckuusr.h
++ . Set ttname when I_AM_SSH: ckuusy.c
++ . Add extended arg parsing for SSH, Rlogin, Telnet: ckuusy.c, ckuus4.c
++ . Security updates: ckuath.c, ck_ssl.c
++ . Change K95 version number to 2.2.0: ckcmai.c
++ . Save K95 term i/o state before executing keyboard macro: ckuus4.c
++ . Add tests for SSH Subsystem active during INPUT/OUTPUT/CONNECT: ckuus[45].c
++ . Enable K95 SET SSH V2 AUTO-REKEY: ckuus3.c
++
++SFTP and SET SFTP subcommands are implemented up to the case statements.
++
++Files of mine that Jeff hadn't picked up:
++ ckuver.h ckcftp.c ckutio.c ckuusx.c (just minor changes for last build-all)
++
++On 4 Jan 2003, SET RECEIVE MOVE-TO was changed to convert is argument to an
++absolute path, which made it impossible to specify a relative path, then
++move to different directories and have it apply relatively to each directory.
++Changed this as follows:
++
++ . Parser uses cmtxt() rather than cmdir() so it won't fail at parse time.
++ . If path is absolute, we fail at parse time if directory doesn't exist.
++ . In reof() we run the the path through xxstring (again, in case deferred
++ evaluation of variables is desired) and then, if not null, use it.
++ . If the directory doesn't exist, rename() fails and reof() returns -4,
++ resulting in a protocol error (this is not a change). We do NOT create
++ the directory on the fly.
++
++I also fixed SET SEND/RECEIVE RENAME-TO to parse with cmtxt() rather than
++cmdir(), since it's parsing a text template, not a directory name, e.g.
++"set receive rename-to file-\v(time)-v(date)-\v(pid)". This was totally
++broken, since when I don't know. We don't call xxstring() in this parse, so
++evaluation is always deferred -- I'd better not change this. ckuus7.c,
++ckcfns.c, 1 May 2003.
++
++From Jeff, Sat May 3 14:15:23 2003:
++ . Pick up the right isascii definition for K95: ckctel.c
++ . malloc... ckuath.c (new safe malloc routines for K95)
++ . Add author listing: ckuus5.c
++ . SSH Heartbeat support (K95 only): ckuus[23].c
++ . Prescan --height and --width to avoid window resizing at startup: ckuusy.c
++ . Add checks for fatal() or doexit() called from sysinit(): ckuusx.c
++ . Move some K95-specific definitions to ckoker.h: ckcdeb.h
++ . Add support for ON_CD macro in zchdir(): ckufio.c
++ . Add a command to let FTP client authenticate with SSLv2: ckcftp.c
++ . Fix parsing of FTP file facts like "UNIX.mode": ckcftp.c
++
++ON_CD will need some explaining (to be done). It's implemented for Unix,
++VMS, WIndows, and OS/2.
++
++The FTP file facts fix came from first exposure to the new OpenBSD FTP
++server: ftp://ftp7.usa.openbsd.org/pub/os/OpenBSD/3.3/i386/
++The period in "UNIX.mode" caused an erroneous word break, adding junk to
++the filename.
++
++About the malloc changes, Jeff says "K95 is not behaving well in low memory
++environments. I'm not sure that C-Kermit does much better. The program does
++not crash but it certainly does not behave the way the user expects it to.
++I'm beginning to think that any malloc() error should be treated as fatal."
++
++Not visible in these changes because it's in K95-specific modules: Jeff made
++SET ATTRIBUTES OFF and SET ATTRIBUTES DATE OFF apply to XYZMODEM transfers.
++
++From Jeff, 11 May 2003:
++ . Add support for SSH Keepalive to relevant SET command (K95): ckuus3.c
++ . Reduce max overlapped i/o requests from 30 to 7 (K95): ckuus7.c
++ . Don't call sysinit() in fatal(): ckuusx.c.
++ . Some new conditionalizations for SSL module: ck_ssl.c
++
++The doublequote-parsing fixes from March and April broke the SWITCH statement,
++which is implemented by internally defining, then executing, a macro. If I
++drop back to the old dumb handling of doublequotes, everything is fixed except
++the problem of March 17th. But can we really expect getncm() to pre-guess
++what the parser is going to do? getncm()'s only job is to find command
++boundaries, which are represented by commas. Commas, however, is needed IN
++commands too. We take a comma literally if it is quoted with \, or is inside
++a matched pair of braces, parens, or doublequotes. It is not unreasonable to
++require a doublequote in a macro definition to be prefixed by \ when it is to
++be taken literally. The proper response to Jason Heskett's complaint of March
++17th should have been to leave the code alone and recommand an appropriate
++form of quoting:
++
++ def TEST {
++ .foo = {X\"}
++ sho mac foo
++ }
++
++And this is what I have done. Another reason for sticking with the old method
++is that it's explainable. The "improved" method, even if it worked, would be
++be impossible to explain. Btw, in testing this I noticed that the switch-test
++script made 8.0.201 dump core. Today's version is fine. The problem with
++quoted strings inside of IF {...} clauses and FOR and WHILE loops is fixed
++too. Perhaps "unbroken" would be a better word. ckuus5.c, 11 May 2003.
++
++Vace discovered that FTP MGET /EXCEPT:{... (with an unterminated /EXCEPT list)
++could crash Kermit. Fixed in ckcftp.c, 11 May 2003.
++
++CONTINUE should not affect SUCCESS/FAILURE status. ckuusr.c, 11 May 2003.
++
++Fixed an oversight that goes back 15 years. While \{123} is allowed for
++decimal codes, \x{12} and \o{123} were never handled. ckucmd.c, 11 May 2003.
++
++Added support for Red Hat <baudboy.h> and /usr/sbin/lockdev. Supposedly this
++allows Kermit to be installed without setuid or setgid bits and still be able
++to lock and use the serial device. Compiles and starts, but not tested.
++ckcdeb.h, makefile, ckutio.c, ckuus5.c, 16 May 2003.
++
++From Jeff: FTP ASCII send data to host when FTP /SSL was in use was broken.
++ftp_dpl is set to Clear when FTP /SSL is in use. This was causing the data to
++be written to the socket with send() instead of the OpenSSL routines.
++ckcftp.c, ckuath.c, 21 May 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Stuff for Kerberos 524: ckcdeb.h. Fixes for FTP; "FTP ASCII send
++data did not properly compute the end of line translations. On Unix (and
++similar platforms) the end of line was correct for no character sets but
++incorrect when character sets were specified. On Windows/OS2, the end of line
++was correct when character sets were specified and incorrect when they were
++not. On MAC, both were broken. Also, FTP Send Byte counts were incorrect
++when character sets were specified." ckcftp.c. 17 Jun 2003.
++
++From Jeff: fixes to HTTP /AGENT: and /USER: switch action: ckcnet.c ckuus3.c
++ck_crp.c ckcftp.c ckuus2.c ckuusy.c ckuusr.c ckcnet.h, 21 Jun 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Fix SET DIALER BACKSPACE so it can override a previous SET KEY
++(e.g. from INI file): ckuus7.c. Some SSL/TLS updates: ck_ssl.c. HTTP support
++for VMS and other VMS improvements (e.g. a way to not have to hardwire the
++C-Kerit version number into the build script) from Martin Vorlaender:
++ckcnet.h, ckuus[r3].c, ckcdeb.h, ckvtio.c, ckcnet.c, ckvker.com. Built on
++Solaris (gcc/ansi) and SunOS (cc/k&r). The new VMS script tests the VMS
++version and includes HTTP support only for VMS 6.2 or later. 2 Jul 2003.
++
++Tried to build on our last VMS system but it seems to be dead. Looks like a
++head crash (makes really loud noises, boot says DKA0 not recognized) (fooey, I
++just paid good money to renew the VMS license). Tried building at another
++site with:
++
++ Process Software MultiNet V4.3 Rev A-X,
++ Compaq AlphaServer ES40, OpenVMS AXP V7.3
++ Compaq C V6.4-008 on OpenVMS Alpha V7.3
++
++Had to make a few corrections to ckvker.com. But still, compilation of
++ckcnet.c bombs, indicating that the SELECT definition somehow got lost
++somewhere since the 209 release (i.e. no SELECT type is defined so it falls
++thru to "SELECT is required for this code"). But I don't see anything in
++ckcdeb.h or ckcnet.[ch] that would explain this. Not ckvker.com either
++(putting the old one back gives the same result). OK, I give up, maybe it's
++just that I haven't tried building it on MultiNet recently. What about UCX?
++Aha, builds fine there except for warnings about mlook, dodo, and parser in
++ckvfio.c (because of ON_CD) -- I suppose I have #include <ckucmd.h>... (done)
++Anyhow it builds OK and the HTTP code is active and almost works (HTTP OPEN
++works; HTTP GET seems to succeed but creates an empty file every time). Tried
++building under MultiNet at another installation; same bad result.
++
++OK so why won't it build for MultiNet? Comparing ckcnet.c with the 209
++version, not a single #ifdef or #include is changed. Tried building with
++p3="NOHTTP" -- builds OK, aha. Where's the problem? Not ckcnet.h...
++Not ckcdeb.h... OK I give up, will revisit this next time I get time to
++do anything with the code.
++
++Later Jeff said "Martin did not implement VMS networking for the HTTP code.
++All he did was activate the #define HTTP which happens to work because his
++connections are using SSL/TLS connections. http_inc(), http_tol(), etc have
++no support for VMS networking regardless of whether it is UCX or MULTINET.
++The vast majority of HTTP connections are not secured by SSL/TLS. It makes no
++sense to support HTTP on VMS until someone is willing to either do the work or
++pay have the work done to implement VMS networking in that code base." So the
++fix is to not enable HTTP for VMS after all. Removed the CKHTTP definition
++for VMS from ckcdeb.h, 6 Jul 2003.
++
++Fixed ckvfio.c to #include <ckuusr.h> (instead of <ckucmd.h>) to pick up
++missing prototypes. 6 Jul 2003.
++
++From Arthur Marsh: solaris2xg+openssl+zlib+srp+pam+shadow and the corresponding
++Solaris 7 target. makefile, 6 Jul 2003.
++
++Remove duplicate #includes for <sys/stat.h>, <errno.h>, and <ctype.h> from
++ckcftp.c. 6 Jul 2003.
++
++Add -DUSE_MEMCPY to Motorola SV/68 targets because of shuffled #includes in
++ckcftp.c. 8 Jul 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Fix problems mixing SSL and SRP without Kerberos. Plus a few minor
++#define comment changes and a reshuffling of #defines in ckcdeb.h to allow me
++to build on X86 Windows without Kerberos. ckcdeb.h, ck_crp.c, ckuath.c,
++10 Jul 2003.
++
++From Jeff: updated ckuat2.h and ckuath.c, 29 Jul 2003.
++
++Mats Peterson noticed that a very small Latin-1 file would be incorrectly
++identified as UCS-2 by scanfile(). Fixed in ckuusx.c, 29 Jul 2003.
++
++Fixed ACCESS macro definition to account for the fact that FIND is now a
++built-in command. ckermit.ini, 30 Jul 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Fix for typo in urlparse() (svc/hos): ckuusy.c, 18 Aug 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Redhat9 makefile targets (needed for for OpenSSL 0.9.7):
++makefile, 19 Aug 2003.
++
++GREP /NOLIST and /COUNT did too much magic, with some undesirable fallout:
++"GREP /NOLIST /COUNT:x args" printed "file:count" for each file. "GREP
++/COUNT:x /NOLIST args" did not print "file:count", but neither did it set the
++count variable. Removed the magic. Also one of the GREP switches,
++/LINENUMBERS, was out of order. Fixed in ckuus6.c, 20 Aug 2003.
++
++From Jeff: "Reorganizing code to enable building with different subsets of
++options; a few typos corrected as well." ckcdeb.h, ckuver.h (for RH9),
++ckcnet.c, ckuus7.c, ckuus3.c: 24 Aug 2003.
++
++Scanfile misidentified a big PDF file as text because the first 800K of it
++*was* text (most other PDF files were correctly tagged as binary). Fixed
++by adding a check for the PDF signature at the beginning of the file.
++scanfile(): ckuusx.c, 25 Aug 2003.
++
++Ditto for PostScript files, but conservatively. Signature at beginning of
++file must begin with "%!PS-Ado". If it's just "%!" (or something nonstandard
++like "%%Creator: Windows PSCRIPT") we do a regular scan. Also added "*.ps"
++to all binary filename patterns. ckuusx.c, 4 Sep 2003.
++
++Ditto (but within #ifndef NOPCLSCAN) for PCL (<ESC>E) and PJL (<ESC>%) files,
++but no binpatterns (note: ".PCL" is the extension for TOPS-20 EXEC scripts).
++ckuusx.c, 4 Sep 2003.
++
++Added comments about OpenSSL 0.9.7 to all linux+openssl targets.
++makefile, 4 Sep 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Added - #define ALLOW_KRB_3DES_ENCRYPT. When this symbol is defined
++at compilation Kermit will allow non-DES session keys to be used during Telnet
++Auth. These session keys can then be used for Telnet Encrypt. The reason
++this is not compiled on by default is that the MIT Kerberos Telnet does not
++follow the RFC for constructing keys for ENCRYPT DES when the keys are longer
++than 8 bytes in length. ckuath.c, ckuus5.c, 4 Sep 2003.
++
++"ftp mget a b c" succeeded if one or more of the files did not exist, even
++with "set ftp error-action proceed". This is because the server's NLST file
++list does not include any files that don't exist, so the client never even
++tries to get them. Fortunately, the way the code is structured, this one was
++easy to fix. ckcftp.c, 14 Sep 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Corrected code in ckcnet.c to ensure that Reverse DNS Lookups are
++not performed if tcp_rdns is OFF. Fixed ck_krb5_getrealm() to actually return
++the realm of the credentials cache and not the default realm specified in the
++krb5.conf file. Previously krb5_cc_get_principal() was not being called.
++Fixed ck_krb5_is_tgt_valid() to test the TGT in the current ccache and not the
++TGT constructed from the default realm. ckcnet.c, ckuath.c, 14 Sep 2003.
++
++Marco Bernardi noticed that IF DIRECTORY could produce a false positive if
++the argument directory had previously been referenced but then removed. This
++is because of the clever isdir() cache that was added to speed up recursion
++through big directory trees. Changed IF DIRECTORY to make a second check
++(definitive but more expensive) if isdir() succeeds, and changed the
++directory-deleting routine, ckmkdir(), to flush the directory cache (UNIX
++only -- this also should be done in K95 but it's not critical). This was
++done by adding a routine, clrdircache() to ckufio.c, which sets prevstat
++to -1 and prevpath[0] to NUL. ckcfn3.c, ckuus6.c, ckufio.c, 18 Sep 2003.
++
++Marco reported the second fix still didn't work for him (even though it did
++for me). Rather than try to figure out why, I concluded that the directory
++cache is just not safe: a directory found a second ago might have been deleted
++or renamed not only by Kermit but by some other process. Why did I add this
++in the first place? The log says:
++
++ Some debug logs showed that isdir() is often called twice in a row on the
++ same file. Rather than try to sort out clients, I added a 1-element cache
++ to Unix isdir(). ckufio.c, 24 Apr 2000.
++
++Experimentation with DIR and DIR /RECURSIVE does not show this happening at
++all. So I #ifdef'd out the directory cache (see #ifdef ISDIRCACHE in ckufio.c;
++ISDIRCACHE is not defined) and backed off the previous changes: ckufio.c,
++ckcfn3.c, ckuus6.c, 28 Sep 2003.
++
++From Jeff: Replace the compile time ALLOW_KRB_3DES_ENCRYPT with a run-time
++command SET TELNET BUG AUTH-KRB5-DES which defaults to ON: ckctel.[ch],
++ckuus[234].c, ck_crp.c, ckuath.c. 4 Oct 2003.
++
++Allow DIAL RETRIES to be any positive number, and catch negative ones.
++Also added code to check for atoi() errors (e.g. truncation). At least on
++some platforms (e.g. Solaris) atoi() is supposed to set errno, but it
++doesn't. ckuus3.c, ckucmd.c, 4 Oct 2003.
++
++Added /DEFAULT: to ASK-class commands (ASK, ASKQ, GETOK):
++
++ . For popups: no way to send defaults to popup_readtext() or popup_readpass().
++ . For GUI ASK[Q], pass default to gui_txt_dialog().
++ . For GUI GETOK, convert "yes" "ok" or "no" default to number for uq_ok().
++ . For Text GETOK, add default to cmkey().
++ . For Text ASK[Q], add default to cmtxt().
++ . For GETC, GETKEY, and READ: no changes.
++
++GETOK, ASK, and ASKQ with /TIMEOUT: no longer fail when the timer goes off
++if a /DEFAULT was supplied. The GUI functions (uq_blah) don't seem to
++support timeouts. Only the text version has been tested. ckuus[26].c,
++4 Oct 2003.
++
++From Jeff: add /DEFAULT: for popups. ckuus6.c. 6 Oct 2003.
++
++Change SET DIAL INTERVAL to be like SET DIAL RETRIES. ckuus[34].c, 6 Oct 2003.
++
++Added target for HP-UX 10/11 + OpenSSL built with gcc, from Chris Cheney.
++Makefile, 12 Oct 2003.
++
++From Jeff, 6 Nov 2003:
++ . #ifdef adjustments: ckcftp.c, ckcdeb.h
++ . Fix spurious consumption of first byte(s) on Telnet connection: ckctel.c
++ . Another HP PJL test for scanfile: ckuusx.c.
++ . K95: Recognize DG4xx protected fields in DG2xx emulation: ckuus7.c.
++ . Add SSLeay version display to SHOW AUTH command: ckuus7.c
++ . Improved SET MOUSE CLEAR help text: ckuus2.c.
++ . Improved Kverbs help text: ckuus2.c (+ new IBM-3151 Kverbs).
++ . Some changes to ck_ssl.c, ckuath.c.
++
++From PeterE, 10 Nov 2003:
++ . Improved HP-UX 10/11 makefile targets for OpenSSL.
++ . #ifdef fix for OpenSSL on HP-UX: ck_ssl.c.
++
++Another new makefile from PeterE with improved and integrated HP-UX targets.
++12 Nov 2003.
++
++A couple fixes to the solaris9g+krb5+krb4+openssl+shadow+pam+zlib target
++from Jeff. Added a solaris9g+openssl+shadow+pam+zlib target. makefile,
++21 Nov 2003.
++
++From Jeff, 30 Nov 2003:
++ . Fix SEND /MOVE-TO: ckuusr.c.
++ . Fix K95 SET TITLE to allow quotes/braces around text: ckuus7.c.
++ . Improved "set term autodownload ?" response: ckuus5.c.
++ . Fix SHOW FEATURES to specify the protocol for encryption: ckuus5.c
++ . Make {SEND, RECEIVE} {MOVE-TO, RENAME-TO} work for XYZMODEM (K95 only).
++
++From Jeff: 7 Jan 2004:
++ . At one point Frank started to add a timer parameter to the
++ uq_txt() function but he only did it for the non-ANSI
++ compilers. I added it for the ANSI compilers, fixed the
++ prototypes and provided a default value easily changed
++ DEFAULT_UQ_TIMEOUT: ckcker.h, ckuus[36].c, ck_ssl.c, ckcftp.c, ckuath.c.
++ . Fixed SET TERMINAL DEBUG ON (typo in variable name): ckuus7.c.
++ . Fixed BEEP INFORMATION; previously it made no sound, now uses
++ MB_ICONQUESTION. ckuusx.c.
++
++From Ian Beckwith <ian@nessie.mcc.ac.uk> (Debianization), 7 Jan 2004:
++ . Search dir/ckermit for docs, as well as dir/kermit in cmdini(): ckuus5.c.
++ . New linux+krb5+krb4+openssl+shadow+pam target (kitchen sink minus SRP,
++ which Debian does not distribute): makefile.
++ ? Mangles the DESTDIR support in makefile to install into a staging area:
++ makefile (I didn't take this one yet).
++
++Updated copyright notices for 2004, all modules. 7 Jan 2004.
++
++Added INPUT /NOMATCH, allowing INPUT to be used for a fixed amount of time
++without attempting to match any text or patterns, so it's no longer
++necessary to "input 600 STRING_THAT_WILL_NEVER_COME". If /NOMATCH is
++included, INPUT succeeds if the timeout expires, with \v(instatus) = 1
++(meaning "timed out"); fails upon interruption or i/o error. ckuusr.h,
++ckuus[r24].c, 7 Jan 2004.
++
++Added SET INPUT SCALE-FACTOR <float>. This scales all INPUT timeouts by the
++given factor, allowing time-sensitive scripts to be adjusted to changing
++conditions such as congested networks or different-speed modems without
++having to change each INPUT-class command. This affects only those timeouts
++that are given in seconds, not as wall-clock times. Although the scale
++factor can have a fractional part, the INPUT timeout is still an integer.
++Added this to SHOW INPUT, and added a \v(inscale) variable for it.
++ckuusr.h, ckuus[r257].c, 7 Jan 2004.
++
++undef \%a, \fverify(abc,\%a) returns 0, which makes it look as if \%a is a
++string composed of a's, b's, and/or c's, when in fact it contains nothing.
++Changed \fverify() to return -1 in this case. ckuus4.c, 12 Jan 2004.
++
++\fcode(xxx) returned an empty string if its argument string was empty. This
++makes it unsafe to use in arithmetic or boolean expressions. Changed it to
++return 0 if its argument was missing, null, or empty. ckuus4.c, 12 Jan 2004.
++
++Updated \verify() and \fcode() help text. ckuus2.c, 12 Jan 2004.
++
++While setting up IKSD, Ian Beckwith noticed that including the --initfile:
++option caused Kermit to start parsing its own Copyright string as if it were
++the command line, and eventually crash. I couldn't reproduce on Solaris /
++Sparc but I could in Linux / i386 (what Ian is using) -- a change from Jeff
++on 28 Apr 2003 set the command-line arg pointer to a literal empty string in
++prescan() about line 1740 of of ckuus4.c; the pointer is incremented next
++time thru the loop, resulting in random memory being referenced. Fixed by
++setting the pointer to NULL instead of "". ckuus4.c, 12 Jan 2004.
++
++declare \&a[999999999999999] would dump core on some platforms. atoi()
++or whatever would truncate the dimension to maxint. When we add 1 to the
++result, we get a negative number, which is used as an index, loop test, etc.
++Fixed both dodcl() and dclarray() to check for (n+1 < 0). ckuus[r5].c,
++12 Jan 2004.
++
++Unix zchki() would fail on /dev/tty, which is unreasonable. This prevented
++FOPEN /READ from reading from the terminal. zchki() already allowed for
++/dev/null, so I added /dev/tty to the list of specials. Ditto for FOPEN
++/WRITE and zchko(). ckufio.c 13 Jan 2004.
++
++Added untabify() routine to ckclib.[ch], 13 Jan 2004.
++Added FREAD /TRIM and /UNTABIFY. ckuus[27].c, 13 Jan 2004.
++Added \funtabify(). ckuusr.h, ckuus[24].c, 13 Jan 2004.
++
++Dat Nguyen noticed that (setq u 'p') followed by (u) dumped core. This was
++caused by an over-clever optimization that skipped mallocs for short
++literals, but then went on later to try to free one that hadn't been
++malloc'd. Fixed in dosexp(): ckuus3.c, 14 Jan 2004.
++
++Catch another copyright date. ckuus5.c, 14 Jan 2004.
++
++Fixed SWITCH to work even when SET COMMAND DOUBLEQUOTE OFF (from Mark
++Sapiro). ckuus5.c, 15 Jan 2004.
++
++Changed version to 8.0.211 so scripts can test for recently added features.
++ckcmai.c, 15 Jan 2004.
++
++Fixed a glitch in K95 "help set port". ckuus2.c, 20 Jan 2004.
++
++Fix from Jeff: Connections to a TLS-aware protocol which require a reconnect
++upon certificate verification failure could not reconnect if the connection
++was initiated from the command line or via a URL. ckctel.c ckcmai.c
++ckuusr.c ckuus7.c ckuusy.c, 20 Jan 2004.
++
++From Alex Lewin: makefile target and #ifdef for Mac OS X 10.3 (Panther):
++makefile, ckcnet.c, 7 Feb 2004.
++
++Added KFLAGS to sco32v507 targets to make PTY and SSH commands work. The
++same flags could probably also be added to earlier OSR5 targets but they
++have not been tested there. makefile, 7 Feb 2004.
++
++Checked a complaint that "LOCAL &a" did not make array \&a[] local. Indeed
++it did not, and can not. You have to use the full syntax in the LOCAL
++command, "LOCAL \&a[]", or else it doesn't know it's not a macro named &a.
++7 Feb 2004.
++
++Fixed some confusion in creating IKSD database file and temp-file names.
++I was calling zfnqfp() without remembering that the path member of the
++returned struct included the filename, so to get just the directory name,
++I needed to strip the filename from the right. ckuusy.c, 2 Mar 2004.
++
++New ckuath.c, ck_ssl.c from Jeff. 2 Mar 2004.
++
++Updated Jeff's affiliation in VERSION command text. ckuusr.c, 2 Mar 2004.
++
++Designation changed from Dev.00 to Beta.01. ckcmai.c, 2 Mar 2004.
++
++Fixed zrename() syslogging -- it had success and failure reversed.
++Beta.02: ckufio.c, 4 Mar 2004.
++
++Problem: when accessing IKSD via a kermit:// or iksd:// URL, and a user ID
++is given but no password, doxarg() set the password to "" instead of leaving
++it NULL, but all the tests in dourl() are for NULL. Fixed in doxarg():
++ckuusy.c, 5 Mar 2004.
++
++The logic in dourl() about which macro to construct (login and connect,
++login and get directory listing, or login and fetch a file) was a bit off,
++so all three cases were not handled. ckcmai.c, 5 Mar 2004.
++
++Trial Beta builds:
++ . HP-UX B.11.11 PA-RISC
++ . HP-UX B.11.23 IA64
++ . Tru64 4.0G Alpha
++ . Tru64 5.1B Alpha
++ . Debian 3.0 i386
++ . Red Hat ES 2.1 i386
++ . Slackware 9.1 i386
++ . VMS 7.3-1 Alpha + UCX 5.3
++ . VMS 7.3-1 Alpha no TCP/IP
++ . VMS 7.3 Alpha MultiNet 4.3 A-X
++ . SCO UnixWare 7.1.4 i386
++ . SCO OSR5.0.7 i386
++ . Solaris 9 Sparc
++
++Fixed compiler warning in doxarg() caused by typo (NULL instead of NUL) in
++the 5 March doxarg() edit. ckuusy.c, 9 Mar 2004.
++
++IKSD (kermit://) command-line URLs did not work right if the client had
++already preauthenticated with Kerberos or somesuch because they tried to log
++in again with REMOTE LOGIN. The macros constructed in doxarg() needed to
++check \v(authstate) before attempting REMOTE LOGIN. ckcmai.c, 10 Mar 2004.
++
++Added ckuker.nr to x.sh (ckdaily upload) and updated ckuker.nr with current
++version number and dates. 10 Mar 2004.
++
++Replaced hardwired references to /usr/local in makefile with $(prefix)
++(which defaults to /usr/local, but can be overridden on the command line),
++suggested by Nelson Beebe for use with Configure. 10 Mar 2004.
++
++From Nelson Beebe: In the Kermit makefile in the install target commands,
++line 981 reads:
++
++ cp $(BINARY) $(DESTDIR)$(BINDIR)/kermit || exit 1;\
++
++Could you please add this line before it:
++
++ rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(BINDIR)/kermit;\
++
++Some sites (mine included) keep multiple versions of software around,
++with hard links between $(prefix)/progname and $(prefix)/progname-x.y.z.
++Failure to remove the $(prefix)/progname at "make install" time then
++replaces the old $(prefix)/progname-x.y.z with the new one, destroying
++an old version that the site wanted to be preserved. makefile, 10 Mar 2004.
++
++Minor syntax and typo fixes (mostly prototypes): ckcdeb.h, ckcfns.c,
++ckclib.c, ckufio.c, ckuusr.h, ckuusx.c, 10 Mar 2004. (I still have a few
++more to do.)
++
++Added CC=$(CC) CC2=$(CC2) to many (but not all) makefile targets that
++reference other makefile targets. On some platforms (notably AIX, Solaris,
++SunOS) there are specific targets for different compilers, so I skipped
++those. makefile, 10 Mar 2004.
++
++Added error checking to kermit:// URL macros, so they don't plow ahead
++after the connection is closed. ckcmai.c, 11 Mar 2004.
++
++Added FreeBSD 4.9 and 5.1 targets (only the herald is affected).
++makefile, ckuver.h, 11 Mar 2004.
++
++Added "LIBS=-lcrypt" to bsd44 targets since nowadays crypt is almost always
++unbundled from libc. Also added explanatory notes. makefile, 11 Mar 2004.
++
++Changed MANDIR to default to $(manroot)/man/man1, and manroot to default
++to $(prefix). More adding of CC=$(CC) clauses: {Free,Net,Open}BSD, 4.4BSD.
++makefile, 11 Mar 2004.
++
++Miscellaneous cleanups: ckuusx.c, ckcnet.c, ckufio.c, 11 Mar 2004.
++
++Corrected the check in the linux target to see if /usr/include/crypt.h
++exists, and if so to define HAVE_CRYPT_H, which is used in ckcdeb.h to
++#include <crypt.h> to get the prototype for crypt() and prevent bogus
++conversions on its return type on 64-bit platforms (the previous test wasn't
++quite right and the resulting symbol wasn't spelled right). makefile,
++12 Mar 2004.
++
++From Jeff, 14 Mar 2004:
++ . Initialize localuidbuf[] in tn_snenv(): ckctel.c.
++ . Remove remote-mode checks in hupok() for K95G only (why?): ckuus3.c.
++ . Add help text for new K95-only TYPE /GUI switches: ckuus2.c.
++ . TYPE /GUI parsing, ...: ckuusr.c.
++ . TYPE /GUI action, dotype(): ckuus6.c
++ . Change Jeff's affiliation: most modules.
++
++20 Mar 2004: Looked into adding long file support, i.e. handling files more
++than 2GB (or 4GB) long. Discovered very quickly this would be a major
++project. Each platform has a different API, or environment, or transition
++plan, or whatever -- a nightmare to handle in portable code. At the very
++least we'll need to convert a lot of Kermit variables from long or unsigned
++long to some new Kermit type, which in turn is #defined or typedef'd
++appropriately for each platform (to off_t or size_t or whatever). Then we
++have to worry about the details of open() vs fopen(); printf() formats (%lld
++vs %Ld vs %"PRId64"...), platforms like HP-UX where you might have to use
++different APIs for different file systems on the same computer, etc. We'll
++need to confront this soon, but let's get a good stable 8.0.211 release out
++first! Meanwhile, for future reference, here are a few articles:
++
++General: http://freshmeat.net/articles/view/709/
++Linux: http://www.ece.utexas.edu/~luo/linux_lfs.html
++HP-UX: http://devrsrc1.external.hp.com/STK/partner/lg_files.pdf
++Solaris: http://wwws.sun.com/software/whitepapers/wp-largefiles/largefiles.pdf
++
++Looked into FTP timeouts. It appears I can just call empty() (which is
++nothing more than a front end for select()) with the desired timeout before
++any kind of network read. If it returns <= 0, we have a timeout. This is
++not quite the same as using alarm() / signal() around a recv() (which could
++get stuck) but alarm() / signal() are not not used in the FTP module and are
++not naturally portable to Windows, but select() is already in use in the FTP
++module for both Unix and Windows. This form of timeout could be used
++portably for both command response and data reads. What about writes to the
++command or data socket? They can get stuck for hours and hours without
++returning too, but the select() approach won't help here -- we need the
++actual send() or recv() to time out, or be wrapped in an alarm()/signal()
++kind of mechanism. But if we can do that for sends, we can also do it for
++receives. Better check with Jeff before I start programming anything.
++20 Mar 2004.
++
++Later: Decided to postpone the above two projects (ditto IPv6) until after
++8.0.211 is released because both will have major impacts on portability.
++Grumble: all i/o APIs should have been designed from the beginning with a
++timeout parameter. To this day, hardly any have this feature.
++
++3-4 Apr 2004: More 8.0.211 Beta.02+ test builds:
++
++ . FreeBSD 3.3
++ . FreeBSD 4.4
++ . Linux Debian 2.1
++ . Linux RH 6.1
++ . Linux RH 7.1
++ . Linux RH 7.2
++ . Linux RH 9 (with 84 different combinations of feature selection)
++ . Linux SuSE 6.4
++ . Linux SuSE 7.0
++ . NetBSD 1.4.1
++ . NetBSD 1.5.2
++ . OpenBSD 2.5
++ . OpenBSD 3.0
++ . QNX 4.25
++ . SCO UnixWare 2.1.3
++ . SCO UnixWare 7.1.4
++ . SCO OpenServer 5.0.7
++ . SCO XENIX 2.3.4 (no TCP)
++
++Changes needed: None.
++
++Problem: SCO XENIX 2.3.4 network build failed in the FTP module with
++header-file syntax and conflicting-definitions trouble. I'm not going to
++try to fix it; 8.0.209 built OK with FTP, so we'll just keep that one
++available.
++
++Got access to VMS 8.1 on IA64. Building the nonet version of C-Kermit
++required minor modifications to ckvvms.h, ckv[ft]io.c, and ckvcon.c, to
++account for a third architecture. Also to SHOW FEATURES in ckuus5.c. Once
++that was done, the UCX 5.5 version built OK too. Starts OK, makes Telnet
++connection OK, sends files. Has some obvious glitches though -- "stat"
++after a file transfer reports 0 elapsed time (in fact it was 00:09:48) and
++1219174400 cps (when in fact it was 10364). This doesn't happen on the
++Alpha. Btw, the IA64 binary is twice as big as the Alpha one. Changed
++to Beta.03. 5 Apr 2004.
++
++Fixed the ckdaily script to include the makefile and man page in the Zip
++file (they were not included because the Zip file was intended mainly for
++VMS users, but some Unix users prefer Zip to tar.gz). 6 Apr 2004.
++
++Traced problems in VMS/IA64 statistics report to rftimer()/gftimer() in
++ckvtio.c, which use sys$ and lib$ calls to figure elapsed time. These work
++on VAX and Alpha but not IA64. Sent a report to the chief engineer of the
++IA64 VMS port; he says it's probably a bug in VMS 8.1 (which is not a real
++release); he'll make sure it's fixed in 8.2. As an experiment, tried
++swapping in the Unix versions of these routines (which call gettimeofday()
++etc). They seem work just fine (it hung a couple times but I think that's
++because the underlying system hung too; trying it later on a new connection,
++it was fine; however I noticed a BIG discrepancy in throughput between
++sending and receiving). Moved definitions for VMS64BIT and VMSI64 to
++ckcdeb.h so all modules can use them and added them to the SHOW FEATURES
++display. Added VMSV80 definition to build procedure. Beta.03+. ckcdeb.h,
++ckcuus5.c, ckcvvms.h, ckvtio.c, ckvker.com, 6 Apr 2004.
++
++While doing the build-all, I noticed the VMS version did not build with
++Multinet or older UCX versions, always with the same errors -- undeclared
++variables, undefined symbols, all TCP/IP related. This didn't happen a
++couple weeks ago... Somehow the order of #includes was messed up --
++ckuusr.h depended on symbols that are defined in ckcnet.h, but ckcnet.h
++was being included after ckuusr.h... this was compounded by two missing
++commas in ckvker.com. 11 Apr 2004.
++
++Removed Beta designation, released as 8.0.211, 10 Apr 2004.
++
++---8.0.211---
++
++I had somehow lost the edit to ckutio.c that changed the UUCP lockfile for
++Mac OS X from /var/spool/uucp to /var/spool/lock. So I slipped it in and
++re-uploaded version 8.0.211. You can tell the difference because SHOW
++VERSIONS has a 17 Apr 2004 for the Communications I/O module. Also the 10.3
++executable now has a designer banner: "Mac OS X 10.3". makefile, ckuver.h,
++ckutio.c, ckuus[45].c, 17 Apr 2004.
++
++***********************
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckermit70.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,17956 @@
++
++ [ [1]Contents ] [ [2]C-Kermit ] [ [3]Kermit Home ]
++
++ Supplement to Using C-Kermit, Second Edition
++
++For C-Kermit 7.0
++
++As of C-Kermit version: 7.0.196
++This file last updated: 8 February 2000
++
++Authors: Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone
++Address: The Kermit Project
++ Columbia University
++ 612 West 115th Street
++ New York NY 10025-7799
++ USA
++Fax: +1 (212) 662-6442
++E-Mail: [4]kermit-support@columbia.edu
++Web: [5]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++Or: [6]http://www.kermit-project.org/
++Or: [7]http://www.columbia.nyc.ny.us/kermit/
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ NOTICES
++
++ This document:
++ Copyright © 1997, 2000, Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone.
++ All rights reserved.
++
++ Kermit 95:
++ Copyright © 1995, 2000, Trustees of Columbia University in the
++ City of New York. All rights reserved.
++
++ C-Kermit:
++ Copyright © 1985, 2000,
++ Trustees of Columbia University in the City of New York. All
++ rights reserved. See the C-Kermit [8]COPYING.TXT file or the
++ copyright text in the [9]ckcmai.c module for disclaimer and
++ permissions.
++
++ When Kerberos(TM) and/or SRP(TM) (Secure Remote Password) and/or SSL
++ protocol are included:
++ Portions Copyright © 1990, Massachusetts Institute of
++ Technology.
++ Portions Copyright © 1991, 1993 Regents of the University of
++ California.
++ Portions Copyright © 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 by AT&T.
++ Portions Copyright © 1997, Stanford University.
++ Portions Copyright © 1995-1997, Eric Young
++ <eay@cryptosoft.com>.
++
++ For the full text of the third-party copyright notices, see
++ [10]Appendix V.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ WHAT IS IN THIS FILE
++
++ This file lists changes made to C-Kermit since the second edition of
++ the book [11]Using C-Kermit was published and C-Kermit 6.0 was
++ released in November 1996. Use this file as a supplement to the second
++ edition of Using C-Kermit until the third edition is published some
++ time in 2000. If the "most recent update" shown above is long ago,
++ contact Columbia University to see if there is a newer release.
++
++ For further information, also see the [12]CKCBWR.TXT ("C-Kermit
++ beware") file for hints, tips, tricks, restrictions, frequently asked
++ questions, etc, plus the system-specific "beware file", e.g.
++ [13]CKUBWR.TXT for UNIX, [14]CKVBWR.TXT for VMS, etc, and also any
++ system-specific update files such as KERMIT95.HTM for Kermit 95 (in
++ the DOCS\MANUAL\ subdirectory of your K95 directory).
++
++ This Web-based copy of the C-Kermit 7.0 update notes supersedes the
++ plain-text CKERMIT2.TXT file. All changes after 19 January 2000
++ appear only here in the Web version. If you need an up-to-date
++ plain-text copy, use your Web browser to save this page as plain
++ text.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ ABOUT FILENAMES
++
++ In this document, filenames are generally shown in uppercase, but on
++ file systems with case-sensitive names such as UNIX, OS-9, and AOS/VS,
++ lowercase names are used: [15]ckubwr.txt, [16]ckermit70.txt, etc.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ ADDITIONAL FILES
++
++ Several other files accompany this new Kermit release:
++
++ SECURITY.TXT
++ Discussion of Kermit's new authentication and encryption
++ features:
++
++ + [17]Plain-text version
++ + [18]HTML (hypertext) version
++
++ IKSD.TXT
++ How to install and manage an Internet Kermit Service Daemon.
++
++ + [19]Plain-text version
++ + [20]HTML (hypertext) version
++
++ Also see [21]cuiksd.htm for instructions for use.
++
++ TELNET.TXT
++ A thorough presentation of Kermit's new advanced Telnet
++ features and controls.
++
++ + [22]Plain-text version
++ + [23]HTML (hypertext) version
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ THE NEW C-KERMIT LICENSE
++
++ The C-Kermit license was rewritten for version 7.0 to grant automatic
++ permission to packagers of free operating-system distributions to
++ include C-Kermit 7.0. Examples include Linux (GNU/Linux), FreeBSD,
++ NetBSD, etc. The new license is in the [24]COPYING.TXT file, and is
++ also displayed by C-Kermit itself when you give the VERSION or
++ COPYRIGHT command. The new C-Kermit license does not apply to
++ [25]Kermit 95.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
++
++ Thanks to Jeff Altman, who joined the Kermit Project in 1995, for much
++ of what you see in C-Kermit 7.0, especially in the networking and
++ security areas, and his key role in designing and implementing the
++ Internet Kermit Service Daemon. And special thanks to Lucas Hart for
++ lots of help with the VMS version; to Peter Eichhorn for continuous
++ testing on the full range of HP-UX versions and for a consolidated set
++ of HP-UX makefile targets; and to Colin Allen, Mark Allen, Roger
++ Allen, Ric Anderson, William Bader, Mitch Baker, Mitchell Bass, Nelson
++ Beebe, Gerry Belanger, Jeff Bernsten, Mark Berryman, John Bigg, Volker
++ Borchert, Jonathan Boswell, Tim Boyer, Frederick Bruckman, Kenneth
++ Cochran, Jared Crapo, Bill Delaney, Igor Sobrado Delgado, Clarence
++ Dold, Joe Doupnik, John Dunlap, Max Evarts, Patrick French, Carl
++ Friedberg, Carl Friend, Hirofumi Fujii, Andrew Gabriel, Gabe Garza,
++ Boyd Gerber, David Gerber, George Gilmer, Hunter Goatley, DJ Hagberg,
++ Kevin Handy, Andy Harper, Randolph Herber, Sven Holström, Michal
++ Jaegermann, Graham Jenkins, Dick Jones, Terry Kennedy, Robert D Keys,
++ Nick Kisseberth, Igor Kovalenko, David Lane, Adam Laurie, Jeff
++ Liebermann, Eric Lonvick, Hoi Wan Louis, Arthur Marsh, Gregorie
++ Martin, Peter Mauzey, Dragan Milicic, Todd Miller, Christian Mondrup,
++ Daniel Morato, Dat Nguyen, Herb Peyerl, Jean-Pierre Radley, Steve
++ Rance, Stephen Riehm, Nigel Roles, Larry Rosenman, Jay S Rouman, David
++ Sanderson, John Santos, Michael Schmitz, Steven Schultz, Bob Shair,
++ Richard Shuford, Fred Smith, Michael Sokolov, Jim Spath, Peter Szell,
++ Ted T'so, Brian Tillman, Linus Torvalds, Patrick Volkerding, Martin
++ Vorländer, Steve Walton, Ken Weaverling, John Weekley, Martin
++ Whitaker, Jim Whitby, Matt Willman, Joellen Windsor, Farrell Woods,
++ and many others for binaries, hosting, reviews, suggestions, advice,
++ bug reports, and all the rest over the 3+ year C-Kermit 7.0
++ development cycle. Thanks to Russ Nelson and the board of the Open
++ Software Initiative ([26]http://www.opensource.org) for their
++ cooperation in developing the new C-Kermit license and to the
++ proprietors of those free UNIX distributions that have incorporated
++ C-Kermit 7.0 for their cooperation and support, especially FreeBSD's
++ Jörg Wunsch.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ NOTE TO KERMIT 95 USERS
++
++ Kermit 95 and C-Kermit share the same command and scripting language,
++ the same Kermit file-transfer protocol implementation, and much else
++ besides.
++
++ Like the book [27]Using C-Kermit, this file concentrates on the
++ aspects of C-Kermit that are common to all versions: UNIX, VMS,
++ Windows, OS/2, VOS, AOS/VS, etc. Please refer to your Kermit 95
++ documentation for information that is specific to Kermit 95.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 corresponds to Kermit 95 1.1.19.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ C-KERMIT VERSIONS AND VERSION NUMBERS
++
++ "C-Kermit" refers to all the many programs that are compiled in whole
++ or in part from common C-language source code, comprising:
++
++ * A Kermit file transfer protocol module
++ * A command parser and script execution module
++ * A modem-dialing module
++ * A network support module
++ * A character-set translation module.
++
++ and several others. These "system-independent" modules are combined
++ with system-dependent modules for each platform to provide the
++ required input/output functions, and also in some cases overlaid with
++ an alternative user interface, such as Macintosh Kermit's
++ point-and-click interface, and in some cases also a terminal emulator,
++ as Kermit 95.
++
++ The C-Kermit version number started as 1.0, ... 3.0, 4.0, 4.1 and then
++ (because of confusion at the time with Berkeley UNIX 4.2), 4B, 4C, and
++ so on, with the specific edit number in parentheses, for example
++ 4E(072) or 5A(188). This scheme was used through 5A(191), but now we
++ have gone back to the traditional numbering scheme with decimal
++ points: major.minor.edit; for example 7.0.196. Internal version
++ numbers (the \v(version) variable), however, are compatible in
++ C-Kermit 5A upwards.
++
++ Meanwhile, C-Kermit derivatives for some platforms (Windows,
++ Macintosh) might go through several releases while C-Kermit itself
++ remains the same. These versions have their own platform-specific
++ version numbers, such as Kermit 95 1.1.1, 1.1.2, and so on.
++
++ C-Kermit Version History:
++
++ 1.0 1981-1982 Command-line only, 4.2 BSD UNIX only
++ 2.0 (*) (who remembers...)
++ 3.0 May 1984 Command-line only, supports several platforms
++ 4.0-4.1 Feb-Apr 1985 (*) First interactive and modular version
++ 4C(050) May 1985
++ 4D(060) April 1986
++ 4E(066) August 1987 Long packets
++ 4E(068) January 1988
++ 4E(072) January 1989
++ 4F(095) August 1989 (*) Attribute packets
++ 5A(188) November 1992 Scripting, TCP/IP, sliding windows (1)
++ 5A(189) September 1993 Control-char unprefixing
++ 5A(190) October 1994 Recovery
++ 5A(191) April 1995 OS/2 only
++ 6.0.192 September 1996 Intelligent dialing, autodownload, lots more (2)
++ 6.1.193 1997-98 (*) Development only
++ 6.1.194 June 1998 K95 only - switches, directory recursion, more
++ 7.0.195 August 1999 IKSD + more (CU only as K95 1.1.18-CU)
++ 7.0.196 1 January 2000 Unicode, lots more
++
++ (*) Never formally released (4.0 was a total rewrite)
++ (1) Using C-Kermit, 1st Edition
++ (2) Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++CONTENTS
++
++ I. [28]C-KERMIT DOCUMENTATION
++
++ II. [29]NEW FEATURES
++
++ (0) [30]INCOMPATIBILITIES WITH PREVIOUS RELEASES
++ (1) [31]PROGRAM AND FILE MANAGEMENT AND COMMANDS
++ 1.0. [32]Bug fixes
++ 1.1. [33]Command Continuation
++ 1.2. [34]Editor Interface
++ 1.3. [35]Web Browser and FTP Interface
++ 1.4. [36]Command Editing
++ 1.5. [37]Command Switches
++ 1.5.1. [38]General Switch Syntax
++ 1.5.2. [39]Order and Effect of Switches
++ 1.5.3. [40]Distinguishing Switches from Other Fields
++ 1.5.4. [41]Standard File Selection Switches
++ 1.5.5. [42]Setting Preferences for Different Commands
++ 1.6. [43]Dates and Times
++ 1.7. [44]Partial Completion of Keywords
++ 1.8. [45]Command Recall
++ 1.9. [46]EXIT Messages
++ 1.10. [47]Managing Keyboard Interruptions
++ 1.11. [48]Taming the Wild Backslash -- Part Deux
++ 1.11.1. [49]Background
++ 1.11.2. [50]Kermit's Quoting Rules
++ 1.11.3. [51]Passing DOS Filenames from Kermit to Shell Commands
++ 1.11.4. [52]Using Variables to Hold DOS Filenames
++ 1.11.5. [53]Passing DOS Filenames as Parameters to Macros
++ 1.11.6. [54]Passing DOS File Names from Macro Parameters to the
++DOS Shell
++ 1.11.7. [55]Passing DOS Filenames to Kermit from the Shell
++ 1.12. [56]Debugging
++ 1.13. [57]Logs
++ 1.14. [58]Automatic File-Transfer Packet Recognition at the Command Pr
++ompt
++ 1.15. [59]The TYPE Command
++ 1.16. [60]The RESET Command
++ 1.17. [61]The COPY and RENAME Commands
++ 1.18. [62]The MANUAL Command
++ 1.19. [63]String and Filename Matching Patterns
++ 1.20. [64]Multiple Commands on One Line
++ 1.21. [65]What Do I Have?
++ 1.22. [66]Generalized File Input and Output
++ 1.22.1. [67]Why Another I/O System?
++ 1.22.2. [68]The FILE Command
++ 1.22.3. [69]FILE Command Examples
++ 1.22.4. [70]Channel Numbers
++ 1.22.5. [71]FILE Command Error Codes
++ 1.22.6. [72]File I/O Variables
++ 1.22.7. [73]File I/O Functions
++ 1.22.8. [74]File I/O Function Examples
++ 1.23. [75]The EXEC Command
++ 1.24. [76]Getting Keyword Lists with '?'
++ (2) [77]MAKING AND USING CONNECTIONS
++ 2.0. [78]SET LINE and SET HOST Command Switches
++ 2.1. [79]Dialing
++ 2.1.1. [80]The Dial Result Message
++ 2.1.2. [81]Long-Distance Dialing Changes
++ 2.1.3. [82]Forcing Long-Distance Dialing
++ 2.1.4. [83]Exchange-Specific Dialing Decisions
++ 2.1.5. [84]Cautions about Cheapest-First Dialing
++ 2.1.6. [85]Blind Dialing (Dialing with No Dialtone)
++ 2.1.7. [86]Trimming the Dialing Dialog
++ 2.1.8. [87]Controlling the Dialing Speed
++ 2.1.9. [88]Pretesting Phone Number Conversions
++ 2.1.10. [89]Greater Control over Partial Dialing
++ 2.1.11. [90]New DIAL-related Variables and Functions
++ 2.1.12. [91]Increased Flexibility of PBX Dialing
++ 2.1.13. [92]The DIAL macro - Last-Minute Phone Number Conversions
++ 2.1.14. [93]Automatic Tone/Pulse Dialing Selection
++ 2.1.15. [94]Dial-Modifier Variables
++ 2.1.16. [95]Giving Multiple Numbers to the DIAL Command
++ 2.2. [96]Modems
++ 2.2.1. [97]New Modem Types
++ 2.2.2. [98]New Modem Controls
++ 2.3. [99]TELNET and RLOGIN
++ 2.3.0. [100]Bug Fixes
++ 2.3.1. [101]Telnet Binary Mode Bug Adjustments
++ 2.3.2. [102]VMS UCX Telnet Port Bug Adjustment
++ 2.3.3. [103]Telnet New Environment Option
++ 2.3.4. [104]Telnet Location Option
++ 2.3.5. [105]Connecting to Raw TCP Sockets
++ 2.3.6. [106]Incoming TCP Connections
++ 2.4. [107]The EIGHTBIT Command
++ 2.5. [108]The Services Directory
++ 2.6. [109]Closing Connections
++ 2.7. [110]Using C-Kermit with External Communication Programs
++ 2.7.0. [111]C-Kermit over tn3270 and tn5250
++ 2.7.1. [112]C-Kermit over Telnet
++ 2.7.2. [113]C-Kermit over Rlogin
++ 2.7.3. [114]C-Kermit over Serial Communication Programs
++ 2.7.4. [115]C-Kermit over Secure Network Clients
++ 2.7.4.1. [116]SSH
++ 2.7.4.2. [117]SSL
++ 2.7.4.3. [118]SRP
++ 2.7.4.4. [119]SOCKS
++ 2.7.4.5. [120]Kerberos and SRP
++ 2.8. [121]Scripting Local Programs
++ 2.9. [122]X.25 Networking
++ 2.9.1. [123]IBM AIXLink/X.25 Network Provider Interface for AIX
++ 2.9.2. [124]HP-UX X.25
++ 2.10. [125]Additional Serial Port Controls
++ 2.11. [126]Getting Access to the Dialout Device
++ 2.12. [127]The Connection Log
++ 2.13. [128]Automatic Connection-Specific Flow Control Selection
++ 2.14. [129]Trapping Connection Establishment and Loss
++ 2.15. [130]Contacting Web Servers with the HTTP Command
++ (3) [131]TERMINAL CONNECTION
++ 3.1. [132]CONNECT Command Switches
++ 3.2. [133]Triggers
++ 3.3. [134]Transparent Printing
++ 3.4. [135]Binary and Text Session Logs
++ (4) [136]FILE TRANSFER AND MANAGEMENT
++ 4.0. [137]Bug Fixes, Minor Changes, and Clarifications
++ 4.1. [138]File-Transfer Filename Templates
++ 4.1.1. [139]Templates in the As-Name
++ 4.1.2. [140]Templates on the Command Line
++ 4.1.3. [141]Post-Transfer Renaming
++ 4.2. [142]File-Transfer Pipes and Filters
++ 4.2.1. [143]Introduction
++ 4.2.1.1. [144]Terminology
++ 4.2.1.2. [145]Notation
++ 4.2.1.3. [146]Security
++ 4.2.2. [147]Commands for Transferring from and to Pipes
++ 4.2.2.1. [148]Sending from a Command
++ 4.2.2.2. [149]Receiving to a Command
++ 4.2.3. [150]Using File-Transfer Filters
++ 4.2.3.1. [151]The SEND Filter
++ 4.2.3.2. [152]The RECEIVE Filter
++ 4.2.4. [153]Implicit Use of Pipes
++ 4.2.5. [154]Success and Failure of Piped Commands
++ 4.2.6. [155]Cautions about Using Pipes to Transfer Directory Trees
++ 4.2.7. [156]Pipes and Encryption
++ 4.2.8. [157]Commands and Functions Related to Pipes
++ 4.2.8.1. [158]The OPEN !READ and OPEN !WRITE Commands
++ 4.2.8.2. [159]The REDIRECT Command
++ 4.2.8.3. [160]Receiving Mail and Print Jobs
++ 4.2.8.4. [161]Pipe-Related Functions
++ 4.3. [162]Automatic Per-File Text/Binary Mode Switching
++ 4.3.1. [163]Exceptions
++ 4.3.2. [164]Overview
++ 4.3.3. [165]Commands
++ 4.3.4. [166]Examples
++ 4.4. [167]File Permissions
++ 4.4.1. [168]When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is OFF
++ 4.4.1.1. [169]Unix
++ 4.4.1.2. [170]VMS
++ 4.4.2. [171]When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is ON
++ 4.4.2.1. [172]System-Specific Permissions
++ 4.4.2.1.1. [173]UNIX
++ 4.4.2.1.2. [174]VMS
++ 4.4.2.2. [175]System-Independent Permissions
++ 4.5. [176]File Management Commands
++ 4.5.1. [177]The DIRECTORY Command
++ 4.5.2. [178]The CD and BACK Commands
++ 4.5.2.1. [179]Parsing Improvements
++ 4.5.2.2. [180]The CDPATH
++ 4.5.3. [181]Creating and Removing Directories
++ 4.5.4. [182]The DELETE and PURGE Commands
++ 4.6. [183]Starting the Remote Kermit Server Automatically
++ 4.7. [184]File-Transfer Command Switches
++ 4.7.1. [185]SEND Command Switches
++ 4.7.2. [186]GET Command Switches
++ 4.7.3. [187]RECEIVE Command Switches
++ 4.8. [188]Minor Kermit Protocol Improvements
++ 4.8.1. [189]Multiple Attribute Packets
++ 4.8.2. [190]Very Short Packets
++ 4.9. [191]Wildcard / File Group Expansion
++ 4.9.1. [192]In UNIX C-Kermit
++ 4.9.2. [193]In Kermit 95
++ 4.9.3. [194]In VMS, AOS/VS, OS-9, VOS, etc.
++ 4.10. [195]Additional Pathname Controls
++ 4.11. [196]Recursive SEND and GET: Transferring Directory Trees
++ 4.11.1. [197]Command-Line Options
++ 4.11.2. [198]The SEND /RECURSIVE Command
++ 4.11.3. [199]The GET /RECURSIVE Command
++ 4.11.4. [200]New and Changed File Functions
++ 4.11.5. [201]Moving Directory Trees Between Like Systems
++ 4.11.6. [202]Moving Directory Trees Between Unlike Systems
++ 4.12. [203]Where Did My File Go?
++ 4.13. [204]File Output Buffer Control
++ 4.14. [205]Improved Responsiveness
++ 4.15. [206]Doubling and Ignoring Characters for Transparency
++ 4.16. [207]New File-Transfer Display Formats
++ 4.17. [208]New Transaction Log Formats
++ 4.17.1. [209]The BRIEF Format
++ 4.17.2. [210]The FTP Format
++ 4.18. [211]Unprefixing NUL
++ 4.19. [212]Clear-Channel Protocol
++ 4.20. [213]Streaming Protocol
++ 4.20.1. [214]Commands for Streaming
++ 4.20.2. [215]Examples of Streaming
++ 4.20.2.1. [216]Streaming on Socket-to-Socket Connections
++ 4.20.2.2. [217]Streaming on Telnet Connections
++ 4.20.2.3. [218]Streaming with Limited Packet Length
++ 4.20.2.4. [219]Streaming on Dialup Connections
++ 4.20.2.5. [220]Streaming on X.25 Connections
++ 4.20.3. [221]Streaming - Preliminary Conclusions
++ 4.21. [222]The TRANSMIT Command
++ 4.22. [223]Coping with Faulty Kermit Implementations
++ 4.22.1. [224]Failure to Accept Modern Negotiation Strings
++ 4.22.2. [225]Failure to Negotiate 8th-bit Prefixing
++ 4.22.3. [226]Corrupt Files
++ 4.22.4. [227]Spurious Cancellations
++ 4.22.5. [228]Spurious Refusals
++ 4.22.6. [229]Failures during the Data Transfer Phase
++ 4.22.7. [230]Fractured Filenames
++ 4.22.8. [231]Bad File Dates
++ 4.23. [232]File Transfer Recovery
++ 4.24. [233]FILE COLLISION UPDATE Clarification
++ 4.25. [234]Autodownload Improvements
++ (5) [235]CLIENT/SERVER
++ 5.0. [236]Hints
++ 5.1. [237]New Command-Line Options
++ 5.2. [238]New Client Commands
++ 5.3. [239]New Server Capabilities
++ 5.3.1. [240]Creating and Removing Directories
++ 5.3.2. [241]Directory Listings
++ 5.4. [242]Syntax for Remote Filenames with Embedded Spaces
++ 5.5. [243]Automatic Orientation Messages upon Directory Change
++ 5.6. [244]New Server Controls
++ 5.7. [245]Timeouts during REMOTE HOST Command Execution
++ (6) [246]INTERNATIONAL CHARACTER SETS
++ 6.0. [247]ISO 8859-15 Latin Alphabet 9
++ 6.1. [248]The HP-Roman8 Character Set
++ 6.2. [249]Greek Character Sets
++ 6.3. [250]Additional Latin-2 Character Sets
++ 6.4. [251]Additional Cyrillic Character Sets
++ 6.5. [252]Automatic Character-Set Switching
++ 6.6. [253]Unicode
++ 6.6.1. [254]Overview of Unicode
++ 6.6.2. [255]UCS Byte Order
++ 6.6.2. [256]UCS Transformation Formats
++ 6.6.3. [257]Conformance Levels
++ 6.6.4. [258]Relationship of Unicode with Kermit's Other Character Sets
++ 6.6.5. [259]Kermit's Unicode Features
++ 6.6.5.1. [260]File Transfer
++ 6.6.5.2. [261]The TRANSLATE Command
++ 6.6.5.3. [262]Terminal Connection
++ 6.6.5.4. [263]The TRANSMIT Command
++ 6.6.5.5. [264]Summary of Kermit Unicode Commands
++ 6.7. [265]Client/Server Character-Set Switching
++ (7) [266]SCRIPT PROGRAMMING
++ 7.0. [267]Bug Fixes
++ 7.1. [268]The INPUT Command
++ 7.1.1. [269]INPUT Timeouts
++ 7.1.2. [270]New INPUT Controls
++ 7.1.3. [271]INPUT with Pattern Matching
++ 7.1.4. [272]The INPUT Match Result
++ 7.2. [273]New or Improved Built-In Variables
++ 7.3. [274]New or Improved Built-In Functions
++ 7.4. [275]New IF Conditions
++ 7.5. [276]Using More than Ten Macro Arguments
++ 7.6. [277]Clarification of Function Call Syntax
++ 7.7. [278]Autodownload during INPUT Command Execution
++ 7.8. [279]Built-in Help for Functions.
++ 7.9. [280]Variable Assignments
++ 7.9.1. [281]Assignment Operators
++ 7.9.2. [282]New Assignment Commands
++ 7.10. [283]Arrays
++ 7.10.1. [284]Array Initializers
++ 7.10.2. [285]Turning a String into an Array of Words
++ 7.10.3. [286]Arrays of Filenames
++ 7.10.4. [287]Automatic Arrays
++ 7.10.5. [288]Sorting Arrays
++ 7.10.6. [289]Displaying Arrays
++ 7.10.7. [290]Other Array Operations
++ 7.10.8. [291]Hints for Using Arrays
++ 7.10.9. [292]Do-It-Yourself Arrays
++ 7.10.10. [293]Associative Arrays
++ 7.11. [294]OUTPUT Command Improvements
++ 7.12. [295]Function and Variable Diagnostics
++ 7.13. [296]Return Value of Macros
++ 7.14. [297]The ASSERT, FAIL, and SUCCEED Commands.
++ 7.15. [298]Using Alarms
++ 7.16. [299]Passing Arguments to Command Files
++ 7.17. [300]Dialogs with Timed Responses
++ 7.18. [301]Increased Flexibility of SWITCH Case Labels
++ 7.19. "[302]Kerbang" Scripts
++ 7.20. [303]IF and XIF Statement Syntax
++ 7.20.1. [304]The IF/XIF Distinction
++ 7.20.2. [305]Boolean Expressions (The IF/WHILE Condition)
++ 7.21. [306]Screen Formatting and Cursor Control
++ 7.22. [307]Evaluating Arithmetic Expressions
++ 7.23. [308]Floating-Point Arithmetic
++ 7.24. [309]Tracing Script Execution
++ 7.25. [310]Compact Substring Notation
++ 7.26. [311]New WAIT Command Options
++ 7.26.1. [312]Waiting for Modem Signals
++ 7.26.2. [313]Waiting for File Events
++ 7.27. [314]Relaxed FOR and SWITCH Syntax
++ (8) [315]USING OTHER FILE TRANSFER PROTOCOLS
++ (9) [316]COMMAND-LINE OPTIONS
++ 9.0. [317]Extended-Format Command-Line Options
++ 9.1. [318]Command Line Personalities
++ 9.2. [319]Built-in Help for Command Line Options
++ 9.3. [320]New Command-Line Options
++ (10) [321]C-KERMIT AND G-KERMIT
++
++III. [322]APPENDICES
++
++III.1. [323]Character Set Tables
++III.1.1. [324]The Hewlett Packard Roman8 Character Set
++III.1.2. [325]Greek Character Sets
++III.1.2.1. [326]The ISO 8859-7 Latin / Greek Alphabet
++III.1.2.2. [327]The ELOT 927 Character Set
++III.1.2.3. [328]PC Code Page 869
++III.2. [329]Updated Country Codes
++
++IV. [330]ERRATA & CORRIGENDA: Corrections to "Using C-Kermit" 2nd Edition.
++V. [331]ADDITIONAL COPYRIGHT NOTICES
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++I. C-KERMIT DOCUMENTATION
++
++ The user manual for C-Kermit is:
++
++ Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, [332]Using C-Kermit, Second
++ Edition, Digital Press / Butterworth-Heinemann, Woburn, MA, 1997,
++ 622 pages, ISBN 1-55558-164-1.
++
++ [333]CLICK HERE for reviews.
++
++ The present document is a supplement to Using C-Kermit 2nd Ed, not a
++ replacement for it.
++
++ US single-copy price: $52.95; quantity discounts available. Available
++ in bookstores or directly from Columbia University:
++
++ The Kermit Project
++ Columbia University
++ 612 West 115th Street
++ New York NY 10025-7799
++ USA
++ Telephone: +1 (212) 854-3703
++ Fax: +1 (212) 662-6442
++
++ Domestic and overseas orders accepted. Price: US $44.95 (US, Canada,
++ and Mexico). Shipping: $4.00 within the USA; $15.00 to all other
++ countries. Orders may be paid by MasterCard or Visa, or prepaid by
++ check in US dollars. Add $65 bank fee for checks not drawn on a US
++ bank. Do not include sales tax. Inquire about quantity discounts.
++
++ You can also order by phone from the publisher, Digital Press /
++ [334]Butterworth-Heinemann, with MasterCard, Visa, or American
++ Express:
++
++ +1 800 366-2665 (Woburn, Massachusetts office for USA & Canada)
++ +44 1865 314627 (Oxford, England distribution centre for UK & Europe)
++ +61 03 9245 7111 (Melbourne, Vic, office for Australia & NZ)
++ +65 356-1968 (Singapore office for Asia)
++ +27 (31) 2683111 (Durban office for South Africa)
++
++ A [335]German-language edition of the First Edition is also available:
++
++ Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, C-Kermit - Einführung und
++ Referenz, Verlag Heinz Heise, Hannover, Germany (1994). ISBN
++ 3-88229-023-4. Deutsch von Gisbert W. Selke. Price: DM 88,00.
++ Verlag Heinz Heise GmbH & Co. KG, Helstorfer Strasse 7, D-30625
++ Hannover. Tel. +49 (05 11) 53 52-0, Fax. +49 (05 11) 53 52-1 29.
++
++ The [336]Kermit file transfer protocol is specified in:
++
++ Frank da Cruz, Kermit, A File Transfer Protocol, Digital Press,
++ Bedford, MA, 1987, 379 pages, ISBN 0-932376-88-6. US single-copy
++ price: $39.95. Availability as above.
++
++ News and articles about Kermit software and protocol are published
++ periodically in the journal, [337]Kermit News. Subscriptions are free;
++ contact Columbia University at the address above.
++
++ Online news about Kermit is published in the
++ [338]comp.protocols.kermit.announce and
++ [339]comp.protocols.kermit.misc newsgroups.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++II. NEW FEATURES
++
++ Support for the Bell Labs Plan 9 operating system was added to version
++ 6.0 too late to be mentioned in the book (although it does appear on
++ the cover).
++
++ Specific changes and additions are grouped together by major topic,
++ roughly corresponding to the chapters of [340]Using C-Kermit.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 0. INCOMPATIBILITIES WITH PREVIOUS RELEASES
++
++ 1. C-Kermit 7.0 uses FAST Kermit protocol settings by default. This
++ includes "unprefixing" of certain control characters. Because of
++ this, file transfers that worked with previous releases might not
++ work in the new release (but it is more likely that they will
++ work, and much faster). If a transfer fails, you'll get a
++ context-sensitive hint suggesting possible causes and cures.
++ Usually SET PREFIXING ALL does the trick.
++ 2. C-Kermit 7.0 transfers files in BINARY mode by default. To restore
++ the previous behavior, put SET FILE TYPE TEXT in your C-Kermit
++ initialization file.
++ 3. No matter whether FILE TYPE is BINARY or TEXT by default, C-Kermit
++ 7.0 now switches between text and binary mode automatically on a
++ per-file basis according to various criteria, including (a) which
++ kind of platform is on the other end of the connection (if known),
++ (b) the version of Kermit on the other end, and (c) the file's
++ name (see [341]Section 4, especially [342]4.3). To disable this
++ automatic switching and restore the earlier behavior, put SET
++ TRANSFER MODE MANUAL in your C-Kermit initialization file. To
++ disable automatic switching for a particular transfer, include a
++ /TEXT or /BINARY switch with your SEND or GET command.
++ 4. The RESEND and REGET commands automatically switch to binary mode;
++ previously if RESEND or REGET were attempted when FILE TYPE was
++ TEXT, these commands would fail immediately, with a message
++ telling you they work only when the FILE TYPE is BINARY. Now they
++ simply do this for you. See [343]Section 4.23 for additional
++ (important) information.
++ 5. SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS and MINIMAL now both prefix linefeed (10
++ and 138) in case rlogin, ssh, or cu are "in the middle", since
++ otherwise <LF>~ might appear in Kermit packets, and this would
++ cause rlogin, ssh, or cu to disconnect, suspend,escape back, or
++ otherwise wreck the file transfer. Xon and Xoff are now always
++ prefixed too, even when Xon/Xoff flow control is not in effect,
++ since unprefixing them has proven dangerous on TCP/IP connections.
++ 6. In UNIX, VMS, Windows, and OS/2, the DIRECTORY command is built
++ into C-Kermit itself rather than implemented by running an
++ external command or program. The built-in command might not behave
++ the way the platform-specific external one did, but many options
++ are available for customization. Of course the underlying
++ platform-specific command can still be accessed with "!", "@", or
++ "RUN" wherever the installation does not forbid. In UNIX, the "ls"
++ command can be accessed directly as "ls" in C-Kermit. See
++ [344]Section 4.5.1 for details.
++ 7. SEND ? prints a list of switches rather than a list of filenames.
++ If you want to see a list of filenames, use a (system-dependent)
++ construction such as SEND ./? (for UNIX, Windows, or OS/2), SEND
++ []? (VMS), etc. See [345]Sections 1.5 and [346]4.7.1.
++ 8. In UNIX, OS-9, and Kermit 95, the wildcard characters in previous
++ versions were * and ?. In C-Kermit 7.0 they are *, ?, [, ], {, and
++ }, with dash used inside []'s to denote ranges and comma used
++ inside {} to separate list elements. If you need to include any of
++ these characters literally in a filename, precede each one with
++ backslash (\). See [347]Section 4.9.
++ 9. SET QUIET { ON, OFF } is now on the command stack, just like SET
++ INPUT CASE, SET COUNT, SET MACRO ERROR, etc, as described on p.458
++ of [348]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition. This allows any macro or
++ command file to SET QUIET ON or OFF without worrying about saving
++ and restoring the global QUIET value. For example, this lets you
++ write a script that tries SET LINE on lots of devices until it
++ finds one free without spewing out loads of error messages, and
++ also without disturbing the global QUIET setting, whatever it was.
++ 10. Because of the new "." operator (which introduces assignments),
++ macros whose names begin with "." can not be invoked "by name".
++ However, they still can be invoked with DO.
++ 11. The syntax of the EVALUATE command has changed. See [349]Section
++ 7.9.2. To restore the previous syntax, use SET EVALUATE OLD.
++ 12. The \v(directory) variable now includes the trailing directory
++ separator; in previous releases it did not. This is to allow
++ constructions such as:
++ cd \v(dir)data.tmp
++ to work across platforms that might have different directory
++ notation, such as UNIX, Windows, and VMS.
++ 13. Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the FLOW-CONTROL setting was global and
++ sticky. In C-Kermit 7.0, there is an array of default flow-control
++ values for each kind of connection, that are applied automatically
++ at SET LINE/PORT/HOST time. Thus a SET FLOW command given before
++ SET LINE/PORT/HOST is likely to be undone. Therefore SET FLOW can
++ be guaranteed to have the desired effect only if given after the
++ SET LINE/PORT/HOST command.
++ 14. Character-set translation works differently in the TRANSMIT
++ command when (a) the file character-set is not the same as the
++ local end of the terminal character-set, or (b) when the terminal
++ character-set is TRANSPARENT.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1. PROGRAM AND FILE MANAGEMENT AND COMMANDS
++
++ 1.0. Bug Fixes
++
++ The following patches were issued to correct bugs in C-Kermit 6.0.
++ These are described in detail in the 6.0 PATCHES file. All of these
++ fixes have been incorporated in C-Kermit 6.1 (never released except as
++ K95 1.1.16-17) and 7.0.
++
++ 0001 All UNIX C-Kermit mishandles timestamps on files before 1970
++ 0002 Solaris 2.5++ Compilation error on Solaris 2.5 with Pro C
++ 0003 All VMS CKERMIT.INI Fix for VMS
++ 0004 VMS/VAX/UCX 2.0 C-Kermit 6.0 can't TELNET on VAX/VMS with UCX 2.0
++ 0005 All C-Kermit Might Send Packets Outside Window
++ 0006 All MOVE from SEND-LIST does not delete original files
++ 0007 Solaris 2.5++ Higher serial speeds on Solaris 2.5
++ 0008 All C-Kermit application file name can't contain spaces
++ 0009 AT&T 7300 UNIXPC setuid and hardware flow-control problems
++ 0010 Linux on Alpha Patch to make ckutio.c compile on Linux/Alpha
++ 0011 OS-9/68000 2.4 Patch to make ck9con.c compile on OS-9/68000 2.4
++ 0012 MW Coherent 4.2 Patches for successful build on Coherent 4.2
++ 0013 SINIX-Y 5.43 "delay" variable conflicts with <sys/clock.h>
++ 0014 VMS/VAX/CMU-IP Subject: Patches for VAX/VMS 5.x + CMU-IP
++ 0015 All XECHO doesn't flush its output
++ 0016 VMS CD and other directory operations might not work
++ 0017 Linux 1.2.x++ Use standard POSIX interface for high serial speeds
++ 0018 UNIX SET WILDCARD-EXPANSION SHELL dumps core
++ 0019 All Hayes V.34 modem init string problem
++ 0020 All READ command does not fail if file not open
++ 0021 All Problems with long function arguments
++ 0022 All Certain \function()s can misbehave
++ 0023 All X MOD 0 crashes program
++ 0024 All Internal bulletproofing for lower() function
++ 0025 OpenBSD Real OpenBSD support for C-Kermit 6.0
++ 0026 All Incorrect checks for macro/command-file nesting depth
++ 0027 All ANSWER doesn't automatically CONNECT
++ 0028 All Overzealous EXIT warning
++ 0029 All OUTPUT doesn't echo when DUPLEX is HALF
++ 0030 All Minor problems with REMOTE DIRECTORY/DELETE/etc
++ 0031 All CHECK command broken
++ 0032 All Problem with SET TRANSMIT ECHO
++ 0033 UNIX, VMS, etc HELP SET SERVER says too much
++ 0034 All READ and !READ too picky about line terminators
++ 0035 All END from inside SWITCH doesn't work
++ 0036 All Problem telnetting to multihomed hosts
++ 0037 All Redirection failures in REMOTE xxx > file
++
++ REDIRECT was missing in many UNIX C-Kermit implementations; in version
++ 7.0, it should be available in all of them.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.1. Command Continuation
++
++ Comments that start with ";" or "#" can no longer be continued. In:
++
++ ; this is a comment -
++ echo blah
++
++ the ECHO command will execute, rather than being taken as a
++ continuation of the preceding comment line. This allows easy
++ "commenting out" of commands from macro definitions.
++
++ However, the text of the COMMENT command can still be continued onto
++ subsequent lines:
++
++ comment this is a comment -
++ echo blah
++
++ As of version 6.0, backslash is no longer a valid continuation
++ character. Only hyphen should be used for command continuation. This
++ is to make it possible to issue commands like "cd a:\" on DOS-like
++ systems.
++
++ As of version 7.0:
++
++ * You can quote a final dash to prevent it from being a continuation
++ character:
++ echo foo\-
++ This prints "foo-". The command is not continued.
++ * You can enter commands such as:
++ echo foo - ; this is a comment
++ interactively and they are properly treated as continued commands.
++ Previously this worked only in command files.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.2. Editor Interface
++
++ SET EDITOR name [ options ]
++ Lets you specify a text-editing program. The name can be a
++ fully specified pathname like /usr/local/bin/emacs19/emacs, or
++ it can be the name of any program in your PATH, e.g. "set
++ editor emacs". In VMS, it must be a DCL command like "edit",
++ "edit/tpu", "emacs", etc. If an environment variable EDITOR is
++ defined when Kermit starts, its value is the default editor.
++ You can also specify options to be included on the editor
++ command line. Returns to Kermit when the editor exits.
++
++ EDIT [ filename ]
++ If the EDIT command is given without a filename, then if a
++ previous filename had been given to an EDIT command, it is
++ used; if not, the editor is started without a file. If a
++ filename is given, the editor is started on that file, and the
++ filename is remembered for subsequent EDIT commands.
++
++ SHOW EDITOR
++ Displays the full pathname of your text editor, if any, along
++ with any command line options, and the file most recently
++ edited (and therefore the default filename for your next EDIT
++ command).
++
++ Related variables: \v(editor), \v(editopts), \v(editfile).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.3. Web Browser and FTP Interface
++
++ C-Kermit includes an FTP command, which simply runs the FTP program;
++ C-Kermit does not include any built-in support for Internet File
++ Transfer Protocol, nor any method for interacting directly with an FTP
++ server. In version 7.0, however, C-Kermit lets you specify your FTP
++ client:
++
++ SET FTP-CLIENT [ name [ options ] ]
++ The name is the name of the FTP executable. In UNIX, Windows,
++ or OS/2, it can be the filename of any executable program in
++ your PATH (e.g. "ftp.exe" in Windows, "ftp" in UNIX); elsewhere
++ (or if you do not have a PATH definition), it must be the fully
++ specified pathname of the FTP program. If the name contains any
++ spaces, enclose it braces. Include any options after the
++ filename; these depend the particular ftp client.
++
++ The Web browser interface is covered in the following subsections.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.3.1. Invoking your Browser from C-Kermit
++
++ BROWSE [ url ]
++ Starts your preferred Web browser on the URL, if one is given,
++ otherwise on the most recently given URL, if any. Returns to
++ Kermit when the browser exits.
++
++ SET BROWSER [ name [ options ] ]
++ Use this command to specify the name of your Web browser
++ program, for example: "set browser lynx". The name must be in
++ your PATH, or else it must be a fully specified filename; in
++ VMS it must be a DCL command.
++
++ SHOW BROWSER
++ Displays the current browser, options, and most recent URL.
++
++ Related variables: \v(browser), \v(browsopts), \v(browsurl).
++
++ Also see [350]Section 2.15: Contacting Web Servers with the HTTP
++ Command.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.3.2. Invoking C-Kermit from your Browser
++
++ The method for doing this depends, of course, on your browser. Here
++ are some examples:
++
++ Netscape on UNIX (X-based)
++ In the Options->Applications section, set your Telnet
++ application to:
++
++ xterm -e /usr/local/bin/kermit/kermit -J %h %p
++
++ (replace "/usr/local/bin/kermit/kermit" by C-Kermit's actual
++ pathname). -J is C-Kermit's command-line option to "be like
++ Telnet"; %h and %p are Netscape placeholders for hostname and
++ port.
++
++ Lynx on UNIX
++ As far as we know, this can be done only at compile time. Add
++ the following line to the Lynx userdefs.h file before building
++ the Lynx binary:
++
++ #define TELNET_COMMAND "/opt/bin/kermit -J"
++
++ And then add lines like the following to the Lynx.cfg file:
++
++ DOWNLOADER:Kermit binary download:/opt/bin/kermit -i -V -s %s -a %s:TRUE
++ DOWNLOADER:Kermit text download:/opt/bin/kermit -s %s -a %s:TRUE
++
++ UPLOADER:Kermit binary upload:/opt/bin/kermit -i -r -a %s:TRUE
++ UPLOADER:Kermit text upload:/opt/bin/kermit -r -a %s:TRUE
++ UPLOADER:Kermit text get:/opt/bin/kermit -g %s:TRUE
++ UPLOADER:Kermit binary get:/opt/bin/kermit -ig %s:TRUE
++
++ But none of the above is necessary if you make C-Kermit your default
++ Telnet client, which you can do by making a symlink called 'telnet' to
++ the C-Kermit 7.0 binary. See [351]Section 9.1 for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.4. Command Editing
++
++ Ctrl-W ("Word delete") was changed in 7.0 to delete back to the
++ previous non-alphanumeric, rather than all the way back to the
++ previous space.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.5. Command Switches
++
++ As of version 7.0, C-Kermit's command parser supports a new type of
++ field, called a "switch". This is an optional command modifier.
++
++ 1.5.1. General Switch Syntax
++
++ A switch is a keyword beginning with a slash (/). If it takes a value,
++ then the value is appended to it (with no intervening spaces),
++ separated by a colon (:) or equal sign (=). Depending on the switch,
++ the value may be a number, a keyword, a filename, a date/time, etc.
++ Examples:
++
++ send oofa.txt ; No switches
++ send /binary oofa.zip ; A switch without a value
++ send /protocol:zmodem oofa.zip ; A switch with a value (:)
++ send /protocol=zmodem oofa.zip ; A switch with a value (=)
++ send /text /delete /as-name:x.x oofa.txt ; Several switches
++
++ Like other command fields, switches are separated from other fields,
++ and from each other, by whitespace, as shown in the examples just
++ above. You can not put them together like so:
++
++ send/text/delete/as-name:x.x oofa.txt
++
++ (as you might do in VMS or DOS, or as we might once have done in
++ TOPS-10 or TOPS0-20, or PIP). This is primarily due to ambiguity
++ between "/" as switch introducer versus "/" as UNIX directory
++ separator; e.g. in:
++
++ send /delete/as-name:foo/text oofa.txt
++
++ Does "foo/text" mean the filename is "foo" and the transfer is to be
++ in text mode, or does it mean the filename is "foo/text"? Therefore we
++ require whitespace between switches to resolve the ambiguity. (That's
++ only one of several possible ambiguities -- it is also conceivable
++ that a file called "text" exists in the path "/delete/as-name:foo/").
++
++ In general, if a switch can take a value, but you omit it, then either
++ a reasonable default value is supplied, or an error message is
++ printed:
++
++ send /print:-Plaserwriter oofa.txt ; Value included = print options
++ send /print oofa.txt ; Value omitted, OK
++ send /mail:kermit@columbia.edu oofa.txt ; Value included = address
++ send /mail oofa.txt ; Not OK - address required
++ ?Address required
++
++ Context-sensitive help (?) and completion (Esc or Tab) are available
++ in the normal manner:
++
++ C-Kermit> send /pr? Switch, one of the following:
++ /print /protocol
++ C-Kermit> send /pro<ESC>tocol:? File-transfer protocol,
++ one of the following:
++ kermit xmodem ymodem ymodem-g zmodem
++ C-Kermit> send /protocol:k<TAB>ermit
++
++ If a switch takes a value and you use completion on it, a colon (:) is
++ printed at the end of its name to indicate this. If it does not take a
++ value, a space is printed.
++
++ Also, if you type ? in a switch field, switches that take values are
++ shown with a trailing colon; those that don't take values are shown
++ without one.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.5.2. Order and Effect of Switches
++
++ The order of switches should not matter, except that they are
++ evaluated from left to right, so if you give two switches with
++ opposite effects, the rightmost one is used:
++
++ send /text /binary oofa.zip ; Sends oofa.zip in binary mode.
++
++ Like other command fields, switches have no effect whatsoever until
++ the command is entered (by pressing the Return or Enter key). Even
++ then, switches affect only the command with which they are included;
++ they do not have global effect or side effects.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.5.3. Distinguishing Switches from Other Fields
++
++ All switches are optional. A command that uses switches lets you give
++ any number of them, including none at all. Example:
++
++ send /binary oofa.zip
++ send /bin /delete oofa.zip
++ send /bin /as-name:mupeen.zip oofa.zip
++ send oofa.zip
++
++ But how does Kermit know when the first "non-switch" is given? It has
++ been told to look for both a switch and for something else, the data
++ type of the next field (filename, number, etc). In most cases, this
++ works well. But conflicts are not impossible. Suppose, for example, in
++ UNIX there was a file named "text" in the top-level directory. The
++ command to send it would be:
++
++ send /text
++
++ But C-Kermit would think this was the "/text" switch. To resolve the
++ conflict, use braces:
++
++ send {/text}
++
++ or other circumlocutions such as "send //text", "send /./text", etc.
++
++ The opposite problem can occur if you give an illegal switch that
++ happens to match a directory name. For example:
++
++ send /f oofa.txt
++
++ There is no "/f" switch (there are several switches that begin with
++ "/f", so "/f" is ambiguous). Now suppose there is an "f" directory in
++ the root directory; then this command would be interpreted as:
++
++ Send all the files in the "/f" directory, giving each one an
++ as-name of "oofa.txt".
++
++ This could be a mistake, or it could be exactly what you intended;
++ C-Kermit has no way of telling the difference. To avoid situations
++ like this, spell switches out in full until you are comfortable enough
++ with them to know the minimum abbreviation for each one. Hint: use ?
++ and completion while typing switches to obtain the necessary feedback.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.5.4. Standard File Selection Switches
++
++ The following switches are used on different file-oriented commands
++ (such as SEND, DIRECTORY, DELETE, PURGE) to refine the selection of
++ files that match the given specification.
++
++ /AFTER:date-time
++ Select only those files having a date-time later than the one
++ given. See [352]Section 1.6 for date-time formats. Synonym:
++ /SINCE.
++
++ /NOT-AFTER:date-time
++ Select only those files having a date-time not later than (i.e.
++ earlier or equal to) the one given. Synonym: /NOT-SINCE.
++
++ /BEFORE:date-time
++ Select only those files having a date-time earlier than the one
++ given.
++
++ /NOT-BEFORE:date-time
++ Select only those files having a date-time not earlier than
++ (i.e. later or equal to) the one given.
++
++ /DOTFILES
++ UNIX and OS-9 only: The filespec is allowed to match files
++ whose names start with (dot) period. Normally these files are
++ not shown.
++
++ /NODOTFILES
++ (UNIX and OS-9 only) Don't show files whose names start with
++ dot (period). This is the opposite of /DOTFILES, and is the
++ default. Note that when a directory name starts with a period,
++ the directory and (in recursive operations) all its
++ subdirectories are skipped.
++
++ /LARGER-THAN:number
++ Only select files larger than the given number of bytes.
++
++ /SMALLER-THAN:number
++ Only select files smaller than the given number of bytes.
++
++ /EXCEPT:pattern
++ Specifies that any files whose names match the pattern, which
++ can be a regular filename, or may contain "*" and/or "?"
++ metacharacters (wildcards), are not to be selected. Example:
++
++ send /except:*.log *.*
++
++ sends all files in the current directory except those with a
++ filetype of ".log". Another:
++
++ send /except:*.~*~ *.*
++
++ sends all files except the ones that look like Kermit or EMACS
++ backup files (such as "oofa.txt.~17~") (of course you can also
++ use the /NOBACKUP switch for this).
++
++ The pattern matcher is the same one used by IF MATCH string
++ pattern ([353]Section 7.4), so you can test your patterns using
++ IF MATCH. If you need to match a literal * or ? (etc), precede
++ it by a backslash (\). If the pattern contains any spaces, it
++ must be enclosed in braces:
++
++ send /except:{Foo bar} *.*
++
++ The pattern can also be a list of up to 8 patterns. In this
++ case, the entire pattern must be enclosed in braces, and each
++ sub-pattern must also be enclosed in braces; this eliminates
++ the need for designating a separator character, which is likely
++ to also be a legal filename character on some platform or
++ other, and therefore a source of confusion. You may include
++ spaces between the subpatterns but they are not necessary. The
++ following two commands are equivalent:
++
++ send /except:{{ck*.o} {ck*.c}} ck*.?
++ send /except:{{ck*.o}{ck*.c}} ck*.?
++
++ If a pattern is to include a literal brace character, precede
++ it with "\". Also note the apparent conflict of this list
++ format and the string-list format described in [354]Section
++ 4.9.1. In case you want to include a wildcard string-list with
++ braces on its outer ends as an /EXCEPT: argument, do it like
++ this:
++
++ send /except:{{{ckuusr.c,ckuus2.c,ckuus6.c}}} ckuus*.c
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.5.5. Setting Preferences for Different Commands
++
++ Certain oft-used commands offer lots of switches because different
++ people have different requirements or preferences. For example, some
++ people want to be able to delete files without having to watch a list
++ of the deleted files scroll past, while others want to be prompted for
++ permission to delete each file. Different people prefer different
++ directory-listing styles. And so on. Such commands can be tailored
++ with the SET OPTIONS command:
++
++ SET OPTIONS command [ switch [ switch [ ... ] ] ]
++ Sets each switch as the default for the given command,
++ replacing the "factory default". Of course you can also
++ override any defaults established by the SET OPTIONS command by
++ including the relevant switches in the affected command any
++ time you issue it.
++
++ SHOW OPTIONS
++ Lists the commands that allows option-setting, and the options
++ currently in effect, if any, for each. Switches that have
++ synonyms are shown under their primary name; for example. /LOG
++ and /VERBOSE are shown as /LIST.
++
++ Commands for which options may be set include DIRECTORY, DELETE,
++ PURGE, and TYPE. Examples:
++
++ SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY /PAGE /NOBACKUP /HEADING /SORT:DATE /REVERSE
++ SET OPTIONS DELETE /LIST /NOHEADING /NOPAGE /NOASK /NODOTFILES
++ SET OPTIONS TYPE /PAGE
++
++ Not necessarily all of a command's switches can be set as options. For
++ example, file selection switches, since these would normally be
++ different for each command.
++
++ Put the desired SET OPTIONS commands in your C-Kermit customization
++ file for each command whose default switches you want to change every
++ time you run C-Kermit.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.6. Dates and Times
++
++ Some commands and switches take date-time values, such as:
++
++ send /after:{8-Feb-2000 10:28:01}
++
++ Various date-time formats are acceptable. The rules for the date are:
++
++ * The year must have 4 digits.
++ * If the year comes first, the second field is the month.
++ * The day, month, and year may be separated by spaces, /, -, or
++ underscore.
++ * The month may be numeric (1 = January) or spelled out or
++ abbreviated in English.
++
++ If the date-time string contains any spaces, it must be enclosed in
++ braces. Examples of legal dates:
++
++ Interpretation:
++ 2000-Feb-8 8 February 2000
++ {2000 Feb 8} 8 February 2000
++ 2000/Feb/8 8 February 2000
++ 2000_Feb_8 8 February 2000
++ 2000-2-8 8 February 2000
++ 2000-02-08 8 February 2000
++ 8-Feb-2000 8 February 2000
++ 08-Feb-2000 8 February 2000
++ 12/25/2000 25 December 2000
++ 25/12/2000 25 December 2000
++
++ The last two examples show that when the year comes last, and the
++ month is given numerically, the order of the day and month doesn't
++ matter as long as the day is 13 or greater (mm/dd/yyyy is commonly
++ used in the USA, whereas dd/mm/yyyy is the norm in Europe). However:
++
++ 08/02/2000 Is ambiguous and therefore not accepted.
++
++ If a date is given, the time is optional and defaults to 00:00:00. If
++ the time is given with a date, it must follow the date, separated by
++ space, /, -, or underscore, and with hours, minutes, and seconds
++ separated by colon (:). Example:
++
++ 2000-Feb-8 10:28:01 Represents 8 February 2000, 10:28:01am
++
++ If a date is not given, the current date is used and a time is
++ required.
++
++ Time format is hh:mm:ss or hh:mm or hh in 24-hour format, or followed
++ by "am" or "pm" (or "AM" or "PM") to indicate morning or afternoon.
++ Examples of times that are acceptable:
++
++ Interpretation:
++ 3:23:56 3:23:56am
++ 3:23:56am 3:23:56am
++ 3:23:56pm 3:23:56pm = 15:23:56
++ 15:23:56 3:23:56pm = 15:23:56
++ 3:23pm 3:23:00pm = 15:23:00
++ 3:23PM 3:23:00pm = 15:23:00
++ 3pm 3:00:00pm = 15:00:00
++
++ Examples of legal date-times:
++
++ send /after:{8 Feb 2000 10:28:01}
++ send /after:8_Feb_2000_10:28:01
++ send /after:8-Feb-2000/10:28:01
++ send /after:2000/02/08/10:28:01
++ send /after:2000/02/08_10:28:01
++ send /after:2000/02/08_10:28:01am
++ send /after:2000/02/08_10:28:01pm
++ send /after:2000/02/08_10:28pm
++ send /after:2000/02/08_10pm
++ send /after:10:00:00pm
++ send /after:10:00pm
++ send /after:10pm
++ send /after:22
++
++ Finally, there is a special all-numeric format you can use:
++
++ yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss
++
++ For example:
++
++ 20000208 10:28:01
++
++ This is Kermit's standard date-time format (based on ISO 8601), and is
++ accepted (among other formats) by any command or switch that requires
++ a date-time, and is output by any function whose result is a calendar
++ date-time.
++
++ There are no optional parts to this format and it must be exactly 17
++ characters long, punctuated as shown (except you can substitute
++ underscore for space in contexts where a single "word" is required).
++ The time is in 24-hour format (23:00:00 is 11:00pm). This is the
++ format returned by \fdate(filename), so you can also use constructions
++ like this:
++
++ send /after:\fdate(oofa.txt)
++
++ which means "all files newer than oofa.txt".
++
++ Besides explicit dates, you can also use the any of the following
++ shortcuts:
++
++ TODAY
++ Stands for the current date at 00:00:00.
++
++ TODAY 12:34:56
++ Stands for the current date at the given time.
++
++ YESTERDAY
++ Stands for yesterday's date at 00:00:00. A time may also be
++ given.
++
++ TOMORROW
++ Stands for tomorrow's date at 00:00:00. A time may also be
++ given.
++
++ + number { DAYS, WEEKS, MONTHS, YEARS } [ time ]
++ Is replaced by the future date indicated, relative to the
++ current date. If the time is omitted, 00:00:00 is used.
++ Examples: +3days, +2weeks, +1year, +37months.
++
++ - number { DAYS, WEEKS, MONTHS, YEARS } [ time ]
++
++ Is replaced by the past date indicated, relative to the current
++ date. If the time is omitted, 00:00:00 is used.
++
++ The time can be separated from the date shortcut by any of the same
++ separators that are allowed for explicit date-times: space, hyphen,
++ slash, period, or underscore. In switches and other space-delimited
++ fields, use non-spaces to separate date/time fields, or enclose the
++ date-time in braces, e.g.:
++
++ purge /before:-4days_12:00:00
++ purge /before:{- 4 days 12:00:00}
++
++ Of course you can also use variables:
++
++ define \%n 43
++ purge /before:-\%ndays_12:00:00
++
++ Shortcut names can be abbreviated to any length that still
++ distinguishes them from any other name that can appear in the same
++ context, e.g. "TOD" for today, "Y" for yesterday. Also, the special
++ abbreviation "wks" is accepted for WEEKS, and "yrs" for "YEARS".
++
++ (To see how to specify dates relative to a specific date, rather than
++ the current one, see the [355]\fmjd() function description below.)
++
++ You can check date formats with the DATE command. DATE by itself
++ prints the current date and time in standard format: yyyymmdd
++ hh:mm:ss. DATE followed by a date and/or time (including shortcuts)
++ converts it to standard format if it can understand it, otherwise it
++ prints an error message.
++
++ The following variables and functions deal with dates and times; any
++ function argument designated as "date-time" can be in any of the
++ formats described above.
++
++ \v(day)
++ The first three letters of the English word for the current day
++ of the week, e.g. "Wed".
++
++ \fday(date-time)
++ The first three letters of the English word for day of the week
++ of the given date. If a time is included, it is ignored.
++ Example: \fday(8 Feb 1988) = "Mon".
++
++ \v(nday)
++ The numeric day of the week: 0 = Sunday, 1 = Monday, ..., 6 =
++ Saturday.
++
++ \fnday(date-time)
++ The numeric day of the week for the given date. If a time is
++ included, it is ignored. Example: \fnday(8 Feb 1988) = "1".
++
++ \v(date)
++ The current date as dd mmm yyyy, e.g. "08 Feb 2000" (as in this
++ example, a leading zero is supplied for day-of-month less than
++ 10).
++
++ \v(ndate)
++ The current date in numeric format: yyyymmdd, e.g. "20000208".
++
++ \v(time)
++ The current time as hh:mm:ss, e.g. "15:27:14".
++
++ \ftime(time)
++ The given free-format date and/or time (e.g. "3pm") returns the
++ time (without the date) converted to hh:mm:ss 24-hour format,
++ e.g. "15:00:00" (the date, if given, is ignored).
++
++ \v(ntime)
++ The current time as seconds since midnight, e.g. "55634".
++
++ \v(tftime)
++ The elapsed time of the most recent file-transfer operation in
++ seconds.
++
++ \v(intime)
++ The elapsed time for the most recent INPUT command to complete,
++ in milliseconds.
++
++ \fntime(time)
++ The given free-format date and/or time is converted to seconds
++ since midnight (the date, if given, is ignored). This function
++ replaces \ftod2secs(), which is now a synonym for \fntime().
++ Unlike \ftod2secs(), \fntime() allows a date to be included,
++ and it allows the time to be in free format (like 3pm), and it
++ allows the amount of time to be more than 24 hours. E.g.
++ \fntime(48:00:00) = 172800. Example of use:
++
++ set alarm \fntime(48:00:00) ; set alarm 48 hours from now.
++
++ \fn2time(seconds)
++ The given number of seconds is converted to hh:mm:ss format.
++
++ \fdate(filename)
++ Returns the modification date-time of the given file in
++ standard format: yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss.
++
++ \fcvtdate(date-time)
++ Converts a free-format date and/or time to Kermit standard
++ format: yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss. If no argument is given, returns the
++ current date-time in standard format. If a date is given but no
++ time, the converted date is returned without a time. If a time
++ is given with no date, the current date is supplied. Examples:
++
++ \fcvtdate(4 Jul 2000 2:21:17pm) = 20000704 14:21:17
++ \fcvtdate() = 20000704 14:21:17 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 2:21:17pm).
++ \fcvtd(4 Jul 2000) = 20000704
++ \fcvtd(6pm) = 20000704 18:00:00 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 6:00pm).
++
++ \fdayofyear(date-time)
++ \fdoy(date-time)
++ Converts a free-format date and/or time to yyyyddd, where ddd
++ is the 3-digit day of the year, and 1 January is Day 1. If a
++ time is included with the date, it is returned in standard
++ format. If a date is included but no time, the date is returned
++ without a time. If a time is given with no date, the time is
++ converted and the current date is supplied. If no argument is
++ given, the current date-time is returned. Synonym: \fdoy().
++ Examples:
++
++ \fddayofyear(4 Jul 2000 2:21:17pm) = 2000185 14:21:17
++ \fdoy() = 2000185 14:21:17 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 2:21:17pm).
++ \fdoy(4 Jul 2000) = 2000185
++ \fdoy(6pm) = 2000185 18:00:00 (on 4 Jul 2000 at 6:00pm).
++
++ Note: The yyyyddd day-of-year format is often erroneously referred to
++ as a Julian date. However, a true Julian date is a simple counting
++ number, the number of days since a certain fixed day in the past.
++ [356]See \fmjd() below.
++
++ \fdoy2date(date-time)
++ Converts a date or date-time in day-of-year format to a
++ standard format date. A yyyyddd-format date must be supplied;
++ time is optional. The given date is converted to yyyymmdd
++ format. If a time is given, it is converted to 24-hour format.
++ Examples:
++
++ \fdoy2date(2000185) = 20000704
++ \fdoy2(2000185 3pm) = 20000704 15:00:00
++
++ \fmjd(date-time)
++ Converts free-format date and/or time to a Modified Julian Date
++ (MJD), the number of days since 17 Nov 1858 00:00:00. If a time
++ is given, it is ignored. Examples:
++
++ \fmjd(4 Jul 2000) = 50998
++ \fmjd(17 Nov 1858) = 0
++ \fmjd(16 Nov 1858) = -1
++
++ \fmjd2date(mjd)
++ Converts an MJD (integer) to standard date format, yyyymmdd:
++
++ \fmjd2(50998) = 4 Jul 1998
++ \fmjd2(0) = 17 Nov 1858
++ \fmjd2(-1) = 16 Nov 1858
++ \fmjd2(-365) = 17 Nov 1857
++
++ MJDs are normal integers and, unlike DOYs, may be added, subtracted,
++ etc, with each other or with other integers, to obtain meaningful
++ results. For example, to find out the date 212 days ago:
++
++ echo \fmjd2date(\fmjd()-212)
++
++ Constructions such as this can be used in any command where a
++ date-time is required, e.g.:
++
++ send /after:\fmjd2date(\fmjd()-212)
++
++ to send all files that are not older than 212 days (this is equivalent
++ to "send /after:-212days").
++
++ MJDs also have other regularities not exhibited by other date formats.
++ For example, \fmodulus(\fmjd(any-date),7) gives the day of the week
++ for any date (where 4=Sun, 5=Mon, ..., 3=Sat). (However, it is easier
++ to use \fnday() for this purpose, and it gives the more conventional
++ result of 0=Sun, 1=Mon, ..., 6=Sat).
++
++ Note that if MJDs are to be compared, they must be compared
++ numerically (IF <, =, >) and not lexically (IF LLT, EQUAL, LGT),
++ whereas DOYs must be compared lexically if they include a time (which
++ contains ":" characters); however, if DOYs do not include a time, they
++ may also be compared numerically.
++
++ In any case, lexical comparison of DOYs always produces the
++ appropriate result, as does numeric comparison of MJDs.
++
++ The same comments apply to sorting. Also note that DOYs are fixed
++ length, but MJDs can vary in length. However, all MJDs between 3 April
++ 1886 and 30 Aug 2132 are 5 decimal digits long. (MJDs become 6 digits
++ long on 31 Aug 2132, and 7 digits long on 13 Oct 4596).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.7. Partial Completion of Keywords
++
++ Partial completion of keywords was added in C-Kermit 7.0. In prior
++ versions, if completion was attempted (by pressing the Esc or Tab key)
++ on a string that matched different keywords, you'd just get a beep.
++ Now Kermit completes up to the first character where the possibly
++ matching keywords differ and then beeps. For example:
++
++ C-Kermit> send /n<Tab>
++
++ which matches /NOT-BEFORE and /NOT-AFTER, now completes up to the
++ dash:
++
++ C-Kermit> send /n<Tab>ot-<Beep>
++
++ Partial completion works for filenames too (as it has for some years).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.8. Command Recall
++
++ C-Kermit has had a command history buffer for some time, which could
++ be scrolled interactively using control characters or (in Kermit 95
++ only) arrow keys. Version 7.0 adds a REDO command that allows the most
++ recent command matching a given pattern to be re-executed:
++
++ { REDO, RR, ^ } [ pattern ]
++ Search the command history list for the most recent command
++ that matches the given pattern, and if one is found, execute it
++ again.
++
++ The pattern can be a simple string (like "send"), in which case the
++ last SEND command is re-executed. Or it can contain wildcard
++ characters "*" and/or "?", which match any string and any single
++ character, respectively (note that "?" must be preceded by backslash
++ to override its normal function of giving help), and in most C-Kermit
++ versions may also include [] character lists and {} string lists (see
++ [357]Section 4.9).
++
++ The match works by appending "*" to the end of the given pattern (if
++ you didn't put one there yourself). Thus "redo *oofa" becomes "redo
++ *oofa*" and therefore matches the most recent command that contains
++ "oofa" anywhere within the command. If you want to inhibit the
++ application of the trailing "*", e.g. to force matching a string at
++ the end of a command, enclose the pattern in braces:
++
++ redo {*oofa}
++
++ matches the most recent command that ends with "oofa".
++
++ REDO commands themselves are not entered into the command history
++ list. If no pattern is given, the previous (non-REDO) command is
++ re-executed. The REDOne command is reinserted at the end of the
++ command history buffer, so the command scrollback character (Ctrl-P,
++ Ctrl-B, or Uparrow) can retrieve it.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ C-Kermit> echo foo
++ foo
++ C-Kermit> show alarm
++ (no alarm set)
++ C-Kermit> echo blah
++ blah
++ C-Kermit> redo ; Most recent command
++ blah
++ C-Kermit> redo s ; Most recent command starting with "s"
++ (no alarm set)
++ C-Kermit> redo echo f ; Most recent command starting with "echo f"
++ foo
++ C-Kermit> redo *foo ; Most recent command that has "foo" in it
++ foo
++ C-Kermit> <Ctrl-P> ; Scroll back
++ C-Kermit> echo foo ; The REDOne command is there
++ C-Kermit> redo {*foo} ; Most recent command that ends with "foo"
++ foo
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ Since REDO, REDIAL, and REDIRECT all start the same way, and RED is
++ the designated non-unique abbreviation for REDIAL, REDO must be
++ spelled out in full. For convenience, RR is included as an invisible
++ easy-to-type synonym for REDO. You can also use the "^" character for
++ this:
++
++ C-Kermit> ^ ; Most recent command
++ C-Kermit> ^ s ; Most recent command starting with "s"
++ C-Kermit> ^s ; Ditto (space not required after "^").
++ C-Kermit> ^*foo ; Most recent command that has "foo" in it.
++ C-Kermit> ^{*foo} ; Most recent command ends with "foo".
++
++ Unlike the manual command-history-scrolling keys, the REDO command can
++ be used in a script, but it's not recommended (since the command to be
++ REDOne might not be found, so if the REDO command fails, you can't
++ tell whether it was because REDO failed to find the requested command,
++ or because the command was found but it failed).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.9. EXIT Messages
++
++ The EXIT and QUIT commands now accept an optional message to be
++ printed. This makes the syntax of EXIT and QUIT just like END and
++ STOP:
++
++ { EXIT, QUIT, END, STOP } [ status-code [ message ] ]
++
++ where status-code is a number (0 indicating success, nonzero
++ indicating failure). This is handy in scripts that are never supposed
++ to enter interactive mode:
++
++ dial 7654321
++ if fail exit 1 Can't make connection - try again later.
++
++ Previously this could only be done in two steps:
++
++ dial 7654321
++ xif fail { echo Can't make connection - try again later, exit 1 }
++
++ A status code must be included in order to specify a message. In the
++ case of EXIT and QUIT, the default status code is contained in the
++ variable \v(exitstatus), and is set automatically by various events
++ (file transfer failures, etc; it can also be set explicitly with the
++ SET EXIT STATUS command). If you want to give an EXIT or QUIT command
++ with a message, but without changing the exit status from what it
++ normally would have been, use the \v(exitstatus) variable, e.g.:
++
++ exit \v(existatus) Goodbye from \v(cmdfile).
++
++ The EXIT status is returned to the system shell or whatever other
++ process invoked C-Kermit, e.g. in UNIX:
++
++ C-Kermit> exit 97 bye bye
++ bye bye
++ $ echo $?
++ 97
++ $
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.10. Managing Keyboard Interruptions
++
++ When C-Kermit is in command or file-transfer mode (as opposed to
++ CONNECT mode), it can be interrupted with Ctrl-C. Version 7.0 adds the
++ ability to disarm the Ctrl-C interrupt:
++
++ SET COMMAND INTERRUPT { ON, OFF }
++ COMMAND INTERRUPT is ON by default, meaning the Ctrl-C can be
++ used to interrupt a command or a file transfer in progress. Use
++ OFF to disable these interruptions, and use it with great
++ caution for obvious reasons.
++
++ SET TRANSFER INTERRUPT { ON, OFF }
++ This can be used to disable keyboard interruption of file
++ transfer when C-Kermit is in local mode, or to re-enable it
++ after it has been disabled. This applies to the X, Z, E, and
++ similar keys as well as to the system interrupt character,
++ usually Ctrl-C. This is distinct from SET TRANSFER
++ CANCELLATION, which tells whether packet mode can be exited by
++ sending a special sequence of characters.
++
++ Several other commands can be interrupted by pressing any key while
++ they are active. Version 7.0 adds the ability to disable this form of
++ interruption also:
++
++ SET INPUT CANCELLATION { ON, OFF }
++ Whether an INPUT command in progress can be interrupted by
++ pressing a key. Normally ON. Setting INPUT CANCELLATION OFF
++ makes INPUT commands uninterruptible except by Ctrl-C (unless
++ COMMAND INTERRUPTION is also OFF).
++
++ SET SLEEP CANCELLATION { ON, OFF }
++ Whether a SLEEP, PAUSE, or WAIT command in progress can be
++ interrupted by pressing a key. Normally ON. Setting SLEEP
++ CANCELLATION OFF makes these commands uninterruptible except by
++ Ctrl-C (unless COMMAND INTERRUPTION is also OFF). Synonyms: SET
++ PAUSE CANCELLATION, SET WAIT CANCELLATION.
++
++ So to make certain a script is not interruptible by the user, include
++ these commands:
++
++ SET TRANSFER INTERRUPT OFF
++ SET SLEEP CANCELLATION OFF
++ SET INPUT CANCELLATION OFF
++ SET COMMAND INTERRUPTION OFF
++
++ Make sure to turn them back on afterwards if interruption is to be
++ re-enabled.
++
++ When a PAUSE, SLEEP, WAIT, or INPUT command is interrupted from the
++ keyboard, the new variable \v(kbchar) contains a copy of the (first)
++ character that was typed and caused the interruption, provided it was
++ not the command interrupt character (usually Ctrl-C). If these
++ commands complete successfully or time out without a keyboard
++ interruption, the \v(kbchar) variable is empty.
++
++ The \v(kbchar) variable (like any other variable) can be tested with:
++
++ if defined \v(kbchar) command
++
++ The command is executed if the variable is not empty.
++
++ The \v(kbchar) variable can be reset with WAIT 0 (PAUSE 0, SLEEP 0,
++ etc).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.11. Taming The Wild Backslash -- Part Deux
++
++ [358]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition, contains a brief section, "Taming
++ the Wild Backslash", on page 48, which subsequent experience has shown
++ to be inadequate for Kermit users intent on writing scripts that deal
++ with Windows, DOS, and OS/2 filenames, in which backslash (\) is used
++ as the directory separator. This section fills in the blanks.
++
++ 1.11.1. Background
++
++ The Kermit command language shares a certain unavoidable but annoying
++ characteristic with most other command languages that are capable of
++ string replacement, namely the necessity to "quote" certain characters
++ when you want them to be taken literally. This is a consequence of the
++ facts that:
++
++ 1. One or more characters must be set aside to denote replacement,
++ rather than acting as literal text.
++ 2. We have only 96 printable characters to work with in ASCII, which
++ is still the only universally portable character set.
++ 3. There is no single printable character that is unused everywhere.
++ 4. Variables are not restricted to certain contexts, as they are in
++ formal programming languages like C and Fortran, but can appear
++ anywhere at all within a command, and therefore require special
++ syntax.
++
++ Thus there can be conflicts. To illustrate, the standard UNIX shell
++ uses dollar sign ($) to introduce variables. So the shell command:
++
++ echo $TERM
++
++ displays the value of the TERM variable, e.g. vt320. But suppose you
++ want to display a real dollar sign:
++
++ echo The price is $10.20
++
++ This causes the shell to evaluate the variable "$1", which might or
++ might not exist, and substitute its value, e.g.:
++
++ The price is 0.20
++
++ (in this case the $1 variable had no value.) This is probably not what
++ you wanted. To force the dollar sign to be taken literally, you must
++ apply a "quoting rule", such as "precede a character by backslash (\)
++ to force the shell to take the character literally":
++
++ echo The price is \$10.20
++ The price is $10.20
++
++ But now suppose you want the backslash AND the dollar sign to be taken
++ literally:
++
++ echo The price is \\$10.20
++
++ This doesn't work, since the first backslash quotes the second one,
++ thereby leaving the dollar sign unquoted again:
++
++ The price is \0.20
++
++ Quoting the dollar sign requires addition of a third backslash:
++
++ echo The price is \\\$10.20
++ The price is \$10.20
++
++ The first backslash quotes the second one, and the third backslash
++ quotes the dollar sign.
++
++ Every command language -- all UNIX shells, VMS DCL, DOS Batch, AOS/VS
++ CLI, etc etc -- has similar rules. UNIX shell rules are probably the
++ most complicated, since many printable characters -- not just one --
++ are special there: dollar sign, single quote, double quote, backslash,
++ asterisk, accent grave, number sign, ampersand, question mark,
++ parentheses, brackets, braces, etc -- practically every
++ non-alphanumeric character needs some form of quoting if it is to be
++ taken literally. And to add to the confusion, the UNIX shell offers
++ many forms of quoting, and many alternative UNIX shells are available,
++ each using slightly different syntax.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.11.2. Kermit's Quoting Rules
++
++ Kermit's basic quoting rules are simple by comparison (there are, of
++ course, additional syntax requirements for macro definitions, command
++ blocks, function calls, etc, but they are not relevant here).
++
++ The following characters are special in Kermit commands:
++
++ Backslash (\)
++ Introduces a variable, or the numeric representation of a
++ special character, or a function, or other item for
++ substitution. If the backslash is followed by a digit or by any
++ of the following characters:
++
++ x, o, d, m, s, f, v, $, %, &, :, {
++
++ this indicates a special substitution item; otherwise the
++ following character is to be taken literally (exceptions: \ at
++ end of line is taken literally; \n, \b, and \n are special
++ items in the OUTPUT command only).
++
++ Semicolon (;)
++ (Only when at the beginning of a line or preceded by at least
++ one space or tab) Introduces a comment.
++
++ Number sign (#)
++ (Only when at the beginning of a line or preceded by at least
++ one space or tab) Just like semicolon; introduces a comment.
++
++ Question mark (?)
++ (Only at the command prompt - not in command files or macros)
++ Requests context-sensitive help.
++
++ To force Kermit to take any of these characters literally, simply
++ precede it by a backslash (\).
++
++ Sounds easy! And it is, except when backslash also has a special
++ meaning to the underlying operating system, as it does in DOS,
++ Windows, and OS/2, where it serves as the directory separator in
++ filenames such as:
++
++ D:\K95\KEYMAPS\READ.ME
++
++ Using our rule, we would need to refer to this file in Kermit commands
++ as follows:
++
++ D:\\K95\\KEYMAPS\\READ.ME
++
++ But this would not be obvious to new users of Kermit software on DOS,
++ Windows, or OS/2, and it would be annoying to seasoned ones. Thus
++ MS-DOS Kermit and Kermit 95 go to rather extreme lengths to allow the
++ more natural notation, as in:
++
++ send d:\k95\keymaps\read.me
++
++ The reason this is tricky is that we also need to allow for variables
++ and other expressions introduced by backslash in the same command. For
++ example, suppose \%a is a variable whose value is "oofa" (without the
++ quotes). What does the following command do?
++
++ send d:\%a
++
++ Does it send the file named "oofa" in the current directory of the D:
++ disk, or does it send a file named "%a" in the root directory of the
++ D: disk? This is the kind of trouble we get into when we attempt to
++ bend the rules in the interest of user friendliness. (The answer is:
++ if the variable \%a has definition that is the name of an existing
++ file, that file is sent; if a file d:\%a exists, it is sent; otherwise
++ if both conditions are true, the variable takes precedence, and the
++ literal filename can be forced by quoting: \\%a.)
++
++ In Kermit 95 (but not MS-DOS Kermit), we also bend the rules another
++ way by allowing you to use forward slash (/) rather than backslash (\)
++ as the directory separator:
++
++ send d:/k95/keymaps/read.me
++
++ This looks more natural to UNIX users, and in fact is perfectly
++ acceptable to the Windows 95/98/NT and OS/2 operating systems on the
++ API level. BUT (there is always a "but") the Microsoft shell,
++ COMMAND.COM, for Windows 95/98 and NT does not allow this notation,
++ and therefore it can not be used in any Kermit command -- such as RUN
++ -- that invokes the Windows command shell AND your command shell is
++ COMMAND.COM or any other shell that does not allow forward slash as
++ directory separator (some alternative shells do allow this).
++
++ NOTE: There exists a wide variety of alternative shells from third
++ parties that do not have this restriction. If you are using a shell
++ that accepts forward slash as a directory separator, you can stop
++ reading right now -- UNLESS (there is always an "unless") you want
++ your scripts to be portable to systems that have other shells. Also
++ note that some Windows shells might actually REQUIRE forward
++ slashes (instead of backslashes) as directory separators; we do not
++ treat this situation below, but the treatment is obvious -- use
++ slash rather backslash as the directory separator.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.11.3. Passing DOS Filenames from Kermit to Shell Commands
++
++ The following Kermit commands invoke the system command shell:
++
++ RUN (and its synonyms ! and @)
++ REDIRECT
++ PIPE
++
++ Each of these commands takes a shell command as an operand. These
++ shell commands are not, and can not be, parsed by Kermit since Kermit
++ does not know the syntax of shell commands, and so can't tell the
++ difference between a keyword, a filename, a variable, a switch, or
++ other item. Therefore the rules can not be bent since Kermit doesn't
++ know where or how to bend them. To illustrate (using the regular
++ Windows shell):
++
++ run c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe
++
++ works OK, but:
++
++ run c:/windows/command/chkdsk.exe
++
++ is not accepted by COMMAND.COM. But:
++
++ run c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
++
++ results in Kermit applying its quoting rules before sending the text
++ to the shell. Since "w" and "c" are not in the list of backslash-item
++ codes, the backslash means "take the following character literally".
++ Thus, by the time this filename gets to the Windows shell, it has
++ become:
++
++ c:windowscommandchkdsk.exe
++
++ which is probably not what you wanted. (If "w" and "c" were in the
++ list, the results could be even stranger.) Even more confusing is the
++ case where a directory or filename starts with one or more digits:
++
++ run c:\123\lotus.exe
++
++ in which "\123" is the Kermit notation for ASCII character 123, which
++ happens to be left brace ({), resulting in "c:{lotus.exe".
++
++ So when passing filenames to a Windows shell, always use double
++ backslashes as directory separators, to ensure that the shell gets
++ single backslashes:
++
++ run c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe
++ run c:\\123\\lotus.exe
++
++ Similar problems might occur with the built-in EDIT, BROWSE, and FTP
++ commands. These commands result in Kermit building a shell command
++ internally to invoke the associated helper program; the form of this
++ command might conflict with the form demanded by certain alternative
++ shells.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.11.4. Using Variables to Hold DOS Filenames
++
++ Now to the next level. Suppose you want to write a script in which
++ filenames are parameters, and therefore are stored in variables.
++ Example:
++
++ define \%f c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
++ ...
++ run \%f
++
++ Obviously this won't work for the reasons just noted; the RUN command
++ requires directory separators be coded as double backslashes:
++
++ define \%f c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe
++ ...
++ run \%f
++
++ This will work; no surprises here. However, if you had used ASSIGN
++ rather than DEFINE, you might have been surprised after all; review
++ pages 348-349 of [359]Using C-Kermit (2nd Ed) for the difference
++ between DEFINE and ASSIGN.
++
++ We have said that any Kermit 95 or MS-DOS Kermit command that parses
++ filenames itself -- SEND, for example -- does not require double
++ backslashes since it knows it is parsing a filename. So since the
++ following works:
++
++ send c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
++
++ Should the following also work?
++
++ define \%f c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
++ ...
++ send \%f
++
++ Answer: No. Why? Because \%f is evaluated "recursively", to allow for
++ the possibility that its definition contains further variable
++ references. This is true of all "backslash-percent-letter" (or -digit)
++ variables, and also for array references. So \%f becomes
++ c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe, which becomes
++ c:windowscommandchkdsk.exe.
++
++ The trick here is to use the "other" kind of variable, that is
++ evaluated only "one level deep" rather than recursively:
++
++ define filename c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
++ ...
++ send \m(filename)
++
++ Similarly if you want to prompt the user for a filename:
++
++ ask filename { Please type a filename: }
++ Please type a filename: c:\windows\command\chkdsk.exe
++ send \m(filename)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.11.5. Passing DOS Filenames as Parameters to Macros
++
++ Suppose you want to pass a DOS filename containing backslashes as a
++ parameter to a Kermit macro. This raises two issues:
++
++ 1. Parameters to macros are "just text" and so are fully evaluated
++ before they are passed to the macro.
++ 2. Once inside the macro, the formal parameters \%1, \%2, ... \%9 are
++ the type of variable that is evaluated recursively.
++
++ Thus a DOS filename is ruined once in the act of parsing the macro
++ invocation, and again when referring to it from within the macro. To
++ illustrate, suppose "test" is a macro. Then in the invocation:
++
++ test c:\mydir\blah.txt
++
++ "c:mydirblah.txt" is assigned to \%1. However, if we double the
++ backslashes:
++
++ test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt
++
++ "c:\mydir\blah.txt" is assigned to \%1. But then when you refer to \%1
++ in the macro, it is evaluated recursively, resulting in
++ "c:mydirblah.txt". To illustrate:
++
++ define test echo \%1
++ test c:\mydir\blah.txt
++ c:mydirblah.txt
++ test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt
++ c:mydirblah.txt
++ test c:\\\\mydir\\\\blah.txt
++ c:\mydir\blah.txt
++
++ Let's address each part of the problem separately. First, inside the
++ macro. You can use the \fcontents() function to force a
++ backslash-percent variable (such as a macro argument) to be evaluated
++ one level deep instead of recursively, for example:
++
++ define test echo { The filename is "\fcontents(\%1)"}
++
++ test c:\mydir\blah.txt ; We don't expect this to work
++ The filename is "c:mydirblah.txt" ; and it doesn't.
++ test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt ; But this does...
++ The filename is "c:\mydir\blah.txt"
++
++ Thus if the filename arrives inside the macro with single backslashes,
++ the backslashes are preserved if you always refer to the parameter
++ through the \fcontents() function.
++
++ Now how to ensure that backslashes are not stripped or misinterpreted
++ when passing a filename to a macro? This brings us back to what we
++ learned in earlier sections:
++
++ 1. If it is a literal filename, either double the backslashes, or (if
++ the filename is to be used only within Kermit itself and not
++ passed to a DOS shell, or it is to be passed to an alternative
++ shell that accepts forward slash as a directory separator), use
++ forward slash instead of backslash as the directory separator.
++ 2. If it is a variable that contains a filename, make sure you use a
++ macro-style variable name, rather than a
++ backslash-percent-character name.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ define test echo \fcontents(\%1)
++ define filename c:\mydir\blah.txt
++
++ test c:\\mydir\\blah.txt ; Literal filename with double backslashes
++ c:\mydir\blah.txt
++
++ test c:/mydir/blah.txt ; Literal filename with forward slashes
++ c:/mydir/blah.txt
++
++ test \m(filename) ; Variable
++ c:\mydir\blah.txt
++
++ But what if you don't like these rules and you still want to pass a
++ literal filename containing single backslashes to a macro? This is
++ possible too, but a bit tricky: turn command quoting off before
++ invoking the macro, and then turn it back on inside the macro.
++ Example:
++
++ define test set command quoting on, echo \fcontents(\%1)
++
++ set command quoting off
++ test c:\mydir\blah.txt
++ c:\mydir\blah.txt
++
++ Upon return from the macro, command quoting is back on (since the
++ macro turned it on).
++
++ Obviously this trick can not be used if the filename is stored in a
++ variable, since it prevents the variable from being evaluated.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.11.6. Passing DOS File Names from Macro Parameters to the DOS Shell
++
++ Now suppose you need to pass a DOS filename to a macro, and the macro
++ needs to pass it, in turn, to the Windows shell via (say) Kermit's RUN
++ command. This works too:
++
++ define xrun run \fcontents(\%1)
++ xrun c:\\windows\\command\\chkdsk.exe
++
++ (or you can use the SET COMMAND QUOTING OFF / ON technique described
++ above to avoid the double backslashes.) But..
++
++ xrun c:/windows/command/chkdsk.exe
++
++ does not work if the Windows shell does not recognize "/" as a
++ directory separator. If there is a chance that a filename might be
++ passed to the macro in this form, the macro will need to convert it to
++ a form acceptable to the shell:
++
++ define xrun run \freplace(\fcontents(\%1),/,\\)
++
++ Here we replace all occurrences (if any) of "/" in the argument with
++ "\" prior to issuing the RUN command. Of course, in order to specify
++ "\" as a literal character in the \freplace() argument list, we have
++ to double it.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.11.7. Passing DOS Filenames to Kermit from the Shell
++
++ As noted in the manual, the \&@[] array contains Kermit's command-line
++ arguments. Suppose one of these arguments, say \&@[3], is a DOS
++ filename such as C:\FOO\BAR\BAZ\OOFA.TXT. (Note: In C-Kermit 7.0 and
++ K95 1.1.18 and later, command-line arguments after "=" or "--" are
++ also available in the top-level \%1..9 variables; see [360]Section
++ 7.5.)
++
++ Of course you can eliminate any problems by using forward slashes
++ rather than backslashes in the filename, but sometimes this is not
++ possible, as when the Kermit command line is being generated by
++ another program than can only generate "native" format DOS filenames.
++
++ As noted in the manual, "\%x" variables and \&x[] arrays are always
++ evaluated "all the way" (recursively). If the contents of one of these
++ variables contains backslashes, this causes another level of
++ evaluation.
++
++ There is another kind of variable, which is evaluated only "one level
++ deep". You can use this to prevent interpretation of the backslashes
++ in the filenames. Example:
++
++ assign filename \fcontents(\&@[3]) ; Transfer contents
++ ...
++ send \m(filename)
++
++ Or, more simply:
++
++ send \fcontents(\&@[3])
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.12. Debugging
++
++ The debug log is produced when you give a "log debug" command. This is
++ normally done at the request of the Kermit help desk, for forwarding
++ to the Kermit developers for analysis as a last resort in
++ troubleshooting problems. (Last resort because it can grow quite huge
++ in a very short time.) In cases where timing information is critical
++ to understanding a problem, you can tell C-Kermit to put a timestamp
++ on each debug log line by giving the command:
++
++ SET DEBUG TIMESTAMP ON
++
++ At any time before or after activating the debug log (SET DEBUG
++ TIMESTAMP OFF turns off timestamping). Timestamps can be turned off
++ and on as desired while logging. Obviously, they increase the size and
++ growth rate of the log significantly, and so should be used sparingly.
++ Timestamps are of the form hh:mm:ss.xxx, where .xxx is thousands of a
++ second (but is included only on platforms that include this feature).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.13. Logs
++
++ In UNIX C-Kermit and in K-95, you can now direct any log to a pipe.
++ This not only lets you send your logs to places other than disk files,
++ but also lets you customize them to any desired degree.
++
++ LOG { DEBUG, PACKETS, SESSION, TRANSACTION, CONNECTION } { file, pipe
++ } ...
++ A "pipe" is the name of a command, preceded by a vertical bar.
++ If the pipe contains any spaces, it must be enclosed in braces.
++
++ Here are some examples for UNIX (always remember the importance of
++ getting the UNIX shell quoting rules right):
++
++ LOG TRANSACTIONS |lpr
++ This sends the transaction log to the default UNIX printer,
++ rather than to a file (use "lp" rather than "lpr" if
++ necessary).
++
++ LOG TRANSACTIONS {| myfilter > t.log}
++ For those who don't like the format of the transaction log, or
++ want to extract certain information from it; write your own
++ output filter.
++
++ LOG SESSION {| lpr -Plaserwriter}
++ This sends the session log to a specific UNIX printer, rather
++ than to a file. Note the braces around the pipeline. These are
++ required because it contains spaces.
++
++ LOG DEBUG {| tail -100 > debug.log}
++ This causes the debug log file to contain only the final 100
++ lines. Suppose C-Kermit crashes under some unpredictable
++ circumstances, and you need a debug log to catch it in the act.
++ But the debug log can grow to huge proportions very quickly,
++ possibly filling up the disk. Piping the debug log through
++ "tail" results in keeping only the last 100 lines (or other
++ number of your choice).
++
++ LOG DEBUG {| grep "^TELNET" > debug.log}
++ This one shows how to log only Telnet negotiations. Piping the
++ debug log through grep or egrep lets you log only specific
++ information, rather than everything. "man grep" for further
++ info.
++
++ LOG DEBUG {| gzip -c > debug.log.gz}
++ Creates a full debug log, but compressed by gzip to save space.
++
++ LOG PACKETS {| tr "\\01" "X" | cut -c9- > packet.log}
++ This one writes the regular packet log, but translates the
++ Ctrl-A that starts each packet to the letter "X" and removes
++ the s-nn-nn- notation from the beginning of each line. Note the
++ double backslash (normal Kermit quoting rules). "man tr" and
++ "man cut" for further info.
++
++ See [361]Section 2.12 for information about the new connection log.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.14. Automatic File-Transfer Packet Recognition at the Command Prompt
++
++ Beginning in version 7.0, C-Kermit can recognize Kermit (and in some
++ cases also Zmodem) file-transfer packets while at its command prompt.
++ This is convenient (for example), if you escaped back from a remote
++ Kermit program and told the local Kermit program to send a file, but
++ forgot to tell the remote Kermit program to receive it (and the local
++ Kermit did not have the "send a Kermit receive command" feature
++ available). This feature is controlled by the following command:
++
++ SET COMMAND AUTODOWNLOAD { ON, OFF }
++ When ON, which is the default, the command parser recognizes
++ Kermit packets when Kermit is in remote mode. An S packet makes
++ it go into receive mode, an I packet makes it go into server
++ mode. When OFF, packet recognition is disabled and the behavior
++ when a packet is received at the command prompt is as it was in
++ C-Kermit 6.1 and earlier (namely to print an error message).
++
++ COMMAND AUTODOWNLOAD is the command-mode equivalent of TERMINAL
++ AUTODOWNLOAD, which is effective during CONNECT mode.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.15. The TYPE Command
++
++ The TYPE command now accepts a selection of optional switches
++ ([362]Section 1.5), and also sets several variables.
++
++ Syntax: TYPE [ switches... ] filename
++
++ Variables:
++
++ \v(ty_ln)
++ Line number of current line (during TYPE command; see /PREFIX)
++
++ \v(ty_lc)
++ Line count of file most recently TYPEd.
++
++ \v(ty_mc)
++ Match count of file most recently TYPEd (see /MATCH).
++
++ Switches:
++
++ /PAGE
++ If /PAGE is included, Kermit pauses at the end of each
++ screenful and issues a "more?" prompt. You may press the space
++ bar to view the next page (screenful), or press "q" or "n" to
++ return to the C-Kermit prompt. If this switch is given, it
++ overrides the COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING setting for this command
++ only. If it is not given, paging is according to COMMAND
++ MORE-PROMPTING.
++
++ /NOPAGE
++ Do not pause at the end of each screenful; show the whole file
++ (or all selected lines) at once. If this switch is given, it
++ overrides the COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING setting for this command
++ only. If it is not given, paging is according to COMMAND
++ MORE-PROMPTING.
++
++ /HEAD[:n]
++ Only show the first n lines of the file (where n is a number).
++ If n is omitted, 10 is used.
++
++ /TAIL[:n]
++ Only show the last n lines of the file (where n is a number).
++ If nis omitted, 10 is used. Note: /HEAD and /TAIL can't be
++ combined; if you give both switches, only the most recent one
++ is used.
++
++ /MATCH:pattern
++ Only type lines from the file that match the given pattern (see
++ [363]Section 4.9.1 for pattern notation). UNIX users familiar
++ with grep should note a significant difference: there is no
++ implied "*" at the beginning and end of the pattern. Thus:
++
++ TYPE /MATCH:foo Lists lines whose entire contents are "foo".
++ TYPE /MATCH:foo* Lists lines that start with "foo".
++ TYPE /MATCH:*foo Lists lines that end with "foo".
++ TYPE /MATCH:*foo* Lists lines that have "foo" anywhere in them.
++
++ /HEAD and /TAIL apply after /MATCH, so "type /tail:20
++ /match:x*" shows the last 20 lines in the file that start with
++ "x".
++
++ /PREFIX:string
++ Print the given string at the beginning of each line. The
++ string may be a constant, a variable, or a quoted variable. If
++ it's an unquoted variable, its value at the time the TYPE
++ command was given is used as a constant. If it is a quoted
++ variable, it is re-evaluated for each line; a useful variable
++ for this context is \v(ty_ln) (the line number of the current
++ line being typed). If the prefix is to include spaces, it must
++ be enclosed in braces. Examples:
++
++ type /prefix:{oofa.txt: } /match:*thing* oofa.txt
++ Prints all lines in oofa.txt that contain "thing" with
++ the filename itself as the prefix (similar to UNIX grep).
++
++ type /prefix:{\v(time). } oofa.txt
++ Prefixes each line of oofa.txt with the time at which the
++ TYPE command was given (one backslash)
++
++ type /prefix:{\\v(time). } oofa.txt
++ Prefixes each line of oofa.txt with the time at which
++ that line is being typed (two backslashes).
++
++ type /prefix:{\\v(ty_ln). } oofa.txt
++ Prefixes each line of oofa.txt with its line number.
++
++ type /prefix:{\\flpad(\\v(ty_ln),4). } oofa.txt
++ Same as the previous example, except the line number is
++ right-adjusted in a 4-column field.
++
++ /WIDTH[:n]
++ Truncates each line at column n (which must be a number) prior
++ to printing it. This option can be used for long lines when you
++ don't want them to wrap. If nis omitted, your current screen
++ width is used.
++
++ /COUNT
++ Counts lines and -- if /MATCH was included, matches -- but does
++ not print any lines from the file. The line and match count is
++ shown at the end, and the variables \v(ty_lc) and \v(ty_lm) are
++ set accordingly.
++
++ SET OPTIONS TYPE { /PAGE, /NOPAGE, /WIDTH:n }
++ Sets the paging default for TYPE commands, which can be
++ overridden in any particular TYPE command by including the
++ desired switch.
++
++ If a TYPE command is given with no switch, and no SET OPTIONS TYPE
++ selection is in effect, paging is according to your COMMAND
++ MORE-PROMPTING setting (SHOW COMMAND).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.16. The RESET Command
++
++ The RESET command, added in 7.0, closes all open files and logs, but
++ does not affect the open connection (if any).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.17. The COPY and RENAME Commands
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, in the UNIX version only, the COPY and RENAME
++ commands are built in and do not call the underlying platform's COPY
++ or RENAME command. This allows them to work in "NOPUSH" versions and
++ other circumstances where it can't access system commands, and it
++ allows file copying and renaming to be done portably in scripts. The
++ characteristics of the built-in COPY or RENAME include:
++ * It fails if the source file is a directory or is wild or lacks
++ read access.
++ * It fails if the source file is the destination file.
++ * It allows the destination file to be a directory, in which case
++ the source file is copied (or renamed) into it with the same name.
++ * It overwrites an existing destination file if its permission
++ allows.
++ * It sets the new file's permission according to umask but also
++ carries forward the source file's execute permission bits if the
++ destination file did not already exist.
++ * It fails if interrupted by Ctrl-C.
++ * Upon error, it prints an appropriate message.
++ * It returns standardized error codes that can be tested by IF
++ SUCCESS / FAIL.
++
++ These commands now also accept the following switches:
++
++ /LIST (/LOG, /VERBOSE) = Print "file1 => file2 (OK)" (or error message).
++ /NOLIST (/NOLOG, /QUIET) = Don't print anything (except error messages).
++
++ /NOLIST is the default.
++
++ The same built-in code is used by the UNIX C-Kermit server to execute
++ REMOTE COPY commands (except in this case no switches are available).
++
++ The COPY command also accepts the following additional switches. When
++ any of these are given (and they can be used in any combination except
++ /SWAP and /APPEND), some of the checks listed above are relaxed, and
++ thus it might be possible to get into trouble in certain cases, e.g.
++ when the source and target files are the same file:
++
++ /APPEND = Append source file to destination file.
++ /SWAP-BYTES = Swap bytes (see [364]Section 6.6.5).
++ /FROMB64 = Decode the source file from Base64 encoding.
++ /TOB64 = Encode the target file in Base64.
++
++ Base64 is the encoding commonly used for enclosures in Internet email.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.18. The MANUAL Command
++
++ The MANUAL command can be used to access the appropriate Kermit manual
++ or other manual. The general syntax is:
++
++ MANUAL [ string ]
++ If the string is omitted, C-Kermit asks the underlying system
++ to access the C-Kermit manual using whatever method is
++ appropriate for the system.
++
++ The specific action depends on the system. In UNIX, a "man" command is
++ issued; "kermit" is the default argument but other manual topics may
++ be specified. If the "man" command allows index or string searching,
++ the appropriate syntax may be included.
++
++ In Kermit 95, the MANUAL command brings up the HTML online K95 manual.
++
++ In VMS and elsewhere, "man" is simply translated to "help", with a
++ default argument of "kermit"; other and/or additional arguments may be
++ included according to the definition of the system's "help" command.
++
++ Correct operation of the "man" command in C-Kermit depends on the
++ appropriate man page or help topic having been installed in the right
++ place with the right permissions and format.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.19. String and Filename Matching Patterns
++
++ A pattern is a string that includes special notation for matching
++ classes or sequences of characters. C-Kermit 7.0 / K95 1.1.19 supports
++ patterns in several places:
++
++ * Filenames ([365]Section 4.9)
++ * SWITCH case labels ([366]Section 7.18)
++ * The new IF MATCH statement ([367]Section 7.4)
++ * TYPE /MATCH ([368]Section 1.15)
++ * SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS and BINARY-PATTERNS ([369]Section 4.3)
++ * The \fsearch() and \farraylook() functions ([370]Sections 7.3 and
++ [371]7.10.7)
++ * The \fpattern() function used with [M,RE]INPUT ([372]Section 7.1)
++
++ Patterns are also called wildcards, especially when used for filename
++ matching. C-Kermit's pattern syntax is explained in [373]Section
++ 4.9.1, and also by the HELP WILDCARDS command.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.20. Multiple Commands on One Line
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, commands can be grouped together on one line by
++ separating the commands with commas and enclosing the list in braces.
++ For example:
++
++ C-Kermit> { echo One, echo Two, echo Three }
++ C-Kermit> do { echo One, echo Two, echo Three }
++
++ Command lists can be nested:
++
++ [ do ] { echo One, echo Two, if true { echo A, echo B}, echo Three }
++
++ and the END command works as it does in macros:
++
++ [ do ] { echo One, echo Two, if true end, echo Three }
++
++ The "one line" stricture is, of course, pliant to line-continuation
++ conventions, namely that lines ending in hyphen (-) or left brace ({)
++ are to be continued. Thus the first example can also be rendered:
++
++ [ do ] {
++ echo One
++ echo Two
++ echo Three
++ }
++
++ (the "do" is optional).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.21. What Do I Have?
++
++ C-Kermit can be built for hundreds of different platforms with
++ practically countless configuration options. Certain commands might
++ not be available in certain configurations, etc. Even on the same
++ platform, different builds are possible: "maximum functionality",
++ "minimum size", "maximum performance", and so on. You can find out a
++ lot about the configuration of your C-Kermit program with the SHOW
++ FEATURES command. Of course, a lot of what it says, especially in the
++ bottom part, might seem like gibberish, but can be deciphered with a
++ Rosetta Stone (such as the C-Kermit source or the [374]ckccfg.txt
++ file). In any case, the output from SHOW FEATURES might easily explain
++ why some expected feature is missing, or some buffer is smaller than
++ expected. Here's a sample of the bottom section for the SunOS version:
++
++C-Kermit 7.0.196, 1 Jan 2000
++
++Major optional features included:
++ Network support (type SHOW NET for further info)
++ Telnet Kermit Option
++ Hardware flow control
++ External XYZMODEM protocol support
++ Latin-1 (West European) character-set translation
++ Latin-2 (East European) character-set translation
++ Cyrillic (Russian, Ukrainian, etc) character-set translation
++ Greek character-set translation
++ Hebrew character-set translation
++ Japanese character-set translation
++ Unicode character-set translation
++ Pseudoterminal control
++ REDIRECT command
++ RESEND command
++ Fullscreen file transfer display
++ Control-character unprefixing
++ Streaming
++ Autodownload
++
++Major optional features not included:
++ No Kerberos(TM) authentication
++ No SRP(TM) (Secure Remote Password) protocol
++ No Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) protocol
++ No Transport Layer Security (TLS) protocol
++ No encryption
++ No X Windows forwarding
++
++Host info:
++ Machine: sun4m
++ Model: (unknown)
++ OS: SunOS
++ OS Release: 4.1.3_U1
++ OS Version: 4
++
++Target: sunos41gsc
++GCC version: 2.7.2
++Compiled Dec 31 1999 10:38:54, options:
++ __GNUC__ __STDC__ _POSIX_JOB_CONTROL _SC_JOB_CONTROL ARRAYREFLEN=1024 BIGBUFOK
++ BROWSER BSD4 CK_ANSIC CK_APC CK_AUTODL CK_CURSES CK_DNS_SRV CK_ENVIRONMENT
++ CK_FAST CK_LOGIN CK_MKDIR CK_NAWS CK_PCT_BAR CK_PERMS CK_RECALL CK_RTSCTS
++ CK_SPEED CK_TIMERS CK_TMPDIR CK_TTGWSIZ CK_TTYFD CK_WREFRESH CKEXEC
++ CKFLOAT=double CKGHNLHOST ckmaxfiles=64 CKMAXOPEN=64 CKMAXPATH=1023 CKREALPATH
++ CKREGEX CKSYSLOG CKTUNING CMDBL=32763 CMDDEP=64 CONGSPD DCMDBUF DIRENT DYNAMIC
++ FNFLOAT FORDEPTH=32 GFTIMER HADDRLIST HDBUUCP IFDEBUG IKS_OPTION IKSDB
++ IKSDCONF INBUFSIZE=32768 INPBUFSIZ=4096 MAC_MAX=16384 MACLEVEL=128 MAXDDIR=32
++ MAXDNUMS=4095 MAXGETPATH=128 MAXTAKE=54 MAXWLD=102400 MSENDMAX=1024 NETCMD
++ NETCONN NETPTY NOKVERBS NOSETBUF OBUFSIZE=32768 PARSENSE PATTERNS PIPESEND
++ RENAME RLOGCODE SAVEDUID SELECT SIG_V SOL_SOCKET sparc STREAMING sun SUNOS4
++ SYSTIMEH TCPSOCKET TIMEH TLOG TNCODE TTLEBUF TTSPDLIST UIDBUFLEN=256 UNIX
++ UNPREFIXZERO USE_LSTAT USE_MEMCPY VNAML=4096 WHATAMI XFRCAN Z_MAXCHAN=46
++ z_maxchan=46 ZXREWIND
++
++ byte order: big endian
++
++ sizeofs: int=4 long=4 short=2 char=1 char*=4 float=4 double=8
++
++ floating-point: precision=16 rounding=1
++
++ Without going into detail about what all the notation means, notice a
++ couple things:
++
++ * The Options section shows symbols ("macros") in effect during
++ compilation, together with their values (for those that have
++ values). The options are listed in alphabetical order to make any
++ particular option easier to find.
++ * MAXWLD is the maximum number of files that a wildcard can expand
++ to.
++ * Anything starting with "NO" is a feature (or something other than
++ a feature) that has been deliberately "compiled out", or omitted.
++ * Important items for script writers include: CMDBL=32763 (the size
++ of the command buffer and therefore the maximum length for a macro
++ or variable definition; CMDDEP=64 (the limit on recursion depth);
++ FORDEPTH=32 (the nesting limit on FOR loops); INBUFSIZE=32768 (the
++ size of the INPUT command circular buffer); MAC_MAX=16384 (the
++ maximum number of macros), etc.
++
++ See the [375]ckccfg.txt file for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22. Generalized File Input and Output
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds a new generalized I/O system for stream files,
++ augmenting (and to some extent, overlapping with) the older OPEN,
++ READ, WRITE, and CLOSE commands. In the new file i/o system, which can
++ be used simultaneously with the old one, all commands are grouped
++ together under the new FILE keyword, and some related functions and
++ variables are added.
++
++ 1.22.1. Why Another I/O System?
++
++ The well-known LOG, OPEN, READ, WRITE, and CLOSE commands have the
++ following restrictions:
++
++ 1. Only one READ file and one WRITE file can be open at a time.
++ 2. The READ and WRITE commands are strictly line oriented.
++ 3. These commands can not be used with binary files.
++ 4. They do not support read/write access or random access.
++ 5. The syntax is a bit counterintuitive for programmers.
++
++ The new file i/o system allows multiple files to be open at once, in
++ any desired combination of modes (read/write/append) supported by the
++ operating system, for line, block (record), or character i/o, for
++ sequential or random access, using consistent syntax and conventions.
++
++ The new system, however, does not replace the old one, since the old
++ system still must be used for:
++
++ 1. The session, packet, debug, transaction, and connection logs.
++ 2. Reading and writing commands rather than files.
++ 3. Existing scripts.
++
++ The new system works only with regular files, not with commands or
++ pipes or mailboxes or pseudoterminals. No special provisions are made
++ in the FILE commands for handling devices or network connections, nor
++ for preventing you from trying to open them; if the underlying
++ operating system treats them like regular stream disk files, the FILE
++ commands (except, of course SEEK, REWIND, and COUNT) might work with
++ them. (In C programming terms, the FILE commands are, at present,
++ nothing more than a front end to fopen() / fread() / fwrite() /
++ fclose() and friends, which are a portable API to sequential files,
++ but this might change in the future for platforms like VMS and VOS
++ that have more complicated file systems.)
++
++ Definitions:
++
++ Channel
++ A number assigned to a file when it is opened, by which it must
++ be referred to in all input/output operations.
++
++ Read/Write Pointer
++ The current position in an open file, expressed as the 0-based
++ byte count from the beginning.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22.2. The FILE Command
++
++ FILE keyword [ switches ] channel [ data ]
++ The keyword specifies the function: FILE OPEN, FILE READ, FILE
++ WRITE, FILE CLOSE, etc. For convenience (and for familiarity to
++ C programmers), the two-word FILE commands can be shortened to
++ the single words FOPEN, FREAD, FWRITE, FCLOSE, and so on.
++ Switches are optional, and modify or amplify the requested file
++ function.
++
++ As in C, Fortran, and other programming languages, open files are
++ referred to by "channels", integers such as 0, 1, 2, 3, and so on. A
++ channel number is assigned when you open a file. The number of
++ available channels depends on the underlying operating system, and can
++ be seen in the variable:
++
++ \v(f_max)
++
++ or by giving the FILE LIST (FLIST) command. Channels are discussed in
++ greater detail in [376]Section 1.22.4.
++
++ FILE command errors can be caught with IF FAIL after the FILE command.
++ In addition, the \v(f_error) variable is set to the completion code of
++ the command: 0 if no error, or a negative number if there was an
++ error. The error codes are listed in [377]Section 1.22.5.
++
++ The command to open a file is:
++
++ FILE OPEN [ switches ] variable filename
++ Opens a file for the type of access specified by the switches,
++ or for read-only access if no switches are given. Upon success,
++ a channel number is assigned to this file and stored in the
++ given variable so you can refer to the open file in subsequent
++ i/o commands. If the file can not be opened, the FILE OPEN
++ command fails. Synonym: FOPEN.
++
++ The FILE OPEN switches are:
++
++ /READ
++ Open the file for read access. If no switches are given, /READ
++ is assumed. If the file does not exist or can't be opened for
++ read access, the FILE OPEN command fails.
++
++ /WRITE
++ Allow writing. If a file of the same name already exists, it is
++ overwritten unless /READ or /APPEND is also included. If a file
++ of the given name does not exist, it is created.
++
++ /APPEND
++ Equivalent to /WRITE, except that if the file exists, it is not
++ destroyed. The read/write pointer is set to the end of the
++ file, so unless you change it with FILE SEEK or REWIND (see
++ below), the first FILE WRITE command adds to the end of the
++ file, preserving what was there already. If /WRITE is also
++ given, it is ignored.
++
++ /BINARY
++ Open the file in "binary" mode, rather than text mode. This
++ switch is meaningless (but still can be used) in UNIX. In VMS,
++ Windows, and OS/2, it inhibits end-of-line processing and
++ conversion, and so should be used for binary files and/or files
++ that are to be accessed in record or character mode rather than
++ line by line.
++
++ The variable for the channel number can be any kind of variable: the
++ \%x kind, a macro name, or an array element. But it must be a
++ variable, not a number -- C-Kermit assigns the channel number; you
++ can't tell it what number to use.
++
++ Example:
++
++ FILE OPEN \%c oofa.txt ; Open oofa.txt for reading.
++ IF FAIL exit 1 Can't open oofa.txt ; Always check to see if it worked.
++ ECHO oofa.txt: channel = \%c
++
++ If the file oofa.txt is opened successfully, a channel number is
++ assigned to the variable \%c. Here's another example using a macro
++ name for the channel number:
++
++ FILE OPEN channel oofa.txt ; Open oofa.txt for reading.
++ IF SUCCESS ECHO oofa.txt: channel = \m(channel)
++
++ Switches can be combined when it makes sense and the underlying
++ operating system allows it. For example, to open a file in binary mode
++ for reading and writing (sometimes called "update"):
++
++ FILE OPEN /READ /WRITE /BINARY \%c budget.db
++
++ Some combinations might be allowed, others not. For example /READ
++ /APPEND will usually not be allowed. /WRITE /APPEND is treated as
++ /APPEND.
++
++ A major advantage of the new system over the older one is that you can
++ have multiple files open at once. Suppose, for example, that you want
++ to open all the files in a certain directory at once:
++
++ .\%n := \ffiles(/usr/olga*,&f) ; Get file list into array.
++ if ( > \%n \v(f_max) ) { ; Make sure there aren't too many.
++ exit 1 {\v(dir): \%n = Too many files}
++ }
++ declare \&c[\%n] ; Make array for channel numbers.
++ for \%i 1 \%n 1 { ; Loop to open every file...
++ file open \&c[\%i] \&f[\%i] ; Try to open this one
++ if fail exit 1 Open error: \&f[\%i] ; Check for failure
++ }
++
++ If this loop completes successfully, the \&c[] array will contain \%n
++ channel numbers of open files in elements 1 through \%n.
++
++ Any file that you open with FILE OPEN stays open until Kermit exits,
++ or you close it explicitly. The command to close a file is:
++
++ FILE CLOSE { ALL, channel }
++ If a channel number is given and the channel refers to an open
++ file, the file is closed and the channel is freed for reuse; if
++ the channel does not refer to an open file, an error message is
++ printed and the command fails. If ALL is specified instead of a
++ specific channel, all files opened with FILE OPEN are closed
++ and if all open files were closed successfully (even if no
++ files were open), the command succeeds; if any open file could
++ not be closed, the command fails; however, all open files that
++ could be closed are still closed. Synonym: FCLOSE.
++
++ FILE CLOSE might fail because, for example, the disk filled up or a
++ quota was exceeded. Example:
++
++ fopen /write \%c new.txt ; Open new.txt for writing.
++ if fail exit 1 ; Check for error.
++ fclose \%c ; Close the file we just opened.
++
++ This creates a 0-length file called new.txt.
++
++ Note that FILE OPEN /WRITE (without /READ or /APPEND) always creates a
++ new file, and therefore destroys any file with the same name that
++ might already exist (assuming you have permission to delete it). To
++ avoid overwriting existing files, simply check first:
++
++ if exist new.txt exit 1 {Fatal - new.txt already exists}
++ fopen /write \%c new.txt
++ if fail ...
++
++ The next two commands give information about open files:
++
++ FILE STATUS channel
++ Tells the name of the file, if any, open on the given channel
++ and the switches it was opened with. The read/write pointer is
++ also shown; this is where the next read or write will occur;
++ "[EOF]" is shown if the current position in the open file is
++ the end -- i.e. the next read will fail if the file was opened
++ in /READ mode; the next write will add material to the end. The
++ current line number (0-based) is also shown if known. The FILE
++ STATUS command succeeds if the channel is open, and fails if
++ there is no open file on the given channel, or if the channel
++ number is invalid or out of range. Synonym: FSTATUS.
++
++ FILE LIST
++ Lists the channel number and name of each open file, along with
++ its OPEN modes (R, W, A, B, RW, etc) and its current read/write
++ pointer or "[EOF]" if it is at the end. Also tells the number
++ of files currently opened with FILE OPEN, plus the maximum
++ number of open files allowed by the system and the maximum
++ number allowed for FILE OPEN. Synonym: FLIST.
++
++ Next come the commands for reading and writing files:
++
++ FILE READ [ switches ] channel [ variable ]
++ Reads data from the file on the given channel number into the
++ variable, if one was given; if no variable was given, the
++ result is printed on the screen. IMPORTANT: The variable should
++ normally be a macro name rather than a \%x or \&x[] variable if
++ you want backslash characters in the file to be taken literally
++ (see pp.408-412 of [378]Using C-Kermit for an explanation; you
++ can also read into a \%x or \&x[] variable, but then you must
++ remember to protect future references to by \fcontents() if you
++ don't want C-Kermit to process any backslashes it might
++ contain). The desired amount of data (according to the
++ switches) is read from the file at the current read/write
++ pointer, and upon completion the read/write position is updated
++ to first byte after the data that was read, no matter what
++ switches were given. Synonym: FREAD.
++
++ FILE WRITE [ switches ] channel text
++ Writes the given text to the file on the given channel number.
++ The text, of course, can be literal text or a variable, or any
++ combination. If the text might contain leading or trailing
++ spaces, it must be enclosed in braces if you want to preserve
++ them. Synonym: FWRITE.
++
++ Before proceeding, a caution about the NUL character. C-Kermit is so
++ named because it is a Kermit program written in the C language. In C,
++ character strings are represented as a sequence of non-NUL bytes
++ terminated by a NUL byte (a byte in which all bits are 0). Thus a C
++ string can not contain NUL bytes; it always ends with the first NUL
++ byte. C-Kermit variables are implemented as C strings and therefore
++ can't contain NUL bytes either, so the FILE READ and FILE WRITE
++ commands do not handle files or strings that contain NUL bytes, except
++ when the /CHARACTER switch is included with the FILE READ or WRITE
++ command, or when /LPAD:0 or /RPAD:0 is given with the FILE WRITE
++ command; these switches are explained below.
++
++ Also note that Kermit can not be used read or write binary numbers in
++ the machine's internal format (integer or floating-point); in general,
++ numbers can be processed only when represented as numeric or
++ floating-point strings.
++
++ FILE READ switches are:
++
++ /LINE
++ Specifies that a line of text is to be read. A line is defined
++ according to the underlying operating system's text-file
++ format. For example, in UNIX a line is a sequence of characters
++ up to and including a linefeed, or the end of the file, which
++ ever comes first. The line terminator (if any) is removed
++ before assigning the text to the variable. If no switches are
++ included with the FILE READ command, /LINE is assumed. Normally
++ this switch should not be used with files opened in /BINARY
++ mode (but nothing prevents it either).
++
++ /SIZE:number
++ Specifies that the given number of bytes (characters) is to be
++ read. The actual number of bytes returned will be less if the
++ end of file is reached (or a NUL byte is encountered). For
++ example, if a file is 514 bytes long, FILE READ /SIZE:512
++ returns 512 bytes the first time and 2 bytes the second time.
++ FILE READ /SIZE provides a kind of "record i/o" for files that
++ do not necessarily contain lines. The resulting block of
++ characters is assigned to the variable without any editing.
++ Synonym: /BLOCK.
++
++ /CHARACTER
++ Equivalent to /SIZE:1. If FILE READ /CHAR succeeds but the
++ variable is empty, this indicates a NUL byte was read. Synonym:
++ BYTE.
++
++ FILE WRITE switches are:
++
++ /LINE
++ Specifies that an appropriate line terminator is to be added to
++ the end of the text. If no switches are included, /LINE is
++ assumed.
++
++ /SIZE:number
++ Specifies that the given number of bytes (characters) is to be
++ written. If the given text is longer than the requested size,
++ it is truncated; if is shorter, it is padded according /LPAD
++ and /RPAD switches. Synonym: /BLOCK.
++
++ /LPAD[:value]
++ If /SIZE was given, but the text is shorter than the requested
++ size, the text is padded on the left with sufficient copies of
++ the character whose ASCII value is given to write the given
++ length. If no value is specified, 32 (the code for Space) is
++ used. The value can also be 0 to write the indicated number of
++ NUL bytes. If /SIZE was not given, this switch is ignored.
++
++ /RPAD[:value]
++ Like LPAD, but pads on the right.
++
++ /CHARACTER
++ Specifies that one character should be written. If the text is
++ empty or not given, a NUL character is written; otherwise the
++ first character of text is given. Synonym: /BYTE.
++
++ /STRING
++ Specifies that the text is to be written as-is, with no
++ terminator added.
++
++ Here's an example in which we copy a text file line by line:
++
++ file open /read \%c oofa.txt ; Open input file
++ if fail exit 1 Can't open input file ; Check that it's open
++ file open /write \%d new.txt ; Open output file
++ if fail exit 1 Can't open output file ; Check
++ while true { ; Loop to copy lines
++ file read /line \%c line ; Read a line
++ if fail break ; Assume failure = end of file
++ file write /line \%d {\m(line)} ; Write the line to output file
++ if fail exit 1 Write failure ; Failure here is fatal
++ }
++ file close \%c ; Close the two files
++ file close \%d
++
++ Note that since /LINE is the default for both FILE READ and FILE
++ WRITE, it can be omitted as in the following example, where we also
++ use the short names for the FILE commands.
++
++ fopen /read \%c oofa.txt ; Open input file
++ if fail exit 1 Can't open input file ; Check that it's open
++ fopen /write \%d new.txt ; Open output file
++ if fail exit 1 Can't open output file ; Check
++ while true { ; Loop to copy lines
++ fread \%c line ; Read a line
++ if fail break ; Assume failure = end of file
++ fwrite \%d {\m(line)} ; Write the line to output file
++ if fail exit 1 Write failure ; Failure here is fatal
++ }
++ fclose \%c ; Close the two files
++ fclose \%d
++
++ Here's the same example using "record i/o" (the open and close
++ sequences are are omitted since they are the same as above). The
++ result is the same, but execution is much faster:
++
++ while true { ; Loop to copy blocks
++ fread /size:512 \%c block ; Read a block into \%a
++ if fail break ; Assume failure = end of file
++ fwrite /string \%d {\m(block)} ; Write the block to output file
++ if fail exit 1 Write failure ; Failure here is fatal
++ }
++
++ Although record i/o is faster, it should not be used in line-oriented
++ applications, since it returns arbitrary chunks of the file to your
++ script, rather than lines. In this example, FWRITE /STRING is used
++ rather than FWRITE /SIZE:512 to avoid the last output block being
++ padded beyond the original file's length.
++
++ A file can also be copied character by character, but this is much
++ slower than line i/o and VERY much slower than block i/o:
++
++ while true { ; Loop to copy blocks
++ fread /char \%c c ; Read a character into c
++ if fail break ; Assume failure = end of file
++ fwrite /char \%d {\m(c)} ; Write character to output file
++ if fail exit 1 Write failure ; Failure is fatal
++ }
++
++ Although character i/o is slow, it is the only way to process files
++ that contain NUL characters (i.e. bytes composed of only zero bits).
++ In the example above, when "fread /char \%c c" returns a NUL, the c
++ variable is empty. But since the FREAD /CHAR command did not fail, we
++ know the result was really a NUL. FWRITE /CHAR, when given an empty
++ variable (or no variable at all) writes a NUL. Thus the loop above
++ will copy any file at all (very slowly). In non-copying applications,
++ NULs are detected like this:
++
++ fread /char \%c c
++ if fail (do something)
++ if not def c (a NUL byte was read)
++
++ Finally some advanced file operations:
++
++ FILE FLUSH channel
++ For output files only: commits all previous writes to disk, in
++ case the computer was buffering them. Synonym: FFLUSH.
++
++ FILE COUNT [ { /BYTES, /LINES, /LIST, /NOLIST } ] channel
++ By default, or if the /BYTES switch is given, counts the bytes
++ in the file, if any, open on the given channel. If the /LINES
++ switch is given, counts lines in the file. If the /LIST switch
++ is given, the result is printed. If the /NOLIST switch is
++ given, the result is not printed. /QUIET is a synonym for
++ /NOLIST. If neither /LIST nor /NOLIST is given, the result is
++ printed if the command is given at top level, i.e. not from a
++ command file or macro. In all cases, the result of the most
++ recent FILE COUNT command is stored in the variable
++ \v(f_count). Note that FILE COUNT /LINE works (and can only
++ work) by reading the entire file; expect it to take some time
++ if the file is large. Synonym: FCOUNT.
++
++ FILE REWIND channel
++ Moves the read/write pointer to the beginning of the file.
++ Equivalent to FILE SEEK channel 0. Synonym: FREWIND.
++
++ FILE SEEK [ switches ] channel { [{+,-}]number, LAST, EOF }
++ Moves the read/write pointer for the file on this channel to
++ the given position, which may be a byte (character) number or a
++ line number, expressed in either absolute or relative terms.
++ Switches:
++
++ /BYTE
++ The number given is a byte number. Synonym: /CHARACTER.
++
++ /LINE
++ The number given is a line number.
++
++ /ABSOLUTE
++ The number given is absolute.
++
++ /RELATIVE
++ The number given is relative to the current position.
++
++ By default, or if the /BYTE switch is given, the number is a
++ byte number (0 = first byte). If /LINE is given, the number is
++ a line number (0 = first line). EOF means to move to the end of
++ the file. LAST means to move to the last line or character of
++ the file, depending on whether it's a line or character seek.
++
++ If neither the /RELATIVE nor the /ABSOLUTE switch is given,
++ then if a signed number is given, the motion is relative to the
++ current position. An expression that evaluates to a negative
++ number is not considered signed for this purpose; that is, a
++ sign (+ or -) must be included as the first character of the
++ number in the command itself to force a relative seek (in the
++ absence of /RELATIVE or /ABSOLUTE).
++
++ If the number has no sign, or if the /ABSOLUTE switch is given,
++ the number represents an absolute position (relative to the
++ beginning of the file). Subsequent FILE READs or WRITEs will
++ take place at the new position.
++
++ If the read/write pointer is placed after the end of the file,
++ a subsequent FILE READ will fail, but a FILE WRITE will succeed
++ (possibly creating a file with "holes"). If a FILE SEEK /BYTE
++ command is given, the current line becomes unknown (unless the
++ position is 0) and subsequent FILE SEEK /RELATIVE /LINE
++ commands will fail until the next non-relative FILE SEEK /LINE
++ command is given. Synonym: FSEEK.
++
++ An absolute FILE SEEK to a negative position fails silently, as does a
++ relative seek to a position before the beginning of the file.
++
++ A caution about relative SEEKs: remember that the number is relative
++ to the current position. Whenever you read or write, this changes the
++ position. In each of the following examples, assume the file open on
++ channel \%c is positioned at line n (the FREAD target variable is
++ omitted for lack of space):
++
++ { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c -1, FREAD \%c } <-- Reads line n twice
++ { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c +0, FREAD \%c } <-- Reads lines n and n+1
++ { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c +1, FREAD \%c } <-- Reads lines n and n+2
++ { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c -2, FREAD \%c } <-- Reads lines n and n-1
++ { FREAD \%c, FSEEK /LINE \%c -3, FREAD \%c } <-- Reads lines n and n-2
++
++ Another caution: Using FSEEK and FREAD /SIZE to repeatedly read the
++ same disk block (e.g. when sampling a database record that is
++ frequently updated) might not give you updated disk blocks due to the
++ internal buffering and caching of the C library (this probably varies
++ from one platform/compiler combination to another). If necessary you
++ can force a fresh disk read with a close/open sequence:
++
++ FCLOS \%c
++ FOPEN \%c samefilename
++ FSEEK \%c samespot
++ FREAD /SIZE:howmanybytes \%c variable
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22.3. FILE Command Examples
++
++ To read the last 10 lines of a text file into an array:
++
++ fopen /read \%c oofa.txt ; Open the file
++ if fail exit 1 Can't open oofa.txt ; Always check for failure
++ dcl \&a[10] ; Declare a 10-element array
++ fcount /line \%c ; Count lines in the file
++ fseek /line \%c \v(f_count)-10 ; Seek to 10 lines from the end
++ if fail exit 1 Can't seek ; Check for failure
++ for \%i 1 10 1 { fread \%c \&a[\%i] } ; Read the last 10 lines
++ fclose \%c ; Close the file
++
++ Note that blank lines show up as empty (undefined) array elements, for
++ example if you give a "show array a" command at this point. This is
++ normal. You can still use these elements; e.g.:
++
++ for \%i 1 10 1 { echo \%i. \&a[\%i] } ; Display the 10 lines
++
++ Here is how to read the last line of a file (already open on channel
++ \%c):
++
++ fseek /line \%c last ; Seek directly to last line
++
++ Alternatively:
++
++ fseek /line \%c eof ; Seek to end of file
++ fseek /line \%c -1 ; Seek to beginning of last line
++
++ Alternatively:
++
++ fcount /line \%c ; Count the file's lines
++ fseek /line \%c \v(f_count)-1 ; Seek to last line
++ fread \%c ; Read it
++
++ To read every other line from the file (using relative SEEK), skipping
++ the first line:
++
++ fopen /read \%c oofa.txt ; Open the file
++ while ( success ) { ; Loop through lines
++ fseek /line \%c +1 ; Skip a line
++ if success fread \%c ; Read & display a line
++ }
++ fclose \%c ; Close the file
++
++ Here is how to read the lines of a file in reverse order:
++
++ fopen /read \%c oofa.txt ; Open
++ if fail exit 1 ; Check
++ fseek /line \%c last ; Seek to last line
++ while success { ; Loop
++ fread \%c ; Read line
++ fseek /line \%c -2 ; Seek backwards two lines
++ }
++ fclose \%c ; Close the file
++
++ The loop works because a relative SEEK outside the file fails.
++
++ It is also possible to use block i/o to manage random-access files
++ with fixed-length records (as long as they don't contain NUL
++ characters). Suppose, for example, you have a file of "card image"
++ records with fixed-field information about customers, such as:
++
++ Name: Columns 1-32 (column numbers are 1-based)
++ Address: Columns 33-72
++ Balance: Columns 73-80
++
++ The records are indexed by customer number, starting with 0. There are
++ no line terminators separating them. Therefore the record for customer
++ number n starts at position nx 80 (\%n*80).
++
++ Now suppose we received a payment from customer number 173 and want to
++ update the balance:
++
++ .\%n = 173 ; Customer (record) number
++ .\%a = 12.72 ; Amount
++ fopen /read /write \%c customer.db ; Open the file
++ if fail stop 1 OPEN FAILED: \f_errmsg() ; Check
++ fseek /byte \%c 80*\%n ; Seek to record
++ fread /size:80 \%c r ; Read the record
++ if fail stop 1 READ FAILED: \f_errmsg() ; Check (IMPORTANT)
++ .\%b := \fright(\m(r),8) ; Extract the balance
++ .\%b := \ffpadd(\%b,\%a,2) ; Add the new payment
++ if fail stop 1 ARITHMETIC ERROR: \%b/\%a ; Catch bad records
++ .r := {\fleft(\m(r),72)\flpad(\%b,8)} ; Update the record
++ fseek /byte \%c 80*\%n ; Reposition to same spot
++ fwrite /size:80 \%c {\m(r)} ; Replace the record
++ if fail stop 1 WRITE FAILED: \f_errmsg() ; Check
++ fclose \%c ; Close the file
++
++ REMEMBER: Using FILE SEEK to move beyond the end of file can result in
++ a file with holes when writing; when reading, an end-of-file error
++ will occur -- be sure to check for it.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22.4. Channel Numbers
++
++ C-Kermit's channel numbers are integers from 0 to some
++ platform-dependent limit, such as 46 or 1985 (the value of \v(f_max)).
++ This is the limit placed by the operating system on the number of
++ files that may be opened by one process or user or job, minus the
++ standard input, output, and error files, and minus the number of files
++ reserved by C-Kermit for logs, OPEN READ and WRITE, and file transfer
++ (and maybe some command files -- the \v(f_max) number can't be exact).
++
++ Although you must include a variable in the FILE OPEN command, to
++ which the channel number is assigned, you don't have to use a variable
++ in the other FILE commands if you know what the number is -- you can
++ just put the number. This saves you a few keystrokes when typing
++ commands at the prompt:
++
++ fopen \%c oofa.txt
++ flist
++ 0. /usr/olga.oofa.txt (R) 0
++
++ This tells the channel number is 0 (the number on the left is the
++ channel file's channel number). Of course you can also find it by
++ echoing the variable:
++
++ echo \%c
++ 0
++
++ Or with "fstatus \%c". Now you can type commands like:
++
++ fread 0
++
++ to read a line from the file. Obviously, however, using digits rather
++ than a variable for the channel number would be poor practice in a
++ script.
++
++ If in commands like:
++
++ fread \%c \%a
++
++ you have trouble remembering which variable is which, note that the
++ channel number is, indeed, a number. Anywhere C-Kermit accepts a
++ number it can also accept an expression, so you can put parentheses
++ around the channel number to remind you it's the channel number and
++ not the variable into which data is to be read:
++
++ fread (\%c) \%a
++
++ Normally channel numbers are assigned sequentially as 0, 1, 2, ... up
++ to the limit. However, once you start closing files, there can be
++ holes in the sequence. New channels are assigned to fill in the holes.
++ Thus you can't depend on channel numbers being in any particular
++ sequence.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22.5. FILE Command Errors
++
++ Each FILE command sets the variable \v(f_error) to one of the
++ following values:
++
++ 0 = No error
++ -1 = System error
++ -2 = Attempt to read after end of file
++ -3 = Channel not open
++ -4 = Channel number out of range (negative or too large)
++ -5 = Numeric argument (size, ...) out of range
++ -6 = File not found
++ -7 = Bad or missing filename
++ -8 = Too many files are already open (FILE OPEN only)
++ -9 = Forbidden operation (e.g. write to a read-only file)
++ -10 = Access denied
++ -11 = Illegal combination of OPEN modes (FILE OPEN only)
++ -12 = Buffer overflow
++ -13 = Current line number unknown (for relative line seeks)
++ -14 through -98: Reserved.
++ -99 = Requested operation not implemented in this version of C-Kermit
++ -999 = Unknown error
++
++ When \v(f_error) is -1, this means the FILE command failed because
++ because of a system error, in which case you can examine the following
++ variables:
++
++ \v(errno) = System error number.
++ \v(errstring) = Error message corresponding to \v(errno).
++
++ A special function is available for translating the \v(f_error) code
++ to an error message string:
++
++\f_errmsg([code])
++ If the code is -1, returns error message of the most recent system
++ error; otherwise if the code is a valid \v(f_error) value, the associated
++ message is returned. If the code is omitted, the status message
++ corresponding to the current \v(f_error) value is returned.
++
++ A FILE command that fails prints the appropriate error message
++ automatically, except when the command is READ or SEEK and the error
++ is -2 (end of file); in that case, the command still fails, but does
++ not print a message. This allows constructions such as:
++
++ fopen \%c oofa.txt
++ while success { fread \%c }
++ fclose \%c
++
++ to work as expected, i.e. without an annoying message when the end of
++ file is reached.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22.6. File I/O Variables
++
++ The variables associated with the file i/o package are:
++
++ \v(f_count)
++ Result of the most recent FILE COUNT (FCOUNT) command.
++
++ \v(f_error)
++ Numeric error code of most recent FILE command (0 = no error).
++
++ \v(f_max)
++ Maximum number of files open simultaneously.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22.7. File I/O Functions
++
++ Some of the FILE commands can also be issued as function calls, which
++ makes script writing a bit more convenient, especially for C
++ programmers. Also, several functions are provided that do not have
++ command equivalents. Each of these functions takes a channel number as
++ the first argument. These functions do not work for OPEN { READ,
++ !READ, WRITE, !WRITE, and APPEND } files.
++
++ \f_status(channel)
++ Returns 0 if the channel is not open, otherwise a number
++ between 1 and 15 which is the sum of the OPEN modes:
++
++ 1 = /READ
++ 2 = /WRITE
++ 4 = /APPEND
++ 8 = /BINARY
++
++ The remaining functions work only for open channels. Each of these
++ functions can fail for the applicable reasons listed in [379]Section
++ 1.22.5. For instructions on handling function errors, see [380]Section
++ 7.12.
++
++ \f_pos(channel)
++ Returns the file's current read/write pointer (0-based). There
++ is no FILE command equivalent.
++
++ \f_line(channel)
++ Returns the file's current line number (0-based), if known,
++ otherwise -1. There is no FILE command equivalent. The line
++ number is known as long as no character or block i/o has been
++ done on the channel.
++
++ \f_handle(channel)
++ Returns the "file handle" of the file. That is, it translates
++ the portable C-Kermit channel number into a system-specific
++ file handle or number that can be passed to other programs on
++ the same platform. In UNIX this is a file descriptor. There is
++ no FILE command equivalent.
++
++ \f_eof(channel)
++ Returns 1 if the read/write pointer of the file on the given
++ channel is at the end of the file, 0 otherwise. Convenient in
++ WHILE statements, e.g.:
++
++ while not \f_eof(\%c) { fread \%c }
++
++ \f_getchar(channel)
++ Equivalent to FREAD /CHAR. Returns the character actually read.
++ If \f_getchar() does not fail but the return value is empty,
++ this means a NULL character was read.
++
++ \f_getline(channel)
++ Equivalent to FREAD /LINE. Returns the line actually read, but
++ with the line terminator stripped. If \f_getline() does not
++ fail but the return value is empty, this normally means an
++ empty line was read.
++
++ \f_getblock(channel,n)
++ Equivalent to FREAD /SIZE:n. Returns the block of characters
++ actually read. If the returned block is smaller than n, it
++ indicates either that the end of file was reached or a NUL
++ character is in the block.
++
++ \f_putchar(channel,c)
++ Equivalent to FWRITE /CHARACTER. Writes the character c. If c
++ contains more than one character, only the first is written. If
++ c is empty a NUL is written. Returns the number of characters
++ written on success, or a negative error code upon failure.
++
++ \f_putline(channel,string)
++ Equivalent to FWRITE /LINE. Writes the string and adds the
++ appropriate line termination character or sequence. If the
++ string is empty or omitted, an empty line is written. Returns
++ the number of characters written on success, or a negative
++ error code upon failure.
++
++ \f_putblock(channel,string)
++ Equivalent to FWRITE /STRING. Writes the string as given. If
++ the string is empty or omitted, nothing is written. Returns the
++ number of characters written on success, or a negative error
++ code upon failure.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.22.8. File I/O Function Examples
++
++ fopen /read \%c oofa.txt ; Open our favorite file for reading
++ if failure exit 1 ; Check that it's open
++ while not \f_eof(\%c) { ; Loop until EOF
++ .line := \f_getline(\%c) ; Get a line
++ if success echo {\m(line)} ; Echo it
++ }
++ if not \f_eof(\%c) { ; Check reason for loop exit
++ exit 1 File Error: \f_errmsg() ; If not EOF say so.
++ }
++
++ frewind \%c ; Rewind the file
++ while not \f_eof(\%c) { ; Same thing but with block i/o
++ .block := \f_getblock(\%c,256) ; (much faster than line i/o)
++ if success xecho {\m(block)}
++ }
++
++ frewind \%c ; Rewind again
++ while not \f_eof(\%c) { ; Same deal but with character i/o
++ .c := \f_getchar(\%c) ; (much slower than line i/o)
++ if success xecho {\m(c)}
++ }
++ close \%c
++
++ To close all open files (equivalent to FCLOSE ALL):
++
++ for \%i 0 \v(f_max)-1 1 {
++ if \f_status(\%i) fclose \%i
++ }
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.23. The EXEC Command
++
++ The EXEC command is available only in UNIX.
++
++ EXEC [ /REDIRECT ] command [ arg1 [ arg2 [ ... ] ]
++ Runs the given command with the arguments in such a way that
++ the command replaces C-Kermit in memory, and C-Kermit ceases to
++ execute. EXEC is like RUN, except instead of returning to
++ C-Kermit when finished, the command returns to whatever process
++ invoked Kermit.
++
++ In the normal case, no files are closed, so the EXEC'd command
++ inherits the open files, read/write pointers, working directory,
++ process ID, user ID (unless command is SUID), group ID (unless command
++ is SGID), groups, etc. (In UNIX, the EXEC command is simply a front
++ end for execvp().)
++
++ If the /REDIRECT switch is included, then if a connection is open (SET
++ LINE or SET HOST), it becomes the standard input and output of the
++ EXEC'd program. If no connection is open, the /REDIRECT switch has no
++ effect. For example to use C-Kermit for PPP dialing in Linux:
++
++ set modem type usr ; Specify the kind of modem you have
++ set line /dev/ttyS1 ; Specify the device it's connected to
++ set speed 57600 ; and the speed
++ set flow rts/cts ; and flow control.
++ set dial retries 100 ; Try the dial sequence up to 100 times.
++ dial {{9-212-555-1212}{9-212-555-1213}{9-212-555-1214}{9-212-555-1215}}
++ if fail exit 1
++ for \%i 1 16 1 { ; Try up to 16 times to get login prompt
++ input 10 Login: ; Wait 10 sec for it to appear
++ if success break ; Got it - proceed...
++ output \13 ; Send a carriage return and try again
++ }
++ if ( > \%i 16 ) stop 1 NO LOGIN PROMPT
++ lineout \(myuserid) ; Send user ID
++ input 30 assword: ; Wait for Password prompt
++ if fail stop 1 NO PASSWORD PROMPT
++ lineout \m(mypassword) ; Send the password.
++ exec /redirect pppd ; Replace ourselves with pppd.
++
++ In this example we assume that the script has already set up the
++ myuserid and mypassword variables -- normally the password should be
++ prompted for, rather than stored on disk. Notice the advantages over
++ the well-known "chat script":
++ * You don't have to control the modem itself with AT commands;
++ Kermit's DIAL command does this for you.
++ * You can have Kermit automatically redial as many times as you want
++ until it gets a connection (if this is legal in your country).
++ * You can have Kermit fetch the number or numbers from a dialing
++ directory.
++ * You can have Kermit cycle through a list of phone numbers (this is
++ new in C-Kermit 7.0; see [381]Section 2.1.16) without having to
++ enter the numbers in a dialing directory.
++ * Dialing is location-independent; you can use the same script to
++ dial from different areas or countries.
++ * Once the connection is made, the full power of Kermit's script
++ language is available to manage the dialog with the terminal
++ server or other device that answers the phone call.
++
++ NOTE: PPP and SLIP dialing are not available in Windows 95/98/NT/2000,
++ whose APIs do not provide a method for an application to hand over a
++ connection to the PPP or SLIP driver.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1.24. Getting Keyword Lists with '?'
++
++ Suppose you type "te" at the C-Kermit> 6.0 prompt and then Esc or Tab
++ to request keyword completion. Kermit beeps, indicating that more than
++ one command starts with "te". But if you type '?' to see what they
++ are, Kermit shows only "telnet". So why the beep? Because of invisible
++ keywords like "telopt", "terminal", and "text". Lots of keywords are
++ invisible because they are either synonyms for other keywords or else
++ esoteric options to be used only in special circumstances, so we don't
++ want them cluttering up the menus.
++
++ But then there is no way for you to discover them. So in C-Kermit 7.0,
++ if you type '?' AFTER the beginning of a keyword field, then invisible
++ keywords are shown too:
++
++ C-Kermit> te<Esc><BEEP>
++ C-Kermit> te? Command, one of the following:
++ telnet telopt terminal text
++ C-Kermit>te
++
++ But if '?' is typed at the beginning of a field, only visible keywords
++ are shown, as before (so, in this example, if '?' is typed at the
++ C-Kermit> prompt, "telnet" is the only command shown that starts with
++ "te").
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2. MAKING AND USING CONNECTIONS The SET LINE, SET HOST, and SET PORT (a
++ synonym for SET LINE) commands have new synonyms, in which the word SET is
++ replaced by the word OPEN: OPEN LINE, etc. There is no new functionality
++ here, but OPEN is a better verb, since SET generally takes no action, whereas
++ these commands actually try to open a connection. Furthermore, there is the
++ symmetry with CLOSE.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.0. SET LINE and SET HOST Command SwitchesThe SET LINE (SET PORT) and SET
++ HOST commands now allow switches before the device or host name, in most
++ cases, and under certain circumstances, also at the end. The new syntax is
++ backwards compatible with the previous syntax; thus SET LINE, SET PORT, and
++ SET HOST commands in command files written for C-Kermit 6.0 or earlier still
++ work. The expanded syntax is:
++
++ { OPEN, SET } { LINE, PORT, HOST } [ switches ] device-or-address [ switches
++ ]
++
++ The first group of switches is:
++
++ /NETWORK-TYPE:{TCP/IP,X.25,PIPE,PTY...}
++ When more than one network type is available, this lets you
++ specify the type of network to use for this connection without
++ affecting your global SET NETWORK TYPE. See [382]Section 2.7
++ about pipes and ptys.
++
++ /USERID:[string]
++ This switch is equivalent to SET LOGIN USERID. If a string is
++ given, it sent to host during Telnet negotiations; if this
++ switch is given but the string is omitted, no user ID is sent
++ to the host. If this switch is not given, your current LOGIN
++ USERID (\v(userid) value), if any, is sent. Unlike most other
++ switches, this one is "sticky", since the value must persist
++ throughout the session in case the server requests the ID
++ string at a later time.
++
++ /CONNECT
++ Enter CONNECT mode immediately and automatically after the
++ device or connection is open. On serial devices, however, when
++ CARRIER-WATCH is not OFF, wait up to 1 second for the Carrier
++ Detect signal to appear before trying to connect, to give the
++ device time to react DTR, which might have been off prior to
++ opening the device.
++
++ /SERVER
++ Enter server mode immediately and automatically after the
++ device or connection is open. Treatment of carrier is the same
++ as for /CONNECT.
++
++ /WAIT
++ /NOWAIT
++ For Telnet connections only: Like SET TELNET WAIT { ON, OFF },
++ but applies only to this connection, and in fact applies only
++ when OPENing this connection (which is usually the only place
++ it matters). Typically you would use TELNET /NOWAIT to make a
++ connection to a misbehaving Telnet server that does not reply
++ to negotiations as required by the Telnet protocol definition.
++
++ Note: /CONNECT and /SERVER switches are not available in the RLOGIN
++ and TELNET commands, since these commands already include an implicit
++ /CONNECT and preclude automatic entry into server mode.
++
++ The /CONNECT and /SERVER switches are especially useful with "set host
++ *" connections. For example, suppose you want to start a Kermit server
++ on socket 3000 of your TCP host. Normally you would have to give the
++ command:
++
++ set host * 3000
++
++ and then wait for a connection to come in, and only then could you
++ give the SERVER command (or else define a macro to do this, and then
++ execute the macro). Now you can do it in one step:
++
++ set host /server * 3000
++
++ This tells C-Kermit to wait for the connection and then enter server
++ mode once it comes in, no matter how long it takes. Similarly, "set
++ host /conn *" can be used to wait for a "chat" connection to come in.
++
++ Another set of switches is available in VMS only, for use only with
++ SET LINE:
++
++ /SHARE
++ Allows the SET LINE device to be opened in shared mode.
++ Normally it makes no sense to open a serial device in shared
++ mode, but it's necessary when C-Kermit is running in an
++ environment such as DECIntact, that opens your job's
++ controlling terminal in such a way that C-Kermit can't open it
++ too, unless it enables SHARE privilege. Note: SHARE privilege
++ is required.
++
++ /NOSHARE
++ Requires that the SET LINE device not be in use by any other
++ process in order for it to be successfully opened by C-Kermit.
++ If neither /SHARE nor /NOSHARE is specified, /NOSHARE is used.
++
++ The second group of switches is:
++
++ /NO-TELNET-INIT
++ Do not send initial Telnet negotiations even if this is a
++ Telnet port.
++
++ /RAW-SOCKET
++ This is a connection to a raw TCP socket ([383]Section 2.3.5).
++
++ /RLOGIN
++ Use Rlogin protocol even if this is not an Rlogin port.
++
++ /TELNET
++ Send initial Telnet negotiations even if this is not a Telnet
++ port.
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19, the TELNET command includes an
++ implicit /TELNET switch. So if you TELNET to a non-TELNET port, Kermit
++ sends initial Telnet negotiations. This makes sense, since that's what
++ "telnet" means.
++
++ If you want to make a connection to a non-Telnet port without sending
++ initial Telnet negotiations, use:
++
++ set host [ /connect ] name-or-address port
++
++ or:
++
++ telnet name-or-address port /no-telnet-init
++
++ Additional switches might be added in the future; type "set host ?" or
++ "set line ?" to see a current list.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1. Dialing
++
++ Automatic redialing is illegal or restricted in many countries, so
++ until C-Kermit 7.0, it was disabled by default, i.e. until a SET DIAL
++ RETRIES command was given. In C-Kermit 7.0, if no SET DIAL RETRIES
++ command has been given, a default is picked dynamically at DIAL time
++ based on the calling country code, if known. At this writing, the only
++ country code known to have no restrictions on automatic redialing is
++ 1. So in this case a limit of 10 is chosen; otherwise 1. If you have
++ not given an explicit SET DIAL RETRIES command, SHOW DIAL shows the
++ value as "(auto)", and then the value actually used is shown when you
++ give the DIAL command.
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, automatic redialing is automatically canceled if
++ the call could not be placed because no dialtone was detected.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.1. The Dial Result Message
++
++ If DIAL DISPLAY is not ON, the "Call complete" message now shows the
++ modem's call result message, for example:
++
++ Dialing: ...
++ Call complete: "CONNECT 31200/ARQ/V32/LAPM/V42BIS"
++
++ The exact format and contents of this message, of course, depends on
++ the make, model, and configuration of your modem, so use your modem
++ manual to interpret it. The call result message is also available in
++ C-Kermit's \v(dialresult) variable.
++
++ C-Kermit> echo \v(dialresult)
++ CONNECT 31200/ARQ/V32/LAPM/V42BIS
++ C-Kermit> echo Speed = \fword(\v(dialresult),2)
++ Speed = 31200
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ Suppose your modem reports the modulation speed as shown above and you
++ want to ensure your call is completed at (say) 24000 bps or more. You
++ can use a little macro to do the job:
++
++define HSDIAL { ; High Speed DIAL
++ local \%s
++ if < \v(argc) 1 if not def \v(dialnumber) end 1 Usage: \%0 number
++ set dial retries 100
++ set dial interval 1
++ while true {
++ dial \%*
++ if fail end 1 DIAL failed.
++ asg \%s \fword(\v(dialresult),2)
++ if def \%s if numeric \%s if not < \%s 24000 break
++ }
++}
++
++ (See [384]Section 7.5 about the \%* variable.)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.2. Long-Distance Dialing Changes
++
++ Due to the glut of cell phones, pagers, fax machines, ISPs, etc, area
++ codes and dialing rules are changing all the time. In the North
++ American Numbering Plan (NANP) countries (USA, Canada, etc), area
++ codes are split or overlayed with increasing frequency, and 10- and
++ 11-digit dialing is gradually becoming the norm for local calls.
++ Changes are occurring In Europe, too, partly for these reasons and
++ partly because of some new EC rules.
++
++ In France, effective 18 October 1996, all calls, even local ones, must
++ be dialed with an area code. French area codes are presently 1-digit
++ numbers, 1-6, and the long-distance dialing prefix is 0. All calls
++ within France are considered long distance and begin with 01, 02, ...,
++ 06.
++
++ Effective 1 May 1997, all calls within the US state of Maryland, even
++ local ones, must be dialed with an area code but without the
++ long-distance prefix -- this is the now widely-known North American
++ phenomenon of "ten digit dialing". The same is happening elsewhere --
++ many cities in Florida adopted 10-digit dialing in 1998.
++
++ In Italy beginning 19 June 1998, all calls to fixed (as opposed to
++ mobile) numbers must be prefixed by 0. When calling into Italy from
++ outside, the 0 must follow the country code (39). Calls to cell
++ phones, however, must be placed without the 0. Then on 29 December
++ 2000, the 0 will become a 4 (for calling fixed numbers) and a prefix
++ of 3 must used for calling mobile phones. More info at:
++ http://www.telecomitalia.it/npnn/.
++
++ In Spain, effective 4 April 1998, with hard cutover on 18 July 1998,
++ all calls within the country must be dialed with 9 digits, and all
++ calls from outside Spain must also be dialed with 9 digits (after the
++ country code, 34). The new 9-digit numbers all begin with "9". More
++ info at: [385]http://www.telefonica.es/cambiodenumeracion/
++
++ Several new dialing features and commands have been added in version
++ 6.1 and 7.0 to address these changes.
++
++ C-Kermit 6.0 and Kermit 95 1.1.11 and earlier handle the French
++ situation via a reasonable subterfuge (setting the local area code to
++ a nonexistent one), but did not handle "ten-digit dialing" well at
++ all; the recommended technique was to change the long-distance dialing
++ prefix to nothing, but this defeated Kermit's "list numbers for one
++ name" feature when the numbers were in different locations. For
++ example:
++
++ set dial ld-prefix
++ dial onlineservice
++
++ where "onlineservice" is a dialing directory entry name corresponding
++ to entries that are in (say) Maryland as well as other states, would
++ not correctly dial the numbers not in Maryland.
++
++ A new command lets you specify a list of area codes to be considered
++ local, except that the area code must be dialed:
++
++ SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES [ areacode [ areacode [ areacode [ ... ] ] ] ]
++ The list may include up to 32 area codes. If a number is called
++ whose area code is in this list, it is dialed WITHOUT the
++ long-distance prefix, but WITH the area code.
++
++ So in Maryland, which (last time we looked) has two area codes, 410
++ and 301, the setup would be:
++
++ SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410 301
++
++ Example:
++
++ SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 301
++ SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410 301 <-- Area codes in 10-digit dialing region
++ DIAL +1 (301) 765-4321 <-- Dials 3017654321 (local with area code)
++ DIAL +1 (410) 765-4321 <-- Dials 4107654321 (local with area code)
++ DIAL +1 (212) 765-4321 <-- Dials 12127654321 (long distance)
++
++ The SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES command does not replace the SET DIAL
++ AREA-CODE command. The latter specifies the area code you are dialing
++ from. If the called number is in the same area code, then the area
++ code is dialed if it is also in the LC-AREA-CODES list, and it is not
++ dialed otherwise. So if "301" had not appeared in the LC-AREA-CODES
++ list in the previous example:
++
++ SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 301
++ SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410 <-- Area codes in 10-digit dialing region
++ DIAL +1 (301) 765-4321 <-- Dials 7654321 (local)
++ DIAL +1 (410) 765-4321 <-- Dials 4107654321 (local with area code)
++ DIAL +1 (212) 765-4321 <-- Dials 12127654321 (long distance)
++
++ The new Kermit versions also add a Local Call Prefix and Local Call
++ Suffix, in case you have any need for it. These are added to the
++ beginning and of local phone numbers (i.e. numbers that are not
++ long-distance or international). Examples:
++
++ SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
++ SET DIAL LC-PREFIX 9
++ SET DIAL LC-SUFFIX *
++ SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 410 <-- Area codes in 10-digit dialing region
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 301
++ DIAL +1 (301) 765-4321 <-- Dials 97654321* (local)
++ DIAL +1 (410) 765-4321 <-- Dials 94107654321* (local with area code)
++ DIAL +1 (212) 765-4321 <-- Dials 12127654321 (long distance)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.3. Forcing Long-Distance Dialing
++
++ Suppose a number is in your country and area, but for some reason you
++ need to dial it long-distance anyway (as is always the case in
++ France). There have always been various ways to handle this:
++
++ 1. Temporarily set your area code to a different (or nonexistent or
++ impossible) one (but this required knowledge of which area codes
++ were nonexistent or impossible in each country).
++ 2. Dial the number literally instead of using the portable format,
++ but this defeats the purpose of the portable dialing directory.
++
++ Now there is also a new command that, very simply, can force
++ long-distance dialing:
++
++ SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE { ON, OFF }
++ If a call is placed to a portable phone number within the same
++ country code as the calling number, it is dialed with the
++ long-distance prefix and the area code if FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE
++ is ON. If OFF, the regular rules and procedures apply.
++
++ Example (France):
++
++ SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 33
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 6
++ SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON
++
++ (In fact, SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 33 automatically sets DIAL
++ FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON...)
++
++ Example (USA, for a certain type of reverse-charge calling in which
++ the called number must always be fully specified):
++
++ SET DIAL PREFIX 18002666328$ ; 1-800-COLLECT
++ SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 1
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 212
++ SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON
++
++ Example (Toronto, where calls to exchange 976 within area code 416
++ must be dialed as long distance, even when you are dialing from area
++ code 416):
++
++ SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 1
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 416
++ SET DIAL FORCE-LONG-DISTANCE ON
++ DIAL +1 (416) 976-xxxx
++
++ If dialing methods were consistent and sensible, of course it would be
++ possible to always dial every domestic call as if it were long
++ distance. But in many locations this doesn't work or if it does, it
++ costs extra. The following macro can be used for dialing any given
++ number with forced long-distance format:
++
++ define LDIAL {
++ local \%x
++ set dial force-long-distance on
++ dial \%*
++ asg \%x \v(success)
++ set dial force-long-distance off
++ end \%x
++ }
++
++ (See [386]Section 7.5 about the \%* variable.)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.4. Exchange-Specific Dialing Decisions
++
++ This applies mainly to the North American Numbering Plan (NANP). Refer
++ to the section "Alternative notations" in [387]Using C-Kermit 2nd
++ Edition, pages 106-107, and the story about Toronto on page 110. Using
++ the new LC-AREA-CODES list, we can address the problem by treating the
++ exchange as part of the area code:
++
++ SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 416
++ SET DIAL LC-AREA-CODES 905276
++ DIAL +1 416 765 4321 <-- 7654321 (local)
++ DIAL +1 905 276 4321 <-- 9052764321 (local with area code)
++ DIAL +1 905 528 4321 <-- 19055284321 (long distance)
++
++ The same technique can be used in Massachusetts (story at top of page
++ 111) and in any other place where dialing to some exchanges within a
++ particular area code is local, but to others in the same area code is
++ long distance.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.5. Cautions about Cheapest-First Dialing
++
++ Kermit does not maintain a knowledge base of telephony information; it
++ only provides the tools to let you enter a phone number in a standard
++ format and dial it correctly from any location in most cases.
++
++ In particular, Kermit does not differentiate the charging method from
++ the dialing method. If a call that is DIALED as long-distance (e.g.
++ from 212 to 718 in country code 1) is not CHARGED as long distance, we
++ have no way of knowing that without keeping a matrix of charging
++ information for every area-code combination within every country, and
++ any such matrix would be obsolete five minutes after it was
++ constructed. Thus, "cheapest-first" sorting is only as reliable as our
++ assumption that the charging method follows the dialing method. A good
++ illustration would be certain online services that have toll-free
++ dialup numbers which they charge you a premium (in your online service
++ bill) for using.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.6. Blind Dialing (Dialing with No Dialtone)
++
++ C-Kermit's init string for Hayes-like modems generally includes an X4
++ command to enable as many result codes as possible, so that Kermit can
++ react appropriately to different failure reasons. One of the result
++ codes that X4 enables is "NO DIALTONE". A perhaps not obvious side
++ effect of enabling this result code that the modem must hear dialtone
++ before it will dial.
++
++ It is becoming increasingly necessary to force a modem to dial even
++ though it does not hear a dialtone on the phone line; for example,
++ with PBXs that have strange dialtones, or with phone systems in
++ different countries, or with ISDN phones, etc. This is called "blind
++ dialing".
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 has two new commands to cope with this situation:
++
++ SET DIAL IGNORE-DIALTONE { ON, OFF }
++ OFF (the default) means to tell the modem to wait for dialtone
++ before dialing. ON means to enable "blind dialing", i.e. tell
++ the modem NOT to wait for dialtone before dialing. Generally
++ this is accomplished by sending ATX3 to the modem just prior to
++ dialing. SET MODEM TYPE xxx and then SHOW MODEM displays
++ Kermit's built-in "ignore dialtone" command.
++
++ SET DIAL COMMAND IGNORE-DIALTONE text
++ This lets you change the built-in ignore-dialtone command (such
++ as ATX3) to whatever you choose, in case the built-in one does
++ not work, or another command works better.
++
++ Notes:
++ 1. The ignore-dialtone command is not sent unless SET DIAL
++ IGNORE-DIALTONE is ON.
++ 2. The ATX3 command generally disables not only NO DIALTONE, but also
++ BUSY. So this will prevent Kermit from detecting when the line is
++ busy. This is a property of the modem, not of Kermit.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.7. Trimming the Dialing Dialog
++
++ The command:
++
++ SET MODEM COMMAND action [ command ]
++
++ is used to override Kermit's built-in modem commands for each action,
++ for each kind of modem in its internal database. If you include a
++ command, this is used instead of the built-in one. If you omit the
++ command, this restores the original built-in command.
++
++ If you want to omit the command altogether, so Kermit doesn't send the
++ command at all, or wait for a response, use:
++
++ SET MODEM COMMAND action {}
++
++ That is, specify a pair of empty braces as the command, for example:
++
++ SET MODEM COMMAND ERROR-CORRECTION ON {}
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.8. Controlling the Dialing Speed
++
++ The rate at which characters are sent to the modem during dialing is
++ normally controlled by the built-in modem database. You might want to
++ override this if Kermit seems to be dialing too slowly, or it is
++ sending characters to the modem faster than the modem handle them. A
++ new command was added for this in C-Kermit 7.0:
++
++ SET DIAL PACING number
++ Specifies the number of milliseconds (thousandths of seconds)
++ to pause between each character when sending commands to the
++ modem during DIAL or ANSWER command execution. 0 means no pause
++ at all, -1 (the default) or any other negative number means to
++ use the value from the database. Any number greater than 0 is
++ the number of milliseconds to pause.
++
++ HINT: You might also need to control the rate at which the modem
++ generates Touch Tones during dialing, for example when sending a
++ numeric page. There are two ways to do this. One way is to insert
++ pause characters into the dialing string. For modems that use the AT
++ command set, the pause character is comma (,) and causes a 2-second
++ pause. On most modems, you can use the S8 register to change the pause
++ interval caused by comma in the dialing string. The other way is to
++ set your modem's tone generation interval, if it has a command for
++ that. Most AT-command-set modems use S11 for this; the value is in
++ milliseconds. For example on USR modems:
++
++ ATS11=200
++
++ selects an interval of 200 milliseconds to separate each dialing tone.
++
++ Hint: To add S-Register settings or other commands to your dialing
++ procedure, use the new SET MODEM COMMAND PREDIAL-INIT command
++ ([388]Section 2.2.2).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.9. Pretesting Phone Number Conversions
++
++ The LOOKUP command now accepts telephone numbers as well as
++ directory-entry names, for example:
++
++ LOOKUP +1 (212) 7654321
++
++ When given a phone number, LOOKUP prints the result of converting the
++ phone number for dialing under the current dialing rules. For example,
++ if my country code is 1 and my area code is 212, and I am dialing out
++ from a PBX whose outside-line prefix is "93,":
++
++ C-Kermit> lookup +1 (212) 7654321
++ +1 (212) 7654321 => 93,7654321
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ You can also use the \fdialconvert(phone-number) function
++ ([389]Section 2.1.11) to do this programmatically:
++
++ C-Kermit> echo "\fdialconvert(+1 (212) 7654321)"
++ "93,7654321"
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ So the new LOOKUP behaves as follows:
++
++ LOOKUP portable-format-phone-number
++ Displays how the number would actually be dialed Sets FAILURE
++ if there was a conversion error, otherwise SUCCESS.
++
++ LOOKUP literal-format-phone-number
++ Displays the same literal-format-phone-number Always sets
++ SUCCESS.
++
++ LOOKUP dialing-directory-name
++ Displays all matching entries and converts portable phone
++ numbers. Sets SUCCESS if at least one entry was found,
++ otherwise FAILURE.
++
++ LOOKUP =anything
++ Displays "=anything" and sets SUCCESS.
++
++ There is, at present, no programmatic way to fetch numbers from the
++ dialing directory. This will be considered for a future release.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.10. Greater Control over Partial Dialing
++
++ The following rules now apply to partial dialing:
++
++ * Phone number transformations based on country and area code,
++ application of prefixes, etc, are performed only on the first
++ PDIAL.
++ * Each PDIAL argument is looked up in the dialing directory, so it
++ is possible have directory entries for pieces of phone numbers or
++ other information.
++ * Suffixes are not applied automatically, since there is no way for
++ C-Kermit to know in which PDIAL segment you want them to be
++ applied.
++
++ However, the suffix that *would* have been applied, based on the
++ dialing rules that were invoked when processing the first PDIAL
++ command, is stored in the variable:
++
++ \v(dialsuffix)
++
++ which you can include in any subsequent PDIAL or DIAL commands.
++
++ Example:
++
++ pdial {\m(my_long_distance_pager_number_part_1)}
++ pdial {\m(my_long_distance_pager_number_part_2)}
++ pdial {\v(dialsuffix)}
++ pdial {\m(my_long_distance_pager_number_part_3)}
++ pdial {@\m(numeric_pager_code)#}
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.11. New DIAL-related Variables and Functions
++
++ \fdialconvert(s)
++ s is a phone number in either literal or portable format (not a
++ dialing directory entry name). The function returns the dial
++ string that would actually be used by the DIAL command when
++ dialing from the current location, after processing country
++ code, area code, and other SET DIAL values, and should be the
++ same as the result of LOOKUP when given a telephone number.
++
++ \v(dialsuffix)
++ Contains the suffix, if any, that was applied in the most
++ recent DIAL command, or the suffix that would have been applied
++ in the most recent PDIAL command. Use this variable to send the
++ dial suffix at any desired point in a PDIAL sequence.
++
++ \v(dialtype)
++ A number indicating the type of call that was most recently
++ placed. Can be used after a normal DIAL command, or after the
++ first PDIAL command in a PDIAL sequence. Values are:
++
++ -2: Unknown because TAPI handled the phone number translation.
++ -1: Unknown because some kind of error occured.
++ 0: Internal within PBX.
++ 1: Toll-free.
++ 2: Local within calling area.
++ 3: Unknown (e.g. because a literal-format phone number was given).
++ 4: Long distance within country.
++ 5: International
++
++ \v(dialcount)
++ The current value of the DIAL retry counter, for use in a DIAL
++ macro ([390]Section 2.1.13).
++
++ \v(d$px)
++ PBX Exchange (see [391]Section 2.1.12).
++
++ Other dial-related variables, already documented in [392]Using
++ C-Kermit (or other sections of this document, e.g. [393]Section
++ 2.1.1), include \v(dialnumber), \v(dialstatus), etc. A convenient way
++ to display all of them is:
++
++ show variable dial ; hint: abbreviate "sho var dial"
++
++ This shows the values of all the variables whose names start with
++ "dial". Also "show variable d$" (to show the \v(d$...) variables).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.12. Increased Flexibility of PBX Dialing
++
++ Refer to [394]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition, pages 107-108. Recall that
++ three commands are needed to configure C-Kermit for dialing from a
++ PBX:
++
++ SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE number
++ SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX number
++ SET DIAL PBX-OUTSIDE-PREFIX number
++
++ Unfortunately, this model does not accommodate PBXs that have more
++ than one exchange. For example our PBX at Columbia University (which
++ must handle more than 10,000 phones) has 853-xxxx and 854-xxxx
++ exchanges.
++
++ Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, the SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE command accepts a
++ list of exchanges, e.g.:
++
++ SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE 853 854
++
++ (multiple exchanges are separated by spaces, not commas).
++
++ So now when dialing a portable-format number that has the same country
++ and area codes as those of your dialing location, C-Kermit compares
++ the exchange of the dialed number with each number in the PBX Exchange
++ list (rather than with a single PBX Exchange number, as it did
++ formerly) to determine whether this is an internal PBX number or an
++ external call. If it is an external call, then the PBX Outside Prefix
++ is applied, and then the normal dialing rules for local or
++ long-distance calls.
++
++ If it is an inside call, the exchange is replaced by the PBX Inside
++ Prefix. But if the PBX has more than one exchange, a single fixed PBX
++ Inside Prefix is probably not sufficient. For example, at Columbia
++ University, we must dial 3-xxxx for an internal call to 853-xxxx, but
++ 4-xxxx for a call to 854-xxxx. That is, the inside prefix is the final
++ digit of the exchange we are dialing. For this reason, C-Kermit 7.0
++ provides a method to determine the inside prefix dynamically at
++ dialing time, consisting of a new variable and new syntax for the SET
++ DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX command:
++
++ \v(d$px)
++ This variable contains the exchange that was matched when a PBX
++ internal call was detected. For example, if the PBX exchange
++ list is "853 854" and a call is placed to +1 (212) 854-9999,
++ \v(d$px) is set to 854.
++
++ SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX \fxxx(...)
++ If the PBX Inside Prefix is defined to be a function, its
++ evaluation is deferred until dialing time. Normally, this would
++ be a string function having \v(d$px) as an operand. Of course,
++ you can still specify a constant string, as before.
++
++ So given the following setup:
++
++ SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 1
++ SET DIAL AREA-CODE 212
++ SET DIAL PBX-OUTSIDE-PREFIX 93,
++ SET DIAL PBX-EXCHANGE 853 854
++ SET DIAL PBX-INSIDE-PREFIX \fright(\v(d$px),1)
++
++ The following numbers give the results indicated:
++
++ Number Result
++ +1 (212) 854-9876 4-9876
++ +1 (212) 853-1234 3-1234
++ +1 (212) 765-4321 93,765-4321
++ +1 (333) 765-4321 93,1333765-4321
++
++ Furthermore, the K_PBX_XCH environment variable may now be set to a
++ list of exchanges to automatically initialize C-Kermit's PBX exchange
++ list, for example (in UNIX ksh or bash):
++
++ export K_PBX_XCH="853 854"
++
++ (Quotes required because of the space.) Of course, this variable can
++ also be set to a single exchange, as before:
++
++ export K_PBX_XCH=853
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.13. The DIAL macro - Last-Minute Phone Number Conversions
++
++ After a DIAL or LOOKUP command is given, a list of phone numbers is
++ assembled from the dialing directory (if any), with all
++ location-dependent conversion rules applied as described in Chapter 5
++ of [395]Using C-Kermit.
++
++ However, additional conversions might still be required at the last
++ minute based on local or ephemeral conditions. So that you can have
++ the final word on the exact format of the dial string, C-Kermit 7.0
++ lets you pass the converted string through a macro of your own design
++ for final processing before dialing. The relevant command is:
++
++ SET DIAL MACRO [ name ]
++ Specifies the name of a macro to be run on each phone number
++ after all built-in conversions have been applied, just before
++ the number is dialed. If no name is given, no macro is run. The
++ phone number, as it would have been dialed if there were no
++ dial macro, is passed to the macro.
++
++ The dial macro can do anything at all (except start a file transfer).
++ However, the normal use for the macro would be to modify the phone
++ number. For this reason the phone number is passed to the macro as
++ argument number 1 (\%1). To cause a modified number to be dialed, the
++ macro should terminate with a RETURN statement specifying a return
++ value. To leave the number alone, the macro should simply end.
++ Example:
++
++ define xxx return 10108889999$\%1
++ set dial macro xxx
++ dial xyzcorp
++
++ This defines a DIAL MACRO called xxx, which puts an access code on the
++ front of the number. Another example might be:
++
++ def xxx if equal "\v(modem)" "hayes-1200" return \freplace(\%1,$,{,,,,,})
++ set dial macro xxx
++ dial xyzcorp
++
++ which replaces any dollar-sign in the dial string by a series of five
++ commas, e.g. because this particular modem does not support the "wait
++ for bong" feature (remember that commas that are to be included
++ literally in function arguments must be enclosed in braces to
++ distinguish them from the commas that separate the arguments) and when
++ the IF condition is not satisfied, the macro does not return a value,
++ and so the number is not modified. Then when a DIAL command is given
++ referencing a dialing directory entry, "xyzcorp". The macro is
++ automatically applied to each matching number.
++
++ Numerous dial-, modem-, communications-, and time-related variables
++ are available for decision making your dial macro. Type SHOW VARIABLES
++ for a list. Of particular interest is the \v(dialcount) variable,
++ which tells how many times the DIAL command gone through its retry
++ loop: 1 on the first try, 2 on the second, 3 on the third, and so on,
++ and the \v(dialresult) and \v(dialstatus) variables.
++
++ Here are some other applications for the DIAL MACRO (from users):
++
++ * Phone numbers in the dialing directory are formatted with '-' for
++ readability, but some modems don't like the hyphens, so the DIAL
++ macro is used to remove them before dialing; e.g
++ 0090-123-456-78-99 becomes 00901234567899: "def xxx return
++ \freplace(\%1,-)".
++ * To set some specific modem (or other) options depending on the
++ called customer or telephone number.
++ * Choosing the most appropriate provider based on (e.g.) time of
++ day, or cycling through a list of providers in case some providers
++ might be busy.
++
++ To illustrate the final item, suppose you have a choice among many
++ phone service providers; the provider is chosen by dialing an access
++ code before the number. Different providers might be better (e.g.
++ cheaper) for certain times of day or days of the week, or for dialing
++ certain locations; you can use the DIAL macro to add the access for
++ the most desirable provider.
++
++ Similarly, when the same number might be reached through multiple
++ providers, it's possible that one provider might not be able to
++ complete the call, but another one can. In that case, you can use the
++ DIAL macro to switch providers each time through the DIAL loop --
++ that's where the \v(dialcount) variable comes in handy.
++
++ The following command can be used to debug the DIAL macro:
++
++ SET DIAL TEST { ON, OFF }
++ Normally OFF, so the DIAL command actually dials. When ON, the
++ DIAL command performs all lookups and number conversions, and
++ then goes through the number list and retry loop, but instead
++ of actually dialing, lists the numbers it would have called if
++ none of the DIAL attempts succeeded (or more precisely, every
++ number was always busy).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.14. Automatic Tone/Pulse Dialing Selection
++
++ SET DIAL METHOD { AUTO, DEFAULT, PULSE, TONE }
++ Chooses the dialing method for subsequent calls.
++
++ Prior to version 7.0, C-Kermit's DIAL METHOD was DEFAULT by default,
++ meaning it does not specify a dialing method to the modem, but relies
++ on the modem to have an appropriate default dialing method set. So,
++ for example, when using Hayes compatible modems, the dial string would
++ be something like ATD7654321, rather than ATDT7654321 or ATDP7654321.
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19, the dial method can be set from the
++ environment variable:
++
++ K_DIAL_METHOD
++
++ when Kermit starts. The values can be TONE, PULSE, or DEFAULT, e.g.
++ (UNIX):
++
++ set K_DIAL_METHOD=TONE; export K_DIAL_METHOD
++
++ In the absence of a K_DIAL_METHOD definition, the new default SET DIAL
++ METHOD is AUTO rather than DEFAULT. When DIAL METHOD is AUTO and the
++ local country code is known, then if tone dialing is universally
++ available in the corresponding area, tone dialing is used; if dialing
++ from a location where pulse dialing is mandatory, pulse dialing is
++ used.
++
++ The "tone country" and "pulse country" lists are preloaded according
++ to our knowledge at the time of release. You can see their contents in
++ the SHOW DIAL listing. You can change the lists with:
++
++ SET DIAL TONE-COUNTRIES [ cc [ cc [ ... ] ] ]
++ Replaces the current TONE-COUNTRIES list with the one given.
++ Each cc is a country code; separate them with spaces (not
++ commas). Example:
++
++ set dial tone-countries 1 358 44 46 49
++
++ If no country codes are given, the current list, if any, is
++ removed, in which case SET DIAL METHOD AUTO is equivalent to
++ SET DIAL METHOD DEFAULT.
++
++ SET DIAL PULSE-COUNTRIES [ cc [ cc [ ... ] ] ]
++ Replaces the current PULSE-COUNTRIES list with the one give.
++ Syntax and operation is like SET DIAL TONE-COUNTRIES.
++
++ If the same country code appears in both lists, Pulse takes
++ precedence.
++
++ The SET DIAL TONE- and PULSE-COUNTRIES commands perform no
++ verification whatsoever on the cc's, since almost any syntax might be
++ legal in some settings. Furthermore, there is no facility to edit the
++ lists; you can only replace the whole list. However, since the only
++ purpose of these lists is to establish a basis for picking tone or
++ pulse dialing automatically, all you need to override the effect of
++ the list is to set a specific dialing method with SET DIAL METHOD TONE
++ or SET DIAL METHOD PULSE.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.15. Dial-Modifier Variables
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, dial modifiers are available in the following
++ variables:
++
++ \v(dm_lp) Long pause
++ \v(dm_sp) Short pause
++ \v(dm_pd) Pulse dial
++ \v(dm_td) Tone dial
++ \v(dm_wa) Wait for answer
++ \v(dm_wd) Wait for dialtone
++ \v(dm_rc) Return to command mode
++
++ You can use these in your dial strings in place of hardwired modifiers
++ like "@", ",", etc, for increased portability of scripts. Example:
++
++ C-Kermit>set modem type usrobotics
++ C-Kermit>sho variables dm
++ \v(dm_lp) = ,
++ \v(dm_sp) = /
++ \v(dm_pd) = P
++ \v(dm_td) = T
++ \v(dm_wa) = @
++ \v(dm_wd) = W
++ \v(dm_rc) = ;
++ C-Kermit>exit
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.1.16. Giving Multiple Numbers to the DIAL Command
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the only way to give a DIAL command a list of
++ phone numbers to try until one answers was to create a dialing
++ directory that had multiple entries under the same name, and then use
++ that entry name in the DIAL command. Now a list of numbers can be
++ given to the DIAL command directly in the following format:
++
++ dial {{number1}{number2}{number3}...}
++
++ This is the same list format used by SEND /EXCEPT: and other commands
++ that allow a list where normally a single item is given. Restrictions
++ on this form of the DIAL command are:
++
++ * The first two braces must be adjacent; spacing is optional
++ thereafter.
++ * Each number must be an actual number to dial, not a dialing
++ directory entry.
++ * Dialing directory entries may not contain number lists in this
++ format.
++
++ In all other respects, the numbers are treated as if they had been
++ fetched from the dialing directory; they can be in literal or portable
++ format, etc. Example:
++
++ dial {{7654321} {+1 (212) 5551212} { 1-212-5556789 }}
++
++ The list can be any length at all, within reason.
++
++ This feature is especially handy for use with the K95 Dialer, allowing
++ a list of phone numbers to be specified in the Telephone Number box
++ without having to set up or reference a separate dialing directory.
++
++ You can also use it to add commonly-dialed sequences as variables in
++ your C-Kermit customization file, e.g.:
++
++ define work {{7654321}{7654322}{7654323}}
++
++ and then:
++
++ dial {\m(work)}
++
++ (the variable name must be enclosed in braces).
++
++ Or more simply:
++
++ define work dial {{7654321}{7654322}{7654323}}
++
++ and then:
++
++ work
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.2. Modems
++
++ 2.2.1. New Modem Types
++
++ Since C-Kermit 6.0:
++
++ atlas-newcom-33600ifxC Atlas/Newcom 33600
++ att-keepintouch AT&T KeepinTouch PCMCIA V.32bis Card Modem
++ att-1900-stu-iii AT&T Secure Data STU-III Model 1900
++ att-1910-stu-iii AT&T Secure Data STU-III Model 1910
++ bestdata Best Data
++ cardinal Cardinal V.34 MVP288X series.
++ compaq Compaq Data+Fax (e.g. in Presario)
++ fujitsu Fujitsu Fax/Modem Adapter
++ generic-high-speed Any modern error-correcting data-compressing modem
++ itu-t-v25ter/v250 ITU-T (CCITT) V.25ter (V.250) standard command set
++ megahertz-att-v34 Megahertz AT&T V.34
++ megahertz-xjack Megahertz X-Jack
++ motorola-codex Motorola Codex 326X Series
++ motorola-montana Motorola Montana
++ mt5634zpx Multitech MT5634ZPX
++ rockwell-v90 Rockwell V.90 56K
++ rolm-244pc Siemens/Rolm 244PC (AT command set)
++ rolm-600-series Siemens/Rolm 600 Series (AT command set)
++ spirit-ii QuickComm Spirit II
++ suprasonic SupraSonic V288+
++ supra-express-v90 Supra Express V.90
++
++ One of the new types, "generic-high-speed" needs a bit of explanation.
++ This type was added to easily handle other types that are not
++ explicitly covered, without going through the bother of adding a
++ complete user-defined modem type. This one works for modern modems
++ that use the AT command set, on the assumption that all the default
++ ("factory") settings of the modem (a) are appropriate for Kermit, (b)
++ include error correction, data compression, and speed buffering; and
++ (c) are recallable with the command AT&F.
++
++ If the command to recall your modem's profile is not AT&F, use the SET
++ MODEM COMMAND INIT-STRING command to specify the appropriate modem
++ command. The default init-string is AT&F\13 (that is, AT, ampersand,
++ F, and then carriage return); a survey of about 20 modern modem types
++ shows they all support this, but they might mean different things by
++ it. For example, the USR Sportster or Courier needs AT&F1 (not AT&F,
++ which is equivalent to AT&F0, which recalls an inappropriate profile),
++ so for USR modems:
++
++ set modem type generic-high-speed
++ set modem command init AT&F1\13
++
++ Of course, USR modems already have their own built-in modem type. But
++ if you use this one instead, it will dial faster because it has fewer
++ commands to give to the modem; in that sense "&F1" is like a macro
++ that bundles numerous commands into a single one. See your modem
++ manual for details about factory profiles and commands to recall them.
++
++ WARNING: Do not use the generic-high-speed modem type in operating
++ systems like VMS where hardware flow control is not available, at
++ least not unless you change the init string from AT&F\13 to something
++ else that enables local Xon/Xoff or other appropriate type of flow
++ control.
++
++ Also see [396]Section 2.1.7 for additional hints about making dialing
++ go faster.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.2.2. New Modem Controls
++
++ SET MODEM CAPABILITIES list
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, this command automatically turns MODEM
++ SPEED-MATCHING OFF if SB (Speed Buffering) is in the list, and
++ turns it ON if SB is absent.
++
++ SET MODEM COMMAND PREDIAL-INIT [ text ]
++ Commands to be sent to the modem just prior to dialing.
++ Normally none.
++
++ SET MODEM SPEAKER { ON, OFF }
++ Determines whether modem speaker is on or off while call is
++ being placed. ON by default. Note: This command does not
++ provide fine-grained control over when the speaker is on or
++ off. Normally, ON means while the call is being placed, until
++ the point at which carrier is successfully established. If your
++ modem has a different speaker option that you want to choose,
++ then use the SET MODEM COMMAND SPEAKER ON text command to
++ specify this option.
++
++ SET MODEM COMMAND SPEAKER { ON, OFF } [ text ]
++ Specify or override the commands to turn your modem's speaker
++ on and off.
++
++ SET MODEM VOLUME { LOW, MEDIUM, HIGH }
++ When MODEM SPEAKER is on, select volume. Note: In some modems,
++ especially internal ones, these commands have no effect; this
++ is a limitation of the particular modem, not of Kermit.
++
++ SET MODEM COMMAND VOLUME { LOW, MEDIUM, HIGH } [ text ]
++ Specify or override the commands to set your modem's speaker
++ volume.
++
++ SET MODEM COMMAND IGNORE-DIALTONE [ text ]
++ The command to enable blind dialing ([397]Section 2.1.6).
++
++ SET MODEM ESCAPE-CHARACTER code
++ Has been augmented to allow codes of 0 or less: < 0 means the
++ escape mechanism is disabled. = 0 means to use (restore) the
++ default value from the modem database. > 0 and < 128 is a
++ literal value to be used instead of the default one. > 127
++ means the escape mechanism is disabled. This affects "modem
++ hangup". When the escape mechanism is disabled, but SET MODEM
++ HANGUP-METHOD is MODEM-COMMAND, it sends the hangup command
++ immediately, without the <pause>+++<pause> business first. This
++ is useful (for example) when sending lots of numeric pages, a
++ process in which never we go online, and so never need to
++ escape back. Eliminating the unnecessary pauses and escape
++ sequence allows a lot more pages to be sent per unit time.
++
++ Recall that C-Kermit can dial modems to which it is connected via
++ TCP/IP (Telnet or Rlogin) as described on page 126 of [398]Using
++ C-Kermit, 2nd Ed. In this case the MODEM HANGUP-METHOD should be
++ MODEM-COMMAND, since RS-232 signals don't work over TCP/IP
++ connections. As noted in the manual, such connections are set up by
++ the following sequence:
++
++ set host host [ port ]
++ set modem type name
++ dial number
++
++ But this can cause complications when you use Kermit to switch between
++ serial and TCP/IP connections. In the following sequence:
++
++ set host name
++ set modem type name
++ set port name
++
++ the first two commands obey the rules for dialing out over Telnet.
++ However, the SET PORT command requires that Kermit close its current
++ (Telnet) connection before it can open the serial port (since Kermit
++ can only have one connection open at a time). But since a modem type
++ was set after the "set host" command was given, Kermit assumes it is a
++ Telnet dialout connection and so sends the modem's hangup sequence is
++ sent to the Telnet host. To avoid this, close the network connection
++ explicitly before opening the serial one:
++
++ set host name
++ close
++ set modem type name
++ set port name
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.3. TELNET and RLOGIN
++
++ For additional background, please also read the [399]TELNET.TXT file,
++ also available on the Web in [400]HTML format.
++
++ Cautions:
++
++ * If making a Telnet connection with C-Kermit takes a very long
++ time, like over a minute, whereas the system Telnet program makes
++ the same connection immediately, try including the /NOWAIT switch:
++ C-Kermit> telnet /nowait hostname
++ See [401]TELNET.TXT or [402]TELNET.HTM for details. If it also
++ takes a very long time to make a Telnet connection with system
++ Telnet, then the delay is most likely caused by reverse DNS
++ lookups when your host is not properly registered in DNS.
++ * When supplying numeric IP addresses to C-Kermit or to any other
++ application (regular Telnet, Rlogin, etc), do not include leading
++ 0's in any fields unless you intend for those fields to be
++ interpreted as octal (or hex) numbers. The description of the
++ Internet address interpreter (the sockets library inet_addr()
++ routine) includes these words:
++
++ All numbers supplied as "parts" in a "." notation may be decimal,
++ octal, or hexadecimal, as specified in the C language (that is, a
++ leading 0x or 0X implies hexadecimal; otherwise, a leading 0
++ implies octal; otherwise, the number is interpreted as decimal).
++ To illustrate, 128.59.39.2 and 128.059.039.002 are not the same
++ host! Even though most of the fields contain non-octal digits.
++ Using system Telnet (not Kermit):
++ $ telnet 128.059.039.002
++ Trying 128.49.33.2 ...
++ Of course the same thing happens with Kermit because it uses (as
++ it must) the same system service for resolving network addresses
++ that Telnet, FTP, and all other TCP/IP applications use.
++ * The RLOGIN section on page 123 does not make it clear that you can
++ use the SET TELNET TERMINAL-TYPE command to govern the terminal
++ type that is reported by C-Kermit to the RLOGIN server.
++ * Note that the SET TCP commands described on pages 122-123 might be
++ absent; some platforms that support TCP/IP do not support these
++ particular controls.
++
++ New commands:
++
++ TELOPT { AO, AYT, BREAK, CANCEL, EC, EL, EOF, EOR, GA, IP, DMARK,
++ DO, DONT, NOP, SB, SE, SUSP, WILL, WONT }
++ This command was available previously, but supported only DO,
++ DONT, WILL, and WONT. Now it lets you send all the Telnet
++ protocol commands. Note that certain commands do not require a
++ response, and therefore can be used as nondestructive "probes"
++ to see if the Telnet session is still open; e.g.:
++
++ set host xyzcorp.com
++ ...
++ telopt nop
++ if fail stop 1 Connection lost
++
++ SET TCP ADDRESS [ ip-address ]
++ Specifies the IP address of the computer that C-Kermit is
++ running on. Normally this is not necessary. The exception would
++ be if your machine has multiple network adapters (physical or
++ virtual) with a different address for each adapter AND you want
++ C-Kermit to use a specific address when making outgoing
++ connections or accepting incoming connections.
++
++ SET TCP DNS-SERVICE-RECORDS { ON, OFF }
++ Tells C-Kermit whether to try to use DNS SRV records to
++ determine the host and port number upon which to find an
++ advertised service. For example, if a host wants regular Telnet
++ connections redirected to some port other than 23, this feature
++ allows C-Kermit to ask the host which port it should use. Since
++ not all domain servers are set up to answer such requests, this
++ feature is OFF by default.
++
++ SET TCP REVERSE-DNS-LOOKUP { ON, OFF, AUTO }
++ Tells Kermit whether to perform a reverse DNS lookup on TCP/IP
++ connections. This allows Kermit to determine the actual
++ hostname of the host it is connected to, which is useful for
++ connections to host pools, and is required for Kerberos
++ connections to host pools and for incoming connections. If the
++ other host does not have a DNS entry, the reverse lookup could
++ take a long time (minutes) to fail, but the connection will
++ still be made. Turn this option OFF for speedier connections if
++ you do not need to know exactly which host you are connected to
++ and you are not using Kerberos. AUTO, the default, means the
++ lookup is done on hostnames, but not on numeric IP addresses.
++
++ SET TELNET WAIT-FOR-NEGOTIATIONS { ON, OFF }
++ Each Telnet option must be fully negotiated either On or Off
++ before the session can continue. This is especially true with
++ options that require sub-negotiations such as Authentication,
++ Encryption, and Kermit; for proper support of these options
++ Kermit must wait for the negotiations to complete. Of course,
++ Kermit has no way of knowing whether a reply is delayed or not
++ coming at all, and so will wait a minute or more for required
++ replies before continuing the session. If you know that
++ Kermit's Telnet partner will not be sending the required
++ replies, you can set this option of OFF to avoid the long
++ timeouts. Or you can instruct Kermit to REFUSE specific options
++ with the SET TELOPT command.
++
++ SET TELOPT [ { /CLIENT, /SERVER } ] option
++ { ACCEPTED, REFUSED, REQUESTED, REQUIRED }
++ [ { ACCEPTED, REFUSED, REQUESTED, REQUIRED } ]
++ SET TELOPT lets you specify policy requirements for Kermit's
++ handling of Telnet option negotiations. Setting an option is
++ REQUIRED causes Kermit to offer the option to the peer and
++ disconnect if the option is refused. REQUESTED causes Kermit to
++ offer an option to the peer. ACCEPTED results in no offer but
++ Kermit will attempt to negotiate the option if it is requested.
++ REFUSED instructs Kermit to refuse the option if it is
++ requested by the peer.
++
++ Some options are negotiated in two directions and accept
++ separate policies for each direction; the first keyword applies
++ to Kermit itself, the second applies to Kermit's Telnet
++ partner; if the second keyword is omitted, an appropriate
++ (option-specific) default is applied. You can also include a
++ /CLIENT or /SERVER switch to indicate whether the given
++ policies apply when Kermit is the Telnet client or the Telnet
++ server; if no switch is given, the command applies to the
++ client.
++
++ Note that some of Kermit's Telnet partners fail to refuse
++ options that they do not recognize and instead do not respond
++ at all. In this case it is possible to use SET TELOPT to
++ instruct Kermit to REFUSE the option before connecting to the
++ problem host, thus skipping the problematic negotiation.
++
++ Use SHOW TELOPT to view current Telnet Option negotiation
++ settings. SHOW TELNET displays current Telnet settings.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.3.0. Bug Fixes
++
++ If "set host nonexistent-host" was given (and it properly failed),
++ followed by certain commands like SEND, the original line and modem
++ type were not restored and C-Kermit thought that it still had a
++ network hostname; fixed in 7.0.
++
++ 2.3.1. Telnet Binary Mode Bug Adjustments
++
++ SET TELNET BUG BINARY-ME-MEANS-U-TOO { ON, OFF } was added to edit 192
++ after the book was printed. Also SET TELNET BUG BINARY-U-MEANS-ME-TOO.
++ The default for both is OFF. ON should be used when communicating with
++ a Telnet partner (client or server) that mistakenly believes that
++ telling C-Kermit to enter Telnet binary mode also means that it, too,
++ is in binary mode, contrary to the Telnet specification, which says
++ that binary mode must be negotiated in each direction separately.
++
++ 2.3.2. VMS UCX Telnet Port Bug Adjustment
++
++ A new command, SET TCP UCX-PORT-BUG, was added for VMS versions with
++ UCX (DEC TCP/IP), applying only to early versions of UCX, like 2.2 or
++ earlier. If you try to use VMS C-Kermit to make a Telnet connection
++ using a port name (like "telnet", which is used by default), the
++ underlying UCX getservbyname() function might return the service
++ number with its bytes swapped and the connection will fail. If "telnet
++ hostname 23" works, then your version of UCX has this bug and you can
++ put "set tcp ucx-port-bug on" in your CKERMIT.INI file to get around
++ it.
++
++ 2.3.3. Telnet New Environment Option
++
++ The TELNET NEW-ENVIRONMENT option ([403]RFC 1572) is supported as 7.0.
++ This option allows the C-Kermit Telnet client to send certain
++ well-known variables to the Telnet server, including USER, PRINTER,
++ DISPLAY, and several others. This feature is enabled by default in
++ Windows and OS/2, disabled by default elsewhere. The command to enable
++ and disable it is:
++
++ SET TELNET ENVIRONMENT { ON, OFF }
++
++ When ON, and you Telnet to another computer, you might (or might not)
++ notice that the "login:" or "Username:" prompt does not appear --
++ that's because your username was sent ahead, in which case the remote
++ system might prompt you only for your password (similar to Rlogin).
++ Use "set telnet environment off" to defeat this feature, particularly
++ in scripts where the dialog must be predictable. You can also use this
++ command to specify or override specific well-known environment
++ variable values:
++
++ SET TELNET ENVIRONMENT { ACCT,DISPLAY,JOB,PRINTER,SYSTEMTYPE,USER } [ text ]
++
++ 2.3.4. Telnet Location Option
++
++ The TELNET LOCATION option ([404]RFC 779) is supported in 7.0. This
++ option allows the C-Kermit Telnet client to send a location string to
++ the server if the server indicates its willingness to accept one. If
++ an environment variable named LOCATION exists at the time C-Kermit
++ starts, its value is used as the location string. If you want to
++ change it, use:
++
++ SET TELNET LOCATION text
++
++ If you omit the text from this command, the Telnet location feature is
++ disabled.
++
++ SET TELNET ENVIRONMENT DISPLAY is used to set the DISPLAY variable
++ that is sent to the host, as well as the the XDISPLAY location.
++
++ 2.3.5. Connecting to Raw TCP Sockets
++
++ The SET HOST and TELNET commands now accept an optional switch,
++ /RAW-SOCKET, at the end, only if you first give a host and a port.
++ Example:
++
++ set host xyzcorp.com 23 /raw-socket
++ set host 128.49.39.2:2000 /raw-socket
++ telnet xyzcorp.com 3000 /raw
++
++ Without this switch, C-Kermit behaves as a Telnet client when (a) the
++ port is 23 or 1649, or (b) the port is not 513 and the server sent
++ what appeared to be Telnet negotiations -- that is, messages starting
++ with 0xFF (IAC). With this switch, Kermit should treat all incoming
++ bytes as raw data, and will not engage in any Telnet negotiations or
++ NVT CRLF manipulations. This allows transparent operation through
++ (e.g.) raw TCP ports on Cisco terminal servers, through the 'modemd'
++ modem server, etc.
++
++ 2.3.6. Incoming TCP Connections
++
++ Accomplished via SET HOST * port, were introduced in C-Kermit 6.0, but
++ for UNIX only. In Version 7.0, they are also available for VMS.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.4. The EIGHTBIT Command
++
++ EIGHTBIT is simply a shorthand for: SET PARITY NONE, SET TERMINAL
++ BYTESIZE 8, SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8; that is, a way to set up an 8-bit
++ clean connection in a single command.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.5. The Services Directory
++
++ Chapter 7 of [405]Using C-Kermit does not mention the ULOGIN macro,
++ which is used by our sample services directory, CKERMIT.KND. Unlike
++ UNIXLOGIN, VMSLOGIN, etc, this one is for use with systems that
++ require a user ID but no password. Therefore it doesn't prompt for a
++ password or wait for a password prompt from the remote service.
++
++ In version 7.0, the CALL macro was changed to not execute a SET MODEM
++ TYPE command if the given modem type was the same as the current one;
++ otherwise the new SET MODEM TYPE command would overwrite any
++ customizations that the user had made to the modem settings. Ditto for
++ SET LINE / SET PORT and SET SPEED.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.6. Closing Connections
++
++ Until version 7.0, there was never an obvious and general way to close
++ a connection. If a serial connection was open, it could be closed by
++ "set line" or "set port" (giving no device name); if a network
++ connection was open, it could be closed by "set host" (no host name).
++
++ In version 7.0, a new command closes the connection in an obvious and
++ straightforward way, no matter what the connection type:
++
++ CLOSE [ CONNECTION ]
++
++ The CLOSE command was already present, and required an operand such as
++ DEBUG-LOG, WRITE-FILE, etc, and so could never be given by itself. The
++ new CONNECTION operand is now the default operand for CLOSE, so CLOSE
++ by itself closes the connection, if one is open, just as you would
++ expect, especially if you are a Telnet or Ftp user.
++
++ Also see the description of the new SET CLOSE-ON-DISCONNECT command in
++ [406]Section 2.10.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7. Using C-Kermit with External Communication Programs
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 includes a new ability to create and conduct sessions
++ through other communications programs. Two methods are available:
++
++ 1. Pty (pseudoterminal): The external program is run on a
++ "pseudoterminal", which is controlled by Kermit. This method works
++ with practically any external program, but it is not portable. At
++ this writing, it works only on some (not all) UNIX versions, and
++ not on any non-UNIX platforms.
++ 2. Pipe: The external program's standard input and output are
++ redirected through a "pipe" controlled by Kermit. This method is
++ relatively portable -- it should work across all UNIX versions,
++ and it also works in Windows and OS/2 -- but it is effective only
++ when the external program actually uses standard i/o (and many
++ don't).
++
++ The two methods are started differently but are used the same way
++ thereafter.
++
++ The purpose of this feature is to let you use C-Kermit services like
++ file transfer, character-set translation, scripting, automatic
++ dialing, etc, on connections that Kermit can't otherwise make itself.
++
++ This feature is the opposite of the REDIRECT feature, in which
++ C-Kermit makes the connection, and redirects an external (local)
++ command or program over this connection. In a pty or pipe connection,
++ C-Kermit runs and controls a local command or program, which makes the
++ connection. (The same method can be used to simply to control a local
++ program without making a connection; see [407]Section 2.8.)
++
++ To find out if your version of Kermit includes PTY support, type "show
++ features" and look for NETPTY in the alphabetical list of options. For
++ pipes, look for NETCMD.
++
++ The commands are:
++
++ SET NETWORK TYPE PTY or SET NETWORK TYPE PIPE
++ SET HOST command
++ where command is any interactive command. If the command does
++ not use standard i/o, you must use SET NETWORK TYPE PTY.
++
++ Notes:
++
++ * COMMAND is an invisible synonym for PIPE.
++ * The command and its arguments are case-sensitive in UNIX.
++
++ The SET NETWORK TYPE, SET HOST sequence sets the given network type
++ for all subsequent SET HOST commands until another SET NETWORK TYPE
++ command is given to change it.
++
++ You can also use the new /NETWORK-TYPE:PTY or /NETWORK-TYPE:PIPE (or
++ simply /PIPE or /PTY) switches on the SET HOST command itself:
++
++ SET HOST /NETWORK-TYPE:PIPE command ; These two are the same
++ SET HOST /PIPE command
++
++ SET HOST /NETWORK-TYPE:PTY command ; Ditto
++ SET HOST /PTY command
++
++ These are like SET NETWORK TYPE followed by SET HOST, except they
++ apply only to the connection being made and do not change the global
++ network type setting (see [408]Section 1.5 about the difference
++ between switches and SET commands).
++
++ Include any command-line options with the command that might be
++ needed, as in this example where C-Kermit uses another copy of itself
++ as the communications program:
++
++ SET HOST /PIPE /CONNECT kermit -YQJ xyzcorp.com
++
++ As usual, if you include the /CONNECT switch, SET HOST enters CONNECT
++ mode immediately upon successful execution of the given command.
++ Therefore new commands are available as a shorthand for SET HOST
++ /CONNECT /PTY and /PIPE:
++
++ PTY [ command ]
++ PIPE [ command ]
++ The PTY and PIPE commands work like the TELNET and RLOGIN
++ commands: they set up the connection (in this case, using the
++ given command) and then enter CONNECT mode automatically (if
++ the PIPE or PTY command is given without a command, it
++ continues the current session if one is active; otherwise it
++ gives an error message).
++
++ The PIPE command is named after the mechanism by which C-Kermit
++ communicates with the command: UNIX pipes. C-Kermit's i/o is "piped"
++ through the given command. Here is a typical example:
++
++ PIPE rlogin -8 xyzcorp.com
++
++ This is equivalent to:
++
++ SET HOST /PIPE rlogin -8 xyzcorp.com
++ CONNECT
++
++ and to:
++
++ SET HOST /PIPE /CONNECT rlogin -8 xyzcorp.com
++
++ IMPORTANT:
++ If you are writing a script, do not use the PIPE, PTY, TELNET,
++ or RLOGIN command unless you really want C-Kermit to enter
++ CONNECT mode at that point. Normally SET HOST is used in
++ scripts to allow the login and other dialogs to be controlled
++ by the script itself, rather than by an actively participating
++ human at the keyboard.
++
++ Throughput of pty and pipe connections is limited by the performance
++ of the chosen command or program and by the interprocess communication
++ (IPC) method used and/or buffering capacity of the pipe or pty, which
++ in turn depends on the underlying operating system.
++
++ In one trial (on SunOS 4.1.3), we observed file transfer rates over an
++ rlogin connection proceeding at 200Kcps for downloads, but only 10Kcps
++ for uploads on the same connection with the same settings (similar
++ disparities were noted in HP-UX). Examination of the logs revealed
++ that a write to the pipe could take as long as 5 seconds, whereas
++ reads were practically instantaneous. On the other hand, using Telnet
++ as the external program rather than rlogin, downloads and uploads were
++ better matched at about 177K each.
++
++ Most external communication programs, like C-Kermit itself, have
++ escape characters or sequences. Normally these begin with (or consist
++ entirely of) a control character. You must be sure that this control
++ character is not "unprefixed" when uploading files, otherwise the
++ external program will "escape back" to its prompt, or close the
++ connection, or take some other unwanted action. When in CONNECT mode,
++ observe the program's normal interaction rules. Of course C-Kermit's
++ own escape character (normally Ctrl-\) is active too, unless you have
++ taken some action to disable it.
++
++ On PTY connections, the underlying PTY driver is not guaranteed to be
++ transparent to control characters -- for example, it might expand
++ tabs, translate carriage returns, generate signals if it sees an
++ interrupt character, and so on. Similar things might happen on a PIPE
++ connection. For this reason, if you plan to transfer files over a PTY
++ or PIPE connection, tell the file sender to:
++
++ SET PREFIXING ALL
++ This causes all control characters to be prefixed and
++ transmitted as printable ASCII characters.
++
++ If the external connection program is not 8-bit clean, you should
++ also:
++
++ SET PARITY SPACE
++ This causes 8-bit data to be encoded in 7 bits using single
++ and/or locking shifts.
++
++ And if it does not make a reliable connection (such as those made by
++ Telnet, Rlogin, Ssh, etc), you should:
++
++ SET STREAMING OFF
++ This forces C-Kermit to treat the connection as unreliable and
++ to engage in its normal ACK/NAK protocol for error detection
++ and correction, rather than "streaming" its packets, as it
++ normally does on a network connection ([409]Section 4.20).
++
++ In some cases, buffer sizes might be restricted, so you might also
++ need to reduce the Kermit packet length to fit; this is a
++ trial-and-error affair. For example, if transfers always fail with
++ 4000-byte packets, try 2000. If that fails too, try 1000, and so on.
++ The commands are:
++
++ SET RECEIVE PACKET-LENGTH number
++ This tells the file receiver to tell the file sender the
++ longest packet length it can accept.
++
++ SET SEND PACKET-LENGTH number
++ This tells the file sender not to send packets longer than the
++ given length, even if the receiver says longer ones are OK. Of
++ course, if the receiver's length is shorter, the shorter length
++ is used.
++
++ If none of this seems to help, try falling back to the bare minimum,
++ lowest-common-denominator protocol settings:
++
++ ROBUST
++ No sliding windows, no streaming, no control-character
++ unprefixing, packet length 90.
++
++ And then work your way back up by trial and error to get greater
++ throughput.
++
++ Note that when starting a PIPE connection, and the connection program
++ (such as telnet or rlogin) prints some greeting or information
++ messages before starting the connection, these are quite likely to be
++ printed with a stairstep effect (linefeed without carriage return).
++ This is because the program is not connected with the UNIX terminal
++ driver; there's not much Kermit can do about it. Once the connection
++ is made, everything should go back to normal. This shouldn't happen on
++ a PTY connection because a PTY is, indeed, a terminal.
++
++ On a similar note, some connection programs (like Solaris 2.5 rlogin)
++ might print lots of error messages like "ioctl TIOCGETP: invalid
++ argument" when used through a pipe. They are annoying but usually
++ harmless. If you want to avoid these messages, and your shell allows
++ redirection of stderr, you can redirect stderr in your pipe command,
++ as in this example where the user's shell is bash:
++
++ PIPE rlogin xyzcorp.com 2> /dev/null
++
++ Or use PTY rather than PIPE, since PTY is available on Solaris.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.0. C-Kermit over tn3270 and tn5250
++
++ Now you can make a connection from C-Kermit "directly" to an IBM
++ mainframe and transfer files with it, assuming it has Kermit-370
++ installed. Because tn3270 is neither 8-bit clean nor transparent to
++ control characters, you must give these commands:
++
++ SET PREFIXING ALL ; Prefix all control characters
++ SET PARITY SPACE ; Telnet connections are usually not 8-bit clean
++
++ and then:
++
++ SET HOST /PTY /CONNECT tn3270 abccorp.com
++
++ or simply:
++
++ pty tn3270 abccorp.com
++
++ SET HOST /PIPE does not work in this case, at least not for file
++ transfer. File transfer does work, however, with SET HOST /PTY,
++ provided you use the default packet length of 90 bytes; anything
++ longer seems to kill the session.
++
++ You can also make connections to IBM AS/400 computers if you have a
++ tn5250 program installed:
++
++ pty tn5250 hostname
++
++ In this case, however, file transfer is probably not in the cards
++ since nobody has ever succeeded in writing a Kermit program for the
++ AS/400. Hint:
++
++ define tn3270 {
++ check pty
++ if fail end 1 Sorry - no PTY support...
++ pty tn3270 \%*
++ }
++
++ Similarly for tn5250. Note that CHECK PTY and CHECK PIPE can be used
++ in macros and scripts to test whether PTY or PIPE support is
++ available.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.1. C-Kermit over Telnet
++
++ Although C-Kermit includes its own Telnet implementation, you might
++ need to use an external Telnet program to make certain connections;
++ perhaps because it has access or security features not available in
++ C-Kermit itself. As noted above, the only precautions necessary are
++ usually:
++
++ SET PREFIXING ALL ; Prefix all control characters
++ SET PARITY SPACE ; Telnet connections might not be 8-bit clean
++
++ and then:
++
++ SET HOST /PTY (or /PIPE) /CONNECT telnet abccorp.com
++
++ or, equivalently:
++
++ PTY (or PIPE) telnet abccorp.com
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.2. C-Kermit over Rlogin
++
++ C-Kermit includes its own Rlogin client, but this can normally be used
++ only if you are root, since the rlogin TCP port is privileged. But
++ ptys and pipes let you make rlogin connections with C-Kermit through
++ your computer's external rlogin program, which is normally installed
++ as a privileged program:
++
++ SET PREFIXING ALL
++
++ and then:
++
++ SET HOST /PTY (or /PIPE) /CONNECT rlogin -8 abccorp.com
++
++ or, equivalently:
++
++ PTY (or PIPE) rlogin -8 abccorp.com
++
++ The "-8" option to rlogin enables transmission of 8-bit data. If this
++ is not available, then include SET PARITY SPACE if you intend to
++ transfer files.
++
++ Note that the normal escape sequence for rlogin is Carriage Return
++ followed by Tilde (~), but only when the tilde is followed by certain
++ other characters; the exact behavior depends on your rlogin client, so
++ read its documentation.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.3. C-Kermit over Serial Communication Programs
++
++ Ptys and pipes also let you use programs that make serial connections,
++ such as cu or tip. For example, C-Kermit can be used through cu to
++ make connections that otherwise might not be allowed, e.g. because
++ C-Kermit is not installed with the required write permissions to the
++ dialout device and the UUCP lockfile directory.
++
++ Suppose your UUCP Devices file contains an entry for a serial device
++ tty04 to be used for direct connections, but this device is protected
++ against you (and Kermit when you run it). In this case you can:
++
++ SET CONTROL PREFIX ALL
++ PTY (or PIPE) cu -l tty04
++
++ (Similarly for dialout devices, except then you also need to include
++ the phone number in the "cu" command.)
++
++ As with other communication programs, watch out for cu's escape
++ sequence, which is the same as the rlogin program's: Carriage Return
++ followed by Tilde (followed by another character to specify an action,
++ like "." for closing the connection and exiting from cu).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.4. C-Kermit over Secure Network Clients
++
++ DISCLAIMER: There are laws in the USA and other countries regarding
++ use, import, and/or export of encryption and/or decryption or other
++ forms of security software, algorithms, technology, and
++ intellectual property. The Kermit Project attempts to follow all
++ known statutes, and neither intends nor suggests that Kermit
++ software can or should be used in any way, in any location, that
++ circumvents any regulations, laws, treaties, covenants, or other
++ legitimate canons or instruments of law, international relations,
++ trade, ethics, or propriety.
++
++ For secure connections or connections through firewalls, C-Kermit 7.0
++ can be a Kerberos, SRP, and/or SOCKS client when built with the
++ appropriate options and libraries. But other application-level
++ security acronyms and methods -- SSH, SSL, SRP, TLS -- pop up at an
++ alarming rate and are (a) impossible to keep up with, (b) usually
++ mutually incompatible, and (c) have restrictions on export or
++ redistribution and so cannot be included in C-Kermit itself.
++
++ However, if you have a secure text-based Telnet (or other) client that
++ employs one of these security methods, you can use C-Kermit "through"
++ it via a pty or pipe.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.4.1. SSH
++
++ C-Kermit does not and can not incorporate SSH due to licensing,
++ patent, and USA export law restrictions.
++
++ The UNIX SSH client does not use standard input/output, and therefore
++ can be used only by Kermit's PTY interface, if one is present. The
++ cautions about file transfer, etc, are the same as for Rlogin.
++ Example:
++
++ SET PREFIXING ALL
++ PTY ssh XYZCORP.COM
++
++ Or, for a scripted session:
++
++ SET PREFIXING ALL
++ SET HOST /PTY ssh XYZCORP.COM
++
++ Hint:
++
++ define ssh {
++ check pty
++ if fail end 1 Sorry - no PTY support...
++ pty ssh \%*
++ }
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.4.2. SSL
++
++ Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) is another TCP/IP security overlay, this
++ one designed by and for Netscape. An SSL Telnet client is available
++ for UNIX from the University of Queensland. More info at:
++
++ [410]http://www.psy.uq.oz.au/~ftp/Crypto/
++
++ Interoperability with C-Kermit is unknown. C-Kermit also includes its
++ own built-in SSL/TLS support, but it is not exportable; [411]CLICK
++ HERE file for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.4.3. SRP
++
++ SRP(TM) is Stanford University's Secure Remote Password protocol. An
++ SRP Telnet client is available from Stanford:
++
++ [412]http://srp.stanford.edu/srp/
++
++ Stanford's SRP Telnet client for UNIX has been tested on SunOS and
++ works fine with C-Kermit, as described in [413]Section 2.7.1, e.g.
++
++ SET PREFIX ALL
++ PTY (or PIPE) srp-telnet xenon.stanford.edu
++
++ C-Kermit itself can be built as an SRP Telnet client on systems that
++ have libsrp.a installed; the C-Kermit support code, however, may not
++ be exported outside the USA or Canada.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.4.4. SOCKS
++
++ C-Kermit can be built as a SOCKS-aware client on systems that have a
++ SOCKS library. See section 8.1.1 of the [414]ckccfg.txt file.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 can also be run over SOCKSified Telnet or rlogin clients
++ with SET NETWORK TYPE COMMAND. Suppose the Telnet program on your
++ system is SOCKS enabled but C-Kermit is not. Make Kermit connections
++ like this:
++
++ SET PREFIX ALL
++ PTY (or PIPE) telnet zzz.com
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.7.4.5. Kerberos
++
++ UNIX C-Kermit can be built with MIT Kerberos IV or V authentication
++ and encryption. Instructions are available in a [415]separate
++ document. Additional modules are required that can not be exported
++ from the USA to any country except Canada, by US law.
++
++ If you have Kerberos installed but you don't have a Kerberized version
++ of C-Kermit, you can use ktelnet as C-Kermit's external communications
++ program to make secure connections without giving up C-Kermit's
++ services:
++
++ SET PREFIX ALL
++ PTY (or PIPE) ktelnet cia.gov
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.8. Scripting Local Programs
++
++ If your version of Kermit has PTY support built in, then any
++ text-based program can be invoked with SET HOST /PTY or equivalent
++ command and controlled using the normal sequence of OUTPUT, INPUT, IF
++ SUCCESS commands (this is the same service that is provided by the
++ 'expect' program, but controlled by the Kermit script language rather
++ than Tcl).
++
++ When PTY service is not available, then any program that uses standard
++ input and output can be invoked with SET HOST /PIPE.
++
++ Here's an example in which we start an external Kermit program, wait
++ for its prompt, give it a VERSION command, and then extract the
++ numeric version number from its response:
++
++ set host /pty kermit -Y
++ if fail stop 1 {Can't start external command}
++ input 10 C-Kermit>
++ if fail stop 1 {No C-Kermit> prompt}
++ output version\13
++ input 10 {Numeric: }
++ if fail stop 1 {No match for "Numeric:"}
++ clear input
++ input 10 \10
++ echo VERSION = "\fsubstr(\v(input),1,6)"
++ output exit\13
++
++ This technique could be used to control any other interactive program,
++ even those that do screen formatting (like Emacs or Vi), if you can
++ figure out the sequence of events. If your Kermit program doesn't have
++ PTY support, then the commands are restricted to those using standard
++ i/o, including certain shells, interactive text-mode "hardcopy"
++ editors like ex, and so on.
++
++ If you are using the PTY interface, you should be aware that it runs
++ the given program or command directly on the pty, without any
++ intervening shell to interpret metacharacters, redirectors, etc. If
++ you need this sort of thing, include the appropriate shell invocation
++ as part of your command; for example:
++
++ pty echo *
++
++ just echoes "*"; whereas:
++
++ pty ksh -c "echo *"
++
++ echoes all the filenames that ksh finds matching "*".
++
++ Similarly for redirection:
++
++ set host /pty ksh -c "cat > foo" ; Note: use shell quoting rules here
++ set transmit eof \4
++ transmit bar
++
++ And for that matter, for built-in shell commands:
++
++ set host /pty ksh -c "for i in *; do echo $i; done"
++
++ The PIPE interface, on the other hand, invokes the shell
++ automatically, so:
++
++ pipe echo *
++
++ prints filenames, not "*".
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.9. X.25 Networking
++
++ X.25 networking is documented in [416]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition.
++ When the book was published, X.25 was available only in SunOS,
++ Solaris, and Stratus VOS. Unlike TCP/IP, X.25 APIs are not
++ standardized; each vendor's X.25 libraries and services (if they have
++ them at all) are unique.
++
++ This section describes new additions.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.9.1. IBM AIXLink/X.25 Network Provider Interface for AIX
++
++ Support for X.25 was added via IBM's Network Provider Interface (NPI),
++ AIXLink/X.25 1.1, to the AIX 4.x version of C-Kermit 7.0.
++ Unfortunately, AIXLink/X.25 is a rather bare-bones facility, lacking
++ in particular any form of PAD support (X.3, X.28, X.29). Thus, the AIX
++ version of C-Kermit, when built to include X.25 networking, has
++ neither a PAD command, nor a SET PAD command. The same is true for the
++ underlying AIX system: no PAD support. Thus it is not possible to have
++ an interactive shell session over an X.25 connection into an AIX
++ system (as far as we know), even from X.25-capable Kermit versions
++ (such as Solaris or VOS) that do include PAD support.
++
++ Thus the X.25 capabilities in AIX C-Kermit are limited to peer-to-peer
++ connections, e.g. from a C-Kermit client to a C-Kermit server. Unlike
++ the Solaris, SunOS, and VOS versions, the AIX version can accept
++ incoming X.25 connections:
++
++ set network type x.25
++ if fail stop 1 Sorry - no X.25 support
++ ; Put any desired DISABLE or ENABLE or SET commands here.
++ set host /server *
++ if fail stop 1 X.25 "set host *" failed
++
++ And then access it from the client as follows:
++
++ set network type x.25
++ if fail stop 1 Sorry - no X.25 support
++ set host xxxxxxx ; Specify the X.25/X.121 address
++ if fail stop 1 Can't open connection
++
++ And at this point the client can use the full range of client
++ commands: SEND, GET, REMOTE xxx, FINISH, BYE.
++
++ The AIX version also adds two new variables:
++
++ \v(x25local_nua)
++ The local X.25 address.
++
++ \v(x25remote_nua)
++ The X.25 address of the host on the other end of the
++ connection.
++
++ C-Kermit's AIX X.25 client has not been tested against anything other
++ than a C-Kermit X.25 server on AIX. It is not known if it will
++ interoperate with C-Kermit servers on Solaris, SunOS, or VOS.
++
++ To make an X.25 connection from AIX C-Kermit, you must:
++
++ set x25 call-user-data xxxx
++
++ where xxxx can be any even-length string of hexadecimal digits, e.g.
++ 123ABC.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.9.2. HP-UX X.25
++
++ Although C-Kermit presently does not include built-in support for
++ HP-UX X.25, it can still be used to make X.25 connections as follows:
++ start Kermit and tell it to:
++
++ set prefixing all
++ set parity space
++ pty padem address
++
++ This should work in HP-UX 9.00 and later (see [417]Section 2.7). If
++ you have an earlier HP-UX version, or the PTY interface doesn't work
++ or isn't available, try:
++
++ set prefixing all
++ set parity space
++ pipe padem address
++
++ Failing that, use Kermit to telnet to localhost and then after logging
++ back in, start padem as you would normally do to connect over X.25.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.10. Additional Serial Port Controls
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds the following commands for greater control over
++ serial ports. These commands are available only in C-Kermit versions
++ whose underlying operating systems provide the corresponding services
++ (such as POSIX and UNIX System V), and even then their successful
++ operation depends on the capabilities of the specific device and
++ driver.
++
++ SET DISCONNECT { ON, OFF }
++ On a SET LINE or SET PORT connection with SET CARRIER ON or
++ AUTO, if the carrier signal drops during the connection,
++ indicating that the connection has been lost, and C-Kermit
++ notices it, this setting governs what happens next. With SET
++ DISCONNECT OFF, which is consistent with previous behavior, and
++ therefore the default, C-Kermit continues to keep the device
++ open and allocated. With SET DISCONNECT ON, C-Kermit
++ automatically closes and releases the device when it senses a
++ carrier on-to-off transition, thus allowing others to use it.
++ However, it remains the default device for i/o (DIAL, REDIAL,
++ INPUT, SEND, CONNECT, etc), so if a subsequent i/o command is
++ given, the device is reopened if it is still available. When it
++ has been automatically closed in this manner, SHOW
++ COMMUNICATIONS puts "(closed)" after its name, and in UNIX, the
++ lockfile disappears -- both from SHOW COMM and from the
++ lockfile directory itself. Synonym: SET CLOSE-ON-DISCONNECT.
++
++ SET EXIT ON-DISCONNECT { ON, OFF }
++ Like DISCONNECT, but makes the program exit if a connection
++ drops.
++
++ Note that SET CLOSE-ON-DISCONNECT and SET EXIT ON-DISCONNECT apply
++ only to connections that drop; they do not apply to connections that
++ can't be made in the first place. For example, they have no effect
++ when a SET LINE, SET HOST, TELNET, or DIAL command fails.
++
++ HANGUP
++ If [CLOSE-ON-]DISCONNECT is ON, and the HANGUP command is given
++ on a serial device, and the carrier signal is no longer present
++ after the HANGUP command, the device is closed and released.
++
++ SET PARITY HARDWARE { EVEN, ODD }
++ Unlike SET PARITY { EVEN, ODD, MARK, SPACE }, which selects 7
++ data bits plus the indicated kind of parity (to be done in
++ software by Kermit itself), SET PARITY HARDWARE selects 8 data
++ bits plus even or odd parity, to be done by the underlying
++ hardware, operating system, or device driver. This command is
++ effective only with a SET LINE or SET PORT device. That is, it
++ has no effect in remote mode, nor on network connections. There
++ is presently no method for selecting 8 data bits plus mark or
++ space parity. If hardware parity is in effect, the variable
++ \v(hwparity) is set to "even" or "odd". Note: some platforms
++ might also support settings of SPACE, MARK, or NONE.
++
++ SET STOP-BITS { 1, 2 }
++ This tells the number of 1-bits to insert after an outbound
++ character's data and parity bits, to separate it from the next
++ character. Normally 1. Choosing 2 stop bits should do no harm,
++ but will slow down serial transmission by approximately 10
++ percent. Historically, 2 stop bits were used with Teletypes (at
++ 110 bps or below) for print-head recovery time. There is
++ presently no method for choosing any number of stop bits
++ besides 1 and 2.
++
++ SET SERIAL [ dps ]
++ dps stands for Data-bits, Parity, Stop-bits. This is the
++ notation familiar to many people for serial port configuration:
++ 7E1, 8N1, 7O2, etc. The data bits number also becomes the
++ TERMINAL BYTESIZE setting. The second character is E for Even,
++ O for Odd, M for Mark, S for Space, or N for None. The list of
++ available options depends on the capabilities of the specific
++ platform. If dps is omitted, 8N1 is used. Type "set serial ?"
++ for a list of available choices. Examples:
++
++ SET SERIAL 7E1
++ Equivalent to SET PARITY EVEN, SET STOP-BITS 1, SET TERM
++ BYTE 7.
++
++ SET SERIAL 8N1
++ Equivalent to SET PARITY NONE, SET STOP-BITS 1, SET TERM
++ BYTE 8.
++
++ SET SERIAL 7E2
++ Equivalent to SET PARITY EVEN and SET STOP-BITS 2, SET
++ TERM BYTE 7.
++
++ SET SERIAL 8E2
++ Same as SET PARITY HARDWARE EVEN, SET STOP-BITS 2, SET
++ TERM BYTE 8.
++
++ SET SERIAL
++ Same as SET PARITY NONE and SET STOP-BITS 1, SET TERM
++ BYTE 8.
++
++ Notes:
++
++ * The SET SERIAL xx2 options are available only in Kermit versions
++ where the SET PARITY HARDWARE command is also available. (SHOW
++ FEATURES includes "HWPARITY" in its options list.)
++ * The SET SERIAL 7xx and 8N1 options affect the software parity
++ setting, even for network connections.
++ * As noted in the manual, selecting 8 data bits does not give you
++ 8-bit terminal sessions in CONNECT mode unless you also SET
++ TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8. The default terminal bytesize remains 7, to
++ protect against the situation where the remote host is generating
++ parity but you don't know about it. If the terminal bytesize was 8
++ by default and you CONNECTed to such a host, you would see only
++ garbage on your screen.
++ * If you do not give a SET STOP-BITS or SET SET SERIAL command,
++ C-Kermit does not attempt to set the device's stop bits; instead,
++ it uses whatever setting the device uses when not given explicit
++ instructions about stop bits.
++
++ SHOW COMMUNICATIONS displays the current settings. Stop bits and
++ hardware parity are shown only for SET PORT / SET LINE (serial)
++ devices, since they do not apply to network connections or to remote
++ mode. STOP-BITS is shown as "(default)" if you have not given an
++ explicit SET STOP-BITS or SET SERIAL command.
++
++ The \v(serial) variable shows the SET SERIAL setting (8N1, 7E1, etc).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.11. Getting Access to the Dialout Device
++
++ This section is for UNIX only; note the special words about QNX at
++ the end. Also see [418]Section 2.0 for SET LINE switches,
++ particularly the /SHARE switch for VMS only.
++
++ C-Kermit does its best to obey the UUCP lockfile conventions of each
++ platform (machine, operating system, OS version) where it runs, if
++ that platform uses UUCP.
++
++ But simply obeying the conventions is often not good enough, due to
++ the increasing likelihood that a particular serial device might have
++ more than one name (e.g. /dev/tty00 and /dev/term/00 are the same
++ device in Unixware 7; /dev/cua and /dev/cufa are the same device in
++ NeXTSTEP), plus the increasingly widespread use of symlinks for device
++ names, such as /dev/modem.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 goes to greater lengths than previous versions to
++ successfully interlock with other communications program (and other
++ instances of Kermit itself); for example, by:
++
++ * Creation of dual lockfiles whenever a symlink is used; one for the
++ link name and one for the real name.
++ * Creation of dual lockfiles in HP-UX according to HP rules.
++ * Creation of dual uppercase/lowercase lockfile names in SCO
++ UNIX/ODT/OSR5.
++ * The use of ttylock() in versions of AIX where it works.
++ * The use, wherever possible, of lockfile names based on
++ inode/major/minor device number rather than device name.
++
++ See the [419]ckuins.txt and [420]ckubwr.txt files for details.
++
++ QNX is almost unique among UNIX varieties in having no UUCP programs
++ nor UUCP-oriented dialout-device locking conventions. QNX does,
++ however, allow a program to get the device open count. This can not be
++ a reliable form of locking unless all applications do it (and they
++ don't), so by default, Kermit uses this information only for printing
++ a warning message such as:
++
++ C-Kermit>set line /dev/ser1
++ WARNING - "/dev/ser1" looks busy...
++
++ However, if you want to use it as a lock, you can do so with:
++
++ SET QNX-PORT-LOCK { ON, OFF }
++
++ QNX-PORT-LOCK is OFF by default; if you set in ON, C-Kermit fails to
++ open any dialout device when its open count indicates that another
++ process has it open. SHOW COMM (in QNX only) displays the setting, and
++ if you have a port open, it also shows the current open count (with
++ C-Kermit's own access always counting as 1).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.12. The Connection Log
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds the ability to log connections, so you can see where
++ you've been and have a record of calls you've made. A connection is
++ defined as any communications session that is begun by SET LINE, SET
++ PORT, DIAL, SET HOST, TELNET, or RLOGIN. Connections are not logged
++ unless you request it; the command is:
++
++ LOG CX [ filename [ { NEW, APPEND } ] ]
++ Enables logging of connections in the given file. If the
++ trailing { NEW, APPEND } keyword is omitted, the file is opened
++ for appending; i.e. new records are written to the end. If NEW
++ is specified, a new file is created; if a file of the same name
++ already existed, it is overwritten. If the filename is omitted,
++ CX.LOG in your home (login) directory is used (note:
++ uppercase). To accept all defaults, just use "log connections"
++ (or "l c" for short). Synonym: LOG CONNECTIONS.
++
++ CLOSE CX-LOG
++ This closes the connection log if it was open. (Note, the CLOSE
++ CONNECTION command closes the connection itself).
++
++ SHOW CX
++ This shows your current connection, if any, including the
++ elapsed time (since you opened it). Synonym: SHOW CONNECTION.
++
++ \v(cx_time)
++ This variable shows the elapsed time of your current
++ connection, or if there is no current connection, of your most
++ recent connection, of if there have been no connections, 0.
++
++ The connection contains one line per connection, of the form:
++
++ yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss username pid p=v [ p=v [ ... ] ]
++
++ where the timestamp (in columns 1-18) shows when the connection was
++ made; username is the login identity of the person who made the
++ connection; pid is Kermit's process ID when it made the connection.
++ The p's are parameters that depend on the type of connection, and the
++ v's are their values:
++
++ T = Connection Type (TCP, SERIAL, DIAL, DECNET, etc).
++ H = The name of the Host from which the connection was made.
++ N = Destination phone Number or Network host name or address.
++ D = Serial connections only: Device name.
++ O = Dialed calls only: Originating country code & area code if known.
++ E = Elapsed time in hh:mm:ss format (or hhh:mm:ss, etc).
++
++ If you always want to keep a connection log, simply add:
++
++ log connections
++
++ to your C-Kermit customization file. Note, however, that if you make a
++ lot of connections, your CX.LOG will grow and grow. You can handle
++ this by adding a "logrotate" procedure like the following to your
++ customization file, before the "log connections" command:
++
++ define LOGROTATE { ; Define LOGROTATE macro
++ local \%i \%m \%d \%n \%f MAX
++ def MAX 4 ; How many months to keep
++ if not def \%1 - ; No argument given
++ end 1 \%0: No filename given
++ if not = 1 \ffiles(\%1) - ; Exactly 1 file must match
++ end 1 \%0: \%1 - File not found
++ .\%d := \fsubstr(\fdate(\%1),1,6) ; Arg OK - get file year & month
++ if = \%d - ; Compare file year & month
++ \fsubstr(\v(ndate),1,6) - ; with current year & month
++ end 0 ; Same year & month - done
++ rename \%1 \%1.\%d ; Different - rename file
++ .\%n := \ffiles(\%1.*) ; How many old files
++ if < \%n \m(MAX) end 0 ; Not enough to rotate
++ .\%m := \%1.999999 ; Initial compare string
++ for \%i 1 \%n 1 { ; Loop thru old logs
++ .\%f := \fnextfile() ; Get next file name
++ if llt \%f \%m .\%m := \%f ; If this one older remember it
++ }
++ delete \%m ; Delete the oldest one
++ }
++ log connections ; Now open the (possibly new) log
++ logrotate \v(home)CX.LOG ; Run the LOGROTATE macro
++
++ As you can see, this compares the yyyymm portion of the modification
++ date (\fdate()) of the given file (\%1) with the current yyyymm. If
++ they differ, the current file has the yyyymm suffix (from its most
++ recent modification date) appended to its name. Then we search through
++ all other such files, find the oldest one, and delete it. Thus the
++ current log, plus the logs from the most recent four months, are kept.
++ This is all done automatically every time you start C-Kermit.
++
++ On multiuser systems, it is possible to keep a single, shared,
++ system-wide connection log, but this is not recommended since (a) it
++ requires you keep a publicly write-accessible logfile (a glaring
++ target for mischief), and (b) it would require each user to log to
++ that file and not disable logging. A better method for logging
++ connections, in UNIX at least, is syslogging (see [421]ckuins.txt
++ Section 15 and [422]Section 4.2 of the [423]IKSD Administration Guide
++ for details).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.13. Automatic Connection-Specific Flow Control Selection
++
++ Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, the appropriate flow-control method for
++ each connection type is kept in a table, for example:
++
++ Remote: NONE
++ Modem: RTS/CTS
++ Direct-Serial: NONE
++ TCPIP: NONE
++
++ The size of the table and values for each connection type can vary
++ from platform to platform. Type "set flow ?" for a list of available
++ flow-control types.
++
++ The table is used to automatically select the appropriate kind of flow
++ control whenever you make a connection. You can display the table
++ with:
++
++ SHOW FLOW-CONTROL
++
++ The defaults are as follows:
++
++ Remote:
++ NONE or XON/XOFF. This is because C-Kermit is not allowed to
++ find out what type of connection the incoming user has (*). No
++ kind of flow control will work on every kind of connection,
++ including (unexpectedly) KEEP, which we would have liked to
++ use, but not turning off flow control at the remote end during
++ file transfer on TCP/IP connections is fatal to the transfer
++ (except in VMS and HP-UX, where it must be set to Xon/Xoff!)
++ Therefore if you are dialing in to a serial port on a server
++ (UNIX or VMS) where C-Kermit is running, you will need to tell
++ C-Kermit to "set flow keep" before transferring files (assuming
++ the modem and port are configured correctly by the system
++ administrator; otherwise you'll need to give a specific kind of
++ flow control, e.g. "set flow xon/xoff"), so in this case
++ C-Kermit will not disable flow control, as it must do when you
++ are coming via Telnet (directly or through a terminal server,
++ except on VMS and HP-UX).
++
++ Modem:
++ This applies when you dial out with a modem. In this case, the
++ MODEM FLOW-CONTROL setting takes affect after the SET FLOW
++ setting, so it can pick the most appropriate flow control for
++ the combination of the particular modem and the
++ computer/port/driver that is dialing.
++
++ Direct-Serial:
++ The default here is NONE because C-Kermit has no way of knowing
++ what kind of flow control, if any, is or can be done by the
++ device at the other end of the connection. RTS/CTS would be a
++ bad choice here, because if the CTS signal is not asserted, the
++ connection will hang. And since direct connections are often
++ made with 3-wire cables, there is a good chance the CTS signal
++ will not be received.
++
++ TCPIP:
++ NONE, since TCP and IP provide their own flow control
++ transparently to the application, except in VMS, where Xon/Xoff
++ is the default due to the requirements of the VMS TCP/IP
++ products.
++
++ Other networks:
++ NONE, since networks should provide their flow control
++ transparently to the application.
++
++ (*) This is possibly the worst feature of UNIX, VMS, and other
++ platforms where C-Kermit runs. If C-Kermit was able to ask the
++ operating system what kind of connection it had to the user, it could
++ set up many things for you automatically.
++
++ You can modify the default-flow-control table with:
++
++ SET FLOW-CONTROL /xxx { NONE, KEEP, RTS/CTS, XON/XOFF, ... }
++
++ where "xxx" is the connection type, e.g.
++
++ SET FLOW /REMOTE NONE
++ SET FLOW /DIRECT RTS/CTS
++
++ If you leave out the switch, SET FLOW works as before, choosing the
++ flow control method to be used on the current connection:
++
++ SET FLOW XON/XOFF
++
++ Thus, whenever you make a connection with SET PORT, SET LINE, DIAL,
++ SET HOST, TELNET, RLOGIN, etc, an appropriate form of flow control is
++ selected automatically. You can override the automatic selection with
++ a subsequent SET FLOW command, such as SET FLOW NONE (no switch
++ included).
++
++ The flow control is changed automatically too when you give a SET
++ MODEM TYPE command. For example, suppose your operating system (say
++ Linux) supports hardware flow control (RTS/CTS). Now suppose you give
++ the following commands:
++
++ set line /dev/ttyS2 ; Automatically sets flow to NONE
++ set modem type usr ; Automatically sets flow to RTS/CTS
++ set modem type rolm ; Doesn't support RTS/CTS so now flow is XON/XOFF
++
++ IMPORTANT: This new feature tends to make the order of SET LINE/HOST
++ and SET FLOW commands matter, where it didn't before. For example, in
++ VMS:
++
++ SET FLOW KEEP
++ SET LINE TTA0:
++
++ the SET LINE undoes the SET FLOW KEEP command; the sequence now must
++ be:
++
++ SET FLOW /DIRECT KEEP
++ SET LINE TTA0:
++
++ or:
++
++ SET LINE TTA0:
++ SET FLOW KEEP
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.14. Trapping Connection Establishment and Loss
++
++ If you define a macro called ON_OPEN, it is executed any time that a
++ SET LINE, SET PORT, SET HOST, TELNET, RLOGIN or similar command
++ succeeds in opening a connection. The argument is the host or device
++ name (as shown by SHOW COMMUNICATIONS, and the same as \v(line)). This
++ macro can be used for all sorts of things, like automatically setting
++ connection- or host-specific parameters when the connection is opened.
++ Example:
++
++ def ON_OPEN {
++ switch \%1 {
++ :abccorp.com, set reliable off, break
++ :xyzcorp.com, set receive packet-length 1000, break
++ etc etc...
++ }
++ }
++
++ If you define a macro called ON_CLOSE, it will be executed any time
++ that a SET LINE, SET PORT, SET HOST, TELNET, RLOGIN or any other kind
++ of connection that C-Kermit has made is closed, either by the remote
++ or by a local CLOSE, HANGUP, or EXIT command or other local action,
++ such as when a new connection is opened before an old one was
++ explicitly closed.
++
++ As soon as C-Kermit notices the connection has been closed, the
++ ON_CLOSE macro is invoked at (a) the top of the command parsing loop,
++ or (b) when a connection is closed implicitly by a command such as SET
++ LINE that closes any open connection prior to making a new connection,
++ or (c) when C-Kermit closes an open connection in the act of exiting.
++
++ The ON_CLOSE macro was inspired by the neverending quest to unite
++ Kermit and SSH. In this case using the "tunnel" mechanism:
++
++ def TUNNEL { ; \%1 = host to tunnel to
++ local \%p
++ if not def \%1 stop 1
++ assign tunnelhost \%1 ; Make global copy
++ undef on_close
++ set macro error off
++ close connection ; Ignore any error
++ open !read tunnel start \%1
++ read \%p ; Get port number
++ if fail stop 1 Tunnel failure: \%1
++ close read
++ if fail stop 1 Tunnel failure: \%1 ; See [424]Section 4.2.8.1
++ assign on_close { ; Set up close handler
++ echo Closing tunnel: \m(tunnelhost)
++ !tunnel stop \m(tunnelhost)
++ undef on_close
++ }
++ set host localhost:\%p /telnet
++ if success end 0
++ undef on_close
++ stop 1 Connection failure: \%1
++ }
++
++ In this case, when the connection stops, we also need to shut down the
++ tunnel, even if it is at a later time after TUNNEL has finished
++ executing. This way we can escape back, reconnect, transfer files, and
++ so on until the connection is broken by logging out from the remote,
++ or by explicitly closing it, or by EXITing from C-Kermit, at which
++ time the tunnel is shut down.
++
++ When the connection is closed, no matter how, the ON_CLOSE macro
++ executes and then undefines (destroys) itself, since we don't want to
++ be closing tunnels in the future when we close subsequent connections.
++
++ Other such tricks can be imagined, including ending ON_CLOSE with a
++ STOP command to force the command stack to be peeled all the way back
++ to the top, for example in a deeply nested script that depends on the
++ connection being open:
++
++ def on_close { stop 1 CONNECTION LOST }
++
++ When C-Kermit invokes the ON_CLOSE macro, it supplies one argument
++ (\%1): the reason the connection was closed as a number, one of the
++ following:
++
++ 2 - Fatal failure to negotiate a required item on a network connection.
++ 1 - Closed by C-Kermit command.
++ 0 - All others (normally closed by remote).
++
++ which may be used for any purpose; for example, to add a comment to
++ the connection log:
++
++ def on_close {
++ local \%m
++ if not open cx end 0
++ switch \%1 {
++ :0, .\%m = Closed by remote, break
++ :1, .\%m = Closed by me, break
++ :2, .\%m = Network protocol negotiation failure, break
++ }
++ if def \%m writeln cx {# \%m}
++ }
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.15. Contacting Web Servers with the HTTP Command
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 (at this writing, the UNIX version only) supports direct
++ contact and interaction with Web servers via HTTP 1.0 protocol. To
++ make a connection, use Kermit's normal method for making a TCP/IP
++ connection, but specify the HTTP port:
++
++ SET HOST host http [ switches ]
++
++ where host is the IP hostname or address, and http is the name of the
++ TCP port for the Web server. Relevant switches include:
++
++ /RAW
++ Treat the connection as a transparent binary pipe. This switch
++ may be required if a port other than 'http' is used.
++
++ /SSL
++ Make an secure private connection with SSL (only if SSL support
++ is included in your version of Kermit). In this case the port
++ name might need to be https rather than http, e.g. "set host
++ secureserver.xyxcorp.com https /ssl".
++
++ /TLS
++ Make an secure private connection with TLS (only if TLS support
++ is included in your version of Kermit). In this case the port
++ name would be https rather than http.
++
++ Then you can issue an HTTP command. In most cases, the server closes
++ the connection when the command is complete. Example:
++
++ SET HOST www.columbia.edu http
++ IF FAIL EXIT 1 Can't contact server
++ HTTP GET kermit/index.html
++
++ At this point the connection is closed, since that's how HTTP 1.0
++ works. If you want to perform additional operations, you must
++ establish a new connection with another SET HOST command.
++
++ The HTTP command acts as a client to the Web server, except instead of
++ displaying the results like a Web browser would, it stores them. Any
++ HTTP command can (but need not) include any or all of the following
++ switches:
++
++ /AGENT:user-agent
++ Identifies the client to the server; "C-Kermit" or "Kermit-95"
++ by default.
++
++ /HEADER:header-line
++ Used for specifying any optional headers. A list of headers is
++ provided using braces for grouping:
++
++ /HEADER:{{tag:value}{tag:value}...}
++
++ For a listing of valid tag value and value formats see [425]RFC
++ 1945: Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0. A maximum of
++ eight headers may be specified.
++
++ /USER:name
++ In case a page requires a username for access.
++
++ /PASSWORD:password
++ In case a page requires a password for access.
++
++ /ARRAY:arrayname
++ Tells Kermit to store the response headers in the given array,
++ one line per element. The array need not be declared in
++ advance. Example:
++
++ C-Kermit? http /array:c get kermit/index.html
++ C-Kermit? show array c
++ Dimension = 9
++ 1. Date: Fri, 26 Nov 1999 23:12:22 GMT
++ 2. Server: Apache/1.3.4 (Unix)
++ 3. Last-Modified: Mon, 06 Sep 1999 22:35:58 GMT
++ 4. ETag: "bc049-f72-37d441ce"
++ 5. Accept-Ranges: bytes
++ 6. Content-Length: 3954
++ 7. Connection: close
++ 8. Content-Type: text/html
++
++ As you can see, the header lines are like MIME e-mail header lines:
++ identifier, colon, value. The /ARRAY switch is the only method
++ available to a script to process the server responses for a POST or
++ PUT command.
++
++ The HTTP commands are:
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] GET remote-filename [ local-filename ]
++ Retrieves the named file. If a local-filename is given, the
++ file is stored locally under that name; otherwise it is stored
++ with its own name.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] HEAD remote-filename local-filename
++ Like GET except without actually getting the file; instead it
++ gets only the headers, storing them into the given file, whose
++ name must be given, one line per header item, as shown above in
++ the /ARRAY: switch description.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] INDEX remote-directory [ local-filename ]
++ Retrieves the file listing for the given server directory.
++ NOTE: This command is not supported by most Web servers.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] POST [ /MIME-TYPE:type ] local-file remote-file
++ Used to send a response as if it were sent from a form. The
++ data to be posted must be read from a file.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] PUT [ /MIME-TYPE:type ] local-file remote-file
++ Uploads a local file to a server file.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] DELETE remote-filename
++ Instructs the server to delete the specified filename.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3. TERMINAL CONNECTION
++
++ 3.1. CONNECT Command Switches
++
++ The following switches (see [426]Section 1.5) were added to the
++ CONNECT command in 7.0:
++
++ /QUIETLY
++ Don't print the "Connecting to..." or "Back at..." messages. CQ
++ is an invisible command synonym for CONNECT /QUIETLY.
++
++ /TRIGGER:string
++ Specify a trigger or triggers ([427]Section 3.2) effective for
++ this CONNECT command only, temporarily overriding any current
++ SET TERMINAL TRIGGER values ([428]Section 3.2).
++
++ Note: Other switches might also be available; type "connect ?" for a
++ list, "help connect" for a description of each.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2. Triggers
++
++ Triggers were added for UNIX, VMS, AOS/VS, and K95 in C-Kermit 7.0.
++
++ SET TERMINAL TRIGGER string
++ Tells C-Kermit to look for the given string during all
++ subsequent CONNECT sessions, and if seen, to return to command
++ mode automatically, as if you had escaped back manually. If the
++ string includes any spaces, you must enclose it in braces.
++ Example:
++
++ set terminal trigger {NO CARRIER}
++
++ Comparisons are made after character-set translation.
++
++ If a string is to include a literal brace character, precede it with a
++ backslash:
++
++ ; My modem always makes this noise when the connection is lost:
++ set terminal trigger |||ppp\{\{\{\{UUUUUUU
++
++ If you want Kermit to look for more than one string simultaneously,
++ use the following syntax:
++
++ set terminal trigger {{string1}{string2}...{stringn}}
++
++ In this case, C-Kermit will return to command mode automatically if
++ any of the given strings is encountered. Up to 8 strings may be
++ specified.
++
++ If the most recent return to command mode was caused by a trigger, the
++ new variable, \v(trigger), shows the trigger value; otherwise
++ \v(trigger) is empty.
++
++ The SHOW TRIGGER command displays the SET TERMINAL TRIGGER values as
++ well as the \v(trigger) value.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3. Transparent Printing
++
++ As noted in the manual, C-Kermit's CONNECT command on UNIX is not a
++ terminal emulator, but rather a "semitransparent pipe" between the
++ terminal or emulator you are using to access C-Kermit, and the remote
++ host to which C-Kermit is connected. The "semitransparent" qualifier
++ is because of character-set translation as well as several actions
++ taken by the emulator in response to the characters or strings that
++ pass through it, such as APCs, Kermit packets (autodownload),
++ triggers, etc.
++
++ The UNIX version of C-Kermit 7.0 adds another such action: Transparent
++ printing, also called Controller printing (as distinct from Autoprint
++ or line or screen print). It is intended mainly for use on UNIX
++ workstation consoles (as opposed to remote logins), but with some care
++ can also be used when accessing C-Kermit remotely.
++
++ Transparent printing is related to APC by sharing C-Kermit's built-in
++ ANSI escape-sequence parser to detect "printer on" and "printer off"
++ sequences from the host. When the printer-on sequence is received, all
++ subsequent arriving characters -- including NUL, control characters,
++ and escape sequences -- are sent to the SET PRINTER device instead of
++ to your screen until the printer-off sequence is received, or you
++ escape back, whichever happens first. These bytes are not translated
++ or modified or filtered in any way by Kermit (except for possibly
++ stripping of the 8th bit, as noted below), but if filtering or
++ translation is desired, this can be accomplished by your SET PRINTER
++ selection (e.g. by choosing a pipeline of filters).
++
++ By default, your SET PRINTER device is your default UNIX printer, but
++ it can also be a file, a command, or the null device (which causes all
++ printer material to be discarded). See [429]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed.,
++ p.41 for details.
++
++ Transparent printing is controlled by the command:
++
++ SET TERMINAL PRINT { ON, OFF }
++ When ON, transparent-print sequences are obeyed, and printing
++ occurs on the system where C-Kermit is running. When OFF,
++ transparent print sequences are ignored and passed through to
++ your actual terminal or emulator, along with the data they
++ enclose. OFF is the default, for compatibility with earlier
++ C-Kermit releases. As noted in the manual, when the current SET
++ PRINTER device is a file, transparent-print material is
++ appended to it; the file is not overwritten.
++
++ SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE { 7, 8 }
++ SET PARITY { EVEN, ODD, MARK, SPACE, NONE }
++ If the terminal bytesize is 7, or PARITY is not NONE, the 8th
++ bit of each byte is stripped prior to printing.
++
++ The transparent-print escape sequences are:
++
++ <ESC>[5i
++ Printer On. Send all subsequent incoming bytes to the printer
++ without any kind of filtering, translation, or alteration.
++ Note: <ESC> stands for ASCII character number 27 (decimal),
++ Escape.
++
++ <ESC>[4i
++ Printer Off. Resume displaying incoming bytes on the screen.
++
++ These are the same sequences used by DEC VT100 and higher terminals
++ and other ANSI X3.64 and ISO 6429 compatible terminals. There is no
++ provision for selecting other printer-control sequences.
++
++ Restrictions:
++
++ 1. You must SET TERM TRANSPARENT-PRINT ON before you can use this
++ feature.
++ 2. Only the 7-bit forms of the escape sequences are supported. The
++ 8-bit CSI C1 control is not recognized.
++ 3. Autoprint is not supported, since this requires a full-fledged
++ terminal emulator with direct access to the screen.
++ 4. The start-print and stop-print sequences pass through to the
++ screen (there is no way to avoid this without causing unacceptable
++ delays or deadlocks in CONNECT mode). Thus if your terminal or
++ emulator also supports transparent printing via these same
++ sequences, an empty file will be sent to its printer. Normally
++ this has no effect.
++
++ Point (4) is similar to the situation with autodownload and APC --
++ when you have several Kermit clients in a chain, you should take care
++ that these features are enabled in only one of them.
++
++ Example 1:
++
++ set printer {|lpr -Plaser} ; Specify the printer (if not default).
++ set term print on ; Enable transparent printing.
++ set term byte 8 ; Enable 8-bit characters.
++ connect ; Enter CONNECT mode.
++
++ Example 2:
++
++ set printer /home/users/olga/printer.log ; Send printer material to a file.
++
++ Example 3:
++
++ set printer {| grep -v ^Received | lpr} ; Filter out some lines
++
++ Then use "pcprint" or "vtprint" commands on the host to initiate
++ transparent print operations. See [430]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed., p.406
++ for details.
++
++ Here is a sample "pcprint" shell script for UNIX:
++
++ #!/bin/sh
++ echo -n '<ESC>[5i'
++ if [ $# -eq 0 ]; then
++ cat
++ else
++ cat $*
++ fi
++ echo -n '<FF><ESC>[4i'
++ # (end)
++
++ (Replace "<ESC>" by the actual ASCII Escape character and "<FF>" by
++ the ASCII Formfeed character).
++
++ If you always want transparent printing enabled, put "set term print
++ on" in your C-Kermit customization file (~/.mykermrc in UNIX). The
++ "set term bytesize" selection, however, is a property of each separate
++ connection.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.4. Binary and Text Session Logs
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 corrects an oversight in earlier releases, in which
++ binary session logs (SET SESSION-LOG BINARY) translated character sets
++ and performed various formatting transformations (e.g. "newline mode")
++ before writing characters to the session log. In C-Kermit 7.0,
++ binary-mode session logging writes characters as they come in, before
++ anything (other that parity-bit stripping) is done to them. Text-mode
++ session logging records the characters after processing.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4. FILE TRANSFER
++
++ Every file is transferred either in text mode (which implies
++ record-format and character-set translation) or binary mode (in which
++ each byte is sent literally without any kind of conversion). The mode
++ in which a file is transferred is controlled by (a) the default mode,
++ in the absence of any other indications; (b) the SET FILE TYPE
++ command; (c) various automatic mechanisms based on client/server
++ negotiations, directory information or filename patterns, etc.
++
++ The default FILE TYPE was changed from TEXT to BINARY in C-Kermit 7.0
++ because:
++
++ * Transferring a text file in binary mode does less damage than
++ transferring a binary file in text mode.
++ * Only binary-mode transfers can be recovered from the point of
++ failure.
++ * The automatic transfer-mode mechanisms switch to text mode on a
++ per-file basis anyway, so only those files that are not covered by
++ the automatic mechanisms are affected.
++ * All file transfers on the Web are done in binary mode, so people
++ are accustomed to it and expect it.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0. BUG FIXES, MINOR CHANGES, AND CLARIFICATIONS
++
++ 4.0.0. Filenames with Spaces
++
++ Filenames that contain spaces are a major nuisance to a program like
++ Kermit, whose command language is line- and word-oriented, in which
++ words are separated by spaces and a filename is assumed to be a
++ "word". In general (unless noted otherwise in the description of a
++ particular command), there is only one way to refer to such files in
++ Kermit commands, and that is to enclose the name in braces:
++
++ send {this file}
++
++ Tells Kermit to send the file whose name is "this file" (two words, no
++ quotes). Of course, various circumlocutions are also possible, such
++ as:
++
++ define \%a this file
++ send \%a
++
++ BUT, perhaps contrary to expectation, you can't use "\32" to represent
++ the space:
++
++ send this\32file
++
++ does not work. Why? Because the Kermit parser, which must work on many
++ operating systems including Windows, has no way of knowing what you
++ mean by "this\32file". Do you mean a file whose name is "this file" in
++ the current directory? Or do you mean a file whose name is "32file" in
++ the "this" subdirectory of the current directory? Guessing won't do
++ here; Kermit must behave consistently and deterministically in all
++ cases on all platforms.
++
++ Note that you can't use Esc or Tab within {...} for filename
++ completion, or question mark to get a filename list. However, you can
++ include wildcards; for example:
++
++ send {* *}
++
++ sends all files whose name contains a space.
++
++ All things considered, it is best to avoid spaces in file and
++ directory names if you can. Also see [431]Section 5.4 on this topic.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.1. Packet out of Window
++
++ C-Kermit 6.0 could send packets "out of window" if the window size was
++ greater than 1 and ACKs had arrived out of order. Fixed in 6.1.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.2. MOVE after ADD SEND-LIST
++
++ ADD SEND-LIST followed by MOVE did not delete original files; fixed in
++ 6.1. Carrier loss was not detected during transfer; in 7.0 C-Kermit
++ checks for this (but results can not be guaranteed). In any case, the
++ protocol will eventually time out if the connection is lost.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.3. GET and RECEIVE As-Names
++
++ In 5A(190) through 6.0.192, the GET and RECEIVE as-name did not
++ properly override the RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting. In 7.0 it does.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.4. New Brief Statistics Listing
++
++ Version 7.0 adds a /BRIEF switch to the STATISTICS command, to display
++ a short file-transfer statistics report. /BRIEF is now the default.
++ Use /VERBOSE to see the full display, which is about 25 lines long.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.5. Improved FAST Command
++
++ The preinstalled definition of the FAST macro did not take enough
++ factors into account. Now it sets packet lengths and window sizes
++ appropriate to the configuration. Furthermore, in IRIX only, it might
++ restrict the SEND packet length to 4000, to work around a bug in the
++ IRIX Telnet server, depending on the IRIX version (see
++ [432]ckubwr.txt, IRIX section). To see the built-in definition of the
++ FAST macro, type "show macro fast". To change it, simply define it to
++ be whatever you want -- it's just a macro, like any other.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.6. The SET SEND BACKUP Command
++
++ Version 7.0 adds SET SEND BACKUP { ON, OFF }. This tells whether
++ backup files should be sent. Backup files are the ones created by
++ Kermit (and EMACS, and possibly other applications) to preserve old
++ copies of files when creating new ones with the same name. Kermit does
++ this when receiving a file and its FILE COLLISION setting is BACKUP
++ (or RENAME, in which case it the new file gets the backup name). On
++ most platforms, the backup name is formed by adding:
++
++ .~n~
++
++ to the end of the filename, where "n" is a number. For example, if the
++ original file is oofa.txt, a backup file might be called:
++
++ oofa.txt.~1~
++
++ (or oofa.txt.~2~, etc). If you SET SEND BACKUP OFF, this tells Kermit
++ not to send files that have backup names. Normally, SET SEND BACKUP is
++ ON (as shown by SHOW PROTOCOL), and backup files are sent if their
++ names match the SEND file specification.
++
++ Also see PURGE, SET FILE COLLISION, SEND /NOBACKUP, DIRECTORY
++ /[NO]BACKUP.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.7. The SET { SEND, RECEIVE } VERSION-NUMBERS Command
++
++ VMS Only. Normally when sending files, VMS C-Kermit strips the version
++ number. For example, if the file is FOO.BAR;34, the name is sent as
++ FOO.BAR (without the ";34"). If you want to keep version numbers on
++ when sending files, use SET SEND VERSION-NUMBERS ON. The effect
++ depends on the receiver.
++
++ Normally when receiving files, and an incoming filename includes a
++ VMS-style version number (such as FOO.BAR;34) VMS C-Kermit strips it
++ before trying to create the new file; this way the new file receives
++ the next highest version number in the customary manner for VMS. If
++ you want version numbers on incoming filenames to be used in creating
++ the new files, use SET RECEIVE VERSION-NUMBERS ON.
++
++ Normally these commands would be effective only when VMS C-Kermit is
++ exchanging files with a non-VMS Kermit program, since VMS-to-VMS
++ transfers use labeled mode unless you have gone out of your way to
++ defeat it.
++
++ Example: You want to send all versions of all files in the current
++ directory from a VMS C-Kermit client to a UNIX C-Kermit server. Use:
++
++ set send version-numbers on
++ send *.*;*
++
++ The resulting Unix files will have VMS-style version numbers as part
++ of their name, for example "foo.bar;1", "foo.bar;2", etc.
++
++ Now suppose you want to send these files from Unix to another VMS
++ system and preserve the version numbers. Again we have a Unix C-Kermit
++ server and VMS C-Kermit client. Give these commands to the client:
++
++ set receive version-numbers on
++ get *
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.8. The SET { SEND, RECEIVE } { MOVE-TO, RENAME-TO } Commands
++
++ These commands are persistent global versions of the /MOVE-TO: and
++ /RENAME-TO: switches of the SEND, GET, and RECEIVE commands. They
++ should normally be used only when setting up a dedicated
++ transaction-processing application, in which each file is to be moved
++ or renamed immediately after, and only if, it is transferred
++ successfully, so that (for example) an independent, concurrent process
++ can notice when new files appear and process them immediately without
++ having to guess whether they are complete.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.0.9. SET FILE INCOMPLETE AUTO
++
++ SET FILE INCOMPLETE { KEEP, DISCARD }, which tells whether to keep or
++ discard incompletely received files, has a new option, AUTO, which is
++ also the default. It means KEEP the incomplete file if the transfer is
++ in binary mode, otherwise DISCARD it. This reduces the chances that a
++ subsequent recovery operation (RESEND, REGET, etc) could produce a
++ corrupt file, since recovery works only for binary-mode transfers.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.1. FILE-TRANSFER FILENAME TEMPLATES
++
++ File-transfer filename templates allow files to be renamed
++ automatically by the file sender, the receiver, or both, during
++ transfer of groups of files.
++
++ 4.1.1. Templates in the As-Name
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 6.1 and Kermit 95 1.1.12 the only options that could
++ be used to affect the names of files being transferred were SET
++ FILENAMES { LITERAL, CONVERTED } and SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES {
++ ON, OFF }, plus the "as-name" feature of the SEND (MOVE, etc) and
++ RECEIVE commands.
++
++ Previously, the as-name could be used only for a single file. For
++ example:
++
++ SEND FOO BAR
++
++ would send the file FOO under the name BAR, but:
++
++ SEND *.TXT anything
++
++ was not allowed, since it would give the same name to each file that
++ was sent. When receiving:
++
++ RECEIVE FOO
++
++ would rename the first incoming file to FOO before storing it on the
++ disk, but subsequent files would not be renamed to FOO, since this
++ would result in overwriting the same file repeatedly. Instead, they
++ were stored under the names they arrived with.
++
++ Beginning in C-Kermit 6.1 and Kermit 95 1.1.12, it is possible to
++ specify as-names in SEND, RECEIVE, and related commands even for file
++ groups. This is accomplished by using replacement variables in the
++ as-name, along with optional material such character-string functions
++ and/or constant strings. An as-name containing replacement variables
++ is called a filename template.
++
++ The key to filename templates is the new variable:
++
++ \v(filename)
++
++ During file transfer it is replaced by the name of each file currently
++ being transferred (after transfer, it is the name of the last file
++ transferred).
++
++ So, for example:
++
++ send *.txt \v(filename).new
++
++ sends each file with its own name, but with ".new" appended to it. Of
++ course if the name already contains periods, this could confuse the
++ file receiver, so you can also achieve fancier effects with
++ constructions like:
++
++ send *.txt \freplace(\v(filename),.,_).new
++
++ which replaces all periods in the original filename by underscores,
++ and then appends ".new" to the result. So, for example, oofa.txt would
++ be sent as oofa_txt.new.
++
++ Another new variable that is useful in this regard is \v(filenumber),
++ which is the ordinal number of the current file in the file group, so
++ you can also:
++
++ send *.txt FILE\flpad(\v(filenum),2,0)
++
++ resulting in a series of files called FILE00, FILE01, FILE02, etc. (At
++ the end of the transfer, \v(filenum) tells the number of files that
++ were transferred).
++
++ If you specify a constant as-name when sending a file group:
++
++ send *.txt thisnameonly
++
++ Kermit complains and asks you to include replacement variables in the
++ as-name. You should generally use \v(filename) or \v(filenumber) for
++ this purpose, since other variables (with the possible exception of
++ date/time related variables) do not change from one file to the next.
++ But Kermit accepts any as-name at all that contains any kind of
++ variables for file group, even if the variable will not change. So:
++
++ send *.txt \%a
++
++ is accepted, but all files are sent with the same name (the value of
++ \%a, if it has one and it is constant). If the variable has no value
++ at all, the files are sent under their own names.
++
++ Of course, the value of \%a in the previous example need not be
++ constant:
++
++ define \%a FILE\flpad(\v(filenum),2,0)_at_\v(time)
++ send *.txt \%a
++
++ The RECEIVE command, when given without an as-name, behaves as always,
++ storing all incoming files under the names they arrive with, subject
++ to SET FILE NAME and SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES modifications ([433]Section
++ 4.10).
++
++ However, when an as-name is given in the RECEIVE command, it is
++ applied to all incoming files rather than to just the first. If it
++ does not contain replacement variables, then the current FILE
++ COLLISION setting governs the result. For example:
++
++ receive foo
++
++ will result in incoming files named foo, foo.~1~, foo.~2~, and so on,
++ with the default FILE COLLISION setting of BACKUP. If it does contain
++ replacement variables, of course they are used.
++
++ When receiving files, the \v(filename) variable refers to the name
++ that was received in the incoming file-header packet, BEFORE any
++ processing by SET FILE NAMES or SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES. Since the
++ filenames in file-header packets are usually in uppercase, you would
++ need to convert them explicitly if you want them in lowercase, e.g.:
++
++ receive \flower(\v(filename)).new
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.1.2. Templates on the Command Line
++
++ On the command-line, use templates as shown above as the -a option
++ argument, bearing in mind the propensity of UNIX and perhaps other
++ shells to treat backslash as a shell escape character. So in UNIX (for
++ example):
++
++ kermit -s oofa.* -a x.\\v(filenum)
++
++ By the way, this represents a change from 6.0 and earlier releases in
++ which the as-name (-a argument or otherwise) was not evaluated by the
++ command parser. Thus, for example, in VMS (where the shell does not
++ care about backslashes), it was possible to:
++
++ kermit -s oofa.txt -a c:\tmp\oofa.txt
++
++ Now backslashes in the as-name must be quoted not only for the shell
++ (if necessary) but also for Kermit itself:
++
++ kermit -s oofa.txt -a c:\\tmp\\oofa.txt ; Kermit only
++ kermit -s oofa.txt -a c:\\\\tmp\\\\oofa.txt ; Shell and Kermit
++
++ You can also use the \fliteral() function for this:
++
++ kermit -s oofa.txt -a \fliteral(c:\tmp\oofa.txt) ; Kermit only
++ kermit -s oofa.txt -a \\fliteral(c:\\tmp\\oofa.txt) ; Shell and Kermit
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.1.3. Post-Transfer Renaming
++
++ Filename templates are now also useful in SET { SEND, RECEIVE }
++ RENAME-TO and in the /RENAME-TO: switch, that can be given to the
++ SEND, GET, or RECEIVE commands; this is similar to an as-name, but is
++ effective on a per-file basis if and only if the file was transferred
++ successfully.
++
++ MOVE-TO and RENAME-TO address a requirement commonly stated for
++ transaction processing and similar systems. Suppose, for example, a
++ central system "X" accepts connections from multiple clients
++ simultaneously; a process on X waits for a file to appear and then
++ processes the file. This process must have a way of knowing when the
++ file has been completely and successfully transferred before it starts
++ to process it. This can be accomplished easily using C-Kermit's SET {
++ SEND, RECEIVE } { MOVE-TO, RENAME-TO } command or /MOVE-TO: or
++ /RENAME-TO: switches, described in [434]Sections 4.7.1 through
++ [435]4.7.3.
++
++ Here's an example for the client side, in which files to be sent are
++ placed in a certain directory (/usr/olga/tosend in this example) by
++ another process when they are ready to go. This might be in a hospital
++ or big doctor's office, where medical insurance claims are entered at
++ a number of workstations, and then deposited in the "tosend"
++ directory, from which they are sent to a claims clearinghouse. We
++ assume the connection is already made and a Kermit server is on the
++ other end.
++
++ local srcdir findir ; Declare local (automatic) variables
++ assign srcdir /usr/olga/tosend ; Local source directory (files to send)
++ assign findir /usr/olga/sent ; Where to move files after they are sent
++ log transactions ; Keep a log of transfers
++ cd \m(srcdir) ; Change to the source directory
++ while true { ; Loop forever...
++ send /move-to:\m(findir) * ; Send all files
++ sleep 60 ; Sleep a minute
++ } ; Go back and do it again
++
++ Note how simple this is. Once each file is sent, it is moved so it
++ won't be sent again (you could also use SEND /RENAME-TO: or even SEND
++ /DELETE). If a transfer fails, the file is not moved and so we try
++ again to send it next time around. If there are no files to send, the
++ SEND command does nothing but a message is printed; you can avoid the
++ message by checking first to see if any files are in the directory:
++
++ while true { ; Loop forever...
++ if > \ffiles(*) 0 - ; If there are any files
++ send /move-to:\m(findir) * ; send them.
++ sleep 60 ; Sleep a minute.
++ } ; Go back and do it again.
++
++ It's even simpler on the server side (here again we assume the
++ connection is already in place):
++
++ local rcvdir findir ; Declare local (automatic) variables
++ assign rcvdir /usr/ivan/tmp ; Temporary receiving directory
++ assign findir /usr/ivan/new ; Where to move files after reception
++ log transactions ; Keep a log of transfers
++ cd \m(rcvdir) ; Change to the source directory
++ set receive move-to \m(findir) ; Declare move-to directory.
++ server ; Enter server mode.
++
++ A separate process (e.g. the medical claim-form decoder) can look for
++ files appearing in the /usr/ivan/new directory and process them with
++ every confidence that they have been completely received.
++
++ Note that the use of MOVE-TO can result in moved files overwriting one
++ another (the application would normally avoid this by assigning each
++ transaction a unique, e.g. based on customer number and claim number).
++ But if filename collisions are a possibility in your application,
++ RENAME-TO might be a better choice; you can use any variables you like
++ in the template to ensure uniqueness of the RENAME-TO filename; for
++ example:
++
++ SET RECEIVE RENAME-TO \v(filename)_\v(ndate)_\v(ntime)_\v(userid)_\v(pid)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2. FILE-TRANSFER PIPES AND FILTERS
++
++ 4.2.1. INTRODUCTION
++
++ Beginning in C-Kermit 6.1 and Kermit 95 1.1.12, it is possible to send
++ from a command, or "pipe", as well as from a file, and to receive to a
++ pipe or command. In a typical example, we might want to transfer an
++ entire directory tree from one UNIX system to another (but without
++ using the methods described in [436]Sections 4.3 , [437]4.10,
++ [438]4.11, and [439]4.15). We could do this in multiple steps as
++ follows:
++
++ 1. Create a tar archive of the desired directory tree
++ 2. Compress the tar archive
++ 3. Transfer it in binary mode to the other computer
++ 4. Decompress it
++ 5. Extract the directory tree from the tar archive
++
++ But this is inconvenient and it requires a temporary file, which might
++ be larger than we have room for.
++
++ The new pipe-transfer feature lets you do such things in a single
++ step, and without intermediate files.
++
++ Additional new features, also discussed here, let you specify pre- and
++ post- processing filters for outbound and incoming files, and give you
++ a way to insert the output from shell or system commands into C-Kermit
++ commands.
++
++ The file-transfer related features are available only with Kermit
++ protocol, not with any external protocols, nor with K95's built-in
++ XYZMODEM protocols (because XYZMODEM recovers from transmission errors
++ by rewinding the source file, and you can't rewind a pipe).
++
++ This section begins by discussing the simple and straightforward use
++ of these features in UNIX, in which pipes and input/output redirection
++ are a fundamental component and therefore "just work", and then goes
++ on to discuss their operation in Windows and OS/2, where matters are
++ much more complicated.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.1.1. TERMINOLOGY
++
++ Standard Input
++ This is a precise technical term denoting the normal source of
++ input for a command or program, which is the keyboard of your
++ terminal by default, but which can be redirected to a file or
++ pipe.
++
++ Stdin
++ Abbreviation for Standard Input.
++
++ Standard Output
++ A precise technical term denoting the normal destination for
++ output from a command or program, which is your terminal screen
++ by default, but which can be redirected to a file.
++
++ Stdout
++ Abbreviation for Standard Output.
++
++ Stdio
++ Abbreviation for Standard Input / Standard Output.
++
++ I/O
++ Abbreviation for Input / Output.
++
++ Shell
++ Text-based system command processor, such as the UNIX shell,
++ DOS COMMAND.COM, etc.
++
++ Pipe
++ A mechanism by which the standard output of one program is sent
++ to the standard input of another.
++
++ Pipeline
++ A series of programs connected by pipes.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.1.2. NOTATION
++
++ In command descriptions, "command" is replaced by a shell or system
++ command or pipeline. The command names specified in these commands are
++ interpreted by your shell, just as if you were typing them at the
++ shell prompt, and so if they are in your PATH, they will be found in
++ the expected manner. Therefore you don't have to specify complete
++ pathnames for commands that are programs (but it shouldn't hurt if you
++ do).
++
++ The normal notation for I/O redirection is as follows:
++
++ < Read Stdin from the given file.
++ > Send Stdout to the given file.
++ | Send Stdout from the command on the left to the command on the right.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ sort < foo > bar
++ Sorts the lines in file "foo" and writes the results to file
++ "bar"
++
++ grep -c "some text" *.txt | grep -v ":0" | sort | pr -3 | lpr
++ This is a command pipeline composed of 5 commands:
++
++ grep -c "some text" *.txt
++ Looks in all files whose names end with ".txt" for the string
++ "some text" and writes to Stdout the names of each file
++ followed by a colon and the number of occurrences in each.
++
++ grep -v ":0"
++ Prints to Stdout the lines from Stdin that do NOT contain the
++ string ":0", in this case, it removes the names of files that
++ do not contain "some text".
++
++ sort
++ Sorts the lines from Stdin alphabetically to Stdout.
++
++ pr -3
++ Arranges the lines from Stdin in three columns.
++
++ lpr
++ Prints its Stdin on the default printer.
++
++ Note that the Kermit features described here work only with commands
++ that use Stdio. If you attempt to use them with commands whose input
++ and output can not be redirected, Kermit will most likely get stuck.
++ Kermit has no way of telling how an external command works, nor what
++ the syntax of the shell is, so it's up to you to make sure you use
++ these features only with redirectable commands.
++
++ The quoting rules of your shell apply to the command. Thus in UNIX,
++ where C-Kermit tries to use your preferred shell for running commands,
++ shell "metacharacters" within commands must be escaped if they are to
++ be taken literally, using the methods normal for your shell. For
++ example, the UNIX tr (translate) command must have its arguments in
++ quotes:
++
++ tr "[a-z]" "[A-Z]"
++
++ otherwise the shell is likely to replace them by all filenames that
++ match, which is probably not what you want. This is also true when
++ using your shell directly, and has nothing to do with Kermit.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.1.3. SECURITY
++
++ Some sites might not wish to allow access to system commands or
++ external programs from within Kermit. Such access, including all the
++ features described here, can be disabled in various ways:
++
++ 1. When building from source code, include -DNOPUSH among the CFLAGS.
++ 2. At runtime, give the NOPUSH command.
++ 3. For server mode, give the DISABLE HOST command.
++ 4. Implicit use of pipes can be disabled as described in [440]Section
++ 4.2.4.
++
++ Note: 3 and 4 are not necessary if you have done 1 or 2.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.2. Commands for Transferring from and to Pipes
++
++ SEND /COMMAND sends data from a command or command pipeline, and
++ RECEIVE /COMMENT writes data to a command or pipeline. The GET
++ /COMMAND command asks a server to send material, and then writes the
++ incoming material to a command or pipeline. These features, along with
++ switches (like "/COMMAND", described in [441]Section 4.7) are new to
++ C-Kermit 6.1. The following synonyms are also provided:
++
++ CSEND = SEND /COMMAND
++ CRECEIVE = RECEIVE /COMMAND
++ CGET = GET /COMMAND
++
++ None of these commands can be used if a SEND or RECEIVE FILTER
++ (respectively, [442]Section 4.2.3) is in effect, or if a NOPUSH
++ command ([443]Section 4.2.1.3) has been given, or if the current
++ protocol is not Kermit.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.2.1. Sending from a Command
++
++ SEND /COMMAND command [ as-name ]
++ SEND /AS-NAME:as-name /COMMAND command
++ CSEND command [ as-name ]
++ These three forms are the same. They work like the SEND
++ command, but instead of sending a file, it sends the standard
++ output of the given command, either under the command's own
++ name, or else with the given as-name. If the command contains
++ spaces, it must be enclosed in braces. Braces should also be
++ used for the as-name if it contains spaces. If braces are
++ included around either the command or the as-name, they are
++ removed after parsing but before use. As with SEND, the
++ transfer is in text or binary mode according the current FILE
++ TYPE setting, unless you override the global transfer mode by
++ including a /TEXT or /BINARY switch. The command must require
++ no input.
++
++ When sending from a command or pipeline, C-Kermit has no way of
++ knowing in advance how much data will be sent, and so it can not send
++ the size to the other Kermit in the Attribute packet, and so the
++ receiving Kermit has no way of displaying "percent done" or a progress
++ bar (thermometer).
++
++ Examples that make sense in text mode (illustrated by common UNIX
++ commands):
++
++ SEND /COMMAND finger
++ CSEND finger
++ sends the current "finger" listing (who's logged in) under the
++ name "finger". The two forms "send /command" and "csend" are
++ equivalent; we won't bother showing them both in the rest of
++ the examples.
++
++ SEND /COMMAND:{finger}
++ CSEND {finger}
++ Same as previous example (braces are removed from "{finger}").
++
++ SEND /COMMAND:{ finger }
++ CSEND { finger }
++ Same as previous example, but note that the spaces are kept.
++ This does not prevent the shell from running the "finger"
++ program, but its output is sent under the name " finger " (with
++ a leading and trailing space).
++
++ SEND /COMMAND:finger /AS-NAME:userlist
++ CSEND finger userlist
++ sends the current finger listing under the name "userlist".
++
++ SEND /COMMAND:{finger | sort -r} /AS-NAME:userlist
++ CSEND {finger | sort -r} userlist
++ sends the current finger listing, sorted in reverse order,
++ under the name "userlist". The braces are needed to distinguish
++ the command from the as-name.
++
++ SEND /COMMAND:{finger | sort -r} /AS-NAME:{userlist}
++ CSEND {finger | sort -r} {userlist}
++ Same as previous example (braces are removed from
++ "{userlist}").
++
++ SEND /COMMAND:{finger | sort -r}
++ /AS-NAME:{\freplace(\v(filename),\32,_)}
++
++ CSEND {finger | sort -r} {\freplace(\v(filename),\32,_)}
++ Like the previous example, but sends the output of the command
++ under the name of the command, but with all spaces (\32)
++ replaced by underscores, so the as-name is "finger_|_sort_-r".
++
++ Examples that make sense in binary mode (three equivalent forms are
++ shown):
++
++ SEND /COMMAND /BINARY {tar cf - . | gzip -c} mydir.tar.gz
++ SEND /COMMAND /BINARY /AS-NAME:mydir.tar.gz {tar cf - . | gzip -c}
++ CSEND /BINARY {tar cf - . | gzip -c} mydir.tar.gz
++ Makes a tar archive of the current directory, compresses it
++ with the GNU gzip program, and sends it as "mydir.tar.gz". The
++ other Kermit can, of course, just store it as a file, or it can
++ use CRECEIVE to uncompress and dearchive it as part of the
++ transfer process.
++
++ When using a "pipeline" of commands in the command field, obviously,
++ the first command must not require any input, and the last command
++ should produce some output, and all intermediate commands should get
++ some input and produce some output.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.2.2. Receiving to a Command
++
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND command
++ CRECEIVE command
++ This is like RECEIVE, except incoming material is written to
++ the standard input of the given command, in text or binary mode
++ according to the normal rules for file reception. Be sure to
++ include a redirector to a file (if the command normally writes
++ to standard output), or the output of the command won't go
++ anywhere. The command may contain spaces; braces are not
++ needed, but they are removed if used.
++
++ WARNING: C-Kermit has no way of knowing anything about the command, or
++ even whether it is a command. Thus this command will always cause
++ C-Kermit to enter protocol mode, as long as some text is specified in
++ the command field. However, if the text does not correspond to a
++ command, the transfer will eventually fail with a message such as
++ "Error writing data" or "Failure to close file".
++
++ Examples for text mode (in UNIX):
++
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND sort -r > reverse.txt
++ CRECEIVE sort -r > reverse.txt
++ The text that is received is sorted in reverse order and stored
++ in the file "reverse.txt". The two forms shown are equivalent.
++
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND {sort -r > reverse.txt}
++ CRECEIVE {sort -r > reverse.txt}
++ The same as the previous example; if braces are included, they
++ are simply removed.
++
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND {sort -r > \flower(\v(filename)).reverse}
++ CRECEIVE {sort -r > \flower(\v(filename)).reverse}
++ Same but stores result under the incoming filename, lowercased,
++ and with ".reverse" appended to it.
++
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND sort
++ CRECEIVE sort
++ Does nothing useful, since the output of sort has nowhere to
++ go.
++
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND sort -r | pr -3 | lpr -Plaserjet
++ CRECEIVE sort -r | pr -3 | lpr -Plaserjet
++ The text that is received is sorted in reverse order, arranged
++ into three columns, and sent to the "laserjet" printer.
++
++ Examples for binary mode:
++
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND:{gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++ CRECEIVE {gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++ Assuming the data that is received is a compressed tar archive,
++ uncompresses the archive and passes it to tar for extraction.
++ In this case the braces are needed because otherwise the final
++ "-" would be taken as a command continuation character (see
++ [444]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition, p.33).
++
++ GET /COMMAND remote-file command
++ GET /COMMAND /AS-NAME:command remote-file
++ CGET remote-file command
++ This command tells the Kermit client to send a GET request for
++ the given remote file to a Kermit server. Unlike GET, however,
++ the incoming material is written to a command, rather than to a
++ file. If the remote-file or the command contain spaces, they
++ must be enclosed in braces. The same cautions about the command
++ apply as for CRECEIVE.
++
++ Examples (for UNIX):
++
++ GET /COMMAND oofa.txt sort -r > oofa.new
++ GET /COMMAND {oofa.txt} {sort -r > oofa.new}
++ CGET oofa.txt sort -r > oofa.new
++ CGET {oofa.txt} {sort -r > oofa.new}
++ These four are equivalent. Each of them requests the server to
++ send its "oofa.txt" file, and as it arrives, it is sorted in
++ reverse order and written to "oofa.new".
++
++ GET /COMMAND {profile exec a} lpr
++ GET /COMMAND {profile exec a} {lpr}
++ GET /COMMAND /AS-NAME:lpr {profile exec a}
++ GET /COMMAND /AS-NAME:{lpr} {profile exec a}
++ GET /COMMAND /AS:lpr {profile exec a}
++ CGET {profile exec a} lpr
++ CGET {profile exec a} {lpr}
++ Here the remote filename contains spaces so it MUST be enclosed
++ in braces. As it arrives it is sent to the lpr program for
++ printing. Braces are optional around "lpr" since it contains no
++ spaces.
++
++ GET /COMMAND *.txt {cat >> new.txt}
++ GET /AS-NAME:{cat >> new.txt} /COMMAND *.txt
++ CGET *.txt {cat >> new.txt}
++ This gets all the ".txt" files from the server and concatenates
++ them all into a single "new.txt" file on the client.
++
++ GET /COMMAND *.txt {echo \v(filename)>>new.txt;cat>>new.txt}
++ CGET *.txt {echo \v(filename)>>new.txt;cat>>new.txt}
++ As above, but inserts each file's name before its contents.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.3. Using File-Transfer Filters
++
++ The commands described in [445]Section 4.2.2 let you send the output
++ of a command, or receive data into a command. But what if you want to
++ specify preprocessing for files that you send, or postprocessing of
++ files that you receive, even when multiple files are involved? For
++ this you need a way to specify send and receive filters. The commands
++ are SET SEND FILTER and SET RECEIVE FILTER; SHOW PROTOCOL displays the
++ current settings.
++
++ 4.2.3.1. The SEND Filter
++
++ SET SEND FILTER [ command ]
++ This command specifies a command to be run on any file that you
++ SEND (or MOVE, MSEND, etc). It also applies to files sent when
++ in server mode, in response to GET commands, but not to the
++ results of REMOTE commands like REMOTE DIRECTORY, REMOTE TYPE,
++ REMOTE HOST, etc. The command may be, but need not be, enclosed
++ in braces; if it is, the braces are stripped before use. The
++ output of this command is sent, rather than the file itself.
++ The current FILE TYPE setting (TEXT or BINARY) applies to the
++ output of the command. The command must contain at least one
++ instance of \v(filename), for which the name of the actual file
++ is substituted. If the command is omitted, the send filter is
++ removed and files are sent in the normal manner.
++
++ The SET SEND FILTER sets up a "global" filter -- that is, one that
++ applies to all subsequent file-sending commands until you change or
++ remove it. You can also specify a "local" filter to be used in a
++ specific file-sending command by using the /FILTER switch (see
++ [446]Section 1.5); for example:
++
++ SEND /FILTER:command [ other-switches ] filename
++
++ Besides \v(filename), you can include any other script programming
++ notation in the send filter: variable names, array references, calls
++ to built-in string or other functions, and so on. These are evaluated
++ during file transfer, NOT during parsing, and they are evaluated
++ separately for each file.
++
++ When the SEND or MOVE (SEND /DELETE) command is used with a send
++ filter, the output from the filter is sent under the file's original
++ name unless you specify an "as-name" or template. The Attribute packet
++ (if any) contains the original file's attributes (size, creation date,
++ etc). So (for example) if the filter changes the file's size, the
++ progress thermometer might be wrong. (We can't send the size of the
++ output from the filter, because it is not known until the transfer is
++ finished.) If you prefer that the size not be sent, use "set
++ attributes size off".
++
++ You can not use send filters with RESEND (SEND /RECOVER) or PSEND
++ (SEND /START).
++
++ Examples for text mode:
++
++ SET SEND FILTER sort -r \v(filename) ; Braces may be omitted
++ SET SEND FILTER {sort -r \v(filename)} ; Braces may be included
++ SEND *.txt
++ This sends every file in the current directory whose name ends
++ with ".txt" under its own name, but with its lines sorted in
++ reverse order.
++
++ SEND /FILTER:{sort -r \v(filename)} *.txt
++ Same as above, but the filter applies only to this SEND
++ command. Braces are required in this case.
++
++ SET SEND FILTER {sort -r \v(filename)}
++ SEND oofa.txt reverse.txt
++ Sends the oofa.txt file with its lines sorted in reverse order
++ under the name "reverse.txt".
++
++ SET SEND FILTER {sort -r \v(filename)}
++ SEND oofa.* \v(filename).reverse
++ Sends all the oofa.* files with their lines sorted in reverse
++ order; each file is sent under its own name but with ".reverse"
++ appended to it.
++
++ SET SEND FILTER {tr "[a-z]" "[A-Z]" < \v(filename)}
++ SEND *.txt
++ Sends all ".txt" files under their own names, but uppercasing
++ their contents.
++
++ Note that the SEND FILTER applies not only to files that are sent with
++ SEND, MOVE, MSEND, etc, but also to files sent by the C-Kermit server
++ in response to GET requests.
++
++ Examples for binary mode:
++
++ SET SEND FILTER {gzip -c \v(filename)}
++ SEND /BINARY oofa.txt oofa.txt.gz
++ Sends the oofa.txt file, compressed by gzip, as oofa.txt.gz.
++
++ SEND /BINARY /FILTER:{gzip -c \v(filename)} oofa.txt oofa.txt.gz
++ As above, but the filter applies only to this SEND command.
++
++ SET SEND FILTER {gzip -c \v(filename)}
++ SEND /BINARY oofa.* \fupper(\replace(\v(filename),.,_)).GZ
++ Sends all the oofa.* files, compressed by gzip, each under its
++ own name, but with the name uppercased, all periods within the
++ name converted to underscores, and ".GZ" appended to it. So,
++ for example, "oofa.txt" is sent as "OOFA_TXT.GZ".
++
++ In the gzip examples, note that the amount of data that is sent is
++ normally less than the original file size because gzip compresses the
++ file. But Kermit sends the original file size ahead in the attribute
++ packet anyway (unless you tell it not too). Thus the transfer will
++ probably appear to terminate early, e.g. when the receiver's
++ file-transfer display thermometer is only at 40%. If this annoys you,
++ tell Kermit to "set attribute length off". On the other hand, you can
++ use the final position of the thermometer as a measure of the
++ effectiveness of compression.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.3.2. The RECEIVE Filter
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER [ command ]
++ This command specifies that the given command will be run on
++ any file that is received before it is written to disk. The
++ command may be, but need not be, enclosed in braces; if it is
++ the braces are stripped before use. The following two commands
++ are equivalent:
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER {sort -r > \v(filename)}
++
++ The RECEIVE filter command may contain a "\v(filename)" sequence to be
++ replaced by the incoming filename from the file header packet, but it
++ is not required. However you must use it whenever your filter would
++ normally write to Stdout, otherwise its output will be lost.
++
++ The RECEIVE filter command may contain one or more "\v(filename)"
++ sequence to be replaced by the incoming filename from the file header
++ packet, but it is not required. However you must use it whenever your
++ filter would normally write to Stdout, otherwise its output will be
++ lost.
++
++ RECEIVE /FILTER:command and GET /FILTER:command can also be used to
++ specify a filter to be used for only one file-transfer operation.
++
++ UNIX examples for text mode:
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER lpr
++ RECEIVE
++ All the files that are received are sent to the default UNIX
++ print spooler.
++
++ RECEIVE /FILTER:lpr
++ Same as above, except the lpr filter is used only with this
++ RECEIVE command.
++
++ RECEIVE lpr
++ This is probably not what you want; it creates a file called
++ lpr.
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER {sort -r > \v(filename)}
++ RECEIVE
++ Stores each incoming file with its lines sorted in reverse
++ order, under its own name.
++
++ RECEIVE /FILTER:{sort -r > \v(filename)}
++ As above, but the filter is used only for this RECEIVE command.
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
++ RECEIVE reverse.txt
++ Stores each incoming file with its lines sorted in reverse
++ order, under the name "reverse.txt". The actual result depends
++ on the FILE COLLISION setting. If it is OVERWRITE and multiple
++ files arrive, then each incoming file destroys the previous
++ one. If it is BACKUP (the default), filename conflicts are
++ resolve by adding "version numbers" to the filenames:
++ reverse.txt, reverse.txt.~1~, reverse.txt.~2~, etc.
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
++ RECEIVE \v(filename).reverse
++ Stores each incoming file with its lines sorted in reverse
++ order, under the name it arrived with, but with ".reverse"
++ appended to it.
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER sort -r > \v(filename)
++ RECEIVE \flower(\v(filename)).reverse
++ Like the previous example, but ensures that the filename is
++ lowercase.
++
++ Examples for binary mode:
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER gunzip -c > \v(filename)
++ RECEIVE
++ This receives one or more presumably compressed file and
++ uncompresses each one into a file having the same name it was
++ sent with. For example, if the file is sent with the name
++ OOFA.TXT.GZ, it is stored with that name, even after
++ decompression.
++
++ SET RECEIVE FILTER gunzip -c > \v(filename)
++ RECEIVE \flower(\fsubstring(\v(filename),1,\flength(\v(filename))-3))
++ Like the previous example, but the resulting filename has its
++ rightmost three characters removed from it and the remainder is
++ lowercased. So if the incoming filename is OOFA.TXT.GZ, it is
++ stored as oofa.txt after decompression.
++
++ Of course you don't want to type such long hideous commands, so we
++ have also introduced several new functions:
++
++ \fstripx(string[,character])
++ This function removes the rightmost segment of the string that
++ starts with the given character. If no character is given,
++ period (.) is used. Thus it is most conveniently used for
++ stripping the extension from a filename (or the decimal portion
++ from a floating-point number written in US/UK style). Examples:
++
++ \fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ) => OOFA.TXT
++ \fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ,.) => OOFA.TXT
++ \fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ,X) => OOFA.T
++ \fstripx(\fstripx(OOFA.TXT.GZ)) => OOFA
++ \fstripx($100.00) => $100
++
++ \fstripn(string,number)
++ Removes the rightmost number characters from the string.
++ Examples:
++
++ \fstripn(OOFA.TXT.GZ) => OOFA.TXT.GZ
++ \fstripn(OOFA.TXT.GZ,3) => OOFA.TXT
++ \fstripn(OOFA.TXT.GZ,7) => OOFA
++
++ \fstripb(string[,c1[,c2]])
++ Strips enclosing matching braces, brackets, parentheses, or
++ quotes from the string. The second argument, c1, specifies
++ which kind of enclosure to look for; if not specified, any
++ enclosing (), [], <>, {}, "", '', or `' are removed. If c1 is
++ specified and c2 is not, then if c1 is an opening brace,
++ bracket, or parenthesis, the matching closing one is supplied
++ automatically as c2. If both c1 and c2 are specified, then to
++ be stripped the string must begin with c1 and end with c2. If
++ the string is not enclosed in the indicated manner, the result
++ is the original string. Examples:
++
++ \fstripb("abc") => abc
++ \fstripb([abc]) => abc
++ \fstripb([abc) => [abc
++ \fstripb(<abc>) => abc
++ \fstripb(<abc>,[) => <abc>
++ \fstripb((abc)) => abc
++ \fstripb((abc),[) => (abc)
++ \fstripb((abc),{(}) => abc
++ \fstripb(+abc+) => +abc+
++ \fstripb(+abc+,+) => abc
++ \fstripb(+abc+,+,^) => +abc+
++ \fstripb(+abc^,+,^) => abc
++ \fstripb('abc') => abc
++ \fstripb(`abc') => abc
++ \fstripb(``abc'') => `abc'
++ \fstripb(\fstripb(``abc'')) => abc
++
++ Notice the special syntax required for including a literal
++ parenthesis in the argument list. As the last two examples
++ illustrate, \fstripb() strips only one level at at a time;
++ nesting can be used to strip a small fixed number of levels;
++ loops can be used to strip larger or indeterminate numbers of
++ levels.
++
++ \flop(string[,char])
++ Removes the leftmost segment of the string that ends with the
++ given character. If no character is given, period (.) is used.
++ Examples:
++
++ \flop(OOFA.TXT.GZ) => TXT.GZ
++ \flop(OOFA.TXT.GZ,.) => TXT.GZ
++ \flop(OOFA.TXT.GZ,X) => T.GZ
++
++ To remove the leftmost number characters, just use
++ \fsubstring(s,number+1). To return the rightmost number
++ characters, use \fright(s,number).
++
++ So the hideous example:
++
++ receive \flower(\fsubstring(\v(filename),1,\flength(\v(filename))-3))
++
++ can now be written as:
++
++ receive \flower(\fstripx(\v(filename)))
++
++ That is, the filename stripped of its extension and then lowercased.
++ This is not only shorter and less hideous, but also does not depend on
++ the length of the extension being 3.
++
++ Note that when a receive filter is in effect, this overrides your FILE
++ COLLISION setting, since Kermit has no way of knowing what the final
++ destination filename will be (because it does not know, and can not be
++ expected to know, the syntax of every version of every command shell
++ on every platform on the planet).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.4. Implicit Use of Pipes
++
++ If you wish, C-Kermit can also examine incoming filenames to see if
++ they start with "!", and if so, the subsequent text is treated as a
++ command to read from or write to. For example, if a Kermit client is
++ given the following command:
++
++ get {!finger | sort}
++
++ the server on the other end, if it supports this feature, will run the
++ "finger" program, pipe its standard output to the "sort" program, and
++ send sort's standard output back to you. Similarly, if you:
++
++ send oofa.txt !sort -r > oofa.new
++
++ or, equivalently:
++
++ send oofa.txt {!sort -r > oofa.new}
++
++ or:
++
++ send /as-name:{!sort -r > oofa.new} oofa.txt
++
++ this has the receiver send the contents of the incoming oofa.txt file
++ to the sort program, which sorts the text in reverse order and stores
++ the result in oofa.new.
++
++ This use of the exclamation mark should be familiar to UNIX users as
++ the "bang" feature that lets you run an external application or
++ command from within another application.
++
++ Kermit's "bang" feature is disabled by default, since it is not
++ unheard for filenames to actually begin with "!". So if you want to
++ use this feature, you must enable it with the following command:
++
++ SET TRANSFER PIPES { ON, OFF }
++ ON enables the recognition of "!" notation in incoming
++ filenames during file transfer as an indicator that the
++ remaining text is the name of a command. OFF, the default,
++ disables this feature and uses the text as a filename in the
++ normal fashion. This command does NOT affect SEND /COMMAND, GET
++ /COMMAND, CSEND, etc.
++
++ So using a combination of CSEND (SEND /COMMAND) and the "bang"
++ feature, you can transfer a directory tree all in one command
++ (assuming the remote Kermit supports pipe transfers and has them
++ enabled):
++
++ CSEND {tar cf - . | gzip -c} {!gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++
++ or:
++
++ SEND /COMMAND:{tar cf - . | gzip -c} /as:{!gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++
++ Pay close attention to the syntax. Braces are needed around the
++ command because it contains spaces; braces are needed around the
++ as-name because it ends with "-". The as-name must begin with "!" or
++ receiving Kermit will not recognize it as a command. The CSEND command
++ must NOT begin with "!" unless you are running a command whose name
++ really does start that character.
++
++ Similarly, you have a Kermit server send a directory tree to be
++ unpacked on the client end:
++
++ CGET {!tar cf - . | gzip -c} {gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++
++ or:
++
++ GET /COMMAND {!tar cf - . | gzip -c} /as:{gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++
++ Notice how, in this case, the bang is required in the remote command,
++ to distinguish it from a filename, but not in the local command, since
++ by definition of CGET (or GET /COMMAND), it is known to be a command.
++
++ SEND and RECEIVE FILTERs supersede the bang feature. For example, if a
++ file arrives under the name "!gunzip -c | tar xf -", but the receiving
++ Kermit also has been given a command like:
++
++ set receive filter sort -r > \v(filename)
++
++ then the incoming data will be sorted rather than gunzipped.
++
++ Finally, if SET TRANSFER PIPES is ON (and in this case, this must be
++ done in your C-Kermit initialization file), you can send from a pipe
++ on the C-Kermit command line:
++
++ kermit -s "!finger | sort -r" -a userlist
++
++ In this case the "filename" contains spaces and so must be quoting
++ using your shell's quoting rules.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.5. Success and Failure of Piped Commands
++
++ Commands or programs started by Kermit as a result of CSEND or
++ CRECEIVE commands, CGET, SEND /COMMAND, REDIRECT commands (see
++ [447]Section 4.2.8.2), implicit use of pipes, RUN commands, and so
++ forth, should return their exit status codes to the Kermit command
++ that caused them to be run, and therefore IF SUCCESS and IF FAILURE
++ tests after these commands should work as expected. For example:
++
++ CSEND blah < filename
++
++ should fail if there is no command called "blah" or if there is no
++ file called "filename". However, this is not foolproof and sometimes
++ C-Kermit might think a command succeeded when it failed, or vice
++ versa. This is most likely to happen when the highly system-dependent
++ methods that Kermit must use to determine a command's exit status code
++ do not supply the right information.
++
++ It can also happen because some commands might define success and
++ failure differently from what you expect, or because you are using a
++ pipeline composed of many commands, and one of them fails to pass
++ failing exit status codes up the chain. The most likely culprit is the
++ shell itself, which in most cases must be interposed between Kermit
++ and any external program to be run.
++
++ In any case, you can examine the following variable to find out the
++ exit status code returned to Kermit by the process most recently run
++ by any command that runs external commands or programs, including
++ CSEND, CRECEIVE, REDIRECT, RUN, etc:
++
++ \v(pexitstat)
++
++ In UNIX, Windows and OS/2, the value should be -2 if no command has
++ been run yet, 0 if the most recent command succeeded, -1, -3, or -4 if
++ there was an internal error, and a positive number returned by the
++ command itself if the command failed. If the number is in the range
++ 1-127, this is the program's exit status code. If it is 128 or
++ greater, this is supposed to indicate that the command or program was
++ interrupted or terminated from outside itself.
++
++ In Windows 95 and 98, the return values of the default shell are
++ unreliable; various third-party shells can be used to work around this
++ deficiency.
++
++ In VMS, it is the actual exit status code of the command that was run.
++ This is an odd number if the command succeeded, and an even number if
++ it failed. You can see the associated message as follows:
++
++ run write sys$output f$message(\v(pexitstat))
++
++ Or, more conveniently, use the new Kermit function:
++
++ echo \ferrstring(\v(pexitstat))
++
++ which converts a system error code (number) to the corresponding
++ message.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.6. Cautions about Using Pipes to Transfer Directory Trees
++
++ Although utilities such as tar and zip/unzip might be available on
++ different platforms (such as UNIX and Windows), this does not
++ necessarily mean you can use them successfully to transfer directory
++ trees between unlike platforms. For example:
++
++ CSEND {tar cf - . | gzip -c} {!gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++
++ when used from UNIX to Windows will have satisfactory results for
++ binary files, but not for text files. UNIX text files have lines
++ ending with Linefeed (LF) only, whereas Windows text files have lines
++ ending in Carriage Return and Linefeed (CRLF). Thus any text files
++ that were in the archive formed by the first tar command will be
++ unpacked by the second tar command in their original form, and will
++ display and print incorrectly in Windows (except in applications that
++ have been explicitly coded to handle UNIX-format text files). On the
++ other hand if you told gzip to use "text mode" to do record format
++ conversion (assuming there was a way to tell it, as there is with most
++ "zip" programs), this would destroy any binary files in the archive.
++
++ Furthermore, if the archive contains text files that are written in
++ languages other than English, the "special" (accented and/or
++ non-Roman) characters are NOT translated, and are therefore likely
++ show up as gibberish on the target system. For example, West European
++ languages are usually encoded in ISO Latin Alphabet 1 in UNIX, but in
++ PC code page 850 on the PC. Capital A with acute accent is code point
++ 193 (decimal) Latin-1, but 181 in CP850. So A-acute in the UNIX file
++ becomes Middle Box Bottom on the PC, and similarly for all the other
++ special characters, and for all other languages -- Greek, Russian,
++ Hebrew, Japanese, etc.
++
++ So when transferring text files between unlike platforms, you should
++ use direct Kermit file transfers so Kermit can apply the needed
++ record-format and character-set transformations. Use pipelines
++ containing archivers like tar or zip only if all the files are binary
++ or the two systems use the same record format and character set for
++ text files.
++
++ Also see [448]Sections 4.3, [449]4.10, [450]4.11, and [451]4.15 for
++ how to transfer directory trees between both like and unlike systems
++ directly with Kermit.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.7. Pipes and Encryption
++
++ Of course pipelines could be used for encrypted file transfers,
++ assuming proper precautions could be taken concerning the transmission
++ of the key. But there is rarely a good way to do this. To illustrate
++ using UNIX crypt:
++
++ csend {crypt key < filename} {!crypt key > filename}
++
++ Or, more ambitiously:
++
++ csend {tar cf - . | gzip -c | crypt key} {!crypt key | gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++
++ transmits the key in the file header packet as part of the
++ (clear-text) remote command, defeating the entire purpose of
++ encrypting the file data.
++
++ But if you are connected in terminal mode to the remote computer and
++ type:
++
++ creceive {crypt key > filename}
++
++ at the remote Kermit prompt, you have also transmitted the key in
++ clear text over the communications link.
++
++ At present, the only secure way to use CSEND and CRECEIVE with an
++ encryption filter is to have a human operator at both ends, so the key
++ does not have to be transmitted.
++
++ Theoretically it would be possible to use PGP software (Pretty Good
++ Privacy, by Phil Zimmerman, Phil's Pretty Good Software) to avoid key
++ transmission (since PGP uses separate public and private key and "lets
++ you communicate securely with people you've never met, with no secure
++ channels needed for prior exchange of keys"), but the specific method
++ has yet to be worked out.
++
++ HINT: See the PGP User's Guide, e.g. at:
++ [452]http://www.telstra.com.au/docs/PGP/
++ Especially the topic "Using PGP as a UNIX-Style Filter":
++ [453]http://www.telstra.com.au/docs/PGP/pgpdoc2/pgpdoc2_17.html
++
++ In any case, better and more convenient security options are now
++ available: Kerberos authentication and encryption ([454]CLICK HERE for
++ details) and the new ability to run C-Kermit "though" other
++ communication programs, described in [455]Section 2.7.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.8. Commands and Functions Related to Pipes
++
++ 4.2.8.1. The OPEN !READ and OPEN !WRITE Commands
++
++ These are described in [456]Using C-Kermit, and are generally useful
++ with reading output from commands that produce more than one line on
++ their standard output, or writing multiple lines into commands that
++ accept them on their standard input.
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0 CLOSE !READ is accepted as a synonym for CLOSE READ,
++ and CLOSE !WRITE for CLOSE WRITE.
++
++ Testing the success and failure of these commands, however, can be a
++ bit tricky. Consider:
++
++ open !read lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj
++
++ (where "lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj" is neither a valid command nor the name
++ of a program or script that can be run). OPEN !READ, in UNIX at least,
++ translates this into execl(shellpath,shellname,"-c",command). This
++ means it starts your preferred shell (e.g. from the SHELL environment
++ variable) and asks it to execute the given command. It must be this
++ way, because your command can be a either an internal shell command
++ (which only your shell can execute) or an external command, which only
++ your shell knows how to find (it knows your PATH and interprets, etc).
++ Therefore unless OPEN !READ can't start your shell, it always
++ succeeds.
++
++ Continuing with the nonexistent-command example:
++
++ C-Kermit> open !read lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj
++ C-Kermit> status
++ SUCCESS
++ C-Kermit> read line
++ C-Kermit> status
++ SUCCESS
++ C-Kermit> echo "\m(line)"
++ "bash: lalaskjfsldkfjsldkfj: command not found"
++ C-Kermit> close read
++ C-Kermit> status
++ FAILURE
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ In other words, the failure can not be detected on OPEN, since the
++ OPEN command succeeds if it can start your shell. It can't be detected
++ on READ, since all this does is read output from the shell, which in
++ this case happens to be an error message. However, failure IS detected
++ upon close, since this is the occasion upon which the shell gives
++ Kermit its exit status code.
++
++ For an illustration of this situation, see [457]Section 2.14.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.8.2. The REDIRECT Command
++
++ A second method of I/O redirection is offered by the REDIRECT command.
++ This is a rather advanced and tricky feature that is presently
++ supported only in UNIX C-Kermit, in OS-9 C-Kermit, and in Kermit 95.
++ Syntax:
++
++ REDIRECT command
++ Runs the given command, sending its standard output to the
++ current communications channel (SET LINE, SET PORT, or SET HOST
++ connection), and reading its standard input from the same
++ connection. Works only in local mode -- i.e. a connection is
++ required -- and then only if the given command uses Standard
++ I/O.
++
++ Example:
++
++ redirect finger
++
++ runs the local "finger" command and sends its output over the
++ connection as plain text, where presumably there is a process set up
++ to read it. Another example:
++
++ redirect finger | sort -r
++
++ shows the use of a pipeline.
++
++ Note: REDIRECT differs from CSEND/CRECEIVE in two important ways: (1)
++ it does not use the Kermit protocol, and (2) it uses a bidirectional
++ pipe rather than a one-way pipe.
++
++ The primary use of the REDIRECT command is to run external protocols,
++ such as sz/rz in UNIX for ZMODEM, when they work over Standard I/O(*).
++ Example:
++
++ set host xyzcorp.com
++ (login, etc)
++ redirect sz oofa.zip
++
++ lets you make a Telnet connection with C-Kermit and then do a ZMODEM
++ transfer over it. ZMODEM protocol messages go both ways over the same
++ connection simultaneously.
++
++ It is possible to use C-Kermit on UNIX as your PPP dialer and then to
++ REDIRECT the connection to the PPP software, but C-Kermit 7.0 offers a
++ better approach to PPP dialing in its new EXEC command ([458]Section
++ 1.23).
++
++ In theory, you can also redirect an interactive process. For example,
++ suppose you tell Kermit 95 to wait for an incoming TCP/IP connection:
++
++ set host * 3000
++
++ and then tell C-Kermit on UNIX to:
++
++ set host kermit95hostname 3000
++ redirect ksh
++
++ and then tell Kermit 95 to CONNECT: now you are talking to the UNIX
++ K-shell; you can give commands (pwd, ls, etc) and see the results. In
++ practice, the K-shell's terminal modes are messed up because (a) it is
++ not going through the Unix terminal driver, and (b) it is "smart" and
++ knows it is being redirected, and so acts in a decidedly inhospitable
++ manner (other applications like EMACS, vi, etc, simply refuse to run
++ if their standard i/o has been redirected).
++
++ (*) The publicly-distributed sz/rz programs do not work as clients.
++ However, Omen Technology does offer an up-to-date redirectable
++ client XYZMODEM program called crzsz.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.8.3. Receiving Mail and Print Jobs
++
++ As of 7.0, and in UNIX only, files that are sent to C-Kermit as mail
++ (when the other Kermit uses a MAIL or SEND /MAIL command) or to be
++ printed (via REMOTE PRINT or SEND /PRINT) are now piped directly to
++ the mail or print program, rather than written to temporary files and
++ then mailed or printed and then deleted. This has the advantages of
++ (a) not requiring a temporary file, and (b) allowing mail to have a
++ proper subject in place of the filename. Temporary files were bad not
++ only because they required (a) space, and (b) writeability of the
++ current directory, but also because using them could result in wiping
++ out an existing file. See [459]Section 4.7 for more about SEND /MAIL
++ and SEND /PRINT.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.2.8.4. Pipe-Related Functions
++
++ The \fcommand(command) function runs the given shell or system command
++ and returns the command's standard output as its value (with any
++ newline characters stripped from the end), unless the result is too
++ long, in which case it returns the empty string. The maximum length
++ for the result is at least 1022 bytes, and it might be longer on some
++ platforms. Examples (UNIX):
++
++ C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(date)"
++ "Fri Apr 18 13:31:42 1997"
++ C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(finger | wc -l)" ; how many users logged in?
++ " 83"
++ C-Kermit> evaluate \fcommand(finger | wc -l) * 2
++ 166
++ C-Kermit> echo Welcome to \fcommand(tty) on \fcommand(date)
++ Welcome to /dev/ttyre on Fri Apr 18 13:31:42 1997
++ C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(ls oofa.*)"
++ "oofa.c
++ oofa.h
++ oofa.o"
++ C-Kermit> cd /directory-with-thousands-of-files
++ C-Kermit> echo "\fcommand(ls -l)" ; This would be too long
++ ""
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ If a command's output would be too long, you can use the other, more
++ laborious method of reading from a command: OPEN !READ command, READ
++ each line, CLOSE !READ.
++
++ The \frawcommand(command) function is identical to \fcommand(command),
++ except it does not remove trailing newline characters:
++
++ C-Kermit> echo "\frawcommand(date)"
++ "Fri Apr 18 13:31:42 1997
++ "
++ C-Kermit> echo "\frawcommand(ls oofa.*)"
++ "oofa.c
++ oofa.h
++ oofa.o
++ "
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ Use \frawcommand() if you want to retain the final line terminators,
++ or if the command's output is "binary". But remember that if the
++ result of this (or any other) function contains any NUL (ASCII code 0)
++ characters, the first NUL will terminate the result string because
++ this is how C strings work (it's "C-Kermit", remember?).
++
++ These functions are useful not only locally, but also in the
++ client/server arena. If you need to get the results from a system
++ command on the server end into a variable on the client end, just do:
++
++ [ remote ] query kermit command(date)
++
++ The result is in the local \v(query) variable; see [460]Using
++ C-Kermit, 2nd Ed., pp.359-360 for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.3. Automatic Per-File Text/Binary Mode Switching
++
++ When transferring files between like systems (e.g. UNIX-to-UNIX),
++ binary mode can be used for all files unless character-set translation
++ is needed, and in fact Kermit programs of recent vintage recognize
++ each others' platforms and switch to binary mode automatically when it
++ is appropriate (e.g. DOS to OS/2, or UNIX to UNIX). (Exception:
++ LABELED mode is chosen for VMS-to-VMS and OS/2-to-OS/2 transfers so
++ complex file formats can be preserved.)
++
++ On a client/server connection between like systems, the transfer mode
++ is currently determined by the file sender, rather than always by the
++ client. If the client is sending, it controls the transfer mode. If a
++ GET command is sent to the server, the server sends all files in
++ binary mode if its TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET is TRANSPARENT; otherwise it
++ uses text mode for text files (according to its text-pattern list) and
++ binary mode for binary files. Of course, the client can control the
++ server's transfer character-set with the REMOTE SET TRANSFER
++ CHARACTER-SET command.
++
++ When transferring files between unlike systems, however, (e.g.
++ UNIX-to-DOS), some files (such as executable program images) must be
++ transferred in binary mode but others (such as plain-text files) must
++ be transferred in text mode so their record format and character sets
++ can be appropriately converted. If a binary file is transferred in
++ text mode, it is ruined. If a text file is transferred in binary mode,
++ then at the very least, its format can be incorrect; at worst it is
++ also corrupted because its character set was not converted (in extreme
++ cases the corruption is total, e.g. because one system is ASCII-based
++ and the other EBCDIC).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.3.1. Exceptions
++
++ VMS C-Kermit, when sending files to a non-VMS system, switches to text
++ or binary mode automatically for each file, based on the record format
++ in the file's directory entry; thus the mechanisms described in this
++ section do not apply to VMS C-Kermit, yet the effect is the same:
++ automatic text/binary mode switching when VMS C-Kermit is sending
++ files. See the VMS Appendix of [461]Using C-Kermit for details.
++
++ Kermit versions that support LABELED or IMAGE transfer mode are
++ likewise not affected by this feature when one of those modes is
++ selected (normally used only when transferring between like systems).
++
++ Kermit versions that support file-transfer pipes and filters are not
++ affected by this feature when pipes or filters are used, since the
++ output of a pipe or filter (such as gzip) is likely to require
++ transfer in a different mode than the original file.
++
++ Finally, SEND /TEXT or SEND /BINARY will force files to be sent in the
++ indicated mode, overriding all automatic transfer-mode-choosing
++ mechanisms.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.3.2. Overview
++
++ Suppose you give C-Kermit a command like:
++
++ SEND *.*
++
++ And suppose the pattern *.* matches a mixture of text files (such as
++ program source code) and binary files (such os object modules or
++ executable programs).
++
++ C-Kermit 6.0 and earlier (except on VMS) send all files in the same
++ mode: whatever you said in your most recent SET FILE TYPE command, or
++ else whatever mode was chosen automatically according to the rules on
++ page 236 of Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed.
++
++ But when text and binary files are mixed in the same group, and the
++ files are being transferred to an unlike system (e.g. UNIX to IBM
++ Mainframe), this results in corruption of either all the text files or
++ all the binary files.
++
++ Stream-oriented file systems such as in UNIX and DOS do not record any
++ information about the file to tell us whether the file should be
++ transferred in binary or text mode, making it impossible to select the
++ transfer mode for each file in a group automatically with any
++ certainty.
++
++ However, we can use some fairly-well established file naming
++ conventions for this purpose. C-Kermit 7.0 lets you provide lists of
++ filename patterns that are used to separately determine the file type
++ for each individual file being transfered. A pattern is a string,
++ possibly containing the special characters "*" (asterisk, which
++ matches any string of zero of more characters) and/or "?" (question
++ mark, which matches any single character). For example "a*b" matches
++ all files whose names start with "a" and end with "b", such as "ab",
++ "arb", "ababababab", etc, but not "abba". And "a?b" matches any file
++ whose name starts with "a", ends with "b", and is exactly 3 characters
++ long.
++
++ NOTE: When typing commands at the C-Kermit prompt, you must prefix
++ "?" with \ to override its normal function of giving help.
++
++ (Also see [462]Section 4.9 for additional pattern-matching notations
++ that might be available in your version of C-Kermit.)
++
++ When you have specified filename recognition patterns, C-Kermit can
++ transfer the ones whose names match any of the binary-mode patterns in
++ binary mode, and those with names that match any of the text-mode
++ patterns in text mode, and those whose names match neither in the
++ prevailing mode you have chosen, or that was chosen automatically via
++ peer recognition.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.3.3. Commands
++
++ SET FILE PATTERNS { ON, OFF, AUTO }
++ This tells Kermit whether to do per-file filename
++ pattern-matching to determine text or binary mode. The normal
++ and default setting is AUTO, which means to use pattern lists
++ to switch transfer mode only when it is certain that the other
++ Kermit program supports automatic notification of transfer mode
++ (via Attribute packets) on a per-file basis (this information
++ is obtained automatically during protocol startup negotiation).
++ ON means to always determine the transfer mode from the
++ filename and pattern list when sending files. Use OFF to
++ disable this feature (without resetting your pattern lists).
++ Also note that if you have selected LABELED file transfer (SET
++ FILE TYPE LABELED), this takes precedence over
++ filename-matching patterns and all files are sent in labeled
++ mode.
++
++ SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL
++ Disables the use of filename patterns, no matter what the FILE
++ PATTERNS setting.
++
++ REMOTE SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL
++ Client command to disable automatic transfer mode, and
++ therefore also filename patterns, in the server. Synonym:
++ REMOTE SET XFER MODE MANUAL.
++
++ { GET, SEND, etc } { /BINARY, /TEXT }
++ Including a /BINARY or /TEXT (or, where supported, /IMAGE or
++ /LABELED) switch with a file-transfer command changes the
++ transfer mode to manual for that command only, and therefore
++ disables patterns that that command.
++
++ SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
++ A list of zero or more patterns, separated by spaces (not
++ commas). Letters in a pattern are case-sensitive if the
++ underlying filenames are case sensitive (as in UNIX), and
++ case-insensitive otherwise (as in Windows). If a file's name is
++ matched by any pattern in the list and SET FILE PATTERNS is ON,
++ the file is sent in binary mode. Examples:
++
++ SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS *.gz *.Z *.tar *.zip *.o *.so *.a *.out ; UNIX
++ SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS *.EXE *.ZIP *.OBJ *.COM ; DOS or OS/2 or Windows
++
++ If a pattern contains spaces, enclose it in braces.
++
++ SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
++ Like SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS, but the patterns choose text
++ files rather than binary ones. Examples:
++
++ SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS *.TXT *.KSC *.HTM* *.BAT ; DOS, Windows, OS/2
++
++ ADD BINARY-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
++ Adds one or more patterns to the BINARY-PATTERN list.
++
++ ADD TEXT-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
++ Adds one or more patterns to the TEXT-PATTERN list.
++
++ REMOVE BINARY-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
++ Removes one or more patterns from the BINARY-PATTERN list. The
++ given patterns are matched with the ones in the BINARY-PATTERNS
++ list with case sensitivity if the underlying file system has
++ case-sensitive names (as do UNIX and OS-9), otherwise with case
++ independence.
++
++ REMOVE TEXT-PATTERNS [ pattern [ pattern [ pattern ... ] ] ]
++ Removes one or more patterns from the TEXT-PATTERN list.
++
++ SHOW PATTERNS
++ Displays the current pattern selections.
++
++ Whenever you give a SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS or SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS
++ command, the previous list is replaced. If you give one of these
++ commands without a pattern list, the previous list is removed.
++
++ When patterns are active and files are being sent, text patterns (if
++ any) are applied first (but only if not RESENDing and not sending in
++ LABELED mode), then binary patterns, so if the same pattern appears in
++ both lists, binary mode is chosen.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.3.4. Examples
++
++ Here's an example that might be used when sending files from UNIX:
++
++ set file type binary
++ set file text-patterns *.c *.h *.w *.txt makefile
++ set file binary-patterns *.o
++ msend makefile wermit wart ck*.[cwho] ck*.txt
++
++ Note that "wermit" and "wart" do not match any patterns so they are
++ sent in the prevailing mode, which is binary. Also note the use of
++ "makefile" as a pattern that does not contain any wildcard characters
++ (there is no other convention to distinguish among "wermit" and
++ "wart", which are binary executables, and "makefile", which is a text
++ file, purely by their names).
++
++ Most C-Kermit implementations have a default pattern list built in,
++ which includes patterns that are almost certain to succeed in picking
++ the right transfer mode. Others are omitted due to ambiguity. For
++ example ".hlp", and ".ini" are generally binary types in Windows but
++ text types everywhere else.
++
++ NOTE: ".doc", used for decades to denote plain-text documentation
++ files, now more often than not denotes a Microsoft Word Document,
++ so ".doc" is now considered a binary type since it does less harm
++ to transfer a plain-text document in binary mode than it does to
++ transfer an MS Word file in text mode (except when IBM mainframes
++ are involved!)
++
++ ANOTHER NOTE: ".com" files are binary in DOS-like operating
++ systems, but they are text (DCL command procedures) in VMS. VMS
++ C-Kermit sends .COM files in text mode; K95 sends them in binary
++ mode. If you download a .COM file from VMS to DOS or Windows, and
++ then upload it to another VMS system, be sure to use SEND /TEXT to
++ preserve its textness.
++
++ You can see the default pattern list by starting C-Kermit without its
++ initialization file (e.g. "kermit -Y") and using the SHOW PATTERNS
++ command. If you will be depending on this feature, be sure to examine
++ the list carefully in conjunction with the applications that you use.
++
++ The default pattern list does not take "backup files" into account
++ because (a) people usually don't want to transfer them; and (b) it
++ would make the pattern lists more than twice as long. For example, we
++ would need to include both *.txt and *.txt.~[0-9]*~ for ".txt" files,
++ and similarly for all the others. Instead, you can use SEND /NOBACKUP
++ (or SET SEND BACKUP OFF) to skip over all backup files.
++
++ Put your most commonly-used safe pattern declarations in your C-Kermit
++ customization file (ckermod.ini, .mykermrc, k95custom.ini, etc).
++
++ As noted, SET FILE PATTERNS is ON by default. Sometimes, however, it
++ is desirable, or necessary, to force files to be sent in a particular
++ mode, and often this must be done from the command line (e.g. when
++ using Kermit as a download helper in a Web browser like Lynx). The -V
++ command-line options is equivalent to SET FILE PATTERNS OFF and SET
++ TRANSFER MODE MANUAL. Example:
++
++ kermit -Vis oofa.txt
++
++ forces oofa.txt to be sent in binary mode, even though ".txt" might
++ match a text pattern.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.4. File Permissions
++
++ "Permissions" refers to a code associated with a file that specifies
++ who is allowed to access it, and in what manner. For example, the
++ owner, the members of one or more groups, the system administrator,
++ and everybody else, might be allowed various combinations of Read,
++ Write, Append, Execute, or Listing access.
++
++ The permission code goes by different names on different platforms. In
++ UNIX, it might be called the filemode. In VMS, it is called the file
++ protection (or protection mask).
++
++ The comments in this section presently apply only to the UNIX and VMS
++ versions of C-Kermit, to which these features were added in version
++ 7.0; the DOS, Windows, and OS/2 file systems embody no notions of
++ protection, and so MS-DOS Kermit and Kermit 95 do not send file
++ permissions, and ignore them when received.
++
++ The permissions for a received file are determined by a combination of
++ the file transfer mode (VMS-to-VMS transfers only), whether a file of
++ the same name exists already, whether permissions of the file are
++ received in the file attribute packet, and the setting of ATTRIBUTES
++ PROTECTION.
++
++ The default for ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is ON. If no attributes are
++ received, the effect is the same as if attributes PROTECTION were OFF.
++
++ For VMS-to-VMS transfers, the default LABELED mode simply copies the
++ protection code from source to destination.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.4.1. When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is OFF
++
++ If no file of the same name exists, system defaults determine the
++ permissions of the new file. Otherwise, the actions taken depend on
++ the current FILE COLLISION setting: BACKUP, OVERWRITE, RENAME, etc, as
++ documented in [463]Using C-Kermit. But now the new file (if it is
++ created at all) automatically inherits the permissions (mode bits) of
++ the existing file in a way that is appropriate for the platform.
++
++ 4.4.1.1. Unix
++
++ All mode bits are inherited except the directory bit, since the
++ incoming file can not possibly be a directory. (In any case, it is not
++ possible to receive a file that has the same name as an existing
++ directory unless FILE COLLISION is set to RENAME).
++
++ 4.4.1.2. VMS
++
++ Files with the same name as an existing file, transferred in modes
++ other than LABELED between VMS systems, inherit the protection of the
++ prior version.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.4.2 When ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION is ON
++
++ File permissions can be conveyed as part of the file transfer process,
++ in accordance with the Kermit protocol definition. If the file sender
++ puts system-dependent and/or system-independent versions of the file
++ protection (permissions) into the Attribute (A) packet, the file
++ receiver can set the new file's permissions from them. Otherwise, the
++ permissions are set the same as for ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION OFF.
++
++ When the incoming A packet contains system-dependent permissions, the
++ file receiver checks to see if the sender has the same system ID (e.g.
++ both the sending and receiving systems are UNIX, or both are VMS); if
++ so, it decodes and uses the system-dependent permissions; otherwise it
++ uses the generic ones (if any) and applies them to the owner field,
++ setting the other fields appropriately as described in the following
++ sections.
++
++ Setting the incoming file's protection from the A packet is controlled
++ by SET ATTRIBUTES PROTECTION (or PERMISSION), which is ON by default,
++ and its status is displayed by SHOW ATTRIBUTES.
++
++ The main benefit of this feature is to not have to "chmod +x" an
++ executable file after transfer from UNIX to UNIX. Its cross-platform
++ benefits are less evident, perhaps to retain the status of the Unix
++ 'x' bit on a VMS system, for subsequent transfer back to a Unix
++ system.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.4.2.1. System-Specific Permissions
++
++ System-specific file permissions are used when the two Kermit programs
++ recognize each other as running on the same type of system. For
++ example, both are running under some form of UNIX (it doesn't matter
++ which UNIX variation -- HP-UX, Solaris, AIX, etc -- all use the same
++ scheme for file permissions); or both are running under VMS (even if
++ one is on an Alpha and the other on a VAX, and/or one is old and the
++ other is new).
++
++ 4.4.2.1.1. UNIX
++
++ UNIX supports three categories of users, File Owner, Group, and World,
++ and three types of file access permission: Read, Write, and Execute.
++ Thus, a UNIX file's permissions are expressed in 9 bits.
++
++ The system-dependent permission string for UNIX is a 3-digit octal
++ string, the low-order 9 bits of the st_mode member of the stat struct;
++ we deliberately chop off the "file format" bits because they are not
++ permissions, nor do we convey the setuid/setgid bits, lock bit, sticky
++ bit, etc.
++
++ 4.4.2.1.2. VMS
++
++ VMS supports four categories of users, System, File Owner, Group, and
++ World, and four types of file access permission: Read, Write, Execute,
++ and Delete. Thus, a VMS file's permissions are expressed in 16 bits.
++
++ The system-dependent protection string for VMS is a 4-digit
++ hexadecimal string, corresponding to the internal-format protection
++ word of the file (RWED for each of World,Group,Owner,System). A new
++ file normally gets all 16 protection bits from the original file of
++ the same name.
++
++ Note: VMS-to-VMS transfers take place in LABELED mode when the two
++ C-Kermits recognize each other's platform as VMS (unless you have
++ disabled LABELED-mode transfers). In this case, all of a file's
++ attributes are preserved in the transfer and the protection mask (and
++ other information) is taken from the file's internal information, and
++ this takes precedence over any information in the Attribute packets.
++ You can defeat the automatic switching into LABELED mode (if you want
++ to) with SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.4.2.2. System-Independent Permissions
++
++ The system-independent ("generic") protection is used when the system
++ IDs of the two Kermit programs do not agree (e.g. one is UNIX, the
++ other is VMS). The generic protection attribute includes the following
++ permissions (not all are applicable to every file system): Read,
++ Write, Append, Execute, Delete, Search. The generic permissions are
++ derived from the owner permissions of the source file, thus, a Unix
++ 'w' permission becomes VMS Write,Delete.
++
++ The Owner field of the new file's permissions is set from the incoming
++ generic protection attribute.
++
++ In UNIX, the Group and World permissions are set according to your
++ umask, except that execute permission is NOT set in these fields if it
++ was not also set in the generic protection (and consequently, is set
++ in the Owner field).
++
++ In VMS, the System, Group, and World permissions are set according to
++ the process default file permission (as shown in VMS by SHOW
++ PROTECTION), except that no permissions are allowed in these fields
++ that are not included in the generic permissions.
++
++ Note that the VMS and UNIX interpretations of Execute permission are
++ not identical. In UNIX, a file (binary executable, shell script, etc)
++ may not be executed unless it has Execute permission, and normally
++ files that are not intended for execution do not have Execute
++ permission. In VMS, Read permission implicitly supplies Execute
++ capability. Generally files that have Read permission also have
++ explicit Execute permission, but files (binary executables, DCL
++ command procedures) that have Read permission and not Execute
++ permission can still be executed.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.5. File Management Commands
++
++ 4.5.1. The DIRECTORY Command
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the DIRECTORY command always ran an external
++ system command (such as "ls" on UNIX) or program to product the
++ directory listing. This had certain advantages, mostly that you could
++ include system-dependent options for customized listings, e.g. on
++ UNIX:
++
++ dir -lt c* | more
++
++ or in VMS:
++
++ directory /size/date/protection/except=*.obj oofa.*;0
++
++ This approach, however, carries some disadvantages: C-Kermit can't
++ return SUCCESS or FAILURE status for (e.g.) "dir foo" according to
++ whether the file "foo" exists; and it runs an inferior process, which
++ might be a problem in some environments for resource and/or security
++ reasons, and won't work at all in a "nopush" environment (e.g. one in
++ which C-Kermit is configured to forbid access to exterior commands and
++ programs, e.g. in a VMS "captive account").
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0 on VMS and UNIX, and in K95 1.1.19 and later, the
++ DIRECTORY command is internal to Kermit. It can be run in a "nopush"
++ environment and returns SUCCESS or FAILURE status appropriately. In
++ UNIX it prints all dates and times in a consistent way (unlike ls). In
++ VMS it prints precise file sizes, rather than "blocks". It offers
++ several formatting and other options, but it is not necessarily more
++ flexible than the corresponding external commands or programs (the
++ UNIX "ls" program, the VMS "directory" command). The syntax is:
++
++ DIRECTORY [ switch [ switch [ ... ] ] ] [ filespec ]
++
++ If no filespec is given, all files in the current directory are
++ listed.
++
++ Optional switches include all the standard file-selection switches
++ presented in [464]Section 1.5.4, plus:
++
++ /ALL
++ Show both regular files and directories; this is the default.
++
++ /ARRAY:x
++ Instead of displaying a directory listing, put the files that
++ would have been shown (based on the filespec and other
++ selection switches) in the given array. The array need not (and
++ should not) be predeclared; if the array already exists, it is
++ destroyed and reused. The array name can be a single letter,
++ like "a", or any fuller form, such as "&a", "\&a", "\&a[]",
++ etc. If the /ARRAY switch is included, the following other
++ switches are ignored: /BRIEF, /VERBOSE, /HEADING, /PAGE,
++ /ENGLISHDATE, /ISODATE, /XFERMODE, /MESSAGE, /SORT, /REVERSE,
++ /ASCENDING. In other words, only file selection switches are
++ meaningful with /ARRAY: /FILES, /DIRECTORIES, /ALL, /DOTFILES,
++ /NOBACKUP, /RECURSIVE, /SMALLER, /LARGER, /AFTER, /BEFORE,
++ /EXCEPT, etc. The resulting array has the number of files (n)
++ as its 0th element, and the filenames in elements 1 through n
++ Example:
++
++ dir /array:&a /files /nobackup /after:19990101 /larger:10000 [ab]*
++ show array &a
++
++ /FILES
++ Only show regular files.
++
++ /DIRECTORIES
++ Only show directories.
++
++ /BACKUP
++ In UNIX, OS-9, K-95, and other versions that support SET FILE
++ COLLISION BACKUP and create backup files by appending .~n~ to
++ the filename (where "n" is a number), /BACKUP means to include
++ these files in directory listings. This is the default.
++
++ /NOBACKUP
++ This is the opposite of /BACKUP: that is, do not include backup
++ files in the listing.
++
++ /BRIEF
++ List filenames only; use a compact format, as many filenames as
++ will fit across the screen (based on the longest name). A brief
++ listing is always sorted alphabetically.
++
++ /VERBOSE
++ List one file per line, and include date, size, and (in UNIX
++ only) permissions of each file. This is the opposite of /BRIEF,
++ and is the default.
++
++ /PAGE
++ Pause at the end of each screenful and give a "more?" prompt,
++ even if SET COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING is OFF.
++
++ /NOPAGE
++ Don't pause at the end of each screenful and give a "more?"
++ prompt, even if SET COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING is ON. If neither
++ /PAGE or /NOPAGE is given, paging is according to the
++ prevailing COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING setting (which can be
++ displayed with SHOW COMMAND).
++
++ /ENGLISHDATE
++ Show dates in dd-mmm-yyyy format; mmm is the first three
++ letters of the English month name.
++
++ /ISODATE
++ Show dates in yyyy-mm-dd format; mm is the month number, 1-12.
++ This is the opposite of /ENGLISHDATE, and is the default.
++
++ /HEADINGS
++ Print a heading before the listing and a summary at the end.
++
++ /NOHEADINGS
++ Don't print a heading before the listing or a summary at the
++ end. This is the opposite of /HEADINGS, and is the default.
++
++ /XFERMODE
++ Only in Kermit programs that support SET FILE PATTERNS. If this
++ switch is included, and the filename matches any FILE
++ BINARY-PATTERN ([465]Section 4.3), "(B)" is printed after the
++ filename; otherwise, if it matches a FILE TEXT-PATTERN, "(T)"
++ is printed.
++
++ /NOXFERMODE
++ Don't display transfer-mode indicators. This is the opposite of
++ /XFERMODE and is the default.
++
++ /RECURSIVE
++ Show files not only in the given directory, but also in its
++ subdirectories (if any), their subdirectories, etc.
++
++ /NORECURSIVE
++ Don't show files in subdirectories. This is the opposite of
++ /RECURSIVE, and is the default.
++
++ /MESSAGE:text
++ This lets you specify a short text string to be appended to the
++ end of each directory listing line (a space is supplied
++ automatically). If the text contains any spaces, enclose it in
++ braces, e.g. /MESSAGE:{two words}.
++
++ /NOMESSAGE
++ Don't append any message to the end of each directory listing
++ line (default).
++
++ /SORT:[{NAME,SIZE,DATE}]
++ Sort the listing by name, size, or date. If the /SORT switch is
++ given but the "sort-by" keyword is omitted, the listing is
++ sorted by name. /SORT:NAME /ASCENDING (alphabetic sort by name)
++ is the default.
++
++ /NOSORT
++ Don't sort the listing. Files are listed in whatever order they
++ are supplied by the operating system, e.g. inode order in UNIX.
++
++ /REVERSE
++ If the /SORT switch is given, reverse the order of the sort.
++ Synonym: /DESCENDING.
++
++ /ASCENDING
++ If the /SORT switch is given, sort the listing in normal order.
++ This is the opposite of /REVERSE and is the default.
++
++ Note that most of the DIRECTORY-specific switches come in pairs, in
++ which one member of a pair (e.g. /NOHEADINGS) is the opposite of the
++ other (e.g. /HEADINGS).
++
++ If you always want to use certain options, you can set them with the
++ SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY command ([466]Section 1.5.5). Use SHOW OPTIONS
++ to list the options currently in effect. To make the desired options
++ apply every time you run C-Kermit, put a SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY command
++ in your C-Kermit customization file, specifying the desired options.
++ Options set in this manner apply to every subsequent DIRECTORY
++ command. Of course, if you include switches in a DIRECTORY command,
++ these override any defaults, built-in or custom. Example:
++
++ DIRECTORY ; Use "factory defaults"
++ SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY /SORT:SIZE /REVERSE /HEADINGS ; Customize defaults
++ DIRECTORY ; Use customized defaults
++ DIR /SORT:NAME ; Override customized default SORT key
++ SET OPT DIR /RECURS ; Add /RECURSIVE to customized defaults
++ DIR /ASCEND ; Override customized default SORT order
++
++ Notes:
++
++ * Only a single sort key is supported; there is presently no way to
++ have multiple sort keys.
++ * If the /BRIEF switch is given, all other switches (except
++ /[NO]RECURSIVE, /[NO]DOTFILES, /DIRECTORIES, /FILES, and /ALL) are
++ ignored.
++ * /SORT:anything gives incorrect results if any files have lengths
++ greater than 10 digits (i.e. that are more than 9999999999 bytes
++ long, i.e. if they are 10GB or more in size) because the overlong
++ length field causes the date and name fields to be misaligned.
++ * /SORT:NAME is redundant in VMS since VMS returns filenames in
++ alphabetic order anyway.
++ * /SORT:NAME ignores alphabetic case on platforms where case does
++ not matter in filenames, but this works only for unaccented Roman
++ letters A-Z.
++ * /SORT:NAME is currently based on code values, and so works fine
++ for ASCII, but will probably produce unexpected results for files
++ with non-ASCII or 8-bit characters in their names. (Locale-based
++ sorting raises rather significant issues of portability, size,
++ performance, etc.)
++ * /SORT:DATE works right only for ISO-format dates, not English
++ ones.
++ * /SORT:SIZE sorts the size field lexically. On some platforms (e.g.
++ Windows), the size of a directory file is listed as "<DIR>" rather
++ than as a number; in this case, the "<DIR>" files are gathered at
++ the end (or beginning, depending on the sort order) of the
++ listing.
++ * /RECURSIVE is accepted but ignored in AOS/VS. Use the normal
++ system-specific filespec notation, e.g. "dir #.txt".
++ * /RECURSIVE has no affect when a full, absolute pathname is given;
++ e.g. "dir /recursive /tmp/foo" (where "foo" is a regular file)
++ only shows the "/tmp/foo" file. If you want to see all "foo" files
++ in the /tmp tree, do "cd /tmp" and then "dir /recursive foo".
++ * If a file size of -1 is shown, or date-time of 0000-00-00
++ 00:00:00, this means the file was located, but access to
++ information about the file was denied to C-Kermit.
++ * In VMS, if FOO.DIR;1 is a directory within your current directory,
++ "directory foo" and "directory [.foo]" list the files in the
++ [.FOO] subdirectory, but "directory foo.dir" lists the directory
++ file itself; similarly for "*.dir" versus "[.*]", etc.
++ * In UNIX, if "foo" is a directory within your current directory,
++ "directory foo" lists the files in the foo directory. If you want
++ to list the foo directory file itself, put an asterisk at the end:
++ "dir foo*".
++
++ Hint: How to find the biggest files in a directory tree:
++
++ cd xxx ; (root of tree)
++ directory /sort:size /recursive /reverse /dotfiles /page
++
++ Another hint: If you often use several different directory-listing
++ formats, define macro shortcuts for them:
++
++ DEFINE WD DIRECTORY /SORT:DATE /REVERSE \%* ; Reverse chronological order
++ DEFINE SD DIRECTORY /SORT:SIZE /REVERSE \%* ; Reverse order of size
++ DEFINE ND DIRECTORY /SORT:NAME /ASCEND \%* ; Alphabetical by name
++ DEFINE DL DIR /DIR /SORT:NAME /ASCEND \%* ; Alphabetical directory list
++
++ Put these definitions in your C-Kermit customization file. Note that
++ "\%*" ([467]Section 7.5) in these definitions lets you include other
++ switches in your macro invocations, e.g.:
++
++ wd /headings *.txt
++
++ Of course you can still access your external directory listing program
++ by using RUN or "!", e.g. in VMS:
++
++ run directory /size/date/protection/except=*.obj oofa.*;0
++
++ or:
++
++ !dir /size/date/prot/exc=*.obj oofa.*;0
++
++ In UNIX, use "!ls" or just "ls" (which is a special synonym for
++ "!ls").
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.5.2. The CD and BACK Commands
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, the CD command has a new friend, the BACK command.
++ BACK means "CD to my previous current directory". A second BACK brings
++ you back to where you were before the first one; thus successive BACK
++ commands switch back and forth between two directories.
++
++ 4.5.2.1. Parsing Improvements
++
++ The CD command, as well as other commands that parse a directory name,
++ were changed in 7.0 to provide all the expected functions: completion
++ on Tab or Esc, directory-name lists on ?, etc. Other affected commands
++ include SET SERVER GET-PATH, SET TEMP-DIRECTORY, SET FILE
++ DOWNLOAD-DIRECTORY, and SPACE. CD and REMOTE CD also now work with
++ logical names.
++
++ In VMS, the situation is a bit complicated since a directory name can
++ look like "DEV:", "[FOO.BAR]", "DEV:[FOO.BAR]", "[FOO]BAR.DIR;1", etc.
++ Completion and ?-help might not always work, but they do in many
++ cases. Examples:
++
++ cd ? Lists all subdirectories of the current directory
++ cd []? Ditto
++ cd k? Ditto, but only those starting with K
++ cd [foo]? Lists all subdirectories of the [FOO] directory
++ cd [-]? Lists all subdirectories of the superior directory
++ cd [--]? Lists all subdirectories of the directory 2 levels up
++ cd [...]? Lists all directories below the current one
++ cd [foo.? Does not work.
++
++ C-Kermit allows all of the following in VMS:
++
++ cd bar CD to subdirectory BAR of the current directory
++ cd .bar Ditto
++ cd [.bar] Ditto
++ cd bar.dir etc...
++ cd bar.dir;
++ cd bar.dir;1
++ cd [foo.bar]
++ cd bar.baz This can go more than 1 level deep...
++ cd dir: (where logical name DIR is defined as [FOO.BAR])
++
++ As well as the following:
++
++ cd .. Go up one level as in UNIX
++ cd . The current directory
++ cd My login directory
++
++ Note that "cd -" (go up one level) does not work as expected, because
++ "-" is Kermit's command continuation character. However, "cd [-]", and
++ "
++ cd {-}" have the desired effect (and so does "cd ..", which is easier
++ to type).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.5.2.2. The CDPATH
++
++ The CD command in the UNIX, Windows, OS/2, and VMS versions of
++ C-Kermit, as of version 6.1 / 1.1.12, searches the CDPATH for the
++ given directory, if it is not absolute and if a CDPATH environment
++ variable is defined. Example (in UNIX ksh or bash):
++
++ $ export CDPATH=$HOME:$HOME/kermit:/tmp
++
++ Now if you give a "cd xxx" command, no matter what your current
++ directory is, if the "xxx" directory is not a subdirectory of your
++ current directory, then the xxx subdirectory of your home directory is
++ used or if that does not exist, then the xxx subdirectory of the
++ kermit subdirectory of your home directory is used or if that does not
++ exist, then /tmp/xxx is used. This is how the ksh "cd" command works,
++ and now the C-Kermit CD command works the same way.
++
++ In VMS, you can define CDPATH to be a list of directories that contain
++ actual directory delimiters, and/or logical names representing
++ directories, using commas to separate them, e.g.:
++
++ $ define cdpath [HOME],[SOMEOTHERDIR],[HOME.MISC]
++ $ define cdpath SYS$LOGIN:,DISK1:[HOME],DISK2:[SCRATCH.IVAN]
++
++ Example:
++
++ $ define cdpath SYS$LOGIN:,[IVAN],[OLAF],[OLGA.MISC]
++ $ kermit
++ DISK1:[OLGA] C-Kermit> cd blah
++
++ tries the BLAH subdirectory of the user's login directory, then
++ [OLGA.BLAH], [IVAN.BLAH], [OLAF.BLAH], and [OLGA.MISC.BLAH], in that
++ order, using the first one it finds, failing if it finds none.
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, you may also set the CDPATH from the Kermit prompt:
++
++ SET CD PATH path
++ Allows the CD PATH to be set from within C-Kermit.
++
++ SHOW CD shows the CD path and all other information relevant to the CD
++ command.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.5.2.3. CD Messages
++
++ Whenever you change directory, you can have C-Kermit display a "Read
++ Me" file from the new directory automatically. The commands are:
++
++ SET CD MESSAGE { ON, OFF, FILE list }
++ ON enables this feature; OFF (the default) disables it. File
++ lets you specify the name of the "Read Me" file. A list of
++ names to look for can be given in the following format:
++
++ {{name1}{name2}{name3}{...}}
++
++ e.g.:
++
++ SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE FILE {{./.readme}{README.TXT}{READ.ME}}
++
++ The default list of CD-message files is system dependent.
++
++ SHOW CD shows your current directory, previous directory, CD path, and
++ CD message info.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.5.3. Creating and Removing Directories
++
++ The MKDIR command now allows you to create multiple directories at
++ once:
++
++ C-Kermit> mkdir a/b/c/d
++
++ creates the directory a in the current directory (if it doesn't exist
++ already), and then creates subdirectory b in the a directory (if it
++ didn't exist already), and so on.
++
++ If you use MKDIR to try to create a directory that already exists,
++ C-Kermit will print a warning ("?Directory already exists"), but the
++ MKDIR command will still succeed. If you want to avoid the warning
++ message, use IF DIRECTORY first to check if the directory already
++ exists.
++
++ The RMDIR command, however, will not remove more than one directory,
++ nor will it remove a directory that contains any files. (There is, as
++ yet, no RMDIR /RECURSIVE command, although one might be added later.)
++
++ In VMS, these commands (like CD) are more forgiving of your syntax
++ than is the DCL command shell; "mkdir oofa" is equivalent to "mkdir
++ [.oofa]" and so on. Also in VMS, you'll find that C-Kermit's RMDIR
++ command is easier than deleting a directory in DCL, since it
++ automatically first gives it owner delete permission if you are the
++ owner.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.5.4. The DELETE and PURGE Commands
++
++ The DELETE command now offers a selection of switches, and has a new
++ companion, the PURGE command. First, DELETE:
++
++ DELETE [ switches... ] filespec
++ Deletes the file or files that match the filespec, which may
++ contain wildcards ([468]Section 4.9).
++
++ Optional switches include the standard file-selection switches
++ presented in [469]Section 1.5.4, plus:
++
++ /ASK
++ Before deleting each file, ask permission interactively.
++ Answers are Yes or OK (delete the file), No (don't delete it),
++ or Quit (stop executing the DELETE command).
++
++ /NOASK
++ Don't ask permission to delete each file.
++
++ /LIST
++ List each file and show whether it was deleted. Synonyms: /LOG,
++ /VERBOSE.
++
++ /NOLIST
++ Don't list files while deleting them. Synonyms: /NOLOG, /QUIET.
++
++ /HEADING
++ Print a heading and summary line.
++
++ /NOHEADING
++ Don't print a heading and summary line.
++
++ /PAGE
++ When listing, pause at the end of each screenful and give the
++ "More?" prompt. If you reply "n" (no), the DELETE command
++ terminates.
++
++ /SIMULATE
++ Do everything implied by the given switches and filespec,
++ except do not actually delete any files. This lets you preview
++ which files would be deleted; implies /LIST.
++
++ Now the PURGE command:
++
++ PURGE [ switches... ] [ filespec ]
++ (VMS only) Runs the DCL PURGE command. Switches and filespec,
++ if any, are passed directly to DCL without parsing or
++ verification. Deletes excess versions of the given (or all)
++ files. The rest of this section does not apply to VMS.
++
++ PURGE [ switches... ] [ filespec ]
++ (UNIX only) Deletes "backup files" that match the filespec,
++ which may contain wildcards ([470]Section 4.9). If no filespec
++ is given, all backup files in the current directory are
++ selected (subject to modification by any switches). Do not
++ include backup notation in the filespec.
++
++ Explanation:
++
++ To avoid destroying preexisting files when a new file arrives that has
++ the same name, C-Kermit backs up the old file by appending a "backup
++ number" to its name. In UNIX, the backup suffix consists of a period,
++ a tilde, a number, and another tilde. For example, if a file called
++ oofa.txt exists and a new oofa.txt file arrives, the original is
++ renamed to oofa.txt.~1~. If another oofa.txt file arrives, the
++ existing one is renamed to oofa.txt.~2~. And so on. This system is
++ compatible with the one used by EMACS. Thus over time, if you receive
++ a lot of files with C-Kermit or edit them with EMACS, backup files can
++ build up. The new PURGE command lets you clean out accumulated backup
++ files:
++
++ Optional switches include the standard file-selection switches
++ presented in [471]Section 1.5.4, plus all the switches listed above
++ for the DELETE command, plus:
++
++ /KEEP:n
++ Retains the n most recent (highest-numbered) backup files for
++ each file. For example, if oofa.txt, oofa.txt.~1~,
++ oofa.txt.~2~, oofa.txt.~10~, oofa.txt.~12~, and oofa.txt.~100~
++ exist, "purge /keep:2 oofa.txt" deletes oofa.txt.~1~,
++ oofa.txt.~2~, and oofa.txt.~10~, and keeps oofa.txt,
++ oofa.txt.~12~, and oofa.txt.~100~. If /KEEP is given without a
++ number, one (the highest numbered) backup file is kept.
++
++ CAUTION: The PURGE command should be used only when *.~*~ files truly
++ are backup files. This is the case for EMACS, and it is the DEFAULT
++ for C-Kermit. However, if C-Kermit's FILE COLLISION has been set to
++ RENAME, newly received files will look like backup files. In that
++ case, don't use the PURGE command or you'll be removing new files
++ rather than old ones. (Use SHOW FILE to find the FILE COLLISION
++ setting.)
++
++ The PURGE command is presently available only in UNIX. The command
++ succeeds if it deleted any files, or if it deleted no files but there
++ were no errors. It fails if it deleted no files and there were errors
++ (i.e. deletion was attempted but failed). In VMS, backup file versions
++ are handled automatically by the OS, and a PURGE command can be used
++ at the VMS prompt to clean them up.
++
++ If you want certain switches to be supplied automatically with each
++ DELETE or PURGE command, you can set them with SET OPTIONS
++ ([472]Section 1.5.5) and you can display any such settings with SHOW
++ OPTIONS. Of course you can override them on a per-command basis by
++ including switches in your PURGE or DELETE command.
++
++ Also see SET FILE COLLISION, SHOW FILE, SEND /NOBACKUP, SET SEND
++ BACKUP, and DIRECTORY /[NO]BACKUP.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.6. Starting the Remote Kermit Server Automatically
++
++ As noted on pages 275-276 of [473]Using C-Kermit 2nd edition, you can
++ have Kermit send "kermit receive" commands automatically when it is in
++ local mode and you give a SEND or similar command, to start the remote
++ Kermit receiver in case it is not already started. The "kermit
++ receive" commands are specified by:
++
++ SET PROTOCOL KERMIT binary-receive-command text-receive-command
++
++ As of version 7.0, a Kermit protocol option has been added to send a
++ string to the host in advance of any Kermit packets when you give a
++ GET-class or REMOTE command. This will switch the remote C-Kermit into
++ the appropriate mode or, if the remote system is at a system command
++ (shell) prompt, execute the string on the remote system. The new
++ syntax of the SET PROTOCOL KERMIT command is:
++
++ SET PROTOCOL KERMIT [ s1 [ s2 [ s3 ] ] ]
++
++ where:
++
++ Default Meaning
++ s1 {kermit -ir} Remote "kermit receive in binary mode" command.
++ s2 {kermit -r} Remote "kermit receive in text mode" command.
++ s3 {kermit -x} Remote "start kermit server" command.
++
++ NOTE: If the remote Kermit is 6.0, the following are recommended for
++ fast startup and high-performance file transfer (see Appendix I in
++ [474]Using C-Kermit, second Edition, for command-line options):
++
++ s1 kermit -YQir (Kermit receive binary, skip init file, fast.)
++ s2 kermit -YQTr (Kermit receive text, skip init file, fast.)
++ s3 kermit -YQx (Kermit server, skip init file, fast.)
++
++ If the remote is C-Kermit 7.0 or later, change the -x option (enter
++ server mode) to -O (uppercase letter O), which means "enter server
++ mode for One transaction only); this way, it is not stuck in server
++ after the transfer. Also note that the Q is redundant in version 7.0,
++ since fast Kermit protocol settings are now the default.
++
++ Note that in case the C-Kermit executable is called "wermit" or
++ "ckermit" you can change "kermit" in the strings above to "wermit" or
++ "ckermit" and C-Kermit 7.0 or later will recognize these as synonyms
++ for "kermit", in case it is at its command prompt when one of these
++ strings is sent to it.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.7. File-Transfer Command Switches
++
++ Over the years, various new methods of transferring a file have
++ accumulated, until we had, in addition to the SEND command, also MOVE
++ (send and then delete), MAIL (send as email), REMOTE PRINT (send to be
++ printed), CSEND (send the output of a command), PSEND (send a part of
++ a file), BSEND (send in binary mode), RESEND (resume an interrupted
++ SEND), etc etc. Similarly: GET, REGET, CGET, RETRIEVE, and so on.
++
++ Not only is it confusing to have different names for these commands,
++ many of which are not real words, but this also does not allow all
++ combinations, like "send a file as mail, then delete it".
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, the SEND, GET, and RECEIVE commands were restructured
++ to accept modifier switches (switches are explained in [475]Section
++ 1.5).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.7.1. SEND Command Switches
++
++ Without switches, the SEND command still works exactly as before:
++
++ send oofa.txt ; send a single file
++ send oofa.* ; send multiple files
++ send oofa.txt x.x ; send oofa.txt as x.x (tell receiver its name is x.x)
++ send ; send from SEND-LIST
++
++ But now the following modifier switches may be included between "send"
++ and the filename. Zero, one, two, or more switches may be included in
++ any combination that makes sense. Switch names (such as /BINARY) can
++ be abbreviated, just like any other keywords. Most of these switches
++ work only when using Kermit protocol (/TEXT and /BINARY are the
++ exceptions).
++
++ /AFTER:date-time
++ Specifies that only those files modified (or, in VMS, created)
++ after the given date-time (see [476]Section 1.6) are to be
++ sent. Examples:
++
++ send /text /after:{2-Feb-1997 10:28:30} *.txt
++ send /text /after:\fdate(oofa.txt) *.txt
++
++ Synonym: /SINCE.
++
++ /ARRAY:arrayname
++ Specifies that instead of sending a file, C-Kermit is to send
++ the contents of the given array. Since an array does not have a
++ filename, you should include an /AS-NAME switch to specify the
++ name under which the array is to be sent (if you do not, the
++ name "_array_x_" is used, where 'x' is replaced by the array
++ designator). See [477]section 7.10 for array-name syntax. As
++ noted in that section, you can also include a range to have a
++ segment of the array sent, rather than the whole thing; for
++ example: "send /array:&a[100:199]". It is strongly recommended
++ that you accompany the /ARRAY switch with a /TEXT or /BINARY
++ switch to force the desired transfer mode, since otherwise the
++ various automatic mechanisms might switch to binary mode when
++ you really wanted text, or vice versa. In text mode a line
++ terminator is added to the end of each array element, but not
++ in binary mode. For details and examples see [478]Section
++ 7.10.11.
++
++ /AS-NAME:text
++ Specifies "text" as the name to send the file under. You can
++ also still specify the as-name as the second filename on the
++ SEND command line. The following two commands are equivalent:
++
++ send oofa.txt oofa.new
++ send /as:oofa.new oofa.txt
++
++ /BEFORE:date-time
++ Specifies that only those files modified (or, in VMS, created)
++ before the given date-time ([479]Section 1.6) are to be sent.
++
++ /BINARY
++ Performs this transfer in binary mode without affecting the
++ global transfer mode, overriding not only the FILE TYPE and
++ TRANSFER MODE settings, but also the FILE PATTERN setting, but
++ for this SEND command only. In other words, SEND /BINARY means
++ what it says: send the file in binary mode, regardless of any
++ other settings. Example:
++
++ set file type text ; Set global transfer mode to text
++ send /binary oofa.zip ; Send a file in binary
++ send oofa.txt ; This one is sent in text mode
++
++ /COMMAND
++ SEND /COMMAND is equivalent to CSEND ([480]Section 4.2.2) -- it
++ says to send the output from a command, rather than the
++ contents of a file. The first "filename" on the SEND command
++ line is interpreted as the name of a command; the second (if
++ any) is the as-name. Examples:
++
++ send /command {grep Sunday oofa.txt} sunday.txt
++ send /as-name:sunday.txt /command {grep Sunday oofa.txt}
++ send /bin /command {tar cf - . | gzip -c} {!gunzip -c | tar xf -}
++
++ /DELETE
++ Deletes the file (or each file in the group) after it has been
++ sent successfully (but does not delete it if it was not sent
++ successfully). SEND /DELETE is equivalent to MOVE. Has no
++ effect when used with /COMMAND. Example:
++
++ send /delete *.log
++
++ /DOTFILES
++ (UNIX and OS-9 only) Normally files whose names begin with "."
++ are skipped when matching wildcards that do not also beging
++ with ".". Include /DOTFILES to force these files to be included
++ too.
++
++ /RECURSIVE
++ Descend the through the directory tree when locating files to
++ send. Automatically sets /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE. Explained in
++ [481]Section 4.11 .
++
++ /EXCEPT:pattern
++ See [482]Section 1.5.4.
++
++ /NOBACKUP
++ This means to skip backup files when sending, even if they
++ match the SEND file specification. This is equivalent to using
++ SEND /EXCEPT and including *.~[0-9]*~ in the exception list (or
++ *.~*~ if Kermit was built without pattern-matching support; see
++ [483]Section 4.9.1). Including this switch is equivalent to
++ giving SET SEND BACKUP OFF ([484]Section 4.0.6) prior to SEND,
++ except its effect is local to the SEND command with which it
++ was given.
++
++ /NODOTFILES
++ The opposite of /DOTFILES (q.v.)
++
++ /FILENAMES:{CONVERTED,LITERAL}
++ Use this switch to override the current global SET FILE NAMES
++ setting for this transfer only.
++
++ /FILTER:command
++ This specifies a filter to pass the file through before sending
++ it. See the [485]section on file-transfer pipes and filters.
++ The /FILTER switch applies only to the file-transfer command it
++ is given with; it does not affect the global SEND FILTER
++ setting, if any.
++
++ /IMAGE
++ VMS: Sends in image mode. Non-VMS: same as /BINARY.
++
++ /LABELED
++ VMS and OS/2 only: Sends in labeled mode.
++
++ /LARGER-THAN:number
++ Specifies that only those files that are longer than the given
++ number of bytes are to be sent.
++
++ /LISTFILE:filename
++ Specifies that the files to be sent are listed in a file with
++ the given filename. The file contains one filename per line.
++ These filenames are not checked in any way; each filename is
++ taken and does not use or depend on any Kermit-specific syntax.
++ In particular, backslashes are not treated specially, leading
++ and trailing spaces are not stripped, etc. However, if a
++ filename contains wildcards, they are expanded. Example: If a
++ file named files.txt contains the following lines:
++
++ blah.txt
++ oofa*
++ x.x
++
++ (but without leading or trailing spaces), then the C-Kermit
++ command "send /listfile:files.txt" will send the files
++ blah.txt, x.x, and all files whose names start with "oofa",
++ assuming the files exist and are readable. The /LISTFILE
++ switch, can, of course, be used with other switches when it
++ makes sense, for example, /EXCEPT, /BINARY, /AFTER, /SMALLER,
++ /MOVE-TO, /DELETE, /AS-NAME with a template, etc.
++
++ /MAIL:address
++ Sends the file as e-mail to the given address or addresses.
++ "send /mail:address filename" is equivalent to "mail filename
++ address". You can include multiple addresses separated by
++ commas. Examples:
++
++ send /mail:kermit-support@columbia.edu packet.log
++ send /mail:cmg,fdc,jrd oofa.txt
++
++ As with any switch argument, if the address or address list
++ contains any spaces, you must enclose it in braces. The format
++ of the addresses must agree with that understood by the
++ mail-sending program on the receiver's computer.
++
++ /MOVE-TO:directory-name
++ Specifies that after each (or the only) source file is sent
++ successfully, and ONLY if it is sent successfully, it should be
++ moved to the named directory. If the directory name contains
++ spaces, enclose it in braces. If the directory does not exist,
++ it is created if possible; if it can't be created, the command
++ fails and an error message is printed. Example:
++
++ send /text /move-to:/users/olga/backup/ *.txt
++
++ /NOT-AFTER:date-time
++ Specifies that only those files modified at or before the given
++ date and time are to be sent.
++
++ /NOT-BEFORE:date-time
++ Specifies that only those files modified at or after the given
++ date and time are to be sent.
++
++ /PATHNAMES:{OFF,ABSOLUTE,RELATIVE}
++ Use this switch to override the current global SET SEND
++ PATHNAMES setting for this transfer only. /PATHNAMES:ABSOLUTE
++ or RELATIVE also sets /FILENAMES:LITERAL (also for this
++ transfer only) since pathnames are not sent otherwise.
++
++ /RENAME-TO:text
++ Specifies that after the (or each) source file is sent
++ successfully, and ONLY if it is sent successfully, it should be
++ renamed to the name given. If the name contains spaces, enclose
++ it in braces. If a file group is being sent, then the "text"
++ must contain a variable reference such as \v(filename) (see
++ [486]Section 4.1). Example:
++
++ send /rename-to:ok_\v(filename) *.*
++
++ This sends each file in the current directory and if it was
++ sent successfully, changes its name to begin with "ok_".
++
++ /SMALLER-THAN:number
++ Specifies that only those files that are smaller than the given
++ number of bytes are to be sent.
++
++ /SUBJECT:text
++ Subject for email. Actually, this is just a synonym for
++ /AS-NAME. If the text includes spaces, you must enclose it in
++ braces. If you don't specify a subject (or as-name), the name
++ of the file is used as the subject. Example:
++
++ send /mail:kermit-support@columbia.edu /subj:{As requested} packet.log
++
++ /PRINT:options
++ Sends the file to be printed, optionally specifying options for
++ the printer. Equivalent to REMOTE PRINT filename options.
++ Examples:
++
++ send /print oofa.txt ; No options.
++ send /print:/copies=3 oofa.txt ; "/copies=3" is a VMS PRINT switch.
++ send /print:-#3 oofa.txt ; "-#3" is a UNIX lpr switch.
++
++ /PROTOCOL:name
++ Uses the given protocol to send the file (Kermit, Zmodem, etc)
++ for this transfer without changing global protocol. Only
++ available in Kermit 95, UNIX, and OS-9. Example:
++
++ set protocol kermit ; Set global protocol
++ send /proto:zmodem /bin oofa.zip ; Send just this file with Zmodem
++ send oofa.txt ; This file is sent with Kermit
++
++ /QUIET
++ When sending in local mode, this suppresses the file-transfer
++ display.
++
++ /RECOVER
++ Used to recover from a previously interrupted transfer; SEND
++ /RECOVER is equivalent to RESEND. Recovery only works in binary
++ mode; SEND /RECOVER and RESEND include an implied /BINARY
++ switch. Even then, recovery will successful only if (a) the
++ original (interrupted) transfer was also in binary mode, or (b)
++ if it was in text mode, the two Kermit programs run on
++ platforms where text-mode transfers are not length-changing.
++
++ /STARTING:number
++ Starts sending the file from the given byte position. SEND
++ /STARTING:n filename is equivalent to PSEND filename n.
++
++ /TEXT
++ Performs this transfer in text mode without affecting the
++ global transfer mode, overriding not only the FILE TYPE and
++ TRANSFER MODE settings, but also the FILE PATTERN setting, for
++ this SEND command only. In other words, SEND /TEXT really send
++ the file in text mode, regardless of any other settings or
++ negotiations.
++
++ About mail... Refer to [487]Section 4.7.1. The same rules apply as for
++ file transfer. If you are mailing multiple files, you can't use an
++ as-name (in this case, a subject) unless it contains replacement
++ variables like \v(filenum). For example, if you:
++
++ send /mail:somebody@xyz.com *.txt
++
++ Then each file will arrive as a separate email message with its name
++ as the subject. But if you:
++
++ send /mail:somebody@xyz.com /subject:{Here is a file} *.txt
++
++ Then each file message will have the same subject, which is probably
++ not what you want. You can get around this with constructions like:
++
++ send /mail:somebody@xyz.com /subject:{Here is \v(filename)} *.txt
++
++ which embed the filename in the subject.
++
++ The MOVE, CSEND, MAIL, and RESEND commands now also accept the same
++ switches. And the switches are also operative when sending from a
++ SEND-LIST (see [488]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed, pp.191-192), so, for
++ example, it is now possible to SEND /PRINT or SEND /MAIL from a
++ SEND-LIST.
++
++ The MSEND and MMOVE commands also take switches, but not all of them.
++ With these commands, which take an arbitrary list of filespecs, you
++ can use /BINARY, /DELETE, /MAIL, /PRINT, /PROTOCOL, /QUIET, /RECOVER,
++ and /TEXT (and /IMAGE or /LABELED, depending on the platform). MMOVE
++ is equivalent to MSEND /DELETE. (If you want to send a group of files,
++ but in mixed transfer modes with per-file as-names, use ADD SEND-LIST
++ and then SEND.)
++
++ The MSEND/MMOVE switches come before the filenames, and apply to all
++ of them:
++
++ msend /print /text *.log oofa.txt /etc/motd
++
++ If you type any of these commands (SEND, CSEND, MSEND, etc) followed
++ by a question mark (?), you will see a list of the switches you can
++ use. If you want to see a list of filenames, you'll need to type
++ something like "send ./?" (UNIX, OS/2, Windows, etc), or "send []?"
++ (VMS), etc. Of course, you can also type pieces of a filename
++ (anything that does not start with "/") and then "?" to get a list of
++ filenames that start that way; e.g. "send x.?" still works as before.
++
++ In UNIX, where "/" is also the directory separator, there is usually
++ no ambiguity between a fully-specified pathname and a switch, except
++ when a file in the root directory has the same name as a switch (as
++ noted in [489]Section 1.5):
++
++ send /etc/motd ; Works as expected
++ send /command ; ???
++
++ The second example interprets "/command" as a switch, not a filename.
++ To send a file actually called "command" in the root directory, use:
++
++ send {/command}
++
++ or other system-dependent forms such as //command, /./command,
++ c:/command, etc, or cd to / and then "send command".
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.7.2. GET Command Switches
++
++ Without switches, the GET command still works about the same as
++ before:
++
++ get oofa.txt ; GET a single file
++ get oofa.* ; GET multiple files
++
++ However, the mechanism for including an "as-name" has changed.
++ Previously, in order to include an as-name, you were required to use
++ the "multiline" form of GET:
++
++ get
++ remote-filespec
++ local-name
++
++ This was because the remote filespec might contain spaces, and so
++ there would be no good way of telling where it ended and where the
++ local name began, e.g:
++
++ get profile exec a foo
++
++ But now since we can use {braces} for grouping, we don't need the
++ multiline GET form any more, and in fact, support for it has been
++ removed. If you give a GET command by itself on a line, it fails and
++ an error message is printed. The new form is:
++
++ GET [ switches... ] remote-name [ local-name ]
++ Ask the server to send the file whose name is remote-name. If
++ the optional local-name is given, store it locally under this
++ name. If the remote-name or local-name contains spaces, they
++ must be enclosed in braces:
++
++ get {profile exec a} foo
++ get oofa.txt {~/My Files/Oofa text}
++
++ If you want to give a list of remote file specifications, use the MGET
++ command:
++
++ MGET [ switches... ] remote-name [ remote-name [ remote-name ... ] ]
++ Ask the server to send the files whose names are given.
++
++ Now you can also include modifier switches between GET or MGET and the
++ remote-name; most of the same switches as SEND:
++
++ /AS-NAME:text
++ Specifies "text" as the name to store the incoming file under.
++ (This switch is not available for MGET.) You can also still
++ specify the as-name as the second filename on the GET command
++ line. The following two commands are equivalent:
++
++ get oofa.txt oofa.new
++ get /as:oofa.new oofa.txt
++
++ /BINARY
++ Tells the server to send the given file(s) in binary mode
++ without affecting the global transfer mode. Example:
++
++ set file type text ; Set global transfer mode to text
++ get /binary oofa.zip ; get a file in binary mode
++ get oofa.txt ; This one is transferred in text mode
++
++ Or, perhaps more to the point:
++
++ get /binary foo.txt ; where "*.txt" is a text-pattern
++
++ This has the expected effect only if the server is C-Kermit 7.0
++ or later or K95 1.1.19 or later.
++
++ /COMMAND
++ GET /COMMAND is equivalent to CGET ([490]Section 4.2.2) -- it
++ says to receive the file into the standard input of a command,
++ rather than saving it on disk. The /AS-NAME or the second
++ "filename" on the GET command line is interpreted as the name
++ of a command. Examples:
++
++ get /command sunday.txt {grep Sunday oofa.txt}
++ get /command /as-name:{grep Sunday oofa.txt} sunday.txt
++ get /bin /command {!gunzip -c | tar xf -} {tar cf - . | gzip -c}
++
++ /DELETE
++ Asks the Kermit server to delete the file (or each file in the
++ group) after it has been transferred successfully (but not to
++ delete it if it was not sent successfully). GET /DELETE is
++ equivalent to RETRIEVE. Example:
++
++ get /delete *.log
++
++ /EXCEPT:pattern
++ Specifies that any files whose names match the pattern, which
++ can be a regular filename, or may contain "*" and/or "?"
++ metacharacters, are to be refused upon arrival. To specify
++ multiple patterns (up to 8), use outer braces around the group,
++ and inner braces around each pattern:
++
++ /EXCEPT:{{pattern1}{pattern2}...}
++
++ See the description of SEND /EXCEPT in [491]Section 4.7.1 for
++ examples, etc. Refusal is accomplished using the Attribute
++ Rejection mechanism (reason "name"), which works only when
++ Attribute packets have been successfully negotiated.
++
++ /FILENAMES:{CONVERTED,LITERAL}
++ Use this switch to override the current global SET FILE NAMES
++ setting for this transfer only.
++
++ /FILTER:command
++ This specifies a filter to pass the incoming file through
++ before writing to disk. See the [492]section on file-transfer
++ pipes and filters. The /FILTER switch applies only to the
++ file-transfer command it is given with; it does not affect the
++ global RECEIVE FILTER setting, if any.
++
++ /IMAGE
++ VMS: Transfer in image mode. Non-VMS: same as /BINARY.
++
++ /LABELED
++ VMS and OS/2 only: Specifies labeled transfer mode.
++
++ /MOVE-TO:directory
++ This tells C-Kermit to move each file that is successfully
++ received to the given directory. Files that are not
++ successfully received are not moved. By default, files are not
++ moved.
++
++ /PATHNAMES:{OFF,ABSOLUTE,RELATIVE,AUTO}
++ Use this switch to override the current global SET RECEIVE
++ PATHNAMES setting for this transfer only. /PATHNAMES:ABSOLUTE
++ or RELATIVE also sets /FILENAMES:LITERAL (also for this
++ transfer only) since incoming pathnames would not be treated as
++ pathnames otherwise. See [493]Section 4.10.
++
++ /QUIET
++ When sending in local mode, this suppresses the file-transfer
++ display.
++
++ /RECOVER
++ Used to recover from a previously interrupted transfer; GET
++ /RECOVER is equivalent to REGET. Recovery only works in binary
++ mode; SEND /RECOVER and RESEND include an implied /BINARY
++ switch. Even then, recovery will successful only if (a) the
++ original (interrupted) transfer was also in binary mode, or (b)
++ if it was in text mode, the two Kermit programs run on
++ platforms where text-mode transfers are not length-changing.
++
++ /RECURSIVE
++ Tells the server that the GET file specification applies
++ recursively. This switch also automatically sets
++ /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE in both the server AND the client. When
++ used in conjunction with /DELETE, this "moves" a directory tree
++ from the server's computer to the client's computer (except
++ that only regular files are deleted from the server's computer,
++ not directories; thus the original directories will be left,
++ but will contain no files). Note that all servers that support
++ /RECURSIVE do not necessarily do so in combination with other
++ switches, such as /RECOVER. (Servers that do include C-Kermit
++ 7.0 and later, K95 1.1.19 and later.)
++
++ /RENAME-TO:string
++ This tells C-Kermit to rename each file that is successfully
++ received to the given string. Files that are not successfully
++ received are not renamed. By default, files are not renamed.
++ The string can be a literal string, which is appropriate when
++ only one file is being received, or it can contain one or more
++ variables that are to be evaluated at the time each file is
++ received, such as \v(filename), \v(filenumber), \v(ntime),
++ \v(pid), \v(user), etc. WARNING: if you give a literal string
++ and more than one file arrives, each incoming file will be
++ given the same name (but SET FILE COLLISION BACKUP or RENAME
++ can be used to keep the incoming files from overwriting each
++ other).
++
++ /TEXT
++ Tells the server to perform this transfer in text mode without
++ affecting its global transfer mode. See /BINARY for additional
++ info.
++
++ The /MAIL and /PRINT options are not available (as they are for SEND),
++ but you can use /COMMAND to achieve the same effect, as in these UNIX
++ examples:
++
++ get /command oofa.txt {mail kermit@columbia.edu}
++ get /command oofa.txt lpr
++
++ In OS/2 or Windows, you can GET and print like this:
++
++ get oofa.txt prn
++
++ The CGET, REGET, RETRIEVE commands also accept the same switches as
++ GET. CGET automatically sets /COMMAND; REGET automatically sets
++ /RECOVER and /BINARY, and RETRIEVE automatically sets /DELETE.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.7.3. RECEIVE Command Switches
++
++ Without switches, the RECEIVE command still works as before:
++
++ receive ; Receives files under their own names
++ receive /tmp ; Ditto, but into the /tmp directory
++ r ; Same as "receive"
++ receive foo.txt ; Receives a file and renames to foo.txt
++
++ Now you can also include modifier switches may be included between
++ "receive" and the as-name; most of the same switches as GET:
++
++ /AS-NAME:text
++ Specifies "text" as the name to store the incoming file under.
++ You can also still specify the as-name as a filename on the
++ command line. The following two commands are equivalent:
++
++ r oofa.new
++ r /as:oofa.new
++
++ /BINARY
++ Performs this transfer in binary mode without affecting the
++ global transfer mode. NOTE: This does not override the incoming
++ filetype (as it does with GET), so this switch is useful only
++ if ATTRIBUTE TYPE is OFF, or if the other Kermit does not send
++ a TYPE (text or binary) attribute. In any case, it has no
++ affect whatsoever on the file sender.
++
++ /COMMAND
++ RECEIVE /COMMAND is equivalent to CRECEIVE ([494]Section 4.2.2)
++ -- it says to receive the file into the standard input of a
++ command, rather than saving it on disk. The /AS-NAME or the
++ "filename" on the RECEIVE command line is interpreted as the
++ name of a command.
++
++ r /command {grep Sunday oofa.txt}
++ r /command /as-name:{grep Sunday oofa.txt}
++ r /bin /command {tar cf - . | gzip -c}
++
++ /EXCEPT:pattern
++ Specifies that any files whose names match the pattern, which
++ can be a regular filename, or may contain "*" and/or "?"
++ metacharacters, are to be refused upon arrival. To specify
++ multiple patterns (up to 8), use outer braces around the group,
++ and inner braces around each pattern:
++
++ /EXCEPT:{{pattern1}{pattern2}...}
++
++ See the description of SEND /EXCEPT in [495]Section 4.7.1 for
++ examples, etc. Refusal is accomplished using the Attribute
++ Rejection mechanism (reason "name"), which works only when
++ Attribute packets have been successfully negotiated.
++
++ /FILENAMES:{CONVERTED,LITERAL}
++ Use this switch to override the current global SET FILE NAMES
++ setting for this transfer only.
++
++ /FILTER:command
++ This specifies a filter to pass the incoming file through
++ before writing to disk. See the [496]section on file-transfer
++ pipes and filters. The /FILTER switch applies only to the
++ file-transfer command it is given with; it does not affect the
++ global RECEIVE FILTER setting, if any.
++
++ /IMAGE
++ VMS: Transfer in image mode. Non-VMS: same as /BINARY. See
++ comments under RECEIVE /BINARY.
++
++ /LABELED
++ VMS and OS/2 only: Specifies labeled transfer mode. See
++ comments under RECEIVE /BINARY.
++
++ /MOVE-TO:directory
++ This tells C-Kermit to move each file that is successfully
++ received to the given directory. Files that are not
++ successfully received are not moved. By default, files are not
++ moved.
++
++ /PATHNAMES:{ABSOLUTE,RELATIVE,OFF,AUTO}
++ Use this switch to override the current global SET RECEIVE
++ PATHNAMES setting for this transfer only. See [497]Section
++ 4.10.
++
++ /RECURSIVE
++ When used with the RECEIVE command, /RECURSIVE is simply a
++ synonym for /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE.
++
++ /RENAME-TO:string
++ This tells C-Kermit to rename each file that is successfully
++ received to the given string. Files that are not successfully
++ received are not renamed. By default, files are not renamed.
++ The string can be a literal string, which is appropriate when
++ only one file is being received, or it can contain one or more
++ variables that are to be evaluated at the time each file is
++ received, such as \v(filename), \v(filenumber), \v(ntime),
++ \v(pid), \v(user), etc. WARNING: if you give a literal string
++ and more than one file arrives, each incoming file will be
++ given the same name (but SET FILE COLLISION BACKUP or RENAME
++ can be used to keep the incoming files from overwriting each
++ other).
++
++ /QUIET
++ When receiving in local mode, this suppresses the file-transfer
++ display.
++
++ /TEXT
++ Receives in text mode without affecting the global transfer
++ mode. See comments under RECEIVE /BINARY.
++
++ The /MAIL and /PRINT options are not available, but you can use
++ /COMMAND to achieve the same effect, as in these UNIX examples:
++
++ r /command {mail kermit@columbia.edu}
++ r /command lpr
++
++ In OS/2 or Windows, you can RECEIVE and print like this:
++
++ receive prn
++
++ The CRECEIVE command now also accepts the same switches.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.8. Minor Kermit Protocol Improvements
++
++ 4.8.1. Multiple Attribute Packets
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 now sends more than one Attribute packet if a file's
++ attributes do not fit into a single packet of the negotiated length.
++ If a particular attribute (such as file creation date-time) does not
++ fit within the negotiated length (which will only happen when the
++ negotiated length is around 20 or less), that attribute is not sent at
++ all.
++
++ 4.8.2. Very Short Packets
++
++ There are certain situations where extremely short packets must be
++ used; 20 or 30 bytes at most. This can happen when one or more devices
++ along the communication path have very small buffers and lack an
++ effective means of flow control. Examples are sometimes cited
++ involving radio modems.
++
++ When the maximum packet length is shorter than certain packets that
++ would be sent, those packets are either truncated or else broken up
++ into multiple packets. Specifically:
++
++ 1. Parameter negotiation packets (I, S, and their ACKs) are truncated
++ to the negotiated length. Any parameters that do not fit are reset
++ to their default values. There is no provision in the Kermit
++ protocol for fragmentation and reassembly of parameter strings.
++ 2. File header packets (containing the filename) are simply
++ truncated. There is no provision in the Kermit protocol for
++ fragmentation and reassembly of filenames.
++ 3. Attribute packets are fragmented and reassembled as described in
++ 4.8.1 without loss of data, except in case a field will not fit at
++ all in the negotiated length (the longest attribute is usually the
++ date and time of file creation/modification) because of the rule
++ that attributes may not be broken across packets.
++ 4. Data packets and other packets are unaffected -- they can be as
++ short as they need to be, within reason.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.9. Wildcard / File Group Expansion
++
++ "Wildcard" refers to the notation used in filenames to specify a group
++ of files by pattern matching.
++
++ 4.9.1. In UNIX C-Kermit
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, C-Kermit was capable of expanding wildcard
++ strings containing only the "metacharacters" '*' and '?':
++
++ *
++ Matches any sequence of zero or more characters. For example:
++ "ck*.c" matches all files whose names start with "ck" and end
++ with ".c", including "ck.c".
++
++ ?
++ Matches any single character. For example, "ck?.c" matches all
++ files whose names are exactly 5 characters long and start with
++ "ck" and end with ".c". When typing commands at the prompt, you
++ must precede any question mark to be used for matching by a
++ backslash (\) to override the normal function of question mark,
++ which is providing menus and file lists.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds the additional features that users of ksh, csh, and
++ bash are accustomed to:
++
++ [abc]
++ Square brackets enclosing a list of characters matches any
++ single character in the list. Example: ckuusr.[ch] matches
++ ckuusr.c and ckuusr.h.
++
++ [a-z]
++ Square brackets enclosing a range of characters; the hyphen
++ separates the low and high elements of the range. For example,
++ [a-z] matches any character from a to z.
++
++ [acdm-z]
++ Lists and ranges may be combined. This example matches a, c, d,
++ or m through z.
++
++ {string1,string2,...}
++ Braces enclose a list of strings to be matched. For example:
++ ck{ufio,vcon,cmai}.c matches ckufio.c, ckvcon.c, or ckcmai.c.
++ The strings may themselves contain metacharacters, bracket
++ lists, or indeed, other lists of strings, but (when matching
++ filenames) they may not contain directory separators.
++
++ Thus, the metacharacters in filenames (and in any other field
++ that can be a pattern, such as the IF MATCH pattern, SEND or
++ GET exception lists, etc) are:
++
++ * ? [ {
++
++ And within braces only, comma (,) is a metacharacter.
++
++ To include a metacharacter in a pattern literally, precede it with a
++ backslash '\' (or two if you are passing the pattern to a macro).
++ Examples:
++
++ send a*b ; Send all files whose names start with 'a' and end with 'b'.
++ send a?b ; Ditto, but the name must be exactly three characters long.
++ send a[a-z]b ; Ditto, but the second character must be a lowercase letter.
++ send a[x\-z]b ; Ditto, except the second character must be 'x', '-', or 'y'.
++ send a[ghi]b ; Ditto, except the second character must be 'g', 'h', or 'i'.
++ send a[?*]b ; Ditto, except the second character must be '?' or '*'.
++ send a[\?\*]b ; Same as previous.
++ send *?[a-z]* ; All files with names containing at least one character
++ ; that is followed by a lowercase letter.
++
++ Or, more practically:
++
++ send ck[cuw]*.[cwh] ; Send the UNIX C-Kermit source files.
++
++ To refer to the C-Kermit sources files and makefile all in one
++ filespec:
++
++ {{makefile,ck[cuw]*.[cwh]}}
++
++ (NOTE: if the entire pattern is a {stringlist}, you must enclose it it
++ TWO pairs of braces, since the SEND command strips the outer brace
++ pair, because of the "enclose in braces if the filename contains
++ spaces" rule).
++
++ If the makefile is called ckuker.mak:
++
++ ck[cuw]*.{[cwh],mak}
++
++ (NOTE: double braces are not needed here since the pattern does not
++ both begin and end with a brace.)
++
++ To add in all the C-Kermit text files:
++
++ ck[cuw]*.{[cwh],mak,txt}
++
++ All of these features can be used anywhere you would type a filename
++ that is allowed to contain wildcards.
++
++ When you are typing at the command prompt, an extra level of quoting
++ is required for the '?' character to defeat its regular function of
++ producing a list of files that match what you have typed so far, for
++ example:
++
++ send ck[cu]?
++
++ lists all the files whose names start with ckc and cku. If you quote
++ the question mark, it is used as a pattern-matching character, for
++ example:
++
++ send ck\?[ft]io.c
++
++ sends all the file and communications i/o modules for all the
++ platforms: ckufio.c, ckutio.c, ckvfio.c, ckvtio.c, etc.
++
++ If, however, a filename actually contains a question mark and you need
++ to refer to it on the command line, you must use three (3)
++ backslashes. For example, if the file is actually called ck?fio.c, you
++ would use:
++
++ send ck\\\?fio.c
++
++ Further notes on quoting:
++
++ * A single backslash is sufficient for quoting a special character
++ at the command prompt or in a command file. However, when passing
++ patterns to macros you'll need double backslashes, and when
++ referring to these patterns within the macro, you'll need to use
++ \fcontents(\%1) (see [498]Section 1.11.5). You should enclose
++ macro argument references in braces in case grouped arguments were
++ passed. Example:
++ define ismatch {
++ if match {\fcont(\%1)} {\fcont(\%2)} {
++ end 0 MATCH
++ } else {
++ end 1 NO MATCH
++ }
++ }
++ ismatch ab*yz a*\\**z ; Backslash must be doubled
++ ismatch {abc def xyz} *b*e*y* ; Braces must be used for grouping
++ * Watch out for possible conflicts between {} in filename patterns
++ and {} used for grouping multiple words into a single field, when
++ the pattern has outer braces. For example, in:
++ if match {abc xyz} {a* *z} echo THEY MATCH
++ braces must be used to group "abc xyz" into a single string.
++ Kermit strips off the braces before comparing the string with the
++ pattern. Therefore:
++ if match makefile {makefile,Makefile} echo THEY MATCH
++ does not work, but:
++ if match makefile {{makefile,Makefile}} echo THEY MATCH
++ does.
++ * If you use a pattern that has outer braces, like {*.txt,*.doc}, in
++ a field that accepts a pattern list (like SEND /EXCEPT:xxx),
++ you'll need to add two extra sets of outer braces:
++ send /except:{{{*.txt,*.doc}}} *.*
++
++ C-Kermit's new pattern matching capabilities are also used when
++ C-Kermit is in server mode, so now you can send requests such as:
++
++ get ck[cuw]*.[cwh]
++
++ to a C-Kermit server without having to tell it to SET WILD SHELL
++ first. Previously this would have required:
++
++ mget ckc*.c ckc*.w ckc*.h cku*.c cku*.w cku*.h ckw*.c ckw*.w ckw*.h
++
++ The new pattern matching features make SET WILD SHELL redundant, and
++ barring any objections, it will eventually be phased out. (One
++ possible reason for retaining it would be as an escape mechanism when
++ Kermit does not understand the underlying file system.)
++
++ By the way, patterns such as these are sometimes referred to as
++ "regular expressions", but they are not quite the same. In a true
++ regular expression (for example), "*" means "zero or more repetitions
++ of the previous item", so (for example), "([0-9]*)" would match zero
++ or more digits in parentheses. In Kermit (and in most shells), this
++ matches one digit followed by zero or more characters, within
++ parentheses. Here are some hints:
++
++ * Although you can't match any sequence of digits (or letters, etc),
++ you can match (say) 1, 2, or 3 of them in row. For example, the
++ following pattern matches Kermit backup files (with backup numbers
++ from 1 to 999):
++ *.~{[1-9],[1-9][0-9],[1-9][0-9][0-9]}~
++ * There is presently no NOT operator, so no way to match any
++ character or string EXCEPT the one(s) shown.
++
++ In other wildcarding news...
++
++ * You may now "send xxx" where "xxx" is a directory name, and this
++ will send all the files from the directory xxx, as if you had
++ typed "send xxx/*". You can also use the special shorthand "send
++ ." to send all the files from the current directory.
++ * To easily skip over backup files (the ones whose names end like
++ .~22~) when sending, you can use SEND /NOBACKUP (see [499]Section
++ 4.0.6 for details).
++ * When choosing Kermit to expand wildcards, rather than the shell,
++ you can choose whether "dot files" -- files whose names begin with
++ ".", which are normally "invisible" -- should be matched:
++ SET WILD KERMIT /NO-MATCH-DOT-FILES (this is the default)
++ SET WILD KERMIT /MATCH-DOT-FILES (this allows matching of "." files)
++ or include the /DOTFILES or /NODOTFILES switch on the command you
++ are using, such as SEND or DIRECTORY.
++ * Commands such as DIRECTORY and SEND allow recursive directory
++ traversal. There are also new functions for this to use in
++ scripts. See [500]Section 4.11 for details.
++
++ When building file lists in UNIX, C-Kermit follows symbolic links.
++ Because of this, you might encounter any or all of the following
++ phenomena:
++
++ * Multiple copies of the same file; e.g. one from its real directory
++ and others from links to its real directory, if both the real
++ directory and the links to it are in the wildcard expansion list.
++ * A command might unexpectedly "hang" for a long time because an NFS
++ link might not be responding, or the directory you are looking at
++ contains a link to a huge directory tree (example: "directory
++ /recursive /etc" when /etc/spool is a symlink to /var/spool, which
++ is a large organization's incoming email directory, containing
++ tens of thousands of subdirectories).
++
++ The size of the file list that Kermit can build is limited in most
++ C-Kermit implementations. The limit, if any, depends on the
++ implementation. Use the SHOW FEATURES command and look in the
++ alphabetized options list for MAXWLD to see the value.
++
++ 4.9.2. In Kermit 95
++
++ Kermit 95 1.1.19 and later uses the same pattern matching syntax as in
++ UNIX, but (as always) you will encounter numerous difficulties if you
++ use backslash (\) as the directory separator. In any command where K95
++ parses filenames itself (that is, practically any file-oriented
++ command except RUN), you can use forward slash (/) as the directory
++ separator to avoid all the nasty conflicts.
++
++ 4.9.3. In VMS, AOS/VS, OS-9, VOS, etc.
++
++ Platforms other than UNIX, Windows 95/98/NT, and OS/2 have their own
++ filename matching capabilities that are, in general, different from
++ Kermit's built-in ones and in any case might conflict with them. For
++ example, [] encloses directory names in VMS.
++
++ Nevertheless you can still use all the pattern-matching capabilities
++ described in [501]Section 4.9.1 by loading a file list into an array
++ (e.g. with \ffiles(*,&a), see [502]Section 4.11.3) and then using IF
++ MATCH on the members.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.10. Additional Pathname Controls
++
++ In version 6.0 and earlier, C-Kermit's SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES
++ command had only ON and OFF as options. In version 7.0, there are more
++ choices:
++
++ SET SEND PATHNAMES OFF
++ When sending a file, strip all disk/directory information from
++ the name. Example: "send /usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" sends the
++ file as "oofa.txt". This applies to actual filenames, not to
++ any as-name you might specify.
++
++ SET SEND PATHNAMES RELATIVE
++ When sending a file, leave the pathname on as given. For
++ example, if your current directory is /usr/olga, "send
++ letters/oofa.txt" sends the file as "letters/oofa.txt", not
++ "/usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" or "letters.txt".
++
++ SET SEND PATHNAMES ABSOLUTE
++ When sending a file, convert its name to the full, absolute
++ local pathname. For example, if your current directory is
++ /usr/olga, "send letters/oofa.txt" sends the file as
++ "/usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt". NOTE: Even with this setting,
++ device and/or node names are not included. For example, in VMS,
++ any node or device name is stripped; in Windows or OS/2, any
++ disk letter is stripped.
++
++ SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES OFF
++ When receiving a file, strip all disk/directory information
++ from the name before attempting to store it. This applies to
++ incoming filename, not to any as-name you might specify.
++ Example: If a file arrives under the name
++ "/usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" it is stored simply as "oofa.txt"
++ in your download directory or, if no download directory has
++ been specified, in your current directory.
++
++ SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES RELATIVE
++ When receiving a file, leave the pathname on as it appears in
++ the incoming name, but if the incoming name appears to be
++ absolute, make it relative to your current or download
++ directory. Examples:
++
++ + "oofa.txt" is stored as "oofa.txt".
++ + "letters/oofa.txt" is stored as "letters/oofa.txt"; the
++ "letters" subdirectory is created if it does not already
++ exist.
++ + "/usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" is stored as
++ "usr/olga/letters/oofa.txt" in your current or download
++ directory, and the "usr", "usr/olga", etc, directories are
++ created if they do not exist.
++
++ SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES ABSOLUTE
++ The incoming filename is used as given. Thus it cannot be
++ stored unless the given path (if any) already exists or can be
++ created. In this case, node, device, or disk designations are
++ NOT stripped, since they most likely were given explicitly by
++ the user as an as-name, meant to be used as given.
++
++ SET RECEIVE PATHNAMES AUTO
++ This is the default, and means RELATIVE if the sender tells me
++ it is a recursive transfer, OFF otherwise.
++
++ Set FILE NAMES CONVERTED now also affects pathnames too. When
++ PATHNAMES are RELATIVE or ABSOLUTE and FILE NAMES are CONVERTED, the
++ file sender converts its native directory-name format to UNIX format,
++ and the file receiver converts from UNIX format to its native one;
++ thus UNIX format is the common intermediate representation for
++ directory hierarchies, as it is in the ZIP/UNZIP programs (which is
++ why ZIP archives are transportable among, UNIX, DOS, and VMS).
++
++ Here's an example in which a file is sent from Windows to UNIX with
++ relative pathnames and FILE NAMES CONVERTED:
++
++ Source name Intermediate name Destination Name
++ C:\K95\TMP\OOFA.TXT K95/TMP/OOFA.TXT k95/tmp/oofa.txt
++
++ In a more complicated example, we send the same file from Windows to
++ VMS:
++
++ Source name Intermediate name Destination Name
++ C:\K95\TMP\OOFA.TXT K95/TMP/OOFA.TXT [.K95.TMP]OOFA.TXT
++
++ (Note that disk letters and device designations are always stripped
++ when pathnames are relative).
++
++ As you can imagine, as more and more directory formats are considered,
++ this approach keeps matters simple: on each platform, Kermit must know
++ only its own local format and the common intermediate one. In most
++ cases, the receiver can detect which format is used automatically.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.11. Recursive SEND and GET: Transferring Directory Trees
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 in selected versions (UNIX, VMS, VOS, AOS/VS, Windows,
++ and OS/2 at this writing) now permits the SEND command to traverse
++ directories "recursively" if you ask it to; that is, to send files
++ from the current or specified directory and all of its subdirectories
++ too, and their subdirectories, etc. (Some other commands can do this
++ too, including DIRECTORY.)
++
++ This feature is new to UNIX, Windows, VOS, and OS/2. VMS and AOS/VS
++ have always included "wildcard" or "template" characters that allow
++ this, and in this case, recursive directory traversal could happen
++ behind Kermit's back, i.e. Kermit does not have to do it itself (in
++ VMS, the notation is "[...]" or "[directory...]"; in AOS/VS is "#").
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, however, SEND /RECURSIVE is supported by C-Kermit
++ itself for VMS.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.11.1. Command-Line Options
++
++ To descend a directory tree when sending files, use the -L
++ command-line option to indicate that the send operation is to be
++ recursive, and include a name or pattern to be sent. When giving a
++ pattern, you should enclose it in quotes to prevent the shell from
++ expanding it. Examples:
++
++ $ kermit -Ls "/usr/olga/*" # send all of Olga's files in all her directories
++ $ kermit -Ls foo.txt # send all foo.txt files in this directory tree
++ $ kermit -Ls "*.txt" # send all .txt files in this directory tree
++ $ kermit -Ls "letters/*" # send all files in the letters directory tree
++ $ kermit -Ls letters # send all files in the letters directory tree
++ $ kermit -Ls "*" # send all files in this directory tree
++ $ kermit -Ls . # UNIX only: send all files in this directory tree
++ $ kermit -s . # UNIX only: a filename of . implies -L
++
++ If you let the shell expand wildcards, Kermit only sends files whose
++ names match files in the current or given directory, because the shell
++ replaces an unquoted wildcard expression with the list of matching
++ files -- and the shell does not build recursive lists. Note that the
++ "." notation for the tree rooted at the current directory is allowed
++ only in UNIX, since in Windows and OS/2, it means "*.*"
++ (nonrecursive).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.11.2. The SEND /RECURSIVE Command
++
++ If you include the /RECURSIVE switch in a SEND (or MOVE, or similar)
++ command, it means to descend the current or specified directory tree
++ searching for files whose names match the given name or pattern. Since
++ this is not terribly useful unless you also include pathnames with the
++ outbound files, the /RECURSIVE switch also includes an implicit
++ /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE switch (which you can undo by including an
++ explicit /PATHNAMES switch after the /RECURSIVE switch).
++
++ Examples:
++
++ SEND /RECURSIVE *
++ Sends all of the files in the current directory and all the
++ files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their
++ subdirectories, etc, including their relative pathnames. Empty
++ directories are not sent.
++
++ SEND /RECURSIVE /PATHNAMES:ABSOLUTE *
++ Sends all of the files in the current directory and all the
++ files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their
++ subdirectories, etc, including their absolute pathnames.
++
++ SEND /RECURSIVE /PATHNAMES:OFF *
++ Sends all of the files in the current directory and all the
++ files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their
++ subdirectories, etc, without pathnames.
++
++ SEND /RECURSIVE /usr/olga/*
++ Sends all of the files in the /usr/olga directory and all the
++ files in all of its subdirectories, and all of their
++ subdirectories, etc.
++
++ SEND /RECURSIVE /usr/olga (or /usr/olga/)
++ Same as above. If the name is a directory name (with or without
++ a trailing slash), its files are sent, and those of its
++ subdirectories, and their subdirectories, etc (see [503]Section
++ 4.9).
++
++ SEND /RECURSIVE /TEXT /usr/olga/*.txt
++ As above, but only files whose names end with ".txt" are sent,
++ and they are sent in text mode (as they would be by default
++ anyway if SET FILE PATTERNS is ON or AUTO).
++
++ SEND .
++ UNIX only: Send all the files in the current directory.
++
++ SEND /RECURSIVE .
++ UNIX only: Sends all of the files in the current directory and
++ all of its subdirectories, etc ([504]Section 4.9).
++
++ The /RECURSIVE switch is different from most other switches in that
++ its effect is immediate (but still local to the command in which it is
++ given), because it determines how filenames are to be parsed. For
++ example, "send *.txt" fails with a parse error ("No files match") if
++ there are no *.txt files in the current directory, but "send
++ /recursive *.txt" succeeds if there are ".txt" files anywhere in the
++ tree rooted at the current directory.
++
++ The /RECURSIVE switch also affects the file lists displayed if you
++ type "?" in a filename field. "send ./?" lists the regular files in
++ the current directory, but "send /recursive ./?" lists the entire
++ directory tree rooted at the current directory.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.11.3. The GET /RECURSIVE Command
++
++ In a client/server setting, the client can also request a recursive
++ transfer with:
++
++ GET /RECURSIVE [ other switches ] remote-filespec [ local-spec ]
++
++ In which remote file specification can be a directory name, a
++ filename, a wildcard, or any combination. If the local-spec is not
++ given (and PATHNAMES are RELATIVE), incoming files and directories go
++ into the current local directory. If local-spec is given and is a
++ directory, it becomes the root of the tree into which the incoming
++ files and directories are placed. If local-spec has the syntax of a
++ directory name (e.g. in UNIX it ends with /), C-Kermit creates the
++ directory and then places the incoming files into it. If local-spec is
++ a filename (not recommended), then all incoming files are stored with
++ that name with collisions handled according to the FILE COLLISION
++ setting.
++
++ Again, the normal method for transferring directory trees uses
++ relative pathnames, and this is the default when the sender has been
++ given the /RECURSIVE switch. The action at the receiver depends on its
++ RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting. The default is AUTO, meaning that if the
++ sender tells it to expect a recursive transfer, then it should
++ automatically switch to relative pathnames for this transfer only;
++ otherwise it obeys the RECEIVE PATHNAMES setting of OFF, ABSOLUTE, or
++ RELATIVE.
++
++ What happens if a file arrives that has an absolute pathname, when the
++ receiver has been told to use only relative pathnames? As a security
++ precaution, in this case the receiver treats the name as if it was
++ relative. For example, if a file arrives as:
++
++ /usr/olga/oofa.txt
++
++ The receiver creates a "usr" subdirectory in its current directory,
++ and then an "olga" subdirectory under the "usr" subdirectory in which
++ to store the incoming file.
++
++ Suppose, however there is a sequence of directories:
++
++ /usr/olga/a/b/c/d/
++
++ in which "a" contains nothing but a subdirectory "b", which in turn
++ contains nothing but a subdirectory "c", which in turn contains
++ nothing but a subdirectory "d", which contains nothing at all. Thus
++ there are no files in the "/usr/olga/a/" tree, and so it is not sent,
++ and therefore it is not reproduced on the target computer.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.11.4. New and Changed File Functions
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds the following functions:
++
++ \ffiles(pattern[,&a])
++ This function has been changed to match only regular files in
++ the current or given directory, and to take an optional array
++ name as a second argument (explained below).
++
++ \fdirectories(pattern[,&a])
++ Returns the number of directories that match the given pattern.
++ If the pattern does not include a directory, then the search is
++ performed in the current directory.
++
++ \frfiles(pattern[,&a])
++ Returns the number of files in the current or given directory
++ and all of its subdirectories, and their subdirectories, etc,
++ that match the given pattern. Warning -- this one can take
++ quite some time if performed at the root of a large directory
++ tree.
++
++ \frdirectories(pattern[,&a])
++ Returns the number of directories in the current or given
++ directory and all of its subdirectories, and their
++ subdirectories, etc, that match the given pattern.
++
++ Each of these functions builds up a list of files to be returned by
++ the \fnextfile() function, just as \ffiles() always has done. (This
++ can also be done with the /ARRAY switch of the DIRECTORY command; see
++ [505]Sections 4.5.1 and [506]7.10).
++
++ Each of these functions can be given an array name as an optional
++ second argument. If an array name is supplied, the array will contain
++ the number of files as its 0th element, and the filenames in elements
++ 1 through last. If the array already existed, its previous contents
++ are lost. For example, if the current directory contains two files,
++ oofa.txt and foo.bar, then "\ffiles(*,&a)" creates an array \&a[] with
++ a dimension of 2, containing the following elements:
++
++ \&a[0] = 2
++ \&a[1] = oofa.txt
++ \&a[2] = foo.bar
++
++ If no files match the specification given in the first argument, the
++ array gets a dimension of 0, which is the same as undeclaring the
++ array.
++
++ Note that the order in which the array is filled (and in which
++ \fnextfile() returns filenames) is indeterminate (but see [507]Section
++ 7.10.5).
++
++ Here's an example that builds and prints a list of all the file whose
++ names end in .txt in the current directory and all its descendents:
++
++ asg \%n \frfiles(*.txt)
++ declare \&a[\%n]
++ for \%i 1 \%n 1 {
++ asg \&a[\%i] \fnextfile()
++ echo \flpad(\%i,4). "\&a[\%i]"
++ }
++
++ Alternatively, using the array method, and then printing the filenames
++ in alphabetic order (see [508]Section 7.10.3 and [509]7.10.5):
++
++ asg \%n \frfiles(*.txt,&a)
++ sort &a
++ for \%i 1 \%n 1 {
++ echo \flpad(\%i,4). "\&a[\%i]"
++ }
++
++ Or even more simply:
++
++ asg \%n \frfiles(*.txt,&a)
++ sort &a
++ show array &a
++
++ As noted elsewhere, the file lists built by \ffiles(), \frfiles(),
++ etc, are now "safe" in the sense that SEND and other file-related
++ commands can reference \fnextfile() without resetting the list:
++
++ set send pathnames relative
++ for \%i 1 \frfiles(*.txt) 1 {
++ asg \%a \fnextfile()
++ echo Sending \%a...
++ send \%a
++ if fail break
++ }
++
++ Copying to an array (as shown on p.398 of [510]Using C-Kermit 2nd Ed)
++ is no longer necessary.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.11.5. Moving Directory Trees Between Like Systems
++
++ 4.11.5.1. UNIX to UNIX
++
++ Transferring a directory tree from one computer to another replicates
++ the file sender's arrangement of files and directories on the file
++ receiver's computer. Normally this is done using relative pathnames,
++ since the user IDs might not be identical on the two computers. Let's
++ say both computers are UNIX based, running C-Kermit 7.0 or later. On
++ the sending computer (leaving out the connection details, etc):
++
++ C-Kermit> cd /usr/olga
++ C-Kermit> send /recursive .
++
++ The /RECURSIVE switch tells C-Kermit to descend through the directory
++ tree and to include relative pathnames on outbound filenames.
++
++ On the receiving computer:
++
++ C-Kermit> mkdir olgas-files ; Make a new directory.
++ C-Kermit> cd olgas-files ; CD to it.
++ C-Kermit> receive /recursive ; = /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE
++
++ Each Kermit program recognizes that the other is running under UNIX
++ and switches to binary mode and literal filenames automatically.
++ Directories are automatically created on the receiving system as
++ needed. File dates and permissions are automatically reproduced from
++ source to destination.
++
++ 4.11.5.2. VMS to VMS
++
++ To send recursively from VMS, simply include the /RECURSIVE switch,
++ for example at the sender:
++
++ $ kermit
++ C-Kermit> cd [olga]
++ C-Kermit> send /recursive *.*;0
++
++ And at the receiver:
++
++ C-Kermit> cd [.olga]
++ C-Kermit> receive /recursive
++
++ The notation "..." within directory brackets in VMS means "this
++ directory and all directories below it"; the /RECURSIVE switch, when
++ given to the sender, implies the use of "..." in the file
++ specification so you don't have to include "..."; but it makes no
++ difference if you do:
++
++ $ kermit
++ C-Kermit> send /recursive [olga...]*.*;0
++
++ And at the receiver:
++
++ C-Kermit> cd [.olga]
++ C-Kermit> receive /recursive
++
++ In either case, since both systems recognize each other as VMS, they
++ switch into LABELED transfer mode automatically.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.11.6. Moving Directory Trees Between Unlike Systems
++
++ There are several difficulties with recursive transfers between unlike
++ systems:
++
++ * File formats can be different, especially text files character
++ sets and record formats. This can now be handled by using SET FILE
++ PATTERN, SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS, and SET FILE BINARY-PATTERNS
++ ([511]Section 4.3).
++ * File naming conventions are different. For example, one system
++ might allow (and use) longer filenames than the other. You can
++ tell Kermit how to handle file names with the normal "set file
++ names" and "set file collision" mechanisms. Most modern Kermits
++ are fairly tolerant of illegal filenames and should not fail
++ simply because of an incoming filename; rather, it will do its
++ best to convert it to a recognizable and unique legal filename.
++ * Directory notations can be different, e.g. backslashes instead of
++ slashes, brackets, parentheses, spaces, etc. But this is now
++ handled by converting pathnames to a standard format during
++ transfer ([512]Section 4.10).
++
++ So now, for the first time, it is possible to send directory trees
++ among any combination of UNIX, DOS, Windows, OS/2, VMS, AOS/VS, etc.
++ Here's an example sending files from an HP-UX system (where text files
++ are encoded in the HP Roman8 character set) to a PC with K95 (where
++ text files are encoded in CP850):
++
++ Sender:
++ cd xxx ; CD to root of source tree
++ set file type binary ; Default transfer mode
++ set file character-set hp-roman8 ; Local character set for text files
++ set xfer character-set latin1 ; Transfer character set
++ set file patterns on ; Enable automatic file-type switching...
++ set file binary-patterns *.Z *.gz *.o ; based on these patterns...
++ set file text-patterns *.txt *.c *.h ; for binary and text files.
++ send /recursive * ; Send all the file in this directory tree
++
++ Receiver:
++ cd yyy ; CD to root of destination tree
++ set file character-set cp850 ; Local character set for text files
++ receive /pathnames:relative ; Receive with pathnames
++
++ Notes:
++ * Replace "xxx" and "yyy" with the desired directories.
++ * Replace the file character sets appropriately.
++ * Change the patterns as needed (or just use the built-in default
++ lists).
++ * SEND /RECURSIVE also implies /PATHNAMES:RELATIVE.
++ * The file sender tells the file receiver the transfer mode of each
++ file.
++ * The file sender tells the file receiver the transfer character
++ set.
++ * By default, destination file dates will be the same as on the
++ source.
++ * Many of the settings shown might already be set by default.
++ * See [513]Sections 4.3, [514]4.10, and [515]4.15 for additional
++ explanation.
++
++ If you are refreshing an existing directory on the destination
++ computer, use "set file collision update" or other appropriate file
++ collision option to handle filename collisions.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.12. Where Did My File Go?
++
++ Now that Kermit can be started by clicking on desktop icons (thus
++ obscuring the concept of "current directory"), and can have a download
++ directory, and can create directories for incoming files on the fly,
++ etc, sometimes it is easy to lose a file after transfer. Of course, if
++ you keep a transaction log:
++
++ LOG TRANSACTIONS
++
++ it will record the fate and final resting place of each file. But in
++ case you did not keep a log, the new command:
++
++ WHERE
++
++ added in C-Kermit 7.0, gives you as much information as it has about
++ the location of the last files transferred, including the pathname
++ reported by the receiving Kermit, if any, when C-Kermit is the sender.
++ This information was also added to SHOW FILE in somewhat less detail.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.13. File Output Buffer Control
++
++ (UNIX only). The new command SET FILE OUTPUT lets you control how
++ incoming files are written to disk:
++
++ SET FILE OUTPUT BUFFERED [ size ]
++ Chooses buffered file output; this is the default. UNIX does
++ its normal sort of disk buffering. The optional size specifies
++ Kermit's own file output buffer size, and therefore the
++ frequency of disk accesses (write() system calls) -- the bigger
++ the size, the fewer the disk accesses.
++
++ SET FILE OUTPUT UNBUFFERED [ size ]
++ This forces each file output write() call to actually commit
++ the data to disk immediately. Choosing this option will usually
++ slow file reception down.
++
++ SET FILE OUTPUT BLOCKING
++ Write() calls should not return until they are complete. This
++ is the normal setting, and it lets Kermit detect disk-write
++ errors immediately.
++
++ SET FILE OUTPUT NONBLOCKING
++ Write() calls should return immediately. This can speed up file
++ reception, but also delay the detection of disk-write errors.
++
++ Experimentation with these parameters should be harmless, and might
++ (or might not) have a perceptible, even dramatic, effect on
++ performance.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.14. Improved Responsiveness
++
++ In version 7.0, C-Kermit's file-transfer protocol engine has been
++ tuned for additional speed and responsiveness.
++
++ * Binary-mode transfers over 8-bit connections, a very common case,
++ are now handled in a special way that minimizes overhead.
++ * SET TRANSFER CRC-CALCULATION is now OFF by default, rather than
++ ON. (This affects only the overall per-transfer CRC, \v(crc16),
++ not the per-packet CRCs)
++ * Connection loss during file transfer is now detected immediately
++ in most cases on Internet connections and on serial connections
++ when CARRIER-WATCH is not set to OFF.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.15. Doubling and Ignoring Characters for Transparency
++
++ The following commands were added in 7.0, primarily to allow
++ successful file transfer through ARPAnet TACs and with Honeywell DPS6
++ systems, but can be used in any setting where they might be needed:
++
++ SET SEND DOUBLE-CHAR { [ char [ char [ ... ] ] ], NONE }
++ Tells C-Kermit to double the specified characters (use decimal
++ notation) in packets that it sends. For example, if you are
++ sending files through a device that uses @ as an escape
++ character, but allows you to send a single copy of @ through by
++ doubling it, use "set send double 64".
++
++ SET RECEIVE IGNORE-CHAR [ char [ char [ ... ] ] ]
++ Tells C-Kermit to ignore the specified character(s) in incoming
++ packets. Use this, for example, when something between the
++ sender and receiver is inserting linefeeds for wrapping, NULs
++ for padding, etc.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.16. New File-Transfer Display Formats
++
++ SET TRANSFER DISPLAY { BRIEF, CRT, FULLSCREEN, NONE, SERIAL }
++ Selects the file-transfer display format.
++
++ BRIEF is the new one. This writes one line to the screen per file,
++ showing the file's name, transfer mode, size, the status of the
++ transfer, and when the transfer is successful, the effective data rate
++ in characters per second (CPS). Example:
++
++ SEND ckcfn3.o (binary) (59216 bytes): OK (0.104 sec, 570206 cps)
++ SEND ckcfns.o (binary) (114436 bytes): OK (0.148 sec, 772006 cps)
++ SEND ckcmai.c (text) (79147 bytes): OK (0.180 sec, 438543 cps)
++ SEND ckcmai.o (binary) (35396 bytes): OK (0.060 sec, 587494 cps)
++ SEND ckcnet.o (binary) (62772 bytes): REFUSED
++ SEND ckcpro.o (binary) (121448 bytes): OK (0.173 sec, 703928 cps)
++ SEND ckcpro.w (text) (63687 bytes): OK (0.141 sec, 453059 cps)
++ SEND makefile (text) (186636 bytes): OK (0.444 sec, 420471 cps)
++ SEND wermit (binary) (1064960 bytes): OK (2.207 sec, 482477 cps)
++
++ Note that transfer times are now obtained in fractional seconds,
++ rather than whole seconds, so the CPS figures are more accurate (the
++ display shows 3 decimal places, but internally the figure is generally
++ precise to the microsecond).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.17. New Transaction Log Formats
++
++ The new command:
++
++ SET TRANSACTION-LOG { VERBOSE, FTP, BRIEF [ separator ] }
++
++ lets you choose the format of the transaction log. VERBOSE (the
++ default) indicates the traditional format described in the book. BRIEF
++ and FTP are new. This command must be given prior to the LOG
++ TRANSACTION command if a non-VERBOSE type is desired.
++
++ 4.17.1. The BRIEF Format
++
++ BRIEF chooses a one-line per file format suitable for direct
++ importation into databases like Informix, Oracle, or Sybase, in which:
++
++ * Each record has 8 fields.
++ * Fields are separated by a non-alphanumeric separator character.
++ * The default separator character is comma (,).
++ * Any field containing the separator character is enclosed in
++ doublequotes.
++ * The final field is enclosed in doublequotes.
++
++ The fields are:
++
++ 1. Date in yyyymmdd format
++ 2. Time in hh:mm:ss format
++ 3. Action: SEND or RECV
++ 4. The local filename
++ 5. The size of the file
++ 6. The transfer mode (text, binary, image, labeled)
++ 7. The status of the transfer: OK or FAILED
++ 8. Additional status-dependent info, in doublequotes.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ 20000208,12:08:52,RECV,/u/olga/oofa.txt,5246,text,OK,"0.284sec 18443cps"
++ 20000208,12:09:31,SEND,/u/olga/oofa.exe,32768,binary,OK,"1.243sec 26362cps"
++ 20000208,12:10:02,SEND,"/u/olga/a,b",10130,text,FAILED,"Refused: date"
++
++ Note how the filename is enclosed in doublequotes in the final
++ example, because it contains a comma.
++
++ To obtain BRIEF format, you must give the SET TRANSACTION-LOG BRIEF
++ command before the LOG TRANSACTIONS command. (If you give them in the
++ opposite order, a heading is written to the log by the LOG command.)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.17.2. The FTP Format
++
++ SET TRANSACTION-LOG FTP (available only in UNIX) chooses a format that
++ is compatible with the WU-FTPD (Washington University FTP daemon) log,
++ and so can be processed by any software that processes the WU-FTPD
++ log. It logs only transfers in and out, both successful and failed
++ (but success or failure is not indicated, due to lack of a field in
++ the WU-FTPD log format for this purpose). Non-transfer events are not
++ recorded.
++
++ Unlike other logs, the FTP-format transaction log is opened in append
++ mode by default. This allows you to easily keep a record of all your
++ kermit transfers, and it also allows the same log to be shared by
++ multiple simultaneous Kermit processes or (permissions permitting)
++ users. You can, of course, force creation of a new logfile by
++ specifying the NEW keyword after the filename, e.g.
++
++ log transactions oofa.log new
++
++ All records in the FTP-style log are in a consistent format. The first
++ field is fixed-length and contains spaces; subsequent fields are
++ variable length, contain no spaces, and are separated by one or more
++ spaces. The fields are:
++
++ Timestamp
++ This is an asctime-style timestamp, example: "Wed Sep 16
++ 20:19:05 1999" It is always exactly 24 characters long, and the
++ subfields are always in fixed positions.
++
++ Elapsed time
++ The whole number of seconds required to transfer the file, as a
++ string of decimal digits, e.g. "24".
++
++ Connection
++ The name of the network host to which C-Kermit is connected, or
++ the name of the serial device through which it has dialed (or
++ has a direct connection), or "/dev/tty" for transfers in remote
++ mode.
++
++ Bytes transferred
++ The number of bytes transferred, decimal digits, e.g.
++ "1537904".
++
++ Filename
++ The name of the file that was transferred, e.g.
++ "/pub/ftp/kermit/a/README.TXT". If the filename contains any
++ spaces or control characters, each such character is replaced
++ by an underscore ('_') character.
++
++ Mode
++ The letter 'b' if the file was transferred in binary mode, or
++ 'a' if it was transferred in text (ASCII) mode.
++
++ Options
++ This field always contains an underscore ('_') character.
++
++ Direction
++ The letter 'o' if the file was transferred Out, and 'i' if the
++ file was transferred In.
++
++ User class
++ The letter 'r' indicates the file was transferred by a Real
++ user.
++
++ User identification
++ The ID of the user who transferred the file.
++
++ Server identification
++ The string "kermit". This distinguishes a Kermit transfer log
++ record from a WU-FTPD record, which contains "ftp" in this
++ field.
++
++ Authentication class
++ The digit '1' if we know the user's ID on the client system,
++ otherwise '0'. Currently, always '0'.
++
++ Authenticated user
++ If the authentication class is '1', this is the user's ID on
++ the client system. Otherwise it is an asterisk ('*'). Currently
++ it is always an asterisk.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ Thu Oct 22 17:42:48 1998 0 * 94 /usr/olga/new.x a _ i r olga kermit 0 *
++ Thu Oct 22 17:51:29 1998 1 * 147899 /usr/olga/test.c a _ o r olga kermit 0 *
++ Thu Oct 22 17:51:44 1998 1 * 235 /usr/olga/test.o b _ i r olga kermit 0 *
++ Fri Oct 23 12:10:25 1998 0 * 235 /usr/olga/x.ksc a _ o r olga kermit 0 *
++
++ Note that an ftp-format transaction log can also be selected on the
++ Kermit command line as follows:
++
++ kermit --xferfile:filespec
++
++ This is equivalent to:
++
++ SET TRANSACTION-LOG FTP
++ LOG TRANSACTIONS filespec APPEND
++
++ Conceivably it could be possible to have a system-wide shared Kermit
++ log, except that UNIX lacks any notion of an append-only file; thus
++ any user who could append to the log could also delete it (or alter
++ it). This problem could be worked around using setuid/setgid tricks,
++ but these would most likely interfere with the other setuid/setgid
++ tricks C-Kermit must use for getting at dialout devices and UUCP
++ logfiles.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.18. Unprefixing NUL
++
++ As of 6.1.193 Alpha.10, C-Kermit can finally send and receive
++ file-transfer packets in which NUL (ASCII 0) is unprefixed (no more
++ NUL-terminated packets!). NUL is, of course, extremely prevalent in
++ binary files such as executables, and this has been a significant
++ source of packet overhead. For example, when transferring itself (the
++ SunOS C-Kermit executable) with minimal prefixing and 9000-byte
++ packets, we see:
++
++ File size: 1064960
++ Packet chars with 0 prefixed: 1199629 overhead = 12.65%
++ Packet chars with 0 unprefixed: 1062393 overhead = -0.03%
++
++ Transfer rates go up accordingly, not only because of the reduced
++ amount of i/o, but also because less computation is required on each
++ end.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.19. Clear-Channel Protocol
++
++ Now that C-Kermit itself is capable of sending and receiving any byte
++ at all on a clear channel ([516]Section 4.18), it is, for the first
++ time, in a position to negotiate a clear channel with the other
++ Kermit, giving it permission (but not requiring it) to unprefix any
++ and all characters that it knows are safe. In general this means all
++ but the Kermit start-of-packet character (normally Ctrl-A), Carriage
++ Return (not only Kermit's end-of-packet character, but also treated
++ specially on Telnet NVT links), and IAC (255, also special to Telnet).
++
++ By default, C-Kermit will say it has a clear channel only if it has
++ opened a TCP socket. Since the Kermit program on the far end of a
++ TCP/IP connection generally does not know it has a TCP/IP connection,
++ it will not announce a clear channel unless it has been told to do so.
++ The command is:
++
++ SET CLEAR-CHANNEL { ON, OFF, AUTO }
++
++ AUTO is the default, meaning that the clear-channel status is
++ determined automatically from the type of connection. ON means to
++ announce a clear channel, OFF means not to announce it. Use SHOW
++ STREAMING ([517]Section 4.20) to see the current CLEAR-CHANNEL status.
++ Synonym: SET CLEARCHANNEL.
++
++ CLEAR-CHANNEL is also set if you start C-Kermit with the -I switch
++ (see [518]Section 4.20).
++
++ Whenever a clear channel is negotiated, the resulting
++ control-character unprefixing is "sticky"; that is, it remains in
++ effect after the transfer so you can use SHOW CONTROL to see what was
++ negotiated.
++
++ You can also see whether a clear channel was negotiated in the
++ STATISTICS /VERBOSE Display.
++
++ The advantage of the clear channel feature is that it can make file
++ transfers go faster automatically. The disadvantage would be
++ file-transfer failures if the channel is not truly clear, for example
++ if C-Kermit made a Telnet connection to a terminal server, and then
++ dialed out from there; or if C-Kermit made an Rlogin connection to
++ host and then made a Telnet connection from there to another host. If
++ a file transfer fails on a TCP/IP connection, use SHOW CONTROL to
++ check whether control characters became unprefixed as a result of
++ protocol negotiations, and/or SHOW STREAMING ([519]Section 4.20) to
++ see if "clear-channel" was negotiated. If this happened, use SET
++ CLEAR-CHANNEL OFF and SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS (or whatever) to prevent
++ it from happening again.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20. Streaming Protocol
++
++ A new Kermit protocol option called "streaming" was added in C-Kermit
++ 7.0. The idea is that if the two Kermit partners have a reliable
++ transport (such as TCP/IP or X.25) between them, then there is no need
++ to send ACKs for Data packets, or NAKs, since a reliable transport
++ will, by definition, deliver all packets in order and undamaged. On
++ such a connection, streaming cuts down not only on Kermit program
++ overhead (switching back and forth between reading and sending
++ packets), but also tends to make the underlying transport use itself
++ more efficiently (e.g. by defeating the Nagle algorithm and/or Delayed
++ ACK stratagem of the TCP layer). Furthermore, it allows transfers to
++ work smoothly on extremely slow network congestions that would
++ otherwise cause timeouts and retransmissions, and even failure when
++ the retry limit was exceeded.
++
++ The trick is knowing when we can stream:
++
++ 1. If C-Kermit has opened a TCP socket or X.25 connection, it offers
++ stream.
++ 2. If C-Kermit has been started with the -I (uppercase) option, or if
++ it has been told to SET RELIABLE ON, it offers to stream.
++ 3. If C-Kermit is in remote mode, and has been told to SET RELIABLE
++ AUTO (or ON), it always offers to stream, and also always agrees
++ to stream, if the other Kermit offers. Unless you take explicit
++ actions to override the defaults, this allows the local Kermit
++ (the one that made the connection, and so knows whether it's
++ reliable) to control streaming.
++
++ (Note that an offer to stream also results in a Clear-Channel
++ announcement if CLEAR-CHANNEL is set to AUTO; see [520]Section 4.19.)
++
++ When BOTH Kermits offer to stream, then they stream; otherwise they
++ don't. Thus streaming-capable Kermit programs interoperate
++ automatically and transparently with nonstreaming ones. If the two
++ Kermits do agree to stream, you'll see the word "STREAMING" on the
++ fullscreen file-transfer display in the Window Slots field. You can
++ also find out afterwards with the STATISTICS or SHOW STREAMING
++ commands.
++
++ WARNING: Automatic choice of streaming is based on the assumption
++ of a "direct" end-to-end network connection; for example, a Telnet
++ or Rlogin connection from host A to host B, and transferring files
++ between A and B. However, if your connection has additional
++ components -- something "in the middle" (B) that you have made a
++ network connection to, which makes a separate connection to the
++ destination host (C), then you don't really have a reliable
++ connection, but C-Kermit has no way of knowing this; transferring
++ files between A and C will probably fail. In such cases, you'll
++ need to tell the *local* C-Kermit to "set reliable off" before
++ transferring files (it does no good to give this command to the
++ remote Kermit since the local one controls the RELIABLE setting).
++
++ Streaming is like using an infinite window size, with no timeouts and
++ no tolerance for transmission errors (since there shouldn't be any).
++ It relies on the underlying transport for flow control, error
++ correction, timeouts, and retransmission. Thus it is very suitable for
++ use on TCP/IP connections, especially slow or bursty ones, since
++ Kermit's packet timeouts won't interfere with the transfer -- each
++ packet takes as long to reach its destination as it takes TCP to
++ deliver it. If TCP can't deliver the packet within its own timeout
++ period (over which Kermit has no control), it signals a fatal error.
++ Just like FTP.
++
++ Streaming goes much faster than non-streaming when a relatively small
++ packet length is used, and it tends to go faster than non-streaming
++ with even the longest packet lengths. The Kermit window size is
++ irrelevant to streaming protocol, but still might affect performance
++ in small ways since it can result in different paths through the code.
++
++ The definition of "reliable transport" does not necessarily demand
++ 8-bit and control-character transparency. Streaming can work with
++ parity and/or control-character prefixing just as well (but not as
++ fast) as without them; in such cases you can leave RELIABLE set to ON,
++ but set CLEARCHANNEL and/or PARITY appropriately.
++
++ Maximum performance -- comparable to and often exceeding FTP -- is
++ achieved on socket-to-socket connections (in which the considerable
++ overhead of the terminal driver and Telnet or Rlogin server is
++ eliminated) with long packets and the new "brief" file-transfer
++ display ([521]Section 4.16).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20.1. Commands for Streaming
++
++ SET RELIABLE { ON, OFF, AUTO }
++ SET RELIABLE ON tells Kermit that it has a reliable transport.
++ SET RELIABLE OFF tells Kermit the transport is not reliable.
++ SET RELIABLE AUTO tells Kermit that it should SET RELIABLE ON
++ whenever it makes a reliable connection (e.g. TELNET or SET
++ HOST on a TCP/IP or X.25 network), and when in remote mode it
++ should believe the transport is reliable if the other Kermit
++ says it is during Kermit protocol negotiation.
++
++ AUTO is the default; the Kermit program that makes the connection
++ knows whether it is reliable, and tells the remote Kermit.
++
++ The RELIABLE setting has several effects, including:
++
++ * It can affect the timeouts used during normal ACK/NAK protocol.
++ * It can affect the clear-channel announcement.
++ * It can affect streaming.
++
++ If you TELNET or SET HOST somewhere, this includes an implicit SET
++ RELIABLE ON command. The -I command-line option is equivalent to SET
++ RELIABLE ON.
++
++ Since SET RELIABLE ON (and -I) also implies SET CLEAR CHANNEL ON, you
++ might find that in certain cases you need to tell Kermit that even
++ though the connection is reliable, it doesn't have a clear channel
++ after all:
++
++ SET CLEAR-CHANNEL OFF
++ SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS ; or whatever...
++
++ You can control streaming without affecting the other items with:
++
++ SET STREAMING { ON, OFF, AUTO }
++
++ AUTO is the default, meaning streaming will occur if Kermit has made a
++ TCP/IP connection or if RELIABLE is ON (or it was started with the -I
++ command line option). OFF means don't stream; ON means offer to stream
++ no matter what.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20.2. Examples of Streaming
++
++ Here we look at the use and behavior of streaming on several different
++ kinds of connections, and compare its performance with non-streaming
++ transfers.
++
++ 4.20.2.1. Streaming on Socket-to-Socket Connections
++
++ Here we get streaming automatically when both Kermit programs are
++ capable of it, since they both make socket connections. For example,
++ on the far end:
++
++ C-Kermit> set host * 3000
++ C-Kermit> server
++
++ and on the near end:
++
++ C-Kermit> set host foo.bar.xyz.com 3000
++ (now give SEND and GET command)
++
++ All subsequent file transfers use streaming automatically.
++
++ Here are the results from 84 trials, run on a production network,
++ disk-to-disk, in which a 1-MB binary file (the SunOS C-Kermit Sparc
++ executable) was sent from a Sun Sparc-10 with SunOS 4.1.3 to an IBM
++ Power Server 850 with AIX 4.1, socket-to-socket, over a 10Mbps 10BaseT
++ Ethernet, using minimal control-character unprefixing, window sizes
++ from 10 to 32, and packet sizes from 1450 to 9010:
++
++ Streaming Nonstreaming
++ Max CPS 748955 683354
++ Min CPS 221522 172491
++ Mean CPS 646134 558680
++ Median CPS 678043 595874
++ Std Dev 101424 111493
++
++ Correlations:
++
++ CPS and window size: -0.036
++ CPS and packet length: 0.254
++ CPS and streaming: 0.382
++
++ Note that the relationship between streaming and throughput is
++ significantly stronger than that between CPS and window size or packet
++ length.
++
++ Also note that this and all other performance measurements in this
++ section are snapshots in time; the results could be much different at
++ other times when the load on the systems and/or the network is higher
++ or lower.
++
++ In a similar socket-to-socket trial, but this time over a wide-area
++ TCP/IP connection (from New York City to Logan, Utah, about 2000
++ miles), the following results were obtained:
++
++ Streaming Nonstreaming
++ Max CPS 338226 318203
++ Min CPS 191659 132314
++ Mean CPS 293744 259240
++ Median CPS 300845 273271
++ Std Dev 41914 52351
++
++ Correlations:
++
++ CPS and window size: 0.164
++ CPS and packet length: 0.123
++ CPS and streaming: 0.346
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20.2.2. Streaming on Telnet Connections
++
++ In this case the local copy of Kermit is told to TELNET or SET HOST,
++ and so it knows it has a reliable connection and -- unless it has been
++ told not to -- will offer to stream, and the other Kermit program,
++ since it has STREAMING set to AUTO, agrees.
++
++ Since we have a reliable connection, we'll also get control-character
++ unprefixing automatically because of the new clear-channel protocol
++ ([522]Section 4.19).
++
++ Any errors that occur during streaming are fatal to the transfer. The
++ message is "Transmission error on reliable link". Should this happen:
++
++ 1. Check the remote Kermit's flow control setting (SHOW
++ COMMUNICATIONS). If it is NONE, change it to XON/XOFF, or vice
++ versa. If it is XON/XOFF (or you just changed it to XOFF/XOFF),
++ make sure the file sender is prefixing the XON and XOFF
++ characters. In the most drastic case, use "set prefix all" to
++ force prefixing of all control characters.
++ 2. The remote Telnet server might chop off the 8th bit. In that case,
++ tell C-Kermit to "set parity space". Or, you might be able to
++ force the Telnet to allow eight-bit data by telling C-Kermit to
++ "set telopt binary request accept" -- that is, request the Telnet
++ server to enter binary mode, and accept binary-mode bids from the
++ server.
++ 3. The remote Telnet server might have a buffering limitation. If a
++ and b don't cure the problem, tell the file receiver to "set
++ receive packet-length 1000" (or other number -- use the largest
++ one that works). This too, is no different from the non-streaming
++ case (more about this in [523]Section 4.20.2.3).
++
++ And remember you can continue interrupted binary-mode transfers where
++ they left off with the RESEND (= SEND /RECOVER) command.
++
++ Here are the figures for the same 84 trials between the same Sun and
++ IBM hosts as in 4.20.2.1, on the same network, but over a Telnet
++ connection rather than socket-to-socket:
++
++ Streaming Nonstreaming
++ Max CPS 350088 322523
++ Min CPS 95547 173152
++ Mean CPS 321372 281830
++ Median CPS 342604 291469
++ Std Dev 40503 29948
++
++ Correlations:
++
++ CPS and window size: 0.001
++ CPS and packet length: 0.152
++ CPS and streaming: 0.128
++
++ Here the effect is not as emphatic as in the socket-to-socket case,
++ yet on the whole streaming tends to be beneficial.
++
++ Additional measurements on HP-UX using C-Kermit 7.0 Beta.06:
++
++ Windowing Streaming
++ HP-UX 8->8 not tested 14Kcps
++ HP-UX 8->9 not tested 76Kcps
++ HP-UX 8->10 36Kcps 66Kcps
++ HP-UX 9->9 not tested 190Kcps
++ HP-UX 9->10 160Kcps 378Kcps
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20.2.3. Streaming with Limited Packet Length
++
++ The IRIX telnet server (at least the ones observed in IRIX 5.3 and
++ 6.2) does not allow Kermit to send packets longer than 4096 bytes.
++ Thus when sending from IRIX C-Kermit when it is on the remote end of a
++ Telnet connection, the packet length must be 4K or less. Trials in
++ this case (in which packet lengths range from 1450 to 4000) show a
++ strong advantage for streaming, which would be evident in any other
++ case where the packet length is restricted, and stronger the shorter
++ the maximum packet length.
++
++ Streaming Nonstreaming
++ Max CPS 426187 366870
++ Min CPS 407500 276517
++ Mean CPS 415226 339168
++ Median CPS 414139 343803
++ Std Dev 6094 25851
++
++ Correlations:
++
++ CPS and window size: 0.116
++ CPS and packet length: 0.241
++ CPS and streaming: 0.901
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20.2.4. Streaming on Dialup Connections
++
++ Here "dialup" refers to a "direct" dialup connection, not a SLIP or
++ PPP connection, which is only a particular kind of TCP/IP connection.
++
++ Attempt this at your own risk, and then only if (a) you have
++ error-correcting modems, and (b) the connections between the modems
++ and computers are also error-free, perfectly flow-controlled, and free
++ of interrupt conflicts. Streaming can be used effectively and to
++ fairly good advantage on such connections, but remember that the
++ transfer is fatal if even one error is detected (also remember that
++ should a binary-mode transfer fail, it can be recovered from the point
++ of failure with RESEND).
++
++ To use streaming on an unreliable connection, you must tell both
++ Kermits that the connection is reliable:
++
++ kermit -I
++
++ or:
++
++ C-Kermit> set reliable on
++
++ In this case, it will probably be necessary to prefix some control
++ characters, for example if your connection is through a terminal
++ server that has an escape character. Most Cisco terminal servers, for
++ example, require Ctrl-^ (30, as well as its high-bit equivalent, 158)
++ to be prefixed. To unprefix these, you'll need to defeat the "clear
++ channel" feature:
++
++ C-Kermit> set reliable on
++ C-Kermit> set clear-channel off
++ C-Kermit> set prefixing none
++ C-Kermit> set control prefix 1 13 30 158 ; and whatever else is necessary
++
++ Dialup trials were done using fixed large window and packet sizes.
++ They compare uploading and downloading of two common types of files,
++ with and without streaming. Configuration:
++
++ HP-9000/715/33 -- 57600bps, RTS/CTS -- USR Courier V.34 --
++ V.34+V.42, 31200bps -- USR V.34+ Rackmount -- 57600bps, RTS/CTS --
++ Cisco terminal server -- Solaris 2.5.1. Packet size = 8000, Window
++ Size = 30, Control Character Unprefixing Minimal (but including the
++ Cisco escape character).
++
++ Since this is not a truly reliable connection, a few trials failed
++ when a bad packet was received (most likely due to UART overruns); the
++ failure was graceful and immediate, and the message was informative.
++ The results of ten successful trials uploading and downloading the two
++ files with and without streaming are:
++
++ Streaming..
++ Off On
++ Upload 5194 5565 txt (= C source code, 78K)
++ 3135 3406 gz (= gzip file, compressed, 85K)
++ Download 5194 5565 txt
++ 3041 3406 gz
++
++ Each CPS figure is the mean of 10 results.
++
++ A brief test was also performed on a LAT-based dialout connection from
++ a VAX 3100 with VMS 5.5 to a USR Courier V.34 connected to a DECserver
++ 700 at 19200 bps. The 1-MB Sparc executable downloaded from a Sun to
++ the VAX at 1100cps without streaming and 1900cps with streaming, using
++ 8000-byte packets, 30 window slots, and minimal prefixing in both
++ cases.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20.2.5. Streaming on X.25 Connections
++
++ We have only limited access to X.25 networks. One trial was performed
++ in which the 1MB Solaris 2.4 Sparc executable was transferred over a
++ SunLink X.25 connection; nothing is known about the actual physical
++ connection. With a packet length of 8000 and a window size of 30, the
++ file transferred at 6400 cps (using a maximum of 6 window slots). With
++ the same packet length, but with streaming, it transferred without
++ mishap at 6710 cps, about 5% faster.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.20.3. Streaming - Preliminary Conclusions
++
++ The results vary with the particular connection, but are good overall.
++ Although numerous lower-level tricks can be used to improve
++ performance on specific platforms or connection methods, streaming
++ occurs at a high, system-independent level of the Kermit protocol and
++ therefore can apply to all types of platforms and (reliable)
++ connections transparently.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.21. The TRANSMIT Command
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the TRANSMIT command transmitted in text or
++ binary mode according to SET FILE TYPE { TEXT, BINARY }. But now that
++ binary mode is likely to be the default for protocol transfers, it is
++ evident that this not also an appropriate default for TRANSMIT, since
++ binary-mode TRANSMIT is a rather specialized and tricky operation.
++ Therefore, TRANSMIT defaults to text mode always, regardless of the
++ FILE TYPE setting.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 expands the capabilities of the TRANSMIT command by
++ adding the following switches (see [524]Section 1.5). The new syntax
++ is:
++
++ TRANSMIT [ switches... ] filename
++
++ Zero or more switches may be included:
++
++ /PIPE
++ When /PIPE is included, "filename" is interpreted as a system
++ command or program whose output is to be sent. Synonym:
++ /COMMAND. Example:
++
++ transmit /pipe finger
++
++ You may enclose the command in braces, but you don't have to:
++
++ xmit /pipe {ls -l | sort -r +0.22 -0.32 | head}
++
++ /BINARY
++ Transmits the file (or pipe output) in binary mode.
++
++ /TEXT
++ Transmits the file (or pipe output) in line-oriented text mode.
++ Current FILE CHARACTER-SET and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET
++ selections govern translation. Default.
++
++ /TRANSPARENT
++ Specifies text mode without character-set translation, no
++ matter what the FILE and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET selections are.
++
++ /NOWAIT
++ This is equivalent to SET TRANSMIT PROMPT 0, but for this
++ TRANSMIT command only. Applies only to text mode; it means to
++ not wait for any kind of echo or turnaround character after
++ sending a line before sending the next line. (Normally Kermit
++ waits for a linefeed.)
++
++ When TRANSMIT ECHO is ON, C-Kermit tries to read back the echo of each
++ character that is sent. Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, 1 second was allowed
++ for each echo to appear; if it didn't show up in a second, the
++ TRANSMIT command would fail. Similarly for the TRANSMIT PROMPT
++ character. However, with today's congested Internet connections, etc,
++ more time is often needed:
++
++ SET TRANSMIT TIMEOUT number
++ Specifies the number of seconds to wait for an echo or the prompt
++ character when TRANSMIT PROMPT is nonzero; the default wait is 1
++ second. If you specify 0, the wait is indefinite. When a timeout
++ interval of 0 is specified, and a desired echo or prompt does not show
++ up, the TRANSMIT command will not terminate until or unless you
++ interrupt it with Ctrl-C; use SET TRANSMIT TIMEOUT 0 with caution.
++
++ Note: to blast a file out the communications connection without any
++ kind of synchronization or timeouts or other manner of checking, use:
++
++ SET TRANSMIT ECHO OFF
++ SET TRANSMIT PROMPT 0 (or include the /NOWAIT switch)
++ SET TRANSMIT PAUSE 0
++ TRANSMIT [ switches ] filename
++
++ In this case, text-file transmission is not-line oriented and large
++ blocks can be sent, resulting in a significant performance improvement
++ over line-at-at-time transmission. Successful operation depends (even
++ more than usual for the TRANSMIT command!) on a clean connection with
++ effective flow control.
++
++ For details on TRANSMIT and character sets, see [525]Section 6.6.5.4.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22. Coping with Faulty Kermit Implementations
++
++ Kermit protocol has been implemented in quite a few third-party
++ commercial, shareware, and freeware software packages, with varying
++ degrees of success. In most cases operation is satisfactory but slow
++ -- only the bare minimum subset of the protocol is available -- short
++ packets, no sliding windows, no attributes, etc. In other cases, the
++ implementation is incorrect, resulting in failures at the initial
++ negotiation stage or corrupted files.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 and Kermit 95 1.1.19 include some new defense mechanisms
++ to help cope with the most common situations. However, bear in mind
++ there is only so much we can do in such cases -- the responsibility
++ for fixing the problem lies with the maker of the faulty software.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.1. Failure to Accept Modern Negotiation Strings
++
++ The published Kermit protocol specification states that new fields can
++ be added to the parameter negotiation string. These are to be ignored
++ by any Kermit implementation that does not understand them; this is
++ what makes the Kermit protocol extensible. Unfortunately, some Kermit
++ implementations become confused (or worse) when receiving a
++ negotiation string longer than the one they expect. You can try
++ working around such problems by telling Kermit to shorten its
++ negotiation string (and thus disable the corresponding new features):
++
++ SET SEND NEGOTIATION-STRING-MAX-LENGTH number
++
++ Try a number like 10. If that doesn't work, try 9, 8, 7, 6, and so on.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.2. Failure to Negotiate 8th-bit Prefixing
++
++ The published Kermit protocol specification states that 8th-bit
++ prefixing (which allows transfer of 8-bit data over a 7-bit
++ connection) occurs if the file sender puts a valid prefix character
++ (normally "&") in the 8th-bit-prefix field of the negotiation string,
++ and the receiver puts either a letter "Y" or the same prefix
++ character. At least one faulty Kermit implementation exists that does
++ not accept the letter "Y". To force C-Kermit / K-95 to reply with the
++ other Kermit's prefix character rather than a "Y", give the following
++ (invisible) command:
++
++ SET Q8FLAG ON
++
++ Use SET Q8FLAG OFF to restore the normal behavior.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.3. Corrupt Files
++
++ Refer to [526]Section 4.22.2. Some Kermit implementations mistakenly
++ interpret the "Y" as a prefix character. Then, whenever a letter Y
++ appears in the data, the Y and the character that follows it are
++ replaced by a garbage character. At this writing, we are not sure if
++ there is any solution, but try "set send negotiation-string-max-length
++ 6" and/or "set q8flag on".
++
++ File corruption can also occur when control characters within the file
++ data are sent without prefixing, as at least some are by default in
++ C-Kermit 7.0 and K-95. Some Kermit implementations do not handle
++ incoming "bare" control characters. To work around, "set prefixing
++ all".
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.4. Spurious Cancellations
++
++ The Kermit protocol specification states that if an ACK to a Data
++ packet contains X in its data field, the transfer of the current file
++ is canceled, and if it contains a Z, the entire transfer is canceled.
++ At least one overzealous Kermit implementation applies this rule to
++ non-Data packets as well, the typical symptom being that any attempt
++ to transfer a file whose name begins with X or Z results in
++ cancellation. This is because the file receiver typically sends back
++ the name under which it stored the file (which might not be the same
++ as the name it was sent with) in the ACK to the File Header packet.
++ This is information only and should not cause cancellation. To work
++ around the problem, use:
++
++ SET F-ACK-BUG { ON, OFF }
++
++ ON tells Kermit not to send back the filename in the ACK to the file
++ header packet as it normally would do (OFF puts Kermit back to normal
++ after using ON).
++
++ A variation on the this bug occurs in an obscure Kermit program for
++ MUMPS: When this Kermit program sends a file called (say) FOO.BAR, it
++ requires that the ACK to its F packet contain exactly the same name,
++ FOO.BAR. However, C-Kermit likes to send back the full pathname,
++ causing the MUMPS Kermit to fail. SET F-ACK-BUG ON doesn't help here.
++ So a separate command has been added to handle this situation:
++
++ SET F-ACK-PATH { ON, OFF }
++
++ Normally it is ON (regardless of the SET SEND PATHNAMES setting). Use
++ SET F-ACK-PATH OFF to instruct Kermit to send back only the filename
++ without the path in the ACK to the F packet.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.5. Spurious Refusals
++
++ Some Kermit implementations, notably PDP-11 Kermit 3.60 and earlier,
++ have bugs in their handling of Attribute packets that can cause
++ unwarranted refusal of incoming files, e.g. based on date or size.
++ This can be worked around by telling one or both of the Kermit
++ partners to:
++
++ SET ATTRIBUTES OFF
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.6. Failures during the Data Transfer Phase
++
++ This can be caused by control-character unprefixing ([527]Section
++ 4.22.3 ), and fixed by:
++
++ SET PREFIXING ALL
++
++ It can also have numerous other causes, explained in Chapter 10 of
++ [528]Using C-Kermit: the connection is not 8-bit transparent (so use
++ "set parity space" or somesuch), inadequate flow control, etc. Consult
++ the manual.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.7. Fractured Filenames
++
++ At least one well-known PC-based communications package negotiates
++ data compression, which (according to the protocol specification)
++ applies to both the filename and the file data, but then fails to
++ decompress the filename. Example: C-Kermit sends a file called
++ R000101.DAT (where 000101 might be non-Y2K-wise YYMMDD notation), and
++ the package in question stores the files as R~#0101.DAT. Workaround:
++ Tell C-Kermit to SET REPEAT COUNTS OFF.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.22.8. Bad File Dates
++
++ At least one well-known PC-based communications package negotiates the
++ passing of file timestamps from sender to receiver, but when it is
++ sending files, it always gives them a timestamp of 1 February 1970.
++ Workaround: tell C-Kermit to SET ATTRIBUTE DATE OFF. You don't get the
++ file's real date, but you also don't get 1 Feb 1970; instead the file
++ gets the current date and time.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.23. File Transfer Recovery
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, RESEND (SEND /RECOVER) and REGET (GET /RECOVER)
++ refused to work if FILE TYPE was not BINARY or the /BINARY switch was
++ not included. Now these commands include an implied /BINARY switch,
++ meaning they set the file type to binary for the duration of the
++ command automatically.
++
++ In the client/server arrangement, this also forces the server into
++ binary mode (if it is C-Kermit 7.0 or greater, or K95 1.1.19 or
++ greater) so the recovery operation proceeds, just as you asked and
++ expected.
++
++ BUT... Just as before, the results are correct only under the
++ following conditions:
++
++ * If the prior interrupted transfer was also in binary mode; or:
++ * If the prior transfer was in text mode and the other computer was
++ a "like platform" (e.g. UNIX-to-UNIX, Windows-to-Windows,
++ DOS-to-Windows) AND there was no character-set translation (i.e.
++ TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET was TRANSPARENT).
++
++ Note that these circumstances are more likely to obtain in C-Kermit
++ 7.0, in which:
++
++ * The default FILE TYPE in C-Kermit 7.0 is BINARY.
++ * The default FILE INCOMPLETE setting is AUTO, which means KEEP if
++ the transfer is in binary mode, DISCARD otherwise.
++ * C-Kermit 7.0, Kermit 95 1.1.17, and MS-DOS Kermit 3.15 and later
++ can recognize "like platforms" and switch into binary mode
++ automatically. Transfers between like platforms are always binary
++ unless character-set translation has been requested, and then is
++ still binary for all files whose names match a binary pattern,
++ unless the automatic mechanisms have been disabled (with a /TEXT
++ switch, or with SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL).
++ * SEND /BINARY and GET /BINARY always force binary-mode transfers,
++ even when FILE TYPE is TEXT, even when TRANSFER MODE is AUTOMATIC,
++ even when PATTERNS are ON and the file's name matches a text
++ pattern.
++
++ But also note that the automatic client/server transfer-mode
++ adjustments do not work with versions of C-Kermit prior to 7.0 or K95
++ prior to 1.1.16.
++
++ If the prior transfer was in text mode:
++
++ * If text-mode transfers between the two platforms are
++ "length-changing" (as they are between UNIX -- which terminates
++ text lines with LF -- and DOS or Windows -- which terminates text
++ lines with CRLF), the recovered file will be corrupt.
++ * If text-mode transfers between the two platforms are not
++ length-changing, but character-set translation was active in the
++ prior transfer, the result will be a file in which the first part
++ has translated characters and the second part does not.
++
++ But in C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19 and later, incompletely transferred
++ text files are not kept unless you change the default. But if you have
++ done this, and you have an incompletely transferred text file, you'll
++ need to:
++
++ * Transfer the whole file again in text mode, or:
++ * Use SEND /STARTING-AT: to recover the transfer at the correct
++ point; but you have to find out what that point is, as described
++ in the manual.
++
++ Kermit has no way of knowing whether the previous transfer was in text
++ or binary mode so it is your responsibility to choose the appropriate
++ recovery method.
++
++ If you use C-Kermit to maintain parallel directories on different
++ computers, using SET FILE COLLISION to transfer only those files that
++ changed since last time, and the files are big enough (or the
++ connection slow enough) to require SEND /RECOVER to resume interrupted
++ transfers, you should remember that SEND /RECOVER (RESEND) overrides
++ all FILE COLLISION settings. Therefore you should use SEND /RECOVER
++ (RESEND) only on the file that was interrupted, not the file group.
++ For example, if the original transfer was initiated with:
++
++ SEND *
++
++ and was interrupted, then after reestablishing your connection and
++ starting the Kermit receiver with SET FILE COLLISION UPDATE on the
++ remote end, use the following sequence at the sender to resume the
++ transfer:
++
++ SEND /RECOVER name-of-interrupted-file
++
++ and then:
++
++ SEND *
++
++ (In C-Kermit 7.0 and later, \v(filename) contains the name of the file
++ most recently transferred, as long you have not EXITed from Kermit or
++ changed directory, etc.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.24. FILE COLLISION UPDATE Clarification
++
++ In UNIX, file modification dates are used when comparing the file date
++ with the date in the attribute packet. In VMS, however, the file
++ creation date is used. These two policies reflect the preferences of
++ the two user communities.
++
++ Also, remember that the file date/time given in the attribute packet
++ is the local time at the file sender. At present, no timezone
++ conversions are defined in or performed by the Kermit protocol. This
++ is primarily because this feature was designed at a time when many of
++ the systems where Kermit runs had no concept of timezone, and
++ therefore would be unable to convert (say, to/from GMT or UTC or Zulu
++ time).
++
++ As a consequence, some unexpected results might occur when
++ transferring files across timezones; e.g. commands on the target
++ system that are sensitive to file dates might work (UNIX "make",
++ backups, etc).
++
++ Timezone handling is deferred for a future release.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.25. Autodownload Improvements
++
++ Refer to pages 164-165 of [529]Using C-Kermit about the hazards of
++ autodownload when C-Kermit is "in the middle". As of C-Kermit 7.0, no
++ more hazards. If C-Kermit has TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD ON and it detects
++ a packet of the current protocol type (Kermit or Zmodem), it "erases"
++ the visual aspect of the packet that would be seen by the terminal
++ (or, more to the point, the emulator, such as K95). This way, only
++ C-Kermit goes into RECEIVE mode, and not also the terminal emulator
++ through which C-Kermit is accessed. And therefore, it is no longer
++ necessary to SET TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD OFF to prevent multiple Kermits
++ from going into receive mode at once, but of course it is still
++ necessary to ensure that, when you have multiple Kermits in a chain,
++ that the desired one receives the autodownload.
++
++ The defaults have not been changed; Kermit 95 still has autodownload
++ ON by default, and C-Kermit has it OFF by default.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5. CLIENT/SERVER
++
++ 5.0. Hints
++
++ If you use SET SERVER GET-PATH to set up your server, and the GET-PATH
++ does not include the server's current directory, clients can become
++ quite confused. For example, "remote dir oofa.txt" shows a file named
++ oofa.txt, but "get oofa.txt" fails. In this situation, you should
++ either DISABLE DIR or make your GET-PATH include the current
++ directory.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.1. New Command-Line Options
++
++ The -G command-line option is like -g (GET), except the incoming file
++ is sent to standard output rather than written to disk.
++
++ The -I option ("Internet") is used to tell a remote C-Kermit program
++ that you are coming in via Internet Telnet or Rlogin and therefore
++ have a reliable connection. The -I option is equivalent to SET
++ RELIABLE ON and SET FLOW NONE.
++
++ The -O option ("Only One") tells C-Kermit to enter server mode but
++ then exit after the first client operation.
++
++ See [530]Section 9.3 for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.2. New Client Commands
++
++ BYE and FINISH no longer try to do anything if a connection is not
++ active. Thus a sequence like "hangup" followed by "bye" or "finish"
++ will no longer get stuck in a long timeout-and-retransmission cycle,
++ nor will it try to open a new connection.
++
++ REMOTE EXIT
++ Similar to FINISH, except it ensures that the Kermit server
++ program exits back to the operating system or shell prompt.
++ (FINISH would return it to its interactive prompt if it was
++ started in interactive mode, and would cause it to exit if it
++ entered server mode via command-line option.) When C-Kermit is
++ to be the server, you can use { ENABLE, DISABLE } EXIT to
++ control the client's access to this feature.
++
++ REMOTE MKDIR directory-name
++ Tells the client to ask the server to create a directory with
++ the given name, which can be absolute or relative. The syntax
++ of the directory name depends on the Kermit server (see
++ [531]next section); in all cases, it can be in the syntax of
++ the system where the server is running (UNIX, VMS, DOS, etc)
++ but newer servers also accept UNIX syntax, no matter what the
++ underlying platform. The server will not execute this command
++ if (a) it does not understand it, (b) a DISABLE MKDIR command
++ has been given, or (c) a DISABLE CWD command has been given;
++ otherwise, the command is executed, but will fail if the
++ directory can not be created, in which cases most servers will
++ attempt to return a message giving the reason for failure. The
++ REMOTE MKDIR command succeeds if the remote directory is
++ created, or if it already exists and therefore does not need to
++ be created, and fails otherwise.
++
++ REMOTE RMDIR directory-name
++ Tells the client to ask the server to remove (delete) a
++ directory with the given name. The same considerations apply as
++ for REMOTE MKDIR.
++
++ REMOTE SET FILE INCOMPLETE { DISCARD, KEEP, AUTO }
++ Previously this was only available in its earlier form, REMOTE
++ SET INCOMPLETE (no FILE). The earlier form is still available,
++ but invisible. Also, AUTO was added, meaning KEEP if in binary
++ mode, DISCARD otherwise.
++
++ REMOTE SET TRANSFER MODE { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL }
++ Tells the client to ask the server to set the given
++ file-transfer mode. Automatic means (roughly): if the client
++ and the server are running on the same kind of computer (e.g.
++ both are on UNIX), then use binary mode automatically; if the
++ system types are different, use some other method to
++ automatically determine text or binary mode, such as filename
++ pattern matching. MANUAL means, in this context, obey the
++ client's FILE TYPE setting (TEXT or BINARY). Synonym: REMOTE
++ SET XFER MODE.
++
++ [ REMOTE ] QUERY KERMIT function(args...)
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the arguments were not evaluated
++ locally. Thus it was not possible to have the server run the
++ function with client-side variables as arguments. Now:
++
++ define \%a oofa.*
++ remote query kermit files(\%a) ; Client's \%a
++ remote query kermit files(\\%a) ; Server's \%a
++
++ [ REMOTE ] LOGIN [ user [ password ] ]
++ LOGIN is now a synonym for REMOTE LOGIN.
++
++ LOGOUT
++ This command, when given in local mode, is equivalent to REMOTE
++ LOGOUT. When given at the IKSD prompt, it logs out the IKSD.
++ When given at the C-Kermit prompt when it has no connection, it
++ does nothing.
++
++ Note that in C-Kermit 7.0, the REMOTE (or R) prefix is not required
++ for QUERY, since there is no local QUERY command. The new top-level
++ QUERY command does exactly what REMOTE QUERY (RQUERY) does.
++
++ All REMOTE commands now have single-word shortcuts:
++
++ Shortcut Full Form
++ RASG REMOTE ASSIGN
++ RCD REMOTE CD
++ RCOPY REMOTE COPY
++ RDEL REMOTE DELETE
++ RDIR REMOTE DIRECTORY
++ REXIT REMOTE EXIT
++ RHELP REMOTE HELP
++ RHOST REMOTE HOST
++ RPWD REMOTE PWD
++ RSET REMOTE SET
++ etc.
++
++ The R prefix is not applied to LOGIN because there is already an
++ RLOGIN command with a different meaning. It is not applied to LOGOUT
++ either, since LOGOUT knows what to do in each case, and for symmetry
++ with LOGIN.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.2.1. Remote Procedure Definitions and Calls
++
++ This is nothing new, but it might not be obvious... REMOTE ASSIGN and
++ REMOTE QUERY may be used to achieve remote procedure execution. The
++ remote procedure can be defined locally or remotely.
++
++ A remote procedure call is accomplished as noted in the previous
++ section:
++
++ [ remote ] query kermit function-name(args...)
++
++ This invokes any function that is built in to the Kermit server, e.g.:
++
++ [ remote ] query kermit size(foo.bar)
++
++ returns the size of the remote file, foo.bar.
++
++ Now note that C-Kermit includes an \fexecute() function, allowing it
++ to execute any macro as if it were a built-in function. So suppose
++ MYMACRO is the name of a macro defined in the server. You can execute
++ it from the client as follows (the redundant "remote" prefix is
++ omitted in the remaining examples):
++
++ query kermit execute(mymacro arg1 arg2...)
++
++ The return value, if any, is the value of the RETURN command that
++ terminated execution of the macro, for example:
++
++ define addtwonumbers return \feval(\%1+\%2)
++
++ The client invocation would be:
++
++ query kermit execute(addtwonumbers 3 4)
++ 7
++
++ The result ("7" in this case) is also assigned to the client's
++ \v(query) variable.
++
++ To execute a remote system command or command procedure (shell script,
++ etc) use:
++
++ query kermit command(name args...)
++
++ Finally, suppose you want the client to send a macro to the server to
++ be executed on the server end. This is done as follows:
++
++ remote assign macroname definition
++ query kermit execute(macroname arg1 arg2...)
++
++ Quoting is required if the definition contains formal parameters.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.3. New Server Capabilities
++
++ 5.3.1. Creating and Removing Directories
++
++ The C-Kermit 7.0 server responds to REMOTE MKDIR and REMOTE RMDIR
++ commands. The directory name may be in either the native format of the
++ server's computer, or in UNIX format. For example, a server running on
++ VMS with a current directory of [IVAN] can accept commands from the
++ client like:
++
++ remote mkdir olga ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (nonspecific format)
++ remote mkdir .olga ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (VMS format without brackets)
++ remote mkdir olga/ ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (UNIX relative format)
++ remote mkdir /ivan/olga ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (UNIX absolute format)
++ remote mkdir [ivan.olga] ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (VMS absolute format)
++ remote mkdir [.olga] ; Makes [IVAN.OLGA] (VMS relative format)
++
++ 5.3.1.1. Creating Directories
++
++ If a directory name is given that contains more than one segment that
++ does not exist, the server attempts to create all the segments. For
++ example, if the client says:
++
++ REMOTE MKDIR letters/angry
++
++ a "letters" subdirectory is created in the server's current directory
++ if it does not already exist, and then an "angry" subdirectory is
++ created beneath it, if it does not already have one. This can repeated
++ to any reasonable depth:
++
++ REMOTE MKDIR a/b/c/d/e/f/g/h/i/j/k/l/m/n/o/p/q/r/s/t/u/v/w/z/y/z
++
++ 5.3.1.2. Removing Directories
++
++ When attempting to execute a REMOTE RMDIR, the server can remove only
++ a single directory, not an entire sequence or tree. The system service
++ that is called to remove the directory generally requires not only
++ that the server process has write delete access, but also that the
++ directory contain no files.
++
++ In the future, a REMOTE RMDIR /RECURSIVE command (and the accompanying
++ protocol) might be added. For now, use the equivalent REMOTE HOST
++ command(s), if any.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.3.2. Directory Listings
++
++ Directory listings are generated by C-Kermit itself, rather than by
++ running the underlying system's directory command. Some control over
++ the listing format can be obtained with the SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY
++ command ([532]Section 4.5.1). The following options affect listings
++ sent by the server: /[NO]HEADING, /[NO]DOTFILES, and /[NO]BACKUP. In
++ UNIX and VMS, the listing is always sorted by filename. There is, at
++ present, no protocol defined for the client to request listing options
++ of the server; this might be added in the future.
++
++ The server's directory listings are in the following format:
++
++ Protection or permissions:
++ In UNIX and OS-9, this is a 10-character field, left adjusted.
++ In VMS it is a 22-character field, left-adjusted. In each case,
++ the protection / permission codes are shown in the server
++ platform's native format. In other operating systems, this
++ field is not shown.
++
++ Size in bytes:
++ This is always a 10-character field. The file's size is shown
++ as a decimal number, right adjusted in the field. If the file
++ is a directory and its size can not be obtained, the size is
++ shown as "<DIR>". Two blanks follow this field.
++
++ Date:
++ Always in yyyy-mm-dd hh:mm:ss numeric format, and therefore 19
++ characters long. If the file's date/time can't be obtained,
++ zeros (0) are shown for all the digits. This field is followed
++ by two blanks.
++
++ Filename:
++ This field extends to the end of the line. Filenames are shown
++ relative to the server's current directory. In UNIX, symbolic
++ links are shown as they are in an "ls -l" listing as "linkname
++ -> filename".
++
++ In UNIX and VMS, listings are returned by the server in alphabetical
++ order of filename. There are presently no other sort or selection
++ options.
++
++ However, since these are fixed-field listings, all fields can be used
++ as sort keys by external sort programs. Note, in particular, that the
++ format used for the date allows a normal lexical on that field to
++ achieve the date ordering. For example, let's assume we have a UNIX
++ client and a UNIX server. In this case, the server's listing has the
++ date in columns 22-40, and thus could be sorted by the UNIX sort
++ program using "sort +0.22 -0.40" or in reverse order by "sort +0.22
++ -0.40r".
++
++ Since the UNIX client can pipe responses to REMOTE commands through
++ filters, any desired sorting can be accomplished this way, for
++ example:
++
++C-Kermit> remote directory | sort +0.22 -0.40
++
++ You can also sort by size:
++
++ C-Kermit> remote directory | sort +0.11 -0.19
++
++ You can use sort options to select reverse or ascending order. "man
++ sort" (in UNIX) for more information. And of course, you can pipe
++ these listings through any other filter of your choice, such as grep
++ to skip unwanted lines.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.4. Syntax for Remote Filenames with Embedded Spaces
++
++ C-Kermit and K95, when in server mode, assume that any spaces in the
++ file specification in an incoming GET command are filename separators.
++ Thus if the client gives a command like:
++
++ get {oofa.txt oofa.bin}
++
++ or, equivalently:
++
++ mget oofa.txt oofa.bin
++
++ the server tries to send the two files, oofa.txt and oofa.bin. But
++ what if you want the server to send you a file named, say:
++
++ D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL
++
++ How does the server know this is supposed to be one file and not
++ seven? In this case, you need to the send file name to the server
++ enclosed in either curly braces:
++
++ {D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}
++
++ or ASCII doublequotes:
++
++ "D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL"
++
++ The method for doing this depends on your client. If your client is
++ C-Kermit 7.0, any recent version of Kermit 95, or MS-DOS Kermit 3.16,
++ then you have to enclose the name in braces just so the client can
++ parse it, so to send braces or doublequotes to the server, you must
++ put them inside the first, outside pair of braces. And you also need
++ to double the backslashes to prevent them from being interpreted:
++
++ get {{D:\\HP OfficeJet 500\\Images\\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}}
++ get {"D:\\HP OfficeJet 500\\Images\\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL"}
++
++ To get around the requirement to double backslashes in literal
++ filenames, of course you can also use:
++
++ set command quoting off
++ get {{D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}}
++ get {"D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL"}
++ set command quoting on
++
++ If you are giving a "kermit" command to the UNIX shell, you have to
++ observe the shell's quoting rules, something like this:
++
++ kermit -ig "{D:\HP OfficeJet 500\Images\My Pretty Picture Dot PCL}"
++
++ Here, the quotes go on the outside so UNIX will pass the entire
++ filename, spaces, braces, and all, as a single argument to Kermit, and
++ the backslashes are not doubled because (a) the UNIX shell ignores
++ them since they are in a quoted string, and (b) Kermit ignores them
++ since the interactive command parser is not activated in this case.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.5. Automatic Orientation Messages upon Directory Change
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0, when acting as a server, can send an orientation message
++ to the client whenever the server directory changes. For example, when
++ the client gives a REMOTE CD command, the server sends the contents of
++ the new directory's "Read Me" file to the client's screen. The
++ following commands govern this feature:
++
++ SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE FILE name
++ Given to the servr, allows the message-file name to be
++ specified at runtime. A list of names to look for can be given
++ in the following format:
++
++ {{name1}{name2}{name3}{...}}
++
++ e.g. SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE FILE
++ {{./.readme}{README.TXT}{READ.ME}}
++
++ REMOTE SET SERVER CD-MESSAGE { ON, OFF }
++ Given to the client, lets the client control whether the server
++ sends automatic CD messages.
++
++ SHOW SERVER
++ Given to server, includes CD-Message status.
++
++ The default CD message file name is system dependent. SHOW CD or SHOW
++ SERVER displays the list. Also see [533]Section 4.5.2.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.6. New Server Controls
++
++ DISABLE ENABLE
++ Allows the server to configured such that DISABLEd features can
++ not be re-enabled by any means -- e.g. if the client is somehow
++ able to get the server into command mode. Once DISABLEd, ENABLE
++ can not be re-ENABLEd.
++
++ SET SERVER IDLE-TIMEOUT seconds
++ This was available previously in Kermit 95 only. Now it can be
++ used in C-Kermit also to specify a maximum number of seconds
++ the server is allowed to be idle before exiting server mode. 0
++ seconds means no idle timeout. In C-Kermit (but not K-95), SET
++ SERVER TIMEOUT and SET SERVER IDLE-TIMEOUT are mutually
++ exclusive -- you can have one or the other (or neither), but
++ not both. (Server timeouts are for the benefit of primitive
++ Kermit clients that are not capable of timing out on their own;
++ to our knowledge, no such clients are still in circulation.)
++
++ SET SERVER KEEPALIVE { ON, OFF }
++ (See next section).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5.7. Timeouts during REMOTE HOST Command Execution
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the C-Kermit server would block waiting for
++ output from a system command invoked via REMOTE HOST from the client.
++ If the system command took a long time to execute, the client would
++ time out and send NAK packets. If the command took too long, the
++ client would reach its retry limit and give up. Even if it didn't, the
++ NAKs would cause unnecessary retransmissions.
++
++ In version 7.0, the C-Kermit server (VMS and select()-capable UNIX
++ versions only), sends "keepalive packets" (empty data packets) once
++ per second while waiting for the system command to complete. This
++ procedure should be entirely transparent to the Kermit client, and
++ should prevent the unwanted timeouts and NAKs. When C-Kermit 7.0
++ itself (or K95 1.1.19) is the client, it prints dots to show the
++ keepalive packets.
++
++ The keepalive feature can be turned off and on with:
++
++ SET SERVER KEEPALIVE { ON, OFF }
++
++ Normally it should be on. Turn it off it if causes trouble with the
++ client, or if it seems to slow down the server (as it might on some
++ platforms under certain circumstances).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6. INTERNATIONAL CHARACTER SETS
++
++ Support for several new single-byte character sets was added in
++ C-Kermit 7.0. Unicode / ISO 10646 is not yet supported, but is a high
++ priority for forthcoming releases.
++
++ 6.0. ISO 8859-15 Latin Alphabet 9
++
++ To accommodate the Euro currency symbol, and to correct several other
++ longstanding problems with ISO Latin Alphabet 1, ISO 8859-15 Latin
++ Alphabet 9 was issued in May 1998. It is supported by C-Kermit 7.0 as
++ a transfer character set, a file character set, and a terminal
++ character set. Translations that preserve the new characters are
++ available between Latin-9 and several other sets including:
++
++ PC Code Page 858 (Western European languages, similar to CP850)
++ Windows Code Page 1252 (Western European languages, similar to Latin-1)
++ Windows Code Page 1250 (Eastern European languages, similar to Latin-2)
++
++ The Latin-9 transfer character set also allows for the OE digraph
++ character, used primarily in French, to be preserved in transfers
++ involving the DEC MCS or NeXT character sets.
++
++ The Euro character is also present in the Universal Character Set,
++ described in [534]Section 6.6.
++
++ 6.1. The HP-Roman8 Character Set
++
++ The HP-Roman8 character set is supported in C-Kermit 6.0 and later but
++ was omitted from Table VII-4 in the 2nd Edition of Using C-Kermit due
++ to lack of space. It is listed in [535]Appendix III.
++
++ 6.2. Greek Character Sets
++
++ Greek character sets were added in 6.1:
++
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { CP869, ELOT927, GREEK-ISO }
++ SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { GREEK-ISO }
++
++ GREEK-ISO is ISO 8859-7, which the same as ELOT 928.
++
++ The new Greek character sets are listed in [536]Appendix III.
++
++ 6.3. Additional Latin-2 Character Sets
++
++ The following have been added as FILE and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SETs:
++
++ MAZOVIA-PC
++ A PC code page used in Poland, equivalent to CP437, but with 18
++ substitutions needed for Polish.
++
++ CP1250
++ The Windows Latin 2 Code Page. Equivalent to ISO 8859-2, but
++ with different encoding.
++
++ 6.4. Additional Cyrillic Character Sets
++
++ The following have been added as FILE and TERMINAL CHARACTER-SETs:
++
++ BULGARIA-PC
++ This is the Cyrillic PC code page used in Bulgaria, where it is
++ called Code Page 856. It is attributed to a company called
++ DATEC, Inc, but CP856 is not a proper designation, since it
++ refers to a Hebrew Code Page (see the IBM Registry).
++
++ CP855
++ This PC Code Page contains all the Cyrillic letters that are
++ also in ISO 8859-5, and is therefore useful for non-Russian
++ Cyrillic text (Ukrainian, Belorussian, etc), unlike CP866,
++ which has a smaller repertoire of Cyrillic letters.
++
++ CP1251
++ The Windows Cyrillic Code Page. Equivalent to CP855, but with
++ different encoding.
++
++ KOI8R
++ An extension to "Old KOI-8" that adds upper and lower case
++ Cyrillic letter Io (looks like Roman E with diaeresis) plus a
++ selection of box-drawing characters to columns 8 through 11,
++ which are vacant in original Old KOI-8. KOI8-R is used for the
++ Russian language. It is specified in [537]RFC 1489.
++
++ KOI8U
++ A similar extension of Old KOI-8, but for Ukrainian. It is
++ specified in [538]RFC 2319.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.5. Automatic Character-Set Switching
++
++ Prior to version 7.0, C-Kermit's file character-set always had to be
++ set explicitly. In 7.0 and later, it is set automatically when:
++
++ 1. This feature is enabled (as it is unless you disable it).
++ 2. An incoming text-mode transfer includes a transfer-character-set
++ announcer and you have not previously given a SET FILE
++ CHARACTER-SET command. In this case, C-Kermit switches to an
++ appropriate file character set. For example, on an HP-UX
++ workstation, an incoming Latin-1 file automatically selects
++ HP-Roman8 for the local copy of the file; in Data General AOS/VS,
++ it would select DG International.
++ 3. You give a SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET command without having
++ previously specified a FILE CHARACTER-SET. An appropriate file
++ character-set is chosen automatically.
++
++ In addition, when you give a SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command, the
++ appropriate transfer character-set is automatically chosen, to be used
++ when you are sending files (but this does not override the one
++ announced by the sender when you are receiving files).
++
++ You might not agree about what is "appropriate", so of course you can
++ disable or change all of the above actions.
++
++ You can disable (or re-enable) the new automatic character-set
++ switching feature in each direction separately:
++
++ SET RECEIVE CHARACTER-SET-SELECTION { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL }
++ AUTOMATIC is the default, causing the behavior described above
++ when an incoming file arrives. Choose MANUAL to defeat this
++ behavior and force your current FILE CHARACTER-SET setting to
++ be used, no matter what it is. Note that SET RECEIVE
++ CHARACTER-SET MANUAL does not disable recognition of the
++ incoming transfer character-set announcer, and translation from
++ the corresponding character-set to your current file
++ character-set. To disable that, use SET ATTRIBUTE CHARACTER-SET
++ OFF.
++
++ SET SEND CHARACTER-SET-SELECTION { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL }
++ Again AUTOMATIC is the default, causing the behavior described
++ above when you give a SET { FILE, TRANSFER } CHARACTER-SET
++ command. Use MANUAL to allow you to specify the transfer and
++ file character-sets independently.
++
++ SHOW CHARACTER-SETS
++ Tells settings of { SEND, RECEIVE } CHARACTER-SET-SELECTION.
++
++ Normally, however, it is more convenient to leave automatic switching
++ active, and change any associations that are not appropriate for your
++ application, area, or country. The commands are:
++
++ SHOW ASSOCIATIONS
++ This command lists all the associations in each direction: for
++ each possible transfer character-set, it lists the associated
++ file character-set, and vice versa. These are two separate and
++ independent lists.
++
++ ASSOCIATE TRANSFER-CHARACTER-SET name1 [ name2 ]
++ Changes the association for the transfer character-set name1 to
++ be the file character-set name2. If name2 is omitted, automatic
++ switching is disabled for this transfer character-set only.
++
++ ASSOCIATE FILE-CHARACTER-SET name1 [ name2 ]
++ Changes the association for the file character-set name1 to be
++ the transfer character-set name2. If name2 is omitted,
++ automatic switching is disabled for this file character-set
++ only.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6. UNICODE
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds support for Unicode, the Universal Character Set,
++ for:
++
++ * File Transfer (SEND, RECEIVE, GET, etc)
++ * Terminal connection (CONNECT)
++ * Unguarded file capture (LOG SESSION)
++ * Unguarded file transmission (TRANSMIT)
++ * Local file character-set conversion (TRANSLATE)
++
++ C-Kermit is not, however, a "Unicode application" in the sense that
++ its commands, messages, or user interface are Unicode. Rather, it is
++ "Unicode aware" in its ability to handle and convert Unicode text in
++ the course of file transfer and terminal connection, and you can also
++ use Kermit to convert local files between Unicode and other character
++ sets. TLA's:
++
++ BMP - Base Multilingual Plane
++ BOM - Byte Order Mark
++ CJK - Chinese, Japanese, and Korean
++ ISO - International Standards Organization
++ TLA - Three-Letter Acronym
++ UCS - Universal Character Set
++ UTF - UCS Transformation Format
++
++ Unicode and ISO 10646 are the coordinated and compatible corporate and
++ international standards for the Universal Character Set (UCS). Unlike
++ single-byte and even most multibyte character sets, the UCS can
++ represent all characters in every existing writing system. A flat
++ plain-text file encoded in some form of UCS can contain any mixture of
++ English, Spanish, Italian, German, Hebrew, Arabic, Greek, Russian,
++ Armenian, Georgian, Japanese, Chinese, Korean, Vietnamese, Tibetan,
++ Hindi, Bengali, Tamil, Thai, Ethiopic, and so on, plus scientific and
++ mathematical notation, as well as texts in Runes, Ogham, Glagolitic,
++ and other historic scripts.
++
++ The UCS already covers these scripts and many more, but it's an
++ evolving standard with efforts underway to accommodate even more
++ languages and writing systems. Support is growing for native UCS use
++ on many platforms and in many applications. The goal of the framers of
++ the UCS is for it to replace ASCII, the ISO Latin Alphabets, ISCII,
++ VISCII, the Chinese, Japanese, and Korean (CJK) multibyte sets, etc,
++ as well as the many private character sets in use today, in other
++ words to become *the* Universal Character Set.
++
++ Until that time, however, conversions between existing sets and the
++ UCS will be necessary when moving text between platforms and
++ applications. Now Kermit can help.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.1. Overview of Unicode
++
++ For a more complete picture, please visit:
++
++ [539]http://www.unicode.org/
++
++ and access the various online introductions, FAQs, technical reports,
++ and other information. For greater depth, order the latest version of
++ the published Unicode Standard. The following overview contains a
++ great many oversimplifications and perhaps an opinion or two.
++
++ At present, the UCS is a 16-bit (2-byte) character set, but with
++ provisions to grow to a 4-byte set. UCS-2 refers to the two-byte set,
++ also called the Base Multilingual Plane (BMP), in which each character
++ has 16 bits, and therefore there are 2^16 = 65536 possible characters.
++ The first 128 characters are the same as US ASCII (C0 control
++ characters and DEL included), the next 32 are the C1 control
++ characters of ISO 6429, and the next 96 are the Right Half of ISO
++ 8859-1 Latin Alphabet 1. The remaining tens of thousands of characters
++ are arranged newly for the UCS, usually (but not always) in sections
++ corresponding to existing standards, such as ISO Latin/Cyrillic, often
++ plus additional characters not appearing in the existing standards due
++ to lack of space (or other reasons).
++
++ ISO 10646 allows for additional planes, e.g. for Egyptian
++ hieroglyphics or ancient (or other esoteric) CJK characters, but these
++ planes are not yet defined and so we will say nothing more about them
++ here, except that their use will require the 4-byte form of UCS,
++ called UCS-4, in some form (more about "forms" in [540]Section 6.6.2).
++
++ Unicode and ISO 10646 are constantly under revision, mainly to add new
++ characters. The Unicode revision is denoted by a version number, such
++ as 1.0, 1.1, 2.0, 3.0. The ISO 10646 standard revision is identified
++ by Edition (such as ISO 10646-1 1993), plus reference to any
++ amendments. The first versions of these standards included encodings
++ for Korean Hangul syllables (Jamos); these encodings were changed in
++ version 1.1 of Unicode and by Amendment 5 to ISO 10646-1. The Unicode
++ Technical Committee and the ISO acknowledge that this was a bad thing
++ to do, and promise never change encodings or character names again,
++ since this poses serious problems for conformance and data
++ interchange.
++
++ A UCS-2 value is customarily written like this:
++
++ U+xxxx
++
++ where "xxxx" represents four hexadecimal digits, 0-9 and A-F. For
++ example, U+0041 is "A", U+00C1 is A-acute, U+042F is uppercase
++ Cyrillic "Ya", U+FB4F is Hebrew Ligature Alef Lamed, and U+FFFD is the
++ special character that means "not a character".
++
++ Most characters from widely-used alphabetic writing systems such as
++ the West European ones, Cyrillic, Greek, Hebrew, Vietnamese, etc, are
++ available in "precomposed" form; for example Uppercase Latin Letter A
++ with Acute Accent is a single character (as it is in Latin-1).
++ However, the UCS also permits composition of a base character with one
++ or more nonspacing diacritics. This means the same character can be
++ represented in more than one way, which can present problems in many
++ application areas, including transfer and character-set conversion of
++ text.
++
++ Conversion from ASCII or Latin-1 to UCS-2 text is "trivial": simply
++ insert a NUL (0) byte before each ASCII or Latin-1 byte. Converting in
++ the reverse direction (provided the UCS-2 file contains only U+0000 to
++ U+00FF) is equally simple (if we ignore the issue of composition):
++ remove every second (NUL) byte. Conversion of other character sets to
++ and from UCS, however, requires tables or algorithms specific to each
++ set. Nevertheless, the relatively transparent upwards compatibility
++ from ASCII and Latin-1, in which a very large share of the world's
++ textual data is encoded, gives the UCS an entree onto existing
++ platforms.
++
++ But the 2-byte format and the preponderance of NUL and other control
++ bytes in UCS-2 text pose problems for current applications and
++ transmission methods. And to make matters worse, different hardware
++ platforms store UCS-2 characters in different byte order. Thus a UCS-2
++ file transferred by FTP (or accessed via NFS, etc) between two
++ computers with different architecture might have its bytes in the
++ wrong order (or worse; see [541]Section 6.6.5.1 ).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.2. UCS Byte Order
++
++ Consider the number 1. In an 8-bit byte, this would be represented by
++ the following series of 0- and 1-bits:
++
++ +-----------------+
++ | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 |
++ +-----------------+
++
++ Therefore in a 16-bit "word" the representation might be:
++
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++ | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 |
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++
++ Now consider the number 256, which is 2 to the 8th power. The binary
++ representation is 100000000 (1 followed by 8 zeros). 256 would go into
++ a 16-bit word like this:
++
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++ | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 |
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++
++ When a computer works this way, it is said to be Big Endian, meaning
++ it puts the most significant (biggest) byte first (on the "left") in a
++ 16-bit word, and the least significant byte second (on the right).
++
++ However, some other computers have the opposite arrangement, called
++ Little Endian, in which 1 is:
++
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++ | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 |
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++
++ and 256 is:
++
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++ | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 | 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 |
++ +-----------------+-----------------+
++
++ Computers such as Sparc, MIPS, PA-RISC, and PowerPC are Big Endian,
++ whereas the PC and the Alpha are Little Endian. Endianness has never
++ been an issue with 7- or 8-bit characters, but it is with UCS
++ characters. It can be a tricky business to share or transfer a UCS-2
++ file between two different kinds of computers.
++
++ To alleviate (but not entirely solve) the problem, UCS-2 files are
++ supposed to begin with the Unicode character U+FEFF, Zero-Width
++ No-Break Space (ZWNBS). This is a kind of "no-op" (note: any such
++ assertion must normally be qualified with many "but ifs" and "excepts"
++ which are omitted here in the interest of brevity). If the bytes are
++ reversed the ZWNBS becomes U+FFFE, which is not (and never will be) a
++ defined UCS character. U+FEFF at the beginning of a UCS file is
++ therefore called a Byte Order Mark, or BOM.
++
++ Any application that creates a UCS-2 (or UTF-16, or UCS-4) file should
++ include a BOM, and any application that reads one should test for a
++ BOM, and if one is found, infer the byte order from it. This is a
++ convention, however -- not a standard or a requirement -- and
++ applications vary in their ability to handle BOMs and "backwards"
++ UCS-2 files.
++
++ Note that a BOM is useful only at the beginning of a file. If you
++ append one UCS-2 file to another, and both have BOMs, the internal BOM
++ is no longer a BOM. And if the byte orders of the two files differ,
++ then either the first part or the second will be backwards. (Various
++ other undesirable effects might also occur, not discussed here.)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.2. UCS Transformation Formats
++
++ UCS textual data can be modified in various ways for transmission or
++ storage. Any officially sanctioned method of doing this is called a
++ UCS Transformation Format, or UTF. One such method, called UTF-16, is
++ essentially identical with UCS-2 except that it designates certain
++ code values as "escape sequences" (called surrogate pairs) to access
++ characters in other planes without having to use full UCS-4. We won't
++ discuss UTF-16 further here, since at the moment there are no other
++ planes. Several other UTF's (such as UTF-1, UTF-2, and UTF-7) have
++ fallen into disuse and are not discussed here. The most important
++ transformation format today is UTF-8.
++
++ UTF-8, so called because it "serializes" UCS-2 data into a stream of
++ 8-bit bytes, is designed to allow the UCS to work with present-day
++ communications gear, computers, and software. The most important
++ properties of UTF-8 are that byte order is constant (no byte swapping)
++ and all (7-bit) ASCII characters represent themselves. Therefore
++ conversion between ASCII and UTF-8 is no conversion at all, and
++ applications or platforms (such as Plan 9 from Bell Labs) that use
++ UTF-8 "for everything" can still run traditional ASCII-only
++ applications and be accessed from them. In particular, unlike UCS-2,
++ ASCII characters are not padded with NUL bytes. But also unlike UCS-2,
++ there is no transparency for Latin-1 or any other non-ASCII character
++ set. Every non-ASCII UCS-2 character is represented by a sequence of 2
++ or 3 UTF-8 bytes. Thus UTF-8 is more compact than UCS-2 for text
++ containing a preponderance of ABC's (or other ASCII characters), about
++ the same as UCS-2 for other alphabetic scripts (Cyrillic, Roman,
++ Greek, etc), and larger than UCS-2 for Chinese, Japanese, and Korean.
++
++ The UTF-8 uncoding of the UCS has been adopted by the Internet as the
++ preferred character set for new applications, and is gradually being
++ retrofitted into traditional applications like FTP ([542]RFC 2640).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.3. Conformance Levels
++
++ Although the Unicode and ISO 10646 standards both describe the same
++ character set, these standards differ in many ways, including their
++ stated requirements for conformance and their classification of
++ conformance levels.
++
++ Kermit has always abided by ISO character-set standards, including ISO
++ character-set designation and invocation methods. In adapting Unicode,
++ therefore, we had to choose from among the available ISO designations
++ which, in turn, correspond with ISO 10646 conformance levels. At
++ present, Kermit claims the lowest conformance level, 1, meaning
++ (roughly) that it does not handle combining forms and it does not
++ handle Korean Hangul Jamos (just as, at present, it does not handle
++ Korean in general). Note that ISO 10646 Conformance Levels 1 and 2
++ sidestep the issue of the code changes for Korean Hangul by announcing
++ non-support for Hangul regardless of encoding.
++
++ ISO 10646 Conformance Level 1 is approximately equivalent to Unicode
++ Normalization Form C (described in Unicode Technical Report 15,
++ incorporated into Unicode 3.0).
++
++ As noted in [543]Section 6.6.2, Kermit does not claim to support
++ UTF-16 at the present time, hence the UCS-2 nomenclature. Kermit
++ treats surrogates just as if they were any other UCS-2 characters,
++ rather than as escapes to other planes, which means that (except when
++ converting between UCS-2 and UTF-8) they are translated to "error"
++ characters, since (a) no other planes are defined yet (and if they
++ were, no other character sets supported by Kermit would encode their
++ characters), and (b) no valid surrogate character corresponds to any
++ other UCS-2 character.
++
++ A minor yet significant aspect of Unicode 3.0 and some recent
++ perturbation of ISO 10646-1 (probably Amendment 18, "Symbols and Other
++ Characters") is the addition of the Euro Sign at U+20AC. As noted in
++ [544]Section 6.0, Kermit's "Euro compliance" includes conversion
++ between Latin Alphabet 9 and various PC code pages. Text can also be
++ converted between UCS-2 or UTF-8 and any other Euro-compliant
++ character set (Latin-9, CP858, CP1250, CP1252) without loss of the
++ Euro Sign.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.4. Relationship of Unicode with Kermit's Other Character Sets
++
++ Kermit's character sets are divided into two groups: single-byte sets
++ (such as Roman, Hebrew, Cyrillic, Greek) and multibyte (various
++ Japanese sets). The two groups are distinct since one normally would
++ not expect to convert Kanji ideograms to Roman (or other) letters, or
++ vice versa.
++
++ Unicode character-set conversion works with both groups, but obviously
++ the result depends on the repertoires of the source and destination
++ character-sets both including the characters in the file. For example,
++ you can translate a Hungarian text file between Latin-2 and Unicode,
++ but not between (say) Unicode and Latin/Greek. By the same token you
++ can convert Japanese text from Shift-JIS or EUC or JIS-7 to Unicode
++ and back, but you can't convert the same file to (say) Latin-1 if it
++ contains Japanese characters.
++
++ JIS-7 is equivalent to DEC Kanji and ISO-2022-JP except that the
++ latter two do not support halfwidth Katakana. Kermit treats all
++ three of these sets the same way, i.e. as JIS-7.
++
++ As noted, Kermit presently does not handle combining diacritics, and
++ so will not correctly convert UCS files that use them into a
++ single-byte character set. For example, if a UCS file contains Latin
++ Capital Letter A (U+0041) followed by Combining Acute Accent (U+0301),
++ the result will be a two-character sequence, A followed by another
++ character. This is what is meant by Conformance Level 1. (The
++ situation grows worse with multiple diacritics, since they can occur
++ in any order.)
++
++ A higher level of conformance is possible, in which "canonical
++ equivalences" are handled via algorithms and databases, at some
++ (perhaps considerable) cost in performance, since a fair amount of
++ additional code must be executed for every character during data
++ transfer (database lookup, sorting of combining sequences into
++ canonical order, etc). This can be added in future releases if there
++ is a need (but in many cases, pre- and postpostprocessing might be a
++ better option).
++
++ Within these constraints, Kermit converts between the UCS and its
++ other character sets. For example, a mixture of Russian and English
++ (and/or Dutch, or Latin) text can bet converted between the UCS and
++ ISO Latin/Cyrillic or KOI-8. But since Kermit does not presently
++ support Arabic character-set conversion, the new availability of UCS
++ conversion does not mean that Kermit can convert from Arabic UCS text
++ to some other character set, because Kermit does not support any other
++ character set that includes Arabic. Ditto for Thai, Armenian,
++ Georgian, Tibetan, Chinese, Korean, etc. However, Kermit CAN convert
++ Arabic (or any other script) between UCS-2 and UTF-8.
++
++ Considering Cyrillic more carefully, note that the UCS also contains
++ numerous Cyrillic characters not found in any of the Cyrillic sets
++ (ISO Latin/Cyrillic, KOI8, CP866, etc) that Kermit supports;
++ characters needed for Abkhasian, Yakut, Tatar, Bashkir, Altaic, Old
++ Church Slavonic, etc; UCS text containing any of these historic or
++ "extended" Cyrillic characters can not be converted to any of Kermit's
++ current single-byte Cyrillic sets without loss. The situation is
++ similar for Greek, Hebrew, etc, and even worse for Japanese since
++ Unicode contains thousands of Kanjis that are lacking from the
++ Japanese character sets based on JIS X 0208, such as EUC-JP, JIS-7,
++ and Shift-JIS.
++
++ In general, when converting from UCS to a single-byte set, there is
++ always the possibility of data loss, just as there is when converting
++ from any larger set to a smaller one. For example, if a UCS file
++ contains Devanagari characters, these characters will be lost when
++ converting to (say) Latin-1, just as Roman vowels with acute accents
++ are lost when converting from Latin-1 (an 8-bit set) to German ISO 646
++ (a 7-bit set).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.5. Kermit's Unicode Features
++
++ C-Kermit can convert between UCS-2 or UTF-8 and any of its other
++ character sets, and also between UCS-2 and UTF-8. When converting
++ between UCS-2 or UTF-8 and a non-Unicode character set (such as
++ Latin-1), the UCS Line Separator (LS, U+2028) and Paragraph Separator
++ (PS, U+2029) characters are converted to the appropriate line
++ terminator (CR, LF, or CRLF). When converting from a non-Unicode set
++ to UCS-2 or UTF-8, however, line terminators are not converted to LS
++ or PS. This is in accordance with the recommendations of Unicode
++ Technical Report #13.
++
++ When C-Kermit starts, it tests the native byte order of the computer.
++ You can see the result in the SHOW FEATURES or SHOW FILE display. It's
++ also available in the variable \v(byteorder): 0 means Big Endian, 1
++ means Little Endian.
++
++ When UCS-2 is involved in file transfer or translation, the following
++ commands tell C-Kermit what to do about byte order:
++
++ SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER { BIG-ENDIAN, LITTLE-ENDIAN }
++ This is for reading UCS-2 files that don't have a BOM, and also
++ for writing UCS-2 files. If this command is not given, the
++ machine's native byte order is used when writing UCS-2 files,
++ and also when reading UCS-2 files that don't have a BOM.
++
++ SET FILE UCS BOM { ON, OFF }
++ This setting is used when creating UCS-2 files. A BOM is added
++ at the beginning by default. Use OFF to not add the BOM. This
++ command has no affect when writing files.
++
++ COPY /SWAP-BYTES sourcefile destinationfile
++ Use this for fixing a UCS-2 file whose bytes are in the wrong
++ order.
++
++ Use SHOW FILE to display the FILE UCS settings.
++
++ Please note, again, that C-Kermit's user interface, including its
++ script language, is not internationalized in any way. String
++ comparisons, case conversion, and so on, work only for US ASCII
++ (comparisons for equality work with other sets, but not
++ lexically-greater-or-less-than or caseless comparisons; even
++ comparisons for equality can fail when composed characters or byte
++ order are involved). String functions such as \findex() and
++ \fsubstring() that reference byte positions do just that; they won't
++ work with UTF-8 text that contains any non-ASCII characters, and they
++ will not work with UCS-2 text at all since they use C strings
++ internally, which are NUL-terminated. These are just a few examples to
++ illustrate that neither Unicode nor any other character-set beyond
++ ASCII is supported at the user-interface, command, or scripting level
++ in this version of C-Kermit.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.5.1. File Transfer
++
++ Kermit supports both UCS-2 and UTF-8 as file and transfer character
++ sets in text-mode file transfer.
++
++ To select UCS-2 or UTF-8 as a file character-set, use:
++
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { UCS2, UTF8 }
++
++ If you want to send a UCS-2 text file (or save an incoming file in
++ UCS-2 format), tell Kermit to:
++
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET UCS2
++
++ and if you want to send a UTF-8 text file (or store an incoming file
++ in UTF-8 format), tell Kermit to:
++
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET UTF8
++
++ When sending UCS-2 files, Kermit determines the byte order from the
++ BOM, if there is one (and if there is a BOM, it is stripped, i.e. not
++ sent). If there is no BOM, the byte order is the one specified in the
++ most recent SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER command, if any, otherwise the
++ computer's native byte order is assumed. When storing incoming files
++ as UCS-2, the byte order is according SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER, if
++ given, otherwise the native one; a BOM is written according to SET
++ FILE UCS BOM.
++
++ A transfer character-set should be chosen that includes all of the
++ characters in the source file. So, for example, if you are sending a
++ UCS-2 file containing only German-language text, your transfer
++ character-set can be Latin-1, Latin-2, Latin-9, UCS-2, or UTF-8. But
++ if you are sending a file that contains a combination of Hebrew and
++ Greek, your transfer character-set must be UCS-2 or UTF-8 if you don't
++ want to lose one script or the other. Furthermore, the transfer
++ character-set must be one that is supported by the receiving Kermit
++ program. Since UCS support is new, it is possible that the other
++ Kermit program (if it supports character sets at all) does not support
++ it, but does support single-byte sets such as Latin-1, Latin/Cyrillic,
++ etc.
++
++ To select UCS-2 or UTF-8 as a transfer character-set, use:
++
++ SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { UCS2, UTF8 }
++
++ It is up to the receiving Kermit program to convert the transfer
++ format to its own local format, if necessary. If it does not
++ understand the UTF-8 or UCS-2 transfer character-set, and your file
++ can not be adequately represented by any single-byte transfer
++ character-set (such as Latin-1 or Latin/Cyrillic) then, if UTF-8
++ format is acceptable on the receiving computer, use UTF-8 as the
++ transfer character-set, with the receiver told to "set unknown-char
++ keep", or with the sender told to "set attribute char off". If you
++ want the file to be stored in UCS-2 format at the receiver, send it it
++ binary mode if the source file is also UCS-2, or else use the
++ TRANSLATE command (next section) to convert it to UCS-2 first, then
++ send it in binary mode. You should not use UCS-2 as a transfer
++ character-set in text-mode transfers to Kermit programs that don't
++ support it, because they are likely to corrupt the result the same way
++ FTP would (see the final paragraph of this section).
++
++ When UCS-2 is the transfer character set, it always goes into Kermit
++ packets in Big Endian format, with no BOM. As always, the transfer
++ character-set is announced by the sender to the receiver. The
++ announcement for UCS-2 is "I162" (ISO Registration 162 = UCS-2 Level
++ 1) and by definition it is Big Endian (the standards say that when
++ UCS-2 is serialized into bytes, the order must be Big Endian). The
++ announcement for UTF-8 is "I190" (UTF-8 Level 1).
++
++ When receiving a file whose transfer character-set is UCS-2 or UTF-8,
++ you must choose the appropriate file character set for the result.
++ There is no way Kermit can do this for you automatically, since UCS
++ data can be in any script at all, or any combination.
++
++ In general, UTF-8 or UCS-2 should be chosen as a transfer
++ character-set if the source file is also encoded in some form of UCS
++ and it contains more than one script. But there are other situations
++ where where UTF-8 or UCS-2 offer advantages. For example, suppose the
++ source file is on a NeXTstation and the destination file is on VMS.
++ Both the NeXT and the DEC Multinational character sets include the
++ French OE digraph, but Latin-1 does not. Therefore French words
++ containing this character might not arrive intact when Latin-1 is the
++ transfer character-set, but will with UTF-8 or UCS-2, since the UCS
++ includes the OE digraph (but so does Latin-9).
++
++ UCS-2 should be chosen as a transfer character-set only for Japanese
++ text files that contain a large preponderance of Kanji, since in this
++ case (and only this case) UCS-2 (two bytes per Kanji) is more
++ efficient than UTF-8 (three bytes per Kanji). The same will be true
++ for Chinese and Korean when they are supported by Kermit. UCS-2 should
++ never be used as a transfer character-set with a transfer partner that
++ does not support UCS-2 since this can cause file corruption (see last
++ paragraph in this section).
++
++ Note that Kermit's repeat-count compression is 100% ineffective for
++ UCS-2, and is also ineffective for multibyte characters in UTF-8 and
++ EUC-JP; this is because repeat-compression is a transport-level
++ mechanism that operates on a per-byte basis; it has no knowledge of
++ the distinction between a byte and a character.
++
++ When C-Kermit starts, it sets up associations ([545]Section 6.5) for
++ incoming files whose transfer character sets are UCS-2 or UTF-8
++ appropriately for the platform so that the file character-set for the
++ incoming file is UCS-2 in Windows and UTF-8 elsewhere. Otherwise,
++ C-Kermit does not make any default associations for UCS-2 or UTF-8,
++ but of course you may add or change associations to suit your needs
++ and preferences by including the appropriate ASSOCIATE commands in
++ your Kermit startup file. For example, if you are a PC user and deal
++ only with text written in Greek and English, you can:
++
++ ASSOCIATE TRANSFER-CHARACTER-SET UTF8 CP869
++ ASSOCIATE TRANSFER-CHARACTER-SET UCS2 CP869
++ ASSOCIATE FILE-CHARACTER-SET CP869 UTF8
++
++ Note that when file transfer involves conversion between a single-byte
++ character set and UCS-2 or UTF-8, the file-transfer thermometer and
++ estimated time left might be inaccurate, since they are based on the
++ source file size, not the transfer encoding. This is purely a cosmetic
++ issue and does not effect the final result. (And is not, strictly
++ speaking, a bug; Kermit protocol presently includes no method for the
++ sender to furnish an "estimated transfer size" to the receiver, and in
++ any case any such guess could be as far off as the file size, given
++ the many other factors that come into play, such as compression and
++ prefixing).
++
++ A caution about FTP and UCS-2. As noted previously, if you transfer a
++ UCS-2 file with FTP in binary mode between two computers with opposite
++ Endianness, the result will have its bytes in the wrong order.
++ However, if you use FTP to transfer a UCS-2 file in "ascii" (text)
++ mode to ANY computer, even if it is identical to yours, the result
++ will be corrupted because FTP's line-terminator conversions do not
++ account for UCS-2. The same holds when sending from a UCS-aware Kermit
++ program to an older Kermit program in text mode with a transfer
++ character-set of UCS-2. So use UCS-2 as a transfer character-set ONLY
++ with a UCS-2-aware Kermit partner.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.5.2. The TRANSLATE Command
++
++ In Kermit versions that have Unicode support included, TRANSLATE now
++ always goes through Unicode; that is, the source set is converted to
++ UCS-2 and thence to the target set. This is a major improvement, since
++ in prior releases, C-Kermit had to pick the "most appropriate"
++ transfer character-set as the intermediate set, and this would result
++ in the loss of any characters that the source and target sets had in
++ common but were lacking from the intermediate set (for example the OE
++ digraph when translating from NeXT to DEC MCS through Latin-1). This
++ never happens when Unicode is the intermediate set because Unicode is
++ a superset of all other character sets supported by Kermit. A more
++ dramatic example would be translation between Cyrillic PC code page
++ 866 and KOI8-R ([546]Section 6.4); formerly all the line- and
++ box-drawing characters would be lost (since ISO 8859-5 does not have
++ any); now the ones that these two sets have in common are preserved.
++
++ UCS-2 and UTF-8 are now both supported as source-file and
++ destination-file character sets by C-Kermit's TRANSLATE command, for
++ example:
++
++ translate oofa.txt ucs2 latin1 oofa-l1.txt
++
++ translates oofa.txt from UCS-2 to Latin-1, storing the result as
++ oofa-l1.txt. Similarly:
++
++ translate oofa.txt utf8 latin1 oofa-l1.txt
++ translate oofa.txt latin1 ucs2 oofa-ucs2.txt
++ translate oofa.txt latin1 utf8 oofa-utf8.txt
++ translate oofa.txt ucs2 utf8 oofa-utf8.txt
++ translate oofa.txt utf8 ucs2 oofa-ucs2.txt
++
++ Treatment of the UCS-2 BOM is exactly the same as for file transfer.
++ Note that if a UCS-2 source file is in the "wrong" byte order and
++ lacks a BOM, and you don't tell Kermit about it with SET FILE UCS
++ BYTE-ORDER, the result of the translation is total gibberish. Recall
++ that you can use COPY /SWAP-BYTES to switch the byte order of an
++ errant UCS-2 file (or any other file for that matter, if you can think
++ of a reason to). Also note that:
++
++ translate oofa.txt ucs2 ucs2 new.txt
++
++ Produces a result in the native (or SET FILE UCS) byte-order as long
++ as oofa.txt has a BOM.
++
++ As a side benefit of the Unicode work, the TRANSLATE command now works
++ for the first time also for all Japanese character sets that Kermit
++ supports. In other words, if you have a Japanese text file in any of
++ the following encodings:
++
++ EUC-JP
++ Shift-JIS
++ JIS-7
++ UCS-2
++ UTF-8
++
++ You can use the TRANSLATE command to convert to any other encoding
++ from the same list.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.5.3. Terminal Connection
++
++ The CONNECT command now allows UTF-8 as a local or remote terminal
++ character-set:
++
++ SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 } { ..., UTF8 }
++ SET TERMINAL REMOTE-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }
++ SET TERMINAL LOCAL-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }
++
++ (Recall that Kermit's terminal character-set has two "ends" -- the set
++ used on the host to which Kermit is connected, and the set used on the
++ local keyboard and screen.)
++
++ UCS-2 is not supported as a terminal character-set (either end) since
++ (a) it is not used that way anywhere to our knowledge, and (b) the
++ problems of Endianness and the high likelihood of loss of
++ synchronization make it impractical. (Telecommunications is
++ byte-oriented; if one byte, or any odd number of bytes, is lost
++ because of buffer overruns, circuit resets, etc (or likewise if a
++ burst of noise appears that takes the guise of an odd number of
++ bytes), the byte order of the subsequent data stream will be
++ backwards; unlike UTF-8 and traditional byte-based character sets,
++ UCS-2 is not "self synchronizing".)
++
++ UTF-8 does not have byte-order or synchronization problems and is
++ growing in popularity as a terminal character set as well as in other
++ application areas. It allows a single terminal session to use multiple
++ scripts (Roman, Cyrillic, Greek, etc) without ISO 2022 character-set
++ switching (which terminal emulators like Kermit 95 can handle but few
++ host applications understand or use), and meshes nicely with the
++ Unicode screen fonts that are beginning to appear.
++
++ UTF-8 was first used in Plan 9 and soon will be available in Linux. It
++ will probably spread from there (Unicode in some form is, of course,
++ also used in Windows NT, but only internally -- not for access from
++ outside).
++
++ To use UTF-8 or any other character set that uses 8-bit bytes in your
++ terminal session, be sure to tell C-Kermit to:
++
++ SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8
++ SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8
++ SET PARITY NONE
++
++ (or use the shortcut command, EIGHTBIT, which does all three at once).
++
++ In a setup where your local Kermit program uses a single-byte
++ character set such as PC Code Page 850 and the remote host uses UTF-8:
++
++ SET TERM CHAR UTF8 CP850
++
++ or:
++
++ SET TERM REMOTE CHAR UTF8
++ SET TERM LOCAL CHAR CP850
++
++ all works as expected. UTF-8 text on the remote displays correctly on
++ your screen, and when you type CP850 characters, they are translated
++ to UTF-8 sequences for transmission, and the echo from the host is
++ translated from UTF-8 back to CP850. Telnet negotiations and
++ autodownload take place before any character-set translation and work
++ as before. The session log (if text mode was selected for it) contains
++ only the local terminal character-set. And so on.
++
++ Kermit merely supplies translations from UTF-8 to your local terminal
++ character-set (this includes treating UTF-8 Line Separator and
++ Paragraph separator as CRLF). However, Kermit does does not, at
++ present, perform "canonicalization" of composed sequences, nor does it
++ automatically execute bidirectionality algorithms for display of
++ mixed-direction text (e.g. Hebrew and English). Such presentation
++ issues, like all others in the terminal-host regime, are left to the
++ host.
++
++ By the way, C-Kermit also allows UTF-8 to be the local end of the
++ terminal character-set, but so far this code is not tested, since we
++ don't have a UTF-8 console or terminal to work with. However, it can
++ be stated without doubt that C-Kermit's key mapping will not work for
++ UTF-8 values, since (a) the key map is indexed by 8-bit byte values
++ and (b) C-Kermit reads keystrokes a byte at a time (these comments do
++ not apply to K95, which has direct access to the keyboard and can read
++ "wide" keycodes and uses them to index a "wide" keymap).
++
++ Restrictions: As noted, the CONNECT command does not support UCS-2 as
++ a REMOTE TERMINAL character-set. Neither does it support the Japanese
++ sets EUC-JP, JIS-7, and Shift-JIS. Support for the Japanese sets (and
++ possibly Chinese and Korean too) might be added in a future release.
++ Since the TRANSMIT command (next section) uses the same REMOTE
++ TERMINAL character-sets as the CONNECT command, it has the same
++ restrictions.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.5.4. The TRANSMIT Command
++
++ As described in Chapter 15 of [547]Using C-Kermit and [548]Section
++ 4.21 of this document, the TRANSMIT command can be used to upload a
++ file without protocol, more or less as if you were typing it on your
++ keyboard while connected to the host. When TRANSMITting in text mode,
++ the file's character set is converted to the host's unless you have
++ SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT, or you include the new
++ TRANSMIT switch, /TRANSPARENT.
++
++ Before C-Kermit 7.0, the file character-set was assumed to be the same
++ as the local end of the terminal character-set, and the TRANSMIT
++ command used the same translations as the CONNECT command, ignoring
++ the file character-set.
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, that assumption (a poor one to begin with) can no
++ longer be made, since UCS-2 can be a file character-set but not a
++ terminal character-set. So now the file's character-set is given by
++ your most recent SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command. The host's character
++ set is the remote end of your most recent SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET
++ command:
++
++ SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET remote-set [ local-set ]
++
++ or:
++
++ SET TERMINAL REMOTE-CHARACTER-SET remote-set
++
++ The TRANSMIT command converts each source-file character from the FILE
++ character-set to the REMOTE TERMINAL character-set, and then transmits
++ the translated characters according to your SET TRANSMIT preferences
++ (Chapter 15).
++
++ If you have SET TRANSMIT ECHO ON, and the host is echoing the
++ transmitted characters, the echos are converted from the remote
++ terminal character-set to the local terminal character-set.
++
++ [ A picture would help... ]
++
++ Confused? Let's work through an example. Suppose your local computer
++ is a NeXTstation, on which text files are encoded in the NeXT
++ character set, and that the remote computer is a Data General AViiON,
++ which uses the Data General International character set. Further
++ suppose that you are logged in to the NeXT from a VT220 terminal which
++ uses the DEC Multinational character set.
++
++ You need to convert the file from NeXT encoding to DG encoding and
++ convert the echoes from DG encoding to DEC encoding. So on the NeXT,
++ tell C-Kermit to:
++
++ eightbit
++ set file character-set next
++ set term character-set dg-international dec-mcs
++ transmit /text nextdata.txt
++
++ (This assumes you have some sort of collection process already set up
++ on the Data General, such as a text editor or the venerable "cat >
++ foo". The EIGHTBIT command is equivalent to SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8,
++ SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8, SET PARITY NONE.)
++
++ To further complicate matters, suppose your local terminal character
++ set is the same as the remote one, so you don't need terminal
++ character-set translation, but you need to TRANSMIT a file that is in
++ a different character set and you want it translated to the host set.
++ In this case, use SET TERM CHARACTER-SET to actually specify the
++ character set used on each end, rather than specifying TRANSPARENT:
++
++ eightbit
++ set file character-set ucs2
++ set term character-set latin1 latin1
++ transmit /text ucs2data.txt
++
++ The distinction between:
++
++ SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET xxx yyy
++
++ (where xxx and yyy are the same set) and:
++
++ SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT
++
++ is new to C-Kermit 7.0, but affects only the TRANSMIT command.
++
++ The TRANSMIT command currently does nothing special with UCS-2/UTF-8
++ Line and Paragraph Separator characters; more experience is required
++ to find out how these behave in a genuine Unicode terminal-host
++ setting.
++
++ Restrictions: As noted, the TRANSMIT command translates from the FILE
++ character-set to the REMOTE TERMINAL character-set. This rules out
++ translations to any character set that is not supported as a REMOTE
++ TERMINAL character-set, such as UCS-2, EUC-JP, JIS-7, and Shift-JIS.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.6.5.5. Summary of Kermit Unicode Commands
++
++ Specifying file character-set and byte order:
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS2, UTF8 }
++ REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS2, UTF8 } (See next
++ section)
++ SET FILE UCS BOM { ON, OFF }
++ SET FILE UCS BYTE-ORDER { BIG-ENDIAN, LITTLE-ENDIAN }
++
++ Specifying the transfer character-set:
++ SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 }
++ REMOTE SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 }
++
++ Specifying the terminal character-set:
++ SET TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 } { ..., UTF8 }
++ SET TERMINAL REMOTE-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }
++ SET TERMINAL LOCAL-CHARACTER-SET { ..., UTF8 }
++
++ Displaying settings:
++ SHOW FILE
++ SHOW TRANSFER
++ SHOW TERMINAL
++ SHOW CHARACTER-SETS
++
++ Commands that use these settings include:
++ SEND, RECEIVE, GET, etc.
++ CONNECT
++ TRANSMIT
++ LOG SESSION
++
++ Converting files:
++ TRANSLATE infile { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 } { ..., UCS-2, UTF-8 }
++ outfile
++ COPY /SWAP-BYTES infile outfile
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6.7. Client/Server Character-Set Switching
++
++ A simple mechanism has been added to allow the client to change the
++ server's FILE CHARACTER-SET:
++
++ REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET name
++ The client asks the server to change its file character-set to
++ the one given. The name must match one of the server's file
++ character-set names. For convenience, C-Kermit uses its own
++ file character-set keyword list for parsing this command so you
++ can use ? for help and Tab or Esc for completion. However,
++ since the server might have a different repertoire (or even use
++ different names for the same sets), C-Kermit accepts any string
++ you supply and sends it to the server. The server, if it
++ supports this command (C-Kermit 7.0 and K95 1.1.19 do), sets
++ its file character-set as requested, and also disables
++ automatic character-set switching ([549]Section 6.5). If the
++ server does not support this command or if it does not support
++ the given character set, the REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET
++ command fails.
++
++ Here's an example that sends a Japanese text file encoded in Shift-JIS
++ to a server using every combination of Kermit's Japanese-capable file
++ and transfer character sets:
++
++ dcl \&x[] = euc ucs2 utf8 ; transfer character-sets
++ dcl \&y[] = eu uc ut ; 2-letter abbreviations for them
++ dcl \&f[] = shift euc jis7 ucs2 utf8 ; file character-sets
++ dcl \&g[] = sj eu j7 uc ut ; 2-letter abbreviations
++
++ set file char shift-jis ; local file character-set is Shift-JIS
++ for \%i 1 \fdim(&x) 1 { ; for each transfer character-set...
++ set xfer char \&x[\%i] ; set it
++ for \%j 1 \fdim(&f) 1 { ; for each remote file character-set...
++ remote set file char \&f[\%j] ; set it
++ if fail exit 1 SERVER REJECTED CHARSET
++ send /text meibo-sj.html meibo-sj-\&y[\%i]-\&g[\%j].txt ; send the fi
++le
++ if fail exit 1 TRANSFER FAILED
++ }
++ }
++
++ The Kermit-370 server does not support REMOTE SET FILE CHARACTER-SET,
++ but since it supports REMOTE KERMIT commands, you can get the same
++ effect with REMOTE KERMIT SET FILE CHARACTER-SET name.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7. SCRIPT PROGRAMMING
++
++ (Also see [550]Section 2.8, Scripting Local Programs.)
++
++ 7.0. Bug Fixes
++
++ The following script programming bugs were fixed in C-Kermit 7.0:
++
++ * IF EXIST and IF DIRECTORY were fixed to properly strip braces from
++ around their arguments, so "if directory {C:\Program Files}", etc,
++ would work as expected. However, this means that if the file or
++ directory name is actually enclosed in braces, the braces must be
++ doubled.
++ * The READ command did not fail if the READ file wasn't open; now it
++ does.
++ * The READ command refused to read the last or only line of a file
++ if it did not end with a proper line terminator; now it does.
++ * The END command, when given from within a SWITCH statement, did
++ not exit from the current macro or command file; instead it just
++ terminated the SWITCH.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.1. The INPUT Command
++
++ 7.1.1. INPUT Timeouts
++
++ The description of the INPUT command on page 422 fails to mention the
++ following two points about the timeout (which apply to C-Kermit 6.0
++ and later):
++
++ 1. "INPUT -1 text" (or "INPUT \%x text", where \%x is any variable
++ whose value is -1 or less) means "wait forever". This form of the
++ INPUT command fails only if it is interrupted, since it will never
++ time out.
++ 2. INPUT 0 performs a nonblocking read of material that has already
++ arrived but has not yet been read, and succeeds immediately if the
++ target string is found, or fails immediately if it is not found.
++
++ The same points apply to MINPUT. REINPUT ignores its timeout
++ parameter.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.1.2. New INPUT Controls
++
++ The following new INPUT controls were added in version 7.0:
++
++ SET INPUT AUTODOWNLOAD { ON, OFF }
++ Explained in [551]Section 7.7.
++
++ SET INPUT CANCELLATION { ON, OFF }
++ This governs whether an INPUT command can be canceled by
++ "pressing any key" on the keyboard. Normally it can be, in
++ which case the INPUT command fails immediately and \v(instatus)
++ is set to 2, indicating interruption. SET INPUT CANCELLATION
++ OFF disables keyboard cancellations; thus if the search text is
++ not encountered, the INPUT command will run for its entire
++ timeout interval. SET INPUT CANCELLATION OFF does not disable
++ interruption by Ctrl-C, however; every command needs an
++ emergency exit. (If you really want to disable interruption by
++ Ctrl-C, use SET COMMAND INTERRUPTION OFF.)
++
++ Also see [552]Section 7.2 for any new variables related to INPUT.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.1.3. INPUT with Pattern Matching
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 allows INPUT, MINPUT, and REINPUT targets to be a pattern
++ (explained in [553]Sections 1.19 and [554]4.9). This solves a
++ long-standing problem illustrated by the following scenario: a certain
++ company has a bank of TCP/IP modem servers, with hostnames server1,
++ server2, server3, and so on. Each server's prompt is its name,
++ followed by a colon (:), for example "Server72:". Without INPUT
++ patterns, it would be rather difficult to wait for the prompt. The
++ brute force approach:
++
++ minput 20 Server1: Server2: Server3: ... (enumerating each one)
++
++ is subject to failure whenever a new server is added. A more subtle
++ approach:
++
++ input 20 Server
++ if fail ...
++ input 2 :
++
++ is liable to false positives, e.g. "Welcome to the XYZ Corp Modem
++ Server. Please read the following message:"...
++
++ With patterns, you can match the prompt with "Server*:" (which doesn't
++ solve the "false positives" problem, but certainly is more compact
++ than the brute force method), or with more specific patterns such as
++ "Server[1-9]:" and "Server[1-9][0-9]:", or equivalently:
++
++ Server{[1-9],[1-9][0-9]}:
++
++ meaning the word "Server" followed by a single digit (1-9) or by two
++ digits representing a number from 1 to 99, followed by a colon.
++
++ INPUT pattern matching has been added in a way that does not interfere
++ with existing scripts. No new commands or switches are used. The
++ simple rule is: if an INPUT search target is the argument of the (new)
++ \fpattern() function, it is a pattern. Otherwise it is taken
++ literally, as before. For example:
++
++ input 5 a*b
++
++ searches for an 'a' followed by an asterisk ('*'), followed by a 'b'.
++ But:
++
++ input 5 \fpattern(a*b)
++
++ searches for an 'a' followed by anything at all up to and including
++ the first 'b'. This means that any search target to INPUT, MINPUT, or
++ REINPUT can be a pattern or a literal string, and in particular that
++ MINPUT can accommodate any mixture of patterns and literal strings.
++
++ In selecting patterns, note that:
++
++ * A leading '*' is always implied so there is no need to include
++ one.
++ * A trailing '*' is meaningless and ignored.
++ * A '*' by itself matches the first character that arrives.
++
++ A syntax note: If your pattern is a selection list, meaning a list of
++ alternatives separated by commas and enclosed in braces, then the
++ outer braces will be stripped by various levels of parsers, so you
++ must include three of each:
++
++ input 10 \fpattern({{{abc,mno,xyz}}})
++
++ Note that this is equivalent to:
++
++ minput 10 abc mno xyz
++
++ except for the setting of the \v(minput) variable.
++
++ And a caution: INPUT pattern matching has a limitation that you
++ probably never noticed with literal-string matching, namely that there
++ is a limit on the size of the match. For example, if the pattern is
++ "a*b", the match will succeed if the 'a' and 'b' are not separated by
++ more than (say) 8K bytes, but will fail if they are farther apart than
++ that. In such cases, it better to use two INPUTs (e.g. "input 10 a"
++ and then "input 100 b").
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.1.4. The INPUT Match Result
++
++ The result of any INPUT, MINPUT, or REINPUT command, no matter whether
++ the search targets are patterns or literal strings, is available in
++ the new \v(inmatch) variable. For example:
++
++ minput 10 cat \fpattern([dh]og)
++ if success echo MINPUT matched "\v(inmatch)"
++
++ This is especially useful when a pattern was matched, since it makes
++ the string that matched the pattern available to Kermit; there would
++ be no way to get it otherwise.
++
++ After an INPUT command, you can view all the INPUT-related variables
++ by typing "show variables in" (abbreviate as "sho var in"), which
++ shows the values of all built-in variables whose names start with
++ "in".
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.2. New or Improved Built-In Variables
++
++ \v(blockcheck)
++ Current BLOCK-CHECK setting, 1, 2, 3, or 4. 4 is the code for
++ BLANK-FREE-2.
++
++ \v(byteorder)
++ The machine's byte order: 0 = Big Endian, 1 = Little Endian.
++
++ \v(cmdbufsize)
++ The length of the command buffer, which is the maximum size for
++ a macro, a command, a variable, or anything else in C-Kermit's
++ script language.
++
++ \v(ctty)
++ The device name of C-Kermit's controlling (login) terminal.
++
++ \v(filename)
++ Described in [555]Sections 4.1 and [556]4.2.
++
++ \v(filenumber)
++ Described in [557]Sections 4.1 and [558]4.2.
++
++ \v(filespec)
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, contains fully qualified filenames rather
++ than (usually) relative ones.
++
++ \v(return)
++ Now holds the END n value of the macro that most recently
++ returned, in case END was used rather than RETURN.
++
++ \v(editor)
++ Pathname of preferred text editor
++
++ \v(editopts)
++ Command-line options for editor
++
++ \v(editfile)
++ File most recently edited
++
++ \v(browser)
++ Pathname of preferred Web browser
++
++ \v(browsopts)
++ Command-line options for Web browser
++
++ \v(browsurl)
++ URL most recently given to Web browser
++
++ \v(dialtype)
++ Type of call most recently placed (see [559]Section 2.1.11).
++
++ \v(kbchar)
++ The character, if any, that was typed at the keyboard to to
++ interrupt the most recent PAUSE, SLEEP, WAIT, MSLEEP, or INPUT
++ command; empty if the most recent such command was not
++ interrupted from the keyboard.
++
++ \v(lockdir)
++ UNIX only - The name of the UUCP lockfile directory, if known,
++ otherwise "(unknown)".
++
++ \v(lockpid)
++ UNIX only - PID of process that owns the communication port
++ that you tried to open with a SET LINE command that failed
++ because the port was in use, otherwise empty. This variable is
++ set with every SET LINE command.
++
++ \v(cx_time)
++ If no connection (SET HOST, SET LINE, DIAL, TELNET, etc) is
++ active, this is 0. If a connection is active, this is the
++ number of seconds since the connection was made.
++
++ \v(hwparity)
++ If hardware parity is in effect, this variable gives its value,
++ such as "even" or "odd" (in which case, the \v(parity) variable
++ will be "none"). Otherwise this variable is empty.
++
++ \v(serial)
++ Current serial port settings in 8N1 format ([560]Section 2.10).
++
++ \v(errno)
++ In UNIX, the current value of the C runtime errno variable,
++ which is quite volatile (meaning that often an "interesting"
++ error code can be overwritten by some other library call or
++ system service that sets errno before you have a chance to look
++ at it). In VMS, the error code returned by the system or
++ library call that most recently failed (success codes are not
++ saved). Not available in other operating systems.
++
++ \v(errstring)
++ The UNIX or VMS system error message that corresponds to
++ \v(errno). Not available in all OS's. Also see
++ [561]\ferrstring().
++
++ \v(setlinemsg)
++ The error message, if any, from the most recent SET LINE, SET
++ PORT, SET HOST, TELNET, or other connection-making command.
++ This is not necessarily the same as \v(errstring) since these
++ commands might fail without generating a system error code, for
++ example (in UNIX) because a lockfile existed indicating the
++ device was assigned by another user.
++
++ \v(exitstatus)
++ The exit status C-Kermit would return if it exited now.
++
++ \v(pexitstat)
++ The exit status of the inferior process most recently invoked
++ by C-Kermit (by RUN, !, REDIRECT, SEND /COMMAND, etc). In VMS,
++ this code can be given to \ferrstring() to get the
++ corresponding error message (in UNIX, program/command return
++ codes are not the same as system error codes). Not available in
++ operating systems other than UNIX and VMS. See [562]Section
++ 4.2.5 for details.
++
++ \v(inmatch)
++ The incoming string of characters, if any, that matched the
++ most recent INPUT, REINPUT, or MINPUT command.
++
++ \v(intime)
++ The number of milliseconds (thousandths of seconds) it took for
++ the most recent INPUT command to find its match, or -1 if no
++ INPUT command has been given yet. If the INPUT command timed
++ out, the value is approximately equal to 1000 times the INPUT
++ timeout. If INPUT failed for some other reason, the value is
++ undefined (\v(instatus) gives INPUT completion status). If your
++ version of C-Kermit is built without high-precision
++ floating-point timers, this number will always be a multiple of
++ 1000.
++
++ \v(inwait)
++ The number of seconds specified as the timeout in the most
++ recent INPUT command.
++
++ \v(dialsuffix)
++ Dialing suffix for use during PDIAL sequence; see [563]Section
++ 2.1.10.
++
++ \v(pid)
++ UNIX, VMS, and K95 only. C-Kermit's primary process ID,
++ numeric, decimal. If you want to show it in hex, use
++ \fn2hex(\v(pid)) If you want to show it in octal, use
++ \fn2octal(\v(pid)).
++
++ \v(printer)
++ Current printer name or SET PRINTER value.
++
++ \v(p_ctl)
++ Control prefix char \v(p_8bit) 8-bit prefix char (if parity not
++ none)
++
++ \v(p_rpt)
++ Repeat prefix char (if repeat compression enabled)
++
++ \v(herald)
++ Kermit's version herald
++
++ \v(test)
++ Kermit's test version, if any, or 0 if this is not a test
++ version. Typical values for test versions are "Alpha.03" or
++ "Beta.14".
++
++ \v(sendlist)
++ The number of entries in the SEND-LIST, 0 if none. Note:
++ entries do not necessarily correspond to files, since an entry
++ might contain wildcards. Also note that the value does not go
++ back to 0 after the files in the list are sent. To reset this
++ variable, use CLEAR SEND-LIST. The purpose of this variable is
++ to determine if a SEND command, when given without any
++ filenames, will be legal. Example:
++
++ xif \v(sendlist) { send } else { send oofa.txt }
++
++ \v(trigger)
++ If the most recent CONNECT session was terminated automatically
++ by a trigger, this variable contains the trigger value.
++
++ \v(ty_ln)
++ TYPE line number (during TYPE)
++
++ \v(ty_lc)
++ TYPE line count (after TYPE)
++
++ \v(ty_mc)
++ TYPE match count (after TYPE)
++
++ \v(xferstat)
++ Status of most recent file transfer:
++
++-1: No transfer yet
++ 0: Succeeded
++ 1: Failed
++
++ \v(xfermsg)
++ If the most recent file transfer failed, this is the reason. If
++ it succeeded, \v(xfermsg) is an empty string.
++
++ \v(tftime)
++ Total elapsed time of most recent file transfer operation, in
++ seconds.
++
++ \v(textdir)
++ Directory that holds (or is supposed to hold) Kermit text files
++ such as installation instructions, release notes, update notes,
++ read-me files, "beware" files, etc.
++
++ \v(name)
++ The name with which the Kermit program was invoked, e.g.
++ "kermit", "wermit", "k95", "k2", etc (see [564]Section 9.1).
++
++ \v(osname)
++ Name of operating system on computer where C-Kermit is running,
++ obtained at runtime (from uname or equivalent).
++
++ \v(osversion)
++ Version of operating system on computer where C-Kermit is
++ running, obtained at runtime (from uname or equivalent).
++
++ \v(osrelease)
++ Release of operating system on computer where C-Kermit is
++ running, obtained at runtime (from uname or equivalent).
++
++ \v(model)
++ The specific hardware model of the computer where C-Kermit is
++ running, if known.
++
++ \v(math_pi)
++ The value of Pi (see [565]Section 7.23)
++
++ \v(math_e)
++ The value of e (see [566]Section 7.23)
++
++ \v(math_precision)
++ How many significant digits in a floating-point number.
++
++ \v(f_count)
++ Result of the most recent FILE COUNT (FCOUNT) command.
++
++ \v(f_error)
++ Numeric error code of most recent FILE command.
++
++ \v(f_max)
++ Maximum number of files open simultaneously.
++
++ The math constants are given in the precision of underlying computer's
++ floating-point arithmetic.
++
++ Note the distinction between \v(osname), \v(osversion), and
++ \v(platform); the latter refers to the platform for which and/or upon
++ which C-Kermit was built, as opposed to the one on which it is
++ actually running. Also note that each operating system can, and
++ probably will, interpret and fill in the os* variables differently, or
++ not at all.
++
++ The SHOW VARIABLES command now accepts a variable name, prefix, or
++ pattern:
++
++ show variables Shows all variables.
++ show variables t Shows all variables that start with "t".
++ show variables *ver* Shows all variables whose names contain "ver".
++ show variables *ver Ditto (an implied "*" is appended).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.3. New or Improved Built-In Functions
++
++ The following new file-i/o functions are explained in [567]Section
++ 1.22.
++
++ \f_status(channel) Status of file open on channel
++ \f_pos(channel) Read/write (byte) pointer of given file
++ \f_line(channel) Current line of file
++ \f_handle(channel) Handle of file
++ \f_eof(channel) Whether given file is at EOF
++ \f_getchar(channel) Read a char from given file
++ \f_getline(channel) Read a line from given file
++ \f_getblock(channel,n) Read a block from given file
++ \f_putchar(channel,c) Write a char to given file
++ \f_putline(channel,string) Write a line to given file
++ \f_putblock(channel,string) Write a block to given file
++
++ The following new date-time-related functions are explained in
++ [568]Section 1.6:
++
++ \fday() Returns day of week of given date
++ \fnday() Returns numeric day of week of given date
++ \ftime() Returns time portion of given date-time
++ \fntime() Converts time to seconds since midnight
++ \fn2time() Converts seconds since midnight to hh:mm:ss
++ \fcvtdate(date-time) Converts free-format date to yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss
++ \fdayofyear(date-time) Converts date to yyyyddd (day-of-year) format
++ \fdoy(date-time) Synonym for \fdayofyear()
++ \fdoy2date(dayofyear) Converts yyyyddd to yyyymmdd
++ \fmjd(date-time) Converts free-format date to Modified Julian Date
++ \fmjd2date(mjd) Converts modified Julian date to yyyymmdd
++
++ The new floating-point arithmetic functions are explained in
++ [569]Section 7.23. f1 and f2 are floating-point (real) numbers; d is
++ the number of decimal places to show:
++
++ \ffpabsolute(f1,d) Absolute value of f1
++ \ffpadd(f1,f2,d) f1 + f1
++ \ffpcosine(f1,d) Cosine of f1
++ \ffpdivide(f1,f2,d) f1 divided by f2
++ \ffpexp(f1,d) e to the f1 power
++ \ffpint(f1) Integer part of f1
++ \ffplog10(f1,d) Log base 10 of f1
++ \ffplogn(f1,d) Natural log of f1
++ \ffpmaximum(f1,f2,d) Maximum of f1 and f2
++ \ffpminimum(f1,f2,d) Minimum of f1 and f2
++ \ffpmodulus(f1,f2,d) Modulus of f1 and f2
++ \ffpmultiply(f1,f2,d) Product of f1 and f2
++ \ffpraise(f1,f2,d) Raise f1 to power f2
++ \ffpround(f1,d) Round f1 to d places
++ \ffpsine(f1,d) Sine of f1
++ \ffpsqrt(f1,d) Square root of f1
++ \ffpsubtract(f1,f2,d) f2 - f1
++ \ffptangent(f1,d) Tangent of f1
++
++ Integer number functions:
++
++ \fabsolute(n)
++ Absolute value of integer n.
++
++ \frandom(n)
++ Returns a random integer between 0 and n-1.
++
++ \fradix(s,n1,n2)
++ If the string s is an integer in radix n1, the result is the
++ same number expressed in radix n2, where n1 and n2 may be any
++ number from 2 through 36, expressed as decimal numbers, or
++ variables (etc) that evaluate to decimal numbers. For the
++ source and result, the digits of any radix, r, are the first r
++ characters in the sequence 0-9,a-z (case doesn't matter for the
++ letters). The string s may have a sign, + or -; if it starts
++ with a minus (-) sign, the result also has a minus sign.
++
++ The \fradix() function does not work with floating-point numbers. It
++ does not reveal the internal storage format of a number; for example,
++ \fradix(-1,10,16) is -1, not something like FFFFFFFFFF. If all three
++ arguments are not given, or if n1 or n2 are not numbers between 2 and
++ 36 inclusive, or s is not a number in radix n1, an error occurs and
++ the empty string is returned. \fradix() also does not offer
++ extended-precision arithmetic; number values are limited to those
++ expressed as a long integer in the architecture of the underlying
++ computer, usually 32 or 64 bits. If you give it an argument whose
++ absolute value is larger than can be held in an unsigned long, the
++ result is -1.
++
++ The next four are shorthand functions for decimal/hexadecimal and
++ decimal/octal number conversion:
++
++ \fn2hex(n)
++ Returns the hexadecimal (base 16) representation of the integer
++ n. This is different from \fhexify(s), which treats its
++ argument as a string rather than a number. The result is always
++ left-padded with 0's to make its length even. Examples:
++
++ \n2hex(0) = "00" \fhexify(0) = "30"
++ \n2hex(255) = "ff" \fhexify(255) = "323535"
++ \n2hex(256) = "0100" \fhexify(256) = "323536"
++
++ \fhex2n(x)
++ Converts hexadecimal number x to decimal equivalent decimal
++ number. This is the inverse of \fn2hex(). Equivalent to
++ \fradix(s,16,10).
++
++ \fn2octal(n)
++ Returns the octal (base 8) representation of the number n.
++ Examples:
++
++ \n2octal(0) = "0"
++ \n2oct(255) = "377"
++ \n2oct(256) = "400"
++ Equivalent to \fradix(n,10,8).
++
++ \foct2n(n)
++ Returns the decimal representation of the given octal number,
++ n. The inverse of \fn2octal(). Equivalent to \fradix(n,8,10).
++
++ String functions:
++
++ \s(name[n:m])
++ Equivalent to \fsubstring(\m(name),n,m) ([570]Section 7.24).
++
++ \:(name[n:m])
++ Equivalent to \fsubstring(name,n,m) (where "name" is any
++ \-quantity) ([571]Section 7.24).
++
++ \fleft(s,n)
++ The leftmost ncharacters of string s; equivalent to
++ \fsubstring(s,1,n).
++
++ \fstripx(string,char)
++ Returns the part of the string up to the rightmost occurrence,
++ if any, of the given character. The default character is period
++ (.) Examples:
++
++ \fstripx(foo/bar,/) = "foo"
++ \fstripx(foo/bar/baz,/) = "foo/bar"
++ \fstripx(autoexec.bat,.) = "autoexec"
++ \fstripx(autoexec.bat) = "autoexec"
++ \fstripx(fstripx(foo/bar/baz,/),/) = "foo"
++
++ \flop(string,character)
++ Returns the portion of the string starting after the first
++ occurrence of the given character. The default character is
++ period (.) Examples:
++
++ \flop(autoexec.bat) = "bat"
++ \flop(baz.foo/bar) = "foo/bar"
++ \flop(baz.foo/bar,/) = "bar
++
++ \fstripn(string,n)
++ Returns the string with ncharacters removed from the end.
++ Example:
++
++ \fstripn(12345678,3) = "12345"
++
++ (For more discussion of \fstripx(), \fstripn(), and \flop() see
++ [572]Section 4.2.3).
++
++ \fb64encode(s)
++ Returns the Base-64 encoding of the string s.
++
++ \fb64decode(s)
++ Returns the decoding of the Base-64 string s. Fails if s is not
++ a Base-64 string, or if its length is not a multiple of 4. Note
++ that if any of the result bytes are null (0), the result string
++ stops there. There is no way to represent strings that contain
++ null bytes in C-Kermit (the same is true for \funhexify()).
++
++ \fword(s1,n,s2,s3)
++ Extracts word number nfrom string s1. By default, a "word" is
++ any sequence of ASCII letters or digits; nis 1-based. If nis
++ omitted, "1" is used. Examples:
++
++ \fword(one two three) = "one"
++ \fword(one two three,1) = "one"
++ \fword(one two three,2) = "two"
++ \fword(one two three,3) = "three"
++
++ and:
++
++ \fword(\v(dialresult),2) = "31200"
++
++ is "31200" if \v(dialresult) is (e.g.) "CONNECT
++ 31200/ARQ/V32/LAPM/V42BIS".
++
++ If you include s2, this replaces the default break set. For
++ example, suppose you have a string \%a whose value is:
++
++ $150.00 $300.00 $39.95
++
++ and you want each dollar amount to be a word; use:
++
++ \fword(\%a,\%n,{ })
++
++ This returns dollar amount number \%n, e.g. "$300.00" for \%n =
++ 2. "{ }" denotes a space (you must enclose it in braces,
++ otherwise it is squeezed out). Note that ASCII control
++ characters are always included in the break set; you don't have
++ to specify them (and you can't not specify them).
++
++ The optional s3 argument lists characters (even control
++ characters) that normally would be considered separators that
++ you want included in words. So the dollars-and-cents example
++ could also be handled this way:
++
++ \fword(\%a,\%n,,$.)
++
++ in other words, use the default separator list, but remove "$"
++ and "." from it so they will be considered part of a word.
++
++ \fsplit(s1,&a,s2,s3)
++ This is like \fword(), except instead of extracting and
++ returning a particular word from string s1, it counts the words
++ and optionally assigns them to the array whose identifying
++ letter, a-z, is given after the "&" in the second argument,
++ with the first word going into element 1, the second into
++ element 2, and so on. The rules regarding break and include
++ lists (s2 and s3) are exactly the same as for \fword().
++ \fsplit() returns the number of words that were assigned, which
++ is either the number of words in the string, or the dimension
++ of the array, whichever is less. If the array is not declared,
++ \fsplit() creates it and returns a number which is both the
++ number of words in s1 and the dimension of the new array.
++ Examples:
++
++ declare \&w[20] ; (Optional.)
++ ...
++ read \%s ; \%s is "This is a sentence with seven words."
++ ...
++ echo "\fsplit(\%s)" ; This would print "7".
++ echo "\fsplit(\%s,&w)" ; Ditto, and also assigns them to array \&w[].
++
++ echo "\&w[7]" ; This would print "words".
++
++ If the line contained fields that were delimited by colon (:),
++ you would use \fsplit(\%s,&w,:). If the fields were delimited
++ by comma, then you would use \fsplit(\%s,&w,{,}); in this case
++ the literal comma must be enclosed in braces to distinguish it
++ from the comma that separates function arguments. To get a word
++ count without loading an array, but still specify break and/or
++ include lists, leave the array argument empty:
++
++ echo "\fsplit(\%s,,:)" ; Use colon as the separator.
++
++ WARNINGS:
++
++ 1. If you use the same array repeatedly, \fsplit() leaves any
++ trailing members undisturbed. For example:
++ dcl \&w[10]
++ \fsplit(1 2 3 4 5,&w) ; Sets \&w[1] thru \&w[5].
++ \fsplit(a b c,&w) ; Sets \&w[1]-[3] leaving [4]-[5] as they were.
++ 2. If you allow \fsplit to create the array (by not declaring it
++ first), it is dimensioned to the number of elements it was
++ created with:
++ \fsplit(1 2 3,&x) ; Creates an array \&x[] with 3 elements.
++ \fsplit(a b c d e,&x) ; This overflows the array.
++
++ Thus if you want to use \fsplit() repeatedly on the same array,
++ either dimension it in advance to the maximum expected size
++ (and then some -- more efficient), or else destroy it after
++ each use (to allow for unexpectedly large arguments). Example
++ using a dynamic array:
++
++ fopen /read \%c some-file
++ if fail ...
++ set function error on ; See [573]Section 7.12
++ while true {
++ dcl \&w[] ; Destroy \&[w] each time thru the loop
++ fread /line \%c \%a
++ if fail break
++ asg \%x \fsplit(\%a,&w)
++ if fail ...
++ ; (do what you want with \&w[] here...)
++ }
++ fclose \%c
++
++ \frindex(s1,s2,n)
++ The "n" argument to \frindex() now works consistently (in
++ mirror image) with the corresponding \findex() argument. In
++ each case, the (n-1)-most characters of s2 are ignored in the
++ search; for findex, this means the starting position of the
++ search is n (the default nis 1, and 0 is treated like 1). For
++ \frindex() it means the default starting point is:
++
++ length(s2) - length(s1) - n (with the same defaults for n).
++
++ \fsearch(pattern,string[,position])
++ Exactly like \findex(), except with a pattern (see [574]Section
++ 7.9) rather than a literal string.
++
++ \frsearch(pattern,string[,position])
++ Exactly like \frindex(), except with a pattern rather than a
++ literal string.
++
++ File Functions:
++
++ \ffiles(), \fnextfile()
++ It is no longer necessary to copy the file list to an array
++ before use, as shown on p.398 of [575]Using C-Kermit 2nd
++ Edition. \ffiles() and friends now make their own safe copies
++ of the file list. Thus constructions like the following are now
++ possible:
++
++ for \%i 1 \ffiles(*.txt) 1 { send \fnextfile() }
++
++ The same is true for the new function \frfiles(),
++ \fdirectories(), and \frdirectories(), described in
++ [576]Section 4.11.3.
++
++ But note that each reference to \fnextfile() still gets you the
++ next file. So "if newer \fnextfile() foo.txt send \fnextfile()"
++ compares one file's age with that of foo.txt, and then sends an
++ entirely different file. If you're going to refer to the same
++ file more than once, assign it to a variable:
++
++ asg \%f \fnextfile()
++ if newer \%f foo.txt send \%f
++
++ (note: assign, not define).
++
++ Also note that \ffiles(), \frfiles(), \fdirectories(), and
++ \frdirectories() all now accept on optional 2nd argument: the
++ name of an array to load with the resulting file or directory
++ list, explained in [577]Section 4.11.3. So you can also load an
++ array with the filelist when you need to refer to the same file
++ more than once:
++
++ for \%i 1 \ffiles(*,&a) 1 { if newer \&a[\%i] foo.txt send \&a[\%i] }
++
++ \fpermissions(file)
++ Returns the platform-specific permissions string for the file,
++ such as "-rw-rw-r--" in UNIX or "(RWE,RWE,RE,E)" in VMS.
++
++ \fdirname(f)
++ Given a file specification f, this function returns the
++ complete pathname of directory the file is in.
++
++ Array Functions:
++
++ \fdimension(&a)
++ Returns the dimension declared for the array whose identifying
++ letter, a-z, or special character "_" or "@", is given after
++ the "&" in the argument. If the array is not declared, 0 is
++ returned. Note that when used with the macro argument vector
++ array, \&_[] (see [578]Section 7.5), the value of this function
++ is one less than \v(argc), and when used with the C-Kermit
++ command-line argument vector array, \&@[], it is equal to the
++ \v(args) variable. Examples:
++
++ echo \fdimension(&a) ; Not declared.
++ 0
++ declare \&a[12] ; Now it's declared.
++ echo \fdim(&a)
++ 12
++
++ \farraylook(pattern,arrayname)
++ Looks in the given array for the pattern and returns the index
++ of the first element that matches, if any, or -1 if none match.
++ The arrayname can include a range specifier to restrict to
++ search to a segment of the array, e.g.
++ \farraylook(*xyz*,&a[32:63]). For greater detail see
++ [579]Section 7.10.7.
++
++ \ftablelook(keyword,arrayname[,delimiter])
++ Looks in the given "table", which must be sorted, for the given
++ keyword. Returns the index of the table element that uniquely
++ matches the given keyword, or -1 if none match, or -2 if more
++ than 1 match. For greater detail see [580]Section 7.10.7.
++
++ Other new functions:
++
++ \fip2hex(s)
++ Converts a dotted decimal IP address to an 8-digit hexadecimal
++ number. \fip2hex(128.59.39.2) = 803b2702.
++
++ \fhex2ip(x)
++ Converts an 8-digit hexadecimal IP address to dotted decimal
++ form, e.g. \fhex2ip(803b2702) = 128.59.39.2. The inverse of
++ \fip2hex().
++
++ \fcommand()
++ \frawcommand()
++ These run an external command and return its output; see
++ [581]Section 4.2.8.4.
++
++ \fdialconvert(s)
++ s is a phone number in either literal or portable format (not a
++ dialing directory entry name). The function returns the dial
++ string that would actually be used when dialing from the
++ current location (after processing country code, area code, and
++ other SET DIAL values).
++
++ \ferrstring(n)
++ Returns the system error message associated with the (numeric)
++ error code n. UNIX and VMS only. Use in conjunction with
++ \v(errno) or \v(pexitstat). See [582]Section 4.2.5 for a usage
++ example. Note: This function doesn't work in Windows because
++ there is not a consistent error-code-to-message mapping; error
++ code "x" means something completely different depending on
++ whether it comes from the C runtime library, Winsock, a
++ Windows-32 API, TAPI, etc,
++
++ \fpattern(s)
++ Used in INPUT, REINPUT, and MINPUT commands to denote search
++ strings that are to be treated as patterns rather than
++ literally.
++
++ Also see [583]Section 7.8 on built-in help for functions.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.4. New IF Conditions
++
++ IF AVAILABLE feature command
++ Executes the command if the given feature is available.
++ Presently used only to determine if specific authentication and
++ encryption options are available. Type "if available ?" to see
++ which features may be tested.
++
++ IF FLOAT f1 command
++ Executes command if f1 is a legal floating point number (which
++ includes integers). Use this to preverify arguments for the
++ \ffp...() floating-point arithmetic functions, e.g. "if float
++ \%1 echo \ffpint(\%1)".
++
++ IF == n1 n2 command
++ Synonym for "if =" (numeric equality). Note that as of C-Kermit
++ 7.0, this and all other numeric comparison operators also work
++ for floating-point numbers.
++
++ IF != n1 n2 command
++ Executes the command if n1 and n2 are both numbers or variables
++ containing numbers and the value of n1 is not equal to the
++ value of n2. This is equivalent to "if not = n1 n2".
++
++ IF <= n1 n2 command
++ Executes the command if n1 and n2 are both numbers or variables
++ containing numbers and the value of n1 is less than or equal to
++ the value of n2. This is equivalent to "if not > n1 n2".
++
++ IF >= n1 n2 command
++ Executes the command if n1 and n2 are both numbers or variables
++ containing numbers and the value of n1 is greater than or equal
++ to the value of n2. Equivalent to "if not < n1 n2".
++
++ IF COMMAND word command
++ Executes the command if word is a built-in C-Kermit command.
++ Example:
++
++ if not command copy define { copy run copy \%1 \%2 }".
++
++ This defines a COPY macro that runs an external COPY command if
++ COPY is not already a built-in command.
++
++ IF LOCAL command
++ Executes the command if Kermit is in local mode, i.e. if it has
++ a SET LINE, SET PORT, or SET HOST (TELNET, RLOGIN, etc) device
++ or connection open. Does not execute the command if in remote
++ mode.
++
++ IF MATCH string pattern command
++ Executes the command if the string matches the pattern. For a
++ description of the syntax for the pattern, see [584]Section
++ 4.9.1. If you want to test if the string contains pattern, use
++ IF \fsearch(pattern,string).
++
++ IF OPEN { DEBUG-LOG, SESSION-LOG, TRANSACTION-LOG, ... } command
++ Executes the command if the given file is open, fails if it is
++ not open. Type IF OPEN ? for a complete list of files that can
++ be checked (all the files that can be opened with the OPEN or
++ LOG commands).
++
++ IF QUIET command
++ Executes the command if SET QUIET is ON, and does not execute
++ it if SET QUIET is OFF. Example: IF NOT QUIET ECHO { This is a
++ message.}.
++
++ IF READABLE name
++ Succeeds if name is the name of an existing file or directory
++ that is readable.
++
++ IF WRITEABLE name
++ Succeeds if name is the name of an existing file or directory
++ that is writeable, e.g.:
++
++ if not writeable \v(lockdir) echo Please read installation instructions!
++
++ IF FLAG command
++ This tests a user-settable condition, which can mean anything
++ you like. SET FLAG ON causes subsequent IF FLAG commands to
++ succeed; SET FLAG OFF causes them to fail. One way to use it
++ would be for debugging your scripts; precede any debugging
++ statements with IF FLAG. Then SET FLAG on to debug your script,
++ SET FLAG OFF to run it without debugging. Another common use is
++ for causing an inner loop to cause an outer loop to exit.
++
++ IF C-KERMIT command
++ C-Kermit, but not Kermit 95 or MS-DOS Kermit, executes the
++ command.
++
++ IF K-95 command
++ Kermit 95, but not C-Kermit or MS-DOS Kermit, executes the
++ command.
++
++ IF MS-KERMIT command
++ MS-DOS Kermit, but not C-Kermit or Kermit 95, executes the
++ command.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.5. Using More than Ten Macro Arguments
++
++ The \v(argc) variable now gives the actual number of arguments, even
++ if the number is greater than 9:
++
++ C-Kermit> define xx echo \v(argc)
++ C-Kermit> xx a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z
++ 27
++
++ Remember that \v(argc) includes the name of the macro itself, so it is
++ always at least 1, and is always 1 greater than the actual number of
++ arguments. As in versions 6.0 and earlier, if more than 9 arguments
++ are given, only the first nine are assigned to the variables \%1..\%9.
++
++ The \&_[] array, discussed on page 353 of [585]Using C-Kermit, 2nd ed,
++ now holds all the arguments, up to some implementation-dependent limit
++ (64 or greater), rather than only the first 9. To illustrate: the
++ following macro tells the number of arguments it was called with and
++ then prints them:
++
++ define show_all_args {
++ local \%i
++ echo \&_[0] - Number of arguments: \feval(\v(argc)-1)
++ for \%i 1 \v(argc)-1 1 { echo \flpad(\%i,3). "\&_[\%i]" }
++ }
++
++ Within a macro \&_[0], like \%0, contains the name of the macro.
++
++ At top level, the \&_[] array is filled as follows:
++
++ * If the first argument on the C-Kermit command line was a filename,
++ or C-Kermit was invoked from a "Kerbang" script ([586]Section
++ 7.19), element 0 contains the filename, and elements 1 through
++ \v(argc)-1 hold the remaining command-line arguments.
++ * Otherwise the program name goes in element 0, and elements 1
++ through \v(argc)-1 hold any arguments that were included after
++ "--" or "="
++
++ The new \%* variable, when used within a macro, is replaced by the
++ text that followed the macro name in the macro invocation. If no
++ arguments were given, \%* is replaced by the empty string. Examples:
++
++ C-Kermit> define xx echo [\%*]
++ C-Kermit> define \%a oofa
++ C-Kermit> xx
++ []
++ C-Kermit> xx \%a
++ [oofa]
++ C-Kermit> xx a
++ [a]
++ C-Kermit> xx a b
++ [a b]
++ C-Kermit> xx a b c
++ [a b c]
++ C-Kermit> xx a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z
++ [a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z]
++
++ Note that \%* can not be used at top level, since Kermit does not have
++ access to the raw command line (only to its elements separately, after
++ they have been processed by the shell and the C library).
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 also adds a SHIFT command:
++
++ SHIFT [ number ]
++ Shifts the macro arguments (except argument 0) the given number
++ of places to the left and adjusts \v(argc) accordingly. The
++ default number is 1.
++
++ To illustrate, suppose macro XXX is invoked as follows:
++
++ xxx arg1 arg2 arg3
++
++ Then inside XXX, \%1 is "arg1", \%2 is "arg2", and \%3 is "arg3".
++ After a SHIFT command is given inside XXX, then \%1 is "arg2", \%2 is
++ "arg3", and \%3 is empty. \%0 (the name of the macro) remains
++ unchanged.
++
++ If more than 9 arguments were given, then arguments are shifted into
++ the \%1..9 variables from the argument vector array.
++
++ At top level, the SHIFT command operates on the \&_[] array and \%1..9
++ variables; the \&@[] array is not affected. See [587]Section 7.16 for
++ details.
++
++ The \%* variable is not affected by the SHIFT command.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.6. Clarification of Function Call Syntax
++
++ Spaces are normally stripped from the front and back of each function
++ argument; to prevent this enclose the argument in braces:
++
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a,{ })
++
++ However, function calls that contain spaces can make trouble when the
++ function is to be used in a "word" field, since space separates words.
++ For example:
++
++ for \%i 1 \fsplit(\%a,&a,{ }) 1 {
++ echo \%i. "\&a[\%i]"
++ }
++
++ In most cases, the trouble can be averted by enclosing the function
++ reference in braces:
++
++ for \%i 1 {\fsplit(\%a,&a,{ })} 1 {
++ echo \%i. "\&a[\%i]"
++ }
++
++ or by replacing spaces with \32 (the ASCII code for space):
++
++ for \%i 1 \fsplit(\%a,&a,\32) 1 {
++ echo \%i. "\&a[\%i]"
++ }
++
++ Braces are also used in function calls to indicate grouping. For
++ example:
++
++ \fsubstring(abcd,2,2) = "bc"
++
++ But suppose "abcd" needed to contain a comma:
++
++ \fsubstring(ab,cd,2,2)
++
++ This would cause an error, since "cd" appears to be the second
++ argument, when really you want the first "2" to be the second
++ argument. Braces to the rescue:
++
++ \fsubstring({ab,cd},2,2) = "b,"
++
++ Similarly, leading and trailing spaces are stripped from each
++ argument, so:
++
++ \fsubstring( abcd ,2,2) = "bc"
++
++ but braces preserve them:
++
++ \fsubstring({ abcd },2,2) = "ab"
++
++ Given these special uses for braces, there is no way to pass literal
++ braces to the function itself. For example:
++
++ \fsubstring(ab{cd,2,2)
++
++ causes an error.
++
++ So if you need a function to include braces, define a variable
++ containing the string that has braces. Example:
++
++ define \%a ab{cd
++ \fsubstring(\%a,2,2) = "b{"
++
++ If the string is to start with a leading brace and end with a closing
++ brace, then double braces must appear around the string (which itself
++ is enclosed in braces):
++
++ define \%a {{{foo}}}
++ \fsubstring(\%a) = "{foo}"
++
++ This also works for any other kind of string:
++
++ define \%a {{ab{cd}}
++ echo \fsubstring(\%a) = "ab{cd"
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.7. Autodownload during INPUT Command Execution
++
++ As of 6.1 / 1.1.12, C-Kermit can be told to look for incoming Kermit
++ (or Zmodem) packets during execution of an INPUT command. By default
++ (for consistency with earlier releases), this is not done. You can
++ enable this feature with:
++
++ SET INPUT AUTODOWNLOAD ON
++
++ (and disable it again with OFF.)
++
++ One possible use for this feature is as a server mode with a time
++ limit:
++
++ INPUT 3600 secret-string-to-end-the-INPUT-command
++
++ In this example, any GET, SEND, or REMOTE commands received within one
++ hour (3600 seconds) of when the INPUT command was issued will be
++ executed. Here's another example, in which we want to stay open until
++ 11:30pm, or until interrupted by seven consecutive Ctrl-C (\3)
++ characters:
++
++ INPUT 23:30:00 \3\3\3\3\3\3\3
++
++ The INPUT AUTODOWNLOAD setting is displayed by SHOW SCRIPTS or SHOW
++ INPUT.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.8. Built-in Help for Functions.
++
++ Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, you may obtain a description of the calling
++ conventions and return values of any built-in function, such as
++ \fsubstring(), with the new HELP FUNCTION command; give the function's
++ name without the leading "\f", e.g. "help func substring". You can use
++ ?, completion, and abbreviation in the normal manner.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.9. Variable Assignments
++
++ 7.9.1. Assignment Operators
++
++ Programmers accustomed to languages such as C or Fortran might find
++ Kermit's method of assigning values to variables unnatural or awkward.
++ Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, you can use the following alternative
++ notation:
++
++ .name = value is equivalent to DEFINE name value
++ .name := value is equivalent to ASSIGN name value
++ .name ::= value is equivalent to ASSIGN name \feval(value)
++
++ When the command begins with a period (.), this indicates an
++ assignment. The name can be a macro name, a \%{digit,letter} variable,
++ or an array element. There can be space(s) between "." and the name.
++ Examples:
++
++ .\%a = This is a string ; Same as "define \%a This is a string"
++ echo \%a
++ This is a string
++
++ .xxx = \%a ; Same as "define xxx \%a"
++ echo \m(xxx)
++ \%a
++
++ .xxx := \%a ; Same as "assign xxx \%a"
++ echo \m(xxx)
++ This is a string
++
++ declare \&a[2] ; Use with arrays...
++ define \%i 2
++ .\&a[1] = first
++ .\&a[\%i] = second
++
++ The following sequence illustrates the differences among three levels
++ of evaluation:
++
++ .\%x = 2 ; Define a variable to have a numeric value
++ .\%y = (3 + \%x) ; Define another variable as an arithmetic expression
++
++ .xxx = 4 * \%y ; "=" simply copies the right-hand side.
++ echo \m(xxx)
++ 4 * \%y
++
++ .xxx := 4 * \%y ; ":=" evaluates the variables first, then copies.
++ echo \m(xxx)
++ 4 * (3 + 2)
++
++ .xxx ::= 4 * \%y ; "::=" evaluates the expression, then copies.
++ echo \m(xxx)
++ 20
++
++ You can also use this syntax to clear (undefine) a variable:
++
++ .\%a = oofa ; Define the variable
++ echo "\%a"
++ "oofa"
++ .\%a ; Clear the variable
++ echo "\%a"
++ ""
++
++ Extra credit: Can you guess what happens below when the file "abc"
++ does not exist?
++
++ fopen /read \%c abc
++ if fail ...
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.9.2. New Assignment Commands
++
++ Recall the DEFINE and ASSIGN commands, and their hidden counterparts,
++ _DEFINE and _ASSIGN. The former take the variable name literally, the
++ latter evaluate the variable-name field to form the variable name
++ dynamically. Examples:
++
++ DEFINE \%x foo ; Sets the value of the variable \%x to "foo".
++ DEFINE \%a \%x ; Sets the value of the variable \%a to "\%x".
++ _DEFINE x_\%a \%x ; Sets the value of the variable x_foo to "\%x".
++ ASSIGN \%a \%x ; Sets the value of the variable \%a to the "foo".
++ _ASSIGN x_\%a \%x ; Sets the value of the variable x_foo to "foo".
++
++ This concept has been carried over to the remaining
++ variable-assignment commands: EVALUATE, INCREMENT, and DECREMENT:
++
++ EVALUATE variablename expression
++ Evaluates the arithmetic expression and assigns its value to
++ the variable whose name is given. Example: "eval \%a 1+1"
++ assigns "2" to \%a.
++
++ _EVALUATE metaname expression
++ Evaluates the arithmetic expression and assigns its value to
++ the variable whose name is computed from the given metaname.
++ Example: "eval foo<\%a>::\%1 \%2 * (\%3 + \%4)" assigns the
++ value of "\%2 * (\%3 + \%4)" to the variable whose name is
++ computed from "foo<\%a>::\%1".
++
++ INCREMENT variablename [ expression ]
++ Evaluates the arithmetic expression and adds its value to the
++ value of the variable whose name is given. Example: "increment
++ \%a".
++
++ _INCREMENT metaname [ expression ]
++ Evaluates the arithmetic expression and adds its value to the
++ value of the variable whose name is computed from the given
++ metaname. Example: "_increment Words::\%1.count[\%2]".
++
++ DECREMENT variablename [ expression ]
++ Evaluates the arithmetic expression and subtracts its value
++ from the value of the variable whose name is given.
++
++ _DECREMENT metaname [ expression ]
++ Evaluates the arithmetic expression and subtracts its value
++ from the value of the variable whose name is computed from the
++ given metaname.
++
++ WARNING: The syntax of the EVALUATE command has changed since C-Kermit
++ 6.0 and K95 1.1.17. Previously, it did not include a variable name,
++ only an expression. To restore the old behavior, use SET EVALUATE OLD.
++ To return to the new behavior after restoring the old behavior, use
++ SET EVALUATE NEW.
++
++ NOTE: There are no analogs to the "_" commands for the operators
++ described in [588]Section 7.9.1; those operators can not be used to
++ assign values to variables whose names must be computed.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10. Arrays
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds lots of new array-related features, and groups them
++ together under the NEW ARRAY command:
++
++ ARRAY { CLEAR, COPY, DECLARE, DESTROY, RESIZE, SHOW, SORT }
++
++ In each of the ARRAY commands, wherever an array name is expected,
++ "short forms" may be used. For example, all of the following are
++ acceptable:
++
++ array show \&a[] (or SHOW ARRAY...)
++ array show &a[]
++ array show a[]
++ array show &a
++ array show a
++
++ In addition, ranges are accepted in the ARRAY COPY, ARRAY CLEAR, ARRAY
++ SET, ARRAY SHOW, and ARRAY SORT commands:
++
++ array clear \&a[16] ; Clears 16 thru end
++ array clear &a[16] ; Ditto
++ array clear a[16] ; Ditto
++
++ array clear \&a[16:32] ; Clears 16 thru 32
++ array clear &a[16:32] ; Ditto
++ array clear a[16:32] ; Ditto
++
++ When using array names as function arguments, you must omit the "\"
++ and you must include the "&". You may optionally include empty
++ brackets. Examples:
++
++ \fsplit(\%a,a) ; Bad
++ \fsplit(\%a,\&a) ; Bad
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a[3]) ; Bad
++
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a) ; Good
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a[]) ; Good
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.1. Array Initializers
++
++ Beginning in C-Kermit 7.0, you may initialize an array -- in whole or
++ in part -- in its declaration:
++
++ [ ARRAY ] DECLARE array-name[size] [ = ] [ value1 [ value2 [...] ] ]
++
++ For compatibility with versions 5A and 6.0, the ARRAY keyword is
++ optional. DECLARE can also be spelled DCL.
++
++ Initializers are (a) optional, (b) start with element 1, (c) must be
++ enclosed in braces if they contain spaces, and (d) are evaluated
++ according to normal rules by the DECLARE command prior to assignment.
++ Thus the assignments made here are the same as those made by the
++ ASSIGN command. This allows you to initialize array elements from the
++ values of other variables. If you actually want to initialize an array
++ element to variable's name, as opposed to its value, use double
++ backslashes (as in "\\&a", "\\v(time)", etc).
++
++ The size (dimension) of the array is optional. If the size is omitted,
++ as in "\&a[]", then the array sizes itself to the number of
++ initializers; if there are no initializers the array is not declared
++ or, if it was declared previously, it is destroyed. If a size is
++ given, any extra elements in the initialization list are discarded and
++ ignored.
++
++ NOTE: Unlike in C, the list of initializers is NOT enclosed in braces.
++ Instead, braces are used to group multiple words together. So:
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = { one two three }
++
++ would create an array with two elements (0 and 1), with element 1
++ having the value " one two three ".
++
++ Examples:
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[16]
++ Declares the array \&a with 17 elements (0 through 16), in
++ which all elements are initially empty. If the array \&a[]
++ existed before, the earlier copy is destroyed.
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE &a[16]
++ ARRAY DECLARE a[16]
++ ARRAY DCL \&a[16]
++ ARRAY DCL &a[16]
++ ARRAY DCL a[16]
++ DECLARE \&a[16]
++ DECLARE &a[16]
++ DECLARE a[16]
++ DCL \&a[16]
++ DCL &a[16]
++ DCL a[16]
++ All of the above are the same as the first example.
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[16] = alpha beta {gamma delta}
++ Declares the array \&a with 17 elements (0 through 16),
++ initializing \&a[1] to "alpha", \&a[2] to "beta", and \&a[3] to
++ "gamma delta". The remaining elements are empty.
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = alpha beta {gamma delta}
++ Same as the previous example, but the array is automatically
++ dimensioned to 3.
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[3] = alpha beta {gamma delta} epsilon zeta
++ Too many initializers; only the first three are kept.
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[0]
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[]
++ ARRAY DECLARE &a[]
++ ARRAY DECLARE &a
++ ARRAY DECLARE a
++ DECLARE \&[0]
++ DECLARE a
++ DCL a
++ All of these are equivalent. Each destroys \&a[] if it exists.
++ Declaring an array with a dimension of 0 is the same as ARRAY
++ DESTROY arrayname.
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = \%1 \%2 \%3
++ Declares the array \&a with 3 elements (0 through 3),
++ initializing \&a[1] to the value of \%1, \&a[2] to the value of
++ \%2, and \&a[3] to the value of \%3. In this case, any
++ reference to one of these array elements is replaced by the
++ value of the corresponding \%n variable at the time the
++ declaration was executed (immediate evaluation; the array
++ element's value does not change if the initializer variable's
++ value changes).
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = \\%1 \\%2 \\%3
++ Declares the array \&a with 3 elements (0 through 3),
++ initializing \&a[1] to the string "\%1", \&a[2] to "\%2", and
++ \&a[3] to "\%3". In this case any reference to one of these
++ array elements is replaced by the CURRENT value of the
++ corresponding \%n variable (deferred evaluation -- the array
++ element's value follows the value of the initializer variable).
++
++ The equal sign (=) preceding the initializer list is optional, but is
++ recommended for clarity. If you need to initialize element 1 to a
++ literal equal sign, use two of them, separated by a space, as in this
++ example:
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] = = + - * /
++
++ Remember, element 0 is not initialized by the DECLARE command. To
++ initialize element 0, use a regular DEFINE or ASSIGN command:
++
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[] one two three four five six seven eight nine
++ DEFINE \&a[0] zero
++
++ Finally, remember that every command level has its own local array,
++ \&_[], containing all the macro arguments (\%0, \%1, ...) for that
++ level. See [589]Section 7.5 for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.2. Turning a String into an Array of Words
++
++ The \fsplit(s1,&a,s2,s3) function assigns the words of string s1 to
++ successive elements of the array (beginning with element 1) whose
++ identifying letter, a-z, is given after the "&" in the second
++ argument, using break and include characters given in s2 and s3. See
++ [590]Section 7.3 for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.3. Arrays of Filenames
++
++ See [591]Section 4.11.3 for news about how \ffiles() and related
++ functions can assign a list of filenames to an array. To recapitulate
++ briefly here:
++
++ \ffiles(*,&a)
++
++ assigns all files that match the first argument to the array denoted
++ by the second argument. If the array has not been declared, it is
++ declared automatically, with exactly the number of elements needed to
++ hold the file list; if it was previously declared, it is destroyed and
++ reused. The filenames are assigned starting at array element 1.
++ Element 0 holds the number of files in the list.
++
++ The DIRECTORY command ([592]Section 4.5.1) can also create filename
++ arrays if you give it the /ARRAY: switch; this allows selection
++ criteria beyond whether the filename matches the given pattern.
++
++ All functions and commands that create filename arrays store the
++ number of filenames, n, as element 0 of the array, and the filenames
++ as elements 1 through n.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.4. Automatic Arrays
++
++ In a command file or macro, you can now have local (automatic) arrays.
++ Just give the name followed by empty subscript brackets (no spaces
++ inside the brackets please) in a LOCAL command, and then declare the
++ array:
++
++ LOCAL \%a \&a[] oofa
++ ARRAY DECLARE \&a[32] = value1 value2 value3 ...
++
++ This declares the scalar variable \%a, the array \&a[], and the macro
++ name "oofa" to be local, and then declares the new local copy of \&a[]
++ with 32 elements, perhaps assigning some initial values. When C-Kermit
++ exits from the command file or macro containing these command, the
++ previous \&a[] array is restored (and if there was no \&a[] at any
++ higher level, this will still be true). The process can be repeated to
++ any level. Thus it is now safe to write scripts or macros containing
++ arrays without danger of interfering with global arrays of the same
++ name.
++
++ Just as scalars are inherited by lower command levels, so are arrays.
++ So, for example, if \&a[] is declared at top level, all lower levels
++ will see it unless they include a "local \&a[]" statement, in which
++ case all levels at and beneath the level where the LOCAL statement was
++ executed will see the local copy. This too can be repeated to any
++ level.
++
++ On the other hand, if you DECLARE an array at a lower command level
++ without also making it LOCAL, this replaces the copy that was declared
++ at the lowest command level above this one.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.5. Sorting Arrays
++
++ Although arrays can be sorted using FOR loops as shown on page 383 of
++ Using C-Kermit, 2nd Ed., this involves quite a bit of repetitive
++ interpretation by the command parser, and so can be slow for large
++ arrays. For this reason, C-Kermit 7.0 adds a built-in SORT command:
++
++ ARRAY SORT [ switches ] array [ array2 ]
++ Sorts the given array in place. Sorting is strictly lexical
++ (string based). The array name can be given fully, e.g.
++ "\&a[]", or the "\" and/or "&" and/or brackets can be omitted,
++ e.g. "array sort \&a[]", "sort &a", "sort a". Also, a range can
++ be indicated in the brackets as noted in [593]Section 7.10, to
++ restrict the sort to a range of elements (equivalent to the
++ /RANGE switch, described just below), e.g. "array sort
++ &a[20:30]".
++
++ A second array may be specified. If it is, and if it is at least as
++ big as the first array, it is sorted according to the first array. For
++ a sample application, see [594]Section 7.10.10.
++
++ See [595]Section 1.5 for an explanation of switches. The optional
++ switches are:
++
++ /CASE:{ON,OFF}
++ /CASE:ON means that alphabetic case is significant in
++ comparisons; uppercase letters are sorted before lowercase
++ ones. /CASE:OFF means case is ignored, e.g. "A" is the same as
++ "a". If this switch is not given, sorting is according the
++ current SET CASE setting.
++
++ /KEY:n
++ Comparison begins at position n(1-based) in each string. If no
++ key is given, the entire strings are compared. Only one key can
++ be given. If an array element is shorter than the key value, n,
++ that element is considered empty for comparison purposes, and
++ therefore lexically less than any element at least ncharacters
++ long.
++
++ /NUMERIC
++ If this switch is included, it means sorting should be numeric,
++ rather than lexical. The sort key is the string starting at the
++ key position, skipping any leading blanks or tabs, and then as
++ much of the string from that point on that fits the definition
++ of "numeric", terminating at the first character that does not
++ qualify. A numeric string has an optional sign (+ or -)
++ followed by one or more digits, and (if your version of Kermit
++ was built with floating-point support; see [596]Section 7.23 )
++ zero or one decimal point (period). If both /CASE and /NUMERIC
++ are given, /NUMERIC takes precedence.
++
++ /RANGE:n[:m]
++ Sort elements nthrough m of the array. By default, the entire
++ array from element 1 to its dimensioned size is sorted, which
++ might produce surprising results if the array is not full; see
++ example in [597]Section 7.10.7. If ":m" is omitted from the
++ range, the dimensioned size is used. Thus, to sort an entire
++ array, \&a[], including its 0th element, use "sort /range:0
++ &a". You can also sort any desired section of an array, e.g.
++ "sort /range:10:20 &a" or "sort /range:\%i:\%j-1 &b". As noted
++ above, you can also specify a range in the array-name brackets.
++ If you specify a range in the array-name brackets AND with a
++ /RANGE switch, the ones in the brackets take precedence.
++
++ /REVERSE
++ Sort in reverse order. If this switch is not given, the array
++ is sorted in ascending order.
++
++ Remember that numeric switch arguments can be numbers, arithmetic
++ expressions, or variables whose values are numbers or expressions, as
++ illustrated in the /RANGE examples above.
++
++ A typical sorting application might be to list students' test scores
++ in descending order. Suppose you had the following records:
++
++ olaf 65
++ olga 98
++ ivan 83
++ xena 100
++
++ (and so on) stored in array \&s[] (e.g. by reading them from a file as
++ illustrated in [598]section 7.10.7). In these records, the student's
++ name is in columns 1-9 and the score in 10-12. So to rearrange the
++ list in descending order of score:
++
++ sort /key:10 /reverse &s
++
++ Then to list your top five students:
++
++ for \%i 1 5 1 { echo \&s[\%i] }
++
++ Or more simply (see next section):
++
++ show array a[1:5]
++
++ To illustrate the difference between a lexical and a numeric sort,
++ suppose you have the following records (the lines that are numbered,
++ starting at column 1) in array \&a[]:
++
++ Column 1 2
++ 12345678901234567890
++
++ 1. Ivan 10.0 2. Olaf 9.95 3. Olga 101.5
++
++ ARRAY SORT /KEY:10 &a[] would order them 3,1,2, but ARRAY SORT /KEY:10
++ /NUMERIC &a[] would order them 2,1,3.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.6. Displaying Arrays
++
++ The SHOW ARRAY command (or ARRAY SHOW) now accepts an optional
++ array-name argument:
++
++ SHOW ARRAY \&a[]
++
++ (you can leave off the \, the \&, and/or the []'s if you like; "show
++ array a" is equivalent to "show array \&a[]"). When an array is
++ specified, its dimension is shown and all defined (non-empty) elements
++ are listed.
++
++ Example:
++
++ assign \%n \ffiles(*,&a) ; Fill an array with filenames ([599]Section 4.11.3
++)
++ show array \&a[] ; Show the array we just read
++ array show \&a[] ; Same as previous
++ array sort \&a[] ; Sort the array
++ array show \&a[] ; Show it after sorting
++ array show \&a ; Show it again
++ array show &a ; Show it again
++ array show a ; Show it again
++
++ (The final four commands demonstrate the alternative forms that are
++ accepted for the array name.)
++
++ If you SHOW ARRAY without giving an array name, all defined arrays are
++ listed by name and dimension, but their contents are not shown.
++
++ You can also show a piece of an array by including a subscript or
++ range within the array brackets:
++
++ array show \&a[5] ; Shows \&a[5]
++ array show &a[3:8] ; Shows \&a[3] through \&a[8]
++ array show a[:\%n-1] ; Shows \&a[0] through \&a[\%n-1]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.7. Other Array Operations
++
++ ARRAY DESTROY arrayname
++ Destroys and undeclares the named array. Subscripts or ranges
++ are not accepted in this command.
++
++ ARRAY COPY array1 array2
++ Copies the first array to the second array. If the target array
++ has not been declared, it is created automatically with the
++ same size as the first. If it has been declared, it will be
++ used as declared; if the source array is larger, only as much
++ of it as will fit is copied to the target array. Syntax for
++ array1 and array2 is as in ARRAY SHOW (SHOW ARRAY). Example:
++
++ .\%n := \ffiles(*,&a) ; Create and load array A with a file list.
++ array copy &a &b ; Copy array A to array B.
++
++ The ARRAY COPY command also lets you copy pieces of arrays by
++ including range specifiers, as in these examples:
++
++ ARRAY COPY \&a[4:27] \&b
++ This copies \&a[] elements 4-27 to \&b[] elements 1-23,
++ creating \&b[] if necessary or, if \&b[] is already
++ declared, stopping early if its size is less than 23.
++
++ ARRAY COPY \&a[4:27] \&b[12]
++ This copies \&a[] elements 4-27 to \&b[] elements 12-35,
++ creating \&b[] if necessary or, if \&b[] is already
++ declared, stopping early if its size is less than 35.
++
++ ARRAY COPY \&a[4:27] \&b[12:14]
++ This copies \&a[] elements 4-6 to \&b[] elements 12-14,
++ creating \&b[] if necessary or, if \&b[] is already
++ declared, stopping early if its size is less than 14.
++
++ ARRAY COPY \&a[17] \&b
++ This copies all the elements of \&a[] starting with 17
++ until the last to \&b[], creating \&b[] if necessary or,
++ if \&b[] is already declared, stopping early if \&b[] is
++ not big enough.
++
++ ARRAY CLEAR arrayname
++ Sets all the elements of the array to the empty value. You may
++ also include a range specifier to clear only a selected portion
++ of the array; for example "array clear \&a[37:214]". If the
++ range is out of bounds, only the part of the array that is in
++ bounds is cleared.
++
++ ARRAY SET arrayname [ value ]
++ Sets all the elements of the array to the given value. If no
++ value is given, the array is cleared. You may also include a
++ range specifier to set only a selected portion of the array;
++ for example "array set \&a[1:9] -1". If the range is out of
++ bounds, only the part of the array that is in bounds is set.
++
++ ARRAY RESIZE arrayname size
++ Resizes the given array. If the size is greater than the
++ array's current dimension, new empty elements are added to the
++ end. If the size is less than the current dimension, the extra
++ elements are discarded. Note: If you have stored the array size
++ in element 0, ARRAY RESIZE does not change this value.
++ Alternative notation: ARRAY RESIZE arrayname[size]. For a
++ practical example, see [600]Section 7.10.11.
++
++ \farraylook(pattern,arrayname)
++ This function returns the index of the first element of the
++ given array that matches the given pattern (for details about
++ pattern syntax, see [601]section 4.9). The array name can
++ include a range specification to restrict the search to a given
++ segment of the array. If no elements match the pattern, -1 is
++ returned.
++
++ \ftablelook(keyword,arrayname[,delimiter])
++ Looks in the given "table", which must be sorted, for the given
++ keyword. The keyword need not be spelled out in full.
++ Pattern-matching characters should not be included as part of
++ the keyword. The function returns the index of the table
++ element that uniquely matches the given keyword, or -1 if none
++ match, or -2 if more than 1 match.
++
++ A "table" is an array that is sorted in lexical order; each of its
++ elements may contain multiple fields, delimited by the given delimiter
++ character or, if no delimiter is specified, a colon (:).
++
++ The \farraylook() function does exactly what you tell it. If you give
++ it a pattern that does not include wildcard characters (such as *, ?,
++ etc), it requires an exact match. For example:
++
++ \farraylook(oofa,&a)
++
++ searches for the first element of \&a[] whose value is "oofa". But:
++
++ \farraylook(oofa*,&a)
++
++ finds the first element whose value starts with "oofa", and;
++
++ \farraylook(*oofa,&a)
++
++ finds the first element whose value ends with "oofa", and;
++
++ \farraylook(*oofa*,&a)
++
++ finds the first element whose value contains "oofa".
++
++ Here's a simple demonstration of looking up patterns in arrays:
++
++ local \&a[] \%x \%n
++ declare \&a[] = zero one two three four five six seven eight nine ten
++ while true {
++ .\%x = 1
++ .\%n = 0
++ ask \%a { Pattern? }
++ if not def \%a exit 0 Done.
++ while <= \%x \fdim(&a) {
++ .\%x := \farraylook(\%a,&a[\%x])
++ if ( < \%x 0 ) break
++ echo \flpad(\%x,3). \&a[\%x]
++ increment \%x
++ increment \%n
++ }
++ if ( < \%n 1 ) echo Pattern not found - "\%a"
++ }
++
++ The array need not be sorted. When a pattern is given, a search is
++ performed; if there is a match, the matching element's index and the
++ element itself are printed, and the search begins again at the next
++ element. Thus each matching element is printed. If none match, the
++ "Pattern not found" message is printed. The process repeats for as
++ many patterns as the user wants to type, and terminates when the user
++ types an empty pattern.
++
++ Now let's build a little command parser, consisting of a keyword
++ table, and a loop to look up the user's commands in it with
++ \ftablelook(). In this case the array elements have "fields" separated
++ by colon (:) -- a keyword and a value. Keyword tables must be sorted
++ if \tablelook() is to work right, so after declaring and initializing
++ the table array, we sort it.
++
++ local \&k[] \%a \%i \%n
++
++ array declare \&k[] = drive:9 do:8 discuss:7 live:6 spend:5 help:4 quit:0
++
++ array sort &k ; Make sure array is sorted
++ echo Type "help" for help. ; Print greeting & instructions
++
++ while true { ; Loop to get commands
++ undefine \%a
++ while not defined \%a { ; Get a command
++ ask \%a { Command? }
++ }
++ .\%n := \ftablelook(\%a,&k) ; Look up the command
++ switch \%n { ; Handle errors
++ :-1, echo Not found - "\%a" ; Doesn't match
++ continue
++ :-2, echo Ambiguous - "\%a" ; Matches too many
++ continue
++ }
++ switch \fword(\&k[\%n],2) { ; Dispatch according to value
++ :9, echo Driving..., break
++ :8, echo Doing..., break
++ :7, echo Discussing..., break
++ :6, echo Living..., break
++ :5, echo Spending..., break
++ :4, echo { Commands (may be abbreviated):}
++ for \%i 1 \fdim(&k) 1 {
++ echo { \%i. \fword(\&k[\%i],1) }
++ }
++ break
++ :0, exit 0 Bye!
++ :default, stop 1 Internal error
++ }
++ }
++
++ In this example, keywords are "drive", "do", "discuss", etc, and their
++ values are unique numbers (values need not be numbers, and there need
++ not be only one value -- there can be 0, 1, 2, or more of them). The
++ user types a command, which can be the whole word (like "help") or any
++ abbreviation (like "hel", "he", or just "h"). If this does not match
++ any keywords, \ftablelook() returns -1; if it matches more than one
++ (as would "d"), it returns -2. Otherwise the array index is returned,
++ 1 or higher.
++
++ Given the array index \%n, we can get the table values as follows:
++
++ \fword(\&k[\%n],1) is the keyword (first field)
++ \fword(\&k[\%n],2) is the value (second field, in this case a number)
++
++ In our example, we use the value (number) as the SWITCH variable. As
++ noted, \fablelook() expects the array elements to contain multiple
++ fields separated by colon (:) (or other character that you specify,
++ e.g. \ftablelook(\%a,&a,^)) and when matching the keyword, ignores the
++ first delimiter and everything after it.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.8. Hints for Using Arrays
++
++ C programmers are accustomed to out-of-bounds array references causing
++ core dumps or worse. In C-Kermit:
++
++ * A reference to an an out-of-bounds array element returns the empty
++ string.
++ * An attempt to set the value of an array element that is out of
++ bounds or that has not been declared simply fails.
++
++ C programmers expect an array of size nto have elements 0 through n-1.
++ Fortran programmers expect the same array to have elements 1 through
++ n. C-Kermit accommodates both styles; when you declare an array of
++ size n, it has n=1 elements, 0 through n, and you can use the array in
++ your accustomed manner, 0-based or 1-based.
++
++ However, note that C-Kermit has certain biases towards 1-based arrays:
++
++ * Assignment of file lists starts with element 1 ([602]Section
++ 7.10.3).
++ * Assignment by \fsplit() starts with element 1 ([603]Section 7.3).
++ * Array initialization skips the 0th element. To initialize a
++ 0-based array, use something like this:
++ declare \&a[3] = one two three
++ .\&a[0] = zero
++ * The ARRAY SORT command skips the 0th element unless you include
++ /RANGE:0
++ * The SHIFT command ignores element 0 of the \&_[] array.
++
++ The distinction between an array's dimensioned size and the number of
++ elements in the array is important when sorting. To illustrate:
++
++ declare \&a[100] ; Declare array &a with 100 elements
++ fopen /read \%c oofa.txt ; Open a file
++ if fail...
++ for \%i 1 \fdim(&a) 1 { ; Read the file into the array
++ fread \%c \&a[\%i]
++ if fail break
++ }
++ fclose \%c
++ if > \%i \fdim(&a) end 1 File has too many lines for array.
++ .\%n ::= \%i - 1
++ echo File has \%n line(s).
++
++ Let's say the file had 95 lines. This leaves elements 96-100 of the
++ array empty. Now suppose you sort the array and write out the result:
++
++ sort &a ; Sort the whole array
++ fopen /write \%o oofa.txt.sorted ; Open an output file
++ if fail ...
++ for \%i 1 \%n 1 { ; Write out 95 records
++ fwrite /line \%o \&a[\%i]
++ if fail end 1 Write error
++ }
++ close write
++
++ You might be surprised at the contents of "oofa.txt.sorted" -- five
++ empty elements, 96-100, floated to the top of the array in the sort,
++ and since your write loop only had 95 iterations, the final 5 lines of
++ the sorted file are lost.
++
++ Therefore, when dealing with partially filled arrays -- especially
++ when sorting them -- remember to specify the number of elements. A
++ handy way of recording an array's "true" size is to put it in the 0th
++ element. That way, it "travels with the array". To illustrate
++ (continuing the previous example at the "close read" statement):
++
++ close read
++ if > \%i \fdim(&a) end 1 File has too many lines for array.
++ .\&a[0] ::= \%i - 1 ; Assign number of lines to \&a[0].
++ echo File has \&a[0] line(s).
++ sort /range:1:\&a[0] &a
++ open write oofa.txt.sorted
++ if fail ...
++ for \%i 1 \&a[0] 1 {
++ writeln file \&a[\%j]
++ if fail end 1 Write error
++ }
++ close write
++
++ Note the SORT switch, /RANGE:1:\&a[0]. This keeps the sort 1-based,
++ and uses element 0 of the array as its size indicator.
++
++ Finally, note that even though some commands or functions might put a
++ size in array element 0, no built-in functions or commands depend on a
++ size actually being there. Thus you are perfectly free to replace the
++ size with something else and treat the array as 0-based.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.9. Do-It-Yourself Arrays
++
++ Kermit's \&x[] arrays are nice because of the accompanying built-in
++ functionality -- ARRAY commands, built-in functions that load and
++ search arrays, automatic evaluation of arithmetic expressions within
++ the subscript brackets, and so on. Yet they also have certain
++ limitations:
++
++ 1. Except when created by dynamic loading (e.g. by \ffiles()) they
++ must be declared and dimensioned in advance.
++ 2. Indices must be numeric, positive, and in range.
++ 3. There can be only one dimension. Matrices or other
++ higher-dimensioned arrays are not available.
++
++ But none of this is to say you can't invent any kind of data structure
++ you like. In [604]Section 7.9.2 you can see some examples. Here's
++ another (courtesy of Dat Thuc Nguyen), in which a pair of matrices is
++ created and then added: no dimensioning necessary.
++
++ .row = 4
++ .col = 9
++
++ ; MACRO TO PRINT A MATRIX
++ define PMATRIX {
++ echo Matrix \%1:
++ for \%r 1 \m(row) 1 {
++ for \%c 1 \m(col) 1 {
++ xecho \flpad(\m(\%1[\%r][\%c]),4)
++ }
++ echo
++ }
++ echo
++ }
++ ; CREATE MATRICES A AND B
++ for \%r 1 \m(row) 1 {
++ for \%c 1 \m(col) 1 {
++ _eval A[\%r][\%c] \%r + \%c
++ _eval B[\%r][\%c] \%r * \%c
++ }
++ }
++ ; CREATE MATRIX C = SUM OF MATRIX A AND MATRIX B
++ for \%r 1 \m(row) 1 {
++ for \%c 1 \m(col) 1 {
++ _eval C[\%r][\%c] \m(A[\%r][\%c]) + \m(B[\%r][\%c])
++ }
++ }
++ pmatrix A ; Print Matrix A
++ pmatrix B ; Print Matrix B
++ pmatrix C ; Print Matrix C
++
++ In the example, we use matrix-like notation to create macros with
++ names like "A[1][1]", "B[3][7]", and so on.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.10. Associative Arrays
++
++ An associative array is a special kind of Do-It-Yourself array. It
++ differs from a regular array in that its indices need not be numbers
++ -- they can be anything at all -- words, filenames, names of months,
++ any character string at all, and that it doesn't have to be (and in
++ fact can't be) declared. An associative array element is simply a
++ macro whose name ends with an index enclosed in angle brackets, for
++ example:
++
++ file<oofa.txt>
++
++ More formally:
++
++ basename<index>
++
++ An associative array is a collection of all associative array elements
++ that have the same basename. Any number of associative arrays, each
++ with any number of elements, can exist at the same time.
++
++ An associative array element can be assigned a value, such as "1",
++ just like any other macro:
++
++ define file<oofa.txt> 1 ; Give "file<oofa.txt>" the value "1".
++
++ or:
++
++ assign file<oofa.txt> \%a ; Give it the value of the variable \%a.
++
++ However, since an associative array element is a macro, it may not
++ have an empty (null) value, since assigning an empty value to a macro
++ undefines the macro.
++
++ You can refer to the value of an associative array element using the
++ familiar notation for macro values:
++
++ echo \m(file<oofa.txt>) ; Echo the value of "file<oofa.txt>".
++
++ Associative arrays are most useful, however, when the value of the
++ index is a variable. In that case, you must use the "hidden" forms of
++ the DEFINE or ASSIGN commands that evaluate the macro name before
++ making the assignment (see [605]Using C-Kermit, page 457). Example:
++
++ define \%f oofa.txt
++ _define file<\%f> 1
++ echo file<\%f> = \m(file<\%f>)
++
++ prints:
++
++ file<oofa.txt> = 1
++
++ and then:
++
++ _increment file<\%f>
++ echo file<\%f> = \m(file<\%f>)
++
++ prints:
++
++ file<oofa.txt> = 2
++
++ What are associative arrays good for? The classic example is "word
++ counts": finding the number of times each word is used in a text
++ without knowing in advance what the words are. Without associative
++ arrays, your program would have to build a table of some kind, and
++ every time a word was encountered, look it up in the table to find its
++ position and counter, or add it to the table if it wasn't found -- a
++ time-consuming and laborious process. Associative arrays, however, let
++ you use the word itself as the table index and therefore sidestep all
++ the table building and lookups.
++
++ Let's work through a practical example. Suppose you have a
++ file-transfer log in which each line is composed of a number of
++ blank-separated fields, and the 9th field is a filename (which happens
++ to be the format of certain FTP server logs, as well as of C-Kermit's
++ new FTP-format transaction log, described in [606]Section 4.17.2), for
++ example:
++
++ Wed Jul 14 09:35:31 1999 22 xx.mit.edu 13412 /pub/ftp/mm/intro.txt ....
++
++ and you want to find out how many times each file was transferred. The
++ following code builds an associative array, file<>, containing the
++ counts for each file:
++
++ local name line max \%c \%n ; Declare local variables
++ fopen /read \%c /var/log/ftpd.log ; Open the log file ([607]Section 1.22)
++ if fail exit 1 Can't open log ; Check
++ while true { ; Loop for each record
++ fread /line \%c line ; Read a line
++ if fail break ; Check for end of file
++ .name := \fword(\m(line),9,{ }) ; Get 9th field = filename (Sec 7.3)
++ _increment file<\m(name)> ; Increment its counter (Sec 7.9.2)
++ }
++ fclose \%c ; Close file when done.
++
++ Note that _INCREMENT (and INCREMENT, and [_]DECREMENT) treat an empty
++ (i.e. nonexistent) variable as having a value of 0, and therefore
++ creates the variable with a value of 1.
++
++ At this point, if you told Kermit to "show macro file<", it would list
++ the associative array. But since you don't necessarily know the names
++ of the files in the array, or even how many elements are in the array,
++ how can you use it in a script program?
++
++ The idea of creating macro names that include character-string indices
++ enclosed in angle brackets is perfectly arbitrary and doesn't depend
++ on any Kermit features that weren't already there -- we could just as
++ easily have used some other notation, such as "file[index]",
++ "file:index", or "file.index", and the code above would have worked
++ just as well (with the corresponding syntax adjustments). But to be
++ able to use an associative array in a program after the array is
++ built, we need a method of accessing all its elements without knowing
++ in advance what they are. That's where the chosen notation comes in.
++
++ First of all, any macro name that ends with "<xxx>" (where "xxx" is
++ any string) is case sensitive, unlike all other macro names, which are
++ case independent. To illustrate, "file<oofa.txt>" and "file<OOFA.TXT>"
++ are two distinct macros, whereas "OOFA", "Oofa", and "oofa", when used
++ as macro names, are all the same.
++
++ Second, the new \faaconvert() function converts an associative array
++ (that is, all macros with names of the form "base<index>" that have
++ the same "base" part) into a pair of regular arrays and returns the
++ number of elements:
++
++ \faaconvert(name,&a[,&b])
++
++ "name" is the name of the associative array, without the angle
++ brackets or index ("file" in our example).
++
++ The second argument is the name of a regular array in which to store
++ the indices of the associative array (filenames in our example); if an
++ array of this name already exists, it is destroyed unless the array is
++ LOCAL. The third argument is the name of another regular array in
++ which to store the values (the counts in our example), with the same
++ rules about array name collisions. If you care only about the indices
++ and not the values, you can omit the third argument to \faaconvert().
++ In any case, the associative array is converted, not copied: its
++ elements are moved to the specified regular arrays, so after
++ conversion the original associative array is gone.
++
++ As with other array-loading functions, \faaconvert() sets element 0 of
++ each array to the number of elements in the array.
++
++ To continue our example:
++
++ .max := 0 ; Maximum count
++ .\%n := \faaconvert(file,&a,&b) ; Convert
++ for \%i 1 \%n 1 { ; Loop through values
++ echo \flpad(\%i,3). \&a[\%i]: \&b[\%i] ; Echo this pair
++ if ( > \&b[\%i] \m(max) ) { ; Check for new maximum
++ .name := \&a[\%i]
++ .max := \&b[\%i]
++ }
++ }
++ echo Most popular file: \m(name), accesses: \m(max)
++
++ This lists the files and counts and then announces which file has the
++ highest count.
++
++ Now suppose you want to sort the array pair created from an
++ associative array. In our example, \&a[] contains filenames, and \&b[]
++ contains the associated counts. Here we take advantage of the ARRAY
++ SORT command's ability to sort a second array according to the first
++ one:
++
++ array sort /reverse /numeric &b &a ; Descending sort by count
++
++ Now to see the top five files and their counts:
++
++ echo The top 5 files are:
++ for \%i 1 5 1 { ; Loop through top 5 values
++ echo \flpad(\%i,3). \&a[\%i]: \&b[\%i] ; Echo this pair
++ }
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.10.11. Transferring Array Contents to Other Computers
++
++ The SEND /ARRAY:arrayname command ([608]Section 4.7.1) allows you to
++ send the contents of any array, or any contiguous segment of it, in
++ either text or binary mode to another computer, using Kermit protocol.
++ When used in conjunction with C-Kermit's other features (the array
++ features described in this section; the file i/o package from
++ [609]Section 1.22; its decision-making, pattern-matching, and string
++ manipulation capabilities, and so on) the possibilities are endless:
++ extracts of large files, remote database queries, ..., all without
++ recourse to system-dependent mechanisms such UNIX pipes and filters,
++ thus ensuring cross-platform portability of scripts that use these
++ features.
++
++ When sending an array in text mode, Kermit appends a line terminator
++ to each array element, even empty ones, and it also converts the
++ character set from your current FILE character-set to your current
++ TRANSFER character-set, if any. No conversions are made or line
++ terminations added in binary mode. For example, the following array:
++
++ dcl \&a[] = One Two Three Four Five Six
++
++ is sent as six lines, one word per line, in text mode, and as the bare
++ unterminated string "OneTwoThreeFourFiveSix" in binary mode.
++
++ You should always include a /TEXT or /BINARY switch in any SEND /ARRAY
++ command to force the desired transfer mode, otherwise you're likely to
++ be surprised by the effects described in [610]Section 4.3.
++
++ Here are some examples:
++
++ send /text /array:\&a[]
++ Sends the entire contents of the array \&a[] in text mode.
++ Since an as-name is not included, the receiver is told the
++ filename is _array_a_.
++
++ send /text /array:&a[]
++ send /text /array:a[]
++ send /text /array:&a
++ send /text /array:a
++ These are all equivalent to the previous example.
++
++ send /text /array:&a /as-name:foo.bar
++ As above, but the array is sent under the name foo.bar.
++
++ send /text /array:&a[100:199] /as:foo.bar
++ As above, but only the elements from 100 through 199 are sent.
++
++ In text-mode transfers, character sets are translated according to
++ your current settings, just as for text files. In binary mode, of
++ course, there is no character-set translation or other conversion of
++ any kind. But remember that array elements can not contain the NUL
++ (ASCII 0) character, since they are implemented as NUL-terminated
++ strings.
++
++ Here's an example that shows how to send all the lines (up to 1000 of
++ them) from a file animals.txt that contain the words "cat", "dog", or
++ "hog" (see [611]Section 4.9 about pattern matching):
++
++ declare \&a[1000]
++ fopen /read \%c animals.txt
++ if fail exit 1
++ .\%i = 0
++ while true {
++ fread \%c line
++ if fail break
++ if match {\m(line)} {*{cat,[dh]og}*} {
++ increment \%i
++ if ( > \%i \fdim(&a) ) break
++ .\&a[\%i] := \m(line)
++ }
++ }
++ fclose \%c
++ send /array:a[1:\%i] /text
++
++ Note that we are careful to send only the part of the array that was
++ filled, not the entire array, because there are likely to be lots of
++ unused elements at the end, and these would be sent as blank lines
++ otherwise.
++
++ This example raises an interesting question: what if we want to send
++ ALL the matching lines, even if there are more than 1000 of them, but
++ we don't know the number in advance? Clearly the problem is limited by
++ Kermit's (and the computer's) memory. If there are a thousand trillion
++ matching lines, they most likely will not fit in memory, and in this
++ case the only solution is to write them first to a temporary file on
++ mass storage and then send the temporary file and delete it
++ afterwards.
++
++ However, when the selection is likely to fit in memory, the
++ once-familiar technique of initial allocation with extents can be
++ used:
++
++ if match {\m(line)} {*{cat,[dh]og}*} {
++ increment \%i
++ if ( > \%i \fdim(&a) ) {
++ array resize a \fdim(&a)+100
++ if fail stop 1 MEMORY FULL
++ echo NEW DIMENSION: \fdim(&a)
++ }
++ .\&a[\%i] := \m(line)
++ }
++
++ This grows the array in chunks of 100 as needed.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.11. OUTPUT Command Improvements
++
++ LINEOUT [ text ]
++ This command is exactly like OUTPUT, except it supplies a
++ carriage return at the end of the text. "lineout exit" is
++ exactly the same as "output exit\13".
++
++ SET OUTPUT SPECIAL-ESCAPES { ON, OFF }
++ This command lets you tell C-Kermit whether to process \N, \L,
++ and \B specially in an OUTPUT command, as distinct from other \
++ sequences (such as \%a, \13, \v(time), etc). Normally the
++ special escapes are handled. Use SET OUTPUT SPECIAL-ESCAPES OFF
++ to disable them.
++
++ Disabling special escapes is necessary in situations when you need to
++ transmit lines of data and you have no control over what is in the
++ lines. For example, a file oofa.txt that contains:
++
++ This is a file
++ It has \%a variables in it
++ And it has \B in it.
++ And it has \L in it.
++ And it has \N in it.
++ And this is the last line.
++
++ can be sent like this:
++
++ local line
++ set output special-escapes off
++ fopen /read \%c oofa.txt
++ if fail stop 1 Can't open oofa.txt
++ while success {
++ fread \%c line
++ if fail break
++ ; Add filtering or processing commands here...
++ output \m(line)\13
++ }
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.12. Function and Variable Diagnostics
++
++ In C-Kermit 6.0 and earlier, the only diagnostic returned by a failing
++ function call was an empty value, which (a) could not be distinguished
++ from an empty value returned by a successful function call; (b) did
++ not give any indication of the cause of failure; and (c) did not cause
++ the enclosing statement to fail. C-Kermit 7.0 corrects these
++ deficiencies.
++
++ SET FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS { ON, OFF }
++ when ON, allows built-in functions to return diagnostic
++ messages when improperly referenced, instead of an empty
++ string. FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS are ON by default. When OFF,
++ improperly referenced functions continue to return an empty
++ string. This command also affects built-in variables; in this
++ case, an error message is returned only if the variable does
++ not exist. When FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS are ON, the error message
++ is also printed.
++
++ For variables, the only message is:
++
++ <ERROR:NO_SUCH_VARIABLE:\v(name)>
++
++ where "name" is the name of the nonexistent variable.
++
++ For functions, the diagnostic message is:
++
++ <ERROR:message:\fname()>
++
++ where "message" is replaced by a message, and "name" is replaced by
++ the function name, e.g. <ERROR:ARG_NOT_NUMERIC:\fmod()>. Messages
++ include:
++
++ ARG_BAD_ARRAY An argument contains a malformed array reference.
++ ARG_BAD_DATE An argument contains a malformed date and/or time.
++ ARG_BAD_PHONENUM An argument contains a malformed telephone number.
++ ARG_BAD_VARIABLE An argument contains a malformed \%x variable.
++ ARG_INCOMPLETE An argument is incomplete (e.g. a broken Base64 string).
++ ARG_EVAL_FAILURE An argument could not be evaluated (internal error).
++ ARG_NOT_ARRAY An argument references an array that is not declared.
++ ARG_NOT_NUMERIC An argument that must be integer contains non-digits.
++ ARG_NOT_FLOAT An argument has bad floating-point number format.
++ ARG_NOT_VARIABLE An argument that must be a variable is not a variable.
++ ARG_OUT_OF_RANGE An argument's numeric value is too big or too small,
++ or an argument contains illegal characters (e.g. a hex
++ or Base-64 string).
++ ARG_TOO_LONG An argument's value is too long.
++ ARRAY_FAILURE Failure to create an array.
++ DIVIDE_BY_ZERO Execution of the function would cause division by zero.
++ FLOATING_POINT_OP Execution error in a floating-point operation.
++ FILE_NOT_FOUND Filename argument names a file that can't be found.
++ FILE_NOT_READABLE Filename argument is not a regular file.
++ FILE_NOT_ACCESSIBLE Filename argument names a file that is read-protected.
++ FILE_ERROR Other error with filename argument.
++ FILE_NOT_OPEN A file function was given a channel that is not open.
++ FILE_ERROR_-n A file function got error -n ([612]Section 1.22).
++ LOOKUP_FAILURE Error looking up function (shouldn't happen).
++ MALLOC_FAILURE Failure to allocate needed memory (shouldn't happen).
++ NAME_AMBIGUOUS The function is not uniquely identified.
++ MISSING_ARG A required argument is missing.
++ NO_SUCH_FUNCTION An argument references a function that is not defined.
++ NO_SUCH_MACRO An argument references a macro that is not defined.
++ RESULT_TOO_LONG The result of a function is too long.
++ UNKNOWN_FUNCTION Internal error locating function (shouldn't happen).
++
++ Examples:
++
++ assign \%m \fmod()
++ ?<ERROR:MISSING_ARG:\fmod()>
++ echo "\fcontents(\%m)"
++ "<ERROR:MISSING_ARG:\fmod()>"
++ echo \fmod(3,x)
++ ?<ERROR:ARG_NOT_NUMERIC:\fmod()>
++ echo \fmod(3,4-2*2)
++ ?<ERROR:DIVIDE_BY_ZERO:\fmod()>
++
++ Notice the use of \fcontents() in echoing the value of a variable that
++ contains a returned error message. That's because the error message
++ includes the name of the variable or function that failed, so you must
++ use \fcontents() to prevent it from being evaluated again -- otherwise
++ the same error will occur.
++
++ The handling of function and variable errors is controlled by:
++
++ SET FUNCTION ERROR { ON, OFF }
++ Tells whether invalid function calls or variable references
++ should cause command errors. FUNCTION ERROR is ON by default.
++ When ON, and an error is diagnosed in a built-in function or
++ variable, the command that includes the function call or
++ variable reference fails. The failing command can be handled in
++ the normal way with IF FAILURE / IF SUCCESS, SET TAKE ERROR, or
++ SET MACRO ERROR.
++
++ When FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS is OFF, there is no error message.
++
++ SHOW SCRIPTS displays the current FUNCTION DIAGNOSTICS and ERROR
++ settings.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.13. Return Value of Macros
++
++ In C-Kermit 5A and 6.0, there are two ways to return one level from a
++ macro: RETURN value and END number text. When RETURN is used, the
++ value, which can be a number or a text string, is assigned to
++ \v(return). When END was used, however, \v(return) was not set.
++ SUCCESS/FAILURE was set according to whether the number was zero, and
++ the text was printed, but the actual value of the number was lost.
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, the END number is available in the \v(return)
++ variable.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.14. The ASSERT, FAIL, and SUCCEED Commands.
++
++ The ASSERT command is just like the IF command, but without a command
++ to execute. It simply succeeds or fails, and this can be tested by a
++ subsequent IF SUCCESS or IF FAILURE command. Example:
++
++ ASSERT = 1 1
++ IF SUCCESS echo 1 = 1.
++
++ The FAIL command does nothing, but always fails. The SUCCEED command
++ does nothing, but always succeeds.
++
++ These commands are handy in debugging scripts when you want to induce
++ a failure (or success) that normally would not occur, e.g. for testing
++ blocks of code that normally are not executed.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.15. Using Alarms
++
++ Alarms may be set in two ways:
++
++ SET ALARM number
++ Sets an alarm for the given number of seconds "from now", i.e.
++ in the future, relative to when the SET ALARM command was
++ given. Examples:
++
++ set alarm 60 ; 60 seconds from now
++ set alarm +60 ; The same as "60"
++ set alarm -60 ; Not legal - you can't set an alarm in the past.
++ set alarm 60*60 ; 60 minutes from now.
++ set alarm \%a+10 ; You can use variables, etc.
++
++ SET ALARM hh:mm:ss
++ Sets an alarm for the specified time. If the given time is
++ earlier than the current time, the alarm is set for the given
++ time in the next day. You may give the time in various formats:
++
++ set alarm 15:00:00 ; 3:00:00pm
++ set alarm 3:00:00pm ; 3:00:00pm
++ set alarm 3:00pm ; 3:00:00pm
++ set alarm 3pm ; 3:00:00pm
++
++ SHOW ALARM
++ Displays the current alarm, if any, in standard date-time
++ format (see [613]Section 1.6): yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss.
++
++ IF ALARM command
++ Executes the command if an alarm has been set and the alarm
++ time has passed.
++
++ IF ALARM { command-list } [ ELSE { command-list } ]
++ Executes the command-list if an alarm has been set and the
++ alarm time has passed. Otherwise, if an ELSE part is given, its
++ command-list is executed.
++
++ CLEAR ALARM
++ Clears the alarm.
++
++ Only one alarm may be set at a time.
++
++ Example: Suppose you have a script that is always running, and that
++ transfers files periodically, and that keeps a transaction log.
++ Suppose you want to start a new transaction log each day:
++
++ log transactions \v(date).log
++ set alarm 00:00:00 ; Set an alarm for midnight
++ while true { ; Main script loop
++ xif alarm { ; If the alarm time is past...
++ close transactions ; Close current log
++ log transactions \v(date).log ; Start new one
++ pause 1 ; To make sure 00:00:00 is past
++ set alarm 00:00:00 ; Set a new alarm
++ }
++ ; put the rest of the script here...
++ }
++
++ Note that IF ALARM -- no matter whether it succeeds or fails -- does
++ NOT clear an expired alarm. Thus, once an alarm has expired, every IF
++ ALARM will succeed until the alarm is cleared (with the CLEAR ALARM
++ command) or reset with a new SET ALARM command.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.16. Passing Arguments to Command Files
++
++ Beginning in version 7.0, C-Kermit accepts arguments on the TAKE
++ command line, for example:
++
++ C-Kermit> take oofa.ksc one two {this is three} four
++
++ This automatically sets the variables \%1 through \%9 to the
++ arguments, and \%0 to the name of the file, in this case:
++
++ \%0 = /usr/olga/oofa.ksc
++ \%1 = one
++ \%2 = two
++ \%3 = this is three
++ \%4 = four
++
++ and \%5..\%9 are undefined (empty). Arguments past the ninth are
++ available in the \&_[] argument-vector array ( [614]Section 7.5).
++
++ The variables are those at the current macro level. Thus, if the TAKE
++ command is executed from within a macro, the macro's arguments are
++ replaced by those given on the TAKE command line (but only if at least
++ one argument is given). The command shown above is exactly equivalent
++ to:
++
++ assign \%0 /usr/olga/oofa.ksc
++ assign \%1 one
++ assign \%2 two
++ assign \%3 this is three
++ assign \%4 four
++ assign \%5
++ assign \%6
++ assign \%7
++ assign \%8
++ assign \%9
++ take oofa.ksc
++
++ Remember, the variables \%0..\%9 are on the macro call stack, and
++ command files are independent of the macro stack. Thus, if a command
++ file TAKEs another command file and passes arguments to it, the
++ variables are changed from that point on for both files, and so forth
++ for all levels of nested command files without intervening macro
++ invocations.
++
++ It would have been possible to change C-Kermit to use the overall
++ command stack, rather than the macro stack, for arguments -- this
++ would have made TAKE work exactly like DO, which is "nicer", but it
++ would also have broken countless existing scripts. However, the new
++ SHIFT command ([615]Section 7.5) makes it possible to create an
++ alternative TAKE command that does indeed save and restore the
++ argument variables at its own level around execution of a command
++ file:
++
++ define mtake {
++ local \%f
++ assign \%f \fcontents(\%1)
++ shift
++ take \%f
++ }
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 also supports a new, easier way to pass arguments to
++ scripts from the system command line:
++
++ kermit filename arg1 arg2 arg3 ...
++
++ in which arg1, arg2, arg3 (etc) are arguments for the script (whose
++ filename is given), and are assigned to \%1, \%2, ... \%9. The
++ filename is assigned to \%0. This applies equally to "Kerbang" scripts
++ in UNIX ([616]Section 7.19). For example, suppose you have a file
++ called "showargs" containing the following lines:
++
++ #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
++ echo Hello from \%0
++ show args
++ exit
++
++ (except not indented, since the "#!" line must be on the left margin).
++ If you give this file execute permission:
++
++ chmod +x showargs
++
++ then you can run it exactly as you would run a UNIX shell script,
++ e.g.:
++
++ $ showargs one two three
++ Hello from /usr/olga/showargs
++ Top-level arguments (\v(argc) = 4):
++ \&_[0] = /usr/olga/showargs
++ \&_[1] = one
++ \&_[2] = two
++ \&_[3] = three
++
++ Furthermore, the \&_[] array now contains the filename, if one was
++ given as the first command line argument, or it is a "Kerbang" script,
++ in element 0.
++
++ Otherwise element 0 is program name, and elements 1 through \v(argc)-1
++ contain the command-line arguments, if any, that appear after "--" or
++ "=", if any. This array is saved and restored around macro calls;
++ recall that inside macros it contains the macro argument vector
++ (allowing you to access arguments programmatically, and to have more
++ than 9 of them).
++
++ At top level, notice the difference between the \&@[] and \&_[]
++ arrays. The former includes C-Kermit options; the latter omits them.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.17. Dialogs with Timed Responses
++
++ The ASK, ASKQ, GETOK, and GETC commands (let's call them the
++ "ASK-class commands") let you write scripts that carry on dialogs with
++ the user, asking them for text, a Yes/No answer, or a character,
++ respectively. Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, these questions would always wait
++ forever for an answer. In C-Kermit 7.0, you may specify a time limit
++ for them with the new command:
++
++ SET ASK-TIMER number
++ Sets a time-limit on ASK-CLASS commands to the given number of
++ seconds. If the number is 0 or less, there is no time limit and
++ these commands wait forever for a response. Any timer that is
++ established by this command remains in effect for all future
++ ASK-class commands until another SET ASK-TIMER command is given
++ (e.g. with a value of 0 to disable ASK timeouts).
++
++ IF ASKTIMEOUT command
++ An ASK-class command that times out returns a failure status.
++ You can test explicitly for a timeout with:
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.18. Increased Flexibility of SWITCH Case Labels
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0 / K95 1.1.19, the case labels in SWITCH
++ statements were string constants.
++
++ Now case labels can be variables, function calls, or any mixture of
++ these with each other and/or with regular characters.
++
++ Furthermore, after the case label is evaluated, it is treated not as a
++ string constant, but as a pattern against which the SWITCH variable is
++ matched ([617]Section 4.9.1).
++
++ This introduces a possible incompatibility with previous releases,
++ since the following characters in case labels are no longer taken
++ literally:
++
++ \ * ? [ {
++
++ Any scripts that previously included any of these characters in case
++ labels must now quote them with backslash (\).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.19. "Kerbang" Scripts
++
++ In UNIX only, Kermit scripts can be stored in files and run
++ "directly", without starting Kermit first (as noted on page 467 of the
++ manual), just as a shell script can be "run" as if it were a program.
++ This section amplifies on that idea a bit, and presents some new
++ aspects of version 7.0 that make it easier to write and run Kermit
++ scripts directly.
++
++ NOTE: On non-UNIX platforms, such as VMS or Windows, Kerbang
++ scripts can be run as "kermit + scriptfilename arg1 arg2 arg3 ...".
++ Windows 95/98/NT file associations do not allow for the passing of
++ parameters. In VMS, however, you can achieve the Kerbang effect by
++ defining a symbol, as in this example:
++
++ $ autotelnet :== "$SYS$TOOLS:KERMIT.EXE + AUTOTELNET.KSC"
++
++ and then running the script like any other command:
++
++ $ autotelnet xyzcorp.com myuserid
++
++ See [618]Section 9.3 for an explanation of the "+" symbol.
++
++ UNIX shell scripts can specify which shell should run them by
++ including a "shebang" line at the top, e.g.:
++
++ #!/bin/sh
++
++ (but not indented; the shebang line must be on the left margin). The
++ term "shebang" is a contraction of "shell" and "bang". "Bang" is a
++ slang word for the exclamation mark ("!"); "shebang" itself is an
++ American slang word used in in the phrase "the whole shebang".
++
++ We can run Kermit scripts directly too, by including a "shebang" line
++ that names Kermit as the "shell"; thus we call these "Kerbang"
++ scripts. This mechanism has been considerably simplified in C-Kermit
++ 7.0 to facilitate C-Kermit's use a scripting tool just like any of the
++ UNIX shells or scripting languages. The rules are the same as for
++ shell scripts:
++
++ 1. The first line of the Kermit script must begin with "#!"
++ immediately followed by the full pathname of the program that will
++ execute the script (in this case, C-Kermit rather than a UNIX
++ shell), followed by any Kermit command-line options. To suppress
++ execution of the C-Kermit initialization file and to make command
++ line arguments available to the script, the final option should be
++ "+":
++ #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
++ Some users have reported that in some circumstances a space might
++ be necessary after the plus sign; this depends on your shell -- it
++ has nothing to do with Kermit. In most cases, no space is needed.
++ 2. The file must have execute permission (granted via "chmod +x
++ filename").
++
++ When C-Kermit is invoked from a Kerbang script (or from the system
++ prompt with a "+" command-line argument, which amounts to the same
++ thing), the following special rules apply:
++
++ 1. The C-Kermit initialization file is NOT executed automatically. If
++ you want it to be executed, include a TAKE command for it in the
++ script, e.g. "take \v(home).kermrc". (In previous releases, the
++ initialization file was always executed, with no way to prevent it
++ except for the user to include Kermit-specific command line
++ options which had nothing to do with the script). Many scripts
++ have no need for the standard Kermit initialization file, which is
++ quite lengthy and not only delays startup of the script, but also
++ spews forth numerous messages that are most likely unrelated to
++ the script.
++ 2. If the initialization file is not executed, neither is your
++ customization file, since the initialization file is the command
++ file from which the customization file is TAKEn. Again, you can
++ include a TAKE command for the initialization file if desired, or
++ for the customization file by itself, or for any other file.
++ 3. C-Kermit does not process command-line arguments at all. Instead,
++ it passes all words on the command line after the "+" to the
++ script as \%0 (the script name), \%1..\%9 (the first nine
++ arguments), as well as in the argument vector array \&_[]. The
++ variable \v(argc) is set to the total number of "words" (as passed
++ by the shell to Kermit) including the script name. Quoting and
++ grouping rules are those of the shell.
++ 4. At any point where the script terminates, it must include an EXIT
++ command if you want it to exit back to the shell; otherwise
++ C-Kermit enters interactive prompting mode when the script
++ terminates. The EXIT command can include a numeric status to be
++ returned to the shell (0, 1, etc), plus an optional message.
++
++ Here is a simple Kerbang script that prints its arguments:
++
++ #/usr/local/bin/kermit +
++ echo Hello from \%0
++ for \%i 0 \v(argc)-1 1 {
++ echo \%i. "\&_[\%i]"
++ }
++ exit 0
++
++ Save this file as (say) "showargs", then give it execute permission
++ and run it (the \&_[] array is the same as \%0..\%9, but allows you to
++ refer to argument variables programmatically; see [619]Section 7.5).
++ (Yes, you could substitute SHOW ARGUMENTS for the loop.)
++
++ $ chmod +x showargs
++ $ ./showargs one "this is two" three
++
++ The script displays its arguments:
++
++ Hello from /usr/olga/showargs
++ 0. "/usr/olga/showargs"
++ 1. "one"
++ 2. "this is two"
++ 3. "three"
++ $
++
++ Notice that no banners or greetings are printed and that startup is
++ instantaneous, just like a shell script. Also notice that grouping of
++ arguments is determined by *shell* quoting rules, not Kermit ones,
++ since the command line is parsed by the shell before Kermit ever sees
++ it.
++
++ Of course you can put any commands at all into a Kerbang script. It
++ can read and write files, make connections, transfer files, anything
++ that Kermit can do -- because it *is* Kermit. And of course, Kerbang
++ scripts can also be executed from the Kermit prompt (or from another
++ script) with a TAKE command; the Kerbang line is ignored since it
++ starts with "#", which is a comment introducer to Kermit just as it is
++ to the UNIX shell. In VMS and other non-UNIX platforms, the Kerbang
++ line has no effect and can be omitted.
++
++ It might be desireable for a script to know whether it has been
++ invoked directly from the shell (as a Kerbang script) or by a TAKE
++ command given to the Kermit prompt or in a Kermit command file or
++ macro. This can be done as in this example:
++
++ #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
++ assign \%m \fbasename(\%0)
++ define usage { exit 1 {usage: \%m phonenumber message} }
++ define apage { (definition of APAGE...) } ; (See [620]book pp.454-456)
++ xif equal "\%0" "\v(cmdfil)" {
++ if not def \%1 usage
++ if not def \%2 usage
++ apage {\%1} {\%2}
++ exit \v(status)
++ }
++
++ In a Kerbang script, \%0 and \v(cmdfile) are the same; both of them
++ are the name of the script. When a script is invoked by a Kermit TAKE
++ command, \%0 is the name of the Kermit program, but \v(cmdfile) is the
++ name of the script. In the example above, a macro called APAGE is
++ defined. If the script was invoked directly, the APAGE macro is also
++ executed. Otherwise, it is available for subsequent and perhaps
++ repeated use later in the Kermit session.
++
++ An especially handy use for Kerbang scripts is to have the
++ initialization file itself be one. Since the standard initialization
++ file is rather long and time-consuming to execute, it is often
++ overkill if you want to start Kermit just to transfer a file. Of
++ course there are command-line switches to suppress initialization-file
++ execution, etc, but another approach is to "run" the initialization
++ file when you want its features (notably the services directory), and
++ run C-Kermit directly when you don't. A setup like this requires that
++ (a) the C-Kermit initialization file is configured as a Kerbang script
++ (has #!/path.../kermit as first line), has execute permission, and is
++ in your PATH; and (b) that you don't have a .kermrc file in your login
++ directory.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.20. IF and XIF Statement Syntax
++
++ The IF command has been improved in two significant ways in C-Kermit
++ 7.0, described in the following subsections. All changes are backwards
++ compatible.
++
++ 7.20.1. The IF/XIF Distinction
++
++ The distinction between IF and XIF is no longer important as of
++ C-Kermit 7.0. You should be able to use IF in all cases (and of
++ course, also XIF for backwards compatibility). In the past, IF was
++ used for single-command THEN parts, followed optionally by a separate
++ ELSE command:
++
++ IF condition command1 ; THEN part
++ ELSE command2 ; ELSE part
++
++ whereas XIF was required if either part had multiple commands:
++
++ XIF condition { command, command, ... } ELSE { command, command, ... }
++
++ The syntactic differences were primarily that IF / ELSE was two
++ commands on two separate lines, whereas XIF was one command on one
++ line, and that XIF allowed (and in fact required) braces around its
++ command lists, whereas IF did not allow them.
++
++ Furthermore, the chaining or nesting of parts and conditions was
++ inconsistent. For example, the IF command could be used like this:
++
++ IF condition command
++ ELSE IF condition command
++ ELSE IF condition command
++ ELSE IF condition command
++ ...
++
++ but XIF could not. C-Kermit 7.0 accepts the old syntax and executes it
++ the same as previous versions, but also accepts a new unified and more
++ convenient syntax:
++
++ IF condition command-list [ ELSE command-list ]
++
++ or:
++
++IF condition command-list
++ELSE command-list
++
++ in which the ELSE part is optional, and where command-list can be a
++ single command (with or without braces around it) or a list of
++ commands enclosed in braces. Examples:
++
++ Example 1:
++
++ IF condition { command1, command2 } ELSE { command3, command4 }
++
++ Example 2 (same as Example 1):
++
++ IF condition {
++ command1
++ command2
++ } ELSE {
++ command3
++ command4
++ }
++
++ Example 3 (same as 1 and 2):
++
++ IF condition {
++ command1
++ command2
++ }
++ ELSE { command3, command4 }
++
++ Example 4 (same as 1-3):
++
++ IF condition {
++ command1
++ command2
++ }
++ ELSE {
++ command3
++ command4
++ }
++
++ Example 5 (ELSE can be followed by another command):
++
++ IF condition {
++ command1
++ command2
++ } ELSE IF condition {
++ command3
++ command4
++ } ELSE {
++ command5
++ command6
++ }
++
++ Example 5 suggests other possibilities:
++
++ IF condition {
++ command1
++ command2
++ } ELSE FOR variable initial final increment {
++ command3
++ command4
++ }
++
++ And this too is possible, except for some non-obvious quoting
++ considerations:
++
++ dcl \&a[6] = one two three four five six
++
++ IF < \%n 3 {
++ echo \\%n is too small: \%n
++ } ELSE FOR \\%i 1 \\%n 1 {
++ echo \\%i. \\&a[\\%i]
++ }
++
++ (The loop variable must be quoted in this context to prevent premature
++ evaluation.)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.20.2. Boolean Expressions (The IF/WHILE Condition)
++
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the IF and WHILE commands accepted only a
++ single Boolean ("true or false") assertion, e.g. "if > \%m 0 command"
++ or "if exist filename command". There was no way to form Boolean
++ expressions and, in particular, nothing that approached a Boolean OR
++ function (AND could be simulated by concatenating IF statements: "if
++ condition1 if condition2..").
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 (and K95 1.1.19) allow grouping of Boolean assertions
++ using parentheses and combining them using AND (or &&) and OR (or ||).
++ Each of these operators -- including the parentheses -- is a field and
++ must be set off by spaces. AND has higher precedence than OR, NOT has
++ higher precedence than AND, but parentheses can be used to force any
++ desired order of evaluation. The old syntax is still accepted.
++
++ Here are some examples:
++
++ define \%z 0 ; Define some variables
++ define \%n 1 ; for use in the examples.
++
++ if > \%n \%z echo \%n is greater. ; Original format - still accepted.
++ if ( > \%n \%z ) echo \%n is greater. ; Parentheses may be used in 7.0.
++ if ( > \%n \%z && not = \%z 0 ) ... ; Two assertions combined with AND.
++ if ( > \%n \%z and not = \%z 0 ) ... ; Same as previous ("and" = "&&").
++ if ( > \%n \%z || not = \%z 0 ) ... ; Two assertions combined with OR.
++ if ( > \%n \%z or not = \%z 0 ) ... ; Same as previous ("or" = "||").
++ if ( > \%n \%z || != \%z 0 ) ... ; Ditto ("!=" = "not =").
++ while ( 1 ) { ... } ; Just like C.
++
++ Notice the spaces around all operators including the parentheses --
++ these are required. The following examples show how parentheses can be
++ used to alter the precedence of the AND and OR operators:
++
++ if ( false || false && false || true ) ,.. ; True
++ if ( false || ( false && false ) || true ) ... ; Same as previous
++ if ( ( false || false ) && ( false || true ) ) ... ; False
++
++ Similarly for NOT:
++
++ if ( not true && false ) ... ; False (NOT binds to TRUE only)
++ if ( ( not true ) && false ) ... ; Same as previous
++ if ( not ( true && false ) ) ... ; True (NOT binds to (TRUE && FALSE))
++
++ Notes:
++
++ 1. The syntax of the Boolean expression itself has not changed; each
++ expression begins with a keyword or token such as "EXIST", ">", or
++ "=", etc; operators such as "<", "=", and ">" do not go between
++ their operands but precede them as before; this might be called
++ "reverse reverse Polish notation"; it allows deterministic
++ on-the-fly parsing of these expressions at the C-Kermit> prompt as
++ well as in scripts, and allows ?-help to be given for each item
++ when IF or WHILE commands are typed at the prompt.
++ 2. Parentheses are required when there is more than one Boolean
++ assertion.
++ 3. Parentheses are not required, but are allowed, when there is only
++ one Boolean assertion.
++ 4. Evaluation of Boolean assertions occurs left to right, but the
++ resulting Boolean expression is evaluated afterwards according to
++ the rules of precedence. All Boolean assertions are always
++ evaluated; there is no "early stopping" property and therefore no
++ question about when or if side effects will occur -- if any
++ Boolean assertion has side effects, they will always occur.
++
++ Constructions of arbitrary complexity are possible, within reason.
++
++ Also see [621]Section 7.4 for new IF / WHILE conditions.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.21. Screen Formatting and Cursor Control
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds a simple way to create formatted screens, the SCREEN
++ command:
++
++ SCREEN { CLEAR, CLEOL, MOVE-TO row [ column ] }
++ Performs screen-formatting actions. Correct operation of these
++ commands depends on proper terminal setup on both ends of the
++ connection -- mainly that the host terminal type is set to
++ agree with the kind of terminal or the emulation you are
++ viewing C-Kermit through. The UNIX version uses terminfo or
++ termcap (not curses); the VMS version uses SMG; K-95 uses its
++ built in screen manager.
++
++ SCREEN CLEAR
++ Moves the cursor to home position and clears the entire screen.
++ Synonyms: CLEAR COMMAND-SCREEN ALL (K-95 only), CLS, CLEAR
++ SCREEN.
++
++ SCREEN CLEOL
++ Clears from the current cursor position to the end of the line.
++ Synonym: CLEAR COMMAND-SCREEN EOL (K-95 only)
++
++ SCREEN MOVE-TO row column
++ Moves the cursor to the indicated row and column. The row and
++ column numbers are 1-based, so on a 24x80 screen the home
++ position is 1 1 and the lower right corner is 24 80. If a row
++ or column number is given that too large for what Kermit or the
++ operating system thinks is your screen size, the appropriate
++ number is substituted.
++
++ These escape sequences used by these commands depends on the platform.
++ In UNIX, your TERM environment variable is used to query the
++ terminfo/termcap database; if the query fails, ANSI/VT100 sequences
++ are used. In VMS, the SMG library is used, which sends sequences based
++ on your VMS terminal type. K95 does its own screen control. On other
++ platforms (such as AOS/VS, VOS, etc), screen formatting is not
++ supported, and the SCREEN command does nothing.
++
++ The three SCREEN actions can be used in scripts to produce menus,
++ formatted screens, dynamic displays, etc. Related variables include:
++
++ \v(terminal) The type terminal C-Kermit thinks you have.
++ \v(rows) The number of rows C-Kermit thinks your terminal has.
++ \v(columns) The number of columns C-Kermit thinks your terminal has.
++
++ And functions:
++
++ \fscrncurx() The current X coordinate of the cursor (K-95 only).
++ \fscrncury() The current Y coordinate of the cursor (K-95 only).
++ \fscrnstr(x,y,n) The string of length nat position (x,y) (K-95 only).
++
++ And commands:
++
++ ECHO string Writes string + CRLF at the current cursor position.
++ XECHO string Writes string at current cursor position; CRLF not supplied.
++ GETC v prompt Issues prompt, reads one character into variable v, no echo.
++
++ And special characters:
++
++ Ctrl-L At the C-Kermit> command prompt, or in a C-Kermit command,
++ works like Return or Enter, but also clears the screen
++
++ Example 1: A macro that prints a message \%1 at cursor position
++ (\%2,\%3):
++
++ define MSG {
++ if not def \%3 def \%3 0 ; Default column to 0
++ if > \v(argc) 2 screen move \%2 \%3 ; Move to given row/col (if any)
++ screen cleol ; Clear to end of line
++ if def \%1 xecho \fcontents(\%1) ; Print message (if any)
++ }
++
++ Example 2: A macro put the cursor on the bottom screen line, left
++ margin:
++
++ define BOT {
++ screen move \v(rows) 0
++ }
++
++ Example 3: A macro to center message \%1 on line \%2.
++
++ define CENTER {
++ if not def \%2 def \%2 1
++ .\%x ::= (\v(cols)-\flen(\%1))/2
++ msg {\%1} {\%2} {\%x}
++ }
++
++ Example 4: A simple menu (building on Examples 1-3):
++
++ def \%c 0 ; Menu choice variable
++ screen clear ; Clear the screen
++ center {Welcome to This Menu} 2 ; Display the menu
++ msg {Choices:} 4
++ msg { 1. File} 6
++ msg { 2. Edit} 7
++ msg { 3. Exit} 8
++ while ( != \%c 3 ) { ; Read and verify choice
++ while true { ; Keep trying till we get a good one
++ screen move 10 ; Move to line 10
++ screen cleol ; Clear this line
++ getc \%c {Your choice: } ; Prompt and get and echo 1 character
++ xecho \%c
++ if ( not numeric \%c ) { msg {Not numeric - "\%c"} 12, continue }
++ if ( >= \%c 1 && <= \%c 3 ) break
++ msg {Out of range - "\%c"} 12
++ }
++ switch \%c { ; Valid choice - execute it.
++ :1, msg {Filing... } 12, break
++ :2, msg {Editing...} 12, break
++ :3, msg {Exiting...} 12, break
++ }
++ }
++ echo Bye ; Exit chosen - say goodbye.
++ bot ; Leave cursor at screen bottom.
++ exit ; And exit.
++
++ Similar scripts can work over the communication connection; substitute
++ INPUT and OUTPUT for GETC and ECHO/XECHO.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.22. Evaluating Arithmetic Expressions
++
++ A new arithmetic operator was added to the list recognized by the
++ EVALUATE command, the \feval() function, and which can also be used
++ anywhere else arithmetic expressions are accepted (numeric command
++ fields, array subscripts, etc):
++
++ Prefix "!"
++ This operator inverts the "truth value" of the number or
++ arithmetic expression that follows. If the value of the operand
++ is 0, the result is 1. If the value is nonzero, the result is
++ 0.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ set eval old
++ evaluate 0
++ 0
++
++ evaluate !0
++ 1
++
++ evaluate !3
++ 0
++
++ evaluate !(-3)
++ 0
++
++ .\%a = 1
++ .\%b = 0
++ evaluate !(\%a|\%b)
++ 0
++
++ evaluate !(\%a&\%b)
++ 1
++
++ evaluate !(!(\%a&\%b))
++ 0
++
++ Note the distinction between Prefix ! (invert truth value) and Suffix
++ ! (factorial). Also the distinction between Prefix ! and Prefix ~
++ (which inverts all the bits in its operand). Also note that prefix
++ operators (!, -, and ~) can not be adjacent unless you use parentheses
++ to separate them, as shown in the final example above.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.23. Floating-Point Arithmetic
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds limited support for floating-point numbers (numbers
++ that have fractional parts, like 3.141592653). This support is
++ provided through a small repertoire of functions and in Boolean
++ expressions that compare numbers, but does not apply to number parsing
++ in general, or to expression evaluation, array subscripts, the
++ INCREMENT and DECREMENT commands, or in any context other than those
++ listed in this section.
++
++ A floating point number has an optional sign (+ or -), followed by a
++ series of decimal digits containing either zero or one period (.)
++ character, which is the decimal point. The use of comma or any other
++ character besides period as a decimal point is not supported.
++ Scientific notation is not supported either. Examples of legal
++ floating-point numbers:
++
++ 0 Integers can be used
++ 1 Ditto
++ 2. A decimal point without decimal digits
++ 3.0 A decimal point with decimal digits
++ 3.141592653 Ditto
++ -4.0 A negative sign can be included
++ +5.0 A positive sign can be included
++
++ Examples of notations that are not accepted:
++
++ 1,000,000 Separators can not be used
++ 1.000.000 Ditto (or multiple decimal points)
++ 6.022137E23 No scientific notation
++ 6.62606868e-34 Ditto
++ 12.5+6.25 No "bare" expressions
++
++ You can use IF FLOAT test a string or variable to see if it's in
++ acceptable floating-point format. Example:
++
++ ask \%f { Type a number: }
++ if not def \%f .\%f = 0.0
++ if not float \%f stop 1 Invalid floating-point number: "\%f"
++
++ C-Kermit's floating-point support, like its support for whole numbers
++ (integers), relies on the capabilities of the underlying computer.
++ Your computer has only a limited amount of precision for numbers,
++ depending on its architecture. Thus floating-point numbers that have
++ too many digits will not be accurate; adding a very small number to a
++ very large one might have no effect at all; and so on. For details,
++ read a text on numerical analysis. Example:
++
++ .\%a = 11111111111111111111 ; A long number
++ .\%b = 22222222222222222222 ; Another one
++ echo \ffpadd(\%a,\%b) ; Add them - the result should be all 3's
++ 33333333333333330000.0 ; See the result
++
++ In this example, the computer has 16 digits of precision; after that,
++ the (low-order) digits are set to 0, since the computer doesn't know
++ what they really are. In fact, the computer returns random digits, but
++ Kermit sets all digits beyond the computer's precision to 0.
++
++ C-Kermit's floating-point functions have names of the form
++ "\ffpxxx(args)" ("\f" for function, "fp" for floating-point), where
++ "xxx" is replaced by the name of the function, such as "sqrt", and
++ "args" is the argument list, consisting of one or two floating-point
++ numbers (depending on the function), and an optional "d" argument that
++ says now many decimal places should be shown in the result. Example:
++
++ \ffpdiv(10,3,1) returns "3.3"
++ \ffpdiv(10,3,2) returns "3.33"
++ \ffpdiv(10,3,3) returns "3.333"
++
++ and so on, up to the precision of the computer. If the decimal-places
++ argument is less than zero, the fractional part of the result is
++ truncated:
++
++ \ffpdiv(10,3,-1) returns "3".
++
++ If the decimal-places argument is 0, or is omitted, C-Kermit returns
++ as many decimal places as are meaningful in the computer's
++ floating-point precision, truncating any extraneous trailing 0's:
++
++ \ffpdiv(10,8) returns "1.25".
++ \ffpdiv(10,4) returns "2.5".
++ \ffpdiv(10,2) returns "5.0".
++ \ffpdiv(10,3) returns "3.333333333333333" (for 16-digit precision).
++
++ There is no way to request that a floating-point function return a
++ decimal point but no decimal places. However, this is easy enough to
++ accomplish in other ways, for example by supplying it outside the
++ function call:
++
++ echo \ffpadd(\%a,\%b,-1).
++
++ Kermit's floating-point functions always round the result for the
++ requested number of decimal places when the "d" argument is given and
++ has a value greater than 0 (see the description of \ffpround() just
++ below).
++
++ Floating-point arguments can be constants in floating-point format or
++ variables whose values are floating-point numbers. If a floating-point
++ argument is omitted, or is a variable with no value, 0.0 is supplied
++ automatically. Example:
++
++ def \%x 999.999
++ undef \%y
++ echo \ffpmin(\%x,\%y)
++ 0.0
++
++ Or equivalently:
++
++ echo \ffpmin(999.999)
++ 0.0
++
++ The floating-point functions are:
++
++ \ffpround(f1,d)
++ Returns f1 rounded to d decimal places. For this function only,
++ d = 0 (or d omitted) has a special meaning: return the integer
++ part of f1 rounded according to the fractional part. Examples:
++
++ \ffpround(2.74653,-1) returns "2" (fraction truncated, no rounding).
++ \ffpround(2.74653,0) returns "3" (integer part is rounded).
++ \ffpround(2.74653) returns "3" (d omitted same as d = 0).
++ \ffpround(2.74653,1) returns "2.7".
++ \ffpround(2.74653,2) returns "2.75".
++ \ffpround(2.74653,3) returns "2.747".
++ \ffpround(2.74653,4) returns "2.7465", etc.
++
++ \ffpadd(f1,f2,d)
++ Returns the sum of f1 and f2.
++
++ \ffpsubtract(f1,f2,d)
++ Subtracts f2 from f1 and returns the result.
++
++ \ffpmultiply(f1,f2,d)
++ Returns the product of f1 and f2.
++
++ \ffpdivide(f1,f2,d)
++ If f2 is not 0, divides f1 by f2 and returns the quotient.
++ If f2 is 0, a DIVIDE_BY_ZERO error occurs.
++
++ \ffpraise(f1,f2,d)
++ If f1 = 0 and f2 <= 0, or if f1 < 0 and f2 has a fractional
++ part, an ARG_OUT_OF_RANGE error occurs; otherwise f1 raised to
++ the f2 power is returned.
++
++ \ffpsqrt(f1,d)
++ If f1 >= 0, returns the square root of f1; otherwise
++ ARG_OUT_OF_RANGE.
++
++ \ffpabsolute(f1,d)
++ Returns the absolute value of f1 (i.e. f1 without a sign). This
++ is the floating-point analog of \fabsolute(n1).
++
++ \ffpint(f1)
++ Returns the integer part of f1. Equivalent to \ffpround(f1,-1).
++
++ \ffpexp(f1,d)
++ The base of natural logarithms, e (2.718282...), raised to the
++ f1 power.
++
++ \ffplogn(f1,d)
++ The natural logarithm of f1 (the power to which e must be
++ raised to obtain f1).
++
++ \ffplog10(f1,d)
++ The base-10 logarithm of f1 (the power to which 10 must be
++ raised to obtain f1).
++
++ \ffpmodulus(f1,f2,d)
++ If f2 is not 0, the remainder after dividing f1 by f2.
++ If f2 is 0, a DIVIDE_BY_ZERO error occurs.
++ This is the floating-point analog of \fmod(n1,n2).
++
++ \ffpmaximum(f1,f2,d)
++ Returns the maximum of f1 and f2. This is the floating-point
++ analog of \fmax(n1,n2).
++
++ \ffpminimum(f1,f2,d)
++ Returns the minimum of f1 and f2. This is the floating-point
++ analog of \fmin(n1,n2).
++
++ \ffpsine(f1,d)
++ Returns the sine of f1 radians.
++
++ \ffpcosine(f1,d)
++ Returns the cosine of f1 radians.
++
++ \ffptangent(f1,d)
++ Returns the tangent of f1 radians.
++
++ Note that all of these functions can be used with integer arguments.
++ If you want an integer result, specify d = -1 (to truncate) or feed
++ the result to \ffpround(xxx,0) (to round).
++
++ Floating-point numbers (or variables or functions that return them)
++ can be used in Boolean expressions (see [622]Section 7.20.2) that
++ compare numbers:
++
++ = x y
++ != x y
++ < x y
++ > x y
++ <= x y
++ >= x y
++
++ In these examples, x and y can be either integers or floating-point
++ numbers in any combination. In an arithmetic comparison of an integer
++ and a floating-point number, the integer is converted to
++ floating-point before the comparison is made. Examples:
++
++ .\%t = 3.000000000
++ .\%f = 3.141592653
++ .\%i = 3
++
++ if > \%f \%i echo Pi is greater.
++ if = \%t \%i echo "\%i" = "\%t".
++
++ A floating-point number can also be used in:
++
++ IF number command
++
++ where the command is executed if the number is nonzero. If the number
++ is floating-point, the command is not executed if the number is 0.0,
++ and is executed otherwise.
++
++ Floating-point numbers can be sorted using ARRAY SORT /NUMERIC (see
++ [623]Section 7.10.5 ).
++
++ Two floating-point constants are provided:
++
++ \v(math_pi) = Pi (3.141592653...)
++ \v(math_e) = e, the base of natural logarithms (2.71828...)
++
++ These are given to the computer's precision, e.g. 16 digits. This
++ number itself is available in a variable:
++
++ \v(math_precision)
++ How many significant digits in a floating-point number.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.24. Tracing Script Execution
++
++ The TRACE command is handy for debugging scripts.
++
++ TRACE [ { /ON, /OFF } ] [ { ASSIGNMENTS, COMMAND-LEVEL, ALL } ]
++ Selects tracing of the given object.
++
++ Optional switches are /ON and /OFF. If no switch is given, /ON is
++ implied. The trace objects are ASSIGNMENTS, COMMAND-LEVEL, and ALL.
++ The default object is ALL, meaning to select all trace objects
++ (besides ALL). Thus TRACE by itself selects tracing of everything, as
++ does TRACE /ON, and TRACE /OFF turns off all tracing.
++
++ When tracing of ASSIGNMENTS is on, every time the value of any
++ user-defined variable or macro changes, C-Kermit prints one of the
++ following:
++
++ >>> name: "value"
++ The name of the variable or macro followed by the new value in
++ quotes. This includes implicit macro-parameter assignments
++ during macro invocation.
++
++ >>> name: (undef)
++ This indicates that the variable or macro has been undefined.
++
++ <<< name: "value"
++ For RETURN statements: the name of the macro and the return
++ value.
++
++ <<< name: (null)
++ For RETURN statements that include no value or an empty value.
++
++ When tracing of COMMAND-LEVEL is on, C-Kermit prints:
++
++ [n] +F: "name"
++ Whenever a command file is entered, where "n" is the command
++ level (0 = top); the name of the command file is shown in
++ quotes.
++
++ [n] +M: "name"
++ Whenever a macro is entered; "n" is the command level. The name
++ of the macro is shown in quotes.
++
++ [n] -F: "name"
++ Whenever a command file is reentered from below, when a macro
++ or command file that it has invoked has returned.
++
++ [n] -M: "name"
++ Whenever a macro is reentered from below.
++
++ For other debugging tools, see SHOW ARGS, SHOW STACK, SET TAKE, SET
++ MACRO, and of course, ECHO.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.25. Compact Substring Notation
++
++ It is often desirable to extract a substring from a string which is
++ stored in a variable, and for this we have the \fsubstring() function,
++ which is used like this:
++
++ define \%a 1234567890
++ echo \fsubstring(\%a,3,4) ; substring from 3rd character length 4
++ 3456
++
++ or like this with macro-named variables:
++
++ define string 1234567890
++ echo \fsubstring(\m(string),3,4)
++ 3456
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 adds a pair of alternative compact notations:
++
++\:(variablename[start:length]) <-- Substring of variable's value
++\s(macroname[start:length]) <-- Substring of macro's definition
++
++ These are exactly equivalent to using \fsubstring(), except more
++ compact to write and also faster since evaluation is in one step
++ instead of two.
++
++ The "\:()" notation can be used with any Kermit variable, that is,
++ almost anything that starts with a backslash:
++
++ \:(\%a[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\%a,2,6)
++ \:(\&x[1][2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\&x[1],2,6)
++ \:(\m(foo)[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\m(foo),2,6)
++ \:(\v(time)[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\v(time),2,6)
++ \:(\$(TERM)[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(\$(TERM),2,6)
++ \:(ABCDEFGH[2:6]) <-- equivalent to \fsubstring(ABCDEFGH,2,6)
++
++ Whatever appears between the left parenthesis and the left bracket is
++ evaluated and then the indicated substring of the result is returned.
++
++ The "\s()" notation is the same, except after evaluating the variable,
++ the result is treated as a macro name and is looked up in the macro
++ table. Then the indicated substring of the macro definition is
++ returned. Example:
++
++ define testing abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
++ define \%a testing
++
++ \s(testing[2:6]) --> bcdefg
++ \:(testing[2:6]) --> esting
++ \:(\%a[2:6]) --> esting
++ \s(\%a[2:6]) --> bcdefg
++
++ Note that the following two examples are equivalent:
++
++ \:(\m(foo)[2:6])
++ \s(foo[2:6])
++
++ The first number in the brackets is the 1-based starting position. If
++ it is omitted, or less than 1, it is treated as 1. If it is greater
++ than the length of the string, an empty string is returned.
++
++ The second number is the length of the desired substring. If the
++ second number is omitted, is less than 0, or would be past the end of
++ the string, then "through the end of the string" is assumed. If it is
++ 0, the empty string is returned.
++
++ If the brackets are empty or omitted, the original string is returned.
++
++ The starting position and length need not be literal numbers; they can
++ also be variables, functions, arithmetic expressions, or even other
++ \s() or \:() quantities; anything that evaluates to a number, for
++ example:
++
++ \s(block[1025:\fhex2n(\s(block[\%b:\%n+4]))/2])
++
++ Syntactically, \m(name) and \s(name) differ only in that the sequence
++ [*] at the end of the name (where * is any sequence of 0 or more
++ characters) is treated as substring notation in \s(name), but is
++ considered part of the name in \m(name) (to see why, see [624]Section
++ 7.10.9).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.26. New WAIT Command Options
++
++ The WAIT command has been extended to allow waiting for different
++ kinds of things (formerly it only waited for modem signals). Now it
++ also can wait for file events.
++
++ 7.26.1. Waiting for Modem Signals
++
++ The previous syntax:
++
++ WAIT time { CD, DSR, RTS, RI, ... }
++
++ has changed to:
++
++ WAIT time MODEM-SIGNALS { CD, DSR, RTS, RI, ... }
++
++ However, the previous syntax is still accepted. The behavior is the
++ same in either case.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.26.2. Waiting for File Events
++
++ The new WAIT option:
++
++ WAIT time FILE { CREATION, DELETION, MODIFICATION } filename
++
++ lets you tell Kermit to wait the given amount of time (or until the
++ given time of day) for a file whose name is filename to be created,
++ deleted, or modified, respectively. The filename may not contain
++ wildcards. If the specified event does not occur within the time
++ limit, or if WAIT CANCELLATION is ON and you interrupt from the
++ keyboard before the time is up, the WAIT command fails. If the event
++ is MODIFICATION and the file does not exist, the command fails.
++ Otherwise, if the given event occurs within the time limit, the
++ command succeeds. Examples:
++
++ WAIT 600 FILE DELETION oofa.tmp
++ Wait up to 10 minutes for file oofa.tmp to disappear.
++
++ WAIT 23:59:59 FILE MOD orders.db
++ Wait until just before midnight for the orders.db file to be
++ changed.
++
++ Example: Suppose you want to have the current copy of /etc/motd on
++ your screen at all times, and you want to hear a bell whenever it
++ changes:
++
++ def \%f /etc/motd ; The file of interest.
++ while 1 { ; Loop forever...
++ cls ; Clear the screen.
++ echo \%f: \v(date) \v(time)... ; Print 2-line heading...
++ echo
++ if ( not exist \%f ) { ; If file doesn't exist,
++ echo \%f does not exist... ; print message,
++ wait 600 file creat \%f ; and wait for it to appear.
++ continue
++ }
++ beep ; Something new - beep.
++ type /head:\v(rows-2) \%f ; Display the file
++ if fail exit 1 \%f: \ferrstring() ; (checking for errors).
++ wait 999 file mod \%f ; Wait for it to change.
++ }
++
++ This notices when the file is created, deleted, or modified, and acts
++ only then (or when you interrupt it with); the time shown in the
++ heading is the time of the most recent event (including when the
++ program started).
++
++ See [625]Section 1.10, where the \v(kbchar) variable is explained.
++ This lets you modify a loop like the one above to also accept
++ single-character commands, which interrupt the WAIT, and dispatch
++ accordingly. For example:
++
++ wait 999 file mod \%f ; Wait for the file to change.
++ if defined \v(kbchar) { ; Interrupted from keyboard?
++ switch \v(kbchar) { ; Handle the keystroke...
++ :q, exit ; Q to Quit
++ :h, echo blah blah, break ; H for Help
++ :default, beep, continue ; Anything else beep and ignore
++ }
++ }
++
++ This lets you write event-driven applications that wait for up to
++ three events at once: a file or modem event, a timeout, and a
++ keystroke.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7.27. Relaxed FOR and SWITCH Syntax
++
++ For consistency with the extended IF and WHILE syntax, the FOR and
++ SWITCH control lists may (but need not be) enclosed in parentheses:
++
++ FOR ( \%i 1 \%n 1 ) { command-list... }
++ SWITCH ( \%c ) { command-list... }
++
++ In the FOR command, the increment item can be omitted if the control
++ list is enclosed in parentheses, in which case the increment defaults
++ appropriately to 1 or -1, depending on the values of the first two
++ variables.
++
++ As with IF, the parentheses around the FOR-command control list must
++ be set off by spaces (in the SWITCH command, the spaces are not
++ required since the SWITCH expression is a single arithmetic
++ expression).
++
++ Also, outer braces around the command list are supplied automatically
++ if you omit them, e.g.:
++
++ FOR ( \%i 1 %n 1 ) echo \%i
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8. USING OTHER FILE TRANSFER PROTOCOLS
++
++ In C-Kermit 7.0, alternative protocols can be selected using switches.
++ Switches are described in [626]Section 1.5; the use of
++ protocol-selection switches is described in [627]Section 4.7.1.
++ Example:
++
++ send /binary /protocol:zmodem x.tar.gz
++
++ Note that file transfer recovery works only with Kermit and Zmodem
++ protocols. With Zmodem, recovery can be initiated only by the sender.
++
++ Only pre-1988 versions of the publicly-distributed sz/rz programs use
++ Standard I/O; those released later than that do not use Standard I/O
++ and therefore do not work with REDIRECT. However, Omen Technology does
++ offer an up-to-date redirectable version called crzsz, which must be
++ licensed for use:
++
++ "Unix Crz and Csz support XMODEM, YMODEM, and ZMODEM transfers when
++ called by dial-out programs such as Kermit and certain versions of
++ cu(1). They are clients designed for this use.
++
++ "Crz and Csz are Copyrighted shareware programs. Use of these
++ programs beyond a brief evaluation period requires registration.
++ Please print the "mailer.rz" file, fill out the form and return
++ same with your registration."
++
++ To use the crzsz programs as your external XYZMODEM programs in
++ C-Kermit, follow the instructions in the book, but put a "c" before
++ each command, e.g.:
++
++ set protocol zmodem {csz %s} {csz -a %s} crz crz crz crz
++
++ To use Zmodem protocol over Telnet or other non-transparent
++ connections, you might need to add the -e (Escape) option:
++
++ set protocol zmodem {csz -e %s} {csz -e -a %s} crz crz crz crz
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9. COMMAND-LINE OPTIONS
++
++ 9.0. Extended-Format Command-Line Options
++
++ Standard UNIX command line options are a single letter. C-Kermit has
++ run out of letters, so new options are in a new extended format:
++
++ --word[:arg]
++
++ where a keyword (rather than a single letter) specifies the function,
++ and if an argument is to be included, it is separated by a colon (or
++ equal sign). Most of the new extended-format command-line options are
++ only for use with the Internet Kermit Service Daemon; see the
++ [628]IKSD Administration Guide for details. However, several of them
++ are also general in nature:
++
++ --nointerrupts
++ Disables keyboard interrupts that are normally enabled, which
++ are usually Ctrl-C (to interrupt a command) and Ctrl-Z (UNIX
++ only, to suspend C-Kermit).
++
++ --help
++ Lists the extended command-line options that are available in
++ your version of C-Kermit. If any options seem to be missing,
++ that is because your copy of C-Kermit was built with
++ compile-time options to deselect them.
++
++ --helpfile:filename
++ Specifies the name of a file to be displayed if the user types
++ HELP (not followed by a specific command or topic), in place of
++ the built-in top-level help text. The file need not fit on one
++ screen; more-prompting is used if the file is more than one
++ screen long if COMMAND MORE-PROMPTING is ON, as it is by
++ default.
++
++ --bannerfile:filename
++ The name of a file containing a message to be printed after the
++ user logs in, in place of the normal message (Copyright notice,
++ "Type HELP or ? for help", "Default transfer mode is...", etc).
++
++ --cdmessage:{on,off,0,1,2}
++ For use in the Server-Side Server configuration; whenever the
++ client tells the server to change directory, the server sends
++ the contents of a "read me" file to the client's screen. This
++ feature is On by default, and operates only in client/server
++ mode when ON or 1. If set to 2 or higher, it also operates when
++ the CD command is given at the IKSD> prompt. Synonym: --cdmsg.
++
++ --cdfile:filename
++ When cdmessage is on, this is the name of the "read me" file to
++ be sent. Normally you would specify a relative (not absolute)
++ name, since the file is opened using the literal name you
++ specified, after changing to the new directory. Example:
++
++ --cdfile:READ.ME
++
++ You can also give a list of up to 8 filenames by (a) enclosing
++ each filename in braces, and (b) enclosing the entire list in
++ braces. Example:
++ --cdfile:{{./.readme}{READ.ME}{aaareadme.txt}{README}{read-this
++ -first}} When a list is given, it is searched from left to
++ right and the first file found is displayed. The default list
++ for UNIX is:
++
++ {{./.readme}{README.TXT}{READ.ME}}
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.1. Command Line Personalities
++
++ Beginning in version 7.0, if the C-Kermit binary is renamed to
++ "telnet" (or TELNET.EXE, telnet.pr, etc, depending on the platform),
++ it accepts the Telnet command line:
++
++ telnet [ host [ port ] ]
++
++ In Unix, you can achieve the same effect with a symlink:
++
++ cd /usr/bin
++ mv telnet oldtelnet
++ ln -ls /usr/local/bin/kermit telnet
++
++ When installed in this manner, C-Kermit always reads its
++ initialization file. If no host (and therefore no port) is given,
++ C-Kermit starts in interactive prompting mode. If a host is given as
++ the first command-line argument, C-Kermit makes a connection to it.
++ The host argument can be an IP host name or address, or the name of a
++ TCP/IP entry in your C-Kermit network directory.
++
++ If a port is given, it is used. If a port is not given, then if the
++ hostname was found in your network directory and port was also listed
++ there, then that port is used. Otherwise port 23 (the Telnet port) is
++ used.
++
++ When C-Kermit is called "telnet" and it is invoked with a hostname on
++ the command line, it exits automatically when the connection is
++ closed. While the connection is open, however, you may escape back and
++ forth as many times as you like, transfer files, etc.
++
++ An rlogin personality is also available, but it is less useful, at
++ least in UNIX and VMS, where the Rlogin TCP port is privileged.
++
++ The new variable \v(name) indicates the name with which C-Kermit was
++ invoked ("kermit", "wermit", "k95", "telnet", etc).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.2. Built-in Help for Command Line Options
++
++ "kermit -h", given from the system prompt, lists as many command-line
++ options as will fit on a standard 24x80 screen. For more comprehensive
++ help, use the interactive HELP OPTIONS command that was added in
++ C-Kermit 7.0:
++
++ HELP OPTIONS
++ Explains how command-line options work, their syntax, etc.
++
++ HELP OPTIONS ALL
++ Lists all command-line options and gives brief help about each one.
++
++ HELP OPTION x
++ Gives brief help about option "x".
++
++ HELP EXTENDED-OPTIONS
++ Lists the available extended-format command-line options.
++
++ HELP EXTENDED-OPTION xxx
++ Gives help for the specified extended option.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.3. New Command-Line Options
++
++ Command-line options added since C-Kermit 6.0 are:
++
++ +
++ (plus sign by itself): The next argument is the name of a
++ script to execute; all subsequent arguments are ignored by
++ C-Kermit itself, but passed to the script as top-level copies
++ of \%1, \%2, etc; the \&_[] is also set accordingly. \%0 and
++ \&_[0] become the name of the script file, rather than the
++ pathname of the C-Kermit program, which is its normal value.
++ Primarily for use in the top line of "Kerbang" scripts in UNIX
++ (see [629]Section 7.19). Example from UNIX command line:
++
++ $ kermit [ regular kermit args ] + filename
++
++ Sample first line of Kerbang script:
++
++ #!/usr/local/bin/kermit +
++
++ --
++ (two hyphens surrounded by whitespace) Equivalent to "=", for
++ compatibility with UNIX getopt(1,3).
++
++ -G
++ GET (like -g), but send the incoming file to standard output.
++ Example: "kermit -G oofa.txt | lpr" retrieves a file from your
++ local computer (providing it is running a Kermit program that
++ supports the autodownload feature and has it enabled) and
++ prints it.
++
++ -O
++ equivalent to -x (start up in server mode), but exits after the
++ first client command has been executed (mnemonic: O = Only
++ One). This one is handy replacing "kermit -x" in the
++ "automatically start Kermit on the other end" string:
++
++ set protocol kermit {kermit -ir} {kermit -r} {kermit -x}
++
++ since -x leaves the remote Kermit in server mode after the
++ transfer, which can be confusing, whereas -O makes it go away
++ automatically after the transfer.
++
++ -L
++ Recursive, when used in combination with -s (mnemonic: L =
++ Levels). In UNIX or other environments where the shell expands
++ wildcards itself, the -s argument, if it contains wildcards,
++ must be quoted to prevent this, e.g.:
++
++ kermit -L -s "*.c"
++
++ In UNIX only, "kermit -L -s ." means to send the current
++ directory tree. See [630]Sections 4.10 and [631]4.11 about
++ recursive file transfer.
++
++ -V
++ Equivalent to SET FILE PATTERNS OFF ([632]Section 4.3) and SET
++ TRANSFER MODE MANUAL. In other words, take the FILE TYPE
++ setting literally. For example, "kermit -VT oofa.bin" means
++ send the file in Text mode, no matter what its name is and no
++ matter whether a kindred spirit is recognized at the other end
++ of the connection.
++
++ -0
++ (digit zero) means "be 100% transparent in CONNECT mode". This
++ is equivalent to the following series of commands: SET PARITY
++ NONE, SET COMMAND BYTESIZE 8, SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8, SET FLOW
++ NONE, SET TERM ESCAPE DISABLED, SET TERM CHAR TRANSPARENT, SET
++ TERM AUTODOWNLOAD OFF, SET TERM APC OFF, SET TELOPT KERMIT
++ REFUSE REFUSE.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 10. C-KERMIT AND G-KERMIT
++
++ Every multifunctioned and long-lived software program grows in
++ complexity and size over time to meet the needs and requests of its
++ users and the demands of the underlying technology as it changes.
++
++ Eventually users begin to notice how big the application has grown,
++ how much disk space it occupies, how long it takes to load, and they
++ start to long for the good old days when it was lean and mean. Not
++ long after that they begin asking for a "light" version that only does
++ the basics with no frills.
++
++ And so it is with C-Kermit. A "light" version of Kermit was released
++ (for UNIX only) in December 1999 under the GNU General Public License;
++ thus it is called G-Kermit (for GNU Kermit). All it does is send and
++ receive files, period. You can find it at:
++
++ [633]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/gkermit.html
++
++ Where the C-Kermit 7.0 binary might be anywhere from 1 to 3 million
++ bytes in size, the G-Kermit binary ranges from 30K to 100K, depending
++ on the underlying architecture (RISC vs CISC, etc).
++
++ G-Kermit and C-Kermit may reside side-by-side on the same computer.
++ G-Kermit does not make connections; it does not have a script
++ language; it does not translate character sets. G-Kermit may be used
++ instead of C-Kermit when:
++
++ * It is on the remote end.
++ * Files are to be transferred in binary mode or in text mode without
++ character-set translation.
++ * File timestamps don't need to be preserved.
++
++ In such cases G-Kermit might be preferred since it generally starts up
++ faster, and yet transfers files just as fast on most (but not
++ necessarily all) kinds of connections; for example, it supports
++ streaming ([634]Section 4.20).
++
++ G-Kermit is also handy for bootstrapping. It is easier to load on a
++ new computer than C-Kermit -- it fits on a floppy diskette with plenty
++ of room to spare. Thus if you have (say) an old PC running (say) SCO
++ Xenix and no network connection, you can download the Xenix version of
++ G-Kermit to (say) a DOS or Windows PC, copy it to diskette, read the
++ diskette on Xenix with "dosread", and then use G-Kermit to receive
++ C-Kermit (which does not fit on a diskette). If diskettes aren't an
++ option, other bootstrapping methods are possible too -- see the
++ [635]G-Kermit web page for details.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++III. APPENDICES
++
++ III.1. Character Set Tables
++
++ III.1.1. The Hewlett Packard Roman8 Character Set
++
++dec col/row oct hex description
++160 10/00 240 A0 (Undefined)
++161 10/01 241 A1 A grave
++162 10/02 242 A2 A circumflex
++163 10/03 243 A3 E grave
++164 10/04 244 A4 E circumflex
++165 10/05 245 A5 E diaeresis
++166 10/06 246 A6 I circumflex
++167 10/07 247 A7 I diaeresis
++168 10/08 250 A8 Acute accent
++169 10/09 251 A9 Grave accent
++170 10/10 252 AA Circumflex accent
++171 10/11 253 AB Diaeresis
++172 10/12 254 AC Tilde accent
++173 10/13 255 AD U grave
++174 10/14 256 AE U circumflex
++175 10/15 257 AF Lira symbol
++176 11/00 260 B0 Top bar (macron)
++177 11/01 261 B1 Y acute
++178 11/02 262 B2 y acute
++179 11/03 263 B3 Degree Sign
++180 11/04 264 B4 C cedilla
++181 11/05 265 B5 c cedilla
++182 11/06 266 B6 N tilde
++183 11/07 267 B7 n tilde
++184 11/08 270 B8 Inverted exclamation mark
++185 11/09 271 B9 Inverted question mark
++186 11/10 272 BA Currency symbol
++187 11/11 273 BB Pound sterling symbol
++188 11/12 274 BC Yen symbol
++189 11/13 275 BD Paragraph
++190 11/14 276 BE Florin (Guilder) symbol
++191 11/15 277 BF Cent symbol
++192 12/00 300 C0 a circumflex
++193 12/01 301 C1 e circumflex
++194 12/02 302 C2 o circumflex
++195 12/03 303 C3 u circumflex
++196 12/04 304 C4 a acute
++197 12/05 305 C5 e acute
++198 12/06 306 C6 o acute
++199 12/07 307 C7 u acute
++200 12/08 310 C8 a grave
++201 12/09 311 C9 e grave
++202 12/10 312 CA o grave
++203 12/11 313 CB u grave
++204 12/12 314 CC a diaeresis
++205 12/13 315 CD e diaeresis
++206 12/14 316 CE o diaeresis
++207 12/15 317 CF u diaeresis
++208 13/00 320 D0 A ring
++209 13/01 321 D1 i circumflex
++210 13/02 322 D2 O with stroke
++211 13/03 323 D3 AE digraph
++212 13/04 324 D4 a ring
++213 13/05 325 D5 i acute
++214 13/06 326 D6 o with stroke
++215 13/07 327 D7 ae digraph
++216 13/08 330 D8 A diaeresis
++217 13/09 331 D9 i grave
++218 13/10 332 DA O diaeresis
++219 13/11 333 DB U diaeresis
++220 13/12 334 DC E acute
++221 13/13 335 DD i diaeresis
++222 13/14 336 DE German sharp s
++223 13/15 337 DF O circumflex
++224 14/00 340 E0 A acute
++225 14/01 341 E1 A tilde
++226 14/02 342 E2 a tilde
++227 14/03 343 E3 Icelandic Eth
++228 14/04 344 E4 Icelandic eth
++229 14/05 345 E5 I acute
++230 14/06 346 E6 I grave
++231 14/07 347 E7 O acute
++232 14/08 350 E8 O grave
++233 14/09 351 E9 O tilde
++234 14/10 352 EA o tilde
++235 14/11 353 EB S caron
++236 14/12 354 EC s caron
++237 14/13 355 ED U acute
++238 14/14 356 EE Y diaeresis
++239 14/15 357 EF y diaeresis
++240 15/00 360 F0 Icelandic Thorn
++241 15/01 361 F1 Icelandic thorn
++242 15/02 362 F2 Middle dot
++243 15/03 363 F3 Greek mu
++244 15/04 364 F4 Pilcrow sign
++245 15/05 365 F5 Fraction 3/4
++246 15/06 366 F6 Long dash, horizontal bar
++247 15/07 367 F7 Fraction 1/4
++248 15/08 370 F8 Fraction 1/2
++249 15/09 371 F9 Feminine ordinal
++250 15/10 372 FA Masculine ordinal
++251 15/11 373 FB Left guillemot
++252 15/12 374 FC Solid box
++253 15/13 375 FD Right guillemot
++254 15/14 376 FE Plus or minus sign
++255 15/15 377 FF (Undefined)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ III.1.2. Greek Character Sets
++
++ III.1.2.1. The ISO 8859-7 Latin / Greek Alphabet = ELOT 928
++
++dec col/row oct hex description
++160 10/00 240 A0 No-break space
++161 10/01 241 A1 Left single quotation mark
++162 10/02 242 A2 right single quotation mark
++163 10/03 243 A3 Pound sign
++164 10/04 244 A4 (UNUSED)
++165 10/05 245 A5 (UNUSED)
++166 10/06 246 A6 Broken bar
++167 10/07 247 A7 Paragraph sign
++168 10/08 250 A8 Diaeresis (Dialytika)
++169 10/09 251 A9 Copyright sign
++170 10/10 252 AA (UNUSED)
++171 10/11 253 AB Left angle quotation
++172 10/12 254 AC Not sign
++173 10/13 255 AD Soft hyphen
++174 10/14 256 AE (UNUSED)
++175 10/15 257 AF Horizontal bar (Parenthetiki pavla)
++176 11/00 260 B0 Degree sign
++177 11/01 261 B1 Plus-minus sign
++178 11/02 262 B2 Superscript two
++179 11/03 263 B3 Superscript three
++180 11/04 264 B4 Accent (tonos)
++181 11/05 265 B5 Diaeresis and accent (Dialytika and Tonos)
++182 11/06 266 B6 Alpha with accent
++183 11/07 267 B7 Middle dot (Ano Teleia)
++184 11/08 270 B8 Epsilon with accent
++185 11/09 271 B9 Eta with accent
++186 11/10 272 BA Iota with accent
++187 11/11 273 BB Right angle quotation
++188 11/12 274 BC Omicron with accent
++189 11/13 275 BD One half
++190 11/14 276 BE Upsilon with accent
++191 11/15 277 BF Omega with accent
++192 12/00 300 C0 iota with diaeresis and accent
++193 12/01 301 C1 Alpha
++194 12/02 302 C2 Beta
++195 12/03 303 C3 Gamma
++196 12/04 304 C4 Delta
++197 12/05 305 C5 Epsilon
++198 12/06 306 C6 Zeta
++199 12/07 307 C7 Eta
++200 12/08 310 C8 Theta
++201 12/09 311 C9 Iota
++202 12/10 312 CA Kappa
++203 12/11 313 CB Lamda
++204 12/12 314 CC Mu
++205 12/13 315 CD Nu
++206 12/14 316 CE Ksi
++207 12/15 317 CF Omicron
++208 13/00 320 D0 Pi
++209 13/01 321 D1 Rho
++210 13/02 322 D2 (UNUSED)
++211 13/03 323 D3 Sigma
++212 13/04 324 D4 Tau
++213 13/05 325 D5 Upsilon
++214 13/06 326 D6 Phi
++215 13/07 327 D7 Khi
++216 13/08 330 D8 Psi
++217 13/09 331 D9 Omega
++218 13/10 332 DA Iota with diaeresis
++219 13/11 333 DB Upsilon with diaeresis
++220 13/12 334 DC alpha with accent
++221 13/13 335 DD epsilon with accent
++222 13/14 336 DE eta with accent
++223 13/15 337 DF iota with accent
++224 14/00 340 E0 upsilon with diaeresis and accent
++225 14/01 341 E1 alpha
++226 14/02 342 E2 beta
++227 14/03 343 E3 gamma
++228 14/04 344 E4 delta
++229 14/05 345 E5 epsilon
++230 14/06 346 E6 zeta
++231 14/07 347 E7 eta
++232 14/08 350 E8 theta
++233 14/09 351 E9 iota
++234 14/10 352 EA kappa
++235 14/11 353 EB lamda
++236 14/12 354 EC mu
++237 14/13 355 ED nu
++238 14/14 356 EE ksi
++239 14/15 357 EF omicron
++240 15/00 360 F0 pi
++241 15/01 361 F1 rho
++242 15/02 362 F2 terminal sigma
++243 15/03 363 F3 sigma
++244 15/04 364 F4 tau
++245 15/05 365 F5 upsilon
++246 15/06 366 F6 phi
++247 15/07 367 F7 khi
++248 15/08 370 F8 psi
++249 15/09 371 F9 omega
++250 15/10 372 FA iota with diaeresis
++251 15/11 373 FB upsilon with diaeresis
++252 15/12 374 FC omicron with diaeresis
++253 15/13 375 FD upsilon with accent
++254 15/14 376 FE omega with accent
++255 15/15 377 FF (UNUSED)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ III.1.2.2. The ELOT 927 Character Set
++
++dec col/row oct hex description
++ 32 02/00 40 20 SPACE
++ 33 02/01 41 21 EXCLAMATION MARK
++ 34 02/02 42 22 QUOTATION MARK
++ 35 02/03 43 23 NUMBER SIGN
++ 36 02/04 44 24 DOLLAR SIGN
++ 37 02/05 45 25 PERCENT SIGN
++ 38 02/06 46 26 AMPERSAND
++ 39 02/07 47 27 APOSTROPHE
++ 40 02/08 50 28 LEFT PARENTHESIS
++ 41 02/09 51 29 RIGHT PARENTHESIS
++ 42 02/10 52 2A ASTERISK
++ 43 02/11 53 2B PLUS SIGN
++ 44 02/12 54 2C COMMA
++ 45 02/13 55 2D HYPHEN, MINUS SIGN
++ 46 02/14 56 2E PERIOD, FULL STOP
++ 47 02/15 57 2F SOLIDUS, SLASH
++ 48 03/00 60 30 DIGIT ZERO
++ 49 03/01 61 31 DIGIT ONE
++ 50 03/02 62 32 DIGIT TWO
++ 51 03/03 63 33 DIGIT THREE
++ 52 03/04 64 34 DIGIT FOUR
++ 53 03/05 65 35 DIGIT FIVE
++ 54 03/06 66 36 DIGIT SIX
++ 55 03/07 67 37 DIGIT SEVEN
++ 56 03/08 70 38 DIGIT EIGHT
++ 57 03/09 71 39 DIGIT NINE
++ 58 03/10 72 3A COLON
++ 59 03/11 73 3B SEMICOLON
++ 60 03/12 74 3C LESS-THAN SIGN, LEFT ANGLE BRACKET
++ 61 03/13 75 3D EQUALS SIGN
++ 62 03/14 76 3E GREATER-THAN SIGN, RIGHT ANGLE BRACKET
++ 63 03/15 77 3F QUESTION MARK
++ 64 04/00 100 40 COMMERCIAL AT SIGN
++ 65 04/01 101 41 CAPITAL LETTER A
++ 66 04/02 102 42 CAPITAL LETTER B
++ 67 04/03 103 43 CAPITAL LETTER C
++ 68 04/04 104 44 CAPITAL LETTER D
++ 69 04/05 105 45 CAPITAL LETTER E
++ 70 04/06 106 46 CAPITAL LETTER F
++ 71 04/07 107 47 CAPITAL LETTER G
++ 72 04/08 110 48 CAPITAL LETTER H
++ 73 04/09 111 49 CAPITAL LETTER I
++ 74 04/10 112 4A CAPITAL LETTER J
++ 75 04/11 113 4B CAPITAL LETTER K
++ 76 04/12 114 4C CAPITAL LETTER L
++ 77 04/13 115 4D CAPITAL LETTER M
++ 78 04/14 116 4E CAPITAL LETTER N
++ 79 04/15 117 4F CAPITAL LETTER O
++ 80 05/00 120 50 CAPITAL LETTER P
++ 81 05/01 121 51 CAPITAL LETTER Q
++ 82 05/02 122 52 CAPITAL LETTER R
++ 83 05/03 123 53 CAPITAL LETTER S
++ 84 05/04 124 54 CAPITAL LETTER T
++ 85 05/05 125 55 CAPITAL LETTER U
++ 86 05/06 126 56 CAPITAL LETTER V
++ 87 05/07 127 57 CAPITAL LETTER W
++ 88 05/08 130 58 CAPITAL LETTER X
++ 89 05/09 131 59 CAPITAL LETTER Y
++ 90 05/10 132 5A CAPITAL LETTER Z
++ 91 05/11 133 5B LEFT SQUARE BRACKET
++ 92 05/12 134 5C REVERSE SOLIDUS, BACKSLASH
++ 93 05/13 135 5D RIGHT SQUARE BRACKET
++ 94 05/14 136 5E CIRCUMFLEX ACCENT
++ 95 05/15 137 5F UNDERSCORE
++ 96 06/00 140 60 ACCENT GRAVE
++ 97 06/01 141 61 GREEK LETTER ALPHA
++ 98 06/02 142 62 GREEK LETTER BETA
++ 99 06/03 143 63 GREEK LETTER GAMMA
++100 06/04 144 64 GREEK LETTER DELTA
++101 06/05 145 65 GREEK LETTER EPSILON
++102 06/06 146 66 GREEK LETTER ZETA
++103 06/07 147 67 GREEK LETTER ETA
++104 06/08 150 68 GREEK LETTER THETA
++105 06/09 151 69 GREEK LETTER IOTA
++106 06/10 152 6A GREEK LETTER KAPPA
++107 06/11 153 6B GREEK LETTER LAMDA
++108 06/12 154 6C GREEK LETTER MU
++109 06/13 155 6D GREEK LETTER NU
++110 06/14 156 6E GREEK LETTER KSI
++111 06/15 157 6F GREEK LETTER OMICRON
++112 07/00 160 70 GREEK LETTER PI
++113 07/01 161 71 GREEK LETTER RHO
++114 07/02 162 72 GREEK LETTER SIGMA
++115 07/03 163 73 GREEK LETTER TAU
++116 07/04 164 74 GREEK LETTER UPSILON
++117 07/05 165 75 GREEK LETTER FI
++118 07/06 166 76 GREEK LETTER XI
++119 07/07 167 77 GREEK LETTER PSI
++120 07/08 170 78 GREEK LETTER OMEGA
++121 07/09 171 79 SPACE
++122 07/10 172 7A SPACE
++123 07/11 173 7B LEFT CURLY BRACKET, LEFT BRACE
++124 07/12 174 7C VERTICAL LINE, VERTICAL BAR
++125 07/13 175 7D RIGHT CURLY BRACKET, RIGHT BRACE
++126 07/14 176 7E TILDE
++127 07/15 177 7F RUBOUT, DELETE
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ III.1.2.3. PC Code Page 869
++
++ (to be filled in...)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ III.2. Updated Country Codes
++
++ Date: Mon, 7 Apr 1997 23:23:49 EDT
++ From: Dave Leibold <dleibold@else.net>
++ Newsgroups: comp.dcom.telecom
++ Subject: Ex-USSR Country Codes Profile
++ Organization: TELECOM Digest
++
++ Ex-USSR Country Codes Profile
++ 4 April 1997
++
++ Below is a summary of the country codes that have formed in the wake
++ of the USSR dissolution, along with some updated findings and reports.
++ Additional or corrected information on any of these nations would be
++ welcome (c/o dleibold@else.net).
++ * Kyrgyz Republic country code 996 will take effect, at least in
++ Canada, effective 1 May 1997, according to CRTC Telecom Order
++ 97-464, based on Stentor Tariff Notice 433. There is no indication
++ whether there will be a permissive dialing period involved or for
++ how long such a permissive operation would remain.
++ * Country code 992 was reported as a recent assignment for
++ Tajikistan, which will be moving from country code 7 at some
++ unknown time.
++ * Uzbekistan has its own country code assignment, but I have no
++ information if this is in service yet or what implementation dates
++ have been set.
++ * Kazakstan does not have a known separate country code assignment
++ at present. It remains in country code 7 for the time being.
++ * Russia seems destined to keep country code 7.
++ * Recent news reports speak of some agreements forming between
++ Russia and Belarus. While there is no outright reunification yet,
++ there is expected to be much closer ties between the two nations.
++ Whether this will lead to a reunification of telephone codes
++ remains to be seen.
++
++ In the table, "Effective" means the date at which the country code
++ began service (which could vary according to the nation). "Mandatory"
++ means the date at which the country code 7 is invalid for calls to
++ that nation. There are a number of question marks since exact dates
++ have not been collected in all cases.
++
++CC Nation Effective Mandatory Notes
++
++370 Lithuania 1993? ??? Announced Jan 1993
++371 Latvia 1993? ???
++372 Estonia 1 Feb 1993? March 1993?
++373 Moldova 1993? ??? Announced Jan 1993
++374 Armenia 1 May 1995 1 July 1995 Announced Jan 1995 (ITU)
++375 Belarus 16 Apr 1995 1997?
++380 Ukraine 16 Apr 1995 Oct 1995?
++7 Kazakstan (no known changes)
++7 Russia (presumably not changing)
++992 Tajikistan ??? ??? Announced 1996-7?
++993 Turkmenistan 3 Jan 1997 3 Apr 1997 Canada as of 29 Nov 1996
++994 Azerbaijan Sept 1994? ??? Announced 1992
++995 Georgia 1994? ??? ref: Telecom Digest Oct 1994
++996 Kyrgyz Republic 1 May 1997 ??? ref: Stentor Canada/CRTC
++998 Uzbekistan ??? ??? Announced 1996? (ITU)
++
++ Details courtesy Toby Nixon, ITU, Stentor (Canada), CRTC (Canada),
++ TELECOM Digest (including information collected for the country code
++ listings).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++IV. ERRATA & CORRIGENDA
++
++ The following errors in [636]Using C-Kermit, Second Edition, first
++ printing, have been noted.
++
++ First, some missing acknowledgements for C-Kermit 6.0: JE Jones of
++ Microware for help with OS-9, Nigel Roles for his help with Plan 9,
++ Lucas Hart for help with VMS and Digital UNIX, Igor Kovalenko for his
++ help with QNX. And later, to Susan Kleinmann for her help with Debian
++ Linux packaging; Patrick Volkerding for his help with Slackware Linux
++ packaging; Jim Knoble for his help with Red Hat Linux packaging; and
++ to dozens of others for sending individual C-Kermit binaries for
++ varied and diverse platforms.
++
++ Thanks to James Spath for both binaries and reporting many of the
++ typos noted below. Also to Dat Thuc Nguyen for spotting several typos.
++
++PAGE REMARKS
++COVER "COS" is a misprint. There is no COS. Pretend it says "SCO" or "VOS".
++ (This is fixed in the second printing.)
++ xxi Second line: Fred Smith's affiliation should be Computrition.
++ 83 Change "commands other" to "commands as other" (1st paragraph)
++ 87 Change "The the" to "The" (2nd paragraph)
++ 92 "set modem-type user-defined supra" should be "set modem type ..."
++ 95 Change "VI" to "vi" (1st paragraph)
++ 96 Change "it it" to "it is" (1st paragraph)
++ 97 Change "advantage a literal" to "advantage of a literal" (2nd
++ paragraph)
++102 The call-waiting example would be better as SET DIAL PREFIX *70W
++ (rather than "*70,") because the former will not cause an incorrect
++ call to be placed with pulse dialing.
++123 Third paragraph from bottom: "..otherwise if a your local username.."
++ should be "..otherwise your local username..".
++160 Delete the "it" between "and" and "to" (2nd paragraph)
++185 In "When TRANSFER DISPLAY is OFF, C-Kermit skips the display...",
++ "OFF" should be "NONE".
++187 The last paragraph says the "A command" is ignored, should be "S".
++194 Change "it known" to "it is known" (4th paragraph).
++235 In C-Kermit 7.0, the syntax of the GET command changed. MGET now
++ must be used to get a list of files and there is no more multiline
++ GET command.
++268 Last paragraph: "effect" should be "affect".
++275 In the SET PROTOCOL KERMIT description, the following sentence is
++ incorrect and should be removed: 'If you omit the commands, the
++ default ones are restored: "kermit -ir" and "kermit -r" respectively".
++ The correct information is given at the bottom of page 281.
++279 9th line. The decimal value of ST is 156, not 155.
++295 In the stepping stones, skip ahead to Chapter 17 on p. 327.
++298 Table 16-2, Portuguese entry. Column 4/00 should show section sign,
++ not acute accent.
++316 Other languages written in the Hebrew alphabet include Karaim (a Turkic
++ language spoken in Lithuania and Poland), Judeo-Kurdish, and Judeo-
++ Georgian.
++332 UNDEFINE definition, change "This just" to "This is just".
++344 It might be necessary to set the modem's pulse generation rate when
++ sending numeric pages; most Hayes compatible modems use the S11
++ register for this.
++350 Delete "is" from between "It" and "ceases" (4th paragraph)
++351 Top - both occurrences of "print \%a" should be "echo \%a".
++364 \v(input) and \v(query) out of alphabetical order.
++378 In the MYSEND macro, "if not \m(rc) goto bad" should be:
++ "if \m(rc) goto bad" (remove the "not").
++382-383 It should be stated that the loop control variable must be of the \%a
++ type, or else an array element; macro names can not be used for this.
++383 In line 3, "\%f[\%i]" should be "\&f[\%i]".
++383 In the sort example, it should be stated that the array is 1-based.
++387 Change "You can list" to "You can get a list" (5th paragraph)
++393 \Fverify() description. The 3rd sentence could be stated more clearly
++ as "If all characters in string2 are also in string1, 0 is returned."
++398 Copying \ffiles() results to an array before is not required as of
++ C-Kermit 7.0 (see [637]Section 7.3).
++403 In "(\%a + 3) * (\%b 5)", a minus sign is missing between b and 5.
++407 C-Kermit 7.0 no longer supports multiline GET. Change
++ "get, \%1, \%2" to "get {\%1} {\%2}" or "get /as:{\%2} {\%1}".
++409 READ example while loop should be:
++ while success { echo \m(line), read line }
++409 "WRITE file" should be "WRITE keyword" (you can't put a filename there)
++ (The same applies to WRITE-LINE / WRITELN).
++414 \Funhexify() missing from Table 18-3.
++425 MINPUT definition, change 2nd "text2" to "text3".
++436 Several lines are missing from the UNIXLOGIN macro listing.
++ After the "xif fail" block, insert:
++
++ out \%1\13 ; Send username, carriage return
++ inp 5 Password: ; Wait 5 sec for this prompt
++ if fail end 1 No password prompt
++ pause ; Wait a sec
++ out \%2\13 ; Send password
++
++440 Change "set terminal byteszie" to "set terminal bytesize".
++ Change "input Password:" to "input 10 Password".
++448 Franchise script: "access line" should be "access \m(line)".
++453 There are two incorrectly coded IF statements in the DELIVER macro
++ definition. Replace both occurrences of "if > \%1 \%3 {" with
++ "xif > \%i \%3 {" (replace "if" by "xif" and "\%1" with "\%i").
++453 "the the" (last paragraph) should be "the".
++454 EOT (last paragraph) is End of Transmission, not End of Text.
++457 _DEFINE definition: "name constructed" should be "name is constructed".
++457 "macro for and" (last paragraph) should be "macro and".
++459 Should explain that \v(user) is a legal abbreviation of \v(userid).
++480 Figure II-2 is backwards; the least-significant bit is transmitted
++ first, then up to the highest, and the parity bit last.
++534 The VMS Appendix section on Odd Record Lengths no longer applies;
++ C-Kermit 7.0 handles odd record lengths as well as even ones.
++559 Table VIII-3, Portuguese entry. Column 4/00 should show section sign,
++ not acute accent.
++560-563 HP-Roman8 missing from Table VII-4; there wasn't room to squeeze it in.
++ It is listed in section II(6).
++565 "d stroke" in Table VII-5 has the wrong appearance; the stem should
++ be upright. The letter shown in the table is actually a lowercase
++ Icelandic eth, which has a curved stem.
++601-604 BeBox, BeOS, Plan 9, and probably others not listed in trademarks.
++604 The words "SCRIBE TEXT FORMATTER" appear at the end of the last
++ sentence of the first paragraph of the Colophon. They should have
++ been in the Index.
++Index: Missing entries: SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES, Call waiting, ...
++ \F() Page 605, add also 413-414
++ \Fbreak 389
++ \Fcapitalize 390
++ \Fchecksum 414
++ \Fcrc16 414
++ \Fexecute 414
++ \Fhexify 390
++ \Fltrim 391
++ \Frepeat 392
++ \Fspawn 392
++ \Ftod2secs 399
++ \v() built_in Page 606, add also 361-364
++ \v(_line) 354, 361
++ \v(apcactive) 361
++ \v(charset) 362
++ \v(cpu) 362
++ \v(crc16) 357, 362
++ \v(d$xxx) add page 362
++ \v(dialnumber) 362
++ \v(dialresult) 362
++ \v(errno) 362
++ \v(errstring) 362
++ \v(exedir) 362
++ \v(inidir) 363
++ \v(ipaddress) 363
++ \v(keyboard) 363
++ \v(macro) 363
++ \v(minput) 363
++ \v(m_xxx) 94, 363
++ \v(password) 364
++ \v(query) 364
++ \v(prompt) 364
++ \v(speed) 356, 364
++ \v(startup) 364
++ \v(status) 364
++ \v(sysid) 364
++ \v(system) 364
++ \v(fsize) at lower half page 606 should read \v(tfsize)
++ \v(xversion) 364
++ BEEP Command 40
++ SET FLOW 62, 212
++
++ Figure II-5 on page 493. The pin assignments of the Mini Din-8
++ connector are not described anywhere. As noted in the text, these tend
++ to vary from vendor to vendor. One common arrangement is:
++
++ 1. HSKout (Handshake out -- definition depends on software)
++ 2. HSKin (Handshake in or external clock)
++ 3. TxD-
++ 4. Not used
++ 5. RxD-
++ 6. TxD+
++ 7. Not used
++ 8. RxD+
++
++ Note the "balanced pairs" for Receive Data (RxD) and Transmit Data
++ (TxD), and the utter lack of modem signals. These connectors follow
++ the RS-423 standard, rather than RS-232. In some arrangements, Pin 1
++ is used for DTR and Pin 2 for CD; in others Pin 1 is RTS and Pin 2 is
++ CTS.
++
++ Please send reports of other errors to the authors, as well as
++ suggestions for improvements, additional index entries, and any other
++ comments:
++
++ [638]kermit@columbia.edu
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++APPENDIX V. ADDITIONAL COPYRIGHT NOTICES
++
++ The following copyrights cover some of the source code used in the
++ development of C-Kermit, Kermit 95, or Kermit 95 support libraries.
++
++/*****************************************************************************/
++/* */
++/* Copyright (c) 1995 by Oy Online Solutions Ltd. */
++/* */
++/* Distribution of this source code is strictly forbbidden. Use of this */
++/* source code is granted to the University of Columbia C-Kermit project */
++/* to be distributed in binary format only. Please familiarize yourself */
++/* with the accompanying LICENSE.P file. */
++/* */
++/*****************************************************************************/
++
++ used for Xmodem, Ymodem, and Zmodem protocol in Kermit 95 (p95.dll,
++ p2.dll)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ Copyright (c) 1997 Stanford University
++
++ The use of this software for revenue-generating purposes may require a
++ license from the owners of the underlying intellectual property.
++ Specifically, the SRP-3 protocol may not be used for
++ revenue-generating purposes without a license.
++
++ Within that constraint, permission to use, copy, modify, and
++ distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose is
++ hereby granted without fee, provided that the above copyright notices
++ and this permission notice appear in all copies of the software and
++ related documentation.
++
++ THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS-IS" AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
++ EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR OTHERWISE, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY
++ WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
++
++ IN NO EVENT SHALL STANFORD BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL,
++ INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY KIND, OR ANY DAMAGES
++ WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER OR NOT
++ ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF DAMAGE, AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
++ ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
++ SOFTWARE.
++
++ Used for Secure Remote Password (TM) protocol (SRP) in C-Kermit,
++ Kermit 95 (k95.exe, k2.exe, k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ Copyright 1990 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology. All
++ Rights Reserved.
++
++ Export of this software from the United States of America may require
++ a specific license from the United States Government. It is the
++ responsibility of any person or organization contemplating export to
++ obtain such a license before exporting.
++
++ WITHIN THAT CONSTRAINT, permission to use, copy, modify, and
++ distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and
++ without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright
++ notice appear in all copies and that both that copyright notice and
++ this permission notice appear in supporting documentation, and that
++ the name of M.I.T. not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining
++ to distribution of the software without specific, written prior
++ permission. M.I.T. makes no representations about the suitability of
++ this software for any purpose. It is provided "as is" without express
++ or implied warranty.
++
++ Used for Telnet Authentication Option, Telnet Encryption Option, and
++ Kerberos (TM) authentication in C-Kermit, Kermit 95 (k95.exe, k2.exe,
++ k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ Copyright (c) 1991, 1993 The Regents of the University of California.
++ All rights reserved.
++
++ Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
++ modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are
++ met:
++ 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
++ notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
++ 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
++ notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
++ the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
++ distribution.
++ 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this
++ software must display the following acknowledgement:
++
++ This product includes software developed by the University of
++ California, Berkeley and its contributors.
++ 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its
++ contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived
++ from this software without specific prior written permission.
++
++ THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''
++ AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
++ THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
++ PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS
++ BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
++ CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
++ SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
++ BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
++ WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE
++ OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN
++ IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
++
++ Used for Telnet Authentication Option, Telnet Encryption Option, and
++ Kerberos (TM) authentication in C-Kermit, Kermit 95 (k95.exe, k2.exe,
++ k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com) All rights
++ reserved.
++
++ This package is an DES implementation written by Eric Young
++ (eay@cryptsoft.com). The implementation was written so as to conform
++ with MIT's libdes.
++
++ This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as
++ the following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions
++ apply to all code found in this distribution.
++
++ Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in
++ the code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product,
++ Eric Young should be given attribution as the author of that the SSL
++ library. This can be in the form of a textual message at program
++ startup or in documentation (online or textual) provided with the
++ package.
++
++ Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
++ modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are
++ met:
++ 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice,
++ this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
++ 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
++ notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
++ the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
++ distribution.
++ 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this
++ software must display the following acknowledgement: This product
++ includes software developed by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)
++
++ THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
++ IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
++ WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
++ DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR
++ ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
++ DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
++ GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
++ INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
++ IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
++ OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
++ ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
++
++ The license and distribution terms for any publically available
++ version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code
++ cannot simply be copied and put under another distrubution license
++ [including the GNU Public License.]
++
++ The reason behind this being stated in this direct manner is past
++ experience in code simply being copied and the attribution removed
++ from it and then being distributed as part of other packages. This
++ implementation was a non-trivial and unpaid effort.
++
++ Used DES encryption in Kermit 95 (k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ * This is version 1.1 of CryptoLib
++ *
++ * The authors of this software are Jack Lacy, Don Mitchell and Matt Blaze
++ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 by AT&T.
++ * Permission to use, copy, and modify this software without fee
++ * is hereby granted, provided that this entire notice is included in
++ * all copies of any software which is or includes a copy or
++ * modification of this software and in all copies of the supporting
++ * documentation for such software.
++ *
++ * NOTE:
++ * Some of the algorithms in cryptolib may be covered by patents.
++ * It is the responsibility of the user to ensure that any required
++ * licenses are obtained.
++ *
++ *
++ * SOME PARTS OF CRYPTOLIB MAY BE RESTRICTED UNDER UNITED STATES EXPORT
++ * REGULATIONS.
++ *
++ *
++ * THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
++ * WARRANTY. IN PARTICULAR, NEITHER THE AUTHORS NOR AT&T MAKE ANY
++ * REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY
++ * OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
++
++ Used for Big Number library in Kermit 95 (k95crypt.dll, k2crypt.dll).
++
++ [ [639]Top ] [ [640]C-Kermit ] [ [641]Kermit Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ CKERMIT70.HTM / The Kermit Project / Columbia University / 8 Feb 2000
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#contents
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.htm
++ 4. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 5. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 6. http://www.kermit-project.org/
++ 7. http://www.columbia.nyc.ny.us/kermit/
++ 8. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/COPYING.TXT
++ 9. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckcmai.c
++ 10. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xv
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 12. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckcbwr.txt
++ 13. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckubwr.txt
++ 14. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckvbwr.txt
++ 15. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckubwr.txt
++ 16. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckermit70.txt
++ 17. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/security.txt
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm
++ 19. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/iksd.txt
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.htm
++ 21. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/cuiksd.htm
++ 22. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/telnet.txt
++ 23. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/telnet.htm
++ 24. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/COPYING.TXT
++ 25. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95.html
++ 26. http://www.opensource.org/
++ 27. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xi
++ 29. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xii
++ 30. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x0
++ 31. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.0
++ 33. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.1
++ 34. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.2
++ 35. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.3
++ 36. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.4
++ 37. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 38. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.1
++ 39. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.2
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.3
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.4
++ 42. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.5
++ 43. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6
++ 44. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.7
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.8
++ 46. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.9
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.10
++ 48. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11
++ 49. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.1
++ 50. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.2
++ 51. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.3
++ 52. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.4
++ 53. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.5
++ 54. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.6
++ 55. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.7
++ 56. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.12
++ 57. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.13
++ 58. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.14
++ 59. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.15
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.16
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.17
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.18
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.19
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.20
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.21
++ 66. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22
++ 67. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.1
++ 68. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.2
++ 69. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.3
++ 70. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.4
++ 71. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.5
++ 72. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.6
++ 73. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.7
++ 74. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.8
++ 75. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.23
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.24
++ 77. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2
++ 78. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.0
++ 79. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1
++ 80. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.1
++ 81. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.2
++ 82. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.3
++ 83. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.4
++ 84. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.5
++ 85. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.6
++ 86. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.7
++ 87. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.8
++ 88. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.9
++ 89. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.10
++ 90. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.11
++ 91. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.12
++ 92. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.13
++ 93. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.14
++ 94. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.15
++ 95. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.16
++ 96. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.2
++ 97. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.2.1
++ 98. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.2.2
++ 99. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3
++ 100. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.0
++ 101. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.1
++ 102. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.2
++ 103. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.3
++ 104. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.4
++ 105. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.5
++ 106. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.6
++ 107. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.4
++ 108. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.5
++ 109. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.6
++ 110. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7
++ 111. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.0
++ 112. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.1
++ 113. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.2
++ 114. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.3
++ 115. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.4
++ 116. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.4.1
++ 117. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.4.2
++ 118. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.4.3
++ 119. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.4.4
++ 120. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.4.5
++ 121. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.8
++ 122. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.9
++ 123. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.9.1
++ 124. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.9.2
++ 125. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.10
++ 126. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.11
++ 127. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.12
++ 128. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.13
++ 129. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.14
++ 130. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.15
++ 131. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x3
++ 132. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x3.1
++ 133. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x3.2
++ 134. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x3.3
++ 135. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x3.4
++ 136. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4
++ 137. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.0
++ 138. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.1
++ 139. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.1.1
++ 140. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.1.2
++ 141. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.1.3
++ 142. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2
++ 143. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.1
++ 144. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.1.1
++ 145. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.1.2
++ 146. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.1.3
++ 147. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.2
++ 148. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.2.1
++ 149. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.2.2
++ 150. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.3
++ 151. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.3.1
++ 152. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.3.2
++ 153. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.4
++ 154. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.5
++ 155. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.6
++ 156. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.7
++ 157. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8
++ 158. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8.1
++ 159. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8.2
++ 160. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8.3
++ 161. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8.4
++ 162. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 163. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3.1
++ 164. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3.2
++ 165. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3.3
++ 166. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3.4
++ 167. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4
++ 168. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.1
++ 169. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.1.1
++ 170. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.1.2
++ 171. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.2
++ 172. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.2.1
++ 173. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.2.1.1
++ 174. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.2.1.2
++ 175. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.4.2.2
++ 176. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5
++ 177. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.1
++ 178. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.2
++ 179. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.2.1
++ 180. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.2.2
++ 181. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.3
++ 182. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.4
++ 183. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.6
++ 184. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7
++ 185. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 186. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.2
++ 187. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.3
++ 188. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.8
++ 189. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.8.1
++ 190. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.8.2
++ 191. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 192. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 193. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.2
++ 194. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.3
++ 195. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 196. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11
++ 197. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.1
++ 198. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.2
++ 199. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.3
++ 200. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.4
++ 201. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.5
++ 202. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.6
++ 203. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.12
++ 204. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.13
++ 205. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.14
++ 206. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.15
++ 207. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.16
++ 208. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.17
++ 209. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.17.1
++ 210. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.17.2
++ 211. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.18
++ 212. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.19
++ 213. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20
++ 214. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.1
++ 215. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.2
++ 216. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.2.1
++ 217. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.2.2
++ 218. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.2.3
++ 219. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.2.4
++ 220. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.2.5
++ 221. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.3
++ 222. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.21
++ 223. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22
++ 224. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.1
++ 225. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.2
++ 226. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.3
++ 227. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.4
++ 228. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.5
++ 229. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.6
++ 230. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.7
++ 231. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.8
++ 232. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.23
++ 233. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.24
++ 234. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.25
++ 235. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5
++ 236. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.0
++ 237. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.1
++ 238. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.2
++ 239. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.3
++ 240. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.3.1
++ 241. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.3.2
++ 242. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.4
++ 243. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.5
++ 244. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.6
++ 245. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.7
++ 246. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6
++ 247. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.0
++ 248. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.1
++ 249. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.2
++ 250. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.3
++ 251. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.4
++ 252. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.5
++ 253. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6
++ 254. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.1
++ 255. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.2
++ 256. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.2
++ 257. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.3
++ 258. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.4
++ 259. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5
++ 260. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5.1
++ 261. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5.2
++ 262. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5.3
++ 263. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5.4
++ 264. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5.5
++ 265. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.7
++ 266. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7
++ 267. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.0
++ 268. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.1
++ 269. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.1.1
++ 270. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.1.2
++ 271. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.1.3
++ 272. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.1.4
++ 273. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.2
++ 274. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.3
++ 275. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.4
++ 276. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 277. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.6
++ 278. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.7
++ 279. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.8
++ 280. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.9
++ 281. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.9.1
++ 282. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.9.2
++ 283. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10
++ 284. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.1
++ 285. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.2
++ 286. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.3
++ 287. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.4
++ 288. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.5
++ 289. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.6
++ 290. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.7
++ 291. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.8
++ 292. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.9
++ 293. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.10
++ 294. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.11
++ 295. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.12
++ 296. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.13
++ 297. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.14
++ 298. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.15
++ 299. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.16
++ 300. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.17
++ 301. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.18
++ 302. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.19
++ 303. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.20
++ 304. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.20.1
++ 305. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.20.2
++ 306. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.21
++ 307. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.22
++ 308. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.23
++ 309. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.24
++ 310. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.25
++ 311. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.26
++ 312. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.26.1
++ 313. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.26.2
++ 314. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.27
++ 315. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x8
++ 316. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9
++ 317. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.0
++ 318. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.1
++ 319. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.2
++ 320. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.3
++ 321. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x10
++ 322. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii
++ 323. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii.1
++ 324. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii.1.1
++ 325. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii.1.2
++ 326. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii.1.2.1
++ 327. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii.1.2.2
++ 328. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii.1.2.3
++ 329. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii.2
++ 330. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiv
++ 331. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xv
++ 332. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 333. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckbreviews.html
++ 334. http://www.bhusa.com/
++ 335. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/manuals.html#ckde
++ 336. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/manuals.html#ktb
++ 337. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/news.html
++ 338. news:comp.protocols.kermit.announce
++ 339. news:comp.protocols.kermit.misc
++ 340. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 341. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4
++ 342. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 343. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.23
++ 344. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.1
++ 345. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 346. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 347. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.
++ 348. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 349. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.9.2
++ 350. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.15
++ 351. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.1
++ 352. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6
++ 353. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.4
++ 354. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 355. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#mjd
++ 356. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#mjd
++ 357. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 358. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 359. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 360. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 361. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.12
++ 362. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 363. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 364. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5
++ 365. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 366. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.18
++ 367. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.4
++ 368. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.15
++ 369. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 370. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.3
++ 371. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.7
++ 372. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.1
++ 373. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 374. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckccfg.txt
++ 375. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckccfg.txt
++ 376. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.4
++ 377. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.5
++ 378. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 379. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22.5
++ 380. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.12
++ 381. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.16
++ 382. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7
++ 383. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.3.5
++ 384. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 385. http://www.telefonica.es/cambiodenumeracion/
++ 386. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 387. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 388. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.2.2
++ 389. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.11
++ 390. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.13
++ 391. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.12
++ 392. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 393. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.1
++ 394. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 395. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 396. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.7
++ 397. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.6
++ 398. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 399. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/telnet.txt
++ 400. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/telnet.htm
++ 401. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/telnet.txt
++ 402. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/telnet.htm
++ 403. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc1572.txt
++ 404. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc779.txt
++ 405. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 406. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.10
++ 407. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.8
++ 408. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 409. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20
++ 410. http://www.psy.uq.oz.au/~ftp/Crypto/
++ 411. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm
++ 412. http://srp.stanford.edu/srp/
++ 413. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7.1,
++ 414. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckccfg.txt
++ 415. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm
++ 416. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 417. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7
++ 418. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.0
++ 419. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckuins.txt
++ 420. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckubwr.txt
++ 421. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckuins.txt
++ 422. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html#x4.2
++ 423. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 424. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8.1
++ 425. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc1945.txt
++ 426. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 427. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x3.2
++ 428. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x3.2
++ 429. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 430. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 431. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.4
++ 432. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckubwr.txt
++ 433. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 434. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 435. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.3
++ 436. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 437. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 438. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11
++ 439. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.15
++ 440. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.4
++ 441. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7
++ 442. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.3
++ 443. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.1.3
++ 444. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 445. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.2
++ 446. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 447. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8.2
++ 448. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 449. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 450. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11
++ 451. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.15
++ 452. http://www.telstra.com.au/docs/PGP/
++ 453. http://www.telstra.com.au/docs/PGP/pgpdoc2/pgpdoc2_17.html
++ 454. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm
++ 455. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.7
++ 456. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 457. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.14
++ 458. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.23
++ 459. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7
++ 460. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 461. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 462. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 463. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 464. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.4
++ 465. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 466. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.5
++ 467. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 468. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 469. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.4
++ 470. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 471. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.4
++ 472. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.5
++ 473. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 474. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 475. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 476. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6
++ 477. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10
++ 478. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.11
++ 479. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6
++ 480. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.2
++ 481. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11
++ 482. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5.4
++ 483. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 484. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.0.6
++ 485. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2
++ 486. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.1
++ 487. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 488. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 489. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 490. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.2
++ 491. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 492. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2
++ 493. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 494. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.2
++ 495. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 496. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2
++ 497. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 498. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.11.5
++ 499. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.0.6
++ 500. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11
++ 501. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 502. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.3
++ 503. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 504. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 505. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.1
++ 506. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10
++ 507. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.5
++ 508. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.3
++ 509. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.5
++ 510. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 511. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 512. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 513. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 514. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 515. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.15
++ 516. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.18
++ 517. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20
++ 518. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20
++ 519. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20
++ 520. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.19
++ 521. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.16
++ 522. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.19
++ 523. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20.2.3
++ 524. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 525. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5.4
++ 526. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.2
++ 527. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22.3
++ 528. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 529. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 530. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.3
++ 531. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x5.2.1
++ 532. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.1
++ 533. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.2
++ 534. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6
++ 535. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii
++ 536. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#xiii
++ 537. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc1489.txt
++ 538. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2319.txt
++ 539. http://www.unicode.org/
++ 540. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.2
++ 541. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.5.1
++ 542. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2640.txt
++ 543. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.6.2
++ 544. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.0
++ 545. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.5
++ 546. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.4
++ 547. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 548. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.21
++ 549. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x6.5
++ 550. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.8
++ 551. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.7
++ 552. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.2
++ 553. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.19
++ 554. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 555. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.1
++ 556. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2
++ 557. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.1
++ 558. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2
++ 559. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.11
++ 560. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.10
++ 561. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#ferrstring
++ 562. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.5
++ 563. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x2.1.10
++ 564. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.1
++ 565. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.23
++ 566. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.23
++ 567. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22
++ 568. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6
++ 569. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.23
++ 570. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.24
++ 571. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.24
++ 572. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.3
++ 573. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.12
++ 574. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.9
++ 575. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 576. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.3
++ 577. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.3
++ 578. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 579. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.7
++ 580. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.7
++ 581. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.8.4
++ 582. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.2.5
++ 583. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.8
++ 584. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 585. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 586. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.19
++ 587. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.16
++ 588. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.9.1
++ 589. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 590. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.3
++ 591. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.3
++ 592. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.5.1
++ 593. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10
++ 594. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.10
++ 595. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 596. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.23
++ 597. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.7
++ 598. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.7
++ 599. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11.3
++ 600. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.11
++ 601. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 602. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.3
++ 603. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.3
++ 604. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.9.2
++ 605. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 606. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.17.2
++ 607. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22
++ 608. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 609. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22
++ 610. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 611. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 612. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.22
++ 613. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6
++ 614. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 615. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 616. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.19
++ 617. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9.1
++ 618. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x9.3
++ 619. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.5
++ 620. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 621. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.4
++ 622. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.20.2
++ 623. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.5
++ 624. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.10.9
++ 625. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.10
++ 626. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 627. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7.1
++ 628. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 629. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.19
++ 630. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.10
++ 631. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.11
++ 632. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.3
++ 633. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/gkermit.html
++ 634. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.20
++ 635. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/gkermit.html
++ 636. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 637. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x7.3
++ 638. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
++ 639. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#top
++ 640. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 641. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckccfg.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,1766 @@
++
++ C-Kermit Configuration Options
++
++ Frank da Cruz
++ [1]The Kermit Project
++ [2]Columbia University
++
++ As of: C-Kermit 8.0.211, 10 April 2004
++ This page last updated: Sun Apr 11 16:45:55 2004 (New York USA Time)
++
++ IF YOU ARE READING A PLAIN-TEXT version of this document, note that
++ this file is a plain-text dump of a Web page. You can visit the
++ original (and possibly more up-to-date) Web page here:
++
++ [3]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++
++ [ [4]C-Kermit Home ] [ [5]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ CONTENTS
++
++ 1. [6]FILE TRANSFER
++ 2. [7]SERIAL COMMUNICATION SPEEDS
++ 3. [8]FULLSCREEN FILE TRANSFER DISPLAY
++ 4. [9]CHARACTER SETS
++ 5. [10]APC EXECUTION
++ 6. [11]PROGRAM SIZE
++ 7. [12]MODEM DIALING
++ 8. [13]NETWORK SUPPORT
++ 9. [14]EXCEPTION HANDLING
++ 10. [15]SECURITY FEATURES
++ 11. [16]ENABLING SELECT()
++ 12. [17]I/O REDIRECTION
++ 13. [18]FLOATING-POINT NUMBERS, TIMERS, AND ARITHMETIC
++ 14. [19]SPECIAL CONFIGURATIONS
++ I. [20]SUMMARY OF COMPILE-TIME OPTIONS
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ OVERVIEW
++
++ This document describes configuration options for C-Kermit (5A and
++ later). The major topics covered include program size (and how to
++ reduce it), how to include or exclude particular features, notes on
++ serial-port, modem, and network support, and a list of C-Kermit's
++ compile-time options.
++
++ For details about your particular operating system, also see the
++ system-specific installation instructions file, such as the
++ [21]C-Kermit Installation Instructions for Unix.
++
++ [ [22]C-Kermit Home ] [ [23]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1. FILE TRANSFER
++
++ [ [24]Top ] [ [25]Contents ] [ [26]Next ] [ [27]Previous ]
++
++ Prior to version 7.0, C-Kermit was always built with the most
++ conservative Kermit file-transfer protocol defaults on every platform:
++ no control-character prefixing, 94-byte packets, and a window size of
++ 1.
++
++ Starting in version 7.0, fast settings are the default. To override
++ these at compile time, include:
++
++ -DNOFAST
++
++ in the C compiler CFLAGS. Even with the fast defaults, C-Kermit
++ automatically drops down to whatever window and packet sizes requested
++ by the other Kermit, if these are smaller, when sending files (except
++ for control-character unprefixing, which is not negotiated, and which
++ is now set to CAUTIOUS rather than NONE at startup). C-Kermit's
++ settings prevail when it is receiving.
++
++ [ [28]C-Kermit Home ] [ [29]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2. SERIAL COMMUNICATION SPEEDS
++
++ [ [30]Top ] [ [31]Contents ] [ [32]Next ] [ [33]Previous ]
++
++ As of 6 September 1997, a new simplified mechanism for obtaining the
++ list of legal serial interface speeds is in place:
++
++ * If the symbol TTSPDLIST is defined, the system-dependent routine
++ ttspdlist() is called at program initialization to obtain the
++ list.
++ * This symbol should be defined only for C-Kermit implementations
++ that have implemented the ttspdlist() function, typically in the
++ ck?tio.c module. See [34]ckutio.c for an example.
++ * TTSPDLIST is automatically defined in [35]ckcdeb.h for UNIX. Add
++ the appropriate #ifdefs for other platforms when the corresponding
++ ttspdlist() functions are filled in.
++ * If TTSPDLIST is (or normally would be) defined, the old code
++ (described below) can still be selected by defining NOTTSPDLIST.
++
++ The ttspdlist() function can obtain the speeds in any way that works.
++ For example, based simply on #ifdef Bnnnn..#endif (in UNIX). Although
++ it might be better to actually check each speed against the currently
++ selected hardware interface before allowing it in the array, there is
++ usually no passive and/or reliable and safe way to do this, and so
++ it's better to let some speeds into the array that might not work,
++ than it is to erroneously exclude others. Speeds that don't work are
++ caught when the SET SPEED command is actually given.
++
++ Note that this scheme does not necessarily rule out split speed
++ operation, but effectively it does in C-Kermit as presently
++ constituted since there are no commands to set input and output speed
++ separately (except the special case "set speed 75/1200").
++
++ Note that some platforms, notably AIX 4.2 and 4.3, implement high
++ serial speeds transparently to the application, e.g. by mapping 50 bps
++ to 57600 bps, and so on.
++
++ That's the whole deal. When TTSPDLIST is not defined, the following
++ applies:
++
++ Speeds are defined in two places: the SET SPEED keyword list in the
++ command parser (as of this writing, in the [36]ckuus3.c source file),
++ and in the system- dependent communications i/o module, ck?tio.c,
++ functions ttsspd() (set speed) and ttgspd() (get speed). The following
++ speeds are assumed to be available in all versions:
++
++ 0, 110, 300, 600, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600
++
++ If one or more of these speeds is not supported by your system, you'll
++ need to change the source code (this has never happened so far). Other
++ speeds that are not common to all systems have Kermit-specific
++ symbols:
++
++ Symbol Symbol
++ Speed (bps) to enable to disable
++ 50 BPS_50 NOB_50
++ 75 BPS_75 NOB_75
++ 75/1200 BPS_7512 NOB_7512
++ 134.5 BPS_134 NOB_134
++ 150 BPS_150 NOB_150
++ 200 BPS_200 NOB_200
++ 1800 BPS_1800 NOB_1800
++ 3600 BPS_3600 NOB_3600
++ 7200 BPS_7200 NOB_7200
++ 14400 BPS_14K NOB_14K
++ 19200 BPS_19K NOB_19K
++ 28800 BPS_28K NOB_28K
++ 38400 BPS_38K NOB_38K
++ 57600 BPS_57K NOB_57K
++ 76800 BPS_76K NOB_76K
++ 115200 BPS_115K NOB_155K
++ 230400 BPS_230K NOB_230K
++ 460800 BPS_460K NOB_460K
++ 921600 BPS_921K NOB_921K
++
++ The [37]ckcdeb.h header file contains default speed configurations for
++ the many systems that C-Kermit supports. You can override these
++ defaults by (a) editing ckcdeb.h, or (b) defining the appropriate
++ enabling and/or disabling symbols on the CC command line, for example:
++
++ -DBPS_14400 -DNOB_115200
++
++ or the "make" command line, e.g.:
++
++ make blah "KFLAGS=-DBPS_14400 -DNOB_115200"
++
++ Note: some speeds have no symbols defined for them, because they have
++ never been needed: 12.5bps, 45.5bps, 20000bps, etc. These can easily
++ be added if required (but they will work only if the OS supports
++ them).
++
++ IMPORTANT: Adding one of these flags at compile time does not
++ necessarily mean that you will be able to use that speed. A particular
++ speed is usable only if your underlying operating system supports it.
++ In particular, it needs to be defined in the appropriate system header
++ file (e.g. in UNIX, cd to /usr/include and grep for B9600 in *.h and
++ sys/*.h to find the header file that contains the definitions for the
++ supported speeds), and supported by the serial device driver, and of
++ course by the physical device itself.
++
++ ALSO IMPORTANT: The list of available speeds is independent of how
++ they are set. The many UNIXes, for example, offer a wide variety of
++ APIs that are BSD-based, SYSV-based, POSIX-based, and purely made up.
++ See the ttsspd(), ttgspd(), and ttspdlist() routines in [38]ckutio.c
++ for illustrations.
++
++ The latest entries in this horserace are the tcgetspeed() and
++ ttsetspeed() routines found in UnixWare 7. Unlike other methods, they
++ accept the entire range of integers (longs really) as speed values,
++ rather than certain codes, and return an error if the number is not,
++ in fact, a legal speed for the device/driver in question. In this
++ case, there is no way to build a list of legal speeds at compile time,
++ since no Bnnnn symbols are defined (except for "depracated, legacy"
++ interfaces like ioctl()) and so the legal speed list must be
++ enumerated in the code -- see ttspdlist() in [39]ckutio.c.
++
++ [ [40]C-Kermit Home ] [ [41]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3. FULLSCREEN FILE TRANSFER DISPLAY
++
++ [ [42]Top ] [ [43]Contents ] [ [44]Next ] [ [45]Previous ]
++
++ New to edit 180 is support for an MS-DOS-Kermit-like local-mode full
++ screen file transfer display, accomplished using the curses library,
++ or something equivalent (for example, the Screen Manager on DEC VMS).
++ To enable this feature, include the following in your CFLAGS:
++
++ -DCK_CURSES
++
++ and then change your build procedure (if necessary) to include the
++ necessary libraries. For example, in Unix these are usually "curses"
++ or "ncurses" (and more recenlty, "ncursesw" and "slang"), perhaps also
++ "termcap", "termlib", or "tinfo":
++
++ "LIBS= -lcurses -ltermcap"
++ "LIBS= -lcurses -ltermlib"
++ "LIBS= -lncurses"
++ "LIBS= -ltermlib"
++ "LIBS= -ltinfo"
++
++ "man curses" for further information, and search through the Unix
++ [46]makefile for "CK_CURSES" to see many examples, and also see the
++ relevant sections of the [47]Unix C-Kermit Installation Instructions,
++ particularly Sections [48]4 and [49]9.2.
++
++ There might still be a complication. Some implementations of curses
++ reserve the right to alter the buffering on the output file without
++ restoring it afterwards, which can leave Kermit's command processing
++ in a mess when the prompt comes back after a fullscreen file transfer
++ display. The typical symptom is that characters you type at the prompt
++ after a local-mode file transfer (i.e. after seeing the curses
++ file-transfer display) do not echo until you press the Return (Enter)
++ key. If this happens to you, try adding
++
++ -DCK_NEWTERM
++
++ to your makefile target (see comments in screenc() in [50]ckuusx.c for
++ an explanation).
++
++ If that doesn't fix the problem, then use a bigger hammer and replace
++ -DCK_NEWTERM with:
++
++ -DNONOSETBUF
++
++ which tells Kermit to force stdout to be unbuffered so CBREAK mode can
++ work.
++
++ In SCO Xenix and SCO UNIX, there are two separate curses libraries,
++ one based on termcap and the other based on terminfo. The default
++ library, usually terminfo, is established when the development system
++ is installed. To manually select terminfo (at compile time):
++
++ compile -DM_TERMINFO and link -ltinfo
++
++ and to manually select termcap:
++
++ compile -DM_TERMCAP and link -ltcap -ltermlib
++
++ <curses.h> looks at M_TERMINFO and M_TERMCAP to decide which header
++ files to use. /usr/lib/libcurses.a is a link to either libtinfo.a or
++ libtcap.a. The C-Kermit compilation options must agree with the
++ version of the curses library that is actually installed.
++
++ NOTE: If you are doing an ANSI-C compilation and you get compile time
++ warnings like the following:
++
++ Warning: function not declared in ckuusx.c: wmove, printw, wclrtoeol,
++ wclear, wrefresh, endwin, etc...
++
++ it means that your <curses.h> file does not contain prototypes for
++ these functions. The warnings should be harmless.
++
++ New to edit 190 is the ability to refresh a messed-up full-screen
++ display, e.g. after receiving a broadcast message. This depends on the
++ curses package including the wrefresh() and clearok() functions and
++ the curscr variable. If your version has these, or has code to
++ simulate them, then add:
++
++ -DCK_WREFRESH
++
++ The curses and termcap libraries add considerable size to the program
++ image (e.g. about 20K on a SUN-4, 40K on a 386). On some small
++ systems, such as the AT&T 6300 PLUS, curses can push Kermit over the
++ edge... even though it compiles, loads, and runs correctly, its
++ increased size apparently makes it swap constantly, slowing it down to
++ a crawl, even when the curses display is not in use. Some new makefile
++ targets have been added to take care of this (e.g. sys3upcshcc), but
++ similar tricks might be necessary in other cases too.
++
++ On the curses file-transfer display, just below the "thermometer", is
++ a running display of the transfer rate, as a flat quotient of file
++ characters per elapsed seconds so far. You can change this to an
++ average that gives greater weight to recent history (0.25 *
++ instantaneous cps + 0.75 * historical cps) by adding -DCPS_WEIGHTED to
++ your CFLAGS (sorry folks, this one is not worth a SET command). You
++ can choose a second type of weighted average in which the weighting
++ smooths out progressively as the transfer progresses by adding
++ -DCPS_VINCE to -DCPS_WEIGHTED.
++
++ An alternative to curses is also available at compile time, but should
++ be selected if your version of Kermit is to be run in local mode only
++ in an ANSI terminal environment, for example on a desktop workstation
++ that has an ANSI console driver. To select this option in place of
++ curses, define the symbol MYCURSES:
++
++ -DMYCURSES
++
++ instead of CK_CURSES. The MYCURSES option uses built-in ANSI (VT100)
++ escape sequences, and depends upon your terminal or console driver to
++ interpret them correctly.
++
++ In some C-Kermit builds, we replace printf() via #define printf...
++ However, this can cause conflicts with the [n]curses header files.
++ Various hacks are required to get around this -- see [51]ckutio.c,
++ [52]ckufio.c, [53]ckuusx.c, [54]ckucmd.c, etc.
++
++ [ [55]C-Kermit Home ] [ [56]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4. CHARACTER SETS
++
++ [ [57]Top ] [ [58]Contents ] [ [59]Next ] [ [60]Previous ]
++
++ Since version 5A, C-Kermit has included support for conversion of
++ character sets for Western European languages (i.e. languages that
++ originated in Western Europe, but are now also spoken in the Western
++ Hemisphere and other parts of the world), via ISO 8859-1 Latin
++ Alphabet 1, for Eastern European languages (ISO Latin-2), Hebrew (and
++ Yiddish), Greek, and Cyrillic-alphabet languages (ISO Latin/Cyrillic).
++ Many file (local) character sets are supported: ISO 646 7-bit national
++ sets, IBM code pages, Apple, DEC, DG, NeXT, etc.
++
++ To build Kermit with no character-set translation at all, include
++ -DNOCSETS in the CFLAGS. To build with no Latin-2, add -DNOLATIN2. To
++ build with no Cyrillic, add -DNOCYRIL. To omit Hebrew, add -DNOHEBREW.
++ If -DNOCSETS is *not* included, you'll always get LATIN1. To build
++ with no KANJI include -DNOKANJI. There is presently no way to include
++ Latin-2, Cyrillic, Hebrew, or Kanji without also including Latin-1.
++
++ [61]Unicode support was added in C-Kermit 7.0, and it adds a fair
++ amount of tables and code (and this is only a "Level 1" implementation
++ -- a higher level would also require building in the entire Unicode
++ database). On a PC with RH 5.2 Linux, building C-Kermit 7.0, we get
++ the following sizes:
++
++ NOCSETS NOUNICODE NOKANJI Before After
++ [ ] [ ] [ ] 1329014 (Full)
++ [ ] [ ] [ X ] 1325686 (Unicode but no Kanji)
++ [ ] [ X ] [ ] 1158837 (All charsets except Unicode)
++ [ X ] [ x ] [ x ] 1090845 (NOCSETS implies the other two)
++
++ Note, by the way, that NOKANJI without NOUNICODE only removes the
++ non-Unicode Kanji sets (Shift-JIS, EUC-JP, JIS-7, etc). Kanji is still
++ representable in UCS-2 and UTF-8.
++
++ [ [62]C-Kermit Home ] [ [63]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5. APC EXECUTION
++
++ [ [64]Top ] [ [65]Contents ] [ [66]Next ] [ [67]Previous ]
++
++ The Kermit CONNECT and INPUT commands are coded to execute Application
++ Program Command escape sequences from the host:
++
++ <ESC>_<text><ESC>\
++
++ where <text> is a C-Kermit command, or a list of C-Kermit commands
++ separated by commas, up to about 1K in length.
++
++ To date, this feature has been included in the OS/2, Windows, VMS,
++ OS-9, and Unix versions, for which the symbol:
++
++ CK_APC
++
++ is defined automatically in [68]ckuusr.h. For OS/2, APC is enabled at
++ runtime by default, for UNIX it is disabled. It is controlled by the
++ SET TERMINAL APC command. Configuring APC capability into a version
++ that gets it by default (because CK_APC is defined in [69]ckuusr.h)
++ can be overridden by including:
++
++ -DNOAPC
++
++ on the CC command line.
++
++ C-Kermit's autodownload feature depends on the APC feature, so
++ deconfiguring APC also disables autodownload (it doesn't use APC
++ escape sequences, but uses the APC switching mechanism internally).
++
++ [ [70]C-Kermit Home ] [ [71]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6. PROGRAM SIZE
++
++ [ [72]Top ] [ [73]Contents ] [ [74]Next ] [ [75]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 6.1. [76]Feature Selection
++ 6.2. [77]Changing Buffer Sizes
++ 6.3. [78]Other Size-Related Items
++ 6.4. [79]Space/Time Tradeoffs
++
++ (Also see [80]Section 4)
++
++ Each release of C-Kermit is larger than the last. On some computers
++ (usually old ones) the size of the program prevents it from being
++ successfully linked and loaded. On some others (also usually old
++ ones), it occupies so much memory that it is constantly swapping or
++ paging. In such cases, you can reduce C-Kermit's size in various ways,
++ outlined in this section. The following options can cut down on the
++ program's size at compile time by removing features or changing the
++ size of storage areas.
++
++ If you are reading this section because all you want is a small, fast,
++ quick-to-load Kermit file-transfer application for the remote end of
++ your connection, and the remote end is Unix based, take a look at
++ G-Kermit:
++
++ [81]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/gkermit.html
++
++ 6.1. Feature Selection
++
++ Features can be added or removed by defining symbols on the CC (C
++ compiler) command line. "-D" is the normal CC directive to define a
++ symbol so, for example, "-DNODEBUG" defines the symbol NODEBUG. Some C
++ compilers might use different syntax, e.g. "-d NODEBUG" or
++ "/DEFINE=NODEBUG". For C compilers that do not accept command-line
++ definitions, you can put the corresponding #define statements in the
++ file ckcsym.h, for example:
++
++ #define NODEBUG
++
++ The following table shows the savings achieved when building C-Kermit
++ 8.0 (Beta.04) with selected feature-deselection switches on an
++ Intel-based PC with Red Hat Linux 7.0 and gcc 2.96. The sizes are for
++ non-security builds. The fully configured non-security build is
++ 2127408 bytes.
++
++ Option Size Savings Effect
++ NOICP 545330 74.4% No Interactive Command Parser (command-line only)
++ NOLOCAL 1539994 27.6% No making connections.
++ NOXFER 1551108 27.1% No file transfer.
++ IKSDONLY 1566608 26.4% Internet Kermit Server only.
++ NOCSETS 1750097 17.7% No character-set conversion.
++ NOSPL 1800293 15.4% No Script Programming Language.
++ NONET 1808575 15.0% No making network connections.
++ NOUNICODE 1834426 13.8% No Unicode character-set conversion.
++ NOHELP 1837877 13.6% No built-in help text.
++ NODEBUG 1891669 11.1% No debug log.
++ NOFRILLS 1918966 9.8% No "frills".
++ NOFTP 1972496 7.3% No FTP client.
++ NODIAL 1984488 6.7% No automatic modem dialing.
++ NOPUSH 2070184 2.7% No shell access, running external programs, etc.
++ NOIKSD 2074129 2.5% No Internet Kermit Server capability.
++ NOHTTP 2082610 2.1% No HTTP client.
++ NOFLOAT 2091332 1.7% No floating-point arithmetic.
++ NOCHANNELIO 2095978 1.5% No FOPEN/FREAD/FWRITE/FCLOSE, etc.
++ MINIDIAL 2098035 1.4% No built-in support for many kinds of modems.
++ NOSERVER 2098987 1.3% No server mode.
++ NOSEXP 2105898 1.0% No S-Expressions.
++ NOPTY 2117743 0.5% No pseudoterminal support.
++ NORLOGIN 2121089 0.3% No RLOGIN connections.
++ NOOLDMODEMS 2124038 0.2% No built-in support for old kinds of modems.
++ NOSSH 2125696 0.1% No SSH command.
++
++ And here are a few combinations
++
++ Options Size Savings Effect
++ NODEBUG NOICP NOCSETS NOLOCAL 281641 86.7% No debug log, parser,
++ character sets, or making connections.
++ NOICP NOCSETS NOLOCAL 376468 82.3% No parser, character sets, or
++ making connections.
++ NOICP NOCSETS NONET 427510 79.9% No parser, character sets, or network
++ connections.
++ NOSPL NOCSETS 1423784 33.1% No script language, or character sets.
++
++ -DNOFRILLS removes various command synonyms; the following top-level
++ commands: CLEAR, DELETE, DISABLE, ENABLE, GETOK, MAIL, RENAME, TYPE,
++ WHO; and the following REMOTE commands: KERMIT, LOGIN, LOGOUT, PRINT,
++ TYPE, WHO.
++
++ 6.2. Changing Buffer Sizes
++
++ Most modern computers have so much memory that (a) there is no need to
++ scrimp and save, and (b) C-Kermit, even when fully configured, is
++ relatively small by today's standards.
++
++ Two major factors affect Kermit's size: feature selection and buffer
++ sizes. Buffer sizes affect such things as the maximum length for a
++ Kermit packet, the maximum length for a command, for a macro, for the
++ name of a macro, etc. Big buffer sizes are used when the following
++ symbol is defined:
++
++ BIGBUFOK
++
++ as it is by default for most modern platforms (Linux, AIX 4 and 5,
++ HP-UX 10 and 11, Solaris, etc) in [82]ckuusr.h. If your build does not
++ get big buffers automatically (SHOW FEATURES tells you), you can
++ include them by rebuilding with BIGBUFOK defined; e.g. in Unix:
++
++ make xxxx KFLAGS=-DBIGBUFOK
++
++ where xxxx is the makefile target. On the other hand, if you want to
++ build without big buffers when they normally would be selected, use:
++
++ make xxxx KFLAGS=-DNOBIGBUF
++
++ There are options to control Kermit's packet buffer allocations. The
++ following symbols are defined in [83]ckcker.h in such a way that you
++ can override them by redefining them in CFLAGS:
++
++ -DMAXSP=xxxx - Maximum send-packet length.
++ -DMAXRP=xxxx - Maximum receive-packet length.
++ -DSBSIZ=xxxx - Total allocation for send-packet buffers.
++ -DRBSIZ=xxxx - Total allocation for receive-packet buffers.
++
++ The defaults depend on the platform.
++
++ Using dynamic allocation (-DDYNAMIC) reduces storage requirements for
++ the executable program on disk, and allows more and bigger packets at
++ runtime. This has proven safe over the years, and now most builds
++ (e.g. all Unix, VMS, Windows, and OS/2 ones) use dynamic memory
++ allocation by default. If it causes trouble, however, then omit the
++ -DDYNAMIC option from CFLAGS, or add -DNODYNAMIC.
++
++ 6.3. Other Size-Related Items
++
++ To make Kermit compile and load successfully, you might have to change
++ your build procedure to:
++
++ a. Request a larger ("large" or "huge") compilation / code-generation
++ model. This is needed for 16-bit PC-based UNIX versions (most or
++ all of which fail to build C-Kermit 7.0 and later anyway). This is
++ typically done with a -M and/or -F switch (see your cc manual or
++ man page for details).
++ b. Some development systems support overlays. If the program is too
++ big to be built as is, check your loader manual ("man ld") to see
++ if an overlay feature is available. See the 2.10/2.11 BSD example
++ in the UNIX makefile. (Actually, as of version 7.0, C-Kermit is
++ too big to build, period, even with overlays, on 2.xx BSD).
++ c. Similarly, some small and/or segment-based architectures support
++ "code mapping", which is similar to overlays (PDP11-based VENIX
++ 1.0, circa 1984, was an example). See the linker documentation on
++ the affected platform.
++
++ It is also possible to reduce the size of the executable program file
++ in several other ways:
++
++ a. Include the -O (optimize) compiler switch if it isn't already
++ included in your "make" entry (and if it works!). If your compiler
++ supports higher levels of optimization (e.g. -O2 or higher number,
++ -Onolimit (HP-UX), etc), try them; the greater the level of
++ optimization, the longer the compilation and more likely the
++ compiler will run out of memory. The the latter eventuality, some
++ compilers also provide command-line options to allocate more
++ memory for the optimizer, like "-Olimit number" in Ultrix.
++ b. If your platofrm supports shared libraries, change the make entry
++ to take advantage of this feature. The way to do this is, of
++ course, platform dependent; see the NeXT makefile target for an
++ example. some platforms (like Solaris) do it automatically and
++ give you no choice. But watch out: executables linked with shared
++ libraries are less portable than statically linked executables.
++ c. Strip the program image after building ("man strip" for further
++ info), or add -s to the LNKFLAGS (UNIX only). This strips the
++ program of its symbol table and relocation information.
++ d. Move character strings into a separate file. See the 2.11 BSD
++ target for an example.
++
++ 6.4. Space/Time Tradeoffs
++
++ There are more than 6000 debug() statements in the program. If you
++ want to save both space (program size) and time (program execution
++ time), include -DNODEBUG in the compilation. If you want to include
++ debugging for tracking down problems, omit -DNODEBUG from the make
++ entry. But when you include debugging, you have two choices for how
++ it's done. One definition defines debug() to be a function call; this
++ is cheap in space but expensive in execution. The other defines debug
++ as "if (deblog)" and then the function call, to omit the function call
++ overhead when the debug log is not active. But this adds a lot of
++ space to the program. Both methods work, take your choice; IFDEBUG is
++ preferred if memory is not a constraint but the computer is likely to
++ be slow. The first method is the default, i.e. if nothing is done to
++ the CFLAGS or in [84]ckcdeb.h (but in some cases, e.g. VMS, it is). To
++ select the second method, include -DIFDEBUG in the compilation (and
++ don't include -DNODEBUG).
++
++ [ [85]C-Kermit Home ] [ [86]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7. MODEM DIALING
++
++ [ [87]Top ] [ [88]Contents ] [ [89]Next ] [ [90]Previous ]
++
++ -DNODIAL removes automatic modem dialing completely, including the
++ entire [91]ckudia.c module, plus all commands that refer to dialing in
++ the various ckuus*.c modules.
++
++ -DMINIDIAL leaves the DIAL and related commands (SET/SHOW MODEM,
++ SET/SHOW DIAL) intact, but removes support for all types of modems
++ except CCITT, Hayes, Unknown, User-defined, Generic-high-speed, and
++ None (= Direct). The MINIDIAL option cuts the size of the dial module
++ approximately in half. Use this option if you have only Hayes or CCITT
++ modems and don't want to carry the baggage for the other types.
++
++ A compromise between full dialer support and MINIDIAL is obtained by
++ removing support for "old" modems -- all the strange non-Hayes
++ compatible 1200 and 2400 bps modems that C-Kermit has been carrying
++ around since 1985 or so. To remove support for these modems, add
++ -DNOOLDMODEMS to CFLAGS at compilation time.
++
++ Finally, if you keep support for old modems, you will notice that
++ their names appear on the "set modem ?" menu. That's because their
++ names are, by default, "visible". But the list is confusing to the
++ younger generation, who have only heard of modems from the
++ V.32bis-and-later era. If you want to be able to use old modems, but
++ don't want their names cluttering up menus, add this to CFLAGS:
++
++ -DM_OLD=1
++
++ [ [92]C-Kermit Home ] [ [93]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8. NETWORK SUPPORT
++
++ [ [94]Top ] [ [95]Contents ] [ [96]Next ] [ [97]Previous ]
++
++ SECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 8.1. [98]TCP/IP
++ 8.2. [99]X.25
++ 8.3. [100]Other Networks
++
++ C-Kermit supports not only serial-port and modem connections, but also
++ TCP/IP and X.25 network connections. Some versions support other
++ network types too like DECnet, LAT, NETBIOS, etc. If you define the
++ following symbol:
++
++ NONET
++
++ then all network support is compiled away.
++
++ 8.1. TCP/IP
++
++ SUBSECTION CONTENTS
++
++ 8.1.1. [101]Firewalls
++ 8.1.2. [102]Compilation and Linking Problems
++ 8.1.3. [103]Enabling Host Address Lists
++ 8.1.4. [104]Enabling Telnet NAWS
++ 8.1.5. [105]Enabling Incoming TCP/IP Connections
++ 8.1.6. [106]Disabling SET TCP Options
++
++ C-Kermit's TCP/IP features require the Berkeley sockets library or
++ equivalent, generally available on any Unix system, as well as in
++ Windows 9x/NT, OS/2, VMS, AOS/VS, VOS, etc. The TCP/IP support
++ includes built-in TELNET, FTP, and HTTP protocol. To select TCP/IP
++ support, include -DTCPSOCKET in your makefile target's CFLAGS, or (in
++ VMS) the appropriate variant (e.g. -DWOLLONGONG, -DMULTINET,
++ -DEXCELAN, -DWINTCP, etc).
++
++ The VMS and/or early Unix third-party TCP/IP products are often
++ incompatible with each other, and sometimes with different versions of
++ themselves. For example, Wollongong reportedly put header files in
++ different directories for different UNIX versions:
++
++ * in.h can be in either /usr/include/sys or /user/include/netinet.
++ * telnet.h can be in either /usr/include/arpa or
++ /user/include/netinet.
++ * inet.h can be in either /usr/include/arpa or /user/include/sys.
++
++ In cases like this, use the -I cc command-line option when possible;
++ otherwise it's better to make links in the file system than it is to
++ hack up the C-Kermit source code. Suppose, for example, Kermit is
++ looking for telnet.h in /usr/include/arpa, but on your computer it is
++ in /usr/include/netinet. Do this (as root, or get the system
++ administrator to do it):
++
++ cd /usr/include/arpa
++ ln /usr/include/netinet/telnet.h telnet.h
++
++ ("man ln" for details about links.)
++
++ The network support for TCP/IP and X.25 is in the source files
++ [107]ckcnet.h, [108]ckctel.c, [109]ckctel.c, [110]ckctel.h,
++ [111]ckcftp.c, with miscellaneous SHOW commands, etc, in the various
++ ckuus*.c modules, plus code in the ck*con.c or ckucns.c (CONNECT
++ command) and several other modules to detect TELNET negotiations, etc.
++
++ Within the TCPSOCKET code, some socket-level controls are included if
++ TCPSOCKET is defined in the C-Kermit CFLAGS and SOL_SOCKET is defined
++ in in the system's TCP-related header files, such as <sys/socket.h>.
++ These are:
++
++ SET TCP KEEPALIVE
++ SET TCP LINGER
++ SET TCP RECVBUF
++ SET TCP SENDBUF
++
++ In addition, if TCP_NODELAY is defined, the following command is also
++ enabled:
++
++ SET TCP NODELAY (Nagle algorithm)
++
++ See the [112]C-Kermit user documentation for descriptions of these
++ commands.
++
++ 8.1.1. Firewalls
++
++ There exist various types of firewalls, set up to separate users of an
++ internal TCP/IP network ("Intranet") from the great wide Internet, but
++ then to let selected users or services get through after all.
++
++ One firewall method is called SOCKS, in which a proxy server allows
++ users inside a firewall to access the outside world, based on a
++ permission list generally stored in a file. SOCKS is enabled in one of
++ two ways. First, the standard sockets library is modified to handle
++ the firewall, and then all the client applications are relinked (if
++ necessary, i.e. if the libraries are not dynamically loaded) with the
++ modified sockets library. The APIs are all the same, so the
++ applications do not need to be recoded or recompiled.
++
++ In the other method, the applications must be modified to call
++ replacement routines, such as Raccept() instead of accept(), Rbind()
++ instead of bind(), etc, and then linked with a separate SOCKS library.
++ This second method is accomplished (for SOCKS4) in C-Kermit by
++ including -DCK_SOCKS in your CFLAGS, and also adding:
++
++ -lsocks
++
++ to LIBS, or replacing -lsockets with -lsocks (depending on whether the
++ socks library also includes all the sockets entry points).
++
++ For SOCKS5, use -DCK_SOCKS5.
++
++ Explicit firewall support can, in general, not be a standard feature
++ or a feature that is selected at runtime, because the SOCKS library
++ tends to be different at each site -- local modifications abound.
++
++ The ideal situation occurs when firewalls are supported by the first
++ method, using dynamically linked sockets-replacement libraries; in
++ this case, all your TCP/IP client applications negotiate the firewall
++ transparently.
++
++ 8.1.2. Compilation and Linking Problems
++
++ If you get a compilation error in [113]ckcnet.c, with a complaint like
++ "incompatible types in assignment", it probably has something to do
++ with the data type your system uses for the inet_addr() function,
++ which is declared (usually) in <arpa/inet.h>. Kermit uses "unsigned
++ long" unless the symbol INADDRX is defined, in which case "struct
++ inaddr" is used instead. Try adding -DINADDRX to CFLAGS in your make
++ entry, and if that fixes the problem, please send a report to
++ kermit@columbia.edu.
++
++ Compilation errors might also have to do with the data type used for
++ getsockopt() and setsockopt() option-length field. This is normally an
++ int, but sometimes it's a short, a long, or an unsigned any of those,
++ or a size_t. To fix the compilation problem, add -DSOCKOPT_T=xxx to
++ the CFLAGS in your makefile target, where xxx is the appropriate type
++ (use "man getsockopt" or grep through your system/network header files
++ to find the needed type).
++
++ 8.1.3. Enabling Host Address Lists
++
++ When you give Kermit an IP host name, it calls the socket routine
++ gethostbyname() to resolve it. gethostbyname() returns a hostent
++ struct, which might or might not not include a list of addresses; if
++ it does, then if the first one fails, Kermit can try the second one,
++ and so on. However, this will only work if the symbol "h_addr" is a
++ macro defined as "h_addr_list[0]", usually in netdb.h. If it is, then
++ you can activate this feature by defining the following symbol in
++ CFLAGS:
++
++ HADDRLIST
++
++ 8.1.4. Enabling Telnet NAWS
++
++ The Telnet Negotiation About Window Size (NAWS) option requires the
++ ability to find out the terminal screen's dimensions. E.g. in Unix, we
++ need something like ioctl(0, TIOCGWINSZ, ...). If your version of
++ Kermit was built with NAWS capability, SHOW VERSIONS includes CK_NAWS
++ among the compiler options. If it doesn't, you can add it by defining
++ CK_NAWS at compile time. Then, if the compiler or linker complain
++ about undefined or missing symbols, or there is no complaint but SHOW
++ TERMINAL fails to show reasonable "Rows =, Columns =" values, then
++ take a look at (or write) the appropriate ttgwsiz() routine. On the
++ other hand, if CK_NAWS is defined by default for your system (in
++ [114]ckcnet.h), but causes trouble, you can override this definition
++ by including the -DNONAWS switch on your CC command line, thus
++ disabling the NAWS feature.
++
++ This appears to be needed at least on the AT&T 3B2, where in
++ [115]ckutio.c, the routine ttgwsiz() finds that the TIOCGWINSZ symbol
++ is defined but lacks definitions for the corresponding winsize struct
++ and its members ws_col and ws_row.
++
++ The UNIX version of C-Kermit also traps SIGWINCH, so it can send a
++ NAWS to the Telnet server any time the local console terminal window
++ size changes, e.g. when you stretch it with a mouse. The
++ SIGWINCH-trapping code is enabled if SIGWINCH is defined (i.e. in
++ signal.h). If this code should cause problems, you can disable it
++ without disabling the NAWS feature altogether, by defining NOSIGWINCH
++ at compile time.
++
++ 8.1.5. Enabling Incoming TCP/IP Connections
++
++ This feature lets you "set host * port" and wait for an incoming
++ connection on the given port. This feature is enabled automatically at
++ compile if TCPSOCKET is defined and SELECT is also defined. But watch
++ out, simply defining SELECT on the cc command line does not guarantee
++ successful compilation or linking (see [116]Section 11).
++
++ If you want to disable incoming TCP/IP connections, then build
++ C-Kermit with:
++
++ -DNOLISTEN
++
++ 8.1.6. Disabling SET TCP Options
++
++ The main reason for this is because of header file / prototype
++ conflicts at compile time regardting get- / setsockopt(). If you can't
++ fix them (without breaking other builds), add the following in CFLAGS:
++
++ -DNOTCPOPTS
++
++ 8.2. X.25
++
++ X.25 support requires (a) a Sun, (b) the SunLink product (libraries
++ and header files), and (c) an X.25 connection into your Sun. Similarly
++ (in C-Kermit 7.0 or later) Stratus VOS and IBM AIX.
++
++ In UNIX, special makefile targets sunos4x25 and sunos41x25 (for SUNOS
++ 4.0 and 4.1, respectively), or aix41x25, are provided to build in this
++ feature, but they only work if conditions (a)-(c) are met. To request
++ this feature, include -DSUNX25 (or -DIBMX25) in CFLAGS.
++
++ SUNX25 (or -DIBMX25) and TCPSOCKET can be freely mixed and matched,
++ and selected by the user at runtime with the SET NETWORK TYPE command
++ or SET HOST switches.
++
++ 8.3. Other Networks
++
++ Support for other networking methods -- NETBIOS, LAT, Named Pipes, etc
++ -- is included in ck*net.h and ck*net.c for implementations (such as
++ Windows or OS/2) where these methods are supported.
++
++ Provision is made in the organization of the modules, header files,
++ commands, etc, for addition of new network types such as DECnet, X.25
++ for other systems (HP-UX, VMS, etc), and so on. Send email to
++ [117]kermit@columbia.edu if you are willing and able to work on such a
++ project.
++
++ [ [118]C-Kermit Home ] [ [119]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9. EXCEPTION HANDLING
++
++ [ [120]Top ] [ [121]Contents ] [ [122]Next ] [ [123]Previous ]
++
++ The C language setjmp/longjmp mechanism is used for handling
++ exceptions. The jump buffer is of type jmp_buf, which almost
++ everywhere is typedef'd as an array, in which case you should have no
++ trouble compiling the exception-handling code. However, if you are
++ building C-Kermit in/for an environment where jmp_buf is something
++ other than an array (e.g. a struct), then you'll have to define the
++ following symbol:
++
++ JBNOTARRAY
++
++ [ [124]C-Kermit Home ] [ [125]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 10. SECURITY FEATURES
++
++ [ [126]Top ] [ [127]Contents ] [ [128]Next ] [ [129]Previous ]
++
++ Security, in the sense of secure authentication and strong encryption,
++ can be built into versionf of C-Kermit for which the appropriate
++ libraries and header files are available (Kerberos IV, Kerberos V,
++ OpenSSL, SRP), as explained in great detail in the Kermit Security
++ Reference
++ . The following symbols govern C-Kermit's security features at build
++ time:
++
++ NO_AUTHENTICATION
++ Means do not configure any TELNET AUTHENTICATION support. It
++ implies NO_ENCRYPTION and undefines any of the auth and encrypt
++ types. It does not undefine CK_SSL even though builds with
++ CK_SSL cannot succeed without CK_AUTHENTICATION. (This will be
++ supported in a future release. It will be needed to allow
++ C-Kermit to be built only as an FTP client.)
++
++ NO_KERBEROS
++ Means do not compile in any KERBEROS support when
++ CK_AUTHENTICATION has been defined.
++
++ NO_SRP
++ Do not compile in any SRP support when CK_AUTHENTICATION has
++ been defined.
++
++ NO_SSL
++ Do not compile in any SSL/TLS support
++
++ NO_ENCRYPTION
++ Do not compile in any Telnet encryption support. It does not
++ affect the use of SSL/TLS
++
++ NOSSH
++ Do not compile in any SSH support whether internal or external
++
++ CK_AUTHENTICATION
++ Telnet AUTHENTICATION support. (Also, required if SSL/TLS
++ support is desired.) On most platforms this does not autodefine
++ any authentication mechanisms such as Kerberos V, Kerberos IV,
++ SRP, ... Those need to be defined separately.
++
++ CK_KERBEROS
++ Defined automatically when KRB4, KRB5, or KRB524 are defined.
++ Implies that some version of Kerberos is in use.
++
++ KRB4
++ Should be defined when Kerberos IV support is desired.
++
++ KRB5
++ Should be defined when Kerberos V support is desired.
++
++ KRB524
++ Should be defined if both Kerberos V and Kerberos IV are used
++ and the Kerberos IV support is provided by the MIT Kerberos IV
++ compatibility library in the current Kerberos 5 distribution.
++
++ KRB5_U2U
++ Should be defined if KRB5 is defined and Kerberos 5 User to
++ User mode is desired.
++
++ HEIMDAL
++ Should be defined if Kerberos V support is provided by HEIMDAL.
++ Support for this option is not complete in C-Kermit 8.0. Anyone
++ interested in working on this should contact kermit-support.
++
++ CK_SRP
++ Should be defined if SRP support is desired.
++
++ CK_ENCRYPTION
++ Should be defined if TELNET ENCRYPTION option support is
++ desired. This option does not define any particular encryption
++ types. That should be done by defining CK_DES or CK_CAST.
++
++ CK_DES
++ Should be defined if either DES or 3DES Telnet Encryption
++ option support is desired.
++
++ LIBDES
++ If CK_DES is defined and DES support is being provided by
++ either Eric Young's libdes.a or OpenSSL 0.9.6x or earlier, this
++ option must be defined. If it is not defined, it will be
++ assumed that DES support is provided by the MIT Kerberos IV
++ libraries.
++
++ CK_CAST
++ Should be defined if CAST Telnet Encryption option support is
++ desired
++
++ CK_SSL
++ Should be defined if SSL/TLS support (OpenSSL) is desired.
++
++ SSL_KRB5
++ If KRB5 is defined, and OpenSSL is built to support the
++ Kerberos 5 ciphers, then you should define SSL_KRB5
++
++ NOSSLKRB5
++ If you are using OpenSSL 0.9.7 or higher and do not wish to
++ build with support for Kerberos 5 TLS ciphers, this option must
++ be defined.
++
++ ZLIB
++ If you are using OpenSSL 0.9.6 or higher and it has been
++ compiled with support for ZLIB compression, this option should
++ be defined to enable Kermit to properly enable the use of
++ compression.
++
++ SSHCMD
++ Defined for C-Kermit to enable the use of external SSH clients
++ from the Kermit command language
++
++ SSHBUILTIN
++ Defined for Kermit implementations that have integrated SSH
++ support. Currently only Windows.
++
++ ANYSSH
++ Defined if either SSHCMD or SSHBUILTIN are defined.
++
++ CK_SNDLOC
++ Telnet Send Location support.
++
++ NOSNDLOC
++ Do not include Telnet Send Location support.
++
++ CK_XDISPLOC
++ Telnet X-Display Location support. Determines if the X-Display
++ location information is sent to the Telnet server either via
++ Telnet XDISPLOC or NEW-ENV options.
++
++ NOXDISPLOC
++ Do not include Telnet X-Display Location support.
++
++ CK_FORWARD_X
++ Telnet Forward X Windows Session Data option. Used to protect
++ the privacy and integrity of X Windows Sessions when secure
++ telnet sessions are in use.
++
++ NOFORWARDX
++ Do not include Telnet Forward X Windows Session Data option.
++
++ Besides the strong forms of security listed above, C-Kermit also
++ embodies various internal security features, including:
++
++ NOPUSH
++ Compiling with the NOPUSH symbol defined removes all the "shell
++ escape" features from the program, including the PUSH, RUN, and
++ SPAWN commands, the "!" and "@" command prefixes, OPEN !READ,
++ OPEN !WRITE, job control (including the SUSPEND command), the
++ REDIRECT command, shell/DCL escape from CONNECT mode, as well
++ as the server's execution of REMOTE HOST commands (and, of
++ course, the ENABLE HOST command). Add NODISPO to also prevent
++ acceptance of incoming MAIL or REMOTE PRINT files. For UNIX,
++ also be sure to read [130]Section 11 of the [131]Unix C-Kermit
++ Installation Instructions. about set[ug]id configuration.
++ Additional restrictions can be enforced when in server mode;
++ read about the DISABLE command in the user manual.
++
++ NOCCTRAP
++ Compiling with NOCCTRAP prevents the trapping of SIGINT by
++ Kermit. Thus if the user generates a SIGINT signal (e.g. by
++ typing the system's interrupt character), Kermit will exit
++ immediately, rather than returning to its prompt.
++
++ NOPUSH and NOCCTRAP together allow Kermit to be run from restricted
++ shells, preventing access to system functions.
++
++ [ [132]C-Kermit Home ] [ [133]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11. ENABLING SELECT()
++
++ [ [134]Top ] [ [135]Contents ] [ [136]Next ] [ [137]Previous ]
++
++ Kermit works best if it can do nonblocking reads, nondestructive input
++ buffer checking, and millisecond sleeps. All of these functions can be
++ accomplished by the select() function, which, unfortunately, is not
++ universally available. Furthermore, select() is required if incoming
++ TCP/IP connections are to be supported.
++
++ select() was introduced with Berkeley UNIX, rejected by AT&T for
++ System V, but is gradually creeping in to all UNIX versions (and other
++ operating systems too) by virtue of its presence in the sockets
++ library, which is needed for TCP/IP. AT&T SVID for System V R4
++ includes select(), but that does not mean that all SVR4
++ implementations have it.
++
++ Furthermore, even when select() is available, it might work only on
++ socket file descriptors, but not on others like serial ports, pipes,
++ etc. For example, in AOS/VS and BeOS, it works only with file
++ descriptors that were created by socket() and opened by connect() or
++ accept().
++
++ Other alternatives include poll() and rdchk(). Only one of these three
++ functions should be included. The following symbols govern this:
++
++ SELECT Use select() (BSD, or systems with sockets libraries)
++ CK_POLL Use poll() (System V)
++ RDCHK Use rdchk() (SCO XENIX and UNIX)
++
++ If your system supports the select() function, but your version of
++ C-Kermit does not, try adding:
++
++ -DSELECT
++
++ to the CFLAGS, and removing -DRDCHK or -DCK_POLL if it is there. If
++ you get compilation errors, some adjustments to ck*tio.c and/or
++ ck*net.c might be needed; search for SELECT (uppercase) in these files
++ (note that there are several variations on the calling conventions for
++ select()).
++
++ Various macros and data types need to be defined in order to use
++ select(). Usually these are picked up from <types.h> or <sys/types.h>.
++ But on some systems, they are in <sys/select.h>. In that case, add the
++ following:
++
++ -DSELECT_H
++
++ to the CFLAGS to tell C-Kermit to #include <sys/select.h>. A good
++ indication that you need to do this would be if you get compile-time
++ complaints about "fd_set" or "FD_SET" not being declared or defined.
++
++ In UNIX, the use of select() vs fork() in the CONNECT command is
++ independent of the above considerations, and is governed by choosing a
++ particular makefile target.
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, select() is also the preferred control mechanism
++ for the CONNECT command. Unfortunately, the structures used by the
++ original UNIX CONNECT command, based on fork(), and those used by
++ select(), are so different, it was not practical to implement them
++ both in one module. So the select()-based CONNECT command module for
++ UNIX is [138]ckucns.c, and the fork-based one remains [139]ckucon.c.
++ To choose the fork-based one, which is more portable (but slower and
++ more fragile), use "wermit" as the make target. To choose the
++ select-based one, use "xermit". Only do this if you can verify that
++ the CONNECT command works on serial connections and PIPE connections
++ as well as TCP connections.
++
++ The select()-based Unix CONNECT module, ckucns.c, must be used if
++ encryption is to be done, since the fork() version (ckucon.c) loses
++ its ability to share vital state information between the two forks.
++ Also note that the select() version is superior in many other ways
++ too. For example, it recovers better from exterior killing, forced
++ disconnections, etc, plus it goes faster.
++
++ SHOW VERSIONS tells whether the CONNECT module uses fork() or
++ select().
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 adds learned script capability, which depends on
++ select(). All the "wermit" based targets (as opposed to "xermit") had
++ NOLEARN added to them. Whenever changing a target over from wermit to
++ xermit, also remember to remove NOLEARN.
++
++ [ [140]C-Kermit Home ] [ [141]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 12. I/O REDIRECTION
++
++ [ [142]Top ] [ [143]Contents ] [ [144]Next ] [ [145]Previous ]
++
++ The REDIRECT command allows a local program to be run with its i/o
++ redirected over the communications connection. Your version of
++ C-Kermit has a REDIRECT command if it was built with the following
++ CFLAG:
++
++ -DCK_REDIR
++
++ This, in turn, is possible only if the underlying API is there. In the
++ case of UNIX this is just the wait() system call, so all UNIX versions
++ get this feature as of 6.0.192 (earlier versions needed a <sys/wait.h>
++ header file defining the symbols WIFEXITED and WEXITSTATUS).
++
++ As of version 7.0, file transfer can be done using pipes and filters.
++ To enable this feature, #define PIPESEND (and fill in the code). To
++ disable on systems where it is normally enabled, define NOPIPESEND.
++ This feature is, of course, also disabled by building with NOPUSH (or
++ giving the "nopush" command at runtime).
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 also adds the PIPE and SET HOST /COMMAND commands, which
++ provide another form of redirection. This feature is selected with
++ -DNETCMD. CK_RDIR must also be defined, since the same mechanisms are
++ used internally.
++
++ [ [146]C-Kermit Home ] [ [147]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 13. FLOATING-POINT NUMBERS, TIMERS, AND ARITHMETIC
++
++ [ [148]Top ] [ [149]Contents ] [ [150]Next ] [ [151]Previous ]
++
++ Floating-point support was added in C-Kermit 7.0.
++
++ Floating-point numbers are enabled internally, at least for use in
++ high-precision file-transfer timers and statistics, unless the
++ following symbol is defined at compile time:
++
++ -DNOFLOAT
++
++ This might be necessary on old PCs that do not have built-in
++ floating-point hardware.
++
++ When NOFLOAT is not defined, the following symbol tells which
++ floating-point type to use:
++
++ -DCKFLOAT=xxxx
++
++ The value is either "double" (normal for 32- and 16-bit architectures)
++ or "float" (normal for 64-bit architectures).
++
++ C-Kermit can be configured to use high-precision file-transfer timers
++ for more accurate statistics. This feature is enabled with:
++
++ -DGFTIMER
++
++ and disabled with:
++
++ -DNOGFTIMER
++
++ If you try to build with -DGFTIMER but you get compilation errors,
++ either fix them (and send email to kermit@columbia.edu telling what
++ you did), or else give up and use -DNOGFTIMER (or -DNOFLOAT) instead.
++ Hint: depending on your machine architecture, you might have better
++ luck using double than float as the data type for floating-point
++ numbers, or vice versa. Look in [152]ckcdeb.h for the CKFLOAT
++ definition.
++
++ Floating-point arithmetic is also supported in the script programming
++ language. First via the \fpp...() functions, such as \fppadd(), which
++ adds two floating-point numbers, second in S-Expressions. Addition,
++ subtraction, multiplication, and division are always available. But
++ other functions such as logs, raising to powers, sines and cosines,
++ etc, require the C Math library. To include user-level floating-point
++ math you must put:
++
++ -DFNFLOAT
++
++ and in Unix you must link with the Math library:
++
++ LIBS=".... -lm"
++
++ In K95 and VMS, FNFLOAT is defined automatically if CKFLOAT is
++ defined. In Unix, however, FNFLOAT must be added to each makefile
++ target individually, because of the special linking instructions that
++ must also be added to each target.
++
++ Note: S-Expressions require FNFLOAT.
++
++ [ [153]C-Kermit Home ] [ [154]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 14. SPECIAL CONFIGURATIONS
++
++ [ [155]Top ] [ [156]Contents ] [ [157]Previous ]
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, if you build C-Kermit normally, but with -DNOICP
++ (No Interactive Command Parser), you get a program capable of making
++ serial connections (but not dialing) and network connections (if
++ TCPSOCKET or other network option included), and can also transfer
++ files using Kermit protocol, but only via autodownload/upload.
++ Furthermore, if you call the executable "telnet", it will act like
++ Telnet -- using the command-line options. However, in this case there
++ is nothing to escape back to, so if you type Ctrl-\c, it just prints a
++ message to this effect.
++
++ You can also build C-Kermit with -DNOXFER, meaning omit all the
++ file-transfer features. This leaves you with a scriptable
++ communications program that is considerably smaller than the full
++ C-Kermit.
++
++ [ [158]C-Kermit Home ] [ [159]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ APPENDIX I: SUMMARY OF COMPILE-TIME OPTIONS
++
++ [ [160]Top ] [ [161]Contents ]
++
++ These are the symbols that can be specified on the cc command line,
++ listed alphabetically. Others are used internally, including those
++ taken from header files, those defined by the compiler itself, and
++ those inferred from the ones given below. Kermit's SHOW VERSIONS
++ command attempts to display most of these. See [162]ckcdeb.h and
++ [163]ckcnet.h for inference rules. For example SVR3 implies ATTSV,
++ MULTINET implies TCPSOCKET, and so on.
++
++ Here is the complete list of the Kermit-specific compile-time
++ switches:
++
++ ACUCNTRL Select BSD 4.3-style acucntrl() bidirectional tty control.
++ aegis Build for Apollo Aegis (predefined on Apollo systems).
++ AIX370 Build for IBM AIX/370 for IBM mainframes.
++ AIXESA Build for IBM AIX/ESA for IBM mainframes.
++ AIXPS2 Build for IBM AIX 3.0 for PS/2 series (never formally
++ released).
++ AIXRS Build for IBM AIX 3.x on RS/6000.
++ AIX41 Build for IBM AIX 4.x on RS/6000.
++ AMIGA Build for Commodore Amiga with Intuition OS.
++ ATT6300 Build for AT&T 6300 PLUS.
++ ATT7300 Build for AT&T 7300 UNIX PC (3B1).
++ ATTSV Build for AT&T System III or V UNIX.
++ AUX Build for Apple A/UX for the Macintosh.
++ BIGBUFOK OK to use big buffers - "memory is not a problem"
++ BPS_xxxx Enable SET SPEED xxxx
++ BSD29 Build for BSD 2.9 or 2.10.
++ BSD4 Build for BSD 4.2.
++ BSD41 Build for BSD 4.1.
++ BSD43 Build for BSD 4.3.
++ BSD44 Build for BSD 4.4.
++ C70 Build for BBN C/70.
++ CIE Build for CIE Systems 680/20.
++ CKCONINTB4CB Work around prompt-disappears after escape back from
++ CONNECT.
++ CKLEARN Build with support for learned scripts.
++ CKLOGDIAL Enable connection log.
++ CKMAXPATH Maximum length for a fully qualified filename.
++ CKREGEX (misnomer) Include [...] or {xxx,xxx,xxx} matching in
++ ckmatch().
++ CKSYSLOG Enable syslogging.
++ CK_ANSIC Enable ANSI C constructs - prototypes, etc.
++ CK_ANSILIBS Use header files for ANSI C libraries.
++ CK_APC Enable APC execution by CONNECT module.
++ CK_CURSES Enable fullscreen file transfer display.
++ CK_DSYSINI Use system-wide init file, with name supplied by Kermit.
++ CK_DTRCD DTR/CD flow control is available.
++ CK_FAST Build with fast Kermit protocol defaults.
++ CK_FORK_SIG UNIX only: signal() number for CONNECT module forks.
++ CK_IFRO IF REMOTE command is available (and can run in remote mode).
++ CK_INI_A System-wide init file takes precedence over user's.
++ CK_INI_B User's init file takes precedence over the system-wide one.
++ CK_LABELED Include support for SET FILE TYPE LABELED.
++ CK_LBRK This version can send Long BREAK.
++ CK_LINGER Add code to turn of TCP socket "linger" parameter.
++ CK_MKDIR This version has a zmkdir() command to create directories.
++ CK_NAWS Include TELNET Negotiate About Window Size support.
++ CK_NEWTERM Use newterm() rather than initscr() to initialize curses.
++ CK_PAM Include PAM authentication (might also require -lpam).
++ CK_PCT_BAR Fullscreen file transfer display should include
++ "thermometer".
++ CK_POLL System-V or POSIX based UNIX has poll() function.
++ CK_POSIX_SIG Use POSIX signal handing: sigjmp_buf, sigsetjmp,
++ siglongjmp.
++ CK_READ0 read(fd,&x,0) can be used to test TCP/IP connections.
++ CK_REDIR Enable the REDIRECT command.
++ CK_RESEND Include the RESEND command (needs zfseek() + append).
++ CK_RTSCTS RTS/CTS flow control is available.
++ CK_SHADOW Include support for shadow passwords (e.g. for IKSD
++ authentication).
++ CK_SOCKBUF Enable TCP socket-buffer-size-increasing code.
++ CK_SOCKS UNIX only: Build with socks library rather than regular
++ sockets
++ CK_SOCKS5 UNIX only: Build with socks 5 lib rather than regular
++ sockets
++ CK_SPEED Enable control-character unprefixing.
++ CK_SYSINI="xxxxx" Quoted string to be used as system-wide init file
++ name.
++ CK_TIMERS Build with support for dynamically calculated packet
++ timeouts.
++ CK_TMPDIR This version of Kermit has an isdir() function.
++ CK_TTYFD Defined on systems where the communications connection file
++ descriptor (ttyfd) can be passed to other processes as a command-line
++ argument via \v(ttyfd).
++ CK_URL Parse URLs as well as hostnames, etc.
++ CK_XONXOFF Xon/Xoff flow control available.
++ CK_XYZ Include support for XYZMODEM protocols.
++ CK_WREFRESH Curses package includes wrefresh(),clearok() for screen
++ refresh.
++ CKFLOAT=type Floating-point data type, "double" or "float".
++ CKTYP_H=xxx Force include of xxx as <types.h> file.
++ CLSOPN When hanging up a tty device, also close and reopen it.
++ CMDDEP Maximum recursion depth for self-referential user-defined fn's.
++ COHERENT Build for Mark Williams Coherent UNIX
++ CONGSPD Define if this version has congspd() routine in ck?tio.c
++ datageneral Build for Data General AOS/VS or AOS/VS II
++ DCLPOPEN popen() is available but needs to be declared
++ DEC_TCPIP Build with support for DEC TCP/IP (UCX) for (Open)VMS
++ DGUX430 Build for DG/UX 4.30
++ DGUX540 Build for DG/UX 5.40
++ DEFPAR=x Default parity, 0, 'e', 'o', 'm', or 's'.
++ DFTTY=xxx Default communications device name.
++ DIRENT UNIX directory structure to be taken from <dirent.h>.
++ DIRPWDRP Prompt for password in REMOTE CWD command.
++ DTILDE Include UNIX ~ notation for username/home-directory
++ DYNAMIC Allocate file transfer packet buffers dynamically with malloc.
++ ENCORE Build for Encore Multimax computers.
++ EXCELAN Build with excelan TCP/IP.
++ FNFLOAT Include floating-point math functions (logs, sin, cos, exp,
++ etc)
++ FT18 Build for Fortune For:Pro 1.8.
++ FT21 Build for Fortune For:Pro 2.1.
++ GEMDOS Build for Atari ST GEMDOS.
++ GFTIMER Use high-precision floating-point file-transfer timers.
++ GID_T=xxx Group IDs are of type xxx (usually int, short, or gid_t).
++ HADDRLIST If gethostbyname() hostent struct contains a list of
++ addresses.
++ HDBUUCP Build with support for Honey DanBer UUCP.
++ HPUX Build for Hewlett Packard HP-UX.
++ HPUX9 Build for Hewlett Packard HP-UX 9.x.
++ HPUX10 Build for Hewlett Packard HP-UX 10.x.
++ HWPARITY Define if this version can SET PARITY HARDWARE { EVEN,
++ ODD...}
++ I386IX Build for Interactive System V R3.
++ IFDEBUG Add IF stmts "if (deblog)" before "debug()" calls.
++ INADDRX TCP/IP inet_addr() type is struct inaddr, not unsigned long.
++ INTERLAN Build with support for Racal/Interlan TCP/IP.
++ ISDIRBUG System defs of S_ISDIR and S_ISREG have bug, define
++ ourselves.
++ ISIII Build for Interactive System III.
++ IX370 Build for IBM IX/370.
++ KANJI Build with Kanji character-set translation support.
++ LCKDIR UUCP lock directory is /usr/spool/uucp/LCK/.
++ LFDEVNO UUCP lockfile name uses device numbers, as in SVR4.
++ LINUXFSSTND For Linux, use FSSTND UUCP lockfile conventions (default).
++ LOCK_DIR=xxx UUCP lock directory is xxx (quoted string).
++ LOCKF Use lockf() (in addition to lockfiles) on serial lines
++ LONGFN BSD long filenames supported using <dir.h> and opendir().
++ LYNXOS Build for Lynx OS 2.2 or later (POSIX-based).
++ MAC Build for Apple Macintosh with Mac OS.
++ MATCHDOT Make wildcards match filenames that start with period (.)
++ MAXRP=number Maximum receive-packet length.
++ MAXSP=number Maximum send-packet length.
++ MDEBUG Malloc-debugging requested.
++ MINIDIAL Minimum modem dialer support: CCITT, Hayes, Unkown, and None.
++ MINIX Build for MINIX.
++ MIPS Build for MIPS workstation.
++ MULTINET Build with support for TGV MultiNet TCP/IP (VAX/VMS).
++ M_UNIX Defined by SCO.
++ NAP The nap() is available (conflicts with SELECT and USLEEP)
++ NAPHACK The nap() call is available but only as syscall(3112,...)
++ NDIR BSD long filenames supported using <ndir.h> and opendir().
++ NDGPWNAM Don't declare getpwnam().
++ NDSYSERRLIST Don't declare sys_errlist[].
++ NEEDSELECTDEFS select() is avaible but we need to define FD_blah
++ ourselves.
++ NETCMD Build with support for SET HOST /COMMAND and PIPE commands.
++ NEXT Build for NeXT Mach 1.x or 2.x or 3.0, 3.1, or 3.2.
++ NEXT33 Build for NeXT Mach 3.3.
++ NOANSI Disable ANSI C function prototyping.
++ NOAPC Do not include CK_APC code.
++ NOARROWKEYS Exclude code to parse ANSI arrow-key sequences.
++ NOB_xxxx Disable SET SPEED xxxx
++ NOBIGBUF Override BIGBUFOK when it is the default
++ NOBRKC Don't try to refer to t_brkc or t_eof tchars structure members.
++ NOCKFQHOSTNAME Exclude code to get fully qualified hostname in case it
++ causes core dumps.
++ NOCCTRAP Disable Control-C (SIGINT) trapping.
++ NOCKSPEED Disable control-prefix removal feature (SET CONTROL).
++ NOCKTIMERS Build without support for dynamic timers.
++ NOCKXYZ Overrides CK_XYZ.
++ NOCKREGEX Do not include [...] or {xxx,xxx,xxx} matching in ckmatch().
++ NOCMDL Build with no command-line option processing.
++ NOCOTFMC No Close(Open()) To Force Mode Change (UNIX version).
++ NOCSETS Build with no support for character set translation.
++ NOCYRIL Build with no support for Cyrillic character set translation.
++ NOCYRILLIC Ditto.
++ NODEBUG Build with no debug logging capability.
++ NODIAL Build with no DIAL or SET DIAL commands.
++ NODISPO Build to always refuse incoming MAIL or REMOTE PRINT files.
++ DNODISPLAY Build with no file-transfer display.
++ NOESCSEQ Build with no support for ANSI escape sequence recognition.
++ NOFAST Do not make FAST Kermit protocol settings the default.
++ NOFDZERO Do not use file descriptor 0 for remote-mode file transfer.
++ NOFILEH Do not #include <sys/file.h>.
++ NOFLOAT Don't include any floating-point data types or operations.
++ NOFRILLS Build with "no frills" (this should be phased out...)
++ NOFTRUNCATE Include this on UNIXes that don't have ftruncate().
++ NOGETUSERSHELL Include this on UNIXes that don't have getusershell().
++ NOGFTIMER Don't use high-precision floating-point file-transfer
++ timers.
++ NOHEBREW Build with no support for Hebrew character sets.
++ NOHELP Build with no built-in help.
++ NOIKSD Build with IKSD support excluded.
++ NOINITGROUPS Include this on UNIXes that don't have initgroups().
++ NOICP Build with no interactive command parser.
++ NOJC Build with no support for job control (suspend).
++ NOKANJI Build with no support for Japanese Kanji character sets.
++ NOKVERBS Build with no support for keyboard verbs (\Kverbs).
++ NOLATIN2 Build with no ISO Latin-2 character-set translation support.
++ NOLEARN Build with no support for learned scripts.
++ NOLINKBITS Use of S_ISLNK and _IFLNK untrustworthy; use readlink()
++ instead.
++ NOLOCAL Build without any local-mode features: No Making Connections.
++ NOLOGDIAL Disable connection log.
++ NOLOGIN Build without IKSD (network login) support.
++ NOLSTAT Not OK to use lstat().
++ NOMDMHUP Build without "modem-specific hangup" (e.g. ATH0) feature.
++ NOMHHOST Exclude the multihomed-host TCP/IP code (if compilcation
++ errors)
++ NOMINPUT Build without MINPUT command.
++ NOMSEND Build with no MSEND command.
++ NONAWS Do not include TELNET Negotiate About Window Size support.
++ NONET Do not include any network support.
++ NONOSETBUF (See NOSETBUF)
++ NOPARSEN Build without automatic parity detection.
++ NOPIPESEND Disable file transfer using pipes and filters.
++ NOPOLL Override CK_POLL definition.
++ NOPOPEN The popen() library call is not available.
++ NOPURGE Build with no PURGE command.
++ NOPUSH Build with no escapes to operating system.
++ NOREALPATH In UNIX, realpath() function is not available.
++ NORECALL Disable the command-recall feature.
++ NOREDIRECT Disable REDIRECT command.
++ NORENAME Don't use rename() system call, use link()/unlink() (UNIX).
++ NORESEND Build with no RESEND command.
++ NORETRY Build with no command-retry feature.
++ NOSCRIPT Build with no SCRIPT command.
++ NOSELECT Don't try to use select().
++ NOSERVER Build with no SERVER mode and no server-related commands.
++ NOSETBUF Don't make console writes unbuffered.
++ NONOSETBUF DO make console writes unbuffered.
++ NOSETREU setreuid() and/or setregid() not available.
++ NOSHOW Build with no SHOW command (not recommended!).
++ NOSIGWINCH Disable SIGWINCH signal trapping.
++ NOSPL Build with no script programming language.
++ NOSTAT Don't call stat() from mainline code.
++ NOSYMLINK Include this for UNIXes that don't have readlink().
++ NOSYSIOCTLH Do not #include <sys/ioctl.h>.
++ NOSYSTIMEH Co not include <sys/time.h>.
++ NOSYSLOG Disable syslogging code.
++ NOTCPOPTS Build with no SET TCP options or underlying support.
++ NOTLOG Build with no support for transaction logging.
++ NOTM_ISDST Struct tm has no tm_isdst member.
++ NOUNICODE Build with no support for Unicode character-set translation.
++ NOURL Don't parse URLs
++ NOUUCP Build with no UUCP lockfile support (dangerous!).
++ NOWARN Make EXIT WARNING be OFF by default (otherwise it's ON).
++ NOWREFRESH Override built-in definition of CK_WREFRESH (q.v.).
++ NOXFER Build with no Kermit or other file-transfer protocols.
++ NOXMIT Build with no TRANSMIT command.
++ NOXPRINT Disables transparent print code.
++ OLDMSG Use old "entering server mode" message (see [164]ckcmai.c).
++ OLINUXHISPEED Build in old Linux hi-serial-speed code (for Linux <=
++ 1.0).
++ OPENBSD Build for OpenBSD.
++ OS2 Build for OS/2.
++ OSF Build for OSF/1.
++ OSFPC Build for OSF/1 on a PC.
++ OSF32 Digital UNIX 3.2 or later.
++ OSF40 Build for Digital UNIX 4.0.
++ OSF50 Build for Digital UNIX 5.0.
++ OSK Build for OS-9.
++ OXOS Build for Olivetti X/OS 2.3.
++ PCIX Build for PC/IX
++ PID_T=xxx Type for pids is xxx (normally int or pid_t).
++ POSIX Build for POSIX: use POSIX header files, functions, etc.
++ _POSIX_SOURCE Disable non-POSIX features.
++ PROVX1 Build for Venix 1.0 on DEC Professional 3xx.
++ PTX Build for Dynix/PTX
++ PWID_T=xxx getpwid() type is xxx.
++ RBSIZ=xxx Define overall size of receive-packet buffer (with DYNAMIC).
++ RDCHK rdchk() system call is available.
++ RENAME rename() system call is available (UNIX).
++ RTAIX Build for AIX 2.2.1 on IBM RT PC.
++ RTU Build for Masscomp / Concurrent RTU.
++ SAVEDUID BSD or other non-AT&T UNIX has saved-setuid feature.
++ SBSIZ=xxx Define overall size of send-packet buffer (use with
++ DYNAMIC).
++ SDIRENT Directory structure specified in <sys/dirent.h>.
++ SELECT select() function available (conflicts with RDCHK and CK_POLL)
++ SELECT_H Include <sys/select.h> for select()-releated definitions.
++ SETEUID BSD 4.4-style seteXid() functions available.
++ SIG_V Type for signal() is void. Used to override normal assumption.
++ SIG_I Type for signal() is int. Used to override normal assumption.
++ SOCKOPT_T Override default data type for get/setsockopt() option
++ length.
++ SOLARIS Build for Solaris.
++ SOLARIS25 Build for Solaris 2.5 or later.
++ SONYNEWS Build for Sony NEWS-OS.
++ STERMIOX <sys/termiox.h> is available.
++ STRATUS Build for Stratus VOS.
++ STRATUSX25 Include Stratus VOS X.25 support.
++ SUN4S5 Build for SUNOS 4.x in the System V R3 environment.
++ SUNOS4 Build for SUNOS 4.0 in the BSD environment.
++ SUNOS41 Build for SUNOS 4.1 in the BSD environment.
++ SUNX25 Build with support for SunLink X.25.
++ SVR3 Build for AT&T System V Release 3.
++ SVR3JC Allow job control support on System V Release 3 UNIX versions.
++ SVR4 Build for AT&T System V Release 4.
++ SW_ACC_ID UNIX only -- swap real & effective ids around access()
++ calls.
++ sxaE50 Build for PFU Compact A Series SX/A TISP.
++ SYSLOGLEVEL=n Force syslogging at given level.
++ SYSTIMEH Include <sys/time.h>.
++ SYSUTIMEH Include <sys/utime.h> for setting file dates (88OPEN)
++ TCPSOCKET Build with support for TCP/IP via Berkeley sockets library.
++ TERMIOX <termiox.h> header file is available (mostly SVR4).
++ TNCODE Include TELNET-specific code.
++ TOWER1 Build for NCR Tower 1632 with OS 1.02.
++ TRS16 Build for Tandy 16/6000.
++ UID_T=xxx Type for uids is xxx (normally int or uid_t).
++ UNIX Must be defined for all UNIX versions.
++ UNIX351M AT&T UNIX 3.51m on the AT&T 7300 UNIX PC.
++ USE_ARROWKEYS Include code to parse ANSI arrow-key sequences.
++ USE_LSTAT OK to use lstat().
++ USE_MEMCPY Define this if memcpy()/memset()/memmove() available.
++ USE_STRERROR Define this if strerror() is available.
++ USLEEP usleep() system call available (conflicts with NAP & SELECT).
++ UTEK Build for Tektronix workstations with UTEK OS.
++ UTIMEH Include <utime.h> for setting file dates (SVR4, POSIX)
++ UTS24 Build for Amdahl UTS 2.4.
++ V7 Build for Version 7 UNIX.
++ VMS Build for VAX/VMS.
++ VOID=xxx VOID type for functions (int or void).
++ VXVE Build for CDC VX/VE 5.2.1.
++ WAIT_T=xxx Type of argument passed to wait().
++ WINTCP Build with Wollongong VAX/VMS TCP/IP (implies TCPSOCKET)
++ WOLLONGONG Build with Wollongong UNIX TCP/IP (implies TCPSOCKET)
++ XENIX Build for Xenix (SCO, Tandy, others).
++ XNDIR Support for BSD long filenames via <sys/ndir.h>.
++ XYZ_INTERNAL Support for XYZMODEM protocols is internal, not external.
++ ZFCDAT Define this if zfcdat() function is available in Kermit.
++ ZILOG Build for Zilog ZEUS.
++ ZJDATE Has zjdate() function that converts date to Julian format.
++ XPRINT Transparent print code included in CONNECT module.
++
++ [ [165]Top ] [ [166]Contents ] [ [167]C-Kermit Home ] [ [168]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++
++ C-Kermit Configuration Options / [169]The Kermit Project /
++ [170]Columbia University / [171]kermit@columbia.edu / 14 March 2003
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 4. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 5. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 6. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x1
++ 7. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x2
++ 8. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x3
++ 9. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x4
++ 10. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x5
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x6
++ 12. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x7
++ 13. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8
++ 14. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x9
++ 15. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x10
++ 16. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x11
++ 17. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x12
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x13
++ 19. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x14
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#xa1
++ 21. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 22. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 23. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 24. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 25. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 26. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x2
++ 27. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x0
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 29. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 30. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 31. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x3
++ 33. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x1
++ 34. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 35. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 36. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuus3.c
++ 37. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 38. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 39. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 42. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 43. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 44. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x4
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x2
++ 46. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/makefile
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 48. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x4
++ 49. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x9.2
++ 50. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusx.c
++ 51. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 52. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 53. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusx.c
++ 54. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckucmd.c
++ 55. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 56. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 57. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 58. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 59. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x5
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x3
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/unicode.html
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 66. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x6
++ 67. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x4
++ 68. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusr.h
++ 69. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusr.h
++ 70. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 71. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 72. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 73. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 74. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x7
++ 75. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x5
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x6.1
++ 77. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x6.2
++ 78. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x6.3
++ 79. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x6.4
++ 80. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x4
++ 81. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/gkermit.html
++ 82. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusr.h
++ 83. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcker.h
++ 84. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 85. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 86. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 87. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 88. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 89. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8
++ 90. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x6
++ 91. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckudia.c
++ 92. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 93. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 94. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 95. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 96. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x9
++ 97. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x7
++ 98. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.1
++ 99. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.2
++ 100. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.3
++ 101. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.1.1
++ 102. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.1.2
++ 103. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.1.3
++ 104. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.1.4
++ 105. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.1.5
++ 106. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8.1.6
++ 107. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.h
++ 108. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckctel.c
++ 109. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckctel.c
++ 110. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckctel.h
++ 111. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcftp.c
++ 112. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 113. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.c
++ 114. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.h
++ 115. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 116. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x11
++ 117. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
++ 118. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 119. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 120. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 121. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 122. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x10
++ 123. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x8
++ 124. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 125. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 126. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 127. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 128. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x11
++ 129. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x9
++ 130. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x11
++ 131. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 132. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 133. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 134. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 135. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 136. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x12
++ 137. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x10
++ 138. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckucns.c
++ 139. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckucon.c
++ 140. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 141. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 142. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 143. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 144. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x13
++ 145. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x11
++ 146. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 147. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 148. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 149. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 150. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x14
++ 151. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x12
++ 152. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 153. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 154. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 155. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 156. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 157. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#x13
++ 158. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 159. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 160. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 161. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 162. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 163. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.h
++ 164. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcmai.c
++ 165. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#top
++ 166. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html#contents
++ 167. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 168. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 169. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 170. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 171. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckcbwr.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,1467 @@
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 General Hints and Tips
++
++ Frank da Cruz
++ [1]The Kermit Project, [2]Columbia University
++
++ As of: C-Kermit 8.0.211, 17 March 2003
++ This page last updated: Sat Apr 10 16:37:37 2004 (New York USA Time)
++
++ IF YOU ARE READING A PLAIN-TEXT version of this document, it is a
++ plain-text dump of a Web page. You can visit the original (and
++ possibly more up-to-date) Web page here:
++
++ [3]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++
++ This document contains platform-independent C-Kermit hints and tips.
++ Also see the platform-specific C-Kermit hints and tips document for
++ your platform, for example:
++
++ [4]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++
++ for Unix. This document also applies to [5]Kermit 95 for Windows,
++ which is based on C-Kermit.
++
++ [ [6]C-Kermit ] [ [7]TUTORIAL ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ CONTENTS
++
++ 0. [8]PATCHES
++ 1. [9]INCOMPATIBLE CHANGES
++ 2. [10]THE C-KERMIT COMMAND PARSER
++ 3. [11]MULTIPLE SESSIONS
++ 4. [12]NETWORK CONNECTIONS
++ 5. [13]MODEMS AND DIALING
++ 6. [14]DIALING HINTS AND TIPS
++ 7. [15]TERMINAL SERVERS
++ 8. [16]TERMINAL EMULATION
++ 9. [17]KEY MAPPING
++ 10. [18]FILE TRANSFER
++ 11. [19]SCRIPT PROGRAMMING
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 0. PATCHES
++
++ [ [20]Top ] [ [21]Contents ] [ [22]Next ]
++
++ Source-level patches for C-Kermit 8.0.211:
++
++ (None)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1. INCOMPATIBLE CHANGES
++
++ [ [23]Top ] [ [24]Contents ] [ [25]Next ]
++
++ These are not necessarily exhaustive lists.
++
++ 1.1. C-Kermit 6.0
++
++ C-Kermit 6.0 was released 6 September 1996 and is completely
++ documented in [26]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition. The following
++ incompatible changes were made in C-Kermit 6.0:
++
++ * Unless you tell C-Kermit otherwise, if a serial or network
++ connection seems to be open, and you attempt to EXIT or to open a
++ new connection, C-Kermit warns you that an active connection
++ appears to be open and asks you if you really want to close it. If
++ you do not want these warnings, add SET EXIT WARNING OFF to your
++ customization file or script, or give this command at the prompt.
++ * The default for SET { SEND, RECEIVE } PATHNAMES was changed from
++ ON to OFF, to prevent unexpected creation of directories and
++ depositing of incoming files in places you might not know to look.
++ * The default for SET FILE INCOMPLETE was changed from DISCARD to
++ KEEP to allow for file transfer recovery.
++ * The default file-transfer block-check is now 3, rather than 1. If
++ the other Kermit does not support this, the two will drop back to
++ type 1 automatically unless the other Kermit fails to follow the
++ protocol specification.
++ * The default flow-control is now "auto" ("do the right thing for
++ each type of connection"), not Xon/Xoff.
++ * Backslash (\) is no longer a command continuation character. Only
++ - (hyphen, dash) may be used for this in C-Kermit 6.0 and later.
++ * Negative INPUT timeout now results in infinite wait, rather than 1
++ second.
++
++ 1.2. C-Kermit 7.0
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 was released 1 January 2000. Its new features are
++ documented in the C-Kermit 7.0 Supplement,
++ [27]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit2.html. The following
++ incompatible changes were made in C-Kermit 7.0:
++ * The "multiline GET" command is gone. Now use either of the
++ following forms instead:
++ get remote-name local-name
++ get /as-name:local-name remote-name
++ If either name contains spaces, enclose it in braces (or, in
++ C-Kermit 8.0, doublequotes).
++ * To include multiple file specifications in a GET command, you must
++ now use MGET rather than GET:
++ mget file1 file2 file3 ...
++ * C-Kermit 7.0 and later use FAST Kermit protocol settings by
++ default. This includes "unprefixing" of certain control
++ characters. Because of this, file transfers that worked with
++ previous releases might not work in the new release especially
++ against a non-Kermit-Project Kermit protocol implementation (but
++ it is more likely that they will work, and much faster). If a
++ transfer fails, you'll get a context-sensitive hint suggesting
++ possible causes and cures. Usually SET PREFIXING ALL does the
++ trick.
++ * By default C-Kermit 7.0 and later send files in text or binary
++ mode by looking at each file to see which is the appropriate mode.
++ To restore the previous behavior, put SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL and
++ the desired SET FILE TYPE (TEXT or BINARY) in your C-Kermit
++ initialization file.
++ * The RESEND and REGET commands automatically switch to binary mode;
++ previously if RESEND or REGET were attempted when FILE TYPE was
++ TEXT, these commands would fail immediately, with a message
++ telling you they work only when the FILE TYPE is BINARY. Now they
++ simply do this for you.
++ * SET PREFIXING CAUTIOUS and MINIMAL now both prefix linefeed (10
++ and 138) in case rlogin, ssh, or cu are "in the middle", since
++ otherwise <LF>~ might appear in Kermit packets, and this would
++ cause rlogin, ssh, or cu to disconnect, suspend,escape back, or
++ otherwise wreck the file transfer. Xon and Xoff are now always
++ prefixed too, even when Xon/Xoff flow control is not in effect,
++ since unprefixing them has proven dangerous on TCP/IP connections.
++ * In UNIX, VMS, Windows, and OS/2, the DIRECTORY command is built
++ into C-Kermit itself rather than implemented by running an
++ external command or program. The built-in command might not behave
++ the way the platform-specific external one did, but many options
++ are available for customization. Of course the underlying
++ platform-specific command can still be accessed with "!", "@", or
++ "RUN" wherever the installation does not forbid. In UNIX, the "ls"
++ command can be accessed directly as "ls" in C-Kermit.
++ * SEND ? prints a list of switches rather than a list of filenames.
++ If you want to see a list of filenames, use a (system-dependent)
++ construction such as SEND ./? (for UNIX, Windows, or OS/2), SEND
++ []? (VMS), etc.
++ * In UNIX, OS-9, and Kermit 95, the wildcard characters in previous
++ versions were * and ?. In C-Kermit 7.0 they are *, ?, [, ], {, and
++ }, with dash used inside []'s to denote ranges and comma used
++ inside {} to separate list elements. If you need to include any of
++ these characters literally in a filename, precede each one with
++ backslash (\).
++ * SET QUIET { ON, OFF } is now on the command stack, just like SET
++ INPUT CASE, SET COUNT, SET MACRO ERROR, etc, as described on p.458
++ of [28]Using C-Kermit, 2nd Edition. This allows any macro or
++ command file to SET QUIET ON or OFF without worrying about saving
++ and restoring the global QUIET value. For example, this lets you
++ write a script that tries SET LINE on lots of devices until it
++ finds one free without spewing out loads of error messages, and
++ also without disturbing the global QUIET setting, whatever it was.
++ * Because of the new "." operator (which introduces assignments),
++ macros whose names begin with "." can not be invoked "by name".
++ However, they still can be invoked with DO or \fexecute().
++ * The syntax of the EVALUATE command has changed. To restore the
++ previous syntax, use SET EVALUATE OLD.
++ * The \v(directory) variable now includes the trailing directory
++ separator; in previous releases it did not. This is to allow
++ constructions such as:
++ cd \v(dir)data.tmp
++ to work across platforms that might have different directory
++ notation, such as UNIX, Windows, and VMS.
++ * Prior to C-Kermit 7.0, the FLOW-CONTROL setting was global and
++ sticky. In C-Kermit 7.0, there is an array of default flow-control
++ values for each kind of connection, that are applied automatically
++ at SET LINE/PORT/HOST time. Thus a SET FLOW command given before
++ SET LINE/PORT/HOST is likely to be undone. Therefore SET FLOW can
++ be guaranteed to have the desired effect only if given after the
++ SET LINE/PORT/HOST command.
++ * Character-set translation works differently in the TRANSMIT
++ command when (a) the file character-set is not the same as the
++ local end of the terminal character-set, or (b) when the terminal
++ character-set is TRANSPARENT.
++
++ 1.3. C-Kermit 8.0
++
++ The following incompatible changes were made in C-Kermit 8.0:
++ * C-Kermit now accepts doublequotes in most contexts where you
++ previously had to use braces to group multiple words into a single
++ field, or to force inclusion of leading or trailing blanks. This
++ might cause problems in contexts where you wanted the doublequote
++ characters to be taken literally. Consult [29]Section 5 of the
++ [30]C-Kermit 8.0 Update Notes for further information.
++ * Using the SET HOST command to make HTTP connections is no longer
++ supported. Instead, use the new [31]HTTP OPEN command.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2. THE C-KERMIT COMMAND PARSER
++
++ [ [32]Top ] [ [33]Contents ] [ [34]Next ] [ [35]Previous ]
++
++ Various command-related limits are shown in the following table, in
++ which the sample values are for a "large memory model" build of
++ C-Kermit, typical for modern platforms (Linux, Solaris, AIX, VMS,
++ etc). You can see the values for your version of Kermit by giving the
++ SHOW FEATURES command. The maximum length for a Kermit command (CMDBL)
++ also determines the maximum length for a macro definition, since
++ DEFINE is itself a command. The maximum length for a variable name is
++ between 256 and 4096 characters, depending on the platform; for array
++ declarations and references, that includes the subscript.
++ ______________________________________________________________
++
++ Item Symbol Sample
++ Value Definition
++ Number of characters in a command CMDBL 32763 ckucmd.h
++ Number of chars in a field of a command ATMBL 10238 ckucmd.h
++ Nesting level for command files MAXTAKE 54 ckuusr.h
++ Nesting level for macros MACLEVEL 128 ckuusr.h
++ Nesting level for FOR / WHILE loops FORDEPTH 32 ckuusr.h
++ Number of macros MAC_MAX 16384 ckuusr.h
++ Size of INPUT buffer INPBUFSIZ 4096 ckuusr.h
++ Maximum files to match a wildcard MAXWLD 102400 ckcdeb.h
++ Filespecs in MSEND command MSENDMAX 1024 ckuusr.h
++ Length for GOTO target label LBLSIZ 50 ckuusr.h
++ \fexecute() recursion depth limit CMDDEP 64 ckucmd.h
++ ______________________________________________________________
++
++ If you need to define a macro that is longer than CMDBL, you can break
++ the macro up into sub-macros or rewrite the macro as a command file.
++ In a pinch you can also redefine CMDBL and recompile C-Kermit. All of
++ these numbers represent tradeoffs: the bigger the number, the more
++ "powerful" Kermit in the corresponding area, but also the bigger the
++ program image and possibly disk footprint, and the longer it takes to
++ load and initialize.
++
++ In the interactive command parser:
++
++ * EMACS- or VI-style command line editing is not supported.
++ * Editing keys are hardwired (Ctrl-U, Ctrl-W, etc).
++
++ If you interrupt C-Kermit before it has issued its first prompt, it
++ will exit. This means that you cannot interrupt execution of the
++ initialization file, or of an "application file" (file whose name is
++ given as the first command-line argument), or of an alternative
++ initialization file ("-y filename"), and get to the prompt. There is,
++ however, one exception to this rule: you *can* interrupt commands --
++ including TAKE commands -- given in the '-C "command list"'
++ command-line argument and -- if there were no action commands among
++ the command-line arguments -- you will be returned to the C-Kermit
++ prompt. So, for example, if you want to start C-Kermit in such a way
++ that it executes a command file before issuing its first prompt, and
++ you also want to be able to interrupt the command file and get to the
++ prompt, include a TAKE command for the desired command in the -C
++ argument, for example:
++
++ kermit -C "take dial.scr"
++
++ At the command prompt, if you use the backslash (\) prefix to enter a
++ control character, space, or question mark into a command literally,
++ the backslash disappears and is replaced by the quoted character. If
++ it was a control character, it is shown as a circumflex (^). This
++ allows editing (backspace, delete, Ctrl-W) to work correctly even for
++ control characters.
++
++ Priot to C-Kermit 8.0, the only way to include a comma literally in a
++ macro definition -- as opposed to having it separate commands within
++ the definition -- is to enter its ASCII value (44) in backslash
++ notation, e.g.:
++
++ DEFINE ROWS RUN MODE CO80\{44}\%1
++
++ In C-Kermit 8.0 you can use constructions like this:
++
++ DEFINE ROWS RUN MODE "CO80,\%1"
++
++ If you quote special characters in a filename (e.g. in the SEND
++ command), filename completion may seem to work incorrectly. For
++ example, if you have a file whose name is a*b (the name really
++ contains an asterisk), and you type "send a\\*<ESC>", the "b" does not
++ appear, nor will Ctrl-R redisplay the completed name correctly. But
++ internally the file name is recognized anyway.
++
++ Question-mark help does not work during execution of an ASKQ command.
++ The question marks are simply accepted as text.
++
++ In OUTPUT commands only, \B sends a BREAK signal, \L sends a Long
++ BREAK signal, and \N sends a NUL (ASCII 0). BREAK and Long BREAK are
++ special signals, not characters, and NUL is a character that normally
++ cannot be included in a C string, since it is the C string terminator.
++ If you really want to output a backslash followed by a B, an L, or an
++ N (as is needed to configure certain modems, etc), double the
++ backslash, e.g. "output \\B". In C-Kermit 7.0 or later, you can disarm
++ and re-arm the special OUTPUT-command escapes (\B, \L, and \N) with
++ SET OUTPUT SPECIAL-ESCAPES { OFF, ON }.
++
++ When using the command-line processor ("kermit -l /dev/tty00 -b
++ 19200", etc), note that in some cases the order of the command-line
++ options makes a difference, contrary to the expectation that order of
++ command-line options should not matter. For example, the -b option
++ must be given after the -l option if it is to affect the device
++ specified in the -l option.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3. MULTIPLE SESSIONS
++
++ [ [36]Top ] [ [37]Contents ] [ [38]Next ] [ [39]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 and earlier do not support multiple sessions. When you
++ SET LINE (or SET PORT, same thing) to a new device, or SET HOST to a
++ new host, the previous SET LINE device or network host connection is
++ closed, resulting in hangup of the modem or termination of the network
++ connection. In windowing environments like HP-VUE, NeXTSTEP, Windows,
++ OS/2, etc, you can run separate copies of Kermit in different windows
++ to achieve multiple sessions.
++
++ To achieve multiple sessions through a single serial port (e.g. when
++ dialing up), you can install SLIP or PPP on your computer and then use
++ C-Kermit's TCP/IP support over the SLIP or PPP connection, assuming
++ you also have TCP/IP networking installed on your computer.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 has the same restriction on SET LINE and SET HOST
++ sessions: only one regular session (dialout, Telnet, etc) can be open
++ at a time. However, version 8.0 adds two new kinds of sessions: FTP
++ and HTTP; one or both of these can be open at the same as a regular
++ session.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4. NETWORK CONNECTIONS
++
++ [ [40]Top ] [ [41]Contents ] [ [42]Next ] [ [43]Previous ]
++
++ FTP Client Bugs
++
++ The Unix C-Kermit 8.0.206 FTP client had the following bugs at the
++ time most of the 8.0.206 binaries were built for the C-Kermit 8.0
++ CDROM:
++
++ 1. FTP MGET fails when directory segments contain wildcards, as in
++ "ftp mget */data/*.dat". Work around by doing a separate MGET for
++ each source directory.
++ 2. FTP MGET can fail or produce random side effects if you have a
++ TMPDIR or CK_TMP environment variable definition in effect, or a
++ SET TEMP-DIRECTORY value, longer than 7 characters. Work around by
++ giving a SET TEMP-DIRECTORY command with a short value, such as
++ "/tmp".
++
++ These two bugs are fixed in the source code that is included on the
++ CDROM, and also in Kermit 95 2.1.1. You can tell if a C-Kermit 8.0.206
++ binary has these fixes by typing SHOW VERSION; if it says "FTP Client,
++ 8.0.200, 24 Oct 2002" it has the fixes; if the edit number is less
++ that 200, it doesn't, in which case can build a new binary from the
++ source code (or contact us and we'll try to get get one for you).
++
++ Making TCP/IP Connections Can Take a Long Time
++
++ The most frequently asked question in many newsgroups is "Why does it
++ take such a long time to make a Telnet connection to (or from) my
++ (e.g.) Linux PC?" (this applies to Kermit as well as to regular Telnet
++ clients):
++
++ 1. Most Telnet servers perform reverse DNS lookups on the client for
++ security and/or logging reasons. If the Telnet client's host
++ cannot be found by the server's local DNS server, the DNS request
++ goes out to the Internet at large, and this can take quite some
++ time. The solution to this problem is to make sure that both
++ client and host are registered in DNS.
++ 2. C-Kermit itself performs reverse DNS lookups unless you tell it
++ not to. This is to allow C-Kermit to let you know which host it is
++ actually connected to in case you have made a connection to a
++ "host pool" (multihomed host). You can disable C-Kermit's reverse
++ DNS lookup with SET TCP REVERSE-DNS-LOOKUP OFF.
++ 3. C-Kermit 7.0 and later strictly enforce Telnet protocol rules. One
++ such rule is that certain negotiations must be responded to. If
++ C-Kermit sends a such a negotiation and the host does not respond,
++ C-Kermit waits a long time for the reply (in case the network is
++ congested or the host is slow), but eventually will time out. To
++ eliminate the waits (and therefore risk possible protocol
++ mismatches -- or worse -- between Telnet client and server), tell
++ C-Kermit to SET TELNET WAIT OFF (or include the /NOWAIT switch
++ with the TELNET command).
++
++ The Rlogin Client
++
++ In multiuser operating systems such as UNIX and VMS, TCP/IP Rlogin
++ connections are available only to privileged users, since "login" is a
++ privileged socket. Assuming you are allowed to use it in the first
++ place, it is likely to behave differently depending on what type of
++ host you are rlogging in to, due to technical reasons having to do
++ with conflicting interpretations of RFC793 (Out-Of-Band Data) and
++ Rlogin (RFC1122)... "Specifically, the TCP urgent pointer in BSD
++ points to the byte after the urgent data byte, and an RFC-compliant
++ TCP urgent pointer points to the urgent data byte. As a result, if an
++ application sends urgent data from a BSD-compatible implementation to
++ an [44]RFC-1122 compatible implementation then the receiver will read
++ the wrong urgent data byte (it will read the byte located after the
++ correct byte in the data stream as the urgent data byte)." Rlogin
++ requires the use of OOB data while Telnet does not. Therefore, it is
++ possible for Telnet to work between all systems while BSD and System V
++ TCP/IP implementations are almost always a bad mix.
++
++ The Telnet Client
++
++ On a TCP/IP TELNET connection, you should normally have PARITY set to
++ NONE and (except in VMS C-Kermit) FLOW-CONTROL also set to NONE. If
++ file transfer does not work with these settings (for example, because
++ the remote TELNET server only gives a 7-bit data path), use SET PARITY
++ SPACE. Do not use SET PARITY MARK, EVEN, or ODD on a TELNET connection
++ -- it interferes with TELNET protocol.
++
++ If echoing does not work right after connecting to a network host or
++ after dialing through a TCP/IP modem server, it probably means that
++ the TELNET server on the far end of the connection is executing the
++ TELNET protocol incorrectly. After initially connecting and
++ discovering incorrect echoing (characters are echoed twice, or not at
++ all), escape back, give the appropriate SET DUPLEX command (FULL or
++ HALF), and then CONNECT again. For a consistently misbehaving
++ connection, you can automate this process in a macro or TAKE file.
++
++ TELNET sessions are treated just like serial communications sessions
++ as far as "terminal bytesize" and "command bytesize" are concerned. If
++ you need to view and/or enter 8-bit characters during a TELNET
++ session, you must tell C-Kermit to SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE 8, SET
++ COMMAND BYTESIZE 8, and SET PARITY NONE.
++
++ If you SET TELNET DEBUG ON prior to making a connection, protocol
++ negotiations will be displayed on your screen. You can also capture
++ them in the debug log (along with everything else) and then extract
++ them easily, since all Telnet negotiations lines begin with
++ (uppercase) "TELNET".
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 5. MODEMS AND DIALING
++
++ [ [45]Top ] [ [46]Contents ] [ [47]Next ] [ [48]Previous ]
++
++ External modems are recommended because:
++
++ * They don't need any special drivers.
++ * They are less likely to interfere with normal operation of your
++ computer.
++ * You can use the lights and speaker to troubleshoot dialing.
++ * You can share them among all types of computers.
++ * You can easily turn them off and on when power-cycling seems
++ warranted.
++ * They are more likely to have manuals.
++
++ Modems can be used by C-Kermit only when they are visible as or
++ through a regular serial port device. Certain modems can not be used
++ in this normal way on many kinds of computers: Winmodems, RPI modems,
++ Controllerless modems, the IBM Mwave, etc; all of these require
++ special drivers that perform some, most, or all of the modem's
++ functions in software. Such drivers are generally NOT available in
++ UNIX or other non-Windows (or non-OS/2, in the case of the Mwave)
++ platforms.
++
++ In order to dial a modem, C-Kermit must know its repertoire of
++ commands and responses. Each modem make and model is likely to have a
++ different repertoire. Since Kermit has no way of knowhing which kind
++ of modem will be dialed, normally you have to tell it with a SET MODEM
++ TYPE command, e.g.:
++
++ set modem type usrobotics
++ set line /dev/cua0
++ set speed 57600
++ dial 7654321
++
++ In the early days, there was a wide variety of modems and command
++ languages. Nowadays, almost every modem uses the Hayes AT command set
++ (but with some differences in the details) and its startup
++ configuration includes error correction, data compression, and
++ hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control. As long as C-Kermit is capable of
++ hardware flow control (as it is on many, but not all, the platforms
++ where it runs, since some operating systems don't support it), the
++ modem can be dailed immediately, without lengthy configuration
++ dialogs, and in fact this is what SET MODEM TYPE GENERIC-HIGH-SPEED
++ does. In C-Kermit 8.0, GENERIC-HIGH-SPEED has become the default modem
++ type, so now it is usually possible to SET LINE, SET SPEED, and DIAL
++ without having to identify your modem. If this doesn't work, of
++ course, then you might have to fall back to the tradiational method:
++ Give a SET MODEM TYPE for a specific modem first, then SET LINE, SET
++ SPEED, and DIAL.
++
++ An important change in C-Kermit 6.0 is that when you give a SET MODEM
++ TYPE command to tell Kermit what kind of modem you have, Kermit also
++ sets a number of other modem-related parameters automatically from its
++ internal modem database. Thus, the order in which you give
++ modem-related commands is significant, whereas in prior releases they
++ could be given in any order.
++
++ In particular, MODEM SPEED-MATCHING is set according to whether the
++ modem is known to be capable of speed buffering. SET MODEM TYPE
++ HAYES-2400 automatically turns SPEED-MATCHING ON, because when the
++ Hayes 2400 reports a particular speed in its CONNECT message, that
++ means its interface speed has changed to that speed, and C-Kermit's
++ must change accordingly if it is to continue communicating. This might
++ cause some confusion if you use "set modem type hayes" for dialing a
++ more advanced type of modem.
++
++ The new default for flow control is "auto", meaning "do the right
++ thing for each type of connection". So (for example) if your version
++ of C-Kermit supports SET FLOW RTS/CTS and your modem also supports
++ RTS/CTS, then Kermit automatically sets its flow control to RTS/CTS
++ and set modem's flow control to RTS/CTS too before attempting to use
++ the modem.
++
++ For these reasons, don't assume that "set modem type hayes" should be
++ used for all modems that uses the Hayes AT command set. "set modem
++ type hayes" really does mean Hayes 1200 or 2400, which in turn means
++ no hardware flow control, and no speed buffering. This choice will
++ rarely work with a modern high-speed modem.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 6. DIALING HINTS AND TIPS
++
++ [ [49]Top ] [ [50]Contents ] [ [51]Next ] [ [52]Previous ]
++
++ If you have a high-speed, error-correcting, data-compressing,
++ speed-buffering modem, you should fix the modem's interface speed as
++ high as possible, preferably (at least) four times higher than its
++ maximum connection (modulation) speed to allow compression to work at
++ full advantage. In this type of setup, you must also have an effective
++ means of flow control enabled between C-Kermit and the modem,
++ preferably hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control. On platforms that do not
++ support hardware flow control, it is usually possible to select
++ software flow control (Xon/Xoff), and C-Kermit will do its best to set
++ the modem for local Xon/Xoff flow control too (but then, of course,
++ Ctrl-S and Ctrl-Q characters can not be transmitted on the
++ connection).
++
++ If you are having trouble dialing your modem, SET DIAL DISPLAY ON to
++ watch the dialing interactions between C-Kermit and your modem.
++ Consult Chapters 3-4 of [53]Using C-Kermit (2nd Ed) for modem-dialing
++ troubleshooting instructions. The following sections offer some
++ addtional hints and tips.
++
++ 6.1. Syntax
++
++ If you want to dial a number that starts with #, you'll need to quote
++ the "#" character (as \# or \{35}), since it is also a comment
++ introducer:
++
++ C-Kermit>dial #98765421-1-212-5551212 ; Looks like a comment
++ ?You must specify a number to dial
++ C-Kermit>dial \#98765421-1-212-5551212 ; Works OK
++ C-Kermit>dial =#98765421-1-212-5551212 ; This works too
++
++ When using a dialing directory, remember what happens if a name is not
++ found:
++
++ C-Kermit>dial xyzcorp
++ Lookup: "xyzcorp" - not found - dialing as given
++
++ This normally does no harm, but some modems might behave strangely
++ when given dial strings that contain certain letters. For example, a
++ certain German modem treats any dial string that contains the letter
++ "s" as a command to fetch a number from its internal list, and replies
++ OK to the ATD command, which is normally not a valid response except
++ for partial dialing. To avoid this situation, use:
++
++ lookup xyzcorp
++ if success dial
++
++ 6.2. The Carrier Signal
++
++ Remember: In many C-Kermit implementations (depending on the
++ underlying operating system -- mostly Windows, OS/2, and
++ System-V-based UNIX versions, and in C-Kermit 7.0, also VMS), you
++ can't CONNECT to a modem and type the modem's dialing command (like
++ "ATDT7654321") manually, unless you first tell C-Kermit to:
++
++ SET CARRIER-WATCH OFF
++
++ This is because (in these implementations), the CONNECT command
++ requires the modem's Carrier Detect (CD) signal to be on, but the CD
++ signal doesn't come on until after dialing is complete. This
++ requirement is what allows C-Kermit to pop back to its prompt
++ automatically when the connection is hung up. See the description of
++ SET CARRIER-WATCH in "Using C-Kermit".
++
++ Similarly, if your dialed connection drops when CARRIER-WATCH is set
++ to AUTO or ON, you can't CONNECT back to the (now disconnected) screen
++ to see what might have happened unless you first SET CARRIER-WATCH
++ OFF. But sometimes not even SET CARRIER-WATCH OFF will help in this
++ situation: certain platforms (for example Unixware 2.1), once carrier
++ drops, won't let the application do i/o with the device any more. In
++ that case, if you want to use the device again, you have to CLOSE it
++ and OPEN it again. Or you can have Kermit do this for you
++ automatically by telling it to SET CLOSE-ON-DISCONNECT ON.
++
++ 6.3. Dialing and Flow Control
++
++ Don't SET FLOW RTS/CTS if your modem is turned off, or if it is not
++ presenting the CTS signal. Otherwise, the serial device driver can get
++ stuck waiting for this signal to appear.
++
++ Most modern modems support RTS/CTS (if they support any hardware flow
++ control at all), but some computers use different RS-232 circuits for
++ the same purposes, e.g. DTR and CD, or DTR and CTS. In such cases, you
++ might be able to make your computer work with your modem by
++ appropriately cross-wiring the circuits in the cable connector, for
++ example the computer's DTR to the modem's RTS, and modem's CD to the
++ computer's CTS. HOWEVER, C-Kermit does not know you have done this. So
++ if you have (say) SET FLOW DTR/CD, C-Kermit will make no attempt to
++ tell the modem to use RTS/CTS. You probably did this yourself when you
++ configured the modem.
++
++ 6.4. The Dial Timeout
++
++ If it takes your call longer to be completed than the timeout interval
++ that C-Kermit calculates, you can use the SET DIAL TIMEOUT command to
++ override C-Kermit's value. But beware: the modem has its own timeout
++ for completing the call. If it is a Hayes-like modem, C-Kermit adjusts
++ the modem's value too by setting register S7. But the maximum value
++ for S7 might be smaller than the time you need! In that case, C-Kermit
++ sets S7 to 0, 255, or other (modem-specific) value to signify "no
++ timeout". If Kermit attempts to set register S7 to a value higher than
++ your modem's maximum, the modem will say "ERROR" and you will get a
++ "Failure to initialize modem" error. In that case, use SET DIAL
++ TIMEOUT to override C-Kermit's calculation of the timeout value with
++ the highest value that is legal for your modem, e.g. 60.
++
++ 6.5. Escape Sequence Guard Time
++
++ A "TIES" (Time-Independent Escape Sequence) modem does not require any
++ guard time around its escape sequence. The following text:
++
++ +++ATH0
++
++ if sent through a TIES modem, for example because you were uploading
++ this file through it, could pop the modem back into command mode and
++ make it hang up the connection. Later versions of the Telebit T1600
++ and T3000 (version LA3.01E firmware and later), and all WorldBlazers,
++ use TIES.
++
++ Although the probability of "+++" appearing in a Kermit packet is
++ markedly lower than with most other protocols (see the [54]File
++ Transfer section below), it can still happen under certain
++ circumstances. It can also happen when using C-Kermit's TRANSMIT
++ command. If you are using a Telebit TIES modem, you can change the
++ modem's escape sequence to an otherwise little-used control character
++ such as Ctrl-_ (Control-Underscore):
++
++ AT S2=31
++
++ A sequence of three consecutive Ctrl-_ characters will not appear in a
++ Kermit packet unless you go to extraordinary lengths to defeat more
++ than a few of Kermit's built-in safety mechanisms. And if you do this,
++ then you should also turn off the modem's escape-sequence recognition
++ altogether:
++
++ AT S48=0 S2=255
++
++ But when escape sequence recognition is turned off, "modem hangup"
++ (<pause>+++<pause>ATH0<CR>) will not work, so you should also SET
++ MODEM HANGUP RS232-SIGNAL (rather then MODEM-COMMAND).
++
++ 6.6. Adaptive Dialing
++
++ Some modems have a feature called adaptive dialing. When they are told
++ to dial a number using Tone dialing, they check to make sure that
++ dialtone has gone away after dialing the first digit. If it has not,
++ the modem assumes the phone line does not accept Tone dialing and so
++ switches to Pulse. When dialing out from a PBX, there is almost always
++ a secondary dialtone. Typically you take the phone off-hook, get the
++ PBX dialtone, dial "9" to get an outside line, and then get the phone
++ company's dialtone. In a situation like this, you need to tell the
++ modem to expect the secondary dialtone. On Hayes and compatible
++ modems, this is done by putting a "W" in the dial string at the
++ appropriate place. For example, to dial 9 for an outside line, and
++ then 7654321, use ATDT9W7654321:
++
++ SET PBX-OUTSIDE-PREFIX 9W
++
++ (replace "9" with whatever your PBX's outside-line prefix is).
++
++ 6.7. The Busy Signal
++
++ Some phone companies are eliminating the busy signal. Instead, they
++ issue a voice message such as "press 1 to automatically redial until
++ the number answers, or...". Obviously this is a disaster for modem
++ calls. If your service has this feature, there's nothing Kermit can do
++ about it. Your modem will respond with NO CARRIER (after a long time)
++ rather than BUSY (immediately), and Kermit will declare the call a
++ failure, rather than trying to redial the same number.
++
++ 6.8. Hanging Up
++
++ There are two ways to hang up a modem: by turning off the serial
++ port's DTR signal (SET MODEM HANGUP-METHOD RS232-SIGNAL) or sending
++ the modem its escape sequence followed by its hangup command (SET
++ MODEM HANGUP-METHOD MODEM-COMMAND). If one doesn't work, try the
++ other. If the automatic hangup performed at the beginning of a DIAL
++ command causes trouble, then SET DIAL HANGUP OFF.
++
++ The HANGUP command has no effect when C-Kermit is in remote mode. This
++ is on purpose. If C-Kermit could hang up its own controlling terminal,
++ this would (a) most likely leave behind zombie processes, and (b) pose
++ a security risk.
++
++ If you DIAL a modem, disconnect, then SET HOST or TELNET, and then
++ HANGUP, Kermit sends the modem's hangup command, such as "+++ATHO".
++ There is no good way to avoid this, because this case can't reliably
++ be distinguished from the case in which the user does SET HOST
++ terminal-server, SET MODEM TYPE name, DIAL. In both cases we have a
++ valid modem type selected and we have a network connection. If you
++ want to DIAL and then later make a regular network connection, you
++ will have to SET MODEM TYPE NONE or SET DIAL HANGUP OFF to avoid this
++ phenomenon.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 7. TERMINAL SERVERS
++
++ [ [55]Top ] [ [56]Contents ] [ [57]Next ] [ [58]Previous ]
++
++ Watch out for terminal server's escape character -- usually a control
++ character such as Ctrl-Circumflex (Ctrl-^). Don't unprefix it in
++ Kermit!
++
++ Ciscos -- must often be told to "terminal download"... Cisco ASM
++ models don't have hardware flow control in both directions.
++
++ Many terminal servers only give you a 7-bit connection, so if you
++ can't make it 8-bit, tell Kermit to "set parity space".
++
++ The following story, regarding trouble transferring 8-bit files
++ through a reverse terminal server, was contributed by an Annex
++ terminal server user:
++
++ Using C-Kermit on an HP 9000 712/80 running the HP-UX 10.0
++ operating system. The HP was connected to a Xylogics Annex
++ MICRO-ELS-UX R7.1 8 port terminal server via ethernet. On the
++ second port of the terminal server is an AT&T Paradyne 3810 modem,
++ which is connected to a telephone line. There is a program which
++ runs on the HP to establish a Telnet connection between a serial
++ line on the Annex and a character special file on the HP (/dev
++ file). This is an Annex specific program called rtelnet (reverse
++ telnet) and is provided with the terminal server software. The
++ rtelnet utility runs on top of the pseudo-terminal facility
++ provided by UNIX. It creates host-originiated connections to
++ devices attached ot Annex serial ports. There are several command
++ line arguments to be specified with this program: the IP address of
++ the terminal server, the number of the port to attach to, and the
++ name of the pseudo-device to create. In addition to these there are
++ options to tell rtelnet how to operate on the connect: -b requests
++ negotiation for Telnet binary mode, -d turns on socket-leve
++ debugging, -f enables "connect on the fly" mode, -r removes the
++ device-name if it already exists, etc. The most important of these
++ to be specified when using 8 data bits and no parity, as we found
++ out, was the -t option. This creates a transparent TCP connection
++ to the terminal server. Again, what we assumed to be happening was
++ that the rtelnet program encountered a character sequence special
++ to itself and then "eating" those kermit packets. I think this is
++ all of the information I can give you on the configuration, short
++ of the values associated with the port on the terminal server.
++
++ How to DIAL from a TCP/IP reverse terminal server (modem server):
++
++ 1. (only if necessary) SET TELNET ECHO REMOTE
++ 2. SET HOST terminal-server-ip-name-or-address [ port ]
++ 3. SET MODEM TYPE modem-type
++ 4. (only if necessary) SET DIAL HANGUP OFF
++ 5. (for troubleshooting) SET DIAL DISPLAY ON
++ 6. DIAL phone-number
++
++ The order is important: SET HOST before SET MODEM TYPE. Since this is
++ a Telnet connection, serial-port related commands such as SET SPEED,
++ SET STOP-BITS, HANGUP (when MODEM HANGUP-METHOD is RS232), etc, have
++ no effect. However, in C-Kermit 8.0, if the modem server supports
++ [59]RFC-2217 Telnet Com-Port Control protocol, these commands do
++ indeed take effect at the server's serial port.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8. TERMINAL EMULATION
++
++ [ [60]Top ] [ [61]Contents ] [ [62]Next ] [ [63]Previous ]
++
++ Except for the Windows, OS/2, and Macintosh versions, C-Kermit does
++ not emulate any kind of terminal. Rather, it acts as a
++ "semitransparent pipe", passing the characters you type during a
++ CONNECT session to the remote host, and sending the characters
++ received from the remote host to your screen. Whatever is controlling
++ your keyboard and screen provides the specific terminal emulation: a
++ real terminal, a PC running a terminal emulator, etc, or (in the case
++ of a self-contained workstation) your console driver, a terminal
++ window, xterm, etc.
++
++ Kermit is semitrantsparent rather than fully transparent in the
++ following ways:
++
++ * During a TELNET ("set host") session, C-Kermit itself executes the
++ TELNET protocol and performs TELNET negotiations. (But it does not
++ perform TN3270 protocol or any other type of 3270 terminal
++ emulation.)
++ * If you have changed your keyboard mapping using SET KEY, C-Kermit
++ replaces the characters you type with the characters or strings
++ they are mapped to.
++ * If you SET your TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET to anything but
++ TRANSPARENT, C-Kermit translates your keystrokes (after applying
++ any SET KEY definitions) before transmitting them, and translates
++ received characters before showing them on your screen.
++ * If your remote and/or local TERMINAL CHARACTER-SET is an ISO 646
++ 7-bit national character set, such as German, French, Italian,
++ Swedish, etc, or Short KOI used for Cyrillic, C-Kermit's CONNECT
++ command automatically skips over ANSI escape sequences to avoid
++ translating their characters. Only ANSI/ISO standard
++ (VT100/200/300-like) 7-bit escape sequence formats are supported
++ for this purpose, no proprietary schemes like H-P, Televideo,
++ Tektronix, etc.
++ * If your version of C-Kermit includes SET TERMINAL APC command,
++ then C-Kermit's CONNECT command will handle APC escape sequences
++ if TERMINAL APC is not set to OFF (which is the default).
++
++ You can make C-Kermit fully transparent by starting it with the -0
++ (dash zero) command-line option.
++
++ If you are running C-Kermit under a console driver, or in a terminal
++ window, that emulates the VT100, and use C-Kermit to log in to a VMS
++ system, the console driver or terminal window (not Kermit) is supposed
++ to reply to the "what are you?" query (ESC Z) from the VAX. If it
++ doesn't, and you can't make it do so, then you can (a) live with the
++ "unknown terminal" problem; (b) tell VMS to SET TERMINAL/DEVICE=VT100;
++ (c) program a key using SET KEY to send the appropriate sequence and
++ then punch the key at the right time; or (d) use the VMSLOGIN macro
++ that is defined in CKERMIT.INI to do this for you automatically.
++
++ SET SESSION-LOG { TEXT, BINARY }, which is effective in UNIX and
++ AOS/VS but not other C-Kermit versions, removes CR, DEL, NUL, XON, and
++ XOFF characters (Using C-Kermit neglects to mention that XON and XOFF
++ are removed). The TEXT-mode setting is ineffective during SCRIPT
++ command execution, as well as on X.25 connections.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9. KEY MAPPING
++
++ [ [64]Top ] [ [65]Contents ] [ [66]Next ] [ [67]Previous ]
++
++ Except in the terminal-emulating versions, C-Kermit's key mapping
++ facilities are limited to normal "ASCII" keys, and cannot be used with
++ function keys, arrow keys, arcane key combinations, etc. Since
++ C-Kermit runs on such a wide variety of hardware platforms (including,
++ for example, more than 360 different UNIX platforms), it is not
++ possible for C-Kermit to support every conceivable keyboard under
++ every release of every UNIX (or VMS, or ...) product on every
++ different kind of computer possibly under all manner of different
++ console drivers, even if it had the means to do so.
++
++ In technical terms, C-Kermit uses the read() function to read
++ keystrokes, and read() returns a single byte (value 0 through 255).
++ C-Kermit's SET KEY function applies to these single-byte codes.
++ "Extended function" keys, such as F-keys, arrow keys, etc, usually
++ return either a 2-byte "scan code" or else a character string (such as
++ an escape sequence like "<ESC> O p"). In both cases, C-Kermit has no
++ way to tell the difference between such multibyte key values, and the
++ corresponding series of single-byte key values. This could only be
++ done by accessing the keyboard at a much lower level in a highly
++ platform-dependent manner, probably requiring tens of thousands of
++ lines of code to support even a sampling of the most popular
++ workstation / OS combinations.
++
++ However, most workstation console drivers (terminal emulation windows,
++ etc) include their own key-mapping facility. For example in AIX, the
++ AIXterm program (in whose window you would run C-Kermit) allows
++ rebinding of the F1-F12 keys to arbitrary strings. The same is true of
++ Xterm and DECterm windows, etc. Consult the technical documentation
++ for your workstation or emulator. See sample Xterm (Xmodmap) mappings
++ in the [68]Unix C-Kermit Hints and Tips document.
++
++ The SET KEY command (except in Kermit 95) does not allow a key
++ definition to be (or contain) the NUL (\0) character.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 10. FILE TRANSFER
++
++ [ [69]Top ] [ [70]Contents ] [ [71]Next ] [ [72]Previous ]
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 is the first release of C-Kermit to use fast (rather than
++ robust and therefore slow) protocol defaults: long packets, sliding
++ windows, control-character unprefixing, and streaming where possible.
++ This makes most transfers (partner willing) dramatically faster "out
++ of the box" but might break some combinations that worked before. If
++ transfers with C-Kermit 7.0 or later fail where transfers worked with
++ earlier C-Kermit versions, try the following (one at a time, in this
++ order):
++
++ 1. SET PREFIXING ALL: Disables control-character unprefixing.
++ 2. SET STREAMING OFF: Disables streaming.
++ 3. CAUTIOUS: Selects medium but cautious protocol settings.
++ 4. ROBUST: this command reverts to the most conservative protocol
++ settings.
++
++ Execution of multiple file transfers by C-Kermit from a command file
++ when in remote mode might exhibit long delays between each transfer.
++ To avoid this, just include the command "SET DELAY 0" in your command
++ file before any of the file-transfer commands.
++
++ File transfer failures can occur for all sorts of reasons, most of
++ them listed in Chapter 10 of [73]Using C-Kermit. The following
++ sections touch on some that aren't.
++
++ The [74]C-Kermit 7.0 Release Notes document SEND /COMMAND as taking an
++ argument, but it doesn't. Instead of SEND /COMMAND:{some command},
++ use:
++
++SEND /COMMAND [ other switches such as /AS-NAME: ] command [ arguments... ]
++
++ 10.1. Laptops
++
++ Watch out for laptops and their assorted power-saver features; for
++ example, a built-in modem's "auto timeout delay" hanging up the
++ connection in the middle of a file transfer. Most modems, even if they
++ have this feature, do not have it enabled by default. But if you
++ experience otherwise inexplicable disconnections in the midst of your
++ Kermit sessions, check the modem manual for such things as "idle
++ timeout", "auto timeout", etc, and add the command to disable this
++ feature to Kermit's init string for this modem.
++
++ 10.2. NFS
++
++ If uploading a large file to an NFS-mounted disk fails (or is
++ painfully slow), try uploading it to a local disk (e.g. /tmp on Unix)
++ and then copying to the NFS disk later.
++
++ 10.3. Modems
++
++ If you are dialing out and find that downloads work but uploads don't,
++ try again with a lower serial-port speed. Case in point: dialing out
++ on a certain PC from Linux at 115200 bps using a USR Courier 56K
++ "V.Everything" external modem and RTS/CTS flow control. Downloads
++ worked flawlessly, uploads stopped dead after the first few packets
++ were sent. The modem lights showed constant retraining (ARQ light
++ blinks slowly), and the CTS light was off 95% of the time, allowing
++ nothing to get through. Reducing the serial port speed to 57600 bps
++ made the problems go away. Evidently the PC in question has a very
++ fast serial port, since dialing the same modem with a different PC at
++ 115200 bps works without incident.
++
++ 10.4. TCP/IP Connections
++
++ If you have trouble transferring files over a TCP/IP connection, tell
++ Kermit to SET PARITY SPACE and try again. If that doesn't work, also
++ try a shorter packet length or smaller window size (to compensate for
++ certain well-known broken Telnet servers), and/or SET RELIABLE OFF.
++
++ 10.5. Multihop Connections
++
++ If you have a multihop connection, with the interior nodes in CONNECT
++ mode (Kermit, Telnet, Rlogin, or any other), you can expect (a) file
++ transfer to be slower, and (b) the connection to be less transparent
++ (to control characters, perhaps to the 8th bit) than a more direct
++ connection. C-Kermit 7.0 and later have a "-0" (dash-zero)
++ command-line option to make it 100% transparent in cases where it is
++ to be used in the middle.
++
++ 10.6. Recovery
++
++ The recovery feature (RESEND command) that was added in version
++ 5A(190) works only for binary-mode transfers. In order for this
++ feature to be useful at all, the default for SET FILE INCOMPLETE was
++ changed from DISCARD to KEEP. Otherwise an interrupted transfer would
++ leave no partial file behind unless you had remembered to change the
++ default. But now you have to pay closer attention to Kermit's messages
++ to know whether a transfer succeeded or failed -- previously, if it
++ failed, the file would not show up on the receiving end at all; in
++ 5A(190) and later, you'll get a partial file which could easily be
++ mistaken for the complete file unless you change the default back to
++ DISCARD or read the screen messages, or keep a transaction log.
++
++ 10.7. Filename Collisions
++
++ SET FILE COLLISION BACKUP is the default. This means:
++
++ * If you send the same file lots of times, there will be many backup
++ files. There is no automatic mechanism within Kermit to delete
++ them, no notion of a "version retention count", etc, but you can
++ use the PURGE command to clean them up.
++ * If a file arrives that has the same name as a directory, the file
++ transfer fails because Kermit will not rename a directory. Send
++ the file with another name, or use SET FILE COLLISION RENAME.
++ * If the directory lacks write permission, the file transfer fails
++ even if you have write access to the file that is being backed up;
++ in that case, switch to SET FILE COLLISION OVERWRITE or APPEND, or
++ send to a different directory.
++
++ SET FILE COLLISION UPDATE depends on the date/time stamp in the
++ attribute packet. However, this is recorded in local time, not
++ Universal Time (GMT), and there is no indication of time zone. The
++ time is expressed to the precision of 1 second, but some file systems
++ do not record with this precision -- for example, MS-DOS records the
++ file date/time only to the nearest 2 seconds. This might cause update
++ operations to send more files than necessary.
++
++ (This paragraph does NOT apply to UNIX, where, as of C-Kermit 7.0,
++ C-Kermit pipes incoming mail and print material directly the mail or
++ print program): When C-Kermit is receiving files from another Kermit
++ program that has been given the MAIL or REMOTE PRINT command, C-Kermit
++ follows the current filename collision action. This can be
++ disconcerting if the action was (for example) BACKUP, because the
++ existing file will be renamed, and the new file will be mailed (or
++ printed) and then deleted. Kermit cannot temporarily change to RENAME
++ because the file collision action occurs when the filename packet is
++ received, and the PRINT or MAIL disposition only comes later, in the
++ Attribute packet.
++
++ Watch out for SET FILE COLLISION RENAME, especially when used in
++ conjunction with recovery. Recall that this option (which is NOT the
++ default) renames the incoming file if a file already exists with the
++ same name (the default is to rename the previously existing file, and
++ store the incoming file with its own name). It is strongly recommended
++ that you do not use SET FILE COLLISION RENAME if you ever intend to
++ use the recovery feature:
++
++ * When the file is first received by C-Kermit, its name is changed
++ if another file already has the same name. When you RESEND the
++ same file after a failure, C-Kermit will probably try to append
++ the re-sent portion to the wrong file.
++ * Assuming that you get RESEND to work with FILE COLLISION RENAME,
++ C-Kermit, when receiving the remainder of the file during a RESEND
++ operation, will report back the wrong name. Nothing can be done
++ about this because the name is reported back before the receiving
++ Kermit program finds out that it is a recovery operation.
++
++ Also watch out for DISABLE DELETE, since this implicitly sets FILE
++ COLLISION to RENAME. And note tht DELETE is DISABLEd automatically any
++ time you Kermit is in local mode (i.e. it makes a connection). Also
++ note that for purposes of DISABLE and ENABLE, "set host *" connections
++ do not count as local mode even though, strictly speaking, they are.
++
++ 10.8. DOS Pathnames
++
++ When referring to foreign MS-DOS, Windows, Atari ST, OS/2, or other
++ file specifications that contain backslash characters in a C-Kermit
++ command, you might have to double each backslash, for example:
++
++ C-Kermit>get c:\\directory\\foo.txt
++
++ This is because backslash is used in C-Kermit commands for introducing
++ special character codes, variables, functions, etc.
++
++ 10.9. Cancellation
++
++ If attempting to cancel local-mode file reception at a very early
++ stage (i.e. before data packets are exchanged) with X or Z does not
++ work, use E or Ctrl-C instead, or wait until the first data packets
++ are sent.
++
++ If you cancel a transfer that is underway using X or Z, and a lot of
++ window slots are in use, it might take a while for the cancellation to
++ take effect, especially if you do this on the receiving end; that's
++ because a lot of packets might already be on their way to you. In that
++ case, just be patient and let Kermit "drain" them.
++
++ If C-Kermit is sending a file, remote-mode packet-mode breakout (three
++ consecutive Ctrl-C's by default) is not effective until after C-Kermit
++ sends its first packet. If C-Kermit is receiving a file or is in
++ server mode, it is effective right away. In the former case, the SET
++ DELAY value determines the earliest time at which you can break out of
++ packet mode.
++
++ 10.10. Partner Peculiarities
++
++ When one or both partners is on an SCO operating system such as OSR5,
++ you might issue the command:
++
++mapchan -n
++
++ to disable character-set conversion by the terminal driver. Similarly
++ for AIX:
++
++setmaps -t NOMAP
++
++ When using C-Kermit to transfer files with the HP48SX calculator, you
++ must SET FLOW NONE. The HP48SX does not support flow control, and
++ evidently also becomes confused if you attempt to use it. You might
++ also need to use SET SEND PAUSE 100 (or other number). For greater
++ detail about transferring files the the HP-48, see:
++
++ [75]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/hp48.html
++
++ Some communication programs have errors in their implementation of
++ Kermit attribute packets. If you get an error message from your
++ communication program like "Attribute error", tell C-Kermit to SET
++ ATTRIBUTES OFF. Better yet, switch to a real Kermit program.
++
++ Some communication software claims to implement Kermit sliding
++ windows, but does so incorrectly. If sliding window transfers fail,
++ set C-Kermit's window size to the smallest one that works, for
++ example, SET WINDOW 1.
++
++ For lots more detail about how to cope with defective Kermit partners,
++ see:
++
++ * [76]Coping with Faulty Kermit Implementations (C-Kermit 7.0 and
++ later).
++ * [77]Coping with Broken Kermit Partners (C-Kermit 8.0 and later).
++
++ The UNIX version of C-Kermit discards carriage returns when receiving
++ files in text mode. Thus, "bare" carriage returns (sometimes used to
++ achieve overstriking) are lost.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11. SCRIPT PROGRAMMING
++
++ [ [78]Top ] [ [79]Contents ] [ [80]Previous ]
++
++ 11.1. Comments Versus the SCRIPT Command
++
++ Remember that ";" and "#" introduce comments when (a) they are the
++ first character on the line, or (b) they are preceded by at least one
++ blank or tab within a line. Thus constructions like:
++
++ INPUT 5 ;
++ SCRIPT ~0 #--#--#
++
++ must be coded using backslash notation to keep the data from being
++ ignored:
++
++ INPUT 5 \59 ; 59 is the decimal ASCII code for ";"
++ SCRIPT ~0 \35--#--# ; 43 is the decimal ASCII code for "#"
++
++ or, more simply:
++
++ INPUT 5 \; ; Just quote the semicolon
++ SCRIPT ~0 \#--#--# ; Just quote the "#"
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.2. Alphabetic Case and the INPUT Command
++
++ INPUT and MINPUT caseless string comparisons do not work for non-ASCII
++ (international) characters. Workaround: SET INPUT CASE OBSERVE. Even
++ then, the "lexically less than" and "lexically greater than"
++ operations (IF LLT, IF LGT) probably won't work as expected. The same
++ is true for the case-conversion functions \Flower() and \Fupper().
++ C-Kermit does not know the collating sequence for different character
++ sets and languages. (On the other hand, it might work depending on
++ such items as how Kermit was linked, whether your operating supports
++ "locales", etc)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.3. NUL (0) Characters in C-Kermit Commands
++
++ You can't include a NUL character (\0) in C-Kermit command text
++ without terminating the character string in which it appears. For
++ example:
++
++ echo In these brackets [\0] is a NUL
++
++ will echo "In these brackets [". This applies to ECHO, INPUT, OUTPUT,
++ and all other commands (but you can represent NUL by "\N" in an OUTPUT
++ string). This is because C-language strings are terminated internally
++ by the NUL character, and it allows all of C-Kermit's string
++ comparison and manipulation functions to work in the normal "C" way.
++
++ To illustrate:
++
++ INPUT 5 \0
++
++ is equivalent to:
++
++ INPUT 5
++
++ and:
++
++ INPUT 5 ABC\0DEF
++
++ is equivalent to:
++
++ INPUT 5 ABC
++
++ INPUT operations discard and ignore NUL characters that arrive from
++ the communication device, meaning that they do not figure into
++ matching operations (e.g. A<NUL>B matches AB); they are not deposited
++ in the INPUT buffer (\v(input)); and they are not counted in
++ \v(incount), with two exceptions:
++
++ 1. An arriving NUL character restarts the INPUT SILENCE timer.
++ 2. An arriving NUL character terminates the INPUT command with the
++ SUCCESS condition if the INPUT command was given an empty search
++ string. In this case \v(incount) is set to 1.
++
++ Also, the \v(inchar) variable is null (completely empty) if the last
++ INPUT character was NUL. That is, there is no way to tell only by
++ looking at \v(inchar) the difference between a NUL that was INPUT and
++ no INPUT at all. If the INPUT command succeeded but \v(inchar) is
++ empty, then a NUL character was input. Also, \v(incount) will be set
++ to 1.
++
++ Here's a sample script fragment to read characters, possibly including
++ NUL, from the communication connection and write them to a file:
++
++ while true {
++ input 1 ; read one byte
++ if fail break ; timed out or connection closed
++ fwrite /char \%c \v(inchar) ; record the byte
++ }
++
++ This works because when \v(inchar) is NUL, that's equivalent to FWRITE
++ /CHAR having no text argument at all, in which case it writes a NUL
++ character.
++
++ \v(incount) and \v(inchar) are NOT affected by the CLEAR command.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.4. \ffiles() and \fnextfile() Peculiarities
++
++ The following script program:
++
++ for \%i 1 \ffiles(oofa.*) 1 {
++ send \fnextfile()
++ }
++
++ did not work as expected in C-Kermit 6.0 and earlier but does work in
++ C-Kermit 7.0 and later.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.5. Commands That Have Only Local Effect
++
++ Certain settings are local to each command level, meaning that
++ subordinate command levels (macros or command files) can change them
++ without affecting their values at higher command levels. When a new
++ command level is invoked, the value is inherited from the previous
++ level. These settings are:
++
++ CASE
++ COUNT and \v(count)
++ INPUT CASE
++ INPUT TIMEOUT
++ MACRO ERROR
++ QUIET
++ TAKE ERROR
++
++ This arrangement allows CASE, TIMEOUT, and ERROR settings, which are
++ used to control automatic exit from a command file or macro upon
++ error, to be automatically restored when the command file or macro
++ exits.
++
++ The COUNT variable follows this rule too, which permits nested SET
++ COUNT / IF COUNT loops, as in this example in which the inner loop
++ counts down from the current COUNT value of the outer loop (try it):
++
++ DEFINE INNER WHILE COUNT { WRITE SCREEN { Inner:}, SHOW COUNT }
++ SET COUNT 5
++ WHILE COUNT { WRITE SCREEN Outer:, SHOW COUNT, DO INNER }
++
++ Keep in mind that an inferior command level cannot manipulate the
++ COUNT value held by a higher level. For example:
++
++ DEFINE OOFA SHOW COUNT, IF COUNT GOTO LOOP
++ SET COUNT 5
++ :LOOP
++ OOFA
++ ECHO Done
++
++ results in an infinite loop; the COUNT value remains at 5 because it
++ is never decremented at the same level at which it was set.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.6. Literal Braces in Function Calls
++
++ Since braces are used in function calls to indicate grouping, there is
++ no way to pass literal braces to the function itself. Solution: Define
++ a variable containing the string that has braces. Example:
++
++ define \%a ab{cd
++ echo \fsubstring(\%a)
++ ab{cd
++
++ If the string is to start with a leading brace and end with a closing
++ brace, then double braces must appear around the string (which itself
++ is enclosed in braces):
++
++ define \%a {{{foo}}}
++ echo \fsubstring(\%a)
++ {foo}
++
++ This also works for any other kind of string:
++
++ define \%a {{ab{cd}}
++ echo \fsubstring(\%a)
++ ab{cd
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.7. Defining Variables on the C-Kermit Command Line
++
++ To define variables on the C-Kermit command line, use the -C
++ command-line option with one or more DEFINE or ASSIGN commands. Note
++ that the C-Kermit command line must cope with the quoting rules of
++ your shell. Examples:
++
++ kermit -C "define \\%a foo, define phonenumber 7654321"
++
++ In this case we follow UNIX quoting rules by doubling the backslash.
++ Once C-Kermit starts, the \%a and \m(phonenumber) variables are
++ defined as indicated and can be used in the normal way.
++
++ In DOS or Windows or OS/2 the command would be:
++
++ kermit -C "define \%%a foo, define phonenumber 7654321"
++
++ Here we need to double the percent sign rather than the backslash
++ because of DOS shell quoting rules.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.8. Per-Character Echo Check with the OUTPUT Command
++
++ Sometimes the OUTPUT command must be used to send commands or data to
++ a device in "echoplex" mode, meaning that characters must be sent one
++ at a time, and the next character can not be sent until the echo from
++ the previous one has been received. For example, a certain PBX might
++ have this characteristic. Let's say a Kermit script is used to program
++ the PBX. If characters are sent too fast, they can be lost. It would
++ seem that the command:
++
++ SET OUTPUT PACING milliseconds
++
++ could be used to take care of this, but the pacing interval is
++ constant and must be set large enough to allow even the slowest echo
++ to finish. If the script is large (an actual example is 14,000 lines
++ long), this can cause it to take hours longer than it needs to.
++
++ Here is a macro you can use to OUTPUT a string in an Echoplex
++ environment:
++
++ define XOUTPUT {
++ local \%c \%i
++ set output pacing 0
++ for \%i 1 \flen(\%*) 1 {
++ asg \%c \fsubstr(\%*,\%i,1)
++ output \%c
++ input 2 \%c
++ }
++ }
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 or later is required.
++
++ It sends one character at a time and then waits up to 2 seconds for
++ the character to be echoed back, but continues to the next character
++ as soon as the echo appears, so no time is wasted. You can add an IF
++ FAIL clause after the INPUT in case you want to do something special
++ about failure to detect an echo within the timeout period. Obviously
++ you can also change the 2-second limit, and adjust the script in any
++ other desired way.
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.9. Scripted File Transfer
++
++ Sometimes a user complains that when she makes a connection by hand,
++ logs in, and transfers a file, there are no problems, but when she
++ scripts the the exact same sequence, the file transfer always fails
++ after a few packets. Here's a scenario where this can happen:
++
++ 1. Upon logging in to the remote computer, it sends a "What Are You?"
++ escape sequence.
++ 2. When you log in interactively, your terminal emulator sends the
++ response. This is invisible to you; you don't know it's happening.
++ 3. When you script the login, and begin a file transfer immediately
++ upon logging in, the host still sends the "What Are You?"
++ sequence. Kermit's INPUT ECHO setting is ON by default, so the
++ escape sequence passes through to the terminal, and the terminal
++ sends its response. But by this time Kermit has already started
++ the file transfer.
++ 4. By default, the local Kermit program examines the keyboard for
++ interruption characters between every packet. The "What Are You"
++ response is sitting in the keyboard buffer. Eventually Kermit will
++ read a character such as "c" that is a valid interruption
++ character, and the file transfer stops with "User cancelled".
++
++ The right way to handle this situation is to have your look for the
++ "What Are You?" sequence and send the response itself, as described in
++ Using C-Kermit, pp.429-431. Or you can work around it by telling the
++ local Kermit to "set input echo off" and/or "set transfer interruption
++ off".
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 11.10. Other...
++
++ Escape sequences (or any strings that contain control characters)
++ can't be used as labels, GOTO targets, or SWITCH cases.
++
++ [ [81]Top ] [ [82]Contents ] [ [83]C-Kermit Home ] [ [84]C-Kermit 8.0
++ Overview ] [ [85]Kermit Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 Unix Hints and Tips / [86]The Kermit Project /
++ [87]Columbia University / [88]kermit@columbia.edu / 10 April 2004
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ 4. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 5. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95.html
++ 6. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 7. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html
++ 8. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x0
++ 9. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x1
++ 10. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x2
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x3
++ 12. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x4
++ 13. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x5
++ 14. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x6
++ 15. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x7
++ 16. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x8
++ 17. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x9
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x10
++ 19. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x11
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 21. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 22. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x2
++ 23. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 24. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 25. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x2
++ 26. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 27. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit2.html
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 29. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x5
++ 30. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++ 31. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 33. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 34. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x3
++ 35. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x1
++ 36. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 37. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 38. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x4
++ 39. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x2
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 42. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x5
++ 43. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x3
++ 44. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc1122.txt
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 46. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x6
++ 48. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x4
++ 49. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 50. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 51. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x7
++ 52. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x5
++ 53. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 54. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x10
++ 55. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 56. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 57. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x8
++ 58. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x6
++ 59. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2217.txt
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x9
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x7
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 66. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x10
++ 67. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x8
++ 68. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 69. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 70. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 71. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x11
++ 72. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x9
++ 73. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 74. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm
++ 75. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/hp48.html
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.22
++ 77. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x15
++ 78. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 79. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 80. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#x10
++ 81. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#top
++ 82. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html#contents
++ 83. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 84. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80.html
++ 85. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 86. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 87. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 88. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckermod.ini
+@@ -0,0 +1,144 @@
++; File CKERMOD.INI, Sample C-Kermit 7.0 customization file.
++;
++; This file, which is ONLY A SAMPLE, should be called:
++;
++; .mykermrc (UNIX, OS-9, Aegis, BeBox, Plan 9)
++; CKERMOD.INI (VMS, OpenVMS, AOS/VS, OS/2, Amiga, Atari ST)
++; ckermod.ini (Stratus VOS)
++;
++; This file is executed automatically by the standard C-Kermit initialization
++; file, CKERMIT.INI (or .kermrc). This file is not executed by C-Kermit itself
++; unless the initialization file is not found.
++;
++; MODify this file to suit your needs and preferences, and install it in your
++; home directory. Or replace it entirely with a new file.
++;
++; The design of this sample customization file lets you fill in a section for
++; each different operating system where you run C-Kermit.
++;
++; In UNIX, if you give this file execute permission and make sure the top
++; line indicates the full path of the C-Kermit 7.0-or-later executable, you
++; can execute this file directly, as if it was a shell script, except it is
++; interpreted by Kermit rather than the shell. This lets you have as many
++; different startup files as you like, each suited to a particular purpose.
++;
++; Authors: Christine Gianone, Frank da Cruz, Jeffrey Altman,
++; The Kermit Project, Columbia University.
++; Creation: 23 November 1992 for C-Kermit 5A(188).
++; Modified: 30 June 1993 for edit 189.
++; 04 October 1994 for edit 190.
++; 17 April 1995 for edit 191.
++; 6 September 1996 for version 6.0, edit 192.
++; 1 January 2000 for version 7.0, edit 196.
++; 14 October 2001 for version 8.0, edit 200.
++
++ECHO
++ECHO Executing SAMPLE C-Kermit customization file \v(cmdfile) for \v(system)...
++ECHO { Please edit this file to reflect your needs and preferences.}
++ECHO
++;
++; ... and then remove the ECHO commands above.
++
++COMMENT - Settings that apply to all the systems I use:
++;
++set delay 1 ; I escape back quickly
++set dial display on ; I like to watch C-Kermit dial
++
++; Dialing locale and method
++;
++; SET DIAL COUNTRY-CODE 1 ; Uncomment and replace with yours
++; SET DIAL AREA-CODE 000 ; Uncomment and replace with yours
++; SET DIAL LD-PREFIX 1 ; Uncomment and replace with yours
++; SET DIAL INTL-PREFIX 011 ; Uncomment and replace with yours
++; SET DIAL METHOD TONE ; Uncomment and replace with PULSE if necessary
++; SET DIAL DIRECTORY ... ... ; List dialing directory files here
++
++if < \v(version) 600192 -
++ stop 1 \v(cmdfile): C-Kermit 6.0.192 or later required.
++
++set take error on ; Make errors fatal temporarily
++check if ; Do we have an IF command?
++set take error off ; Yes we do, back to normal
++
++; The ON_EXIT macro is executed automatically when C-Kermit exits.
++; Define as desired.
++;
++define ON_EXIT echo Returning you to \v(system) now.
++
++; System-independent quick dialing macro. Depends on having the
++; macros MYMODEM, MYPORT, and (optionally) MYSPEED defined in the
++; system-dependent sections below.
++;
++define MYDIAL {
++ if not defined MYMODEM end 1 {\%0: Modem type not defined.}
++ set modem type \m(MYMODEM)
++ if fail end 1 {\%0: \m(MYMODEM): Unsupported modem type.}
++ if not defined MYPORT end 1 {\%0: Communication port not defined.}
++ set port \m(MYPORT)
++ if fail end 1 {\%0: SET PORT \m(MYPORT) failed.}
++ if defined MYFLOW set flow \m(MYFLOW)
++ if fail end 1 {\%0: SET FLOW \m(MYFLOW) failed.}
++ if defined MYSPEED set speed \m(MYSPEED)
++ if fail end 1 {\%0: SET SPEED \m(MYSPEED) failed.}
++ dial \%1\%2\%3\%4\%5\%6\%7\%8\%9
++ end \v(status)
++}
++
++forward \v(system) ; Go execute system-dependent commands
++
++:UNIX ; UNIX, all versions...
++define MYPORT /dev/cua ; My dialing environment
++define MYMODEM usr ; Replace these by what you actually have
++define MYSPEED 57600
++;
++; If you want all your downloads to go to the same directory, no matter
++; what your current directory is, uncomment and edit the following command:
++;
++; set file download-directory ~/download ; Download directory for UNIX
++
++; Put other UNIX-specific commands here...
++end ; End of UNIX section
++
++:VMS ; VMS and OpenVMS
++define MYPORT TXA0: ; My dialing environment
++define MYMODEM usr ; Replace these by what you actually have
++define MYSPEED 57600
++; set file download-directory [\$(USER).DOWNLOAD] ; Download directory for VMS
++; Put other VMS-specific commands here...
++end ; End of VMS section
++
++:WIN32 ; Windows and OS/2 customizations...
++:OS/2
++define MYPORT COM1 ; My dialing environment
++define MYMODEM usr ; Replace these by what you actually have
++define MYSPEED 57600
++set command byte 8 ; Use 8 bits between Kermit and console
++set xfer char latin1 ; Use Latin-1 for text file transfer
++set term char latin1 ; And use Latin-1 during CONNECT mode
++; set file download-directory C:\DOWNLOADS
++end
++
++:OS9/68K ; OS-9/68000
++define MYPORT /t3 ; My dialing environment
++define MYMODEM usr ; Replace these by what you actually have
++define MYSPEED 9600
++; set file download-directory ~/downloads
++end ; End of OS-9 section
++
++:AOS/VS ; Data General AOS/VS
++define MYPORT @con3 ; My dialing environment
++define MYMODEM usr ; Replace these by what you actually have
++define MYSPEED 9600
++; set file download-directory \v(home)DOWNLOADS
++end
++
++; And so on, you get the idea...
++; Fill in the sections that apply to you.
++
++:Stratus_VOS ; Stratus VOS
++:Amiga ; Commodore Amiga
++:Atari_ST ; Atari ST
++:Macintosh ; Apple Macintosh
++:unknown ; Others
++
++; (End of CKERMOD.INI)
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckermit80.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,10349 @@
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 Update Notes
++
++ [ [1]Contents ] [ [2]C-Kermit ] [ [3]Kermit Home ]
++
++ Second Supplement to Using C-Kermit, Second Edition
++
++For C-Kermit 8.0
++
++ As of C-Kermit version: 8.0.211
++ Date of C-Kermit release: 10 April 2003
++ This file last updated: Sat Apr 10 16:36:11 2004
++
++ * IF YOU ARE READING A PLAIN-TEXT version of this document, note
++ that it is a plain-text dump of a Web page. You can visit the
++ original (and possibly more up-to-date) Web page here:
++ [4]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++ * If you are reading the HTML version of this file with a GUI Web
++ browser, the features added since C-Kermit 8.0.201 are shown in
++ red if your browser and monitor permit. Features that were new to
++ versions 8.0.200 and 201 are in black.
++
++Authors: Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone
++Address: The Kermit Project
++ Columbia University
++ 612 West 115th Street
++ New York NY 10025-7799
++ USA
++Fax: +1 (212) 662-6442
++E-Mail: [5]kermit-support@columbia.edu
++Web: [6]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++Or: [7]http://www.kermit-project.org/
++Or: [8]http://www.columbia.nyc.ny.us/kermit/
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ NOTICES
++
++ This document:
++ Copyright © 1997, 2002, Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone.
++ All rights reserved.
++
++ Kermit 95:
++ Copyright © 1995, 2002, Trustees of Columbia University in the
++ City of New York. All rights reserved.
++
++ C-Kermit:
++ Copyright © 1985, 2002,
++ Trustees of Columbia University in the City of New York. All
++ rights reserved. See the C-Kermit [9]COPYING.TXT file or the
++ copyright text in the [10]ckcmai.c module for disclaimer and
++ permissions.
++
++ When Kerberos(TM) and/or SRP(TM) (Secure Remote Password) and/or
++ SSL/TLS protocol are included:
++ Portions Copyright © 1990, Massachusetts Institute of
++ Technology.
++ Portions Copyright © 1991, 1993 Regents of the University of
++ California.
++ Portions Copyright © 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995 by AT&T.
++ Portions Copyright © 1997, Stanford University.
++ Portions Copyright © 1995-1997, Eric Young
++ <eay@cryptosoft.com>.
++
++ For the full text of the third-party copyright notices, see
++ [11]Appendix V.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ WHAT IS IN THIS FILE
++
++ This file lists changes made to C-Kermit since version 7.0 was
++ released in January 2000. Use this file as a supplement to:
++
++ * The second edition of [12]Using C-Kermit; and:
++ * The [13]C-Kermit 7.0 Update Notes. Also available in plain-text
++ form as [14]ckermit70.txt.
++
++ until the third edition of Using C-Kermit is published. We apologize
++ for the scattered documentation and will consolidate it when we are
++ able.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ ADDITIONAL FILES Several other files accompany this new Kermit
++ release:
++
++ [15]ckututor.html
++ C-Kermit Tutorial (for Unix). Also distributed in Nroff form as
++ [16]ckuker.nr, the Unix C-Kermit manual page.
++
++ [17]security.htm
++ Discussion of Kermit's new authentication and encryption
++ features, updated for C-Kermit 8.0.
++
++ [18]telnet.htm
++ Detailed documentation of Kermit's Telnet client, updated for
++ C-Kermit 8.0.
++
++ [19]ftpscripts.html
++ Tutorial: Writing FTP automation scripts
++
++ [20]ckcbwr.html
++ Platform-independent C-Kermit hints and tips. Also distributed
++ in plain text form as [21]ckcbwr.txt
++
++ [22]ckubwr.html
++ Unix-specific C-Kermit hints and tips. Also distributed in
++ plain text form as [23]ckubwr.txt.
++
++ [24]ckvbwr.html
++ VMS-specific C-Kermit hints and tips. Also distributed in plain
++ text form as [25]ckvbwr.txt.
++
++ [26]ckuins.html
++ Unix C-Kermit installation instructions. Also distributed in
++ plain text form as [27]ckuins.txt.
++
++ [28]ckvins.html
++ VMS C-Kermit installation instructions. Also distributed in
++ plain text form as [29]ckvins.txt.
++
++ [30]ckccfg.html
++ Compile-time configuration options. Also distributed in plain
++ text form as [31]ckccfg.txt.
++
++ [32]ckcplm.html
++ C-Kermit Program Logic Manual. Also distributed in plain text
++ form as [33]ckcplm.txt.
++
++ [34]iksd.html
++ Internet Kermit Service Aministrators Guide for Unix.
++
++ [35]skermit.html
++ C-Kermit as an SSH Subsystem (SFTP server replacement).
++
++ [ [36]Top ] [ [37]C-Kermit ] [ [38]Kermit Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++CONTENTS
++
++ [39]0. WHAT'S NEW
++ [40]1. FIXES SINCE VERSION 7.0.196
++ [41]2. SSH AND HTTP
++ [42]2.1. SSH Connections
++ [43]2.2. HTTP Connections
++ [44]2.2.1. HTTP Command Switches
++ [45]2.2.2. HTTP Action Commands
++ [46]2.2.3. HTTP Headers
++ [47]2.2.4. Secure HTTP Connections
++ [48]2.2.5. HTTP Variables
++ [49]2.2.6. The HTTP Command-Line Personality
++ [50]3. THE BUILT-IN FTP CLIENT
++ [51]3.1. Making and Managing FTP Connections
++ [52]3.1.1. Kermit Command-Line Options for FTP
++ [53]3.1.2. The FTP Command-Line Personality
++ [54]3.1.3. The FTP URL Interpreter
++ [55]3.1.4. Interactive FTP Session Establishment
++ [56]3.2. Making Secure FTP Connections
++ [57]3.3. Setting FTP Preferences
++ [58]3.4. Managing Directories and Files
++ [59]3.5. Uploading Files With FTP
++ [60]3.5.1. FTP PUT Switches
++ [61]3.5.2. Update Mode
++ [62]3.5.3. Recovery
++ [63]3.6. Downloading Files With FTP
++ [64]3.6.1. FTP GET Switches
++ [65]3.6.2. Filename Collisions
++ [66]3.6.3. Recovery
++ [67]3.7. Translating Character Sets
++ [68]3.7.1. Character Sets and Uploading
++ [69]3.7.2. Character Sets and Downloading
++ [70]3.8. FTP Command Shortcuts
++ [71]3.9. Dual Sessions
++ [72]3.10. Automating FTP Sessions
++ [73]3.10.1. FTP-Specific Variables and Functions
++ [74]3.10.2. Examples
++ [75]3.10.3. Automating Secure FTP Connections
++ [76]3.11. Advanced FTP Protocol Features [77]4. FILE SCANNING
++ [78]5. FILE AND DIRECTORY NAMES CONTAINING SPACES
++ [79]6. OTHER COMMAND PARSING IMPROVEMENTS
++ [80]6.1. Grouping Macro Arguments
++ [81]6.2. Directory and File Name Completion
++ [82]6.3. Passing Arguments to Command Files
++ [83]6.4. More-Prompting
++ [84]6.5. Commas in Macro Definitions
++ [85]6.6. Arrow Keys
++ [86]7. NEW COMMANDS AND SWITCHES
++ [87]8. SCRIPTING IMPROVEMENTS
++ [88]8.1. Performance and Debugging
++ [89]8.2. Using Macros as Numeric Variables
++ [90]8.3. New IF Conditions
++ [91]8.4. The ON_UNKNOWN_COMMAND and ON_CD Macros
++ [92]8.5. The SHOW MACRO Command
++ [93]8.6. Arrays
++ [94]8.7. New or Improved Built-in Variables and Functions
++ [95]8.8. The RETURN and END Commands
++ [96]8.9. UNDEFINing Groups of Variables
++ [97]8.10. The INPUT and MINPUT Commands
++ [98]8.11. Learned Scripts
++ [99]8.12. Pattern Matching
++ [100]8.13. Dates and Times
++ [101]8.14. Trapping Keyboard Interruption
++ [102]9. S-EXPRESSIONS
++ [103]9.1. What is an S-Expression?
++ [104]9.2. Integer and Floating-Point-Arithmetic
++ [105]9.3. How to Use S-Expressions
++ [106]9.4. Summary of Built-in Constants and Operators
++ [107]9.5. Variables
++ [108]9.6. Assignments and Scope
++ [109]9.7. Conditional Expressions
++ [110]9.8. Extensibility
++ [111]9.9. Examples
++ [112]9.10. Differences from Algebraic Notation
++ [113]9.11.Differences from Lisp
++ [114]10. FILE TRANSFER
++ [115]11. MODEMS AND DIALING
++ [116]12. TERMINAL CONNECTION
++ [117]13. CHARACTER SETS
++ [118]14. DIALOUT FROM TELNET TERMINAL SERVERS
++ [119]15. COPING WITH BROKEN KERMIT PARTNERS
++ [120]16. NEW COMMAND-LINE OPTIONS
++ [121]17. LOGS
++
++ [ [122]Top ] [ [123]C-Kermit ] [ [124]Kermit Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++0. WHAT'S NEW
++
++ The Initialization and Customization Files
++ C-Kermit 8.0 now supports specification of the initialization
++ file name (path) in an environment variable, CKERMIT_INI. It
++ also relies far less than before on the initialization for
++ functioning. See [125]Section 5 of the Unix C-Kermit
++ [126]installation instructions for details. As of version
++ 8.0.201, C-Kermit also executes your customization file (if you
++ have one) even if the initialization file was not found.
++ Previously, the customization file was executed by a TAKE
++ command in the initialization file (and it still is, if an
++ initialization is found).
++
++ Incompatible Changes
++ As always, we do our best to avoid changes that break existing
++ scripts. However, C-Kermit 8.0 does include a rather pervasive
++ syntax change that might alter the behavior of scripts that
++ depend on the previous behavior. As described in [127]Section
++ 5, C-Kermit now accepts doublequotes in most contexts where you
++ previously had to use braces to group multiple words into a
++ single field, or to force inclusion of leading or trailing
++ blanks. Most noticeably, in C-Kermit 7.0 and earlier:
++
++ echo {this is a string}
++
++ would print:
++
++ this is a string
++
++ whereas:
++
++ echo "this is a string"
++
++ printed:
++
++ "this is a string"
++
++ In C-Kermit 8.0, both print:
++
++ this is a string
++
++ To force the doublequotes to be treated as part of the string,
++ use either of the following forms:
++
++ echo {"this is a string"}
++ echo ""this is a string""
++
++ Similarly, to force braces to be treated as part of the string:
++
++ echo "{this is a string}"
++ echo {{this is a string}}
++
++ Other incompatibilities:
++
++ 1. Using the SET HOST command to make HTTP connections is no
++ longer supported. Instead, use the new HTTP OPEN command,
++ described in [128]Section 2.2.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.1 Alpha.01 (8 December 2000)
++
++ Its major new features are those listed in the [129]Table of
++ Contents: the FTP client, file scanning, command parsing and
++ scripting improvements, S-Expressions, and support for the
++ Telnet Com Port Option, plus wider availability of the
++ Kerberos, SSL/TLS, and SRP security options for secure Internet
++ connections.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.1.199 Alpha.02 (4 January 2001)
++
++ + C-Kermit now accepts [130]FTP, TELNET, and IKSD URLs as its
++ first command-line argument.
++ + Character-set translation added to the FTP client for
++ [131]filenames.
++ + Optional [132]setting of date of incoming files by FTP [M]GET
++ from the server date.
++ + [133]FTP CHECK filename added to let FTP client check the
++ existence of a file on the server.
++ + [134]FTP GET /NAMELIST:filename added to get list of server
++ filenames into a local file.
++ + [135]FTP [M]PUT /SERVER-RENAME:template added to make server
++ rename a file as indicated by the template after it has
++ arrived completely.
++ + FTP [M]GET /SERVER-RENAME:template added to make server
++ rename a file as indicated by the template after it has been
++ sent completely.
++ + FTP [136]VDIRECTORY added for getting verbose directory
++ listings from TOPS-20.
++ + [137]FTP TYPE TENEX added for transferring 8-bit binary files
++ with PDP-10s.
++ + Added [138]automatic text/binary mode switching for FTP
++ [M]GET, based on filename patterns (e.g. *.zip, *.gz, *.exe
++ are binary; *.txt, *.c are text).
++ + [139]SET SEND I-PACKETS OFF added for coping with Kermit
++ servers that do not support I packets.
++ + A new option was added to [140]\fword() and \fsplit() for
++ parsing comma-separated lists that might contain empty
++ elements.
++ + Bug fixes including:
++ o {} or "" could not be used as expected to represent the
++ empty string.
++ o ,- on a line by itself in a macro definition caused
++ subsequent statements to be skipped.
++ o FTP [M]GET didn't work right if path segments were
++ included in the filespec.
++ o FTP MGET, if interrupted, did not clear its file list.
++ o Various problems with FTP PUT /AS-NAME that nobody
++ noticed.
++ o Some FTP messages and displays interfered with each
++ other.
++ o Parsing of YESTERDAY, TODAY, and TOMORROW in date-time
++ fields was broken.
++ o Automatic old-to-new dialing directory format conversion
++ was broken on VMS.
++ o Various source-code portability problems fixed.
++ + Improvement of various HELP and SHOW messages.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.1.199 Alpha.04 (1 April 2001)
++
++ + Big changes:
++ o Changed default modem type from NONE to GENERIC.
++ o Generic dialing now sends no init string at all.
++ o Changed default terminal bytesize from 7 to 8.
++ + New features:
++ o SET SESSION-LOG TIMESTAMPED-TEXT for timestamped session
++ log.
++ + New modem types:
++ o Conexant modem family
++ o Lucent VENUS chipset
++ o PCTel V.90 chipset
++ o Zoom V.90
++ o Zoom V.92
++ + FTP client:
++ o FTP OPEN /PASSIVE and /ACTIVE switches added.
++ o Now works with servers that that don't include path in
++ NLST response.
++ o Fixed SEND /RECURSIVE not to follow symlinks (UNIX).
++ o SET FTP VERBOSE-MODE default is now OFF instead of ON.
++ + Kermit protocol:
++ o Fixed what I hope is the last "Receive window full"
++ error.
++ o SET PREFIXING or SET CONTROL PREFIX now automatically
++ sets CLEARCHANNEL OFF.
++ o Fixed incorrect report of number of files transferred at
++ end of transfer.
++ o Fixed SEND /RECURSIVE not to follow symlinks (UNIX).
++ + UNIX:
++ o HTTP and shadow passwords enabled for SCO 5.0.6.
++ o Even with SET FILENAMES CONVERTED, spaces were still
++ accepted in incoming filenames; now they are converted
++ to underscores.
++ o Added support for compile-time mktemp()/mkstemp()
++ selection.
++ + VMS:
++ o Session-log format for scripted sessions fixed.
++ + Scripting:
++ o Fixed \frdir() not to follow symlinks (UNIX).
++ o Fixed \fday() not to dump core for dates prior to 17 Mar
++ 1858.
++ + General:
++ o "Closing blah..." message upon exit could not be
++ surpressed.
++ o Added /PAGE and /NOPAGE to DELETE switches.
++ o Added GO response for DELETE /ASK (delete all the rest
++ without asking).
++ o Added GO response to "more?" prompt (for multi-page
++ screen output).
++ o Updated HELP texts.
++
++ C-Kermit 7.1.199 Beta.01 (10 May 2001)
++
++ + FTP client verbosity adjustments.
++ + Bug with generic modem dialing pausing several secs fixed.
++ + SET HOST /USER:, SET LOGIN USERID, etc, fixed when given no
++ user ID.
++ + A couple \v(dm_blah) dial modifier variables added.
++ + "--version" command-line switch added.
++ + Fixed NetBSD serial-port DTR handling.
++ + Lots of syntax cleanups for Flexelint and gcc -Wall.
++ + Fixed modem-type aliases to not take precedence over real
++ names.
++ + Fixed funny treatment of doublequotes by ECHO command.
++ + Enabled SET SESSION-LOG for VMS and other non-UNIX platorms.
++ + Fixed changing direction in command history buffer.
++ + Fixed handling of IKSD URLs.
++ + Made sure DELETE prints a message if it got any errors.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0.200 Beta.02 (28 June 2001)
++
++ + Major version number increased from 7 to 8.
++ + [141]SSH command.
++ + More-consistent Kermit protocol defaults.
++ + CONNECT idle timeout and action selection.
++ + CONNECT status variable.
++ + A way to allocate more space for filename lists.
++ + Pseudoterminal handler fixed for late-model Linuxes.
++ + Command-line option -dd for timestamped debug log.
++ + Download directory now works for external protocols too.
++ + GREP /COUNT:variable.
++ + SET ATTRIBUTE RECORD-FORMAT { OFF, ON }.
++ + Bug fixes.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0.200 Beta.03 (9 Sep 2001)
++
++ + [142]HTTP 1.1 connections and scripting
++ + [143]ON_CTRLC macro for trapping Ctrl-C in scripts
++ + [144]Date-time parsing improvements, timezones, comparison,
++ arithmetic
++ + [145]Pattern-matching improvements
++ + FTP improvements
++ + SET EXIT HANGUP { ON, OFF }
++ + SET FILE EOF { CTRL-Z, LENGTH }
++ + ASK[Q] /TIMEOUT
++ + Bug fixes
++ + New platforms
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0.200 Beta.04 (16 Nov 2001)
++
++ + [146]New Unix man page
++ + [147]New Unix installation instructions
++ + SET TELOPT policies are now enforced on non-Telnet ports if
++ the server begins Telnet negotiations.
++ + SET TERMINAL IDLE-ACTION { TELNET-NOP, TELNET-AYT }.
++ + UUCP lockfile creation race condition fixed.
++ + Dialout, modem signals, hangup, hardware flow control, etc,
++ tested extensively on many platforms, numerous problems
++ fixed.
++ + Improved hints when dialing fails.
++ + SET STOP-BITS 2 can now be given without SET FLOW HARDWARE.
++ + Major improvements in RFC 2217 Telnet Com-Port Control.
++ + Improved ability to REDIAL a modem server port.
++ + kermit -h now shows the command name in the usage usage
++ string.
++ + kermit -h now shows ALL command-line options.
++ + kermit -s blah, where blah is a symlink, now works.
++ + --noperms command-line option = SET ATTRIBUTE PERMISSIONS
++ OFF.
++ + HTTP and HTTPS URLs now supported on the command line.
++ + An http command-line personality is now available.
++ + Initialization file streamlined to load faster, anachronisms
++ removed.
++ + Updated NEWS, INTRO, HELP text, SHOW commands. In particular,
++ see SHOW COMM, HELP SET LINE, HELP WAIT.
++ + Date/time arithmetic routines converted from floating-point
++ to integer arithmetic (internally) for greater accuracy and
++ portability.
++ + Quoted strings containing commas no longer break macro
++ execution.
++ + Dynamic Kermit file-transfer timeouts are now much more
++ aggressive.
++ + New "hot keys" to turn debug.log on/off during file transfer.
++ + Improved hints when file transfer fails.
++ + FTP CD orientation messages are now printed.
++ + -R now accepted on the FTP command line to request Recursion.
++ + -m allows Active or Passive mode to be chosen on the FTP
++ command line.
++ + -dd on the FTP command line creates a timestamped debug.log.
++ + FTP command-line security options filled in.
++ + Improved automatic text/binary mode switching for MGET.
++ + Removed spurious error messages that sometimes occur during
++ MGET.
++ + DIRECTORY, GREP, TYPE, HEAD, and TAIL now have a /OUTPUT:file
++ option.
++ + TYPE /NUMBER adds line numbers.
++ + CAT = TYPE /NOPAGE; MORE = TYPE /PAGE.
++ + GETOK ?-help fixed.
++ + \v(timestamp) (= "\v(ndate) \v(time)")
++ + \v(hour) (hour of the day, 0-23)
++ + \funix2dospath() converts a UNIX path (/) to a DOS one (\).
++ + \fdos2unixpath() converts a DOS (Windows, OS/2) path to a
++ UNIX one.
++ + \fkeywordval() parses name=value pair, allows macro keyword
++ parameters.
++ + We now make every attempt to not write passwords to the
++ debug.log.
++ + New Certficate Authority certificates file, includes the
++ Kermit Project at Columbia University so you can access our
++ IKSD securely.
++ + Secure targets improved and better documented in Unix
++ makefile.
++ + All Linux (libc and glibc) builds consolidated under "make
++ linux".
++ + HP-UX makefile targets now have consistent names.
++ + New aix50 and aix51 targets added.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0.200 Final (12 Dec 2001)
++
++ + Remote/local-mode confusion on some platforms introduced in
++ Beta.04, fixed.
++ + Many of the makefile targets adjusted, new ones added.
++ + New "make install" target should please most people.
++ + New command: SHOW IKSD.
++ + FTP over TLS.
++ + Last-minute touchups to text messages, HELP text, etc.
++ + Enable modem-signal reading for SCO OSR5 and Unixware 7.
++ + Special superfast TRANSMIT /BINARY /NOECHO /NOWAIT mode
++ added.
++ + Fixed PBX dialing in unmarked-area-code case.
++ + Improved SHOW COMMUNICATIONS tells lockfile directory,
++ typical dialout device name.
++ + Some FTP OPEN command parsing problems fixed.
++ + Some errors in date arithmetic fixed.
++ + New command: SET TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD { ..., ERROR { STOP,
++ CONTINUE } }
++ + New command: HELP FIREWALL.
++ + SET MODEM HANGUP-METHOD DTR added as synomym for RS232-SIGNAL
++ + Support for secure URL protocols added: telnets:, ftps:,
++ https:.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0.201 (8 Feb 2002)
++
++ + Installability as an [148]SSH v2 Subsystem.
++ + [149]SET LOCUS command.
++ + [150]L-versions of CD, DIR, DELETE, MKDIR, etc, to force
++ local execution.
++ + [151]USER and ACCOUNT added as synonyms for FTP USER and FTP
++ ACCOUNT.
++ + [152]SHOW VARIABLES now accepts a list of variables.
++ + Rudimentary support for [153]Caller ID when receiving phone
++ calls.
++ + Up/Down [154]Arrow-key navigation of command history buffer.
++ + [155]Automatic execution of customization file if init file
++ is missing.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0.206 Beta.01 (11 Oct 2002)
++
++ New commands:
++
++ o ORIENTATION lists location-related variables and their
++ values.
++ o KCD changes to special directories by their symbolic
++ names ("kcd ?" for a list).
++ o SET CD HOME path to specify home directory for CD and
++ KCD commands.
++ o CONTINUE given at top level is equivalent to END --
++ handy when PROMPT'ed out of a script, to continue the
++ script.
++
++ New switches or operands for existing commands:
++
++ o GETOK /TIMEOUT
++ o ASK, ASKQ, GETOK /QUIET (suppresses error message on
++ timeout)
++ o COPY /APPEND now allows concatenating multiple source
++ files into one dest file.
++ o SET TCP { HTTP-PROXY, SOCKS-SERVER } /USER, /PASSWORD.
++ o DIRECTORY command now accepts multiple filespecs, e.g.
++ "dir a b c".
++
++ SET QUIET ON now also applies to:
++
++ o SET HOST connection progress messages.
++ o "Press the X or E key to cancel" file-transfer message.
++ o REMOTE CD response.
++ o REMOTE LOGIN response.
++
++ Improvements and new features:
++
++ o Numerous FTP client fixes and new features, listed
++ below.
++ o C-Kermit, when in remote mode at the end of a file
++ transfer, now prints a one-line "where" message. Control
++ with SET TRANSFER REPORT.
++ o Unix makefile "install" target now creates an UNINSTALL
++ script.
++ o Improved operation and performance on RFC 2217 Telnet
++ connections.
++ o Improved CONNECT (interactive terminal connection)
++ performance.
++ o HELP text updated for many commands.
++
++ New or fixed makefile targets:
++
++ o Solaris 9 (several variations)
++ o Concurrent PowerMAX
++ o Mac OS X 10.2
++ o FreeBSD 1.0
++ o FreeBSD 4.6, 5.0
++ o AIX 5.2, 5.3
++
++ Bugs fixed (general):
++
++ o Failure to run in VMS Batch fixed.
++ o LDIRECTORY fixed to run Kermit's built-in DIRECTORY
++ command rather than an external one.
++ o Fixed Solaris and other SVORPOSIX builds to find out
++ their full hostnames rather than just the "uname -n"
++ name.
++ o Fixed some problems matching strings that start with
++ ".".
++ o Fixed some problems matching pattern that contain
++ {a,b,c} lists.
++ o Fixed erroneous reporting of text-mode reception as
++ binary when sender did not report the file size
++ (cosmetic only).
++ o Many problems with SWITCH statements fixed.
++ o Fixed SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY /DOTFILES to work for server
++ too.
++ o Fixed DELETE to print an error message if the file was
++ not found.
++ o Fixed SET CONTROL UNPREFIX ALL and SET PREFIXING NONE to
++ do the same thing.
++ o Fixed bugs executing macros from within the ON_EXIT
++ macro.
++ o \fday() and \fnday() fixed for dates prior to 17 Nov
++ 1858.
++ o Serial speed-changing bug in Linux fixed.
++ o "Unbalanced braces" script parsing errors when using
++ \{number} fixed.
++ o "if defined \v(name)" fixed to behave as described in
++ the book.
++ o Fixed Problems caused by LOCAL variables whose names are
++ left substrings of macro names.
++ o The INPUT command was fixed to honor the PARITY setting.
++ o Fixed bug with COPY to existing file that is longer than
++ source file.
++ o REINPUT command failed to strip braces/quotes around its
++ target string.
++ o Network directory lookups didn't work for SSH
++ connections.
++ o REMOTE SET { FILE, TRANSFER } CHARACTER-SET fixed.
++ o Closed some holes whereby an incompletely received file
++ was not deleted when SET FILE INCOMPLETE is DISCARD,
++ e.g. when the Kermit is hung up upon.
++ o SET XFER CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT fixed to do the same
++ as SET XFER TRANSLATION OFF.
++ o SET HOST PTY (e.g. SSH) connection fixed to pass along
++ window-size changes.
++ o C-Kermit search path for TAKE files was accidentally
++ disabled.
++
++ FTP client bugs fixed:
++
++ o Character set translation was broken on little-endian
++ (e.g. PC) architectures.
++ o FTP PUT /SERVER-RENAME:, /RENAME-TO:, /MOVE-TO: switches
++ were sticky.
++ o Make SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL apply to FTP.
++ o Make SET FILE INCOMPLETE { KEEP, DISCARD } apply to FTP.
++ o FTP MGET /UPDATE handled equal times incorrectly.
++ o FTP MGET /RECOVER fixed to ignore file dates, use only
++ size.
++ o FTP MGET /RECOVER sometimes downloaded files it didn't
++ need to.
++ o FTP downloads with TRANSFER DISPLAY BRIEF could give
++ misleading error messages.
++ o FTP MGET temp file not deleted if FTP DEBUG set to OFF
++ after it was ON.
++ o LOCUS not switched back when FTP connection is lost.
++ o Set incoming file date even if it was not completely
++ received.
++ o FTP MGET sent SIZE and MDTM commands even when it didn't
++ have to.
++ o FTP MGET sent SIZE and MDTM commands even when it knew
++ they wouldn't work.
++ o FTP MGET failed if no files were selected for download.
++ o FTP MGET a* b* c* would fail to get any c*'s if no b*'s
++ existed.
++ o Big problems canceling MGET with Ctrl-C.
++ o Some extraneous LOCUS dialogs squelched.
++ o Some inconsistencies in SET FTP FILENAMES AUTO fixed.
++ o Fixed file-descriptor pileup after multiple MGETs when
++ using mkstemp().
++ o Fixed "mget foo", where foo is a directory name.
++
++ FTP improvements:
++
++ o New [156]FTP protocol features added (FEAT, MLSD).
++ o FTP MGET /RECURSIVE now works as expected if server
++ supports MLSD.
++ o FTP MGET /DATES-DIFFER to download if local and remote
++ file dates differ.
++ o FTP DATES default changed to ON.
++ o FTP MPUT, MGET /EXCEPT now allows up to 64 patterns (up
++ from 8).
++ o Top-level SITE and PASSIVE commands added for
++ convenience.
++ o MGET /COLLISION:APPEND /AS-NAME:newfile *.* puts all
++ remote files into one local file.
++ o SET FTP SERVER-TIME-OFFSET for when server has wrong
++ timezone set.
++ o Allow for alternative server interpretations of [M]MPUT
++ /UNIQUE.
++ o SET FTP ANONOMOUS-PASSWORD lets you specify the default
++ anonymous password.
++ o Allow "GET /RECURSIVE path/file" to force local
++ subdirectory creation.
++ o SET FTP DISPLAY is like SET TRANSFER DISPLAY but applies
++ only to FTP.
++ o FTP { ENABLE, DISABLE } new-protocol-feature-name.
++ o FTP MGET /NODOTFILES.
++ o Debug log now records FTP commands and responses in
++ grep-able format.
++
++ [ [157]Top ] [ [158]Contents ] [ [159]C-Kermit ] [ [160]Kermit Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++1. FIXES SINCE VERSION 7.0.196 First, the changes from 7.0.196 to 7.0.197...
++Source and makefile tweaks to get successful builds on platforms that were not
++available in time for the 7.0 release:
++
++ * 4.2BSD
++ * 4.3BSD
++ * AIX 4.3
++ * AT&T 3B2 and 3B20
++ * BeOS 4.5
++ * CLIX
++ * Interactive UNIX System V/386 R3.2 V4.1.1
++ * OS-9/68000
++ * OSF/1 1.3.
++ * PS/2 AIX 1.2.1
++ * SCO OSR5.0.x
++ * SCO Xenix 2.3.4
++ * SINIX 5.41/Intel
++ * Stratus FTX
++ * Stratus VOS
++ * SunOS 4.1 with X.25
++ * Ultrix 4.2
++ * Unixware 2.0
++
++ There were no functional changes from 196 to 197.
++
++ Fixes applied after C-Kermit 7.0.197 was released:
++
++ Source code: Big flexelint and "gcc -Wall" audit and cleanup.
++
++ Configuration:
++ * Solaris RTS/CTS (hardware flow control) didn't work.
++ * BSDI RTS/CTS worked only in one direction.
++ * FreeBSD 4.0 with ncurses 5.0 broke interactive command parsing.
++ * QNX-32 build lacked -DBIGBUFOK so couldn't execute big macros.
++
++ Connections:
++ * SET HOST /PTY didn't work on some platforms.
++ * Broken SET HOST /USER:xxx /PASSWORD:yyy /ACCOUNT:zzz switches
++ fixed.
++ * Transparent printing was broken in Unix.
++ * ANSWER 0 (wait forever) didn't work.
++ * Some problems in Multitech modem command strings.
++ * Spurious "?Sorry, can't condition console terminal" errors.
++ * Disabling modem command strings by setting them to nothing broke
++ dialing.
++ * SET DIAL TIMEOUT value was usually ignored.
++ * SET DIAL METHOD PULSE didn't work.
++ * Certain modem commands, if changed, not refreshed if modem type
++ changed.
++ * SET SESSION-LOG command was missing from VMS.
++ * VMS session log format fixed for scripts.
++ * HANGUP by dropping DTR didn't work in NetBSD.
++ * SET FLOW /AUTO versus SET FLOW confusion fixed.
++ * Spurious secondary Solaris lockfile removed.
++ * SCO OSR5 DTR On/Off hangup.
++ * UUCP lockfile race condition.
++
++ Commands and scripts:
++ * Missing CAUTIOUS and FAST commands restored.
++ * Broken PTY command in late-model Linuxes fixed (API changed).
++ * Fixed off-by-one error in command recall when switching direction.
++ * Fixed recall of commands that contain '?'.
++ * COPY /SWAP-BYTES didn't work on some architectures.
++ * Various combinations of COPY switches didn't work.
++ * Various problems with COPY or RENAME with a directory name as
++ target.
++ * SHIFT didn't decrement \v(argc) if used within IF, ELSE, or SWITCH
++ block.
++ * SHIFT didn't affect the \%* variable.
++ * Divide by zero improperly handled in some \function()s.
++ * Problems with RETURN from right-recursive functions.
++ * FSEEK /LINE \%c LAST didn't work if already at end.
++ * Some buffer vulnerabilities and potential memory leaks were
++ discovered and fixed.
++ * \frdirectory() fixed not to follow symbolic links.
++ * SET EXIT WARNING OFF fixed to work when EXIT given in a script.
++ * Missing DELETE and MKDIR error message fixed.
++ * \fday() core dump for ancient dates fixed.
++
++ File transfer:
++ * SEND /COMMAND was broken.
++ * CRECEIVE was broken (but RECEIVE /COMMAND was OK).
++ * Quoting wildcard chars in filenames didn't work.
++ * Problems canceling streaming file transfers with X or Z.
++ * Problems shifting between streaming and windowing file transfer.
++ * Non-FULL file-transfer displays erroneously said STREAMING when
++ not.
++ * An active SEND-LIST prevented GET from working.
++ * SET SERVER GET-PATH interpretation of relative names like "." was
++ wrong.
++ * The MAIL command was broken.
++ * "kermit -s *" might have skipped some files.
++ * Transaction log entries were not made for external protocol
++ transfers.
++ * File count report fixed to show number of files actually
++ transferred.
++ * Fixed filename conversion to convert spaces to underscores.
++ * Made SET PREFIXING / SET CONTROL PREFIX also adjust CLEARCHANNEL.
++ * More "Receive window full" errors fixed.
++ * Broken terminal buffering after curses display in Solaris fixed.
++ * SET FILE INCOMPLETE DISCARD did not work in all cases.
++ * Packet log changed to reformat the start-of-packet character
++ printably.
++ * Dynamic timeouts could grow ridiculously large.
++
++ Character sets:
++ * Hebrew-7 translations missed the letter Tav.
++ * C1 area of CP1252 was ignored.
++ * SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT could give garbage
++ translations.
++ * TRANSLATE might not work on Little Endian architectures.
++ * Insufficient range checking in certain TRANSLATE operations.
++
++ The following bugs in C-Kermit 8.0.200 were fixed in 8.0.201:
++
++ * An obscure path through the code could cause the Unix version of
++ C-Kermit to dump core during its startup sequence. This happened
++ to only one person, but now it's fixed.
++ * When C-Kermit 8.0 is in Kermit server mode and the client says
++ "get blah", where blah (on the server) is a symlink rather than a
++ real file, the server unreasonably refused to send the linked-to
++ file.
++ * When C-Kermit is an FTP client and says "get foo/bar" (i.e. a
++ filename that includes one or more path segments), it failed to
++ accept the incoming file (this happened only with GET, not MGET).
++ * Array references should be case insensitive but only lowercase
++ array letters were accepted.
++ * SHOW VARIABLES dumped core on \v(sexpression) and \v(svalue).
++ * Spurious refusals of remote directory listings if the remote
++ server's date was set in the past.
++ * In AIX, and maybe elsewhere too, Kermit's COPY command always
++ failed with "Source and destination are the same file" when the
++ destination file didn't exist.
++ * The VMS version of C-Kermit did not work in Batch or when SPAWN'd.
++ To compound the problem, it also pretty much ignored the -B and -z
++ command-line options, whose purpose is to work around such
++ problems.
++ * C-Kermit 8.0 could not be built on IRIX 5.x.
++ * The C-Kermit 8.0 build for QNX6 said it was an "(unknown
++ version)".
++
++ Other fixes are listed in the [161]previous section.
++
++ [ [162]Top ] [ [163]Contents ] [ [164]C-Kermit ] [ [165]Kermit Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++2. SSH AND HTTP
++
++ 2.1. SSH Connections
++
++ This section does not apply to [166]Kermit 95 2.0, which has its
++ own built-in SSH client, which is documented [167]SEPARATELY.
++
++ On most UNIX platforms, C-Kermit can make SSH (Secure SHell)
++ connection by running the external SSH command or program through its
++ pseudoterminal interface. The command is:
++
++ SSH text
++ Tells Kermit to start the external SSH client, passing the
++ given text to it on the command line. Normally the text is just
++ the hostname, but it can be anything else that is acceptable to
++ the ssh client. If the command succeeds, the connection is made
++ and Kermit automatically enters CONNECT (terminal) mode. You
++ can use the SSH command to make a connection to any host that
++ has an SSH server.
++
++ Kermit's SSH command gives you all the features of Kermit on an SSH
++ connection: command language, file transfer, character-set
++ translation, scripting, and all the rest. By default, C-Kermit invokes
++ SSH with "-e none", which disables the ssh escape character and makes
++ the connection transparent for purposes of file transfer. You can,
++ however, change the SSH invocation to whatever else you might need (an
++ explicit path, additional command-line arguments, etc) with:
++
++ SET SSH COMMAND text
++ Specifies the system command that Kermit's SSH command should
++ use to invoke the external SSH client. Use this command to
++ supply a specific path or alternative name, or to include
++ different or more command-line options.
++
++ In most cases, these connections work quite well. They can be scripted
++ like any other connection, and file transfer goes as fast as, or
++ faster than, on a regular Telnet connection. In some cases, however,
++ the underlying pseudoterminal driver is a limiting factor, resulting
++ in slow or failed file transfers. Sometimes you can work around such
++ problems by reducing the Kermit packet length. Note that Kermit does
++ not consider SSH connections to be reliable, so it does not offer to
++ use streaming in Kermit protocol transfers (but you can force it with
++ SET RELIABLE or SET STREAMING if you wish).
++
++ The SSH command is like the TELNET command: it enters CONNECT mode
++ automatically when the connection is made. Therefore, to script an SSH
++ connection, use:
++
++ set host /pty ssh -e none [ other-options ] host
++ if fail ...
++
++ to make the connection.
++
++ Here's a sequence that can be used to make a connection to a given
++ host using Telnet if the host accepts it, otherwise SSH:
++
++ if not defined \%1 exit 1 Usage: \%0 host
++ set quiet on
++ set host \%1 23 /telnet
++ if fail {
++ set host /pty ssh -l \m(user) -e none \%1
++ if fail exit 1 \%1: Telnet and SSH both fail
++ echo SSH connection to \%1 successful
++ } else {
++ echo Telnet connection to \%1 successful
++ }
++
++ In SSH v2, it is possible to make an SSH connection direct to a Kermit
++ server system if the host administrator has configured the SSH server
++ to allow this; [168]CLICK HERE for details.
++
++ Since Kermit uses external ssh client software, and since there are
++ different ssh clients (and different releases of each one), the exact
++ command to be used to make an SSH/Kermit connection can vary. Here is
++ the command for the OpenSSH 3.0.2p1 client:
++
++set host /pipe ssh -e none [ -l username ] -T -s hostname kermit
++
++ Example:
++
++set host /pipe ssh -e none -l olga -T -s hq.xyzcorp.com kermit
++
++ The SSH client might or might not prompt you for a password or other
++ information before it makes the connection; this depends on your SSH
++ configuration (your public and private keys, your authorized hosts
++ file, etc). Here's a brief synopsis of the OpenSSH client command
++ syntax ("man ssh" for details):
++
++ -e none
++ This tells the SSH client to use no escape character. Since we
++ will be transferring files across the connection, we don't want
++ the connection to suddenly block because some character in the
++ data.
++
++ -l username
++ This is the username on the remote host. You can omit the -l
++ option and its argument if your local and remote usernames are
++ the same. If they are different, you must supply the remote
++ username.
++
++ -T
++ This tells the SSH client to tell the SSH server not to
++ allocate a pseudoterminal. We are not making a terminal
++ connection, we don't need a terminal, and in fact if a terminal
++ were allocated on the remote end, the connection would not
++ work.
++
++ -s ... kermit
++ This tells the SSH client to tell the SSH server to start the
++ specified subsystem ("kermit") once the connection is made. The
++ subsystem name comes after the hostname.
++
++ hostname
++ The IP host name or address of the desired host.
++
++ You might want to include other or additional ssh command-line
++ options; "man ssh" explains what they are. Here are some examples for
++ the OpenSSH 3.0.2p1 client:
++
++ -oClearAllForwardings yes
++ -oForwardAgent no
++ -oForwardX11 no
++ -oFallbackToRsh no
++ These ensure that a secure connection is used and that the
++ connection used for file transfer is not also used for
++ forwarding other things that might be specified in the
++ ssh_config file.
++
++ -oProtocol 2
++ (i.e. SSH v2) Ensures that the negotiated protocol supports
++ subsystems.
++
++ Once you have an SSH connection to a Kermit server, it's just like any
++ other connection to a Kermit server (and very similar to a connection
++ to an FTP server). You give the client file transfer and management
++ commands for the server, and the server executes them. Of course you
++ can also give the client any other commands you wish.
++
++ [ [169]SSH Kermit Server Subsystem ] [ [170]Kermit 95 Built-in SSH
++ Client ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2.2. HTTP Connections
++
++ Hypertext Transfer Protocol, or HTTP, is the application protocol of
++ the World Wide Web (WWW), used between Web browsers (clients) and Web
++ servers. It allows a client to get files from websites, upload files
++ to websites, delete files from websites, get information about website
++ directories and files, and interact with server-side CGI scripts.
++ C-Kermit includes an HTTP client capable of both clear-text and secure
++ HTTP connections, that can do all these tasks and can be automated
++ through the Kermit scripting language.
++
++ Although C-Kermit 7.0 could make HTTP connections to Web servers, it
++ could do so only when no other connection was open, and the procedure
++ was somewhat awkward. C-Kermit 8.0 improves matters by:
++
++ * Allowing an HTTP connection to be open at the same time as a
++ regular SET LINE or SET HOST connection, and also at the same time
++ as an FTP connection ([171]Section 3);
++ * Upgrading the HTTP protocol level from 1.0 to 1.1, thus allowing
++ for persistent connections, in which a series of commands can be
++ sent on the same connection, rather than only one as in HTTP 1.0
++ (and C-Kermit 7.0);
++ * Providing for "one-shot" URL-driven HTTP operations such as GET or
++ PUT.
++ * Providing a distinct HTTP command-line personality.
++
++ Persistent HTTP connections are managed with the following commands:
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] OPEN [ security-options ] host-or-url [ port ]
++ Opens a persistent connection to the specified host (IP host
++ name or address) on the specified port. If any switches
++ (options, listed in the next section) are included, their
++ values are saved and used for all subsequent HTTP action
++ commands on the same connection. If no port is specified, HTTP
++ (80) is used. A Uniform Resource Locator (URL, [172]RFC 1738)
++ can be given instead of a hostname (or address) and port (but
++ the URL can not include a directory/file path). The security
++ options are explained [173]below. The HTTP OPEN command
++ replaces the C-Kermit 7.0 SET HOST hostname HTTP command, which
++ no longer works with HTTP GET and related commands.
++
++ HTTP CLOSE
++ Closes any open HTTP connection and clears any saved switch
++ values.
++
++ A URL starts with a protocol name, which must be http or https in this
++ case; optionally includes a username and password; and must contain a
++ host name or address:
++
++ protocol://[user[.password]]@host[:port][URI]
++
++ HTTP is Hypertext Transfer Protocol. HTTPS is the secure (SSL/TLS)
++ version of HTTP. The TCP service port is derived from the protocol
++ prefix (so normally the ":port" field is omitted). Thus the URL
++ protocol name specifies a default TCP service port and the URL user
++ and password fields can take the place of the /USER and /PASSWORD
++ switches ([174]Section 2.2.1). The optional URI is a "compact string
++ of characters for identifying an abstract or physical resource"
++ ([175]RFC 2396), such as a file. It must begin with a slash (/); if
++ the URI is omitted, "/" is supplied. Examples:
++
++ http open http://www.columbia.edu/
++ Equivalent to http open www.columbia.edu or http open
++ www.columbia.edu http.
++
++ http open https://olga.secret@www1.xyzcorp.com/
++ Equivalent to http /user:olga /pass:secret open
++ www1.xyzcorp.com https.
++
++ Persistence is accomplished unilaterally by C-Kermit 8.0. An HTTP 1.0
++ server closes the connection after each action. Although HTTP 1.1
++ allows multiple actions on the same connection, an HTTP 1.1 server
++ tends to close the connection if it is idle for more than a few
++ seconds, to defend itself against denial-of-service attacks. But when
++ you use Kermit's HTTP OPEN command to create a connection, Kermit
++ reopens it automatically (if necessary) for each HTTP action until you
++ close it with HTTP CLOSE, regardless of the server's HTTP protocol
++ version, or how many times it closes the connection.
++
++ Firewalls can be negotiated through proxies with the following
++ commands:
++
++ SET TCP HTTP-PROXY [ host[:port] ]
++ If a host (by hostname or IP address) is specified, Kermit uses
++ it as a proxy server when attempting outgoing TCP connections
++ -- not only HTTP connections, but all TCP/IP connections,
++ Telnet and FTP included. This allows Kermit to adapt to the
++ HTTP firewall penetration method (as opposed to other methods
++ such as SOCKS4). If no hostname or ip-address is specified, any
++ previously specified Proxy server is removed. If no port number
++ is specified, the "http" service is used. This command must be
++ given before the HTTP OPEN command if a proxy is to be used or
++ canceled.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] CONNECT host[:port]
++ Instructs the HTTP server to act as a proxy, establishing a
++ connection to the specified host (IP hostname or address) on
++ the given port (80 = HTTP by default) and to redirect all data
++ transmitted between Kermit and itself to the given host for the
++ life of the connection. This command is to be used only for
++ debugging HTTP proxy connections. If a proxy connection is
++ required, instruct Kermit to use the proxy with the SET TCP
++ HTTP-PROXY command.
++
++ 2.2.1. HTTP Command Switches
++
++ HTTP switches, like all other switches, are optional. When HTTP
++ switches are included with the HTTP OPEN command, they apply
++ automatically to this and all subsequent HTTP actions (GET, PUT, ...)
++ on the same connection until an HTTP CLOSE command is given. So if you
++ include switches (or the equivalent URL fields, such as user and
++ password) in the HTTP OPEN command, you can omit them from subsequent
++ commands on the same connection. If the connection has closed since
++ your last command, it is automatically reopened with the same options.
++
++ If you include switches with an HTTP action command (such as GET or
++ PUT), they apply only to that command.
++
++ /USER:name
++ To be used in case a page requires a username for access. The
++ username is sent with page requests. If it is given with the
++ OPEN command it is saved until needed. If a username is
++ included in a URL, it overrides the username given in the
++ switch. CAUTION: Username and password (and all other
++ information, including credit card numbers and other material
++ that you might prefer to protect from public view) are sent
++ across the network in clear text on regular HTTP connections,
++ but authentication is performed securely on HTTPS connections.
++
++ /PASSWORD:text
++ To be used in case a web page requires a password for access.
++ The password is sent with page requests. If it is given with
++ the OPEN command it is saved until needed. If a password is
++ given in a URL, it overrides the one given here. CAUTION: (same
++ as for /USER:).
++
++ /AGENT:user-agent
++ Identifies the client to the server. Overrides the default
++ agent string, which is "C-Kermit" (for C-Kermit) or "Kermit-95"
++ (for Kermit 95).
++
++ /ARRAY:array-designator
++ Tells Kermit to store the response headers in the given array,
++ one line per element. The array need not be declared in
++ advance. Example: /array:&a.
++
++ /TOSCREEN
++ Tells Kermit to display any response text on the screen. It
++ applies independently of the output file specification; thus it
++ is possible to have the server response go to the screen, a
++ file, both, or neither.
++
++ /HEADER:header-item(s)
++ Used for specifying any optional headers to be sent with HTTP
++ requests.
++
++ /HEADER:tag:value
++
++ To send more than one header, use braces for grouping:
++
++ /HEADER:{{tag:value}{tag:value}...}
++
++ For a list of valid tags and value formats see [176]RFC 2616,
++ "Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1". A maximum of eight
++ headers may be specified.
++
++ 2.2.2. HTTP Action Commands
++
++ HTTP actions can occur within a persistent connection, or they can be
++ self-contained ("connectionless"). A persistent HTTP connection begins
++ with an HTTP OPEN command, followed by zero or more HTTP action
++ commands, and is terminated with an HTTP CLOSE command:
++
++ http open www.columbia.edu
++ if failure stop 1 HTTP OPEN failed: \v(http_message)
++ http get kermit/index.html
++ if failure stop 1 HTTP GET failed: \v(http_message)
++ (more actions possible here...)
++ http close
++
++ A self-contained HTTP action occurs when a URL is given instead of a
++ remote file name to an HTTP action command. In this case, Kermit makes
++ the HTTP connection, takes the action, and then closes the connection.
++ If an HTTP connection was already open, it is closed silently and
++ automatically.
++
++ http get http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++
++ Kermit's HTTP action commands are as follows. Switches may be included
++ with any of these to override switch (or default) values given in the
++ HTTP OPEN command.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] GET remote-filename [ local-filename ]
++ Retrieves the named file from the server specified in the most
++ recent HTTP OPEN command for which a corresponding HTTP CLOSE
++ command has not been given. The filename may not include
++ wildcards (HTTP protocol does not support them). If no HTTP
++ OPEN command is in effect, this form of the HTTP GET command
++ fails. The default local filename is the same as the remote
++ name, but with any pathname stripped. For example, the command
++ http get kermit/index.html stores the file in the current local
++ directory as index.html. If the /HEADERS: switch is included,
++ information about the file is also stored in the specified
++ array (explained in [177]Section 2.2.3). All files are
++ transferred in binary mode. HTTP does not provide for
++ record-format or character-set conversion.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] GET url [ local-filename ]
++ When HTTP GET is given a URL rather than a filename, Kermit
++ opens a connection to the designated server (closing any
++ previously open HTTP connection), gets the file, and then
++ closes the connection. If the URL does not include a filename,
++ index.html is supplied. This is the self-contained one-step
++ "connectionless" method for getting a file from a Web server.
++ The data is not interpreted; HTTP GET is like "lynx -source"
++ rather than "lynx -dump".
++
++ In the remaining HTTP action commands, the distinction between a
++ remote filename and a URL are the same as in the HTTP GET command.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] HEAD remote-filename-or-url [ local-filename ]
++ Like GET except without actually getting the file; instead it
++ retrieves only the headers. If the /ARRAY: or /TOSCREEN switch
++ is included, there is no default local output filename but you
++ can still specify one. If neither of these switches is
++ included, the default local filename is the same as the remote
++ filename, but with any path stripped and with ".head" appended.
++ The HEAD command can be used in a script with the /ARRAY:
++ switch to retrieve information about the requested resource to
++ determine whether the resource should actually be retrieved
++ with a subsequent GET request.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] INDEX remote-directory-or-url [ local-filename ]
++ Asks the server to send a listing of the files in the given
++ server directory. This command is not supported by most Web
++ servers. Even when it is supported, there is no standard format
++ for the listing.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] POST [ /MIME-TYPE:type ] source-file
++ remote-path-or-url [ result-file ]
++ Sends data to a process running on the remote host; the result
++ is usually an HTML file but could be anything. The data to be
++ posted must be read from a local file (the source-file). If a
++ result file is specified, Kermit stores the server's response
++ in it.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] PUT [ MIME-TYPE:type ] local-file [
++ remote-file-or-url [ result-file ] ]
++ Uploads a local file to the server. Only the name of a single
++ file can be given; wildcards (and group transfers) are not
++ supported by HTTP protocol. If no remote filename is given, the
++ file is sent with the same name as the local file, but with any
++ pathname stripped.
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] DELETE remote-file-or-url [ local-result-file ]
++ Asks the server to delete the specified single file. If a
++ result file is specified, it will contain any response data
++ returned by the server.
++
++ Note the limitations of HTTP protocol compared to (say) FTP or Kermit.
++ There is no command for changing directories, no standard way to get
++ file or directory lists, no way to transfer file groups by using
++ wildcard notation, etc, and therefore no good way to (say) fetch all
++ pages, descend through subdirectories, perform automatic updates, etc.
++ There is no assurrance a connection will stay open and, as noted,
++ there is no provision for data conversion between unlike platforms.
++ The data's MIME headers can be used for postprocessing.
++
++ 2.2.3. HTTP Headers
++
++ Each HTTP request and response contains a set of name/value pairs
++ called headers. HTTP headers are specified in [178]RFC 2616. For
++ example, an HTTP GET request for /index.html on www.columbia.edu
++ contains the following headers:
++
++ GET /index.html HTTP/1.1
++ Host: www.columbia.edu:80
++ User-agent: C-Kermit 8.0
++ Authorization: Basic base64-encoded-username-password
++
++ These might be followed by any others specified with a /HEADERS:
++ switch:
++
++ Accept: image/gif, image/x-xbitmap, image/jpeg, *.*
++ Accept-Encoding: gzip
++ Accept-Language: en
++ Accept-Charset: iso-8859-1,utf-8
++ Cookie: cookie-data
++
++ The server sends back a short report about the file prior to sending
++ the file contents. Example:
++
++ HTTP/1.1 200 OK
++ Date: Fri, 24 Aug 2001 21:09:39 GMT
++ Server: Apache/1.3.4 (Unix)
++ Last-Modified: Mon, 06 Aug 2001 21:16:13 GMT
++ ETag: "1fa137-10d7-3b6f091d"
++ Accept-Ranges: bytes
++ Content-Length: 4311
++ Content-Type: text/html
++
++ If you want to have this information available to a Kermit script you
++ can use the /ARRAY switch to have Kermit put it in array, one line per
++ array element. Example:
++
++ set exit warning off
++ http open www.columbia.edu
++ if fail exit 1 Can't reach server
++ http /array:&a get /index.html
++ if fail exit 1 Can't get file
++ echo Header lines: \fdim(&a)
++ for \%i 1 \fdim(&a) 1 {
++ echo \%i. \&a[\%i]
++ }
++
++ Note that the "Date:" item is the current date and time; the
++ "Last-Modifed:" item is the file's modification date and time. An
++ example showing how to use this information is presented in
++ [179]Section 8.13.7.
++
++ 2.2.4. Secure HTTP Connections
++
++ SSL/TLS (Secure Sockets Layer / Transport Layer Security) is the
++ protocol used to secure HTTP, SMTP, and other Internet applications.
++ See the [180]C-Kermit Reference Section 5.4 for an introduction to
++ SSL/TLS. To make a secure HTTP connection, you need:
++
++ 1. A secure client (a version of C-Kermit or Kermit 95 with SSL/TLS
++ security built in). Type "check ssl" at the Kermit prompt to make
++ sure you have it.
++ 2. A secure server to connect to.
++ 3. The CA Root Certificate used to authenticate the server to the
++ client. (see [181]Section 15 of the security reference for an
++ introduction to certificates).
++
++ And you must make a connection to the secure HTTP port: service name
++ HTTPS, port number 443 (as opposed to service HTTP, port 80). You can
++ also make secure connections to other ports by including the /TLS or
++ /SSL switch with the HTTP OPEN command, if the host supports SSL/TLS
++ on the given port:
++
++ The quality of the SSL/TLS connection depends on the cipher suite.
++ There are several possibilities:
++
++ Anonymous cipher suite:
++ If an anonymous cipher suite is negotiated, the connection is
++ encrypted but there is no authentication. This connection is
++ subject to a Man-In-The-Middle (MITM) attack.
++
++ X.509 certificate on the server:
++ When you connect to certain secure servers, an X.509
++ certificate is returned. This certificate is issued to a
++ special hostname, something like www1.xyzcorp.com or
++ wwws.xyzcorp.com (rather than the normal www.xyzcorp.com). It
++ is signed by the host's Certificate Authority (CA). If the host
++ certificate is configured on the client, it can be used to
++ verify the certificate received from the server. If the
++ certificate it verified as authentic, a check is made to ensure
++ it has not expired and it was issued to the host you were
++ attempting to connect to. If you had asked to connect to (say)
++ www.xyzcorp.com but were given a certificate for
++ www1.xyzcorp.com, you would be prompted for permission to
++ continue.
++
++ If the verification succeeded, the connection would be
++ encrypted with one-way (server-to-client) authentication. This
++ connection is not subject to a MITM attack.
++
++ If a username and password are transmitted over this
++ connection, they are not subject to interception. However, the
++ standard risks associated with passing the password to the host
++ for verification apply; for example, if the host has been
++ compromised, the password will be compromised.
++
++ X.509 client certificate:
++ If a connection has been established with an X.509 server
++ certificate, the server can ask the client to send a
++ certificate of its own. This certificate must be verified
++ against a CA Root certificate. The certificate itself (or
++ subject info from the certificate) is used to determine the
++ authorization for the client, and if successful, the username
++ and password need not be sent to the server.
++
++ Kerberos 5:
++ Instead of using X.509 certifcates, Kerberos 5 can be used to
++ perform the authentication and key exchange. In this situation,
++ there is mutual authentication between the client and server.
++ The Kerberos 5 principal is used by the server to look up the
++ appropriate authorization data. There is no need to send
++ username and password.
++
++ An HTTP connection is made with the HTTP OPEN command:
++
++ HTTP [ switches ] OPEN [ { /SSL, /TLS } ] host [ port ]
++ If /SSL or /TLS switches are included (these are synonyms), or
++ if the service is HTTPS or the port is 443, a secure connection
++ is attempted using the current authentication settings; see
++ HELP SET AUTHENTICATION for details ([182]Section 6.2 of the
++ security reference). If the no /SSL or /TLS switch is included
++ but the port is 443 or the service is HTTPS, a secure
++ connection is attempted. If an /SSL or /TLS switch is included
++ but a port is not specified, an SSL/TLS connection is attempted
++ on the default port (80).
++
++ Certificates are covered in the separate [183]Kermit Security
++ Reference for C-Kermit 8.0. You should let Kermit know to verify
++ certificates with the SET AUTHENTICATION TLS command. For example:
++
++ SET AUTHENTICATION TLS CRL-DIR directory
++ Specifies a directory that contains certificate revocation
++ files where each file is named by the hash of the certificate
++ that has been revoked.
++
++ SET AUTHENTICATION TLS CRL-FILE filename
++ Specifies a file that contains a list of certificate
++ revocations.
++
++ SET AUTHENTICATION TLS VERIFY-DIR directory
++ Specifies a directory that contains root CA certificate files
++ used to verify the certificate chains presented by the peer.
++ Each file is named by a hash of the certificate.
++
++ SET AUTHENTICATION TLS VERIFY-FILE filename
++ Specifies a file that contains root CA certificates to be used
++ for verifying certificate chains.
++
++ SET AUTHENTICATION TLS VERIFY OFF
++ Tells Kermit not to require a certificate and accept any
++ certificate that is presented regardless of whether it is
++ valid.
++
++ There are many other options; see the security document for details.
++
++ Now suppose you need need to fetch the file denoted by the following
++ URL:
++
++ https://myuserid:mypassword@wwws.xyzcorp.com/clients/info/secret.html
++
++ Once you have set up the handling of certificates as desired, you can
++ use the following Kermit commands:
++
++ http /user:myuserid /password:mypassword open www1.xyzcorp.com https
++ if success {
++ http get /clients/info/secret.html
++ http close
++ }
++
++ As another example, let's say that you have a web form you need to
++ populate with three fields: red,white and blue.
++
++ <FORM ACTION="http://www.xyzcorp.com/cgi-bin/form.cgi" METHOD="POST">
++ <INPUT NAME="Red">
++ <INPUT NAME="White">
++ <INPUT NAME="Blue">
++ </FORM>
++
++ You can handle this with the HTTP POST command. The data to be posted
++ is stored in the local file data.txt.
++
++ Red=seven stripes&White=six stripes&Blue=fifty stars
++
++ and the response from the server will be stored into response.txt.
++
++ http open www.xyzcorp.com http
++ if success {
++ http /array:c post data.txt /cgi-bin/form.cgi response.txt
++ http close
++ }
++
++ In this scenario, the Common Gateway Interface (CGI) sends a response
++ whether it succeeds or fails in a script-dependent manner. The script
++ can either report success and enclose the response data; or it might
++ send a 302 Found error which indicates that the "Location:" header
++ should be used to determine the URL at which the data can be found.
++
++ 2.2.5. HTTP Variables
++
++ \v(http_code)
++ The HTTP protocol code number of the most recent server reply,
++ e.g. 404 for "not found".
++
++ \v(http_connected)
++ 1 when an HTTP connection is open, 0 when there is no HTTP
++ connection.
++
++ \v(http_host)
++ If an HTTP connection is open, the hostname:port, e.g.
++ www.columbia.edu:80; otherwise, empty.
++
++ \v(http_message)
++ Server error message, if any, from most recent HTTP command.
++
++ \v(http_security)
++ A list of the security parameters and values for the current
++ connection, if any. Empty if the connection is not to a secure
++ server, or there is no connection.
++
++ To display all the HTTP variables at once, type SHOW VAR HTTP:
++
++ C-Kermit> http open www.columbia.edu
++ C-Kermit> http get lkjlkjlkjlkj
++ C-Kermit> sho var http
++ \v(http_code) = 404
++ \v(http_connected) = 1
++ \v(http_host) = www.columbia.edu:80
++ \v(http_message) = Not Found
++ \v(http_security) = NULL
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ 2.2.6. The HTTP Command-Line Personality
++
++ If you invoke C-Kermit with the name "http" or "https", you can use a
++ special set of HTTP-specific command-line options. You can do this by
++ creating a symbolic linke "http" or "https" to the C-Kermit 8.0
++ executable, or by having a separate copy of it called "http" or
++ "https". Here's the usage message ("http -h"):
++
++ Usage: ./http host [ options... ]
++ -h This message.
++ -d Debug to debug.log.
++ -S Stay (issue command prompt when done).
++ -Y Do not execute Kermit initialization file.
++ -q Quiet (suppress most messages).
++ -u name Username.
++ -P password Password.
++ -g pathname Get remote pathname.
++ -p pathname Put remote pathname.
++ -H pathname Head remote pathname.
++ -l pathname Local path for -g, -p, and -H.
++ -z opt[=value] Security options...
++ cert=file Client certificate file
++ certsok Accept all certificates
++ key=file Client private key file
++ secure Use SSL
++ verify=n 0 = none, 1 = peer , 2 = certificate required
++
++ The "host" argument is the name of a Web host, e.g. www.columbia.edu.
++ The action options are -p, -g, and -H. If you give an action option,
++ Kermit does the action and then exits. If you give a host without an
++ action option, Kermit makes an HTTP connection to the host and then
++ gives you the C-Kermit prompt. Here's a simple example that fetches a
++ publicly readable Web page:
++
++ http www.columbia.edu -g kermit/index.html
++
++ If you need to access a website for which a username and password are
++ required, you can supply them on the command line with -u and -P. If
++ you include a username but omit the password, Kermit prompts you for
++ it:
++
++ http www.columbia.edu -u olga -p kermit/index.html -l index.html
++ Password:
++
++ Note that when PUT'ing files to websites, you have to supply both the
++ -p (remote pathname) and -l (local path) options.
++
++ If your version of Kermit is built with SSL/TLS security, you can also
++ use the -z option to make secure HTTP (https) connections.
++
++ Finally, as noted in [184]Section 16, you can also give a URL instead
++ of a host name and options.
++
++ [ [185]Top ] [ [186]Contents ] [ [187]C-Kermit Home ] [ [188]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++3. THE BUILT-IN FTP CLIENT
++
++ 3.1. [189]Making and Managing FTP Connections
++ 3.2. [190]Making Secure FTP Connections
++ 3.3. [191]Setting FTP Preferences
++ 3.4. [192]Managing Directories and Files
++ 3.5. [193]Uploading Files With FTP
++ 3.6. [194]Downloading Files With FTP
++ 3.7. [195]Translating Character Sets
++ 3.8. [196]FTP Command Shortcuts
++ 3.9. [197]Dual Sessions
++ 3.10. [198]Automating FTP Sessions
++ 3.11. [199]Advanced FTP Protocol Features
++
++ Earlier versions of C-Kermit and K95 included an FTP command, but it
++ simply invoked an external FTP client. Now, by popular demand, Kermit
++ includes its own built-in FTP client that offers the following
++ advantages over traditional FTP clients (and its previous interface to
++ them):
++
++ * Any of Kermit's built-in [200]security methods can be used to
++ establish and conduct secure FTP sessions with [201]FTP servers
++ that support these methods. (Security modules can be subject to
++ export restrictions.)
++ * Kermit's FTP client uses "passive mode" by default to avoid
++ blockage by firewalls and network address translators. Of course
++ active mode can be chosen too when needed.
++ * [202]Character sets can be translated as part of the transfer
++ process even when the FTP server does not support character-set
++ translation, including to/from the new Internet standard
++ international character set, [203]Unicode UTF-8. This includes
++ both the file's name and (for text files only) its contents.
++ * All of C-Kermit's [204]file-selection mechanisms are available:
++ size, date, name patterns and lists, exception lists, etc.
++ * [205]Atomic file movement capabilities are provided (delete, move,
++ or rename files automatically after successful transfer).
++ * The correct file type, "ascii" (i.e. text) or binary, is chosen
++ automatically for each file (explained in [206]Section 4), and any
++ mixture of text and binary files can be sent in a single
++ operation, even across platforms.
++ * Update mode ("don't bother transferring files that didn't change
++ since last time") and recovery (resumption of an interrupted
++ transfer from the point of failure) are available in both
++ directions.
++ * When uploading files from UNIX to UNIX, the file's permissions can
++ be preserved if desired.
++ * Recursive directory-tree PUTs are supported between any two
++ platforms that have tree-structured file systems. Recursive GETs
++ are supported between like platforms if the server cooperates and
++ between like or unlike platforms if the server supports MLSD
++ ([207]Section 3.11).
++ * When receiving files, all of Kermit's file collision actions are
++ available: backup, update, refuse, rename, etc.
++ * Multi-file transfers can be interrupted on a per-file basis,
++ automatically skipping to the next file.
++ * FTP sessions are [208]fully scriptable.
++ * An entire FTP session (connect, login, CD, upload or download,
++ logout) can be specified on the command line without using a
++ script.
++ * All of Kermit's logging options and formats are available to keep
++ an accurate and complete record of each connection and file
++ transfer, and to aid in troubleshooting.
++ * All of Kermit's file-transfer display options are available
++ (fullscreen, brief, CRT, serial, none).
++
++ And best of all:
++ * Kermit doesn't give you those annoying per-file prompts every time
++ you start a multi-file transfer without remembering to give a
++ "prompt" command first :-).
++
++ [ [209]Top ] [ [210]FTP Top ] [ [211]FTP Client Overview ] [ [212]FTP
++ Script Tutorial ] [ [213]C-Kermit Home ] [ [214]Kermit Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1. Making and Managing FTP Connections
++
++ Each copy of Kermit can have one FTP connection open at a time. FTP
++ connections are independent of regular terminal connections; a
++ terminal connection (serial or network via SET LINE, DIAL, SET HOST,
++ TELNET, etc) may be, but need not be, open at the same time as an FTP
++ connection, and terminal connections can also be closed, and new
++ connections opened, without interfering with the FTP connection (and
++ vice versa). Thus, for example, Kermit can have an FTP connection and
++ a TELNET connection open to the same host simultaneously, using the
++ TELNET connection (e.g.) to send mail or take other desired actions as
++ various FTP actions complete. Of course, each copy of Kermit can do
++ only one thing at a time, so it can't (for example) transfer a file
++ with FTP and another file with Kermit protocol simultaneously.
++
++ A Kermit FTP session can be established by [215]command-line options,
++ by [216]URL, or by [217]interactive commands.
++
++ 3.1.1. Kermit Command-Line Options for FTP
++
++ The new command-line option '-9' (sorry, we're out of letters) can be
++ used when starting C-Kermit, telling it to make an FTP connection:
++
++ kermit -9 hostname
++
++ or if a non-default FTP port is needed:
++
++ kermit -9 hostname:port
++
++ You can also specify the username on the command line with the -M ("My
++ User ID") option that was already there for other connection types:
++
++ kermit -9 hostname -M olga
++
++ If you specify the username on the command line, Kermit uses it when
++ making the connection and does not prompt you for it (but it does
++ prompt you for the password if one is required).
++
++ Once the connection is made, you get the regular Kermit prompt, and
++ can give interactive commands such as the ones described below. When
++ you give a BYE command, Kermit closes the session and exits, just as a
++ regular FTP client would do. If you don't want Kermit to exit when you
++ give a BYE command, include the -S ("Stay") option on the command
++ line.
++
++ Other Kermit command-line options that are not specific to non-FTP
++ connections should affect the FTP session in the expected ways; for
++ example, -i and -T force binary and text mode transfers, respectively.
++
++ File transfers can not be initiated on the "kermit -9" command line;
++ for that you need to use Kermit's FTP personality (next section) or
++ you can use URLs ([218]Section 3.1.3).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.2. The FTP Command-Line Personality
++
++ If you want to replace your regular FTP client with C-Kermit, you can
++ make a link called "ftp" to the C-Kermit binary (or you can store a
++ copy of the C-Kermit binary under the name "ftp"). When C-Kermit is
++ invoked with a program name of "ftp" (or "FTP", case doesn't matter),
++ it assumes the command-line personality of the regular FTP client:
++
++ ftp [ options ] hostname [ port ]
++
++ In this case the options are like those of a regular FTP client:
++
++ -d Debug: enables debug messages and creates a debug.log file.
++ -n No autologin: Kermit should not send your user ID automatically.
++ -t Packet trace: accepted but is treated the same as -d.
++ -v Verbose: accepted but ignored (operation is verbose by default).
++ -i Not interactive: accepted but ignored.
++
++ and the hostname can also be a URL (explained in [219]Section 3.1.3).
++ To specify a non-default TCP port for the FTP server, include the port
++ number or name after the hostname.
++
++ There are also some bonus options that allow you to execute an entire
++ FTP session from the shell command line, as long as you don't include
++ the -n option. These are not available with regular FTP clients, and
++ at least one of these options (-g) conflicts with UNIX ftp (where -g
++ means "no globbing", which does not apply to Kermit), and some of them
++ (like the options above) also conflict with regular Kermit
++ command-line options:
++
++ -m mode = "passive" (default) or "active"
++ -Y Don't execute the Kermit initialization file [1]
++ -q Quiet, suppresses all but error messages [1]
++ -S Stay, don't exit automatically [1]
++ -A Autologin anonymously [2]
++ -u name Username for autologin [2] (synonym: -M [1])
++ -P password Password for autologin (see cautions below) [2]
++ -D directory cd after autologin [2]
++ -b Binary mode [2]
++ -a Text ("ascii") mode [2] (synonym: -T [1])
++ -R Recursive (works with -p) [4]
++ -p files Files to put (upload) after autologin [2] (synonym: -s [1])
++ -g files Files to get (download) after autologin [3]
++
++ [1] Same as Kermit, not available in regular FTP clients.
++ [2] Conflicts with Kermit, not available in regular FTP clients.
++ [3] Same as Kermit, conflicts with regular FTP clients.
++ [4] Conflicts with Kermit, available in some FTP clients.
++
++ Fancier options such as restart, character-set translation, filename
++ collision selection, automatic move/rename/delete, etc, are not
++ available from the command line; for these you can use the commands
++ described in the following sections. The -R option might also work
++ with -g (GET) but that depends on the server.
++
++ The following security options are also available, explained in
++ [220]Section 3.2:
++
++ -k realm Kerberos 4 realm [4]
++ -f Kerberos 5 credentials forwarding [4]
++ -x autoencryption mode [4]
++ -c cipher SRP cipher type [4]
++ -H hash SRP encryption hash [4]
++ -z option Security options [4]
++
++ If you include -A or specify a name of "anonymous" or "ftp", you are
++ logged in anonymously and, in the absence of -P, Kermit automatically
++ supplies a password of "user@host", where "user" is your local user
++ ID, and "host" is the hostname of the computer where Kermit is
++ running. If you do not include -p or -g, Kermit enters command mode so
++ you can type commands or execute them from a script.
++
++ If you include -p or -g, Kermit attempts to transfer the specified
++ files and then exits automatically at the end of the transfer unless
++ you also included -S (Stay). It uses the "brief" file transfer display
++ (one line per file) unless you include the -q option to suppress it.
++
++ When uploading files with -p, Kermit switches automatically between
++ text and binary mode for each file.
++
++ When downloading, you can either specify a particular mode (text or
++ binary) to be used for all the files, or you can let Kermit select the
++ type for each file automatically, based on its name (see [221]Sections
++ 3.5 and [222]3.6 for greater detail). In UNIX be sure to quote any
++ wildcard characters to prevent the shell from expanding them, as shown
++ in the examples just below. Filename collisions are handled according
++ Kermit's FILE COLLISION setting (if specified in your Kermit
++ customization file; otherwise the default, which is BACKUP).
++
++ It should go without saying that the -P option should be used with
++ caution. In addition to the well-known risks of transmitting plaintext
++ passwords over the Internet, in this case the password also echos to
++ the screen if you type it, and can be seen in ps and w listings that
++ show the user's currently active command and command-line arguments.
++ Thus command-line FTP sessions are most appropriate for secure or
++ anonymous connections (those that do not require passwords).
++
++ Here's an example in which you download the latest C-Kermit "tarball"
++ from the Columbia University FTP archive:
++
++ ftp -A kermit.columbia.edu -bg kermit/archives/ckermit.tar.gz
++
++ This assumes that "ftp" is a symbolic link to C-Kermit. It logs you in
++ anonymously and gets the ckermit.tar.gz file in binary mode from the
++ kermit/archives directory.
++
++ Here's a slightly more ambitious example that illustrates CD'ing to
++ the desired server directory to get a group of files in text mode (in
++ this case the C-Kermit source files):
++
++ ftp -A kermit.columbia.edu -D kermit/f -ag "ck[cuw]*.[cwh]" makefile
++
++ In this case we CD to the kermit/f directory so we don't have to
++ include it in each file specification, and we quote the ck[cuw]*.[cwh]
++ specification so the shell doesn't expand it, since we have to pass it
++ as-is to the server. Note also that the quotes don't go around the
++ entire file list; only around each file specification that needs to be
++ quoted.
++
++ Here's one more example, that uploads a debug log file in binary mode
++ to the Kermit incoming directory (as we might ask you to do when
++ following up on a problem report):
++
++ ftp -A kermit.columbia.edu -D kermit/incoming -bp debug.log
++
++ In this case the -D option is required to tell the server where to put
++ the incoming file.
++
++ Unless the -Y option is included, your Kermit initialization file
++ (.mykermrc in UNIX, K95.INI in Windows) is executed before the command
++ line options, so you can set any FTP-related preferences there, as
++ described in the subsequent sections.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.3. The FTP URL Interpreter
++
++ If Kermit is invoked with either its regular personality (as "kermit")
++ or its FTP personality (as "ftp"), you can also give a URL
++ (Universal Resource Locator) instead of a hostname and options,
++ with or without a username and password:
++ ftp ftp://user:password@host/path
++ ftp ftp://user@host/path
++ ftp ftp://@host/path (or ftp://:@host/path)
++ ftp ftp://host/path
++ kermit ftp://host/path
++
++ If the FTP personality is used, the service must be "ftp". In all
++ cases, a hostname or address must be included. If a user is included
++ but no password, you are prompted for the password. If a path
++ (filename) is included:
++ * If "@" is included without a user, Kermit prompts for the username
++ and password.
++ * If no user and no "@" are included, "anonymous" is used.
++ * GET is assumed.
++
++ If no path (and no action options) are included, an interactive FTP
++ session is started, as in this example:
++ ftp ftp://kermit.columbia.edu
++
++ If a path is included, but a username is not included, "anonymous" is
++ used and an appropriate user@host password is supplied automatically.
++ If authentication is successful, Kermit attempts to GET the file
++ indicated by the path or, if the path is the name of a directory, it
++ asks the server for a directory listing. In both cases, Kermit
++ disconnects from the server and exits after the operation is complete
++ (unless you have included the -S option on the command line).
++
++ Here's an example that gets a listing of the Kermit directory at the
++ Kermit ftp site:
++ ftp ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/
++
++ This example gets the top-level READ.ME file from the same directory:
++ ftp ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/READ.ME
++
++ Here's the same example, but requesting a text-mode transfer:
++ ftp -T ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/READ.ME
++ This illustrates that you can mix command-line options and URLs
++ if you desire.
++
++ Here's an example that logs in as a (fictitious) real user to get a
++ file:
++ ftp ftp://olga@ftp.xyzcorp.com/resume.txt
++ The password is not included, so Kermit prompts for it.
++
++ This scheme allows Kermit to be used as the FTP helper of other
++ applications, such as Web browsers, with all its advantages over other
++ FTP clients (especially the ones that are built in to most Web
++ browsers), e.g. that it can be given wildcards, and it can pick text
++ and binary mode automatically for each file.
++
++ HINT: suppose somebody sends you an FTP URL in email, or you see it in
++ some text. If your terminal screen supports copy/paste, copy the url,
++ and then at the shell prompt type "kermit", a space, and then paste
++ the URL, e.g.:
++
++ $ kermit ftp://alpha.greenie.net/pub/mgetty/source/1.1/mgetty1.1.27-O
++
++ "$ is the shell prompt; the part you type is underlined, the rest is
++ pasted in. Kermit does the rest.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1.4. Interactive FTP Session Establishment
++
++ As you read this and the following sections, bear in mind that any
++ command that can be given at the prompt can also be used in a script
++ program. Kermit's script programming language is the same as its
++ interactive command language. [223]CLICK HERE if you would like to
++ learn a bit more about script writing.
++
++ An FTP session is established with the FTP OPEN command:
++
++ FTP [ OPEN ] [ { /SSL, /TLS } ] hostname [ switches ] [ port ]
++ Opens an FTP connection to the given host on the given port
++ and, if FTP AUTOLOGIN is ON, also logs you in to the server,
++ prompting for username and password if necessary. If no port is
++ specified, the regular FTP protocol port (21) is used. The OPEN
++ keyword is optional (unless the hostname conflicts with one of
++ the FTP command keywords, which you can list by typing "ftp
++ ?").
++
++ The hostname can be an IP host name, numeric IP address, or if you
++ have a network directory active (SET NETWORK DIRECTORY; see Chapter 6
++ of [224]Using C-Kermit), an entry name in the directory. In the latter
++ case, if the given hostname matches exactly one entry, the associated
++ name or address is used; if it matches more than one, Kermit cycles
++ through them until one is found that can be opened; if it matches
++ none, then the hostname is used as-is. If a directory is active but
++ you want to bypass directory lookup, include an "=" sign at the
++ beginning of the hostname, and/or use a numeric IP address.
++
++ When an FTP connection is opened, the default file-transfer mode is
++ set to binary if the client and server platforms are alike (e.g. both
++ of them are some kind of UNIX), and to text ("ascii") if they are not
++ alike. This has no particular effect for uploading since Kermit
++ automatically switches between text and binary mode for each file, but
++ might be important for downloading. The connection is also set to
++ Stream mode and File structure. Record- or page-oriented file
++ transfers are not supported by C-Kermit's FTP client.
++
++ The optional FTP OPEN switches are:
++
++ /ANONYMOUS
++ Logs you in anonymously, automatically supplying username
++ "anonymous" and user@host as the password, based on your local
++ user and host names.
++
++ /NOLOGIN
++
++ Overrides SET FTP AUTOLOGIN ON for this connection only.
++
++ /USER:name
++ Uses the given username to log you in, thus avoiding the Name:
++ prompt.
++ Overrides SET FTP AUTOLOGIN OFF for this connection only.
++
++ /PASSWORD:text
++ Uses the given text as your password, thus avoiding the
++ Password: prompt. This switch is not recommended for use in
++ script files, which would be a security risk.
++
++ /ACCOUNT:text
++ Uses the given text as your account (or secondary password,
++ depending on the requirements of the server; most servers do
++ not require or accept an account name). If an account is not
++ supplied, you are not prompted for one.
++
++ /PASSIVE
++ Opens the connection in passive mode. Passive mode is the
++ default in Kermit's FTP client, unlike in most others, since it
++ works better through firewalls. The /PASSIVE and /ACTIVE
++ switches apply only to the connection that is being opened, and
++ do not affect the global FTP PASSIVE-MODE setting.
++
++ /ACTIVE
++ Opens the connection in active mode. Use this switch if the
++ server does not support passive mode, or use the command SET
++ FTP PASSIVE-MODE OFF.
++
++ /NOINIT
++ Added in C-Kermit 8.0.201. Tells C-Kermit not to send REST,
++ STRU, FEAT, and MODE commands to the server when the connection
++ is opened, since these have been reported to cause confusion in
++ certain servers.
++
++ When a username or password is missing, a prompt is issued at the
++ controlling terminal and you must type the response; the response can
++ not be scripted. Use the switches to avoid prompts, or one of the
++ secure authentication methods described in the next section, or see
++ [225]SET FTP AUTOLOGIN and the [226]FTP USER and similar commands
++ described later in this section.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ ftp open kermit.columbia.edu /anonymous ; Open and log in anonymously
++ ftp kermit.columbia.edu /anonymous ; The OPEN keyword can be omitted
++ ftp xyzcorp.com ; Open and maybe prompt for username
++ ftp xyzcorp.com /user:olga ; Open and log in as olga
++ ftp testing.abccorp.com 449 ; Specify a special TCP port number
++ ftp testing.abccorp.com /user:olaf /password:secret 449
++
++ The FTP OPEN command succeeds if a connection was opened to the server
++ (even if the given username and password were not valid) and fails
++ otherwise (see [227]Section 3.8 for details).
++
++ When your FTP session is complete, you can terminate it as follows:
++
++ FTP BYE
++ Closes the FTP connection if one was open. The FTP prefix can
++ be omitted if no other connection is open at the same time (see
++ [228]Section 3.8 for details). If a connection log is active,
++ an FTP record is written to it. If Kermit was started with the
++ -9 command-line option or with its FTP command-line
++ personality, and the -S (Stay) option was not given, AND there
++ is no other active connection, the FTP BYE command also exits,
++ just as it does on a regular FTP client. Synonyms: FTP CLOSE,
++ FTP QUIT (but if the FTP prefix is omitted from QUIT, this
++ becomes the regular Kermit QUIT command, which is equivalent to
++ EXIT; i.e. it closes the connection and exits from Kermit).
++
++ The following commands can be used to achieve greater control over the
++ connection and login process:
++
++ SET FTP ANONYMOUS-PASSWORD text
++ Allows you to choose the password text to be sent automatically
++ by Kermit when you open an FTP connection with the /ANONYMOUS
++ switch.
++
++ SET FTP AUTOLOGIN { ON, OFF }
++ If you give this command prior to opening an FTP connection, it
++ controls whether Kermit tries to log you in automatically as
++ part of the connection process. Normally ON, which means the
++ username and password are sent automatically (and prompted for
++ if they are not yet known). When OFF, FTP OPEN connects to the
++ server without logging in. OFF is equivalent to the -n
++ command-line option when using Kermit's FTP command-line
++ personality.
++
++ FTP USER name [ password [ account ] ]
++ Used to log in to an FTP server to which a connection has been
++ made without autologin, or when autologin failed. If the
++ password is furnished on the command line, it is used;
++ otherwise you are prompted for a password. An account may also
++ be furnished if required by the server; it is not required by
++ Kermit and is not prompted for if omitted. Synonyms: USER, FTP
++ LOGIN.
++
++ FTP ACCOUNT text
++ Sends an account name to a server that supports accounts. If
++ the server does not support accounts, an error response occurs.
++ If the server does support accounts, the account is accepted if
++ it is valid and rejected if it is not. The account might be
++ used for charging purposes or it might be a secondary password,
++ or it might be used for any other purpose, such as an access
++ password for a particular disk. Servers that support accounts
++ might or might not allow or require the account to be sent
++ prior to login; usually it is sent after login, if at all.
++ Synonym: ACCOUNT.
++
++ Example:
++
++set ftp autologin off ; One thing at a time please
++ftp xyzcorp.com ; Try to make the connection
++if fail exit 1 FTP connection failed ; Check that it was made
++ftp user olga secret ; Now log in to the server
++if fail exit 1 FTP login failed ; Check that it worked
++ftp account 103896854 ; Login OK - send account
++if fail echo WARNING - FTP ACCT failed ; Warn if problem
++... ; (have session here)
++bye ; Log out and disconnect
++
++ The following commands are used to control or get information about
++ the FTP connection. Any particular FTP server does not necessarily
++ support all of them.
++
++ FTP RESET
++ Terminates a user session but leaves the connection open,
++ allowing a new login via FTP USER.
++
++ FTP IDLE [ number ]
++ Most FTP servers automatically log you out and and disconnect
++ your session if there has been no activity for a certain amount
++ of time. Use this command to ask the server to set its idle
++ limit to the given number of seconds. Omit the number to ask
++ the server to inform you of its current idle limit.
++
++ FTP STATUS [ filename ]
++ Asks the FTP server to send information about the current
++ session. The result is a free-format report that might include
++ server identification, username and login time, FTP protocol
++ settings, and file-transfer statistics. If a filename is given,
++ the server is supposed to send detailed information about the
++ file.
++
++ FTP SYSTEM
++ Asks the FTP server to identify its operating system (Listed in
++ Internet Assigned Numbers, Operating System Names). Examples:
++ UNIX, VMS, VM/CMS, WINDOWS-NT. Unfortunately many variations
++ are allowed (e.g. LINUX-2.0, LINUX-2.2, FREEBSD, ULTRIX, etc,
++ instead of UNIX; WINDOWS-NT-3, WINDOWS-NT-3.5, WINDOWS-NT-3.51,
++ WINDOWS-NT-4, etc). The report might also include other
++ information like "Type L8", "Type I", or "Type A", indicating
++ the file-transfer mode.
++
++ FTP HELP [ keyword [ keyword [ ... ] ]
++ Asks the server to list the commands it supports. The response
++ is usually cryptic, listing FTP command mnemonics, not the
++ commands used by the client (since the server has no way of
++ knowing anything about the client's user interface). For
++ example, the PUT command is STOR in FTP protocol. If a keyword
++ is given, which should be an FTP protocol command,
++ slightly-more- detailed help is given about the corresponding
++ command (if the FTP server supports this feature). Examples:
++ "ftp help", "ftp help stor".
++
++ FTP SITE text
++ (Advanced) Sends an FTP SITE (site-specific) command. Usually
++ this means that the FTP server is asked to run an external
++ command with the given arguments. You might be able to find out
++ what SITE commands are available by sending "ftp help site" to
++ the server, but in general the availability of and response to
++ SITE commands is (not surprisingly) site specific.
++
++ FTP QUOTE text
++ (Advanced) Sends an FTP command in FTP protocol format. Use
++ this command to send commands to the server that the FTP client
++ might not know about.
++
++ SHOW FTP
++ Lists client (Kermit) FTP settings and information. Also SHOW
++ CONNECTION, SHOW COMMUNICATIONS.
++
++ HELP FTP [ keyword ]
++ Asks Kermit to list and describe its built-in FTP commands.
++
++ HELP SET FTP [ keyword ]
++ Asks Kermit to list and describe its built-in SET FTP commands.
++
++ [ [229]Top ] [ [230]FTP Top ] [ [231]C-Kermit Home ] [ [232]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2. Making Secure FTP Connections
++
++ Also see: [233]Accessing IBM Information Exchange with Kermit.
++
++ In the previous section, you can see several examples of traditional
++ insecure authentication: username and password sent across the network
++ in clear text. Of course this is bad practice on at least two counts:
++ (1) storing passwords in files (such as script files) gives access to
++ the target systems to anybody who can obtain read access to your
++ scripts; and (2) sending this information over the network leaves it
++ open to interception by network sniffers or compromised hosts.
++
++ Because of the increasing need for security on the Internet, FTP
++ servers are beginning to appear that offer secure forms of
++ authentication, in which no information is sent over the network that
++ would allow anyone who intercepts it to usurp your identity and gain
++ your access rights.
++
++ Kermit provides an equivalent form of FTP security for each type of
++ IETF standard security implemented in Telnet. These include
++ GSSAPI-KERBEROS5, KERBEROS4, Secure Remote Password (SRP), and
++ Transport Layer Security (SSL and TLS). It does not presently include
++ SSL tunneling nor any form of SSH v1 or v2. When Kermit is built with
++ the necessary libraries, secure FTP connections are attempted by
++ default, in which all connections are authenticated and the command
++ and data channels are private.
++
++ The use of authentication and encryption for FTP connections can be
++ adjusted with the commands listed below, which are available only if
++ your version of Kermit was built with the corresponding security
++ options and libraries:
++
++ SET FTP AUTHTYPE { AUTOMATIC, GSSAPI-KRB5, KERBEROS4, SRP, SSL, TLS }
++ Specifies an ordered list of authentication methods to be
++ attempted when AUTOAUTHENTICATION is ON. The default list is:
++ GSSAPI-KRB5, SRP, KERBEROS_V4, TLS, SSL. If none of the
++ selected methods are supported by the server, an insecure login
++ is used as a fallback. Note, by the way, that SSL or TLS can be
++ used to secure an anonymous connection.
++
++ SET FTP AUTOAUTHENTICATION { ON, OFF }
++ Tells whether authentication should be negotiated by the FTP
++ OPEN command. Default is ON. Use SET FTP AUTOAUTHENTICATION OFF
++ to force a clear-text, unencrypted connection to FTP servers
++ (such as the one at the Kermit FTP site) that normally would
++ try to negotiate secure authentication and encryption.
++
++ SET FTP AUTOENCRYPTION { ON, OFF }
++ Tells whether encryption (privacy) should be negotiated by the
++ FTP OPEN command, which can happen only if secure
++ authentication is also negotiated. Default is ON.
++
++ SET FTP AUTOLOGIN { ON, OFF }
++ Tells Kermit whether to try logging in automatically when you
++ make an FTP connection, as opposed to letting you do it "by
++ hand" with the FTP USER command.
++
++ SET FTP COMMAND-PROTECTION-LEVEL { CLEAR, CONFIDENTIAL, PRIVATE, SAFE
++ }
++ Determines the level of protection applied to the command
++ channel:
++
++ CLEAR Data is sent in plaintext and not protected against tampering.
++ CONFIDENTIAL Data is encrypted but not protected against tampering.
++ PRIVATE Data is encrypted and is protected against tampering.
++ SAFE Data is sent in plaintext but protected against tampering.
++
++ The default is PRIVATE.
++
++ SET FTP CREDENTIAL-FORWARDING { ON, OFF }
++ Tells whether end-user credentials are to be forwarded to the
++ server if supported by the authentication method (GSSAPI-KRB5
++ only). This is often required to allow access to distributed
++ file systems (e.g. AFS.)
++
++ SET FTP DATA-PROTECTION-LEVEL { CLEAR, CONFIDENTIAL, PRIVATE, SAFE }
++ Tells what level of protection is applied to subsequent data
++ channels. The meanings of the protection-level keywords are the
++ same as for SET FTP COMMAND-PROTECTION-LEVEL. The default is
++ PRIVATE.
++
++ SET FTP SRP CIPHER name
++ Specifies the cipher to be used for encryption when SRP
++ authentication is in use. The list of possible choices is
++ computed based on the capabilities of the local SRP library and
++ includes NONE plus zero or more of the following:
++
++ BLOWFISH_ECB CAST5_ECB DES_ECB DES3_ECB
++ BLOWFISH_CBC CAST5_CBC DES_CBC DES3_CBC
++ BLOWFISH_CFB64 CAST5_CFB64 DES_CFB64 DES3_CFB64
++ BLOWFISH_OFB64 CAST5_OFB64 DES_OFB64 DES3_OFB64
++
++ The default is DES3_ECB.
++
++ SET FTP SRP HASH name
++ Specifies the hash to be used for data protection when SRP
++ authentication is in use. The choices are MD5 and SHA. The
++ default is SHA.
++
++ Command-line options:
++
++ -k name
++ Specifies the realm to be used with Kerberos 4 authentication
++ (= SET AUTH K4 REALM name).
++
++ -f
++ Enables forwarding of Kerberos 5 credentials to the host when
++ using GSSAPI authentication (= SET AUTH K5 FORWARDABLE ON).
++
++ -x
++ Enables autoencryption (= SET FTP AUTOENCRYPTION ON).
++
++ -c cipher
++ Specifies the kind of cipher to be used for encryption with SRP
++ authentication. Equivalent to SET FTP SRP CIPHER, with the same
++ choices. If this option is not given, CAST5_CBC is used.
++
++ -H hash
++ Specifies the hash to be used for encryption with SRP
++ authentication. Equivalent to SET FTP SRP HASH, with the same
++ choices. If this option is not given, SHA is used.
++
++ -z debug
++ Turns on SSL/TLS debugging.
++
++ -z secure
++ Requires secure connection.
++
++ -z certsok
++ Says to accept all certificates without checking validity.
++
++ -z verify=n
++ Sets certificate verification mode to the given number, n:
++ 0 = no verification
++ 1 = verify certificate if presented
++ 2 = require verification of certificate
++
++ -z cert=filename
++ Specifies a file containing a client certificate to be
++ presented to the FTP server.
++
++ -z key=filename
++ Specifies a file containing a private key matching the client
++ certificate.
++
++ -z !krb4
++ (nokrb4) Disables the use of Kerberos 4.
++
++ -z !gss
++ -z nogss
++ Disables the use of GSSAPI - Kerberos 5.
++
++ -z !srp
++ -z nosrp
++ Disables use of SRP.
++
++ -z !ssl
++ -z nossl
++ Disables the use of SSL.
++
++ -z !tls
++ -z notls
++ Disables the use of TLS.
++
++ Caution: If your FTP connection is secured via AUTH TLS, it is not
++ possible to interrupt a file transfer. This is a limitation of all
++ known FTP servers that support AUTH TLS.
++
++ Note that when using certain security methods, such as SSL or TLS, you
++ may be prompted to confirm or verify certain actions or conditions,
++ for example, whether to accept self-signed certificates. This can
++ interfere with unattended operation of scripts; see [234]Section 3.10.
++
++ [ [235]Top ] [ [236]FTP Top ] [ [237]C-Kermit Home ] [ [238]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.3. Setting FTP Preferences FTP preferences can be set globally and
++ persistently with the commands in the following sections; many of
++ these can also be overridden on a per-command basis with switches that
++ have the same name.
++
++ 3.3.1. Logs, Messages, and Other Feedback
++
++ You can control the amount of feedback received from your FTP session
++ with the commands in this section. First, you can create a log of your
++ FTP transfers with the following commands:
++
++ SET TRANSACTION-LOG { VERBOSE, FTP, BRIEF }
++ Selects the log format. VERBOSE is the default, and is
++ described in [239]the manual. FTP chooses a WU-FTPD format, the
++ same as is used by the popular FTP server. BRIEF creates
++ per-file records in comma-separated-list format. For greater
++ detail, see [240]Section 4.17 of the [241]C-Kermit 7.0 Update
++ Notes.
++
++ LOG TRANSACTIONS filename
++ Records FTP (or Kermit, or any other protocol) uploads and
++ downloads in the given file using the format selected by the
++ most recent SET TRANSACTION-LOG command, if any, or else the
++ default format.
++
++ FTP screen messages and displays are controlled by the following
++ commands:
++
++ SET TRANSFER DISPLAY { FULLSCREEN, CRT, SERIAL, BRIEF, NONE, OFF }
++ FTP transfers use Kermit's normal file-transfer display styles.
++ Use this command to choose the desired format; the default on
++ most platforms is FULLSCREEN. The display is automatically
++ disabled if Kermit is running in the background or in batch.
++ BRIEF is always used for command-line initiated transfers
++ (unless suppressed by -q). While a file-transfer is in
++ progress, you can interrupt it in the normal Kermit way by
++ typing one of the following keys or key combinations:
++ X - Cancel current file but go on to the next one (if any).
++ Z - Cancel the entire transfer. Ctrl-L or Ctrl-W - Refresh
++ the file-transfer display (if any).
++
++ SET FTP DISPLAY { FULLSCREEN, CRT, SERIAL, BRIEF, NONE, OFF }
++ Like SET TRANSFER DISPLAY, but applies only to FTP connections,
++ and does not affect Kermit- or other protocol file transfers.
++
++ SET QUIET { ON, OFF }
++ This command applies to Kermit in general, not just FTP. OFF by
++ default; when ON, it surpresses most messages from most
++ commands as well as the file-transfer display.
++
++ SET FTP PROGRESS-MESSAGES { ON, OFF }
++ Tells whether Kermit should print locally-generated feedback
++ messages for each non-file-transfer command. ON by default.
++
++ SET FTP VERBOSE-MODE { ON, OFF }
++ Tells whether to display all responses from the FTP server. OFF
++ by default. This shows all responses to all commands, except
++ when the file-transfer display is active, and unless you have
++ SET QUIET ON. When OFF, responses are shown only for commands
++ such as FTP PWD whose purpose is to display a response.
++
++ SET FTP DEBUG { ON, OFF }
++ Tells whether local client debugging information should be
++ displayed. OFF by default. When ON, the commands that are sent
++ to the server are shown, as well as its responses (even if
++ VERBOSE-MODE is OFF), plus additional informational messages
++ are printed regarding the progress of secure operations. Also,
++ the temporary file created by the [242]MGET command is not
++ deleted so you can see what's in it.
++
++ Set all of these to OFF when silent running is desired.
++
++ 3.3.2. Operational Preferences
++
++ FTP DISABLE new-protocol-feature-name
++ FTP ENABLE new-protocol-feature-name
++ Explained in [243]Section 3.11.
++
++ SET FTP AUTOLOGIN { ON, OFF }
++ If you give this command prior to opening an FTP connection, it
++ controls whether Kermit tries to log you in automatically as
++ part of the connection process. Normally ON, which means the
++ username and password are sent automatically (and prompted for
++ if they are not yet known). When OFF, FTP OPEN connects to the
++ server without logging in. OFF is equivalent to the -n
++ command-line option when using Kermit's FTP command-line
++ personality. See [244]Section 3.1.4 for usage.
++
++ SET FTP PASSIVE-MODE { ON, OFF }
++ ON by default, to avoid random TCP port assignment for data
++ connections, which can prevent FTP protocol from working
++ through firewalls and network address translators (for more on
++ these topics, see the [245]Kermit security reference. Set to
++ OFF in case the FTP server does not support passive mode, or in
++ case the client has problems with it (it has been observed, for
++ example, that when using passive mode, the SCO XENIX 2.3.4
++ TCP/IP stack hangs in the connect() call forever). Synonyms:
++ PASSIVE [ ON ], PASSIVE OFF, PASV [ ON ], PASV OFF.
++
++ SET FTP SEND-PORT-COMMANDS { ON, OFF }
++ This command determines whether the FTP client sends a new PORT
++ command to the server when accepting incoming data connections
++ (as when not using passive mode.) When PASSIVE-MODE is OFF and
++ SET SEND-PORT is OFF, the port that was originally specified is
++ reused. This is the default behavior for normal FTP clients but
++ it is not compatible with many firewalls.
++
++ SET FTP CHARACTER-SET-TRANSLATION { ON, OFF }
++ Whether to translate character sets when transferring files
++ with FTP (explained in [246]Section 3.7). OFF by default.
++
++ SET FTP SERVER-CHARACTER-SET name
++ Tells Kermit the character set used by the FTP server, UTF-8 by
++ default ([247]Section 3.7).
++
++ SET FTP SERVER-TIME-OFFSET delta-time
++ Tells Kermit to apply the given [248]delta time to file
++ timestamps provided by the server for its files; for use when
++ (for example) the server does not have its timezone set
++ correctly.
++
++ SET FTP ERROR-ACTION { PROCEED, QUIT }
++ When transferring a group of files with FTP, and an error
++ occurs with one of the files, Kermit normally goes on the next
++ file. Use SET FTP ERROR-ACTION to QUIT to make Kermit stop the
++ transfer immediately and fail if an error occurs with any
++ single file in the group. Example: you have given Kermit a list
++ of files to send, and one of the files can not be found, or
++ read permission is denied. Note that cancelling a file by
++ typing 'X' during transfer is not considered an error (if you
++ want to cancel the entire transfer, type 'Z' or Ctrl-C).
++
++ SET FTP PERMISSIONS { AUTO, ON, OFF }
++ When uploading files with PUT or MPUT, this tells whether
++ Kermit should send each file's permissions. The default is OFF,
++ which means not to send permissions, in which case the uploaded
++ file's permissions are set by the FTP server according to its
++ own criteria. ON means to send them, AUTO means to send them
++ only if the client (Kermit) and server are on like platforms
++ (e.g. both UNIX). This command has no effect when downloading,
++ since the FTP protocol does not include a way for the server to
++ inform the client of a file's permissions. Also see [249]FTP
++ PUT /PERMISSIONS. Note that setting permissions after uploading
++ is likely to work (correctly or at all) only when the client
++ and server platforms are alike (e.g. both of them are some form
++ of UNIX). Also note that Windows files don't have permissions.
++ Also see [250]FTP CHMOD.
++
++ SET FTP DATES { ON, OFF }
++ When downloading files with GET or MGET, this tells whether
++ Kermit should try to set the received file's date from the
++ server's date. FTP DATES is ON by default. Note, however, that
++ FTP protocol does not allow date preservation when uploading.
++ So at best, SET FTP DATES ON can work only when downloading,
++ and then only when the server agrees to furnish file dates.
++
++ SET FTP FILENAMES { AUTO, CONVERTED, LITERAL }
++ When uploading (sending) files, this tells whether to convert
++ outbound filenames to "common form". This means allowing only
++ one period in a name, uppercasing any lowercase letters,
++ replacing spaces by underscores, etc. AUTOMATIC is the default,
++ meaning LITERAL when client and server are the same type of
++ system (e.g. UNIX) and CONVERTED otherwise. Special case: if
++ the setting is AUTOMATIC and the client is not UNIX and the
++ server identifies itself as UNIX, Kermit uses a less-strict
++ form of conversion, in which lowercase letters are not
++ uppercased and the filename can contain any number of periods,
++ but spaces are still converted to underscore. When receiving,
++ conversion generally means to change all-uppercase names to
++ lowercase and spaces to underscore.
++
++ SET FTP UNIQUE-SERVER-NAMES { ON, OFF }
++ Applies only to uploads. Tells the server to create new, unique
++ names for incoming files that have the same names as existing
++ files. OFF by default, in which case the server overwrites
++ existing files with new files of the same name. When ON, the
++ server uses its own built-in method for creating new names for
++ incoming files; for example, appending a period (.) and a
++ number to the name. CAUTION: Use this option only if you do not
++ need to refer to the file after it is uploaded, since FTP
++ protocol provides no mechanism for the client to find out what
++ name was assigned by the server.
++
++ SET FTP COLLISION { ... }
++ When downloading, what to do if an incoming file has the same
++ name as an existing file. Options are the same as for SET FILE
++ COLLISION. If this command is not given, Kermit's regular FILE
++ COLLISION setting is used. If this command is given, it
++ overrides the FILE COLLISION setting for FTP transfers only.
++ See [251]Section 3.6.2 for details.
++
++ SET FTP TYPE { TEXT, BINARY, TENEX }
++ Changes the default transfer mode. When sending (uploading)
++ files, this command has no effect unless you disable automatic
++ text/binary mode switching ([252]Section 4) with SET FILE SCAN
++ OFF or SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL. When receiving (downloading)
++ files, this command establishes the transfer mode to be used
++ when a filename does not match any of Kermit's text or binary
++ filename patterns, unless you use SET FTP
++ GET-FILETYPE-SWITCHING or SET TRANSFER MODE MANUAL to disable
++ automatic switching, in which case, this command establishes
++ the transfer mode for all downloaded files. In all cases,
++ however, the FTP TYPE can be overridden in any GET or PUT
++ command by including a /TEXT (/ASCII), /BINARY, or /TENEX
++ switch. The FTP TYPE is independent of the Kermit FILE TYPE
++ setting. TENEX is used for sending 8-bit binary files to 36-bit
++ platforms such as TOPS-10, TOPS-20, and TENEX, and getting them
++ back again. Synonym: ASCII = TEXT. Note: there is also an FTP
++ TYPE command, which does what SET FTP TYPE does but also sends
++ a TYPE command to the server immediately if the given type is
++ different from the current one.
++
++ If you want want specific FTP preference settings to be in effect for
++ all your Kermit FTP sessions, put the desired SET FTP commands in your
++ Kermit customization file (~/.mykermrc in UNIX, K95CUSTOM.INI in
++ Windows).
++
++ [ [253]Top ] [ [254]FTP Top ] [ [255]C-Kermit Home ] [ [256]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.4. Managing Directories and Files
++
++ In Kermit, commands for directory and file management can refer to:
++
++ * The local computer
++ * A remote computer when you have a connection to a Kermit server or
++ IKSD.
++ * A remote computer when you have a connection to an FTP server.
++
++ (There can also be an HTTP connection, but the commands in this
++ section don't apply to HTTP connections.)
++
++ Thus in general, each such command comes in three forms:
++
++ 1. With no prefix in C-Kermit 8.0.200, it refers to the local
++ computer (CD, DIR, etc). In C-Kermit 8.0.201 and later, however,
++ the "locus" switches to automatically to the remote FTP server
++ when you make an FTP connection (see the SET LOCUS description
++ [257]Section 7); thus C-Kermit 8.0.201 acts almost exactly like a
++ regular FTP client when it has an FTP connection, yet still acts
++ like itself on other kinds of connections.
++ 2. With the REMOTE prefix, it is for a Kermit server (REMOTE CD,
++ REMOTE DIR).
++ 3. With the FTP prefix, it's for an FTP server (FTP CD, FTP DIR).
++ 4. Also see [258]Section 3.8, which explains "R-commands" and
++ "L-commands".
++
++ Kermit's FTP file and directory management commands are as follows.
++ When an R-command is included in the Synonyms list, be sure to read
++ [259]Section 3.8 about rules for use of R-commands.
++
++ FTP CD [ directory ]
++ Tells the FTP server to change its default (working) directory
++ to the one given, which usually must be expressed in the syntax
++ of the server platform (UNIX, VMS, etc). If the directory is
++ not specified, the result depends on the FTP server -- it might
++ complain that the command is illegal, or it might change to
++ your original login directory. Synonyms: FTP CWD (Change
++ Wording Directory); RCD.
++
++ FTP CDUP
++ Tells the FTP server to change its default (working) directory
++ to the parent directory of its current one (equivalent to
++ "cd .." in UNIX, or "cd [-]" in VMS). Synonyms: RCDUP, FTP UP.
++
++ FTP PWD
++ Asks the FTP server to report ("print") its current working
++ directory. Synonym: RPWD.
++
++ FTP MKDIR directory
++ Asks the FTP server to create the directory whose name is
++ given. In general, the name must be in the syntax of the
++ server's file system, and it must be either absolute (a full
++ pathname) or relative to the server's current (working)
++ directory. This command fails if the directory can't be created
++ for any reason, including that it exists already. Synonym:
++ RMKDIR.
++
++ FTP RMDIR directory
++ Asks the FTP server to remove the directory whose name is
++ given. The rules are the same as for MKDIR, plus in most cases,
++ the server will not remove any directory unless it is empty.
++ Synonym: RRMDIR.
++
++ FTP DIRECTORY [ filespec ] [ redirectors ]
++ Tells the FTP server to send a directory listing of the
++ specified files. If no filespec is given, the server lists all
++ files in its current working directory. The results are in
++ whatever format the server chooses to send them. You can use
++ UNIX-like redirectors to send the listing to a file or a
++ pipeline, exactly as with the regular Kermit client/server
++ REMOTE DIRECTORY command ([260]Using C-Kermit, Chapter 11).
++ Synonym: RDIRECTORY. Examples:
++
++ ftp dir ; Show listing of all files on screen
++ ftp dir *.txt ; List *.txt files on screen
++ ftp dir *.txt > somefile ; Put listing in somefile
++ ftp dir *.txt >> somefile ; Append listing to somefile
++ ftp dir *.txt | sort > somefile ; Put sorted listing in somefile
++ ftp dir | more ; Runs list through "more"
++ ftp dir | sort | more ; Runs list through "sort" and "more"
++
++ FTP VDIRECTORY [ filespec ] [ redirectors ]
++ "Verbose" directory. This is an alternative FTP DIRECTORY
++ command primarily for use with DECSYSTEM-20 (TOPS-20) FTP
++ servers, which send only filenames when given a DIRECTORY
++ command; the VDIRECTORY command makes them also send file
++ sizes, dates, and attributes.
++
++ FTP CHECK filespec
++ Asks the FTP server whether the given file exists or, if the
++ filespec contains wildcards, if any files match, and this
++ command succeeds or fails accordingly.
++
++ FTP MODTIME filename
++ Asks the FTP server, via the not-yet-standard FTP MDTM command,
++ to send the modification date and time of the given file. The
++ response should be a numeric string in the format:
++ yyyymmddhhmmssxxxxx... where yyyy is the year, mm is the month,
++ dd is the day, hh is the hour (0-23), mm is the minute, ss is
++ the second, and xxx... is the optional fraction of the second
++ (0 or more digits). The date and time is expressed in UTC (GMT,
++ Zulu, Zero-Meridian). The result is available programmatically
++ in the [261]\v(ftp_message) variable, and is understandable by
++ Kermit's date-time switches and functions. For example, suppose
++ we want to upload all local files that are newer than a
++ particular file on the server:
++
++ C-Kermit> ftp modtime signpost
++ C-Kermit> echo \v(ftp_message)
++ 20010807113542.014
++ C-Kermit> ftp mput /after:\v(ftp_message)GMT *
++
++ Note that we must append "GMT" to the date-time string to let
++ the /AFTER switch know the time is GMT rather than local.
++
++ FTP SIZE filename
++ Asks the FTP server to send the size (in bytes) of the given
++ file. The result might vary depending on whether the current
++ FTP TYPE is binary or text ("ascii"). For a reliable byte
++ count, do FTP TYPE BINARY first. The result is available
++ programmatically in the [262]\v(ftp_message) variable.
++
++ FTP CHMOD permissions filename
++ Tells the FTP server to set the permissions (protection) of the
++ given file to the ones given. The permissions and filename must
++ be given in whatever syntax is required by the server. Example
++ (for a UNIX-based FTP server):
++
++ ftp chmod 664 oofa.txt
++
++ Not all servers support this command. For non-UNIX-based
++ servers, you might need to use FTP QUOTE or FTP SITE and the
++ appropriate platform-specific FTP server command.
++
++ FTP UMASK [ number ]
++ This command is probably specific to UNIX-based servers; it
++ sets the UNIX "umask", which is the default permissions mask
++ for new (in this case, incoming) files. Crudely put, the UNIX
++ umask is an octal representation of a binary number in in which
++ a 1 bit stands for a permission bit that must be 0, and a 0 bit
++ stands for a permission bit that can be 0 or 1 depending on
++ other factors, such as the permissions of the parent directory.
++ Example: "umask 007" requires that new files are created
++ without read/write/execute world permission. If the number is
++ not specified, the server's current umask is reported.
++
++ FTP RENAME filename newname
++ Asks the FTP server to rename the file whose name is "filename"
++ to "newname". Works only for one file; can not be used with
++ wildcards. The server's interpretation of "newname" can vary
++ (in some cases it must be a filename, in others perhaps it can
++ also be a directory name, in which case if the filename denote
++ a regular file, the file might be moved to the given
++ directory). Some servers might allow files to be renamed
++ ("moved") between physical disks or partitions, others might
++ not. Synonym: RRENAME.
++
++ FTP DELETE [ switches ] filespec [ filespec [ ... ] ]
++ Tells the FTP server to delete the file or files listed. Each
++ file specification may, but need not, contain wildcard
++ characters to match multiple files. File specifications and
++ wildcard syntax must be those of the server. Any file
++ specifications that contain spaces must be enclosed in braces
++ or doublequotes. FTP DELETE switches are:
++
++ /ERROR-ACTION: /FILENAMES: /NOBACKUPFILES /QUIET
++ /EXCEPT: /LARGER-THAN: /NODOTFILES /NOPAGE
++ /PAGE /RECURSIVE /SMALLER-THAN:
++
++ When used with FTP DELETE, the /RECURSIVE switch deletes files
++ but not directories, and furthermore depends on the server
++ providing recursive file lists, which is not the normal
++ behavior. For further details, see the decriptions of these
++ switches in [263]Section 3.6. Synonyms: FTP MDELETE (Kermit
++ makes no distinction between DELETE and MDELETE); RDELETE.
++
++ FTP TYPE { TEXT, BINARY, TENEX }
++ Tells the FTP server to change its file-transfer type to the
++ one given, immediately. See [264]SET FTP TYPE for details.
++
++ [ [265]Top ] [ [266]FTP Top ] [ [267]C-Kermit Home ] [ [268]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.5. Uploading Files With FTP
++
++ Uploading means sending files from the client (Kermit) to the FTP
++ server. The basic command for uploading files with FTP is PUT:
++
++ FTP PUT [ switches ] [ filespec [ as-name ] ]
++ Uploads (sends) the file or files that match the file
++ specification, which may include wildcards, to the server. If
++ no filespec is given, the names of files to send are taken from
++ the /LISTFILE: file, if any, otherwise from the SEND-LIST, if
++ any. Unless you go out of your way to prevent it, Kermit
++ determines the transfer mode (text or binary) for each file
++ automatically, and switches automatically on a per-file basis.
++ If an as-name is given, the file is sent under that name
++ instead of its own (if an as-name is given with a wildcard
++ filespec, the result is a bit more complicated, and is
++ explained later in this section).
++
++ Unlike normal FTP clients, Kermit does not prompt you by default (or
++ at all) for each file; it just sends them, just as it does with Kermit
++ protocol. The filespec can be a literal filename or a Kermit pattern,
++ described in:
++
++ [269]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++
++ Kermit patterns are equivalent to C-Shell patterns and provide a fair
++ amount of flexibility in selecting which files to send, which is
++ augmented by the file-selection switches presented in [270]Section
++ 3.5.1.
++
++ FTP MPUT [ switches ] filespec [ filespec [ ... ] ]
++ FTP MPUT is just like FTP PUT except it allows you to give more
++ than one file specification, and it does not allow an as-name
++ in the file list. However, as-names can be given to either PUT
++ or MPUT with the /AS-NAME: switch.
++
++ If a PUT or MPUT command results in one file being uploaded, it
++ succeeds if the file is uploaded completely and fails otherwise. If
++ more than one file is selected for upload, success or failure depends
++ on the [271]FTP ERROR-ACTION setting; if it is PROCEED (the default
++ setting), then the [M]PUT command succeeds if at least one of the
++ files was completely uploaded, and fails otherwise, If FTP
++ ERROR-ACTION is QUIT, the [M]PUT command succeeds if all selected
++ files were uploaded successfully, and fails if any file failed.
++
++ FTP uploads may be interrupted just like Kermit uploads. While the
++ transfer is in progress, type:
++
++ X to interrupt the current file and go on to the next file.
++ Z to cancel the current file and all remaining files.
++ ^C (Control-C): Like Z, but might act more quickly.
++
++ MPUT may be used as in regular FTP clients, but it is not required to
++ send multiple files; in Kermit it is required only if you want to give
++ multiple file specifications. Examples:
++
++ ftp put oofa.txt ; Send a single file oofa.txt
++ ftp put oofa.txt budget.txt ; Send single file oofa.txt as budget.txt
++ ftp put *.txt ; Send all *.txt files
++ ftp mput *.txt ; Send all *.txt files (same as "put *.txt")
++ ftp mput *.txt foo.bar ; Send all *.txt files plus foo.bar
++
++ The distinction between PUT and MPUT is important only when more than
++ one filespec is given, just like the distinction between Kermit SEND
++ and MSEND:
++
++ ftp put oofa.txt budget.txt ; Send oofa.txt AS budget.txt
++ ftp mput oofa.txt budget.txt ; Send oofa.txt AND budget.txt
++
++ If the source file specification includes any path segments, for
++ example:
++
++ put /tmp/oofa.txt
++ put subdir/another/andanother/oofa.txt
++
++ the path portion is stripped from the filename that is sent to the
++ server. However, if an as-name contains a path, it is retained.
++ Examples:
++
++ ftp put /usr/doc/oofa.txt ; Send as "oofa.txt".
++ ftp put oofa.txt /tmp/oofa.txt ; Send as "/tmp/oofa.txt"
++
++ The latter example sends the file oofa.txt from your current local
++ directory to the server's /tmp directory. This works only if the
++ server uses the same directory notation that you used in the as-name
++ AND the given directory already exists on the server AND if you have
++ write access to it.
++
++ Use caution when uploading from a case-sensitive file system, such as
++ UNIX, to a file system that is not case sensitive, such as Windows or
++ VMS. If you have two files in UNIX, AA and aa and upload both of them,
++ the second one will overwrite the first. The only way around this
++ provided by FTP protocol is its "unique server names" feature (SET FTP
++ UNIQUE-SERVER-NAMES or the /UNIQUE switch described below).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.5.1. FTP PUT Switches
++
++ FTP PUT and MPUT are similar in format and behavior to the regular
++ Kermit SEND and MSEND commands, and they allow most of the same
++ optional switches:
++
++C-Kermit>ftp put ? Filename, or switch, one of the following:
++ /after: /larger-than: /rename-to:
++ /array: /listfile: /server-character-set:
++ /as-name: /local-character-set: /server-rename-to:
++ /before: /move-to: /simulate
++ /binary /nobackupfiles /smaller-than:
++ /command /nodotfiles /tenex
++ /delete /nofollowlinks /text
++ /dotfiles /not-after: /transparent
++ /error-action: /not-before: /type:
++ /except: /permissions: /update
++ /filenames: /quiet /unique-server-names
++ /filter: /recover
++ /followlinks /recursive
++
++ Since most of these switches are common to Kermit's SEND and MSEND
++ commands, they described only briefly here. For greater detail see:
++
++ [272]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5 (explanation
++ of switches)
++ [273]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7
++ (file-transfer switches)
++
++ First the file-selection switches:
++
++ /AFTER:date-time
++ /BEFORE:date-time
++ /NOT-AFTER:date-time
++ /NOT-BEFORE:date-time
++ Only send those files modified on or after or before the given
++ date and time. These switches can be combined to select files
++ modified between two date/times. Various date-time formats are
++ accepted; if the date-time contains spaces, it must be enclosed
++ in braces or doublequotes. See
++ [274]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6 and
++ [275]Section 8.13 of this document for details about date-time
++ formats. Examples:
++
++ ftp put /after:{1 jan 2000 0:00:00} *
++ ftp put /after:-5days *
++
++ /LARGER-THAN:number
++ /SMALLER-THAN:number
++ Only send files larger (smaller) than the given number of bytes
++ (octets). These switches can be combined to select files in a
++ certain size range.
++
++ /TYPE:{TEXT,BINARY}
++ Only send files that are the given type, which is determined
++ for each file just before sending it by file scanning. BINARY
++ includes TENEX; if you have included a /TENEX switch, or
++ previously given a [SET] FTP TYPE TENEX command, binary files
++ are sent in TENEX, rather than BINARY mode.
++
++ /[NO]DOTFILES
++ [Don't] include files whose names begin with dot (.). By
++ default, such files are not included unless your filespec
++ explicitly mentions them.
++
++ /NOBACKUPFILES
++ Don't include files whose names end with .~nnn~, where nnn is a
++ number, e.g. oofa.txt.~27~. These are backup files created by
++ Kermit, EMACS, and other applications. By default, backup files
++ are included.
++
++ /NOFOLLOWLINKS
++ (UNIX only) Skip over symbolic links rather than following them
++ (default). This applies to wildcard and/or recursive [M]PUTs;
++ if a single filename is given, and it happens to be a symbolic
++ link, the file it points to is sent.
++
++ /FOLLOWLINKS
++ (UNIX only) Always follow (resolve) symbolic links, even in
++ wildcard or recursive [M]PUTs. Use with caution. Watch out for
++ circular links, endless loops, etc.
++
++ /EXCEPT:pattern
++ Exception list -- don't send files whose names match the given
++ pattern. See [276]Section 1.5.4 of the [277]C-Kermit 7.0 Update
++ Notes for details. If you want to exclude a directory from a
++ recursive [M]PUT, use /EXCEPT:{dirname/*}.
++
++ /RECURSIVE
++ Sends the desired files from the current (or given) directory,
++ plus all directories beneath it, including empty directories,
++ replicating the directory structure on the server. No special
++ capabilities are required in the server, but of course your
++ login ID on the server must have the appropriate access and
++ permission to create directories. Recursive PUTs work not only
++ between like platforms (e.g. UNIX to UNIX) but also between
++ unlike ones (e.g. UNIX to VMS or Windows), in which case
++ text-file format differences are handled by Kermit's automatic
++ text/binary mode switching ([278]Section 4) and character-set
++ translation ([279]Section 3.7). Synonym: /SUBDIRECTORIES.
++
++ /UPDATE
++ Send only files that have changed since last time ([280]Section
++ 3.5.2).
++
++ /ARRAY:arrayname
++ The "file" to be sent is an array, or a segment of one, rather
++ than a real file. In this case the other selection switches
++ don't apply. The array contents are sent in text mode, and each
++ array element is treated as a line. Example:
++
++ ftp put /as-name:array.txt /array:&a
++
++ (or, to send a segment of the array, /array:&a[100:199]). If
++ you don't include an /AS-NAME, a name of "_array_x_" is used
++ (where x is the array letter). If you include this switch, most
++ other switches are meaningless and ignored.
++
++ /COMMAND
++ The "file" to be sent is the standard output of a command,
++ rather than a real file. It is sent in text or binary mode
++ according to the prevailing FTP TYPE, which can be overridden
++ with a /TEXT or /BINARY switch. Example: Example:
++
++ ftp put /command /as-name:{userlist} {finger | sort -r}
++
++ /LISTFILE:filename
++ Tells Kermit to obtain the list of files to be sent from the
++ file whose name is given. This file must contain one file
++ specification (which may be wild) per line. If the list
++ includes files from different directories, such as a recursive
++ listing of a directory tree, the paths are recreated on the
++ server (if possible) if you include the /RECURSIVE switch;
++ otherwise all the files are sent to the current directory on
++ the server.
++
++ Now the other switches:
++
++ /AS-NAME:text
++ If a single file is being sent, send it with the given text as
++ its name. If multiple files are being sent, the text must be a
++ template that includes variables such as \v(filename),
++ \v(filenumber), \v(ntime), to allow dynamic creation of each
++ name. The same applies to the as-name field of the FTP PUT
++ command. If this switch is not included (and an as-name is not
++ included as the second filename to PUT), each file is sent with
++ its own name.
++
++ /BINARY
++ /TEXT
++ /TENEX
++ Forces this upload to take place in the given mode, regardless
++ of the current FTP TYPE setting, and without automatic
++ text/binary switching. /ASCII is a synonym for /TEXT.
++
++ /FILTER:command
++ Specifies that the file(s) is/are to be passed through the
++ given command or pipeline on their way to the server. Example:
++
++ ftp put /binary /filter:{gzip -c \v(filename)} /as-name:\v(filename).gz *
++
++ /TRANSPARENT
++ /LOCAL-CHARACTER-SET:name
++ /SERVER-CHARACTER-SET:name
++ Character-set translation for text files, explained in
++ [281]Section 3.7.
++
++ /ERROR-ACTION:{PROCEED,QUIT}
++ Overrides the prevailing [282]FTP ERROR-ACTION for the duration
++ of this PUT or MPUT command only.
++
++ /RECOVER
++ Resume an interrupted transfer where from the point of
++ interruption (explained in [283]Section 3.5.2). Synonym:
++ /RESTART.
++
++ /DELETE
++ Tells Kermit to delete each source file immediately after, and
++ only if, it has been uploaded completely and successfully.
++ This, in effect, moves the file from the client to the server.
++
++ /MOVE-TO:directory
++ Tells Kermit to move each source file to the named local
++ directory after, and only if, it has been uploaded completely
++ and successfully.
++
++ /RENAME-TO:template
++ Tells Kermit to rename each (local) source file according to
++ the given template after, and only if, it has been uploaded
++ completely and successfully. The template works as in /AS-NAME.
++
++ /SERVER-RENAME-TO:template
++ Tells Kermit to ask the server to rename each file according to
++ the given template as soon as, and only if, it has been
++ received completely and successfully. The template works as in
++ /AS-NAME. Requires write and rename access on the server, so
++ doesn't usually work with (e.g.) anonymous uploads to public
++ incoming areas where the permissions don't allow renaming.
++ Examples:
++
++ ftp mput /server-rename:\v(filename).ok *
++ Appends ".ok" to each filename on the server when it's
++ finished uploading.
++
++ ftp mput /as-name:\v(filename).tmp /server-rename:\v(filename) *
++ This is the reverse of the previous example; it uses a
++ temporary name while uploading is in progress and reverts
++ the file to its real name when uploading is complete.
++
++ ftp mput /as-name:\v(filename)
++ /server-rename:../final/\v(filename) *
++ Moves the file from the working directory to a final
++ directory when the upload is complete, but in this case
++ you have to know the pathname syntax of the server. If
++ the rename fails, the [M]PUT command fails according to
++ the [284]FTP ERROR-ACTION selection.
++
++ /FILENAMES:{AUTOMATIC,CONVERTED,LITERAL}
++ Overrides the [285]FTP FILENAMES setting for this upload only.
++
++ /PERMISSIONS:{ON,OFF}
++ Overrides the [286]FTP PERMISSIONS setting for this upload
++ only.
++
++ /UNIQUE
++ Tells Kermit to tell the server to give [287]unique names to
++ incoming files that would otherwise overwrite existing files
++ that have the same name. This switch conflicts with /UPDATE,
++ /RECOVER, /PERMISSIONS, and /SERVER-RENAME since the client has
++ no way of knowing the name assigned by the server.
++
++ /QUIET
++ Don't display file-transfer progress or statistics.
++
++ /SIMULATE
++ Shows which files would be sent without actually sending them.
++ Useful (for example) with /UPDATE (next section). The results
++ are shown in the file-transfer display (if it is not disabled)
++ and in the transaction log (if one is active). Hint: use SET
++ TRANSFER DISPLAY BRIEF.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.5.2. Update Mode
++
++ When you include the /UPDATE switch, this means to skip sending any
++ file that already exists on the server if the local file's
++ modification date/time is not later than that of the corresponding
++ file on the server. Here is a typical application for update mode:
++ Suppose that on Computer A, you maintain a large set of files (say, a
++ collection of Web pages and graphics images, or the source files for a
++ software application), and you need to keep a parallel copy on another
++ Computer, B. Of course you could upload the entire collection every
++ day:
++
++ cd source-directory
++ ftp computerb.xyzcorp.com
++ ( authentication details... )
++ ftp cd target-directory
++ ftp put [ switches ] *
++
++ But if the total size is large or the network slow, this would be
++ unnecessarily time-consuming. Worse, if other users or sites had to
++ update whenever new files appeared in B's directory, this would cause
++ them unnecessary work. By including the /UPDATE switch:
++
++ ftp put /update [ other-switches ] *
++
++ only those files that changed since last time are uploaded. Here's how
++ it works. For each local file that is selected for uploading:
++
++ * The remote filename is determined in the normal way, according to
++ the [288]FTP FILENAMES setting, /FILENAMES switch, or the as-name,
++ if any.
++ * Kermit sends an MDTM (modification time) command for the
++ corresponding remote filename to the server.
++ * If the server does not understand the MDTM command, the file is
++ sent.
++ * If the server can't find a file with the given name, the file is
++ sent.
++ * If the local file's modification time is later than that of the
++ remote file, the file is sent.
++ * Otherwise -- the remote file exists but its modification time is
++ equal to or earlier than that of the local file -- the file is
++ skipped.
++
++ All time comparisons take place in Coordinated Universal Time
++ (UTC)([289]1), also known as GMT or Zulu time: Timezone 0; standard
++ time, without daylight savings.
++
++ WARNING: Some FTP servers, such as Novell NWFTPD.NLM, ignore or
++ misimplement the FTP specification and send local time rather than
++ UTC.
++
++ Update mode is useful only when always used in the same direction.
++ When you upload (PUT) a file with FTP, the destination file receives
++ the current timestamp on the server's computer, not the original
++ file's timestamp ([290]2). If you try to FTP PUT /UPDATE the same file
++ again, it will be skipped (as expected) since the remote copy is
++ newer. However, if you try to FTP GET /UPDATE the same file
++ ([291]Section 3.6), it will be transferred for the same reason.
++
++ To check the availability of PUT /UPDATE on a particular connection,
++ issue an FTP MODTIME command for a file that is known to exist on the
++ server. If it succeeds, PUT /UPDATE should work and in that case, you
++ can run a procedure like the one above every day: the first time, it
++ sends all the files; after that, it sends only the ones that changed.
++ If a transaction log is active, a notation is included for any files
++ that are skipped.
++
++ Notes:
++ 1. Why is Coordinated Universal Time abbreviated UTC? From the
++ [292]National Institute of Standards and Technology FAQ: "In 1970
++ the Coordinated Universal Time system was devised by an
++ international advisory group of technical experts within the
++ International Telecommunication Union (ITU). The ITU felt it was
++ best to designate a single abbreviation for use in all languages
++ in order to minimize confusion. Since unanimous agreement could
++ not be achieved on using either the English word order, CUT, or
++ the French word order, TUC, the acronym UTC was chosen as a
++ compromise."
++ 2. The Kermit FTP client is unusual in that, when downloading only,
++ it can set the received file's date from the file's date on the
++ server, but this should not affect the update feature. When
++ uploading to an FTP server, however, there is no mechanism for the
++ client to set the date of the uploaded file on the server.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.5.3 Recovery
++
++ Suppose that while you are uploading a large file over a slow
++ connection, the connection is lost before the entire file is
++ transferred. With most FTP clients, you would have to start over, thus
++ resending the portion of the file that was sent already, and that is
++ already on the server. But Kermit's /RECOVER switch (Synonym:
++ /RESTART) lets you continue an interrupted transfer from the point of
++ failure, thus transferring only the part that wasn't sent already. The
++ prerequisites for recovery are:
++
++ * The transfer must be in BINARY mode, or else the client and server
++ must reside on like systems (e.g. both on some form of UNIX).
++ * The FTP server must support the SIZE command.
++
++ Here's how it works. When you include the /RECOVER switch:
++
++ * Kermit checks for conflicting switches, such as /UPDATE and
++ /UNIQUE; if /RECOVER is given with these switches an error occurs.
++ If /RECOVER is given in other circumstances where it could serve
++ no useful purpose (e.g. with arrays, pipes, or filters), it is
++ ignored.
++
++ If the switch is accepted, then for each selected file:
++
++ * If it is not binary (determined by scanning) and the client and
++ server are not on like platforms, recovery is canceled (the entire
++ file is sent). Otherwise:
++ * A SIZE command is sent for the file (using its remote name). If
++ the reply indicates the file was not found, or the SIZE command
++ was not understood, or any other kind of error, recovery is
++ canceled. Otherwise:
++ * A MDTM (modification time) command is sent for the file. If a
++ valid reply is received, and the modification time of the local
++ file is later than that of the remote file, recovery is canceled.
++ Otherwise:
++ * If the sizes of the two files are identical, the file is not sent.
++ Otherwise:
++ * Kermit seeks to the recovery spot in the local file, tells the
++ server to APPEND the data which is about to arrive to the remote
++ file, and then sends the data starting at the recovery point.
++
++ To safeguard file integrity, recovery is not attempted unless all the
++ preconditions are met. For the widest possible usefulness, APPEND is
++ used rather than RESTART. For stream transfers (the only kind that
++ Kermit supports) the results are the same.
++
++ By design, the /RECOVER switch can be included with any FTP PUT or
++ MPUT command, even if it specifies a group of files. This allows you
++ to resume an interrupted batch transfer from where it left off. The
++ files that were already completely sent are skipped, the file that was
++ interrupted is recovered, and the remaining files are uploaded.
++
++ By the way, it doesn't matter how the original partial file was
++ uploaded -- FTP, Kermit, Zmodem, etc: as long as the preconditions are
++ met, it can be recovered with FTP PUT /RECOVER, or for that matter
++ also using Kermit protocol and SEND /RECOVER.
++
++ A word of caution, however, when the original upload was in text mode
++ with character-set translation ([293]Section 3.7):
++
++ * If the original upload involved a translation from one single-byte
++ character set to another (e.g. Code Page 850 to Latin-1), recovery
++ is safe if you specify the same translations for the recovery. If
++ you don't, the resulting file will contain a mixture of character
++ sets.
++ * If the original upload involved a translation that changed the
++ size of the file (e.g. from an alphabetic Code Page or Latin
++ Alphabet to Unicode, or vice versa), recovery is NOT safe, even if
++ you specify the same translations.
++
++ Kermit has no way of knowing anything about the previous upload. As a
++ safeguard, an error occurs if you include /RECOVER and also specify a
++ character-set of UCS2 or UTF8, since recovery can't possibly work in
++ that situation. Otherwise, it's up to you to avoid unsafe recovery
++ operations.
++
++ [ [294]Top ] [ [295]FTP Top ] [ [296]C-Kermit Home ] [ [297]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6. Downloading Files With FTP
++
++ Although uploading files with Kermit's FTP client is just as easy and
++ flexible as sending files with Kermit protocol, the same is not always
++ true for downloading because FTP servers lack some of the capabilities
++ of a Kermit server:
++
++ * If you want to get more than one file, you have to use MGET, not
++ GET, since the underlying FTP protocol is different in the two
++ cases. Kermit can't "autodetect" which one you mean, as it can
++ with PUT and MPUT, since it can't be expected to know the wildcard
++ syntax of the remote platform and/or FTP server (the same is true
++ for all other FTP clients). To complicate matters, FTP protocol
++ now includes two underlying mechanisms (NLST and MLSD) for
++ accomplishing MGET operations and, as explained in [298]Section
++ 3.11, the two behave differently.
++ * Automatic text-binary mode switching is not done by the server. It
++ can be done by the client (Kermit), but in this case it is not
++ based on a file scan (since there is no way for Kermit prescan a
++ server file), but rather on the filename, using C-Kermit 7.0
++ [299]filename patterns.
++ * Some options that are available with FTP PUT can not be used with
++ FTP [M]GET or don't work the same way:
++ /PERMISSIONS (FTP protocol has no mechanism for this).
++ /[NOT-]BEFORE, /[NOT-]AFTER (because of the timezone problem).
++ /RECOVER works only in binary mode. /RECURSIVE has limited
++ utility.
++
++ The commands for downloading are:
++
++ SET FILE DOWNLOAD-DIRECTORY [ directory ]
++ As with Kermit transfers, this command, if given, tells
++ C-Kermit where to store incoming files in the absence of a
++ specific as-name. If not given, incoming files are stored as
++ indicated by the as-name, if any, otherwise in the current
++ directory, just as with Kermit transfers. The more verbose
++ transfer display formats give the full pathname of each
++ received file, and, in case you have trouble finding a
++ downloaded file afterwards, its full path is also listed in the
++ transaction log (if you kept one), and you can also ask Kermit
++ where it went with the [300]WHERE command.
++
++ SET FTP GET-FILETYPE-SWITCHING { ON, OFF }
++ ON by default, causing Kermit to switch automatically into text
++ or binary mode for each file based on whether its name matches
++ a text pattern or binary pattern. Set this OFF, or use a /TEXT,
++ /BINARY, or /TENEX switch to defeat this feature. Use SHOW
++ PATTERNS to see the current pattern list.
++
++ [ FTP ] GET [ switches ] filename [ as-name ]
++ Asks the server to send the given file, and if it comes, stores
++ it locally under the given as-name, if any, otherwise under its
++ original name (modified according to the selected filename
++ conversion option), in your download directory, if you have
++ specified one, otherwise in the directory indicated in the
++ as-name, if any, otherwise in your current directory. If you
++ accidentally use a wildcard in the filename ("get *.txt") the
++ server will reply with a message like "File not found" (unless
++ there is a file whose name actually is "*.txt"). If FTP
++ GET-FILETYPE-SWITCHING is ON, and in the absence of any GET
++ switches to override it, the file is transferred in binary mode
++ if it matches any of Kermit's binary name patterns, and in text
++ mode if it matches any of Kermit's text name patterns, and in
++ the prevailing FTP TYPE if it matches none of these patterns.
++
++ [ FTP ] MGET [ switches ] filespec [ filespec [ filespec [ ... ] ] ]
++ Like GET, but for multiple files. One or more file
++ specifications can be given, and any or all (or none) of them
++ can contain wildcards or can be directory names. The file list
++ may not include an as-name, but you can still give one with the
++ /AS-NAME: switch.
++
++ In both the FTP GET and MGET commands, any filenames that contain
++ spaces must be enclosed in braces or doublequotes (see [301]Section 5
++ for details).
++
++ FTP downloads may be interrupted just like Kermit transfers. While the
++ transfer is in progress, type:
++
++ * X to interrupt the current file and go on to the next file.
++ * Z (or Control-C) to cancel the current file and all remaining
++ files.
++
++ Before proceeding, a brief word about temporary files. In FTP
++ protocol, the MGET command works by requesting a file list from the
++ server, and then (internally) issuing a GET command (FTP RETR protocol
++ directive) for each file. The file list returned by the server can be
++ any size at all, so in case it is huge, we don't store it in memory;
++ instead we put it in a temporary file. For troubleshooting purposes,
++ you should be aware of two points:
++
++ 1. The location of the temporary file is chosen according the TMP or
++ TEMP environment variables. If neither of these variables is
++ defined, you might need to define it. In case there is not enough
++ space on the indicated disk or partition for the server's file
++ list, you might need to either clean up the temporary area, or
++ redefine the environment variable to indicate a different area
++ that has sufficient space.
++ 2. If you want to look at the list yourself, use SET FTP DEBUG ON.
++ This tells Kermit to (a) give you the full pathname of the
++ temporary file at the end of each MGET command, and (b) not to
++ delete it, as it normally does.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6.1. FTP GET Switches
++
++ The following switches are available with FTP GET and MGET:
++
++ /TEXT
++ Specifies a text-mode transfer. Overrides the global FTP TYPE
++ setting and filename pattern-matching for the duration of the
++ current command only, All files are downloaded in text mode.
++ Synonym: /ASCII.
++
++ /BINARY
++ Specifies a binary-mode transfer. Overrides the global FTP TYPE
++ setting and filename pattern-matching for the duration of the
++ current command only. All files are downloaded in binary mode.
++
++ /TENEX
++ Like /BINARY but specifies a special binary transfer mode to be
++ used when getting 8-bit binary files from a 36-bit platform
++ such as TOPS-10, TOPS-20, or TENEX. All files are downloaded in
++ the special binary mode.
++
++ /RECOVER
++ This instructs Kermit to try to recover an incomplete download
++ from the point of failure. Works only in binary mode, and only
++ if the server supports the (not-yet-standard) FTP "REST"
++ directive. See [302]Section 3.6.3 for details. Synonym:
++ /RESTART.
++
++ /FILENAMES:{CONVERTED,LITERAL}
++ Overrides the [303]FTP FILENAMES (filename conversion) setting
++ for this download only, forcing incoming filenames to be either
++ converted or taken literally.
++
++ /AS-NAME:text
++ For GET, this is equivalent to giving an as-name after the
++ filename. For MGET, this is the only way to specify alternative
++ names for the incoming files. With MGET, the /AS-NAME text
++ should (must) contain a Kermit variable, usually \v(filename)
++ or \v(filenumber). Example:
++
++ mget /text /as-name:\v(filename).new *.c
++
++ This gets all ".c" files and stores them with "
++
++ .new" appended to their names. See the [304]C-Kermit 7.0 Update
++ Notes for details.
++
++ /COMMAND
++ This specifies that the incoming file is to be written to the
++ standard input of a command, rather than to a file. The command
++ name is the as-name from the GET command or the /AS-NAME
++ argument. If you need to refer to the incoming file's name in
++ the command, use \v(filename). See the description of the
++ regular Kermit [305]GET /COMMAND command for details and
++ examples.
++
++ /QUIET
++ Transfers the files quietly; don't put up a file-transfer
++ display.
++
++ /ERROR-ACTION:{QUIT,PROCEED}
++ This switch affects only MGET. If an error occurs with a
++ particular file, this tells whether to go on to the next file
++ (PROCEED) or to stop right away and fail (QUIT). The default is
++ PROCEED.
++
++ The file selection switches are:
++
++ /EXCEPT:{pattern} or /EXCEPT:{{pattern}{pattern}{...}}
++ Exception list for MGET; skip downloading any file whose name
++ matches any of the given patterns (when using the second
++ format, up to 64 patterns may be specified). [306]CLICK HERE
++ for syntax details.
++
++ /SMALLER-THAN:number
++ Download only files whose size is smaller than the given number
++ of bytes (octets). Requires that the FTP server support the
++ SIZE or MLSD directive.
++
++ /LARGER-THAN:number
++ Download only files whose size is greater than the given number
++ of bytes. Requires that the FTP server support the SIZE or MLSD
++ directive.
++
++ /NOBACKUPFILES
++ During MGET, don't download any files whose names end with
++ backup suffixes (.~n~ where n is a number).
++
++ /NODOTFILES
++ During MGET, don't download any files whose names begin with
++ period (.). Equivalent to /EXCEPT:{.*}.
++
++ /LISTFILE:local-filename
++ The given file contains a list of files to GET, one per line.
++ Filenames in the listfile can contain wildcard characters in
++ the syntax of the server. There is no limit on the number of
++ lines in the listfile.
++
++ /NAMELIST:local-filename
++ If this switch is given, then instead of actually retrieving
++ the selected files, the GET command retrieves a list of the
++ names of the files that would be retrieved, and places it in
++ the specifed file. The resulting file is an ordinary text file,
++ with one filename per line, suitable for reading by a person,
++ or processing by a computer program, including Kermit itself
++ (FOPEN / FREAD / FWRITE / FCLOSE), and as /FILELIST: file. If
++ the filename is omitted or given as "-" (dash, hyphen), the
++ list goes to the screen. NOTE: if you want a copy of the
++ complete list sent by the server, use SET FTP DEBUG ON, perform
++ an MGET, and the temporary file containing the list will be
++ kept rather than deleted (and Kermit tells you its name).
++
++ /UPDATE, /COLLISION:keyword
++ Explained in [307]Section 3.6.2.
++
++ /RECURSIVE
++ This means to try to download an entire directory tree, rather
++ than just files from a particular directory. In fact, FTP
++ protocol does not provide a method to request a recursive
++ download (unless the server supports MLSD; see [308]Section
++ 3.11), so this works only if the FTP server does it anyway,
++ without being asked, as some do. In this case, Kermit detects
++ that names in the returned file list contain directory
++ separators, and therefore attempts to create the needed
++ directories as the files arrive. But this can work only if the
++ server is on the same kind of platform as the client, so the
++ pathname syntax can be recognized, and also because the server
++ does not switch between text and binary mode, which would be
++ vital for cross-platform transfers. Use with caution. Synonym:
++ /SUBDIRECTORIES.
++
++ Even when the server does not provide recursive file lists,
++ [M]GET /RECURSIVE forces Kermit to replicate any directory
++ structure implied or expressed by the server's file list. For
++ example:
++
++ get somepath/somefile
++
++ Gets the file named somefile from the server's somepath
++ directory and puts it Kermit's current (or download) directory,
++ whereas:
++
++ get /recursive somepath/somefile
++
++ creates the path locally and then puts the file in it.
++ Similarly for MGET:
++
++ mget */data/*
++
++ downloads all the files in all the data subdirectories of all
++ the subdirectories of the server's current directory and stores
++ them locally in Kermit's current (or download) directory,
++ whereas:
++
++ mget /recursive */data/*
++
++ re-creates the server's directory structure locally.
++
++ The FTP protocol does not include explicit mechanisms for recursion,
++ so Kermit builds upon what is available. Although an Internet draft
++ describes a mechanism ("MLSD") that would allow protocol-driven
++ recursion, similar to Kermit's File Attribute packets (circa 1984), it
++ has not yet attained RFC or standard status, and servers are not yet
++ widely available that offer this feature. In the meantime, the
++ effectiveness of MGET /RECURSIVE depends on the FTP server
++ implementation. If the server returns a recursive list in response to
++ the standard NLST command (whose behavior is ill-defined), Kermit's
++ FTP MGET /RECURSIVE command uses it to re-create the remote directory
++ tree locally. If the server supports MLSD, C-Kermit 8.0.206 and Kermit
++ 95 2.1 and later are able to sense it automatically and use it, as
++ described below in [309]Section 3.11.
++
++ The /BEFORE:, /AFTER:, /NOT-BEFORE:, and /NOT-AFTER: switches are not
++ available for downloading because of the confusion with timezones.
++ Would the given times be in the local timezone, the server's timezone,
++ or GMT? The FTP server's directory listings show its own local times
++ but since we don't know what timezone the server is in, there's no way
++ to reconcile our local times with the server's. Similarly,
++ /PERMISSIONS can't be preserved in downloads because FTP protocol
++ provides no means of querying the server for a file's permission.
++
++ Source-file disposition switches:
++
++ /DELETE
++ Each file that is downloaded successfully is to be deleted from
++ the server. Requires the appropriate file access rights on the
++ server.
++
++ /SERVER-RENAME-TO:template
++ Asks the server to rename each (remote) source file immediately
++ after, and only if, it is sent correctly. See [310]PUT
++ /SERVER-RENAME-TO: for details.
++
++ Destination-file disposition switches:
++
++ /TO-SCREEN
++ Displays the incoming file on the screen rather than storing it
++ on disk. If this switch is given, the /RENAME-TO and /MOVE-TO
++ switches are ignored, the file-transfer display is suppressed,
++ and the given file(s) is/are shown on the screen. Can be used
++ with /FILTER, e.g.
++
++ get /text /to-screen /filter:more oofa.txt
++
++ In fact, you should always use /TO-SCREEN with /FILTER or
++ /COMMAND when the command would result in displaying the
++ incoming file on the screen; otherwise C-Kermit would have no
++ way of knowing to suppress its file transfer display (since it
++ can't be expected to know what the command or filter does).
++
++ /RENAME-TO:template
++ Each file that is downloaded is to be renamed as indicated if
++ and only if it was received completely and without error. The
++ template can be literal text or can contain variables that are
++ evaluated for each file. For MGET, the text must contain
++ variables; for GET it can be a literal string. The \v(filename)
++ variable contains the name of the current file, so:
++
++ ftp mget /rename-to:\v(filename).ok *
++
++ causes each file that is successfully downloaded to have ".ok"
++ appended to its name. For details see [311]Section 4.1 of the
++ [312]C-Kermit 7.0 Update Notes.
++
++ /MOVE-TO:text
++ Just like /RENAME-TO:, except the text denotes the name of a
++ directory to which successfully downloaded files are to be
++ moved. If the directory does not exist, it is created.
++
++ The file transfer display does not show the /MOVE-TO or /RENAME-TO
++ value, since the incoming file has not yet been moved or renamed.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6.2. Filename Collisions
++
++ What should happen if an incoming file has the same name as an
++ existing file in the same directory? By default, Kermit's FILE
++ COLLISION setting applies: BACKUP, RENAME, UPDATE, DISCARD, etc, as
++ described in [313]Using C-Kermit. Kermit's default FILE COLLISION
++ setting is BACKUP (rename the existing file and store the incoming
++ file under its own name) and therefore this is also the default FTP
++ collision action.
++
++ The name under which an incoming file is to be stored is determined as
++ follows:
++
++ * If an as-name was given, the as-name is used. Otherwise:
++ * If the client and server platforms are alike or [314]FTP FILENAMES
++ is set to LITERAL (or the /FILENAMES:LITERAL switch was given for
++ this download), the incoming filename is used literally.
++ Otherwise:
++ * The incoming filename is converted to a form that is friendly to
++ the local platform. For UNIX, for example, incoming filenames that
++ are all uppercase (as they might be from, say, VMS or an IBM
++ mainframe) are converted to lowercase.
++
++ If the resulting name coincides with the name of a local file that
++ already exists, we have a filename collision. Collisions are handled
++ according to the currently selected collision action:
++
++ SET FTP COLLISION { BACKUP, RENAME, UPDATE, DISCARD, APPEND, OVERWRITE
++ }
++ This establishes a filename collision for FTP, separate from
++ the Kermit one. The initial FTP collision setting is inherited
++ from Kermit's FILE COLLISION setting when the first FTP command
++ is given, but subsequent changes to Kermit's FILE COLLISION
++ setting do not affect the FTP COLLISION setting. SHOW FTP tells
++ the current FTP COLLISION setting.
++
++ FTP GET /COLLISION:{BACKUP,RENAME,UPDATE,DISCARD,APPEND,OVERWRITE}
++ Overrides the current FTP COLLISION action for this download
++ only.
++
++ FTP GET /UPDATE
++ This is equivalent to GET /COLLISION:UPDATE, and is included
++ for symmetry with PUT /UPDATE
++
++ FTP GET /UPDATE and /COLLISION:UPDATE mean to download only those
++ files whose modification dates on the server are later than those on
++ the client. Date-time comparisons are done in Coordinated Universal
++ Time (UTC, GMT, ZULU). The command:
++
++ FTP MGET /COLLISION:APPEND /AS-NAME:newfilename *.*
++
++ Downloads all matching remote files into a single local file (in
++ whatever order the server sends them).
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.6.3. Recovery
++
++ Recovery is available for downloads too, but there are some
++ differences from the uploading case described in [315]Section 3.5.3:
++
++ * The transfer must be in BINARY mode. It can not be in text mode,
++ even if the FTP server is on the same kind of platform as Kermit,
++ and even if there is no character-set translation. The original
++ download must also have been in binary mode.
++ * The FTP server must support the REST ("restart") directive.
++ Unfortunately, this is not a standard command; at this writing, it
++ is described only in an Internet Draft, not an RFC or Internet
++ Standard, but nevertheless it is found in several popular FTP
++ servers, such as [316]ProFTPD.
++
++ Here's how download recovery works:
++
++ * Kermit checks for conflicting switches, such as /UPDATE, /COMMAND,
++ or /FILTER. If /RECOVER is given with these switches an error
++ occurs.
++ * The prevailing transfer mode (SET FTP TYPE) must be BINARY. If it
++ is not, the /BINARY switch must have been included with the FTP
++ [M]GET command.
++
++ If the /RECOVER switch is accepted, then for each selected file:
++
++ * A SIZE command is sent for the file (using its remote name). If
++ the reply indicates the file was not found, or the SIZE command
++ was not understood, or any other kind of error, recovery is
++ canceled (i.e. the entire file is downloaded).
++ * If the sizes of the two files are identical, the file is not sent.
++ Otherwise:
++ * Kermit sends the REST directive to the server, indicating the size
++ of the local file. If the server responds affirmatively, Kermit
++ opens the local file in append mode and appends the incoming data
++ to it. Otherwise, recovery is canceled and the entire file is
++ downloaded.
++
++ The /RECOVER switch can be included with any FTP GET or MGET command,
++ even if it specifies a group of files. This lets you resume an
++ interrupted batch transfer from where it left off. The files that were
++ already completely sent are skipped, the file that was interrupted is
++ recovered, and the remaining files are uploaded. BUT... unlike with
++ uploading, where this can be done with any mixture of text and binary
++ files, when downloading, it can only be done if all the files are
++ binary.
++
++ It doesn't matter how the original partial file was downloaded -- FTP,
++ Kermit, HTTP, Zmodem, etc: as long as the preconditions are met, it
++ can be recovered with FTP [M]GET /RECOVER, or for that matter also
++ with GET /RECOVER (using Kermit protocol).
++
++ [ [317]Top ] [ [318]FTP Top ] [ [319]C-Kermit Home ] [ [320]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7. Translating Character Sets
++
++ A possibly unique feature of Kermit's FTP client is its ability to
++ convert character sets when transferring files in text mode,
++ independent of the capabilites of the FTP server, as well as to
++ translate the character sets of filenames regardless of transfer mode.
++ For compatibility with existing FTP clients, and because there is a
++ certain performance penalty, Kermit won't do this unless you ask for
++ it. If you enable this feature, you need to inform Kermit of the
++ character set (to be) used on the server and in some cases (explained
++ below) also the local file character set. This discussion assumes you
++ know a bit about character sets (as you must if you have to use them);
++ see Chapter 16 of [321]Using C-Kermit for a detailed treatment. The
++ Kermit commands for FTP character-set conversion are:
++
++ SET FTP CHARACTER-SET-TRANSLATION { ON, OFF }
++ Whether to translate character sets when transferring text
++ files with FTP. OFF by default. Set this to ON to enable
++ character-set translation for subsequent FTP uploads and
++ downloads.
++
++ SET FTP SERVER-CHARACTER-SET [322]name
++ Text character set (to be) used by the server. Most FTP servers
++ are ignorant of character sets, so all translations are done
++ unilaterally by Kermit's FTP client. This means that when
++ downloading files, you must know in advance the character-set
++ used in the files you are downloading (and in their names).
++ When uploading, you must specify the character-set to which
++ local filenames and text-file contents are to be translated for
++ transmission to the server. If you SET FTP
++ CHARACTER-SET-TRANSLATION ON but do not specify an FTP
++ SERVER-CHARACTER-SET, [323]UTF8 is used, since this is the new
++ Internet standard international character set; it is upwards
++ compatible with ASCII and it encompasses most written languages
++ and therefore does not favor any particular group of people, as
++ any other default would do. If you SET FTP SERVER-CHARACTER-SET
++ to something (anything) when FTP CHARACTER-SET TRANSLATION is
++ OFF, this also sets the latter ON.
++
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET [324]name
++ This is the regular Kermit (non-FTP-specific) command for
++ identifying the character set (to be) used in local text files
++ and filenames.
++
++ TO REITERATE: If you SET FTP CHARACTER-SET TRANSLATION ON but do not
++ specify an FTP SERVER-CHARACTER-SET, outbound text files are converted
++ to UTF-8 and inbound text files are assumed to be UTF-8. If this is
++ not appropriate, be sure to also specify the desired FTP
++ SERVER-CHARACTER-SET.
++
++ You can use "special" (non-ASCII) characters in filenames in all the
++ client / server file management commands (FTP MKDIR, RMDIR, DIRECTORY,
++ VDIRECTORY, DELETE, etc), and also in file-transfer commands. When
++ giving commands such as FTP DIR (RDIR) and FTP PWD (RPWD), the reply
++ is translated too, so you can read it. In this example, the client and
++ server use entirely different codes to represent the special
++ characters of German:
++
++ C-Kermit> ftp xyzcorp.de /anonymous
++ C-Kermit> set ftp server-character-set latin1
++ C-Kermit> set file character-set german
++ C-Kermit> rcd Städte
++ C-Kermit> rpwd
++ "/pub/ftp/Städte is current directory"
++ C-Kermit> rdir
++ -rw-rw---- 1 olaf 54018 Jan 6 17:58 Adenbüttel.txt
++ -rw-rw---- 1 ursula 373 Jan 5 15:19 Aßlar.txt
++ -rw-rw---- 1 gisbert 482 Jan 5 15:20 Blowatz.txt
++ -rw-rw---- 1 gudrun 124 Jan 5 15:19 Böblingen.txt
++ -rw-rw---- 1 olga 14348 Jan 7 14:23 Köln.txt
++
++ When the client and server file systems use different character sets,
++ you should take care to use only those characters that the two sets
++ share in common when creating filenames or text-file contents. For
++ example, PC code pages contain a lot line- and box-drawing characters,
++ and sometimes "smart quotes", etc, that are not found in ISO standard
++ 8-bit character sets. You should be especially careful to avoid using
++ such characters in filenames.
++
++ [ [325]C-Kermit Character Sets ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.1. Character Sets and Uploading
++
++ Kermit's PUT and MPUT commands include full file-scanning
++ capabilities, as described in [326]Section 4. Thus if FTP
++ CHARACTER-SET-TRANSLATION is ON and your character-set associations
++ are set up appropriately, Kermit automatically switches on a per-file
++ basis between text and binary mode, and for each text file between
++ your chosen 7-bit text character set (e.g. ASCII or ISO 646 German),
++ 8-bit text (e.g. Latin-1 or Japanese EUC), UCS-2, and UTF-8, and
++ converts each of these automatically to the server character-set, and
++ furthermore automatically differentiates between the Little and Big
++ Endian forms of UCS-2, always sending in Big Endian form.
++
++ WARNING: It is not advisable to use UCS-2 (or any Unicode
++ transformation other than UTF-8) "on the wire", i.e. as a server
++ character set. Most FTP servers are not able to cope with it, since
++ it contains lots of 0 (NUL) characters. If you do use it, Kermit
++ does not translate filenames to or from UCS-2, for reasons well
++ known to C programmers (for example, UNIX APIs assume filename
++ strings are NUL-terminated). [327]UTF-8 is the preferred (and
++ standard) Unicode format for the Internet.
++
++ FTP character-set translations differ from the regular Kermit ones by
++ not restricting translations to a file-character-set /
++ transfer-character-set pair. You can have Kermit's FTP client
++ translate between any pair of character sets it knows about. You can
++ see the list of supported character sets by typing either of the
++ following:
++
++ set ftp server-character-set ?
++ set file character-set ?
++
++ A typical list looks like this ([328]CLICK HERE for an explanation of
++ the names):
++
++ C-Kermit>set file char ? One of the following:
++ ascii cp869-greek hebrew-7 mazovia-pc
++ british cyrillic-iso hebrew-iso next-multinational
++ bulgaria-pc danish hp-roman8 norwegian
++ canadian-french dec-kanji hungarian portuguese
++ cp1250 dec-multinational iso2022jp-kanji shift-jis-kanji
++ cp1251-cyrillic dg-international italian short-koi
++ cp1252 dutch jis7-kanji spanish
++ cp437 elot927-greek koi8 swedish
++ cp850 elot928-greek koi8r swiss
++ cp852 euc-jp koi8u ucs2
++ cp855-cyrillic finnish latin1-iso utf8
++ cp858 french latin2-iso
++ cp862-hebrew german latin9-iso
++ cp866-cyrillic greek-iso macintosh-latin
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ Thus you can translate not only between private sets (like PC code
++ pages) and standard ones (like Latin-1) as in Kermit protocol, but
++ also between any given pair of private sets (e.g. CP852 and Mazovia).
++ All conversions go through Unicode as the intermediate character set,
++ resulting in a minimum of character loss, since Unicode is a superset
++ of all other character sets known to Kermit.
++
++ In addition to the SET commands listed above, the FTP PUT and MPUT
++ commands include switches that apply only to the current command:
++
++ /LOCAL-CHARACTER-SET:name
++ /SERVER-CHARACTER-SET:name
++ Use these switches to force a particular translation. These
++ switches override the global FTP CHARACTER-SET-TRANSLATION and
++ SERVER-CHARACTER-SET settings and also character-set
++ differentiation by file scanning for the duration of the PUT or
++ MPUT command. The file scan is still performed, however, to
++ determine whether the file is text or binary; thus these
++ switches do not affect binary files unless you also include the
++ /TEXT switch to force all files to be treated as text.
++
++ In other words, if you include one or both of these switches with a
++ PUT or MPUT command, they are used. Similarly, the /TRANSPARENT switch
++ disables character-set translation for the PUT or MPUT command despite
++ the prevailing FTP CHARACTER-SET-TRANSLATION and SERVER-CHARACTER-SET
++ settings.
++
++ When uploading, the FILE CHARACTER-SET setting is ignored unless you
++ have forced Kermit not to [329]scan local files by including a /TEXT
++ or /BINARY switch with your [M]PUT command, or by disabling automatic
++ text/binary switching in some other way.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ 1. Suppose you have a CP852 (East European) text file that you want
++ to upload and store in ISO Latin Alphabet 2 encoding:
++ ftp put /local-char:cp852 /server-char:latin2 magyar.txt
++ 2. Suppose you always want your text files converted to Latin-2 when
++ uploading with FTP. Then put:
++ set ftp server-character-set latin2
++ in your Kermit customization file, and then you can omit the
++ /SERVER-CHARACTER-SET: switch from your FTP PUT commands:
++ ftp put /local-char:cp852 magyar.txt
++ 3. Now suppose that all the text files on your PC are written in
++ Hungarian, but they have a variety of encodings, and you don't
++ want to have to include the /LOCAL-CHARACTER-SET: switch on every
++ FTP PUT command, or (more to the point) you want to be able to
++ send a mixture of these files all at once. Put these commands in
++ your Kermit customization file:
++ set ftp server-character-set latin2 ; ISO 8859-2
++ set file default 7-bit-character-set hungarian ; ISO 646 Hungarian
++ set file default 8-bit-character-set cp852 ; PC East European Code Page
++ and now PUT and MPUT will automatically detect and switch among
++ ISO 646 Hungarian, Code Page 852, UTF-8, and UCS-2 encodings,
++ translating each one to Latin-2 for uploading:
++ ftp put *.txt
++
++ And since binary files are also detected automatically, the latter can
++ be simplified to:
++
++ ftp put *
++
++ even when "*" matches a diverse collection of binary and text files,
++ because translations are skipped automatically for binary files.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.2. Character Sets and Downloading
++
++ The commands and switches are the same as for uploading, but automatic
++ character-set switching works differently, since Kermit can't scan the
++ server files in advance. Instead, the transfer mode (text or binary)
++ is based on the filenames; each name is compared with Kermit's list of
++ text name patterns and binary name patterns. If the name matches a
++ binary pattern (for example, if the filename is oofa.tar.gz and one of
++ the filename patterns is "*.gz"), the file is downloaded in binary
++ mode; otherwise if it matches a text pattern (e.g. oofa.txt matches
++ "*.txt"), it is transferred in text ("ascii") mode. Otherwise, it is
++ transferred in the prevailing FTP TYPE.
++
++ In C-Kermit 8.0, the pattern lists used with FTP GET are not the same
++ lists used with Kermit transfers, and can not be viewed with SHOW
++ PATTERNS, nor adjusted with ADD and REMOVE TEXT-PATTERNS and
++ BINARY-PATTERNS, or SET FILE TEXT-PATTERNS and BINARY-PATTERNS.
++ Configuration of the FTP patterns list will be added in a future
++ release.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ get /server-char:latin1 /local-char:cp850 Grüße.txt
++ In this command, the filename contains special characters,
++ which you enter using whatever character set your local
++ computer uses, in this case PC Code Page 850 (cp850). The
++ command tells Kermit (in case it didn't know already from its
++ FILE CHARACTER-SET setting) that the local character set is
++ cp850 and the server's character-set is ISO 8859-1 Latin
++ Alphabet 1 (latin1). Kermit translates the filename from cp850
++ to latin1 and sends the latin1 name to the server. Since it's a
++ text file (matches "*.txt"), its contents are translated to
++ cp850 on arrival, and it is saved with a cp850 name.
++
++ mget /text /server:latin1 /local:utf8 *.txt
++ This command:
++
++ + Tells C-Kermit that the server's files are encoded in ISO
++ 8859-1 Latin Alphabet 1.
++ + Tells C-Kermit to translate the incoming files into Unicode
++ UTF-8 for storage.
++ + Asks the server to send all ".txt" files in text mode.
++
++ mget /server:latin1 /local:utf8 *
++ Tells Kermit to get all files from the server's directory,
++ switching between text and binary mode based on the filename.
++ The names of all the files are translated (to UTF-8 in this
++ case), but contents are translated (also to UTF-8) only for
++ text files.
++
++ Note that any pair of 8-bit character sets is likely to have some
++ incompatibilities. Any characters in the source file that do not have
++ equivalents in the destination file's character set are converted to
++ question marks. This applies to both filenames and to text file
++ contents.
++
++ Also note that the server's ability to accept special characters in
++ filenames depends on the particular server. For example:
++
++ get Grüße.txt
++
++ works with WU-FTPD, but:
++
++ mget Grüß*.txt
++
++ does not.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.7.3. RFC2640
++
++ [330]RFC2640, July 1999, specifies a method by which the FTP client
++ and server can negotiate the use of UTF8. However, RFC2640-capable
++ servers are rare to nonexistent at this writing, and in any case you
++ don't need them to be able to transfer text in UTF8. C-Kermit lets you
++ upload and download text files in any character set it knows about,
++ converting to or from any other character set it knows about, without
++ the knowledge, permission, or cooperation of the server, and
++ regardless of its capabilities.
++
++ [ [331]Top ] [ [332]FTP Top ] [ [333]C-Kermit Home ] [ [334]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.8. FTP Command Shortcuts
++
++ C-Kermit's FTP client coexists with other C-Kermit functions by
++ requiring the "ftp" prefix for each FTP-related command: FTP OPEN, FTP
++ GET, FTP BYE, and so on. For interactive use, however, this can be
++ rather awkward and sometimes surprising, for example when a GET
++ command starts a Kermit GET rather than an FTP GET. In fact, many
++ Kermit commands might just as easily apply to an FTP connection: GET,
++ PUT (SEND), BYE, and CLOSE. The following command lets you choose how
++ these commands are interpreted:
++
++ SET GET-PUT-REMOTE { AUTO, KERMIT, FTP }
++ Controls the orientation of GET, PUT, REMOTE and other
++ file-transfer and client/server commands that might apply to
++ either Kermit or FTP. The default setting is AUTO, meaning that
++ these commands apply to FTP if an FTP connection is open, and
++ to Kermit otherwise. KERMIT means they always apply to Kermit,
++ FTP means they always apply to FTP.
++
++ Here is a complete list of affected commands:
++
++ Kermit Command FTP Equivalent
++ (none) FTP [ OPEN ]
++ LOGIN FTP USER
++ LOGOUT FTP RESET
++ BYE FTP BYE
++ FINISH FTP BYE
++ CLOSE FTP BYE
++ HANGUP FTP BYE
++ BINARY FTP TYPE BINARY
++ TEXT (or ASCII) FTP TYPE ASCII
++ SEND (or PUT) FTP PUT
++ MSEND (or MPUT) FTP MPUT
++ RESEND FTP PUT /RECOVER
++ CSEND FTP PUT /COMMAND
++ GET FTP GET
++ MGET FTP MGET
++ REGET FTP GET /RECOVER
++ REMOTE HELP (RHELP) FTP HELP
++ REMOTE CD (RCD) FTP CD (CWD)
++ REMOTE PWD (RPWD) FTP PWD
++ REMOTE DIRECTORY (RDIR) FTP DIRECTORY
++ REMOTE DELETE (RDEL) FTP DELETE
++ REMOTE MKDIR (RMKDIR) FTP MKDIR
++ REMOTE RMDIR (RRMDIR) FTP RMDIR
++ REMOTE RENAME (RRENAME) FTP RENAME
++ REMOTE TYPE (RTYPE) FTP TYPE
++ REMOTE EXIT (REXIT) FTP BYE
++
++ The commands in the right-hand column always access FTP. The commands
++ in the left column can access either Kermit protocol or FTP:
++
++ * When GET-PUT-REMOTE is set to KERMIT, or to AUTO when there is no
++ FTP connection, the commands in the left-hand column access Kermit
++ protocol, and those right-hand column are required for FTP.
++ * When GET-PUT-REMOTE is set to FTP, or to AUTO when there is an
++ active FTP connection, the commands in the left-hand column access
++ the FTP connection and can not be used to access Kermit protocol.
++ In this case, if you want to be able to use both Kermit protocol
++ and the FTP connection, you must SET GET-PUT-REMOTE KERMIT, and
++ then use the FTP commands in the right-hand column to access the
++ FTP connection.
++
++ Note that file-management commands such as DIRECTORY, DELETE, CD, PWD,
++ MKDIR, RMDIR, HELP, RENAME, COPY, TYPE, and so on, always apply
++ locally, no matter what kind of connection you have. This is the
++ opposite of most FTP clients, where these commands are intended for
++ the server, and require an "L" prefix for local execution (e.g. "dir"
++ gets a directory listing from the server, "ldir" gets a local
++ directory listing). To illustrate with the CD command and a typical
++ UNIX FTP client:
++
++ Client Server Change Local Directory Change Remote Directory
++ FTP FTP lcd cd (cwd)
++ Kermit Kermit cd rcd, remote cd
++ Kermit FTP cd ftp cd, rcd, remote cd
++
++ Also note that not all REMOTE commands are useful with FTP, since FTP
++ servers do not offer the corresponding functions. These include:
++
++ * REMOTE ASSIGN - FTP servers don't have variables
++ * REMOTE COPY - FTP servers don't copy files
++ * REMOTE HOST - FTP servers don't execute host (shell) commands
++ * REMOTE KERMIT - FTP servers don't execute Kermit commands
++ * REMOTE PRINT - FTP servers don't print files
++ * REMOTE QUERY - FTP servers don't have variables
++ * REMOTE SET - FTP servers don't have Kermit settings
++ * REMOTE WHO - FTP servers don't send user lists
++
++ Finally note that command shortcuts do not apply to the HELP command.
++ For help about an FTP command, use (for example) "help ftp delete",
++ not "help delete" or "help rdelete".
++
++ [ [335]Top ] [ [336]FTP Top ] [ [337]C-Kermit Home ] [ [338]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.9. Dual Sessions
++
++ You can have an FTP session open at the same time as a regular Kermit
++ SET LINE or SET HOST (terminal) session. In this case, the default SET
++ GET-PUT-REMOTE AUTO setting should ensure that all "two-faced"
++ commands like GET, PUT, REMOTE, HANGUP, BYE, etc, apply to the Kermit
++ session, and all commands for the FTP session must include the FTP
++ prefix. To be absolutely certain, you can use SET GET-PUT-REMOTE
++ KERMIT.
++
++ ftp foo.bar.baz.com
++ if fail ...
++ (log in)
++ set host foo.bar.baz.com
++ if fail ...
++ (log in)
++
++ Now you have both an FTP and Telnet connection to the same host (of
++ course they could also be to different hosts, and you could also have
++ a direct or dialed serial connection instead of a Telnet connection).
++ Now assuming you have a Kermit server on the far end of the Kermit
++ connection:
++
++ rcd incoming ; Changes Kermit server's directory (= REMOTE CD)
++ ftp cd incoming ; Changes FTP server's directory
++ put oofa.txt ; Sends a file on the Kermit connection
++ ftp put oofa.txt ; Sends a file on the FTP connection
++ bye ; Shuts down the Kermit connection
++ ftp bye ; Shuts down the FTP connection
++
++ Note that PUT and SEND are synonyms for both FTP and Kermit
++ connections.
++
++ You can also establish dual sessions on the Kermit command line:
++
++ kermit -j host1 -9 host2
++
++ This makes a Telnet connection to host1 and an FTP connection to
++ host2.
++
++ [ [339]Top ] [ [340]FTP Top ] [ [341]C-Kermit Home ] [ [342]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.10. Automating FTP Sessions
++
++ Most of Kermit's scripting features can be used to make and control
++ FTP sessions: FOR and WHILE loops, IF-ELSE and SWITCH constructions,
++ variables, arrays, built-in functions, and all the rest. You can't use
++ INPUT, MINPUT, OUTPUT, CLEAR, or SCRIPT on an FTP session, but these
++ are not needed since the FTP protocol is well defined.
++
++ [343]CLICK HERE for an FTP scripting tutorial.
++
++ 3.10.1. FTP-Specific Variables and Functions
++
++ The following variable tells whether an FTP connection is open:
++
++ \v(ftp_connected)
++ 1 if there is an active FTP connection, 0 if there isn't.
++
++ The FTP OPEN command sets:
++
++ \v(ftp_host)
++ The host to which the most recent FTP connection was made.
++
++ \v(ftp_security)
++ The security method negotiated for the current FTP session. The
++ value is "NULL" when no security is used. See [344]3.2. Making
++ Secure FTP Connections.
++
++ \v(ftp_server)
++ The OS type (UNIX, VMS, etc) of the FTP server host.
++
++ The FTP USER command (or FTP OPEN /USER:, or FTP with automatic login)
++ sets:
++
++ \v(ftp_loggedin)
++ 1 if you are logged in to an FTP server, 0 if you are not.
++
++ The current COMMAND-PROTECTION-LEVEL and DATA-PROTECTION-LEVEL values
++ are reflected in:
++
++ \v(ftp_cpl)
++ \v(ftp_dpl)
++ The values are "clear", "confidential", "safe" or "private".
++ See [345]3.2. Making Secure FTP Connections.
++
++ The FTP GET-PUT-REMOTE setting is reflected in:
++
++ \v(ftp_getputremote)
++ The values are "auto", "ftp", or "kermit".
++
++ Every FTP command sets the \v(success) variable, as well as the
++ following two FTP-specific variables:
++
++ \v(ftp_code)
++ The standardized numeric FTP protocol code from the server's
++ response to the last client command, a 3-digit decimal number
++ defined in [346]RFC959. Briefly:
++
++ 1xx = Positive Preliminary Reply
++ 2xx = Positive Completion Reply
++ 3xx = Positive Intermediate Reply
++ 4xx = Transient Negative Completion Reply
++ 5xx = Permanent Negative Completion Reply
++
++ \v(ftp_message)
++ The text message, if any, from the server's response to the
++ last client command. If the most recent response had multiple
++ lines, this variable has only the final line. These messages
++ are not standardized and vary in format and content from server
++ to server. Synonym: \v(ftp_msg).
++
++ FTP file transfers set the regular Kermit transfer status variables:
++
++ \v(cps) Characters per second of most recent transfer.
++ \v(filespec) File specification used in most recent transfer.
++ \v(fsize) Size of file most recently transferred.
++ \v(tfsize) Total size of file group most recently transferred.
++ \v(xferstatus) Status of most recent transfer (0 = success, 1 = failure).
++ \v(tftime) Elapsed time of most recent transfer, in seconds.
++
++ During an FTP transfer, the per-file variables are:
++
++ \v(filename) Name of current file.
++ \v(filenumber) Ordinal file number in group (1, 2, 3, ...)
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.10.2. Examples
++
++ Let's begin with a simple example showing how to log in, send some
++ files, and log out:
++
++ define error if fail { ftp bye, stop 1 Error: \%1 }
++ set transact brief
++ log t
++ ftp ftp.xyzcorp.com /anonymous
++ if fail stop 1 Connection failed
++ if not \v(ftp_loggedin) stop 1 Login failed
++ ftp cd incoming
++ error {ftp cd}
++ cd upload
++ error {local cd}
++ ftp put /delete *
++ error {put}
++ ftp bye
++
++ First we define an error handling macro to be used after the
++ connection is made. Then we set up a brief-format transaction log to
++ keep a record of our file transfers. Then we make a connection to the
++ host and log in anonymously. The "if fail" command checks whether the
++ connection was made. The "if not" command checks whether login was
++ successful. Obviously the script should not continue unless both tests
++ succeed.
++
++ Next we change to the server's 'incoming' directory and to our own
++ 'upload' directory, and send all the files that are in it (they can be
++ any mixture of text and binary files), deleting each source file
++ automatically after it is successfully uploaded. Each of these
++ operations is checked with the ERROR macro, which prevents the script
++ from continuing past a failure.
++
++ Finally we close the FTP session with the "bye" command.
++
++ Just like any other Kermit script, this one can be used in many ways:
++
++ * It can be stored in a file, and Kermit can be told to TAKE the
++ file.
++ * In UNIX, it can be a "[347]kerbang" script and therefore run
++ directly from the shell prompt or as a cron job.
++
++ We could have used command shortcuts like "rcd", "put", and "bye", but
++ since they can be ambiguous under certain circumstances, it is better
++ to avoid them in scripts; they are intended mainly for convenience
++ during interactive use. However, if you wish to use the shortcuts in a
++ script, you can do it this way (error handling omitted for brevity):
++
++ local \%t ; Declare a local temporary veriable
++ assign \%t \v(ftp_getputremote) ; Save current FTP GET-PUT-REMOTE setting
++ set ftp get-put-remote ftp ; Choose FTP orientation
++ ftp xyzcorp.com /anonymous ; Open an FTP connection
++ get oofa.txt ; GET a file
++ put foo.bar ; PUT a file
++ rdel yesterday.log ; Delete a file on the server
++ bye ; Log out and disconnect from server.
++ set ftp get-put-remote \%t ; Restore previous GET-PUT-REMOTE setting
++
++ Of course, FTP scripts can also be written as macros. This lets you
++ pass parameters such as hostnames, usernames, and filenames to them:
++
++ define doftpget {
++ if < \v(argc) 4 end 1 Usage: \%0 host user remotefile [ localfile ]
++ ftp \%1 /user:\%2
++ if fail end 1 FTP OPEN \%1 failed
++ if not \v(ftp_loggedin) end 1 FTP LOGIN failed
++ ftp get {\%3} {\%4}
++ if fail end 1 FTP GET \%3 failed
++ ftp bye
++ }
++
++ Add this definition to your Kermit customization file, and it will
++ always be available when you start Kermit. This macro lets you
++ download a file with FTP by giving a single command, e.g.:
++
++ doftpget xyzcorp.com anonymous oofa.txt
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.10.3. Automating Secure FTP Sessions
++
++ Often when making secure connections, you are prompted interactively
++ for certain information or permission to proceed. These prompts can
++ stop an automated procedure. To avoid them, you must give the
++ appropriate commands to disable them, and/or supply the prompted-for
++ information beforehand. Here are a few hints:
++
++ * Make sure that SET TAKE ERROR and SET MACRO ERROR are both OFF.
++ This is the default, but in case you have set either one of these
++ ON in your script or initialization file, this makes the script
++ halt on any kind of error. Normally you would want to check each
++ operation for success or failure and take appropriate action.
++ * On SSL and TLS connections, you may be asked whether it is OK to
++ proceed with a connection to server that presents a self-signed
++ certificate. You can use the SET AUTHENTICATION SSL (or TLS)
++ VERIFY or SET AUTH SSL (or TLS) CERTS-OK commands to avoid this
++ prompt by not requesting a certificate from the peer.
++ * (More to be added...)
++
++ [ [348]Top ] [ [349]FTP Top ] [ [350]FTP Script Tutorial ] [
++ [351]C-Kermit Home ] [ [352]Kermit Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.11. Advanced FTP Protocol Features
++
++ The remainder of the FTP documention (through the end of Section 3) is
++ new to C-Kermit 8.0.206, but we leave it in black to prevent
++ headaches. Except for titles.
++ * [353]TERMINOLOGY
++ * [354]FEATURE NEGOTIATION
++ * [355]USING MGET: NLST VERSUS MLSD
++ * [356]EXAMPLES
++ * [357]REFERENCES
++
++ The new releases of [358]C-Kermit (8.0.206) and [359]Kermit 95 (2.1)
++ support new FTP protocol features from RFC 2389 as well as most of
++ what's in the Elz and Hethmon Extensions to FTP Internet Draft (see
++ [360]References). Some of these features, such as SIZE (request a
++ file's size), MDTM (request file's modification time), and REST
++ (restart interrupted transfer) have been widely implemented in FTP
++ clients and servers for years (as well as in the initial release of
++ the Kermit FTP clients). Others such as FEAT and MLSD are rarely seen
++ and are new to the upcoming Kermit releases. TVFS (Trivial Virtual
++ File Store) is supported implicitly, and the UTF-8 character-set is
++ already fully supported at the protocol and data-interchange level.
++
++ For Kermit users, the main benefit of the new FTP protocol extensions
++ is the ability to do recursive downloads. But the extensions also
++ introduce complications and tradeoffs that you should be aware of. Of
++ course Kermit tries to "do the right thing" automatically in every
++ case for backwards compatibility. But (as noted later) some cases are
++ inherently ambiguous and/or can result in nasty surprises, and for
++ those situations new commands and switches are available to give you
++ precise control over Kermit's behavior, in case the defaults don't
++ produce the desired results.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.11.1. Terminology Command-line FTP clients such as Kermit (as well
++ as the traditional FTP programs found on Unix, VMS, ..., even Windows)
++ have commands like PUT, MPUT, GET, MGET, and BYE, which they convert
++ into zero or more FTP protocol commands, such as NLST, RETR, QUIT. For
++ clarity, we'll use "command" to refer to commands given by the user to
++ the FTP client, and "directive" for FTP protocol commands sent by the
++ FTP client to the FTP server.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.11.2. Feature Negotiation New FTP protocol features are negotiated
++ by the client sending a FEAT directive and the server responding with
++ a list of (new) features it supports, or else with an error indication
++ if it does not support the FEAT directive at all, in which case the
++ client has to guess which new features it supports (Kermit guesses
++ that it supports SIZE and MDTM but not MLST). Note that the MLST
++ feature includes MLSD, which is not listed separately as a feature.
++
++ Guessing is nice when it works, but sometimes it doesn't, and some FTP
++ servers become confused when you send them a directive they don't
++ understand, or they do something you didn't want, sometimes to the
++ point of closing the connection. For this reason, Kermit lets you
++ override default or negotiated features with the following new
++ commands:
++
++ FTP { ENABLE, DISABLE } FEAT
++ Enables or disables the automatic sending of a FEAT directive
++ upon connection to an FTP server. Note that
++ FTP [ OPEN ] /NOINIT also inhibits sending the FEAT directive
++ (and several others) for the connection being OPEN'd, but
++ without necessarily disabling FEAT for subsequent connections
++ in the same Kermit instance. FEAT is ENABLED by default, in
++ which case many FTP servers are likely to reply:
++
++500 'FEAT': command not understood
++
++ which is normally harmless (but you never know). (In C-Kermit
++ 8.0.208, this error message is suppressed unless you SET FTP
++ DEBUG ON.)
++
++ FTP ENABLE { MDTM, MLST, SIZE }
++ Enables the given directive for implicit use by the FTP GET and
++ MGET commands in case it has been disabled or erroneously
++ omitted by the server in its FEAT response. Note: MLSD can be
++ used in the FTP ENABLE and DISABLE commands as a synonym for
++ MLST. YOU MUST GIVE THIS COMMAND AFTER MAKING THE FTP
++ CONNECTION.
++
++ FTP DISABLE { MDTM, MLST, SIZE }
++ Disables implicit use of the given directive by GET or MGET in
++ case it causes problems; for example, because it makes
++ multifile downloads take too long or the server announces it
++ erroneously or misimplements it. Use DISABLE FEAT before making
++ a connection to prevent Kermit from sending the FEAT directive
++ as part of its initial sequence. Note that disabling FEAT,
++ SIZE, or MDTM does not prevent you from executing explicit FTP
++ FEATURES, FTP SIZE, or FTP MODTIME commands. Also note that
++ disabling SIZE prevents PUT /RESTART (recovery of interrupted
++ uploads) from working. YOU MUST GIVE THIS COMMAND AFTER MAKING
++ THE FTP CONNECTION.
++
++ To enable or disable more than one feature, use multiple FTP ENABLE or
++ FTP DISABLE commands. The SHOW FTP command shows which features are
++ currently enabled and disabled.
++
++ FTP FEATURES
++ This command sends a FEAT directive to the server. In case you
++ have been disabling and enabling different features, this
++ resynchronizes Kermit's feature list with the server's. If the
++ server does not support the FEAT directive, Kermit's feature
++ list is not changed.
++
++ FTP OPTIONS directive
++ Informational only: the server tells what options, if any, it
++ supports for the given directive, e.g. MLST. Fails if the
++ server does not support the OPTS directive or if the directive
++ for which options are requested is not valid. The directive is
++ case-insensitive.
++
++ FTP SIZE filename
++ Sends a SIZE directive to the server for the given file. The
++ filename must not contain wildcards. The server responds with
++ an error if the file can't be found, is not accessible, or the
++ SIZE directive is not supported, otherwise with the length of
++ the file in bytes, which Kermit displays and also makes
++ available to you in its \v(ftp_message) variable. If the
++ directive is successful, Kermit (re-)enables it for internal
++ use by the GET and MGET directives on this connection.
++
++ FTP MODTIME filename
++ Works just like the SIZE directive except it sends an MDTM
++ directive. Upon success, the server sends modification
++ date-time string, which Kermit interprets for you and also
++ makes available in its \v(ftp_message) variable.
++
++ Whenever a SIZE or MDTM directive is sent implicitly and rejected by
++ the server because it is unknown, Kermit automatically disables it.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.11.3. Using MGET: NLST versus MLSD When you give an MGET command to
++ an FTP client, it sends a request to the FTP server for a list of
++ files, and then upon successful receipt of the list, goes through it
++ and issues a RETR (retrieve) directive for each file on the list (or
++ possibly only for selected files).
++
++ With the new FTP protocol extensions, now there are two ways to get
++ the list of files: the NLST directive, which has been part of FTP
++ protocol since the beginning, and the new MLSD directive, which is new
++ and not yet widely implemented. When NLST is used and you give a
++ command like "mget *.txt", the FTP client sends:
++
++NLST *.txt
++
++ and the server sends back a list of the files whose names match, e.g.
++
++foo.txt
++bar.txt
++baz.txt
++
++ Then when downloading each file, the client sends SIZE (if it wants
++ have a percent-done display) and MDTM (if it wants to set the
++ downloaded file's timestamp to match that of the original), as well as
++ RETR (to retrieve the file).
++
++ But when MLSD is used, the client is not supposed to send the filename
++ or wildcard to the server; instead it sends an MLSD directive with no
++ argument (or the name of a directory), and the server sends back a
++ list of all the files in the current or given directory; then the
++ client goes through the list and checks each file to see if it matches
++ the given pattern, the rationale being that the user knows only the
++ local conventions for wildcards and not necessarily the server's
++ conventions. So with NLST the server interprets wildcards; with MLSD
++ the client does.
++
++ The interpretation of NLST wildcards by the server is not
++ necessarily required or even envisioned by the FTP protocol
++ definition (RFC 959), but in practice most clients and servers work
++ this way.
++
++ The principal advantage of MLSD is that instead of sending back a
++ simple list of filenames, it sends back a kind of database in which
++ each entry contains a filename together with information about the
++ file: type, size, timestamp, and so on; for example:
++
++size=0;type=dir;perm=el;modify=20020409191530; bin
++size=3919312;type=file;perm=r;modify=20000310140400; bar.txt
++size=6686176;type=file;perm=r;modify=20001215181000; baz.txt
++size=3820092;type=file;perm=r;modify=20000310140300; foo.txt
++size=27439;type=file;perm=r;modify=20020923151312; foo.zip
++(etc etc...)
++
++ (If the format of the file list were the only difference between NLST
++ and MLSD, the discussion would be finished: it would always be better
++ to use MLSD when available, and the MGET user interface would need no
++ changes. But there's a lot more to MLSD than the file-list format;
++ read on...)
++
++ The client learns whether the server supports MLSD in FEAT exchange.
++ But the fact that the server supports MLSD doesn't mean the client
++ should always use it. It is better to use MLSD:
++
++ * On connections where the server imposes a time penalty for every
++ command, e.g. the Red Hat Rawhide server. With MLSD, the client
++ needs to send only one command (RETR) per file, whereas NLST
++ requires three (SIZE, RETR, and MDTM). Suppose there is a
++ 30-second delay for each command and 1000 files are to be fetched;
++ in that case, MLSD saves 60,000 seconds = 1000 minutes = 16 hours
++ and 40 minutes.
++ * For recursive downloads since there is no dependable way to
++ download directory trees with NLST.
++
++ But it is better to use NLST:
++
++ * If you want only a couple short files out of a large directory. In
++ this case, NLST is the better choice since the server sends a list
++ of only the files you want, not a list of (say) a million files,
++ which can make a big difference on slow connections. For example,
++ suppose your wildcard matches three files of 1K each, but the
++ million-file listing is 80MB long, and your connection is through
++ a modem. The overhead of using MLSD is practically infinite.
++ * If the server supports wildcarding features not known to the
++ client, but that can be used to achieve desirable effects
++ otherwise unobtainable, such as "[dir...]*.txt" in VMS or AOS/VS
++ "except" clauses.
++ * If you have been given a wildcard string by an FTP site
++ administrator for fetching a specific group of files out of a
++ larger directory, e.g. "mget ck[cuw]*.[cwh] makefile", that is
++ expected to work with any client (an FTP site administrator can't
++ be expected to know the wildcard syntax of every FTP client).
++
++ But when using MLSD there are complications:
++
++ * MLSD wants either a blank argument (meaning the current directory)
++ or else the name of a specific directory. The client must not send
++ it a wildcard or a filename.
++ * But if the user's command is "mget xxx", how does the client know
++ whether to send "xxx" in the MLSD directive? It might be the name
++ of a directory on on the server, in which case it should be sent,
++ or it might be the name of a file on the server (or a wildcard),
++ in which case it must not be sent. Since the client knows its own
++ wildcard syntax, then in most cases it would be right to send
++ "MLSD" with no argument if xxx is wild, and to send "MLSD xxx" if
++ it is not.
++ * But suppose the server's file system allows filename characters
++ that correspond with the client's wildcard syntax? For example:
++ "[abc]" could be either a valid VMS directory name or a wildcard
++ pattern used by the FTP client. What should the client do with
++ "mget [abc]"? In this case there must be a way for the user to
++ force sending the MGET argument as the MLSD argument.
++ * If "xxx" is a regular file in the server's current directory,
++ "mget xxx" works with NLST but not with MLSD.
++
++ To further complicate matters, NLST can (in theory) work just like
++ MLSD: if sent with a blank argument or a directory name, it is
++ supposed to return a complete list of files in the current or given
++ directory, which the client can match locally against some pattern. It
++ is not known if any FTP server or client does this but nevertheless,
++ it should be possible since this behavior can be inferred from RFC
++ 959.
++
++ In view of these considerations, and given the need to preserve the
++ traditional FTP client command structure and behavior so the software
++ will be usable by most people:
++
++ 1. The MGET command should produce the expected result in the common
++ cases, regardless of whether NLST or MLSD is used underneath.
++ 2. For anomalous cases, the user needs a way to control whether the
++ MGET argument is sent to the server or kept for local use.
++ 3. At the same time, the user might need a way to send a directory
++ name to the server, independent of any wildcard pattern.
++ 4. The user needs a way to force NLST or MLSD for a given MGET
++ command.
++
++ By default, Kermit's MGET command uses MLSD if MLST is reported by the
++ server in its FEAT list. When MLSD is used, the filespec is sent to
++ the server if it is not wild (according to Kermit's own definition of
++ "wild" since it can't possibly know the server's definition). If the
++ filespec is wild it is held for local use to select files from the
++ list returned by the server. If MLST is not reported by the server or
++ is disabled, Kermit sends the MGET filespec with the NLST directive.
++
++ The default behavior can be overridden globally with FTP DISABLE MLST,
++ which forces Kermit to use NLST to get file lists. And then for
++ situations in which MLSD is enabled, the following MGET switches can
++ be used to override the defaults for a specific MGET operation:
++
++ /NLST
++ Forces the client to send NLST. Example:
++
++mget /nlst foo.*
++
++ /MLSD
++ Forces the client to send MLSD (even if MLST is disabled).
++ Example:
++
++mget /mlsd foo.*
++
++ /MATCH:pattern
++ When this switch is given, it forces the client to hold the
++ pattern for local use against the returned file list. If a
++ remote filespec is also given (e.g. the "blah" in "mget
++ /match:*.txt blah"), then it is sent as the NLST or MLSD
++ argument, presumably to specify the directory whose files are
++ to be listed. When the /MATCH switch is not given, the MGET
++ filespec is sent to the server if the directive is NLST or if
++ the filespec is not wild. Examples:
++
++ Command: With NLST: With MLSD:
++ mget NLST MLSD
++ mget *.txt NLST *.txt MLSD
++ mget foo NLST foo MLSD foo
++ mget /match:*.txt NLST MLSD
++ mget /match:*.txt foo NLST foo MLSD foo
++
++ In other words, the pattern is always intepreted locally unless MGET
++ uses NLST and no /MATCH switch was given.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.11.4. Examples
++
++ 3.11.4.1. Downloading a Single File
++
++ There are no choices here, just use the FTP GET command. Kermit always
++ sends the RETR directive, and possibly SIZE and/or MDTM. The small
++ advantage of using MLST in this case is outweighed by the risk and
++ effort of coding a special case.
++
++ 3.11.4.2. Downloading a Group of Files from a Single Directory
++
++ This case presents tradeoffs, especially on slow connections:
++
++ * For downloading all or most of the files in a directory, MLSD is
++ better because it eliminates the need to send SIZE and MDTM for
++ each file. No special actions are required in this case; Kermit
++ uses MLSD automatically if the server supports it (unless you have
++ disabled it).
++ * For a small number of files from a large directory, NLST is better
++ because it bypasses downloading of a potentially huge file list
++ prior to the files themselves. If you have a connection to a
++ server that supports MLSD, use the /NLST switch to force NLST:
++
++mget /nlst t[1234].h
++
++ * If the server supports MLSD but does not support separate SIZE or
++ MDTM directives, and you need the size and/or timestamp
++ information, MLSD is better; no special actions required.
++ * If the server supports MLSD but does not support the "size" and
++ "modify" facts, but it does support the SIZE or MDTM directives,
++ and you need the size and/or timestamp information, NLST is
++ better.
++
++ 3.11.4.3. Downloading a Directory Tree
++
++ MLSD is the only choice for recursive downloads; they rarely, if ever,
++ work with NLST (the few cases where they do work rely on
++ extra-protocol "secret" notations for the NLST argument). No special
++ actions are required to force MLSD when the server supports it, unless
++ you have disabled it. Examples:
++
++ MGET /RECURSIVE
++ This tells the server to send all files and directories in the
++ tree rooted at its current directory.
++
++ MGET /RECURSIVE *.txt
++ This tells the server to send all *.txt files in the tree
++ rooted at its current directory.
++
++ MGET /MLSD /RECURSIVE *.txt
++ Same as the previous example but forces Kermit to send MLSD in
++ case it was disabled, or in case the server is known to support
++ it even though it did not announce it in its FEAT listing.
++
++ MGET /RECURSIVE /MATCH:*.zip archives
++ Tells the server to send all ZIP files in the tree rooted at
++ its "archives" directory.
++
++ MGET /RECURSIVE /MATCH:* [abc]
++ The server is running on VMS and you want it to send all the
++ files in the directory tree rooted at [ABC]. But since "[abc]"
++ looks just like a wildcard, you have to include a /MATCH:
++ switch to force Kermit to send "[abc]" as the MLSD argument.
++
++ In all cases in which the /RECURSIVE switch is included, the server's
++ tree is duplicated locally.
++
++ Although MLSD allows recursion and NLST does not, the MLSD
++ specification places a heavy burden on the client; the obvious,
++ straightforward, and elegant implementation (depth-first, the one
++ that Kermit currently uses) requires as many open temporary files
++ as the server's directory tree is deep, and therefore client
++ resource exhaustion -- e.g. exceeding the maximum number of open
++ files -- is a danger. Unfortunately MLSD was not designed with
++ recursion in mind. (Breadth-first traversal could be problematic
++ due to lack of sufficient navigation information.)
++
++ Of course all of Kermit's other MGET switches can be used too, e.g.
++ for finer-grained file selection (by date, size, etc), for moving or
++ renaming files as they arrive, to override Kermit's automatic per-file
++ text/binary mode switching, to pass the incoming files through a
++ filter, to convert text-file character sets, and so on.
++
++ 3.11.4.4. NLST/MLSD Summary Table
++
++ Here's a table summarizing MGET behavior when the server supports both
++ NLST and MLSD. /NLST and /MLSD switches are included for clarity to
++ indicate which protocol is being used, and the expected effects. In
++ practice you can omit the /NLST and /MLSD switches and the Kermit
++ client chooses the appropriate or desired protocol as described above.
++ Sample commands presume a Unix file system on the server, but of
++ course the server can have any file system or syntax at all.
++
++ User's Command FTP Sends Remarks
++ mget /nlst NLST Gets a list of all the files in the server's current
++ and downloads each file. The list includes names only, so Kermit also
++ must send SIZE and MDTM directives if size and timestamp information
++ is required (this is always true of NLST). Sending NLST without an
++ argument is allowed by the RFC959 NLST definition and by the Kermit
++ FTP client, but might not work with other clients, and also might not
++ work with every server.
++ mget /nlst foo NLST foo If "foo" is a directory, this gets a list of
++ all the files from the server's "foo" directory and downloads each
++ file; otherwise this downloads the file named "foo" (if any) from the
++ server's current directory.
++ mget /nlst *.txt NLST *.txt Gets a list of the files in the server's
++ current directory whose names match the pattern *.txt, and then
++ downloads each file from the list. Because we are using NLST, we send
++ the filespec (*.txt) to the server and the server interprets any
++ wildcards.
++ mget /nlst foo/*.txt NLST foo/*.txt Gets a list of the files in the
++ server's "foo" directory whose names match the pattern *.txt, and then
++ downloads each file from the list (server interprets wildcards).
++ mget /nlst /match:*.txt NLST Gets a list of all the files in the
++ server's current directory and then downloads each one whose name
++ matches the pattern *.txt (client interprets wildcards).
++ mget /nlst /match:*.txt foo NLST foo Gets a list of all the files in
++ the server's "foo" directory and then downloads each one whose name
++ matches the pattern *.txt (client interprets wildcards).
++ mget /mlsd MLSD Gets a list of all the files from the server's current
++ directory and then downloads each one. The list might include size and
++ timestamp information, in which case Kermit does not need to send SIZE
++ and MDTM directives for each file (this is always true of MLSD).
++ mget /mlsd foo MLSD foo Gets a list of all the files from the server's
++ "foo" directory (where the string "foo" does not contain wildcards)
++ and then downloads each one. If "foo" is a regular file and not a
++ directory, this command is supposed to fail, but some servers have
++ been observed that send the file.
++ mget /mlsd *.txt MLSD Gets a list of all the files from the server's
++ current directory and then downloads only the ones whose names match
++ the pattern "*.txt". Because we are using MLSD and the MGET filespec
++ is wild, we do not send the filespec to the server, but treat it as
++ though it had been given in a /MATCH: switch and use it locally to
++ match the names in the list.
++ mget /mlsd foo/*.txt MLSD This one won't work because MLSD requires
++ that the notions of server directory and filename-matching pattern be
++ separated. However, the client, which can't be expected to know the
++ server's file-system syntax, winds up sending a request that the
++ server will (or should) reject.
++ mget /mlsd /match:*.txt MLSD Gets a list of all the files from the
++ server's current directory and then downloads only the ones whose
++ names match the pattern "*.txt" (client interprets wildcards).
++ mget /mlsd /match:*.txt foo MLSD foo If "foo" is a directory on the
++ server, this gets a list of all the files from the server's "foo"
++ directory and then downloads only the ones whose names match the
++ pattern "*.txt" (client interprets wildcards). This leaves the server
++ CD'd to the "foo" directory; there's no way the client can restore the
++ server's original directory because MLSD doesn't give that
++ information, and since the client can not be expected to know the
++ server's file-system syntax, it would not be safe to guess. If "foo"
++ is a regular file, MLSD fails.
++ mget /mlsd foo bar MLSD This one is problematic. You're supposed to be
++ able to give MGET a list a filespecs; in this case we name two
++ directories. The client must change the server's directory to "foo" to
++ get the list of files, and then the files themselves. But then it has
++ no way to return to the server's previous directory in order to do the
++ same for "bar", as explained in the previous example.
++ mget /mlsd /match:* [abc] MLSD [abc] Including a /MATCH: switch forces
++ [abc] to be sent to the server even though the client would normally
++ think it was a wildcard and hold it for local interpretation. In this
++ example, [abc] might be a VMS directory name.
++ mget /mlsd /match:* t*.h MLSD t*.h Contrary to the MLSD specification,
++ some MLSD-capable FTP servers do interpret wildcards. This form of the
++ MGET command can be used to force a wildcard to be sent to the server
++ for interpretation.
++
++ When MLSD is used implicitly (that is, without an /MLSD switch given
++ to force the use of MLSD) and an MGET command such as "mget foo/*.txt"
++ fails, Kermit automatically falls back to NLST and tries again.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.11.5. References
++
++ 1. Postel, J., and J. Reynolds, File Transfer Protocol (FTP), RFC
++ 959, October 1985: [361]ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc959.txt.
++ 2. Hethmon, P, and R. Elz, Feature negotiation mechanism for the File
++ Transfer Protocol, RFC 2389, August 1998:
++ [362]ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2389.txt.
++ 3. Elz, R, and P. Hethmon, Extensions to FTP, Internet Draft
++ draft-ietf-ftpext-mlst-16.txt, September 2002:
++ [363]http://www.ietf.org/internet-drafts/draft-ietf-ftpext-mlst-16
++ .txt.
++ 4. [364]The Kermit FTP Client (overview).
++
++ [ [365]Top ] [ [366]FTP Top ] [ [367]C-Kermit Home ] [ [368]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++4. FILE SCANNING
++
++ A new feature called file scanning is used in various contexts to
++ determine if a file is text or binary, and if it is text, what kind of
++ text. The overhead of file scanning is surprisingly tolerable, usually
++ about a quarter second per file. File scanning is now used instead of
++ filename patterns unless you SET FILE SCAN OFF, which restores the
++ previous behavior.
++
++ The primary benefit of file scanning is in file transfer. For all
++ practical purposes, now you can stop worrying about whether a file
++ should be sent in binary or text mode, or about sending mixtures of
++ text and binary files in a single operation, or configuring and
++ fine-tuning your lists of binary-file and text-file name patterns: now
++ it all just works.
++
++ File scanning is done by the file sender, which determines the type of
++ each file before it sends it and informs the receiver (Kermit or FTP
++ server) of the type. File scanning is NOT done by the receiver,
++ because it is the sender's responsibility to determine each file's
++ type, send the file in the right mode, and inform the receiver of the
++ mode. If both transfer partners are capable of this (or any other)
++ form of automatic text/binary mode switching, then files can be sent
++ in both directions with no worries about corruption due to
++ inappropriate transfer mode. (As noted in [369]Section 3, FTP servers
++ don't do this, so this discussion does not apply when using Kermit to
++ download from an FTP server.)
++
++ The rest of this section is mainly for the curious. If you don't read
++ it and simply accept all defaults, every file you send should go in
++ the appropriate mode automatically. As always, however, for
++ character-set translation to work for 7- and 8-bit character-set
++ files, the appropriate SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command(s) must have
++ been executed to identify their encoding (Kermit's default file
++ character-set is neutral ASCII except on platforms like HP-UX or
++ DG/UX, where the default file character-set is known). And of course,
++ receiving is another matter -- obviously the other Kermit must also
++ send each file in the appropriate mode.
++
++ Scanning is more reliable than filename patterns simply because
++ filenames are not reliable indicators of the file's contents. Classic
++ examples include ".doc" files, which are binary if Microsoft Word
++ documents but text on most other platforms, and ".com" files, which
++ are binary on DOS and Windows but text on VMS. Anyway, nobody knows
++ the naming conventions (if any) of all the applications (and persons!)
++ on your computer. Scanning, on the other hand, determines each file's
++ type by inspecting its contents rather than just looking at its name.
++
++ Also, file patterns -- even when they work as intended -- categorize
++ each file only as text or binary, whereas file scanning can make finer
++ distinctions:
++
++ BINARY
++ Binary data, not to be converted in any way. Examples include
++ binary machine code (executable programs), graphics images
++ (GIF, JPG, etc), compressed files (Z, GZ, etc), archives and
++ packages (ZIP, TAR, RPM, etc), object files and libraries (OBJ,
++ DLL, etc).
++
++ 7-BIT TEXT
++ Text encoded in a 7-bit character set such as ASCII or one of
++ the ISO 646 national versions. Kermit has no way to tell which
++ character is used, only that it's 7-bit text. Typical examples
++ include program source code, README files, Perl or Kermit
++ scripts, plain-text email, HTML, TeX, and various textual
++ encodings of binary files: Hex, Base64, etc. When sending such
++ files, the FILE DEFAULT 7BIT-CHARACTER-SET is used as the file
++ character-set, and then the appropriate transfer character set
++ is chosen from the associations list (ASSOCIATE, SHOW
++ ASSOCIATIONS).
++
++ 8-BIT TEXT
++ Text encoded in an 8-bit character set such as Latin-1,
++ Latin-2, Latin/Hebrew, Latin/Cyrillic, KOI8, HP-Roman8, JIS X
++ 0208, Code Page 437, or Code Page 1252. Again, Kermit has no
++ way of knowing which particular set is in use, only that it's
++ 8-bit text. When sending such files, the FILE DEFAULT
++ 8BIT-CHARACTER-SET is used as the file character-set, and then
++ the appropriate transfer character set is chosen from the
++ associations list.
++
++ UCS2 TEXT
++ Unicode in its basic form, 16 bits (2 octets) per character.
++ When sending such files, UCS2 is the file character-set and the
++ byte order is identified automatically; the appropriate
++ transfer character set is chosen from the associations list.
++ Normally this would be UTF8. UTF-16 is not supported yet;
++ Kermit's Unicode translations are restricted to Plane 0, the
++ Base Multilingual Plane (BMP).
++
++ UTF8 TEXT
++ Unicode in its 8-bit transformation format. When sending such
++ files, UTF8 is the file character-set; the appropriate transfer
++ character set is chosen from the associations list, normally
++ UCS2 or UTF8.
++
++ File scanning is available in UNIX C-Kermit, in K-95, and to a limited
++ extent, in VMS C-Kermit (full scanning is problematic in VMS because
++ even plain-text files might contain binary record-format information).
++ The relevant commands are:
++
++ SET TRANSFER MODE { AUTOMATIC, MANUAL }
++ Tells whether the file-transfer mode (text or binary) should be
++ set by automatic or "manual" means. AUTOMATIC is the default,
++ which allows any of the automatic methods that are enabled to
++ do their jobs: FILE SCAN, FILE PATTERNS, peer recognition, etc.
++ MANUAL lets you control the transfer mode with the SET FILE
++ TYPE commands. As always, /TEXT and /BINARY switches on your
++ file-transfer commands override all other methods; if you give
++ one of these switches, scanning is not done. SHOW TRANSFER
++ displays the current TRANSFER MODE setting.
++
++ SET FILE SCAN { ON [ number ], OFF }
++ Turns this feature on and off. It's ON by default. When OFF,
++ the previous rules apply (SET FILE PATTERNS, etc). When ON is
++ given, you can also specify a number of bytes to be scanned.
++ The default is 49152 (= 48K). If a negative number is given,
++ the entire file is scanned, no matter how big, for maximum
++ certainty (for example, a PostScript file that appears to be
++ plain text might include an embedded graphic past the normal
++ scanning limit). SHOW FILE displays the current FILE SCAN
++ setting.
++
++ SET FILE DEFAULT 7BIT-CHARACTER-SET name
++ Tells the 7-bit character-set to use if scanning identifies a
++ 7-bit text file, e.g. GERMAN. SHOW FILE displays the current
++ SET FILE DEFAULT settings. So does SHOW CHARACTER-SETS.
++
++ SET FILE DEFAULT 8BIT-CHARACTER-SET name
++ Tells the 8-bit character-set to use if scanning identifies an
++ 8-bit text file, e.g. LATIN1. SHOW FILE and SHOW CHARACTER-SET
++ display this.
++
++ ASSOCIATE FILE-CHARACTER-SET fcs tcs
++ When sending files and a file character-set (fcs) is identified
++ by scanning, this tells C-Kermit which transfer character-set
++ (tcs) to translate it to. It also allows C-Kermit to set the
++ appropriate transfer character-set automatically whenever you
++ give a SET FILE CHARACTER-SET command.
++
++ ASSOCIATE TRANSFER-CHARACTER-SET tcs fcs
++ When receivinging files and a file arrives whose transfer
++ character-set (tcs) is announced by the sender, this command
++ tells C-Kermit which file character-set (fcs) to translate it
++ to. It also allows C-Kermit to set the appropriate file
++ character-set whenever you give a SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET
++ command.
++
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET name
++ When given for a 7-bit set, also sets FILE DEFAULT
++ 7BIT-CHARACTER-SET to the same set. When given for an 8-bit
++ set, also sets FILE DEFAULT 8BIT-CHARACTER-SET to the same set.
++ If an ASSOCIATE FILE-CHARACTER-SET command has been given for
++ this set, also sets the corresponding transfer character-set.
++
++ DIRECTORY /XFERMODE [ filespec ]
++ Performs a file scan of the given files, listing the result for
++ each file. If FILE SCAN is OFF but PATTERNS are ON, the result
++ shown according to the current FILE TEXT-PATTERNS and
++ BINARY-PATTERNS, and are restricted to (B) and (T). When FILE
++ SCAN is ON, the results are:
++
++ (B) Binary
++ (T)(7BIT) Text: 7-bit
++ (T)(8BIT) Text: 8-bit
++ (T)(UTF8) Text: Unicode UTF8
++ (T)(UCS2BE) Text: Unicode UCS2 Big Endian
++ (T)(UCS2LE) Text: Unicode UCS2 Little Endian
++
++ So you can use DIR /XFER to get a preview of how each file in a
++ selected group will be transferred. Everything to the right of
++ the (B) or (T) is new. If FILE SCAN is OFF, you only get the
++ (B) or (T) as before.
++
++ Note: Big and Little Endian refer to the ordering of bytes
++ within a computer word. Big Endian architecture is standard and
++ is used on most non-PC computers. Little Endian architecture is
++ used on PCs.
++
++ To illustrate file-transfer with scanning, suppose you have a
++ directory containing a mixture of text and binary files, and each text
++ file can be 7-bit German ISO 646, 8-bit Latin-1, or Unicode in any of
++ the following forms: UCS2 Little Endian, UCS2 Big Endian, or UTF8
++ ([370]UTF-16 is not supported yet). Assuming all the built-in defaults
++ are in effect, the following three commands do the job:
++
++ set file char german ; This sets the default for 7-bit text files
++ set file char latin1 ; This sets the default for 8-bit text files
++ send *
++
++ Each file is sent in the appropriate mode (text or binary), with text
++ files converted to the appropriate transfer character-set and labeled
++ so the receiver can convert them according to its own local
++ conventions.
++
++ By the way, what if you want to inhibit character-set translation but
++ still allow automatic text/binary mode switching? Previously, you
++ could simply SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT. But now with file
++ scanning, the file and transfer character-sets are set automatically
++ per file. A new command was added for this purpose:
++
++ SET TRANSFER TRANSLATION { ON, OFF }
++ Enables and disables file-transfer character-set translation.
++ It is enabled by default.
++
++ When TRANSFER TRANSLATION is OFF but FILE SCAN is ON, files are still
++ scanned to see if they are text or binary, but no character-set
++ translation is done when they text: only the normal record-format
++ conversion.
++
++ Like all SET commands, SET TRANSFER TRANSLATION is global and
++ persistent. You can also force a particular file-transfer command
++ (SEND, MSEND, GET, RECEIVE, TRANSMIT, etc) to not translate without
++ affecting the global translation settings by including the new
++ /TRANSPARENT switch, e.g.
++
++ send /transparent oofa.txt
++
++ As of C-Kermit 8.0.206, SET TRANSFER CHARACTER-SET TRANSPARENT implies
++ SET TRANSFER TRANSLATION OFF.
++
++ File scanning is also used in the TYPE command. The source file type
++ and character set are determined as above, and then the file is
++ automatically converted to your display character-set, line by line.
++ In Kermit 95, the display character-set is Unicode, perhaps converted
++ to your current console code page; in other versions of C-Kermit, it
++ is your current file character-set. Thus if you have the following set
++ appriately:
++
++ SET FILE CHARACTER-SET (necessary in Unix but not K95)
++ SET FILE DEFAULT 7BIT CHARACTER-SET
++ SET FILE DEFAULT 8BIT CHARACTER-SET
++
++ then you should be able to TYPE any text file and see something
++ reasonable. For example, in Unix, if your DEFAULT 7BIT-CHARACTER-SET
++ is ITALIAN and your DEFAULT 8BIT-CHARACTER-SET is LATIN1, and your
++ FILE CHARACTER-SET is LATIN1, you can TYPE an Italian ISO 646 file, a
++ Latin-1 file, or any kind of Unicode file, and have it translated
++ automatically to Latin-1 for your display.
++
++ In the GUI version of Kermit 95, you can see mixtures of many
++ different scripts if the file is UTF8 or UCS2: Roman, Cyrillic,
++ Hebrew, Greek, Armenian, Georgian, etc, all on the same screen at
++ once.
++
++ File scanning also adds a new criterion for file selection, i.e. to
++ select only text (or binary) files. Several commands now include a new
++ switch, /TYPE:{BINARY,TEXT,ALL}. BINARY means select only binary
++ regular files (not directories). TEXT means select only text files.
++ ALL means don't scan; select all files. Examples:
++
++ SEND /TYPE:BINARY *.*
++ Sends only binary files, skipping over text files.
++
++ NOTE: File scanning is NOT done when using external protocols (because
++ the external protocol programs, such as sz, are processing each file,
++ not Kermit).
++
++ DIRECTORY /TYPE:TEXT
++ Lists only text files but not binary files.
++
++ DELETE /TYPE:BINARY foo.*
++ Deletes all foo.* files that are regular binary files but does
++ not delete any text files.
++
++ CHMOD /TYPE:BINARY 775 *
++ (UNIX) Changes the permissions of all binary files to 775.
++
++ When FILE SCAN is OFF and FILE PATTERNS are ON, behavior is as before
++ with PATTERNS ON, but with some improvements:
++
++ * Pathnames are now stripped prior to pattern matching.
++ * Backup suffixes (like .~3~) are stripped prior to pattern
++ matching.
++
++ [ [371]Top ] [ [372]Contents ] [ [373]C-Kermit Home ] [ [374]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++5. FILE AND DIRECTORY NAMES CONTAINING SPACES
++
++ Prior to the introduction of the graphical user interface (GUI), it
++ was inconceivable that file or directory names could contain spaces,
++ because space is a field delimiter in all command languages. GUIs,
++ however, use dialog boxes for filenames, so there is never any
++ question of distinguishing a filename from adjacent fields -- because
++ there are no adjacent fields -- and therefore it has become quite
++ common on computers that have GUIs to have file and directory names
++ composed of multiple words. Of course this poses problems for command
++ shells and other text-oriented programs.
++
++ Most command shells address these problems by allowing such names to
++ be enclosed in doublequotes, e.g.:
++
++ cd "c:\Program Files"
++
++ C-Kermit previously used braces for this:
++
++ cd {c:\Program Files}
++
++ which was not what most people expected. And even when braces were
++ used, Kermit had difficulties with completion, file menus, and so
++ forth, within braced fields.
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 allows either doublequotes or braces to be used for
++ grouping:
++
++ send "this file"
++ send {this file}
++ rename "this file" "that file"
++ rename {this file} "that file"
++ rename "this file" {that file}
++ cd {Program Files}
++ cd "Program Files"
++
++ Note that the doublequotes or brackets must enclose the whole file or
++ directory specification:
++
++ "c:\My Directory"
++
++ not:
++
++ c:\"My Directory"
++
++ In C-Kermit 8.0, you can also use completion on these filenames, in
++ which case Kermit supplies the quotes (or braces) automatically.
++ Example (in which the current directory contains only one file whose
++ name starts with "th" and its full name is "this file" (without the
++ quotes, but with the space)):
++
++ cat th<Tab>
++
++ Kermit repaints the filename field like this:
++
++ cat "this file"
++
++ That is, it backspaces over the original "th" and then writes the
++ filename in doublequotes.
++
++ If completion is only partial, Kermit still supplies the quotes, but
++ in this case also beeps. To continue the filename, you must first
++ backspace over the closing quote. The closing quote is supplied in
++ this case to make sure that you can see the spaces, especially if they
++ are trailing. For example, if the current directory contains two files
++ whose names start with "th", and their fill names are "this file" and
++ "this other file":
++
++ cat th<Tab>
++
++ Kermit prints:
++
++ cat "this "<Beep>
++
++ If it didn't print the closing quote, you would probably wonder why it
++ was beeping.
++
++ Also, if you begin a filename field with a doublequote or opening
++ brace, now you can use completion or get ?-help; this was never
++ possible before.
++
++ C-Kermit>type "thi? Input file specification, one of the following:
++ this file this other file
++ C-Kermit>type "thi_
++
++ [ [375]Top ] [ [376]Contents ] [ [377]C-Kermit Home ] [ [378]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++6. OTHER COMMAND PARSING IMPROVEMENTS
++
++ 6.1. Grouping Macro Arguments
++
++ Doublequotes now can be used in macro invocations to group arguments
++ containing spaces, where previously only braces could be used:
++
++ define xx show args
++ xx one "this is two" three
++
++ Result:
++
++ Macro arguments at level 0 (\v(argc) = 4):
++ \%0 = xx
++ \%1 = one
++ \%2 = this is two
++ \%3 = three
++
++ Also, you can now quote braces and quotes in macro args (this didn't
++ work before). Examples:
++
++ xx "{" ; The argument is a single left brace
++ xx {"} ; The argument is a doublequote character
++
++ In case this new behavior interferes with your scripts, you can
++ restore the previous behavior with:
++
++ SET COMMAND DOUBLEQUOTING OFF
++
++ 6.2. Directory and File Name Completion
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 also includes better completion for directory names, e.g.
++ in the CD command. If the name typed so far uniquely matches a
++ directory name, it is completed (as before), but now if the directory
++ contains any subdirectories, completion is partial (allowing you to
++ supply additional path segments without backspacing); otherwise it is
++ complete.
++
++ Completion has also been improved for file and directory names that
++ contain not only spaces (as described above) but also "metacharacters"
++ such as asterisk (*) and tilde (~): now the field is repainted if
++ necessary. For example, if the current directory contains only one
++ file whose name contains "blah", then in:
++
++ type *blah<Tab>
++
++ "*blah" is replaced by the filename. In earlier releases, the part
++ typed so far was left on the command line (and in the history buffer),
++ so even when the original command worked, the recalled version would
++ not. Similarly for ~ (the nearly-universal Unix notation for
++ username):
++
++ type ~olga/x<Tab>
++
++ is repainted as (e.g.):
++
++ type /users/home/olga/x(Beep)
++
++ Speaking of command history, the new SHOW HISTORY command shows your
++ command history and recall buffer. SAVE COMMAND HISTORY saves it into
++ a file of your choice.
++
++ 6.3. Passing Arguments to Command Files
++
++ The method for passing arguments to command files has been improved.
++ Prior to C-Kermit 7.0 there was no provision for doing this. In
++ C-Kermit 7.0, the TAKE command was changed to allow arguments to be
++ given after the filename:
++
++ take commandfile arg1 arg2 ...
++
++ This was accomplished by replacing the current \%1, \%2, etc, with the
++ given arguments, since a new set of macro argument variables is
++ created only when a macro is executed, not a command file. It is much
++ more intuitive, however, if arguments to command files worked like
++ those to macros: the command file sees the arguments as its own \%1,
++ \%2, etc, but the caller's variables are not disturbed. C-Kermit 8.0
++ accomplishes this by automatically creating an intermediate temporary
++ macro to start the command file (if any arguments were given), thus
++ creating a new level of arguments as expected.
++
++ 6.4. More-Prompting
++
++ The familiar --more?-- prompt that appears at the end of each
++ screenful of command-response output now accepts a new answer: G (Go)
++ meaning "show all the rest without pausing and asking me any more
++ questions". P (Proceed) is a synonym for G.
++
++ 6.5. Commas in Macro Definitions
++
++ As noted in the [379]C-Kermit manual, comma is used to separate
++ commands in a macro definition. Even when the macro is defined on
++ multiple lines using curly-brace block-structure notation without
++ commas, the definition is still stored internally as a comma-separated
++ list of commands. Therefore special tricks are needed to include a
++ comma in a command. The classic example is:
++
++ define foo {
++ (some command)
++ if fail echo Sorry, blah failed...
++ }
++
++ This would result in Kermit trying to execute a "blah" command. This
++ could always be handled by enclosing the text in braces:
++
++ define foo {
++ (some command)
++ if fail echo {Sorry, blah failed...}
++ }
++
++ but doublequotes (more intuitive) should have worked too. Now they do:
++
++ define foo {
++ (some command)
++ if fail echo "Sorry, blah failed..."
++ }
++
++ 6.6. Arrow Keys
++
++ As of version 8.0.201, C-Kermit on most platforms lets you access the
++ command history buffer with arrow keys, just as you always could with
++ control characters. The restrictions are:
++
++ 1. Only Up and Down arrow keys are accepted.
++ 2. Only 7-bit ANSI arrow-key sequences are understood (ESC followed
++ by [ or uppercase letter O, followed by uppercase letter A or (up)
++ B (down).
++
++ This change was made to facilitate command recall in Linux-based PDAs
++ that don't have a Control key, or at least not one that's easily (or
++ always) accessible, such as the Sharp Zaurus SL5500.
++
++ [ [380]Top ] [ [381]Contents ] [ [382]C-Kermit Home ] [ [383]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++7. NEW COMMANDS AND SWITCHES
++
++ See [384]Section 4 for more about file scanning and the /TYPE: switch.
++
++ ASK[Q] [ /TIMEOUT:number /QUIET /DEFAULT:text ] variable [ prompt ]
++ The new optional /TIMEOUT: switch for ASK and ASKQ causes the
++ command to time out and and fail if no response is given within
++ the specified number of seconds, 1 or greater (0 or less means
++ no timeout, wait forever). This works just like SET ASK-TIMER,
++ except its effect is local to the ASK command with which it is
++ given and it does not disturb the global ask timer setting. The
++ new /QUIET switch tells Kermit not to print an error message if
++ the ASK or ASKQ command times out waiting for a response.
++
++ Version 8.0.211 adds the /DEFAULT:text switch for ASK-Class
++ commands (ASK, ASKQ, and GETOK). This lets you supply a default
++ answer in case the user supplies an empty answer or the
++ /TIMEOUT: switch was included and the time limit expired
++ without an answer. In both these cases, the command succeeds.
++
++ CAT filename
++ Equivalent to TYPE /NOPAGE.
++
++ CDUP
++ Changes Kermit's local working directory to the parent of the
++ current one. Equivalent to "cd .." in UNIX or Windows, "cd [-]"
++ in VMS, "cd ^" in AOS/VS, etc; in other words, it's a
++ platform-independent way of moving one level up in a directory
++ tree.
++
++ CHMOD [ switches ] permission files
++ UNIX only. Sets file permissions for one or more files or
++ directories. The permission must be given as an octal number,
++ e.g. 664, 755. Switches: /DIRECTORIES, /FILES, /NOLIST, /PAGE,
++ /DOTFILES, /LIST, /NOPAGE, /RECURSIVE, /TYPE:{TEXT,BINARY,ALL},
++ /SIMULATE. The /TYPE: switch allows selection of only text or
++ binary files. For example, if you have a mixture of source
++ files and executables, you can use "chmod /files /type:text
++ 664" to give owner/group read/write and world read permission
++ to the text files, and "chmod /files /type:binary 775" to give
++ the same plus execute permission to the executables. Use
++ /SIMULATE to see which files would be affected, without
++ actually changing their permissions.
++
++ CLEAR KEYBOARD-BUFFER
++ Flushes any as-yet unread characters from the keyboard input
++ buffer. Useful for flushing typeahead in scripts.
++
++ CONTINUE
++ When given at an interactive command prompt that was reached by
++ issuing a PROMPT command (described in this section) from a
++ script, this command returns to the script, continuing its
++ execution at the command after the PROMPT command. In this
++ context, CONTINUE is simply a more-intuitive synonym for END.
++
++ COPY, RENAME, and TRANSLATE
++ These commands now work on file groups if the target filename
++ is a directory, e.g. "copy oofa.* ..", "rename * ~olga/tmp/"
++
++ COPY /APPEND source destination
++ The source file specification can now include wildcards, in
++ which case all of the source files that match will go into the
++ destination file in alphabetical order by name.
++
++ DELETE /ASK
++ Asks permission to delete each file before deleting it. In
++ C-Kermit 7.0, the answers were "yes" (or "ok") and "no".
++ C-Kermit 8.0 adds "go" (meaning, delete all the rest without
++ asking) and "quit" (cancel the DELETE command and return to the
++ prompt).
++
++ DELETE /DIRECTORIES
++ Deletes not only files but also directories.
++
++ DELETE /RECURSIVE
++ Deletes all files that match the given file specification in
++ the current (or given) directory and all directories beneath
++ it.
++
++ DELETE /SUMMARY
++ Prints only the number of files deleted and total size freed,
++ without listing each file.
++
++ DELETE /TREE
++ Shorthand for DELETE /RECURSIVE /DIRECTORIES /DOTFILES/.
++ Equivalent to Windows DELTREE or Unix "rm -Rf". If no file
++ specification is given, the contents of the current directory,
++ plus all of its subdirectories and their contents, are deleted.
++
++ DELETE /TYPE:BINARY
++ Delete only regular binary files (requires FILE SCAN ON).
++
++ DELETE /TYPE:TEXT
++ Delete only regular text files (requires FILE SCAN ON).
++
++ DIRECTORY [ switches ] [ filespec [ filespec [ filespec ... ] ] ]
++ The DIRECTORY command now accepts more than one file
++ specification; e.g. "directory moon.txt sun.doc stars.*".
++
++ DIRECTORY /NORECURSIVE xxx
++ If xxx is a directory name, forces listing of the directory
++ itself rather than its contents.
++
++ DIRECTORY /FOLLOWLINKS xxx
++ (UNIX only) Tells the DIRECTORY command to follow symbolic
++ links. This not the default because it can cause endless loops.
++
++ DIRECTORY /NOFOLLOWLINKS xxx
++ (UNIX only) Tells the DIRECTORY command not to follow symbolic
++ links, but rather, merely to list them. This is the default.
++
++ DIRECTORY /OUTPUT:filename
++ Sends the results of the DIRECTORY command to the given file.
++
++ DIRECTORY /SUMMARY
++ Prints only the number of directories and files and the total
++ size, without listing each file.
++
++ DIRECTORY /TYPE:{TEXT,BINARY}
++ Shows only files of the selected type, based on file scan.
++
++ DIRECTORY /XFERMODE
++ Now shows results of file scan (see [385]Section 4).
++
++ FOPEN [ switches ] channel filename
++
++ As of version 8.0.211, FOPEN allows /dev/tty as a filename in
++ Unix-based operating systems.
++
++ FREAD /TRIM
++ (8.0.211) Trims any trailing blanks or tabs from the item (such
++ as a line of text) that it has read.
++
++ FREAD /UNTABIFY
++ (8.0.211) Converts Horizontal Tab characters to the appropriate
++ number of spaces, based on VT100-like tab stops
++ (1,9,17,25,...).
++
++ GREP [ switches ] pattern files
++ Similar to Unix grep command: displays file lines that match
++ the given [386]pattern. Switches:
++
++ /COUNT[:variable]
++ Don't show the matching lines, just tell how many lines
++ match. If a variable name is specified, the count is
++ stored in the given variable.
++
++ /DOTFILES
++ Include files whose names begin with dot.
++
++ /LINENUMBERS
++ Show line numbers of matching lines.
++
++ /NAMEONLY
++ only list the names of files that contain matching lines,
++ but not the lines themselves.
++
++ /NOBACKUP
++ Skip backup files.
++
++ /NOCASE
++ Ignore alphabetic case while pattern matching.
++
++ /NODOTFILES
++ skip files whose names start with dot (period).
++
++ /NOLIST
++ Suppress output but set SUCCESS or FAILURE according to
++ search result.
++
++ /NOMATCH
++ Look for lines that do not match the pattern.
++
++ /NOPAGE
++ Don't pause between screens of output.
++
++ /OUTPUT:filename
++ Write results into the given file.
++
++ /PAGE
++ Pause between screens of output.
++
++ /RECURSIVE
++ Search files in subdirectories too.
++
++ /TYPE:{TEXT,BINARY}
++ Search only files of the specified type.
++
++ Synonyms: FIND, SEARCH.
++
++ GETOK /TIMEOUT:n /QUIET /DEFAULT:text
++ The new /QUIET switch instructs GETOK, when given a timeout,
++ not to print an error message if it times out. As of 8.0.211, a
++ default answer can be supplied (see ASK).
++
++ HEAD [ switches ] filename
++ Equivalent to TYPE /HEAD [ other-switches ] filename.
++
++ HELP DATE
++ Explains date-time formats, including timezone notation and
++ delta times.
++
++ HELP FIREWALLS
++ Explains the firewall negotiation capabilities of your version
++ of Kermit.
++
++ KCD [ symbolic-directory-name ]
++ Changes Kermit's working directory to the named symbolic
++ directory, such as such as exedir, inidir, startup, download,
++ or and home. Type "kcd ?" for a list of symbolic directory
++ names known to your copy of Kermit, or give the new ORIENTATION
++ command for a more detailed explanation. If you give a KCD
++ command without a directory name, Kermit returns to its "home"
++ directory, which is determined in some way that depends on the
++ underlying operating system, but which you can redefine with
++ the (new) SET CD HOME command. Your home directory is shown by
++ SHOW CD and it's also the value of the \v(home) variable.
++
++ LICENSE
++ Displays the C-Kermit license.
++
++ L-commands
++ When Kermit has a connection to a Kermit or FTP server, file
++ managment commands such as CD, DIRECTORY, and DELETE might be
++ intended for the local computer or the remote server. C-Kermit
++ 8.0.200 and earlier always executes these commands on the local
++ computer. If you want them executed by the remote server, you
++ have to prefix them with REMOTE (e.g. REMOTE CD) or use special
++ R-command aliases (e.g. RCD = REMOTE CD, RDIR = REMOTE DIR,
++ etc). But this feels unnatural to FTP users, who expect
++ unprefixed file management commands to be executed by the
++ remote server, rather than locally. C-Kermit 8.0.201 adds
++ automatic locus switching to present an FTP-like interface for
++ FTP connections and the normal Kermit interface for Kermit
++ connections, and a SET LOCUS command (described below) to
++ control whether or how this is done. For when LOCUS is REMOTE,
++ a new set of commands was added for local management: LCD
++ (Local CD), LDIR (Local DIR), etc. These are described below
++ under SET LOCUS.
++
++ MORE filename
++ Equivalent to TYPE /PAGE.
++
++ ORIENTATION
++ Displays symbolic directory names and the corresponding
++ variable names and values. The symbolic names, such as exedir,
++ inidir, startup, download, and home, can be used as arguments
++ to the new KCD command.
++
++ PROMPT [ text ]
++ For use in a macro or command file: enters interactive command
++ mode within the current context ([387]Section 8.1). If the
++ optional text is included, the prompt is set to it. The text
++ can include variables, functions, etc, as in the SET PROMPT
++ command. They are evaluated each time the prompt is printed.
++ Unlike the SET PROMPT command, the text argument applies only
++ to the current command level. Thus you can have different
++ prompts at different levels.
++
++ REMOTE SET MATCH { DOTIFILE, FIFO } { ON, OFF }
++ Allows the client to tell the server whether wildcards sent to
++ the server should match dot files (files whose names begin with
++ period) or FIFOs (named pipes). See SET MATCH.
++
++ SET ATTRIBUTE RECORD-FORMAT { ON, OFF }
++ Allows control of the Kermit's Record-Format attribute. Set
++ this to OFF in case incoming file are refused due to unknown or
++ invalid record formats if you want to accept the file anyway
++ (and, perhaps, postprocess it to fix its record format).
++
++ SET CD HOME [ directory ]
++ Specifies the target directory for the CD and KCD commands,
++ when they are given without an argument, and also sets the
++ value of the \v(home) variable.
++
++ SET EXIT HANGUP { OFF, ON }
++ Normally ON, meaning that when Kermit exits, it also explicitly
++ hangs up the current SET LINE / SET PORT serial port according
++ to the current SET MODEM TYPE and SET MODEM HANGUP METHOD, and
++ closes the port device if it was opened by Kermit in the first
++ place (as opposed to inherited). SET EXIT HANGUP OFF tells
++ Kermit not to do this. This can't prevent the operating system
++ from closing the device when Kermit exits (and it's a "last
++ close") but if the port or modem have been conditioned to
++ somehow ignore the close and keep the connection open, at least
++ Kermit itself won't do anything explicit to hang it up or close
++ it.
++
++ SET FILE EOF { CTRL-Z, LENGTH }
++ Specifies the end-of-file detection method to be used by
++ C-Kermit when sending and receiving text files, and in the TYPE
++ and similar text-file oriented commands. The normal and default
++ method is LENGTH. You can specify CTRL-Z when handling CP/M or
++ MS-DOS format text files, in which a Ctrl-Z (ASCII 26)
++ character within the file marks the end of the file.
++
++ SET FILE LISTSIZE number
++ Allocates space for the given number of filenames to be filled
++ in by the wildcard expander. The current number is shown by
++ SHOW FILE. If you give a command that includes a filename
++ containing a wildcard (such as "*") that matches more files
++ that Kermit's list has room for, you can adjust the list size
++ with this command.
++
++ SET FILE STRINGSPACE number
++ Allocates space for the given amount of filename strings for
++ use by the wildcard expander. The current number is shown by
++ SHOW FILE. The number is the total number of bytes of all the
++ file specifications that match the given wildcard.
++
++ If you need to process a bigger list of files than your computer
++ has memory for, you might be able use an external file list. The
++ Kermit SEND and the FTP PUT and GET commands accept a /LISTFILE:
++ switch, which gives the name of a file that contains the list of
++ files to be transferred. Example for UNIX:
++
++ !find . -print | grep / > /tmp/names
++ ftp put /update /recursive /listfile:/tmp/names
++
++ SET LOCUS { AUTO, LOCAL, REMOTE }
++ Added in C-Kermit 8.0.201. Sets the locus for unprefixed file
++ management commands such as CD, DIRECTORY, MKDIR, etc. When
++ LOCUS is LOCAL these commands act locally and a REMOTE (or R)
++ prefix (e.g. REMOTE CD, RCD, RDIR) is required to send file
++ management commands to a remote server. When LOCUS is REMOTE,
++ an L prefix is required to issue local file management commands
++ (e.g. LCD, LDIR). The word LOCAL can't be used as a prefix
++ since it is already used for declaring local variables. LOCUS
++ applies to all types of connections, and thus is orthogonal to
++ SET GET-PUT-REMOTE, which selects between Kermit and FTP for
++ remote file-transfer and management commands. The default LOCUS
++ is AUTO, which means we switch to REMOTE whenever an FTP
++ connection is made, and to LOCAL whenever a non-FTP connection
++ is made, and switch back accordingly whenever a connnection is
++ closed. So by default, Kermit behaves in its traditional manner
++ unless you make an FTP connection, in which case it acts like a
++ regular FTP client (but better :-) LOCUS applies to the
++ following commands:
++
++ Unprefixed Remote Local Description
++ CD (CWD) RCD LCD Change (Working) Directory
++ CDUP RCDUP LCDUP CD Up
++ PWD RPWD LPWD Print Working Directory
++ DIRECTORY RDIR LDIR Request a directory listinga
++ DELETE RDEL LDEL Delete (a) file(s)
++ RENEME RREN LREN Rename a file
++ MKDIR RMKDIR LMKDIR Create a directory
++ RMDIR RRMDIR LRMDIR Remove a directory
++
++ SET MATCH { DOTIFILE, FIFO } { ON, OFF }
++ Whether C-Kermit filename patterns (wildcards) should match
++ filenames that start with dot (period), or (Unix only) FIFOs
++ (named pipes). The defaults are to skip dotfiles in Unix but
++ match them elsewhere, and to skip FIFOs. Applies to both
++ interactive use and to server mode, when the server receives
++ wildcards, e.g. in a GET command. Also see REMOTE SET MATCH.
++
++ SET OPTIONS DIRECTORY /DOTFILES
++ Now works for server listings too (UNIX only). Give this
++ command prior to having Kermit enter server mode, and then it
++ will show files whose names begin with dot (period) when sent a
++ REMOTE DIRECTORY command.
++
++ SET QUIET ON
++ (as well as the -q command-line option) Now applies also to:
++
++ + SET HOST connection progress messages.
++ + "Press the X or E key to cancel" file-transfer message.
++ + REMOTE CD response.
++ + REMOTE LOGIN response.
++
++ SET RECEIVE PERMISSIONS { ON, OFF }
++ Tells C-Kermit whether to set the permissions of incoming files
++ (received with Kermit protocol) from the permissions supplied
++ in the file's Attribute packet (if any). Normally ON. Also see
++ SET SEND PERMISSIONS.
++
++ SET ROOT directory
++ Like UNIX chroot, without requiring privilege. Sets the root
++ for file access, does not allow reference to or creation of
++ files outside the root, and can't be undone.
++
++ SET SEND PERMISSIONS { ON, OFF }
++ Tells C-Kermit whether to include file permissions in the
++ attributes it includes with each file when sending with Kermit
++ protocol. Also see SET RECEIVE PERMISSIONS.
++
++ SET TCP { HTTP-PROXY, SOCKS-SERVER } /USER:name /PASSWORD:text
++ These commands now allow specification of username and
++ password.
++
++ SET TERMINAL . . .
++ (See [388]Section 12.)
++
++ SET TRANSFER MESSAGE [ text ]
++ Sets an initial text message to be displayed in the
++ file-transfer display. The transfer message is automatically
++ deleted once used, so must be set each time a message a
++ desired. Any variables in the message are evaluated at the time
++ the SET command is given. If the optional text is omitted, any
++ transfer message that is currently set is removed. Synonym: SET
++ XFER MSG. SHOW TRANSFER displays it if it has been set but not
++ yet used.
++
++ SHOW COMMUNICATIONS
++ In C-Kermit 8.0, SHOW COMMUNICATIONS, when given in remote mode
++ (i.e. before any connection has been established), tells the
++ typical dialout device name for the particular platform on
++ which it's running (e.g. TXA0: for VMS, or /dev/cua0p0 for
++ HP-UX). On Unix platforms, it also tells the name of the
++ lockfile directory. This way, you have an idea of what the SET
++ LINE device name should look like, and if the SET LINE command
++ fails, you know the name of the directory or device that is
++ protected against you.
++
++ SHOW VARIABLES [ name [ name [ ... ] ] ]
++ In C-Kermit 8.0.201 you can request values of a list of
++ built-in (\v(xxx)) variables. Each name is a pattern, as
++ before, but now it a free pattern rather than an anchored one
++ (explained in [389]Section 8.12) so now "show var date time"
++ shows the values of all variables whose names include the
++ strings "date" or "time".
++
++ TAIL [ switches ] filename
++ Equivalent to TYPE /TAIL [ other-switches ] filename.
++
++ TRANSMIT /NOECHO [ other switches ] filename
++ The /NOECHO switch is equivalent to giving the command SET
++ TRANSMIT ECHO OFF prior to the TRANSMIT command, except the
++ switch affects only the command with which it was given and
++ does not affect the prevailing global setting.
++
++ TRANSMIT /NOWAIT [ other switches ] filename
++ The /NOWAIT switch is equivalent to giving the command SET
++ TRANSMIT PROMPT 0 prior to the TRANSMIT command, except the
++ switch affects only the command with which it was given and
++ does not affect the prevailing global setting.
++
++ TRANSMIT /NOWAIT /NOECHO /BINARY [ other switches ] filename
++ When the TRANSMIT command is given with the /NOWAIT, /NOECHO,
++ and /BINARY switches, this activates a special "blast the whole
++ file out the communications connection all at once" mode that
++ Kermit didn't have prior to version 8.0. There has been
++ increasing demand for this type of transmission with the advent
++ of devices that expect image (e.g. .JPG) or sound (e.g. .MP3)
++ files as raw input. The obvious question is: how does the
++ receiving device know when it has the whole file? This depends
++ on the device, of course; usually after a certain amount of
++ time elapses with nothing arriving, or else when Kermit hangs
++ up or closes the connection.
++
++ TYPE /CHARACTER-SET:name
++ Allows you to specify the character set in which the file to be
++ typed is encoded.
++
++ TYPE /NUMBER
++ Adds line numbers.
++
++ TYPE /OUTPUT:filename
++ Sends the results of the TYPE command to the given file.
++
++ TYPE /TRANSLATE-TO:name
++ Used in conjunction with TYPE /CHARACTER-SET:xxx; allows you to
++ specify the character set in which the file is to be displayed.
++
++ TYPE /TRANSPARENT
++ Used to disable character-set translation in the TYPE command,
++ which otherwise can take place automatically based on file
++ scanning, even when /CHARACTER-SET and /TRANSLATE-TO switches
++ are not given.
++
++ VOID text
++ Parses the text, evaluating any backslash items in it (such as
++ function calls) but doesn't do anything further, except
++ possibly printing error messages. Useful for invoking functions
++ that have side effects without using or printing their direct
++ results, e.g. "void \fsplit(\%a,&a)".
++
++ Symbolic Links in UNIX
++
++ The UNIX versions of C-Kermit have had /FOLLOWLINKS and /NOFOLLOWLINKS
++ switches added to several commands to control the treatment of
++ symbolic links. Different commands deal differently with symbolic
++ links:
++
++ Kermit SEND, FTP MPUT
++ /NOFOLLOWLINKS is the default, which means symbolic links are
++ skipped entirely. The alternative, /FOLLOWLINKS, should be used
++ with caution, since an innocent link might point to a whole
++ file system, or it might cause a loop. There is no way in
++ Kermit or FTP protocol to send the link itself. We either skip
++ them or follow them; we can't duplicate them.
++
++ DIRECTORY
++ /NOFOLLOWLINKS is the default, which means the DIRECTORY
++ command lists symbolic links in a way that shows they are
++ links, but it does not follow them. The alternative,
++ /FOLLOWLINKS, follows links and gives information about the
++ linked-to directories and files.
++
++ DELETE, RMDIR
++ The DELETE command does not have link-specific switches. DELETE
++ never follows links. If you tell Kermit to delete a symbolic
++ link, it deletes the link itself, not the linked-to file. Ditto
++ for RMDIR.
++
++ COPY
++ The COPY command behaves just like the UNIX cp command; it
++ always follows links.
++
++ RENAME
++ The RENAME command behaves just like the UNIX mv command; it
++ operates on links directly rather than following.
++
++ [ [390]Top ] [ [391]Contents ] [ [392]C-Kermit Home ] [ [393]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++8. OTHER SCRIPTING IMPROVEMENTS
++
++ 8.1. Performance and Debugging
++
++ A command cache for frequently used commands plus some related
++ optimizations increases the speed of compute-bound scripts by anywhere
++ from 50% to 1000%.
++
++ The new PROMPT command can be used to set breakpoints for debugging
++ scripts. If executed in a command file or macro, it gives you an
++ interactive command prompt in the current context of the script, with
++ all its variables, arguments, command stack, etc, available for
++ examination or change, and the ability to resume the script at any
++ point (END resumes it, Ctrl-C or STOP cancels it and returns to top
++ level).
++
++ The new Ctrl-C trapping feature ([394]Section 8.14) lets you intercept
++ interruption of scripts. This can be used in combination with the
++ PROMPT command to debug scripts. Example:
++
++define ON_CTRLC {
++ echo INTERRUPTED BY CTRL-C...
++ echo The command stack has not yet been rolled back:
++ show stack
++ echo Type Ctrl-C again or use the END command to return to top level.
++ prompt Debug>
++}
++
++ Adding this ON_CTRL definition to your script lets you interrupt it at
++ any point and get prompt that is issued at the current command level,
++ so you can query local variables, etc.
++
++ [ [395]Top ] [ [396]Contents ] [ [397]C-Kermit Home ] [ [398]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.2. Using Macros as Numeric Variables
++
++ A macro is a way to assign a value to a name, and then use the name to
++ refer to the value. Macros are used in two ways in Kermit: as
++ "subroutines" or functions composed of Kermit commands, which are
++ executed, or as variables to hold arbitrary values -- text, numbers,
++ filenames, etc.
++
++ When a macro is to be executed, its name is given as if it were a
++ C-Kermit command, optionally preceded by the word "do". When a macro
++ is used as a variable, it must be "escaped" with \m(xxx) (or
++ equivalent function, e.g. \s(xxx), \:(xxx), \fdefinition(xxx)), where
++ xxx is the macro name, for example:
++
++ define filename /usr/olga/oofa.txt
++ send \m(filename)
++
++ Of course variables can also hold numbers:
++
++ define size 17
++ declare \&a[\m(size)]
++ ...
++ define index 3
++ if ( == \m(index) 3 ) echo The third value is: \&a[\m(index)]
++ evaluate index (\m(index) * 4)
++ if ( > \m(index) \m(size) ) echo Out of range!
++
++ But these are contexts in which only numbers are valid. C-Kermit 8.0
++ has been changed to treat non-escaped non-numeric items in strictly
++ numeric contexts as macro names. So it is now possible (but not
++ required) to omit the \m(...) notation and just use the macro name in
++ these contexts:
++
++ define size 17
++ declare \&a[size]
++ ...
++ define index 3
++ if ( == index 3 ) echo The third value is: \&a[index]
++ evaluate index (index * 4)
++ if ( > index size ) echo Out of range!
++
++ This is especially nice for loops that deal with arrays. Here, for
++ example, is a loop that reverses the order of the elements in an
++ array. Whereas formerly it was necessary to write:
++
++ .\%n ::= \fdim(&a)
++ for \%i 1 \%n/2 1 {
++ .tmp := \&a[\%n-\%i+1]
++ .\&a[\%n-\%i+1] := \&a[\%i]
++ .\&a[\%i] := \m(tmp)
++ }
++
++ Recoding this to use macro names "i" and "n" instead of the backslash
++ variables \%i and \%n, we have:
++
++ .n ::= \fdim(&a)
++ for i 1 n/2 1 {
++ .tmp := \&a[n-i+1]
++ .\&a[n-i+1] := \&a[i]
++ .\&a[i] := \m(tmp)
++ }
++
++ which reduces the backslash count to less than half. The final
++ statement in the loop could be written ".\&a[i] ::= tmp" if the array
++ contained only numbers (since ::= indicates arithmetic expression
++ evaluation).
++
++ Also, now you can use floating-point numbers in integer contexts (such
++ as array subscripts), in which case they are truncated to an integer
++ value (i.e. the fractional part is discarded).
++
++ Examples of numeric contexts include:
++
++ * Array subscripts.
++ * Any numeric function argument.
++ * Right-hand side of ::= assignments.
++ * EVALUATE command or \fevaluate() function expression.
++ * The INCREMENT or DECREMENT by-value.
++ * IF =, >, <, !=, >=, and <= comparands.
++ * The IF number construct.
++ * FOR-loop variables.
++ * STOP, END, and EXIT status codes.
++ * The INPUT timeout value.
++ * PAUSE, WAIT, SLEEP, MSLEEP intervals.
++ * The SHIFT argument.
++ * Numeric switch arguments, e.g. TYPE /WIDTH:number, SEND
++ /LARGER:number.
++ * SCREEN MOVE-TO row and column number.
++ * Various SET DIAL parameters (timeout, retry limit, etc).
++ * Various SET SEND or RECEIVE parameters (packet length, window
++ size, etc).
++ * Various other SET parameters.
++
++ and:
++
++ * S-Expressions (explained in [399]Section 9).
++
++ Macro names used in numeric contexts must not include mathematical
++ operators. Although it is legal to create a macro called "foo+bar", in
++ a numeric context this would be taken as the sum of the values of
++ "foo" and "bar". Any such conflict can be avoided, of course, by
++ enclosing the macro name in \m(...).
++
++ [ [400]Top ] [ [401]Contents ] [ [402]C-Kermit Home ] [ [403]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.3. New IF Conditions
++
++ Several new IF conditions are available:
++
++ IF DECLARED arrayname
++ Explained in [404]Section 8.6.
++
++ IF KBHIT
++ Allows a script to test whether a key was pressed without
++ actually trying to read it.
++
++ IF KERBANG (Unix only)
++ True if Kermit was started from a Kerbang script. This is
++ useful for knowing how to interpret the \&@[] and \&_[]
++ argument vector arrays, and under what conditions to exit.
++
++ IF INTEGER n
++ This is just a synonym for IF NUMERIC, which is true if n
++ contains only digits (or, if n is a variable, its value
++ contains only digits).
++
++ By contrast, IF FLOAT n succeeds if n is a floating-point number OR an
++ integer (or a variable with floating-point or integer value).
++ Therefore, IF FLOAT should be used whenever any kind of number is
++ acceptable, whereas IF INTEGER (or IF NUMERIC) when only an integer
++ can be used.
++
++ [ [405]Top ] [ [406]Contents ] [ [407]C-Kermit Home ] [ [408]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.4. The ON_UNKNOWN_COMMAND Macro
++
++ The new ON_UNKNOWN_COMMAND macro, if defined, is executed whenever you
++ give a command that is not known to C-Kermit; any operands are passed
++ as arguments. Here are some sample definitions:
++
++ DEF ON_UNKNOWN_COMMAND telnet \%1 ; Treat unknown commands as hostnames
++ DEF ON_UNKNOWN_COMMAND dial \%1 ; Treat unknown commands phone numbers
++ DEF ON_UNKNOWN_COMMAND take \%1 ; Treat unknown commands as filenames
++ DEF ON_UNKNOWN_COMMAND !\%* ; Treat unknown commands as shell commands
++
++ The ON_CD macro, if defined, is executed whenever Kermit is given a CD
++ (change directory) command (8.0.211). Upon entry to this macro, the
++ directory has already changed and the new directory string is
++ available in the \v(directory) variable, and also as the first
++ argument (\%1).
++
++ [ [409]Top ] [ [410]Contents ] [ [411]C-Kermit Home ] [ [412]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.5. The SHOW MACRO Command
++
++ The SHOW MACRO command has been changed to accept more than one macro
++ name:
++
++ (setq a 1 b 2 c 3)
++ show mac a b c
++ a = 1
++ b = 2
++ c = 3
++
++ An exact match is required for each name (except that case doesn't
++ matter). If you include wildcard characters, however, a pattern match
++ is performed:
++
++ show mac [a-c]*x
++
++ shows all macros whose names start with a, b, or c, and end with x.
++
++ [ [413]Top ] [ [414]Contents ] [ [415]C-Kermit Home ] [ [416]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.6. Arrays
++
++ A clarification regarding references to array names (as opposed to
++ array elements): You can use array-name "abbreviations" like &a only
++ in contexts that expect array names, like ARRAY commands or array-name
++ function arguments such as the second argument of \fsplit(). In a
++ LOCAL statement, however, you have to write \&a[], since "local &a"
++ might refer to a macro named "&a".
++
++ In function arguments, however, you MUST use the abbreviated form:
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a) or \fsplit(\%a,&a[]). If you include the backslash (as
++ in "\fsplit(\%a,\&a[])") a parse error occurs.
++
++ Here are the new array-related commands:
++
++ IF DECLARED arrayname
++ Allows a script to test whether an array has been declared. The
++ arrayname can be a non-array backslash variable such as \%1 or
++ \m(name), in which case it is evaluated first, and the result
++ is treated as the array name. Otherwise, arrayname is treated
++ as in the ARRAY commands: it can be a, &a, &a[], \&a, \&a[],
++ \&a[3], \&a[3:9], etc, with the appropriate results in each
++ case. Synonym: IF DCL.
++
++ UNDECLARE arrayname
++ UNDECLARE is a new top-level command to undeclare an array.
++ Previously this could only be done with "declare \&a[0]" (i.e.
++ re-declare the array with a dimension of 0).
++
++ ARRAY LINK linkname arrayname
++ Creates a symbolic link from the array named by linkname (which
++ must be the name of an array that is not yet declared in the
++ current context) to the array named by arrayname (which must
++ the name of a currently declared array that is not itself a
++ link, or a variable containing the name of such an array). The
++ two names indicate the same array: if you change an array
++ element, the change is reflected in the link too, and vice
++ versa. If you undeclare the link, the real array is unaffected.
++ If you undeclare the real array, all links to it disappear. If
++ you resize an array (directly or through a link), all links to
++ it are updated automatically.
++
++ Array links let you pass array names as arguments to macros. For
++ example, suppose you had a program that needed to uppercase all the
++ elements of different arrays at different times. You could write a
++ macro to do this, with the array name as an argument. But without
++ array links, there would be no way to refer to the argument array
++ within the macro. Array links make it easy:
++
++ define arrayupper {
++ local \&e[] \%i
++ array link \&e[] \%1
++ for i 1 \fdim(&e) 1 { .\&e[i] := \fupper(\&e[i]) }
++ }
++ declare \&a[] = these are some words
++ arrayupper &a
++ show array &a
++
++ The macro declares the array link LOCAL, which means it doesn't
++ conflict with any array of the same name that might exist outside the
++ macro, and that the link is destroyed automatically when the macro
++ exits. This works, by the way, even if the link name and the macro
++ argument name are the same, as long as the link is declared LOCAL.
++
++ As noted, you can't make a link to a nonexistent array. So when
++ writing a macro whose job is to create an array whose name is passed
++ as an argument, you must declare the array first (the size doesn't
++ matter as long as it's greater than 0). Example:
++
++ define tryme { ; Demonstration macro
++ local \&e[] ; We only need this inside the macro
++ array link \&e[] \%1 ; Make local link
++ shift ; Shift argument list
++ void \fsplit(\%*,&e) ; Split remainder of arg list into array
++ }
++ declare \&a[1] ; Declare target array in advance
++ tryme &a here are some words ; Invoke the macro with array name and words
++ show array a ; See the results
++
++ One final improvement allows the macro itself to declare the array
++ (this was not possible in earlier Kermit releases): if the array name
++ in the DECLARE command is a variable (and not an array name), or
++ includes variables, the resulting value is used as the array name. So:
++
++ define tryme { ; Demonstration macro
++ declare \%1[1] ; Preliminary declaration for target array
++ local \&e[] ; We only need this inside the macro
++ array link \&e[] \%1 ; Make local link
++ shift ; Shift argument list
++ void \fsplit(\%*,&e) ; Split remainder of arg list into array
++ }
++ tryme &a here are some words ; Invoke the macro with array name and words
++ show array a ; See the results
++
++ The SHOW ARRAY command now indicates whether an array name is a link.
++
++ Also see the descriptions of [417]\fjoin() and [418]\fsplit(), plus
++ [419]Section 8.10 on the MINPUT command, which shows how an entire
++ array (or segment of it) can be used as the MINPUT target list.
++
++ [ [420]Top ] [ [421]Contents ] [ [422]C-Kermit Home ] [ [423]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.7. New or Improved Built-in Variables and Functions
++
++ The following new built-in variables are available:
++
++ \v(buildid) A date string like "20000808" indicating when C-Kermit was
++built.
++ \v(ftime) Current time, secs since midnight, including fraction of se
++cond.
++ \v(iprompt) The current SET PROMPT value
++ \v(sexp) The most recent S-Expression (see [424]Section 9)
++ \v(sdepth) The current S-Expression invocation depth ([425]Section 9)
++ \v(svalue) The value of the most recent S-Expression ([426]Section 9)
++
++ \v(ftp_code) Most recent FTP response code ([427]Section 3)
++ \v(ftp_connected) FTP connection status ([428]Section 3)
++ \v(ftp_cpl) FTP Command Protection Level ([429]Section 3.2)
++ \v(ftp_dpl) FTP Data Protection Level ([430]Section 3.2)
++ \v(ftp_getputremote) The current SET GET-PUT-REMOTE setting ([431]Section 3.8
++)
++ \v(ftp_host) Name or IP address of FTP server ([432]Section 3)
++ \v(ftp_loggedin) FTP login status ([433]Section 3)
++ \v(ftp_message) Most recent FTP response message ([434]Section 3)
++ \v(ftp_security) FTP Security method ([435]Section 3.2)
++ \v(ftp_server) OS type of FTP server ([436]Section 3)
++
++ \v(http_code) Most recent HTTP response code
++ \v(http_connected) HTTP connection status
++ \v(http_host) Name or IP address of HTTP server
++ \v(http_message) Most recent HTTP response message
++ \v(http_security) TLS cipher used to secure the HTTP session
++
++ \v(hour) Hour of the day, 0 to 23.
++ \v(timestamp) Equivalent to "\v(ndate) \v(time)".
++
++ \v(log_debug) Current debug log file, if any.
++ \v(log_packet) Current packet log file, if any.
++ \v(log_session) Current session log file, if any.
++ \v(log_transaction) Current transaction log file, if any.
++ \v(log_connection) Current connection log file, if any.
++
++ The following new or improved built-in functions are available:
++
++ \fcmdstack() Allows programmatic access to the command stack.
++ \fcvtdate() [437]Section 8.13, format options added
++ \fdelta2secs() [438]Section 8.13
++ \fdostounixpath(s1) Converts a DOS filename to Unix format.
++ \fsplit() Now allows grouping/nesting in source string.
++ \fword() Allows the same grouping and nesting.
++ \fjoin(&a,s1,n1,n2) Copies an array into a single string.
++ \fsubstitute(s1,s2,s3) Substitutes characters within a string.
++ \freplace() Has new 4th "occurrence" argument.
++ \fsexpression() Evaluates an S-Expression (explained in [439]Section
++9).
++ \ftrim(), \fltrim() Now trim CR and LF by default, as well as SP and Tab.
++ \funixtodospath(s1) Converts a Unix filename to DOS format.
++ \fkeywordval(s1,c1) Assigns values to keywords (macros) (explained below)
++.
++
++ Most functions that have "2" in their names to stand for the word "to"
++ can now also be written with "to", e.g. "\fdelta2secs(),"
++ \fdeltatosecs()."
++
++ \funtabify(string)
++ (New to 8.0.211) Replaces Horizontal Tab characters in the
++ given string with spaces based on VT100-like tab stops.
++
++ \fverify(s1,s2,n)
++ As of version 8.0.211, returns -1 if s2 is an empty string.
++ Previously it returned 0, making \fverify(abc,\%a) look as if
++ \%a was a string combosed of a's, b's, and/or c's when in fact
++ it contained nothing.
++
++ \fcode(string)
++ As of version 8.0.211, returns 0 if string is empty or missing.
++ Previously it returned the empty string, which made it unsafe
++ to use in arithmetic or boolean expressions.
++
++ \v(inscale)
++ New to version 8.0.211, its value is the INPUT SCALE-FACTOR
++ ([440]Section 8.10), default 1.0.
++
++ 8.7.1. The \fkeywordval() Function
++
++ \fkeywordval(s1,c1) is new to C-Kermit 8.0. Given a string s1 of the
++ form "name=value", it creates a macro with the given name and assigns
++ it the given value. If no value appears after the equal sign, any
++ existing macro of the given name is undefined. Blanks are
++ automatically trimmed from around the name and value. The optional c1
++ parameter is the assignment operator character, equal sign (=) by
++ default. This function is handy for processing keyword parameters or
++ any other form of parameter-value pair. Suppose, for example, you want
++ to write a macro that accepts keyword parameters rather than
++ positional ones:
++
++ define MYDIAL {
++ local \%i modem hangup method device speed number
++ def number 5551234 ; Assign default parameter values
++ def speed 57600
++ def modem usrobotics
++ def hangup rs232
++ def method tone
++ def country 1
++ for \%i 1 \v(argc)-1 1 { ; Parse any keyword parameters...
++ if not \fkeywordval(\&_[\%i]) end 1 Bad parameter: "\&_[\%i]"
++ }
++ set dial country \m(country)
++ set modem type \m(modem)
++ set modem hang \m(hangup)
++ set dial method \m(tone)
++ set line \m(device)
++ if fail stop 1
++ set speed \m(speed)
++ if fail stop 1
++ show comm
++ set dial display on
++ dial \m(number)
++ if success connect
++ }
++
++ In this example, all the defaults are set up inside the macro, and
++ therefore it can be invoked with no parameters at all. But if you want
++ to have the macro dial a different number, you can supply it as
++ follows:
++
++ mydial number=7654321
++
++ You can supply any number of keyword parameters, and you can give them
++ in any order:
++
++ mydial number=7654321 hangup=modem speed=115200
++
++ 8.7.2. The \fsplit(), \fjoin(), and \fword() Functions
++
++ \fjoin(&a,s1,n1,n2) is also new; it creates a string from an array (or
++ a piece of one). &a is the name of the array (a range specifier can be
++ included); s1 is a character or string to separate each element in the
++ result string (can be omitted, in which case the elements are not
++ separated at all), and n1 is a grouping mask, explained below. If s1
++ is empty or not specified, the array elements are separated with
++ spaces. If you want the elements concatenated with no separator,
++ include a nonzero n2 argument. Given the array:
++
++ declare \&a[] = 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
++
++ you can get effects like this:
++
++ \fjoin(&a) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
++ \fjoin(&a,:) 0:1:2:3:4:5:6:7:8:9
++ \fjoin(&a,{,}) 0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9
++ \fjoin(&a,...) 0...1...2...3...4...5...6...7...8...9
++ \fjoin(&a,,,1) 0123456789
++
++ \fsplit(), \fword(), \fstripb(), and \fjoin() accept a "grouping mask"
++ argument, n1, which is a number from 0 to 63, in which:
++
++ 1 = "" doublequotes
++ 2 = {} braces
++ 4 = '' singlequotes
++ 8 = () parentheses
++ 16 = [] square brackets
++ 32 = <> angle brackets
++
++ These can be OR'd (added) together to make any number 0-63 (-1 is
++ treated the same as 63, 0 means no grouping). If a bit is on, the
++ corresponding kind of grouping is selected. (If more than 1 bit is set
++ for \fjoin(), only the lowest-order one is used.)
++
++ If you include the same character in the grouping mask and the include
++ list, the grouping mask takes precedence. Example:
++
++ def \%a a "b c d" e
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a[],,,-1) = 3 <-- doublequote used for grouping
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a[],,",-1) = 3 <-- doublequote still used for grouping
++
++ Nesting of matched left and right grouping characters (parentheses,
++ braces, and brackets, but not quotes) is recognized. Example:
++
++ def \%a a (b c <d e [f g {h i} j k] l m> n o) p
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a,,,0) = 16 (no grouping)
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a,,,2) = 15 (braces only)
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a,,,16) = 11 (square brackets only)
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a,,,32) = 7 (angle brackets only)
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a,,,63) = 3 (all)
++ \fsplit(\%a,&a,,,-1) = 3 (all)
++
++ \fsplit() and \fjoin() are "reciprocal" functions. You can split a
++ string up into an array and join it back into a new string that is
++ equivalent, as long as \fsplit() and \fjoin() are given equivalent
++ grouping masks, except that the type of braces might change. Example:
++
++ def \%a a {b c [d e] f g} "h i" j <k l> m
++ echo STRING=[\%a]
++ echo WORDS=\fsplit(\%a,&a,,,-1)
++ show array a
++ asg \%b \fjoin(&a,{ },2)
++ echo JOIN =[\%b]
++ echo WORDS=\fsplit(\%b,&b,,,-1)
++ show array b
++
++ The arrays a and b are identical. The strings a and b are as follows:
++
++ \%a: a {b c [d e] f g} "h i" j <k l> m
++ \%b: a {b c [d e] f g} {h i} j {k l} m
++
++ It is possible to quote separator grouping characters with backslash
++ to override their grouping function. And of course to include
++ backslash itself in the string, it must be quoted too. Furthermore,
++ each backslash must be doubled, so the command parser will still pass
++ one backslash to \fsplit() for each two that it sees. Here are some
++ examples using \fsplit() with a grouping mask of 8 (treat parentheses
++ as grouping characters).
++
++ String Result
++ a b c d e f 6
++ a b\\ c d e f 5
++ a b (c d e) f 4
++ a b \\(c d e\\) f 6
++ a b \\\\(c d e\\\\) f 7
++
++ \fsplit() has also been changed to create its array (if one is given)
++ each time it is called, so now it can be conveniently called in a loop
++ without having to redeclare the array each time.
++
++ Incidentally... Sometimes you might want to invoke \fsplit() in a
++ situation where you don't care about its return value, e.g. when you
++ just want to fill the array. Now you can "call" \fsplit() or any other
++ function with the new [441]VOID command:
++
++ void \fsplit(\%a,&a)
++
++ \fsplit() and \fjoin() also accept a new, optional 6th argument, an
++ options flag, a number that can specify a number of options. So far
++ there is just one option, whose value is 1:
++
++ separator-flag
++ Normally separators are collapsed. So, for example,
++
++ \fword(Three little words,2)
++
++ returns "little" (the second word). Space is a separator, but
++ there are multiple spaces between each word. If the value 1 is
++ included in the option flag, however, each separator counts. If
++ two separators are adjacent, an empty word is produced between
++ them. This is useful for parsing (e.g.) comma-separated lists
++ exported from databases or spreadsheets.
++
++ 8.7.3. The \fcmdstack() Function
++
++ The new \fcmdstack() function gives access to the command stack:
++
++ \fcmdstack(n1,n2)
++ Arguments: n1 is the command stack level. If omitted, the
++ current level, \v(cmdlevel), is used. n2 is a function code
++ specifying the desired type of information:
++
++ 0 (default) = name of object at level n1.
++ 1 (nonzero) = object type (0 = prompt; 1 = command file; 2 = macro).
++
++ The default for n2 is 0.
++
++ The name associated with prompt is "(prompt)". Here's a loop that can
++ be included in a macro or command file to show the stack (similar to
++ what the SHOW STACK command does):
++
++ for \%i \v(cmdlevel) 0 -1 {
++ echo \%i. [\fcmdstack(\%i,1)] \fcmdstack(\%i,0)
++ }
++
++ In this connection, note that \v(cmdfile) always indicates the most
++ recently invoked active command file (if any), even if that file is
++ executing a macro. Similarly, \v(macro) indicates the most recently
++ invoked macro (if any), even if the current command source is not a
++ macro. The name of the "caller" of the currently executing object
++ (command file or macro) is:
++
++ \fcmdstack(\v(cmdlevel)-1)
++
++ and its type is:
++
++ \fcmdstack(\v(cmdlevel)-1,1)
++
++ To find the name of the macro that invoked the currently executing
++ object, even if one or more intermediate command files (or prompting
++ levels) are involved, use a loop like this:
++
++ for \%i \v(cmdlevel)-1 0 -1 {
++ if = \fcmdstack(\%i,1) 2 echo CALLER = \fcmdstack(\%i,0)
++ }
++
++ Of course if you make a macro to do this, the macro must account for
++ its own additional level:
++
++ define CALLER {
++ for \%i \v(cmdlevel)-2 0 -1 {
++ if = \fcmdstack(\%i,1) 2 return \fcmdstack(\%i,0)
++ }
++ return "(none)"
++ }
++
++ The built-in variable \v(cmdsource) gives the current command source
++ as a word ("prompt", "file", or "macro").
++
++ 8.7.4. The VOID Command
++
++ VOID is like ECHO in that all functions and variables in its argument
++ text are evaluated. but it doesn't print anything (except possibly an
++ error message if a function was invocation contained or resulted in
++ any errors). VOID sets FAILURE if it encounters any errors, SUCCESS
++ otherwise.
++
++ [ [442]Top ] [ [443]Contents ] [ [444]C-Kermit Home ] [ [445]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.8. The RETURN and END Commands
++
++ The execution of a macro is terminated in any of the following ways:
++
++ * With an END [ number [ message ] ] command. If a number is given,
++ the macro succeeds if the number is 0, and fails if it is not
++ zero; if a number is not given, the macro succeeds.
++ * With a STOP command, which works just like END except it peels
++ back the command stack all the way to top level.
++ * With a RETURN [ text ] command, in which case the macro always
++ succeeds.
++ * By running out of commands to execute, in which case the macro
++ succeeds or fails according the most recently executed command
++ that sets success or failure.
++
++ The same considerations apply to command files invoked by the TAKE
++ command.
++
++ If a macro does not execute any commands that set success or failure,
++ then invoking the macro does not change the current SUCCESS/FAILURE
++ status. It follows, then, that the mere invocation of a macro does not
++ change the SUCCESS/FAILURE status either. This makes it possible to
++ write macros to react to the status of other commands (or macros), for
++ example:
++
++ define CHKLINE {
++ if success end 0
++ stop 1 SET LINE failed - please try another device.
++ }
++ set modem type usrobotics
++ set line /dev/cua0
++ chkline
++ set speed 57600
++ dial 7654321
++
++ By the way, none of this is news. But it was not explicitly documented
++ before, and C-Kermit 7.0 and earlier did not always handle the RETURN
++ statement as it should have.
++
++ [ [446]Top ] [ [447]Contents ] [ [448]C-Kermit Home ] [ [449]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.9. UNDEFINing Groups of Variables
++
++ The UNDEFINE command, which previously accepted one variable name, now
++ accepts a list of them, and also accepts wildcard notation to allow
++ deletion of variables that match a given pattern.
++
++ UNDEFINE [ switches ] name [ name [ name [ ... ] ] ]
++ Undefines the variables whose names are given. Up to 64 names
++ may be given in one UNDEFINE command.
++
++ If you omit the switches and include only one name, the UNDEFINE
++ command works as before.
++
++ Switches include:
++
++ /MATCHING
++ Specifies that the names given are to treated as patterns
++ rather than literal variable names. Note: pattern matching
++ can't be used with array references; use the ARRAY command to
++ manipulate arrays and subarrays.
++
++ /LIST
++ List the name of each variable to be undefined, and whether it
++ was undefined successfully ("ok" or "error"), plus a summary
++ count at the end.
++
++ /SIMULATE
++ List the names of the variables that would be deleted without
++ actually deleting them. Implies /LIST.
++
++ The UNDEFINE command fails if there were any errors and succeeds
++ otherwise.
++
++ The new _UNDEFINE command is like UNDEFINE, except the names are
++ assumed to be variable names themselves, which contain the names (or
++ parts of them) of the variables to be undefined. For example, if you
++ have the following definitions:
++
++ define \%a foo
++ define foo This is some text
++
++ then:
++
++ undef \%a
++
++ undefines the variable \%a, but:
++
++ _undef \%a
++
++ undefines the macro foo.
++
++ Normal Kermit patterns are used for matching; metacharacters include
++ asterisk, question mark, braces, and square brackets. Thus, when using
++ the /MATCHING switch, if the names of the macros you want to undefine
++ contain any of these characters, you must quote them with backslash to
++ force them to be taken literally. Also note that \%* is not the name
++ of a variable; it is a special notation used within a macro for "all
++ my arguments". The command "undef /match \%*" deletes all \%x
++ variables, where x is 0..9 and a..z. Use "undef /match \%[0-9]" to
++ delete macro argument variables or "undef /match \%[i-n]" to delete a
++ range of \%x variables.
++
++ [ [450]Top ] [ [451]Contents ] [ [452]C-Kermit Home ] [ [453]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.10. The INPUT and MINPUT Commands
++
++ As of C-Kermit 8.0.211, the INPUT and MINPUT commands accept a switch:
++
++ [M]INPUT /NOMATCH timeout
++ The /NOMATCH switch allows INPUT or MINPUT to read incoming
++ material for the specified amount of time, without attempting
++ to match it with any text or patterns. When this switch is
++ included, the [M]INPUT command succeeds when the timeout
++ interval expires, with \v(instatus) set to 1, meaning "timed
++ out", or fails upon interruption or i/o error.
++
++ Also in version 8.0.211, there is a new way to apply a scale factor to
++ [M]INPUT timeouts:
++
++ SET INPUT SCALE-FACTOR floating-point-number
++ This scales all [M]INPUT timeouts by the given factor, allowing
++ time-sensitive scripts to be adjusted to changing conditions
++ such as congested networks or different-speed modems without
++ having to change each INPUT-class command. This affects only
++ those timeouts that are given in seconds, not as wall-clock
++ times. Although the scale factor can have a fractional part,
++ the INPUT timeout is still an integer. The new built-in
++ variable \v(inscale) tells the current INPUT SCALE-FACTOR.
++
++ The MINPUT command can be used to search the incoming data stream for
++ several targets simultaneously. For example:
++
++ MINPUT 8 one two three
++
++ waits up to 8 seconds for one of the words "one", "two", or "three" to
++ arrive. Words can be grouped to indicate targets that contain spaces:
++
++ MINPUT 8 nineteeen twenty "twenty one"
++
++ And of course you can also use variables in place of (or as part of)
++ the target names:
++
++ MINPUT 8 \%a \&x[3] \m(foo)
++
++ Until now you had to know the number of targets in advance when
++ writing the MINPUT statement. Each of the examples above has exactly
++ three targets.
++
++ But suppose your script needs to look for a variable number of
++ targets. For this you can use arrays and \fjoin(), described in
++ [454]Section 8.7. Any number of \fjoin() invocations can be included
++ in the MINPUT target list, and each one is expanded into the
++ appropriate number of separate targets each time the MINPUT command is
++ executed. Example:
++
++ declare \&a[10] = one two three
++ minput 10 foo \fjoin(&a) bar
++
++ This declares an array of ten elements, and assigns values to the
++ first three of them. The MINPUT command looks for these three (as well
++ as the words "foo" and "bar"). Later, if you assign additional
++ elements to the array, the same MINPUT command also looks for the new
++ elements.
++
++ If an array element contains spaces, each word becomes a separate
++ target. To create one target per array element, use \fjoin()'s
++ grouping feature:
++
++ dcl \&a[] = {aaa bbb} {ccc ddd} {xxx yyy zzz}
++
++ minput 10 \fjoin(&a) <-- 7 targets
++ minput 10 \fjoin(&a,,2) <-- 3 targets
++
++ [ [455]Top ] [ [456]Contents ] [ [457]C-Kermit Home ] [ [458]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.11. Learned Scripts
++
++ C-Kermit now includes a simple script recorder that monitors your
++ commands, plus your actions during CONNECT mode, and automatically
++ generates a script program that mimics what it observed. You should
++ think of this feature as a script-writing ASSISTANT since, as you will
++ see [459]later in this section, the result generally needs some
++ editing to make it both secure and flexible. The script recorder is
++ controlled by the new LEARN command:
++
++ LEARN [ /ON /OFF /CLOSE ] [ filename ]
++ If you give a filename, the file is opened for subsequent
++ recording. The /ON switch enables recording to the current file
++ (if any); /OFF disables recording. /CLOSE closes the current
++ script recording file (if any). If you give a filename without
++ any switches, /ON is assumed.
++
++ The /OFF and /ON switches let you turn recording off and on during a
++ session without closing the file.
++
++ When recording:
++
++ * All commands that you type (or recall) at the prompt are recorded
++ in the file except:
++ + LEARN commands are not recorded.
++ + The CONNECT command is not recorded.
++ + The TELNET command is converted to SET HOST /NETWORK:TCP.
++ * Commands obtained from macros or command files are not recorded.
++ * During CONNECT:
++ + Every line you type is converted to an OUTPUT command.
++ + The last prompt before any line you type becomes an INPUT
++ command.
++ + Timeouts are calculated automatically for each INPUT command.
++ + A PAUSE command is inserted before each OUTPUT command just
++ to be safe.
++
++ Thus the script recorder is inherently line-oriented. It can't be used
++ to script character-oriented interactions like typing Space to a
++ "More?" prompt or editing a text file with VI or EMACS.
++
++ But it has advantages too; for example it takes control characters
++ into account that might not be visible to you otherwise, and it
++ automatically converts control characters in both the input and output
++ streams to the appropriate notation. It can tell, for example that the
++ "$ " prompt on the left margin in UNIX is really {\{13}\{10}$ },
++ whereas in VMS it might be {\{13}\{10}\{13}$ }. These sequences are
++ detected and recorded automatically.
++
++ A learned script should execute correctly when you give a TAKE command
++ for it. However, it is usually appropriate to edit the script a bit.
++ The most important change would be to remove any passwords from it.
++ For example, if the script contains:
++
++ INPUT 9 {\{13}\{10}Password: }
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT bigsecret\{13}
++
++ you should replace this by something like:
++
++ INPUT 9 {\{13}\{10}Password: }
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ ASKQ pswd Please type your password:
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT \m(pswd)\{13}
++
++ The LEARN command can't do this for you since it knows nothing about
++ "content"; it only knows about lines and can't be expected to parse or
++ understand them -- after all, the Password prompt might be in some
++ other language. So remember: if you use the LEARN command to record a
++ login script, be sure edit the resulting file to remove any passwords.
++ Also be sure to delete any backup copies your editor or OS might have
++ made of the file.
++
++ Other manual adjustments might also be appropriate:
++
++ * If the target of an INPUT command can vary, you can replace the
++ INPUT command with MINPUT and the appropriate target list, and/or
++ the target with a \fpattern(). For example, suppose you are
++ dialing a number that can be answered by any one of 100 terminal
++ servers, whose prompts are ts-00>, ts-01>, ts-02>, ... ts-99>. The
++ script records a particular one of these, but you want it to work
++ for all of them, so change (e.g.):
++ INPUT 10 ts-23> ; or whatever
++ to:
++ INPUT 10 \fpattern(ts-[0-9][0-9]>)
++ * The INPUT timeout values are conservative, but they are based only
++ on a single observation; you might need to tune them.
++ * The PAUSE commands might not be necessary, or the PAUSE interval
++ might need adjustment.
++ * In case you made typographical errors during recording, they are
++ incorporated in your script; you can edit them out if you want to.
++
++ Here is a sample script generated by Kermit ("learn vms.ksc") in which
++ a Telnet connection is made to a VMS computer, the user logs in,
++ starts Kermit on VMS, sends it a file, and then logs out:
++
++ ; Scriptfile: vms.ksc
++ ; Directory: /usr/olga
++ ; Recorded: 20001124 15:21:23
++
++ SET HOST /NETWORK:TCP vms.xyzcorp.com
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 Connection failed
++
++ INPUT 7 {\{13}\{10}\{13}Username: }
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT olga\{13}
++ INPUT 3 {\{13}\{10}\{13}Password: }
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT secret\{13}
++ INPUT 18 {\{13}\{10}\{13}$ }
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT set default [.incoming]\{13}
++ INPUT 12 {\{13}\{10}\{13}$ }
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT kermit\{13}
++ INPUT 15 {\{13}\{10}\{13}ALTO:[OLGA.INCOMING] C-Kermit>}
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT receive\{13}
++ send myfile.txt
++
++ INPUT 18 {\{13}\{10}\{13}ALTO:[OLGA.INCOMING] C-Kermit>}
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT exit\{13}
++ INPUT 6 {\{13}\{10}\{13}$ }
++ IF FAIL STOP 1 INPUT timeout
++ PAUSE 1
++ OUTPUT logout\{13}
++ close
++ exit
++
++ The commands generated by Kermit during CONNECT (INPUT, IF FAIL,
++ PAUSE, and OUTPUT) have uppercase keywords; the commands typed by the
++ user are in whatever form the user typed them (in this case,
++ lowercase).
++
++ [ [460]Top ] [ [461]Contents ] [ [462]C-Kermit Home ] [ [463]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.12. Pattern Matching
++
++ A pattern is a character string that is used to match other strings.
++ Patterns can contain metacharacters that represent special actions
++ like "match any single character", "match zero or more characters",
++ "match any single character from a list", and so on. The best known
++ application of patterns is in file specifications that contain
++ wildcards, as in "send *.txt", meaning "send all files whose names end
++ with .txt".
++
++ Patterns are also used in increasingly many other ways, to the extent
++ it is useful to point out certain important distinctions in the ways
++ in which they are used:
++
++ Anchored Patterns
++ If an anchored pattern does not begin with "*", it must match
++ the beginning of the string, and if it does not end with "*",
++ it must match the end of the string. For example, the anchored
++ pattern "abc" matches only the string "abc", not "abcde" or
++ "xyzabc" or "abcabc". The anchored pattern "abc*" matches any
++ string that starts with "abc"; the anchored pattern "*abc"
++ matches any string that ends with "abc"; the anchored pattern
++ "*abc*" matches any string that contains "abc" (including any
++ that start and/or end with it).
++
++ Floating Patterns
++ A floating pattern matches any string that contains a substring
++ that matches the pattern. In other words, a floating pattern
++ has an implied "*" at the beginning and end. You can anchor a
++ floating pattern to the beginning by starting it with "^", and
++ you can anchor it to the end by ending it with "$" (see
++ examples below).
++
++ Wildcards
++ A wildcard is an anchored pattern that has the additional
++ property that "*" does not match directory separators.
++
++ This terminology lets us describe Kermit's commands with a bit more
++ precision. When a pattern is used for matching filenames, it is a
++ wildcard, except in the TEXT-PATTERNS and BINARY-PATTERNS lists and
++ /EXCEPT: clauses, in which case directory separators are not
++ significant (for example, a BINARY-PATTERN of "*.exe" matches any file
++ whose name ends in .exe, no matter how deeply it might be buried in
++ subdirectories). When Kermit parses a file specification directly,
++ however, it uses the strict wildcard definition. For example, "send
++ a*b" sends all files whose names start with "a" and end with "b" in
++ the current directory, and not any files whose names end with "b" that
++ happen to be in subdirectories whose names start with "a". And as
++ noted, wildcards are anchored, so "delete foo" deletes the file named
++ "foo", and not all files whose names happen to contain "foo".
++
++ Most other patterns are anchored. For example:
++
++ if match abc bc ...
++
++ does not succeed (and you would be surprised if it did!). In fact, the
++ only floating patterns are the ones used by commands or functions that
++ search for patterns in files, arrays, or strings. These include:
++
++ * The GREP and TYPE /MATCH commands.
++ * The \fsearch(), \frsearch(), and \farraylook() functions.
++
++ Thus these are the only contexts in which explicit anchors ("^" and
++ "$") may be used:
++
++ grep abc *.txt
++ Prints all lines containing "abc" in all files whose names end
++ with ".txt".
++
++ grep ^abc *.txt
++ Prints all lines that start with "abc" in all ".txt" files.
++
++ grep abc$ *.txt
++ Prints all lines that end with "abc" in all ".txt" files.
++
++ grep ^a*z$ *.txt
++ Prints all lines that start with "a" and end with "z" in all
++ ".txt" files.
++
++ Similarly for TYPE /PAGE, /fsearch(), /frsearch(), and \farraylook().
++
++ Here is a brief summary of anchored and floating pattern equivalences:
++
++ Anchored Floating
++ abc ^abc$
++ *abc abc$
++ abc* ^abc
++ *abc* abc
++
++ [ [464]Top ] [ [465]Contents ] [ [466]C-Kermit Home ] [ [467]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.13. Dates and Times
++
++ C-Kermit's comprehension of date-time formats is considerably expanded
++ in version 8.0. Any command that reads dates, including the DATE
++ command itself, or any switch, such as the /BEFORE: and /AFTER:
++ switches, or any function such as \fcvtdate(), now can understand
++ dates and times expressed in any ISO 8601 format, in Unix "asctime"
++ format, in FTP MDTM format, and in practically any format used in RFC
++ 822 or RFC 2822 electronic mail, with or without timezones, and in a
++ great many other formats as well. HELP DATE briefly summarizes the
++ acceptable date-time formats.
++
++ Furthermore, C-Kermit 8.0 includes a new and easy-to-use form of
++ date-time arithmetic, in which any date or time can be combined with a
++ "delta time", to add or subtract the desired time interval (years,
++ months, weeks, days, hours, minutes, seconds) to/from the given date.
++ And new functions are available to compare dates and to compute their
++ differences.
++
++ As you can imagine, all this requires quite a bit of "syntax". The
++ basic format is:
++
++ [ date ] [ time ] [ delta ]
++
++ Each field is optional, but in most cases (depending on the context)
++ there must be at least one field. If a date is given, it must come
++ first. If no date is given, the current date is assumed. If no time is
++ given, an appropriate time is supplied depending on whether a date was
++ supplied. If no delta is given, no arithmetic is done. If a delta is
++ given without a date or time, the current date and time are used as
++ the base.
++
++ Date-time-delta fields are likely to contain spaces (although they
++ need not; space-free forms are always available). Therefore, in most
++ contexts -- and notably as switch arguments -- date-time information
++ must be enclosed in braces or doublequotes, for example:
++
++ send /after:"8-Aug-2001 12:00 UTC" *.txt
++
++ Kermit's standard internal format for dates and times is:
++
++ yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss
++
++ for example:
++
++ 20010208 10:28:01
++
++ Date-times can always be given in this format. yyyy is the 4-digit
++ year, mm is the two-digit month (1-12; supply leading zero for
++ Jan-Sep), dd is the 2-digit day (leading zero for 1-9), hh is the hour
++ (0-23), mm the minute (0-59), ss the second (0-59), each with leading
++ zero if less than the field width. The date and time can be separated
++ by a space, an underscore, a colon, or the letter T. The time is in
++ 24-hour format. Thus the various quantites are at the following fixed
++ positions:
++
++Position Contents
++ 1-4 Year (4 digits, 0000-9999)
++ 5-6 Month (2 digits, 1-12)
++ 7-8 Day (2 digits, 1-31)
++ 9 Date-Time Separator (space, :, _, or the letter T)
++ 10-11 Hour (2 digits, 0-23)
++ 12 Hour-Minute Separator (colon)
++ 13-14 Minute (2 digits, 0-59)
++ 15 Minute-Second Separator (colon)
++ 16-17 Second (2 digits, 0-59)
++
++ Example:
++
++ 19800526 13:07:12 26 May 1980, 13:07:12 (1:07:12PM)
++
++ This is the format produced by the DATE command and by any function
++ that returns a date-time. It is suitable for lexical comparison and
++ sorting, and for use as a date-time in any Kermit command. When this
++ format is given as input to a command or function, various date-time
++ separators (as noted) are accepted:
++
++ 19800526 13:07:12 26 May 1980, 13:07:12 (1:07:12PM)
++ 20010208_10:28:35 2 February 2001, 10:28:35 AM
++ 18580101:12:00:00 1 January 1858, noon
++ 20110208T00:00:00 2 February 2011, midnight
++
++ Certain other special date-time formats that are encountered on
++ computer networks are recognized:
++
++ Asctime Format
++ This is a fixed format used by Unix, named after Unix's
++ asctime() ("ASCII time") function. It is always exactly 24
++ characters long. Example: Fri Aug 10 16:38:01 2001
++
++ Asctime with Timezone
++ This is like Asctime format, but includes a 3-character
++ timezone between the time and year. It is exactly 28 characters
++ long. Example: Fri Aug 10 16:38:01 GMT 2001
++
++ E-Mail Format
++ E-mail date-time formats are defined in [468]RFC 2822 with a
++ fair amount of flexibility and options. The following examples
++ are typical of e-mails and HTTP (web-page) headers:
++
++ Sat, 14 Jul 2001 11:49:29 (No timezone)
++ Fri, 24 Mar 2000 14:19:59 EST (Symbolic timezone)
++ Tue, 26 Jun 2001 10:19:45 -0400 (EDT) (GMT Offset + comment)
++
++ FTP MDTM Format
++ This is the date-time format supplied by FTP servers that
++ support the (not yet standard but widely used nevertheless)
++ MDTM command, by which the FTP client asks for a file's
++ modification time:
++
++ yyyymmddhhmmss[.ffff]
++
++ where yyyy is the 4-digit year, mm is the 2-digit month, and so
++ on, exactly 14 digits long. An optional fractional part
++ (fraction of second) may also be included, separated by a
++ decimal point (period). Kermit rounds to the nearest second.
++ Example:
++
++ 20020208102835.515 (8 February 2002 10:28:36 AM)
++
++ 8.13.1. The Date
++
++ The date, if given, must precede the time and/or delta, and can be in
++ many, many formats. For starters, you can use several symbolic date
++ names in place of actual dates:
++
++ NOW
++ This is replaced by the current date and time. The time can not
++ be overriden (if you want to supply a specific time, use TODAY
++ rather than NOW).
++
++ TODAY
++ This is replaced by the current date and a default time of
++ 00:00:00 is supplied, but can be overridden by a specific time;
++ for example, if today is 8 February 2002, then "TODAY" is
++ "20020802 00:00:00" but "TODAY 10:28" is "20020802 10:28:00".
++
++ TOMORROW
++ Like TODAY, but one day later (if today is 8 February 2002,
++ then "TOMORROW" is "20020803 00:00:00" but "TOMORROW 16:30" is
++ "20020803 16:30:00").
++
++ YESTERDAY
++ Like TODAY, but one day earlier.
++
++ MONDAY, TUESDAY, WEDNESDAY, ..., SUNDAY
++ The date on the given day of the week, today or later. A
++ default time of 00:00:00 is supplied but can be overridden.
++ Example: "SATURDAY 12:00" means next Saturday (or today, if
++ today is Saturday) at noon.
++
++ You can give an explicit date in almost any conceivable format, but
++ there are some rules:
++
++ * If a date is given, it must have three fields: day, month, and
++ year; the order can vary (except that the month can not be last).
++ * If names are used for days, months, etc, they must be English.
++ * The year must lie between 0000 and 9999, inclusive.
++ * All calendar calculations use Gregorian dating, so calculated
++ dates for years prior to 1582 (or later, depending on the country)
++ will not agree with historical dates. Other forms of dating (e.g.
++ Hebrew, Chinese) are not supported.
++
++ Various date-field separators are accepted: hyphen, slash, space,
++ underscore, period. The same field separator (if any) must be used in
++ both places; for example 18-Sep-2001 but not 18-Sep/2001. Months can
++ be numeric (1-12) or English names or abbreviations. Month name
++ abbreviations are normally three letters, e.g. Apr, May, Jun, Jul.
++ Capitalization doesn't matter.
++
++ Here are a few examples:
++
++ 18 Sep 2001 (English month, abbreviated)
++ 18 September 2001 (English month, spelled out)
++ 2001 Sept 18 (Year, month, day)
++ 18-Sep-2001 (With hyphens)
++ 18/09/2001 (All numeric with slashes)
++ 18.09.2001 (Ditto, with periods)
++ 18_09_2001 (Ditto, with underscores)
++ 09/18/2001 (See below)
++ 2001/09/18 (See below)
++ September 18, 2001 (Correspondence style)
++ Sep-18-2001 (Month-day-year)
++ 20010918 (Numeric, no separators)
++
++ You can also include the day of the week with a specific date, in
++ which case it is accepted (if it is a valid day name), but not
++ verified to agree with the given date:
++
++ Tue, 18 Sep 2001 (Abbreviated, with comma)
++ Tue,18 Sep 2001 (Comma but no space)
++ Tue 18 Sep 2001 (Abbreviated, no comma)
++ Tuesday 18 Sep 2001 (Spelled out)
++ Tuesday, 18 Sep 2001 (etc)
++ Friday, 18 Sep 2001 (Accepted even if not Friday)
++
++ In all-numeric dates with the year last, such as 18/09/2001, Kermit
++ identifies the year because it's 4 digits, then decides which of the
++ other two numbers is the month or day based on its value. If both are
++ 12 or less and are unequal, the date is ambiguous and is rejected. In
++ all-numeric dates with the year first, the second field is always the
++ month and the third is the day. The month never comes last. A date
++ with no separators is accepted only if it is all numeric and has
++ exactly eight digits, and is assumed to be in yyyymmdd format.
++
++ 20010918 (18-Sep-2001 00:00:00)
++
++ or 14 digits (as in FTP MDTM format):
++
++ 20010918123456 (18-Sep-2001 12:34:56)
++
++ You can always avoid ambiguity by putting the year first, or by using
++ an English, rather than numeric, month. A date such as 09/08/2001
++ would be ambiguous but 2001/09/08 is not, nor is 09-Aug-2001.
++
++ Until the late 1990s, it was common to encounter 2-digit years, and
++ these are found to this day in old e-mails and other documents. Kermit
++ accepts these dates if they have English months, and interprets them
++ according to the windowing rules of [469]RFC 2822: "If a two digit
++ year is encountered whose value is between 00 and 49, the year is
++ interpreted by adding 2000, ending up with a value between 2000 and
++ 2049. If a two digit year is encountered with a value between 50 and
++ 99, or any three digit year is encountered, the year is interpreted by
++ adding 1900."
++
++ If you need to specify a year prior to 1000, use leading zeros to
++ ensure it is not misinterpreted as a "non-Y2K-compliant" modern year:
++
++ 7-Oct-77 (19771007 00:00:00)
++ 7-Oct-0077 (00771007 00:00:00)
++
++ 8.13.2. The Time
++
++ The basic time format is hh:mm:dd; that is hours, minutes, seconds,
++ separated by colons, perhaps with an optional fractional second
++ separated by a decimal point (period). The hours are in 24-hour
++ format; 12 is noon, 13 is 1pm, and so on. Fields omitted from the
++ right default to zero. Fields can be omitted from the left or middle
++ by including the field's terminating colon. Examples:
++
++ 11:59:59 (11:59:59 AM)
++ 11:59 (11:59:00 AM)
++ 11 (11:00:00 AM)
++ 11:59:59.33 (11:59:59 AM)
++ 11:59:59.66 (Noon)
++ 03:21:00 (3:21:00 AM)
++ 3:21:00 (3:21:00 AM)
++ 15:21:00 (3:21:00 PM)
++ :21:00 (00:21:00 AM)
++ ::01 (00:00:01 AM)
++ 11::59 (11:00:59 AM)
++
++ Leading zeros can be omitted, but it is customary and more readable to
++ keep them in the minute and second fields:
++
++ 03:02:01 (03:02:01 AM)
++ 3:02:01 (03:02:01 AM)
++ 3:2:1 (03:02:01 AM)
++
++ AM/PM notation is accepted if you wish to use it:
++
++ 11:59:59 (11:59:59 AM)
++ 11:59:59AM (11:59:59 AM)
++ 11:59:59A.M. (11:59:59 AM)
++ 11:59:59am (11:59:59 AM)
++ 11:59:59a.m. (11:59:59 AM)
++ 11:59:59PM (11:59:59 PM = 23:59:59)
++ 11:59:59P.M. (11:59:59 PM = 23:59:59)
++ 11:59:59pm (11:59:59 PM = 23:59:59)
++ 11:59:59p.m. (11:59:59 PM = 23:59:59)
++
++ You can omit the colons if you wish, in which case Kermit uses the
++ following rules to interpret the time:
++
++ 1. 6 digits is hh:mm:ss, e.g. 123456 is 12:34:56.
++ 2. 5 digits is h:mm:ss, e.g. 12345 is 1:23:45.
++ 3. 4 digits is hh:mm, e.g. 1234 is 12:34.
++ 4. 3 digits is h:mm, e.g. 123 is 1:23.
++ 5. 2 digits is hh, e.g. 12 is 12:00.
++ 6. 1 digit is h (the hour), e.g. 1 is 1:00.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ 1 (01:00:00 AM)
++ 10 (10:00:00 AM)
++ 230 (02:30:00 AM)
++ 230pm (02:30:00 PM = 14:30:00)
++ 1115 (11:15:00 AM)
++ 2315 (11:15:00 PM = 23:15:00 PM)
++ 23150 (02:31:50 AM)
++ 231500 (23:15:00 PM)
++
++ 8.13.3. Time Zones
++
++ If a time is given, it can (but need not) be followed by a time zone
++ designator. If no time zone is included, the time is treated as local
++ time and no timezone conversions are performed.
++
++ The preferred time zone designator is the UTC Offset, as specified in
++ [470]RFC 2822: a plus sign or minus sign immediately followed by
++ exactly four decimal digits, signifying the difference in hh (hours)
++ and mm (minutes) from Universal Coordinated Time (UTC, also known as
++ Greenwich Mean Time, or GMT), with negative numbers to the West and
++ positive numbers to the East. For example:
++
++ Fri, 13 Jul 2001 12:54:29 -0700
++
++ indicates a local time of 12:54:29 that is 07 hours and 00 minutes
++ behind (less than, East of) Universal Time. The space is optional, so
++ the example could also be written as:
++
++ Fri, 13 Jul 2001 12:54:29-0700
++
++ The following symbolic time zones are also accepted, as specified by
++ [471]RFC 2822 and/or in ISO 8601:
++
++ GMT = +0000 Greenwich Mean Time
++ Z = +0000 Zulu (Zero Meridian) Time
++ UTC = +0000 Universal Coordinated Time
++ UT = +0000 Universal Time
++ EDT = -0400 Eastern (USA) Daylight Time
++ EST = -0500 Eastern (USA) Standard Time
++ CDT = -0500 Central (USA) Daylight Time
++ CST = -0600 Central (USA) Standard Time
++ MDT = -0600 Mountain (USA) Daylight Time
++ MST = -0700 Mountain (USA) Standard Time
++ PDT = -0700 Pacific (USA) Daylight Time
++ PST = -0800 Pacific (USA) Standard Time
++
++ Note that GMT, Z, UTC, and UT all express the same concept: standard
++ (not daylight) time at the Zero Meridian. UTC, by the way, is an
++ international standard symbol and does not correspond to the order of
++ the English words, Universal Coordinated Time, but it happens to have
++ the same initial letters as these words. Of course hundreds of other
++ symbolic timezones and variations exist, but they are not
++ standardized, and are therefore not supported by Kermit.
++
++ When a time zone is included with a time, the time is converted to
++ local time. In case the conversion crosses a midnight boundary, the
++ date is adjusted accordingly. Examples converting to EST (Eastern USA
++ Standard Time = -0500):
++
++ 11:30:00 = 11:30:00
++ 11:30:00 EST = 11:30:00
++ 11:30:00 GMT = 06:30:00
++ 11:30:00 PST = 14:30:00
++ 11:30:00Z = 06:30:00
++ 11:30PM GMT = 18:30:00
++ 11:30 -0500 = 11:30:00
++ 11:30 -0800 = 08:30:00
++ 11:30 +0200 = 04:30:00
++
++ Unlike most of Kermit's other date-time conversions, timezone
++ knowledge (specifically, the offset of local time from UTC) is
++ embodied in the underlying operating system, not in Kermit itself, and
++ any conversion errors in this department are the fault of the OS. For
++ example, most UNIX platforms do not perform conversions for years
++ prior to 1970.
++
++ 8.13.4. Delta Time
++
++ Date/time expressions can be composed of a date and/or time and a
++ delta time, or a delta time by itself. When a delta time is given by
++ itself, it is relative to the current local date and time. Delta times
++ have the following general format:
++
++ {+,-}[number units][hh[:mm[:ss]]]
++
++ In other words, a delta time always starts with a plus or minus sign,
++ which is followed by a "part1", a "part2", or both. The "part1", if
++ given, specifies a number of days, weeks, months, or years; "part2"
++ specifies a time in hh:mm:ss notation. In arithmetic terms, these
++ represents some number of days or other big time units, and then a
++ fraction of a day expressed as hours, minutes, and seconds; these are
++ to be added to or subtracted from the given (or implied) date and
++ time. The syntax is somewhat flexible, as shown by the following
++ examples:
++
++ +1 day (Plus one day)
++ +1day (Ditto)
++ +1d (Ditto)
++ + 1 day (Ditto)
++ + 1 day 3:00 (Plus one day and 3 hours)
++ +1d3:00 (Ditto)
++ +1d3 (Ditto)
++ +3:00:00 (Plus 3 hours)
++ +3:00 (Ditto)
++ +3 (Ditto)
++ +2 days (Plus 2 days)
++ -12 days 7:14:22 (Minus 12 days, 7 hours, 14 minutes, and 22 seconds)
++
++ The words "week", "month", and "year" can be used like "day" in the
++ examples above. A week is exactly equivalent to 7 days. When months
++ are specified, the numeric month number of the date is incremented or
++ decremented by the given number, and the year and day adjusted
++ accordingly if necessary (for example, 31-Jan-2001 +1month =
++ 03-Mar-2001 because February does not have 31 days). When years are
++ specified, they are added or subtracted to the base year. Examples
++ (assuming the current date is 10-Aug-2001 and the current time is
++ 19:21:11):
++
++ 18-Sep-2001 +1day (20010918 00:00:00)
++ today +1day (20010811 00:00:00)
++ now+1d (20010811 19:21:11)
++ + 1 day (20010811 19:21:11)
++ + 1 day 3:14:42 (20010811 22:35:54)
++ + 7 weeks (20010928 19:21:11)
++ +1d3:14:42 (20010811 22:35:54)
++ +1w3:14:42 (20010817 22:35:54)
++ +1m3:14:42 (20010910 22:35:54)
++ +1y3:14:42 (20020810 22:35:54)
++ 2 feb 2001 + 10 years (20110208 00:00:00)
++ 2001-02-08 +10y12 (20110208 12:00:00)
++ 31-dec-1999 23:59:59+00:00:01 (20000101 00:00:00)
++ 28-feb-1996 +1day (19960229 00:00:00) (leap year)
++ 28-feb-1997 +1day (19970301 00:00:00) (nonleap year)
++ 28-feb-1997 +1month (19970328 00:00:00)
++ 28-feb-1997 +1month 11:59:59 (19970328 11:59:59)
++ 28-feb-1997 +20years (20170228 00:00:00)
++ 28-feb-1997 +8000years (99970228 00:00:00)
++
++ For compatibility with VMS, the following special delta-time format is
++ also accepted:
++
++ +number-hh:mm:ss
++ -number-hh:mm:ss
++
++ (no spaces). The hyphen after the number indicates days. It
++ corresponds exactly to the Kermit notation:
++
++ +numberdhh:mm:ss
++ -numberdhh:mm:ss
++
++ The following forms all indicate exactly the same date and time:
++
++ 18-Sep-2001 12:34:56 +1-3:23:01
++ 18-Sep-2001 12:34:56 +1d3:23:01
++ 18-Sep-2001 12:34:56 +1 day 3:23:01
++
++ and mean "add a day plus 3 hours, 23 minutes, and 1 second" to the
++ given date.
++
++ Note that delta times are not at all the same as UTC offsets; the
++ former specifies an adjustment to the given date/time and the latter
++ specifies that the local time is a particular distance from Universal
++ Time, for example:
++
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -0800 (20010811 16:34:56 -- UTC Offset)
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -08:00 (20010811 04:34:56 -- Delta time)
++
++ If you give a time followed by a modifer that starts with a + or -
++ sign, how does Kermit know whether it's a UTC offset or a delta time?
++ It is treated as a UTC offset if the sign is followed by exactly four
++ decimal digits; otherwise it is a delta time. Examples (for USA
++ Eastern Daylight Time):
++
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -0800 (20010811 16:34:56 -- UTC Offset)
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -08:00 (20010811 04:34:56 -- Delta time)
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -800 (20010811 04:34:56 -- Delta time)
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -8 (20010811 04:34:56 -- Delta time)
++
++ The first example says that at some unknown place which is 8 hours
++ ahead of Universal Time, the time is 12:34:56, and this corresponds to
++ 16:34:56 in Eastern Daylight time. The second example says to subtract
++ 8 hours from the local time. The third and fourth are delta times
++ because, even though a colon is not included, the time does not
++ consist of exactly 4 digits.
++
++ When a delta time is written after a timezone, however, there is no
++ ambiguity and no syntax distinction is required:
++
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -0800 -0800 (20010811 08:34:56)
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -0800 -08:00 (Ditto)
++ 11-Aug-2001 12:34:56 -08:00 -08:00 (Illegal)
++
++ 8.13.5. The DATE Command
++
++ Obviously a great many combinations of date, time, time zone, and
++ delta time are possible, as well as many formatting options. The
++ purpose of all this flexibility is to comply with as many standards as
++ possible -- Internet RFCs, ISO standards, and proven corporate
++ standards -- as well as with notations commonly used by real people,
++ in order that dates and times from the widest variety of sources can
++ be assigned to a variable and used in any date-time field in any
++ Kermit command.
++
++ You can test any date-and/or-time format with the DATE command, which
++ converts it to standard yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss format if it is understood,
++ or else gives an explicit error message (rather than just "BAD DATE"
++ as in previous C-Kermit releases) to indicate what is wrong with it.
++ Examples (on Tuesday, 31 July 2001 in New York City, Eastern Daylight
++ Time, UTC -0400):
++
++ DATE command argument Result
++ 12:30 20010731 12:30:00
++ 12:30:01 20010731 12:30:01
++ 12:30:01.5 20010731 12:30:02
++ 1230 20010731 12:30:00
++ 230 20010731 02:30:00
++ 230+1d 20010801 02:30:00
++ 230+1d3:00 20010801 05:30:00
++ 20010718 19:21:15 20010718 19:21:15
++ 20010718_192115 20010718 19:21:15
++ 20010718T192115 20010718 19:21:15
++ 18 Jul 2001 +0400 20010717 23:59:59
++ 18 Jul 2001 192115 20010718 19:21:15
++ 18 Jul 2001 192115.8 20010718 19:21:16
++ 18-Jul-2001T1921 20010718 19:21:00
++ 18-Jul-2001 1921Z 20010718 15:21:00
++ 18-Jul-2001 1921 GMT 20010718 15:21:00
++ 18-Jul-2001 1921 UTC 20010718 15:21:00
++ 18-Jul-2001 1921 Z 20010718 15:21:00
++ 18-Jul-2001 1921Z 20010718 15:21:00
++ 18-Jul-2001 1921 -04:00:00 20010718 19:21:00
++ 21-Jul-2001_08:20:00am 20010721 08:20:00
++ 21-Jul-2001_8:20:00P.M. 20010721 20:20:00
++ Fri Jul 20 11:26:25 2001 20010720 11:26:25
++ Fri Jul 20 11:26:25 GMT 2001 20010720 07:26:25
++ Sun, 9 Apr 2000 06:46:46 +0100 20000409 01:46:46
++ Sunday, 9 Apr 2000 06:46:46 +0100 20000409 01:46:46
++ now 20010731 19:41:12
++ today 20010731 00:00:00
++ today 09:00 20010731 09:00:00
++ tomorrow 20010801 00:00:00
++ tomorrow 09:00 20010801 09:00:00
++ tomorrow 09:00 GMT 20010801 05:00:00
++ yesterday 20010730 00:00:00
++ yesterday 09:00 20010730 09:00:00
++ + 3 days 20010803 00:00:00
++ +3 days 20010803 00:00:00
++ +3days 20010803 00:00:00
++ + 3days 20010803 00:00:00
++ + 3 days 09:00 20010803 09:00:00
++ + 2 weeks 20010814 00:00:00
++ + 1 month 20010831 00:00:00
++ - 7 months 20001231 00:00:00
++ + 10 years 20110731 00:00:00
++ friday 20010803 00:00:00
++ saturday 20010804 00:00:00
++ sunday 20010805 00:00:00
++ monday 20010806 00:00:00
++ tuesday 20010731 00:00:00
++ wednesday 20010801 00:00:00
++ thursday 20010802 00:00:00
++ friday 07:00 20010803 07:00:00
++ thursday 1:00pm 20010802 13:00:00
++ thursday 1:00pm GMT 20010802 09:00:00
++ Thu, 10 Nov 94 10:50:47 EST 19941110 10:50:47
++ Fri, 20 Oct 1995 18:35:15 -0400 (EDT) 19951020 18:35:15
++ 31/12/2001 20011231 00:00:00
++ 12/31/2001 20011231 00:00:00
++ 2001-July-20 20010720 00:00:00
++ 2001-September-30 20010930 00:00:00
++ 30-September-2001 20010930 00:00:00
++ Sep 30, 2001 12:34:56 20010930 12:34:56
++ September 30, 2001 20010930 00:00:00
++ September 30, 2001 630 20010930 06:30:00
++ September 30 2001 630 20010930 06:30:00
++ Sep-30-2001 12:34:59 20010930 12:34:59
++ 20010807113542.014 20010807 11:35.42
++ 20010807113542.014Z 20010807 07:35:42
++
++ 8.13.6. New Date-Time Functions
++
++ In the following descriptions, date-time function arguments are the
++ same free-format date-time strings discussed above, with the same
++ defaults for missing fields. They are automatically converted to
++ standard format internally prior to processing.
++
++ \fcvtdate(d1)
++ Converts the date-time d1 to standard format and local time.
++ This function is not new, but now it accepts a wider range of
++ argument formats that can include timezones and/or delta times.
++ If the first argument is omitted, the current date and time are
++ assumed. The optional second argument is a format code for the
++ result:
++
++ n1 = 1: yyyy-mmm-dd hh:mm:ss (mmm = English 3-letter month
++ abbreviation)
++ n1 = 2: dd-mmm-yyyy hh:mm:ss (ditto)
++ n1 = 3: yyyymmddhhmmss (all numeric)
++
++ \futcdate(d1)
++ Converts the date-time d1 to Universal Coordinated Time (UTC),
++ also known as GMT or Zulu or Zero-Meridian time. The default d1
++ is NOW. If d1 is a valid date-time, the UTC result is returned
++ in standard format, yyyymmdd hh:ss:mm.
++
++ \fcmpdates(d1,d2)
++ Compares two free-format date-times, d1 and d2, and, if both
++ arguments are valid, returns a number: -1 if d1 is earlier than
++ (before) d2; 0 if d1 is the same as d2; 1 if d1 is later than
++ (after) d2.
++
++ \fdiffdates(d1,d2)
++ Computes the difference between two free-format date-times, d1
++ and d2. If both arguments are valid, returns a delta time which
++ is negative if d1 is earlier than (before) d2 and positive
++ otherwise. If d1 and d2 are equal, the result is "+0:00".
++ Otherwise, the result consists of the number of days, hours,
++ minutes, and seconds that separate the two date-times. If the
++ number of days is zero, it is omitted. If the number of days is
++ nonzero but the hours, minutes, and seconds are all zero, the
++ time is omitted. if the seconds are zero, they are omitted.
++
++ \fdelta2secs(dt)
++ Converts a delta time to seconds. For example, "+1d00:00:01" to
++ 86401. Valid delta times must start with a + or - sign. Days
++ are accepted as time units, but not years, months, or weeks. If
++ the result would overflow a computer long word (as would happen
++ with 32-bit long words when the number of days is greater than
++ 24854), the function fails.
++
++ HINT: Although Kermit has a number of built-in date and time
++ variables, it doesn't have a single one suitable for writing a
++ timestamp. For this you would normally use something like "\v(ndate)
++ \v(time)". But \fcvtdate() (with no arguments) is equivalent: it
++ returns the current date and time in yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss format,
++ suitable for time stamping.
++
++ 8.13.7. Date-Time Programming Examples
++
++ Here's a macro that converts any date-time to UTC, which you might use
++ if C-Kermit didn't already have a \futcdate() function:
++
++ define utcdate {
++ .local := \fcvtdate(\%*) ; 1.
++ .tmp := \fcvtdate(\m(local)UTC) ; 2.
++ .offset := \fdiffdate(\m(local),\m(tmp)) ; 3.
++ .utc := \fcvtdate(\m(local)\m(offset)) ; 4.
++ sho mac utc ; 5.
++ }
++
++ Brief explanation: Line 1 converts the macro argument, a free-format
++ date-time, to standard-format local time. Line 2 appends the "UTC"
++ timezone to the local time and converts the result to local time. In
++ other words, we take the same time as the local time, but pretend it's
++ UTC time, and convert it to local time. For example, if New York time
++ is 4 hours ahead of UTC, then 6:00pm New York time is 2:00pm UTC. Line
++ 3 gets the difference of the two results (e.g. "+04:00"). Line 4
++ appends the difference (delta time) to the local time, and converts it
++ again, which adds (or subtracts) the UTC offset to the given time.
++ Line 5 displays the result.
++
++ Here's a script that opens a web page, gets its headers into an array,
++ scans the array for the "Last-Modified:" header, and inteprets it:
++ http open www.columbia.edu
++ if fail stop 1 HTTP OPEN failed
++ http /array:a head index.html /dev/null
++ if fail stop 1 HTTP GET failed
++ show array a
++ for \%i 1 \fdim(&a) 1 {
++ .\%x := \findex(:,\&a[\%i])
++ if not \%x continue
++ .tag := \fleft(\&a[\%i],\%x-1)
++ .val := \fltrim(\fsubstr(\&a[\%i],\%x+1))
++ if ( eq "\m(tag)" "Last-Modified" ) {
++ echo HTTP Date: \m(val)
++ .rdate := \fcvtdate(\m(val))
++ echo {Standard Date (local): \m(rdate)}
++ echo {Standard Date (UTC): \futcdate(\m(rdate))}
++ break
++ }
++ }
++ http close
++
++ The result:
++
++ HTTP Date: Mon, 13 Aug 2001 20:05:42 GMT
++ Standard Date (local): 20010813 16:05:42
++ Standard Date (UTC): 20010813 20:05:42
++
++ As you can see, Kermit had no trouble decoding the date-time-string
++ from the website, converting to local time, and converting back to UTC
++ with no conflicts or loss of information. If it had been in any other
++ known format, the result would have been the same.
++
++ Now suppose we want to download the web page only if it is newer than
++ our local copy. The \fdate(filename) function (which returns the
++ modification date-time of the given file) and the new \fcmpdates()
++ function make it easy. Insert the following just before the BREAK
++ statement:
++
++ if ( < 0 \fcmpdates(\m(rdate),\fdate(index.html)) ) {
++ echo GETTING index.html...
++ http get index.html index.html
++ if success echo HTTP GET OK
++ } else {
++ echo index.html: no update needed
++ }
++ http close
++ exit
++
++ This says, "if 0 is less than the comparison of the remote file date
++ and the local file date, get the remote file, otherwise skip it." And
++ it automatically reconciles the time-zone difference (if any).
++
++ It would be nice to be able to extend this script into a
++ general-purpose website updater, but unfortunately HTTP protocol
++ doesn't provide any mechanism for the client to ask the server for a
++ list of files, recursive or otherwise.
++
++ [ [472]Top ] [ [473]Contents ] [ [474]C-Kermit Home ] [ [475]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 8.14. Trapping Keyboard Interruption
++
++ Normally when you type Ctrl-C and Kermit is in command mode (as
++ opposed to CONNECT mode) with COMMAND INTERRUPTION ON (as it is unless
++ you have set it OFF), Kermit interrupts any command that is currently
++ in progress, and if a command file or macro is executing, rolls the
++ command stack back to top level, closing all open command files,
++ deactivating all macros, deallocating all local variables and arrays,
++ and leaving you at the command prompt.
++
++ Suppose, however, you want certain actions to occur when a script is
++ interrupted; for example, closing open files, writing log entries, or
++ displaying summary results. You can do this by defining a macro named
++ ON_CTRLC. When Ctrl-C is detected, and a macro with this name is
++ defined, Kermit executes it from the current command level, thus
++ giving it full access to the environment in which the interruption
++ occurred, including local variables and open files. Only when the
++ ON_CTRLC macro completes execution is the command stack rolled back to
++ top level.
++
++ Once the ON_CTRLC macro is defined, it can be executed only once. This
++ is to prevent recursion if the user types Ctrl-C while the ON_CTRLC
++ macro is executing. If you type Ctrl-C while the Ctrl-C macro is
++ active, this does not start a new copy of ON_CTRLC; rather, it returns
++ to the top-level command prompt. After the ON_CTRLC macro returns, it
++ has been removed from the macro table so if you want to use it again
++ or install a different Ctrl-C trap, you must execute a new DEFINE
++ ON_CTRLC command. In any case, as always when you interrupt a script
++ with Ctrl-C, its completion status is FAILURE.
++
++ Normally the ON_CTRLC macro would be defined in the command file or
++ macro to which it applies, and should be declared LOCAL. This way, if
++ the command file or macro completes successfully without being
++ interrupted, the ON_CTRLC definition disappears automatically.
++ Otherwise the definition would still be valid and the macro would be
++ executed, probably out of context, the next time you typed Ctrl-C.
++
++ Here's a simple example of a command file that sets a Ctrl-C trap for
++ itself:
++
++ local on_ctrlc ; Make Ctrl-C trap local to this command file.
++ define on_ctrlc { ; Define the ON_CTRLC macro.
++ echo Interrupted at \v(time).
++ echo Iterations: \%n
++ }
++ xecho Type Ctrl-C to quit
++ for \%n 1 999 1 { ; Prints a dot every second until interrupted.
++ sleep 1
++ xecho .
++ }
++ echo Finished normally at \v(time) ; Get here only if not interrupted.
++ decrement \%n
++ echo Iterations: \%n
++
++ This prints a summary no matter whether it completes normally or is
++ interrupted from the keyboard. In both cases the trap is automatically
++ removed afterwards.
++
++ For an example of how to use ON_CTRLC to debug scripts, see
++ [476]Section 8.1.
++
++ [ [477]Top ] [ [478]Contents ] [ [479]C-Kermit Home ] [ [480]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++9. S-EXPRESSIONS
++
++ This section is primarily for those who want to write
++ calculation-intensive scripts, especially if they require
++ floating-point arithmetic, and/or for those who are familiar with the
++ LISP programming language.
++
++ Ever since C-Kermit version 5 was released in 1988, scripting has been
++ one of its major attractions, and arithmetic is a key part of it.
++ Versions 5 and 6 included integer arithmetic only, using traditional
++ algebraic notation, e.g.:
++
++ echo \fevaluate(3*(2+7)/2)
++ 13
++
++ C-Kermit 7.0 added support for floating-point arithmetic, but only
++ through function calls:
++
++ echo \ffpdivide(\ffpmultiply(3.0,\ffpadd(2.0,7.0)),2.0)
++ 13.5
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 introduces a third form of arithmetic that treats
++ integers and floating-point numbers uniformly, is easier to read and
++ write, and executes very quickly:
++
++ (/ (* 3 (+ 2 7)) 2)
++ 13.5
++
++ But first some background.
++
++ The Kermit command and scripting language differs from true
++ programming languages (such as C or Fortran) in many ways; one of the
++ most prominent differences is the way in which variables are
++ distinguished from constants. In a command language, words are taken
++ literally; for example, the Unix shell:
++
++ cat foo.bar
++
++ displays the file named foo.bar. Whereas in a programming language
++ like C, words are assumed to be variables:
++
++ s = foo.bar; /* Assigns the value of foo.bar to the variable s */
++
++ To make a programming language take words literally, you have to quote
++ or "escape" them:
++
++ s = "foo.bar"; /* Assigns a pointer to the string "foo.bar" to the variable
++s */
++
++ The opposite holds for command languages: to get them to treat a word
++ as a variable rather than a constant, you have to escape them. For
++ example, in the Unix shell:
++
++ foo=123 ; Assign value 123 to variable foo.
++ echo foo ; Prints "foo"
++ echo $foo ; Prints "123"
++
++ And in Kermit:
++
++ define foo 123 ; Assign value 123 to variable foo.
++ echo 123 ; This prints "123".
++ echo foo ; This prints "foo".
++ echo \m(foo) ; This prints "123".
++
++ In other words, character strings (such as "foo" above) are
++ interpreted as literal strings, rather than variable names, except in
++ special commands like DEFINE that deal specifically with variable
++ names (or in numeric contexts as explained in [481]Section 8.2). The
++ special "escape" character (dollar sign ($) for the shell, backslash
++ (\) for Kermit) indicates that a variable is to be replaced by its
++ value.
++
++ The requirement to escape variable names in command languages normally
++ does not impose any special hardship, but can add a considerable
++ notational burden to arithmetic expressions, which are typically full
++ of variables. Especially in Kermit when floating point numbers are
++ involved, where you must use special \ffpxxx() functions, e.g.
++ "\ffpadd(\m(a),\m(b))" rather than the simple "+" operator to add two
++ floating-point numbers together, because the original arithmetic
++ handler doesn't support floating point (this might change in the
++ future). To illustrate, the general formula for the area of a triangle
++ is:
++
++ sqrt(s * (s - a) * (s - b) * (s - c))
++
++ where a, b, and c are the lengths of the triangle's three sides and:
++
++ s = (a + b + c) / 2
++
++ Except in special cases (e.g. a = 3, b = 4, c = 5), the result has a
++ fractional part so the computation must be done using floating-point
++ arithmetic. We can create a Kermit 7.0 function for this as follows:
++
++ def area {
++ local s t1 t2 t3
++ assign s \ffpdiv(\ffpadd(\ffpadd(\%1,\%2),\%3),2.0)
++ assign t1 \ffpsub(\m(s),\%1)
++ assign t2 \ffpsub(\m(s),\%2)
++ assign t3 \ffpsub(\m(s),\%3)
++ return \ffpsqrt(\ffpmul(\m(s),\ffpmul(\m(t1),\ffpmul(\m(t2),\m(t3)))))
++ }
++
++ But as you can see, this is rather cumbersome. Note, in particular,
++ that arithmetic functions like \ffpadd(), \ffpmul(), etc, take exactly
++ two operands (like their symbolic counterparts + and *), so obtaining
++ the product of three or more numbers (as we do in this case) is
++ awkward.
++
++ Using the alternative S-Expression notation, we can reduce this to a
++ form that is both easier to read and executes faster (the details are
++ explained later):
++
++ def newarea {
++ (let s (/ (+ \%1 \%2 \%3) 2.0))
++ (sqrt (* s (- s \%1) (- s \%2) (- s \%3)))
++ }
++
++ In both examples, the \%1..3 variables are the normal Kermit macro
++ arguments, referenced by the normal escaping mechanism. For increased
++ readability, we can also assign the macro arguments \%1, \%2, and \%3
++ to the letters a, b, and c corresponding to our formula:
++
++def newarea {
++ (let a \%1 b \%2 c \%3)
++ (let s (/ (+ a b c) 2.0))
++ (sqrt (* s (- s a) (- s b) (- s c)))
++}
++
++ And now the Kermit function reads almost like the original formula.
++ Here Kermit behaves more like a regular programming language. In an
++ S-Expression, macro names need not be escaped when they are used as
++ the names of numeric variables.
++
++ [ [482]Top ] [ [483]Contents ] [ [484]C-Kermit Home ] [ [485]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.1. What is an S-Expression?
++
++ The S-Expression concept is borrowed from the Lisp programming
++ language. "S-Expression" is short for Symbolic Expression (itself
++ sometimes shortened to SEXP). S-Expressions provide a kind of
++ Alternative Mini-Universe within the Kermit command language when the
++ regular rules don't apply, a universe enclosed in parentheses.
++
++ C-Kermit does not pretend to be a full Lisp interpreter; only the
++ arithmetic parts of Lisp have been incorporated: S-Expressions that
++ operate on numbers and return numeric values (plus extensibility
++ features described in [486]Section 9.8, which allow some degree of
++ string processing).
++
++ An S-Expression is a list of zero or more items, separated by spaces,
++ within parentheses. Examples:
++
++ ()
++ (1)
++ (a)
++ (+ a 1)
++ (* 2 a b)
++
++ If the S-Expression is empty, it has the NIL (empty) value. If it is
++ not empty and the first item is an operator (such as + or *), there
++ can be zero or more subsequent items, called the operands:
++
++ (+ 1 2)
++
++ Here the operator is "+" and the operands are "1" and "2", and the
++ value of the S-Expression is the value of the operation (in this case
++ 3). The operator always comes first, which is different from the
++ familiar algebraic notation; this because S-Expression operators can
++ have different numbers of operands:
++
++ (+ 1)
++ (+ 1 2)
++ (+ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9)
++
++ If the first item in the S-Expression is not an operator, then it must
++ be a variable or a number (or a macro; see [487]Section 9.8), and the
++ S-Expression can only contain one item; in this case, the
++ S-Expression's value is the value of the variable or number:
++
++ (a)
++ (3)
++
++ Operands can be numbers, variables that have numeric values, functions
++ that return numbers, or other S-Expressions. To illustrate an
++ S-Expression within an S-Expression, observe that:
++
++ (+ 1 2)
++
++ is equivalent to any of the following (plus an infinite number of
++ others):
++
++ (+ 1 (+ 1 1))
++ (+ (- 3 2) (/ 14 (+ 3 4)))
++
++ S-Expressions can be nested to any reasonable level; for example, the
++ value of the following S-Expression is 64:
++
++ (- (* (+ 2 (* 3 4)) (- 9 (* 2 2))) 6)
++
++ Operators have no precedence, implied or otherwise, since they can't
++ be mixed. The only exceptions are unary + and -, which simply indicate
++ the sign of a number:
++
++ (* 3 -1)
++
++ Order of evaluation is specified entirely by parentheses, which are
++ required around each operator and its operands: (+ a (* b c)) instead
++ of (a + b * c).
++
++ S-Expressions provide a simple and isolated environment in which
++ Kermit's macro names can be used without the \m(...) escaping that is
++ normally required. Given:
++
++ define a 1
++ define b 2
++ define c 3
++
++ Then:
++
++ (+ \m(a) \m(b) \m(c))
++
++ is equivalent to:
++
++ (+ a b c)
++
++ Within an S-Expression, as in other strictly numeric contexts
++ ([488]Section 8.2), any operand that starts with a letter is treated
++ as a Kermit macro name. In this context, abbreviations are not
++ accepted; variable names must be spelled out in full. Alphabetic case
++ is not significant; "a" and "A" are the same variable, but both are
++ different from "area".
++
++ Of course, regular Kermit variables and functions can be used in
++ S-Expressions in the normal ways:
++
++ (* \v(math_pi) (^ \%r 2)) ; Area of a circle with radius \%r
++ (+ \fjoin(&a)) ; Sum of all elements of array \&a[]
++
++ [ [489]Top ] [ [490]Contents ] [ [491]C-Kermit Home ] [ [492]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.2. Integer and Floating-Point-Arithmetic
++
++ Normally, if all numbers in an S-Expression are integers, the result
++ is an integer:
++
++ (+ 1 1) ; Result is 2
++ (/ 9 3) ; Result is 3
++
++ If any of the operands is floating point, however, the result is also
++ floating point:
++
++ (+ 1 1.0) ; Result is 2.0
++ (/ 9.0 3) ; Result is 3.0
++
++ If all the operands are integers but the result has a fractional part,
++ the result is floating point:
++
++ (/ 10 3) ; Result is 3.333333333333333
++
++ To force an integer result in such cases, use the TRUNCATE operator:
++
++ (truncate (/ 10 3)) ; Result is 3
++
++ Similarly, to force a computation to occur in floating point, you can
++ coerce one of its operands to FLOAT:
++
++ (+ 1 (float 1)) ; Result is 2.0
++
++ The result is also floating point if the magnitude of any integer
++ operand, intermediate result, or the result itself, is larger than the
++ maximum for the underlying machine architecture:
++
++ (^ 100 100)
++
++ If the result is too large even for floating-point representation,
++ "Infinity" is printed; if it is too small to be distinguished from 0,
++ 0.0 is returned.
++
++ Large numbers can be used and large results generated, but they are
++ accurate only to the precision of the underlying machine. For example,
++ the result of:
++
++ (+ 111111111111111111111 222222222222222222222)
++
++ should be 333333333333333333333, but 333333333333333300000.0 is
++ produced instead if the machine is accurate to only about 16 decimal
++ digits, even with coercion to floating-point. The order of magnitude
++ is correct but the least significant digits are wrong. The imprecise
++ nature of the result is indicated by the ".0" at the end. Contrast
++ with:
++
++ (+ 111111111 222222222)
++
++ which produces an exact integer result.
++
++ [ [493]Top ] [ [494]Contents ] [ [495]C-Kermit Home ] [ [496]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.3. How to Use S-Expressions
++
++ S-Expressions may be given as commands to C-Kermit. Any command whose
++ first character is "(" (left parenthesis) is interpreted as an
++ S-Expression.
++
++ If you enter an S-Expression at the C-Kermit> prompt, its result is
++ printed:
++
++ C-Kermit>(/ 10.0 3)
++ 3.333333333333333
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ If an S-Expression is executed within a macro or command file, its
++ value is not printed. However, you can control the printing action
++ with:
++
++ SET SEXPRESSION ECHO { AUTO, ON, OFF }
++ AUTO is the default, meaning print the value at top level only;
++ ON means always print the value; OFF means never print it.
++
++ In any case, the value of the most recent S-Expression (and the
++ S-Expression itself) may be accessed programmatically through the
++ following variables:
++
++ \v(sexpression)
++ The S-Expression most recently executed.
++
++ \v(svalue)
++ The value of the S-Expression most recently executed.
++
++ Besides issuing S-Expressions as commands in themselves, you can also
++ execute them anywhere within a Kermit command, but in this case they
++ must be enclosed in a function call (otherwise they are taken
++ literally):
++
++ \fsexpression(s)
++ The argument "s" is an S-Expression; the outer parentheses may
++ be omitted. The value of the S-Expression is returned. Note
++ that since S-Expressions usually contain spaces, some form of
++ grouping or quoting might be needed in some contexts:
++
++ echo \fsexpression((+ 1 1)) ; Outer parentheses may be included
++ echo \fsexpr(+ 1 1) ; Outer parentheses may be omitted
++ echo Value = "\fsexp(+ 1 a)" ; Can be embedded in strings
++ echo Value = \&a[\fsexp(/ b 2)] ; Can be used in array subscripts
++ if = {\fsexp(+ 1 1)} 2 { ; Braces needed here for grouping
++ echo One plus one still equals two
++ }
++
++ The IF statement illustrates how to use S-Expressions as (or in) IF or
++ WHILE conditions:
++
++ * Although S-Expressions and IF conditions are similar in
++ appearance, they are not interchangeable. Therefore you must use
++ \fsexpr() to let Kermit know it's an S-Expression rather than a
++ regular IF condition, or a boolean or algebraic expression within
++ an IF condition.
++ * In contexts where a single "word" is expected, you must enclose
++ the \fsexp() invocation in braces if the S-Expression contains
++ spaces (and most of them do).
++
++ If an S-Expression is the last command executed in a macro, its value
++ becomes the return value of the macro; no RETURN command is needed.
++ Example:
++
++ def newarea {
++ (let s (/ (+ \%1 \%2 \%3) 2.0))
++ (sqrt (* s (- s \%1) (- s \%2) (- s \%3)))
++ }
++
++ This is equivalent to (but more efficient than):
++
++ def newarea {
++ (let s (/ (+ \%1 \%2 \%3) 2.0))
++ return \fsexp(sqrt (* s (- s \%1) (- s \%2) (- s \%3)))
++ }
++
++ When an S-Expression is entered as a command -- that is, the first
++ nonblank character of the command is a left parenthesis -- then it is
++ allowed to span multiple lines, as many as you like, until the first
++ left parenthesis is matched:
++
++ (let s (/
++ (+
++ \%1
++ \%2
++ \%3
++ )
++ 2.0
++ )
++ )
++ (sqrt (*
++ s
++ (- s \%1)
++ (- s \%2)
++ (- s \%3)
++ )
++ )
++
++ The S-Expression concept lends itself easily to embedding and
++ recursion, but the depth to which recursion can occur is limited by
++ the resources of the computer (memory size, address space, swap space
++ on disk) and other factors. There is no way that C-Kermit can know
++ what this limit is, since it varies not only from computer to
++ computer, but also from moment to moment. If resources are exhausted
++ by recursion, C-Kermit simply crashes; there's no way to trap this
++ error. However, you can set a depth limit on S-Expressions:
++
++ SET SEXPRESSION DEPTH-LIMIT number
++ Limits the number of times the S-Expression reader can invoke
++ itself without returning to the given number. The default limit
++ is 1000. This limit applies to S-Expressions embedded within
++ other S-Expressions as well as to S-Expressions that invoke
++ recursive macros. If the limit is exceeded, Kermit prints
++ "?S-Expression depth limit exceeded" and returns to its prompt.
++ More about recursion in [497]Section 9.8.
++
++ You can also test the depth programmatically:
++
++ \v(sdepth)
++ The current S-Expression invocation depth. The depth includes
++ both nesting level and recursion. For example, in:
++ (foo (foo (foo (foo (foo))))), the innermost (foo) is at depth
++ 5.
++
++ Help, completion, and syntax checking are not available within an
++ S-Expression. If you type ? within an S-Expression, it says:
++
++ C-Kermit>(? S-Expression ("help sexp" for details)
++
++ As it says, typing "help sexp" will display a brief help text.
++
++ The SHOW SEXPRESSION command displays current SET SEXPRESSION settings
++ and related information.
++
++ [ [498]Top ] [ [499]Contents ] [ [500]C-Kermit Home ] [ [501]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.4. Summary of Built-in Constants and Operators
++
++ Three constants are built in:
++
++ * PI, whose value is the value of pi (the quotient of circumference
++ of any circle and its diameter, 3.141592653...) to the underlying
++ machine's precision;
++ * T, which always has the value 1, which signifies truth in Kermit
++ logical expressions or S-Expressions;
++ * NIL, which always has the empty value, and can serve as a False
++ truth value.
++
++ These constants are specific to S-Expressions and are not visible
++ outside them. They may not be used as the target of an assignment. So,
++ for example:
++
++ (setq t 0) Fails
++ assign t 0 Succeeds but this is not the same T!
++
++ E (the base of natural logarithms, 2.7182818184...) is not built in
++ since it is not intrinsic in most Lisp dialects. If you want E to be
++ the base of natural logarithms you can:
++
++ (setq e (exp 1))
++
++ Operators are either symbols (such as "+") or words. Words must be
++ spelled out in full, not abbreviated. Differences of alphabetic case
++ are ignored.
++
++ The most basic operation in S-Expressions is evaluation:
++
++ EVAL [ s-expression or variable or number [ another [ another ... ] ]
++ ]
++ Evaluates its operands and returns the value of the last one
++ evaluated. Examples:
++
++ (eval) 0
++ (eval 1) 1
++ (eval a) value of a
++ (eval (+ 1 a)) value of a+1
++ (eval (setq a 1) (setq b (+ a 0.5))) value of b (= a+0.5)
++
++ You can use "." as a shorthand for EVAL:
++
++ (.)
++ (. 1)
++ (. a)
++ (. (+ 1 a))
++ (. (setq a 1) (setq b (+ a 0.5)))
++
++ Opposite of EVAL is the operator that suppresses evaluation of its
++ operand:
++
++ QUOTE item
++ The value (quote item) is "item". If the item is itself an
++ S-Expression, the result is the S-Expression with the outer
++ parentheses stripped. Examples:
++
++ (quote) (illegal)
++ (quote a) a
++ (quote hello) hello
++ (quote (this is a string)) this is a string
++ (quote this is a string) (illegal)
++
++ A shorthand notation is also accepted for quoting:
++ 'a is equivalent to (quote a). And therefore:
++ '(a b c) is equivalent to (quote (a b c)).
++ More about quoting in [502]Section 9.8.
++
++ STRING item
++ Is a combination of EVAL and QUOTE. It evaluates the item as an
++ S-Expression, and then puts quotes around the result (more
++ about this in [503]Section 9.8).
++
++ The following operators assign values to variables:
++
++ SETQ [ variable [ value [ variable [ value [ ... ] ] ] ] ]
++ Applies to global variables. For each variable given: if a
++ value is not given, the variable is undefined. If a value is
++ given, assigns the value to the variable. The value may be a
++ number, a variable, or anything that resolves to a number
++ including an S-Expression. Returns the value of the last
++ assignment. Examples:
++
++ (setq) Does nothing, returns NIL.
++ (setq a) Undefines a, returns NIL.
++ (setq a 1) Assigns 1 to a, returns 1.
++ (setq a 1 b 2) Assigns 1 to a, 2 to b, returns 2.
++ (setq a 1 b 2 c) Assigns 1 to a, 2 to b, undefines c, returns NIL.
++
++ To undefine a variable that is not the final one in the list, give it
++ a value of "()" or NIL:
++
++ (setq a () b 2) Undefines a, assigns 2 to b, returns 2.
++ (setq a nil b 2) Ditto.
++
++ Note that a variable can be used right away once it has a value:
++
++ (setq a 1 b a) Assigns 1 to a, the value of a (1) to b, returns 1.
++
++ The results of SETQ (when used with macro names) can be checked
++ conveniently with SHOW MACRO, e.g:
++
++ show mac a b c
++
++ LET [ variable [ value [ variable [ value [ ... ] ] ] ] ]
++ Like SETQ, but applies to local variables. Note that "local" is
++ used in the Kermit sense, not the Lisp sense; it applies to the
++ current Kermit command level, not to the current S-Expression.
++
++ If you want to use SETQ or LET to assign a value to a backslash
++ variable such as \%a or \&a[2], you must double the backslash:
++
++ (setq \\%a 3)
++ (setq \\%b (+ \%a 1))
++ (setq \\&a[2] (setq (\\%c (+ \%a \%b))))
++
++ In other words:
++
++ * Double the backslash when you want to indicate the variable's
++ NAME;
++ * Don't double the backslash when you want its VALUE.
++
++ See [504]Section 9.6 for a fuller explanation of variable syntax and
++ scope.
++
++ Here's a summary table of arithmetic operators; in the examples, a is
++ 2 and b is -1.3:
++
++ Operator Description Example Result
++ + Adds all operands (0 or more) (+ a b) 0.7
++ - Subtracts all operands (0 or more) (- 9 5 2 1) 1
++ * Multiplies all operands (0 or more) (* a (+ b 1) 3) -1.80
++ / Divides all operands (2 or more) (/ b a 2) -0.325
++ ^ Raise given number to given power (^ 3 2) 9
++ ++ Increments variables (++ a 1.2) 3.2
++ -- Decrements variables (-- a) 1
++ ABS Absolute value of 1 operand (abs (* a b 3)) 7.8
++ MAX Maximum of all operands (1 or more) (max 1 2 3 4) 4
++ MIN Minimum of all operands (1 or more) (min 1 2 3 4) 1
++ MOD (%) Modulus of all operands (1 or more) (mod 7 4 2) 1
++ FLOAT Convert an integer to floating-point (float 1) 1.0
++ TRUNCATE Integer part of floating-point operand (truncate 3.333) 3
++ CEILING Ceiling of floating-point operand (ceiling 1.25) 2
++ FLOOR Floor of floating-point operand (floor 1.25) 1
++ ROUND Operand rounded to nearest integer (round 1.75) 2
++ SQRT Square root of 1 operand (sqrt 2) 1.414..
++ EXP e (2.71828..) to the given power (exp -1) 0.367..
++ SIN Sine of angle-in-radians (sin (/ pi 2)) 1.0
++ COS Cosine of angle-in-radians (cos pi) -1.0
++ TAN Tangent of angle-in-radians (tan pi) 0.0
++ LOG Natural log (base e) of given number (log 2.7183) 1.000..
++ LOG10 Log base 10 of given number (log10 1000) 3.0
++
++ The ++ and -- operators are also assignment operators and work just
++ like SETQ and LET in their interpretations of operators and operands,
++ but:
++
++ * Each target variable must already be defined and have a numeric
++ value;
++ * The assignment value is the amount by which to increment or
++ decrement the variable.
++ * If an assignment value is not given, 1 is used.
++
++ If you include more than one variable-value pair in a ++ or --
++ expression, every variable (except, optionally, the last) must be
++ followed by a value. Examples:
++
++ (++ a) Equivalent to (setq a (+ a 1)) and to (++ a 1)
++ (++ a 2) Equivalent to (setq a (+ a 2))
++ (-- a (* 2 pi)) Equivalent to (setq a (- a (* 2 pi)))
++ (++ a 1 b 1 c 1 d) Equivalent to four SETQs incrementing a,b,c,d by 1.
++
++ Another group of operators forms the predicates. These return a "truth
++ value", in which 0 (or NIL) is false, and 1 or any other nonzero
++ number is true.
++
++ Operator Description Example Result
++ = (or ==) Operands are equal (= 1 1.0) 1
++ != Operands are not equal (!= 1 1.0) 0
++ < Operands in strictly ascending order (< 1 2 3) 1
++ <= Operands in ascending order (<= 1 1 2 3) 1
++ > Operands in strictly descending order (> 3 2 1) 1
++ >= Operands in descending order (<= 3 3 2 1) 1
++ AND (&&) Operands are all true (and 1 1 1 1 0) 0
++ OR (||) At least one operand is true (or 1 1 1 1 0) 1
++ XOR Logical Exclusive OR (xor 3 1) 0
++ NOT (!) Reverses truth value of operand (not 3) 0
++
++ The Exclusive OR of two values is true if one value is true and the
++ other value is false.
++
++ And another group operates on bits within an integer word:
++
++ Operator Description Example Result
++ & Bitwise AND (& 7 2) 2
++ | Bitwise OR (| 1 2 3 4) 7
++ # Bitwise Exclusive OR (# 3 1) 2
++ ~ Reverses all bits (~ 3) -4
++
++ These operators coerce their operands to integer by truncation if
++ necessary. The result of bit reversal is hardware dependent.
++
++ The final category of operator works on truth values:
++
++ Operator Description Example Result
++ IF Conditional evaluation (if (1) 2 3) 2
++
++ IF (predicate) (s1) [ (s2) ]
++ The IF operator is similar to Kermit's IF command. If the
++ predicate is true (i.e. evaluates to a nonzero number), the
++ first S-Expression (s1) is evaluated and its value is returned.
++ Otherwise, if (s2) is given, it is evaluated and its value
++ returned; if (s2) is not given, nothing happens and the NIL
++ (empty) value is returned.
++
++ You can group multiple expressions in the s1 and s2 expressions using
++ EVAL (or "."):
++
++ (if (< a 0) (eval (setq x 0) (setq y 0)) (eval (setq x a) (setq y b)))
++
++ or equivalently:
++
++ (if (< a 0) (. (setq x 0) (setq y 0)) (. (setq x a) (setq y b)))
++
++ Each operator has its own requirement as to number and type of
++ operands. In the following table, "number" means any kind of number --
++ integer or floating-point -- or a variable, function, macro, or
++ S-Expression that returns a number; "vname" means variable name,
++ "fpnumber" means a floating-point number (or anything that resolves to
++ one), and "integer" means integer (or anything that resolves to one).
++ "truthvalue" means anything that resolves to a value of zero or an
++ empty value (which indicates false) or a nonzero value (which
++ indicates true). "any" means any kind of value, including none at all.
++
++ Operator Number of operands Type of operands Returns
++ EVAL (.) 0 or more S-Expression Last value (default NIL)
++ STRING 1 S-Expression string
++ QUOTE (') 1 word string
++ SETQ 0 or more vname value pairs Last value (default NIL)
++ LET 0 or more vname value pairs Last value (default NIL)
++ + 0 or more number number (default 0)
++ - 0 or more number number (default 0)
++ * 0 or more number number (see note (1))
++ / 2 or more number number
++ ^ 2 or more number number
++ ++ 1 or more vname value pairs Result of last increment
++ -- 1 or more vname value pairs Result of last decrement
++ ABS 1 number number
++ MAX 1 or more number number
++ MIN 1 or more number number
++ MOD (%) 2 number number
++ FLOAT 1 number fpnumber
++ TRUNCATE 1 number integer
++ CEILING 1 number integer
++ FLOOR 1 number integer
++ ROUND 1 number integer
++ SQRT 1 number fpnumber
++ EXP 1 number fpnumber
++ SIN 1 number fpnumber
++ COS 1 number fpnumber
++ TAN 1 number fpnumber
++ LOG 1 number fpnumber
++ LOG10 1 number fpnumber
++ = (==) 1 or more number truthvalue
++ != 1 or more number truthvalue
++ < 1 or more number truthvalue
++ <= 1 or more number truthvalue
++ > 1 or more number truthvalue
++ >= 1 or more number truthvalue
++ AND (&&) 1 or more truthvalue truthvalue
++ OR (||) 1 or more truthvalue truthvalue
++ XOR 2 truthvalue truthvalue
++ NOT (!) 1 truthvalue truthvalue
++ & 1 or more number (see note 2) integer
++ | 1 or more number (see note 2) integer
++ # 2 number (see note 2) integer
++ ~ 1 number (see note 2) integer
++ IF 2 or 3 truthvalue,any,any any
++
++ Operators that don't require any arguments return the default values
++ shown.
++
++ 1. The value of "*", when used as an operator, is initially "1" and
++ the value of the most recent S-Expression thereafter, as in Franz
++ Lisp. This is handy when doing a series of calculations by hand:
++ C-Kermit>(* 13272.42 0.40)
++ 5308.968
++ C-Kermit>(/ * 2)
++ 2654.4840
++ C-Kermit>
++ 2. The bitwise operators coerce their operands to integer by
++ truncation.
++
++ [ [505]Top ] [ [506]Contents ] [ [507]C-Kermit Home ] [ [508]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.5. Variables
++
++ As noted elsewhere in this discussion, all backslash items (variables
++ such as \%a, macro parameters such as \%1, array elements such as
++ \&a[\%i], built-in variables such as \v(ndate), built-in functions
++ such as \fjoin(), macro names enclosed in \m(), \s(), or \:(), etc)
++ are evaluated at "top level" before the S-Expression is sent to the
++ S-Expression reader. To use a backslash variable as the target of an
++ assignment (e.g. by SETQ, LET, ++, or --), you must double the
++ backslash, e.g. (setq \\%r 1234). This is discussed at greater length
++ in the next section.
++
++ Thus S-Expression reader generally deals only with macro names (not
++ backslash items) as variables. It is important to understand how the
++ reader handles macro names. There are fundamentally two kinds of
++ S-Expressions: those that contain a single element, such as:
++
++ (foo)
++
++ and those that contain more than one element:
++
++ (foo a b c)
++
++ If an S-Expression contains only one element, and it is the name of a
++ macro, the macro's definition is examined. If the definition is a
++ number (integer or floating-point, positive or negative), then this
++ becomes the value of the expression. If the definition starts with '
++ (apostrophe), then the quoted word or string is the value of the
++ expression (explained in [509]Section 9.8). Otherwise, the macro is
++ assumed to be composed of Kermit commands (possibly including
++ S-Expressions), which are executed. If the macro has a RETURN value,
++ or it executes an S-Expression as its last command, the result becomes
++ the value of the S-Expression; otherwise the result is empty.
++
++ For S-Expressions that contain more than one element, and the first
++ element is the name of a macro, then this macro is executed with the
++ arguments that are given, after the arguments are evaluated by the
++ S-Expression reader. Likewise, If the first element is a built-in
++ operator, then it is applied to the operands after they are evaluated.
++ In both cases, each operand is fed to the S-Expression reader
++ recursively for evaluation. If an operand is a number or a quoted
++ string, it is used as-is. But if it's a macro name, this degenerates
++ into the first case, and the previous paragraph applies.
++
++ Examples:
++
++ define foo 123
++ (foo) Result: 123
++ define foo 'abc
++ (foo) Result: abc
++ define foo '(one two three)
++ (foo) Result: one two three
++ define foo return \frandom(1000)
++ (foo) Result: 713 (or other number)
++ define foo (+ a b)
++ (foo) Result: The sum of a and b
++
++ A more difficult example:
++
++ define foo abc
++ (foo) Result: ???
++
++ The result in the last example depends on the definition of abc:
++
++ * If it has no definition, an error occurs; otherwise:
++ * If the definition is an S-Expression, the result is the
++ S-Expression's value; otherwise:
++ * If the definition consists of Kermit commands, they are executed.
++ But in this case "(foo)" produces the empty result, because it
++ doesn't RETURN anything.
++
++ The use of macros as S-Expression operators is described in
++ [510]Section 9.8.
++
++ [ [511]Top ] [ [512]Contents ] [ [513]C-Kermit Home ] [ [514]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.6. Assignments and Scope
++
++ The assignment operators SETQ and LET apply to global and local
++ variables, respectively. SETQ and LET are standard Lisp operators
++ adapted to Kermit scoping rules. When the operands are numeric or
++ arithmetic, SETQ is equivalent to Kermit's EVALUATE command:
++
++ (setq a (+ 1 2))
++ evaluate a 1 + 2
++
++ When the operand is a string, SETQ is equivalent to DEFINE:
++
++ (setq a '(this is a string))
++ define a this is a string
++
++ In the first case, both statements create a macro named "a" with a
++ value of 3. But in neither case is the macro "a" necessarily global.
++ If either of these commands executes in an environment (i.e. macro
++ invocation level) where a "local a" command has been given, the "a"
++ macro is global to that environment, but is not visible outside it.
++
++ LET is equivalent to the Kermit LOCAL command, followed by the
++ corresponding EVALUATE:
++
++ (let a (+ 1 2))
++
++ is equivalent to:
++
++ local a
++ evaluate a 1 + 2
++
++ Again, "local" in this context applies to the Kermit macro invocation
++ stack, not to the S-Expression nesting level. To illustrate, recall
++ our "newarea" macro:
++
++def newarea {
++ (let a \%1 b \%2 c \%3)
++ (let s (/ (+ a b c) 2.0))
++ (sqrt (* s (- s a) (- s b) (- s c)))
++}
++
++ Because SETQ and LET expressions return a value, they can be placed
++ within a larger S-Expression. In this case we can replace the first
++ reference to the "s" variable by its defining expression:
++
++def newarea {
++ (let a \%1 b \%2 c \%3)
++ (sqrt (* (let s (/ (+ a b c) 2.0)) (- s a) (- s b) (- s c)))
++}
++
++ This would not work if LET were local to the S-Expression, but it
++ works nicely in the context of Kermit macros. The previous definition
++ is equivalent to:
++
++def newarea {
++ local a b c s
++ (setq a \%1 b \%2 c \%3)
++ (sqrt (* (setq s (/ (+ a b c) 2.0)) (- s a) (- s b) (- s c)))
++}
++
++ In both cases, the variables a, b, c, and s are local to the "newarea"
++ macro, and global within it.
++
++ Multiple assignments can be handled in several ways. Here is the
++ obvious way to initialize a series of variables to the same value:
++
++ (setq a 0)
++ (setq b 0)
++ (setq c 0)
++ (setq s 0)
++
++ Here is a more compact and efficient way of doing the same thing:
++
++ (setq a 0 b 0 c 0 s 0)
++
++ However, in case the value was more complex, it's better to put only
++ one copy of it in the S-Expression; in this case we rely on the fact
++ that SETQ returns the value of its last assignment:
++
++ (setq a (setq b (setq c (setq s (* x (^ y 2))))))
++
++ Similarly, to set a series of variables to x, x+1, x+2, ...
++
++ (setq c (+ (setq b (+ (setq a (+ (setq s x) 1)) 1)) 1))
++
++ In the last example, you can see why "last" does not always correspond
++ to "rightmost" (the leftmost variable "c" is assigned last).
++
++ If you are working with backslash variables like \%a or array elements
++ like \&a[1], remember two rules:
++ 1. Don't put spaces inside array brackets.
++ 2. You must double the backslash when using SETQ, LET, ++, or -- to
++ assign a value to a backslash variable.
++
++ Examples of assigning to a backslash variable:
++
++ (setq x 1)
++ (setq \\%a 0)
++ (setq \\&a[x+1] 1)
++ (++ \\%x)
++ (-- \\&a[x+2])
++
++ Examples of referring to a backslash variable's value:
++
++ (setq a (+ \%a 1))
++ (setq b (+ \%a \&a[1]))
++ (++ a \%x)
++ (-- b \&a[1])
++
++ The special notation is required because all backslashed items (\%x
++ variables, array elements, built-in \v(xxx) variables, and \fxxx()
++ function invocations) are evaluated in a single pass BEFORE the
++ S-Expression is executed; any other approach would result in
++ unacceptable performance. So, for example, in:
++
++ declare \&a[] = 1 2 3
++ define \%x 4
++ define \%y 0
++ (setq \\%y (+ \%x \&a[1]))
++
++ the S-Expression becomes:
++
++ (setq \%y (+ 4 1))
++
++ before it is sent to the S-Expression evaluator. If the backslash had
++ not been doubled on the assignment target, the result would have been:
++
++ (setq 0 (+ 4 1))
++
++ which is illegal because you can't assign a value to a number.
++ Conversely, if backslashes were doubled on right-hand-side values:
++
++ (setq \\%y (+ \\%x \\&a[1])
++
++ this too, would give an error (not numeric - "\%x").
++
++ If you omit the double backslash in the assignment target, the result
++ depends on whether the variable already has a value:
++
++ (setq \%a (* 3 3))
++
++ If \%a has a non-numeric single-word value, then this becomes the name
++ of the variable that is assigned by SETQ. To illustrate:
++
++ define \%a foo
++ echo \%a
++ foo
++ (setq \%a (* 3 3))
++ echo \%a
++ foo
++ show macro foo
++ foo = 9
++
++ If \%a has no value, a numeric value, or a multiword value, an
++ "invalid assignment" error occurs.
++
++ [ [515]Top ] [ [516]Contents ] [ [517]C-Kermit Home ] [ [518]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.7. Conditional Expressions
++
++ The IF operator provides a compact form of decision-making within
++ S-Expressions. An IF expression can stand wherever a number might
++ stand, as long is it returns a number. Here's a quick way to obtain
++ the average value of all the elements in an array that contains only
++ numbers:
++
++ (/ (+ \fjoin(&a)) (float \fdim(&a)))
++
++ This results in a "Divide by zero" error if the array is empty. If you
++ want to define the average value of an empty array to be 0 instead of
++ getting an error, you can use IF to check the array size:
++
++ (if \fdim(&a) (/ (+ \fjoin(&a)) (float \fdim(&a))) 0)
++
++ or equivalently:
++
++ (if (not \fdim(&a)) 0 (/ (+ \fjoin(&a)) (float \fdim(&a))))
++
++ Of course, IF can fit anywhere else into an S-Expression:
++
++ (setq a (+ b (if (< c 0) 0 c)))
++
++ and the IF expression can be as complex as you like:
++
++ (setq a (+ b (if (and (or (> x 0) (> y 0)) (< c 0) (> d 1) (!= e 0)) 1 0)))
++
++ and the "then" and "else" parts can contain multiple S-Expressions
++ enclosed within (EVAL ...):
++
++ (if x (eval (...) (...) (...)) (eval (...) (...) (...)))
++
++ AND and OR operators are guaranteed to "short circuit". If any operand
++ of AND is false, none of the subsequent operands is evaluated;
++ likewise, if an OR operand is true, no further operands are evaluated.
++
++ Bear in mind that the S-Expression IF is not the same as Kermit IF;
++ the condition is only allowed to be an S-Expression or a variable or
++ number, not the whole list of possibilities you see when you type "if
++ ?" at the C-Kermit> prompt. But keep reading...
++
++ [ [519]Top ] [ [520]Contents ] [ [521]C-Kermit Home ] [ [522]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.8. Extensibility
++
++ To extend the capabilities of S-Expressions, you can use Kermit macro
++ names as operators, with the following limitations:
++
++ * The macro must not have the same name as a built-in operator.
++ * You must use the full macro name, not an abbreviation.
++
++ And with the following enhancement:
++
++ * If the last statement executed by the macro is an S-Expression,
++ its value is returned automatically. In other words:
++
++ define bump (++ \%1)
++
++ is equivalent to:
++
++ define bump return \fsexpression(++ \%1)
++
++ Here's an example in which we define a FIBONACCI operator that returns
++ the nth element, n >= 0, of the Fibonacci series, 0 1 1 2 3 5 8 13 21
++ 34 55, . . ., in which the first element is 0, the second is 1, and
++ each subsequent element is the sum of the two before it. This series
++ was devised by Leonardo Pisano, Filius Bonacci (Fibonacci for short)
++ in 1202 to describe how fast rabbits can breed, and also forms the
++ basis for the Golden Mean, the branching behavior of plants, the
++ spiral of a nautilus shell, etc. (Thanks to [523]Dat Thuc Nguyen for
++ December 2003 corrections to this section!)
++
++ We can write a FIBONACCI function as a macro easily with
++ S-Expressions:
++
++ define FIBONACCI {
++ (if (== \%1 0) 0
++ (if (== \%1 1) 1 (+ (fibonacci (- \%1 2)) (fibonacci (- \%1 1)))))
++ }
++
++ You can read this as:
++
++ If the argument (\%1) is 0, return a result of 0; if it is 1,
++ return 1; otherwise:
++ return the sum of fibonacci(argument - 2) and fibonacci(argument -
++ 1)
++
++ Note that a RETURN statement is not needed, since S-Expressions
++ automatically set the return value of their containing macros.
++
++ For comparison, here's how it would be coded without S-Expressions:
++
++ define FIBONACCI {
++ if == \%1 0 {
++ return 0
++ } else if == \%1 1 {
++ return 1
++ } else {
++ return \feval(\fexec(fibonacci \feval(\%1-2)) -
++ + \fexec(fibonacci \feval(\%1-1)))
++ }
++ }
++
++ Now we can use the FIBONACCI function (whichever way you write it)
++ just as if it were a built-in operator:
++
++ (fibonacci 6)
++
++ Or:
++
++ (setq a 10)
++ (fibonacci a)
++
++ Within S-Expressions only (not outside them), S-Expressions themselves
++ can be used as macro arguments:
++
++ (setq a 2 b 4)
++ (setq x (fibonacci (* a b )))
++
++ The value of the S-Expression (in this case "8"), and not the
++ S-Expression itself, is sent to the macro.
++
++ Your macro is responsible for argument validation and error handling.
++ A robust Fibonacci macro would be more like this:
++
++ define FIBONACCI {
++ if < \v(argc) 2 end 1 ?\%0: Missing argument
++ if > \v(argc) 2 end 1 ?\%0: Too many arguments
++ if not integer \%1 end 1 ?\%0: Integers only
++ if < \%1 1 end 1 ?\%0: Argument out of range
++ (if (== \%1 0) 0
++ (if (== \%1 1) 1 (+ (fibonacci (- \%1 2)) (fibonacci (- \%1 1)))))
++ }
++
++ Recall that "END nonzero-number [ message ]" causes a macro invocation
++ to fail. When the macro is the operator in an S-Expression, this makes
++ the S-Expression fail too. Also note that our Fibonacci macro is just
++ an illustration, not a practical example. Since it is recursive (calls
++ itself), it won't work for large arguments because the call stack can
++ exceed available memory. See [524]Section 9.9.2 for a practical
++ alternative.
++
++ Kermit macros, when used as S-Expression operators, can do anything at
++ all except initiate file transfers: they can print messages on the
++ screen, read and write files, interact with the user, and so on. For
++ example, here's a macro ASKME that asks you to enter a number, makes
++ sure that you did, and then returns its value for use in the
++ S-Expression:
++
++ define ASKME {
++ local \%n
++ while true {
++ ask \%n { Number: }
++ if not def \%n continue
++ if not numeric \%n {
++ echo Not numeric - "\%n"
++ continue
++ }
++ break
++ }
++ return \%n
++ }
++ (setq a (* 2 (askme))) ; Get number from user, double it, assign result to a.
++
++ Here's a macro you can use to validate that a number is in a given
++ range:
++
++ define inrange {
++ if != \v(argc) 4 end 1 ?\%0: Wrong number of arguments
++ if ( < \%1 \%2 || > \%1 \%3 ) return 0
++ return 1
++ }
++
++ The first argument is the number to be checked, the second is the
++ minimum acceptable value, the third is the maximum. You can use this
++ (for example) in IF conditions:
++
++ define yes echo \%1 IS OK
++ define no echo \%1 IS NOT OK
++
++ (setq a -1 b 999)
++ (if (inrange a 0 100) (yes a) (no a))
++ (if (inrange b -1000 +1000) (yes b) (no b))
++
++ This is just an illustration, of course; there's already a built-in
++ operator to let you do range checking without help from macros:
++
++ (if (<= 0 a 100) (yes a) (no a))
++ (if (<= -1000 b +1000) (yes b) (no b))
++
++ To send string parameters to a macro, some kind of quoting is required
++ to tell the S-Expression parser to take a given "word" literally
++ rather than replacing it by its value. For this we use the Lisp QUOTE
++ operator:
++
++ define length return \flength(\%1)
++ (length (quote abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz))
++ 26
++
++ This causes the string "abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz" to be sent
++ literally to the LENGTH macro. Kermit, like Lisp, also offers a
++ shortcut for QUOTE, that lets us quote a word by prefixing it with a
++ single quote (') character, also called apostophe (ASCII 39):
++
++ (length 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz)
++ 26
++
++ The two forms are equivalent.
++
++ How the macro treats its arguments is up to the macro. In the example
++ above, the argument is treated as a literal string. However, it can
++ also be treated as a variable name:
++
++ define string This is a string
++ define length return \flength(\m(\%1))
++ (length 'string)
++ 16
++
++ Note the construct \m(\%1). This means "the value of the macro whose
++ name is the value of
++ \%1". The value of \%1 in this case is the word "string", and the
++ value of the macro whose name is "string" is "This is a string".
++
++ What if the macro takes multiple arguments, or a variable number of
++ them? Here's a simple macro that prints a phrase that includes its
++ arguments:
++
++ define complain echo It's too \%*!
++
++ (Recall that \%* means "all arguments".)
++
++ It can be called in the traditional way:
++
++ complain hot Result: "It's too hot!"
++ complain cold and wet Result: "It's too cold and wet!"
++
++ Or from an S-Expression if you quote the arguments:
++
++ (complain 'hot) Result: "It's too hot!"
++ (complain 'cold 'and 'wet) Result: "It's too cold and wet!"
++
++ To group multiple words into a single argument, use parentheses:
++
++ (complain (quote (cold and wet))) Result: "It's too cold and wet!"
++ (complain '(cold and wet)) Result: "It's too cold and wet!"
++
++ Note the difference:
++
++ (complain 'cold 'and 'wet) Three arguments
++ (complain '(cold and wet)) One argument
++
++ Since the COMPLAIN macro uses \%* to refer to all its arguments, no
++ matter how many, it doesn't care which form you use. But it makes a
++ difference in cases where the macro refers to its arguments
++ individually.
++
++ To illustrate, let's consider a macro that receives the name of a
++ macro and its argument list and executes it with its arguments,
++ without knowing how many arguments there are. The following LOOP macro
++ is used to execute the given macro with the given argument list the
++ requested number of times:
++
++ def loop { local i, for i 1 \%1 1 do \%2 \%3 }
++
++ Within the LOOP macro, the first argument (\%1) is the loop count, \%2
++ is the macro name, and \%3 is the argument list. When the LOOP macro
++ is invoked traditionally like this:
++
++ loop 3 complain hot
++
++ it prints "It's too hot!" three times. To invoke it from an
++ S-Expression, you must quote both the macro name as well as the
++ argument, since in this case the macro name itself is an argument:
++
++ (loop 3 'complain 'hot)
++
++ Now what if you need to send different or variable numbers of
++ arguments to the LOOP macro? The LOOP macro can handle it already,
++ provided you group the arguments into LOOP's third argument (\%3). In
++ Kermit syntax, without grouping:
++
++ loop 3 complain cold and wet
++
++ prints "It's too cold!" three times ("and wet" is lost); but with
++ grouping (either of the following two forms):
++
++ loop 3 complain {cold and wet}
++ loop 3 complain "cold and wet"
++
++ the LOOP macro prints "It's too cold and wet!" three times as desired.
++
++ To do the same thing in an S-Expression, just use the Lisp forms of
++ quoting instead of the Kermit forms; the following two are equivalent:
++
++ (loop 3 'complain (quote (cold and wet)))
++ (loop 3 'complain '(cold and wet))
++
++ Here's a similar example in which we write a macro that shows both the
++ name and the value of one or more other macros, whose names are given
++ as arguments (similar to "show macro"):
++
++ define display {
++ local \%i
++ for \%i 1 \v(argc)-1 1 {
++ echo \&_[\%i] = \m(\&_[\%i])
++ }
++ }
++
++ (Recall that \&_[] is the macro's argument vector array, equivalent to
++ \%1, \%2, ...) The DISPLAY macro can be used in S-Expressions like
++ this:
++
++ (setq a 1 b 2 c 3)
++ (display 'a 'b 'c 'd)
++
++ which prints:
++
++ a = 1
++ b = 2
++ c = 3
++ d =
++
++ The names must be quoted to prevent their evaluation before they are
++ sent to the macro. This ability to pass variables "by name" to macros,
++ rather than by value, lets you write macros that change the values of
++ argument variables. For example, here's a macro that doubles the value
++ of its argument variable:
++
++ define double (++ \%1 \%1)
++
++ which you can call like this:
++
++ (setq a 12)
++ (double 'a)
++
++ In the macro, \%1 is replace by the variable name "a"; "(++ a a)" adds
++ "a" to itself, and sets the value of "a" to the result.
++
++ There are no built-in operators other than QUOTE, ', and STRING for
++ handling strings in S-Expressions, but using just these, plus macros
++ that use Kermit's regular string-handling features, you can easily
++ extend S-Expressions to do string manipulation:
++
++ define len return \flen(\%1) Returns length of argument string
++ define cap return \fupper(\%1) Uppercase argument string
++ define rev return \freverse(\%1) Reverses argument string
++ define sub return \fsubstr(\%1,\%2,\%3) Returns substring of arg string
++
++ (len '(this is a string)) Result: 16
++ (rev '(this is a string)) Result: gnirts a si siht
++ (rev (cap '(this is a string))) Result: GNIRTS A SI SIHT
++ (sub (rev (cap '(this is a string))) 5 9) Result: TS A SI S
++
++ You can assign a string to a macro name as follows:
++
++ (setq foo '(this is a string))
++ (setq foo (quote (this is a string)))
++
++ The two are exactly equivalent. In both cases, the macro "foo" has the
++ value:
++
++ '(this is a string)
++
++ so when it is retrieved it can be identified as a string rather than a
++ number or commands to be executed. Thus:
++
++ (setq foo (quote (this is a string)))
++ show macro foo
++ foo = '(this is a string)
++ (foo)
++ this is a string
++
++ Note the different results for "show macro foo" and "(foo)". The
++ former shows the internal definition; the latter evaluates the
++ variable, which removes the quoting. And perhaps more important, note
++ that if the apostrophe and surrounding parentheses were not stored as
++ part of the definition, (foo) would try to execute "this is a string"
++ as a command.
++
++ Given the assignment above, the following work as expected:
++
++ (len foo) Result: 16
++ (rev foo) Result: gnirts a si siht
++ (rev (cap foo)) Result: GNIRTS A SI SIHT
++ (sub (rev (cap foo)) 5 8) Result: TS A SI S
++
++ Note that, unlike built-in S-Expression operators that return numbers
++ or truth values, these operators return strings. If you want to assign
++ their return values to other variables, you can do so:
++
++ (setq bar (rev (cap foo))) Result: GNIRTS A SI SIHT
++
++ But now the S-Expression processor doesn't know the value of "bar" is
++ supposed to be a string, rather than a macro to execute. For this you
++ need one final special operator, STRING. The STRING operator takes an
++ S-Expression as an operand, evaluates it, and then returns its value
++ enclosed in '(), so you can use the value as a string is subsequent
++ S-Expressions. Use STRING for referencing macros that return strings:
++
++ (setq bar (string (rev (cap foo)))) Result: '(GNIRTS A SI SIHT)
++
++ STRING is like QUOTE, except that it evaluates its operand before
++ applying the quoting, rather than taking the operand literally.
++
++ To reference backslash variables or functions that return string
++ values, you must use the regular quoting mechanisms:
++
++ (setq time '(\v(time)))
++ (setq date '(\v(date)))
++ assign \%r this is a string
++ (setq s1 '(\%r))
++
++ That's because backslash items are evaluated BEFORE the S-Expression
++ parser ever sees them, and the values of \v(time) and so on are not
++ valid S-Expressions, so STRING won't like them.
++
++ Finally a brief word on the touchy topic of quoting. Suppose you want
++ to include (say) literal parentheses in a string that will later be
++ processed by the S-Expression reader (or \fsplit() or \fword()).
++ Normally, you can't do this because parentheses are meaningful in
++ these contexts. To defeat the normal parsing rules, you can quote the
++ parentheses with backslash. However, due to the many levels of string
++ processing involved, a surprisingly large amount of backslashes might
++ be required, for example:
++
++ (setq s '(a b (c d) \\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\(e f (g h) x\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\) j k))
++
++ This is nearly impossible to explain(*). Instead, just remember two
++ points:
++
++ * In situations like this, it's better to use DEFINE to create the
++ string, rather than SETQ. The example above requires only double
++ backslashes when DEFINE is used:
++ define s '(a b (c d) \\(e f (g h) x\\) j k)
++ * The level of quoting depends on how many levels of evaluation the
++ string must pass through, which is not always obvious. However,
++ the number of backslashes required in any given situation is
++ always a power of 2. So if 1 doesn't work, try 2; if 2 doesn't
++ work, try 4; if 4 doesn't work, try 8, 16, 32, and so on.
++
++ Considerations like this apply in any scripting language (shell, Tcl,
++ Perl, Python, etc). The situation is known as "Quoting Hell".
++
++ (*) If you really want an explanation, here it is:
++
++ * Every SEXP has its backslash items evaluated in a single pass at
++ top level before being passed to the SEXP reader, so \%1,
++ \v(ftime), etc, can be evaluated up front, freeing the SEXP reader
++ of having to know about such things, which in turn makes it much
++ more efficient. Therefore one level of quoting is lost right away,
++ and therefore you must double each backslash that is to be used as
++ a quote.
++ * When the SEXP reader sees '\', it treats it as a quote; discards
++ it and keeps the next character. Thus '\\' becomes '\'. This would
++ be the end of it, except that:
++ * The SEXP reader must call itself recursively on its operands, so
++ we must double any quotes in the operands: 2^2 = 4.
++ * If the result is to be passed as an argument to a macro, the
++ backslashes must again be doubled, because the macro processor
++ evaluates the arguments before sending them to the macro: 2^3 = 8.
++ * If the macro itself is to see the quotes, rather than just the
++ result of the quoting, the quotes must be doubled again: 2^4 = 16.
++
++ Moral: To create string constants in which grouping characters must be
++ quoted, use DEFINE rather than SETQ.
++
++ [ [525]Top ] [ [526]Contents ] [ [527]C-Kermit Home ] [ [528]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.9. Examples
++
++ 9.9.1. Statistics
++
++ The following program computes statistics -- means, maxima, mimima,
++ variance, standard deviation, and correlation -- from data stored in
++ parallel arrays, \&x[] and \&y[], which can contain any mixture of
++ integer and floating-point numbers: positive, negative, or zero. Array
++ setup and validation are not shown. Except for the traditional FOR
++ loop and printing the results at the end, the entire computation is
++ done with S-Expressions:
++
++; Initialize sums, maxima, minima, and number of elements
++
++ (setq xsum 0 ysum 0 xsum2 0 ysum2 0 xysum 0)
++ (setq xmin (setq xmax \&x[1]) ymin (setq ymax \&y[1]))
++ (setq n \fdim(&x))
++
++; Loop through elements and accumulate sums, maxima, and minima
++
++ for i 1 n 1 {
++ (setq x \&x[i] y \&y[i]) ; Notational convenience
++ (setq xmax (max xmax x) ymax (max ymax y)) ; X and Y maxima
++ (setq xmin (min xmin x) ymin (min ymin y)) ; X and Y minima
++ (++ xsum x ysum y) ; X and Y sums
++ (++ xsum2 (^ x 2) ysum2 (^ y 2)) ; Sum of X and Y squares
++ (++ xysum (* x y)) ; Sum of XY products
++ }
++
++; Calculate results
++
++ (setq xmean (/ xsum n) ymean (/ ysum n)) ; Mean X and Y
++ (setq xss (- xsum2 (/ (^ xsum 2) n))) ; Intermediate values
++ (setq yss (- ysum2 (/ (^ ysum 2) n)))
++ (setq xyss (- xysum (/ (* xsum ysum) n)))
++ (setq xvar (/ xss n) yvar (/ yss n)) ; X and Y variance
++ (setq sdx (sqrt xvar) sdy (sqrt yvar)) ; Std deviation in X and Y
++ (setq tmp (* xss yss))
++ (setq cc (if tmp (/ xyss (sqrt tmp)) 1.0)) ; Correlation coefficient
++ show macro xmean ymean xvar yvar sdx sdy cc ; Print the results
++
++ The final "if tmp" check accounts for the possibility that both arrays
++ contain all 0's. Results can also be printed with "echo CC = \m(cc)",
++ or any other desired way. Interestingly, if we had not needed the sum
++ of the squares and products, we could have obtained the sums, maxima,
++ and minima of the X's and Y's without a loop like this:
++
++ (setq xsum (+ \fjoin(&x)) ysum (+ \fjoin(&y)))
++ (setq xmax (max \fjoin(&x)) ymax (max \fjoin(&y)))
++ (setq xmin (min \fjoin(&x)) ymin (min \fjoin(&y)))
++
++ Any Kermit function that returns numbers or lists of numbers can be
++ included in an S-Expression as an operand.
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.9.2. Practical Fibonacci Series
++
++ The recursive Fibonacci example given previously is simple and
++ elegant, but not very useful since it causes memory occupation to grow
++ each time it calls itself, until eventually both physical memory and
++ disk swap space are filled and the program crashes. Even for small
++ arguments, like 17, execution time can be prohibitive:
++
++ (setq t1 \v(ftime))
++ (setq result (fibonacci 17))
++ (setq t2 (- \v(ftime) t1))
++ echo FIBONACCI(17) = \m(result): TIME = \ffpround(t2,3)
++
++ prints (on a certain rather slow computer):
++
++ FIBONACCI(17) = 1597: TIME = 5.861
++
++ Any recursive function can be recoded iteratively. The result is not
++ as pretty, but execution is far less expensive:
++
++ define FIBITER {
++ (if (== \%3 0) (\%2) (fibiter (+ \%1 \%2) \%1 (- \%3 1)))
++ }
++ define FIBONACCI {
++ (fibiter 1 0 \%1)
++ }
++
++ Here's the result on the same computer for the same argument of 17:
++
++ FIBONACCI(17) = 1597: TIME = 0.015
++
++ (47 times faster.) Execution time increases proportionally to the size
++ of the argument in the iterative case, whereas in the recursive case
++ it goes up geometrically, quickly reaching infinity.
++
++ [ [529]Top ] [ [530]Contents ] [ [531]C-Kermit Home ] [ [532]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.10. Differences from Algebraic Notation
++
++ In C-Kermit:
++
++ * Algebraic notation uses infix operators and normal rules of
++ operator precedence, with parentheses used to force exceptions to
++ the rules; many operations can be included in an expression.
++ S-Expressions use prefix operators with no intrinsic precedence;
++ each operation is enclosed in parentheses, and the arrangement of
++ parentheses determines precedence.
++ * Algebraic infix operators require two operands; S-Expression
++ prefix operators can accept a variable number of operands.
++ * You can use algebraic notation anywhere that C-Kermit accepts a
++ number, e.g. "echo \&a[((1+1)*2-1]", but you can use S-Expressions
++ only as top-level commands. You can, however, use either algebraic
++ or S-Expressions anywhere at all by enclosing them in \fevaluate()
++ or \fsexpression(), respectively.
++ * You can use any mixture of integer and floating-point numbers in
++ S-Expressions, but only integers are permitted in algebraic
++ expressions. Outside of S-Expressions, floating point arithmetic
++ is supported only by \ffp...() function calls.
++ * Operators and operands in S-Expressions must be separated by
++ spaces, e.g. "(+ a b)". Spaces are not required in algebraic
++ expressions: "((a+b)*c)".
++ * When assigning values to backslash variables (such as \%x or
++ \&a[2]) using SETQ or LET, you must double the backslash.
++
++ [ [533]Top ] [ [534]Contents ] [ [535]C-Kermit Home ] [ [536]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ 9.11. Differences from Lisp
++
++ * Kermit has a lot of built-in operators not found in Lisp: ++, ^,
++ etc.
++ * Most dialects of real Lisp do not allow S-Expressions that don't
++ start with an operator, for example:
++ (a)
++ This expression can cause an error in Lisp (even if "a" has a
++ value), but is acceptable in Kermit, where it returns the value of
++ the variable "a". Similarly, (1) returns the value "1".
++ * In real Lisp, EVAL requires exactly one operand. In Kermit, it can
++ have 0, 1, 2, or more operands. It returns the value of the last
++ operand evaluated.
++ * Real Lisp SETQ and LET usually require an even number of operands.
++ Kermit allows an odd number, in which case the last (or only)
++ variable is undefined (i.e. deleted, destroyed).
++ * Kermit does not support ratios such as "7/8". Some Lisp dialects
++ accept ratios as numbers, and generate ratios when told to divide
++ two integers whose quotient is not a whole number; e.g. in Common
++ Lisp:
++ [13] USER(37): (/ (+ 1 2 3 4) 3)
++ 10/3
++ [13] USER(38):
++ * The result of (/ 10 3) is 3.333.... Some Lisp dialects truncate
++ the result to 3 since both operands are integers, some don't; some
++ give the result as a ratio. C-Kermit always gives a floating point
++ result when there is a fractional part. If you want an integer
++ result, you can use TRUNCATE, FLOOR, or CEILING, e.g. (truncate (/
++ 10 3)).
++ * There is currently no "bignum" support. Large numbers can be used
++ and large results generated, but (as noted in [537]Section 9.2)
++ they are accurate only to the precision of the underlying machine.
++ \v(math_precision) gives the machine precision as a number of
++ decimal digits, e.g. 16.
++ * Scientific notation for floating-point numbers is not supported.
++ If the magnitude of a number is greater than the precision of the
++ underlying hardware, the less-significant digits are shown but
++ their values are meaningless. If it the number is too small to be
++ represented internally, it is shown as "0.0".
++ * Many Lisp features are omitted: List processing (CAR, CDR, etc),
++ DEFUN, Lisp-specific control structures, and so on.
++
++ [ [538]Top ] [ [539]Contents ] [ [540]C-Kermit Home ] [ [541]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++10. FILE TRANSFER
++
++ New commands and switches:
++
++ SET TRANSFER REPORT { OFF, ON }
++ Enables or disables the (new) one-line message printed by
++ Kermit after a remote-mode file transfer to indicate the source
++ and destination file, complete with path, to let you know where
++ the file went.
++
++ SEND /TYPE:{TEXT,BINARY}
++ Sends only files of the given type (see [542]Section 4).
++
++ SEND /NOFOLLOWLINKS:
++ (UNIX only) Skip over symbolic links rather than following them
++ (default). This applies to wildcard and/or recursive SENDs; if
++ a single filename is given, and it happens to be a symbolic
++ link, the file it points to is sent.
++
++ SEND /FOLLOWLINKS:
++ (UNIX only) Follow (resolve) symbolic links. Watch out for
++ circular links, endless loops, etc.
++
++ SET SEND I-PACKETS { OFF, ON }
++ When sending commands to a Kermit server, this tells whether
++ command packets should be preceded by an I (information)
++ packet, which is used to synchronize parameters prior to
++ executing the command. Normally ON. The only reason to set this
++ OFF is for communicating with buggy Kermit servers that
++ misbehave when an I packet is sent to them. There is also a SET
++ RECEIVE I-PACKETS command, but presently it has no effect.
++
++ SET TRANSFER MESSAGE [ text ]
++ Sets an initial message to be shown in the Last Message field
++ of the fullscreen file-transfer display.
++
++ SET TRANSFER TRANSLATION { ON, OFF }
++ Inhibits or re-enables text-file transfer character-set
++ translation globally.
++
++ { SEND, MSEND, GET, RECEIVE } /TRANSPARENT
++ Inhibits character-set translation for this transfer only.
++
++ { GET, RECEIVE } /PIPES:{ON,OFF}
++ Overrides global TRANSFER PIPES setting for this transfer only;
++ ON allows incoming files with names like "!tar xf -" to be
++ opened as pipelines rather than regular files.
++
++ The following new "hot keys" are available when Kermit's file-transfer
++ display is visible:
++
++ D: Turn on debugging, open "debug.log" if not already open.
++ d: Turn off debugging but leave log open (if it was open).
++ T: Turn on debug-log timestamps.
++ t: Turn off debug-log timestamps.
++
++ Other improvements:
++ * SET FILE DOWNLOAD-DIRECTORY now works for external protocols (e.g.
++ sz/rz) too.
++ * Improved automatic per-file text/binary switching, described in
++ [543]Section 4.
++ * When sending a file group (e.g. "send *.*"), failure to open a
++ file is no longer fatal; now C-Kermit simply goes ahead to the
++ next file.
++ * Transaction log entries are now made for external protocols too.
++
++ [ [544]Top ] [ [545]Contents ] [ [546]C-Kermit Home ] [ [547]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++11. MODEMS AND DIALING
++
++ In C-Kermit 8.0, the default modem type for dialing has changed from
++ NONE (= DIRECT, meaning no modem) to GENERIC. This change should have
++ no impact on direct connections. For dialing, it means that, unless
++ you SET MODEM TYPE to a specific type, such as USROBOTICS or CONEXANT,
++ Kermit assumes:
++
++ 1. The modem uses the Hayes AT command set.
++ 2. The modem supports error correction, data compression, and
++ hardware flow control and is already configured to use them.
++
++ In fact, Kermit assumes the modem is completely configured, and
++ therefore does not send it an initialization string or any
++ configuration commands. Instead, it sends only the simplest and most
++ portable commands:
++
++ ATQ0V1 Give dial result codes.
++ ATDTnumber Dial the number.
++
++ (or ATD or ATDP, as appropriate).
++
++ The new defaults work for direct connections and for most modern
++ modems on most platforms, and they work much faster than
++ "full-treatment" dialing. If the new defaults don't work for you, or
++ if you need to perform explicit modem configuations or interactions,
++ then set a specific modem type and use the SET MODEM and SET DIAL
++ commands as documented in Using C-Kermit.
++
++ WARNING: Don't use the generic modem on hosts that do not support
++ RTS/CTS flow control. If Xon/Xoff is in use on the serial port,
++ you'll need to select a particular modem type so Kermit knows what
++ command to give it to enable Xon/Xoff flow control between itself
++ and your serial port.
++
++ The following new modem types were added in C-Kermit 8.0:
++
++ lucent: Lucent Venus chipset
++ pctel: PCTel V.90 chipset
++ conexant: Conexant (ex-Rockwell) modem family
++ zoom-v32bis: New name for "Zoom"
++ zoom-v34 Zoom V.34
++ zoom-v90 Zoom V.90 56K
++ zoom-v92: Zoom V.92 with V.44 data compression
++ zoltrix-v34: New name for "zoltrix"
++ zoltrix-hsp-v90: Synonym for PCTel
++ zoltrix-hcf-v90: Synonym for ITU-T-V250
++ smartlink-v90: Synonym for usrobotics (same chipset)
++ acer-v90: Synonym for Rockwell-v90
++
++ New DIAL-related variables:
++
++ \v(dm_hf): Dial modifier: Wait for Hook-Flash.
++ \v(dm_wb): Dial modifier: Wait for Bong.
++
++ Finally, if dialing fails, Kermit now prints a context-sensitive hint
++ suggesting possible reasons and remedies.
++
++ Added in C-Kermit 8.0.201: Rudimentary support for Caller ID, for
++ use with the ANSWER command. If the modem reports Caller ID
++ information, Kermit stores it in variables that you can access after
++ the call is answered:
++
++ \v(callid_date) The date of the call
++ \v(callid_time) The time of the call
++ \v(callid_name) The name of the caller
++ \v(callid_nmbr) The telephone number of the caller
++ \v(callid_mesg) A message
++
++ The format of these items depends on the originating and answering
++ phone companies and the modems and their configuration.
++
++ Not very many modems support Caller ID, and those that do (a) tend to
++ have it disabled by default, and (b) use different commands to enable
++ it. A quick survey shows of some current models shows:
++
++ - USR V.90: No
++ - ITU-T V.250: No
++ - Lucent Venus: No
++ - Diamond Supra: #CID=1
++ - Rockwell 56K: #CID=1
++ - PCTEL: #CID=1
++ - Zoltrix: +VCID=1
++ - Conexant: +VCID=1
++
++ To use Kermit's Caller ID feature, you have to set the modem to wait
++ for at least two rings before answering, and you have to give the
++ command to enable Caller ID; for example (after choosing a modem with
++ SET MODEM TYPE):
++
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=2#CID=1\{13}
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=2+VCID=1\{13}
++
++ These commands can be undone with:
++
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=1#CID=0\{13}
++ set modem command autoanswer on ATS0=1+VCID=0\{13}
++
++ Kermit presently has no built-in knowledge of the Caller ID
++ capabilities or commands of the modems in its database.
++
++ Since the variables can be accessed only after the call is answered,
++ the only way to refuse a call is to answer it, inspect the variables,
++ and then hang it up if desired.
++
++ [ [548]Top ] [ [549]Contents ] [ [550]C-Kermit Home ] [ [551]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++12. TERMINAL CONNECTION
++
++ Now that 7-bit connections are no longer the norm, the default
++ terminal bytesize (also called "data size" or "word size") in C-Kermit
++ 8.0 is 8 bits, rather than 7 bits as it was in C-Kermit 7.0 and
++ earlier:
++
++ SET ESCAPE character
++ This command, which specifies your CONNECT-mode escape
++ character, allows you to specify any ASCII control character in
++ a variety of formats. C-Kermit 8.0.201 now also lets you
++ specify any 8-bit value, 128-255, as the escape character. In
++ the SET ESCAPE command, you can type the 8-bit character
++ literally or you can enter its numeric code. Here are examples
++ that you can enter from a terminal or console that uses the ISO
++ Latin-1 character set:
++
++ C-Kermit> set escape Ã
++ C-Kermit> set escape 195
++ C-Kermit> show escape
++ Escape character: Code 195 (Ã): enabled
++ C-Kermit>
++
++ Both of these commands set the escape character value to 195
++ (decimal), which happens to be uppercase letter A with Tilde in
++ Latin-1. SHOW ESCAPE and SHOW TERMINAL show the value, as does
++ the CONNECT message.
++
++ SET TERMINAL AUTODOWNLOAD ERROR { STOP, CONTINUE }
++ When Kermit has a terminal connection to another computer, and
++ a file transfer is initiated automatically because a Kermit
++ packet was received in CONNECT mode (i.e. in the terminal
++ screen), this command tells what Kermit should do if the
++ transfer fails. The default is to STOP, which leaves Kermit in
++ command mode with its file-transfer display showing, so you can
++ see that the transfer failed and why. If you SET TERMINAL
++ AUTODOWNLOAD ERROR CONTINUE, this causes Kermit to return
++ automatically to its terminal screen (i.e. resume its CONNECT
++ session) as if the transfer had succeeded; this can be
++ desirable if the entire session is under control of a
++ host-based script.
++
++ SET TERMINAL BYTESIZE { 7, 8 }
++ The byte size to use during CONNECT and INPUT command
++ execution, which can be more restrictive than the bytesize
++ implied by the current PARITY setting, but not less
++ restrictive. In C-Kermit 7.0 and earlier, the terminal bytesize
++ was 7 by default to protect against the likelihood that parity
++ was in use on the connection without the user's knowledge. When
++ the terminal bytesize is 8 (as it is in C-Kermit 8.0 and
++ later), the user will see garbage in this (increasingly
++ unlikely) situation. Note that 8 data bits are required for
++ most character sets other than ASCII: Latin-1, UTF-8, and so
++ on.
++
++ A new command has been added to produce timestamped session logs:
++
++ SET TERMINAL SESSION-LOG TIMESTAMPED-TEXT
++ Records the terminal session in text mode (like SET TERMINAL
++ SESSION-LOG TEXT) but adds a timestamp at the beginning of each
++ line. The timestamp format is hh:mm:ss.nnn, and indicates the
++ time at which the first character of the line appeared.
++
++ In most UNIX versions (those built with the select()-capable CONNECT
++ module -- pretty much all the ones that have or could have TELNET
++ included), an idle timeout feature has been added:
++
++ SET TERMINAL IDLE-TIMEOUT number
++ If the number is not 0, then Kermit is to take an action when
++ the given amount of time passes with no activity during CONNECT
++ mode. If the number is positive it is the maximum number of
++ idle seconds; if number is negative it represents milliseconds
++ (thousandths of seconds). If 0 is given as the number, there
++ are no idle timeouts. Synonym: SET TERMINAL IDLE-LIMIT.
++
++ SET TERMINAL IDLE-ACTION { RETURN, HANGUP, EXIT, OUTPUT [ string ] }
++ The action to be taken upon an idle timeout in CONNECT mode.
++ RETURN to the prompt, HANGUP the connection, EXIT from Kermit,
++ or OUTPUT the given string (if no string is given, a NUL (ASCII
++ 0) character is sent).
++
++ SET TERMINAL IDLE-ACTION { TELNET-NOP, TELNET-AYT }
++ Actions that can be selected on Telnet connections only, that
++ might be useful if idle limits are enforced by the Telnet
++ server or in the TCP/IP protocol: TELNET-NOP sends a "NO
++ Operation" (do-nothing) command, which causes no response from
++ the server; TELNET-AYT sends an "Are You There" message to the
++ server, which should make the server send back a message.
++ Neither of these actions interferes with your remote session.
++
++ SET TERMINAL IDLE-ACTION is useful for connections to hosts or
++ services that automatically log you out after a certain amount of idle
++ time, e.g.:
++
++ set term idle-timeout 300
++ set term idle-action output \32
++
++ sends a space (as if you had pressed the space bar) every 300 seconds
++ (five minutes) while there is no activity (32 is the ASCII code for
++ space).
++
++ When C-Kermit returns from CONNECT to command mode, the reason for the
++ transition is given in a new variable, \v(cx_status):
++
++ 0 No CONNECT command given yet.
++ 1 User escaped back manually.
++ 2 A trigger string was encountered.
++ 3 IKSD entered server mode.
++ 4 Application Program Command received from host.
++ 5 Idle timeout.
++ 6 Telnet protocol error.
++ 7 Keystroke macro.
++ 8 Time limit exceeded.
++ 100 Internal error.
++ 101 Carrier required by not detected.
++ 102 I/O error on connection.
++ 103 Disconnected by host.
++ 104 Disconnected by user.
++ 105 Session limit exceeded.
++ 106 Rejected due to Telnet policy.
++ 107 Received kill signal.
++
++ Values 100 and above indicate there is no connection.
++
++ [ [552]Top ] [ [553]Contents ] [ [554]C-Kermit Home ] [ [555]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++13. CHARACTER SETS
++
++ See the section on [556]file scanning above, and the section on
++ character-set conversion in [557]FTP. Also:
++
++ * True support for CP1252 (rather than treating it as Latin-1).
++ * Proper handling of C1 values when converting ISO 8-bit text to
++ UTF-8.
++ * TYPE /CHARACTER-SET: /TRANSLATE-TO: allows specific translations.
++ * The TRANSLATE command now works on multiple files.
++ * K_CHARSET environment variable to set the file character-set.
++ * SET TRANSFER TRANSLATION OFF.
++ * FTP client character-set translation ([558]Section 3.7).
++
++ [ [559]Top ] [ [560]Contents ] [ [561]C-Kermit Home ] [ [562]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++14. DIALOUT FROM TELNET TERMINAL SERVERS
++
++ For years, C-Kermit has supported dialing out from Telnet modem
++ servers (also called reverse terminal servers or access servers), but
++ until now there was no way for Kermit to control the communication
++ parameters (speed, parity, etc) on the serial port of the terminal
++ server; it had to use whatever was there.
++
++ But now, if you make a connection to a server that supports the Telnet
++ Com Port Control Option, [563]RFC 2217, you have the same degree of
++ control as you would have over a serial port on the computer where
++ Kermit is running: SET SPEED, SET FLOW, SET PARITY, SET STOP-BITS,
++ SHOW COMM, WAIT, SET CARRIER-WATCH, the modem-signal variables,
++ sending Break, and so on, apply to the connection between the terminal
++ server and the modem.
++
++ For example, using a Cisco Access Server 2509, where specifying a TCP
++ port in the 6000's selects a serial port that can be used for dialing
++ out:
++
++ set host xxx 6001 ; xxx is the IP hostname or address of the server
++ (log in if necessary) ; With a script or by hand
++ set modem type usr ; Tell Kermit what kind of modem it has
++ set speed 57600 ; This affects the server's port
++ set flow rts/cts ; Ditto
++ dial 7654321
++
++ The modem server might or might not require a login sequence. It might
++ also allow for automatic authentication, e.g. via Kerberos tickets.
++ NOTE: If the modem server requires a login sequence, then REDIAL might
++ not work as expected.
++
++ When you have a Telnet Com Port connection, your SET SPEED and SET
++ FLOW options change automatically to reflect the capabilities of the
++ server, rather than those of your local computer.
++
++ See the configuration manual for your server for additional
++ information. For example, how to set up the server to drop the Telnet
++ connection automatically when the telephone call is hung up (e.g.
++ "autohangup" on Cisco models).
++
++ For a Linux-based Telnet Com-Port server, click the Srdird link:
++
++ [ [564]Top ] [ [565]Contents ] [ [566]Sredird ] [ [567]C-Kermit Home ]
++ [ [568]Kermit Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++15. COPING WITH BROKEN KERMIT PARTNERS
++
++ There are lots of faulty Kermit protocol implementations out there,
++ found mainly in 3rd-party products ranging from communications
++ software packages to file-transfer functions imbedded within devices.
++ This topic is covered [569]HERE for C-Kermit 7.0, but C-Kermit 8.0
++ adds some additional tricks.
++
++ SET ATTRIBUTE RECORD-FORMAT { ON, OFF }
++ Allows control of the Kermit's Record-Format attribute. Set
++ this to OFF in case incoming file are refused due to unknown or
++ invalid record formats if you want to accept the file anyway.
++
++ SET SEND I-PACKETS { ON, OFF }
++ A Kermit server is supposed to accept I-packets; this is how
++ the client lets the server know its capabilities and
++ preferences before sending a command. Apparently there is at
++ least one Kermit server implementation that does not accept
++ I-packets, and does not properly respond with an Error packet
++ if it gets one. To get around such situations in C-Kermit 8.0,
++ you can use SET SEND I-PACKETS OFF to inhibit the sending of I
++ packets. In this case, the client must be able to adjust to the
++ server's configuration, rather than the other way around as we
++ are used to.
++
++ SET PROTOCOL KERMIT {} {} {}
++ C-Kermit 6.0 and later automatically send "autoupload" and
++ "autodownload" commands when in local mode and you give a file
++ transfer command. For example, if you tell kermit to "send
++ oofa.txt", Kermit sends "kermit -r" and a carriage return, in
++ case you had forgotten to start Kermit on the far end and told
++ it to receive a file. If a Kermit program had already been
++ started on the far end, it should harmlessly absorb this
++ string. However, some Kermit programs violate the Kermit
++ protocol definition and treat such strings as Kermit packets
++ even though they are not. In such cases, give this command to
++ set the Kermit protocol autoupload and download strings to
++ nothing, which tells Kermit not to send them. (This is not a
++ new feature, but it was not previously included in the "Coping"
++ section of the documentation.)
++
++ [ [570]Top ] [ [571]Contents ] [ [572]C-Kermit Home ] [ [573]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++16. NEW COMMAND-LINE OPTIONS
++
++ kermit -h Now prints a complete listing of its command-line options,
++ rather than an abbreviated list squeezed into a 24x80 space.
++
++ -dd Debug, like -d but adds timestamps
++ --version Shows C-Kermit version number.
++ --noperms Equivalent to SET ATTRIBUTE PROTECTION OFF.
++
++ Kermit now accepts a selection of URLs (Universal Resource Locators)
++ as its first command-line argument. These are:
++
++ telnet:hostname
++ Makes a Telnet connection to the given host (IP hostname or
++ address).
++
++ ftp://[user[:password]@]hostname[/path...]
++ Makes an FTP connection to the given host (IP hostname or
++ address). If a username is given, Kermit tries to log you in;
++ if a password is given, it is used; if not, you are prompted
++ for one. If no username is given, an anonymous login is
++ performed. If a pathname is included, Kermit tries to GET the
++ given file. See [574]Section 3.1.3 for details.
++
++ ftps://[user[:password]@]hostname[/path...]
++ Makes a secure FTP connection over SSL.
++
++ telnets://[user[:password]@]hostname
++ Makes a secure Telnet connection over SSL.
++
++ kermit://[user[:password]@]hostname[/path...]
++ Makes a connection to an [575]Internet Kermit Server.
++
++ http://[user[:password]@]hostname[/path...]
++ Makes a connection to Web server.
++
++ https://[user[:password]@]hostname[/path...]
++ Makes a connection to secure Web server.
++
++ [ [576]Top ] [ [577]Contents ] [ [578]C-Kermit Home ] [ [579]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ __________________________________________________________________________
++
++17. LOGS
++
++ In C-Kermit 8.0, we make an effort to keep passwords out of the debug
++ log. This can never be 100% effective, but it's better than before,
++ when there were no precautions at all. Whenever Kermit knows it's
++ prompting for, parsing, or transmitting a password, it temporarily
++ turns off logging and then turns it back on afterwards. This keeps the
++ debug log password-free in most common cases, but there can be no
++ guarantees.
++
++ As noted elsewhere, the new "-dd" command-line option selects a
++ timestamped debug log (equivalent to "set debug timestamps on", "log
++ debug debug.log").
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 also supports a new timestamped session log via "set
++ session-log timestamped-text", "log session".
++
++ There have been requests for other kinds of logs, for example a
++ command log. These might be added at some point. One person wanted to
++ be able to log commands with timestamps, but only commands issued at
++ the prompt, not commands from files or macros, and also wanted a
++ header line at the beginning showing the date, user, and host. This
++ can be done as follows:
++
++ .filename := \v(home)commands.log ; (for example)
++ fopen /write \%c \m(filename)
++ if success {
++ fwrite /line \%c \v(date): User=\v(user) Host=\v(host)
++ fclose \%c
++ set debug timestamps on
++ log debug {| grep "CMD(P)" >> \m(filename)} append
++ }
++
++ [ [580]Top ] [ [581]Contents ] [ [582]C-Kermit Home ] [ [583]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++ C-Kermit 8.0 Update Notes / [584]The Kermit Project / Columbia
++ University / 15 Dec 2003
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 4. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html
++ 5. mailto:kermit-support@columbia.edu
++ 6. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 7. http://www.kermit-project.org/
++ 8. http://www.columbia.nyc.ny.us/kermit/
++ 9. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/COPYING.TXT
++ 10. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckcmai.c
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#xv
++ 12. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 13. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.html
++ 14. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckermit70.txt
++ 15. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html
++ 16. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckuker.nr
++ 17. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/telnet.htm
++ 19. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpscripts.html
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcbwr.html
++ 21. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckcbwr.txt
++ 22. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckubwr.html
++ 23. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckubwr.txt
++ 24. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckvbwr.html
++ 25. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckvbwr.txt
++ 26. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 27. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckuins.txt
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckvins.html
++ 29. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckvins.txt
++ 30. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckccfg.html
++ 31. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckccfg.txt
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html
++ 33. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/f/ckcplm.txt
++ 34. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/iksd.html
++ 35. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/skermit.html
++ 36. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 37. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 38. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 39. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x0
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x1
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2
++ 42. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.1
++ 43. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2
++ 44. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.1
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.2
++ 46. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.3
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.4
++ 48. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.5
++ 49. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.6
++ 50. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 51. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1
++ 52. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.1
++ 53. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.2
++ 54. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.3
++ 55. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.4
++ 56. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 57. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.3
++ 58. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.4
++ 59. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5.1
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5.2
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5.3
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6.1
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6.2
++ 66. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6.3
++ 67. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 68. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7.1
++ 69. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7.2
++ 70. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.8
++ 71. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.9
++ 72. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10
++ 73. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10.1
++ 74. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10.2
++ 75. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10.3
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 77. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 78. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x5
++ 79. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6
++ 80. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6.1
++ 81. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6.2
++ 82. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6.3
++ 83. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6.4
++ 84. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6.5
++ 85. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6.6
++ 86. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x7
++ 87. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8
++ 88. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.1
++ 89. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.2
++ 90. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.3
++ 91. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.4
++ 92. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.5
++ 93. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.6
++ 94. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.7
++ 95. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.8
++ 96. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.9
++ 97. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.10
++ 98. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.11
++ 99. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.12
++ 100. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13
++ 101. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.14
++ 102. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9
++ 103. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.1
++ 104. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.2
++ 105. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.3
++ 106. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.4
++ 107. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.5
++ 108. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.6
++ 109. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.7
++ 110. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 111. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.9
++ 112. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.10
++ 113. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.11
++ 114. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x10
++ 115. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x11
++ 116. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x12
++ 117. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x13
++ 118. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x14
++ 119. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x15
++ 120. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x16
++ 121. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x17
++ 122. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 123. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 124. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 125. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html#x5
++ 126. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 127. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x5
++ 128. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2
++ 129. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 130. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x15
++ 131. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 132. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpdates
++ 133. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpcheck
++ 134. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpnamelist
++ 135. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#srvrename
++ 136. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpvdir
++ 137. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#setftptype
++ 138. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6
++ 139. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x15
++ 140. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.7
++ 141. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.1
++ 142. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2
++ 143. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.14
++ 144. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13
++ 145. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13
++ 146. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckututor.html
++ 147. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 148. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/skermit.html
++ 149. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#setlocus
++ 150. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#lcommands
++ 151. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpuser
++ 152. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#showvar
++ 153. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#callerid
++ 154. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x6.6
++ 155. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x0
++ 156. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 157. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 158. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 159. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 160. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 161. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x0
++ 162. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 163. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 164. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 165. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 166. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95.html
++ 167. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/sshclient.html
++ 168. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/skermit.html
++ 169. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/skermit.html
++ 170. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/sshclien.htm
++ 171. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 172. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc1738.txt
++ 173. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.2
++ 174. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.1
++ 175. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2396.txt
++ 176. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2616.txt
++ 177. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x2.2.3
++ 178. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2616.txt
++ 179. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13.7
++ 180. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm#x5.4
++ 181. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm#x15
++ 182. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm#x6.2
++ 183. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++ 184. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x16
++ 185. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 186. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 187. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 188. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 189. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1
++ 190. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 191. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.3
++ 192. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.4
++ 193. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5
++ 194. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6
++ 195. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 196. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.8
++ 197. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.9
++ 198. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10
++ 199. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 200. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm
++ 201. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.htm#servers
++ 202. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcsets.html
++ 203. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/unicode.html
++ 204. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x1.5.4
++ 205. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/case10.html
++ 206. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 207. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 208. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpscripts.html
++ 209. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 210. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 211. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpclient.html
++ 212. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpscripts.html
++ 213. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 214. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 215. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.1
++ 216. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.3
++ 217. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.4
++ 218. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.3
++ 219. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.3
++ 220. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 221. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5
++ 222. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6
++ 223. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpscripts.html
++ 224. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 225. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpautolog
++ 226. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpuser
++ 227. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.8
++ 228. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.8
++ 229. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 230. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 231. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 232. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 233. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ibm_ie.html
++ 234. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10
++ 235. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 236. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 237. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 238. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 239. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck60manual.html
++ 240. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.17
++ 241. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html
++ 242. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6
++ 243. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 244. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.4
++ 245. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/security.html
++ 246. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 247. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 248. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13.4
++ 249. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#permswitch
++ 250. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpchmod
++ 251. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6.2
++ 252. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 253. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 254. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 255. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 256. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 257. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x7
++ 258. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.8
++ 259. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.8
++ 260. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 261. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10
++ 262. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.10
++ 263. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6
++ 264. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#setftptype
++ 265. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 266. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 267. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 268. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 269. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.9
++ 270. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5.1
++ 271. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#erroraction
++ 272. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.5
++ 273. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x4.7
++ 274. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html#x1.6
++ 275. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13
++ 276. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x1.5.4
++ 277. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm
++ 278. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 279. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 280. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5.2
++ 281. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 282. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#erroraction
++ 283. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5.2
++ 284. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#erroraction
++ 285. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpfilenames
++ 286. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpperms
++ 287. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpunique
++ 288. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpfilenames
++ 289. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#note_utc
++ 290. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#note_date
++ 291. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6
++ 292. http://www.boulder.nist.gov/timefreq/faq/faq.htm#10:
++ 293. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 294. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 295. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 296. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 297. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 298. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 299. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x4.3
++ 300. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit70.html
++ 301. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x5
++ 302. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6.3
++ 303. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpfilenames
++ 304. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x4.1
++ 305. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x4.2.2
++ 306. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x1.5.4
++ 307. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.6.2
++ 308. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 309. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11
++ 310. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#srvrename
++ 311. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x4.1
++ 312. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm
++ 313. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 314. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftpfilenames
++ 315. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.5.3
++ 316. http://www.proftpd.net/
++ 317. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 318. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 319. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 320. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 321. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 322. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcsets.html
++ 323. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/unicode.html
++ 324. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcsets.html
++ 325. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcsets.html
++ 326. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 327. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/utf8.html
++ 328. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcsets.html
++ 329. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 330. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2640.txt
++ 331. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 332. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 333. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 334. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 335. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 336. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 337. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 338. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 339. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 340. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 341. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 342. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 343. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpscripts.html
++ 344. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 345. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 346. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc959.txt
++ 347. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckscripts.html
++ 348. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 349. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 350. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpscript.html
++ 351. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 352. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 353. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11.1
++ 354. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11.2
++ 355. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11.3
++ 356. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11.4
++ 357. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11.5
++ 358. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 359. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/k95.html
++ 360. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.11.5
++ 361. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc959.txt
++ 362. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2389.txt
++ 363. http://www.ietf.org/internet-drafts/draft-ietf-ftpext-mlst-16.txt
++ 364. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ftpclient.html
++ 365. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 366. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ftp
++ 367. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 368. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 369. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 370. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#ucs2
++ 371. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 372. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 373. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 374. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 375. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 376. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 377. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 378. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 379. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckb2.htm
++ 380. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 381. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 382. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 383. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 384. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 385. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 386. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.12
++ 387. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.1
++ 388. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x12
++ 389. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.12
++ 390. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 391. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 392. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 393. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 394. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.14
++ 395. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 396. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 397. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 398. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 399. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9
++ 400. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 401. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 402. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 403. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 404. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.6
++ 405. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 406. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 407. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 408. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 409. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 410. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 411. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 412. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 413. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 414. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 415. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 416. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 417. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#fjoin
++ 418. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#fsplit
++ 419. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.10
++ 420. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 421. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 422. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 423. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 424. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9
++ 425. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9
++ 426. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9
++ 427. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 428. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 429. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 430. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 431. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.8
++ 432. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 433. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 434. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 435. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.2
++ 436. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3
++ 437. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13
++ 438. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.13
++ 439. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9
++ 440. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.10
++ 441. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.7.4
++ 442. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 443. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 444. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 445. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 446. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 447. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 448. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 449. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 450. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 451. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 452. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 453. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 454. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.7
++ 455. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 456. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 457. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 458. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 459. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#scriptedit
++ 460. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 461. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 462. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 463. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 464. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 465. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 466. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 467. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 468. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2822.txt
++ 469. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2822.txt
++ 470. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2822.txt
++ 471. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2822.txt
++ 472. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 473. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 474. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 475. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 476. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.1
++ 477. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 478. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 479. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 480. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 481. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.2
++ 482. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 483. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 484. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 485. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 486. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 487. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 488. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x8.2
++ 489. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 490. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 491. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 492. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 493. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 494. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 495. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 496. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 497. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 498. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 499. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 500. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 501. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 502. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 503. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 504. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.6
++ 505. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 506. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 507. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 508. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 509. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 510. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.8
++ 511. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 512. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 513. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 514. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 515. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 516. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 517. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 518. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 519. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 520. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 521. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 522. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 523. mailto:thucdat@hotmail.com
++ 524. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.9.2
++ 525. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 526. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 527. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 528. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 529. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 530. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 531. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 532. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 533. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 534. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 535. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 536. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 537. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x9.2
++ 538. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 539. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 540. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 541. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 542. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 543. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 544. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 545. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 546. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 547. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 548. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 549. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 550. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 551. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 552. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 553. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 554. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 555. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 556. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x4
++ 557. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 558. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.7
++ 559. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 560. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 561. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 562. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 563. ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/rfc2217.txt
++ 564. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 565. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 566. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/sredird/
++ 567. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 568. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 569. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermi70.htm#x4.22
++ 570. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 571. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 572. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 573. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 574. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#x3.1.3
++ 575. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/cuiksd.html
++ 576. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 577. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 578. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 579. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 580. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#top
++ 581. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit80.html#contents
++ 582. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 583. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 584. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckcplm.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,3076 @@
++
++ C-Kermit Program Logic Manual
++
++ Frank da Cruz
++ [1]The Kermit Project
++ [2]Columbia University
++
++ As of: C-Kermit 8.0.211, 10 April 2004
++ This page last updated: Sat Apr 10 16:45:30 2004 (New York USA Time)
++
++ IF YOU ARE READING A PLAIN-TEXT version of this document, note that
++ this file is a plain-text dump of a Web page. You can visit the
++ original (and possibly more up-to-date) Web page here:
++
++ [3]http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html
++
++ [ [4]C-Kermit Home ] [ [5]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ CONTENTS
++
++ 1. [6]INTRODUCTION
++ 2. [7]FILES
++ 3. [8]SOURCE CODE PORTABILITY AND STYLE
++ 4. [9]MODULES
++ 4.A. [10]Group A: Library Routines
++ 4.B. [11]Group B: Kermit File Transfer
++ 4.C. [12]Group C: Character-Set Conversion
++ 4.D. [13]Group D: User Interface
++ 4.E. [14]Group E: Platform-Dependent I/O
++ 4.F. [15]Group F: Network Support
++ 4.G. [16]Group G: Formatted Screen Support
++ 4.H. [17]Group H: Pseudoterminal Support
++ 4.I. [18]Group I: Security
++ I. [19]APPENDIX I: FILE PERMISSIONS
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 1. INTRODUCTION
++
++ The Kermit Protocol is specified in the book Kermit, A File Transfer
++ Protocol by Frank da Cruz, Digital Press / Butterworth Heinemann,
++ Newton, MA, USA (1987), 379 pages, ISBN 0-932376-88-6. It is assumed
++ the reader is familiar with the Kermit protocol specification.
++
++ This file describes the relationship among the modules and functions
++ of C-Kermit 5A and later, and other programming considerations.
++ C-Kermit is designed to be portable to any kind of computer that has a
++ C compiler. The source code is broken into many files that are grouped
++ according to their function, as shown in the [20]Contents.
++
++ C-Kermit has seen constant development since 1985. Throughout its
++ history, there has been a neverending tug-of-war among:
++
++ a. Functionality: adding new features, fixing bugs, improving
++ performance.
++ b. Adding support for new platforms.
++ c. "Buzzword 1.0 compliance".
++
++ The latter category is the most frustrating, since it generally
++ involves massive changes just to keep the software doing what it did
++ before in some new setting: e.g. the K&R-to-ANSIC conversion (which
++ had to be done, of course, without breaking K&R); Y2K (not a big deal
++ in our case); the many and varied UNIX and other API "standards";
++ IPv6.
++
++ [ [21]Contents ] [ [22]C-Kermit ] [ [23]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 2. FILES
++
++ C-Kermit source files begin with the two letters "ck", for example
++ ckutio.c. Filenames are kept short (6.3) for maximum portability and
++ (obviously I hope) do not contain spaces or more than one period. The
++ third character in the name denotes something about the function group
++ and the expected level of portability:
++
++ a General descriptive material and documentation (text)
++ b BOO file encoders and decoders (obsolete)
++ c All platforms with C compilers (*)
++ d Data General AOS/VS
++ e Reserved for "ckermit" files, like ckermit.ini, ckermit2.txt
++ f (reserved)
++ g (reserved)
++ h (reserved)
++ i Commodore Amiga (Intuition)
++ j (unused)
++ k (unused)
++ l Stratus VOS
++ m Macintosh with Mac OS 1-9
++ n Microsoft Windows NT/2000/XP
++ o OS/2 and/or Microsoft Windows 9x/ME/NT/2000/XP
++ p Plan 9 from Bell Labs
++ q (reserved)
++ r DEC PDP-11 with RSTS/E (never used, open for reassigment)
++ s Atari ST GEMDOS (last supported in version 5A(189))
++ t DEC PDP-11 with RT-11 (never used, open for reassigment)
++ u Unix-based operating systems (*)
++ v VMS and OpenVMS
++ w Wart (Lex-like preprocessor, platform independent)
++ x (reserved)
++ y (reserved)
++ z (reserved)
++ 0-3 (reserved)
++ 4 IBM AS/400
++ 5-8 (reserved)
++ 9 Microware OS-9
++ _ Encryption modules
++
++ (*) In fact there is little distinction between the ckc*.* and cku*.*
++ categories. It would make more sense for all cku*.* modules to be
++ ckc*.* ones, except ckufio.c, ckutio.c, ckucon.c, ckucns.c, and
++ ckupty.c, which truly are specific to Unix. The rest (ckuus*.c,
++ ckucmd.c, etc) are quite portable.
++
++ One hint before proceeding: functions are scattered all over the
++ ckc*.c and cku*.c modules, where function size has begun to take
++ precedence over the desirability of grouping related functions
++ together, the aim being to keep any particular module from growing
++ disproportionately large. The easiest way (in UNIX) to find out in
++ what source file a given function is defined is like this (where the
++ desired function is foo()...):
++
++ grep ^foo\( ck*.c
++
++ This works because the coding convention has been to make function
++ names always start on the left margin with their contents indented,
++ for example:
++
++static char *
++foo(x,y) int x, y; {
++ ...
++}
++
++ Also note the style for bracket placement. This allows
++ bracket-matching text editors (such as EMACS) to help you make sure
++ you know which opening bracket a closing bracket matches, particularly
++ when the opening bracket is above the visible screen, and it also
++ makes it easy to find the end of a function (search for '}' on the
++ left margin).
++
++ Of course EMACS tags work nicely with this format too:
++
++ $ cd kermit-source-directory
++ $ etags ck[cu]*.c
++ $ emacs
++ Esc-X Visit-Tags-Table<CR><CR>
++
++ (but remember that the source file for ckcpro.c is [24]ckcpro.w!)
++
++ Also:
++
++ * Tabs should be set every 8 spaces, as on a VT100.
++ * All lines must no more than 79 characters wide after tab
++ expansion.
++ * Note the distinction between physical tabs (ASCII 9) and the
++ indentation conventions, which are: 4 for block contents, 2 for
++ most other stuff (obviously this is not a portability issue, just
++ style).
++
++ [ [25]Contents ] [ [26]C-Kermit ] [ [27]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3. SOURCE CODE PORTABILITY AND STYLE
++
++ C-Kermit was designed in 1985 as a platform-independent replacement
++ for the earlier Unix Kermit. c-Kermit's design was expected to promote
++ portability, and judging from the number of platforms to which it has
++ been adapted since then, the model is effective, if not ideal
++ (obviously if we had it all to do over, we'd change a few things). To
++ answer the oft-repeated question: "Why are there so many #ifdefs?",
++ it's because:
++
++ * Many of them are related to feature selection and program size,
++ and so need to be there anyway.
++ * Those that treat compiler, library, platform, header-file, and
++ similar differences have built up over time as hundreds of people
++ all over the world adapted C-Kermit to their particular
++ environments and sent back their changes. There might be more
++ politically-correct ways to achieve portability, but this one is
++ natural and proven. The basic idea is to introduce changes that
++ can be selected by defining a symbol, which, if not defined,
++ leaves the program exactly as it was before the changes.
++ * Although it might be possible to "clean up" the "#ifdef mess",
++ nobody has access to all the hundreds of platforms served by the
++ #ifdefs to check the results.
++
++ And to answer the second-most-oft-repeated question: "Why don't you
++ just use GNU autoconfig / automake / autowhatever instead of
++ hard-coding all those #ifdefs?" Answers:
++
++ * The GNU tools are not available on all the platforms where
++ C-Kermit must be built and I wouldn't necessarily trust them if
++ they were.
++ * Each platform is a moving target, so the tools themselves would
++ need to updated before Kermit could be updated.
++ * It would only add another layer of complexity to an already
++ complex process.
++ * Conversion at this point would not be practical unless there was a
++ way to test the results on all the hundreds of platforms where
++ C-Kermit is supposed to build.
++
++ When writing code for the system-indendent C-Kermit modules, please
++ stick to the following coding conventions to ensure portability to the
++ widest possible variety of C preprocessors, compilers, and linkers, as
++ well as certain network and/or email transports. The same holds true
++ for many of the "system dependent" modules too; particularly the Unix
++ ones, since they must be buildable by a wide variety of compilers and
++ linkers, new and old.
++
++ This list does not purport to be comprehensive, and although some
++ items on it might seem far-fetched, they would not be listed unless I
++ had encountered them somewhere, some time. I wish I had kept better
++ records so I could cite specific platforms and compilers.
++
++ * Try to keep variable and function names unique within 6
++ characters, especially if they are used across modules, since 6 is
++ the maximum for some old linkers (actually, this goes back to
++ TOPS-10 and -20 and other old DEC OS's where C-Kermit never ran
++ anyway; a more realistic maximum is probably somewhere between 8
++ and 16). We know for certain that VAX C has a 31-character max
++ because it complains -- others might not complain, but just
++ silently truncate, thus folding two or more routines/variables
++ into one.
++ * Keep preprocessor symbols unique within 8 characters; that's the
++ max for some preprocessors (sorry, I can't give a specific
++ example, but in 1988 or thereabouts, I had to change character-set
++ symbols like TC_LATIN1 and TC_LATIN2 to TC_1LATIN and TC_2LATIN
++ because the digits were being truncated and ignored on a platform
++ where I actually had to build C-Kermit 5A; unfortunately I didn't
++ note which platform -- maybe some early Ultrix version?)
++ * Don't create preprocessor symbols, or variable or function names,
++ that start with underscore (_). These are usually reserved for
++ internal use by the compiler and header files.
++ * Don't put #include directives inside functions or { blocks }.
++ * Don't use the #if or #elif preprocessor constructions, only use
++ #ifdef, #ifndef, #define, #undef, and #endif.
++ * Put tokens after #endif in comment brackets, e.g.
++ #endif /* FOO */.
++ * Don't indent preprocessor statements - # must always be first char
++ on line.
++ * Don't put whitespace after # in preprocessor statements.
++ * Don't use #pragma, even within #ifdefs -- it makes some
++ preprocessors give up.
++ * Same goes for #module, #if, etc - #ifdefs do NOT protect them.
++ * Don't use logical operators in preprocessor constructions.
++ * Avoid #ifdefs inside argument list to function calls (I can't
++ remember why this one is here, but probably needn't be; we do this
++ all the time).
++ * Always cast strlen() in expressions to int:
++ if ((int)strlen(foo) < x)...
++ * Any variable whose value might exceed 16383 should be declared as
++ long, or if that is not possible, then as unsigned.
++ * Avoid typedefs; they might be portable but they are very confusing
++ and there's no way to test for their presence or absence at
++ compile time. Use preprocessor symbols instead if possible; at
++ least you can test their definitions.
++ * Unsigned long is not portable; use a preprocessor symbol (Kermit
++ uses ULONG for this).
++ * Long long is not portable. If you really need it, be creative.
++ * Similarly 1234LL is not portable, nor almost any other constant
++ modifier other than L.
++ * Unsigned char is not portable, use CHAR (a preprocessor symbol
++ defined in the Kermit header files) and always take precautions
++ against character signage (more about this [28]below).
++ * Don't use initializers with automatic arrays or structs: it's not
++ portable.
++ * Don't use big automatic arrays or structs in functions that might
++ be called recursively; some platforms have fixed-size stacks (e.g.
++ Windows 9x: 256K) and recursive functions crash with stack
++ overflow. Even when there is not a compiler limitation, this
++ causes memory to be consumed without bound, and can end up filling
++ swap space.
++ * Don't assume that struct assignment performs a copy, or that it
++ even exists.
++ * Don't use sizeof to get the size of an array; someone might come
++ along later and and change it from static to malloc'd. Always use
++ a symbol to refer to the array's size.
++ * Don't put prototypes for static functions into header files that
++ are used by modules that don't contain that function; the link
++ step can fail with unresolved references (e.g. on AOS/VS).
++ * Avoid the construction *++p (the order of evaluation varies; it
++ shouldn't but at least one compiler had a bug that made me include
++ this item).
++ * Don't use triple assignments, like a = b = c = 0; (or quadruple,
++ etc). Some compilers generate bad code for these, or crash, etc
++ (some version of DEC C as I recall).
++ * Some compilers don't allow structure members to have the same
++ names as other identifiers. Try to give structure members unique
++ names.
++ * Don't assume anything about order of evaluation in boolean
++ expressions, or that they will stop early if a required condition
++ is not true, e.g.:
++ if (i > 0 && p[i-1] == blah)
++ can still dump core if i == 0 (hopefully this is not true of any
++ modern compiler, but I would not have said this if it did not
++ actually happen somewhere).
++ * Don't have a switch() statement with no cases (e.g. because of
++ #ifdefs); this is a fatal error in some compilers.
++ * Don't put lots of code in a switch case; move it out to a separate
++ function; some compilers run out of memory when presented with a
++ huge switch() statement -- it's not the number of cases that
++ matters; it's the overall amount of code.
++ * Some compilers might also limit the number of switch() cases, e.g.
++ to 254.
++ * Don't put anything between "switch() {" and "case:" -- switch
++ blocks are not like other blocks.
++ * Don't jump into or out of switches.
++ * Don't make character-string constants longer than about 250 bytes.
++ Longer strings should be broken up into arrays of strings.
++ * Don't write into character-string constants (obviously). Even when
++ you know you are not writing past the end; the compiler or linker
++ might have put them into read-only and/or shared memory, and/or
++ coalesced multiple equal constants so if you change one you change
++ them all.
++ * Don't depend on '\r' being carriage return.
++ * Don't depend on '\n' being linefeed or for that matter any SINGLE
++ character.
++ * Don't depend on '\r' and '\n' being different (e.g. as separate
++ switch() cases).
++ * In other words, don't use \n or \r to stand for specific
++ characters; use \012 and \015 instead.
++ * Don't code for "buzzword 1.0 compliance", unless "buzzword" is K&R
++ and "1.0" is the first edition.
++ * Don't use or depend on anything_t (size_t, pid_t, etc), except
++ time_t, without #ifdef protection (time_t is the only one I've
++ found that is accepted everywhere). This is a tough one because
++ the same function might require (say) a size_t arg on one
++ platform, whereas size_t is unheard of on another; or worse, it
++ might require a totally different data type, like int or long or
++ some other typedef'd thing. It has often proved necessary to
++ define a symbol to stand for the type of a particular argument to
++ a particular library or system function to get around this
++ problem.
++ * Don't use or depend on internationalization ("i18n") features,
++ wchar_t, locales, etc, in portable code; they are not portable.
++ Anyway, locales are not the right model for Kermit's
++ multi-character-set support. Kermit does all character-set
++ conversion itself and does not use any external libraries or
++ functions.
++ * In particular, don't use any library functions that deal with wide
++ characters or Unicode in any form. These are not only nonportable,
++ but a constantly shifting target (e.g. the ones in glibc).
++ * Don't make any assumption about signal handler type. It can be
++ void, int, long, or anything else. Always declare signal handlers
++ as SIGTYP (see definition in ckcdeb.h and augment it if necessary)
++ and always use SIGRETURN at exit points from signal handlers.
++ * Signals should always be re-armed to be used again (this barely
++ scratches the surface -- the differences between BSD/V7 and System
++ V and POSIX signal handling are numerous, and some platforms do
++ not even support signals, alarms, or longjmps correctly or at all
++ -- avoid all of this if you can).
++ * On the other hand, don't assume that signals are disarmed after
++ being raised. In some platforms you have to re-arm them, in others
++ they stay armed.
++ * Don't call malloc() and friends from a signal handler; don't do
++ anything but setting integer global variables in a signal handler.
++ * malloc() does not initialize allocated memory -- it never said it
++ did. Don't expect it to be all 0's.
++ * Did You Know: malloc() can succeed and the program can still dump
++ core later when it attempts to use the malloc'd memory? (This
++ happens when allocation is deferred until use and swap space is
++ full.)
++ * memset(), memmove(), and memcpy() are not portable, don't use them
++ without protecting them in ifdefs (we have USE_MEMCPY for this).
++ bzero()/bcopy() too, except we're guaranteed to have
++ bzero()/bcopy() when using the sockets library (not really). See
++ examples in the source.
++ * Don't assume that strncpy() stops on the first null byte -- most
++ versions always copy the number of bytes given in arg 3, padding
++ out with 0's and overwriting whatever was there before. Use
++ C-Kermit ckstrncpy() if you want predictable non-padding behavior,
++ guaranteed NUL-termination, and a useful return code.
++ * DID YOU KNOW.. that some versions of inet_blah() routines return
++ IP addresses in network byte order, while others return them local
++ machine byte order? So passing them to ntohs() or whatever is not
++ always the right thing to do.
++ * Don't use ANSI-format function declarations without #ifdef
++ CK_ANSIC, and always provide an #else for the non-ANSI case.
++ * Use the Kermit _PROTOTYP() macro for declaring function
++ prototypes; it works in both the ANSI and non-ANSI cases.
++ * Don't depend on any other ANSI preprocessor features like
++ "pasting" -- they are often missing or nonoperational.
++ * Don't assume any C++ syntax or semantics.
++ * Don't use // as a comment introducer. C is not C++.
++ * Don't declare a string as "char foo[]" in one module and "extern
++ char * foo" in another, or vice-versa: this causes core dumps.
++ * With compiler makers falling all over themselves trying to outdo
++ each other in ANSI strictness, it has become increasingly
++ necessary to cast EVERYTHING. This is increasingly true for char
++ vs unsigned char. We need to use unsigned chars if we want to deal
++ with 8-bit character sets, but most character- and string-oriented
++ APIs want (signed) char arguments, so explicit casts are
++ necessary. It would be nice if every compiler had a
++ -funsigned-char option (as gcc does), but they don't.
++ * a[x], where x is an unsigned char, can produce a wild memory
++ reference if x, when promoted to an int, becomes negative. Cast it
++ to (unsigned), even though it ALREADY IS unsigned.
++ * Be careful how you declare functions that have char or long
++ arguments; for ANSI compilers you MUST use ANSI declarations to
++ avoid promotion problems, but you can't use ANSI declarations with
++ non-ANSI compilers. Thus declarations of such functions must be
++ hideously entwined in #ifdefs. Example: latter:
++ int /* Put character in server command buffer */
++ #ifdef CK_ANSIC
++ putsrv(char c)
++ #else
++ putsrv(c) char c;
++ #endif /* CK_ANSIC */
++ /* putsrv */ {
++ *srvptr++ = c;
++ *srvptr = '\0'; /* Make sure buffer is null-terminated */
++ return(0);
++ }
++ * Be careful how you return characters from functions that return
++ int values -- "getc-like functions" -- in the ANSI world. Unless
++ you explicitly cast the return value to (unsigned), it is likely
++ to be "promoted" to an int and have its sign extended.
++ * At least one compiler (the one on DEC OSF/1 1.3) treats "/*" and
++ "*/" within string constants as comment begin and end. No amount
++ of #ifdefs will get around this one. You simply can't put these
++ sequences in a string constant, e.g. "/usr/local/doc/*.*".
++ * Avoid putting multiple macro references on a single line, e.g.:
++ putchar(BS); putchar(SP); putchar(BS)
++
++ This overflows the CPP output buffer of more than a few C
++ preprocessors (this happened, for example, with SunOS 4.1 cc, which
++ evidently has a 1K macro expansion buffer).
++
++ C-Kermit needs constant adjustment to new OS and compiler releases.
++ Every new OS release shuffles header files or their contents, or
++ prototypes, or data types, or levels of ANSI strictness, etc. Every
++ time you make an adjustment to remove a new compilation error, BE VERY
++ CAREFUL to #ifdef it on a symbol unique to the new configuration so
++ that the previous configuration (and all other configurations on all
++ other platforms) remain as before.
++
++ Assume nothing. Don't assume header files are where they are supposed
++ to be, that they contain what you think they contain, that they define
++ specific symbols to have certain values -- or define them at all!
++ Don't assume system header files protect themselves against multiple
++ inclusion. Don't assume that particular system or library calls are
++ available, or that the arguments are what you think they are -- order,
++ data type, passed by reference vs value, etc. Be conservative when
++ attempting to write portable code. Avoid all advanced features.
++
++ If you see something that does not make sense, don't assume it's a
++ mistake -- it might be there for a reason, and changing it or removing
++ is likely to cause compilation, linking, or runtime failures sometime,
++ somewhere. Some huge percentage of the code, especially in the
++ platform-dependent modules, is workarounds for compiler, linker, or
++ API bugs.
++
++ But finally... feel free to violate any or all of these rules in
++ platform-specific modules for environments in which the rules are
++ certain not to apply. For example, in VMS-specific code, it is OK to
++ use #if, because VAX C, DEC C, and VMS GCC all support it.
++
++ [ [29]Contents ] [ [30]C-Kermit ] [ [31]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.1. Memory Leaks
++
++ The C language and standard C library are notoriously inadequate and
++ unsafe. Strings are arrays of characters, usually referenced through
++ pointers. There is no native string datatype. Buffers are fixed size,
++ and C provides no runtime bounds checking, thus allowing overwriting
++ of other data or even program code. With the popularization of the
++ Internet, the "buffer exploit" has become a preferred method for
++ hackers to hijack privileged programs; long data strings are fed to a
++ program in hopes that it uses unsafe C library calls such as strcpy()
++ or sprintf() to copy strings into automatic arrays, thus overwriting
++ the call stack, and therefore the routine's return address. When such
++ a hole is discovered, a "string" can be constructed that contains
++ machine code to hijack the program's privileges and penetrate the
++ system.
++
++ This problem is partially addressed by the strn...() routines, which
++ should always be used in preference to their str...() equivalents
++ (except when the copy operation has already been prechecked, or there
++ is a good reason for not using them, e.g. the sometimes undesirable
++ side effect of strncpy() zeroing the remainder of the buffer). The
++ most gaping whole, however, is sprintf(), which performs no length
++ checking on its destination buffer, and is not easy to replace.
++ Although snprintf() routines are starting to appear, they are not yet
++ widespread, and certainly not universal, nor are they especially
++ portable, or even full-featured.
++
++ For these reasons, we have started to build up our own little library
++ of C Library replacements, ckclib.[ch]. These are safe and highly
++ portable primitives for memory management and string manipulation,
++ such as:
++
++ ckstrncpy()
++ Like strncpy but returns a useful value, doesn't zero buffer.
++
++ ckitoa()
++ Opposite of atoi()
++
++ ckltoa()
++ Opposite of atol()
++
++ ckctoa()
++ Returns character as string
++
++ ckmakmsg()
++ Used with ck?to?() as a safe sprintf() replacement for up to 4
++ items
++
++ ckmakxmsg()
++ Like ckmakmsg() but accepts up to 12 items
++
++ More about library functions in [32]Section 4.A.
++
++ [ [33]Contents ] [ [34]C-Kermit ] [ [35]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 3.2. The "char" vs "unsigned char" Dilemma
++
++ This is one of the most aggravating and vexing characteristics of the
++ C language. By design, chars (and char *'s) are SIGNED. But in the
++ modern era, however, we need to process characters that can have (or
++ include) 8-bit values, as in the ISO Latin-1, IBM CP 850, or UTF-8
++ character sets, so this data must be treated as unsigned. But some C
++ compilers (such as those based on the Bell UNIX V7 compiler) do not
++ support "unsigned char" as a data type. Therefore we have the macro or
++ typedef CHAR, which we use when we need chars to be unsigned, but
++ which, unfortunately, resolves itself to "char" on those compilers
++ that don't support "unsigned char". AND SO... We have to do a lot of
++ fiddling at runtime to avoid sign extension and so forth.
++
++ Some modern compilers (e.g. IBM, DEC, Microsoft) have options that say
++ "make all chars be unsigned" (e.g. GCC "-funsigned-char") and we use
++ them when they are available. Other compilers don't have this option,
++ and at the same time, are becoming increasingly strict about type
++ mismatches, and spew out torrents of warnings when we use a CHAR where
++ a char is expected, or vice versa. We fix these one by one using
++ casts, and the code becomes increasingly ugly. But there remains a
++ serious problem, namely that certain library and kernel functions have
++ arguments that are declared as signed chars (or pointers to them),
++ whereas our character data is unsigned. Fine, we can can use casts
++ here too -- but who knows what happens inside these routines.
++
++ [ [36]Contents ] [ [37]C-Kermit ] [ [38]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4. MODULES
++
++ When C-Kermit is on the far end of a connection, it is said to be in
++ remote mode. When C-Kermit has made a connection to another computer,
++ it is in local mode. (If C-Kermit is "in the middle" of a multihop
++ connection, it is still in local mode.)
++
++ On another axis, C-Kermit can be in any of several major states:
++
++ Command State
++ Reading and writing from the job's controlling terminal or
++ "console". In this mode, all i/o is handled by the Group E
++ conxxx() (console i/o) routines.
++
++ Protocol State
++ Reading and writing from the communicatons device. In this
++ mode, all i/o is handled by the Group E ttxxx() (terminal i/o)
++ routines.
++
++ Terminal State
++ Reading from the keyboard with conxxx() routines and writing to
++ the communications device with ttxxx() routines AND vice-versa.
++
++ When in local mode, the console and communications device are
++ distinct. During file transfer, Kermit may put up a file-transfer
++ display on the console and sample the console for interruption
++ signals.
++
++ When in remote mode, the console and communications device are the
++ same, and therefore there can be no file-transfer display on the
++ console or interruptions from it (except for "in-band" interruptions
++ such as ^C^C^C).
++
++ [ [39]Contents ] [ [40]C-Kermit ] [ [41]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.A. Group A: Library Functions
++
++ Library functions, strictly portable, can be used by all modules on
++ all platforms: [42]ckclib.h, [43]ckclib.c.
++
++ (To be filled in... For now, see [44]Section 3.1 and the comments in
++ ckclib.c.)
++
++ [ [45]Contents ] [ [46]C-Kermit ] [ [47]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.B. Group B: Kermit File Transfer
++
++ The Kermit protocol kernel. These files, whose names start with "ckc
++ are supposed to be totally portable C, and are expected to compile
++ correctly on any platform with any C compiler. "Portable" does not
++ mean the same as as "ANSI" -- these modules must compile on 10- and
++ 20-year old computers, with C preprocessors, compilers, and/or linkers
++ that have all sorts of restrictions. The Group B modules do not
++ include any header files other than those that come with Kermit
++ itself. They do not contain any library calls except from the standard
++ C library (e.g. printf()). They most certainly do not contain any
++ system calls. Files:
++
++ [48]ckcsym.h
++ For use by C compilers that don't allow -D on the command line.
++
++ [49]ckcasc.h
++ ASCII character symbol definitions.
++
++ [50]ckcsig.h
++ System-independent signal-handling definitions and prototypes.
++
++ [51]ckcdeb.h
++ Originally, debugging definitions. Now this file also contains
++ all definitions and prototypes that are shared by all modules
++ in all groups.
++
++ [52]ckcker.h
++ Kermit protocol symbol definitions.
++
++ [53]ckcxla.h
++ Character-set-related symbol definitions (see next section).
++
++ [54]ckcmai.c
++ The main program. This module contains the declarations of all
++ the protocol-related global variables that are shared among the
++ other modules.
++
++ [55]ckcpro.w
++ The protocol module itself, written in "wart", a lex-like
++ preprocessor that is distributed with Kermit under the name
++ CKWART.C.
++
++ [56]ckcfns.c, [57]ckcfn2.c, [58]ckcfn3.c
++ The protocol support functions used by the protocol module.
++
++ [59]Group B modules may call upon functions from [60]Group E, but not
++ from [61]Group D modules (with the single exception that the main
++ program invokes the user interface, which is in Group D). (This last
++ assertion is really only a conjecture.)
++
++ [ [62]Contents ] [ [63]C-Kermit ] [ [64]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.C. Group C: Character-Set Conversion
++
++ Character set translation tables and functions. Used by the [65]Group
++ B, protocol modules, but may be specific to different computers. (So
++ far, all character character sets supported by C-Kermit are supported
++ in [66]ckuxla.c and [67]ckuxla.h, including Macintosh and IBM
++ character sets). These modules should be completely portable, and not
++ rely on any kind of system or library services.
++
++ [68]ckcxla.h
++ Character-set definitions usable by all versions of C-Kermit.
++
++ ck?xla.h
++ Character-set definitions for computer "?", e.g. [69]ckuxla.h
++ for UNIX, [70]ckmxla.h for Macintosh.
++
++ [71]ck?xla
++ Character-set translation tables and functions for computer
++ "?", For example, CKUXLA.C for UNIX, CKMXLA.C for Macintosh. So
++ far, these are the only two such modules. The UNIX module is
++ used for all versions of C-Kermit except the Macintosh version.
++
++ [72]ckcuni.h
++ Unicode definitions
++
++ [73]ckcuni.c
++ Unicode module
++
++ Here's how to add a new file character set in the original
++ (non-Unicode modules). Assuming it is based on the Roman (Latin)
++ alphabet. Let's call it "Barbarian". First, in ck?xla.h, add a
++ definition for FC_BARBA (8 chars maximum length) and increase
++ MAXFCSETS by 1. Then, in ck?xla.c:
++
++ * Add a barbarian entry into the fcsinfo array.
++ * Add a "barbarian" entry to file character set keyword table,
++ fcstab.
++ * Add a "barbarian" entry to terminal character set keyword table,
++ ttcstab.
++ * Add a translation table from Latin-1 to barbarian: yl1ba[].
++ * Add a translation table from barbarian to Latin-1: ybal1[].
++ * Add a translation function from Barbarian to ASCII: xbaas().
++ * Add a translation function from Barbarian to Latin-1: xbal1().
++ * Add a translation function from Latin-1 to Barbarian: xl1ba().
++ * etc etc for each transfer character set...
++ * Add translation function pointers to the xls and xlr tables.
++
++ Other translations involving Barbarian (e.g. from Barbarian to
++ Latin-Cyrillic) are performed through these tables and functions. See
++ ckuxla.h and ckuxla.c for extensive examples.
++
++ To add a new Transfer Character Set, e.g. Latin Alphabet 9 (for the
++ Euro symbol), again in the "old" character-set modules:
++
++ In ckcxla.h:
++
++ + Add a TC_xxxx definition and increase MAXTCSETS accordingly.
++
++ In ck?xla.h (since any transfer charset is also a file charset):
++
++ + Add an FC_xxxx definition and increase MAXFCSETS accordingly.
++
++ In ck?xla.c:
++
++ + Add a tcsinfo[] entry.
++ + Make a tcstab[] keyword table entry.
++ + Make an fcsinfo[] table entry.
++ + Make an fcstab[] keyword table entry.
++ + Make a tcstab[] keyword table entry.
++ + If necessary, make a langinfo[] table entry.
++ + Make entries in the function pointer arrays.
++ + Provide any needed functions.
++
++ As of C-Kermit 7.0, character sets are also handled in parallel by the
++ new (and very large) Unicode module, ckcuni.[ch]. Eventually we should
++ phase out the old way, described just above, and operate entirely in
++ (and through) Unicode. The advantages are many. The disadvantages are
++ size and performance. To add a character to the Unicode modules:
++
++ In ckcuni.h:
++
++ + (To be filled in...)
++
++ In ckcuni.c:
++
++ + (To be filled in...)
++
++ [ [74]Contents ] [ [75]C-Kermit ] [ [76]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.D. Group D: User Interface
++
++ This is the code that communicates with the user, gets her commands,
++ informs her of the results. It may be command-line oriented,
++ interactive prompting dialog, menus and arrow keys, windows and mice,
++ speech recognition, telepathy, etc. The one provided is command-and
++ prompt, with the ability to read commands from various sources: the
++ console keyboard, a file, or a macro definition. The user interface
++ has three major functions:
++
++ 1. Sets the parameters for the file transfer and then starts it. This
++ is done by setting certain (many) global variables, such as the
++ protocol machine start state, the file specification, file type,
++ communication parameters, packet length, window size, character
++ set, etc.
++ 2. Displays messages on the user's screen during the file transfer,
++ using the screen() function, which is called by the group-1
++ modules.
++ 3. Executes any commands directly that do not require Kermit
++ protocol, such as the CONNECT command, local file management
++ commands, parameter-setting commands, FTP client commands, etc.
++
++ If you plan to imbed the [77]Group B, files into a program with a
++ different user interface, your interface must supply an appropriate
++ screen() function, plus a couple related ones like chkint() and
++ intmsg() for handling keyboard (or mouse, etc) interruptions during
++ file transfer. The best way to find out about this is to link all the
++ C-Kermit modules together except the ckuu*.o and ckucon.o modules, and
++ see which missing symbols turn up.
++
++ C-Kermit's character-oriented user interface (as opposed to the
++ Macintosh version's graphical user interface) consists of the
++ following modules. C-Kermit can be built with an interactive command
++ parser, a command-line-option-only parser, a graphical user interface,
++ or any combination, and it can even be built with no user interface at
++ all (in which case it runs as a remote-mode Kermit server).
++
++ [78]ckucmd.h
++ [79]ckucmd.c
++ The command parsing primitives used by the interactive command
++ parser to parse keywords, numbers, filenames, etc, and to give
++ help, complete fields, supply defaults, allow abbreviations and
++ editing, etc. This package is totally independent of Kermit,
++ but does depend on the [80]Group E functions.
++
++ [81]ckuusr.h
++ Definitions of symbols used in Kermit's commands.
++
++ ckuus*.c
++ Kermit's interactive command parser, including the script
++ programming language: [82]ckuusr.c (includes top-level keyword
++ tables); [83]ckuus2.c (HELP command text); [84]ckuus3.c (most
++ of the SET command); [85]ckuus4.c (includes variables and
++ functions); ckuus[567].c (miscellaneous);
++
++ [86]ckuusy.c
++ The command-line-option parser.
++
++ [87]ckuusx.c
++ User interface functions common to both the interactive and
++ command-line parsers.
++
++ [88]ckuver.h
++ Version heralds for different implementations.
++
++ [89]ckuscr.c
++ The (old, uucp-like) SCRIPT command
++
++ [90]ckudia.c
++ The DIAL command. Includes specific knowledge of many types of
++ modems.
++
++ Note that none of the above files is actually Unix-specific. Over time
++ they have proven to be portable among all platforms where C-Kermit is
++ built: Unix, VMS, AOS/VS, Amiga, OS-9, VOS, etc etc. Thus the third
++ letter should more properly be "c", but changing it would be too
++ confusing.
++
++ ck?con.c, ckucns.c
++ The CONNECT command. Terminal connection, and in some cases
++ (Macintosh, Windows) also terminal emulation. NOTE: As of
++ C-Kermit 7.0, there are two different CONNECT modules for UNIX:
++ [91]ckucon.c -- the traditional, portable, fork()-based version
++ -- and [92]ckucns.c, a new version that uses select() rather
++ than forks so it can handle encryption. ckucns.c is the
++ preferred version for Unix; ckucon.c is not likely to keep pace
++ with it in terms of upgrades, etc. However, since select() is
++ not portable to every platform, ckucon.c will be kept
++ indefinitely for those platforms that can't use ckucns.c. NOTE:
++ SunLink X.25 support is available only in ckucon.c.
++
++ ck_*.*, ckuat*.*
++ Modules having to do with authentication and encryption. Since
++ the relaxation of USA export laws, they are included with the
++ general source-code distribution. Secure C-Kermit binaries can
++ be built using special targets in the standard makefile.
++ However, secure prebuilt binaries may not be distributed.
++
++ For other implementations, the files may, and probably do, have
++ different names. For example, the Macintosh graphical user interface
++ filenames start with "ckm". Kermit 95 uses the ckucmd and ckuus*
++ modules, but has its own CONNECT command modules. And so on.
++
++ Here is a brief description of C-Kermit's "user interface interface",
++ from ckuusr.c. It is nowhere near complete; in particular, hundreds of
++ global variables are shared among the many modules. These should, some
++ day, be collected into classes or structures that can be passed around
++ as needed; not only for purity's sake, but also to allow for multiple
++ simultaneous communication sessions and or user interfaces. Our list
++ of things to do is endless, and reorganizing the source is almost
++ always at the bottom.
++
++ The ckuus*.c modules (like many of the ckc*.c modules) depend on the
++ existence of C library features like fopen, fgets, feof, (f)printf,
++ argv/argc, etc. Other functions that are likely to vary among
++ operating systems -- like setting terminal modes or interrupts -- are
++ invoked via calls to functions that are defined in the [93]Group E
++ platform-dependent modules, ck?[ft]io.c. The command line parser
++ processes any arguments found on the command line, as passed to main()
++ via argv/argc. The interactive parser uses the facilities of the cmd
++ package (developed for this program, but, in theory, usable by any
++ program). Any command parser may be substituted for this one. The only
++ requirements for the Kermit command parser are these:
++
++ 1. Set parameters via global variables like duplex, speed, ttname,
++ etc. See [94]ckcmai.c for the declarations and descriptions of
++ these variables.
++ 2. If a command can be executed without the use of Kermit protocol,
++ then execute the command directly and set the sstate (start state)
++ variable to 0. Examples include SET commands, local directory
++ listings, the CONNECT command.
++ 3. If a command requires the Kermit protocol, set the following
++ variables:
++ sstate string data
++ 'x' (enter server mode) (none)
++ 'r' (send a 'get' command) cmarg, cmarg2
++ 'v' (enter receive mode) cmarg2
++ 'g' (send a generic command) cmarg
++ 's' (send files) nfils, cmarg & cmarg2 OR cmlist
++ 'c' (send a remote host command) cmarg
++
++ cmlist is an array of pointers to strings.
++ cmarg, cmarg2 are pointers to strings.
++ nfils is an integer (hmmm, probably should be an unsigned long).
++
++ cmarg can be:
++ A filename string (possibly wild), or:
++ a pointer to a prefabricated generic command string, or:
++ a pointer to a host command string.
++
++ cmarg2 is:
++ The name to send a single file under, or:
++ the name under which to store an incoming file; must not
++ be wild.
++ If it's the name for receiving, a null value means to
++ store the file under the name it arrives with.
++
++ cmlist is:
++ A list of nonwild filenames, such as passed via argv.
++
++ nfils is an integer, interpreted as follows:
++ -1: filespec (possibly wild) in cmarg, must be expanded
++ internally.
++ 0: send from stdin (standard input).
++ >0: number of files to send, from cmlist.
++
++ The screen() function is used to update the screen during file
++ transfer. The tlog() function writes to a transaction log (if TLOG is
++ defined). The debug() function writes to a debugging log (if DEBUG is
++ defined). The intmsg() and chkint() functions provide the user i/o for
++ interrupting file transfers.
++
++ [ [95]Contents ] [ [96]C-Kermit ] [ [97]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.E. Group E: Platform-Dependent I/O
++
++ Platform-dependent function definitions. All the Kermit modules,
++ including the command package, call upon these functions, which are
++ designed to provide system-independent primitives for controlling and
++ manipulating devices and files. For Unix, these functions are defined
++ in the files [98]ckufio.c (files), [99]ckutio.c (communications), and
++ [100]ckusig.c (signal handling).
++
++ For VMS, the files are [101]ckvfio.c, ckvtio.c, and [102]ckusig.c (VMS
++ can use the same signal handling routines as Unix). It doesn't really
++ matter what the files are called, except for Kermit distribution
++ purposes (grouping related files together alphabetically), only that
++ each function is provided with the name indicated, observes the same
++ calling and return conventions, and has the same type.
++
++ The Group E modules contain both functions and global variables that
++ are accessed by modules in the other groups. These are now described.
++
++ (By the way, I got this list by linking all the C-Kermit modules
++ together except ckutio and ckufio. These are the symbols that ld
++ reported as undefined. But that was a long time ago, probably circa
++ Version 6.)
++
++ 4.E.1. Global Variables
++
++ char *DELCMD;
++ Pointer to string containing command for deleting files.
++ Example: char *DELCMD = "rm -f "; (UNIX)
++ Example: char *DELCMD = "delete "; (VMS)
++ Note trailing space. Filename is concatenated to end of this
++ string. NOTE: DELCMD is used only in versions that do not
++ provide their own built-in DELETE command.
++
++ char *DIRCMD;
++ Pointer to string containing command for listing files when a
++ filespec is given.
++ Example: char *DIRCMD = "/bin/ls -l "; (UNIX)
++ Example: char *DIRCMD = "directory "; (VMS)
++ Note trailing space. Filename is concatenated to end of this
++ string. NOTE: DIRCMD is used only in versions that do not
++ provide their own built-in DIRECTORY command.
++
++ char *DIRCM2;
++ Pointer to string containing command for listing files when a
++ filespec is not given. (currently not used, handled in another
++ way.)
++ Example: char *DIRCMD2 = "/bin/ls -ld *";
++ NOTE: DIRCMD2 is used only in versions that do not provide
++ their own built-in DIRECTORY command.
++
++ char *PWDCMD;
++ Pointer to string containing command to display current
++ directory.
++ Example: char *PWDCMD = "pwd ";
++ NOTE: PWDCMD is used only in versions that do not provide their
++ own built-in PWD command.
++
++ char *SPACMD;
++ Pointer to command to display free disk space in current
++ device/directory.
++ Example: char *SPACMD = "df .";
++ NOTE: SPACMD is used only in versions that do not provide their
++ own built-in SPACE command.
++
++ char *SPACM2;
++ Pointer to command to display free disk space in another
++ device/directory.
++ Example: char *SPACM2 = "df ";
++ Note trailing space. Device or directory name is added to this
++ string. NOTE: SPACMD2 is used only in versions that do not
++ provide their own built-in SPACE command.
++
++ char *TYPCMD;
++ Pointer to command for displaying the contents of a file.
++ Example: char *TYPCMD = "cat ";
++ Note trailing space. Device or directory name is added to this
++ string. NOTE: TYPCMD is used only in versions that do not
++ provide their own built-in TYPE command.
++
++ char *WHOCMD;
++ Pointer to command for displaying logged-in users.
++ Example: char *WHOCMD = "who ";
++ Note trailing space. Specific user name may be added to this
++ string.
++
++ int backgrd = 0;
++ Flag for whether program is running in foreground (0) or
++ background (nonzero). Background operation implies that screen
++ output should not be done and that all errors should be fatal.
++
++ int ckxech;
++ Flag for who is to echo console typein:
++ 1: The program (system is not echoing).
++ 0: The OS, front end, terminal, etc (not this program).
++
++ char *ckxsys;
++ Pointer to string that names the computer and operating system.
++ Example: char *ckxsys = " NeXT Mach 1.0";
++ Tells what computer system ckxv applies to. In UNIX Kermit,
++ this variable is also used to print the program herald, and in
++ the SHOW VERSION command.
++
++ char *ckxv;
++ Pointer to version/edit info of ck?tio.c module.
++ Example: char *ckxv = "UNIX Communications Support, 6.0.169, 6
++ Sep 96";
++ Used by SHOW VERSION command.
++
++ char *ckzsys;
++ Like ckxsys, but briefer.
++ Example: char *ckzsys = " 4.3 BSD";
++ Tells what platform ckzv applies to. Used by the SHOW VERSION
++ command.
++
++ char *ckzv;
++ Pointer to version/edit info of ck?fio.c module.
++ Example: char *ckzv = "UNIX File support, 6.0.113, 6 Sep 96";
++ Used by SHOW VERSION command.
++
++ int dfflow;
++ Default flow control. 0 = none, 1 = Xon/Xoff, ... (see FLO_xxx
++ symbols in ckcdeb.h)
++ Set by Group E module. Used by [103]ckcmai.c to initialize flow
++ control variable.
++
++ int dfloc;
++ Default location. 0 = remote, 1 = local. Set by Group E module.
++ Used by ckcmai.c to initialize local variable. Used in various
++ places in the user interface.
++
++ int dfprty;
++ Default parity. 0 = none, 'e' = even, 'o' = odd, 'm' = mark,
++ 's' = space. Set by Group E module. Used by ckcmai.c to
++ initialize parity variable.
++
++ char *dftty;
++ Default communication device. Set by Group E module. Used in
++ many places. This variable should be initialized the the symbol
++ CTTNAM, which is defined in ckcdeb.h, e.g. as "/dev/tty" for
++ UNIX, "TT:" for VMS, etc. Example: char *dftty = CTTNAM;
++
++ char *mtchs[];
++ Array of string pointers to filenames that matched the most
++ recent wildcard match, i.e. the most recent call to zxpand().
++ Used (at least) by command parsing package for partial filename
++ completion.
++
++ int tilde_expand;
++ Flag for whether to attempt to expand leading tildes in
++ directory names (used in UNIX only, and then only when the
++ symbol DTILDE is defined.
++
++ int ttnproto;
++ The protocol being used to communicate over a network device.
++ Values are defined in ckcnet.h. Example: NP_TELNET is network
++ protocol "telnet".
++
++ int maxnam;
++ The maximum length for a filename, exclusive of any device or
++ directory information, in the format of the host operating
++ system.
++
++ int maxpath;
++ The maximum length for a fully specified filename, including
++ device designator, directory name, network node name, etc, in
++ the format of the host operating system, and including all
++ punctuation.
++
++ int ttyfd;
++ File descriptor of the communication device. -1 if there is no
++ open or usable connection, including when C-Kermit is in remote
++ mode. Since this is not implemented everywhere, references to
++ it are in #ifdef CK_TTYFD..#endif.
++
++ [ [104]Contents ] [ [105]C-Kermit ] [ [106]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.E.2. Functions
++
++ These are divided into three categories: file-related functions (B.1),
++ communication functions (B.2), and miscellaneous functions (B.3).
++
++ 4.E.2.1. File-Related Functions
++
++ In most implementations, these are collected together into a module
++ called ck?fio.c, where ? = "u" ([107]ckutio.c for Unix), "v"
++ ([108]ckvtio.c for VMS), [109]etc. To be totally platform-independent,
++ C-Kermit maintains its own file numbers, and provides the functions
++ described in this section to deal with the files associated with them.
++ The file numbers are referred to symbolically, and are defined as
++ follows in ckcker.h:
++
++ #define ZCTERM 0 /* Console terminal */
++ #define ZSTDIO 1 /* Standard input/output */
++ #define ZIFILE 2 /* Current input file for SEND command */
++ #define ZOFILE 3 /* Current output file for RECEIVE command */
++ #define ZDFILE 4 /* Current debugging log file */
++ #define ZTFILE 5 /* Current transaction log file */
++ #define ZPFILE 6 /* Current packet log file */
++ #define ZSFILE 7 /* Current session log file */
++ #define ZSYSFN 8 /* Input from a system function (pipe) */
++ #define ZRFILE 9 /* Local file for READ command */ (NEW)
++ #define ZWFILE 10 /* Local file for WRITE command */ (NEW)
++ #define ZMFILE 11 /* Auxilliary file for internal use */ (NEW)
++ #define ZNFILS 12 /* How many defined file numbers */
++
++ In the descriptions below, fn refers to a filename, and n refers to
++ one of these file numbers. Functions are of type int unless otherwise
++ noted, and are listed mostly alphabetically.
++
++ int
++ chkfn(n) int n;
++ Checks the file number n. Returns:
++ -1: File number n is out of range
++ 0: n is in range, but file is not open
++ 1: n in range and file is open
++
++ int
++ iswild(filspec) char *filespec;
++ Checks if the file specification is "wild", i.e. contains
++ metacharacters or other notations intended to match multiple
++ filenames. Returns:
++ 0: not wild
++ 1: wild.
++
++ int
++ isdir(string) char *string;
++ Checks if the string is the name of an existing directory. The
++ idea is to check whether the string can be "cd'd" to, so in
++ some cases (e.g. DOS) it might also indicate any file
++ structured device, such as a disk drive (like A:). Other
++ nonzero returns indicate system-dependent information; e.g. in
++ VMS isdir("[.FOO]") returns 1 but isdir("FOO.DIR;1") returns 2
++ to indicate the directory-file name is in a format that needs
++ conversion before it can be combined with a filename. Returns:
++ 0: not a directory (including any kind of error)
++ 1: it is an existing directory
++
++ char *
++ zfcdat(name) char *name;
++ Returns modification (preferably, otherwise creation) date/time
++ of file whose name is given in the argument string. Return
++ value is a pointer to a string of the form yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss,
++ for example 19931231 23:59:59, which represents the local time
++ (no timezone or daylight savings time finagling required).
++ Returns the null string ("") on failure. The text pointed to by
++ the string pointer might be in a static buffer, and so should
++ be copied to a safe place by the caller before any subsequent
++ calls to this function.
++
++ struct zfnfp *
++ zfnqfp(fn, buflen, buf) char * fn; int buflen; char * buf;
++ Given the filename fn, the corresponding fully qualified,
++ absolute filename is placed into the buffer buf, whose length
++ is buflen. On failure returns a NULL pointer. On success
++ returns a pointer to a struct zfnfp containing pointers to the
++ full pathname and to just the filename, and an int giving the
++ length of the full pathname. All references to this function in
++ mainline code must be protected by #ifdef ZFNQFP..#endif,
++ because it is not present in all of the ck*fio.c modules. So if
++ you implement this function in a version that did not have it
++ before, be sure to add #define ZFNQFP in the appropriate spot
++ in ckcdeb.h or in the build-procedure CFLAGS.
++
++ int
++ zcmpfn(s1,s2) char * s2, * s2;
++ Compares two filenames to see if they refer to the same.
++ Internally, the arguments can be converted to fully qualified
++ pathnames, e.g. with zfnqfp(), realpath(), or somesuch. In Unix
++ or other systems where symbolic links exist, the link should be
++ resolved before making the comparison or looking at the inodes.
++ Returns:
++ 0: Files are not identical.
++ 1: Files are identical.
++
++ int
++ zfseek(pos) long pos;
++ Positions the input pointer on the current input file to the
++ given position. The pos argument is 0-based, the offset
++ (distance in bytes) from beginning of the file. Needed for
++ RESEND, PSEND, and other recovery operations. This function is
++ not necessarily possible on all systems, e.g. record-oriented
++ systems. It should only be used on binary files (i.e. files we
++ are sending in binary mode) and stream-oriented file systems.
++ Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: On success.
++
++ int
++ zchdir(dirnam) char *dirnam;
++ Changes current or default directory to the one given in
++ dirnam. Returns:
++ 0: On failure.
++ 1: on success.
++
++ long
++ zchki(fn) char *fn;
++ Check to see if file with name fn is a regular, readable,
++ existing file, suitable for Kermit to send -- not a directory,
++ not a symbolic link, etc. Returns:
++ -3: if file exists but is not accessible (e.g.
++ read-protected);
++ -2: if file exists but is not of a readable type (e.g. a
++ directory);
++ -1: on error (e.g. file does not exist, or fn is garbage);
++ >=0: (length of file) if file exists and is readable.
++ Also see isdir(), zgetfs().
++
++ int
++ zchkpid(pid) unsigned long pid;
++ Returns:
++ 1: If the given process ID (e.g. pid in UNIX) is valid and
++ active
++ 0: otherwise.
++
++ long
++ zgetfs(fn) char *fn;
++ Gets the size of the given file, regardless of accessibility.
++ Used for directory listings. Unlike zchki(), should return the
++ size of any kind of file, even a directory. zgetfs() also
++ should serve as a mini "get file info" function that can be
++ used until we design a better one, by also setting some global
++ variables:
++ int zgfs_link = 1/0 = file is (not) a symbolic link.
++ int zgfs_dir = 1/0 = file is (not) a directory.
++ char linkname[] = if zgfs_link != 0, name of file link points
++ to.
++ Returns:
++ -1: on error (e.g. file does not exist, or fn is garbage);
++ >=0: (length of file) if file exists and is readable.
++
++ int
++ zchko(fn) char *fn;
++ Checks to see if a file of the given name can be created.
++ Returns:
++ -1: if file cannot be created, or on any kind of error.
++ 0: if file can be created.
++
++ int
++ zchkspa(fn,len) char *f; long len;
++ Checks to see if there is sufficient space to store the file
++ named fn, which is len bytes long. If you can't write a
++ function to do this, then just make a dummy that always returns
++ 1; higher level code will recover from disk-full errors. The
++ receiving Kermit uses this function to refuse an incoming file
++ based on its size, via the attribute mechanism. Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: if there is not enough space.
++ 1: if there is enough space.
++
++ int
++ zchin(n,c) int n; int *c;
++ Gets a character from file number n, return it in c (call with
++ &c). Returns:
++ -1: on failure, including EOF.
++ 0: on success with character in c.
++
++ int
++ zchout(n,c) int n; char c;
++ Writes the character c to file number n. Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ zclose(n) int n;
++ Closes file number n. Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 1: on success.
++
++ int
++ zdelet(fn) char *name;
++ Attempts to delete (remove, erase) the named file. Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 1: if file was deleted successfully.
++
++ char *
++ zgperm(char * f)
++ Returns a pointer to the system-dependent numeric
++ permissions/protection string for file f, or NULL upon failure.
++ Used if CK_PERMS is defined.
++
++ char *
++ ziperm(char * f)
++ Returns a pointer to the system-dependent symbolic
++ permissions/protection string for file f, or NULL upon failure.
++ Used if CK_PERMS is defined. Example: In UNIX zgperm(f) might
++ return "100770", but ziperm() might return "-rwxrwx---". In
++ VMS, zgperm() would return a hexadecimal string, but ziperm()
++ would return something like "(RWED,RWED,RE,)".
++
++ char *
++ zgtdir()
++ Returns a pointer to the name of the current directory, folder,
++ etc, or a NULL pointer if the current directory cannot be
++ determined. If possible, the directory specification should be
++ (a) fully specified, e.g. as a complete pathname, and (b) be
++ suitable for appending a filename. Thus, for example, Unix
++ directory names should end with '/'. VMS directory names should
++ look like DEV:[NAME] (rather than, say, NAME.DIR;1).
++
++ char *
++ zhome()
++ Returns a pointer to a string containing the user's home
++ directory, or NULL upon error. Should be formatted like
++ zgtdir() (q.v.).
++
++ int
++ zinfill()
++ Fill buffer from input file. This function is used by the macro
++ zminchar(), which is defined in ckcker.h. zminchar() manages
++ its own buffer, and calls zinfill() to fill it whenever it
++ becomes empty. It is used only for sending files, and reads
++ characters only from file number ZIFILE. zinfill() returns -1
++ upon end of file, -2 upon fatal error, and -3 upon timeout
++ (e.g. when reading from a pipe); otherwise it returns the first
++ character from the buffer it just read.
++
++ int
++ zkself()
++ Kills the current job, session, process, etc, logs out,
++ disappears. Used by the Kermit server when it receives a BYE
++ command. On failure, returns -1. On success, does not return at
++ all! This function should not be called until all other steps
++ have been taken to close files, etc.
++
++ VOID
++ zstrip(fn,&fn2) char *fn1, **fn2;
++ Strips device and directory, etc, from file specification fn,
++ leaving only the filename (including "extension" or "filetype"
++ -- the part after the dot). For example DUA0:[PROGRAMS]OOFA.C;3
++ becomes OOFA.C, or /usr/fdc/oofa.c becomes oofa.c. Returns a
++ pointer to result in fn2.
++
++ int
++ zsetperm(char * file, unsigned int code)
++ Set permissions of file to given system-dependent code. 0: On
++ failure.
++ 1: on success.
++
++ int
++ zsetroot(char * dir)
++ Sets the root for the user's file access, like Unix chroot(),
++ but does not require privilege. In Unix, this must be
++ implemented entirely by Kermit's own file access routines.
++ Returns:
++ 1: Success
++ -1: Invalid argument
++ -2:
++ -3: Internal error
++ -4: Access to given directory denied
++ -5: New root not within old root
++
++ int
++ zinroot(char * file)
++ If no root is set (zsetroot()), returns 1.
++ Otherwise, if given file is in the root, returns 1.
++ Otherwise, returns 0.
++
++ VOID
++ zltor(fn,fn2) char *fn1, *fn2;
++ Local-To-Remote filename translation. OBSOLETE: replaced by
++ nzltor() (q.v.). Translates the local filename fn into a format
++ suitable for transmission to an arbitrary type of computer, and
++ copies the result into the buffer pointed to by fn2.
++ Translation may involve (a) stripping the device and/or
++ directory/path name, (b) converting lowercase to uppercase, (c)
++ removing spaces and strange characters, or converting them to
++ some innocuous alphabetic character like X, (d) discarding or
++ converting extra periods (there should not be more than one).
++ Does its best. Returns no value. name2 is a pointer to a
++ buffer, furnished by the caller, into which zltor() writes the
++ resulting name. No length checking is done.
++
++ #ifdef NZLTOR
++ VOID
++ nzltor(fn,fn2,convert,pathnames,max) char *fn1,*fn2; int
++ convert,pathnames,max;
++ Replaces zltor(). This new version handles pathnames and checks
++ length. fn1 and fn2 are as in zltor(). This version is called
++ unconditionally for each file, rather than only when filename
++ conversion is enabled. Pathnames can have the following values:
++
++ PATH_OFF: Pathname, if any, is to be stripped
++ PATH_REL: The relative pathname is to be included
++ PATH_ABS: The full pathname is to be included
++
++ After handling pathnames, conversion is done to the result as
++ in the zltor() description if convert != 0; if relative or
++ absolute pathnames are included, they are converted to UNIX
++ format, i.e. with slash (/) as the directory separator. The max
++ parameter specifies the maximum size of fn2. If convert > 0,
++ the regular conversions are done; if convert < 0, minimal
++ conversions are done (we skip uppercasing the letters, we allow
++ more than one period, etc; this can be used when we know our
++ partner is UNIX or similar).
++
++ #endif /* NZLTOR */
++
++ int
++ nzxpand(fn,flags) char *fn; int flags;
++ Replaces zxpand(), which is obsolete as of C-Kermit 7.0.
++ Call with:
++ fn = Pointer to filename or pattern.
++ flags = option bits:
++ flags & ZX_FILONLY Match regular files
++ flags & ZX_DIRONLY Match directories
++ flags & ZX_RECURSE Descend through directory tree
++ flags & ZX_MATCHDOT Match "dot files"
++ flags & ZX_NOBACKUP Don't match "backup files"
++ flags & ZX_NOLINKS Don't follow symlinks.
++
++ Returns the number of files that match fn, with data structures
++ set up so the first file (if any) will be returned by the next
++ znext() call. If ZX_FILONLY and ZX_DIRONLY are both set, or
++ neither one is set, files and directories are matched. Notes:
++
++ 1. It is essential that the number returned by nzxpand() reflect
++ the actual number of filenames that will be returned by
++ znext() calls. In other words:
++ for (n = nzxpand(string,flags); n > 0; n--) {
++ znext(buf);
++ printf("%s\n", buf);
++ }
++ should print all the file names; no more, no less.
++ 2. In UNIX, DOS, OS-9, etc, where directories contain entries
++ for themselves (.) and the superior directory (..), these
++ should NOT be included in the list under any circumstances,
++ including when ZX_MATCHDOT is set.
++ 3. Additional option bits might be added in the future, e.g. for
++ sorting (sort by date/name/size, reverse/ascending, etc).
++ Currently this is done only in higher level code (through a
++ hack in which the nzxpand() exports its filename array, which
++ is not portable because not all OS's can use this mechanism).
++
++ int
++ zmail(addr,fn) char *addr, fn;
++ Send the local, existing file fn as e-mail to the address addr.
++ Returns:
++ 0: on success
++ 2: if mail delivered but temp file can't be deleted
++ -2: if mail can't be delivered
++
++ int
++ zmkdir(path) char *path;
++ The path can be a file specification that might contain
++ directory information, in which the filename is expected to be
++ included, or an unambiguous directory specification (e.g. in
++ UNIX it must end with "/"). This routine attempts to create any
++ directories in the given path that don't already exist. Returns
++ 0 or greater success: no directories needed creation, or else
++ all directories that needed creation were created successfully;
++ the return code is the number of directories that were created.
++ Returns -1 on failure to create any of the needed directories.
++
++ int
++ zrmdir(path) char *path;
++ Attempts to remove the given directory. Returns 0 on success,
++ -1 on failure. The detailed semantics are open -- should it
++ fail if the directory contains any files or subdirectories,
++ etc. It is probably best for this routine to behave in whatever
++ manner is customary on the underlying platform; e.g. in UNIX,
++ VMS, DOS, etc, where directories can not be removed unless they
++ are empty.
++
++ VOID
++ znewn(fn,s) char *fn, **s;
++ Transforms the name fn into a filename that is guaranteed to be
++ unique. If the file fn does not exist, then the new name is the
++ same as fn; Otherwise, it's different. this function does its
++ best, returns no value. New name is created in caller's space.
++ Call like this: znewn(old,&new);. The second parameter is a
++ pointer to the new name. This pointer is set by znewn() to
++ point to a static string in its own space, so be sure to the
++ result to a safe place before calling this function again.
++
++ int
++ znext(fn) char *fn;
++ Copies the next file name from a file list created by zxpand()
++ into the string pointed to by fn (see zxpand). If no more
++ files, then the null string is placed there. Returns 0 if there
++ are no more filenames, with 0th element the array pointed to by
++ fn set to NUL. If there is a filename, it is stored in the
++ array pointed to by fn and a positive number is returned. NOTE:
++ This is a change from earlier definitions of this function
++ (pre-1999), which returned the number of files remaining; thus
++ 0 was the return value when returning the final file. However,
++ no mainline code ever depended on the return value, so this
++ change should be safe.
++
++ int
++ zopeni(n,fn) int n; char *fn;
++ Opens the file named fn for input as file number n. Returns:
++ 0: on failure.
++ 1: on success.
++
++ int
++ zopeno(n,fn,zz,fcb) int n; char *name; struct zattr *zz; struct
++ filinfo *fcb;
++ Attempts to open the named file for output as file number n. zz
++ is a Kermit file attribute structure as defined in ckcdeb.h,
++ containing various information about the file, including its
++ size, creation date, and so forth. This function should attempt
++ to honor as many of these as possible. fcb is a "file control
++ block" in the traditional sense, defined in ckcdeb.h,
++ containing information relevant to complicated file systems
++ like VMS (RMS), IBM MVS, etc, like blocksize, record length,
++ organization, record format, carriage control, etc. Returns:
++ 0: on failure.
++ 1: on success.
++
++ int
++ zoutdump()
++ Dumps a file output buffer. Used with the macro zmchout()
++ defined in ckcker.h. Used only with file number ZOFILE, i.e.
++ the file that is being received by Kermit during file transfer.
++ Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ zprint(p,fn) char *p, *f;
++ Prints the file with name fn on a local printer, with options
++ p. Returns:
++ 0: on success
++ 3: if file sent to printer but can't be deleted
++ -3: if file can't be printed
++
++ int
++ zrename(fn,fn2) char *fn, *fn2;
++ Changes the name of file fn to fn2. If fn2 is the name of an
++ existing directory, or a file-structured device, then file fn
++ is moved to that directory or device, keeping its original
++ name. If fn2 lacks a directory separator when passed to this
++ function, an appropriate one is supplied. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ zcopy(source,dest) char * source, * dest;
++ Copies the source file to the destination. One file only. No
++ wildcards. The destination string may be a filename or a
++ directory name. Returns:
++ 0: on success.
++ <0: on failure:
++ -2: source file is not a regular file.
++ -3: source file not found.
++ -4: permission denied.
++ -5: source and destination are the same file.
++ -6: i/o error.
++ -1: other error.
++
++ char *
++ zlocaltime(char *)
++ Call with: "yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss" GMT/UTC date-time. Returns
++ pointer to local date-time string "yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss" on
++ success, NULL on failure.
++
++ VOID
++ zrtol(fn,fn2) char *fn, *fn2;
++ Remote-To-Local filename translation. OBSOLETE: replaced by
++ nzrtol(). Translates a "standard" filename to a local filename.
++ For example, in Unix this function might convert an
++ all-uppercase name to lowercase, but leave lower- or mix-case
++ names alone. Does its best, returns no value. New name is in
++ string pointed to by fn2. No length checking is done.
++
++ #ifdef NZLTOR
++ int
++ nzrtol(fn,fn2,convert,pathnames,max) char *fn1,*fn2; int
++ convert,pathnames,max;
++ Replaces zrtol. Like zrtol but handles pathnames and checks
++ length. See nzltor for detailed description of parameters.
++
++ #endif /* NZLTOR */
++
++ int
++ zsattr(xx) struct zattr *xx;
++ Fills in a Kermit file attribute structure for the file which
++ is to be sent, namely the currently open ZIFILE. Note that this
++ is not a very good design, but we're stuck with it. Callers
++ must ensure that zsattr() is called only on real files, not on
++ pipes, internally generated file-like objects such as server
++ REMOTE command responses, etc. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success with the structure filled in.
++ If any string member is null, it should be ignored by the
++ caller.
++ If any numeric member is -1, it should be ignored by the
++ caller.
++
++ int
++ zshcmd(s) char *s;
++ s contains to pointer to a command to be executed by the host
++ computer's shell, command parser, or operating system. If the
++ system allows the user to choose from a variety of command
++ processors (shells), then this function should employ the
++ user's preferred shell. If possible, the user's job
++ (environment, process, etc) should be set up to catch keyboard
++ interruption signals to allow the user to halt the system
++ command and return to Kermit. The command must run in ordinary,
++ unprivileged user mode. If possible, this function should
++ return -1 on failure to start the command, or else it should
++ return 1 if the command succeeded and 0 if it failed.
++
++ int
++ pexitstatus
++ zshcmd() and zsyscmd() should set this to the command's actual
++ exit status code if possible.
++
++ int
++ zsyscmd(s) char *s;
++ s contains to pointer to a command to be executed by the host
++ computer's shell, command parser, or operating system. If the
++ system allows the user to choose from a variety of command
++ processors (shells), then this function should employ the
++ system standard shell (e.g. /bin/sh for Unix), so that the
++ results will always be the same for everybody. If possible, the
++ user's job (environment, process, etc) should be set up to
++ catch keyboard interruption signals to allow the user to halt
++ the system command and return to Kermit. The command must run
++ in ordinary, unprivileged user mode. If possible, this function
++ should return -1 on failure to start the command, or else it
++ should return 1 if the command succeeded and 0 if it failed.
++
++ VOID
++ z_exec(s,args) char * s; char * args[];
++ This one executes the command s (which is searched for using
++ the system's normal searching mechanism, such as PATH in UNIX),
++ with the given argument vector, which follows the conventions
++ of UNIX argv[]: the name of the command pointed to by element
++ 0, the first arg by element 1, and so on. A null args[] pointer
++ indicates the end of the arugment list. All open files must
++ remain open so the exec'd process can use them. Returns only if
++ unsuccessful.
++
++ int
++ zsinl(n,s,x) int n, x; char *s;
++ Reads a line from file number n. Writes the line into the
++ address s provided by the caller. Writing terminates when
++ newline is read, but with newline discarded. Writing also
++ terminates upon EOF or if length x is exhausted. Returns:
++ -1: on EOF or error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ zsout(n,s) int n; char *s;
++ Writes the string s out to file number n. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ zsoutl(n,s) int n; char *s;
++ Writes the string s out to file number n and adds a line
++ (record) terminator (boundary) appropriate for the system and
++ the file format. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ zsoutx(n,s,x) int n, x; char *s;
++ Writes exactly x characters from string s to file number n. If
++ s has fewer than x characters, then the entire string s is
++ written. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ >= 0: on success, the number of characters actually written.
++
++ int
++ zstime(fn,yy,x) char *fn; struct zattr *yy; int x;
++ Sets the creation date (and other attributes) of an existing
++ file, or compares a file's creation date with a given date.
++ Call with:
++
++ fn: pointer to name of existing file.
++ yy: Pointer to a Kermit file attribute structure in which yy->date.val
++ is a date of the form yyyymmdd hh:mm:ss, e.g. 19900208 13:00:00, which
++ is to be used for setting or comparing the file date. Other attributes
++ in the struct can also be set, such as the protection/permission (See
++ [110]Appendix I), when it makes sense (e.g. "yy->lprotect.val" can be
++ set if the remote system ID matches the local one).
++ x: A function code: 0 means to set the file's creation date as given.
++ 1 means compare the date from the yy struct with the file's date.
++
++ Returns:
++ -1: on any kind of error.
++ 0: if x is 0 and the file date was set successfully.
++ 0: if x is 1 and date from attribute structure > file
++ creation date.
++ 1: if x is 1 and date from attribute structure <= file
++ creation date.
++
++ VOID
++ zstrip(name,name2) char *name, **name2;
++ Strips pathname from filename "name". Constructs the resulting
++ string in a static buffer in its own space and returns a
++ pointer to it in name2. Also strips device name, file version
++ numbers, and other "non-name" material.
++
++ int
++ zxcmd(n,s) char *s;
++ Runs a system command so its output can be accessed as if it
++ were file n. The command is run in ordinary, unprivileged user
++ mode.
++ If n is ZSTDIO or ZCTERM, returns -1.
++ If n is ZIFILE or ZRFILE, then Kermit reads from the command,
++ otherwise Kermit writes to the command.
++ Returns 0 on error, 1 on success.
++
++ int
++ zxpand(fn) char *fn;
++ OBSOLETE: Replaced by nzxpand(), q.v.
++
++ #ifdef ZXREWIND
++ int
++ zxrewind()
++ Returns the number of files returned by the most recent
++ nzxpand() call, and resets the list to the beginning so the
++ next znext() call returns the first file. Returns -1 if zxpand
++ has not yet been called. If this function is available,
++ ZXREWIND should be defined; otherwise it should not be
++ referenced.
++
++ #endif /* ZXREWIND */
++
++ int
++ xsystem(cmd) char *cmd;
++ Executes the system command without redirecting any of its i/o,
++ similar (well, identical) to system() in Unix. But before
++ passing the command to the system, xsystem() ensures that all
++ privileges are turned off, so that the system command executes
++ in ordinary unprivileged user mode. If possible, xsystem()
++ returns the return code of the command that was executed.
++
++ 4.E.2.2. IKSD Variables and Functions
++
++ These must be implemented in any C-Kermit version that is to be
++ installed as an Internet Kermit Service Daemon (IKSD). IKSD is
++ expected to be started by the Internet Daemon (e.g. inetd) with its
++ standard i/o redirected to the incoming connection.
++
++ int ckxanon;
++ Nonzero if anonymous logins allowed.
++
++ extern int inserver;
++ Nonzero if started in IKSD mode.
++
++ extern int isguest;
++ Nonzero if IKSD and user logged in anonymously.
++
++ extern char * homdir;
++ Pointer to user's home directory.
++
++ extern char * anonroot;
++ Pointer to file-system root for anonymous users.
++
++ Existing functions must make "if (inserver && isguest)" checks for
++ actions that would not be legal for guests: zdelete(), zrmdir(),
++ zprint(), zmail(), etc.
++
++ int
++ zvuser(name) char * name;
++ Verifies that user "name" exists and is allowed to log in. If
++ the name is "ftp" or "anonymous" and ckxanon != 0, a guest
++ login is set up. Returns 0 if user not allowed to log in,
++ nonzero if user may log in.
++
++ int
++ zvpass(string) char * string;
++ Verifies password of the user from the most recent zvuser()
++ call. Returns nonzero if password is valid for user, 0 if it
++ isn't. Makes any appropriate system log entries (IKSD logins,
++ failed login attempts, etc). If password is valid, logs the
++ user in as herself (if real user), or sets up restricted
++ anonymous access if user is guest (e.g. changes file-system
++ root to anonroot and sets isguest = 1).
++
++ VOID
++ zsyslog()
++ Begins any desired system logging of an IKSD session.
++
++ VOID
++ zvlogout()
++ Terminates an IKSD session. In most cases this is simply a
++ wrapper for exit() or doexit(), with some system logging added.
++
++ 4.E.2.3. Privilege Functions
++
++ These functions are used by C-Kermit to adapt itself to operating
++ systems where the program can be made to run in a "privileged" mode,
++ e.g. setuid or setgid in Unix. C-Kermit should NOT read and write
++ files or start subprocesses as a privileged program. This would
++ present a serious threat to system security. The security package has
++ been installed to prevent such security breaches by turning off the
++ program's special privileges at all times except when they are needed.
++
++ In UNIX, the only need Kermit has for privileged status is access to
++ the UUCP lockfile directory, in order to read, create, and destroy
++ lockfiles, and to open communication devices that are normally
++ protected against the user (see the [111]Unix C-Kermit Installation
++ Instructions for discussion). Therefore, privileges should only be
++ enabled for these operations and disabled at all other times. This
++ relieves the programmer of the responsibility of putting expensive and
++ unreliable access checks around every file access and subprocess
++ creation.
++
++ Strictly speaking, these functions are not required in all C-Kermit
++ implementations, because their use (so far, at least) is internal to
++ the Group E modules. However, they should be included in all C-Kermit
++ implementations for operating systems that support the notion of a
++ privileged program (UNIX, RSTS/E, what others?).
++
++ int
++ priv_ini()
++ Determine whether the program is running in privileged status.
++ If so, turn off the privileges, in such a way that they can be
++ turned on again when needed. Called from sysinit() at program
++ startup time. Returns:
++ 0 on success
++ nonzero on failure, in which case the program should halt
++ immediately.
++
++ int
++ priv_on()
++ If the program is not privileged, this function does nothing.
++ If the program is privileged, this function returns it to
++ privileged status. priv_ini() must have been called first.
++ Returns:
++ 0 on success
++ nonzero on failure
++
++ int
++ priv_off()
++ Turns privileges off (if they are on) in such a way that they
++ can be turned back on again. Returns:
++ 0 on success
++ nonzero on failure
++
++ int
++ priv_can()
++ Turns privileges off in such a way that they cannot be turned
++ back on. Returns:
++ 0 on success
++ nonzero on failure
++
++ int
++ priv_chk()
++ Attempts to turns privileges off in such a way that they can be
++ turned on again later. Then checks to make sure that they were
++ really turned off. If they were not really turned off, then
++ they are cancelled permanently. Returns:
++ 0 on success
++ nonzero on failure
++
++ 4.E.2.4. Console-Related Functions
++
++ These relate to the program's "console", or controlling terminal, i.e.
++ the terminal that the user is logged in on and types commands at, or
++ on a PC or workstation, the actual keyboard and screen.
++
++ int
++ conbin(esc) char esc;
++ Puts the console into "binary" mode, so that Kermit's command
++ parser can control echoing and other treatment of characters
++ that the user types. esc is the character that will be used to
++ get Kermit's attention during packet mode; puts this in a
++ global place. Sets the ckxech variable. Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ concb(esc) char esc;
++ Put console in "cbreak" (single-character wakeup) mode. That
++ is, ensure that each console character is available to the
++ program immediately when the user types it. Otherwise just like
++ conbin(). Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ conchk()
++ Returns a number, 0 or greater, the number of characters
++ waiting to be read from the console, i.e. the number of
++ characters that the user has typed that have not been read yet
++ by Kermit.
++
++ long
++ congspd();
++ Returns the speed ("baud rate") of the controlling terminal, if
++ known, otherwise -1L.
++
++ int
++ congks(timo) int timo;
++ Get Keyboard Scancode. Reads a keyboard scan code from the
++ physical console keyboard. If the timo parameter is greater
++ than zero, then times out and returns -2 if no character
++ appears within the given number of seconds. Upon any other kind
++ of error, returns -1. Upon success returns a scan code, which
++ may be any positive integer. For situations where scan codes
++ cannot be read (for example, when an ASCII terminal is used as
++ the job's controlling terminal), this function is identical to
++ coninc(), i.e. it returns an 8-bit character value. congks() is
++ for use with workstations whose keyboards have Alternate,
++ Command, Option, and similar modifier keys, and Function keys
++ that generate codes greater than 255.
++
++ int
++ congm()
++ Console get modes. Gets the current console terminal modes and
++ saves them so that conres() can restore them later. Returns 1
++ if it got the modes OK, 0 if it did nothing (e.g. because
++ Kermit is not connected with any terminal), -1 on error.
++
++ int
++ coninc(timo) int timo;
++ Console Input Character. Reads a character from the console. If
++ the timo parameter is greater than zero, then coninc() times
++ out and returns -2 if no character appears within the given
++ number of seconds. Upon any other kind of error, returns -1.
++ Upon success, returns the character itself, with a value in the
++ range 0-255 decimal.
++
++ VOID
++ conint(f,s) SIGTYP (*f)(), (*s)();
++ Sets the console to generate an interrupt if the user types a
++ keyboard interrupt character, and to transfer control the
++ signal-handling function f. For systems with job control, s is
++ the address of the function that suspends the job. Sets the
++ global variable "backgrd" to zero if Kermit is running in the
++ foreground, and to nonzero if Kermit is running in the
++ background. See ckcdeb.h for the definition of SIGTYP. No
++ return value.
++
++ VOID
++ connoi()
++ Console no interrupts. Disable keyboard interrupts on the
++ console. No return value.
++
++ int
++ conoc(c) char c;
++ Writes character c to the console terminal. Returns:
++ 0 on failure, 1 on success.
++
++ int
++ conol(s) char *s;
++ Writes string s to the console. Returns -1 on error, 0 or
++ greater on success.
++
++ int
++ conola(s) char *s[]; {
++ Writes an array of strings to the console. Returns -1 on error,
++ 0 or greater on success.
++
++ int
++ conoll(s) char *s;
++ Writes string s to the console, followed by the necessary line
++ termination characters to put the console cursor at the
++ beginning of the next line. Returns -1 on error, 0 or greater
++ on success.
++
++ int
++ conres()
++ Restores the console terminal to the modes obtained by congm().
++ Returns: -1 on error, 0 on success.
++
++ int
++ conxo(x,s) int x; char *s;
++ Write x characters from string s to the console. Returns 0 or
++ greater on success, -1 on error.
++
++ char *
++ conkbg();
++ Returns a pointer to the designator of the console keyboard
++ type. For example, on a PC, this function would return "88",
++ "101", etc. Upon failure, returns a pointer to the empty
++ string.
++
++ 4.E.2.5. Communications Functions
++
++ The communication device is the device used for terminal emulation and
++ file transfer. It may or may not be the same device as the console,
++ and it may or may not be a terminal (serial-port) device; it could
++ also be a network connection. For brevity, the communication device is
++ referred to here as the "tty". When the communication device is the
++ same as the console device, Kermit is said to be in remote mode. When
++ the two devices are different, Kermit is in local mode.
++
++ int
++ ttchk()
++ Returns the number of characters that have arrived at the
++ communication device but have not yet been read by ttinc(),
++ ttinl(), and friends. If communication input is buffered (and
++ it should be), this is the sum of the number of unread
++ characters in Kermit's buffer PLUS the number of unread
++ characters in the operating system's internal buffer. The call
++ must be nondestructive and nonblocking, and as inexpensive as
++ possible. Returns:
++ 0: or greater on success,
++ 0: in case of internal error,
++ -1: or less when it determines the connection has been broken,
++ or there is no connection.
++
++ That is, a negative return from ttchk() should reliably
++ indicate that there is no usable connection. Furthermore,
++ ttchk() should be callable at any time to see if the connection
++ is open. When the connection is open, every effort must be made
++ to ensure that ttchk returns an accurate number of characters
++ waiting to be read, rather than just 0 (no characters) or 1 (1
++ or more characters), as would be the case when we use select().
++ This aspect of ttchk's operation is critical to successful
++ operation of sliding windows and streaming, but "nondestructive
++ buffer peeking" is an obscure operating system feature, and so
++ when it is not available, we have to do it ourselves by
++ managing our own internal buffer at a level below ttinc(),
++ ttinl(), etc, as in the UNIX version (non-FIONREAD case).
++
++ An external global variable, clsondisc, if nonzero, means that
++ if a serial connection drops (carrier on-to-off transition
++ detected by ttchk()), the device should be closed and released
++ automatically.
++
++ int
++ ttclos()
++ Closes the communication device (tty or network). If there were
++ any kind of exclusive access locks connected with the tty,
++ these are released. If the tty has a modem connection, it is
++ hung up. For true tty devices, the original tty device modes
++ are restored. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ ttflui()
++ Flush communications input buffer. If any characters have
++ arrived but have not yet been read, discard these characters.
++ If communications input is buffered by Kermit (and it should
++ be), this function flushes Kermit's buffer as well as the
++ operating system's internal input buffer. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ ttfluo()
++ Flush tty output buffer. If any characters have been written
++ but not actually transmitted (e.g. because the system has been
++ flow-controlled), remove them from the system's output buffer.
++ (Note, this function is not actually used, but it is
++ recommended that all C-Kermit programmers add it for future
++ use, even if it is only a dummy function that returns 0
++ always.)
++
++ int
++ ttgmdm()
++ Looks for the modem signals CTS, DSR, and CTS, and returns
++ those that are on in as its return value, in a bit mask as
++ described for ttwmdm, in which a bit is on (1) or off (0)
++ according to whether the corresponding signal is on (asserted)
++ or off (not asserted). Return values:
++ -3: Not implemented
++ -2: if the line does not have modem control
++ -1: on error
++ >=0: on success, with bit mask containing the modem signals.
++
++ long
++ ttgspd()
++ Returns the current tty speed in BITS (not CHARACTERS) per
++ second, or -1 if it is not known or if the tty is really a
++ network, or upon any kind of error. On success, the speed
++ returned is the actual number of bits per second, like 1200,
++ 9600, 19200, etc.
++
++ int
++ ttgwsiz()
++ Get terminal window size. Returns -1 on error, 0 if the window
++ size can't be obtained, 1 if the window size has been
++ successfully obtained. Upon success, the external global
++ variables tt_rows and tt_cols are set to the number of screen
++ rows and number of screen columns, respectively. As this
++ function is not implemented in all ck*tio.c modules, calls to
++ it must be wrapped in #ifdef CK_TTGWSIZ..#endif. NOTE: This
++ function must be available to use the TELNET NAWS feature
++ (Negotiate About Window Size) as well as Rlogin.
++
++ int
++ tthang()
++ Hang up the current tty device. For real tty devices, turn off
++ DTR for about 1/3-1/2 second (or other length of time,
++ depending on the system). If the tty is really a network
++ connection, close it. Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: if it does not even try to hang up.
++ 1: if it believes it hung up successfully.
++
++ VOID
++ ttimoff()
++ Turns off all pending timer interrupts.
++
++ int
++ ttinc(timo) int timo; (function is old, return codes are new)
++ Reads one character from the communication device. If timo is
++ greater than zero, wait the given number of seconds and then
++ time out if no character arrives, otherwise wait forever for a
++ character. Returns:
++ -3: internal error (e.g. tty modes set wrong)
++ -2: communications disconnect
++ -1: timeout or other error
++ >=0: the character that was read.
++ It is HIGHLY RECOMMENDED that ttinc() be internally buffered so
++ that calls to it are relatively inexpensive. If it is possible
++ to to implement ttinc() as a macro, all the better, for example
++ something like:
++
++ #define ttinc(t) ( (--txbufn >= 0) ? txbuf[ttbufp++] : txbufr(t) )
++
++ (see description of txbufr() below)
++
++ int
++ ttinl(dest,max,timo,eol,start,turn) int max,timo,turn; CHAR
++ *dest, eol, start;
++ ttinl() is Kermit's packet reader. Reads a packet from the
++ communications device, or up to max characters, whichever
++ occurs first. A line is a string of characters starting with
++ the start character up to and including the character given in
++ eol or until the length is exhausted, or, if turn != 0, until
++ the line turnaround character (turn) is read. If turn is 0,
++ ttinl() *should* use the packet length field to detect the end,
++ to allow for the possibility that the eol character appears
++ unprefixed in the packet data. (The turnaround character is for
++ half-duplex linemode connections.)
++
++ If timo is greater than zero, ttinl() times out if the eol
++ character is not encountered within the given number of seconds
++ and returns -1.
++
++ The characters that were input are copied into "dest" with
++ their parity bits stripped if parity is not none. The first
++ character copied into dest should be the start character, and
++ the last should be the final character of the packet (the last
++ block check character). ttinl() should also absorb and discard
++ the eol and turn characters, and any other characters that are
++ waiting to be read, up until the next start character, so that
++ subsequent calls to ttchk() will not succeed simply because
++ there are some terminators still sitting in the buffer that
++ ttinl() didn't read. This operation, if performed, MUST NOT
++ BLOCK (so if it can't be performed in a guaranteed nonblocking
++ way, don't do it).
++
++ On success, ttinl() returns the number of characters read.
++ Optionally, ttinl() can sense the parity of incoming packets.
++ If it does this, then it should set the global variable ttprty
++ accordingly. ttinl() should be coded to be as efficient as
++ possible, since it is at the "inner loop" of packet reception.
++ ttinl() returns:
++ -1: Timeout or other possibly correctable error.
++ -2: Interrupted from keyboard.
++ -3: Uncorrectable i/o error -- connection lost, configuration
++ problem, etc.
++ >=0: on success, the number of characters that were actually
++ read and placed in the dest buffer, not counting the trailing
++ null.
++
++ int
++ ttoc(c) char c;
++ Outputs the character c to the communication line. If the
++ operation fails to complete within two seconds, this function
++ returns -1. Otherwise it returns the number of characters
++ actually written to the tty (0 or 1). This function should only
++ be used for interactive, character-mode operations, like
++ terminal connection, script execution, dialer i/o, where the
++ overhead of the signals and alarms does not create a
++ bottleneck. (THIS DESCRIPTION NEEDS IMPROVEMENT -- If the
++ operation fails within a "certain amount of time"... which
++ might be dependent on the communication method, speed, etc. In
++ particular, flow-control deadlocks must be accounted for and
++ broken out of to prevent the program from hanging indefinitely,
++ etc.)
++
++ int
++ ttol(s,n) int n; char *s;
++ Kermit's packet writer. Writes the n characters of the string
++ pointed to to by s. NOTE: It is ttol's responsibility to write
++ ALL of the characters, not just some of them. Returns:
++ -1: on a possibly correctable error (so it can be retried).
++ -3: on a fatal error, e.g. connection lost.
++ >=0: on success, the actual number of characters written (the
++ specific number is not actually used for anything).
++
++ int
++ ttopen(ttname,lcl,modem,timo) char *ttname; int *lcl, modem,
++ timo;
++ Opens a tty device, if it is not already open. ttopen must
++ check to make sure the SAME device is not already open; if it
++ is, ttopen returns successfully without doing anything. If a
++ DIFFERENT device is currently open, ttopen() must call ttclos()
++ to close it before opening the new one.
++
++ Parameters:
++
++ ttname:
++ character string - device name or network host
++ name.
++
++ lcl:
++ If called with lcl < 0, sets value of lcl as
++ follows:
++ 0: the terminal named by ttname is the job's
++ controlling terminal.
++ 1: the terminal named by ttname is not the job's
++ controlling terminal.
++ If the device is already open, or if the requested
++ device can't be opened, then lcl remains (and is
++ returned as) -1.
++
++ modem:
++ Less than zero: this is the negative of the network
++ type, and ttname is a network host name. Network
++ types (from [112]ckcnet.h:
++
++ NET_TCPB 1 TCP/IP Berkeley (socket) (implemented in [113]ckutio.c)
++ NET_TCPA 2 TCP/IP AT&T (streams) (not yet implemented)
++ NET_DEC 3 DECnet (not yet implemented)
++
++ Zero or greater: ttname is a terminal device name.
++ Zero means a direct connection (don't use modem
++ signals). Positive means use modem signals
++ depending on the current setting of ttcarr (see
++ ttscarr()).
++
++ timo:
++ > 0: number of seconds to wait for open() to return
++ before timing out.
++ <=0: no timer, wait forever (e.g. for incoming
++ call).
++ For real tty devices, ttopen() attempts to gain
++ exclusive access to the tty device, for example in
++ UNIX by creating a "lockfile" (in other operating
++ systems, like VMS, exclusive access probably
++ requires no special action).
++
++ Side effects:
++ Copies its arguments and the tty file descriptor to
++ global variables that are available to the other
++ tty-related functions, with the lcl value altered as
++ described above. Gets all parameters and settings
++ associated with the line and puts them in a global area,
++ so that they can be restored by ttres(), e.g. when the
++ device is closed.
++
++ Returns:
++ 0: on success
++ -5: if device is in use
++ -4: if access to device is denied
++ -3: if access to lock mechanism denied
++ -2: upon timeout waiting for device to open
++ -1: on other error
++
++ int
++ ttpkt(speed,flow,parity) long speed; int flow, parity;
++ Puts the currently open tty device into the appropriate modes
++ for transmitting and receiving Kermit packets.
++
++ Arguments:
++
++ speed:
++ if speed > -1, and the device is a true tty device,
++ and Kermit is in local mode, ttpkt also sets the
++ speed.
++
++ flow:
++ if in the range 0-3, ttpkt selects the
++ corresponding type of flow control. Currently 0 is
++ defined as no flow control, 1 is Xon/Xoff, and no
++ other types are defined. If (and this is a horrible
++ hack, but it goes back many years and will be hard
++ to eradicate) flow is 4, then the appropriate tty
++ modes are set for modem dialing, a special case in
++ which we talk to a modem-controlled line without
++ requiring carrier. If flow is 5, then we require
++ carrier.
++
++ parity:
++ This is simply copied into a global variable so
++ that other functions (like ttinl, ttinc, etc) can
++ use it.
++
++ Side effects:
++ Copies its arguments to global variables, flushes the
++ terminal device input buffer.
++
++ Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ ttsetflow(int)
++ Enables the given type of flow control on the open serial
++ communications device immediately. Arguments are the FLO_xxx
++ values from ckcdeb.h, except FLO_DIAL, FLO_DIAX, or FLO_AUTO,
++ which are not actual flow-control types. Returns 0 on success,
++ -1 on failure.
++
++ #ifdef TTSPDLIST
++ long *
++ ttspdlist()
++ Returns a pointer to an array of longs, or NULL on failure. On
++ success, element 0 of the array contains number, n, indicating
++ how many follow. Elements 1-n are serial speeds, expressed in
++ bits per second, that are legal on this platform. The user
++ interface may use this list to construct a menu, keyword table,
++ etc.
++
++ #endif /* TTSPDLIST */
++
++ int
++ ttres()
++ Restores the tty device to the modes and settings that were in
++ effect at the time it was opened (see ttopen). Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ ttruncmd(string) char * string;
++ Runs the given command on the local system, but redirects its
++ input and output to the communication (SET LINE, SET PORT, or
++ SET HOST) device. Returns:
++ 0: on failure.
++ 1: on success.
++
++ int
++ ttscarr(carrier) int carrier;
++ Copies its argument to a variable that is global to the other
++ tty-related functions, and then returns it. The values for
++ carrier are defined in ckcdeb.h: CAR_ON, CAR_OFF, CAR_AUTO.
++ ttopen(), ttpkt(), and ttvt() use this variable when deciding
++ how to open the tty device and what modes to select. The
++ meanings are these:
++
++ CAR_OFF: Ignore carrier at all times.
++ CAR_ON: Require carrier at all times, except when dialing. This means,
++ for example, that ttopen() could hang forever waiting for carrier if
++ it is not present.
++ CAR_AUTO: If the modem type is zero (i.e. the connection is direct),
++ this is the same as CAR_OFF. If the modem type is positive, then heed
++ carrier during CONNECT (ttvt mode), but ignore it at other times
++ (packet mode, during SET LINE, etc). Compatible with pre-5A versions
++ of C-Kermit. This should be the default carrier mode.
++
++ Kermit's DIAL command ignores the carrier setting, but
++ ttopen(), ttvt(), and ttpkt() all honor the carrier option in
++ effect at the time they are called. None of this applies to
++ remote mode (the tty device is the job's controlling terminal)
++ or to network host connections (modem type is negative).
++
++ int
++ ttsndb()
++ Sends a BREAK signal on the tty device. On a real tty device,
++ send a real BREAK lasting approximately 275 milliseconds. If
++ this is not possible, simulate a BREAK by (for example)
++ dropping down some very low baud rate, like 50, and sending a
++ bunch of null characters. On a network connection, do the
++ appropriate network protocol for BREAK. Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ ttsndlb()
++ Like ttsndb(), but sends a "Long BREAK" (approx 1.5 seconds).
++ For network connections, it is identical to ttsndb().
++ Currently, this function is used only if CK_LBRK is defined (as
++ it is for UNIX and VMS).
++
++ int
++ ttsspd(cps) int cps;
++ For serial devices only, set the device transmission speed to
++ (note carefully) TEN TIMES the argument. The argument is in
++ characters per second, but transmission speeds are in bits per
++ second. cps are used rather than bps because high speeds like
++ 38400 are not expressible in a 16-bit int but longs cannot be
++ used because keyword-table values are ints and not longs. If
++ the argument is 7, then the bps is 75, not 70. If the argument
++ is 888, this is a special code for 75/1200 split-speed
++ operation (75 bps out, 1200 bps in). Returns:
++ -1: on error, meaning the requested speed is not valid or
++ available.
++ >=0: on success (don't try to use this value for anything).
++
++ int
++ ttvt(speed,flow) long speed; int flow;
++ Puts the currently open tty device into the appropriate modes
++ for terminal emulation. The arguments are interpreted as in
++ ttpkt(). Side effects: ttvt() stores its arguments in global
++ variables, and sets a flag that it has been called so that
++ subsequent calls can be ignored so long as the arguments are
++ the same as in the last effective call. Other functions, such
++ as ttopen(), ttclose(), ttres(), ttvt(), etc, that change the
++ tty device in any way must unset this flag. In UNIX Kermit,
++ this flag is called tvtflg.
++
++ int
++ ttwmdm(mdmsig,timo) int mdmsig, timo;
++ Waits up to timo seconds for all of the given modem signals to
++ appear. mdmsig is a bit mask, in which a bit is on (1) or off
++ (0) according to whether the corresponding signal is to be
++ waited for. These symbols are defined in ckcdeb.h:
++ BM_CTS (bit 0) means wait for Clear To Send
++ BM_DSR (bit 1) means wait for Data Set Ready
++ BM_DCD (bit 2) means wait for Carrier Detect
++ Returns:
++ -3: Not implemented.
++ -2: This line does not have modem control.
++ -1: Timeout: time limit exceeded before all signals were
++ detected.
++ 1: Success.
++
++ int
++ ttxin(n,buf) int n; CHAR *buf;
++ Reads x characters from the tty device into the specified buf,
++ stripping parity if parity is not none. This call waits
++ forever, there is no timeout. This function is designed to be
++ called only when you know that at least x characters are
++ waiting to be read (as determined, for example, by ttchk()).
++ This function should use the same buffer as ttinc().
++
++ int
++ txbufr(timo) int timo;
++ Reads characters into the internal communications input buffer.
++ timo is a timeout interval, in seconds. 0 means no timeout,
++ wait forever. Called by ttinc() (and possibly ttxin() and
++ ttinl()) when the communications input buffer is empty. The
++ buffer should be called ttxbuf[], its length is defined by the
++ symbol TXBUFL. The global variable txbufn is the number of
++ characters available to be read from ttxbuf[], and txbufp is
++ the index of the next character to be read. Should not be
++ called if txbufn > 0, in which case the buffer does not need
++ refilling. This routine returns:
++ -2: Communications disconnect
++ -1: Timeout
++ >=0: A character (0 - 255) On success, the first character that
++ was read, with the variables txbufn and txbufp set
++ appropriately for any remaining characters.
++ NOTE: Currently this routine is used internally only by the
++ UNIX and VMS versions. The aim is to make it available to all
++ versions so there is one single coherent and efficient way of
++ reading from the communications device or network.
++
++ 4.E.2.6. Miscellaneous system-dependent functions
++
++ VOID
++ ztime(s) char **s;
++ Returns a pointer, s, to the current date-and-time string in s.
++ This string must be in the fixed-field format associated with
++ the C runtime asctime() function, like: "Sun Sep 16 13:23:45
++ 1973\n" so that callers of this function can extract the
++ different fields. The pointer value is filled in by ztime, and
++ the data it points to is not safe, so should be copied to a
++ safe place before use. ztime() has no return value. As a side
++ effect, this routine can also fill in the following two
++ external variables (which must be defined in the
++ system-dependendent modules for each platform):
++ long ztusec: Fraction of seconds of clock time, microseconds.
++ long ztmsec: Fraction of seconds of clock time, milliseconds.
++ If these variables are not set by zstime(), they remain at
++ their initial value of -1L.
++
++ int
++ gtimer()
++ Returns the current value of the elapsed time counter in
++ seconds (see rtimer), or 0 on any kind of error.
++
++ #ifdef GFTIMER
++ CKFLOAT
++ gftimer()
++ Returns the current value of the elapsed time counter in
++ seconds, as a floating point number, capable of representing
++ not only whole seconds, but also the fractional part, to the
++ millisecond or microsecond level, whatever precision is
++ available. Requires a function to get times at subsecond
++ precision, as well as floating-point support. That's why it's
++ #ifdef'd.
++
++ #endif /* GFTIMER */
++
++ int
++ msleep(m) int m;
++ Sleeps (pauses, does nothing) for m milliseconds (a millisecond
++ is one thousandth of a second). Returns:
++ -1: on failure.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ VOID
++ rtimer()
++ Sets the elapsed time counter to zero. If you want to time how
++ long an operation takes, call rtimer() when it starts and
++ gtimer when it ends. rtimer() has no return value.
++
++ #ifdef GFTIMER
++ VOID
++ rftimer()
++ Sets the elapsed time counter to zero. If you want to time how
++ long an operation takes, call rftimer() when it starts and
++ gftimer when it ends. rftimer() has no return value. Note:
++ rftimer() is to be used with gftimer() and rtimer() is to be
++ used with gtimer(). See the rftimer() description.
++
++ #endif /* GFTIMER */
++
++ int
++ sysinit()
++ Does whatever needs doing upon program start. In particular, if
++ the program is running in any kind of privileged mode, turns
++ off the privileges (see priv_ini()). Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ syscleanup()
++ Does whatever needs doing upon program exit. Returns:
++ -1: on error.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ int
++ psuspend()
++ Suspends the Kermit process, puts it in the background so it
++ can be continued ("foregrounded") later. Returns:
++ -1: if this function is not supported.
++ 0: on success.
++
++ [ [114]Contents ] [ [115]C-Kermit ] [ [116]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.F. Group F: Network Support
++
++ As of version 5A, C-Kermit includes support for several networks.
++ Originally, this was just worked into the ttopen(), ttclos(), ttinc(),
++ ttinl(), and similar routines in [117]ckutio.c. But this made it
++ impossible to share this code with non-UNIX versions, like VMS,
++ AOS/VS, OS/2, etc. So as of edit 168, network code has been separated
++ out into its own module and header file, ckcnet.c and ckcnet.h:
++
++ [118]ckcnet.h: Network-related symbol definitions.
++ [119]ckcnet.c: Network i/o (TCP/IP, X.25, etc), shared by most
++ platforms.
++ [120]cklnet.c: Network i/o (TCP/IP, X.25, etc) specific to Stratus
++ VOS.
++
++ The routines and variables in these modules fall into two categories:
++
++ 1. Support for specific network packages like SunLink X.25 and TGV
++ MultiNet, and:
++ 2. support for specific network virtual terminal protocols like CCITT
++ X.3 and TCP/IP Telnet.
++
++ Category (1) functions are analogs to the tt*() functions, and have
++ names like netopen, netclos, nettinc, etc. Group A-D modules do not
++ (and must not) know anything about these functions -- they continue to
++ call the old Group E functions (ttopen, ttinc, etc). Category (2)
++ functions are protocol specific and have names prefixed by a protocol
++ identifier, like tn for telnet x25 for X.25.
++
++ ckcnet.h contains prototypes for all these functions, as well as
++ symbol definitions for network types, protocols, and network- and
++ protocol- specific symbols, as well as #includes for the header files
++ necessary for each network and protocol.
++
++ The following functions are to be provided for networks that do not
++ use normal system i/o (open, read, write, close):
++
++ int
++ netopen()
++ To be called from within ttopen() when a network connection is
++ requested. Calling conventions and purpose same as Group E
++ ttopen().
++
++ int
++ netclos()
++ To be called from within ttclos() when a network connection is
++ being closed. Calling conventions and purpose same as Group E
++ ttclos().
++
++ int
++ nettchk()
++ To be called from within ttchk(). Calling conventions and
++ purpose same as Group E ttchk().
++
++ int
++ netflui()
++ To be called from within ttflui(). Calling conventions and
++ purpose same as Group E ttflui().
++
++ int
++ netbreak()
++ To send a network break (attention) signal. Calling conventions
++ and purpose same as Group E ttsndbrk().
++
++ int
++ netinc()
++ To get a character from the network. Calling conventions same
++ as Group E ttsndbrk().
++
++ int
++ nettoc()
++ Send a "character" (byte) to the network. Calling conventions
++ same as Group E ttoc().
++
++ int
++ nettol()
++ Send a "line" (sequence of bytes) to the network. Calling
++ conventions same as Group E ttol().
++
++ Conceivably, some systems support network connections simply by
++ letting you open a device of a certain name and letting you do i/o to
++ it. Others (like the Berkeley sockets TCP/IP library on UNIX) require
++ you to open the connection in a special way, but then do normal i/o
++ (read, write). In such a case, you would use netopen(), but you would
++ not use nettinc, nettoc, etc.
++
++ VMS TCP/IP products have their own set of functions for all network
++ operations, so in that case the full range of netxxx() functions is
++ used.
++
++ The technique is to put a test in each corresponding ttxxx() function
++ to see if a network connection is active (or is being requested), test
++ for which kind of network it is, and if necessary route the call to
++ the corresponding netxxx() function. The netxxx() function must also
++ contain code to test for the network type, which is available via the
++ global variable ttnet.
++
++ [ [121]Contents ] [ [122]C-Kermit ] [ [123]Kermit Home ]
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.F.1. Telnet Protocol
++
++ (This section needs a great deal of updating...)
++
++ As of edit 195, Telnet protocol is split out into its own files, since
++ it can be implemented in remote mode, which does not have a network
++ connection:
++
++ [124]ckctel.h: Telnet protocol symbol definitions.
++ [125]ckctel.c: Telnet protocol.
++
++ The Telnet protocol is supported by the following variables and
++ routines:
++
++ int tn_init
++ Nonzero if telnet protocol initialized, zero otherwise.
++
++ int
++ tn_init()
++ Initialize the telnet protocol (send initial options).
++
++ int
++ tn_sopt()
++ Send a telnet option.
++
++ int
++ tn_doop()
++ Receive and act on a telnet option from the remote.
++
++ int
++ tn_sttyp()
++ Send terminal type using telnet protocol.
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.F.2. FTP Protocol
++
++ (To be filled in...)
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.F.3. HTTP Protocol
++
++ (To be filled in...)
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.F.4. X.25 Networks
++
++ These routines were written SunLink X.25 and have since been adapted
++ to at least on one other: IBM AIXLink/X.25.
++
++ int
++ x25diag()
++ Reads and prints X.25 diagnostics
++
++ int
++ x25oobh()
++ X.25 out of band signal handler
++
++ int
++ x25intr()
++ Sends X.25 interrupt packet
++
++ int
++ x25reset()
++ Resets X.25 virtual circuit
++
++ int
++ x25clear()
++ Clear X.25 virtual circuit
++
++ int
++ x25stat()
++ X.25 status
++
++ int
++ setqbit()
++ Sets X.25 Q-bit
++
++ int
++ resetqbit()
++ Resets X.25 Q-bit
++
++ int
++ x25xin()
++ Reads n characters from X.25 circuit.
++
++ int
++ x25inl()
++ Read a Kermit packet from X.25 circuit.
++
++ [ [126]Contents ] [ [127]C-Kermit ] [ [128]Kermit Home ]
++ ______________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.F.5. Adding New Network Types
++
++ Example: Adding support for IBM X.25 and Hewlett Packard X.25. First,
++ add new network type symbols for each one. There are already some
++ network types defined for other X.25 packages:
++
++ NET_SX25 is the network-type ID for SunLink X.25.
++ NET_VX25 is the network-type ID for VOS X.25.
++
++ So first you should new symbols for the new network types, giving them
++ the next numbers in the sequence, e.g.:
++
++#define NET_HX25 11 /* Hewlett-Packard X.25 */
++#define NET_IX25 12 /* IBM X.25 */
++
++ This is in ckcnet.h.
++
++ Then we need symbols to say that we are actually compiling in the code
++ for these platforms. These would be defined on the cc command line:
++
++ -DIBMX25 (for IBM)
++ -DHPX25 (for HP)
++
++ So we can build C-Kermit versions for AIX and HP-UX both with and
++ without X.25 support (since not all AIX and IBM systems have the
++ needed libraries, and so an executable that was linked with them might
++ no load).
++
++ Then in ckcnet.h:
++
++#ifdef IBMX25
++#define ANYX25
++#endif /* IBMX25 */
++
++#ifdef HPX25
++#define ANYX25
++#endif /* HPX25 */
++
++ And then use ANYX25 for code that is common to all of them, and IBMX25
++ or HPX25 for code specific to IBM or HP.
++
++ It might also happen that some code can be shared between two or more
++ of these, but not the others. Suppose, for example, that you write
++ code that applies to both IBM and HP, but not Sun or VOS X.25. Then
++ you add the following definition to ckcnet.h:
++
++#ifndef HPORIBMX25
++#ifdef HPX25
++#define HPORIBMX25
++#else
++#ifdef IBMX25
++#define HPORIBMX25
++#endif /* IBMX25 */
++#endif /* HPX25 */
++#endif /* HPORIBMX25 */
++
++ You can NOT use constructions like "#if defined (HPX25 || IBMX25)";
++ they are not portable.
++
++ [ [129]Contents ] [ [130]C-Kermit ] [ [131]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.G. Group G: Formatted Screen Support
++
++ So far, this is used only for the fullscreen local-mode file transfer
++ display. In the future, it might be extended to other uses. The
++ fullscreen display code is in and around the routine screenc() in
++ [132]ckuusx.c.
++
++ In the UNIX version, we use the curses library, plus one call from the
++ termcap library. In other versions (OS/2, VMS, etc) we insert dummy
++ routines that have the same names as curses routines. So far, there
++ are two methods for simulating curses routines:
++
++ 1. In VMS, we use the Screen Management Library (SMG), and insert
++ stubs to convert curses calls into SMG calls.
++ 2. In OS/2, we use the MYCURSES code, in which the stub routines
++ actually emit the appropriate escape sequences themselves.
++
++ Here are the stub routines:
++
++ int
++ tgetent(char *buf, char *term)
++ Arguments are ignored. Returns 1 if the user has a supported
++ terminal type, 0 otherwise. Sets a global variable (for
++ example, "isvt52" or "isdasher") to indicate the terminal type.
++
++ VOID
++ move(int row, int col)
++ Sends the escape sequence to position the cursor at the
++ indicated row and column. The numbers are 0-based, e.g. the
++ home position is 0,0.
++
++ int
++ clear()
++ Sends the escape sequence to clear the screen.
++
++ int
++ clrtoeol()
++ Sends the escape sequence to clear from the current cursor
++ position to the end of the line.
++
++ In the MYCURSES case, code must be added to each of the last three
++ routines to emit the appropriate escape sequences for a new terminal
++ type.
++
++ clearok(curscr), wrefresh()
++ In real curses, these two calls are required to refresh the
++ screen, for example after it was fractured by a broadcast
++ message. These are useful only if the underlying screen
++ management service keeps a copy of the entire screen, as curses
++ and SMG do. C-Kermit does not do this itself.
++
++ [ [133]Contents ] [ [134]C-Kermit ] [ [135]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.H. Group H: Pseudoterminal Support
++
++ (To be filled in...)
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ 4.I. Group I: Security
++
++ (To be filled in...)
++
++ [ [136]Contents ] [ [137]C-Kermit ] [ [138]Kermit Home ]
++ ________________________________________________________________________
++
++ APPENDIX I. FILE PERMISSIONS
++
++ I.1. Format of System-Dependent File Permissions in A-Packets
++
++ The format of this field (the "," attribute) is interpreted according
++ to the System ID ("." Attribute).
++
++ For UNIX (System ID = U1), it's the familiar 3-digit octal number, the
++ low-order 9 bits of the filemode: Owner, Group, World, e.g. 660 =
++ read/write access for owner and group, none for world, recorded as a
++ 3-digit octal string. High-order UNIX permission bits are not
++ transmitted.
++
++ For VMS (System ID = D7), it's a 4-digit hex string, representing the
++ 16-bit file protection WGOS fields (World,Group,Owner,System), in that
++ order (which is the reverse of how they're shown in a directory
++ listing); in each field, Bit 0 = Read, 1 = Write, 2 = Execute, 3 =
++ Delete. A bit value of 0 means permission is granted, 1 means
++ permission is denied. Sample:
++
++ r-01-00-^A/!FWERMIT.EXE'"
++ s-01-00-^AE!Y/amd/watsun/w/fdc/new/wermit.exe.DV
++ r-02-01-^A]"A."D7""B8#119980101 18:14:05!#8531&872960,$A20B-!7(#512@ #.Y
++ s-02-01-^A%"Y.5!
++
++ A VMS directory listing shows the file's protection as (E,RWED,RED,RE)
++ which really means (S=E,O=RWED,G=RED,W=RE), which is reverse order
++ from the internal storage, so (RE,RED,RWED,E). Now translate each
++ letter to its corresponding bit:
++
++ RE=0101, RED=1101, RWED=1111, E=0010
++
++ Now reverse the bits:
++
++ RE=1010, RED=0010, RWED=0000, E=1101
++
++ This gives the 16-bit quantity:
++
++ 1010001000001101
++
++ This is the internal representation of the VMS file permission; in
++ hex:
++
++ A20B
++
++ as shown in the sample packet above.
++
++ The VMS format probably would also apply to RSX or any other FILES-11
++ system.
++
++ I.2. Handling of Generic Protection
++
++ To be used when the two systems are different (and/or do not recognize
++ or understand each other's local protection codes).
++
++ First of all, the book is wrong. This should not be the World
++ protection, but the Owner protection. The other fields should be set
++ according to system defaults (e.g. UNIX umask, VMS default protection,
++ etc), except that no non-Owner field should give more permissions than
++ the Owner field.
++
++ [ [139]Top ] [ [140]Contents ] [ [141]C-Kermit Home ] [ [142]Kermit
++ Home ]
++ _________________________________________________________________
++
++
++ C-Kermit Program Logic Manual / [143]The Kermit Project /
++ [144]Columbia University / [145]kermit@columbia.edu / 10 April 2004
++
++References
++
++ 1. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/
++ 2. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 3. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html
++ 4. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 5. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 6. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x1
++ 7. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x2
++ 8. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x3
++ 9. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4
++ 10. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.A
++ 11. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.B
++ 12. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.C
++ 13. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.D
++ 14. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.E
++ 15. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.F
++ 16. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.G
++ 17. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.H
++ 18. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.I
++ 19. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#xa1
++ 20. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 21. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 22. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 23. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 24. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcpro.w
++ 25. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 26. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 27. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 28. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x3.2
++ 29. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 30. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 31. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 32. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.A
++ 33. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 34. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 35. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 36. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 37. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 38. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 39. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 40. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 41. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 42. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckclib.h
++ 43. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckclib.c
++ 44. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x3.1
++ 45. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 46. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 47. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 48. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcsym.h
++ 49. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcasc.h
++ 50. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcsig.h
++ 51. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcdeb.h
++ 52. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcker.h
++ 53. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcxla.h
++ 54. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcmai.c
++ 55. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcpro.w
++ 56. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcfns.c
++ 57. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcfn2.c
++ 58. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcfn3.c
++ 59. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.B
++ 60. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.E
++ 61. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.D
++ 62. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 63. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 64. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 65. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.B
++ 66. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuxla.c
++ 67. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuxla.h
++ 68. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcxla.h
++ 69. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuxla.h
++ 70. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckmxla.h
++ 71. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ck?xla
++ 72. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcuni.h
++ 73. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcuni.c
++ 74. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 75. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 76. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 77. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.B
++ 78. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckucmd.h
++ 79. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckucmd.c
++ 80. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.E
++ 81. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusr.h
++ 82. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusr.c
++ 83. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuus2.c
++ 84. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuus3.c
++ 85. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuus4.c
++ 86. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusy.c
++ 87. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusx.c
++ 88. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuver.h
++ 89. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuscr.c
++ 90. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckudia.c
++ 91. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckucon.c
++ 92. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckucns.c
++ 93. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x4.E
++ 94. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcmai.c
++ 95. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 96. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 97. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 98. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckufio.c
++ 99. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 100. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckusig.c
++ 101. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckvfio.c
++ 102. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckusig.c
++ 103. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcmai.c
++ 104. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 105. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 106. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 107. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 108. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckvtio.c
++ 109. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#x2
++ 110. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#xa1
++ 111. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckuins.html
++ 112. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.h
++ 113. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 114. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 115. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 116. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 117. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckutio.c
++ 118. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.h
++ 119. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckcnet.c
++ 120. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/cklnet.c
++ 121. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 122. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 123. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 124. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckctel.h
++ 125. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckctel.c
++ 126. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 127. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 128. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 129. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 130. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 131. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 132. ftp://kermit.columbia.edu/kermit/c-kermit/ckuusx.c
++ 133. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 134. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 135. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 136. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 137. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 138. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 139. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#top
++ 140. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckcplm.html#contents
++ 141. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++ 142. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 143. http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/index.html
++ 144. http://www.columbia.edu/
++ 145. mailto:kermit@columbia.edu
+--- /dev/null
++++ ckermit-212/ckaaaa.txt
+@@ -0,0 +1,385 @@
++ckaaaa.txt 10 Apr 2004
++
++ C-KERMIT VERSION 8.0.211
++ OVERVIEW OF FILES
++
++ Communications software for UNIX and (Open)VMS.
++
++ And in former versions also for:
++ Stratus VOS, AOS/VS, QNX,
++ Plan 9, OS-9, Apollo Aegis, and the Commodore Amiga.
++ The Apple Macintosh, the Atari ST.
++
++ The Kermit Project - Columbia University
++
++ http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ - kermit@columbia.edu
++
++
++ Copyright (C) 1985, 2004,
++ Trustees of Columbia University in the City of New York.
++ All rights reserved. See the C-Kermit COPYING.TXT file or the
++ copyright text in the ckcmai.c module for disclaimer and permissions.
++
++
++DOCUMENTATION
++
++ C-Kermit is documented in the book "Using C-Kermit", Second Edition, by
++ Frank da Cruz and Christine M. Gianone, Digital Press, ISBN 1-55558-164-1,
++ supplementated by Web-based updates for C-Kermit 7.0 and 8.0.
++
++PLATFORMS
++ Security
++ Name Included Last Updated
++
++ Unix Yes 8.0.211 10 Apr 2004
++ (Open)VMS No 8.0.208 10 Apr 2004
++ Windows (K95) Yes 8.0.208 14 Mar 2003 (K95 2.1)
++ OS/2 (K95) Yes 8.0.208 14 Mar 2003 (K95 2.1)
++ DG AOS/VS No 7.0.196 1 Jan 2000
++ Stratus VOS No 7.0.196 1 Jan 2000
++ Bell Plan 9 No 7.0.196 1 Jan 2000
++ Microware OS-9 No 7.0.196 1 Jan 2000
++ Commodore Amiga No 7.0.196 1 Jan 2000
++ Macintosh No 5A(190) 16 Aug 1994 (Mac Kermit 0.991)
++ Atari ST No 5A(189) 30 Jun 1993
++
++QUICK START FOR FTP USERS
++
++ If you have a Web browser, go to:
++
++ http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ckermit.html
++
++ And take it from there. Otherwise...
++
++ The definitive FTP source for Kermit software is kermit.columbia.edu.
++ Kermit software obtained from other FTP sites is not necessarily complete
++ or up to date, and may have been modified.
++
++C-Kermit for UNIX computers that have a C compiler and 'make' program:
++
++ Directory kermit/archives, binary mode, file cku211.tar.Z or cku211.tar.gz
++
++ This is a compressed tar archive of UNIX C-Kermit source code, makefile, and
++ other files. It unpacks into its current directory, so download it into a
++ fresh directory. Transfer in binary mode, uncompress (or gunzip), untar (tar
++ xvf cku211.tar), and then give the appropriate "make" command to build for
++ your UNIX system; read the comments in the makefile and ckuins.txt for
++ further info.
++
++C-Kermit for VMS:
++
++ If you have VMS UNZIP, get the file kermit/archives/ckv211.zip in binary
++ mode, unzip, and build with CKVKER.COM.
++
++Others: In the kermit/f or kermit/test directories under the appropriate
++prefixes, explained below.
++
++
++INSTALLATION
++
++Installation procedures depend on the system. Please read the CK?INS.TXT,
++if any, file for your system (?=U for UNIX, V for VMS, etc). Please note
++the naming and placement for the initialization files:
++
++ CKERMIT.INI
++ The standard initialization file. Please leave it as is unless you
++ know what you are doing and (if you are changing it or replacing it
++ for others to use) you are prepared to support it. Rename this file
++ to .kermrc in UNIX, OS-9, BeBox, or Plan 9. In Stratus VOS, rename
++ it ckermit.ini (lowercase). On multiuser systems, it goes either in the
++ (or EACH) user's home (login) directory, or else in a common shared
++ place if C-Kermit has been configured to look in that place (see
++ ckccfg.txt for details).
++
++ CKERMOD.INI
++ A *sample* customization file. On multiuser OS's, a copy of this file
++ goes in each user's home directory, and then each user edits it to suit
++ her needs and preferences; e.g. by defining macros for their common
++ connections.
++
++ DIALING DIRECTORIES
++ Dialing directory files can be system-wide, per-group, or per-user, or
++ any combination. For example, there can be a corporate wide directory
++ shared by all users, a supplemental directory for each division or
++ department, and a personal directory for each user. Simply be sure the
++ dialing directory files are identified a SET DIAL DIRECTORY command in
++ the user's (or the system-wide) C-Kermit initialization file, or in the
++ environment variable (logical name, symbol) K_DIAL_DIRECTORY. (The
++ standard initialization file looks by default in the user's home or login
++ directory.) When installing C-Kermit on multiuser platforms from which
++ users will dial out, you can also set environment variables for area
++ code, country code, and the various dialing prefixes as described on page
++ 478 of "Using C-Kermit" (second edition), so users don't have to worry
++ about defining these items themselves. Network directories and service
++ directories can also be set up in a similar manner.
++
++ DOCUMENTATION
++ In UNIX, the general C-Kermit man page (or one of the versions tailored
++ for a specific platform, like HP-UX or Solaris) should be installed in
++ the appropriate place. In VMS, the VMS help topic (CKVKER.HLP) should
++ be installed as described in CKVINS.TXT. Plain-text documentation such
++ as CKERMIT2.TXT should be put in whatever place people are accustomed
++ to looking.
++
++FILES AND FILE NAMING CONVENTIONS
++
++C-Kermit is a family of Kermit programs for many different computer systems.
++The program shares a common set of system-independent file transfer protocol
++modules, written in the C language. System-dependent operations are collected
++into system-specific modules for each system.
++
++C-Kermit file names all start with the letters "CK", followed by a single
++letter indicating the subgroup. When referring to these files in the UNIX,
++AOS/VS, or VOS environments, use lowercase letters, rather than the uppercase
++letters shown here. Subgroups:
++
++ _: Security/Authentication/Encryption code, possibly regulated by law
++ a: General descriptive material and documentation
++ b: BOO file encoders and decoders (obsolete)
++ c: All platforms with C compilers
++ d: Data General AOS/VS
++ e: Reserved for "ckermit" files, like CKERMIT.INI, CKERMIT80.TXT
++ f: (reserved)
++ g: (reserved)
++ h: (reserved)
++ i: Commodore Amiga (Intuition)
++ j: (unused)
++ k: (unused)
++ l: Stratus VOS
++ m: Macintosh with Mac OS
++ n: Microsoft Windows NT
++ o: OS/2 and/or Microsoft Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000/XP/...
++ p: Bell Labs Plan 9
++ q: (reserved)
++ r: DEC PDP-11 with RSTS/E (reserved)
++ s: Atari ST GEMDOS (last supported in version 5A(189))
++ t: DEC PDP-11 with RT-11 (reserved)
++ u: UNIX or environments with UNIX-like C libraries
++ v: VMS and OpenVMS
++ w: Wart (Lex-like preprocessor, used with all systems)
++ x: (reserved)
++ y: (reserved)
++ z: (reserved)
++ 0-3: (reserved)
++ 4: IBM AS/400 (reserved)
++ 5-8: (reserved)
++ 9: Microware OS-9
++
++Examples:
++
++ ckaaaa.txt - This file
++ ckufio.c - File i/o for UNIX
++ ckstio.c - Communications i/o for the Atari ST
++ makefile - makefile for building UNIX C-Kermit
++ ckpker.mk - makefile for building Plan 9 C-Kermit
++ ckvker.com - build procedure for VMS C-Kermit
++
++IMPORTANT FILES (use lowercase names on UNIX, VOS, or AOS/VS):
++
++ ckaaaa.txt - This file (overview of the C-Kermit files).
++ For system-specific distributions, this will normally
++ be replaced by a system-specific READ.ME file.
++
++ ckermit70.txt - Updates: Supplement to "Using C-Kermit", 2nd Ed, for 7.0.
++ ckermit80.txt - Updates: Supplement to "Using C-Kermit", 2nd Ed, for 8.0.
++ ckututor.txt - C-Kermit Tutorial for Unix (plain text)
++ ckcbwr.txt - "Beware file" (limitations, known bugs, hints), general.
++ ckermit.ini - Standard initialization file (rename to .kermrc in UNIX, OS-9)
++ ckermod.ini - Sample customization file (rename to .mykermrc in UNIX, OS-9)
++
++The following can be found at the Kermit FTP site:
++
++ ckermit.kdd - Sample dialing directory file (rename to .kdd in UNIX, OS-9)
++ ckermit.knd - Sample dialing directory file (rename to .knd in UNIX, OS-9)
++ ckermit.ksd - Sample services directory file (rename to .ksd in UNIX, OS-9)
++ ckedemo.ksc - Demonstration macros from "Using C-Kermit"
++ ckepage.ksc - Ditto
++ ckevt.ksc - Ditto
++
++UNIX-specific files:
++
++ ckuins.txt - UNIX-specific installation instructions.
++ ckubwr.txt - UNIX-specific beware file.
++ ckuker.nr - "man page" for UNIX.
++
++VMS-specific files:
++
++ ckvins.txt - VMS-specific installation instructions.
++ ckvbwr.txt - VMS-specific beware file
++ ckvker.hlp - VMS C-Kermit HELP topic (needs updating).
++
++DG AOS/VS-specific files:
++
++ ckdins.txt - Data General AOS/VS C-Kermit installation instructions
++ ckdbwr.txt - AOS/VS "beware" file
++ ckd*.cli - Procedures for building AOS/VS C-Kermit
++
++The following files are of interest mainly to programmers and historians
++(find them at the Kermit ftp site):
++
++ ckcker.ann - Release announcements.
++ ckccfg.txt - Configuration information (feature selection), general.
++ ckcplm.txt - Program logic manual (for programmers).
++ ckc211.txt - Program update history for edit 201-211.
++ ckc200.txt - Program update history for edit 198-200 (big)
++ ckc197.txt - Program update history for edit 195-197 (big)
++ ckc190.txt - Program update history for edits 189-190 (big).
++ ckc188.txt - Program update history, edits 179-188 (big).
++ ckc178.txt - Program edit history, 5A edits through 178 (very big).
++ ckcv4f.txt - Program edit history, version 4F.
++ ckcv4e.txt - Program edit history, version 4E.
++
++BINARIES
++
++If you have FTP access to kermit.columbia.edu (also known as
++kermit.cc.columbia.edu, ftp.cc.columbia.edu), you can also retrieve various
++C-Kermit binaries from the directory kermit/bin/ck*.*, or more conventiently
++from the web page:
++
++ http://www.columbia.edu/kermit/ck80binaries.html
++
++Test versions would be in kermit/test/bin/ck*.*. Be sure to transfer these
++files in binary mode. The READ.ME file in that directory explains what's
++what.
++
++SOURCE FILES
++
++The source files for the UNIX version (all UNIX versions) are available in
++kermit/archives/ckuNNN.tar.Z, approximately 1MB in size. Transfer this file
++in binary mode. This is a compressed tar archive. There is also a gzip'd
++version, cku211.tar.gz. To get the binary tar archive:
++
++ mkdir kermit (at shell prompt, make a Kermit directory)
++ cd kermit (make it your current directory)
++
++ ftp kermit.columbia.edu (make an ftp connection)
++ user: anonymous (log in as user "anonymous", lower case!)
++ password: (use your email id as a password)
++ cd kermit/archives (go to the archives directory)
++ type binary (specify binary file transfer)
++ get cku211.tar.Z (get the tar archive) (or get cku192.tar.gz)
++ bye (disconnect and exit from ftp)
++
++ uncompress cku211.tar.Z (at the shell prompt, uncompress the archive)
++ tar xvf cku211.tar (extract the files from the tar archive)
++ make xxx (build C-Kermit for your system)
++
++(where "xxx" is the makefile entry appropriate for your system.)
++
++All C-Kermit source and other text files are also kept separately in the
++kermit/f directory. The files necessary to build a particular implementation
++of C-Kermit are listed in the appropriate makefile or equivalent:
++
++ UNIX: makefile (or rename ckuker.mak to makefile)
++ 2.11 BSD: ckubs2.mak (rename to makefile), ckustr.sed
++ Plan 9: ckpker.mk (rename to mkfile)
++ Macintosh: ckmker.mak (rename to kermit.make, use MPW C 3.2)
++ VMS: CKVKER.COM (DCL) (and optionally also CKVKER.MMS)
++ or CKVOLD.COM (for VMS 4.x)
++ Amiga: CKIKER.MAK (Aztec C) or CKISAS.MAK (SAS C)
++ Atari ST: CKSKER.MAK
++ OS-9: ck9ker.mak or ck9ker.gcc
++ AOS/VS: ckdmak.cli, ckdcc.cli, ckdlnk.cli
++Stratus VOS: cklmak.cm
++
++Minimal source files for building selected versions (these patterns get all
++the files you need, and in some cases maybe a few extra):
++
++ UNIX: ck[cuw]*.[cwh] (including QNX, Plan 9, and BeBox)
++ UNIX: ck[cuw_]*.[cwh] (Unix with security modules)
++ VMS: ck[cuwv]*.[cwh]
++ Mac: ck[cuwm]*.[cwhr]
++ AOS/VS: ck[cuwd]*.[cwh]
++ VOS: ck[cwhl]*.[cwh]
++ Amiga: ck[cuwi]*.[cwh]
++ Atari: ck[cuws]*.[cwh]
++ OS-9: ck[cuw9]*.[cwha]
++
++For a detailed, specific source file list for this C-Kermit release, see the
++file ckcxxx.txt, where xxx is the current C-Kermit edit number, such as 211.
++
++Finally, here is a more detailed description of the C-Kermit file naming
++conventions. A C-Kermit filename has the form:
++
++ CK<system><what>.<type>
++
++where:
++
++<system> is described earlier in this file;
++
++<type> is the file type (use lowercase on UNIX, VOS, or AOS/VS):
++
++ c: C language source
++ h: Header file for C language source
++ w: Wart preprocessor source, converted by Wart (or Lex) to a C program
++ r: Macintosh resource file (8-bit text)
++ a: Assembler source
++
++ txt: Plain text.
++ nr: Nroff/Troff text formatter source for UNIX "man page"
++ mss: Scribe text formatter source
++ ps: Typeset material to be printed on a PostScript printer
++ hlp: A VMS Help topic
++
++ ini: Initialization file
++ ksc: A Kermit Script to be executed by the TAKE command
++ kdd: A Kermit Dialing Directory
++ knd: A Kermit Network Directory
++ ksd: A Kermit Services Directory
++
++ mak: A Makefile or other build procedure (often needs renaming)
++ com: (VMS only) a DCL command procedure
++ cli: (AOS/VS only) a command procedure
++ cmd: (OS/2 only) a Rexx command procedure
++
++ boo: "boo"-encoded executable program, decode with CKBUNB program.
++ hex: "hex"-encoded executable program, decode with CKVDEH program (VMS only).
++ hqx: BinHex'd Macintosh Kermit program, decode with BinHex version 4.0.
++ uue: A uuencoded binary file, decode with uudecode or (DG only) CKDECO.
++
++ def: An OS/2 linker definitions file.
++ sh: A UNIX shell script.
++ sed: A UNIX sed (editor) script.
++ str: A file of character strings extracted from C-Kermit (BSD 2.1x only).
++
++<what> is mnemonic (up to 3 characters) for what's in the file:
++
++NOTE: After C-Kermit 6.0, text filetypes such as .DOC and .HLP were changed
++to .TXT to avoid confusion in Windows-based Web browsers, which would
++otherwise mistake them for Microsoft Word or Windows Help documents.
++
++ aaa: A "read-me" file, like this one
++ ins: Installation instructions or procedures
++ bwr: "Beware" file -- things to watch out for, hints and tips
++ plm: Program Logic Manual
++ ker: General C-Kermit definitions, information, documentation
++
++ nnn: Digits: C-Kermit edit number (e.g. cku211.tar.gz)
++ cmd: Command parsing
++ con: CONNECT command
++ cns: CONNECT command (UNIX only - version that uses select(), not fork())
++ deb: Debug/Transaction Log formats, Typedefs
++ dia: Modem/Dialer control
++ fio: System-depdendent File I/O
++ fns: Protocol support functions
++ fn2: More protocol support functions (and FN3, ...)
++ lib: Common library routines module
++ mai: Main program
++ net: Network i/o module
++ pro: Protocol
++ scr: SCRIPT command
++ tel: Telnet protocol module
++ tio: System-dependent communications i/o & control and interrupt handing
++ sig: Signal handling module
++ usr: Interactive/script user interface
++ us2: More user interface (mainly help text)
++ us3: Still more user interface (and USR4, USR5, USR6, USR7)
++ usx: Common user interface functions
++ usy: Command-line parsing
++ xla: Character set translation module
++ uni: Unicode support
++ pty: Pseudoterminal support
++ mdb: Malloc-debugging module (not included in real builds)
++ str: Strings module (only for 2.xBSD)
++
++(End of ckaaaa.txt)